1 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2 . This is the primary source of the Exim Manual. It is an xfpt document that is
3 . converted into DocBook XML for subsequent conversion into printable and online
4 . formats. The markup used herein is "standard" xfpt markup, with some extras.
5 . The markup is summarized in a file called Markup.txt.
7 . WARNING: When you use the .new macro, make sure it appears *before* any
8 . adjacent index items; otherwise you get an empty "paragraph" which causes
9 . unwanted vertical space.
10 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
15 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
16 . This outputs the standard DocBook boilerplate.
17 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
23 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
24 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
26 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
31 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle; (&chapternumber;)"
32 toc_chapter_blanks="yes,yes"
33 table_warn_overflow="overprint"
37 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38 . This generates the outermost <book> element that wraps the entire document.
39 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
44 . These definitions set some parameters and save some typing.
45 . Update the Copyright year (only) when changing content.
46 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
48 .set previousversion "4.98"
49 .include ./local_params
51 .set ACL "access control lists (ACLs)"
52 .set I " "
54 .set drivernamemax "64"
60 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
61 . Additional xfpt markup used by this document, over and above the default
62 . provided in the xfpt library.
63 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
65 . --- Override the &$ flag to automatically insert a $ with the variable name.
67 .flag &$ $& "<varname>$" "</varname>"
69 . --- Short flags for daggers in option headings. They will always be inside
70 . --- an italic string, but we want the daggers to be in Roman.
72 .flag &!! "</emphasis>†<emphasis>"
73 .flag &!? "</emphasis>‡<emphasis>"
75 . --- A macro for an Exim option definition heading, generating a one-line
76 . --- table with four columns. For cases when the option name is given with
77 . --- a space, so that it can be split, a fifth argument is used for the
79 . --- Also one for multiple option def headings be grouped in a single
80 . --- table (but without the split capability).
83 .itable all 0 0 4 8* left 6* center 6* center 6* right
87 .row "&%$1%&" "Use: &'$2'&" "Type: &'$3'&" "Default: &'$4'&"
98 .orow "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
108 .orow "$+1" "$+2" "$+3" "$+4"
113 . --- A macro for the common 2-column tables. The width of the first column
114 . --- is suitable for the many tables at the start of the main options chapter;
115 . --- a small number of other 2-column tables override it.
117 .macro table2 196pt 254pt
118 .itable none 0 0 2 $1 left $2 left
122 . --- A macro for a plain variable, including the .vitem and .vindex
128 . --- A macro for a "tainted" marker, done as a one-element table
130 .itable none 0 0 1 10pt left
135 . --- A macro for a tainted variable, adding a taint-marker
141 . --- A macro for a cmdline option, including a .oindex
142 . --- 1st arg is the option name, undecorated (we do that here).
143 . --- 2nd arg, optional, text (decorated as needed) to be appended to the name
145 .vitem &%$1%&$=2+&~$2+
149 . --- A macro that generates .row, but puts &I; at the start of the first
150 . --- argument, thus indenting it. Assume a minimum of two arguments, and
151 . --- allow up to four arguments, which is as many as we'll ever need.
155 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
159 .row "&I;$1" "$2" "$3"
167 . --- Macros for option, variable, and concept index entries. For a "range"
168 . --- style of entry, use .scindex for the start and .ecindex for the end. The
169 . --- first argument of .scindex and the only argument of .ecindex must be the
170 . --- ID that ties them together.
171 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
172 . --- head, or list-item.
175 &<indexterm role="concept">&
176 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
178 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
184 &<indexterm role="concept" id="$1" class="startofrange">&
185 &<primary>&$2&</primary>&
187 &<secondary>&$3&</secondary>&
193 &<indexterm role="concept" startref="$1" class="endofrange"/>&
197 &<indexterm role="option">&
198 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
200 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
205 . --- The index entry points to the most-recent chapter head, section or subsection
206 . --- head, or varlist item.
209 &<indexterm role="variable">&
210 &<primary>&$1&</primary>&
212 &<secondary>&$2&</secondary>&
218 .echo "** Don't use .index; use .cindex or .oindex or .vindex"
222 . use this for a concept-index entry for a header line
224 .cindex "&'$1'& header line"
225 .cindex "header lines" $1
227 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
230 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
231 . The <bookinfo> element is removed from the XML before processing for ASCII
233 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
237 <title>Specification of the Exim Mail Transfer Agent</title>
238 <titleabbrev>The Exim MTA</titleabbrev>
242 <author><firstname>Exim</firstname><surname>Maintainers</surname></author>
243 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
244 <revhistory><revision>
246 <authorinitials>EM</authorinitials>
247 </revision></revhistory>
250 </year><holder>The Exim Maintainers</holder></copyright>
255 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
256 . These implement index entries of the form "x, see y" and "x, see also y".
257 . However, the DocBook DTD doesn't allow <indexterm> entries
258 . at the top level, so we have to put the .chapter directive first.
259 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
261 .chapter "Introduction" "CHID1"
265 <indexterm role="$2">
266 <primary>$3</primary>
268 <secondary>$5</secondary>
270 <$1><emphasis>$4</emphasis></$1>
275 . NB: for the 4-arg variant the ordering is awkward
277 .seeother see "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
280 .seeother seealso "$1" "$2" "$3" "$4"
283 .see variable "<emphasis>$1</emphasis>, <emphasis>$2</emphasis>, etc." "numerical variables"
284 .see concept address rewriting rewriting
285 .see concept "Bounce Address Tag Validation" BATV
286 .see concept "Client SMTP Authorization" CSA
287 .see concept "CR character" "carriage return"
288 .see concept CRL "certificate revocation list"
289 .seealso concept de-tainting "tainted data"
290 .see concept delivery "bounce message" "failure report"
291 .see concept dialup "intermittently connected hosts"
292 .see concept exiscan "content scanning"
293 .see concept fallover fallback
294 .see concept filter "Sieve filter" Sieve
295 .see concept headers "header lines"
296 .see concept ident "RFC 1413"
297 .see concept "LF character" "linefeed"
298 .seealso concept maximum limit
299 .see concept monitor "Exim monitor"
300 .see concept "no_<emphasis>xxx</emphasis>" "entry for xxx"
301 .see concept NUL "binary zero"
302 .see concept "passwd file" "/etc/passwd"
303 .see concept "process id" pid
304 .see concept RBL "DNS list"
305 .see concept redirection "address redirection"
306 .see concept "return path" "envelope sender"
307 .see concept scanning "content scanning"
309 .see concept string expansion expansion
310 .see concept "top bit" "8-bit characters"
311 .see concept variables "expansion, variables"
312 .see concept "zero, binary" "binary zero"
315 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
316 . This is the real start of the first chapter. See the comment above as to why
317 . we can't have the .chapter line here.
318 . chapter "Introduction"
319 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
321 Exim is a mail transfer agent (MTA) for hosts that are running Unix or
322 Unix-like operating systems. It was designed on the assumption that it would be
323 run on hosts that are permanently connected to the Internet. However, it can be
324 used on intermittently connected hosts with suitable configuration adjustments.
326 Configuration files currently exist for the following operating systems: AIX,
327 BSD/OS (aka BSDI), Darwin (Mac OS X), DGUX, Dragonfly, FreeBSD, GNU/Hurd,
328 GNU/Linux, HI-OSF (Hitachi), HI-UX, HP-UX, IRIX, MIPS RISCOS, NetBSD, OpenBSD,
329 OpenUNIX, QNX, SCO, SCO SVR4.2 (aka UNIX-SV), Solaris (aka SunOS5), SunOS4,
330 Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX, formerly DEC-OSF1), Ultrix, and UnixWare.
331 Some of these operating systems are no longer current and cannot easily be
332 tested, so the configuration files may no longer work in practice.
334 There are also configuration files for compiling Exim in the Cygwin environment
335 that can be installed on systems running Windows. However, this document does
336 not contain any information about running Exim in the Cygwin environment.
338 The terms and conditions for the use and distribution of Exim are contained in
339 the file &_NOTICE_&. Exim is distributed under the terms of the GNU General
340 Public Licence, a copy of which may be found in the file &_LICENCE_&.
342 The use, supply, or promotion of Exim for the purpose of sending bulk,
343 unsolicited electronic mail is incompatible with the basic aims of Exim,
344 which revolve around the free provision of a service that enhances the quality
345 of personal communications. The author of Exim regards indiscriminate
346 mass-mailing as an antisocial, irresponsible abuse of the Internet.
348 Exim owes a great deal to Smail 3 and its author, Ron Karr. Without the
349 experience of running and working on the Smail 3 code, I could never have
350 contemplated starting to write a new MTA. Many of the ideas and user interfaces
351 were originally taken from Smail 3, though the actual code of Exim is entirely
352 new, and has developed far beyond the initial concept.
354 Many people, both in Cambridge and around the world, have contributed to the
355 development and the testing of Exim, and to porting it to various operating
356 systems. I am grateful to them all. The distribution now contains a file called
357 &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_&, in which I have started recording the names of
361 .section "Exim documentation" "SECID1"
362 . Keep this example change bar when updating the documentation!
365 .cindex "documentation"
366 This edition of the Exim specification applies to version &version() of Exim.
367 Substantive changes from the &previousversion; edition are marked in some
368 renditions of this document; this paragraph is so marked if the rendition is
369 capable of showing a change indicator.
372 This document is very much a reference manual; it is not a tutorial. The reader
373 is expected to have some familiarity with the SMTP mail transfer protocol and
374 with general Unix system administration. Although there are some discussions
375 and examples in places, the information is mostly organized in a way that makes
376 it easy to look up, rather than in a natural order for sequential reading.
377 Furthermore, this manual aims to cover every aspect of Exim in detail, including
378 a number of rarely-used, special-purpose features that are unlikely to be of
381 .cindex "books about Exim"
382 An &"easier"& discussion of Exim which provides more in-depth explanatory,
383 introductory, and tutorial material can be found in a book entitled &'The Exim
384 SMTP Mail Server'& (second edition, 2007), published by UIT Cambridge
385 (&url(https://www.uit.co.uk/exim-book/)).
387 The book also contains a chapter that gives a general introduction to SMTP and
388 Internet mail. Inevitably, however, the book is unlikely to be fully up-to-date
389 with the latest release of Exim. (Note that the earlier book about Exim,
390 published by O'Reilly, covers Exim 3, and many things have changed in Exim 4.)
392 .cindex "Debian" "information sources"
393 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you will find information about
394 Debian-specific features in the file
395 &_/usr/share/doc/exim4-base/README.Debian_&.
396 The command &(man update-exim.conf)& is another source of Debian-specific
399 .cindex "&_doc/NewStuff_&"
400 .cindex "&_doc/ChangeLog_&"
402 As Exim develops, there may be features in newer versions that have not
403 yet made it into this document, which is updated only when the most significant
404 digit of the fractional part of the version number changes. Specifications of
405 new features that are not yet in this manual are placed in the file
406 &_doc/NewStuff_& in the Exim distribution.
408 Some features may be classified as &"experimental"&. These may change
409 incompatibly while they are developing, or even be withdrawn. For this reason,
410 they are not documented in this manual. Information about experimental features
411 can be found in the file &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
413 All changes to Exim (whether new features, bug fixes, or other kinds of
414 change) are noted briefly in the file called &_doc/ChangeLog_&.
416 .cindex "&_doc/spec.txt_&"
417 This specification itself is available as an ASCII file in &_doc/spec.txt_& so
418 that it can easily be searched with a text editor. Other files in the &_doc_&
422 .row &_OptionLists.txt_& "list of all options in alphabetical order"
423 .row &_dbm.discuss.txt_& "discussion about DBM libraries"
424 .row &_exim.8_& "a man page of Exim's command line options"
425 .row &_experimental.txt_& "documentation of experimental features"
426 .row &_filter.txt_& "specification of the filter language"
427 .row &_Exim3.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 2 to release 3"
428 .row &_Exim4.upgrade_& "upgrade notes from release 3 to release 4"
429 .row &_openssl.txt_& "installing a current OpenSSL release"
432 The main specification and the specification of the filtering language are also
433 available in other formats (HTML, PostScript, PDF, and Texinfo). Section
434 &<<SECTavail>>& below tells you how to get hold of these.
438 .section "FTP site and websites" "SECID2"
441 The primary site for Exim source distributions is the &%exim.org%& FTP site,
442 available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP. These services, and the &%exim.org%&
443 website, are hosted at the University of Cambridge.
447 As well as Exim distribution tar files, the Exim website contains a number of
448 differently formatted versions of the documentation. A recent addition to the
449 online information is &url(https://wiki.exim.org,the Exim wiki),
450 which contains what used to be a separate FAQ, as well as various other
451 examples, tips, and know-how that have been contributed by Exim users.
452 The wiki site should always redirect to the correct place, which is currently
453 provided by GitHub, and is open to editing by anyone with a GitHub account.
456 An Exim Bugzilla exists at &url(https://bugs.exim.org). You can use
457 this to report bugs, and also to add items to the wish list. Please search
458 first to check that you are not duplicating a previous entry.
459 Please do not ask for configuration help in the bug-tracker.
462 .section "Mailing lists" "SECID3"
463 .cindex "mailing lists" "for Exim users"
464 The following Exim mailing lists exist:
467 .row &'exim-announce@lists.exim.org'& "Moderated, low volume announcements list"
468 .row &'exim-users@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list"
469 .row &'exim-users-de@lists.exim.org'& "General discussion list in German language"
470 .row &'exim-dev@lists.exim.org'& "Discussion of bugs, enhancements, etc."
471 .row &'exim-cvs@lists.exim.org'& "Automated commit messages from the VCS"
474 You can subscribe to these lists, change your existing subscriptions, and view
475 or search the archives via the mailing lists link on the Exim home page.
476 .cindex "Debian" "mailing list for"
477 If you are using a Debian distribution of Exim, you may wish to subscribe to
478 the Debian-specific mailing list &'pkg-exim4-users@lists.alioth.debian.org'&
481 &url(https://alioth-lists.debian.net/cgi-bin/mailman/listinfo/pkg-exim4-users)
483 Please ask Debian-specific questions on that list and not on the general Exim
486 .section "Bug reports" "SECID5"
487 .cindex "bug reports"
488 .cindex "reporting bugs"
489 Reports of obvious bugs can be emailed to &'bugs@exim.org'& or reported
490 via &url(https://bugs.exim.org,the Bugzilla). However, if you are unsure
491 whether some behaviour is a bug or not, the best thing to do is to post a
492 message to the &'exim-dev'& mailing list and have it discussed.
496 .section "Where to find the Exim distribution" "SECTavail"
498 .cindex "HTTPS download site"
499 .cindex "distribution" "FTP site"
500 .cindex "distribution" "https site"
501 The master distribution site for the Exim distribution is
503 &url(https://downloads.exim.org/)
505 The service is available over HTTPS, HTTP and FTP.
506 We encourage people to migrate to HTTPS.
508 The content served at &url(https://downloads.exim.org/) is identical to the
509 content served at &url(https://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim) and
510 &url(ftp://ftp.exim.org/pub/exim).
512 If accessing via a hostname containing &'ftp'&, then the file references that
513 follow are relative to the &_exim_& directories at these sites.
514 If accessing via the hostname &'downloads'& then the subdirectories described
515 here are top-level directories.
517 There are now quite a number of independent mirror sites around
518 the world. Those that I know about are listed in the file called &_Mirrors_&.
520 Within the top exim directory there are subdirectories called &_exim3_& (for
521 previous Exim 3 distributions), &_exim4_& (for the latest Exim 4
522 distributions), and &_Testing_& for testing versions. In the &_exim4_&
523 subdirectory, the current release can always be found in files called
527 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2_&
529 where &'n.nn'& is the highest such version number in the directory. The three
530 files contain identical data; the only difference is the type of compression.
531 The &_.xz_& file is usually the smallest, while the &_.gz_& file is the
532 most portable to old systems.
534 .cindex "distribution" "signing details"
535 .cindex "distribution" "public key"
536 .cindex "public key for signed distribution"
537 The distributions will be PGP signed by an individual key of the Release
538 Coordinator. This key will have a uid containing an email address in the
539 &'exim.org'& domain and will have signatures from other people, including
540 other Exim maintainers. We expect that the key will be in the "strong set" of
541 PGP keys. There should be a trust path to that key from the Exim Maintainer's
542 PGP keys, a version of which can be found in the release directory in the file
543 &_Exim-Maintainers-Keyring.asc_&. All keys used will be available in public keyserver pools,
544 such as &'pool.sks-keyservers.net'&.
546 At the time of the last update, releases were being made by Jeremy Harris and signed
547 with key &'0xBCE58C8CE41F32DF'&. Other recent keys used for signing are those
548 of Heiko Schlittermann, &'0x26101B62F69376CE'&,
549 and of Phil Pennock, &'0x4D1E900E14C1CC04'&.
551 The signatures for the tar bundles are in:
553 &_exim-n.nn.tar.xz.asc_&
554 &_exim-n.nn.tar.gz.asc_&
555 &_exim-n.nn.tar.bz2.asc_&
557 For each released version, the log of changes is made available in a
558 separate file in the directory &_ChangeLogs_& so that it is possible to
559 find out what has changed without having to download the entire distribution.
561 .cindex "documentation" "available formats"
562 The main distribution contains ASCII versions of this specification and other
563 documentation; other formats of the documents are available in separate files
564 inside the &_exim4_& directory of the FTP site:
566 &_exim-html-n.nn.tar.gz_&
567 &_exim-pdf-n.nn.tar.gz_&
568 &_exim-postscript-n.nn.tar.gz_&
569 &_exim-texinfo-n.nn.tar.gz_&
571 These tar files contain only the &_doc_& directory, not the complete
572 distribution, and are also available in &_.bz2_& and &_.xz_& forms.
575 .section "Limitations" "SECID6"
577 .cindex "limitations of Exim"
578 .cindex "bang paths" "not handled by Exim"
579 Exim is designed for use as an Internet MTA, and therefore handles addresses in
580 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
581 domain format only. It cannot handle UUCP &"bang paths"&, though
582 simple two-component bang paths can be converted by a straightforward rewriting
583 configuration. This restriction does not prevent Exim from being interfaced to
584 UUCP as a transport mechanism, provided that domain addresses are used.
586 .cindex "domainless addresses"
587 .cindex "address" "without domain"
588 Exim insists that every address it handles has a domain attached. For incoming
589 local messages, domainless addresses are automatically qualified with a
590 configured domain value. Configuration options specify from which remote
591 systems unqualified addresses are acceptable. These are then qualified on
594 .cindex "transport" "external"
595 .cindex "external transports"
596 The only external transport mechanisms that are currently implemented are SMTP
597 and LMTP over a TCP/IP network (including support for IPv6). However, a pipe
598 transport is available, and there are facilities for writing messages to files
599 and pipes, optionally in &'batched SMTP'& format; these facilities can be used
600 to send messages to other transport mechanisms such as UUCP, provided they can
601 handle domain-style addresses. Batched SMTP input is also catered for.
603 Exim is not designed for storing mail for dial-in hosts. When the volumes of
604 such mail are large, it is better to get the messages &"delivered"& into files
605 (that is, off Exim's queue) and subsequently passed on to the dial-in hosts by
608 Although Exim does have basic facilities for scanning incoming messages, these
609 are not comprehensive enough to do full virus or spam scanning. Such operations
610 are best carried out using additional specialized software packages. If you
611 compile Exim with the content-scanning extension, straightforward interfaces to
612 a number of common scanners are provided.
616 .section "Runtime configuration" "SECID7"
617 Exim's runtime configuration is held in a single text file that is divided
618 into a number of sections. The entries in this file consist of keywords and
619 values, in the style of Smail 3 configuration files. A default configuration
620 file which is suitable for simple online installations is provided in the
621 distribution, and is described in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& below.
624 .section "Calling interface" "SECID8"
625 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "command line interface"
626 Like many MTAs, Exim has adopted the Sendmail command line interface so that it
627 can be a straight replacement for &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& or
628 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& when sending mail, but you do not need to know anything
629 about Sendmail in order to run Exim. For actions other than sending messages,
630 Sendmail-compatible options also exist, but those that produce output (for
631 example, &%-bp%&, which lists the messages in the queue) do so in Exim's own
632 format. There are also some additional options that are compatible with Smail
633 3, and some further options that are new to Exim. Chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&
634 documents all Exim's command line options. This information is automatically
635 made into the man page that forms part of the Exim distribution.
637 Control of messages in the queue can be done via certain privileged command
638 line options. There is also an optional monitor program called &'eximon'&,
639 which displays current information in an X window, and which contains a menu
640 interface to Exim's command line administration options.
644 .section "Terminology" "SECID9"
645 .cindex "terminology definitions"
646 .cindex "body of message" "definition of"
647 The &'body'& of a message is the actual data that the sender wants to transmit.
648 It is the last part of a message and is separated from the &'header'& (see
649 below) by a blank line.
651 .cindex "bounce message" "definition of"
652 When a message cannot be delivered, it is normally returned to the sender in a
653 delivery failure message or a &"non-delivery report"& (NDR). The term
654 &'bounce'& is commonly used for this action, and the error reports are often
655 called &'bounce messages'&. This is a convenient shorthand for &"delivery
656 failure error report"&. Such messages have an empty sender address in the
657 message's &'envelope'& (see below) to ensure that they cannot themselves give
658 rise to further bounce messages.
660 The term &'default'& appears frequently in this manual. It is used to qualify a
661 value which is used in the absence of any setting in the configuration. It may
662 also qualify an action which is taken unless a configuration setting specifies
665 The term &'defer'& is used when the delivery of a message to a specific
666 destination cannot immediately take place for some reason (a remote host may be
667 down, or a user's local mailbox may be full). Such deliveries are &'deferred'&
670 The word &'domain'& is sometimes used to mean all but the first component of a
671 host's name. It is &'not'& used in that sense here, where it normally refers to
672 the part of an email address following the @ sign.
674 .cindex "envelope, definition of"
675 .cindex "sender" "definition of"
676 A message in transit has an associated &'envelope'&, as well as a header and a
677 body. The envelope contains a sender address (to which bounce messages should
678 be delivered), and any number of recipient addresses. References to the
679 sender or the recipients of a message usually mean the addresses in the
680 envelope. An MTA uses these addresses for delivery, and for returning bounce
681 messages, not the addresses that appear in the header lines.
683 .cindex "message" "header, definition of"
684 .cindex "header section" "definition of"
685 The &'header'& of a message is the first part of a message's text, consisting
686 of a number of lines, each of which has a name such as &'From:'&, &'To:'&,
687 &'Subject:'&, etc. Long header lines can be split over several text lines by
688 indenting the continuations. The header is separated from the body by a blank
691 .cindex "local part" "definition of"
692 .cindex "domain" "definition of"
693 The term &'local part'&, which is taken from
694 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822), is used to refer to the
695 part of an email address that precedes the @ sign. The part that follows the
696 @ sign is called the &'domain'& or &'mail domain'&.
698 .cindex "local delivery" "definition of"
699 .cindex "remote delivery, definition of"
700 The terms &'local delivery'& and &'remote delivery'& are used to distinguish
701 delivery to a file or a pipe on the local host from delivery by SMTP over
702 TCP/IP to another host. As far as Exim is concerned, all hosts other than the
703 host it is running on are &'remote'&.
705 .cindex "return path" "definition of"
706 &'Return path'& is another name that is used for the sender address in a
709 .cindex "queue" "definition of"
710 The term &'queue'& is used to refer to the set of messages awaiting delivery
711 because this term is in widespread use in the context of MTAs. However, in
712 Exim's case, the reality is more like a pool than a queue, because there is
713 normally no ordering of waiting messages.
715 .cindex "queue runner" "definition of"
716 The term &'queue runner'& is used to describe a process that scans the queue
717 and attempts to deliver those messages whose retry times have come. This term
718 is used by other MTAs and also relates to the command &%runq%&, but in Exim
719 the waiting messages are normally processed in an unpredictable order.
721 .cindex "spool directory" "definition of"
722 The term &'spool directory'& is used for a directory in which Exim keeps the
723 messages in its queue &-- that is, those that it is in the process of
724 delivering. This should not be confused with the directory in which local
725 mailboxes are stored, which is called a &"spool directory"& by some people. In
726 the Exim documentation, &"spool"& is always used in the first sense.
733 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
734 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
736 .chapter "Incorporated code" "CHID2"
737 .cindex "incorporated code"
738 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
741 A number of pieces of external code are included in the Exim distribution.
744 Regular expressions are supported in the main Exim program and in the
745 Exim monitor using the freely-distributable PCRE2 library, copyright
746 © University of Cambridge. The source to PCRE2 is not longer shipped with
747 Exim, so you will need to use the version of PCRE2 shipped with your system,
748 or obtain and install the full version of the library from
749 &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
751 .cindex "cdb" "acknowledgment"
752 Support for the cdb (Constant DataBase) lookup method is provided by code
753 contributed by Nigel Metheringham of (at the time he contributed it) Planet
754 Online Ltd. The implementation is completely contained within the code of Exim.
755 It does not link against an external cdb library. The code contains the
756 following statements:
759 Copyright © 1998 Nigel Metheringham, Planet Online Ltd
761 This program is free software; you can redistribute it and/or modify it under
762 the terms of the GNU General Public License as published by the Free Software
763 Foundation; either version 2 of the License, or (at your option) any later
765 This code implements Dan Bernstein's Constant DataBase (cdb) spec. Information,
766 the spec and sample code for cdb can be obtained from
767 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html). This implementation borrows
768 some code from Dan Bernstein's implementation (which has no license
769 restrictions applied to it).
772 .cindex "SPA authentication"
773 .cindex "Samba project"
774 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
775 Client support for Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& is provided
776 by code contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux. Server support was contributed by
777 Tom Kistner. This includes code taken from the Samba project, which is released
781 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
782 .cindex "&'pwauthd'& daemon"
783 Support for calling the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& and &'saslauthd'& daemons is provided
784 by code taken from the Cyrus-SASL library and adapted by Alexander S.
785 Sabourenkov. The permission notice appears below, in accordance with the
786 conditions expressed therein.
789 Copyright © 2001 Carnegie Mellon University. All rights reserved.
791 Redistribution and use in source and binary forms, with or without
792 modification, are permitted provided that the following conditions
796 Redistributions of source code must retain the above copyright
797 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer.
799 Redistributions in binary form must reproduce the above copyright
800 notice, this list of conditions and the following disclaimer in
801 the documentation and/or other materials provided with the
804 The name &"Carnegie Mellon University"& must not be used to
805 endorse or promote products derived from this software without
806 prior written permission. For permission or any other legal
807 details, please contact
809 Office of Technology Transfer
810 Carnegie Mellon University
812 Pittsburgh, PA 15213-3890
813 (412) 268-4387, fax: (412) 268-7395
814 tech-transfer@andrew.cmu.edu
817 Redistributions of any form whatsoever must retain the following
820 &"This product includes software developed by Computing Services
821 at Carnegie Mellon University (&url(https://www.cmu.edu/computing/)."&
823 CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO
824 THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY
825 AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL CARNEGIE MELLON UNIVERSITY BE LIABLE
826 FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR ANY DAMAGES
827 WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS, WHETHER IN
828 AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION, ARISING
829 OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS SOFTWARE.
834 .cindex "Exim monitor" "acknowledgment"
837 The Exim Monitor program, which is an X-Window application, includes
838 modified versions of the Athena StripChart and TextPop widgets.
839 This code is copyright by DEC and MIT, and their permission notice appears
840 below, in accordance with the conditions expressed therein.
843 Copyright 1987, 1988 by Digital Equipment Corporation, Maynard, Massachusetts,
844 and the Massachusetts Institute of Technology, Cambridge, Massachusetts.
848 Permission to use, copy, modify, and distribute this software and its
849 documentation for any purpose and without fee is hereby granted,
850 provided that the above copyright notice appear in all copies and that
851 both that copyright notice and this permission notice appear in
852 supporting documentation, and that the names of Digital or MIT not be
853 used in advertising or publicity pertaining to distribution of the
854 software without specific, written prior permission.
856 DIGITAL DISCLAIMS ALL WARRANTIES WITH REGARD TO THIS SOFTWARE, INCLUDING
857 ALL IMPLIED WARRANTIES OF MERCHANTABILITY AND FITNESS, IN NO EVENT SHALL
858 DIGITAL BE LIABLE FOR ANY SPECIAL, INDIRECT OR CONSEQUENTIAL DAMAGES OR
859 ANY DAMAGES WHATSOEVER RESULTING FROM LOSS OF USE, DATA OR PROFITS,
860 WHETHER IN AN ACTION OF CONTRACT, NEGLIGENCE OR OTHER TORTIOUS ACTION,
861 ARISING OUT OF OR IN CONNECTION WITH THE USE OR PERFORMANCE OF THIS
866 .cindex "opendmarc" "acknowledgment"
867 The DMARC implementation uses the OpenDMARC library which is Copyrighted by
868 The Trusted Domain Project. Portions of Exim source which use OpenDMARC
869 derived code are indicated in the respective source files. The full OpenDMARC
870 license is provided in the LICENSE.opendmarc file contained in the distributed
874 Many people have contributed code fragments, some large, some small, that were
875 not covered by any specific license requirements. It is assumed that the
876 contributors are happy to see their code incorporated into Exim under the GPL.
883 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
884 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
886 .chapter "How Exim receives and delivers mail" "CHID11" &&&
887 "Receiving and delivering mail"
890 .section "Overall philosophy" "SECID10"
891 .cindex "design philosophy"
892 Exim is designed to work efficiently on systems that are permanently connected
893 to the Internet and are handling a general mix of mail. In such circumstances,
894 most messages can be delivered immediately. Consequently, Exim does not
895 maintain independent queues of messages for specific domains or hosts, though
896 it does try to send several messages in a single SMTP connection after a host
897 has been down, and it also maintains per-host retry information.
900 .section "Policy control" "SECID11"
901 .cindex "policy control" "overview"
902 Policy controls are now an important feature of MTAs that are connected to the
903 Internet. Perhaps their most important job is to stop MTAs from being abused as
904 &"open relays"& by misguided individuals who send out vast amounts of
905 unsolicited junk and want to disguise its source. Exim provides flexible
906 facilities for specifying policy controls on incoming mail:
909 .cindex "&ACL;" "introduction"
910 Exim 4 (unlike previous versions of Exim) implements policy controls on
911 incoming mail by means of &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs). Each list is a
912 series of statements that may either grant or deny access. ACLs can be used at
913 several places in the SMTP dialogue while receiving a message from a remote
914 host. However, the most common places are after each RCPT command, and at the
915 very end of the message. The sysadmin can specify conditions for accepting or
916 rejecting individual recipients or the entire message, respectively, at these
917 two points (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). Denial of access results in an SMTP
920 An ACL is also available for locally generated, non-SMTP messages. In this
921 case, the only available actions are to accept or deny the entire message.
923 When Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension, facilities are
924 provided in the ACL mechanism for passing the message to external virus and/or
925 spam scanning software. The result of such a scan is passed back to the ACL,
926 which can then use it to decide what to do with the message.
928 When a message has been received, either from a remote host or from the local
929 host, but before the final acknowledgment has been sent, a locally supplied C
930 function called &[local_scan()]& can be run to inspect the message and decide
931 whether to accept it or not (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). If the message
932 is accepted, the list of recipients can be modified by the function.
934 Using the &[local_scan()]& mechanism is another way of calling external scanner
935 software. The &%SA-Exim%& add-on package works this way. It does not require
936 Exim to be compiled with the content-scanning extension.
938 After a message has been accepted, a further checking mechanism is available in
939 the form of the &'system filter'& (see chapter &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&). This
940 runs at the start of every delivery process.
945 .section "User filters" "SECID12"
946 .cindex "filter" "introduction"
947 .cindex "Sieve filter"
948 In a conventional Exim configuration, users are able to run private filters by
949 setting up appropriate &_.forward_& files in their home directories. See
950 chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& (about the &(redirect)& router) for the
951 configuration needed to support this, and the separate document entitled
952 &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'& for user details. Two different kinds
953 of filtering are available:
956 Sieve filters are written in the standard filtering language that is defined
957 by &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3028.html,RFC 3028).
959 Exim filters are written in a syntax that is unique to Exim, but which is more
960 powerful than Sieve, which it pre-dates.
963 User filters are run as part of the routing process, described below.
967 .section "Message identification" "SECTmessiden"
968 .cindex "message ids" "details of format"
969 .cindex "format" "of message id"
970 .cindex "id of message"
975 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
976 Every message handled by Exim is given a &'message id'& which is 23
977 characters long. It is divided into three parts, separated by hyphens, for
978 example &`16VDhn-000000001bo-D342`&. Each part is a sequence of letters and digits,
979 normally encoding numbers in base 62. However, in the Darwin operating
980 system (Mac OS X) and when Exim is compiled to run under Cygwin, base 36
981 (avoiding the use of lower case letters) is used instead, because the message
982 id is used to construct filenames, and the names of files in those systems are
983 not always case-sensitive.
985 .cindex "pid (process id)" "re-use of"
986 The detail of the contents of the message id have changed as Exim has evolved.
987 Earlier versions relied on the operating system not re-using a process id (pid)
988 within one second. On modern operating systems, this assumption can no longer
989 be made, so the algorithm had to be changed. To retain backward compatibility,
990 the format of the message id was retained, which is why the following rules are
994 The first six characters of the message id are the time at which the message
995 started to be received, to a granularity of one second. That is, this field
996 contains the number of seconds since the start of the epoch (the normal Unix
997 way of representing the date and time of day).
999 After the first hyphen, the next
1001 characters are the id of the process that received the message.
1003 There are two different possibilities for the final four characters:
1005 .oindex "&%localhost_number%&"
1006 If &%localhost_number%& is not set, this value is the fractional part of the
1007 time of reception, normally in units of
1010 that must use base 36 instead of base 62 (because of case-insensitive file
1011 systems), the units are
1014 If &%localhost_number%& is set, it is multiplied by
1015 500000 (250000) and added to
1016 the fractional part of the time, which in this case is in units of 2 us (4 us).
1020 After a message has been received, Exim waits for the clock to tick at the
1021 appropriate resolution before proceeding, so that if another message is
1022 received by the same process, or by another process with the same (re-used)
1023 pid, it is guaranteed that the time will be different. In most cases, the clock
1024 will already have ticked while the message was being received.
1026 The exim_msgdate utility (see section &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>&) can be
1027 used to display the date, and optionally the process id, of an Exim
1031 .section "Receiving mail" "SECID13"
1032 .cindex "receiving mail"
1033 .cindex "message" "reception"
1034 The only way Exim can receive mail from another host is using SMTP over
1035 TCP/IP, in which case the sender and recipient addresses are transferred using
1036 SMTP commands. However, from a locally running process (such as a user's MUA),
1037 there are several possibilities:
1040 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bm%& option, the message is read
1041 non-interactively (usually via a pipe), with the recipients taken from the
1042 command line, or from the body of the message if &%-t%& is also used.
1044 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bS%& option, the message is also read
1045 non-interactively, but in this case the recipients are listed at the start of
1046 the message in a series of SMTP RCPT commands, terminated by a DATA
1047 command. This is called &"batch SMTP"& format,
1048 but it isn't really SMTP. The SMTP commands are just another way of passing
1049 envelope addresses in a non-interactive submission.
1051 If the process runs Exim with the &%-bs%& option, the message is read
1052 interactively, using the SMTP protocol. A two-way pipe is normally used for
1053 passing data between the local process and the Exim process.
1054 This is &"real"& SMTP and is handled in the same way as SMTP over TCP/IP. For
1055 example, the ACLs for SMTP commands are used for this form of submission.
1057 A local process may also make a TCP/IP call to the host's loopback address
1058 (127.0.0.1) or any other of its IP addresses. When receiving messages, Exim
1059 does not treat the loopback address specially. It treats all such connections
1060 in the same way as connections from other hosts.
1064 .cindex "message sender, constructed by Exim"
1065 .cindex "sender" "constructed by Exim"
1066 In the three cases that do not involve TCP/IP, the sender address is
1067 constructed from the login name of the user that called Exim and a default
1068 qualification domain (which can be set by the &%qualify_domain%& configuration
1069 option). For local or batch SMTP, a sender address that is passed using the
1070 SMTP MAIL command is ignored. However, the system administrator may allow
1071 certain users (&"trusted users"&) to specify a different sender addresses
1072 unconditionally, or all users to specify certain forms of different sender
1073 address. The &%-f%& option or the SMTP MAIL command is used to specify these
1074 different addresses. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of trusted
1075 users, and the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of allowing untrusted
1076 users to change sender addresses.
1078 Messages received by either of the non-interactive mechanisms are subject to
1079 checking by the non-SMTP ACL if one is defined. Messages received using SMTP
1080 (either over TCP/IP or interacting with a local process) can be checked by a
1081 number of ACLs that operate at different times during the SMTP session. Either
1082 individual recipients or the entire message can be rejected if local policy
1083 requirements are not met. The &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
1084 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) is run for all incoming messages.
1086 Exim can be configured not to start a delivery process when a message is
1087 received; this can be unconditional, or depend on the number of incoming SMTP
1088 connections or the system load. In these situations, new messages wait on the
1089 queue until a queue runner process picks them up. However, in standard
1090 configurations under normal conditions, delivery is started as soon as a
1091 message is received.
1097 .section "Handling an incoming message" "SECID14"
1098 .cindex "spool directory" "files that hold a message"
1099 .cindex "file" "how a message is held"
1100 When Exim accepts a message, it writes two files in its spool directory. The
1101 first contains the envelope information, the current status of the message, and
1102 the header lines, and the second contains the body of the message. The names of
1103 the two spool files consist of the message id, followed by &`-H`& for the
1104 file containing the envelope and header, and &`-D`& for the data file.
1106 .cindex "spool directory" "&_input_& sub-directory"
1107 By default, all these message files are held in a single directory called
1108 &_input_& inside the general Exim spool directory. Some operating systems do
1109 not perform very well if the number of files in a directory gets large; to
1110 improve performance in such cases, the &%split_spool_directory%& option can be
1111 used. This causes Exim to split up the input files into 62 sub-directories
1112 whose names are single letters or digits. When this is done, the queue is
1113 processed one sub-directory at a time instead of all at once, which can improve
1114 overall performance even when there are not enough files in each directory to
1115 affect file system performance.
1117 The envelope information consists of the address of the message's sender and
1118 the addresses of the recipients. This information is entirely separate from
1119 any addresses contained in the header lines. The status of the message includes
1120 a list of recipients who have already received the message. The format of the
1121 first spool file is described in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>&.
1123 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
1124 Address rewriting that is specified in the rewrite section of the configuration
1125 (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&) is done once and for all on incoming addresses,
1126 both in the header lines and the envelope, at the time the message is accepted.
1127 If during the course of delivery additional addresses are generated (for
1128 example, via aliasing), these new addresses are rewritten as soon as they are
1129 generated. At the time a message is actually delivered (transported) further
1130 rewriting can take place; because this is a transport option, it can be
1131 different for different forms of delivery. It is also possible to specify the
1132 addition or removal of certain header lines at the time the message is
1133 delivered (see chapters &<<CHAProutergeneric>>& and
1134 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
1138 .section "Life of a message" "SECID15"
1139 .cindex "message" "life of"
1140 .cindex "message" "frozen"
1141 A message remains in the spool directory until it is completely delivered to
1142 its recipients or to an error address, or until it is deleted by an
1143 administrator or by the user who originally created it. In cases when delivery
1144 cannot proceed &-- for example when a message can neither be delivered to its
1145 recipients nor returned to its sender, the message is marked &"frozen"& on the
1146 spool, and no more deliveries are attempted.
1148 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
1149 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
1150 An administrator can &"thaw"& such messages when the problem has been
1151 corrected, and can also freeze individual messages by hand if necessary. In
1152 addition, an administrator can force a delivery error, causing a bounce message
1155 .oindex "&%timeout_frozen_after%&"
1156 .oindex "&%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&"
1157 There are options called &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& and
1158 &%timeout_frozen_after%&, which discard frozen messages after a certain time.
1159 The first applies only to frozen bounces, the second to all frozen messages.
1161 .cindex "message" "log file for"
1162 .cindex "log" "file for each message"
1163 While Exim is working on a message, it writes information about each delivery
1164 attempt to its main log file. This includes successful, unsuccessful, and
1165 delayed deliveries for each recipient (see chapter &<<CHAPlog>>&). The log
1166 lines are also written to a separate &'message log'& file for each message.
1167 These logs are solely for the benefit of the administrator and are normally
1168 deleted along with the spool files when processing of a message is complete.
1169 The use of individual message logs can be disabled by setting
1170 &%no_message_logs%&; this might give an improvement in performance on very busy
1173 .cindex "journal file"
1174 .cindex "file" "journal"
1175 All the information Exim itself needs to set up a delivery is kept in the first
1176 spool file, along with the header lines. When a successful delivery occurs, the
1177 address is immediately written at the end of a journal file, whose name is the
1178 message id followed by &`-J`&. At the end of a delivery run, if there are some
1179 addresses left to be tried again later, the first spool file (the &`-H`& file)
1180 is updated to indicate which these are, and the journal file is then deleted.
1181 Updating the spool file is done by writing a new file and renaming it, to
1182 minimize the possibility of data loss.
1184 Should the system or Exim crash after a successful delivery but before
1185 the spool file has been updated, the journal is left lying around. The next
1186 time Exim attempts to deliver the message, it reads the journal file and
1187 updates the spool file before proceeding. This minimizes the chances of double
1188 deliveries caused by crashes.
1192 .section "Processing an address for delivery" "SECTprocaddress"
1193 .cindex "drivers" "definition of"
1194 .cindex "router" "definition of"
1195 .cindex "transport" "definition of"
1196 The main delivery processing elements of Exim are called &'routers'& and
1197 &'transports'&, and collectively these are known as &'drivers'&. Code for a
1198 number of them is provided in the source distribution, and compile-time options
1199 specify which ones are included in the binary. Runtime options specify which
1200 ones are actually used for delivering messages.
1202 .cindex "drivers" "instance definition"
1203 Each driver that is specified in the runtime configuration is an &'instance'&
1204 of that particular driver type. Multiple instances are allowed; for example,
1205 you can set up several different &(smtp)& transports, each with different
1206 option values that might specify different ports or different timeouts. Each
1207 instance has its own identifying name. In what follows we will normally use the
1208 instance name when discussing one particular instance (that is, one specific
1209 configuration of the driver), and the generic driver name when discussing
1210 the driver's features in general.
1212 A &'router'& is a driver that operates on an address, either determining how
1213 its delivery should happen, by assigning it to a specific transport, or
1214 converting the address into one or more new addresses (for example, via an
1215 alias file). A router may also explicitly choose to fail an address, causing it
1218 A &'transport'& is a driver that transmits a copy of the message from Exim's
1219 spool to some destination. There are two kinds of transport: for a &'local'&
1220 transport, the destination is a file or a pipe on the local host, whereas for a
1221 &'remote'& transport the destination is some other host. A message is passed
1222 to a specific transport as a result of successful routing. If a message has
1223 several recipients, it may be passed to a number of different transports.
1225 .cindex "preconditions" "definition of"
1226 An address is processed by passing it to each configured router instance in
1227 turn, subject to certain preconditions, until a router accepts the address or
1228 specifies that it should be bounced. We will describe this process in more
1229 detail shortly. First, as a simple example, we consider how each recipient
1230 address in a message is processed in a small configuration of three routers.
1232 To make this a more concrete example, it is described in terms of some actual
1233 routers, but remember, this is only an example. You can configure Exim's
1234 routers in many different ways, and there may be any number of routers in a
1237 The first router that is specified in a configuration is often one that handles
1238 addresses in domains that are not recognized specifically by the local host.
1239 Typically these are addresses for arbitrary domains on the Internet. A precondition
1240 is set up which looks for the special domains known to the host (for example,
1241 its own domain name), and the router is run for addresses that do &'not'&
1242 match. Typically, this is a router that looks up domains in the DNS in order to
1243 find the hosts to which this address routes. If it succeeds, the address is
1244 assigned to a suitable SMTP transport; if it does not succeed, the router is
1245 configured to fail the address.
1247 The second router is reached only when the domain is recognized as one that
1248 &"belongs"& to the local host. This router does redirection &-- also known as
1249 aliasing and forwarding. When it generates one or more new addresses from the
1250 original, each of them is routed independently from the start. Otherwise, the
1251 router may cause an address to fail, or it may simply decline to handle the
1252 address, in which case the address is passed to the next router.
1254 The final router in many configurations is one that checks to see if the
1255 address belongs to a local mailbox. The precondition may involve a check to
1256 see if the local part is the name of a login account, or it may look up the
1257 local part in a file or a database. If its preconditions are not met, or if
1258 the router declines, we have reached the end of the routers. When this happens,
1259 the address is bounced.
1263 .section "Processing an address for verification" "SECID16"
1264 .cindex "router" "for verification"
1265 .cindex "verifying address" "overview"
1266 As well as being used to decide how to deliver to an address, Exim's routers
1267 are also used for &'address verification'&. Verification can be requested as
1268 one of the checks to be performed in an ACL for incoming messages, on both
1269 sender and recipient addresses, and it can be tested using the &%-bv%& and
1270 &%-bvs%& command line options.
1272 When an address is being verified, the routers are run in &"verify mode"&. This
1273 does not affect the way the routers work, but it is a state that can be
1274 detected. By this means, a router can be skipped or made to behave differently
1275 when verifying. A common example is a configuration in which the first router
1276 sends all messages to a message-scanning program unless they have been
1277 previously scanned. Thus, the first router accepts all addresses without any
1278 checking, making it useless for verifying. Normally, the &%no_verify%& option
1279 would be set for such a router, causing it to be skipped in verify mode.
1284 .section "Running an individual router" "SECTrunindrou"
1285 .cindex "router" "running details"
1286 .cindex "preconditions" "checking"
1287 .cindex "router" "result of running"
1288 As explained in the example above, a number of preconditions are checked before
1289 running a router. If any are not met, the router is skipped, and the address is
1290 passed to the next router. When all the preconditions on a router &'are'& met,
1291 the router is run. What happens next depends on the outcome, which is one of
1295 &'accept'&: The router accepts the address, and either assigns it to a
1296 transport or generates one or more &"child"& addresses. Processing the
1297 original address ceases
1298 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
1299 unless the &%unseen%& option is set on the router. This option
1300 can be used to set up multiple deliveries with different routing (for example,
1301 for keeping archive copies of messages). When &%unseen%& is set, the address is
1302 passed to the next router. Normally, however, an &'accept'& return marks the
1305 Any child addresses generated by the router are processed independently,
1306 starting with the first router by default. It is possible to change this by
1307 setting the &%redirect_router%& option to specify which router to start at for
1308 child addresses. Unlike &%pass_router%& (see below) the router specified by
1309 &%redirect_router%& may be anywhere in the router configuration.
1311 &'pass'&: The router recognizes the address, but cannot handle it itself. It
1312 requests that the address be passed to another router. By default, the address
1313 is passed to the next router, but this can be changed by setting the
1314 &%pass_router%& option. However, (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router
1315 must be below the current router (to avoid loops).
1317 &'decline'&: The router declines to accept the address because it does not
1318 recognize it at all. By default, the address is passed to the next router, but
1319 this can be prevented by setting the &%no_more%& option. When &%no_more%& is
1320 set, all the remaining routers are skipped. In effect, &%no_more%& converts
1321 &'decline'& into &'fail'&.
1323 &'fail'&: The router determines that the address should fail, and queues it for
1324 the generation of a bounce message. There is no further processing of the
1325 original address unless &%unseen%& is set on the router.
1327 &'defer'&: The router cannot handle the address at the present time. (A
1328 database may be offline, or a DNS lookup may have timed out.) No further
1329 processing of the address happens in this delivery attempt. It is tried again
1330 next time the message is considered for delivery.
1332 &'error'&: There is some error in the router (for example, a syntax error in
1333 its configuration). The action is as for defer.
1336 If an address reaches the end of the routers without having been accepted by
1337 any of them, it is bounced as unrouteable. The default error message in this
1338 situation is &"unrouteable address"&, but you can set your own message by
1339 making use of the &%cannot_route_message%& option. This can be set for any
1340 router; the value from the last router that &"saw"& the address is used.
1342 Sometimes while routing you want to fail a delivery when some conditions are
1343 met but others are not, instead of passing the address on for further routing.
1344 You can do this by having a second router that explicitly fails the delivery
1345 when the relevant conditions are met. The &(redirect)& router has a &"fail"&
1346 facility for this purpose.
1349 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECID17"
1350 .cindex "case of local parts"
1351 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
1352 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
1353 Once routing is complete, Exim scans the addresses that are assigned to local
1354 and remote transports and discards any duplicates that it finds. During this
1355 check, local parts are treated case-sensitively. This happens only when
1356 actually delivering a message; when testing routers with &%-bt%&, all the
1357 routed addresses are shown.
1361 .section "Router preconditions" "SECTrouprecon"
1362 .cindex "router" "preconditions, order of processing"
1363 .cindex "preconditions" "order of processing"
1364 The preconditions that are tested for each router are listed below, in the
1365 order in which they are tested. The individual configuration options are
1366 described in more detail in chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&.
1369 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1370 The &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& options can specify that
1371 the local parts handled by the router may or must have certain prefixes and/or
1372 suffixes. If a mandatory affix (prefix or suffix) is not present, the router is
1373 skipped. These conditions are tested first. When an affix is present, it is
1374 removed from the local part before further processing, including the evaluation
1375 of any other conditions.
1377 Routers can be designated for use only when not verifying an address, that is,
1378 only when routing it for delivery (or testing its delivery routing). If the
1379 &%verify%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is verifying an
1381 Setting the &%verify%& option actually sets two options, &%verify_sender%& and
1382 &%verify_recipient%&, which independently control the use of the router for
1383 sender and recipient verification. You can set these options directly if
1384 you want a router to be used for only one type of verification.
1385 Note that cutthrough delivery is classed as a recipient verification for this purpose.
1387 If the &%address_test%& option is set false, the router is skipped when Exim is
1388 run with the &%-bt%& option to test an address routing. This can be helpful
1389 when the first router sends all new messages to a scanner of some sort; it
1390 makes it possible to use &%-bt%& to test subsequent delivery routing without
1391 having to simulate the effect of the scanner.
1393 Routers can be designated for use only when verifying an address, as
1394 opposed to routing it for delivery. The &%verify_only%& option controls this.
1395 Again, cutthrough delivery counts as a verification.
1397 Individual routers can be explicitly skipped when running the routers to
1398 check an address given in the SMTP EXPN command (see the &%expn%& option).
1401 If the &%domains%& option is set, the domain of the address must be in the set
1402 of domains that it defines.
1403 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
1404 .cindex de-tainting "using router domains option"
1405 .cindex de-tainting &$domains$&
1406 A match verifies the variable &$domain$& (which carries tainted data)
1407 and assigns an untainted value to the &$domain_data$& variable.
1408 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1409 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1410 refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&.
1412 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1413 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1416 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
1417 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix_v$&"
1418 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
1419 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
1420 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix_v$&"
1421 .cindex affix "router precondition"
1422 If the &%local_parts%& option is set, the local part of the address must be in
1423 the set of local parts that it defines.
1424 A match verifies the variable &$local_part$& (which carries tainted data)
1425 .cindex de-tainting &$local_parts$&
1426 and assigns an untainted value to the &$local_part_data$& variable.
1427 Such an untainted value is often needed in the transport.
1428 For specifics of the matching operation and the resulting untainted value,
1429 refer to section &<<SECTlocparlis>>&.
1431 When an untainted value is wanted, use this option
1432 rather than the generic &%condition%& option.
1434 If &%local_part_prefix%& or
1435 &%local_part_suffix%& is in use, the prefix or suffix is removed from the local
1436 part before this check. If you want to do precondition tests on local parts
1437 that include affixes, you can do so by using a &%condition%& option (see below)
1438 that uses the variables &$local_part$&, &$local_part_prefix$&,
1439 &$local_part_prefix_v$&, &$local_part_suffix$&
1440 and &$local_part_suffix_v$& as necessary.
1443 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
1444 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
1446 If the &%check_local_user%& option is set, the local part must be the name of
1447 an account on the local host. If this check succeeds, the uid and gid of the
1448 local user are placed in &$local_user_uid$& and &$local_user_gid$& and the
1449 user's home directory is placed in &$home$&; these values can be used in the
1450 remaining preconditions.
1453 If the &%router_home_directory%& option is set, it is expanded at this point,
1454 because it overrides the value of &$home$&. If this expansion were left till
1455 later, the value of &$home$& as set by &%check_local_user%& would be used in
1456 subsequent tests. Having two different values of &$home$& in the same router
1457 could lead to confusion.
1460 If the &%senders%& option is set, the envelope sender address must be in the
1461 set of addresses that it defines.
1464 If the &%require_files%& option is set, the existence or non-existence of
1465 specified files is tested.
1468 .cindex "customizing" "precondition"
1469 If the &%condition%& option is set, it is evaluated and tested. This option
1470 uses an expanded string to allow you to set up your own custom preconditions.
1471 Expanded strings are described in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
1473 Note that while using
1474 this option for address matching technically works,
1475 it does not set any de-tainted values.
1476 Such values are often needed, either for router-specific options or
1477 for transport options.
1478 Using the &%domains%& and &%local_parts%& options is usually the most
1479 convenient way to obtain them.
1483 Note that &%require_files%& comes near the end of the list, so you cannot use
1484 it to check for the existence of a file in which to lookup up a domain, local
1485 part, or sender. However, as these options are all expanded, you can use the
1486 &%exists%& expansion condition to make such tests within each condition. The
1487 &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files that the router may be
1488 going to use internally, or which are needed by a specific transport (for
1489 example, &_.procmailrc_&).
1493 .section "Delivery in detail" "SECID18"
1494 .cindex "delivery" "in detail"
1495 When a message is to be delivered, the sequence of events is as follows:
1498 If a system-wide filter file is specified, the message is passed to it. The
1499 filter may add recipients to the message, replace the recipients, discard the
1500 message, cause a new message to be generated, or cause the message delivery to
1501 fail. The format of the system filter file is the same as for Exim user filter
1502 files, described in the separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail
1504 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
1505 (&*Note*&: Sieve cannot be used for system filter files.)
1507 Some additional features are available in system filters &-- see chapter
1508 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>& for details. Note that a message is passed to the system
1509 filter only once per delivery attempt, however many recipients it has. However,
1510 if there are several delivery attempts because one or more addresses could not
1511 be immediately delivered, the system filter is run each time. The filter
1512 condition &%first_delivery%& can be used to detect the first run of the system
1515 Each recipient address is offered to each configured router, in turn, subject to
1516 its preconditions, until one is able to handle it. If no router can handle the
1517 address, that is, if they all decline, the address is failed. Because routers
1518 can be targeted at particular domains, several locally handled domains can be
1519 processed entirely independently of each other.
1521 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
1522 .cindex "loop" "while routing"
1523 A router that accepts an address may assign it to a local or a remote
1524 transport. However, the transport is not run at this time. Instead, the address
1525 is placed on a list for the particular transport, which will be run later.
1526 Alternatively, the router may generate one or more new addresses (typically
1527 from alias, forward, or filter files). New addresses are fed back into this
1528 process from the top, but in order to avoid loops, a router ignores any address
1529 which has an identically-named ancestor that was processed by itself.
1531 When all the routing has been done, addresses that have been successfully
1532 handled are passed to their assigned transports. When local transports are
1533 doing real local deliveries, they handle only one address at a time, but if a
1534 local transport is being used as a pseudo-remote transport (for example, to
1535 collect batched SMTP messages for transmission by some other means) multiple
1536 addresses can be handled. Remote transports can always handle more than one
1537 address at a time, but can be configured not to do so, or to restrict multiple
1538 addresses to the same domain.
1540 Each local delivery to a file or a pipe runs in a separate process under a
1541 non-privileged uid, and these deliveries are run one at a time. Remote
1542 deliveries also run in separate processes, normally under a uid that is private
1543 to Exim (&"the Exim user"&), but in this case, several remote deliveries can be
1544 run in parallel. The maximum number of simultaneous remote deliveries for any
1545 one message is set by the &%remote_max_parallel%& option.
1546 The order in which deliveries are done is not defined, except that all local
1547 deliveries happen before any remote deliveries.
1549 .cindex "queue runner"
1550 When it encounters a local delivery during a queue run, Exim checks its retry
1551 database to see if there has been a previous temporary delivery failure for the
1552 address before running the local transport. If there was a previous failure,
1553 Exim does not attempt a new delivery until the retry time for the address is
1554 reached. However, this happens only for delivery attempts that are part of a
1555 queue run. Local deliveries are always attempted when delivery immediately
1556 follows message reception, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for
1557 better behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example,
1558 causing quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file).
1560 .cindex "delivery" "retry in remote transports"
1561 Remote transports do their own retry handling, since an address may be
1562 deliverable to one of a number of hosts, each of which may have a different
1563 retry time. If there have been previous temporary failures and no host has
1564 reached its retry time, no delivery is attempted, whether in a queue run or
1565 not. See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for details of retry strategies.
1567 If there were any permanent errors, a bounce message is returned to an
1568 appropriate address (the sender in the common case), with details of the error
1569 for each failing address. Exim can be configured to send copies of bounce
1570 messages to other addresses.
1572 .cindex "delivery" "deferral"
1573 If one or more addresses suffered a temporary failure, the message is left on
1574 the queue, to be tried again later. Delivery of these addresses is said to be
1577 When all the recipient addresses have either been delivered or bounced,
1578 handling of the message is complete. The spool files and message log are
1579 deleted, though the message log can optionally be preserved if required.
1585 .section "Retry mechanism" "SECID19"
1586 .cindex "delivery" "retry mechanism"
1587 .cindex "retry" "description of mechanism"
1588 .cindex "queue runner"
1589 Exim's mechanism for retrying messages that fail to get delivered at the first
1590 attempt is the queue runner process. You must either run an Exim daemon that
1591 uses the &%-q%& option with a time interval to start queue runners at regular
1592 intervals or use some other means (such as &'cron'&) to start them. If you do
1593 not arrange for queue runners to be run, messages that fail temporarily at the
1594 first attempt will remain in your queue forever. A queue runner process works
1595 its way through the queue, one message at a time, trying each delivery that has
1596 passed its retry time.
1597 You can run several queue runners at once.
1599 Exim uses a set of configured rules to determine when next to retry the failing
1600 address (see chapter &<<CHAPretry>>&). These rules also specify when Exim
1601 should give up trying to deliver to the address, at which point it generates a
1602 bounce message. If no retry rules are set for a particular host, address, and
1603 error combination, no retries are attempted, and temporary errors are treated
1608 .subsection "Temporary delivery failure" SECID20
1609 .cindex "delivery" "temporary failure"
1610 There are many reasons why a message may not be immediately deliverable to a
1611 particular address. Failure to connect to a remote machine (because it, or the
1612 connection to it, is down) is one of the most common. Temporary failures may be
1613 detected during routing as well as during the transport stage of delivery.
1614 Local deliveries may be delayed if NFS files are unavailable, or if a mailbox
1615 is on a file system where the user is over quota. Exim can be configured to
1616 impose its own quotas on local mailboxes; where system quotas are set they will
1619 If a host is unreachable for a period of time, a number of messages may be
1620 waiting for it by the time it recovers, and sending them in a single SMTP
1621 connection is clearly beneficial. Whenever a delivery to a remote host is
1623 .cindex "hints database" "deferred deliveries"
1624 Exim makes a note in its hints database, and whenever a successful
1625 SMTP delivery has happened, it looks to see if any other messages are waiting
1626 for the same host. If any are found, they are sent over the same SMTP
1627 connection, subject to a configuration limit as to the maximum number in any
1632 .subsection "Permanent delivery failure" SECID21
1633 .cindex "delivery" "permanent failure"
1634 .cindex "bounce message" "when generated"
1635 When a message cannot be delivered to some or all of its intended recipients, a
1636 bounce message is generated. Temporary delivery failures turn into permanent
1637 errors when their timeout expires. All the addresses that fail in a given
1638 delivery attempt are listed in a single message. If the original message has
1639 many recipients, it is possible for some addresses to fail in one delivery
1640 attempt and others to fail subsequently, giving rise to more than one bounce
1641 message. The wording of bounce messages can be customized by the administrator.
1642 See chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>& for details.
1644 .cindex "&'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line"
1645 Bounce messages contain an &'X-Failed-Recipients:'& header line that lists the
1646 failed addresses, for the benefit of programs that try to analyse such messages
1649 .cindex "bounce message" "recipient of"
1650 A bounce message is normally sent to the sender of the original message, as
1651 obtained from the message's envelope. For incoming SMTP messages, this is the
1652 address given in the MAIL command. However, when an address is expanded via a
1653 forward or alias file, an alternative address can be specified for delivery
1654 failures of the generated addresses. For a mailing list expansion (see section
1655 &<<SECTmailinglists>>&) it is common to direct bounce messages to the manager
1660 .subsection "Failures to deliver bounce messages" SECID22
1661 .cindex "bounce message" "failure to deliver"
1662 If a bounce message (either locally generated or received from a remote host)
1663 itself suffers a permanent delivery failure, the message is left in the queue,
1664 but it is frozen, awaiting the attention of an administrator. There are options
1665 that can be used to make Exim discard such failed messages, or to keep them
1666 for only a short time (see &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
1667 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
1673 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1674 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
1676 .chapter "Building and installing Exim" "CHID3"
1677 .scindex IIDbuex "building Exim"
1679 .section "Unpacking" "SECID23"
1680 Exim is distributed as a gzipped or bzipped tar file which, when unpacked,
1681 creates a directory with the name of the current release (for example,
1682 &_exim-&version()_&) into which the following files are placed:
1685 .irow &_ACKNOWLEDGMENTS_& "contains some acknowledgments"
1686 .irow &_CHANGES_& "contains a reference to where changes are &&&
1688 .irow &_LICENCE_& "the GNU General Public Licence"
1689 .irow &_Makefile_& "top-level make file"
1690 .irow &_NOTICE_& "conditions for the use of Exim"
1691 .irow &_README_& "list of files, directories and simple build &&&
1695 Other files whose names begin with &_README_& may also be present. The
1696 following subdirectories are created:
1699 .irow &_Local_& "an empty directory for local configuration files"
1700 .irow &_OS_& "OS-specific files"
1701 .irow &_doc_& "documentation files"
1702 .irow &_exim_monitor_& "source files for the Exim monitor"
1703 .irow &_scripts_& "scripts used in the build process"
1704 .irow &_src_& "remaining source files"
1705 .irow &_util_& "independent utilities"
1708 The main utility programs are contained in the &_src_& directory and are built
1709 with the Exim binary. The &_util_& directory contains a few optional scripts
1710 that may be useful to some sites.
1713 .section "Multiple machine architectures and operating systems" "SECID24"
1714 .cindex "building Exim" "multiple OS/architectures"
1715 The building process for Exim is arranged to make it easy to build binaries for
1716 a number of different architectures and operating systems from the same set of
1717 source files. Compilation does not take place in the &_src_& directory.
1718 Instead, a &'build directory'& is created for each architecture and operating
1720 .cindex "symbolic link" "to build directory"
1721 Symbolic links to the sources are installed in this directory, which is where
1722 the actual building takes place. In most cases, Exim can discover the machine
1723 architecture and operating system for itself, but the defaults can be
1724 overridden if necessary.
1725 .cindex compiler requirements
1726 .cindex compiler version
1727 A C99-capable compiler will be required for the build.
1730 .section "PCRE2 library" "SECTpcre"
1731 .cindex "PCRE2 library"
1732 Exim no longer has an embedded regular-expression library as the vast majority of
1733 modern systems include PCRE2 as a system library, although you may need to
1734 install the PCRE2 package or the PCRE2 development package for your operating
1735 system. If your system has a normal PCRE2 installation the Exim build
1736 process will need no further configuration. If the library or the
1737 headers are in an unusual location you will need to either set the PCRE2_LIBS
1738 and INCLUDE directives appropriately,
1739 or set PCRE2_CONFIG=yes to use the installed &(pcre-config)& command.
1740 If your operating system has no
1741 PCRE2 support then you will need to obtain and build the current PCRE2
1742 from &url(https://github.com/PhilipHazel/pcre2/releases).
1743 More information on PCRE2 is available at &url(https://www.pcre.org/).
1745 .section "DBM libraries" "SECTdb"
1746 .cindex "DBM libraries" "discussion of"
1747 .cindex "hints database" "DBM files used for"
1748 Even if you do not use any DBM files in your configuration, Exim still needs a
1749 DBM library in order to operate, because it uses indexed files for its hints
1750 databases. Unfortunately, there are a number of DBM libraries in existence, and
1751 different operating systems often have different ones installed.
1753 .cindex "Solaris" "DBM library for"
1754 .cindex "IRIX, DBM library for"
1755 .cindex "BSD, DBM library for"
1756 .cindex "Linux, DBM library for"
1757 If you are using Solaris, IRIX, one of the modern BSD systems, or a modern
1758 Linux distribution, the DBM configuration should happen automatically, and you
1759 may be able to ignore this section. Otherwise, you may have to learn more than
1760 you would like about DBM libraries from what follows.
1762 .cindex "&'ndbm'& DBM library"
1763 Licensed versions of Unix normally contain a library of DBM functions operating
1764 via the &'ndbm'& interface, and this is what Exim expects by default. Free
1765 versions of Unix seem to vary in what they contain as standard. In particular,
1766 some early versions of Linux have no default DBM library, and different
1767 distributors have chosen to bundle different libraries with their packaged
1768 versions. However, the more recent releases seem to have standardized on the
1769 Berkeley DB library.
1772 Ownership of the Berkeley DB library has moved to a major corporation;
1773 development seems to have stalled and documentation is not freely available.
1774 This is probably not tenable for the long term use by Exim.
1777 Different DBM libraries have different conventions for naming the files they
1778 use. When a program opens a file called &_dbmfile_&, there are several
1782 A traditional &'ndbm'& implementation, such as that supplied as part of
1783 Solaris, operates on two files called &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&.
1785 .cindex "&'gdbm'& DBM library"
1786 The GNU library, &'gdbm'&, operates on a single file. If used via its &'ndbm'&
1787 compatibility interface it makes two different hard links to it with names
1788 &_dbmfile.dir_& and &_dbmfile.pag_&, but if used via its native interface, the
1789 filename is used unmodified.
1791 .cindex "Berkeley DB library"
1792 The Berkeley DB package, if called via its &'ndbm'& compatibility interface,
1793 operates on a single file called &_dbmfile.db_&, but otherwise looks to the
1794 programmer exactly the same as the traditional &'ndbm'& implementation.
1796 If the Berkeley package is used in its native mode, it operates on a single
1797 file called &_dbmfile_&; the programmer's interface is somewhat different to
1798 the traditional &'ndbm'& interface.
1800 To complicate things further, there are several very different versions of the
1801 Berkeley DB package. Version 1.85 was stable for a very long time, releases
1802 2.&'x'& and 3.&'x'& were current for a while,
1803 but the latest versions when Exim last revamped support were numbered 5.&'x'&.
1804 Maintenance of some of the earlier releases has ceased,
1805 and Exim no longer supports versions before 3.&'x'&.
1806 All versions of Berkeley DB could be obtained from
1807 &url(http://www.sleepycat.com/), which is now a redirect to their new owner's
1808 page with far newer versions listed.
1809 It is probably wise to plan to move your storage configurations away from
1810 Berkeley DB format, as today there are smaller and simpler alternatives more
1811 suited to Exim's usage model.
1813 .cindex "&'tdb'& DBM library"
1814 Yet another DBM library, called &'tdb'&, is available from
1815 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/tdb/files/). It has its own interface, and also
1816 operates on a single file.
1818 It is possible to use &url(https://www.sqlite.org/index.html,sqlite3)
1819 for the DBM library.
1823 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
1824 Exim and its utilities can be compiled to use any of these interfaces. In order
1825 to use any version of the Berkeley DB package in native mode, you must set
1826 USE_DB in an appropriate configuration file (typically
1827 &_Local/Makefile_&). For example:
1831 Similarly, for gdbm you set USE_GDBM, for tdb you set USE_TDB,
1832 and for sqlite3 you set USE_SQLITE.
1833 An error is diagnosed if you set more than one of these.
1834 You can set USE_NDBM if needed to override an operating system default.
1836 At the lowest level, the build-time configuration sets none of these options,
1837 thereby assuming an interface of type (1). However, some operating system
1838 configuration files (for example, those for the BSD operating systems and
1839 Linux) assume type (4) by setting USE_DB as their default, and the
1840 configuration files for Cygwin set USE_GDBM. Anything you set in
1841 &_Local/Makefile_&, however, overrides these system defaults.
1843 As well as setting USE_DB, USE_GDBM, or USE_TDB, it may also be
1844 necessary to set DBMLIB, to cause inclusion of the appropriate library, as
1845 in one of these lines:
1850 DBMLIB = -lgdbm -lgdbm_compat
1852 The last of those was for a Linux having GDBM provide emulated NDBM facilities.
1853 Settings like that will work if the DBM library is installed in the standard
1854 place. Sometimes it is not, and the library's header file may also not be in
1855 the default path. You may need to set INCLUDE to specify where the header
1856 file is, and to specify the path to the library more fully in DBMLIB, as in
1859 INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/include/db-4.1
1860 DBMLIB=/usr/local/lib/db-4.1/libdb.a
1862 There is further detailed discussion about the various DBM libraries in the
1863 file &_doc/dbm.discuss.txt_& in the Exim distribution.
1866 When moving from one DBM library to another,
1867 for the hints databases it suffices to just remove all the files in the
1868 directory named &"db/"& under the spool directory.
1869 This is because hints are only for optimisation and will be rebuilt
1870 during normal operations.
1871 Non-hints DBM databases (used by &"dbm"& lookups in the configuration)
1872 will need individual rebuilds for the new DBM library.
1873 This is not done automatically
1878 .section "Pre-building configuration" "SECID25"
1879 .cindex "building Exim" "pre-building configuration"
1880 .cindex "configuration for building Exim"
1881 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
1882 .cindex "&_src/EDITME_&"
1883 Before building Exim, a local configuration file that specifies options
1884 independent of any operating system has to be created with the name
1885 &_Local/Makefile_&. A template for this file is supplied as the file
1886 &_src/EDITME_&, and it contains full descriptions of all the option settings
1887 therein. These descriptions are therefore not repeated here. If you are
1888 building Exim for the first time, the simplest thing to do is to copy
1889 &_src/EDITME_& to &_Local/Makefile_&, then read it and edit it appropriately.
1891 There are three settings that you must supply, because Exim will not build
1892 without them. They are the location of the runtime configuration file
1893 (CONFIGURE_FILE), the directory in which Exim binaries will be installed
1894 (BIN_DIRECTORY), and the identity of the Exim user (EXIM_USER and
1895 maybe EXIM_GROUP as well). The value of CONFIGURE_FILE can in fact be
1896 a colon-separated list of filenames; Exim uses the first of them that exists.
1898 There are a few other parameters that can be specified either at build time or
1899 at runtime, to enable the same binary to be used on a number of different
1900 machines. However, if the locations of Exim's spool directory and log file
1901 directory (if not within the spool directory) are fixed, it is recommended that
1902 you specify them in &_Local/Makefile_& instead of at runtime, so that errors
1903 detected early in Exim's execution (such as a malformed configuration file) can
1906 .cindex "content scanning" "specifying at build time"
1907 Exim's interfaces for calling virus and spam scanning software directly from
1908 access control lists are not compiled by default. If you want to include these
1909 facilities, you need to set
1911 WITH_CONTENT_SCAN=yes
1913 in your &_Local/Makefile_&. For details of the facilities themselves, see
1914 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
1917 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
1918 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
1919 If you are going to build the Exim monitor, a similar configuration process is
1920 required. The file &_exim_monitor/EDITME_& must be edited appropriately for
1921 your installation and saved under the name &_Local/eximon.conf_&. If you are
1922 happy with the default settings described in &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&,
1923 &_Local/eximon.conf_& can be empty, but it must exist.
1925 This is all the configuration that is needed in straightforward cases for known
1926 operating systems. However, the building process is set up so that it is easy
1927 to override options that are set by default or by operating-system-specific
1928 configuration files, for example, to change the C compiler, which
1929 defaults to &%gcc%&. See section &<<SECToverride>>& below for details of how to
1934 .section "Support for iconv()" "SECID26"
1935 .cindex "&[iconv()]& support"
1937 The contents of header lines in messages may be encoded according to the rules
1938 described in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047).
1939 This makes it possible to transmit characters that are not
1940 in the ASCII character set, and to label them as being in a particular
1941 character set. When Exim is inspecting header lines by means of the &%$h_%&
1942 mechanism, it decodes them, and translates them into a specified character set
1943 (default is set at build time). The translation is possible only if the operating system
1944 supports the &[iconv()]& function.
1946 However, some of the operating systems that supply &[iconv()]& do not support
1947 very many conversions. The GNU &%libiconv%& library (available from
1948 &url(https://www.gnu.org/software/libiconv/)) can be installed on such
1949 systems to remedy this deficiency, as well as on systems that do not supply
1950 &[iconv()]& at all. After installing &%libiconv%&, you should add
1954 to your &_Local/Makefile_& and rebuild Exim.
1958 .section "Including TLS/SSL encryption support" "SECTinctlsssl"
1959 .cindex "TLS" "including support for TLS"
1960 .cindex "encryption" "including support for"
1961 .cindex "OpenSSL" "building Exim with"
1962 .cindex "GnuTLS" "building Exim with"
1963 Exim is usually built to support encrypted SMTP connections, using the STARTTLS
1964 command as per &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2487,RFC 2487).
1965 It can also support clients that expect to
1966 start a TLS session immediately on connection to a non-standard port (see the
1967 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& runtime option and the &%-tls-on-connect%& command
1970 If you want to build Exim with TLS support, you must first install either the
1971 OpenSSL or GnuTLS library. There is no cryptographic code in Exim itself for
1974 If you do not want TLS support you should set
1978 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
1980 If OpenSSL is installed, you should set
1983 TLS_LIBS=-lssl -lcrypto
1985 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You may also need to specify the locations of the
1986 OpenSSL library and include files. For example:
1989 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/local/openssl/lib -lssl -lcrypto
1990 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/local/openssl/include/
1992 .cindex "pkg-config" "OpenSSL"
1993 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
1996 USE_OPENSSL_PC=openssl
1998 .cindex "USE_GNUTLS"
1999 If GnuTLS is installed, you should set
2002 TLS_LIBS=-lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
2004 in &_Local/Makefile_&, and again you may need to specify the locations of the
2005 library and include files. For example:
2008 TLS_LIBS=-L/usr/gnu/lib -lgnutls -ltasn1 -lgcrypt
2009 TLS_INCLUDE=-I/usr/gnu/include
2011 .cindex "pkg-config" "GnuTLS"
2012 If you have &'pkg-config'& available, then instead you can just use:
2015 USE_GNUTLS_PC=gnutls
2018 You do not need to set TLS_INCLUDE if the relevant directory is already
2019 specified in INCLUDE. Details of how to configure Exim to make use of TLS are
2020 given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
2025 .section "Use of tcpwrappers" "SECID27"
2027 .cindex "tcpwrappers, building Exim to support"
2028 .cindex "USE_TCP_WRAPPERS"
2029 .cindex "TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME"
2030 .cindex "tcp_wrappers_daemon_name"
2031 Exim can be linked with the &'tcpwrappers'& library in order to check incoming
2032 SMTP calls using the &'tcpwrappers'& control files. This may be a convenient
2033 alternative to Exim's own checking facilities for installations that are
2034 already making use of &'tcpwrappers'& for other purposes. To do this, you
2035 should set USE_TCP_WRAPPERS in &_Local/Makefile_&, arrange for the file
2036 &_tcpd.h_& to be available at compile time, and also ensure that the library
2037 &_libwrap.a_& is available at link time, typically by including &%-lwrap%& in
2038 EXTRALIBS_EXIM. For example, if &'tcpwrappers'& is installed in &_/usr/local_&,
2041 USE_TCP_WRAPPERS=yes
2042 CFLAGS=-O -I/usr/local/include
2043 EXTRALIBS_EXIM=-L/usr/local/lib -lwrap
2045 in &_Local/Makefile_&. The daemon name to use in the &'tcpwrappers'& control
2046 files is &"exim"&. For example, the line
2048 exim : LOCAL 192.168.1. .friendly.domain.example
2050 in your &_/etc/hosts.allow_& file allows connections from the local host, from
2051 the subnet 192.168.1.0/24, and from all hosts in &'friendly.domain.example'&.
2052 All other connections are denied. The daemon name used by &'tcpwrappers'&
2053 can be changed at build time by setting TCP_WRAPPERS_DAEMON_NAME in
2054 &_Local/Makefile_&, or by setting tcp_wrappers_daemon_name in the
2055 configure file. Consult the &'tcpwrappers'& documentation for
2059 .section "Including support for IPv6" "SECID28"
2060 .cindex "IPv6" "including support for"
2061 Exim contains code for use on systems that have IPv6 support. Setting
2062 &`HAVE_IPV6=YES`& in &_Local/Makefile_& causes the IPv6 code to be included;
2063 it may also be necessary to set IPV6_INCLUDE and IPV6_LIBS on systems
2064 where the IPv6 support is not fully integrated into the normal include and
2067 Two different types of DNS record for handling IPv6 addresses have been
2068 defined. AAAA records (analogous to A records for IPv4) are in use, and are
2069 currently seen as the mainstream. Another record type called A6 was proposed
2070 as better than AAAA because it had more flexibility. However, it was felt to be
2071 over-complex, and its status was reduced to &"experimental"&.
2073 have a compile option for including A6 record support but this has now been
2078 .section "Dynamically loaded module support" "SECTdynamicmodules"
2079 .cindex "lookup modules"
2080 .cindex "router modules"
2081 .cindex "transport modules"
2082 .cindex "authenticator modules"
2083 .cindex "dynamic modules"
2084 .cindex ".so building"
2085 On some platforms, Exim supports not compiling all lookup types directly into
2086 the main binary, instead putting some into external modules which can be loaded
2088 This permits packagers to build Exim with support for lookups with extensive
2089 library dependencies without requiring all systems to install all of those
2092 Any combination of lookup types can be built this way.
2093 Lookup types that provide several variants will be loaded as
2095 Types that provide only one method are not loaded until used by
2096 the runtime configuration.
2100 set &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& to the directory into which the modules will be
2101 installed; Exim will only load modules from that directory, as a security
2102 measure. You will need to set &`CFLAGS_DYNAMIC`& if not already defined
2103 for your OS; see &_OS/Makefile-Linux_& for an example.
2104 Some other requirements for adjusting &`EXTRALIBS`& may also be necessary,
2105 see &_src/EDITME_& for details.
2107 Then, for each module to be loaded dynamically, define the relevant
2108 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&> flags to have the value "2" instead of "yes".
2109 For example, this will build in lsearch but load sqlite and mysql support
2110 only if each is installed:
2116 Set also &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&>&` INCLUDE`& and
2117 &`LOOKUP_`&<&'lookup_type'&>`_LIBS if needed for each lookup type,
2118 ensuring that duplicates are not present in more global values.
2121 Similarly, authenticator, router and transport drivers can be built
2122 as external modules.
2123 Modules will be searched for as demanded by the runtime configuration,
2124 permitting a smaller Exim binary.
2126 For building, as above but using
2127 &`AUTH_*`&, &`ROUTER_*`& and &`TRANSPORT_*`& instead of &`LOOKUP_*`&,
2131 .section "The building process" "SECID29"
2132 .cindex "build directory"
2133 Once &_Local/Makefile_& (and &_Local/eximon.conf_&, if required) have been
2134 created, run &'make'& at the top level. It determines the architecture and
2135 operating system types, and creates a build directory if one does not exist.
2136 For example, on a Sun system running Solaris 8, the directory
2137 &_build-SunOS5-5.8-sparc_& is created.
2138 .cindex "symbolic link" "to source files"
2139 Symbolic links to relevant source files are installed in the build directory.
2141 If this is the first time &'make'& has been run, it calls a script that builds
2142 a make file inside the build directory, using the configuration files from the
2143 &_Local_& directory. The new make file is then passed to another instance of
2144 &'make'&. This does the real work, building a number of utility scripts, and
2145 then compiling and linking the binaries for the Exim monitor (if configured), a
2146 number of utility programs, and finally Exim itself. The command &`make
2147 makefile`& can be used to force a rebuild of the make file in the build
2148 directory, should this ever be necessary.
2150 If you have problems building Exim, check for any comments there may be in the
2151 &_README_& file concerning your operating system, and also take a look at the
2152 FAQ, where some common problems are covered.
2156 .section 'Output from &"make"&' "SECID283"
2157 The output produced by the &'make'& process for compile lines is often very
2158 unreadable, because these lines can be very long. For this reason, the normal
2159 output is suppressed by default, and instead output similar to that which
2160 appears when compiling the 2.6 Linux kernel is generated: just a short line for
2161 each module that is being compiled or linked. However, it is still possible to
2162 get the full output, by calling &'make'& like this:
2166 The value of FULLECHO defaults to &"@"&, the flag character that suppresses
2167 command reflection in &'make'&. When you ask for the full output, it is
2168 given in addition to the short output.
2172 .section "Overriding build-time options for Exim" "SECToverride"
2173 .cindex "build-time options, overriding"
2174 The main make file that is created at the beginning of the building process
2175 consists of the concatenation of a number of files which set configuration
2176 values, followed by a fixed set of &'make'& instructions. If a value is set
2177 more than once, the last setting overrides any previous ones. This provides a
2178 convenient way of overriding defaults. The files that are concatenated are, in
2181 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2182 &_OS/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2184 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>
2185 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'archtype'&>
2186 &_Local/Makefile-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2187 &_OS/Makefile-Base_&
2189 .cindex "&_Local/Makefile_&"
2190 .cindex "building Exim" "operating system type"
2191 .cindex "building Exim" "architecture type"
2192 where <&'ostype'&> is the operating system type and <&'archtype'&> is the
2193 architecture type. &_Local/Makefile_& is required to exist, and the building
2194 process fails if it is absent. The other three &_Local_& files are optional,
2195 and are often not needed.
2197 The values used for <&'ostype'&> and <&'archtype'&> are obtained from scripts
2198 called &_scripts/os-type_& and &_scripts/arch-type_& respectively. If either of
2199 the environment variables EXIM_OSTYPE or EXIM_ARCHTYPE is set, their
2200 values are used, thereby providing a means of forcing particular settings.
2201 Otherwise, the scripts try to get values from the &%uname%& command. If this
2202 fails, the shell variables OSTYPE and ARCHTYPE are inspected. A number
2203 of &'ad hoc'& transformations are then applied, to produce the standard names
2204 that Exim expects. You can run these scripts directly from the shell in order
2205 to find out what values are being used on your system.
2208 &_OS/Makefile-Default_& contains comments about the variables that are set
2209 therein. Some (but not all) are mentioned below. If there is something that
2210 needs changing, review the contents of this file and the contents of the make
2211 file for your operating system (&_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&) to see what the
2215 .cindex "building Exim" "overriding default settings"
2216 If you need to change any of the values that are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&
2217 or in &_OS/Makefile-<ostype>_&, or to add any new definitions, you do not
2218 need to change the original files. Instead, you should make the changes by
2219 putting the new values in an appropriate &_Local_& file. For example,
2220 .cindex "Tru64-Unix build-time settings"
2221 when building Exim in many releases of the Tru64-Unix (formerly Digital UNIX,
2222 formerly DEC-OSF1) operating system, it is necessary to specify that the C
2223 compiler is called &'cc'& rather than &'gcc'&. Also, the compiler must be
2224 called with the option &%-std1%&, to make it recognize some of the features of
2225 Standard C that Exim uses. (Most other compilers recognize Standard C by
2226 default.) To do this, you should create a file called &_Local/Makefile-OSF1_&
2227 containing the lines
2232 If you are compiling for just one operating system, it may be easier to put
2233 these lines directly into &_Local/Makefile_&.
2235 Keeping all your local configuration settings separate from the distributed
2236 files makes it easy to transfer them to new versions of Exim simply by copying
2237 the contents of the &_Local_& directory.
2240 .cindex "NIS lookup type" "including support for"
2241 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type" "including support for"
2242 .cindex "LDAP" "including support for"
2243 .cindex "lookup" "inclusion in binary"
2244 Exim contains support for doing LDAP, NIS, NIS+, and other kinds of file
2245 lookup, but not all systems have these components installed, so the default is
2246 not to include the relevant code in the binary. All the different kinds of file
2247 and database lookup that Exim supports are implemented as separate code modules
2248 which are included only if the relevant compile-time options are set. In the
2249 case of LDAP, NIS, and NIS+, the settings for &_Local/Makefile_& are:
2255 and similar settings apply to the other lookup types. They are all listed in
2256 &_src/EDITME_&. In many cases the relevant include files and interface
2257 libraries need to be installed before compiling Exim.
2258 .cindex "cdb" "including support for"
2259 However, there are some optional lookup types (such as cdb) for which
2260 the code is entirely contained within Exim, and no external include
2261 files or libraries are required. When a lookup type is not included in the
2262 binary, attempts to configure Exim to use it cause runtime configuration
2265 .cindex "pkg-config" "lookups"
2266 .cindex "pkg-config" "authenticators"
2267 Many systems now use a tool called &'pkg-config'& to encapsulate information
2268 about how to compile against a library; Exim has some initial support for
2269 being able to use pkg-config for lookups and authenticators. For any given
2270 makefile variable which starts &`LOOKUP_`& or &`AUTH_`&, you can add a new
2271 variable with the &`_PC`& suffix in the name and assign as the value the
2272 name of the package to be queried. The results of querying via the
2273 &'pkg-config'& command will be added to the appropriate Makefile variables
2274 with &`+=`& directives, so your version of &'make'& will need to support that
2275 syntax. For instance:
2278 LOOKUP_SQLITE_PC=sqlite3
2280 AUTH_GSASL_PC=libgsasl
2281 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
2282 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI_PC=heimdal-gssapi
2285 .cindex "Perl" "including support for"
2286 Exim can be linked with an embedded Perl interpreter, allowing Perl
2287 subroutines to be called during string expansion. To enable this facility,
2291 must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&. Details of this facility are given in
2292 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
2294 .cindex "X11 libraries, location of"
2295 The location of the X11 libraries is something that varies a lot between
2296 operating systems, and there may be different versions of X11 to cope
2297 with. Exim itself makes no use of X11, but if you are compiling the Exim
2298 monitor, the X11 libraries must be available.
2299 The following three variables are set in &_OS/Makefile-Default_&:
2302 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2303 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib
2305 These are overridden in some of the operating-system configuration files. For
2306 example, in &_OS/Makefile-SunOS5_& there is
2309 XINCLUDE=-I$(X11)/include
2310 XLFLAGS=-L$(X11)/lib -R$(X11)/lib
2312 If you need to override the default setting for your operating system, place a
2313 definition of all three of these variables into your
2314 &_Local/Makefile-<ostype>_& file.
2317 If you need to add any extra libraries to the link steps, these can be put in a
2318 variable called EXTRALIBS, which appears in all the link commands, but by
2319 default is not defined. In contrast, EXTRALIBS_EXIM is used only on the
2320 command for linking the main Exim binary, and not for any associated utilities.
2322 .cindex "DBM libraries" "configuration for building"
2323 There is also DBMLIB, which appears in the link commands for binaries that
2324 use DBM functions (see also section &<<SECTdb>>&). Finally, there is
2325 EXTRALIBS_EXIMON, which appears only in the link step for the Exim monitor
2326 binary, and which can be used, for example, to include additional X11
2329 .cindex "configuration file" "editing"
2330 The make file copes with rebuilding Exim correctly if any of the configuration
2331 files are edited. However, if an optional configuration file is deleted, it is
2332 necessary to touch the associated non-optional file (that is,
2333 &_Local/Makefile_& or &_Local/eximon.conf_&) before rebuilding.
2336 .section "OS-specific header files" "SECID30"
2338 .cindex "building Exim" "OS-specific C header files"
2339 The &_OS_& directory contains a number of files with names of the form
2340 &_os.h-<ostype>_&. These are system-specific C header files that should not
2341 normally need to be changed. There is a list of macro settings that are
2342 recognized in the file &_OS/os.configuring_&, which should be consulted if you
2343 are porting Exim to a new operating system.
2347 .section "Overriding build-time options for the monitor" "SECID31"
2348 .cindex "building Eximon"
2349 A similar process is used for overriding things when building the Exim monitor,
2350 where the files that are involved are
2352 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_&
2353 &_OS/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2354 &_Local/eximon.conf_&
2355 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>
2356 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'archtype'&>
2357 &_Local/eximon.conf-_&<&'ostype'&>-<&'archtype'&>
2359 .cindex "&_Local/eximon.conf_&"
2360 As with Exim itself, the final three files need not exist, and in this case the
2361 &_OS/eximon.conf-<ostype>_& file is also optional. The default values in
2362 &_OS/eximon.conf-Default_& can be overridden dynamically by setting environment
2363 variables of the same name, preceded by EXIMON_. For example, setting
2364 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH in the environment overrides the value of
2365 LOG_DEPTH at runtime.
2369 .section "Installing Exim binaries and scripts" "SECID32"
2370 .cindex "installing Exim"
2371 .cindex "BIN_DIRECTORY"
2372 The command &`make install`& runs the &(exim_install)& script with no
2373 arguments. The script copies binaries and utility scripts into the directory
2374 whose name is specified by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting in &_Local/Makefile_&.
2375 .cindex "setuid" "installing Exim with"
2376 The install script copies files only if they are newer than the files they are
2377 going to replace. The Exim binary is required to be owned by root and have the
2378 &'setuid'& bit set, for normal configurations. Therefore, you must run &`make
2379 install`& as root so that it can set up the Exim binary in this way. However, in
2380 some special situations (for example, if a host is doing no local deliveries)
2381 it may be possible to run Exim without making the binary setuid root (see
2382 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for details).
2384 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
2385 Exim's runtime configuration file is named by the CONFIGURE_FILE setting
2386 in &_Local/Makefile_&. If this names a single file, and the file does not
2387 exist, the default configuration file &_src/configure.default_& is copied there
2388 by the installation script. If a runtime configuration file already exists, it
2389 is left alone. If CONFIGURE_FILE is a colon-separated list, naming several
2390 alternative files, no default is installed.
2392 .cindex "system aliases file"
2393 .cindex "&_/etc/aliases_&"
2394 One change is made to the default configuration file when it is installed: the
2395 default configuration contains a router that references a system aliases file.
2396 The path to this file is set to the value specified by
2397 SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& (&_/etc/aliases_& by default).
2398 If the system aliases file does not exist, the installation script creates it,
2399 and outputs a comment to the user.
2401 The created file contains no aliases, but it does contain comments about the
2402 aliases a site should normally have. Mail aliases have traditionally been
2403 kept in &_/etc/aliases_&. However, some operating systems are now using
2404 &_/etc/mail/aliases_&. You should check if yours is one of these, and change
2405 Exim's configuration if necessary.
2407 The default configuration uses the local host's name as the only local domain,
2408 and is set up to do local deliveries into the shared directory &_/var/mail_&,
2409 running as the local user. System aliases and &_.forward_& files in users' home
2410 directories are supported, but no NIS or NIS+ support is configured. Domains
2411 other than the name of the local host are routed using the DNS, with delivery
2414 It is possible to install Exim for special purposes (such as building a binary
2415 distribution) in a private part of the file system. You can do this by a
2418 make DESTDIR=/some/directory/ install
2420 This has the effect of pre-pending the specified directory to all the file
2421 paths, except the name of the system aliases file that appears in the default
2422 configuration. (If a default alias file is created, its name &'is'& modified.)
2423 For backwards compatibility, ROOT is used if DESTDIR is not set,
2424 but this usage is deprecated.
2426 .cindex "installing Exim" "what is not installed"
2427 Running &'make install'& does not copy the Exim 4 conversion script
2428 &'convert4r4'&. You will probably run this only once if you are
2429 upgrading from Exim 3. None of the documentation files in the &_doc_&
2430 directory are copied, except for the info files when you have set
2431 INFO_DIRECTORY, as described in section &<<SECTinsinfdoc>>& below.
2433 For the utility programs, old versions are renamed by adding the suffix &_.O_&
2434 to their names. The Exim binary itself, however, is handled differently. It is
2435 installed under a name that includes the version number and the compile number,
2436 for example, &_exim-&version()-1_&. The script then arranges for a symbolic link
2437 called &_exim_& to point to the binary. If you are updating a previous version
2438 of Exim, the script takes care to ensure that the name &_exim_& is never absent
2439 from the directory (as seen by other processes).
2441 .cindex "installing Exim" "testing the script"
2442 If you want to see what the &'make install'& will do before running it for
2443 real, you can pass the &%-n%& option to the installation script by this
2446 make INSTALL_ARG=-n install
2448 The contents of the variable INSTALL_ARG are passed to the installation
2449 script. You do not need to be root to run this test. Alternatively, you can run
2450 the installation script directly, but this must be from within the build
2451 directory. For example, from the top-level Exim directory you could use this
2454 (cd build-SunOS5-5.5.1-sparc; ../scripts/exim_install -n)
2456 .cindex "installing Exim" "install script options"
2457 There are two other options that can be supplied to the installation script.
2460 &%-no_chown%& bypasses the call to change the owner of the installed binary
2461 to root, and the call to make it a setuid binary.
2463 &%-no_symlink%& bypasses the setting up of the symbolic link &_exim_& to the
2467 INSTALL_ARG can be used to pass these options to the script. For example:
2469 make INSTALL_ARG=-no_symlink install
2471 The installation script can also be given arguments specifying which files are
2472 to be copied. For example, to install just the Exim binary, and nothing else,
2473 without creating the symbolic link, you could use:
2475 make INSTALL_ARG='-no_symlink exim' install
2480 .section "Installing info documentation" "SECTinsinfdoc"
2481 .cindex "installing Exim" "&'info'& documentation"
2482 Not all systems use the GNU &'info'& system for documentation, and for this
2483 reason, the Texinfo source of Exim's documentation is not included in the main
2484 distribution. Instead it is available separately from the FTP site (see section
2487 If you have defined INFO_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_& and the Texinfo
2488 source of the documentation is found in the source tree, running &`make
2489 install`& automatically builds the info files and installs them.
2493 .section "Setting up the spool directory" "SECID33"
2494 .cindex "spool directory" "creating"
2495 When it starts up, Exim tries to create its spool directory if it does not
2496 exist. The Exim uid and gid are used for the owner and group of the spool
2497 directory. Sub-directories are automatically created in the spool directory as
2503 .section "Testing" "SECID34"
2504 .cindex "testing" "installation"
2505 Having installed Exim, you can check that the runtime configuration file is
2506 syntactically valid by running the following command, which assumes that the
2507 Exim binary directory is within your PATH environment variable:
2511 If there are any errors in the configuration file, Exim outputs error messages.
2512 Otherwise it outputs the version number and build date,
2513 the DBM library that is being used, and information about which drivers and
2514 other optional code modules are included in the binary.
2515 Some simple routing tests can be done by using the address testing option. For
2518 &`exim -bt`& <&'local username'&>
2520 should verify that it recognizes a local mailbox, and
2522 &`exim -bt`& <&'remote address'&>
2524 a remote one. Then try getting it to deliver mail, both locally and remotely.
2525 This can be done by passing messages directly to Exim, without going through a
2526 user agent. For example:
2528 exim -v postmaster@your.domain.example
2529 From: user@your.domain.example
2530 To: postmaster@your.domain.example
2531 Subject: Testing Exim
2533 This is a test message.
2536 The &%-v%& option causes Exim to output some verification of what it is doing.
2537 In this case you should see copies of three log lines, one for the message's
2538 arrival, one for its delivery, and one containing &"Completed"&.
2540 .cindex "delivery" "problems with"
2541 If you encounter problems, look at Exim's log files (&'mainlog'& and
2542 &'paniclog'&) to see if there is any relevant information there. Another source
2543 of information is running Exim with debugging turned on, by specifying the
2544 &%-d%& option. If a message is stuck on Exim's spool, you can force a delivery
2545 with debugging turned on by a command of the form
2547 &`exim -d -M`& <&'exim-message-id'&>
2549 You must be root or an &"admin user"& in order to do this. The &%-d%& option
2550 produces rather a lot of output, but you can cut this down to specific areas.
2551 For example, if you use &%-d-all+route%& only the debugging information
2552 relevant to routing is included. (See the &%-d%& option in chapter
2553 &<<CHAPcommandline>>& for more details.)
2555 .cindex '&"sticky"& bit'
2556 .cindex "lock files"
2557 One specific problem that has shown up on some sites is the inability to do
2558 local deliveries into a shared mailbox directory, because it does not have the
2559 &"sticky bit"& set on it. By default, Exim tries to create a lock file before
2560 writing to a mailbox file, and if it cannot create the lock file, the delivery
2561 is deferred. You can get round this either by setting the &"sticky bit"& on the
2562 directory, or by setting a specific group for local deliveries and allowing
2563 that group to create files in the directory (see the comments above the
2564 &(local_delivery)& transport in the default configuration file). Another
2565 approach is to configure Exim not to use lock files, but just to rely on
2566 &[fcntl()]& locking instead. However, you should do this only if all user
2567 agents also use &[fcntl()]& locking. For further discussion of locking issues,
2568 see chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
2570 One thing that cannot be tested on a system that is already running an MTA is
2571 the receipt of incoming SMTP mail on the standard SMTP port. However, the
2572 &%-oX%& option can be used to run an Exim daemon that listens on some other
2573 port, or &'inetd'& can be used to do this. The &%-bh%& option and the
2574 &'exim_checkaccess'& utility can be used to check out policy controls on
2577 Testing a new version on a system that is already running Exim can most easily
2578 be done by building a binary with a different CONFIGURE_FILE setting. From
2579 within the runtime configuration, all other file and directory names
2580 that Exim uses can be altered, in order to keep it entirely clear of the
2584 .section "Replacing another MTA with Exim" "SECID35"
2585 .cindex "replacing another MTA"
2586 Building and installing Exim for the first time does not of itself put it in
2587 general use. The name by which the system's MTA is called by mail user agents
2588 is either &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&, or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& (depending on the
2589 operating system), and it is necessary to make this name point to the &'exim'&
2590 binary in order to get the user agents to pass messages to Exim. This is
2591 normally done by renaming any existing file and making &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&
2592 or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&
2593 .cindex "symbolic link" "to &'exim'& binary"
2594 a symbolic link to the &'exim'& binary. It is a good idea to remove any setuid
2595 privilege and executable status from the old MTA. It is then necessary to stop
2596 and restart the mailer daemon, if one is running.
2598 .cindex "FreeBSD, MTA indirection"
2599 .cindex "&_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&"
2600 Some operating systems have introduced alternative ways of switching MTAs. For
2601 example, if you are running FreeBSD, you need to edit the file
2602 &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_& instead of setting up a symbolic link as just
2603 described. A typical example of the contents of this file for running Exim is
2606 sendmail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2607 send-mail /usr/exim/bin/exim
2608 mailq /usr/exim/bin/exim -bp
2609 newaliases /usr/bin/true
2611 Once you have set up the symbolic link, or edited &_/etc/mail/mailer.conf_&,
2612 your Exim installation is &"live"&. Check it by sending a message from your
2613 favourite user agent.
2615 You should consider what to tell your users about the change of MTA. Exim may
2616 have different capabilities to what was previously running, and there are
2617 various operational differences such as the text of messages produced by
2618 command line options and in bounce messages. If you allow your users to make
2619 use of Exim's filtering capabilities, you should make the document entitled
2620 &'Exim's interface to mail filtering'& available to them.
2624 .section "Running the daemon" SECTdaemonLaunch
2625 The most common command line for launching the Exim daemon looks like
2629 This starts a daemon which
2631 listens for incoming smtp connections, launching handler processes for
2634 starts a queue-runner process every five minutes, to inspect queued messages
2635 and run delivery attempts on any that have arrived at their retry time
2637 Should a queue run take longer than the time between queue-runner starts,
2638 they will run in parallel.
2639 Numbers of jobs of the various types are subject to policy controls
2640 defined in the configuration.
2643 .section "Upgrading Exim" "SECID36"
2644 .cindex "upgrading Exim"
2645 If you are already running Exim on your host, building and installing a new
2646 version automatically makes it available to MUAs, or any other programs that
2647 call the MTA directly. However, if you are running an Exim daemon, you do need
2648 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2649 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2650 to send it a HUP signal, to make it re-execute itself, and thereby pick up the
2651 new binary. You do not need to stop processing mail in order to install a new
2652 version of Exim. The install script does not modify an existing runtime
2658 .section "Stopping the Exim daemon on Solaris" "SECID37"
2659 .cindex "Solaris" "stopping Exim on"
2660 The standard command for stopping the mailer daemon on Solaris is
2662 /etc/init.d/sendmail stop
2664 If &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& has been turned into a symbolic link, this script
2665 fails to stop Exim because it uses the command &'ps -e'& and greps the output
2666 for the text &"sendmail"&; this is not present because the actual program name
2667 (that is, &"exim"&) is given by the &'ps'& command with these options. A
2668 solution is to replace the line that finds the process id with something like
2670 pid=`cat /var/spool/exim/exim-daemon.pid`
2672 to obtain the daemon's pid directly from the file that Exim saves it in.
2674 Note, however, that stopping the daemon does not &"stop Exim"&. Messages can
2675 still be received from local processes, and if automatic delivery is configured
2676 (the normal case), deliveries will still occur.
2681 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2682 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2684 .chapter "The Exim command line" "CHAPcommandline"
2685 .scindex IIDclo1 "command line" "options"
2686 .scindex IIDclo2 "options" "command line"
2687 Exim's command line takes the standard Unix form of a sequence of options,
2688 each starting with a hyphen character, followed by a number of arguments. The
2689 options are compatible with the main options of Sendmail, and there are also
2690 some additional options, some of which are compatible with Smail 3. Certain
2691 combinations of options do not make sense, and provoke an error if used.
2692 The form of the arguments depends on which options are set.
2695 .section "Setting options by program name" "SECID38"
2697 If Exim is called under the name &'mailq'&, it behaves as if the option &%-bp%&
2698 were present before any other options.
2699 The &%-bp%& option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
2701 This feature is for compatibility with some systems that contain a command of
2702 that name in one of the standard libraries, symbolically linked to
2703 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& or &_/usr/lib/sendmail_&.
2706 If Exim is called under the name &'rsmtp'& it behaves as if the option &%-bS%&
2707 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The
2708 &%-bS%& option is used for reading in a number of messages in batched SMTP
2712 If Exim is called under the name &'rmail'& it behaves as if the &%-i%& and
2713 &%-oee%& options were present before any other options, for compatibility with
2714 Smail. The name &'rmail'& is used as an interface by some UUCP systems.
2717 .cindex "queue runner"
2718 If Exim is called under the name &'runq'& it behaves as if the option &%-q%&
2719 were present before any other options, for compatibility with Smail. The &%-q%&
2720 option causes a single queue runner process to be started.
2722 .cindex "&'newaliases'&"
2723 .cindex "alias file" "building"
2724 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "calling Exim as &'newaliases'&"
2725 If Exim is called under the name &'newaliases'& it behaves as if the option
2726 &%-bi%& were present before any other options, for compatibility with Sendmail.
2727 This option is used for rebuilding Sendmail's alias file. Exim does not have
2728 the concept of a single alias file, but can be configured to run a given
2729 command if called with the &%-bi%& option.
2732 .section "Trusted and admin users" "SECTtrustedadmin"
2733 Some Exim options are available only to &'trusted users'& and others are
2734 available only to &'admin users'&. In the description below, the phrases &"Exim
2735 user"& and &"Exim group"& mean the user and group defined by EXIM_USER and
2736 EXIM_GROUP in &_Local/Makefile_& or set by the &%exim_user%& and
2737 &%exim_group%& options. These do not necessarily have to use the name &"exim"&.
2740 .cindex "trusted users" "definition of"
2741 .cindex "user" "trusted definition of"
2742 The trusted users are root, the Exim user, any user listed in the
2743 &%trusted_users%& configuration option, and any user whose current group or any
2744 supplementary group is one of those listed in the &%trusted_groups%&
2745 configuration option. Note that the Exim group is not automatically trusted.
2747 .cindex '&"From"& line'
2748 .cindex "envelope from"
2749 .cindex "envelope sender"
2750 Trusted users are always permitted to use the &%-f%& option or a leading
2751 &"From&~"& line to specify the envelope sender of a message that is passed to
2752 Exim through the local interface (see the &%-bm%& and &%-f%& options below).
2753 See the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option for a way of permitting non-trusted
2754 users to set envelope senders.
2758 For a trusted user, there is never any check on the contents of the &'From:'&
2759 header line, and a &'Sender:'& line is never added. Furthermore, any existing
2760 &'Sender:'& line in incoming local (non-TCP/IP) messages is not removed.
2762 Trusted users may also specify a host name, host address, interface address,
2763 protocol name, ident value, and authentication data when submitting a message
2764 locally. Thus, they are able to insert messages into Exim's queue locally that
2765 have the characteristics of messages received from a remote host. Untrusted
2766 users may in some circumstances use &%-f%&, but can never set the other values
2767 that are available to trusted users.
2769 .cindex "user" "admin definition of"
2770 .cindex "admin user" "definition of"
2771 The admin users are root, the Exim user, and any user that is a member of the
2772 Exim group or of any group listed in the &%admin_groups%& configuration option.
2773 The current group does not have to be one of these groups.
2775 Admin users are permitted to list the queue, and to carry out certain
2776 operations on messages, for example, to force delivery failures. It is also
2777 necessary to be an admin user in order to see the full information provided by
2778 the Exim monitor, and full debugging output.
2780 By default, the use of the &%-M%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options to cause
2781 Exim to attempt delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users.
2782 However, this restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%prod_requires_admin%&
2783 option false (that is, specifying &%no_prod_requires_admin%&).
2785 Similarly, the use of the &%-bp%& option to list all the messages in the queue
2786 is restricted to admin users unless &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set
2791 &*Warning*&: If you configure your system so that admin users are able to
2792 edit Exim's configuration file, you are giving those users an easy way of
2793 getting root. There is further discussion of this issue at the start of chapter
2799 .section "Command line options" "SECID39"
2800 Exim's command line options are described in alphabetical order below. If none
2801 of the options that specifies a specific action (such as starting the daemon or
2802 a queue runner, or testing an address, or receiving a message in a specific
2803 format, or listing the queue) are present, and there is at least one argument
2804 on the command line, &%-bm%& (accept a local message on the standard input,
2805 with the arguments specifying the recipients) is assumed. Otherwise, Exim
2806 outputs a brief message about itself and exits.
2808 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2809 . Insert a stylized XML comment here, to identify the start of the command line
2810 . options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
2811 . creates a man page for the options.
2812 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
2815 <!-- === Start of command line options === -->
2821 .cindex "options" "command line; terminating"
2822 This is a pseudo-option whose only purpose is to terminate the options and
2823 therefore to cause subsequent command line items to be treated as arguments
2824 rather than options, even if they begin with hyphens.
2827 This option causes Exim to output a few sentences stating what it is.
2828 The same output is generated if the Exim binary is called with no options and
2832 This option is an alias for &%-bV%& and causes version information to be
2839 These options are used by Sendmail for selecting configuration files and are
2843 .cmdopt -atrn <&'host'&> <&'domainlist'&>
2844 This option requests an ODMR customer connection.
2845 See &<<SECTODMRCUST>>& for details.
2848 .cmdopt -B <&'type'&>
2850 .cindex "8-bit characters"
2851 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "8-bit characters"
2852 This is a Sendmail option for selecting 7 or 8 bit processing. Exim is 8-bit
2853 clean; it ignores this option.
2857 .cindex "SMTP" "listener"
2858 .cindex "queue runner"
2859 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections. Usually
2860 the &%-bd%& option is combined with the &%-q%&<&'time'&> option, to specify
2861 that the daemon should also initiate periodic queue runs.
2863 The &%-bd%& option can be used only by an admin user. If either of the &%-d%&
2864 (debugging) or &%-v%& (verifying) options are set, the daemon does not
2865 disconnect from the controlling terminal. When running this way, it can be
2866 stopped by pressing ctrl-C.
2868 By default, Exim listens for incoming connections to the standard SMTP port on
2869 all the host's running interfaces. However, it is possible to listen on other
2870 ports, on multiple ports, and only on specific interfaces. Chapter
2871 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a description of the options that control this.
2873 When a listening daemon
2874 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
2875 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
2876 is started without the use of &%-oX%& (that is, without overriding the normal
2877 configuration), it writes its process id to a file called &_exim-daemon.pid_&
2878 in Exim's spool directory. This location can be overridden by setting
2879 PID_FILE_PATH in &_Local/Makefile_&. The file is written while Exim is still
2882 When &%-oX%& is used on the command line to start a listening daemon, the
2883 process id is not written to the normal pid file path. However, &%-oP%& can be
2884 used to specify a path on the command line if a pid file is required.
2888 .cindex restart "on HUP signal"
2889 .cindex signal "HUP, to restart"
2890 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
2891 .cindex signal "to reload configuration"
2892 .cindex daemon "reload configuration"
2893 .cindex reload configuration
2894 can be used to cause the daemon to re-execute itself. This should be done
2895 whenever Exim's configuration file, or any file that is incorporated into it by
2896 means of the &%.include%& facility, is changed, and also whenever a new version
2897 of Exim is installed. It is not necessary to do this when other files that are
2898 referenced from the configuration (for example, alias files) are changed,
2899 because these are reread each time they are used.
2901 Either a SIGTERM or a SIGINT signal should be used to cause the daemon
2902 to cleanly shut down.
2903 Subprocesses handling recceiving or delivering messages,
2904 or for scanning the queue,
2905 will not be affected by the termination of the daemon process.
2908 This option has the same effect as &%-bd%& except that it never disconnects
2909 from the controlling terminal, even when no debugging is specified.
2912 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2913 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2914 Run Exim in expansion testing mode. Exim discards its root privilege, to
2915 prevent ordinary users from using this mode to read otherwise inaccessible
2916 files. If no arguments are given, Exim runs interactively, prompting for lines
2917 of data. Otherwise, it processes each argument in turn.
2919 If Exim was built with USE_READLINE=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&, it tries
2920 to load the &%libreadline%& library dynamically whenever the &%-be%& option is
2921 used without command line arguments. If successful, it uses the &[readline()]&
2922 function, which provides extensive line-editing facilities, for reading the
2923 test data. A line history is supported.
2925 Long expansion expressions can be split over several lines by using backslash
2926 continuations. As in Exim's runtime configuration, white space at the start of
2927 continuation lines is ignored. Each argument or data line is passed through the
2928 string expansion mechanism, and the result is output. Variable values from the
2929 configuration file (for example, &$qualify_domain$&) are available, but no
2930 message-specific values (such as &$message_exim_id$&) are set, because no message
2931 is being processed (but see &%-bem%& and &%-Mset%&).
2933 &*Note*&: If you use this mechanism to test lookups, and you change the data
2934 files or databases you are using, you must exit and restart Exim before trying
2935 the same lookup again. Otherwise, because each Exim process caches the results
2936 of lookups, you will just get the same result as before.
2938 Macro processing is done on lines before string-expansion: new macros can be
2939 defined and macros will be expanded.
2940 Because macros in the config file are often used for secrets, those are only
2941 available to admin users.
2943 The word &"set"& at the start of a line, followed by a single space,
2944 is recognised specially as defining a value for a variable.
2945 .cindex "tainted data" "expansion testing"
2946 If the sequence &",t"& is inserted before the space,
2947 the value is marked as tainted.
2948 The syntax is otherwise the same as the ACL modifier &"set ="&.
2950 .cmdopt -bem <&'filename'&>
2951 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
2952 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
2953 This option operates like &%-be%& except that it must be followed by the name
2954 of a file. For example:
2956 exim -bem /tmp/testmessage
2958 The file is read as a message (as if receiving a locally-submitted non-SMTP
2959 message) before any of the test expansions are done. Thus, message-specific
2960 variables such as &$message_size$& and &$header_from:$& are available. However,
2961 no &'Received:'& header is added to the message. If the &%-t%& option is set,
2962 recipients are read from the headers in the normal way, and are shown in the
2963 &$recipients$& variable. Note that recipients cannot be given on the command
2964 line, because further arguments are taken as strings to expand (just like
2967 .cmdopt -bF <&'filename'&>
2968 .cindex "system filter" "testing"
2969 .cindex "testing" "system filter"
2970 This option is the same as &%-bf%& except that it assumes that the filter being
2971 tested is a system filter. The additional commands that are available only in
2972 system filters are recognized.
2974 .cmdopt -bf <&'filename'&>
2975 .cindex "filter" "testing"
2976 .cindex "testing" "filter file"
2977 .cindex "forward file" "testing"
2978 .cindex "testing" "forward file"
2979 .cindex "Sieve filter" "testing"
2980 This option runs Exim in user filter testing mode; the file is the filter file
2981 to be tested, and a test message must be supplied on the standard input. If
2982 there are no message-dependent tests in the filter, an empty file can be
2985 If you want to test a system filter file, use &%-bF%& instead of &%-bf%&. You
2986 can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command, in order to test a system
2987 filter and a user filter in the same run. For example:
2989 exim -bF /system/filter -bf /user/filter </test/message
2991 This is helpful when the system filter adds header lines or sets filter
2992 variables that are used by the user filter.
2994 If the test filter file does not begin with one of the special lines
2999 it is taken to be a normal &_.forward_& file, and is tested for validity under
3000 that interpretation. See sections &<<SECTitenonfilred>>& to
3001 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for a description of the possible contents of non-filter
3004 The result of an Exim command that uses &%-bf%&, provided no errors are
3005 detected, is a list of the actions that Exim would try to take if presented
3006 with the message for real. More details of filter testing are given in the
3007 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
3009 When testing a filter file,
3010 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3011 .cindex "envelope from"
3012 .cindex "envelope sender"
3013 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for filter testing"
3014 the envelope sender can be set by the &%-f%& option,
3015 or by a &"From&~"& line at the start of the test message. Various parameters
3016 that would normally be taken from the envelope recipient address of the message
3017 can be set by means of additional command line options (see the next four
3020 .cmdopt -bfd <&'domain'&>
3021 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
3022 This sets the domain of the recipient address when a filter file is being
3023 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the value of
3026 .cmdopt -bfl <&'local&~part'&>
3027 This sets the local part of the recipient address when a filter file is being
3028 tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is the username of the
3029 process that calls Exim. A local part should be specified with any prefix or
3030 suffix stripped, because that is how it appears to the filter when a message is
3031 actually being delivered.
3033 .cmdopt -bfp <&'prefix'&>
3034 .cindex affix "filter testing"
3035 This sets the prefix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
3036 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
3039 .cmdopt -bfs <&'suffix'&>
3040 .cindex affix "filter testing"
3041 This sets the suffix of the local part of the recipient address when a filter
3042 file is being tested by means of the &%-bf%& option. The default is an empty
3045 .cmdopt -bh <&'IP&~address'&>
3046 .cindex "testing" "incoming SMTP"
3047 .cindex "SMTP" "testing incoming"
3048 .cindex "testing" "relay control"
3049 .cindex "relaying" "testing configuration"
3050 .cindex "policy control" "testing"
3051 .cindex "debugging" "&%-bh%& option"
3052 This option runs a fake SMTP session as if from the given IP address, using the
3053 standard input and output. The IP address may include a port number at the end,
3054 after a full stop. For example:
3056 exim -bh 10.9.8.7.1234
3057 exim -bh fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678
3059 When an IPv6 address is given, it is converted into canonical form. In the case
3060 of the second example above, the value of &$sender_host_address$& after
3061 conversion to the canonical form is
3062 &`fe80:0000:0000:0a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678`&.
3064 Comments as to what is going on are written to the standard error file. These
3065 include lines beginning with &"LOG"& for anything that would have been logged.
3066 This facility is provided for testing configuration options for incoming
3067 messages, to make sure they implement the required policy. For example, you can
3068 test your relay controls using &%-bh%&.
3072 You can test features of the configuration that rely on ident
3073 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2487,RFC 1413))
3074 information by using the &%-oMt%& option. However, Exim cannot actually perform
3075 an ident callout when testing using &%-bh%& because there is no incoming SMTP
3078 &*Warning 2*&: Address verification callouts (see section &<<SECTcallver>>&)
3079 are also skipped when testing using &%-bh%&. If you want these callouts to
3080 occur, use &%-bhc%& instead.
3082 Messages supplied during the testing session are discarded, and nothing is
3083 written to any of the real log files. There may be pauses when DNS (and other)
3084 lookups are taking place, and of course these may time out. The &%-oMi%& option
3085 can be used to specify a specific IP interface and port if this is important,
3086 and &%-oMaa%& and &%-oMai%& can be used to set parameters as if the SMTP
3087 session were authenticated.
3089 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%& whose
3090 output just states whether a given recipient address from a given host is
3091 acceptable or not. See section &<<SECTcheckaccess>>&.
3093 Features such as authentication and encryption, where the client input is not
3094 plain text, cannot easily be tested with &%-bh%&. Instead, you should use a
3095 specialized SMTP test program such as
3096 &url(https://www.jetmore.org/john/code/swaks/,swaks,swaks).
3098 .cmdopt -bhc <&'IP&~address'&>
3099 This option operates in the same way as &%-bh%&, except that address
3100 verification callouts are performed if required. This includes consulting and
3101 updating the callout cache database.
3104 .cindex "alias file" "building"
3105 .cindex "building alias file"
3106 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-bi%& option"
3107 Sendmail interprets the &%-bi%& option as a request to rebuild its alias file.
3108 Exim does not have the concept of a single alias file, and so it cannot mimic
3109 this behaviour. However, calls to &_/usr/lib/sendmail_& with the &%-bi%& option
3110 tend to appear in various scripts such as NIS make files, so the option must be
3113 If &%-bi%& is encountered, the command specified by the &%bi_command%&
3114 configuration option is run, under the uid and gid of the caller of Exim. If
3115 the &%-oA%& option is used, its value is passed to the command as an argument.
3116 The command set by &%bi_command%& may not contain arguments. The command can
3117 use the &'exim_dbmbuild'& utility, or some other means, to rebuild alias files
3118 if this is required. If the &%bi_command%& option is not set, calling Exim with
3121 . // Keep :help first, then the rest in alphabetical order
3123 .cindex "querying exim information"
3124 We shall provide various options starting &`-bI:`& for querying Exim for
3125 information. The output of many of these will be intended for machine
3126 consumption. This one is not. The &%-bI:help%& option asks Exim for a
3127 synopsis of supported options beginning &`-bI:`&. Use of any of these
3128 options shall cause Exim to exit after producing the requested output.
3131 .cindex "DSCP" "values"
3132 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all
3133 recognised DSCP names.
3136 .cindex "Sieve filter" "capabilities"
3137 This option causes Exim to emit an alphabetically sorted list of all supported
3138 Sieve protocol extensions on stdout, one per line. This is anticipated to be
3139 useful for ManageSieve
3140 (&url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc5804.html,RFC 5804))
3141 implementations, in providing that protocol's
3142 &`SIEVE`& capability response line. As the precise list may depend upon
3143 compile-time build options, which this option will adapt to, this is the only
3144 way to guarantee a correct response.
3147 .cindex "local message reception"
3148 This option runs an Exim receiving process that accepts an incoming,
3149 locally-generated message on the standard input. The recipients are given as the
3150 command arguments (except when &%-t%& is also present &-- see below). Each
3151 argument can be a comma-separated list of
3152 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822) addresses.
3154 default option for selecting the overall action of an Exim call; it is assumed
3155 if no other conflicting option is present.
3157 If any addresses in the message are unqualified (have no domain), they are
3158 qualified by the values of the &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&
3159 options, as appropriate. The &%-bnq%& option (see below) provides a way of
3160 suppressing this for special cases.
3162 Policy checks on the contents of local messages can be enforced by means of
3163 the non-SMTP ACL. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for details.
3165 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bm%&"
3166 The return code is zero if the message is successfully accepted. Otherwise, the
3167 action is controlled by the &%-oe%&&'x'& option setting &-- see below.
3170 .cindex "message" "format"
3171 .cindex "format" "message"
3172 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3173 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
3174 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
3175 of the message must be as defined in
3176 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822),
3178 compatibility with Sendmail and Smail, a line in one of the forms
3180 From sender Fri Jan 5 12:55 GMT 1997
3181 From sender Fri, 5 Jan 97 12:55:01
3183 (with the weekday optional, and possibly with additional text after the date)
3184 is permitted to appear at the start of the message. There appears to be no
3185 authoritative specification of the format of this line. Exim recognizes it by
3186 matching against the regular expression defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%&
3187 option, which can be changed if necessary.
3189 .oindex "&%-f%&" "overriding &""From""& line"
3190 The specified sender is treated as if it were given as the argument to the
3191 &%-f%& option, but if a &%-f%& option is also present, its argument is used in
3192 preference to the address taken from the message. The caller of Exim must be a
3193 trusted user for the sender of a message to be set in this way.
3195 .cmdopt -bmalware <&'filename'&>
3196 .cindex "testing", "malware"
3197 .cindex "malware scan test"
3198 This debugging option causes Exim to scan the given file or directory
3199 (depending on the used scanner interface),
3200 using the malware scanning framework. The option of &%av_scanner%& influences
3201 this option, so if &%av_scanner%&'s value is dependent upon an expansion then
3202 the expansion should have defaults which apply to this invocation. ACLs are
3203 not invoked, so if &%av_scanner%& references an ACL variable then that variable
3204 will never be populated and &%-bmalware%& will fail.
3206 Exim will have changed working directory before resolving the filename, so
3207 using fully qualified pathnames is advisable. Exim will be running as the Exim
3208 user when it tries to open the file, rather than as the invoking user.
3209 This option requires admin privileges.
3211 The &%-bmalware%& option will not be extended to be more generally useful,
3212 there are better tools for file-scanning. This option exists to help
3213 administrators verify their Exim and AV scanner configuration.
3216 .cindex "address qualification, suppressing"
3217 By default, Exim automatically qualifies unqualified addresses (those
3218 without domains) that appear in messages that are submitted locally (that
3219 is, not over TCP/IP). This qualification applies both to addresses in
3220 envelopes, and addresses in header lines. Sender addresses are qualified using
3221 &%qualify_domain%&, and recipient addresses using &%qualify_recipient%& (which
3222 defaults to the value of &%qualify_domain%&).
3224 Sometimes, qualification is not wanted. For example, if &%-bS%& (batch SMTP) is
3225 being used to re-submit messages that originally came from remote hosts after
3226 content scanning, you probably do not want to qualify unqualified addresses in
3227 header lines. (Such lines will be present only if you have not enabled a header
3228 syntax check in the appropriate ACL.)
3230 The &%-bnq%& option suppresses all qualification of unqualified addresses in
3231 messages that originate on the local host. When this is used, unqualified
3232 addresses in the envelope provoke errors (causing message rejection) and
3233 unqualified addresses in header lines are left alone.
3237 .cindex "configuration options" "extracting"
3238 .cindex "options" "configuration &-- extracting"
3239 If this option is given with no arguments, it causes the values of all Exim's
3240 main configuration options to be written to the standard output. The values
3241 of one or more specific options can be requested by giving their names as
3242 arguments, for example:
3244 exim -bP qualify_domain hold_domains
3246 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
3247 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
3248 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
3249 However, any option setting that is preceded by the word &"hide"& in the
3250 configuration file is not shown in full, except to an admin user. For other
3251 users, the output is as in this example:
3253 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
3255 If &%config%& is given as an argument, the config is
3256 output, as it was parsed, any include file resolved, any comment removed.
3258 If &%config_file%& is given as an argument, the name of the runtime
3259 configuration file is output. (&%configure_file%& works too, for
3260 backward compatibility.)
3261 If a list of configuration files was supplied, the value that is output here
3262 is the name of the file that was actually used.
3264 .cindex "options" "hiding name of"
3265 If the &%-n%& flag is given, then for most modes of &%-bP%& operation the
3266 name will not be output.
3268 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
3269 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
3270 If &%log_file_path%& or &%pid_file_path%& are given, the names of the
3271 directories where log files and daemon pid files are written are output,
3272 respectively. If these values are unset, log files are written in a
3273 sub-directory of the spool directory called &%log%&, and the pid file is
3274 written directly into the spool directory.
3276 If &%-bP%& is followed by a name preceded by &`+`&, for example,
3278 exim -bP +local_domains
3280 it searches for a matching named list of any type (domain, host, address, or
3281 local part) and outputs what it finds.
3283 .cindex "options" "router &-- extracting"
3284 .cindex "options" "transport &-- extracting"
3285 .cindex "options" "authenticator &-- extracting"
3286 If one of the words &%router%&, &%transport%&, or &%authenticator%& is given,
3287 followed by the name of an appropriate driver instance, the option settings for
3288 that driver are output. For example:
3290 exim -bP transport local_delivery
3292 The generic driver options are output first, followed by the driver's private
3293 options. A list of the names of drivers of a particular type can be obtained by
3294 using one of the words &%router_list%&, &%transport_list%&, or
3295 &%authenticator_list%&, and a complete list of all drivers with their option
3296 settings can be obtained by using &%routers%&, &%transports%&, or
3299 .cindex "environment"
3300 If &%environment%& is given as an argument, the set of environment
3301 variables is output, line by line. Using the &%-n%& flag suppresses the value of the
3304 .cindex "options" "macro &-- extracting"
3305 If invoked by an admin user, then &%macro%&, &%macro_list%& and &%macros%&
3306 are available, similarly to the drivers. Because macros are sometimes used
3307 for storing passwords, this option is restricted.
3308 The output format is one item per line.
3309 For the "-bP macro <name>" form, if no such macro is found
3310 the exit status will be nonzero.
3313 .cindex "queue" "listing messages in"
3314 .cindex "listing" "messages in the queue"
3315 This option requests a listing of the contents of the mail queue on the
3316 standard output. If the &%-bp%& option is followed by a list of message ids,
3317 just those messages are listed. By default, this option can be used only by an
3318 admin user. However, the &%queue_list_requires_admin%& option can be set false
3319 to allow any user to see the queue.
3321 Each message in the queue is displayed as in the following example:
3323 25m 2.9K 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 <alice@wonderland.fict.example>
3324 red.king@looking-glass.fict.example
3327 .cindex "message" "size in queue listing"
3328 .cindex "size" "of message"
3329 The first line contains the length of time the message has been in the queue
3330 (in this case 25 minutes), the size of the message (2.9K), the unique local
3331 identifier for the message, and the message sender, as contained in the
3332 envelope. For bounce messages, the sender address is empty, and appears as
3333 &"<>"&. If the message was submitted locally by an untrusted user who overrode
3334 the default sender address, the user's login name is shown in parentheses
3335 before the sender address.
3337 .cindex "frozen messages" "in queue listing"
3338 If the message is frozen (attempts to deliver it are suspended) then the text
3339 &"*** frozen ***"& is displayed at the end of this line.
3341 The recipients of the message (taken from the envelope, not the headers) are
3342 displayed on subsequent lines. Those addresses to which the message has already
3343 been delivered are marked with the letter D. If an original address gets
3344 expanded into several addresses via an alias or forward file, the original is
3345 displayed with a D only when deliveries for all of its child addresses are
3350 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but in addition it shows delivered addresses
3351 that were generated from the original top level address(es) in each message by
3352 alias or forwarding operations. These addresses are flagged with &"+D"& instead
3357 .cindex "queue" "count of messages on"
3358 This option counts the number of messages in the queue, and writes the total
3359 to the standard output. It is restricted to admin users, unless
3360 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
3364 .cindex queue "list of message IDs"
3365 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but only outputs message ids
3370 This option operates like &%-bp%&, but the output is not sorted into
3371 chronological order of message arrival. This can speed it up when there are
3372 lots of messages in the queue, and is particularly useful if the output is
3373 going to be post-processed in a way that doesn't need the sorting.
3376 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpa%&.
3379 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpi%&.
3382 This option is a combination of &%-bpr%& and &%-bpu%&.
3386 This option operates like &%-bp%& but shows only undelivered top-level
3387 addresses for each message displayed. Addresses generated by aliasing or
3388 forwarding are not shown, unless the message was deferred after processing by a
3389 router with the &%one_time%& option set.
3393 .cindex "testing" "retry configuration"
3394 .cindex "retry" "configuration testing"
3395 This option is for testing retry rules, and it must be followed by up to three
3396 arguments. It causes Exim to look for a retry rule that matches the values
3397 and to write it to the standard output. For example:
3399 exim -brt bach.comp.mus.example
3400 Retry rule: *.comp.mus.example F,2h,15m; F,4d,30m;
3402 See chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& for a description of Exim's retry rules. The first
3403 argument, which is required, can be a complete address in the form
3404 &'local_part@domain'&, or it can be just a domain name. If the second argument
3405 contains a dot, it is interpreted as an optional second domain name; if no
3406 retry rule is found for the first argument, the second is tried. This ties in
3407 with Exim's behaviour when looking for retry rules for remote hosts &-- if no
3408 rule is found that matches the host, one that matches the mail domain is
3409 sought. Finally, an argument that is the name of a specific delivery error, as
3410 used in setting up retry rules, can be given. For example:
3412 exim -brt haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d
3413 Retry rule: *@haydn.comp.mus.example quota_3d F,1h,15m
3417 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
3418 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
3419 This option is for testing address rewriting rules, and it must be followed by
3420 a single argument, consisting of either a local part without a domain, or a
3421 complete address with a fully qualified domain. Exim outputs how this address
3422 would be rewritten for each possible place it might appear. See chapter
3423 &<<CHAPrewrite>>& for further details.
3426 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
3427 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
3428 This option is used for batched SMTP input, which is an alternative interface
3429 for non-interactive local message submission. A number of messages can be
3430 submitted in a single run. However, despite its name, this is not really SMTP
3431 input. Exim reads each message's envelope from SMTP commands on the standard
3432 input, but generates no responses. If the caller is trusted, or
3433 &%untrusted_set_sender%& is set, the senders in the SMTP MAIL commands are
3434 believed; otherwise the sender is always the caller of Exim.
3436 The message itself is read from the standard input, in SMTP format (leading
3437 dots doubled), terminated by a line containing just a single dot. An error is
3438 provoked if the terminating dot is missing. A further message may then follow.
3440 As for other local message submissions, the contents of incoming batch SMTP
3441 messages can be checked using the non-SMTP ACL (see section &<<SECnonSMTP>>&).
3442 Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using &%qualify_domain%& and
3443 &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the &%-bnq%& option is used.
3445 Some other SMTP commands are recognized in the input. HELO and EHLO act
3446 as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN, ATRN, and HELP act as NOOP;
3447 QUIT quits, ignoring the rest of the standard input.
3449 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bS%&"
3450 If any error is encountered, reports are written to the standard output and
3451 error streams, and Exim gives up immediately. The return code is 0 if no error
3452 was detected; it is 1 if one or more messages were accepted before the error
3453 was detected; otherwise it is 2.
3455 More details of input using batched SMTP are given in section
3456 &<<SECTincomingbatchedSMTP>>&.
3459 .cindex "SMTP" "local input"
3460 .cindex "local SMTP input"
3461 This option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by reading SMTP commands
3462 on the standard input, and producing SMTP replies on the standard output. SMTP
3463 policy controls, as defined in ACLs (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) are applied.
3464 Some user agents use this interface as a way of passing locally-generated
3465 messages to the MTA.
3468 .cindex "sender" "source of"
3469 this usage, if the caller of Exim is trusted, or &%untrusted_set_sender%& is
3470 set, the senders of messages are taken from the SMTP MAIL commands.
3471 Otherwise the content of these commands is ignored and the sender is set up as
3472 the calling user. Unqualified addresses are automatically qualified using
3473 &%qualify_domain%& and &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate, unless the
3474 &%-bnq%& option is used.
3478 &%-bs%& option is also used to run Exim from &'inetd'&, as an alternative to
3479 using a listening daemon. Exim can distinguish the two cases by checking
3480 whether the standard input is a TCP/IP socket. When Exim is called from
3481 &'inetd'&, the source of the mail is assumed to be remote, and the comments
3482 above concerning senders and qualification do not apply. In this situation,
3483 Exim behaves in exactly the same way as it does when receiving a message via
3484 the listening daemon.
3487 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
3488 .cindex "address" "testing"
3489 This option runs Exim in address testing mode, in which each argument is taken
3490 as a recipient address to be tested for deliverability. The results are
3491 written to the standard output. If a test fails, and the caller is not an admin
3492 user, no details of the failure are output, because these might contain
3493 sensitive information such as usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3495 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3496 right angle bracket for addresses to be tested.
3498 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3499 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'root'& and there are
3502 Each address is handled as if it were the recipient address of a message
3503 (compare the &%-bv%& option). It is passed to the routers and the result is
3504 written to the standard output. However, any router that has
3505 &%no_address_test%& set is bypassed. This can make &%-bt%& easier to use for
3506 genuine routing tests if your first router passes everything to a scanner
3509 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bt%&"
3510 The return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3511 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3512 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3514 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
3515 &*Note*&: When actually delivering a message, Exim removes duplicate recipient
3516 addresses after routing is complete, so that only one delivery takes place.
3517 This does not happen when testing with &%-bt%&; the full results of routing are
3520 &*Warning*&: &%-bt%& can only do relatively simple testing. If any of the
3521 routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender address of a
3523 .oindex "&%-f%&" "for address testing"
3524 you can use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate sender when running
3525 &%-bt%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the calling user at the
3526 default qualifying domain. However, if you have set up (for example) routers
3527 whose behaviour depends on the contents of an incoming message, you cannot test
3528 those conditions using &%-bt%&. The &%-N%& option provides a possible way of
3532 .cindex "version number of Exim"
3533 This option causes Exim to write the current version number, compilation
3534 number, and compilation date of the &'exim'& binary to the standard output.
3535 It also lists the DBM library that is being used, the optional modules (such as
3536 specific lookup types), the drivers that are included in the binary, and the
3537 name of the runtime configuration file that is in use.
3539 As part of its operation, &%-bV%& causes Exim to read and syntax check its
3540 configuration file. However, this is a static check only. It cannot check
3541 values that are to be expanded. For example, although a misspelt ACL verb is
3542 detected, an error in the verb's arguments is not. You cannot rely on &%-bV%&
3543 alone to discover (for example) all the typos in the configuration; some
3544 realistic testing is needed. The &%-bh%& and &%-N%& options provide more
3545 dynamic testing facilities.
3548 .cindex "verifying address" "using &%-bv%&"
3549 .cindex "address" "verification"
3550 This option runs Exim in address verification mode, in which each argument is
3551 taken as a recipient address to be verified by the routers. (This does
3552 not involve any verification callouts). During normal operation, verification
3553 happens mostly as a consequence processing a &%verify%& condition in an ACL
3554 (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). If you want to test an entire ACL, possibly
3555 including callouts, see the &%-bh%& and &%-bhc%& options.
3557 If verification fails, and the caller is not an admin user, no details of the
3558 failure are output, because these might contain sensitive information such as
3559 usernames and passwords for database lookups.
3561 If no arguments are given, Exim runs in an interactive manner, prompting with a
3562 right angle bracket for addresses to be verified.
3564 Unlike the &%-be%& test option, you cannot arrange for Exim to use the
3565 &[readline()]& function, because it is running as &'exim'& and there are
3568 Verification differs from address testing (the &%-bt%& option) in that routers
3569 that have &%no_verify%& set are skipped, and if the address is accepted by a
3570 router that has &%fail_verify%& set, verification fails. The address is
3571 verified as a recipient if &%-bv%& is used; to test verification for a sender
3572 address, &%-bvs%& should be used.
3574 If the &%-v%& option is not set, the output consists of a single line for each
3575 address, stating whether it was verified or not, and giving a reason in the
3576 latter case. Without &%-v%&, generating more than one address by redirection
3577 causes verification to end successfully, without considering the generated
3578 addresses. However, if just one address is generated, processing continues,
3579 and the generated address must verify successfully for the overall verification
3582 When &%-v%& is set, more details are given of how the address has been handled,
3583 and in the case of address redirection, all the generated addresses are also
3584 considered. Verification may succeed for some and fail for others.
3587 .cindex "return code" "for &%-bv%&"
3588 return code is 2 if any address failed outright; it is 1 if no address
3589 failed outright but at least one could not be resolved for some reason. Return
3590 code 0 is given only when all addresses succeed.
3592 If any of the routers in the configuration makes any tests on the sender
3593 address of a message, you should use the &%-f%& option to set an appropriate
3594 sender when running &%-bv%& tests. Without it, the sender is assumed to be the
3595 calling user at the default qualifying domain.
3598 This option acts like &%-bv%&, but verifies the address as a sender rather
3599 than a recipient address. This affects any rewriting and qualification that
3605 .cindex "inetd" "wait mode"
3606 This option runs Exim as a daemon, awaiting incoming SMTP connections,
3607 similarly to the &%-bd%& option. All port specifications on the command-line
3608 and in the configuration file are ignored. Queue-running may not be specified.
3610 In this mode, Exim expects to be passed a socket as fd 0 (stdin) which is
3611 listening for connections. This permits the system to start up and have
3612 inetd (or equivalent) listen on the SMTP ports, starting an Exim daemon for
3613 each port only when the first connection is received.
3615 If the option is given as &%-bw%&<&'time'&> then the time is a timeout, after
3616 which the daemon will exit, which should cause inetd to listen once more.
3618 .cmdopt -C <&'filelist'&>
3619 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
3620 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
3621 .cindex "alternate configuration file"
3622 This option causes Exim to find the runtime configuration file from the given
3623 list instead of from the list specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE
3624 compile-time setting. Usually, the list will consist of just a single filename,
3625 but it can be a colon-separated list of names. In this case, the first
3626 file that exists is used. Failure to open an existing file stops Exim from
3627 proceeding any further along the list, and an error is generated.
3629 When this option is used by a caller other than root, and the list is different
3630 from the compiled-in list, Exim gives up its root privilege immediately, and
3631 runs with the real and effective uid and gid set to those of the caller.
3632 However, if a TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, that
3633 file contains a list of full pathnames, one per line, for configuration files
3634 which are trusted. Root privilege is retained for any configuration file so
3635 listed, as long as the caller is the Exim user (or the user specified in the
3636 CONFIGURE_OWNER option, if any), and as long as the configuration file is
3637 not writeable by inappropriate users or groups.
3639 Leaving TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST unset precludes the possibility of testing a
3640 configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and delivery,
3641 even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time, Exim is
3642 running as the Exim user, so when it re-executes to regain privilege for the
3643 delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root can
3644 test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a message
3645 in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using &%-M%&).
3647 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
3648 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option
3649 must start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &`/../`&.
3650 However, if the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of
3651 CONFIGURE_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as
3652 usual. There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is
3653 unset, any filename can be used with &%-C%&.
3655 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be used to confine alternative configuration files
3656 to a directory to which only root has access. This prevents someone who has
3657 broken into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
3660 The &%-C%& facility is useful for ensuring that configuration files are
3661 syntactically correct, but cannot be used for test deliveries, unless the
3662 caller is privileged, or unless it is an exotic configuration that does not
3663 require privilege. No check is made on the owner or group of the files
3664 specified by this option.
3667 .vitem &%-D%&<&'macro'&>=<&'value'&>
3669 .cindex "macro" "setting on command line"
3670 This option can be used to override macro definitions in the configuration file
3671 (see section &<<SECTmacrodefs>>&). However, like &%-C%&, if it is used by an
3672 unprivileged caller, it causes Exim to give up its root privilege.
3673 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
3674 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
3676 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_& then it should be a
3677 colon-separated list of macros which are considered safe and, if &%-D%& only
3678 supplies macros from this list, and the values are acceptable, then Exim will
3679 not give up root privilege if the caller is root, the Exim run-time user, or
3680 the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a transition mechanism and is expected
3681 to be removed in the future. Acceptable values for the macros satisfy the
3682 regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
3684 The entire option (including equals sign if present) must all be within one
3685 command line item. &%-D%& can be used to set the value of a macro to the empty
3686 string, in which case the equals sign is optional. These two commands are
3692 To include spaces in a macro definition item, quotes must be used. If you use
3693 quotes, spaces are permitted around the macro name and the equals sign. For
3696 exim '-D ABC = something' ...
3698 &%-D%& may be repeated up to 10 times on a command line.
3699 Only macro names up to 22 letters long can be set.
3702 .vitem &%-d%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3704 .cindex "debugging" "list of selectors"
3705 .cindex "debugging" "&%-d%& option"
3706 This option causes debugging information to be written to the standard
3707 error stream. It is restricted to admin users because debugging output may show
3708 database queries that contain password information. Also, the details of users'
3709 filter files should be protected. If a non-admin user uses &%-d%&, Exim
3710 writes an error message to the standard error stream and exits with a non-zero
3713 When &%-d%& is used, &%-v%& is assumed. If &%-d%& is given on its own, a lot of
3714 standard debugging data is output. This can be reduced, or increased to include
3715 some more rarely needed information, by directly following &%-d%& with a string
3716 made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. These add or remove sets
3717 of debugging data, respectively. For example, &%-d+filter%& adds filter
3718 debugging, whereas &%-d-all+filter%& selects only filter debugging. Note that
3719 no spaces are allowed in the debug setting. The available debugging categories
3721 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
3722 .irow acl "ACL interpretation"
3723 .irow auth "authenticators"
3724 .irow deliver "general delivery logic"
3725 .irow dns "DNS lookups (see also resolver)"
3726 .irow dnsbl "DNS black list (aka RBL) code"
3727 .irow exec "arguments for &[execv()]& calls"
3728 .irow expand "detailed debugging for string expansions"
3729 .irow filter "filter handling"
3730 .irow hints_lookup "hints data lookups"
3731 .irow host_lookup "all types of name-to-IP address handling"
3732 .irow ident "ident lookup"
3733 .irow interface "lists of local interfaces"
3734 .irow lists "matching things in lists"
3735 .irow load "system load checks"
3736 .irow local_scan "can be used by &[local_scan()]& (see chapter &&&
3737 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&)"
3738 .irow lookup "general lookup code and all lookups"
3739 .irow memory "memory handling"
3740 .irow noutf8 "modifier: avoid UTF-8 line-drawing"
3741 .irow pid "modifier: add pid to debug output lines"
3742 .irow process_info "setting info for the process log"
3743 .irow queue_run "queue runs"
3744 .irow receive "general message reception logic"
3745 .irow resolver "turn on the DNS resolver's debugging output"
3746 .irow retry "retry handling"
3747 .irow rewrite "address rewriting""
3748 .irow route "address routing"
3749 .irow timestamp "modifier: add timestamp to debug output lines"
3750 .irow tls "TLS logic"
3751 .irow transport "transports"
3752 .irow uid "changes of uid/gid and looking up uid/gid"
3753 .irow verify "address verification logic"
3754 .irow all "almost all of the above (see below), and also &%-v%&"
3756 The &`all`& option excludes &`memory`& when used as &`+all`&, but includes it
3757 for &`-all`&. The reason for this is that &`+all`& is something that people
3758 tend to use when generating debug output for Exim maintainers. If &`+memory`&
3759 is included, an awful lot of output that is very rarely of interest is
3760 generated, so it now has to be explicitly requested. However, &`-all`& does
3761 turn everything off.
3763 .cindex "resolver, debugging output"
3764 .cindex "DNS resolver, debugging output"
3765 The &`resolver`& option produces output only if the DNS resolver was compiled
3766 with DEBUG enabled. This is not the case in some operating systems. Also,
3767 unfortunately, debugging output from the DNS resolver is written to stdout
3770 The default (&%-d%& with no argument) omits &`expand`&, &`filter`&,
3771 &`interface`&, &`load`&, &`memory`&, &`pid`&, &`resolver`&, and &`timestamp`&.
3772 However, the &`pid`& selector is forced when debugging is turned on for a
3773 daemon, which then passes it on to any re-executed Exims. Exim also
3774 automatically adds the pid to debug lines when several remote deliveries are
3777 The &`timestamp`& selector causes the current time to be inserted at the start
3778 of all debug output lines. This can be useful when trying to track down delays
3781 .cindex debugging "UTF-8 in"
3782 .cindex UTF-8 "in debug output"
3783 The &`noutf8`& selector disables the use of
3784 UTF-8 line-drawing characters to group related information.
3785 When disabled. ascii-art is used instead.
3786 Using the &`+all`& option does not set this modifier,
3788 If the &%debug_print%& option is set in any driver, it produces output whenever
3789 any debugging is selected, or if &%-v%& is used.
3791 .vitem &%-dd%&<&'debug&~options'&>
3793 This option behaves exactly like &%-d%& except when used on a command that
3794 starts a daemon process. In that case, debugging is turned off for the
3795 subprocesses that the daemon creates. Thus, it is useful for monitoring the
3796 behaviour of the daemon without creating as much output as full debugging does.
3799 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
3800 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
3801 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
3804 .cindex "bounce message" "generating"
3805 This option specifies that an incoming message is a locally-generated delivery
3806 failure report. It is used internally by Exim when handling delivery failures
3807 and is not intended for external use. Its only effect is to stop Exim
3808 generating certain messages to the postmaster, as otherwise message cascades
3809 could occur in some situations. As part of the same option, a message id may
3810 follow the characters &%-E%&. If it does, the log entry for the receipt of the
3811 new message contains the id, following &"R="&, as a cross-reference.
3814 .oindex "&%-e%&&'x'&"
3815 There are a number of Sendmail options starting with &%-oe%& which seem to be
3816 called by various programs without the leading &%o%& in the option. For
3817 example, the &%vacation%& program uses &%-eq%&. Exim treats all options of the
3818 form &%-e%&&'x'& as synonymous with the corresponding &%-oe%&&'x'& options.
3820 .cmdopt -F <&'string'&>
3821 .cindex "sender" "name"
3822 .cindex "name" "of sender"
3823 This option sets the sender's full name for use when a locally-generated
3824 message is being accepted. In the absence of this option, the user's &'gecos'&
3825 entry from the password data is used. As users are generally permitted to alter
3826 their &'gecos'& entries, no security considerations are involved. White space
3827 between &%-F%& and the <&'string'&> is optional.
3829 .cmdopt -f <&'address'&>
3830 .cindex "sender" "address"
3831 .cindex "address" "sender"
3832 .cindex "trusted users"
3833 .cindex "envelope from"
3834 .cindex "envelope sender"
3835 .cindex "user" "trusted"
3836 This option sets the address of the envelope sender of a locally-generated
3837 message (also known as the return path). The option can normally be used only
3838 by a trusted user, but &%untrusted_set_sender%& can be set to allow untrusted
3841 Processes running as root or the Exim user are always trusted. Other
3842 trusted users are defined by the &%trusted_users%& or &%trusted_groups%&
3843 options. In the absence of &%-f%&, or if the caller is not trusted, the sender
3844 of a local message is set to the caller's login name at the default qualify
3847 There is one exception to the restriction on the use of &%-f%&: an empty sender
3848 can be specified by any user, trusted or not, to create a message that can
3849 never provoke a bounce. An empty sender can be specified either as an empty
3850 string, or as a pair of angle brackets with nothing between them, as in these
3851 examples of shell commands:
3853 exim -f '<>' user@domain
3854 exim -f "" user@domain
3856 In addition, the use of &%-f%& is not restricted when testing a filter file
3857 with &%-bf%& or when testing or verifying addresses using the &%-bt%& or
3860 Allowing untrusted users to change the sender address does not of itself make
3861 it possible to send anonymous mail. Exim still checks that the &'From:'& header
3862 refers to the local user, and if it does not, it adds a &'Sender:'& header,
3863 though this can be overridden by setting &%no_local_from_check%&.
3866 .cindex "&""From""& line"
3867 space between &%-f%& and the <&'address'&> is optional (that is, they can be
3868 given as two arguments or one combined argument). The sender of a
3869 locally-generated message can also be set (when permitted) by an initial
3870 &"From&~"& line in the message &-- see the description of &%-bm%& above &-- but
3871 if &%-f%& is also present, it overrides &"From&~"&.
3874 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing (command-line)"
3875 This option is equivalent to an ACL applying:
3877 control = suppress_local_fixups
3879 for every message received. Note that Sendmail will complain about such
3880 bad formatting, where Exim silently just does not fix it up. This may change
3883 As this affects audit information, the caller must be a trusted user to use
3886 .cmdopt -h <&'number'&>
3887 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-h%& option ignored"
3888 This option is accepted for compatibility with Sendmail, but has no effect. (In
3889 Sendmail it overrides the &"hop count"& obtained by counting &'Received:'&
3893 .cindex "Solaris" "&'mail'& command"
3894 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
3895 This option, which has the same effect as &%-oi%&, specifies that a dot on a
3896 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message.
3897 Solaris 2.4 (SunOS 5.4) Sendmail has a similar &%-i%& processing option
3898 &url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf),
3899 p. 1M-529), and therefore a &%-oi%& command line option, which both are used
3900 by its &'mailx'& command.
3902 .cmdopt -L <&'tag'&>
3903 .cindex "syslog" "process name; set with flag"
3904 This option is equivalent to setting &%syslog_processname%& in the config
3905 file and setting &%log_file_path%& to &`syslog`&.
3906 Its use is restricted to administrators. The configuration file has to be
3907 read and parsed, to determine access rights, before this is set and takes
3908 effect, so early configuration file errors will not honour this flag.
3910 The tag should not be longer than 32 characters.
3912 .cmdopt -M <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
3913 .cindex "forcing delivery"
3914 .cindex "delivery" "forcing attempt"
3915 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
3916 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message in turn. If
3917 any of the messages are frozen, they are automatically thawed before the
3918 delivery attempt. The settings of &%queue_domains%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
3919 and &%hold_domains%& are ignored.
3922 .cindex "hints database" "overriding retry hints"
3923 hints for any of the addresses are overridden &-- Exim tries to deliver even if
3924 the normal retry time has not yet been reached. This option requires the caller
3925 to be an admin user. However, there is an option called &%prod_requires_admin%&
3926 which can be set false to relax this restriction (and also the same requirement
3927 for the &%-q%&, &%-R%&, and &%-S%& options).
3929 The deliveries happen synchronously, that is, the original Exim process does
3930 not terminate until all the delivery attempts have finished. No output is
3931 produced unless there is a serious error. If you want to see what is happening,
3932 use the &%-v%& option as well, or inspect Exim's main log.
3934 .cmdopt -Mar <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
3935 .cindex "message" "adding recipients"
3936 .cindex "recipient" "adding"
3937 This option requests Exim to add the addresses to the list of recipients of the
3938 message (&"ar"& for &"add recipients"&). The first argument must be a message
3939 id, and the remaining ones must be email addresses. However, if the message is
3940 active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), it is not altered. This option
3941 can be used only by an admin user.
3943 .vitem "&%-MC%&&~<&'transport'&>&~<&'hostname'&>&&&
3945 &~<&'sequence&~number'&>&&&
3946 &~<&'message&~id'&>"
3948 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
3949 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
3950 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
3951 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3952 by Exim to invoke another instance of itself to deliver a waiting message using
3953 an existing SMTP connection, which is passed as the standard input. Details are
3954 given in chapter &<<CHAPSMTP>>&. This must be the final option, and the caller
3955 must be root or the Exim user in order to use it.
3958 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3959 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3960 connection to the remote host has been authenticated.
3963 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3964 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the
3965 remote host supports the ESMTP &_DSN_& extension.
3968 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3969 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-d%& option
3970 to pass on an information string on the purpose of the process.
3972 .cmdopt -MCG <&'queue&~name'&>
3973 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3974 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that an
3975 alternate queue is used, named by the following argument.
3978 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3979 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that a
3980 remote host supports the ESMTP &_CHUNKING_& extension.
3983 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3984 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3985 which Exim is connected advertised limits on numbers of mails, recipients or
3987 The limits are given by the following three arguments.
3990 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3991 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the server to
3992 which Exim is connected supports pipelining.
3995 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
3996 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option. It signifies that the connection
3997 t a remote server is via a SOCKS proxy, using addresses and ports given by
3998 the following four arguments.
4000 .cmdopt -MCQ <&'process&~id'&>&~<&'pipe&~fd'&>
4001 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4002 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option when the original delivery was
4003 started by a queue runner. It passes on the process id of the queue runner,
4004 together with the file descriptor number of an open pipe. Closure of the pipe
4005 signals the final completion of the sequence of processes that are passing
4006 messages through the same SMTP connection.
4008 .cmdopt -MCq <&'recipient&~address'&>&~<&'size'&>
4009 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4010 by Exim to implement quota checking for local users.
4013 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4014 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
4015 ESMTP SIZE option should be used on messages delivered down the existing
4019 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4020 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
4021 host to which Exim is connected supports TLS encryption.
4023 .vitem &%-MCr%&&~<&'SNI'&> &&&
4027 These options are not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4028 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MCt%& option, and passes on the fact that
4029 a TLS Server Name Indication was sent as part of the channel establishment.
4030 The argument gives the SNI string.
4031 The "r" variant indicates a DANE-verified connection.
4033 .cmdopt -MCt <&'IP&~address'&>&~<&'port'&>&~<&'cipher'&>
4034 This option is not intended for use by external callers. It is used internally
4035 by Exim in conjunction with the &%-MC%& option, and passes on the fact that the
4036 connection is being proxied by a parent process for handling TLS encryption.
4037 The arguments give the local address and port being proxied, and the TLS cipher.
4039 .cmdopt -Mc <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4040 .cindex "hints database" "not overridden by &%-Mc%&"
4041 .cindex "delivery" "manually started &-- not forced"
4042 This option requests Exim to run a delivery attempt on each message, in turn,
4043 but unlike the &%-M%& option, it does check for retry hints, and respects any
4044 that are found. This option is not very useful to external callers. It is
4045 provided mainly for internal use by Exim when it needs to re-invoke itself in
4046 order to regain root privilege for a delivery (see chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&).
4047 However, &%-Mc%& can be useful when testing, in order to run a delivery that
4048 respects retry times and other options such as &%hold_domains%& that are
4049 overridden when &%-M%& is used. Such a delivery does not count as a queue run.
4050 If you want to run a specific delivery as if in a queue run, you should use
4051 &%-q%& with a message id argument. A distinction between queue run deliveries
4052 and other deliveries is made in one or two places.
4054 .cmdopt -Mes <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>
4055 .cindex "message" "changing sender"
4056 .cindex "sender" "changing"
4057 This option requests Exim to change the sender address in the message to the
4058 given address, which must be a fully qualified address or &"<>"& (&"es"& for
4059 &"edit sender"&). There must be exactly two arguments. The first argument must
4060 be a message id, and the second one an email address. However, if the message
4061 is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered.
4062 This option can be used only by an admin user.
4064 .cmdopt -Mf <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4065 .cindex "freezing messages"
4066 .cindex "message" "manually freezing"
4067 This option requests Exim to mark each listed message as &"frozen"&. This
4068 prevents any delivery attempts taking place until the message is &"thawed"&,
4069 either manually or as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& configuration option.
4070 However, if any of the messages are active (in the middle of a delivery
4071 attempt), their status is not altered. This option can be used only by an admin
4074 .cmdopt -Mg <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4075 .cindex "giving up on messages"
4076 .cindex "message" "abandoning delivery attempts"
4077 .cindex "delivery" "abandoning further attempts"
4078 This option requests Exim to give up trying to deliver the listed messages,
4079 including any that are frozen. However, if any of the messages are active,
4080 their status is not altered. For non-bounce messages, a delivery error message
4081 is sent to the sender.
4082 Bounce messages are just discarded. This option can be used only by an admin
4085 .cmdopt -MG <&'queue&~name'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4087 .cindex "named queues" "moving messages"
4088 .cindex "queue" "moving messages"
4089 This option requests that each listed message be moved from its current
4090 queue to the given named queue.
4091 The destination queue name argument is required, but can be an empty
4092 string to define the default queue.
4093 If the messages are not currently located in the default queue,
4094 a &%-qG<name>%& option will be required to define the source queue.
4096 .cmdopt -Mmad <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4097 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling all"
4098 This option requests Exim to mark all the recipient addresses in the messages
4099 as already delivered (&"mad"& for &"mark all delivered"&). However, if any
4100 message is active (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not
4101 altered. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4103 .cmdopt -Mmd <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'address'&>&~<&'address'&>&~...
4104 .cindex "delivery" "cancelling by address"
4105 .cindex "recipient" "removing"
4106 .cindex "removing recipients"
4107 This option requests Exim to mark the given addresses as already delivered
4108 (&"md"& for &"mark delivered"&). The first argument must be a message id, and
4109 the remaining ones must be email addresses. These are matched to recipient
4110 addresses in the message in a case-sensitive manner. If the message is active
4111 (in the middle of a delivery attempt), its status is not altered. This option
4112 can be used only by an admin user.
4114 .cmdopt -Mrm <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4115 .cindex "removing messages"
4116 .cindex "abandoning mail"
4117 .cindex "message" "manually discarding"
4118 This option requests Exim to remove the given messages from the queue. No
4119 bounce messages are sent; each message is simply forgotten. However, if any of
4120 the messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used
4121 only by an admin user or by the user who originally caused the message to be
4122 placed in the queue.
4127 . .cindex REQUIRETLS
4128 . This option is used to request REQUIRETLS processing on the message.
4129 . It is used internally by Exim in conjunction with -E when generating
4133 .cmdopt -Mset <&'message&~id'&>
4134 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
4135 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
4136 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-be%& (that is, when testing
4137 string expansions). Exim loads the given message from its spool before doing
4138 the test expansions, thus setting message-specific variables such as
4139 &$message_size$& and the header variables. The &$recipients$& variable is made
4140 available. This feature is provided to make it easier to test expansions that
4141 make use of these variables. However, this option can be used only by an admin
4142 user. See also &%-bem%&.
4144 .cmdopt -Mt <&'message&~id'&>&~<&'message&~id'&>&~...
4145 .cindex "thawing messages"
4146 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
4147 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
4148 .cindex "message" "thawing frozen"
4149 This option requests Exim to &"thaw"& any of the listed messages that are
4150 &"frozen"&, so that delivery attempts can resume. However, if any of the
4151 messages are active, their status is not altered. This option can be used only
4154 .cmdopt -Mvb <&'message&~id'&>
4155 .cindex "listing" "message body"
4156 .cindex "message" "listing body of"
4157 This option causes the contents of the message body (-D) spool file to be
4158 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4160 .cmdopt -Mvc <&'message&~id'&>
4161 .cindex "message" "listing in RFC 2822 format"
4162 .cindex "listing" "message in RFC 2822 format"
4163 This option causes a copy of the complete message (header lines plus body) to
4164 be written to the standard output in
4165 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
4166 format. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4168 .cmdopt -Mvh <&'message&~id'&>
4169 .cindex "listing" "message headers"
4170 .cindex "header lines" "listing"
4171 .cindex "message" "listing header lines"
4172 This option causes the contents of the message headers (-H) spool file to be
4173 written to the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4175 .cmdopt -Mvl <&'message&~id'&>
4176 .cindex "listing" "message log"
4177 .cindex "message" "listing message log"
4178 This option causes the contents of the message log spool file to be written to
4179 the standard output. This option can be used only by an admin user.
4182 This is a synonym for &%-om%& that is accepted by Sendmail
4183 (&url(https://docs.oracle.com/cd/E19457-01/801-6680-1M/801-6680-1M.pdf)
4184 p. 1M-258), so Exim treats it that way too.
4187 .cindex "debugging" "&%-N%& option"
4188 .cindex "debugging" "suppressing delivery"
4189 This is a debugging option that inhibits delivery of a message at the transport
4190 level. It implies &%-v%&. Exim goes through many of the motions of delivery &--
4191 it just doesn't actually transport the message, but instead behaves as if it
4192 had successfully done so. However, it does not make any updates to the retry
4193 database, and the log entries for deliveries are flagged with &"*>"& rather
4196 Because &%-N%& discards any message to which it applies, only root or the Exim
4197 user are allowed to use it with &%-bd%&, &%-q%&, &%-R%& or &%-M%&. In other
4198 words, an ordinary user can use it only when supplying an incoming message to
4199 which it will apply. Although transportation never fails when &%-N%& is set, an
4200 address may be deferred because of a configuration problem on a transport, or a
4201 routing problem. Once &%-N%& has been used for a delivery attempt, it sticks to
4202 the message, and applies to any subsequent delivery attempts that may happen
4206 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &"no aliasing"&.
4207 For normal modes of operation, it is ignored by Exim.
4208 When combined with &%-bP%& it makes the output more terse (suppresses
4209 option names, environment values and config pretty printing).
4211 .cmdopt -O <&'data'&>
4212 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to mean &`set option`&. It is ignored by
4215 .cmdopt -oA <&'file&~name'&>
4216 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oA%& option"
4217 This option is used by Sendmail in conjunction with &%-bi%& to specify an
4218 alternative alias filename. Exim handles &%-bi%& differently; see the
4222 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4223 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4224 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4225 This is a debugging option which limits the maximum number of messages that can
4226 be delivered down one SMTP connection, overriding the value set in any &(smtp)&
4227 transport. If <&'n'&> is omitted, the limit is set to 1.
4230 .cindex "background delivery"
4231 .cindex "delivery" "in the background"
4232 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4233 including the listening daemon. It requests &"background"& delivery of such
4234 messages, which means that the accepting process automatically starts a
4235 delivery process for each message received, but does not wait for the delivery
4236 processes to finish.
4238 When all the messages have been received, the reception process exits,
4239 leaving the delivery processes to finish in their own time. The standard output
4240 and error streams are closed at the start of each delivery process.
4241 This is the default action if none of the &%-od%& options are present.
4243 If one of the queueing options in the configuration file
4244 (&%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%&, for example) is in effect, &%-odb%&
4245 overrides it if &%queue_only_override%& is set true, which is the default
4246 setting. If &%queue_only_override%& is set false, &%-odb%& has no effect.
4249 .cindex "foreground delivery"
4250 .cindex "delivery" "in the foreground"
4251 This option requests &"foreground"& (synchronous) delivery when Exim has
4252 accepted a locally-generated message. (For the daemon it is exactly the same as
4253 &%-odb%&.) A delivery process is automatically started to deliver the message,
4254 and Exim waits for it to complete before proceeding.
4256 The original Exim reception process does not finish until the delivery
4257 process for the final message has ended. The standard error stream is left open
4260 However, like &%-odb%&, this option has no effect if &%queue_only_override%& is
4261 false and one of the queueing options in the configuration file is in effect.
4263 If there is a temporary delivery error during foreground delivery, the
4264 message is left in the queue for later delivery, and the original reception
4265 process exits. See chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>& for a way of setting up a
4266 restricted configuration that never queues messages.
4270 This option is synonymous with &%-odf%&. It is provided for compatibility with
4274 .cindex "non-immediate delivery"
4275 .cindex "delivery" "suppressing immediate"
4276 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
4277 This option applies to all modes in which Exim accepts incoming messages,
4278 including the listening daemon. It specifies that the accepting process should
4279 not automatically start a delivery process for each message received. Messages
4280 are placed in the queue, and remain there until a subsequent queue runner
4281 process encounters them. There are several configuration options (such as
4282 &%queue_only%&) that can be used to queue incoming messages under certain
4283 conditions. This option overrides all of them and also &%-odqs%&. It always
4287 .cindex "SMTP" "delaying delivery"
4288 .cindex "first pass routing"
4289 This option is a hybrid between &%-odb%&/&%-odi%& and &%-odq%&.
4290 However, like &%-odb%& and &%-odi%&, this option has no effect if
4291 &%queue_only_override%& is false and one of the queueing options in the
4292 configuration file is in effect.
4294 When &%-odqs%& does operate, a delivery process is started for each incoming
4295 message, in the background by default, but in the foreground if &%-odi%& is
4296 also present. The recipient addresses are routed, and local deliveries are done
4297 in the normal way. However, if any SMTP deliveries are required, they are not
4298 done at this time, so the message remains in the queue until a subsequent queue
4299 runner process encounters it. Because routing was done, Exim knows which
4300 messages are waiting for which hosts, and so a number of messages for the same
4301 host can be sent in a single SMTP connection. The &%queue_smtp_domains%&
4302 configuration option has the same effect for specific domains. See also the
4306 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4307 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received (for
4308 example, a malformed address), the error is reported to the sender in a mail
4311 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oee%&"
4313 this error message is successfully sent, the Exim receiving process
4314 exits with a return code of zero. If not, the return code is 2 if the problem
4315 is that the original message has no recipients, or 1 for any other error.
4316 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option if Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4319 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4320 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oem%&"
4321 This is the same as &%-oee%&, except that Exim always exits with a non-zero
4322 return code, whether or not the error message was successfully sent.
4323 This is the default &%-oe%&&'x'& option, unless Exim is called as &'rmail'&.
4326 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4327 If an error is detected while a non-SMTP message is being received, the
4328 error is reported by writing a message to the standard error file (stderr).
4329 .cindex "return code" "for &%-oep%&"
4330 The return code is 1 for all errors.
4333 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4334 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4338 .cindex "error" "reporting"
4339 This option is supported for compatibility with Sendmail, but has the same
4343 .cindex "dot" "in incoming non-SMTP message"
4344 This option, which has the same effect as &%-i%&, specifies that a dot on a
4345 line by itself should not terminate an incoming, non-SMTP message. Otherwise, a
4346 single dot does terminate, though Exim does no special processing for other
4347 lines that start with a dot. This option is set by default if Exim is called as
4348 &'rmail'&. See also &%-ti%&.
4351 This option is treated as synonymous with &%-oi%&.
4353 .cmdopt -oMa <&'host&~address'&>
4354 .cindex "sender" "host address, specifying for local message"
4355 A number of options starting with &%-oM%& can be used to set values associated
4356 with remote hosts on locally-submitted messages (that is, messages not received
4357 over TCP/IP). These options can be used by any caller in conjunction with the
4358 &%-bh%&, &%-be%&, &%-bf%&, &%-bF%&, &%-bt%&, or &%-bv%& testing options. In
4359 other circumstances, they are ignored unless the caller is trusted.
4361 The &%-oMa%& option sets the sender host address. This may include a port
4362 number at the end, after a full stop (period). For example:
4364 exim -bs -oMa 10.9.8.7.1234
4366 An alternative syntax is to enclose the IP address in square brackets,
4367 followed by a colon and the port number:
4369 exim -bs -oMa [10.9.8.7]:1234
4371 The IP address is placed in the &$sender_host_address$& variable, and the
4372 port, if present, in &$sender_host_port$&. If both &%-oMa%& and &%-bh%&
4373 are present on the command line, the sender host IP address is taken from
4374 whichever one is last.
4376 .cmdopt -oMaa <&'name'&>
4377 .cindex "authentication" "name, specifying for local message"
4378 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMaa%&
4379 option sets the value of &$sender_host_authenticated$& (the authenticator
4380 name). See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of SMTP authentication.
4381 This option can be used with &%-bh%& and &%-bs%& to set up an
4382 authenticated SMTP session without actually using the SMTP AUTH command.
4384 .cmdopt -oMai <&'string'&>
4385 .cindex "authentication" "id, specifying for local message"
4386 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMai%&
4387 option sets the value of &$authenticated_id$& (the id that was authenticated).
4388 This overrides the default value (the caller's login id, except with &%-bh%&,
4389 where there is no default) for messages from local sources. See chapter
4390 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated ids.
4392 .cmdopt -oMas <&'address'&>
4393 .cindex "authentication" "sender, specifying for local message"
4394 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMas%&
4395 option sets the authenticated sender value in &$authenticated_sender$&. It
4396 overrides the sender address that is created from the caller's login id for
4397 messages from local sources, except when &%-bh%& is used, when there is no
4398 default. For both &%-bh%& and &%-bs%&, an authenticated sender that is
4399 specified on a MAIL command overrides this value. See chapter
4400 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for a discussion of authenticated senders.
4402 .cmdopt -oMi <&'interface&~address'&>
4403 .cindex "interface" "address, specifying for local message"
4404 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMi%&
4405 option sets the IP interface address value. A port number may be included,
4406 using the same syntax as for &%-oMa%&. The interface address is placed in
4407 &$received_ip_address$& and the port number, if present, in &$received_port$&.
4409 .cmdopt -oMm <&'message&~reference'&>
4410 .cindex "message reference" "message reference, specifying for local message"
4411 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMm%&
4412 option sets the message reference, e.g. message-id, and is logged during
4413 delivery. This is useful when some kind of audit trail is required to tie
4414 messages together. The format of the message reference is checked and will
4415 abort if the format is invalid. The option will only be accepted if exim is
4416 running in trusted mode, not as any regular user.
4418 The best example of a message reference is when Exim sends a bounce message.
4419 The message reference is the message-id of the original message for which Exim
4420 is sending the bounce.
4422 .cmdopt -oMr <&'protocol&~name'&>
4423 .cindex "protocol, specifying for local message"
4424 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
4425 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMr%&
4426 option sets the received protocol value that is stored in
4427 &$received_protocol$&. However, it does not apply (and is ignored) when &%-bh%&
4428 or &%-bs%& is used. For &%-bh%&, the protocol is forced to one of the standard
4429 SMTP protocol names (see the description of &$received_protocol$& in section
4430 &<<SECTexpvar>>&). For &%-bs%&, the protocol is always &"local-"& followed by
4431 one of those same names. For &%-bS%& (batched SMTP) however, the protocol can
4432 be set by &%-oMr%&. Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4434 .cmdopt -oMs <&'host&~name'&>
4435 .cindex "sender" "host name, specifying for local message"
4436 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMs%&
4437 option sets the sender host name in &$sender_host_name$&. When this option is
4438 present, Exim does not attempt to look up a host name from an IP address; it
4439 uses the name it is given.
4441 .cmdopt -oMt <&'ident&~string'&>
4442 .cindex "sender" "ident string, specifying for local message"
4443 See &%-oMa%& above for general remarks about the &%-oM%& options. The &%-oMt%&
4444 option sets the sender ident value in &$sender_ident$&. The default setting for
4445 local callers is the login id of the calling process, except when &%-bh%& is
4446 used, when there is no default.
4449 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-om%& option ignored"
4450 In Sendmail, this option means &"me too"&, indicating that the sender of a
4451 message should receive a copy of the message if the sender appears in an alias
4452 expansion. Exim always does this, so the option does nothing.
4455 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-oo%& option ignored"
4456 This option is ignored. In Sendmail it specifies &"old style headers"&,
4457 whatever that means.
4459 .cmdopt -oP <&'path'&>
4460 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4461 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4462 This option is useful only in conjunction with &%-bd%& or &%-q%& with a time
4463 value. The option specifies the file to which the process id of the daemon is
4464 written. When &%-oX%& is used with &%-bd%&, or when &%-q%& with a time is used
4465 without &%-bd%&, this is the only way of causing Exim to write a pid file,
4466 because in those cases, the normal pid file is not used.
4469 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of daemon"
4470 .cindex "daemon" "process id (pid)"
4471 This option is not intended for general use.
4472 The daemon uses it when terminating due to a SIGTEM, possibly in
4473 combination with &%-oP%&&~<&'path'&>.
4474 It causes the pid file to be removed.
4476 .cmdopt -or <&'time'&>
4477 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
4478 This option sets a timeout value for incoming non-SMTP messages. If it is not
4479 set, Exim will wait forever for the standard input. The value can also be set
4480 by the &%receive_timeout%& option. The format used for specifying times is
4481 described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4483 .cmdopt -os <&'time'&>
4484 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
4485 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
4486 This option sets a timeout value for incoming SMTP messages. The timeout
4487 applies to each SMTP command and block of data. The value can also be set by
4488 the &%smtp_receive_timeout%& option; it defaults to 5 minutes. The format used
4489 for specifying times is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&.
4492 This option has exactly the same effect as &%-v%&.
4494 .cmdopt -oX <&'number&~or&~string'&>
4495 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
4496 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
4497 .cindex "port" "receiving TCP/IP"
4498 This option is relevant only when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option
4499 is also given. It controls which ports and interfaces the daemon uses. Details
4500 of the syntax, and how it interacts with configuration file options, are given
4501 in chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&. When &%-oX%& is used to start a daemon, no pid
4502 file is written unless &%-oP%& is also present to specify a pid filename.
4505 .cindex "daemon notifier socket"
4506 This option controls the creation of an inter-process communications endpoint
4508 It is only relevant when the &%-bd%& (start listening daemon) option is also
4510 Normally the daemon creates this socket, unless a &%-oX%& and &*no*& &%-oP%&
4511 option is also present.
4512 If this option is given then the socket will not be created. This is required
4513 if the system is running multiple daemons, in which case it should
4515 The features supported by the socket will not be available in such cases.
4517 The socket is currently used for
4519 fast ramp-up of queue runner processes
4521 caching compiled regexes
4523 obtaining a current queue size
4527 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4528 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4529 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4530 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to be delayed until it is
4534 .cindex "Perl" "starting the interpreter"
4535 This option applies when an embedded Perl interpreter is linked with Exim (see
4536 chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&). It overrides the setting of the &%perl_at_start%&
4537 option, forcing the starting of the interpreter to occur as soon as Exim is
4540 .vitem &%-p%&<&'rval'&>:<&'sval'&>
4542 For compatibility with Sendmail, this option is equivalent to
4544 &`-oMr`& <&'rval'&> &`-oMs`& <&'sval'&>
4546 It sets the incoming protocol and host name (for trusted callers). The
4547 host name and its colon can be omitted when only the protocol is to be set.
4548 Note the Exim already has two private options, &%-pd%& and &%-ps%&, that refer
4549 to embedded Perl. It is therefore impossible to set a protocol value of &`d`&
4550 or &`s`& using this option (but that does not seem a real limitation).
4551 Repeated use of this option is not supported.
4554 .cindex "queue runner" "starting manually"
4555 This option is normally restricted to admin users. However, there is a
4556 configuration option called &%prod_requires_admin%& which can be set false to
4557 relax this restriction (and also the same requirement for the &%-M%&, &%-R%&,
4558 and &%-S%& options).
4560 .cindex "queue runner" "description of operation"
4561 If other commandline options do not specify an action,
4562 the &%-q%& option starts one queue runner process. This scans the queue of
4563 waiting messages, and runs a delivery process for each one in turn. It waits
4564 for each delivery process to finish before starting the next one. A delivery
4565 process may not actually do any deliveries if the retry times for the addresses
4566 have not been reached. Use &%-qf%& (see below) if you want to override this.
4569 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4570 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4571 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4572 the delivery process spawns other processes to deliver other messages down
4573 passed SMTP connections, the queue runner waits for these to finish before
4576 When all the queued messages have been considered, the original queue runner
4577 process terminates. In other words, a single pass is made over the waiting
4578 mail, one message at a time. Use &%-q%& with a time (see below) if you want
4579 this to be repeated periodically.
4581 Exim processes the waiting messages in an unpredictable order. It isn't very
4582 random, but it is likely to be different each time, which is all that matters.
4583 If one particular message screws up a remote MTA, other messages to the same
4584 MTA have a chance of getting through if they get tried first.
4586 It is possible to cause the messages to be processed in lexical message id
4587 order, which is essentially the order in which they arrived, by setting the
4588 &%queue_run_in_order%& option, but this is not recommended for normal use.
4590 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>
4591 The &%-q%& option may be followed by one or more flag letters that change its
4592 behaviour. They are all optional, but if more than one is present, they must
4593 appear in the correct order. Each flag is described in a separate item below.
4597 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
4598 .cindex "queue" "routing"
4599 .cindex "routing" "whole queue before delivery"
4600 .cindex "first pass routing"
4601 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
4602 An option starting with &%-qq%& requests a two-stage queue run. In the first
4603 stage, the queue is scanned as if the &%queue_smtp_domains%& option matched
4604 every domain. Addresses are routed, local deliveries happen, but no remote
4607 Performance will be best if the &%queue_run_in_order%& option is false.
4609 the &%queue_fast_ramp%& option is true
4610 and a daemon-notifier socket is available
4611 then in the first phase of the run,
4612 once a threshold number of messages are routed for a given host,
4613 a delivery process is forked in parallel with the rest of the scan.
4615 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
4616 The hints database that remembers which messages are waiting for specific hosts
4617 is updated, as if delivery to those hosts had been deferred.
4619 After the first queue scan complete,
4620 a second, normal queue scan is done, with routing and delivery taking
4622 Messages that are routed to the same host should mostly be
4623 delivered down a single SMTP
4624 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
4625 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
4626 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
4627 connection because of the hints that were set up during the first queue scan.
4629 Two-phase queue runs should be used on systems which, even intermittently,
4630 have a large queue (such as mailing-list operators).
4631 They may also be useful for hosts that are connected to the Internet
4634 .vitem &%-q[q]i...%&
4636 .cindex "queue" "initial delivery"
4637 If the &'i'& flag is present, the queue runner runs delivery processes only for
4638 those messages that haven't previously been tried. (&'i'& stands for &"initial
4639 delivery"&.) This can be helpful if you are putting messages in the queue using
4640 &%-odq%& and want a queue runner just to process the new messages.
4642 .vitem &%-q[q][i]f...%&
4644 .cindex "queue" "forcing delivery"
4645 .cindex "delivery" "forcing in queue run"
4646 If one &'f'& flag is present, a delivery attempt is forced for each non-frozen
4647 message, whereas without &'f'& only those non-frozen addresses that have passed
4648 their retry times are tried.
4650 .vitem &%-q[q][i]ff...%&
4652 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4653 If &'ff'& is present, a delivery attempt is forced for every message, whether
4656 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]]l%&
4658 .cindex "queue" "local deliveries only"
4659 The &'l'& (the letter &"ell"&) flag specifies that only local deliveries are to
4660 be done. If a message requires any remote deliveries, it remains in the queue
4663 .vitem &%-q[q][i][f[f]][l][G<name>[/<time>]]]%&
4666 .cindex "named queues" "deliver from"
4667 .cindex "queue" "delivering specific messages"
4668 If the &'G'& flag and a name is present, the queue runner operates on the
4669 queue with the given name rather than the default queue.
4670 The name should not contain a &'/'& character.
4671 For a periodic queue run (see below)
4672 append to the name a slash and a time value.
4674 If other commandline options specify an action, a &'-qG<name>'& option
4675 will specify a queue to operate on.
4678 exim -bp -qGquarantine
4680 exim -qGoffpeak -Rf @special.domain.example
4683 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&>&~<&'start&~id'&>&~<&'end&~id'&>
4684 When scanning the queue, Exim can be made to skip over messages whose ids are
4685 lexically less than a given value by following the &%-q%& option with a
4686 starting message id. For example:
4688 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4690 Messages that arrived earlier than &`0t5C6f-0000c8-00`& are not inspected. If a
4691 second message id is given, messages whose ids are lexically greater than it
4692 are also skipped. If the same id is given twice, for example,
4694 exim -q 0t5C6f-0000c8-00 0t5C6f-0000c8-00
4696 just one delivery process is started, for that message. This differs from
4697 &%-M%& in that retry data is respected, and it also differs from &%-Mc%& in
4698 that it counts as a delivery from a queue run. Note that the selection
4699 mechanism does not affect the order in which the messages are scanned. There
4700 are also other ways of selecting specific sets of messages for delivery in a
4701 queue run &-- see &%-R%& and &%-S%&.
4703 .vitem &%-q%&<&'qflags'&><&'time'&>
4704 .cindex "queue runner" "starting periodically"
4705 .cindex "periodic queue running"
4706 When a time value is present, the &%-q%& option causes Exim to run as a daemon,
4707 starting a queue runner process at intervals specified by the given time value
4708 (whose format is described in section &<<SECTtimeformat>>&). This form of the
4709 &%-q%& option is commonly combined with the &%-bd%& option, in which case a
4710 single daemon process handles both functions. A common way of starting up a
4711 combined daemon at system boot time is to use a command such as
4713 /usr/exim/bin/exim -bd -q30m
4715 Such a daemon listens for incoming SMTP calls, and also starts a queue runner
4716 process every 30 minutes.
4718 .cindex "named queues" "queue runners"
4719 It is possible to set up runners for multiple named queues within one daemon,
4722 exim -qGhipri/2m -q10m -qqGmailinglist/1h
4725 When a daemon is started by &%-q%& with a time value, but without &%-bd%&, no
4726 pid file is written unless one is explicitly requested by the &%-oP%& option.
4728 .vitem &%-qR%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4730 This option is synonymous with &%-R%&. It is provided for Sendmail
4733 .vitem &%-qS%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4735 This option is synonymous with &%-S%&.
4737 .vitem &%-R%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4739 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific recipients"
4740 .cindex "delivery" "to given domain"
4741 .cindex "domain" "delivery to"
4742 The <&'rsflags'&> may be empty, in which case the white space before the string
4743 is optional, unless the string is &'f'&, &'ff'&, &'r'&, &'rf'&, or &'rff'&,
4744 which are the possible values for <&'rsflags'&>. White space is required if
4745 <&'rsflags'&> is not empty.
4747 This option is similar to &%-q%& with no time value, that is, it causes Exim to
4748 perform a single queue run, except that, when scanning the messages on the
4749 queue, Exim processes only those that have at least one undelivered recipient
4750 address containing the given string, which is checked in a case-independent
4751 way. If the <&'rsflags'&> start with &'r'&, <&'string'&> is interpreted as a
4752 regular expression; otherwise it is a literal string.
4754 If you want to do periodic queue runs for messages with specific recipients,
4755 you can combine &%-R%& with &%-q%& and a time value. For example:
4757 exim -q25m -R @special.domain.example
4759 This example does a queue run for messages with recipients in the given domain
4760 every 25 minutes. Any additional flags that are specified with &%-q%& are
4761 applied to each queue run.
4763 Once a message is selected for delivery by this mechanism, all its addresses
4764 are processed. For the first selected message, Exim overrides any retry
4765 information and forces a delivery attempt for each undelivered address. This
4766 means that if delivery of any address in the first message is successful, any
4767 existing retry information is deleted, and so delivery attempts for that
4768 address in subsequently selected messages (which are processed without forcing)
4769 will run. However, if delivery of any address does not succeed, the retry
4770 information is updated, and in subsequently selected messages, the failing
4771 address will be skipped.
4773 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing delivery"
4774 If the <&'rsflags'&> contain &'f'& or &'ff'&, the delivery forcing applies to
4775 all selected messages, not just the first; frozen messages are included when
4778 The &%-R%& option makes it straightforward to initiate delivery of all messages
4779 to a given domain after a host has been down for some time. When the SMTP
4780 command ETRN is accepted by its ACL (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&), its default
4781 effect is to run Exim with the &%-R%& option, but it can be configured to run
4782 an arbitrary command instead.
4785 This is a documented (for Sendmail) obsolete alternative name for &%-f%&.
4787 .vitem &%-S%&<&'rsflags'&>&~<&'string'&>
4789 .cindex "delivery" "from given sender"
4790 .cindex "queue runner" "for specific senders"
4791 This option acts like &%-R%& except that it checks the string against each
4792 message's sender instead of against the recipients. If &%-R%& is also set, both
4793 conditions must be met for a message to be selected. If either of the options
4794 has &'f'& or &'ff'& in its flags, the associated action is taken.
4796 .cmdopt -Tqt <&'times'&>
4797 This is an option that is exclusively for use by the Exim testing suite. It is not
4798 recognized when Exim is run normally. It allows for the setting up of explicit
4799 &"queue times"& so that various warning/retry features can be tested.
4802 .cindex "recipient" "extracting from header lines"
4806 When Exim is receiving a locally-generated, non-SMTP message on its standard
4807 input, the &%-t%& option causes the recipients of the message to be obtained
4808 from the &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'& header lines in the message instead of
4809 from the command arguments. The addresses are extracted before any rewriting
4810 takes place and the &'Bcc:'& header line, if present, is then removed.
4812 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
4813 If the command has any arguments, they specify addresses to which the message
4814 is &'not'& to be delivered. That is, the argument addresses are removed from
4815 the recipients list obtained from the headers. This is compatible with Smail 3
4816 and in accordance with the documented behaviour of several versions of
4817 Sendmail, as described in man pages on a number of operating systems (e.g.
4818 Solaris 8, IRIX 6.5, HP-UX 11). However, some versions of Sendmail &'add'&
4819 argument addresses to those obtained from the headers, and the O'Reilly
4820 Sendmail book documents it that way. Exim can be made to add argument addresses
4821 instead of subtracting them by setting the option
4822 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& false.
4824 .cindex "&%Resent-%& header lines" "with &%-t%&"
4825 If there are any &%Resent-%& header lines in the message, Exim extracts
4826 recipients from all &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&, and &'Resent-Bcc:'& header
4827 lines instead of from &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and &'Bcc:'&. This is for compatibility
4828 with Sendmail and other MTAs. (Prior to release 4.20, Exim gave an error if
4829 &%-t%& was used in conjunction with &%Resent-%& header lines.)
4831 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
4832 talks about different sets of &%Resent-%& header lines (for when a
4833 message is resent several times). The RFC also specifies that they should be
4834 added at the front of the message, and separated by &'Received:'& lines. It is
4835 not at all clear how &%-t%& should operate in the present of multiple sets,
4836 nor indeed exactly what constitutes a &"set"&.
4837 In practice, it seems that MUAs do not follow the RFC. The &%Resent-%& lines
4838 are often added at the end of the header, and if a message is resent more than
4839 once, it is common for the original set of &%Resent-%& headers to be renamed as
4840 &%X-Resent-%& when a new set is added. This removes any possible ambiguity.
4843 This option is exactly equivalent to &%-t%& &%-i%&. It is provided for
4844 compatibility with Sendmail.
4846 .cmdopt -tls-on-connect
4847 .cindex "TLS" "use without STARTTLS"
4848 .cindex "TLS" "automatic start"
4849 This option is available when Exim is compiled with TLS support. It forces all
4850 incoming SMTP connections to behave as if the incoming port is listed in the
4851 &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option. See section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>& and chapter
4852 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
4856 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-U%& option ignored"
4857 Sendmail uses this option for &"initial message submission"&, and its
4858 documentation states that in future releases, it may complain about
4859 syntactically invalid messages rather than fixing them when this flag is not
4860 set. Exim ignores this option.
4863 This option causes Exim to write information to the standard error stream,
4864 describing what it is doing. In particular, it shows the log lines for
4865 receiving and delivering a message, and if an SMTP connection is made, the SMTP
4866 dialogue is shown. Some of the log lines shown may not actually be written to
4867 the log if the setting of &%log_selector%& discards them. Any relevant
4868 selectors are shown with each log line. If none are shown, the logging is
4872 AIX uses &%-x%& for a private purpose (&"mail from a local mail program has
4873 National Language Support extended characters in the body of the mail item"&).
4874 It sets &%-x%& when calling the MTA from its &%mail%& command. Exim ignores
4877 .cmdopt -X <&'logfile'&>
4878 This option is interpreted by Sendmail to cause debug information to be sent
4879 to the named file. It is ignored by Exim.
4881 .cmdopt -z <&'log-line'&>
4882 This option writes its argument to Exim's logfile.
4883 Use is restricted to administrators; the intent is for operational notes.
4884 Quotes should be used to maintain a multi-word item as a single argument,
4892 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4893 . Insert a stylized DocBook comment here, to identify the end of the command
4894 . line options. This is for the benefit of the Perl script that automatically
4895 . creates a man page for the options.
4896 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4899 <!-- === End of command line options === -->
4906 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4907 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
4910 .chapter "The Exim runtime configuration file" "CHAPconf" &&&
4911 "The runtime configuration file"
4913 .cindex "runtime configuration"
4914 .cindex "configuration file" "general description"
4915 .cindex "CONFIGURE_FILE"
4916 .cindex "configuration file" "errors in"
4917 .cindex "error" "in configuration file"
4918 .cindex "return code" "for bad configuration"
4919 Exim uses a single runtime configuration file that is read whenever an Exim
4920 binary is executed. Note that in normal operation, this happens frequently,
4921 because Exim is designed to operate in a distributed manner, without central
4924 If a syntax error is detected while reading the configuration file, Exim
4925 writes a message on the standard error, and exits with a non-zero return code.
4926 The message is also written to the panic log. &*Note*&: Only simple syntax
4927 errors can be detected at this time. The values of any expanded options are
4928 not checked until the expansion happens, even when the expansion does not
4929 actually alter the string.
4931 The name of the configuration file is compiled into the binary for security
4932 reasons, and is specified by the CONFIGURE_FILE compilation option. In
4933 most configurations, this specifies a single file. However, it is permitted to
4934 give a colon-separated list of filenames, in which case Exim uses the first
4935 existing file in the list.
4938 .cindex "EXIM_GROUP"
4939 .cindex "CONFIGURE_OWNER"
4940 .cindex "CONFIGURE_GROUP"
4941 .cindex "configuration file" "ownership"
4942 .cindex "ownership" "configuration file"
4943 The runtime configuration file must be owned by root or by the user that is
4944 specified at compile time by the CONFIGURE_OWNER option (if set). The
4945 configuration file must not be world-writeable, or group-writeable unless its
4946 group is the root group or the one specified at compile time by the
4947 CONFIGURE_GROUP option.
4949 &*Warning*&: In a conventional configuration, where the Exim binary is setuid
4950 to root, anybody who is able to edit the runtime configuration file has an
4951 easy way to run commands as root. If you specify a user or group in the
4952 CONFIGURE_OWNER or CONFIGURE_GROUP options, then that user and/or any users
4953 who are members of that group will trivially be able to obtain root privileges.
4955 Up to Exim version 4.72, the runtime configuration file was also permitted to
4956 be writeable by the Exim user and/or group. That has been changed in Exim 4.73
4957 since it offered a simple privilege escalation for any attacker who managed to
4958 compromise the Exim user account.
4960 A default configuration file, which will work correctly in simple situations,
4961 is provided in the file &_src/configure.default_&. If CONFIGURE_FILE
4962 defines just one filename, the installation process copies the default
4963 configuration to a new file of that name if it did not previously exist. If
4964 CONFIGURE_FILE is a list, no default is automatically installed. Chapter
4965 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>& is a &"walk-through"& discussion of the default
4970 .section "Using a different configuration file" "SECID40"
4971 .cindex "configuration file" "alternate"
4972 A one-off alternate configuration can be specified by the &%-C%& command line
4973 option, which may specify a single file or a list of files. However, when
4974 &%-C%& is used, Exim gives up its root privilege, unless called by root (or
4975 unless the argument for &%-C%& is identical to the built-in value from
4976 CONFIGURE_FILE), or is listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file and the caller
4977 is the Exim user or the user specified in the CONFIGURE_OWNER setting. &%-C%&
4978 is useful mainly for checking the syntax of configuration files before
4979 installing them. No owner or group checks are done on a configuration file
4980 specified by &%-C%&, if root privilege has been dropped.
4982 Even the Exim user is not trusted to specify an arbitrary configuration file
4983 with the &%-C%& option to be used with root privileges, unless that file is
4984 listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST file. This locks out the possibility of
4985 testing a configuration using &%-C%& right through message reception and
4986 delivery, even if the caller is root. The reception works, but by that time,
4987 Exim is running as the Exim user, so when it re-execs to regain privilege for
4988 the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes privilege to be lost. However, root
4989 can test reception and delivery using two separate commands (one to put a
4990 message in the queue, using &%-odq%&, and another to do the delivery, using
4993 If ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX is defined &_in Local/Makefile_&, it specifies a
4994 prefix string with which any file named in a &%-C%& command line option must
4995 start. In addition, the filename must not contain the sequence &"&`/../`&"&.
4996 There is no default setting for ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX; when it is unset, any
4997 filename can be used with &%-C%&.
4999 One-off changes to a configuration can be specified by the &%-D%& command line
5000 option, which defines and overrides values for macros used inside the
5001 configuration file. However, like &%-C%&, the use of this option by a
5002 non-privileged user causes Exim to discard its root privilege.
5003 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the use of &%-D%& is
5004 completely disabled, and its use causes an immediate error exit.
5006 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS option in &_Local/Makefile_& permits the binary builder
5007 to declare certain macro names trusted, such that root privilege will not
5008 necessarily be discarded.
5009 WHITELIST_D_MACROS defines a colon-separated list of macros which are
5010 considered safe and, if &%-D%& only supplies macros from this list, and the
5011 values are acceptable, then Exim will not give up root privilege if the caller
5012 is root, the Exim run-time user, or the CONFIGURE_OWNER, if set. This is a
5013 transition mechanism and is expected to be removed in the future. Acceptable
5014 values for the macros satisfy the regexp: &`^[A-Za-z0-9_/.-]*$`&
5016 Some sites may wish to use the same Exim binary on different machines that
5017 share a file system, but to use different configuration files on each machine.
5018 If CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_NODE is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim first
5019 looks for a file whose name is the configuration filename followed by a dot
5020 and the machine's node name, as obtained from the &[uname()]& function. If this
5021 file does not exist, the standard name is tried. This processing occurs for
5022 each filename in the list given by CONFIGURE_FILE or &%-C%&.
5024 In some esoteric situations different versions of Exim may be run under
5025 different effective uids and the CONFIGURE_FILE_USE_EUID is defined to
5026 help with this. See the comments in &_src/EDITME_& for details.
5030 .section "Configuration file format" "SECTconffilfor"
5031 .cindex "configuration file" "format of"
5032 .cindex "format" "configuration file"
5033 Exim's configuration file is divided into a number of different parts. General
5034 option settings must always appear at the start of the file. The other parts
5035 are all optional, and may appear in any order. Each part other than the first
5036 is introduced by the word &"begin"& followed by at least one literal
5037 space, and the name of the part. The optional parts are:
5040 &'ACL'&: Access control lists for controlling incoming SMTP mail (see chapter
5043 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
5044 &'authenticators'&: Configuration settings for the authenticator drivers. These
5045 are concerned with the SMTP AUTH command (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&).
5047 &'routers'&: Configuration settings for the router drivers. Routers process
5048 addresses and determine how the message is to be delivered (see chapters
5049 &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPredirect>>&).
5051 &'transports'&: Configuration settings for the transport drivers. Transports
5052 define mechanisms for copying messages to destinations (see chapters
5053 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&&--&<<CHAPsmtptrans>>&).
5055 &'retry'&: Retry rules, for use when a message cannot be delivered immediately.
5056 If there is no retry section, or if it is empty (that is, no retry rules are
5057 defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. In this situation, temporary errors
5058 are treated the same as permanent errors. Retry rules are discussed in chapter
5061 &'rewrite'&: Global address rewriting rules, for use when a message arrives and
5062 when new addresses are generated during delivery. Rewriting is discussed in
5063 chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&.
5065 &'local_scan'&: Private options for the &[local_scan()]& function. If you
5066 want to use this feature, you must set
5068 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
5070 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. Details of the &[local_scan()]&
5071 facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&.
5074 .cindex "configuration file" "leading white space in"
5075 .cindex "configuration file" "trailing white space in"
5076 .cindex "white space" "in configuration file"
5077 Leading and trailing white space in configuration lines is always ignored.
5079 Blank lines in the file, and lines starting with a # character (ignoring
5080 leading white space) are treated as comments and are ignored. &*Note*&: A
5081 # character other than at the beginning of a line is not treated specially,
5082 and does not introduce a comment.
5084 Any non-comment line can be continued by ending it with a backslash. Note that
5085 the general rule for white space means that trailing white space after the
5086 backslash and leading white space at the start of continuation
5087 lines is ignored. Comment lines beginning with # (but not empty lines) may
5088 appear in the middle of a sequence of continuation lines.
5090 A convenient way to create a configuration file is to start from the
5091 default, which is supplied in &_src/configure.default_&, and add, delete, or
5092 change settings as required.
5094 The ACLs, retry rules, and rewriting rules have their own syntax which is
5095 described in chapters &<<CHAPACL>>&, &<<CHAPretry>>&, and &<<CHAPrewrite>>&,
5096 respectively. The other parts of the configuration file have some syntactic
5097 items in common, and these are described below, from section &<<SECTcos>>&
5098 onwards. Before that, the inclusion, macro, and conditional facilities are
5103 .section "File inclusions in the configuration file" "SECID41"
5104 .cindex "inclusions in configuration file"
5105 .cindex "configuration file" "including other files"
5106 .cindex "&`.include`& in configuration file"
5107 .cindex "&`.include_if_exists`& in configuration file"
5108 You can include other files inside Exim's runtime configuration file by
5111 &`.include`& <&'filename'&>
5112 &`.include_if_exists`& <&'filename'&>
5114 on a line by itself. Double quotes round the filename are optional. If you use
5115 the first form, a configuration error occurs if the file does not exist; the
5116 second form does nothing for non-existent files.
5117 The first form allows a relative name. It is resolved relative to
5118 the directory of the including file. For the second form an absolute filename
5121 Includes may be nested to any depth, but remember that Exim reads its
5122 configuration file often, so it is a good idea to keep them to a minimum.
5123 If you change the contents of an included file, you must HUP the daemon,
5124 because an included file is read only when the configuration itself is read.
5126 The processing of inclusions happens early, at a physical line level, so, like
5127 comment lines, an inclusion can be used in the middle of an option setting,
5130 hosts_lookup = a.b.c \
5133 Include processing happens after macro processing (see below). Its effect is to
5134 process the lines of the included file as if they occurred inline where the
5139 .section "Macros in the configuration file" "SECTmacrodefs"
5140 .cindex "macro" "description of"
5141 .cindex "configuration file" "macros"
5142 If a line in the main part of the configuration (that is, before the first
5143 &"begin"& line) begins with an upper case letter, it is taken as a macro
5144 definition, and must be of the form
5146 <&'name'&> = <&'rest of line'&>
5148 The name must consist of letters, digits, and underscores, and need not all be
5149 in upper case, though that is recommended. The rest of the line, including any
5150 continuations, is the replacement text, and has leading and trailing white
5151 space removed. Quotes are not removed. The replacement text can never end with
5152 a backslash character, but this doesn't seem to be a serious limitation.
5154 Macros may also be defined between router, transport, authenticator, or ACL
5155 definitions. They may not, however, be defined within an individual driver or
5156 ACL, or in the &%local_scan%&, retry, or rewrite sections of the configuration.
5158 .section "Macro substitution" "SECID42"
5159 Once a macro is defined, all subsequent lines in the file (and any included
5160 files) are scanned for the macro name; if there are several macros, the line is
5161 scanned for each, in turn, in the order in which the macros are defined. The
5162 replacement text is not re-scanned for the current macro, though it is scanned
5163 for subsequently defined macros. For this reason, a macro name may not contain
5164 the name of a previously defined macro as a substring. You could, for example,
5167 &`ABCD_XYZ = `&<&'something'&>
5168 &`ABCD = `&<&'something else'&>
5170 but putting the definitions in the opposite order would provoke a configuration
5171 error. Macro expansion is applied to individual physical lines from the file,
5172 before checking for line continuation or file inclusion (see above). If a line
5173 consists solely of a macro name, and the expansion of the macro is empty, the
5174 line is ignored. A macro at the start of a line may turn the line into a
5175 comment line or a &`.include`& line.
5178 .section "Redefining macros" "SECID43"
5179 Once defined, the value of a macro can be redefined later in the configuration
5180 (or in an included file). Redefinition is specified by using &'=='& instead of
5185 MAC == updated value
5187 Redefinition does not alter the order in which the macros are applied to the
5188 subsequent lines of the configuration file. It is still the same order in which
5189 the macros were originally defined. All that changes is the macro's value.
5190 Redefinition makes it possible to accumulate values. For example:
5194 MAC == MAC and something added
5196 This can be helpful in situations where the configuration file is built
5197 from a number of other files.
5199 .section "Overriding macro values" "SECID44"
5200 The values set for macros in the configuration file can be overridden by the
5201 &%-D%& command line option, but Exim gives up its root privilege when &%-D%& is
5202 used, unless called by root or the Exim user. A definition on the command line
5203 using the &%-D%& option causes all definitions and redefinitions within the
5208 .section "Example of macro usage" "SECID45"
5209 As an example of macro usage, consider a configuration where aliases are looked
5210 up in a MySQL database. It helps to keep the file less cluttered if long
5211 strings such as SQL statements are defined separately as macros, for example:
5213 ALIAS_QUERY = select mailbox from user where \
5214 login='${quote_mysql:$local_part}';
5216 This can then be used in a &(redirect)& router setting like this:
5218 data = ${lookup mysql{ALIAS_QUERY}}
5220 In earlier versions of Exim macros were sometimes used for domain, host, or
5221 address lists. In Exim version 4 these are handled better by named lists &-- see
5222 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
5225 .section "Builtin macros" "SECTbuiltinmacros"
5226 Exim defines some macros depending on facilities available, which may
5227 differ due to build-time definitions and from one release to another.
5228 All of these macros start with an underscore.
5229 They can be used to conditionally include parts of a configuration
5232 The following classes of macros are defined:
5234 &` _HAVE_* `& build-time defines
5235 &` _DRIVER_ROUTER_* `& router drivers
5236 &` _DRIVER_TRANSPORT_* `& transport drivers
5237 &` _DRIVER_AUTHENTICATOR_* `& authenticator drivers
5238 &` _EXP_COND_* `& expansion conditions
5239 &` _EXP_ITEM_* `& expansion items
5240 &` _EXP_OP_* `& expansion operators
5241 &` _EXP_VAR_* `& expansion variables
5242 &` _LOG_* `& log_selector values
5243 &` _OPT_MAIN_* `& main config options
5244 &` _OPT_ROUTERS_* `& generic router options
5245 &` _OPT_TRANSPORTS_* `& generic transport options
5246 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATORS_* `& generic authenticator options
5247 &` _OPT_ROUTER_*_* `& private router options
5248 &` _OPT_TRANSPORT_*_* `& private transport options
5249 &` _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_*_* `& private authenticator options
5252 Use an &"exim -bP macros"& command to get the list of macros.
5255 .section "Conditional skips in the configuration file" "SECID46"
5256 .cindex "configuration file" "conditional skips"
5257 .cindex "&`.ifdef`&"
5258 You can use the directives &`.ifdef`&, &`.ifndef`&, &`.elifdef`&,
5259 &`.elifndef`&, &`.else`&, and &`.endif`& to dynamically include or exclude
5260 portions of the configuration file. The processing happens whenever the file is
5261 read (that is, when an Exim binary starts to run).
5263 The implementation is very simple. Instances of the first four directives must
5264 be followed by text that includes the names of one or macros. The condition
5265 that is tested is whether or not any macro substitution has taken place in the
5269 message_size_limit = 50M
5271 message_size_limit = 100M
5274 sets a message size limit of 50M if the macro &`AAA`& is defined
5275 (or &`A`& or &`AA`&), and 100M
5276 otherwise. If there is more than one macro named on the line, the condition
5277 is true if any of them are defined. That is, it is an &"or"& condition. To
5278 obtain an &"and"& condition, you need to use nested &`.ifdef`&s.
5280 Although you can use a macro expansion to generate one of these directives,
5281 it is not very useful, because the condition &"there was a macro substitution
5282 in this line"& will always be true.
5284 Text following &`.else`& and &`.endif`& is ignored, and can be used as comment
5285 to clarify complicated nestings.
5289 .section "Common option syntax" "SECTcos"
5290 .cindex "common option syntax"
5291 .cindex "syntax of common options"
5292 .cindex "configuration file" "common option syntax"
5293 For the main set of options, driver options, and &[local_scan()]& options,
5294 each setting is on a line by itself, and starts with a name consisting of
5295 lower-case letters and underscores. Many options require a data value, and in
5296 these cases the name must be followed by an equals sign (with optional white
5297 space) and then the value. For example:
5299 qualify_domain = mydomain.example.com
5301 .cindex "hiding configuration option values"
5302 .cindex "configuration options" "hiding value of"
5303 .cindex "options" "hiding value of"
5304 Some option settings may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
5305 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
5306 line option to read these values, you can precede the option settings with the
5307 word &"hide"&. For example:
5309 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/admin/secret-password
5311 For non-admin users, such options are displayed like this:
5313 mysql_servers = <value not displayable>
5315 If &"hide"& is used on a driver option, it hides the value of that option on
5316 all instances of the same driver.
5318 The following sections describe the syntax used for the different data types
5319 that are found in option settings.
5322 .section "Boolean options" "SECID47"
5323 .cindex "format" "boolean"
5324 .cindex "boolean configuration values"
5325 .oindex "&%no_%&&'xxx'&"
5326 .oindex "&%not_%&&'xxx'&"
5327 Options whose type is given as boolean are on/off switches. There are two
5328 different ways of specifying such options: with and without a data value. If
5329 the option name is specified on its own without data, the switch is turned on;
5330 if it is preceded by &"no_"& or &"not_"& the switch is turned off. However,
5331 boolean options may be followed by an equals sign and one of the words
5332 &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"&, or &"no"&, as an alternative syntax. For example,
5333 the following two settings have exactly the same effect:
5338 The following two lines also have the same (opposite) effect:
5343 You can use whichever syntax you prefer.
5348 .section "Integer values" "SECID48"
5349 .cindex "integer configuration values"
5350 .cindex "format" "integer"
5351 If an option's type is given as &"integer"&, the value can be given in decimal,
5352 hexadecimal, or octal. If it starts with a digit greater than zero, a decimal
5353 number is assumed. Otherwise, it is treated as an octal number unless it starts
5354 with the characters &"0x"&, in which case the remainder is interpreted as a
5357 If an integer value is followed by the letter K, it is multiplied by 1024; if
5358 it is followed by the letter M, it is multiplied by 1024x1024;
5359 if by the letter G, 1024x1024x1024.
5361 of integer option settings are output, values which are an exact multiple of
5362 1024 or 1024x1024 are sometimes, but not always, printed using the letters K
5363 and M. The printing style is independent of the actual input format that was
5367 .section "Octal integer values" "SECID49"
5368 .cindex "integer format"
5369 .cindex "format" "octal integer"
5370 If an option's type is given as &"octal integer"&, its value is always
5371 interpreted as an octal number, whether or not it starts with the digit zero.
5372 Such options are always output in octal.
5375 .section "Fixed point numbers" "SECID50"
5376 .cindex "fixed point configuration values"
5377 .cindex "format" "fixed point"
5378 If an option's type is given as &"fixed-point"&, its value must be a decimal
5379 integer, optionally followed by a decimal point and up to three further digits.
5383 .section "Time intervals" "SECTtimeformat"
5384 .cindex "time interval" "specifying in configuration"
5385 .cindex "format" "time interval"
5386 A time interval is specified as a sequence of numbers, each followed by one of
5387 the following letters, with no intervening white space:
5397 For example, &"3h50m"& specifies 3 hours and 50 minutes. The values of time
5398 intervals are output in the same format. Exim does not restrict the values; it
5399 is perfectly acceptable, for example, to specify &"90m"& instead of &"1h30m"&.
5403 .section "String values" "SECTstrings"
5404 .cindex "string" "format of configuration values"
5405 .cindex "format" "string"
5406 If an option's type is specified as &"string"&, the value can be specified with
5407 or without double-quotes. If it does not start with a double-quote, the value
5408 consists of the remainder of the line plus any continuation lines, starting at
5409 the first character after any leading white space, with trailing white space
5410 removed, and with no interpretation of the characters in the string. Because
5411 Exim removes comment lines (those beginning with #) at an early stage, they can
5412 appear in the middle of a multi-line string. The following two settings are
5413 therefore equivalent:
5415 trusted_users = uucp:mail
5416 trusted_users = uucp:\
5417 # This comment line is ignored
5420 .cindex "string" "quoted"
5421 .cindex "escape characters in quoted strings"
5422 If a string does start with a double-quote, it must end with a closing
5423 double-quote, and any backslash characters other than those used for line
5424 continuation are interpreted as escape characters, as follows:
5427 .irow &`\\`& "single backslash"
5428 .irow &`\n`& "newline"
5429 .irow &`\r`& "carriage return"
5431 .irow "&`\`&<&'octal digits'&>" "up to 3 octal digits specify one character"
5432 .irow "&`\x`&<&'hex digits'&>" "up to 2 hexadecimal digits specify one &&&
5436 If a backslash is followed by some other character, including a double-quote
5437 character, that character replaces the pair.
5439 Quoting is necessary only if you want to make use of the backslash escapes to
5440 insert special characters, or if you need to specify a value with leading or
5441 trailing spaces. These cases are rare, so quoting is almost never needed in
5442 current versions of Exim. In versions of Exim before 3.14, quoting was required
5443 in order to continue lines, so you may come across older configuration files
5444 and examples that apparently quote unnecessarily.
5447 .section "Expanded strings" "SECID51"
5448 .cindex "expansion" "definition of"
5449 Some strings in the configuration file are subjected to &'string expansion'&,
5450 by which means various parts of the string may be changed according to the
5451 circumstances (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). The input syntax for such strings
5452 is as just described; in particular, the handling of backslashes in quoted
5453 strings is done as part of the input process, before expansion takes place.
5454 However, backslash is also an escape character for the expander, so any
5455 backslashes that are required for that reason must be doubled if they are
5456 within a quoted configuration string.
5459 .section "User and group names" "SECID52"
5460 .cindex "user name" "format of"
5461 .cindex "format" "user name"
5462 .cindex "groups" "name format"
5463 .cindex "format" "group name"
5464 User and group names are specified as strings, using the syntax described
5465 above, but the strings are interpreted specially. A user or group name must
5466 either consist entirely of digits, or be a name that can be looked up using the
5467 &[getpwnam()]& or &[getgrnam()]& function, as appropriate.
5470 .section "List construction" "SECTlistconstruct"
5471 .cindex "list" "syntax of in configuration"
5472 .cindex "format" "list item in configuration"
5473 .cindex "string" "list, definition of"
5474 The data for some configuration options is a list of items, with colon as the
5475 default separator. Many of these options are shown with type &"string list"& in
5476 the descriptions later in this document. Others are listed as &"domain list"&,
5477 &"host list"&, &"address list"&, or &"local part list"&. Syntactically, they
5478 are all the same; however, those other than &"string list"& are subject to
5479 particular kinds of interpretation, as described in chapter
5480 &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
5482 In all these cases, the entire list is treated as a single string as far as the
5483 input syntax is concerned. The &%trusted_users%& setting in section
5484 &<<SECTstrings>>& above is an example. If a colon is actually needed in an item
5485 in a list, it must be entered as two colons. Leading and trailing white space
5486 on each item in a list is ignored. This makes it possible to include items that
5487 start with a colon, and in particular, certain forms of IPv6 address. For
5490 local_interfaces = 127.0.0.1 : ::::1
5492 contains two IP addresses, the IPv4 address 127.0.0.1 and the IPv6 address ::1.
5494 &*Note*&: Although leading and trailing white space is ignored in individual
5495 list items, it is not ignored when parsing the list. The spaces around the first
5496 colon in the example above are necessary. If they were not there, the list would
5497 be interpreted as the two items 127.0.0.1:: and 1.
5499 .subsection "Changing list separators" "SECTlistsepchange"
5500 .cindex "list separator" "changing"
5501 .cindex "IPv6" "addresses in lists"
5502 Doubling colons in IPv6 addresses is an unwelcome chore, so a mechanism was
5503 introduced to allow the separator character to be changed. If a list begins
5504 with a left angle bracket, followed by any punctuation character, that
5505 character is used instead of colon as the list separator. For example, the list
5506 above can be rewritten to use a semicolon separator like this:
5508 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1
5510 This facility applies to all lists, with the exception of the list in
5511 &%log_file_path%&. It is recommended that the use of non-colon separators be
5512 confined to circumstances where they really are needed.
5514 .cindex "list separator" "newline as"
5515 .cindex "newline" "as list separator"
5516 It is also possible to use newline and other control characters (those with
5517 code values less than 32, plus DEL) as separators in lists. Such separators
5518 must be provided literally at the time the list is processed. For options that
5519 are string-expanded, you can write the separator using a normal escape
5520 sequence. This will be processed by the expander before the string is
5521 interpreted as a list. For example, if a newline-separated list of domains is
5522 generated by a lookup, you can process it directly by a line such as this:
5524 domains = <\n ${lookup mysql{.....}}
5526 This avoids having to change the list separator in such data. You are unlikely
5527 to want to use a control character as a separator in an option that is not
5528 expanded, because the value is literal text. However, it can be done by giving
5529 the value in quotes. For example:
5531 local_interfaces = "<\n 127.0.0.1 \n ::1"
5533 Unlike printing character separators, which can be included in list items by
5534 doubling, it is not possible to include a control character as data when it is
5535 set as the separator. Two such characters in succession are interpreted as
5536 enclosing an empty list item.
5540 .subsection "Empty items in lists" "SECTempitelis"
5541 .cindex "list" "empty item in"
5542 An empty item at the end of a list is always ignored. In other words, trailing
5543 separator characters are ignored. Thus, the list in
5545 senders = user@domain :
5547 contains only a single item. If you want to include an empty string as one item
5548 in a list, it must not be the last item. For example, this list contains three
5549 items, the second of which is empty:
5551 senders = user1@domain : : user2@domain
5553 &*Note*&: There must be white space between the two colons, as otherwise they
5554 are interpreted as representing a single colon data character (and the list
5555 would then contain just one item). If you want to specify a list that contains
5556 just one, empty item, you can do it as in this example:
5560 In this case, the first item is empty, and the second is discarded because it
5561 is at the end of the list.
5566 .section "Format of driver configurations" "SECTfordricon"
5567 .cindex "drivers" "configuration format"
5568 There are separate parts in the configuration for defining routers, transports,
5569 and authenticators. In each part, you are defining a number of driver
5570 instances, each with its own set of options. Each driver instance is defined by
5571 a sequence of lines like this:
5573 <&'instance name'&>:
5578 In the following example, the instance name is &(localuser)&, and it is
5579 followed by three options settings:
5584 transport = local_delivery
5586 For each driver instance, you specify which Exim code module it uses &-- by the
5587 setting of the &%driver%& option &-- and (optionally) some configuration
5588 settings. For example, in the case of transports, if you want a transport to
5589 deliver with SMTP you would use the &(smtp)& driver; if you want to deliver to
5590 a local file you would use the &(appendfile)& driver. Each of the drivers is
5591 described in detail in its own separate chapter later in this manual.
5593 You can have several routers, transports, or authenticators that are based on
5594 the same underlying driver (each must have a different instance name).
5596 The order in which routers are defined is important, because addresses are
5597 passed to individual routers one by one, in order. The order in which
5598 transports are defined does not matter at all. The order in which
5599 authenticators are defined is used only when Exim, as a client, is searching
5600 them to find one that matches an authentication mechanism offered by the
5603 .cindex "generic options"
5604 .cindex "options" "generic &-- definition of"
5605 Within a driver instance definition, there are two kinds of option: &'generic'&
5606 and &'private'&. The generic options are those that apply to all drivers of the
5607 same type (that is, all routers, all transports or all authenticators). The
5608 &%driver%& option is a generic option that must appear in every definition.
5609 .cindex "private options"
5610 The private options are special for each driver, and none need appear, because
5611 they all have default values.
5613 The options may appear in any order, except that the &%driver%& option must
5614 precede any private options, since these depend on the particular driver. For
5615 this reason, it is recommended that &%driver%& always be the first option.
5617 Driver instance names, which are used for reference in log entries and
5618 elsewhere, can be any sequence of letters, digits, and underscores (starting
5619 with a letter) and must be unique among drivers of the same type. A router and
5620 a transport (for example) can each have the same name, but no two router
5621 instances can have the same name. The name of a driver instance should not be
5622 confused with the name of the underlying driver module. For example, the
5623 configuration lines:
5628 create an instance of the &(smtp)& transport driver whose name is
5629 &(remote_smtp)&. The same driver code can be used more than once, with
5630 different instance names and different option settings each time. A second
5631 instance of the &(smtp)& transport, with different options, might be defined
5637 command_timeout = 10s
5639 The names &(remote_smtp)& and &(special_smtp)& would be used to reference
5640 these transport instances from routers, and these names would appear in log
5643 Comment lines may be present in the middle of driver specifications. The full
5644 list of option settings for any particular driver instance, including all the
5645 defaulted values, can be extracted by making use of the &%-bP%& command line
5653 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5654 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
5656 .chapter "The default configuration file" "CHAPdefconfil"
5657 .scindex IIDconfiwal "configuration file" "default &""walk through""&"
5658 .cindex "default" "configuration file &""walk through""&"
5659 The default configuration file supplied with Exim as &_src/configure.default_&
5660 is sufficient for a host with simple mail requirements. As an introduction to
5661 the way Exim is configured, this chapter &"walks through"& the default
5662 configuration, giving brief explanations of the settings. Detailed descriptions
5663 of the options are given in subsequent chapters. The default configuration file
5664 itself contains extensive comments about ways you might want to modify the
5665 initial settings. However, note that there are many options that are not
5666 mentioned at all in the default configuration.
5670 .section "Macros" "SECTdefconfmacros"
5671 All macros should be defined before any options.
5673 One macro is specified, but commented out, in the default configuration:
5675 # ROUTER_SMARTHOST=MAIL.HOSTNAME.FOR.CENTRAL.SERVER.EXAMPLE
5677 If all off-site mail is expected to be delivered to a "smarthost", then set the
5678 hostname here and uncomment the macro. This will affect which router is used
5679 later on. If this is left commented out, then Exim will perform direct-to-MX
5680 deliveries using a &(dnslookup)& router.
5682 In addition to macros defined here, Exim includes a number of built-in macros
5683 to enable configuration to be guarded by a binary built with support for a
5684 given feature. See section &<<SECTbuiltinmacros>>& for more details.
5687 .section "Main configuration settings" "SECTdefconfmain"
5688 The main (global) configuration option settings section must always come first
5689 in the file, after the macros.
5690 The first thing you'll see in the file, after some initial comments, is the line
5692 # primary_hostname =
5694 This is a commented-out setting of the &%primary_hostname%& option. Exim needs
5695 to know the official, fully qualified name of your host, and this is where you
5696 can specify it. However, in most cases you do not need to set this option. When
5697 it is unset, Exim uses the &[uname()]& system function to obtain the host name.
5699 The first three non-comment configuration lines are as follows:
5701 domainlist local_domains = @
5702 domainlist relay_to_domains =
5703 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 127.0.0.1
5705 These are not, in fact, option settings. They are definitions of two named
5706 domain lists and one named host list. Exim allows you to give names to lists of
5707 domains, hosts, and email addresses, in order to make it easier to manage the
5708 configuration file (see section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&).
5710 The first line defines a domain list called &'local_domains'&; this is used
5711 later in the configuration to identify domains that are to be delivered
5714 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
5715 There is just one item in this list, the string &"@"&. This is a special form
5716 of entry which means &"the name of the local host"&. Thus, if the local host is
5717 called &'a.host.example'&, mail to &'any.user@a.host.example'& is expected to
5718 be delivered locally. Because the local host's name is referenced indirectly,
5719 the same configuration file can be used on different hosts.
5721 The second line defines a domain list called &'relay_to_domains'&, but the
5722 list itself is empty. Later in the configuration we will come to the part that
5723 controls mail relaying through the local host; it allows relaying to any
5724 domains in this list. By default, therefore, no relaying on the basis of a mail
5725 domain is permitted.
5727 The third line defines a host list called &'relay_from_hosts'&. This list is
5728 used later in the configuration to permit relaying from any host or IP address
5729 that matches the list. The default contains just the IP address of the IPv4
5730 loopback interface, which means that processes on the local host are able to
5731 submit mail for relaying by sending it over TCP/IP to that interface. No other
5732 hosts are permitted to submit messages for relaying.
5734 Just to be sure there's no misunderstanding: at this point in the configuration
5735 we aren't actually setting up any controls. We are just defining some domains
5736 and hosts that will be used in the controls that are specified later.
5738 The next two configuration lines are genuine option settings:
5740 acl_smtp_rcpt = acl_check_rcpt
5741 acl_smtp_data = acl_check_data
5743 These options specify &'Access Control Lists'& (ACLs) that are to be used
5744 during an incoming SMTP session for every recipient of a message (every RCPT
5745 command), and after the contents of the message have been received,
5746 respectively. The names of the lists are &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5747 &'acl_check_data'&, and we will come to their definitions below, in the ACL
5748 section of the configuration. The RCPT ACL controls which recipients are
5749 accepted for an incoming message &-- if a configuration does not provide an ACL
5750 to check recipients, no SMTP mail can be accepted. The DATA ACL allows the
5751 contents of a message to be checked.
5753 Two commented-out option settings are next:
5755 # av_scanner = clamd:/tmp/clamd
5756 # spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 783
5758 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with the
5759 content-scanning extension. The first specifies the interface to the virus
5760 scanner, and the second specifies the interface to SpamAssassin. Further
5761 details are given in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
5763 Three more commented-out option settings follow:
5765 # tls_advertise_hosts = *
5766 # tls_certificate = /etc/ssl/exim.crt
5767 # tls_privatekey = /etc/ssl/exim.pem
5769 These are example settings that can be used when Exim is compiled with
5770 support for TLS (aka SSL) as described in section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&. The
5771 first one specifies the list of clients that are allowed to use TLS when
5772 connecting to this server; in this case, the wildcard means all clients. The
5773 other options specify where Exim should find its TLS certificate and private
5774 key, which together prove the server's identity to any clients that connect.
5775 More details are given in chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&.
5777 Another two commented-out option settings follow:
5779 # daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 465 : 587
5780 # tls_on_connect_ports = 465
5782 .cindex "port" "465 and 587"
5783 .cindex "port" "for message submission"
5784 .cindex "message" "submission, ports for"
5785 .cindex "submissions protocol"
5786 .cindex "smtps protocol"
5787 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
5788 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
5789 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
5790 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
5791 These options provide better support for roaming users who wish to use this
5792 server for message submission. They are not much use unless you have turned on
5793 TLS (as described in the previous paragraph) and authentication (about which
5794 more in section &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&).
5795 Mail submission from mail clients (MUAs) should be separate from inbound mail
5796 to your domain (MX delivery) for various good reasons (eg, ability to impose
5797 much saner TLS protocol and ciphersuite requirements without unintended
5799 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6409,RFC 6409) (previously 4409)
5800 specifies use of port 587 for SMTP Submission,
5801 which uses STARTTLS, so this is the &"submission"& port.
5802 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314)
5803 specifies use of port 465 as the &"submissions"& protocol,
5804 which should be used in preference to 587.
5805 You should also consider deploying SRV records to help clients find
5807 Older names for &"submissions"& are &"smtps"& and &"ssmtp"&.
5809 Two more commented-out options settings follow:
5812 # qualify_recipient =
5814 The first of these specifies a domain that Exim uses when it constructs a
5815 complete email address from a local login name. This is often needed when Exim
5816 receives a message from a local process. If you do not set &%qualify_domain%&,
5817 the value of &%primary_hostname%& is used. If you set both of these options,
5818 you can have different qualification domains for sender and recipient
5819 addresses. If you set only the first one, its value is used in both cases.
5821 .cindex "domain literal" "recognizing format"
5822 The following line must be uncommented if you want Exim to recognize
5823 addresses of the form &'user@[10.11.12.13]'& that is, with a &"domain literal"&
5824 (an IP address within square brackets) instead of a named domain.
5826 # allow_domain_literals
5828 The RFCs still require this form, but many people think that in the modern
5829 Internet it makes little sense to permit mail to be sent to specific hosts by
5830 quoting their IP addresses. This ancient format has been used by people who
5831 try to abuse hosts by using them for unwanted relaying. However, some
5832 people believe there are circumstances (for example, messages addressed to
5833 &'postmaster'&) where domain literals are still useful.
5835 The next configuration line is a kind of trigger guard:
5839 It specifies that no delivery must ever be run as the root user. The normal
5840 convention is to set up &'root'& as an alias for the system administrator. This
5841 setting is a guard against slips in the configuration.
5842 The list of users specified by &%never_users%& is not, however, the complete
5843 list; the build-time configuration in &_Local/Makefile_& has an option called
5844 FIXED_NEVER_USERS specifying a list that cannot be overridden. The
5845 contents of &%never_users%& are added to this list. By default
5846 FIXED_NEVER_USERS also specifies root.
5848 When a remote host connects to Exim in order to send mail, the only information
5849 Exim has about the host's identity is its IP address. The next configuration
5854 specifies that Exim should do a reverse DNS lookup on all incoming connections,
5855 in order to get a host name. This improves the quality of the logging
5856 information, but if you feel it is too expensive, you can remove it entirely,
5857 or restrict the lookup to hosts on &"nearby"& networks.
5858 Note that it is not always possible to find a host name from an IP address,
5859 because not all DNS reverse zones are maintained, and sometimes DNS servers are
5862 The next two lines are concerned with &'ident'& callbacks, as defined by
5863 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1413,RFC 1413)
5864 (hence their names):
5867 rfc1413_query_timeout = 0s
5869 These settings cause Exim to avoid ident callbacks for all incoming SMTP calls.
5870 Few hosts offer RFC1413 service these days; calls have to be
5871 terminated by a timeout and this needlessly delays the startup
5872 of an incoming SMTP connection.
5873 If you have hosts for which you trust RFC1413 and need this
5874 information, you can change this.
5876 This line enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is negotiated by clients
5877 and not expected to cause problems but can be disabled if needed.
5882 When Exim receives messages over SMTP connections, it expects all addresses to
5883 be fully qualified with a domain, as required by the SMTP definition. However,
5884 if you are running a server to which simple clients submit messages, you may
5885 find that they send unqualified addresses. The two commented-out options:
5887 # sender_unqualified_hosts =
5888 # recipient_unqualified_hosts =
5890 show how you can specify hosts that are permitted to send unqualified sender
5891 and recipient addresses, respectively.
5893 The &%log_selector%& option is used to increase the detail of logging
5896 log_selector = +smtp_protocol_error +smtp_syntax_error \
5897 +tls_certificate_verified
5900 The &%percent_hack_domains%& option is also commented out:
5902 # percent_hack_domains =
5904 It provides a list of domains for which the &"percent hack"& is to operate.
5905 This is an almost obsolete form of explicit email routing. If you do not know
5906 anything about it, you can safely ignore this topic.
5908 The next two settings in the main part of the default configuration are
5909 concerned with messages that have been &"frozen"& on Exim's queue. When a
5910 message is frozen, Exim no longer continues to try to deliver it. Freezing
5911 occurs when a bounce message encounters a permanent failure because the sender
5912 address of the original message that caused the bounce is invalid, so the
5913 bounce cannot be delivered. This is probably the most common case, but there
5914 are also other conditions that cause freezing, and frozen messages are not
5915 always bounce messages.
5917 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 2d
5918 timeout_frozen_after = 7d
5920 The first of these options specifies that failing bounce messages are to be
5921 discarded after 2 days in the queue. The second specifies that any frozen
5922 message (whether a bounce message or not) is to be timed out (and discarded)
5923 after a week. In this configuration, the first setting ensures that no failing
5924 bounce message ever lasts a week.
5926 Exim queues it's messages in a spool directory. If you expect to have
5927 large queues, you may consider using this option. It splits the spool
5928 directory into subdirectories to avoid file system degradation from
5929 many files in a single directory, resulting in better performance.
5930 Manual manipulation of queued messages becomes more complex (though fortunately
5933 # split_spool_directory = true
5936 In an ideal world everybody follows the standards. For non-ASCII
5937 messages &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2048,RFC 2047)
5938 is a standard, allowing a maximum line length of 76
5939 characters. Exim adheres that standard and won't process messages which
5940 violate this standard. (Even ${rfc2047:...} expansions will fail.)
5941 In particular, the Exim maintainers have had multiple reports of
5942 problems from Russian administrators of issues until they disable this
5943 check, because of some popular, yet buggy, mail composition software.
5945 # check_rfc2047_length = false
5948 If you need to be strictly RFC compliant you may wish to disable the
5949 8BITMIME advertisement. Use this, if you exchange mails with systems
5950 that are not 8-bit clean.
5952 # accept_8bitmime = false
5955 Libraries you use may depend on specific environment settings. This
5956 imposes a security risk (e.g. PATH). There are two lists:
5957 &%keep_environment%& for the variables to import as they are, and
5958 &%add_environment%& for variables we want to set to a fixed value.
5959 Note that TZ is handled separately, by the &%timezone%& runtime
5960 option and by the TIMEZONE_DEFAULT buildtime option.
5962 # keep_environment = ^LDAP
5963 # add_environment = PATH=/usr/bin::/bin
5967 .section "ACL configuration" "SECID54"
5968 .cindex "default" "ACLs"
5969 .cindex "&ACL;" "default configuration"
5970 In the default configuration, the ACL section follows the main configuration.
5971 It starts with the line
5975 and it contains the definitions of two ACLs, called &'acl_check_rcpt'& and
5976 &'acl_check_data'&, that were referenced in the settings of &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
5977 and &%acl_smtp_data%& above.
5979 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
5980 The first ACL is used for every RCPT command in an incoming SMTP message. Each
5981 RCPT command specifies one of the message's recipients. The ACL statements
5982 are considered in order, until the recipient address is either accepted or
5983 rejected. The RCPT command is then accepted or rejected, according to the
5984 result of the ACL processing.
5988 This line, consisting of a name terminated by a colon, marks the start of the
5993 This ACL statement accepts the recipient if the sending host matches the list.
5994 But what does that strange list mean? It doesn't actually contain any host
5995 names or IP addresses. The presence of the colon puts an empty item in the
5996 list; Exim matches this only if the incoming message did not come from a remote
5997 host, because in that case, the remote hostname is empty. The colon is
5998 important. Without it, the list itself is empty, and can never match anything.
6000 What this statement is doing is to accept unconditionally all recipients in
6001 messages that are submitted by SMTP from local processes using the standard
6002 input and output (that is, not using TCP/IP). A number of MUAs operate in this
6005 deny domains = +local_domains
6006 local_parts = ^[.] : ^.*[@%!/|]
6007 message = Restricted characters in address
6009 deny domains = !+local_domains
6010 local_parts = ^[./|] : ^.*[@%!] : ^.*/\\.\\./
6011 message = Restricted characters in address
6013 These statements are concerned with local parts that contain any of the
6014 characters &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&, &"|"&, or dots in unusual places.
6015 Although these characters are entirely legal in local parts (in the case of
6016 &"@"& and leading dots, only if correctly quoted), they do not commonly occur
6017 in Internet mail addresses.
6019 The first three have in the past been associated with explicitly routed
6020 addresses (percent is still sometimes used &-- see the &%percent_hack_domains%&
6021 option). Addresses containing these characters are regularly tried by spammers
6022 in an attempt to bypass relaying restrictions, and also by open relay testing
6023 programs. Unless you really need them it is safest to reject these characters
6024 at this early stage. This configuration is heavy-handed in rejecting these
6025 characters for all messages it accepts from remote hosts. This is a deliberate
6026 policy of being as safe as possible.
6028 The first rule above is stricter, and is applied to messages that are addressed
6029 to one of the local domains handled by this host. This is implemented by the
6030 first condition, which restricts it to domains that are listed in the
6031 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
6032 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
6033 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
6035 The second condition on the first statement uses two regular expressions to
6036 block local parts that begin with a dot or contain &"@"&, &"%"&, &"!"&, &"/"&,
6037 or &"|"&. If you have local accounts that include these characters, you will
6038 have to modify this rule.
6040 Empty components (two dots in a row) are not valid in
6041 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822),
6043 allows them because they have been encountered in practice. (Consider the
6044 common convention of local parts constructed as
6045 &"&'first-initial.second-initial.family-name'&"& when applied to someone like
6046 the author of Exim, who has no second initial.) However, a local part starting
6047 with a dot or containing &"/../"& can cause trouble if it is used as part of a
6048 filename (for example, for a mailing list). This is also true for local parts
6049 that contain slashes. A pipe symbol can also be troublesome if the local part
6050 is incorporated unthinkingly into a shell command line.
6052 The second rule above applies to all other domains, and is less strict. This
6053 allows your own users to send outgoing messages to sites that use slashes
6054 and vertical bars in their local parts. It blocks local parts that begin
6055 with a dot, slash, or vertical bar, but allows these characters within the
6056 local part. However, the sequence &"/../"& is barred. The use of &"@"&, &"%"&,
6057 and &"!"& is blocked, as before. The motivation here is to prevent your users
6058 (or your users' viruses) from mounting certain kinds of attack on remote sites.
6060 accept local_parts = postmaster
6061 domains = +local_domains
6063 This statement, which has two conditions, accepts an incoming address if the
6064 local part is &'postmaster'& and the domain is one of those listed in the
6065 &'local_domains'& domain list. The &"+"& character is used to indicate a
6066 reference to a named list. In this configuration, there is just one domain in
6067 &'local_domains'&, but in general there may be many.
6069 The presence of this statement means that mail to postmaster is never blocked
6070 by any of the subsequent tests. This can be helpful while sorting out problems
6071 in cases where the subsequent tests are incorrectly denying access.
6073 require verify = sender
6075 This statement requires the sender address to be verified before any subsequent
6076 ACL statement can be used. If verification fails, the incoming recipient
6077 address is refused. Verification consists of trying to route the address, to
6078 see if a bounce message could be delivered to it. In the case of remote
6079 addresses, basic verification checks only the domain, but &'callouts'& can be
6080 used for more verification if required. Section &<<SECTaddressverification>>&
6081 discusses the details of address verification.
6083 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
6084 control = submission
6086 This statement accepts the address if the message is coming from one of the
6087 hosts that are defined as being allowed to relay through this host. Recipient
6088 verification is omitted here, because in many cases the clients are dumb MUAs
6089 that do not cope well with SMTP error responses. For the same reason, the
6090 second line specifies &"submission mode"& for messages that are accepted. This
6091 is described in detail in section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>&; it causes Exim to fix
6092 messages that are deficient in some way, for example, because they lack a
6093 &'Date:'& header line. If you are actually relaying out from MTAs, you should
6094 probably add recipient verification here, and disable submission mode.
6096 accept authenticated = *
6097 control = submission
6099 This statement accepts the address if the client host has authenticated itself.
6100 Submission mode is again specified, on the grounds that such messages are most
6101 likely to come from MUAs. The default configuration does not define any
6102 authenticators, though it does include some nearly complete commented-out
6103 examples described in &<<SECTdefconfauth>>&. This means that no client can in
6104 fact authenticate until you complete the authenticator definitions.
6106 require message = relay not permitted
6107 domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
6109 This statement rejects the address if its domain is neither a local domain nor
6110 one of the domains for which this host is a relay.
6112 require verify = recipient
6114 This statement requires the recipient address to be verified; if verification
6115 fails, the address is rejected.
6117 # deny dnslists = black.list.example
6118 # message = rejected because $sender_host_address \
6119 # is in a black list at $dnslist_domain\n\
6122 # warn dnslists = black.list.example
6123 # add_header = X-Warning: $sender_host_address is in \
6124 # a black list at $dnslist_domain
6125 # log_message = found in $dnslist_domain
6127 These commented-out lines are examples of how you could configure Exim to check
6128 sending hosts against a DNS black list. The first statement rejects messages
6129 from blacklisted hosts, whereas the second just inserts a warning header
6132 # require verify = csa
6134 This commented-out line is an example of how you could turn on client SMTP
6135 authorization (CSA) checking. Such checks do DNS lookups for special SRV
6140 The final statement in the first ACL unconditionally accepts any recipient
6141 address that has successfully passed all the previous tests.
6145 This line marks the start of the second ACL, and names it. Most of the contents
6146 of this ACL are commented out:
6149 # message = This message contains a virus \
6152 These lines are examples of how to arrange for messages to be scanned for
6153 viruses when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension, and a
6154 suitable virus scanner is installed. If the message is found to contain a
6155 virus, it is rejected with the given custom error message.
6157 # warn spam = nobody
6158 # message = X-Spam_score: $spam_score\n\
6159 # X-Spam_score_int: $spam_score_int\n\
6160 # X-Spam_bar: $spam_bar\n\
6161 # X-Spam_report: $spam_report
6163 These lines are an example of how to arrange for messages to be scanned by
6164 SpamAssassin when Exim has been compiled with the content-scanning extension,
6165 and SpamAssassin has been installed. The SpamAssassin check is run with
6166 &`nobody`& as its user parameter, and the results are added to the message as a
6167 series of extra header line. In this case, the message is not rejected,
6168 whatever the spam score.
6172 This final line in the DATA ACL accepts the message unconditionally.
6175 .section "Router configuration" "SECID55"
6176 .cindex "default" "routers"
6177 .cindex "routers" "default"
6178 The router configuration comes next in the default configuration, introduced
6183 Routers are the modules in Exim that make decisions about where to send
6184 messages. An address is passed to each router, in turn, until it is either
6185 accepted, or failed. This means that the order in which you define the routers
6186 matters. Each router is fully described in its own chapter later in this
6187 manual. Here we give only brief overviews.
6190 # driver = ipliteral
6191 # domains = !+local_domains
6192 # transport = remote_smtp
6194 .cindex "domain literal" "default router"
6195 This router is commented out because the majority of sites do not want to
6196 support domain literal addresses (those of the form &'user@[10.9.8.7]'&). If
6197 you uncomment this router, you also need to uncomment the setting of
6198 &%allow_domain_literals%& in the main part of the configuration.
6200 Which router is used next depends upon whether or not the ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6201 macro has been defined, per
6203 .ifdef ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6212 If ROUTER_SMARTHOST has been defined, either at the top of the file or on the
6213 command-line, then we route all non-local mail to that smarthost; otherwise, we'll
6214 perform DNS lookups for direct-to-MX lookup. Any mail which is to a local domain will
6215 skip these routers because of the &%domains%& option.
6219 driver = manualroute
6220 domains = ! +local_domains
6221 transport = smarthost_smtp
6222 route_data = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6223 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0.0.0.0 ; 127.0.0.0/8 ; ::1
6226 This router only handles mail which is not to any local domains; this is
6227 specified by the line
6229 domains = ! +local_domains
6231 The &%domains%& option lists the domains to which this router applies, but the
6232 exclamation mark is a negation sign, so the router is used only for domains
6233 that are not in the domain list called &'local_domains'& (which was defined at
6234 the start of the configuration). The plus sign before &'local_domains'&
6235 indicates that it is referring to a named list. Addresses in other domains are
6236 passed on to the following routers.
6238 The name of the router driver is &(manualroute)& because we are manually
6239 specifying how mail should be routed onwards, instead of using DNS MX.
6240 While the name of this router instance is arbitrary, the &%driver%& option must
6241 be one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6243 With no pre-conditions other than &%domains%&, all mail for non-local domains
6244 will be handled by this router, and the &%no_more%& setting will ensure that no
6245 other routers will be used for messages matching the pre-conditions. See
6246 &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for more on how the pre-conditions apply. For messages which
6247 are handled by this router, we provide a hostname to deliver to in &%route_data%&
6248 and the macro supplies the value; the address is then queued for the
6249 &(smarthost_smtp)& transport.
6254 domains = ! +local_domains
6255 transport = remote_smtp
6256 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.0/8
6259 The &%domains%& option behaves as per smarthost, above.
6261 The name of the router driver is &(dnslookup)&,
6262 and is specified by the &%driver%& option. Do not be confused by the fact that
6263 the name of this router instance is the same as the name of the driver. The
6264 instance name is arbitrary, but the name set in the &%driver%& option must be
6265 one of the driver modules that is in the Exim binary.
6267 The &(dnslookup)& router routes addresses by looking up their domains in the
6268 DNS in order to obtain a list of hosts to which the address is routed. If the
6269 router succeeds, the address is queued for the &(remote_smtp)& transport, as
6270 specified by the &%transport%& option. If the router does not find the domain
6271 in the DNS, no further routers are tried because of the &%no_more%& setting, so
6272 the address fails and is bounced.
6274 The &%ignore_target_hosts%& option specifies a list of IP addresses that are to
6275 be entirely ignored. This option is present because a number of cases have been
6276 encountered where MX records in the DNS point to host names
6277 whose IP addresses are 0.0.0.0 or are in the 127 subnet (typically 127.0.0.1).
6278 Completely ignoring these IP addresses causes Exim to fail to route the
6279 email address, so it bounces. Otherwise, Exim would log a routing problem, and
6280 continue to try to deliver the message periodically until the address timed
6287 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
6289 file_transport = address_file
6290 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6292 Control reaches this and subsequent routers only for addresses in the local
6293 domains. This router checks to see whether the local part is defined as an
6294 alias in the &_/etc/aliases_& file, and if so, redirects it according to the
6295 data that it looks up from that file. If no data is found for the local part,
6296 the value of the &%data%& option is empty, causing the address to be passed to
6299 &_/etc/aliases_& is a conventional name for the system aliases file that is
6300 often used. That is why it is referenced by from the default configuration
6301 file. However, you can change this by setting SYSTEM_ALIASES_FILE in
6302 &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim.
6307 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6308 # local_part_suffix_optional
6309 file = $home/.forward
6314 file_transport = address_file
6315 pipe_transport = address_pipe
6316 reply_transport = address_reply
6318 This is the most complicated router in the default configuration. It is another
6319 redirection router, but this time it is looking for forwarding data set up by
6320 individual users. The &%check_local_user%& setting specifies a check that the
6321 local part of the address is the login name of a local user. If it is not, the
6322 router is skipped. The two commented options that follow &%check_local_user%&,
6325 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6326 # local_part_suffix_optional
6328 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
6329 show how you can specify the recognition of local part suffixes. If the first
6330 is uncommented, a suffix beginning with either a plus or a minus sign, followed
6331 by any sequence of characters, is removed from the local part and placed in the
6332 variable &$local_part_suffix$&. The second suffix option specifies that the
6333 presence of a suffix in the local part is optional. When a suffix is present,
6334 the check for a local login uses the local part with the suffix removed.
6336 When a local user account is found, the file called &_.forward_& in the user's
6337 home directory is consulted. If it does not exist, or is empty, the router
6338 declines. Otherwise, the contents of &_.forward_& are interpreted as
6339 redirection data (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>& for more details).
6341 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling in default router"
6342 Traditional &_.forward_& files contain just a list of addresses, pipes, or
6343 files. Exim supports this by default. However, if &%allow_filter%& is set (it
6344 is commented out by default), the contents of the file are interpreted as a set
6345 of Exim or Sieve filtering instructions, provided the file begins with &"#Exim
6346 filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, respectively. User filtering is discussed in the
6347 separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&.
6349 The &%no_verify%& and &%no_expn%& options mean that this router is skipped when
6350 verifying addresses, or when running as a consequence of an SMTP EXPN command.
6351 There are two reasons for doing this:
6354 Whether or not a local user has a &_.forward_& file is not really relevant when
6355 checking an address for validity; it makes sense not to waste resources doing
6358 More importantly, when Exim is verifying addresses or handling an EXPN
6359 command during an SMTP session, it is running as the Exim user, not as root.
6360 The group is the Exim group, and no additional groups are set up.
6361 It may therefore not be possible for Exim to read users' &_.forward_& files at
6365 The setting of &%check_ancestor%& prevents the router from generating a new
6366 address that is the same as any previous address that was redirected. (This
6367 works round a problem concerning a bad interaction between aliasing and
6368 forwarding &-- see section &<<SECTredlocmai>>&).
6370 The final three option settings specify the transports that are to be used when
6371 forwarding generates a direct delivery to a file, or to a pipe, or sets up an
6372 auto-reply, respectively. For example, if a &_.forward_& file contains
6374 a.nother@elsewhere.example, /home/spqr/archive
6376 the delivery to &_/home/spqr/archive_& is done by running the &%address_file%&
6382 # local_part_suffix = +* : -*
6383 # local_part_suffix_optional
6384 transport = local_delivery
6386 The final router sets up delivery into local mailboxes, provided that the local
6387 part is the name of a local login, by accepting the address and assigning it to
6388 the &(local_delivery)& transport. Otherwise, we have reached the end of the
6389 routers, so the address is bounced. The commented suffix settings fulfil the
6390 same purpose as they do for the &(userforward)& router.
6393 .section "Transport configuration" "SECID56"
6394 .cindex "default" "transports"
6395 .cindex "transports" "default"
6396 Transports define mechanisms for actually delivering messages. They operate
6397 only when referenced from routers, so the order in which they are defined does
6398 not matter. The transports section of the configuration starts with
6402 Two remote transports and four local transports are defined.
6406 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6411 This transport is used for delivering messages over SMTP connections.
6412 The list of remote hosts comes from the router.
6413 The &%message_size_limit%& usage is a hack to avoid sending on messages
6414 with over-long lines.
6416 The &%hosts_try_prdr%& option enables an efficiency SMTP option. It is
6417 negotiated between client and server and not expected to cause problems
6418 but can be disabled if needed. The built-in macro _HAVE_PRDR guards the
6419 use of the &%hosts_try_prdr%& configuration option.
6421 The other remote transport is used when delivering to a specific smarthost
6422 with whom there must be some kind of existing relationship, instead of the
6423 usual federated system.
6428 message_size_limit = ${if > {$max_received_linelength}{998} {1}{0}}
6432 # Comment out any of these which you have to, then file a Support
6433 # request with your smarthost provider to get things fixed:
6434 hosts_require_tls = *
6435 tls_verify_hosts = *
6436 # As long as tls_verify_hosts is enabled, this this will have no effect,
6437 # but if you have to comment it out then this will at least log whether
6438 # you succeed or not:
6439 tls_try_verify_hosts = *
6441 # The SNI name should match the name which we'll expect to verify;
6442 # many mail systems don't use SNI and this doesn't matter, but if it does,
6443 # we need to send a name which the remote site will recognize.
6444 # This _should_ be the name which the smarthost operators specified as
6445 # the hostname for sending your mail to.
6446 tls_sni = ROUTER_SMARTHOST
6448 .ifdef _HAVE_OPENSSL
6449 tls_require_ciphers = HIGH:!aNULL:@STRENGTH
6452 tls_require_ciphers = SECURE192:-VERS-SSL3.0:-VERS-TLS1.0:-VERS-TLS1.1
6459 After the same &%message_size_limit%& hack, we then specify that this Transport
6460 can handle messages to multiple domains in one run. The assumption here is
6461 that you're routing all non-local mail to the same place and that place is
6462 happy to take all messages from you as quickly as possible.
6463 All other options depend upon built-in macros; if Exim was built without TLS support
6464 then no other options are defined.
6465 If TLS is available, then we configure "stronger than default" TLS ciphersuites
6466 and versions using the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option, where the value to be
6467 used depends upon the library providing TLS.
6468 Beyond that, the options adopt the stance that you should have TLS support available
6469 from your smarthost on today's Internet, so we turn on requiring TLS for the
6470 mail to be delivered, and requiring that the certificate be valid, and match
6471 the expected hostname. The &%tls_sni%& option can be used by service providers
6472 to select an appropriate certificate to present to you and here we re-use the
6473 ROUTER_SMARTHOST macro, because that is unaffected by CNAMEs present in DNS.
6474 You want to specify the hostname which you'll expect to validate for, and that
6475 should not be subject to insecure tampering via DNS results.
6477 For the &%hosts_try_prdr%& option see the previous transport.
6479 All other options are defaulted.
6483 file = /var/mail/$local_part_data
6490 This &(appendfile)& transport is used for local delivery to user mailboxes in
6491 traditional BSD mailbox format.
6493 We prefer to avoid using &$local_part$& directly to define the mailbox filename,
6494 as it is provided by a potential bad actor.
6495 Instead we use &$local_part_data$&,
6496 the result of looking up &$local_part$& in the user database
6497 (done by using &%check_local_user%& in the the router).
6499 By default &(appendfile)& runs under the uid and gid of the
6500 local user, which requires the sticky bit to be set on the &_/var/mail_&
6501 directory. Some systems use the alternative approach of running mail deliveries
6502 under a particular group instead of using the sticky bit. The commented options
6503 show how this can be done.
6505 Exim adds three headers to the message as it delivers it: &'Delivery-date:'&,
6506 &'Envelope-to:'& and &'Return-path:'&. This action is requested by the three
6507 similarly-named options above.
6513 This transport is used for handling deliveries to pipes that are generated by
6514 redirection (aliasing or users' &_.forward_& files). The &%return_output%&
6515 option specifies that any output on stdout or stderr generated by the pipe is to
6516 be returned to the sender.
6524 This transport is used for handling deliveries to files that are generated by
6525 redirection. The name of the file is not specified in this instance of
6526 &(appendfile)&, because it comes from the &(redirect)& router.
6531 This transport is used for handling automatic replies generated by users'
6536 .section "Default retry rule" "SECID57"
6537 .cindex "retry" "default rule"
6538 .cindex "default" "retry rule"
6539 The retry section of the configuration file contains rules which affect the way
6540 Exim retries deliveries that cannot be completed at the first attempt. It is
6541 introduced by the line
6545 In the default configuration, there is just one rule, which applies to all
6548 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
6550 This causes any temporarily failing address to be retried every 15 minutes for
6551 2 hours, then at intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
6552 1.5 until 16 hours have passed, then every 6 hours up to 4 days. If an address
6553 is not delivered after 4 days of temporary failure, it is bounced. The time is
6554 measured from first failure, not from the time the message was received.
6556 If the retry section is removed from the configuration, or is empty (that is,
6557 if no retry rules are defined), Exim will not retry deliveries. This turns
6558 temporary errors into permanent errors.
6561 .section "Rewriting configuration" "SECID58"
6562 The rewriting section of the configuration, introduced by
6566 contains rules for rewriting addresses in messages as they arrive. There are no
6567 rewriting rules in the default configuration file.
6571 .section "Authenticators configuration" "SECTdefconfauth"
6572 .cindex "AUTH" "configuration"
6573 The authenticators section of the configuration, introduced by
6575 begin authenticators
6577 defines mechanisms for the use of the SMTP AUTH command. The default
6578 configuration file contains two commented-out example authenticators
6579 which support plaintext username/password authentication using the
6580 standard PLAIN mechanism and the traditional but non-standard LOGIN
6581 mechanism, with Exim acting as the server. PLAIN and LOGIN are enough
6582 to support most MUA software.
6584 The example PLAIN authenticator looks like this:
6587 # driver = plaintext
6588 # server_set_id = $auth2
6589 # server_prompts = :
6590 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6591 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6593 And the example LOGIN authenticator looks like this:
6596 # driver = plaintext
6597 # server_set_id = $auth1
6598 # server_prompts = <| Username: | Password:
6599 # server_condition = Authentication is not yet configured
6600 # server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
6603 The &%server_set_id%& option makes Exim remember the authenticated username
6604 in &$authenticated_id$&, which can be used later in ACLs or routers. The
6605 &%server_prompts%& option configures the &(plaintext)& authenticator so
6606 that it implements the details of the specific authentication mechanism,
6607 i.e. PLAIN or LOGIN. The &%server_advertise_condition%& setting controls
6608 when Exim offers authentication to clients; in the examples, this is only
6609 when TLS or SSL has been started, so to enable the authenticators you also
6610 need to add support for TLS as described in section &<<SECTdefconfmain>>&.
6612 The &%server_condition%& setting defines how to verify that the username and
6613 password are correct. In the examples it just produces an error message.
6614 To make the authenticators work, you can use a string expansion
6615 expression like one of the examples in chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>&.
6617 Beware that the sequence of the parameters to PLAIN and LOGIN differ; the
6618 usercode and password are in different positions.
6619 Chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& covers both.
6621 .ecindex IIDconfiwal
6625 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6626 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6628 .chapter "Regular expressions" "CHAPregexp"
6630 .cindex "regular expressions" "library"
6632 Exim supports the use of regular expressions in many of its options. It
6633 uses the PCRE2 regular expression library; this provides regular expression
6634 matching that is compatible with Perl 5. The syntax and semantics of
6635 regular expressions is discussed in
6636 online Perl manpages, in
6637 many Perl reference books, and also in
6638 Jeffrey Friedl's &'Mastering Regular Expressions'&, which is published by
6639 O'Reilly (see &url(http://www.oreilly.com/catalog/regex2/)).
6640 . --- the http: URL here redirects to another page with the ISBN in the URL
6641 . --- where trying to use https: just redirects back to http:, so sticking
6642 . --- to the old URL for now. 2018-09-07.
6644 The documentation for the syntax and semantics of the regular expressions that
6645 are supported by PCRE2 is included in the PCRE2 distribution, and no further
6646 description is included here. The PCRE2 functions are called from Exim using
6647 the default option settings (that is, with no PCRE2 options set), except that
6648 the PCRE2_CASELESS option is set when the matching is required to be
6651 In most cases, when a regular expression is required in an Exim configuration,
6652 it has to start with a circumflex, in order to distinguish it from plain text
6653 or an &"ends with"& wildcard. In this example of a configuration setting, the
6654 second item in the colon-separated list is a regular expression.
6656 domains = a.b.c : ^\\d{3} : *.y.z : ...
6658 The doubling of the backslash is required because of string expansion that
6659 precedes interpretation &-- see section &<<SECTlittext>>& for more discussion
6660 of this issue, and a way of avoiding the need for doubling backslashes. The
6661 regular expression that is eventually used in this example contains just one
6662 backslash. The circumflex is included in the regular expression, and has the
6663 normal effect of &"anchoring"& it to the start of the string that is being
6666 There are, however, two cases where a circumflex is not required for the
6667 recognition of a regular expression: these are the &%match%& condition in a
6668 string expansion, and the &%matches%& condition in an Exim filter file. In
6669 these cases, the relevant string is always treated as a regular expression; if
6670 it does not start with a circumflex, the expression is not anchored, and can
6671 match anywhere in the subject string.
6673 In all cases, if you want a regular expression to match at the end of a string,
6674 you must code the $ metacharacter to indicate this. For example:
6676 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example
6678 matches the domain &'123.example'&, but it also matches &'123.example.com'&.
6681 domains = ^\\d{3}\\.example\$
6683 if you want &'example'& to be the top-level domain. The backslash before the
6684 $ is needed because string expansion also interprets dollar characters.
6688 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6689 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
6691 .chapter "File and database lookups" "CHAPfdlookup"
6692 .scindex IIDfidalo1 "file" "lookups"
6693 .scindex IIDfidalo2 "database" "lookups"
6694 .cindex "lookup" "description of"
6695 Exim can be configured to look up data in files or databases as it processes
6696 messages. Two different kinds of syntax are used:
6699 A string that is to be expanded may contain explicit lookup requests. These
6700 cause parts of the string to be replaced by data that is obtained from the
6701 lookup. Lookups of this type are conditional expansion items. Different results
6702 can be defined for the cases of lookup success and failure. See chapter
6703 &<<CHAPexpand>>&, where string expansions are described in detail.
6704 The key for the lookup is &*specified*& as part of the string to be expanded.
6706 Lists of domains, hosts, and email addresses can contain lookup requests as a
6707 way of avoiding excessively long linear lists. In this case, the data that is
6708 returned by the lookup is often (but not always) discarded; whether the lookup
6709 succeeds or fails is what really counts. These kinds of list are described in
6710 chapter &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>&.
6711 Depending on the lookup type (see below)
6712 the key for the lookup may need to be &*specified*& as above
6713 or may be &*implicit*&,
6714 given by the context in which the list is being checked.
6717 String expansions, lists, and lookups interact with each other in such a way
6718 that there is no order in which to describe any one of them that does not
6719 involve references to the others. Each of these three chapters makes more sense
6720 if you have read the other two first. If you are reading this for the first
6721 time, be aware that some of it will make a lot more sense after you have read
6722 chapters &<<CHAPdomhosaddlists>>& and &<<CHAPexpand>>&.
6724 .section "Examples of different lookup syntax" "SECID60"
6725 It is easy to confuse the two different kinds of lookup, especially as the
6726 lists that may contain the second kind are always expanded before being
6727 processed as lists. Therefore, they may also contain lookups of the first kind.
6728 Be careful to distinguish between the following two examples:
6730 domains = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch{/some/file}}
6731 domains = lsearch;/some/file
6734 The first uses a string expansion, the result of which must be a domain list.
6735 The key for an expansion-style lookup must be given explicitly.
6736 No strings have been specified for a successful or a failing lookup; the
6737 defaults in this case are the looked-up data and an empty string, respectively.
6738 The expansion takes place before the string is processed as a list, and the
6739 file that is searched could contain lines like this:
6741 192.168.3.4: domain1:domain2:...
6742 192.168.1.9: domain3:domain4:...
6744 When the lookup succeeds, the result of the expansion is a list of domains (and
6745 possibly other types of item that are allowed in domain lists).
6746 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6747 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a lookup expansion"
6748 The result of the expansion is not tainted.
6751 In the second example, the lookup is a single item in a domain list. It causes
6752 Exim to use a lookup to see if the domain that is being processed can be found
6754 The file could contains lines like this:
6759 Any data that follows the keys is not relevant when checking that the domain
6760 matches the list item.
6762 The key for a list-style lookup is implicit, from the lookup context, if
6763 the lookup is a single-key type (see below).
6764 For query-style lookup types the query must be given explicitly.
6767 It is possible, though no doubt confusing, to use both kinds of lookup at once.
6768 Consider a file containing lines like this:
6770 192.168.5.6: lsearch;/another/file
6772 If the value of &$sender_host_address$& is 192.168.5.6, expansion of the
6773 first &%domains%& setting above generates the second setting, which therefore
6774 causes a second lookup to occur.
6776 The lookup type may optionally be followed by a comma
6777 and a comma-separated list of options.
6778 Each option is a &"name=value"& pair.
6779 Whether an option is meaningful depends on the lookup type.
6781 All lookups support the option &"cache=no_rd"&.
6782 If this is given then the cache that Exim manages for lookup results
6783 is not checked before doing the lookup.
6784 The result of the lookup is still written to the cache.
6786 The rest of this chapter describes the different lookup types that are
6787 available. Any of them can be used in any part of the configuration where a
6788 lookup is permitted.
6791 .section "Lookup types" "SECID61"
6792 .cindex "lookup" "types of"
6793 .cindex "single-key lookup" "definition of"
6794 Two different types of data lookup are implemented:
6797 The &'single-key'& type requires the specification of a file in which to look,
6798 and a single key to search for. The key must be a non-empty string for the
6799 lookup to succeed. The lookup type determines how the file is searched.
6800 .cindex "tainted data" "single-key lookups"
6801 The file string may not be tainted.
6803 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
6804 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a single-key lookup"
6805 All single-key lookups support the option &"ret=key"&.
6806 If this is given and the lookup
6807 (either underlying implementation or cached value)
6808 returns data, the result is replaced with a non-tainted
6809 version of the lookup key.
6812 .cindex "query-style lookup" "definition of"
6813 The &'query-style'& type accepts a generalized database query. No particular
6814 key value is assumed by Exim for query-style lookups. You can use whichever
6815 Exim variables you need to construct the database query.
6817 For the string-expansion kind of lookups, the query is given in the first
6818 bracketed argument of the &${lookup ...}$& expansion.
6819 For the list-argument kind of lookup the query is given by the remainder of the
6820 list item after the first semicolon.
6822 .cindex "tainted data" "quoting for lookups"
6823 If tainted data is used in the query then it should be quoted by
6824 using the &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& expansion operator
6825 appropriate for the lookup.
6828 The code for each lookup type is in a separate source file that is included in
6829 the binary of Exim only if the corresponding compile-time option is set. The
6830 default settings in &_src/EDITME_& are:
6835 which means that only linear searching and DBM lookups are included by default.
6836 For some types of lookup (e.g. SQL databases), you need to install appropriate
6837 libraries and header files before building Exim.
6842 .section "Single-key lookup types" "SECTsinglekeylookups"
6843 .cindex "lookup" "single-key types"
6844 .cindex "single-key lookup" "list of types"
6845 The following single-key lookup types are implemented:
6848 .cindex "cdb" "description of"
6849 .cindex "lookup" "cdb"
6850 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6851 The given file is searched as a Constant DataBase file, using the key
6852 string without a terminating binary zero. The cdb format is designed for
6853 indexed files that are read frequently and never updated, except by total
6854 re-creation. As such, it is particularly suitable for large files containing
6855 aliases or other indexed data referenced by an MTA. Information about cdb and
6856 tools for building the files can be found in several places:
6858 &url(https://cr.yp.to/cdb.html)
6859 &url(https://www.corpit.ru/mjt/tinycdb.html)
6860 &url(https://packages.debian.org/stable/utils/freecdb)
6861 &url(https://github.com/philpennock/cdbtools) (in Go)
6863 A cdb distribution is not needed in order to build Exim with cdb support,
6864 because the code for reading cdb files is included directly in Exim itself.
6865 However, no means of building or testing cdb files is provided with Exim, so
6866 you need to obtain a cdb distribution in order to do this.
6869 .cindex "DBM" "lookup type"
6870 .cindex "lookup" "dbm"
6871 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6872 Calls to DBM library functions are used to extract data from the given
6873 DBM file by looking up the record with the given key. A terminating binary
6874 zero is included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. See section
6875 &<<SECTdb>>& for a discussion of DBM libraries.
6877 .cindex "Berkeley DB library" "file format"
6878 For all versions of Berkeley DB, Exim uses the DB_HASH style of database
6879 when building DBM files using the &%exim_dbmbuild%& utility. However, when
6880 using Berkeley DB versions 3 or 4, it opens existing databases for reading with
6881 the DB_UNKNOWN option. This enables it to handle any of the types of database
6882 that the library supports, and can be useful for accessing DBM files created by
6883 other applications. (For earlier DB versions, DB_HASH is always used.)
6886 .cindex "lookup" "dbmjz"
6887 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- embedded NULs"
6889 .cindex "dbmjz lookup type"
6890 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that the lookup key is
6891 interpreted as an Exim list; the elements of the list are joined together with
6892 ASCII NUL characters to form the lookup key. An example usage would be to
6893 authenticate incoming SMTP calls using the passwords from Cyrus SASL's
6894 &_/etc/sasldb2_& file with the &(gsasl)& authenticator or Exim's own
6895 &(cram_md5)& authenticator.
6898 .cindex "lookup" "dbmnz"
6899 .cindex "lookup" "dbm &-- terminating zero"
6900 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
6902 .cindex "&_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_&"
6903 .cindex "dbmnz lookup type"
6904 This is the same as &(dbm)&, except that a terminating binary zero
6905 is not included in the key that is passed to the DBM library. You may need this
6906 if you want to look up data in files that are created by or shared with some
6907 other application that does not use terminating zeros. For example, you need to
6908 use &(dbmnz)& rather than &(dbm)& if you want to authenticate incoming SMTP
6909 calls using the passwords from Courier's &_/etc/userdbshadow.dat_& file. Exim's
6910 utility program for creating DBM files (&'exim_dbmbuild'&) includes the zeros
6911 by default, but has an option to omit them (see section &<<SECTdbmbuild>>&).
6914 .cindex "lookup" "dsearch"
6915 .cindex "dsearch lookup type"
6916 The given file must be an absolute directory path; this is searched for an entry
6917 whose name is the key by calling the &[lstat()]& function.
6918 Unless the options (below) permit a path,
6919 the key may not contain any forward slash characters.
6920 If &[lstat()]& succeeds then so does the lookup.
6921 .cindex "tainted data" "dsearch result"
6922 The result is regarded as untainted.
6924 Options for the lookup can be given by appending them after the word "dsearch",
6925 separated by a comma. Options, if present, are a comma-separated list having
6926 each element starting with a tag name and an equals.
6928 Three options are supported, for the return value and for filtering match
6930 The "ret" option requests an alternate result value of
6931 the entire path for the entry. Example:
6933 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,ret=full {/etc}}
6935 The default result is just the requested entry.
6937 The "filter" option requests that only directory entries of a given type
6938 are matched. The match value is one of "file", "dir" or "subdir" (the latter
6939 not matching "." or ".."). Example:
6941 ${lookup {passwd} dsearch,filter=file {/etc}}
6943 The default matching is for any entry type, including directories
6946 The "key" option relaxes the restriction that only a simple path component can
6947 be searched for, to permit a sequence of path components. Example:
6949 ${lookup {foo/bar} dsearch,key=path {/etc}}
6951 If this option is used, a ".." component in the key is specifically disallowed.
6952 The default operation is that the key may only be a single path component.
6954 An example of how this
6955 lookup can be used to support virtual domains is given in section
6956 &<<SECTvirtualdomains>>&.
6958 .subsection iplsearch
6959 .cindex "lookup" "iplsearch"
6960 .cindex "iplsearch lookup type"
6961 The given file is a text file containing keys and data. A key is
6962 terminated by a colon or white space or the end of the line. The keys in the
6963 file must be IP addresses, or IP addresses with CIDR masks. Keys that involve
6964 IPv6 addresses must be enclosed in quotes to prevent the first internal colon
6965 being interpreted as a key terminator. For example:
6967 1.2.3.4: data for 1.2.3.4
6968 192.168.0.0/16: data for 192.168.0.0/16
6969 "abcd::cdab": data for abcd::cdab
6970 "abcd:abcd::/32" data for abcd:abcd::/32
6972 The key for an &(iplsearch)& lookup must be an IP address (without a mask). The
6973 file is searched linearly, using the CIDR masks where present, until a matching
6974 key is found. The first key that matches is used; there is no attempt to find a
6975 &"best"& match. Apart from the way the keys are matched, the processing for
6976 &(iplsearch)& is the same as for &(lsearch)&.
6978 &*Warning 1*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
6979 &(iplsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
6980 lookup types support only literal keys.
6982 &*Warning 2*&: In a host list, you must always use &(net-iplsearch)& so that
6983 the implicit key is the host's IP address rather than its name
6984 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
6986 &*Warning 3*&: Do not use an IPv4-mapped IPv6 address for a key; use the
6987 IPv4, in dotted-quad form. (Exim converts IPv4-mapped IPv6 addresses to this
6988 notation before executing the lookup.)
6990 One option is supported, "ret=full", to request the return of the entire line
6991 rather than omitting the key portion.
6992 Note however that the key portion will have been de-quoted.
6996 .cindex json "lookup type"
6997 .cindex JSON expansions
6998 The given file is a text file with a JSON structure.
6999 An element of the structure is extracted, defined by the search key.
7000 The key is a list of subelement selectors
7001 (colon-separated by default but changeable in the usual way)
7002 which are applied in turn to select smaller and smaller portions
7003 of the JSON structure.
7004 If a selector is numeric, it must apply to a JSON array; the (zero-based)
7005 nunbered array element is selected.
7006 Otherwise it must apply to a JSON object; the named element is selected.
7007 The final resulting element can be a simple JSON type or a JSON object
7008 or array; for the latter two a string-representation of the JSON
7010 For elements of type string, the returned value is de-quoted.
7016 .cindex database lmdb
7017 The given file is an LMDB database.
7018 LMDB is a memory-mapped key-value store,
7019 with API modeled loosely on that of BerkeleyDB.
7020 See &url(https://symas.com/products/lightning-memory-mapped-database/,LMDB)
7021 for the feature set and operation modes.
7023 Exim provides read-only access via the LMDB C library.
7024 The library can be obtained from &url(https://github.com/LMDB/lmdb)
7025 or your operating system package repository.
7026 To enable LMDB support in Exim set LOOKUP_LMDB=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
7028 You will need to separately create the LMDB database file,
7029 possibly using the &"mdb_load"& utility.
7033 .cindex "linear search"
7034 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch"
7035 .cindex "lsearch lookup type"
7036 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in lsearch lookup"
7037 The given file is a text file that is searched linearly for a
7038 line beginning with the search key, terminated by a colon or white space or the
7039 end of the line. The search is case-insensitive; that is, upper and lower case
7040 letters are treated as the same. The first occurrence of the key that is found
7041 in the file is used.
7043 White space between the key and the colon is permitted. The remainder of the
7044 line, with leading and trailing white space removed, is the data. This can be
7045 continued onto subsequent lines by starting them with any amount of white
7046 space, but only a single space character is included in the data at such a
7047 junction. If the data begins with a colon, the key must be terminated by a
7052 Empty lines and lines beginning with # are ignored, even if they occur in the
7053 middle of an item. This is the traditional textual format of alias files. Note
7054 that the keys in an &(lsearch)& file are literal strings. There is no
7055 wildcarding of any kind.
7057 .cindex "lookup" "lsearch &-- colons in keys"
7058 .cindex "white space" "in lsearch key"
7059 In most &(lsearch)& files, keys are not required to contain colons or #
7060 characters, or white space. However, if you need this feature, it is available.
7061 If a key begins with a doublequote character, it is terminated only by a
7062 matching quote (or end of line), and the normal escaping rules apply to its
7063 contents (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&). An optional colon is permitted after
7064 quoted keys (exactly as for unquoted keys). There is no special handling of
7065 quotes for the data part of an &(lsearch)& line.
7068 .cindex "NIS lookup type"
7069 .cindex "lookup" "NIS"
7070 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
7071 The given file is the name of a NIS map, and a NIS lookup is done with
7072 the given key, without a terminating binary zero. There is a variant called
7073 &(nis0)& which does include the terminating binary zero in the key. This is
7074 reportedly needed for Sun-style alias files. Exim does not recognize NIS
7075 aliases; the full map names must be used.
7077 .subsection (n)wildlsearch
7078 .cindex "wildlsearch lookup type"
7079 .cindex "lookup" "wildlsearch"
7080 .cindex "nwildlsearch lookup type"
7081 .cindex "lookup" "nwildlsearch"
7082 &(wildlsearch)& or &(nwildlsearch)&: These search a file linearly, like
7083 &(lsearch)&, but instead of being interpreted as a literal string, each key in
7084 the file may be wildcarded. The difference between these two lookup types is
7085 that for &(wildlsearch)&, each key in the file is string-expanded before being
7086 used, whereas for &(nwildlsearch)&, no expansion takes place.
7088 .cindex "case sensitivity" "in (n)wildlsearch lookup"
7089 Like &(lsearch)&, the testing is done case-insensitively. However, keys in the
7090 file that are regular expressions can be made case-sensitive by the use of
7091 &`(-i)`& within the pattern. The following forms of wildcard are recognized:
7094 The string may begin with an asterisk to mean &"ends with"&. For example:
7096 *.a.b.c data for anything.a.b.c
7097 *fish data for anythingfish
7100 The string may begin with a circumflex to indicate a regular expression. For
7101 example, for &(wildlsearch)&:
7103 ^\N\d+\.a\.b\N data for <digits>.a.b
7105 Note the use of &`\N`& to disable expansion of the contents of the regular
7106 expression. If you are using &(nwildlsearch)&, where the keys are not
7107 string-expanded, the equivalent entry is:
7109 ^\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7111 The case-insensitive flag is set at the start of compiling the regular
7112 expression, but it can be turned off by using &`(-i)`& at an appropriate point.
7113 For example, to make the entire pattern case-sensitive:
7115 ^(?-i)\d+\.a\.b data for <digits>.a.b
7118 If the regular expression contains white space or colon characters, you must
7119 either quote it (see &(lsearch)& above), or represent these characters in other
7120 ways. For example, &`\s`& can be used for white space and &`\x3A`& for a
7121 colon. This may be easier than quoting, because if you quote, you have to
7122 escape all the backslashes inside the quotes.
7124 &*Note*&: It is not possible to capture substrings in a regular expression
7125 match for later use, because the results of all lookups are cached. If a lookup
7126 is repeated, the result is taken from the cache, and no actual pattern matching
7127 takes place. The values of all the numeric variables are unset after a
7128 &((n)wildlsearch)& match.
7131 Although I cannot see it being of much use, the general matching function that
7132 is used to implement &((n)wildlsearch)& means that the string may begin with a
7133 lookup name terminated by a semicolon, and followed by lookup data. For
7136 cdb;/some/file data for keys that match the file
7138 The data that is obtained from the nested lookup is discarded.
7141 Keys that do not match any of these patterns are interpreted literally. The
7142 continuation rules for the data are the same as for &(lsearch)&, and keys may
7143 be followed by optional colons.
7145 &*Warning*&: Unlike most other single-key lookup types, a file of data for
7146 &((n)wildlsearch)& can &'not'& be turned into a DBM or cdb file, because those
7147 lookup types support only literal keys.
7150 .cindex "spf lookup type"
7151 .cindex "lookup" "spf"
7152 If Exim is built with SPF support, manual lookups can be done
7153 (as opposed to the standard ACL condition method).
7154 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
7157 .section "Query-style lookup types" "SECTquerystylelookups"
7158 .cindex "lookup" "query-style types"
7159 .cindex "query-style lookup" "list of types"
7160 The supported query-style lookup types are listed below. Further details about
7161 many of them are given in later sections.
7164 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7165 .cindex "lookup" "DNS"
7166 This does a DNS search for one or more records whose domain names
7167 are given in the supplied query. The resulting data is the contents of the
7168 records. See section &<<SECTdnsdb>>&.
7171 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
7172 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
7173 This does a lookup in an InterBase database.
7176 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup type"
7177 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7178 This does an LDAP lookup using a query in the form of a URL, and
7179 returns attributes from a single entry. There is a variant called &(ldapm)&
7180 that permits values from multiple entries to be returned. A third variant
7181 called &(ldapdn)& returns the Distinguished Name of a single entry instead of
7182 any attribute values. See section &<<SECTldap>>&.
7185 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
7186 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
7187 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7188 MySQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7191 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
7192 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
7193 This does a NIS+ lookup using a query that can specify the name of
7194 the field to be returned. See section &<<SECTnisplus>>&.
7197 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
7198 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
7199 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to an
7200 Oracle database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7203 .cindex "lookup" "passwd"
7204 .cindex "passwd lookup type"
7205 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
7206 This is a query-style lookup with queries that are just user names. The
7207 lookup calls &[getpwnam()]& to interrogate the system password data, and on
7208 success, the result string is the same as you would get from an &(lsearch)&
7209 lookup on a traditional &_/etc/passwd file_&, though with &`*`& for the
7210 password value. For example:
7212 *:42:42:King Rat:/home/kr:/bin/bash
7216 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
7217 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
7218 The format of the query is an SQL statement that is passed to a
7219 PostgreSQL database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7222 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
7223 .cindex lookup Redis
7224 The format of the query is either a simple get or simple set,
7225 passed to a Redis database. See section &<<SECTsql>>&.
7228 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
7229 .cindex "lookup" "sqlite"
7230 The format of the query is
7231 an SQL statement that is passed to an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>&.
7234 This is a lookup type that is used for testing Exim. It is
7235 not likely to be useful in normal operation.
7238 .cindex "whoson lookup type"
7239 .cindex "lookup" "whoson"
7240 &'Whoson'& (&url(http://whoson.sourceforge.net)) is a protocol that
7241 allows a server to check whether a particular (dynamically allocated) IP
7242 address is currently allocated to a known (trusted) user and, optionally, to
7243 obtain the identity of the said user. For SMTP servers, &'Whoson'& was popular
7244 at one time for &"POP before SMTP"& authentication, but that approach has been
7245 superseded by SMTP authentication. In Exim, &'Whoson'& can be used to implement
7246 &"POP before SMTP"& checking using ACL statements such as
7248 require condition = \
7249 ${lookup whoson {$sender_host_address}{yes}{no}}
7251 The query consists of a single IP address. The value returned is the name of
7252 the authenticated user, which is stored in the variable &$value$&. However, in
7253 this example, the data in &$value$& is not used; the result of the lookup is
7254 one of the fixed strings &"yes"& or &"no"&.
7258 .section "Temporary errors in lookups" "SECID63"
7259 .cindex "lookup" "temporary error in"
7260 Lookup functions can return temporary error codes if the lookup cannot be
7261 completed. For example, an SQL or LDAP database might be unavailable. For this
7262 reason, it is not advisable to use a lookup that might do this for critical
7263 options such as a list of local domains.
7265 When a lookup cannot be completed in a router or transport, delivery
7266 of the message (to the relevant address) is deferred, as for any other
7267 temporary error. In other circumstances Exim may assume the lookup has failed,
7268 or may give up altogether.
7272 .section "Default values in single-key lookups" "SECTdefaultvaluelookups"
7273 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7274 .cindex "lookup" "default values"
7275 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7276 .cindex "lookup" "* added to type"
7277 .cindex "default" "in single-key lookups"
7278 In this context, a &"default value"& is a value specified by the administrator
7279 that is to be used if a lookup fails.
7281 &*Note:*& This section applies only to single-key lookups. For query-style
7282 lookups, the facilities of the query language must be used. An attempt to
7283 specify a default for a query-style lookup provokes an error.
7285 If &"*"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example, &%lsearch*%&)
7286 and the initial lookup fails, the key &"*"& is looked up in the file to
7287 provide a default value. See also the section on partial matching below.
7289 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
7290 .cindex "lookup" "*@ added to type"
7291 .cindex "alias file" "per-domain default"
7292 Alternatively, if &"*@"& is added to a single-key lookup type (for example
7293 &%dbm*@%&) then, if the initial lookup fails and the key contains an @
7294 character, a second lookup is done with everything before the last @ replaced
7295 by *. This makes it possible to provide per-domain defaults in alias files
7296 that include the domains in the keys. If the second lookup fails (or doesn't
7297 take place because there is no @ in the key), &"*"& is looked up.
7298 For example, a &(redirect)& router might contain:
7300 data = ${lookup{$local_part@$domain}lsearch*@{/etc/mix-aliases}}
7302 Suppose the address that is being processed is &'jane@eyre.example'&. Exim
7303 looks up these keys, in this order:
7309 The data is taken from whichever key it finds first. &*Note*&: In an
7310 &(lsearch)& file, this does not mean the first of these keys in the file. A
7311 complete scan is done for each key, and only if it is not found at all does
7312 Exim move on to try the next key.
7316 .section "Partial matching in single-key lookups" "SECTpartiallookup"
7317 .cindex "partial matching"
7318 .cindex "wildcard lookups"
7319 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching"
7320 .cindex "lookup" "wildcard"
7321 .cindex "asterisk" "in search type"
7322 The normal operation of a single-key lookup is to search the file for an exact
7323 match with the given key. However, in a number of situations where domains are
7324 being looked up, it is useful to be able to do partial matching. In this case,
7325 information in the file that has a key starting with &"*."& is matched by any
7326 domain that ends with the components that follow the full stop. For example, if
7327 a key in a DBM file is
7329 *.dates.fict.example
7331 then when partial matching is enabled this is matched by (amongst others)
7332 &'2001.dates.fict.example'& and &'1984.dates.fict.example'&. It is also matched
7333 by &'dates.fict.example'&, if that does not appear as a separate key in the
7336 &*Note*&: Partial matching is not available for query-style lookups. It is
7337 also not available for any lookup items in address lists (see section
7338 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&).
7340 Partial matching is implemented by doing a series of separate lookups using
7341 keys constructed by modifying the original subject key. This means that it can
7342 be used with any of the single-key lookup types, provided that
7343 partial matching keys
7344 beginning with a special prefix (default &"*."&) are included in the data file.
7345 Keys in the file that do not begin with the prefix are matched only by
7346 unmodified subject keys when partial matching is in use.
7348 Partial matching is requested by adding the string &"partial-"& to the front of
7349 the name of a single-key lookup type, for example, &%partial-dbm%&. When this
7350 is done, the subject key is first looked up unmodified; if that fails, &"*."&
7351 is added at the start of the subject key, and it is looked up again. If that
7352 fails, further lookups are tried with dot-separated components removed from the
7353 start of the subject key, one-by-one, and &"*."& added on the front of what
7356 A minimum number of two non-* components are required. This can be adjusted
7357 by including a number before the hyphen in the search type. For example,
7358 &%partial3-lsearch%& specifies a minimum of three non-* components in the
7359 modified keys. Omitting the number is equivalent to &"partial2-"&. If the
7360 subject key is &'2250.dates.fict.example'& then the following keys are looked
7361 up when the minimum number of non-* components is two:
7363 2250.dates.fict.example
7364 *.2250.dates.fict.example
7365 *.dates.fict.example
7368 As soon as one key in the sequence is successfully looked up, the lookup
7371 .cindex "lookup" "partial matching &-- changing prefix"
7372 .cindex "prefix" "for partial matching"
7373 The use of &"*."& as the partial matching prefix is a default that can be
7374 changed. The motivation for this feature is to allow Exim to operate with file
7375 formats that are used by other MTAs. A different prefix can be supplied in
7376 parentheses instead of the hyphen after &"partial"&. For example:
7378 domains = partial(.)lsearch;/some/file
7380 In this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7381 &`a.b.c`&, &`.a.b.c`&, and &`.b.c`& (the default minimum of 2 non-wild
7382 components is unchanged). The prefix may consist of any punctuation characters
7383 other than a closing parenthesis. It may be empty, for example:
7385 domains = partial1()cdb;/some/file
7387 For this example, if the domain is &'a.b.c'&, the sequence of lookups is
7388 &`a.b.c`&, &`b.c`&, and &`c`&.
7390 If &"partial0"& is specified, what happens at the end (when the lookup with
7391 just one non-wild component has failed, and the original key is shortened right
7392 down to the null string) depends on the prefix:
7395 If the prefix has zero length, the whole lookup fails.
7397 If the prefix has length 1, a lookup for just the prefix is done. For
7398 example, the final lookup for &"partial0(.)"& is for &`.`& alone.
7400 Otherwise, if the prefix ends in a dot, the dot is removed, and the
7401 remainder is looked up. With the default prefix, therefore, the final lookup is
7402 for &"*"& on its own.
7404 Otherwise, the whole prefix is looked up.
7408 If the search type ends in &"*"& or &"*@"& (see section
7409 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& above), the search for an ultimate default that
7410 this implies happens after all partial lookups have failed. If &"partial0"& is
7411 specified, adding &"*"& to the search type has no effect with the default
7412 prefix, because the &"*"& key is already included in the sequence of partial
7413 lookups. However, there might be a use for lookup types such as
7414 &"partial0(.)lsearch*"&.
7416 The use of &"*"& in lookup partial matching differs from its use as a wildcard
7417 in domain lists and the like. Partial matching works only in terms of
7418 dot-separated components; a key such as &`*fict.example`&
7419 in a database file is useless, because the asterisk in a partial matching
7420 subject key is always followed by a dot.
7422 When the lookup is done from a string-expansion,
7423 the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild and non-wild parts of the key
7424 during the expansion of the replacement text.
7425 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
7430 .section "Lookup caching" "SECID64"
7431 .cindex "lookup" "caching"
7432 .cindex "caching" "lookup data"
7433 Exim caches all lookup results in order to avoid needless repetition of
7434 lookups. However, because (apart from the daemon) Exim operates as a collection
7435 of independent, short-lived processes, this caching applies only within a
7436 single Exim process. There is no inter-process lookup caching facility.
7438 If an option &"cache=no_rd"& is used on the lookup then
7439 the cache is only written to, cached data is not used for the operation
7440 and a real lookup is done.
7442 For single-key lookups, Exim keeps the relevant files open in case there is
7443 another lookup that needs them. In some types of configuration this can lead to
7444 many files being kept open for messages with many recipients. To avoid hitting
7445 the operating system limit on the number of simultaneously open files, Exim
7446 closes the least recently used file when it needs to open more files than its
7447 own internal limit, which can be changed via the &%lookup_open_max%& option.
7449 The single-key lookup files are closed and the lookup caches are flushed at
7450 strategic points during delivery &-- for example, after all routing is
7456 .section "Quoting lookup data" "SECID65"
7457 .cindex "lookup" "quoting"
7458 .cindex "quoting" "in lookups"
7459 When data from an incoming message is included in a query-style lookup, there
7460 is the possibility of special characters in the data messing up the syntax of
7461 the query. For example, a NIS+ query that contains
7465 will be broken if the local part happens to contain a closing square bracket.
7466 For NIS+, data can be enclosed in double quotes like this:
7468 [name="$local_part"]
7470 but this still leaves the problem of a double quote in the data. The rule for
7471 NIS+ is that double quotes must be doubled. Other lookup types have different
7472 rules, and to cope with the differing requirements, an expansion operator
7473 of the following form is provided:
7475 ${quote_<lookup-type>:<string>}
7477 For example, the way to write the NIS+ query is
7479 [name="${quote_nisplus:$local_part}"]
7481 .cindex "tainted data" "in lookups"
7482 &*All*& tainted data used in a query-style lookup must be quoted
7483 using a mechanism appropriate for the lookup type.
7484 See chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>& for full coverage of string expansions. The quote
7485 operator can be used for all lookup types, but has no effect for single-key
7486 lookups, since no quoting is ever needed in their key strings.
7491 .section "More about dnsdb" "SECTdnsdb"
7492 .cindex "dnsdb lookup"
7493 .cindex "lookup" "dnsdb"
7494 .cindex "DNS" "as a lookup type"
7495 The &(dnsdb)& lookup type uses the DNS as its database. A simple query consists
7496 of a record type and a domain name, separated by an equals sign. For example,
7497 an expansion string could contain:
7499 ${lookup dnsdb{mx=a.b.example}{$value}fail}
7501 If the lookup succeeds, the result is placed in &$value$&, which in this case
7502 is used on its own as the result. If the lookup does not succeed, the
7503 &`fail`& keyword causes a &'forced expansion failure'& &-- see section
7504 &<<SECTforexpfai>>& for an explanation of what this means.
7506 The supported DNS record types are A, CNAME, MX, NS, PTR, SOA, SPF, SRV, TLSA
7507 and TXT, and, when Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, AAAA.
7508 If no type is given, TXT is assumed.
7510 For any record type, if multiple records are found, the data is returned as a
7511 concatenation, with newline as the default separator. The order, of course,
7512 depends on the DNS resolver. You can specify a different separator character
7513 between multiple records by putting a right angle-bracket followed immediately
7514 by the new separator at the start of the query. For example:
7516 ${lookup dnsdb{>: a=host1.example}}
7518 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7519 white space is ignored.
7520 For lookup types that return multiple fields per record,
7521 an alternate field separator can be specified using a comma after the main
7522 separator character, followed immediately by the field separator.
7524 .cindex "PTR record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7525 When the type is PTR,
7526 the data can be an IP address, written as normal; inversion and the addition of
7527 &%in-addr.arpa%& or &%ip6.arpa%& happens automatically. For example:
7529 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=192.168.4.5}{$value}fail}
7531 If the data for a PTR record is not a syntactically valid IP address, it is not
7532 altered and nothing is added.
7534 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7535 .cindex "SRV record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7536 For an MX lookup, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7537 each record, separated by a space. For an SRV lookup, the priority, weight,
7538 port, and host name are returned for each record, separated by spaces.
7539 The field separator can be modified as above.
7541 .cindex "TXT record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7542 .cindex "SPF record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7543 For TXT records with multiple items of data, only the first item is returned,
7544 unless a field separator is specified.
7545 To concatenate items without a separator, use a semicolon instead.
7547 default behaviour is to concatenate multiple items without using a separator.
7549 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n,: txt=a.b.example}}
7550 ${lookup dnsdb{>\n; txt=a.b.example}}
7551 ${lookup dnsdb{spf=example.org}}
7553 It is permitted to specify a space as the separator character. Further
7554 white space is ignored.
7556 .cindex "SOA record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7557 For an SOA lookup, while no result is obtained the lookup is redone with
7558 successively more leading components dropped from the given domain.
7559 Only the primary-nameserver field is returned unless a field separator is
7562 ${lookup dnsdb{>:,; soa=a.b.example.com}}
7565 .subsection "Dnsdb lookup modifiers" SECTdnsdb_mod
7566 .cindex "dnsdb modifiers"
7567 .cindex "modifiers" "dnsdb"
7568 .cindex "options" "dnsdb"
7569 Modifiers for &(dnsdb)& lookups are given by optional keywords,
7570 each followed by a comma,
7571 that may appear before the record type.
7573 The &(dnsdb)& lookup fails only if all the DNS lookups fail. If there is a
7574 temporary DNS error for any of them, the behaviour is controlled by
7575 a defer-option modifier.
7576 The possible keywords are
7577 &"defer_strict"&, &"defer_never"&, and &"defer_lax"&.
7578 With &"strict"& behaviour, any temporary DNS error causes the
7579 whole lookup to defer. With &"never"& behaviour, a temporary DNS error is
7580 ignored, and the behaviour is as if the DNS lookup failed to find anything.
7581 With &"lax"& behaviour, all the queries are attempted, but a temporary DNS
7582 error causes the whole lookup to defer only if none of the other lookups
7583 succeed. The default is &"lax"&, so the following lookups are equivalent:
7585 ${lookup dnsdb{defer_lax,a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7586 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7588 Thus, in the default case, as long as at least one of the DNS lookups
7589 yields some data, the lookup succeeds.
7591 .cindex "DNSSEC" "dns lookup"
7592 Use of &(DNSSEC)& is controlled by a dnssec modifier.
7593 The possible keywords are
7594 &"dnssec_strict"&, &"dnssec_lax"&, and &"dnssec_never"&.
7595 With &"strict"& or &"lax"& DNSSEC information is requested
7597 With &"strict"& a response from the DNS resolver that
7598 is not labelled as authenticated data
7599 is treated as equivalent to a temporary DNS error.
7600 The default is &"lax"&.
7602 See also the &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$& variable.
7604 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
7605 .cindex "DNS" timeout
7606 Timeout for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retrans modifier.
7607 The form is &"retrans_VAL"& where VAL is an Exim time specification
7609 The default value is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retrans%&.
7611 Retries for the dnsdb lookup can be controlled by a retry modifier.
7612 The form if &"retry_VAL"& where VAL is an integer.
7613 The default count is set by the main configuration option &%dns_retry%&.
7615 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
7616 .cindex TTL "of dns lookup"
7618 Dnsdb lookup results are cached within a single process (and its children).
7619 The cache entry lifetime is limited to the smallest time-to-live (TTL)
7620 value of the set of returned DNS records.
7623 .subsection "Pseudo dnsdb record types" SECID66
7624 .cindex "MX record" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7625 By default, both the preference value and the host name are returned for
7626 each MX record, separated by a space. If you want only host names, you can use
7627 the pseudo-type MXH:
7629 ${lookup dnsdb{mxh=a.b.example}}
7631 In this case, the preference values are omitted, and just the host names are
7634 .cindex "name server for enclosing domain"
7635 Another pseudo-type is ZNS (for &"zone NS"&). It performs a lookup for NS
7636 records on the given domain, but if none are found, it removes the first
7637 component of the domain name, and tries again. This process continues until NS
7638 records are found or there are no more components left (or there is a DNS
7639 error). In other words, it may return the name servers for a top-level domain,
7640 but it never returns the root name servers. If there are no NS records for the
7641 top-level domain, the lookup fails. Consider these examples:
7643 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.quercite.com}}
7644 ${lookup dnsdb{zns=xxx.edu}}
7646 Assuming that in each case there are no NS records for the full domain name,
7647 the first returns the name servers for &%quercite.com%&, and the second returns
7648 the name servers for &%edu%&.
7650 You should be careful about how you use this lookup because, unless the
7651 top-level domain does not exist, the lookup always returns some host names. The
7652 sort of use to which this might be put is for seeing if the name servers for a
7653 given domain are on a blacklist. You can probably assume that the name servers
7654 for the high-level domains such as &%com%& or &%co.uk%& are not going to be on
7657 .cindex "CSA" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7658 A third pseudo-type is CSA (Client SMTP Authorization). This looks up SRV
7659 records according to the CSA rules, which are described in section
7660 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&. Although &(dnsdb)& supports SRV lookups directly, this is
7661 not sufficient because of the extra parent domain search behaviour of CSA. The
7662 result of a successful lookup such as:
7664 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
7666 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
7667 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
7668 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
7670 .cindex "A+" "in &(dnsdb)& lookup"
7671 The pseudo-type A+ performs an AAAA
7672 and then an A lookup. All results are returned; defer processing
7673 (see below) is handled separately for each lookup. Example:
7675 ${lookup dnsdb {>; a+=$sender_helo_name}}
7679 .subsection "Multiple dnsdb lookups" SECID67
7680 In the previous sections, &(dnsdb)& lookups for a single domain are described.
7681 However, you can specify a list of domains or IP addresses in a single
7682 &(dnsdb)& lookup. The list is specified in the normal Exim way, with colon as
7683 the default separator, but with the ability to change this. For example:
7685 ${lookup dnsdb{one.domain.com:two.domain.com}}
7686 ${lookup dnsdb{a=one.host.com:two.host.com}}
7687 ${lookup dnsdb{ptr = <; 1.2.3.4 ; 4.5.6.8}}
7689 In order to retain backwards compatibility, there is one special case: if
7690 the lookup type is PTR and no change of separator is specified, Exim looks
7691 to see if the rest of the string is precisely one IPv6 address. In this
7692 case, it does not treat it as a list.
7694 The data from each lookup is concatenated, with newline separators by default,
7695 in the same way that multiple DNS records for a single item are handled. A
7696 different separator can be specified, as described above.
7701 .section "More about LDAP" "SECTldap"
7702 .cindex "LDAP" "lookup, more about"
7703 .cindex "lookup" "LDAP"
7704 .cindex "Solaris" "LDAP"
7705 The original LDAP implementation came from the University of Michigan; this has
7706 become &"Open LDAP"&, and there are now two different releases. Another
7707 implementation comes from Netscape, and Solaris 7 and subsequent releases
7708 contain inbuilt LDAP support. Unfortunately, though these are all compatible at
7709 the lookup function level, their error handling is different. For this reason
7710 it is necessary to set a compile-time variable when building Exim with LDAP, to
7711 indicate which LDAP library is in use. One of the following should appear in
7712 your &_Local/Makefile_&:
7714 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=UMICHIGAN
7715 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP1
7716 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=OPENLDAP2
7717 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=NETSCAPE
7718 LDAP_LIB_TYPE=SOLARIS
7720 If LDAP_LIB_TYPE is not set, Exim assumes &`OPENLDAP1`&, which has the
7721 same interface as the University of Michigan version.
7723 There are three LDAP lookup types in Exim. These behave slightly differently in
7724 the way they handle the results of a query:
7727 &(ldap)& requires the result to contain just one entry; if there are more, it
7730 &(ldapdn)& also requires the result to contain just one entry, but it is the
7731 Distinguished Name that is returned rather than any attribute values.
7733 &(ldapm)& permits the result to contain more than one entry; the attributes
7734 from all of them are returned.
7738 For &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, if a query finds only entries with no attributes,
7739 Exim behaves as if the entry did not exist, and the lookup fails. The format of
7740 the data returned by a successful lookup is described in the next section.
7741 First we explain how LDAP queries are coded.
7744 .subsection "Format of LDAP queries" SECTforldaque
7745 .cindex "LDAP" "query format"
7746 An LDAP query takes the form of a URL as defined in
7747 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2255,RFC 2255). For example, in
7748 the configuration of a &(redirect)& router one might have this setting:
7750 data = ${lookup ldap \
7751 {ldap:///cn=$local_part,o=University%20of%20Cambridge,\
7752 c=UK?mailbox?base?}}
7754 .cindex "LDAP" "with TLS"
7755 The URL may begin with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& if your LDAP library supports
7756 secure (encrypted) LDAP connections. The second of these ensures that an
7757 encrypted TLS connection is used.
7759 With sufficiently modern LDAP libraries, Exim supports forcing TLS over regular
7760 LDAP connections, rather than the SSL-on-connect &`ldaps`&.
7761 See the &%ldap_start_tls%& option.
7763 Starting with Exim 4.83, the initialization of LDAP with TLS is more tightly
7764 controlled. Every part of the TLS configuration can be configured by settings in
7765 &_exim.conf_&. Depending on the version of the client libraries installed on
7766 your system, some of the initialization may have required setting options in
7767 &_/etc/ldap.conf_& or &_~/.ldaprc_& to get TLS working with self-signed
7768 certificates. This revealed a nuance where the current UID that exim was
7769 running as could affect which config files it read. With Exim 4.83, these
7770 methods become optional, only taking effect if not specifically set in
7774 .subsection "LDAP quoting" SECID68
7775 .cindex "LDAP" "quoting"
7776 Two levels of quoting are required in LDAP queries, the first for LDAP itself
7777 and the second because the LDAP query is represented as a URL. Furthermore,
7778 within an LDAP query, two different kinds of quoting are required. For this
7779 reason, there are two different LDAP-specific quoting operators.
7781 The &%quote_ldap%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7782 filter specifications. Conceptually, it first does the following conversions on
7791 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2254,RFC 2254).
7792 The resulting string is then quoted according
7793 to the rules for URLs, that is, all non-alphanumeric characters except
7797 are converted to their hex values, preceded by a percent sign. For example:
7799 ${quote_ldap: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7803 %20a%5C28bc%5C29%5C2A%2C%20a%3Cyz%3E%3B%20
7805 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a leading and a trailing space):
7807 a\28bc\29\2A, a<yz>;
7809 The &%quote_ldap_dn%& operator is designed for use on strings that are part of
7810 base DN specifications in queries. Conceptually, it first converts the string
7811 by inserting a backslash in front of any of the following characters:
7815 It also inserts a backslash before any leading spaces or # characters, and
7816 before any trailing spaces. (These rules are in
7817 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2255,RFC 2253).)
7818 The resulting string is then quoted according to the rules for URLs.
7821 ${quote_ldap_dn: a(bc)*, a<yz>; }
7825 %5C%20a(bc)*%5C%2C%20a%5C%3Cyz%5C%3E%5C%3B%5C%20
7827 Removing the URL quoting, this is (with a trailing space):
7829 \ a(bc)*\, a\<yz\>\;\
7831 There are some further comments about quoting in the section on LDAP
7832 authentication below.
7835 .subsection "LDAP connections" SECID69
7836 .cindex "LDAP" "connections"
7837 The connection to an LDAP server may either be over TCP/IP, or, when OpenLDAP
7838 is in use, via a Unix domain socket. The example given above does not specify
7839 an LDAP server. A server that is reached by TCP/IP can be specified in a query
7842 ldap://<hostname>:<port>/...
7844 If the port (and preceding colon) are omitted, the standard LDAP port (389) is
7845 used. When no server is specified in a query, a list of default servers is
7846 taken from the &%ldap_default_servers%& configuration option. This supplies a
7847 colon-separated list of servers which are tried in turn until one successfully
7848 handles a query, or there is a serious error. Successful handling either
7849 returns the requested data, or indicates that it does not exist. Serious errors
7850 are syntactical, or multiple values when only a single value is expected.
7851 Errors which cause the next server to be tried are connection failures, bind
7852 failures, and timeouts.
7854 For each server name in the list, a port number can be given. The standard way
7855 of specifying a host and port is to use a colon separator
7856 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1738,RFC 1738)). Because
7857 &%ldap_default_servers%& is a colon-separated list, such colons have to be
7858 doubled. For example
7860 ldap_default_servers = ldap1.example.com::145:ldap2.example.com
7862 If &%ldap_default_servers%& is unset, a URL with no server name is passed
7863 to the LDAP library with no server name, and the library's default (normally
7864 the local host) is used.
7866 If you are using the OpenLDAP library, you can connect to an LDAP server using
7867 a Unix domain socket instead of a TCP/IP connection. This is specified by using
7868 &`ldapi`& instead of &`ldap`& in LDAP queries. What follows here applies only
7869 to OpenLDAP. If Exim is compiled with a different LDAP library, this feature is
7872 For this type of connection, instead of a host name for the server, a pathname
7873 for the socket is required, and the port number is not relevant. The pathname
7874 can be specified either as an item in &%ldap_default_servers%&, or inline in
7875 the query. In the former case, you can have settings such as
7877 ldap_default_servers = /tmp/ldap.sock : backup.ldap.your.domain
7879 When the pathname is given in the query, you have to escape the slashes as
7880 &`%2F`& to fit in with the LDAP URL syntax. For example:
7882 ${lookup ldap {ldapi://%2Ftmp%2Fldap.sock/o=...
7884 When Exim processes an LDAP lookup and finds that the &"hostname"& is really
7885 a pathname, it uses the Unix domain socket code, even if the query actually
7886 specifies &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`&. In particular, no encryption is used for a
7887 socket connection. This behaviour means that you can use a setting of
7888 &%ldap_default_servers%& such as in the example above with traditional &`ldap`&
7889 or &`ldaps`& queries, and it will work. First, Exim tries a connection via
7890 the Unix domain socket; if that fails, it tries a TCP/IP connection to the
7893 If an explicit &`ldapi`& type is given in a query when a host name is
7894 specified, an error is diagnosed. However, if there are more items in
7895 &%ldap_default_servers%&, they are tried. In other words:
7898 Using a pathname with &`ldap`& or &`ldaps`& forces the use of the Unix domain
7901 Using &`ldapi`& with a host name causes an error.
7905 Using &`ldapi`& with no host or path in the query, and no setting of
7906 &%ldap_default_servers%&, does whatever the library does by default.
7910 .subsection "LDAP authentication and control information" SECID70
7911 .cindex "LDAP" "authentication"
7912 The LDAP URL syntax provides no way of passing authentication and other control
7913 information to the server. To make this possible, the URL in an LDAP query may
7914 be preceded by any number of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> settings, separated by
7915 spaces. If a value contains spaces it must be enclosed in double quotes, and
7916 when double quotes are used, backslash is interpreted in the usual way inside
7917 them. The following names are recognized:
7918 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
7919 .irow DEREFERENCE "set the dereferencing parameter"
7920 .irow NETTIME "set a timeout for a network operation"
7921 .irow USER "set the DN, for authenticating the LDAP bind"
7922 .irow PASS "set the password, likewise"
7923 .irow REFERRALS "set the referrals parameter"
7924 .irow SERVERS "set alternate server list for this query only"
7925 .irow SIZE "set the limit for the number of entries returned"
7926 .irow TIME "set the maximum waiting time for a query"
7928 The value of the DEREFERENCE parameter must be one of the words &"never"&,
7929 &"searching"&, &"finding"&, or &"always"&. The value of the REFERRALS parameter
7930 must be &"follow"& (the default) or &"nofollow"&. The latter stops the LDAP
7931 library from trying to follow referrals issued by the LDAP server.
7933 .cindex LDAP timeout
7934 .cindex timeout "LDAP lookup"
7935 The name CONNECT is an obsolete name for NETTIME, retained for
7936 backwards compatibility. This timeout (specified as a number of seconds) is
7937 enforced from the client end for operations that can be carried out over a
7938 network. Specifically, it applies to network connections and calls to the
7939 &'ldap_result()'& function. If the value is greater than zero, it is used if
7940 LDAP_OPT_NETWORK_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (OpenLDAP), or
7941 if LDAP_X_OPT_CONNECT_TIMEOUT is defined in the LDAP headers (Netscape
7942 SDK 4.1). A value of zero forces an explicit setting of &"no timeout"& for
7943 Netscape SDK; for OpenLDAP no action is taken.
7945 The TIME parameter (also a number of seconds) is passed to the server to
7946 set a server-side limit on the time taken to complete a search.
7948 The SERVERS parameter allows you to specify an alternate list of ldap servers
7949 to use for an individual lookup. The global &%ldap_default_servers%& option provides a
7950 default list of ldap servers, and a single lookup can specify a single ldap
7951 server to use. But when you need to do a lookup with a list of servers that is
7952 different than the default list (maybe different order, maybe a completely
7953 different set of servers), the SERVERS parameter allows you to specify this
7954 alternate list (colon-separated).
7956 Here is an example of an LDAP query in an Exim lookup that uses some of these
7957 values. This is a single line, folded to fit on the page:
7960 {user="cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK" pass=secret
7961 ldap:///o=University%20of%20Cambridge,c=UK?sn?sub?(cn=foo)}
7964 The encoding of spaces as &`%20`& is a URL thing which should not be done for
7965 any of the auxiliary data. Exim configuration settings that include lookups
7966 which contain password information should be preceded by &"hide"& to prevent
7967 non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& option to see their values.
7969 The auxiliary data items may be given in any order. The default is no
7970 connection timeout (the system timeout is used), no user or password, no limit
7971 on the number of entries returned, and no time limit on queries.
7973 When a DN is quoted in the USER= setting for LDAP authentication, Exim
7974 removes any URL quoting that it may contain before passing it to the LDAP library.
7976 some libraries do this for themselves, but some do not. Removing the URL
7977 quoting has two advantages:
7980 It makes it possible to use the same &%quote_ldap_dn%& expansion for USER=
7981 DNs as with DNs inside actual queries.
7983 It permits spaces inside USER= DNs.
7986 For example, a setting such as
7988 USER=cn=${quote_ldap_dn:$1}
7990 should work even if &$1$& contains spaces.
7992 Expanded data for the PASS= value should be quoted using the &%quote%&
7993 expansion operator, rather than the LDAP quote operators. The only reason this
7994 field needs quoting is to ensure that it conforms to the Exim syntax, which
7995 does not allow unquoted spaces. For example:
7999 The LDAP authentication mechanism can be used to check passwords as part of
8000 SMTP authentication. See the &%ldapauth%& expansion string condition in chapter
8005 .subsection "Format of data returned by LDAP" SECID71
8006 .cindex "LDAP" "returned data formats"
8007 The &(ldapdn)& lookup type returns the Distinguished Name from a single entry
8008 as a sequence of values, for example
8010 cn=manager,o=University of Cambridge,c=UK
8012 The &(ldap)& lookup type generates an error if more than one entry matches the
8013 search filter, whereas &(ldapm)& permits this case, and inserts a newline in
8014 the result between the data from different entries. It is possible for multiple
8015 values to be returned for both &(ldap)& and &(ldapm)&, but in the former case
8016 you know that whatever values are returned all came from a single entry in the
8019 In the common case where you specify a single attribute in your LDAP query, the
8020 result is not quoted, and does not contain the attribute name. If the attribute
8021 has multiple values, they are separated by commas. Any comma that is
8022 part of an attribute's value is doubled.
8024 If you specify multiple attributes, the result contains space-separated, quoted
8025 strings, each preceded by the attribute name and an equals sign. Within the
8026 quotes, the quote character, backslash, and newline are escaped with
8027 backslashes, and commas are used to separate multiple values for the attribute.
8028 Any commas in attribute values are doubled
8029 (permitting treatment of the values as a comma-separated list).
8030 Apart from the escaping, the string within quotes takes the same form as the
8031 output when a single attribute is requested. Specifying no attributes is the
8032 same as specifying all of an entry's attributes.
8034 Here are some examples of the output format. The first line of each pair is an
8035 LDAP query, and the second is the data that is returned. The attribute called
8036 &%attr1%& has two values, one of them with an embedded comma, whereas
8037 &%attr2%& has only one value. Both attributes are derived from &%attr%&
8038 (they have SUP &%attr%& in their schema definitions).
8041 ldap:///o=base?attr1?sub?(uid=fred)
8044 ldap:///o=base?attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
8047 ldap:///o=base?attr?sub?(uid=fred)
8048 value1.1,value1,,2,value two
8050 ldap:///o=base?attr1,attr2?sub?(uid=fred)
8051 attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
8053 ldap:///o=base??sub?(uid=fred)
8054 objectClass="top" attr1="value1.1,value1,,2" attr2="value two"
8057 make use of Exim's &%-be%& option to run expansion tests and thereby check the
8058 results of LDAP lookups.
8059 The &%extract%& operator in string expansions can be used to pick out
8060 individual fields from data that consists of &'key'&=&'value'& pairs.
8061 The &%listextract%& operator should be used to pick out individual values
8062 of attributes, even when only a single value is expected.
8063 The doubling of embedded commas allows you to use the returned data as a
8064 comma separated list (using the "<," syntax for changing the input list separator).
8069 .section "More about NIS+" "SECTnisplus"
8070 .cindex "NIS+ lookup type"
8071 .cindex "lookup" "NIS+"
8072 NIS+ queries consist of a NIS+ &'indexed name'& followed by an optional colon
8073 and field name. If this is given, the result of a successful query is the
8074 contents of the named field; otherwise the result consists of a concatenation
8075 of &'field-name=field-value'& pairs, separated by spaces. Empty values and
8076 values containing spaces are quoted. For example, the query
8078 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir
8080 might return the string
8082 name=mg1456 passwd="" uid=999 gid=999 gcos="Martin Guerre"
8083 home=/home/mg1456 shell=/bin/bash shadow=""
8085 (split over two lines here to fit on the page), whereas
8087 [name=mg1456],passwd.org_dir:gcos
8093 with no quotes. A NIS+ lookup fails if NIS+ returns more than one table entry
8094 for the given indexed key. The effect of the &%quote_nisplus%& expansion
8095 operator is to double any quote characters within the text.
8099 .section "SQL lookups" "SECTsql"
8100 .cindex "SQL lookup types"
8101 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8102 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8103 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8104 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8105 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8106 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8107 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8108 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8109 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8110 .cindex lookup Redis
8111 Exim can support lookups in InterBase, MySQL, Oracle, PostgreSQL, Redis,
8113 databases. Queries for these databases contain SQL statements, so an example
8116 ${lookup mysql{select mailbox from users where id='userx'}\
8119 If the result of the query contains more than one field, the data for each
8120 field in the row is returned, preceded by its name, so the result of
8122 ${lookup pgsql{select home,name from users where id='userx'}\
8127 home=/home/userx name="Mister X"
8129 Empty values and values containing spaces are double quoted, with embedded
8130 quotes escaped by a backslash. If the result of the query contains just one
8131 field, the value is passed back verbatim, without a field name, for example:
8135 If the result of the query yields more than one row, it is all concatenated,
8136 with a newline between the data for each row.
8139 .subsection "More about MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase, and Redis" SECID72
8140 .cindex "MySQL" "lookup type"
8141 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type"
8142 .cindex "lookup" "MySQL"
8143 .cindex "lookup" "PostgreSQL"
8144 .cindex "Oracle" "lookup type"
8145 .cindex "lookup" "Oracle"
8146 .cindex "InterBase lookup type"
8147 .cindex "lookup" "InterBase"
8148 .cindex "Redis lookup type"
8149 .cindex lookup Redis
8150 If any MySQL, PostgreSQL, Oracle, InterBase or Redis lookups are used, the
8151 &%mysql_servers%&, &%pgsql_servers%&, &%oracle_servers%&, &%ibase_servers%&,
8152 or &%redis_servers%&
8153 option (as appropriate) must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8155 .oindex &%mysql_servers%&
8156 .oindex &%pgsql_servers%&
8157 .oindex &%oracle_servers%&
8158 .oindex &%ibase_servers%&
8159 .oindex &%redis_servers%&
8160 (For MySQL and PostgreSQL, the global option need not be set if all
8161 queries contain their own server information &-- see section
8162 &<<SECTspeserque>>&.)
8164 each item in the list is a slash-separated list of four
8165 items: host name, database name, user name, and password. In the case of
8166 Oracle, the host name field is used for the &"service name"&, and the database
8167 name field is not used and should be empty. For example:
8169 hide oracle_servers = oracle.plc.example//userx/abcdwxyz
8171 Because password data is sensitive, you should always precede the setting with
8172 &"hide"&, to prevent non-admin users from obtaining the setting via the &%-bP%&
8173 option. Here is an example where two MySQL servers are listed:
8175 hide mysql_servers = localhost/users/root/secret:\
8176 otherhost/users/root/othersecret
8178 For MySQL and PostgreSQL, a host may be specified as <&'name'&>:<&'port'&> but
8179 because this is a colon-separated list, the colon has to be doubled. For each
8180 query, these parameter groups are tried in order until a connection is made and
8181 a query is successfully processed. The result of a query may be that no data is
8182 found, but that is still a successful query. In other words, the list of
8183 servers provides a backup facility, not a list of different places to look.
8185 For Redis the global option need not be specified if all queries contain their
8186 own server information &-- see section &<<SECTspeserque>>&.
8187 If specified, the option must be set to a colon-separated list of server
8189 Each item in the list is a slash-separated list of three items:
8190 host, database number, and password.
8192 The host is required and may be either an IPv4 address and optional
8193 port number (separated by a colon, which needs doubling due to the
8194 higher-level list), or a Unix socket pathname enclosed in parentheses
8196 The database number is optional; if present that number is selected in the backend
8198 The password is optional; if present it is used to authenticate to the backend
8201 The &%quote_mysql%&, &%quote_pgsql%&, and &%quote_oracle%& expansion operators
8202 convert newline, tab, carriage return, and backspace to \n, \t, \r, and \b
8203 respectively, and the characters single-quote, double-quote, and backslash
8204 itself are escaped with backslashes.
8206 The &%quote_redis%& expansion operator
8207 escapes whitespace and backslash characters with a backslash.
8209 .subsection "Specifying the server in the query" SECTspeserque
8210 For MySQL, PostgreSQL and Redis lookups (but not currently for Oracle and InterBase),
8211 it is possible to specify a list of servers with an individual query. This is
8212 done by appending a comma-separated option to the query type:
8214 &`,servers=`&&'server1:server2:server3:...'&
8216 Each item in the list may take one of two forms:
8218 If it contains no slashes it is assumed to be just a host name. The appropriate
8219 global option (&%mysql_servers%& or &%pgsql_servers%&) is searched for a host
8220 of the same name, and the remaining parameters (database, user, password) are
8223 If it contains any slashes, it is taken as a complete parameter set.
8225 The list of servers is used in exactly the same way as the global list.
8226 Once a connection to a server has happened and a query has been
8227 successfully executed, processing of the lookup ceases.
8229 This feature is intended for use in master/slave situations where updates
8230 are occurring and you want to update the master rather than a slave. If the
8231 master is in the list as a backup for reading, you might have a global setting
8234 mysql_servers = slave1/db/name/pw:\
8238 In an updating lookup, you could then write:
8240 ${lookup mysql,servers=master {UPDATE ...} }
8242 That query would then be sent only to the master server. If, on the other hand,
8243 the master is not to be used for reading, and so is not present in the global
8244 option, you can still update it by a query of this form:
8246 ${lookup pgsql,servers=master/db/name/pw {UPDATE ...} }
8249 A now-deprecated syntax places the servers specification before the query,
8250 semicolon separated:
8252 ${lookup mysql{servers=master; UPDATE ...} }
8254 The new version avoids issues with tainted
8255 arguments explicitly expanded as part of the query.
8256 The entire string within the braces becomes tainted,
8257 including the server specification - which is not permissible.
8258 If the older sytax is used, a warning message will be logged.
8259 This syntax will be removed in a future release.
8261 &*Note*&: server specifications in list-style lookups are still problematic.
8264 .subsection "Special MySQL features" SECID73
8265 For MySQL, an empty host name or the use of &"localhost"& in &%mysql_servers%&
8266 causes a connection to the server on the local host by means of a Unix domain
8267 socket. An alternate socket can be specified in parentheses.
8268 An option group name for MySQL option files can be specified in square brackets;
8269 the default value is &"exim"&.
8270 The full syntax of each item in &%mysql_servers%& is:
8272 <&'hostspec'&><&'portspec'&>(<&'socket name'&>)[<&'option group'&>]/&&&
8273 <&'database'&>/<&'user'&>/<&'password'&>
8275 Any of the four sub-parts of the first field can be omitted. For normal use on
8276 the local host it can be left blank or set to just &"localhost"&.
8279 A &'hostspec'& can be a hostname, an IPv4 address or an IPv6 address.
8280 For the latter, a &'portspec'& is a dot followed by a port number;
8281 for the other two a &'portspec'& is a colon followed by a port number.
8284 Note that the default list-separator for the list of servers is a colon so
8285 (unless that is changed) all colons in list items must be doubled.
8287 No database need be supplied &-- but if it is absent here, it must be given in
8290 If a MySQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert, update,
8291 or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows affected.
8293 &*Warning*&: This can be misleading. If an update does not actually change
8294 anything (for example, setting a field to the value it already has), the result
8295 is zero because no rows are affected.
8297 To get an encryted connection, use a Mysql option file with the required
8298 parameters for the connection.
8301 .subsection "Special PostgreSQL features" SECID74
8303 The &'hostspec'& for PostgreSQL follows the same rules as for MySQL above.
8306 PostgreSQL lookups can also use Unix domain socket connections to the database.
8307 This is usually faster and costs less CPU time than a TCP/IP connection.
8308 However it can be used only if the mail server runs on the same machine as the
8309 database server. A configuration line for PostgreSQL via Unix domain sockets
8312 hide pgsql_servers = (/tmp/.s.PGSQL.5432)/db/user/password : ...
8314 In other words, instead of supplying a host name, a path to the socket is
8315 given. The path name is enclosed in parentheses so that its slashes aren't
8316 visually confused with the delimiters for the other server parameters.
8318 If a PostgreSQL query is issued that does not request any data (an insert,
8319 update, or delete command), the result of the lookup is the number of rows
8322 .subsection "More about SQLite" SECTsqlite
8323 .cindex "lookup" "SQLite"
8324 .cindex "sqlite lookup type"
8325 SQLite is different to the other SQL lookups because a filename is required in
8326 addition to the SQL query. An SQLite database is a single file, and there is no
8327 daemon as in the other SQL databases.
8329 .oindex &%sqlite_dbfile%&
8330 There are two ways of
8331 specifying the file.
8332 The first is by using the &%sqlite_dbfile%& main option.
8333 The second, which allows separate files for each query,
8334 is to use an option appended, comma-separated, to the &"sqlite"&
8335 lookup type word. The option is the word &"file"&, then an equals,
8337 The filename in this case cannot contain whitespace or open-brace charachters.
8339 A deprecated method is available, prefixing the query with the filename
8340 separated by white space.
8342 .cindex "tainted data" "sqlite file"
8343 the query cannot use any tainted values, as that taints
8344 the entire query including the filename - resulting in a refusal to open
8347 In all the above cases the filename must be an absolute path.
8349 Here is a lookup expansion example:
8351 sqlite_dbfile = /some/thing/sqlitedb
8353 ${lookup sqlite {select name from aliases where id='userx';}}
8355 In a list, the syntax is similar. For example:
8357 domainlist relay_to_domains = sqlite;\
8358 select * from relays where ip='$sender_host_address';
8360 The only character affected by the &%quote_sqlite%& operator is a single
8361 quote, which it doubles.
8363 .cindex timeout SQLite
8364 .cindex sqlite "lookup timeout"
8365 The SQLite library handles multiple simultaneous accesses to the database
8366 internally. Multiple readers are permitted, but only one process can
8367 update at once. Attempts to access the database while it is being updated
8368 are rejected after a timeout period, during which the SQLite library
8369 waits for the lock to be released. In Exim, the default timeout is set
8370 to 5 seconds, but it can be changed by means of the &%sqlite_lock_timeout%&
8373 .subsection "More about Redis" SECTredis
8374 .cindex "lookup" "Redis"
8375 .cindex "redis lookup type"
8376 Redis is a non-SQL database. Commands are simple get and set.
8379 ${lookup redis{set keyname ${quote_redis:objvalue plus}}}
8380 ${lookup redis{get keyname}}
8383 As of release 4.91, "lightweight" support for Redis Cluster is available.
8384 Requires &%redis_servers%& list to contain all the servers in the cluster, all
8385 of which must be reachable from the running exim instance. If the cluster has
8386 master/slave replication, the list must contain all the master and slave
8389 When the Redis Cluster returns a "MOVED" response to a query, Exim does not
8390 immediately follow the redirection but treats the response as a DEFER, moving on
8391 to the next server in the &%redis_servers%& list until the correct server is
8398 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8399 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
8401 .chapter "Domain, host, address, and local part lists" &&&
8402 "CHAPdomhosaddlists" &&&
8403 "Domain, host, and address lists"
8404 .scindex IIDdohoadli "lists of domains; hosts; etc."
8405 A number of Exim configuration options contain lists of domains, hosts,
8406 email addresses, or local parts. For example, the &%hold_domains%& option
8407 contains a list of domains whose delivery is currently suspended. These lists
8408 are also used as data in ACL statements (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), and as
8409 arguments to expansion conditions such as &%match_domain%&.
8411 Each item in one of these lists is a pattern to be matched against a domain,
8412 host, email address, or local part, respectively. In the sections below, the
8413 different types of pattern for each case are described, but first we cover some
8414 general facilities that apply to all four kinds of list.
8416 Note that other parts of Exim use a &'string list'& which does not
8417 support all the complexity available in
8418 domain, host, address and local part lists.
8422 .section "Results of list checking" SECTlistresults
8423 The primary result of doing a list check is a truth value.
8424 In some contexts additional information is stored
8425 about the list element that matched:
8428 A &%hosts%& ACL condition
8429 will store a result in the &$host_data$& variable.
8431 A &%local_parts%& router option or &%local_parts%& ACL condition
8432 will store a result in the &$local_part_data$& variable.
8434 A &%domains%& router option or &%domains%& ACL condition
8435 will store a result in the &$domain_data$& variable.
8437 A &%senders%& router option or &%senders%& ACL condition
8438 will store a result in the &$sender_data$& variable.
8440 A &%recipients%& ACL condition
8441 will store a result in the &$recipient_data$& variable.
8444 The detail of the additional information depends on the
8445 type of match and is given below as the &*value*& information.
8450 .section "Expansion of lists" "SECTlistexpand"
8451 .cindex "expansion" "of lists"
8453 Each list, after any leading change-of-separator specification
8454 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) is expanded as a single string,
8455 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
8456 &*Note*&: As a result, if any component was tainted then the
8457 entire expansion result string becomes tainted.
8459 Splitting out a leading explicit change-of-separator permits
8460 one being safely used on a list that has tainted components
8461 while still detecting the use of a tainted setting.
8462 The latter is not permitted.
8465 &'Exception: the router headers_remove option, where list-item
8466 splitting is done before string-expansion.'&
8469 expansion must be a list, possibly containing empty items, which is split up
8470 into separate items for matching. By default, colon is the separator character,
8471 but this can be varied if necessary. See sections &<<SECTlistconstruct>>& and
8472 &<<SECTempitelis>>& for details of the list syntax; the second of these
8473 discusses the way to specify empty list items.
8476 If the string expansion is forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the item it is
8477 testing (domain, host, address, or local part) is not in the list. Other
8478 expansion failures cause temporary errors.
8480 If an item in a list is a regular expression, backslashes, dollars and possibly
8481 other special characters in the expression must be protected against
8482 misinterpretation by the string expander. The easiest way to do this is to use
8483 the &`\N`& expansion feature to indicate that the contents of the regular
8484 expression should not be expanded. For example, in an ACL you might have:
8486 deny senders = \N^\d{8}\w@.*\.baddomain\.example$\N : \
8487 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/badsenders/bydomain}}
8489 The first item is a regular expression that is protected from expansion by
8490 &`\N`&, whereas the second uses the expansion to obtain a list of unwanted
8491 senders based on the receiving domain.
8496 .subsection "Negated items in lists" SECID76
8497 .cindex "list" "negation"
8498 .cindex "negation" "in lists"
8499 Items in a list may be positive or negative. Negative items are indicated by a
8500 leading exclamation mark, which may be followed by optional white space. A list
8501 defines a set of items (domains, etc). When Exim processes one of these lists,
8502 it is trying to find out whether a domain, host, address, or local part
8503 (respectively) is in the set that is defined by the list. It works like this:
8505 The list is scanned from left to right. If a positive item is matched, the
8506 subject that is being checked is in the set; if a negative item is matched, the
8507 subject is not in the set. If the end of the list is reached without the
8508 subject having matched any of the patterns, it is in the set if the last item
8509 was a negative one, but not if it was a positive one. For example, the list in
8511 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c : *.b.c
8513 matches any domain ending in &'.b.c'& except for &'a.b.c'&. Domains that match
8514 neither &'a.b.c'& nor &'*.b.c'& do not match, because the last item in the
8515 list is positive. However, if the setting were
8517 domainlist relay_to_domains = !a.b.c
8519 then all domains other than &'a.b.c'& would match because the last item in the
8520 list is negative. In other words, a list that ends with a negative item behaves
8521 as if it had an extra item &`:*`& on the end.
8523 Another way of thinking about positive and negative items in lists is to read
8524 the connector as &"or"& after a positive item and as &"and"& after a negative
8529 .subsection "File names in lists" SECTfilnamlis
8530 .cindex "list" "filename in"
8531 If an item in a domain, host, address, or local part list is an absolute
8532 filename (beginning with a slash character), each line of the file is read and
8533 processed as if it were an independent item in the list, except that further
8534 filenames are not allowed,
8535 and no expansion of the data from the file takes place.
8536 Empty lines in the file are ignored, and the file may also contain comment
8540 For domain and host lists, if a # character appears anywhere in a line of the
8541 file, it and all following characters are ignored.
8543 Because local parts may legitimately contain # characters, a comment in an
8544 address list or local part list file is recognized only if # is preceded by
8545 white space or the start of the line. For example:
8547 not#comment@x.y.z # but this is a comment
8551 Putting a filename in a list has the same effect as inserting each line of the
8552 file as an item in the list (blank lines and comments excepted). However, there
8553 is one important difference: the file is read each time the list is processed,
8554 so if its contents vary over time, Exim's behaviour changes.
8556 If a filename is preceded by an exclamation mark, the sense of any match
8557 within the file is inverted. For example, if
8559 hold_domains = !/etc/nohold-domains
8561 and the file contains the lines
8566 then &'a.b.c'& is in the set of domains defined by &%hold_domains%&, whereas
8567 any domain matching &`*.b.c`& is not.
8571 .subsection "An lsearch file is not an out-of-line list" SECID77
8572 As will be described in the sections that follow, lookups can be used in lists
8573 to provide indexed methods of checking list membership. There has been some
8574 confusion about the way &(lsearch)& lookups work in lists. Because
8575 an &(lsearch)& file contains plain text and is scanned sequentially, it is
8576 sometimes thought that it is allowed to contain wild cards and other kinds of
8577 non-constant pattern. This is not the case. The keys in an &(lsearch)& file are
8578 always fixed strings, just as for any other single-key lookup type.
8580 If you want to use a file to contain wild-card patterns that form part of a
8581 list, just give the filename on its own, without a search type, as described
8582 in the previous section. You could also use the &(wildlsearch)& or
8583 &(nwildlsearch)&, but there is no advantage in doing this.
8588 .subsection "Named lists" SECTnamedlists
8589 .cindex "named lists"
8590 .cindex "list" "named"
8591 A list of domains, hosts, email addresses, or local parts can be given a name
8592 which is then used to refer to the list elsewhere in the configuration. This is
8593 particularly convenient if the same list is required in several different
8594 places. It also allows lists to be given meaningful names, which can improve
8595 the readability of the configuration. For example, it is conventional to define
8596 a domain list called &'local_domains'& for all the domains that are handled
8597 locally on a host, using a configuration line such as
8599 domainlist local_domains = localhost:my.dom.example
8601 Named lists are referenced by giving their name preceded by a plus sign, so,
8602 for example, a router that is intended to handle local domains would be
8603 configured with the line
8605 domains = +local_domains
8607 The first router in a configuration is often one that handles all domains
8608 except the local ones, using a configuration with a negated item like this:
8612 domains = ! +local_domains
8613 transport = remote_smtp
8616 The four kinds of named list are created by configuration lines starting with
8617 the words &%domainlist%&, &%hostlist%&, &%addresslist%&, or &%localpartlist%&,
8618 respectively. Then there follows the name that you are defining, followed by an
8619 equals sign and the list itself. For example:
8621 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.23.0/24 : my.friend.example
8622 addresslist bad_senders = cdb;/etc/badsenders
8624 A named list may refer to other named lists:
8626 domainlist dom1 = first.example : second.example
8627 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : third.example
8628 domainlist dom3 = fourth.example : +dom2 : fifth.example
8630 &*Warning*&: If the last item in a referenced list is a negative one, the
8631 effect may not be what you intended, because the negation does not propagate
8632 out to the higher level. For example, consider:
8634 domainlist dom1 = !a.b
8635 domainlist dom2 = +dom1 : *.b
8637 The second list specifies &"either in the &%dom1%& list or &'*.b'&"&. The first
8638 list specifies just &"not &'a.b'&"&, so the domain &'x.y'& matches it. That
8639 means it matches the second list as well. The effect is not the same as
8641 domainlist dom2 = !a.b : *.b
8643 where &'x.y'& does not match. It's best to avoid negation altogether in
8644 referenced lists if you can.
8647 The list item which references a named list (&"+<listname>"&)
8651 .cindex "hiding named list values"
8652 .cindex "named lists" "hiding value of"
8653 Some named list definitions may contain sensitive data, for example, passwords for
8654 accessing databases. To stop non-admin users from using the &%-bP%& command
8655 line option to read these values, you can precede the definition with the
8656 word &"hide"&. For example:
8658 hide domainlist filter_for_domains = ldap;PASS=secret ldap::/// ...
8662 Named lists may have a performance advantage. When Exim is routing an
8663 address or checking an incoming message, it caches the result of tests on named
8664 lists. So, if you have a setting such as
8666 domains = +local_domains
8668 on several of your routers
8669 or in several ACL statements,
8670 the actual test is done only for the first one. However, the caching works only
8671 if there are no expansions within the list itself or any sublists that it
8672 references. In other words, caching happens only for lists that are known to be
8673 the same each time they are referenced.
8675 By default, there may be up to 16 named lists of each type. This limit can be
8676 extended by changing a compile-time variable. The use of domain and host lists
8677 is recommended for concepts such as local domains, relay domains, and relay
8678 hosts. The default configuration is set up like this.
8682 .subsection "Named lists compared with macros" SECID78
8683 .cindex "list" "named compared with macro"
8684 .cindex "macro" "compared with named list"
8685 At first sight, named lists might seem to be no different from macros in the
8686 configuration file. However, macros are just textual substitutions. If you
8689 ALIST = host1 : host2
8690 auth_advertise_hosts = !ALIST
8692 it probably won't do what you want, because that is exactly the same as
8694 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : host2
8696 Notice that the second host name is not negated. However, if you use a host
8699 hostlist alist = host1 : host2
8700 auth_advertise_hosts = ! +alist
8702 the negation applies to the whole list, and so that is equivalent to
8704 auth_advertise_hosts = !host1 : !host2
8708 .subsection "Named list caching" SECID79
8709 .cindex "list" "caching of named"
8710 .cindex "caching" "named lists"
8711 While processing a message, Exim caches the result of checking a named list if
8712 it is sure that the list is the same each time. In practice, this means that
8713 the cache operates only if the list contains no $ characters, which guarantees
8714 that it will not change when it is expanded. Sometimes, however, you may have
8715 an expanded list that you know will be the same each time within a given
8716 message. For example:
8718 domainlist special_domains = \
8719 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}cdb{/some/file}}
8721 This provides a list of domains that depends only on the sending host's IP
8722 address. If this domain list is referenced a number of times (for example,
8723 in several ACL lines, or in several routers) the result of the check is not
8724 cached by default, because Exim does not know that it is going to be the
8725 same list each time.
8727 By appending &`_cache`& to &`domainlist`& you can tell Exim to go ahead and
8728 cache the result anyway. For example:
8730 domainlist_cache special_domains = ${lookup{...
8732 If you do this, you should be absolutely sure that caching is going to do
8733 the right thing in all cases. When in doubt, leave it out.
8737 .section "Domain lists" "SECTdomainlist"
8738 .cindex "domain list" "patterns for"
8739 .cindex "list" "domain list"
8740 Domain lists contain patterns that are to be matched against a mail domain.
8741 The following types of item may appear in domain lists:
8744 .cindex "primary host name"
8745 .cindex "host name" "matched in domain list"
8746 .oindex "&%primary_hostname%&"
8747 .cindex "domain list" "matching primary host name"
8748 .cindex "@ in a domain list"
8749 If a pattern consists of a single @ character, it matches the local host name,
8750 as set by the &%primary_hostname%& option (or defaulted). This makes it
8751 possible to use the same configuration file on several different hosts that
8752 differ only in their names.
8754 The value for a match will be the primary host name.
8756 The pattern may not be tainted.
8761 .cindex "@[] in a domain list"
8762 .cindex "domain list" "matching local IP interfaces"
8763 .cindex "domain literal"
8764 If a pattern consists of the string &`@[]`& it matches an IP address enclosed
8765 in square brackets (as in an email address that contains a domain literal), but
8766 only if that IP address is recognized as local for email routing purposes. The
8767 &%local_interfaces%& and &%extra_local_interfaces%& options can be used to
8768 control which of a host's several IP addresses are treated as local.
8769 In today's Internet, the use of domain literals is controversial;
8770 see the &%allow_domain_literals%& main option.
8772 The value for a match will be the string &`@[]`&.
8774 The pattern may not be tainted.
8780 .cindex "@mx_primary"
8781 .cindex "@mx_secondary"
8782 .cindex "domain list" "matching MX pointers to local host"
8783 If a pattern consists of the string &`@mx_any`& it matches any domain that
8784 has an MX record pointing to the local host or to any host that is listed in
8785 .oindex "&%hosts_treat_as_local%&"
8786 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&. The items &`@mx_primary`& and &`@mx_secondary`&
8787 are similar, except that the first matches only when a primary MX target is the
8788 local host, and the second only when no primary MX target is the local host,
8789 but a secondary MX target is. &"Primary"& means an MX record with the lowest
8790 preference value &-- there may of course be more than one of them.
8793 The pattern may not be tainted.
8796 The MX lookup that takes place when matching a pattern of this type is
8797 performed with the resolver options for widening names turned off. Thus, for
8798 example, a single-component domain will &'not'& be expanded by adding the
8799 resolver's default domain. See the &%qualify_single%& and &%search_parents%&
8800 options of the &(dnslookup)& router for a discussion of domain widening.
8802 Sometimes you may want to ignore certain IP addresses when using one of these
8803 patterns. You can specify this by following the pattern with &`/ignore=`&<&'ip
8804 list'&>, where <&'ip list'&> is a list of IP addresses. These addresses are
8805 ignored when processing the pattern (compare the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option
8806 on a router). For example:
8808 domains = @mx_any/ignore=127.0.0.1
8810 This example matches any domain that has an MX record pointing to one of
8811 the local host's IP addresses other than 127.0.0.1.
8813 The list of IP addresses is in fact processed by the same code that processes
8814 host lists, so it may contain CIDR-coded network specifications and it may also
8815 contain negative items.
8817 Because the list of IP addresses is a sublist within a domain list, you have to
8818 be careful about delimiters if there is more than one address. Like any other
8819 list, the default delimiter can be changed. Thus, you might have:
8821 domains = @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;0.0.0.0 : \
8822 an.other.domain : ...
8824 so that the sublist uses semicolons for delimiters. When IPv6 addresses are
8825 involved, it is easiest to change the delimiter for the main list as well:
8827 domains = <? @mx_any/ignore=<;127.0.0.1;::1 ? \
8828 an.other.domain ? ...
8830 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting &`@mx_`&).
8834 .cindex "asterisk" "in domain list"
8835 .cindex "domain list" "asterisk in"
8836 .cindex "domain list" "matching &""ends with""&"
8837 If a pattern starts with an asterisk, the remaining characters of the pattern
8838 are compared with the terminating characters of the domain. The use of &"*"& in
8839 domain lists differs from its use in partial matching lookups. In a domain
8840 list, the character following the asterisk need not be a dot, whereas partial
8841 matching works only in terms of dot-separated components. For example, a domain
8842 list item such as &`*key.ex`& matches &'donkey.ex'& as well as
8845 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the asterisk).
8846 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the matched string
8847 and &$1$& to the variable portion which the asterisk matched.
8850 .cindex "regular expressions" "in domain list"
8851 .cindex "domain list" "matching regular expression"
8852 If a pattern starts with a circumflex character, it is treated as a regular
8853 expression, and matched against the domain using a regular expression matching
8854 function. The circumflex is treated as part of the regular expression.
8855 Email domains are case-independent, so this regular expression match is by
8856 default case-independent, but you can make it case-dependent by starting it
8857 with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the syntax of regular expressions
8858 are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&.
8860 &*Warning*&: Because domain lists are expanded before being processed, you
8861 must escape any backslash and dollar characters in the regular expression, or
8862 use the special &`\N`& sequence (see chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&) to specify that
8863 it is not to be expanded (unless you really do want to build a regular
8864 expression by expansion, of course).
8866 The value for a match will be the list element string (starting with the circumflex).
8867 Additionally, &$0$& will be set to the string matching the regular expression,
8868 and &$1$& (onwards) to any submatches identified by parentheses.
8873 .cindex "lookup" "in domain list"
8874 .cindex "domain list" "matching by lookup"
8875 If a pattern starts with the name of a single-key lookup type followed by a
8876 semicolon (for example, &"dbm;"& or &"lsearch;"&), the remainder of the pattern
8877 must be a filename in a suitable format for the lookup type. For example, for
8878 &"cdb;"& it must be an absolute path:
8880 domains = cdb;/etc/mail/local_domains.cdb
8882 The appropriate type of lookup is done on the file using the domain name as the
8883 key. In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used; Exim is interested
8884 only in whether or not the key is present in the file. However, when a lookup
8885 is used for the &%domains%& option on a router
8886 or a &%domains%& condition in an ACL statement, the value is preserved in the
8887 &$domain_data$& variable and can be referred to in other router options or
8888 other statements in the same ACL.
8889 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8890 .cindex "de-tainting" "using ACL domains condition"
8891 The value will be untainted.
8893 &*Note*&: If the data result of the lookup (as opposed to the key)
8894 is empty, then this empty value is stored in &$domain_data$&.
8895 The option to return the key for the lookup, as the value,
8896 may be what is wanted.
8900 Any of the single-key lookup type names may be preceded by
8901 &`partial`&<&'n'&>&`-`&, where the <&'n'&> is optional, for example,
8903 domains = partial-dbm;/partial/domains
8905 This causes partial matching logic to be invoked; a description of how this
8906 works is given in section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&.
8909 .cindex "asterisk" "in lookup type"
8910 Any of the single-key lookup types may be followed by an asterisk. This causes
8911 a default lookup for a key consisting of a single asterisk to be done if the
8912 original lookup fails. This is not a useful feature when using a domain list to
8913 select particular domains (because any domain would match), but it might have
8914 value if the result of the lookup is being used via the &$domain_data$&
8918 If the pattern starts with the name of a query-style lookup type followed by a
8919 semicolon (for example, &"nisplus;"& or &"ldap;"&), the remainder of the
8920 pattern must be an appropriate query for the lookup type, as described in
8921 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example:
8923 hold_domains = mysql;select domain from holdlist \
8924 where domain = '${quote_mysql:$domain}';
8926 In most cases, the value resulting from the lookup is not used (so for an SQL query, for
8927 example, it doesn't matter what field you select). Exim is interested only in
8928 whether or not the query succeeds. However, when a lookup is used for the
8929 &%domains%& option on a router, the value is preserved in the &$domain_data$&
8930 variable and can be referred to in other options.
8931 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8932 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router domains option"
8933 The value will be untainted.
8936 If the pattern starts with the name of a lookup type
8937 of either kind (single-key or query-style) it may be
8938 followed by a comma and options,
8939 The options are lookup-type specific and consist of a comma-separated list.
8940 Each item starts with a tag and and equals "=" sign.
8943 .cindex "domain list" "matching literal domain name"
8944 If none of the above cases apply, a caseless textual comparison is made
8945 between the pattern and the domain.
8947 The value for a match will be the list element string.
8948 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
8949 Note that this is commonly untainted
8950 (depending on the way the list was created).
8951 Specifically, explicit text in the configuration file in not tainted.
8952 This is a useful way of obtaining an untainted equivalent to
8953 the domain, for later operations.
8955 However if the list (including one-element lists)
8956 is created by expanding a variable containing tainted data,
8957 it is tainted and so will the match value be.
8961 Here is an example that uses several different kinds of pattern:
8963 domainlist funny_domains = \
8966 *.foundation.fict.example : \
8967 \N^[1-2]\d{3}\.fict\.example$\N : \
8968 partial-dbm;/opt/data/penguin/book : \
8969 nis;domains.byname : \
8970 nisplus;[name=$domain,status=local],domains.org_dir
8972 There are obvious processing trade-offs among the various matching modes. Using
8973 an asterisk is faster than a regular expression, and listing a few names
8974 explicitly probably is too. The use of a file or database lookup is expensive,
8975 but may be the only option if hundreds of names are required. Because the
8976 patterns are tested in order, it makes sense to put the most commonly matched
8981 .section "Host lists" "SECThostlist"
8982 .cindex "host list" "patterns in"
8983 .cindex "list" "host list"
8984 Host lists are used to control what remote hosts are allowed to do. For
8985 example, some hosts may be allowed to use the local host as a relay, and some
8986 may be permitted to use the SMTP ETRN command. Hosts can be identified in
8987 two different ways, by name or by IP address. In a host list, some types of
8988 pattern are matched to a host name, and some are matched to an IP address.
8989 You need to be particularly careful with this when single-key lookups are
8990 involved, to ensure that the right value is being used as the key.
8993 .subsection "Special host list patterns" SECID80
8994 .cindex "empty item in hosts list"
8995 .cindex "host list" "empty string in"
8996 If a host list item is the empty string, it matches only when no remote host is
8997 involved. This is the case when a message is being received from a local
8998 process using SMTP on the standard input, that is, when a TCP/IP connection is
9001 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
9002 The special pattern &"*"& in a host list matches any host or no host. Neither
9003 the IP address nor the name is actually inspected.
9007 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by IP address" SECThoslispatip
9008 .cindex "host list" "matching IP addresses"
9009 If an IPv4 host calls an IPv6 host and the call is accepted on an IPv6 socket,
9010 the incoming address actually appears in the IPv6 host as
9011 &`::ffff:`&<&'v4address'&>. When such an address is tested against a host
9012 list, it is converted into a traditional IPv4 address first. (Not all operating
9013 systems accept IPv4 calls on IPv6 sockets, as there have been some security
9016 The following types of pattern in a host list check the remote host by
9017 inspecting its IP address:
9020 If the pattern is a plain domain name (not a regular expression, not starting
9021 with *, not a lookup of any kind), Exim calls the operating system function
9022 to find the associated IP address(es). Exim uses the newer
9023 &[getipnodebyname()]& function when available, otherwise &[gethostbyname()]&.
9024 This typically causes a forward DNS lookup of the name. The result is compared
9025 with the IP address of the subject host.
9027 If there is a temporary problem (such as a DNS timeout) with the host name
9028 lookup, a temporary error occurs. For example, if the list is being used in an
9029 ACL condition, the ACL gives a &"defer"& response, usually leading to a
9030 temporary SMTP error code. If no IP address can be found for the host name,
9031 what happens is described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
9034 .cindex "@ in a host list"
9035 If the pattern is &"@"&, the primary host name is substituted and used as a
9036 domain name, as just described.
9039 If the pattern is an IP address, it is matched against the IP address of the
9040 subject host. IPv4 addresses are given in the normal &"dotted-quad"& notation.
9041 IPv6 addresses can be given in colon-separated format, but the colons have to
9042 be doubled so as not to be taken as item separators when the default list
9043 separator is used. IPv6 addresses are recognized even when Exim is compiled
9044 without IPv6 support. This means that if they appear in a host list on an
9045 IPv4-only host, Exim will not treat them as host names. They are just addresses
9046 that can never match a client host.
9049 .cindex "@[] in a host list"
9050 If the pattern is &"@[]"&, it matches the IP address of any IP interface on
9051 the local host. For example, if the local host is an IPv4 host with one
9052 interface address 10.45.23.56, these two ACL statements have the same effect:
9054 accept hosts = 127.0.0.1 : 10.45.23.56
9058 .cindex "CIDR notation"
9059 If the pattern is an IP address followed by a slash and a mask length, for
9064 , it is matched against the IP address of the subject
9065 host under the given mask. This allows an entire network of hosts to be
9066 included (or excluded) by a single item. The mask uses CIDR notation; it
9067 specifies the number of address bits that must match, starting from the most
9068 significant end of the address.
9070 &*Note*&: The mask is &'not'& a count of addresses, nor is it the high number
9071 of a range of addresses. It is the number of bits in the network portion of the
9072 address. The above example specifies a 24-bit netmask, so it matches all 256
9073 addresses in the 10.11.42.0 network. An item such as
9077 matches just two addresses, 192.168.23.236 and 192.168.23.237. A mask value of
9078 32 for an IPv4 address is the same as no mask at all; just a single address
9081 Here is another example which shows an IPv4 and an IPv6 network:
9083 recipient_unqualified_hosts = 192.168.0.0/16: \
9084 3ffe::ffff::836f::::/48
9086 The doubling of list separator characters applies only when these items
9087 appear inline in a host list. It is not required when indirecting via a file.
9090 recipient_unqualified_hosts = /opt/exim/unqualnets
9092 could make use of a file containing
9097 to have exactly the same effect as the previous example. When listing IPv6
9098 addresses inline, it is usually more convenient to use the facility for
9099 changing separator characters. This list contains the same two networks:
9101 recipient_unqualified_hosts = <; 172.16.0.0/12; \
9104 The separator is changed to semicolon by the leading &"<;"& at the start of the
9110 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host address" &&&
9112 .cindex "host list" "lookup of IP address"
9113 When a host is to be identified by a single-key lookup of its complete IP
9114 address, the pattern takes this form:
9116 &`net-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9120 hosts_lookup = net-cdb;/hosts-by-ip.db
9122 The text form of the IP address of the subject host is used as the lookup key.
9123 IPv6 addresses are converted to an unabbreviated form, using lower case
9124 letters, with dots as separators because colon is the key terminator in
9125 &(lsearch)& files. [Colons can in fact be used in keys in &(lsearch)& files by
9126 quoting the keys, but this is a facility that was added later.] The data
9127 returned by the lookup is not used.
9129 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
9130 .cindex "host list" "masked IP address"
9131 Single-key lookups can also be performed using masked IP addresses, using
9132 patterns of this form:
9134 &`net<`&&'number'&&`>-<`&&'single-key-search-type'&&`>;<`&&'search-data'&&`>`&
9138 net24-dbm;/networks.db
9140 The IP address of the subject host is masked using <&'number'&> as the mask
9141 length. A textual string is constructed from the masked value, followed by the
9142 mask, and this is used as the lookup key. For example, if the host's IP address
9143 is 192.168.34.6, the key that is looked up for the above example is
9144 &"192.168.34.0/24"&.
9146 When an IPv6 address is converted to a string, dots are normally used instead
9147 of colons, so that keys in &(lsearch)& files need not contain colons (which
9148 terminate &(lsearch)& keys). This was implemented some time before the ability
9149 to quote keys was made available in &(lsearch)& files. However, the more
9150 recently implemented &(iplsearch)& files do require colons in IPv6 keys
9151 (notated using the quoting facility) so as to distinguish them from IPv4 keys.
9152 For this reason, when the lookup type is &(iplsearch)&, IPv6 addresses are
9153 converted using colons and not dots.
9154 In all cases except IPv4-mapped IPv6, full, unabbreviated IPv6
9155 addresses are always used.
9156 The latter are converted to IPv4 addresses, in dotted-quad form.
9158 Ideally, it would be nice to tidy up this anomalous situation by changing to
9159 colons in all cases, given that quoting is now available for &(lsearch)&.
9160 However, this would be an incompatible change that might break some existing
9163 &*Warning*&: Specifying &%net32-%& (for an IPv4 address) or &%net128-%& (for an
9164 IPv6 address) is not the same as specifying just &%net-%& without a number. In
9165 the former case the key strings include the mask value, whereas in the latter
9166 case the IP address is used on its own.
9170 .subsection "Host list patterns that match by host name" SECThoslispatnam
9171 .cindex "host" "lookup failures"
9172 .cindex "unknown host name"
9173 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9174 There are several types of pattern that require Exim to know the name of the
9175 remote host. These are either wildcard patterns or lookups by name. (If a
9176 complete hostname is given without any wildcarding, it is used to find an IP
9177 address to match against, as described in section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&
9180 If the remote host name is not already known when Exim encounters one of these
9181 patterns, it has to be found from the IP address.
9182 Although many sites on the Internet are conscientious about maintaining reverse
9183 DNS data for their hosts, there are also many that do not do this.
9184 Consequently, a name cannot always be found, and this may lead to unwanted
9185 effects. Take care when configuring host lists with wildcarded name patterns.
9186 Consider what will happen if a name cannot be found.
9188 Because of the problems of determining host names from IP addresses, matching
9189 against host names is not as common as matching against IP addresses.
9191 By default, in order to find a host name, Exim first does a reverse DNS lookup;
9192 if no name is found in the DNS, the system function (&[gethostbyaddr()]& or
9193 &[getipnodebyaddr()]& if available) is tried. The order in which these lookups
9194 are done can be changed by setting the &%host_lookup_order%& option. For
9195 security, once Exim has found one or more names, it looks up the IP addresses
9196 for these names and compares them with the IP address that it started with.
9197 Only those names whose IP addresses match are accepted. Any other names are
9198 discarded. If no names are left, Exim behaves as if the host name cannot be
9199 found. In the most common case there is only one name and one IP address.
9201 There are some options that control what happens if a host name cannot be
9202 found. These are described in section &<<SECTbehipnot>>& below.
9204 .cindex "host" "alias for"
9205 .cindex "alias for host"
9206 As a result of aliasing, hosts may have more than one name. When processing any
9207 of the following types of pattern, all the host's names are checked:
9210 .cindex "asterisk" "in host list"
9211 If a pattern starts with &"*"& the remainder of the item must match the end of
9212 the host name. For example, &`*.b.c`& matches all hosts whose names end in
9213 &'.b.c'&. This special simple form is provided because this is a very common
9214 requirement. Other kinds of wildcarding require the use of a regular
9217 .cindex "regular expressions" "in host list"
9218 .cindex "host list" "regular expression in"
9219 If the item starts with &"^"& it is taken to be a regular expression which is
9220 matched against the host name. Host names are case-independent, so this regular
9221 expression match is by default case-independent, but you can make it
9222 case-dependent by starting it with &`(?-i)`&. References to descriptions of the
9223 syntax of regular expressions are given in chapter &<<CHAPregexp>>&. For
9228 is a regular expression that matches either of the two hosts &'a.c.d'& or
9229 &'b.c.d'&. When a regular expression is used in a host list, you must take care
9230 that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted as part of the
9231 string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`& to mark that
9232 part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9234 sender_unqualified_hosts = \N^(a|b)\.c\.d$\N : ....
9236 &*Warning*&: If you want to match a complete host name, you must include the
9237 &`$`& terminating metacharacter in the regular expression, as in the above
9238 example. Without it, a match at the start of the host name is all that is
9245 .subsection "Behaviour when an IP address or name cannot be found" SECTbehipnot
9246 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, permanent"
9247 While processing a host list, Exim may need to look up an IP address from a
9248 name (see section &<<SECThoslispatip>>&), or it may need to look up a host name
9249 from an IP address (see section &<<SECThoslispatnam>>&). In either case, the
9250 behaviour when it fails to find the information it is seeking is the same.
9252 &*Note*&: This section applies to permanent lookup failures. It does &'not'&
9253 apply to temporary DNS errors, whose handling is described in the next section.
9255 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
9256 .cindex "&`+ignore_unknown`&"
9257 Exim parses a host list from left to right. If it encounters a permanent
9258 lookup failure in any item in the host list before it has found a match,
9259 Exim treats it as a failure and the default behavior is as if the host
9260 does not match the list. This may not always be what you want to happen.
9261 To change Exim's behaviour, the special items &`+include_unknown`& or
9262 &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the list (at top level &-- they are
9263 not recognized in an indirected file).
9264 The effects of these special items do not propagate into referenced
9268 If any item that follows &`+include_unknown`& requires information that
9269 cannot found, Exim behaves as if the host does match the list. For example,
9271 host_reject_connection = +include_unknown:*.enemy.ex
9273 rejects connections from any host whose name matches &`*.enemy.ex`&, and also
9274 any hosts whose name it cannot find.
9277 If any item that follows &`+ignore_unknown`& requires information that cannot
9278 be found, Exim ignores that item and proceeds to the rest of the list. For
9281 accept hosts = +ignore_unknown : friend.example : \
9284 accepts from any host whose name is &'friend.example'& and from 192.168.4.5,
9285 whether or not its host name can be found. Without &`+ignore_unknown`&, if no
9286 name can be found for 192.168.4.5, it is rejected.
9289 Both &`+include_unknown`& and &`+ignore_unknown`& may appear in the same
9290 list. The effect of each one lasts until the next, or until the end of the
9293 .subsection "Mixing wildcarded host names and addresses in host lists" &&&
9295 .cindex "host list" "mixing names and addresses in"
9297 This section explains the host/ip processing logic with the same concepts
9298 as the previous section, but specifically addresses what happens when a
9299 wildcarded hostname is one of the items in the hostlist.
9302 If you have name lookups or wildcarded host names and
9303 IP addresses in the same host list, you should normally put the IP
9304 addresses first. For example, in an ACL you could have:
9306 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : *.friend.example
9308 The reason you normally would order it this way lies in the
9309 left-to-right way that Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses
9310 without doing any DNS lookups, but when it reaches an item that requires
9311 a host name, it fails if it cannot find a host name to compare with the
9312 pattern. If the above list is given in the opposite order, the
9313 &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be found, even
9314 if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
9317 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
9318 address, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
9320 accept hosts = *.friend.example
9321 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
9323 If the first &%accept%& fails, Exim goes on to try the second one. See chapter
9324 &<<CHAPACL>>& for details of ACLs. Alternatively, you can use
9325 &`+ignore_unknown`&, which was discussed in depth in the first example in
9330 .subsection "Temporary DNS errors when looking up host information" &&&
9332 .cindex "host" "lookup failures, temporary"
9333 .cindex "&`+include_defer`&"
9334 .cindex "&`+ignore_defer`&"
9335 A temporary DNS lookup failure normally causes a defer action (except when
9336 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& converts it into a permanent error). However,
9337 host lists can include &`+ignore_defer`& and &`+include_defer`&, analogous to
9338 &`+ignore_unknown`& and &`+include_unknown`&, as described in the previous
9339 section. These options should be used with care, probably only in non-critical
9340 host lists such as whitelists.
9344 .subsection "Host list patterns for single-key lookups by host name" &&&
9346 .cindex "unknown host name"
9347 .cindex "host list" "matching host name"
9348 If a pattern is of the form
9350 <&'single-key-search-type'&>;<&'search-data'&>
9354 dbm;/host/accept/list
9356 a single-key lookup is performed, using the host name as its key. If the
9357 lookup succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual data that is looked up
9360 &*Reminder*&: With this kind of pattern, you must have host &'names'& as
9361 keys in the file, not IP addresses. If you want to do lookups based on IP
9362 addresses, you must precede the search type with &"net-"&
9363 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&).
9364 There is, however, no reason why you could not use
9365 two items in the same list, one doing an address lookup and one doing a name
9366 lookup, both using the same file.
9370 .subsection "Host list patterns for query-style lookups" SECID81
9371 If a pattern is of the form
9373 <&'query-style-search-type'&>;<&'query'&>
9375 the query is obeyed, and if it succeeds, the host matches the item. The actual
9376 data that is looked up is not used. The variables &$sender_host_address$& and
9377 &$sender_host_name$& can be used in the query. For example:
9379 hosts_lookup = pgsql;\
9380 select ip from hostlist where ip='$sender_host_address'
9382 The value of &$sender_host_address$& for an IPv6 address contains colons. You
9383 can use the &%sg%& expansion item to change this if you need to. If you want to
9384 use masked IP addresses in database queries, you can use the &%mask%& expansion
9387 If the query contains a reference to &$sender_host_name$&, Exim automatically
9388 looks up the host name if it has not already done so. (See section
9389 &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& for comments on finding host names.)
9391 Historical note: prior to release 4.30, Exim would always attempt to find a
9392 host name before running the query, unless the search type was preceded by
9393 &`net-`&. This is no longer the case. For backwards compatibility, &`net-`& is
9394 still recognized for query-style lookups, but its presence or absence has no
9395 effect. (Of course, for single-key lookups, &`net-`& &'is'& important.
9396 See section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&.)
9402 .section "Address lists" "SECTaddresslist"
9403 .cindex "list" "address list"
9404 .cindex "address list" "empty item"
9405 .cindex "address list" "patterns"
9406 Address lists contain patterns that are matched against mail addresses. There
9407 is one special case to be considered: the sender address of a bounce message is
9408 always empty. You can test for this by providing an empty item in an address
9409 list. For example, you can set up a router to process bounce messages by
9410 using this option setting:
9414 The presence of the colon creates an empty item. If you do not provide any
9415 data, the list is empty and matches nothing. The empty sender can also be
9416 detected by a regular expression that matches an empty string,
9417 and by a query-style lookup that succeeds when &$sender_address$& is empty.
9419 Non-empty items in an address list can be straightforward email addresses. For
9422 senders = jbc@askone.example : hs@anacreon.example
9424 A certain amount of wildcarding is permitted. If a pattern contains an @
9425 character, but is not a regular expression and does not begin with a
9426 semicolon-terminated lookup type (described below), the local part of the
9427 subject address is compared with the local part of the pattern, which may start
9428 with an asterisk. If the local parts match, the domain is checked in exactly
9429 the same way as for a pattern in a domain list. For example, the domain can be
9430 wildcarded, refer to a named list, or be a lookup:
9432 deny senders = *@*.spamming.site:\
9433 *@+hostile_domains:\
9434 bozo@partial-lsearch;/list/of/dodgy/sites:\
9435 *@dbm;/bad/domains.db
9437 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9438 .cindex "address list" "local part starting with !"
9439 If a local part that begins with an exclamation mark is required, it has to be
9440 specified using a regular expression, because otherwise the exclamation mark is
9441 treated as a sign of negation, as is standard in lists.
9443 If a non-empty pattern that is not a regular expression or a lookup does not
9444 contain an @ character, it is matched against the domain part of the subject
9445 address. The only two formats that are recognized this way are a literal
9446 domain, or a domain pattern that starts with *. In both these cases, the effect
9447 is the same as if &`*@`& preceded the pattern. For example:
9449 deny senders = enemy.domain : *.enemy.domain
9452 The following kinds of more complicated address list pattern can match any
9453 address, including the empty address that is characteristic of bounce message
9457 .cindex "regular expressions" "in address list"
9458 .cindex "address list" "regular expression in"
9459 If (after expansion) a pattern starts with &"^"&, a regular expression match is
9460 done against the complete address, with the pattern as the regular expression.
9461 You must take care that backslash and dollar characters are not misinterpreted
9462 as part of the string expansion. The simplest way to do this is to use &`\N`&
9463 to mark that part of the string as non-expandable. For example:
9465 deny senders = \N^.*this.*@example\.com$\N : \
9466 \N^\d{8}.+@spamhaus.example$\N : ...
9468 The &`\N`& sequences are removed by the expansion, so these items do indeed
9469 start with &"^"& by the time they are being interpreted as address patterns.
9472 .cindex "address list" "lookup for complete address"
9473 Complete addresses can be looked up by using a pattern that starts with a
9474 lookup type terminated by a semicolon, followed by the data for the lookup. For
9477 deny senders = cdb;/etc/blocked.senders : \
9478 mysql;select address from blocked where \
9479 address='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'
9481 Both query-style and single-key lookup types can be used. For a single-key
9482 lookup type, Exim uses the complete address as the key. However, empty keys are
9483 not supported for single-key lookups, so a match against the empty address
9484 always fails. This restriction does not apply to query-style lookups.
9486 Partial matching for single-key lookups (section &<<SECTpartiallookup>>&)
9487 cannot be used, and is ignored if specified, with an entry being written to the
9489 .cindex "*@ with single-key lookup"
9490 However, you can configure lookup defaults, as described in section
9491 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&, but this is useful only for the &"*@"& type of
9492 default. For example, with this lookup:
9494 accept senders = lsearch*@;/some/file
9496 the file could contains lines like this:
9498 user1@domain1.example
9501 and for the sender address &'nimrod@jaeger.example'&, the sequence of keys
9504 nimrod@jaeger.example
9508 &*Warning 1*&: Do not include a line keyed by &"*"& in the file, because that
9509 would mean that every address matches, thus rendering the test useless.
9511 &*Warning 2*&: Do not confuse these two kinds of item:
9513 deny recipients = dbm*@;/some/file
9514 deny recipients = *@dbm;/some/file
9516 The first does a whole address lookup, with defaulting, as just described,
9517 because it starts with a lookup type. The second matches the local part and
9518 domain independently, as described in a bullet point below.
9522 The following kinds of address list pattern can match only non-empty addresses.
9523 If the subject address is empty, a match against any of these pattern types
9528 .cindex "@@ with single-key lookup"
9529 .cindex "address list" "@@ lookup type"
9530 .cindex "address list" "split local part and domain"
9531 If a pattern starts with &"@@"& followed by a single-key lookup item
9532 (for example, &`@@lsearch;/some/file`&), the address that is being checked is
9533 split into a local part and a domain. The domain is looked up in the file. If
9534 it is not found, there is no match. If it is found, the data that is looked up
9535 from the file is treated as a colon-separated list of local part patterns, each
9536 of which is matched against the subject local part in turn.
9538 .cindex "asterisk" "in address list"
9539 The lookup may be a partial one, and/or one involving a search for a default
9540 keyed by &"*"& (see section &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>&). The local part
9541 patterns that are looked up can be regular expressions or begin with &"*"&, or
9542 even be further lookups. They may also be independently negated. For example,
9545 deny senders = @@dbm;/etc/reject-by-domain
9547 the data from which the DBM file is built could contain lines like
9549 baddomain.com: !postmaster : *
9551 to reject all senders except &%postmaster%& from that domain.
9553 .cindex "local part" "starting with !"
9554 If a local part that actually begins with an exclamation mark is required, it
9555 has to be specified using a regular expression. In &(lsearch)& files, an entry
9556 may be split over several lines by indenting the second and subsequent lines,
9557 but the separating colon must still be included at line breaks. White space
9558 surrounding the colons is ignored. For example:
9560 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer2 : ^[0-9]+$ :
9563 As in all colon-separated lists in Exim, a colon can be included in an item by
9566 If the last item in the list starts with a right angle-bracket, the remainder
9567 of the item is taken as a new key to look up in order to obtain a continuation
9568 list of local parts. The new key can be any sequence of characters. Thus one
9569 might have entries like
9571 aol.com: spammer1 : spammer 2 : >*
9572 xyz.com: spammer3 : >*
9575 in a file that was searched with &%@@dbm*%&, to specify a match for 8-digit
9576 local parts for all domains, in addition to the specific local parts listed for
9577 each domain. Of course, using this feature costs another lookup each time a
9578 chain is followed, but the effort needed to maintain the data is reduced.
9580 .cindex "loop" "in lookups"
9581 It is possible to construct loops using this facility, and in order to catch
9582 them, the chains may be no more than fifty items long.
9585 The @@<&'lookup'&> style of item can also be used with a query-style
9586 lookup, but in this case, the chaining facility is not available. The lookup
9587 can only return a single list of local parts.
9590 &*Warning*&: There is an important difference between the address list items
9591 in these two examples:
9594 senders = *@+my_list
9596 In the first one, &`my_list`& is a named address list, whereas in the second
9597 example it is a named domain list.
9602 .subsection "Case of letters in address lists" SECTcasletadd
9603 .cindex "case of local parts"
9604 .cindex "address list" "case forcing"
9605 .cindex "case forcing in address lists"
9606 Domains in email addresses are always handled caselessly, but for local parts
9607 case may be significant on some systems (see &%caseful_local_part%& for how
9608 Exim deals with this when routing addresses). However,
9609 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2505,RFC 2505) (&'Anti-Spam
9610 Recommendations for SMTP MTAs'&) suggests that matching of addresses to
9611 blocking lists should be done in a case-independent manner. Since most address
9612 lists in Exim are used for this kind of control, Exim attempts to do this by
9615 The domain portion of an address is always lowercased before matching it to an
9616 address list. The local part is lowercased by default, and any string
9617 comparisons that take place are done caselessly. This means that the data in
9618 the address list itself, in files included as plain filenames, and in any file
9619 that is looked up using the &"@@"& mechanism, can be in any case. However, the
9620 keys in files that are looked up by a search type other than &(lsearch)& (which
9621 works caselessly) must be in lower case, because these lookups are not
9624 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
9625 To allow for the possibility of caseful address list matching, if an item in
9626 an address list is the string &"+caseful"&, the original case of the local
9627 part is restored for any comparisons that follow, and string comparisons are no
9628 longer case-independent. This does not affect the domain, which remains in
9629 lower case. However, although independent matches on the domain alone are still
9630 performed caselessly, regular expressions that match against an entire address
9631 become case-sensitive after &"+caseful"& has been seen.
9632 The effects of &"+caseful"& propagate into any referenced named lists.
9635 This string may not be tainted.
9636 To do caseful matching on list elements whic are tainted,
9637 place them in a named list.
9642 .section "Local part lists" "SECTlocparlis"
9643 .cindex "list" "local part list"
9644 .cindex "local part" "list"
9645 These behave in the same way as domain and host lists, with the following
9648 Case-sensitivity in local part lists is handled in the same way as for address
9649 lists, as just described. The &"+caseful"& item can be used if required. In a
9650 setting of the &%local_parts%& option in a router with &%caseful_local_part%&
9651 set false, the subject is lowercased and the matching is initially
9652 case-insensitive. In this case, &"+caseful"& will restore case-sensitive
9653 matching in the local part list, but not elsewhere in the router. If
9654 &%caseful_local_part%& is set true in a router, matching in the &%local_parts%&
9655 option is case-sensitive from the start.
9658 This string may not be tainted.
9659 To do caseful matching on list elements whic are tainted,
9660 place them in a named list.
9663 If a local part list is indirected to a file (see section &<<SECTfilnamlis>>&),
9664 comments are handled in the same way as address lists &-- they are recognized
9665 only if the # is preceded by white space or the start of the line.
9666 Otherwise, local part lists are matched in the same way as domain lists, except
9667 that the special items that refer to the local host (&`@`&, &`@[]`&,
9668 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`&) are not recognized.
9669 Refer to section &<<SECTdomainlist>>& for details of the other available item
9671 .ecindex IIDdohoadli
9676 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9677 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
9679 .chapter "String expansions" "CHAPexpand"
9680 .scindex IIDstrexp "expansion" "of strings"
9681 Many strings in Exim's runtime configuration are expanded before use. Some of
9682 them are expanded every time they are used; others are expanded only once.
9684 When a string is being expanded it is copied verbatim from left to right except
9685 .cindex expansion "string concatenation"
9686 when a dollar or backslash character is encountered. A dollar specifies the
9687 start of a portion of the string that is interpreted and replaced as described
9688 below in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& onwards. Backslash is used as an
9689 escape character, as described in the following section.
9691 .cindex "tainted data" tracking
9692 If any porttion of the result string is tainted, the entire result is.
9694 Whether a string is expanded depends upon the context. Usually this is solely
9695 dependent upon the option for which a value is sought; in this documentation,
9696 options for which string expansion is performed are marked with † after
9697 the data type. ACL rules always expand strings. A couple of expansion
9698 conditions do not expand some of the brace-delimited branches, for security
9700 .cindex "tainted data" expansion
9701 .cindex "tainted data" definition
9702 .cindex expansion "tainted data"
9703 and expansion of data deriving from the sender (&"tainted data"&)
9704 is not permitted (including acessing a file using a tainted name).
9706 Common ways of obtaining untainted equivalents of variables with
9708 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
9709 come down to using the tainted value as a lookup key in a trusted database.
9710 This database could be the filesystem structure,
9711 or the password file,
9712 or accessed via a DBMS.
9713 Specific methods are indexed under &"de-tainting"&.
9717 .section "Literal text in expanded strings" "SECTlittext"
9718 .cindex "expansion" "including literal text"
9719 An uninterpreted dollar can be included in an expanded string by putting a
9720 backslash in front of it. A backslash can be used to prevent any special
9721 character being treated specially in an expansion, including backslash itself.
9722 If the string appears in quotes in the configuration file, two backslashes are
9723 required because the quotes themselves cause interpretation of backslashes when
9724 the string is read in (see section &<<SECTstrings>>&).
9726 .cindex "expansion" "non-expandable substrings"
9727 A portion of the string can specified as non-expandable by placing it between
9728 two occurrences of &`\N`&. This is particularly useful for protecting regular
9729 expressions, which often contain backslashes and dollar signs. For example:
9731 deny senders = \N^\d{8}[a-z]@some\.site\.example$\N
9733 On encountering the first &`\N`&, the expander copies subsequent characters
9734 without interpretation until it reaches the next &`\N`& or the end of the
9739 .section "Character escape sequences in expanded strings" "SECID82"
9740 .cindex "expansion" "escape sequences"
9741 A backslash followed by one of the letters &"n"&, &"r"&, or &"t"& in an
9742 expanded string is recognized as an escape sequence for the character newline,
9743 carriage return, or tab, respectively. A backslash followed by up to three
9744 octal digits is recognized as an octal encoding for a single character, and a
9745 backslash followed by &"x"& and up to two hexadecimal digits is a hexadecimal
9748 These escape sequences are also recognized in quoted strings when they are read
9749 in. Their interpretation in expansions as well is useful for unquoted strings,
9750 and for other cases such as looked-up strings that are then expanded.
9753 .section "Testing string expansions" "SECID83"
9754 .cindex "expansion" "testing"
9755 .cindex "testing" "string expansion"
9757 Many expansions can be tested by calling Exim with the &%-be%& option. This
9758 takes the command arguments, or lines from the standard input if there are no
9759 arguments, runs them through the string expansion code, and writes the results
9760 to the standard output. Variables based on configuration values are set up, but
9761 since no message is being processed, variables such as &$local_part$& have no
9762 value. Nevertheless the &%-be%& option can be useful for checking out file and
9763 database lookups, and the use of expansion operators such as &%sg%&, &%substr%&
9766 When reading lines from the standard input,
9767 macros can be defined and ACL variables can be set.
9771 set acl_m_myvar = bar
9773 Such macros and variables can then be used in later input lines.
9775 Exim gives up its root privilege when it is called with the &%-be%& option, and
9776 instead runs under the uid and gid it was called with, to prevent users from
9777 using &%-be%& for reading files to which they do not have access.
9780 If you want to test expansions that include variables whose values are taken
9781 from a message, there are two other options that can be used. The &%-bem%&
9782 option is like &%-be%& except that it is followed by a filename. The file is
9783 read as a message before doing the test expansions. For example:
9785 exim -bem /tmp/test.message '$h_subject:'
9787 The &%-Mset%& option is used in conjunction with &%-be%& and is followed by an
9788 Exim message identifier. For example:
9790 exim -be -Mset 1GrA8W-0004WS-LQ '$recipients'
9792 This loads the message from Exim's spool before doing the test expansions, and
9793 is therefore restricted to admin users.
9796 .section "Forced expansion failure" "SECTforexpfai"
9797 .cindex "expansion" "forced failure"
9798 A number of expansions that are described in the following section have
9799 alternative &"true"& and &"false"& substrings, enclosed in brace characters
9800 (which are sometimes called &"curly brackets"&). Which of the two strings is
9801 used depends on some condition that is evaluated as part of the expansion. If,
9802 instead of a &"false"& substring, the word &"fail"& is used (not in braces),
9803 the entire string expansion fails in a way that can be detected by the code
9804 that requested the expansion. This is called &"forced expansion failure"&, and
9805 its consequences depend on the circumstances. In some cases it is no different
9806 from any other expansion failure, but in others a different action may be
9807 taken. Such variations are mentioned in the documentation of the option that is
9813 .section "Expansion items" "SECTexpansionitems"
9814 The following items are recognized in expanded strings. White space may be used
9815 between sub-items that are keywords or substrings enclosed in braces inside an
9816 outer set of braces, to improve readability. &*Warning*&: Within braces,
9817 white space is significant.
9820 .vitem &*$*&<&'variable&~name'&>&~or&~&*${*&<&'variable&~name'&>&*}*&
9821 .cindex "expansion" "variables"
9822 Substitute the contents of the named variable, for example:
9827 The second form can be used to separate the name from subsequent alphanumeric
9828 characters. This form (using braces) is available only for variables; it does
9829 &'not'& apply to message headers. The names of the variables are given in
9830 section &<<SECTexpvar>>& below. If the name of a non-existent variable is
9831 given, the expansion fails.
9833 .vitem &*${*&<&'op'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
9834 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
9835 The string is first itself expanded, and then the operation specified by
9836 <&'op'&> is applied to it. For example:
9840 The string starts with the first character after the colon, which may be
9841 leading white space. A list of operators is given in section &<<SECTexpop>>&
9842 below. The operator notation is used for simple expansion items that have just
9843 one argument, because it reduces the number of braces and therefore makes the
9844 string easier to understand.
9846 .vitem &*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
9847 This item inserts &"basic"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
9848 expansion item below.
9851 .vitem "&*${acl{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9852 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
9853 .cindex "&%acl%&" "call from expansion"
9854 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
9855 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
9856 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
9857 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
9858 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
9859 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
9860 a value using a "message =" modifier and returns accept or deny, the value becomes
9861 the result of the expansion.
9862 If no message is set and the ACL returns accept or deny
9863 the expansion result is an empty string.
9864 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail. Otherwise the expansion fails.
9867 .vitem "&*${authresults{*&<&'authserv-id'&>&*}}*&"
9868 .cindex authentication "results header"
9869 .chindex Authentication-Results:
9870 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
9871 This item returns a string suitable for insertion as an
9872 &'Authentication-Results:'&
9874 The given <&'authserv-id'&> is included in the result; typically this
9875 will be a domain name identifying the system performing the authentications.
9876 Methods that might be present in the result include:
9885 Example use (as an ACL modifier):
9887 add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
9889 This is safe even if no authentication results are available
9890 and would generally be placed in the DATA ACL.
9893 .vitem "&*${certextract{*&<&'field'&>&*}{*&<&'certificate'&>&*}&&&
9894 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
9895 .cindex "expansion" "extracting certificate fields"
9896 .cindex "&%certextract%&" "certificate fields"
9897 .cindex "certificate" "extracting fields"
9898 The <&'certificate'&> must be a variable of type certificate.
9899 The field name is expanded and used to retrieve the relevant field from
9900 the certificate. Supported fields are:
9904 &`subject `& RFC4514 DN
9905 &`issuer `& RFC4514 DN
9910 &`subj_altname `& tagged list
9914 If the field is found,
9915 <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
9916 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
9917 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
9918 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
9920 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
9921 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
9924 Some field names take optional modifiers, appended and separated by commas.
9926 The field selectors marked as "RFC4514" above
9927 output a Distinguished Name string which is
9929 parseable by Exim as a comma-separated tagged list
9930 (the exceptions being elements containing commas).
9931 RDN elements of a single type may be selected by
9932 a modifier of the type label; if so the expansion
9933 result is a list (newline-separated by default).
9934 The separator may be changed by another modifier of
9935 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9936 Recognised RDN type labels include "CN", "O", "OU" and "DC".
9938 The field selectors marked as "time" above
9939 take an optional modifier of "int"
9940 for which the result is the number of seconds since epoch.
9941 Otherwise the result is a human-readable string
9942 in the timezone selected by the main "timezone" option.
9944 The field selectors marked as "list" above return a list,
9945 newline-separated by default,
9946 (embedded separator characters in elements are doubled).
9947 The separator may be changed by a modifier of
9948 a right angle-bracket followed immediately by the new separator.
9950 The field selectors marked as "tagged" above
9951 prefix each list element with a type string and an equals sign.
9952 Elements of only one type may be selected by a modifier
9953 which is one of "dns", "uri" or "mail";
9954 if so the element tags are omitted.
9956 If not otherwise noted field values are presented in human-readable form.
9958 .vitem "&*${dlfunc{*&<&'file'&>&*}{*&<&'function'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}&&&
9959 {*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&"
9961 This expansion dynamically loads and then calls a locally-written C function.
9962 This functionality is available only if Exim is compiled with
9966 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Once loaded, Exim remembers the dynamically loaded
9967 object so that it doesn't reload the same object file in the same Exim process
9968 (but of course Exim does start new processes frequently).
9970 There may be from zero to eight arguments to the function.
9973 a local function that is to be called in this way,
9974 first &_DLFUNC_IMPL_& should be defined,
9975 and second &_local_scan.h_& should be included.
9976 The Exim variables and functions that are defined by that API
9977 are also available for dynamically loaded functions. The function itself
9978 must have the following type:
9980 int dlfunction(uschar **yield, int argc, uschar *argv[])
9982 Where &`uschar`& is a typedef for &`unsigned char`& in &_local_scan.h_&. The
9983 function should return one of the following values:
9985 &`OK`&: Success. The string that is placed in the variable &'yield'& is put
9986 into the expanded string that is being built.
9988 &`FAIL`&: A non-forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message taken
9989 from &'yield'&, if it is set.
9991 &`FAIL_FORCED`&: A forced expansion failure occurs, with the error message
9992 taken from &'yield'& if it is set.
9994 &`ERROR`&: Same as &`FAIL`&, except that a panic log entry is written.
9996 When compiling a function that is to be used in this way with gcc,
9997 you need to add &%-shared%& to the gcc command. Also, in the Exim build-time
9998 configuration, you must add &%-export-dynamic%& to EXTRALIBS.
10001 .vitem "&*${env{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10002 .cindex "expansion" "extracting value from environment"
10003 .cindex "environment" "values from"
10004 The key is first expanded separately, and leading and trailing white space
10006 This is then searched for as a name in the environment.
10007 If a variable is found then its value is placed in &$value$&
10008 and <&'string1'&> is expanded, otherwise <&'string2'&> is expanded.
10010 Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
10011 appear, for example:
10013 ${env{USER}{$value} fail }
10015 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
10016 {<&'string1'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
10018 If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted an empty string is substituted on
10020 If {<&'string1'&>} is omitted the search result is substituted on
10023 The environment is adjusted by the &%keep_environment%& and
10024 &%add_environment%& main section options.
10027 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
10028 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10029 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by key"
10030 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by key"
10031 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
10032 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
10033 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
10034 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
10036 <&'key1'&> = <&'value1'&> <&'key2'&> = <&'value2'&> ...
10038 .vindex "&$value$&"
10039 where the equals signs and spaces (but not both) are optional. If any of the
10040 values contain white space, they must be enclosed in double quotes, and any
10041 values that are enclosed in double quotes are subject to escape processing as
10042 described in section &<<SECTstrings>>&. The expanded <&'string1'&> is searched
10043 for the value that corresponds to the key. The search is case-insensitive. If
10044 the key is found, <&'string2'&> is expanded, and replaces the whole item;
10045 otherwise <&'string3'&> is used. During the expansion of <&'string2'&> the
10046 variable &$value$& contains the value that has been extracted. Afterwards, it
10047 is restored to any previous value it might have had.
10049 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, the item is replaced by an empty string if the
10050 key is not found. If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10051 extracted is used. Thus, for example, these two expansions are identical, and
10054 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}}
10055 ${extract{gid}{uid=1984 gid=2001}{$value}}
10057 Instead of {<&'string3'&>} the word &"fail"& (not in curly brackets) can
10058 appear, for example:
10060 ${extract{Z}{A=... B=...}{$value} fail }
10062 This forces an expansion failure (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&);
10063 {<&'string2'&>} must be present for &"fail"& to be recognized.
10065 .vitem "&*${extract json{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
10066 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10067 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'key'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}&&&
10068 {*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10069 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON object"
10070 .cindex JSON expansions
10071 The key and <&'string1'&> are first expanded separately. Leading and trailing
10072 white space is removed from the key (but not from any of the strings). The key
10073 must not be empty and must not consist entirely of digits.
10074 The expanded <&'string1'&> must be of the form:
10076 { <&'"key1"'&> : <&'value1'&> , <&'"key2"'&> , <&'value2'&> ... }
10078 .vindex "&$value$&"
10079 The braces, commas and colons, and the quoting of the member name are required;
10080 the spaces are optional.
10081 Matching of the key against the member names is done case-sensitively.
10082 For the &"json"& variant,
10083 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
10085 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
10086 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
10087 . XXX should be a UTF-8 compare
10089 The results of matching are handled as above.
10092 .vitem "&*${extract{*&<&'number'&>&*}{*&<&'separators'&>&*}&&&
10093 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10094 .cindex "expansion" "extracting substrings by number"
10095 .cindex "&%extract%&" "substrings by number"
10096 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10097 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
10098 This is what distinguishes this form of &%extract%& from the previous kind. It
10099 behaves in the same way, except that, instead of extracting a named field, it
10100 extracts from <&'string1'&> the field whose number is given as the first
10101 argument. You can use &$value$& in <&'string2'&> or &`fail`& instead of
10102 <&'string3'&> as before.
10104 The fields in the string are separated by any one of the characters in the
10105 separator string. These may include space or tab characters.
10106 The first field is numbered one. If the number is negative, the fields are
10107 counted from the end of the string, with the rightmost one numbered -1. If the
10108 number given is zero, the entire string is returned. If the modulus of the
10109 number is greater than the number of fields in the string, the result is the
10110 expansion of <&'string3'&>, or the empty string if <&'string3'&> is not
10111 provided. For example:
10113 ${extract{2}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
10117 ${extract{-4}{:}{x:42:99:& Mailer::/bin/bash}}
10119 yields &"99"&. Two successive separators mean that the field between them is
10120 empty (for example, the fifth field above).
10123 .vitem "&*${extract json {*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
10124 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10125 "&*${extract jsons{*&<&'number'&>&*}}&&&
10126 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10127 .cindex "expansion" "extracting from JSON array"
10128 .cindex JSON expansions
10129 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10130 apart from leading and trailing white space, which is ignored.
10132 Field selection and result handling is as above;
10133 there is no choice of field separator.
10134 For the &"json"& variant,
10135 if a returned value is a JSON string, it retains its leading and
10137 For the &"jsons"& variant, which is intended for use with JSON strings, the
10138 leading and trailing quotes are removed from the returned value.
10141 .vitem &*${filter{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'condition'&>&*}}*&
10142 .cindex "list" "selecting by condition"
10143 .cindex "expansion" "selecting from list by condition"
10146 <&'string1'&> first has the part after any change-of-list-separator
10147 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) expanded,
10148 then the whole is taken as a list.
10150 The default separator for the list is a colon.
10152 For each item in this list,
10153 its value is placed in &$item$&, and then the condition is evaluated.
10154 Any modification of &$value$& by this evaluation is discarded.
10155 If the condition is true, &$item$& is added to the output as an
10156 item in a new list; if the condition is false, the item is discarded. The
10157 separator used for the output list is the same as the one used for the
10158 input, but a separator setting is not included in the output. For example:
10160 ${filter{a:b:c}{!eq{$item}{b}}}
10162 yields &`a:c`&. At the end of the expansion, the value of &$item$& is restored
10163 to what it was before.
10164 See also the &%map%& and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10167 .vitem &*${hash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10168 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
10169 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
10170 This is a textual hashing function, and was the first to be implemented in
10171 early versions of Exim. In current releases, there are other hashing functions
10172 (numeric, MD5, and SHA-1), which are described below.
10174 The first two strings, after expansion, must be numbers. Call them <&'m'&> and
10175 <&'n'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is, if
10176 <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you can
10177 use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10179 ${hash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10181 The second number is optional (in both notations). If <&'n'&> is greater than
10182 or equal to the length of the string, the expansion item returns the string.
10183 Otherwise it computes a new string of length <&'n'&> by applying a hashing
10184 function to the string. The new string consists of characters taken from the
10185 first <&'m'&> characters of the string
10187 abcdefghijklmnopqrstuvwxyzABCDEFGHIJKLMNOPQWRSTUVWXYZ0123456789
10189 If <&'m'&> is not present the value 26 is used, so that only lower case
10190 letters appear. For example:
10192 &`$hash{3}{monty}} `& yields &`jmg`&
10193 &`$hash{5}{monty}} `& yields &`monty`&
10194 &`$hash{4}{62}{monty python}}`& yields &`fbWx`&
10197 .vitem "&*$header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10198 &*$h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10199 "&*$bheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10200 &*$bh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10201 "&*$lheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10202 &*$lh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&" &&&
10203 "&*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&&&
10204 &*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
10205 .cindex "expansion" "header insertion"
10206 .vindex "&$header_$&"
10207 .vindex "&$bheader_$&"
10208 .vindex "&$lheader_$&"
10209 .vindex "&$rheader_$&"
10210 .cindex "header lines" "in expansion strings"
10211 .cindex "header lines" "character sets"
10212 .cindex "header lines" "decoding"
10213 Substitute the contents of the named message header line, for example
10217 The newline that terminates a header line is not included in the expansion, but
10218 internal newlines (caused by splitting the header line over several physical
10219 lines) may be present.
10221 The difference between the four pairs of expansions is in the way
10222 the data in the header line is interpreted.
10225 .cindex "white space" "in header lines"
10226 &%rheader%& gives the original &"raw"& content of the header line, with no
10227 processing at all, and without the removal of leading and trailing white space.
10230 .cindex "list" "of header lines"
10231 &%lheader%& gives a colon-separated list, one element per header when there
10232 are multiple headers with a given name.
10233 Any embedded colon characters within an element are doubled, so normal Exim
10234 list-processing facilities can be used.
10235 The terminating newline of each element is removed; in other respects
10236 the content is &"raw"&.
10239 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in header lines"
10240 &%bheader%& removes leading and trailing white space, and then decodes base64
10241 or quoted-printable MIME &"words"& within the header text, but does no
10242 character set translation. If decoding of what looks superficially like a MIME
10243 &"word"& fails, the raw string is returned. If decoding
10244 .cindex "binary zero" "in header line"
10245 produces a binary zero character, it is replaced by a question mark &-- this is
10246 what Exim does for binary zeros that are actually received in header lines.
10249 &%header%& tries to translate the string as decoded by &%bheader%& to a
10250 standard character set. This is an attempt to produce the same string as would
10251 be displayed on a user's MUA. If translation fails, the &%bheader%& string is
10252 returned. Translation is attempted only on operating systems that support the
10253 &[iconv()]& function. This is indicated by the compile-time macro HAVE_ICONV in
10254 a system Makefile or in &_Local/Makefile_&.
10257 In a filter file, the target character set for &%header%& can be specified by a
10258 command of the following form:
10260 headers charset "UTF-8"
10262 This command affects all references to &$h_$& (or &$header_$&) expansions in
10263 subsequently obeyed filter commands. In the absence of this command, the target
10264 character set in a filter is taken from the setting of the &%headers_charset%&
10265 option in the runtime configuration. The value of this option defaults to the
10266 value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The ultimate default is
10269 Header names follow the syntax of
10270 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822),
10271 which states that they may contain
10272 any printing characters except space and colon. Consequently, curly brackets
10273 &'do not'& terminate header names, and should not be used to enclose them as
10274 if they were variables. Attempting to do so causes a syntax error.
10276 Only header lines that are common to all copies of a message are visible to
10277 this mechanism. These are the original header lines that are received with the
10278 message, and any that are added by an ACL statement or by a system
10279 filter. Header lines that are added to a particular copy of a message by a
10280 router or transport are not accessible.
10282 For incoming SMTP messages, no header lines are visible in
10283 ACLs that are obeyed before the data phase completes,
10284 because the header structure is not set up until the message is received.
10285 They are visible in DKIM, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
10286 Header lines that are added in a RCPT ACL (for example)
10287 are saved until the message's incoming header lines are available, at which
10288 point they are added.
10289 When any of the above ACLs are
10290 running, however, header lines added by earlier ACLs are visible.
10292 Upper case and lower case letters are synonymous in header names. If the
10293 following character is white space, the terminating colon may be omitted, but
10294 this is not recommended, because you may then forget it when it is needed. When
10295 white space terminates the header name, this white space is included in the
10296 expanded string. If the message does not contain the given header, the
10297 expansion item is replaced by an empty string. (See the &%def%& condition in
10298 section &<<SECTexpcond>>& for a means of testing for the existence of a
10301 If there is more than one header with the same name, they are all concatenated
10302 to form the substitution string, up to a maximum length of 64K. Unless
10303 &%rheader%& is being used, leading and trailing white space is removed from
10304 each header before concatenation, and a completely empty header is ignored. A
10305 newline character is then inserted between non-empty headers, but there is no
10306 newline at the very end. For the &%header%& and &%bheader%& expansion, for
10307 those headers that contain lists of addresses, a comma is also inserted at the
10308 junctions between headers. This does not happen for the &%rheader%& expansion.
10310 .cindex "tainted data" "message headers"
10311 When the headers are from an incoming message,
10312 the result of expanding any of these variables is tainted.
10315 .vitem &*${hmac{*&<&'hashname'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10316 .cindex "expansion" "hmac hashing"
10318 This function uses cryptographic hashing (either MD5 or SHA-1) to convert a
10319 shared secret and some text into a message authentication code, as specified in
10320 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2104.RFC 2104).
10321 This differs from &`${md5:secret_text...}`& or
10322 &`${sha1:secret_text...}`& in that the hmac step adds a signature to the
10323 cryptographic hash, allowing for authentication that is not possible with MD5
10324 or SHA-1 alone. The hash name must expand to either &`md5`& or &`sha1`& at
10325 present. For example:
10327 ${hmac{md5}{somesecret}{$primary_hostname $tod_log}}
10329 For the hostname &'mail.example.com'& and time 2002-10-17 11:30:59, this
10332 dd97e3ba5d1a61b5006108f8c8252953
10334 As an example of how this might be used, you might put in the main part of
10335 an Exim configuration:
10337 SPAMSCAN_SECRET=cohgheeLei2thahw
10339 In a router or a transport you could then have:
10342 X-Spam-Scanned: ${primary_hostname} ${message_exim_id} \
10343 ${hmac{md5}{SPAMSCAN_SECRET}\
10344 {${primary_hostname},${message_exim_id},$h_message-id:}}
10346 Then given a message, you can check where it was scanned by looking at the
10347 &'X-Spam-Scanned:'& header line. If you know the secret, you can check that
10348 this header line is authentic by recomputing the authentication code from the
10349 host name, message ID and the &'Message-id:'& header line. This can be done
10350 using Exim's &%-be%& option, or by other means, for example, by using the
10351 &'hmac_md5_hex()'& function in Perl.
10354 .vitem &*${if&~*&<&'condition'&>&*&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10355 .cindex "expansion" "conditional"
10356 .cindex "&%if%&, expansion item"
10357 If <&'condition'&> is true, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the whole
10358 item; otherwise <&'string2'&> is used. The available conditions are described
10359 in section &<<SECTexpcond>>& below. For example:
10361 ${if eq {$local_part}{postmaster} {yes}{no} }
10363 The second string need not be present; if it is not and the condition is not
10364 true, the item is replaced with nothing. Alternatively, the word &"fail"& may
10365 be present instead of the second string (without any curly brackets). In this
10366 case, the expansion is forced to fail if the condition is not true (see section
10367 &<<SECTforexpfai>>&).
10369 If both strings are omitted, the result is the string &`true`& if the condition
10370 is true, and the empty string if the condition is false. This makes it less
10371 cumbersome to write custom ACL and router conditions. For example, instead of
10373 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}{true}{false}}
10377 condition = ${if >{$acl_m4}{3}}
10382 .vitem &*${imapfolder{*&<&'foldername'&>&*}}*&
10383 .cindex expansion "imap folder"
10384 .cindex "&%imapfolder%& expansion item"
10385 This item converts a (possibly multilevel, or with non-ASCII characters)
10386 folder specification to a Maildir name for filesystem use.
10387 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMDA>>&.
10391 .vitem &*${length{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10392 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
10393 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
10394 The &%length%& item is used to extract the initial portion of a string. Both
10395 strings are expanded, and the first one must yield a number, <&'n'&>, say. If
10396 you are using a fixed value for the number, that is, if <&'string1'&> does not
10397 change when expanded, you can use the simpler operator notation that avoids
10398 some of the braces:
10400 ${length_<n>:<string>}
10402 The result of this item is either the first <&'n'&> bytes or the whole
10403 of <&'string2'&>, whichever is the shorter. Do not confuse &%length%& with
10404 &%strlen%&, which gives the length of a string.
10405 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
10408 .vitem "&*${listextract{*&<&'number'&>&*}&&&
10409 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&"
10410 .cindex "expansion" "extracting list elements by number"
10411 .cindex "&%listextract%&" "extract list elements by number"
10412 .cindex "list" "extracting elements by number"
10413 The <&'number'&> argument must consist entirely of decimal digits,
10414 apart from an optional leading minus,
10415 and leading and trailing white space (which is ignored).
10418 The <&'string1'&> argument, after any leading change-of-separator
10419 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
10420 is expanded and the whole forms the list.
10422 By default, the list separator is a colon.
10424 The first field of the list is numbered one.
10425 If the number is negative, the fields are
10426 counted from the end of the list, with the rightmost one numbered -1.
10427 The numbered element of the list is extracted and placed in &$value$&,
10428 then <&'string2'&> is expanded as the result.
10430 If the modulus of the
10431 number is zero or greater than the number of fields in the string,
10432 the result is the expansion of <&'string3'&>.
10436 ${listextract{2}{x:42:99}}
10440 ${listextract{-3}{<, x,42,99,& Mailer,,/bin/bash}{result: $value}}
10442 yields &"result: 42"&.
10444 If {<&'string3'&>} is omitted, an empty string is used for string3.
10445 If {<&'string2'&>} is also omitted, the value that was
10447 You can use &`fail`& instead of {<&'string3'&>} as in a string extract.
10450 .vitem &*${listquote{*&<&'separator'&>&*}{*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&
10451 .cindex quoting "for list"
10452 .cindex list quoting
10453 This item doubles any occurrence of the separator character
10454 in the given string.
10455 An empty string is replaced with a single space.
10456 This converts the string into a safe form for use as a list element,
10457 in a list using the given separator.
10460 .vitem "&*${lookup&~{*&<&'key'&>&*}&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~&&&
10461 {*&<&'file'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&" &&&
10462 "&*${lookup&~*&<&'search&~type'&>&*&~{*&<&'query'&>&*}&~&&&
10463 {*&<&'string1'&>&*}&~{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10464 .cindex "expansion" "lookup in"
10465 .cindex "file" "lookups"
10466 .cindex "lookup" "in expanded string"
10467 The two forms of lookup item specify data lookups in files and databases, as
10468 discussed in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. The first form is used for single-key
10469 lookups, and the second is used for query-style lookups. The <&'key'&>,
10470 <&'file'&>, and <&'query'&> strings are expanded before use.
10472 If there is any white space in a lookup item which is part of a filter command,
10473 a retry or rewrite rule, a routing rule for the &(manualroute)& router, or any
10474 other place where white space is significant, the lookup item must be enclosed
10475 in double quotes. The use of data lookups in users' filter files may be locked
10476 out by the system administrator.
10478 .vindex "&$value$&"
10479 If the lookup succeeds, <&'string1'&> is expanded and replaces the entire item.
10480 During its expansion, the variable &$value$& contains the data returned by the
10481 lookup. Afterwards it reverts to the value it had previously (at the outer
10482 level it is empty). If the lookup fails, <&'string2'&> is expanded and replaces
10483 the entire item. If {<&'string2'&>} is omitted, the replacement is the empty
10484 string on failure. If <&'string2'&> is provided, it can itself be a nested
10485 lookup, thus providing a mechanism for looking up a default value when the
10486 original lookup fails.
10488 If a nested lookup is used as part of <&'string1'&>, &$value$& contains the
10489 data for the outer lookup while the parameters of the second lookup are
10490 expanded, and also while <&'string2'&> of the second lookup is expanded, should
10491 the second lookup fail. Instead of {<&'string2'&>} the word &"fail"& can
10492 appear, and in this case, if the lookup fails, the entire expansion is forced
10493 to fail (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). If both {<&'string1'&>} and
10494 {<&'string2'&>} are omitted, the result is the looked up value in the case of a
10495 successful lookup, and nothing in the case of failure.
10497 For single-key lookups, the string &"partial"& is permitted to precede the
10498 search type in order to do partial matching, and * or *@ may follow a search
10499 type to request default lookups if the key does not match (see sections
10500 &<<SECTdefaultvaluelookups>>& and &<<SECTpartiallookup>>& for details).
10502 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in lookup expansion"
10503 If a partial search is used, the variables &$1$& and &$2$& contain the wild
10504 and non-wild parts of the key during the expansion of the replacement text.
10505 They return to their previous values at the end of the lookup item.
10507 This example looks up the postmaster alias in the conventional alias file:
10509 ${lookup {postmaster} lsearch {/etc/aliases} {$value}}
10511 This example uses NIS+ to look up the full name of the user corresponding to
10512 the local part of an address, forcing the expansion to fail if it is not found:
10514 ${lookup nisplus {[name=$local_part],passwd.org_dir:gcos} \
10519 .vitem &*${map{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&
10520 .cindex "expansion" "list creation"
10523 <&'string1'&> first has the part after any change-of-list-separator
10524 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) expanded,
10525 then the whole is taken as a list.
10527 The default separator for the list is a colon.
10529 For each item in this list,
10530 its value is place in &$item$&, and then <&'string2'&> is
10531 expanded and added to the output as an item in a new list. The separator used
10532 for the output list is the same as the one used for the input, but a separator
10533 setting is not included in the output. For example:
10535 ${map{a:b:c}{[$item]}} ${map{<- x-y-z}{($item)}}
10537 expands to &`[a]:[b]:[c] (x)-(y)-(z)`&. At the end of the expansion, the
10538 value of &$item$& is restored to what it was before. See also the &%filter%&
10539 and &%reduce%& expansion items.
10541 .vitem &*${nhash{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10542 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
10543 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
10544 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10545 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10546 if <&'string1'&> and <&'string2'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10547 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10549 ${nhash_<n>_<m>:<string>}
10551 The second number is optional (in both notations). If there is only one number,
10552 the result is a number in the range 0&--<&'n'&>-1. Otherwise, the string is
10553 processed by a div/mod hash function that returns two numbers, separated by a
10554 slash, in the ranges 0 to <&'n'&>-1 and 0 to <&'m'&>-1, respectively. For
10557 ${nhash{8}{64}{supercalifragilisticexpialidocious}}
10559 returns the string &"6/33"&.
10563 .vitem &*${perl{*&<&'subroutine'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}{*&<&'arg'&>&*}...}*&
10564 .cindex "Perl" "use in expanded string"
10565 .cindex "expansion" "calling Perl from"
10566 This item is available only if Exim has been built to include an embedded Perl
10567 interpreter. The subroutine name and the arguments are first separately
10568 expanded, and then the Perl subroutine is called with those arguments. No
10569 additional arguments need be given; the maximum number permitted, including the
10570 name of the subroutine, is nine.
10572 The return value of the subroutine is inserted into the expanded string, unless
10573 the return value is &%undef%&. In that case, the entire expansion is
10574 forced to fail, in the same way as an explicit &"fail"& on a lookup item
10575 does (see section &<<SECTforexpfai>>&). Whatever you return is evaluated
10576 in a scalar context, thus the return value is a scalar. For example, if you
10577 return a Perl vector, the return value is the size of the vector,
10580 If the subroutine exits by calling Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails
10581 with the error message that was passed to &%die%&. More details of the embedded
10582 Perl facility are given in chapter &<<CHAPperl>>&.
10584 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_perl%& which locks
10585 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10588 .vitem &*${prvs{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'keynumber'&>&*}}*&
10589 .cindex "&%prvs%& expansion item"
10590 The first argument is a complete email address and the second is secret
10591 keystring. The third argument, specifying a key number, is optional. If absent,
10592 it defaults to 0. The result of the expansion is a prvs-signed email address,
10593 to be typically used with the &%return_path%& option on an &(smtp)& transport
10594 as part of a bounce address tag validation (BATV) scheme. For more discussion
10595 and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10597 .vitem "&*${prvscheck{*&<&'address'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}&&&
10598 {*&<&'string'&>&*}}*&"
10599 .cindex "&%prvscheck%& expansion item"
10600 This expansion item is the complement of the &%prvs%& item. It is used for
10601 checking prvs-signed addresses. If the expansion of the first argument does not
10602 yield a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the whole item expands to the
10603 empty string. When the first argument does expand to a syntactically valid
10604 prvs-signed address, the second argument is expanded, with the prvs-decoded
10605 version of the address and the key number extracted from the address in the
10606 variables &$prvscheck_address$& and &$prvscheck_keynum$&, respectively.
10608 These two variables can be used in the expansion of the second argument to
10609 retrieve the secret. The validity of the prvs-signed address is then checked
10610 against the secret. The result is stored in the variable &$prvscheck_result$&,
10611 which is empty for failure or &"1"& for success.
10613 The third argument is optional; if it is missing, it defaults to an empty
10614 string. This argument is now expanded. If the result is an empty string, the
10615 result of the expansion is the decoded version of the address. This is the case
10616 whether or not the signature was valid. Otherwise, the result of the expansion
10617 is the expansion of the third argument.
10619 All three variables can be used in the expansion of the third argument.
10620 However, once the expansion is complete, only &$prvscheck_result$& remains set.
10621 For more discussion and an example, see section &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
10623 .vitem &*${readfile{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}}*&
10624 .cindex "expansion" "inserting an entire file"
10625 .cindex "file" "inserting into expansion"
10626 .cindex "&%readfile%& expansion item"
10627 The filename and end-of-line (eol) string are first expanded separately. The file is
10628 then read, and its contents replace the entire item. All newline characters in
10629 the file are replaced by the end-of-line string if it is present. Otherwise,
10630 newlines are left in the string.
10631 String expansion is not applied to the contents of the file. If you want this,
10632 you must wrap the item in an &%expand%& operator. If the file cannot be read,
10633 the string expansion fails.
10635 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readfile%& which
10636 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10640 .vitem "&*${readsocket{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'request'&>&*}&&&
10641 {*&<&'options'&>&*}{*&<&'eol&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'fail&~string'&>&*}}*&"
10642 .cindex "expansion" "inserting from a socket"
10643 .cindex "socket, use of in expansion"
10644 .cindex "&%readsocket%& expansion item"
10645 This item inserts data from a Unix domain or TCP socket into the expanded
10646 string. The minimal way of using it uses just two arguments, as in these
10649 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}}
10650 ${readsocket{inet:some.host:1234}{request string}}
10652 For a Unix domain socket, the first substring must be the path to the socket.
10653 For an Internet socket, the first substring must contain &`inet:`& followed by
10654 a host name or IP address, followed by a colon and a port, which can be a
10655 number or the name of a TCP port in &_/etc/services_&. An IP address may
10656 optionally be enclosed in square brackets. This is best for IPv6 addresses. For
10659 ${readsocket{inet:[::1]:1234}{request string}}
10661 Only a single host name may be given, but if looking it up yields more than
10662 one IP address, they are each tried in turn until a connection is made. For
10663 both kinds of socket, Exim makes a connection, writes the request string
10664 (unless it is an empty string; no terminating NUL is ever sent)
10665 and reads from the socket until an end-of-file
10666 is read. A timeout of 5 seconds is applied. Additional, optional arguments
10667 extend what can be done. Firstly, you can vary the timeout. For example:
10669 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}}
10672 The third argument is a list of options, of which the first element is the timeout
10673 and must be present if any options are given.
10674 Further elements are options of form &'name=value'&.
10677 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s:shutdown=no}}
10680 The following option names are recognised:
10683 Defines if the result data can be cached for use by a later identical
10684 request in the same process.
10685 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10686 If not, all cached results for this connection specification
10687 will be invalidated.
10691 Defines whether or not a write-shutdown is done on the connection after
10692 sending the request. Values are &"yes"& (the default) or &"no"&
10693 (preferred, eg. by some webservers).
10697 Controls the use of Server Name Identification on the connection.
10698 Any nonempty value will be the SNI sent; TLS will be forced.
10702 Controls the use of TLS on the connection.
10703 Values are &"yes"& or &"no"& (the default).
10704 If it is enabled, a shutdown as described above is never done.
10708 A fourth argument allows you to change any newlines that are in the data
10709 that is read, in the same way as for &%readfile%& (see above). This example
10710 turns them into spaces:
10712 ${readsocket{inet:127.0.0.1:3294}{request string}{3s}{ }}
10714 As with all expansions, the substrings are expanded before the processing
10715 happens. Errors in these sub-expansions cause the expansion to fail. In
10716 addition, the following errors can occur:
10719 Failure to create a socket file descriptor;
10721 Failure to connect the socket;
10723 Failure to write the request string;
10725 Timeout on reading from the socket.
10728 By default, any of these errors causes the expansion to fail. However, if
10729 you supply a fifth substring, it is expanded and used when any of the above
10730 errors occurs. For example:
10732 ${readsocket{/socket/name}{request string}{3s}{\n}\
10735 You can test for the existence of a Unix domain socket by wrapping this
10736 expansion in &`${if exists`&, but there is a race condition between that test
10737 and the actual opening of the socket, so it is safer to use the fifth argument
10738 if you want to be absolutely sure of avoiding an expansion error for a
10739 non-existent Unix domain socket, or a failure to connect to an Internet socket.
10741 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_readsocket%& which
10742 locks out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10745 .vitem &*${reduce{*&<&'string1'&>}{<&'string2'&>&*}{*&<&'string3'&>&*}}*&
10746 .cindex "expansion" "reducing a list to a scalar"
10747 .cindex "list" "reducing to a scalar"
10748 .vindex "&$value$&"
10750 This operation reduces a list to a single, scalar string.
10753 <&'string1'&> first has the part after any change-of-list-separator
10754 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) expanded,
10755 then the whole is taken as a list.
10757 The default separator for the list is a colon.
10759 Then <&'string2'&> is expanded and
10760 assigned to the &$value$& variable. After this, each item in the <&'string1'&>
10761 list is assigned to &$item$&, in turn, and <&'string3'&> is expanded for each of
10762 them. The result of that expansion is assigned to &$value$& before the next
10763 iteration. When the end of the list is reached, the final value of &$value$& is
10764 added to the expansion output. The &%reduce%& expansion item can be used in a
10765 number of ways. For example, to add up a list of numbers:
10767 ${reduce {<, 1,2,3}{0}{${eval:$value+$item}}}
10769 The result of that expansion would be &`6`&. The maximum of a list of numbers
10772 ${reduce {3:0:9:4:6}{0}{${if >{$item}{$value}{$item}{$value}}}}
10774 At the end of a &*reduce*& expansion, the values of &$item$& and &$value$& are
10775 restored to what they were before. See also the &%filter%& and &%map%&
10778 . A bit of a special-case logic error in writing an expansion;
10779 . probably not worth including in the mainline of documentation.
10780 . If only we had footnotes (the html output variant is the problem).
10783 . &*Note*&: if an &'expansion condition'& is used in <&'string3'&>
10784 . and that condition modifies &$value$&,
10785 . then the string expansions dependent on the condition cannot use
10786 . the &$value$& of the reduce iteration.
10789 .vitem &*$rheader_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~or&~&*$rh_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&
10790 This item inserts &"raw"& header lines. It is described with the &%header%&
10791 expansion item in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
10793 .vitem "&*${run<&'options'&> {*&<&'command&~string'&>&*}{*&<&'string1'&>&*}&&&
10794 {*&<&'string2'&>&*}}*&"
10795 .cindex "expansion" "running a command"
10796 .cindex "&%run%& expansion item"
10797 This item runs an external command, as a subprocess.
10798 One option is supported after the word &'run'&, comma-separated
10799 and without whitespace.
10801 If the option &'preexpand'& is not used,
10802 the command string before expansion is split into individual arguments by spaces
10803 and then each argument is separately expanded.
10804 Then the command is run
10805 in a separate process, but under the same uid and gid. As in other command
10806 executions from Exim, a shell is not used by default. If the command requires
10807 a shell, you must explicitly code it.
10808 The command name may not be tainted, but the remaining arguments can be.
10810 &*Note*&: if tainted arguments are used, they are supplied by a
10811 potential attacker;
10812 a careful assessment for security vulnerabilities should be done.
10814 If the option &'preexpand'& is used,
10815 the command string is first expanded as a whole.
10816 The expansion result is split apart into individual arguments by spaces,
10817 and then the command is run as above.
10818 Since the arguments are split by spaces, when there is a variable expansion
10819 which has an empty result, it will cause the situation that the argument will
10820 simply be omitted when the program is actually executed by Exim. If the
10821 script/program requires a specific number of arguments and the expanded
10822 variable could possibly result in this empty expansion, the variable must be
10823 quoted. This is more difficult if the expanded variable itself could result
10824 in a string containing quotes, because it would interfere with the quotes
10825 around the command arguments. A possible guard against this is to wrap the
10826 variable in the &%sg%& operator to change any quote marks to some other
10828 Neither the command nor any argument may be tainted.
10830 The standard input for the command exists, but is empty. The standard output
10831 and standard error are set to the same file descriptor.
10832 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
10833 .vindex "&$value$&"
10834 If the command succeeds (gives a zero return code) <&'string1'&> is expanded
10835 and replaces the entire item; during this expansion, the standard output/error
10836 from the command is in the variable &$value$&. If the command fails,
10837 <&'string2'&>, if present, is expanded and used. Once again, during the
10838 expansion, the standard output/error from the command is in the variable
10841 If <&'string2'&> is absent, the result is empty. Alternatively, <&'string2'&>
10842 can be the word &"fail"& (not in braces) to force expansion failure if the
10843 command does not succeed. If both strings are omitted, the result is contents
10844 of the standard output/error on success, and nothing on failure.
10846 .vindex "&$run_in_acl$&"
10847 The standard output/error of the command is put in the variable &$value$&.
10848 In this ACL example, the output of a command is logged for the admin to
10851 warn condition = ${run{/usr/bin/id}{yes}{no}}
10852 log_message = Output of id: $value
10854 If the command requires shell idioms, such as the > redirect operator, the
10855 shell must be invoked directly, such as with:
10857 ${run{/bin/bash -c "/usr/bin/id >/tmp/id"}{yes}{yes}}
10859 Note that &$value$& will not persist beyond the reception of a single message.
10861 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
10862 The return code from the command is put in the variable &$runrc$&, and this
10863 remains set afterwards, so in a filter file you can do things like this:
10865 if "${run{x y z}{}}$runrc" is 1 then ...
10866 elif $runrc is 2 then ...
10870 If execution of the command fails (for example, the command does not exist),
10871 the return code is 127 &-- the same code that shells use for non-existent
10874 &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot assume the order in which
10875 option values are expanded, except for those preconditions whose order of
10876 testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot reliably expect to set &$runrc$&
10877 by the expansion of one option, and use it in another.
10879 The &(redirect)& router has an option called &%forbid_filter_run%& which locks
10880 out the use of this expansion item in filter files.
10883 .vitem &*${sg{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'regex'&>&*}{*&<&'replacement'&>&*}}*&
10884 .cindex "expansion" "string substitution"
10885 .cindex "&%sg%& expansion item"
10886 This item works like Perl's substitution operator (s) with the global (/g)
10887 option; hence its name. However, unlike the Perl equivalent, Exim does not
10888 modify the subject string; instead it returns the modified string for insertion
10889 into the overall expansion. The item takes three arguments: the subject string,
10890 a regular expression, and a substitution string. For example:
10892 ${sg{abcdefabcdef}{abc}{xyz}}
10894 yields &"xyzdefxyzdef"&. Because all three arguments are expanded before use,
10895 if any $, } or \ characters are required in the regular expression or in the
10896 substitution string, they have to be escaped. For example:
10898 ${sg{abcdef}{^(...)(...)\$}{\$2\$1}}
10900 yields &"defabc"&, and
10902 ${sg{1=A 4=D 3=C}{\N(\d+)=\N}{K\$1=}}
10904 yields &"K1=A K4=D K3=C"&. Note the use of &`\N`& to protect the contents of
10905 the regular expression from string expansion.
10907 The regular expression is compiled in 8-bit mode, working against bytes
10908 rather than any Unicode-aware character handling.
10911 .vitem &*${sort{*&<&'string'&>&*}{*&<&'comparator'&>&*}{*&<&'extractor'&>&*}}*&
10912 .cindex sorting "a list"
10913 .cindex list sorting
10914 .cindex expansion "list sorting"
10916 <&'string'&> first has the part after any change-of-list-separator
10917 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) expanded,
10918 then the whole is taken as a list.
10920 The default separator for the list is a colon.
10922 The <&'comparator'&> argument is interpreted as the operator
10923 of a two-argument expansion condition.
10924 The numeric operators plus ge, gt, le, lt (and ~i variants) are supported.
10925 The comparison should return true when applied to two values
10926 if the first value should sort before the second value.
10927 The <&'extractor'&> expansion is applied repeatedly to elements of the list,
10928 the element being placed in &$item$&,
10929 to give values for comparison.
10931 The item result is a sorted list,
10932 with the original list separator,
10933 of the list elements (in full) of the original.
10937 ${sort{3:2:1:4}{<}{$item}}
10939 sorts a list of numbers, and
10941 ${sort {${lookup dnsdb{>:,,mx=example.com}}} {<} {${listextract{1}{<,$item}}}}
10943 will sort an MX lookup into priority order.
10947 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
10948 SRS encoding. See section &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
10952 .vitem &*${substr{*&<&'start'&>&*}{*&<&'len'&>&*}{*&<&'subject'&>&*}}*&
10953 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
10954 .cindex "substring extraction"
10955 .cindex "expansion" "substring extraction"
10956 The three strings are expanded; the first two must yield numbers. Call them
10957 <&'n'&> and <&'m'&>. If you are using fixed values for these numbers, that is,
10958 if <&'start'&> and <&'len'&> do not change when they are expanded, you
10959 can use the simpler operator notation that avoids some of the braces:
10961 ${substr_<n>_<m>:<subject>}
10963 The second number is optional (in both notations).
10964 If it is absent in the simpler format, the preceding underscore must also be
10967 The &%substr%& item can be used to extract more general substrings than
10968 &%length%&. The first number, <&'n'&>, is a starting offset, and <&'m'&> is the
10969 length required. For example
10971 ${substr{3}{2}{$local_part}}
10973 If the starting offset is greater than the string length the result is the
10974 null string; if the length plus starting offset is greater than the string
10975 length, the result is the right-hand part of the string, starting from the
10976 given offset. The first byte (character) in the string has offset zero.
10978 The &%substr%& expansion item can take negative offset values to count
10979 from the right-hand end of its operand. The last byte (character) is offset -1,
10980 the second-last is offset -2, and so on. Thus, for example,
10982 ${substr{-5}{2}{1234567}}
10984 yields &"34"&. If the absolute value of a negative offset is greater than the
10985 length of the string, the substring starts at the beginning of the string, and
10986 the length is reduced by the amount of overshoot. Thus, for example,
10988 ${substr{-5}{2}{12}}
10990 yields an empty string, but
10992 ${substr{-3}{2}{12}}
10996 When the second number is omitted from &%substr%&, the remainder of the string
10997 is taken if the offset is positive. If it is negative, all bytes (characters) in the
10998 string preceding the offset point are taken. For example, an offset of -1 and
10999 no length, as in these semantically identical examples:
11002 ${substr{-1}{abcde}}
11004 yields all but the last character of the string, that is, &"abcd"&.
11006 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11010 .vitem "&*${tr{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'characters'&>&*}&&&
11011 {*&<&'replacements'&>&*}}*&"
11012 .cindex "expansion" "character translation"
11013 .cindex "&%tr%& expansion item"
11014 This item does single-character (in bytes) translation on its subject string. The second
11015 argument is a list of characters to be translated in the subject string. Each
11016 matching character is replaced by the corresponding character from the
11017 replacement list. For example
11019 ${tr{abcdea}{ac}{13}}
11021 yields &`1b3de1`&. If there are duplicates in the second character string, the
11022 last occurrence is used. If the third string is shorter than the second, its
11023 last character is replicated. However, if it is empty, no translation takes
11026 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11032 .section "Expansion operators" "SECTexpop"
11033 .cindex "expansion" "operators"
11034 For expansion items that perform transformations on a single argument string,
11035 the &"operator"& notation is used because it is simpler and uses fewer braces.
11036 The substring is first expanded before the operation is applied to it. The
11037 following operations can be performed:
11040 .vitem &*${address:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11041 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
11042 .cindex "&%address%& expansion item"
11043 The string is interpreted as an
11044 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11045 address, as it might appear in a
11046 header line, and the effective address is extracted from it. If the string does
11047 not parse successfully, the result is empty.
11049 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11052 .vitem &*${addresses:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11053 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2822 address handling"
11054 .cindex "&%addresses%& expansion item"
11055 The string (after expansion) is interpreted as a list of addresses in
11056 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11057 format, such as can be found in a &'To:'& or &'Cc:'& header line. The
11058 operative address (&'local-part@domain'&) is extracted from each item, and the
11059 result of the expansion is a colon-separated list, with appropriate
11060 doubling of colons should any happen to be present in the email addresses.
11061 Syntactically invalid RFC2822 address items are omitted from the output.
11063 It is possible to specify a character other than colon for the output
11064 separator by starting the string with > followed by the new separator
11065 character. For example:
11067 ${addresses:>& Chief <ceo@up.stairs>, sec@base.ment (dogsbody)}
11069 expands to &`ceo@up.stairs&&sec@base.ment`&. The string is expanded
11070 first, so if the expanded string starts with >, it may change the output
11071 separator unintentionally. This can be avoided by setting the output
11072 separator explicitly:
11074 ${addresses:>:$h_from:}
11077 Compare the &%address%& (singular)
11078 expansion item, which extracts the working address from a single RFC2822
11079 address. See the &%filter%&, &%map%&, and &%reduce%& items for ways of
11082 To clarify "list of addresses in RFC 2822 format" mentioned above, Exim follows
11083 a strict interpretation of header line formatting. Exim parses the bare,
11084 unquoted portion of an email address and if it finds a comma, treats it as an
11085 email address separator. For the example header line:
11087 From: =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>
11089 The first example below demonstrates that Q-encoded email addresses are parsed
11090 properly if it is given the raw header (in this example, &`$rheader_from:`&).
11091 It does not see the comma because it's still encoded as "=2C". The second
11092 example below is passed the contents of &`$header_from:`&, meaning it gets
11093 de-mimed. Exim sees the decoded "," so it treats it as &*two*& email addresses.
11094 The third example shows that the presence of a comma is skipped when it is
11095 quoted. The fourth example shows SMTPUTF8 handling.
11097 # exim -be '${addresses:From: \
11098 =?iso-8859-2?Q?Last=2C_First?= <user@example.com>}'
11100 # exim -be '${addresses:From: Last, First <user@example.com>}'
11101 Last:user@example.com
11102 # exim -be '${addresses:From: "Last, First" <user@example.com>}'
11104 # exim -be '${addresses:フィル <フィリップ@example.jp>}'
11108 .vitem &*${base32:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
11109 .cindex "&%base32%& expansion item"
11110 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
11111 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
11112 base 32 and output as a (empty, for zero) string of characters.
11113 Only lowercase letters are used.
11115 .vitem &*${base32d:*&<&'base-32&~digits'&>&*}*&
11116 .cindex "&%base32d%& expansion item"
11117 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 32"
11118 The string must consist entirely of base-32 digits.
11119 The number is converted to decimal and output as a string.
11121 .vitem &*${base62:*&<&'digits'&>&*}*&
11122 .cindex "&%base62%& expansion item"
11123 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
11124 The string must consist entirely of decimal digits. The number is converted to
11125 base 62 and output as a string of six characters, including leading zeros. In
11126 the few operating environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for
11127 its message identifiers (because those systems do not have case-sensitive
11128 filenames), base 36 is used by this operator, despite its name. &*Note*&: Just
11129 to be absolutely clear: this is &'not'& base64 encoding.
11131 .vitem &*${base62d:*&<&'base-62&~digits'&>&*}*&
11132 .cindex "&%base62d%& expansion item"
11133 .cindex "expansion" "conversion to base 62"
11134 The string must consist entirely of base-62 digits, or, in operating
11135 environments where Exim uses base 36 instead of base 62 for its message
11136 identifiers, base-36 digits. The number is converted to decimal and output as a
11139 .vitem &*${base64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11140 .cindex "expansion" "base64 encoding"
11141 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in string expansion"
11142 .cindex "&%base64%& expansion item"
11143 .cindex certificate "base64 of DER"
11144 This operator converts a string into one that is base64 encoded.
11146 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11147 returns the base64 encoding of the DER form of the certificate.
11150 .vitem &*${base64d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11151 .cindex "expansion" "base64 decoding"
11152 .cindex "base64 decoding" "in string expansion"
11153 .cindex "&%base64d%& expansion item"
11154 This operator converts a base64-encoded string into the un-coded form.
11157 .vitem &*${domain:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11158 .cindex "domain" "extraction"
11159 .cindex "expansion" "domain extraction"
11160 The string is interpreted as an
11161 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11162 address and the domain is extracted from it.
11163 If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
11166 .vitem &*${escape:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11167 .cindex "expansion" "escaping non-printing characters"
11168 .cindex "&%escape%& expansion item"
11169 If the string contains any non-printing characters, they are converted to
11170 escape sequences starting with a backslash. Whether characters with the most
11171 significant bit set (so-called &"8-bit characters"&) count as printing or not
11172 is controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& option.
11174 .vitem &*${escape8bit:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11175 .cindex "expansion" "escaping 8-bit characters"
11176 .cindex "&%escape8bit%& expansion item"
11177 If the string contains any characters with the most significant bit set,
11178 they are converted to escape sequences starting with a backslash.
11179 Backslashes and DEL characters are also converted.
11182 .vitem &*${eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${eval10:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11183 .cindex "expansion" "expression evaluation"
11184 .cindex "expansion" "arithmetic expression"
11185 .cindex "&%eval%& expansion item"
11186 These items supports simple arithmetic and bitwise logical operations in
11187 expansion strings. The string (after expansion) must be a conventional
11188 arithmetic expression, but it is limited to basic arithmetic operators, bitwise
11189 logical operators, and parentheses. All operations are carried out using
11190 integer arithmetic. The operator priorities are as follows (the same as in the
11191 C programming language):
11193 .irow &'highest:'& "not (~), negate (-)"
11194 .irow "" "multiply (*), divide (/), remainder (%)"
11195 .irow "" "plus (+), minus (-)"
11196 .irow "" "shift-left (<<), shift-right (>>)"
11197 .irow "" "and (&&)"
11199 .irow &'lowest:'& "or (|)"
11201 Binary operators with the same priority are evaluated from left to right. White
11202 space is permitted before or after operators.
11204 For &%eval%&, numbers may be decimal, octal (starting with &"0"&) or
11205 hexadecimal (starting with &"0x"&). For &%eval10%&, all numbers are taken as
11206 decimal, even if they start with a leading zero; hexadecimal numbers are not
11207 permitted. This can be useful when processing numbers extracted from dates or
11208 times, which often do have leading zeros.
11210 A number may be followed by &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& to multiply it by 1024, 1024*1024
11212 respectively. Negative numbers are supported. The result of the computation is
11213 a decimal representation of the answer (without &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"&). For example:
11216 &`${eval:1+1} `& yields 2
11217 &`${eval:1+2*3} `& yields 7
11218 &`${eval:(1+2)*3} `& yields 9
11219 &`${eval:2+42%5} `& yields 4
11220 &`${eval:0xc&5} `& yields 4
11221 &`${eval:0xc|5} `& yields 13
11222 &`${eval:0xc^5} `& yields 9
11223 &`${eval:0xc>>1} `& yields 6
11224 &`${eval:0xc<<1} `& yields 24
11225 &`${eval:~255&0x1234} `& yields 4608
11226 &`${eval:-(~255&0x1234)} `& yields -4608
11229 As a more realistic example, in an ACL you might have
11233 {>{$rcpt_count}{10}} \
11236 {$recipients_count} \
11237 {${eval:$rcpt_count/2}} \
11240 message = Too many bad recipients
11242 The condition is true if there have been more than 10 RCPT commands and
11243 fewer than half of them have resulted in a valid recipient.
11246 .vitem &*${expand:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11247 .cindex "expansion" "re-expansion of substring"
11248 The &%expand%& operator causes a string to be expanded for a second time. For
11251 ${expand:${lookup{$domain}dbm{/some/file}{$value}}}
11253 first looks up a string in a file while expanding the operand for &%expand%&,
11254 and then re-expands what it has found.
11257 .vitem &*${from_utf8:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11259 .cindex "UTF-8" "conversion from"
11260 .cindex "expansion" "UTF-8 conversion"
11261 .cindex "&%from_utf8%& expansion item"
11262 The world is slowly moving towards Unicode, although there are no standards for
11263 email yet. However, other applications (including some databases) are starting
11264 to store data in Unicode, using UTF-8 encoding. This operator converts from a
11265 UTF-8 string to an ISO-8859-1 string. UTF-8 code values greater than 255 are
11266 converted to underscores. The input must be a valid UTF-8 string. If it is not,
11267 the result is an undefined sequence of bytes.
11269 Unicode code points with values less than 256 are compatible with ASCII and
11270 ISO-8859-1 (also known as Latin-1).
11271 For example, character 169 is the copyright symbol in both cases, though the
11272 way it is encoded is different. In UTF-8, more than one byte is needed for
11273 characters with code values greater than 127, whereas ISO-8859-1 is a
11274 single-byte encoding (but thereby limited to 256 characters). This makes
11275 translation from UTF-8 to ISO-8859-1 straightforward.
11278 .vitem &*${hash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11279 .cindex "hash function" "textual"
11280 .cindex "expansion" "textual hash"
11281 The &%hash%& operator is a simpler interface to the hashing function that can
11282 be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings that
11283 change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11285 ${hash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11287 See the description of the general &%hash%& item above for details. The
11288 abbreviation &%h%& can be used when &%hash%& is used as an operator.
11292 .vitem &*${headerwrap_*&<&'cols'&>&*_*&<&'limit'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11293 .cindex header "wrapping operator"
11294 .cindex expansion "header wrapping"
11295 This operator line-wraps its argument in a way useful for headers.
11296 The &'cols'& value gives the column number to wrap after,
11297 the &'limit'& gives a limit number of result characters to truncate at.
11298 Either just the &'limit'& and the preceding underbar, or both, can be omitted;
11299 the defaults are 80 and 998.
11300 Wrapping will be inserted at a space if possible before the
11301 column number is reached.
11302 Whitespace at a chosen wrap point is removed.
11303 A line-wrap consists of a newline followed by a tab,
11304 and the tab is counted as 8 columns.
11308 .vitem &*${hex2b64:*&<&'hexstring'&>&*}*&
11309 .cindex "base64 encoding" "conversion from hex"
11310 .cindex "expansion" "hex to base64"
11311 .cindex "&%hex2b64%& expansion item"
11312 This operator converts a hex string into one that is base64 encoded. This can
11313 be useful for processing the output of the various hashing functions.
11317 .vitem &*${hexquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11318 .cindex "quoting" "hex-encoded unprintable characters"
11319 .cindex "&%hexquote%& expansion item"
11320 This operator converts non-printable characters in a string into a hex
11321 escape form. Byte values between 33 (!) and 126 (~) inclusive are left
11322 as is, and other byte values are converted to &`\xNN`&, for example, a
11323 byte value 127 is converted to &`\x7f`&.
11326 .vitem &*${ipv6denorm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11327 .cindex "&%ipv6denorm%& expansion item"
11328 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11329 This expands an IPv6 address to a full eight-element colon-separated set
11330 of hex digits including leading zeroes.
11331 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11332 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11334 .vitem &*${ipv6norm:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11335 .cindex "&%ipv6norm%& expansion item"
11336 .cindex "IP address" normalisation
11337 .cindex "IP address" "canonical form"
11338 This converts an IPv6 address to canonical form.
11339 Leading zeroes of groups are omitted, and the longest
11340 set of zero-valued groups is replaced with a double colon.
11341 A trailing ipv4-style dotted-decimal set is converted to hex.
11342 Pure IPv4 addresses are converted to IPv4-mapped IPv6.
11345 .vitem &*${lc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11346 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11347 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11348 .cindex "lower casing"
11349 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11350 .cindex "&%lc%& expansion item"
11351 This forces the letters in the string into lower-case, for example:
11355 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11357 .vitem &*${length_*&<&'number'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11358 .cindex "expansion" "string truncation"
11359 .cindex "&%length%& expansion item"
11360 The &%length%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%length%& function that
11361 can be used when the parameter is a fixed number (as opposed to a string that
11362 changes when expanded). The effect is the same as
11364 ${length{<number>}{<string>}}
11366 See the description of the general &%length%& item above for details. Note that
11367 &%length%& is not the same as &%strlen%&. The abbreviation &%l%& can be used
11368 when &%length%& is used as an operator.
11369 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11372 .vitem &*${listcount:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11373 .cindex "expansion" "list item count"
11374 .cindex "list" "item count"
11375 .cindex "list" "count of items"
11376 .cindex "&%listcount%& expansion item"
11377 The part of the string after any leading change-of-separator is expanded,
11378 then the whole is interpreted as a list and the number of items is returned.
11381 .vitem &*${listnamed:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&&~and&~&*${listnamed_*&<&'type'&>&*:*&<&'name'&>&*}*&
11382 .cindex "expansion" "named list"
11383 .cindex "&%listnamed%& expansion item"
11384 The name is interpreted as a named list and the content of the list is returned,
11385 expanding any referenced lists, re-quoting as needed for colon-separation.
11386 If the optional type is given it must be one of "a", "d", "h" or "l"
11387 and selects address-, domain-, host- or localpart- lists to search among respectively.
11388 Otherwise all types are searched in an undefined order and the first
11389 matching list is returned.
11390 &*Note*&: Neither string-expansion of lists referenced by named-list syntax elements,
11391 nor expansion of lookup elements, is done by the &%listnamed%& operator.
11394 .vitem &*${local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11395 .cindex "expansion" "local part extraction"
11396 .cindex "&%local_part%& expansion item"
11397 The string is interpreted as an
11398 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11399 address and the local part is extracted from it.
11400 If the string does not parse successfully, the result is empty.
11401 The parsing correctly handles SMTPUTF8 Unicode in the string.
11404 .vitem &*${mask:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*& &&&
11405 &*${mask_n:*&<&'IP&~address'&>&*/*&<&'bit&~count'&>&*}*&
11406 .cindex "masked IP address"
11407 .cindex "IP address" "masking"
11408 .cindex "CIDR notation"
11409 .cindex "expansion" "IP address masking"
11410 .cindex "&%mask%& expansion item"
11411 If the form of the string to be operated on is not an IP address followed by a
11412 slash and an integer (that is, a network address in CIDR notation), the
11413 expansion fails. Otherwise, this operator converts the IP address to binary,
11414 masks off the least significant bits according to the bit count, and converts
11415 the result back to text, with mask appended. For example,
11417 ${mask:10.111.131.206/28}
11419 returns the string &"10.111.131.192/28"&.
11421 Since this operation is expected to
11422 be mostly used for looking up masked addresses in files, the
11425 address uses dots to separate components instead of colons, because colon
11426 terminates a key string in lsearch files. So, for example,
11428 ${mask:3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031/99}
11432 3ffe.ffff.836f.0a00.000a.0800.2000.0000/99
11434 If the optional form &*mask_n*& is used, IPv6 address result are instead
11435 returned in normailsed form, using colons and with zero-compression.
11436 Letters in IPv6 addresses are always output in lower case.
11439 .vitem &*${md5:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11441 .cindex "expansion" "MD5 hash"
11442 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11443 .cindex "&%md5%& expansion item"
11444 The &%md5%& operator computes the MD5 hash value of the string, and returns it
11445 as a 32-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in lower case.
11447 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11448 returns the MD5 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11451 .vitem &*${nhash_*&<&'n'&>&*_*&<&'m'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11452 .cindex "expansion" "numeric hash"
11453 .cindex "hash function" "numeric"
11454 The &%nhash%& operator is a simpler interface to the numeric hashing function
11455 that can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to
11456 strings that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11458 ${nhash{<n>}{<m>}{<string>}}
11460 See the description of the general &%nhash%& item above for details.
11463 .vitem &*${quote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11464 .cindex "quoting" "in string expansions"
11465 .cindex "expansion" "quoting"
11466 .cindex "&%quote%& expansion item"
11467 The &%quote%& operator puts its argument into double quotes if it
11468 is an empty string or
11469 contains anything other than letters, digits, underscores, dots, and hyphens.
11470 Any occurrences of double quotes and backslashes are escaped with a backslash.
11471 Newlines and carriage returns are converted to &`\n`& and &`\r`&,
11472 respectively For example,
11480 The place where this is useful is when the argument is a substitution from a
11481 variable or a message header.
11483 .vitem &*${quote_local_part:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11484 .cindex "&%quote_local_part%& expansion item"
11485 This operator is like &%quote%&, except that it quotes the string only if
11486 required to do so by the rules of
11487 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
11488 for quoting local parts. For example,
11489 a plus sign would not cause quoting (but it would for &%quote%&).
11490 If you are creating a new email address from the contents of &$local_part$&
11491 (or any other unknown data), you should always use this operator.
11493 This quoting determination is not SMTPUTF8-aware, thus quoting non-ASCII data
11494 will likely use the quoting form.
11495 Thus &'${quote_local_part:フィル}'& will always become &'"フィル"'&.
11498 .vitem &*${quote_*&<&'lookup-type'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11499 .cindex "quoting" "lookup-specific"
11500 This operator applies lookup-specific quoting rules to the string. Each
11501 query-style lookup type has its own quoting rules which are described with
11502 the lookups in chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&. For example,
11504 ${quote_ldap:two * two}
11510 For single-key lookup types, no quoting is ever necessary and this operator
11511 yields an unchanged string.
11514 .vitem &*${randint:*&<&'n'&>&*}*&
11515 .cindex "random number"
11516 This operator returns a somewhat random number which is less than the
11517 supplied number and is at least 0. The quality of this randomness depends
11518 on how Exim was built; the values are not suitable for keying material.
11519 If Exim is linked against OpenSSL then RAND_pseudo_bytes() is used.
11520 If Exim is linked against GnuTLS then gnutls_rnd(GNUTLS_RND_NONCE) is used,
11521 for versions of GnuTLS with that function.
11522 Otherwise, the implementation may be arc4random(), random() seeded by
11523 srandomdev() or srandom(), or a custom implementation even weaker than
11527 .vitem &*${reverse_ip:*&<&'ipaddr'&>&*}*&
11528 .cindex "expansion" "IP address"
11529 This operator reverses an IP address; for IPv4 addresses, the result is in
11530 dotted-quad decimal form, while for IPv6 addresses the result is in
11531 dotted-nibble hexadecimal form. In both cases, this is the "natural" form
11532 for DNS. For example,
11534 ${reverse_ip:192.0.2.4}
11535 ${reverse_ip:2001:0db8:c42:9:1:abcd:192.0.2.127}
11540 f.7.2.0.0.0.0.c.d.c.b.a.1.0.0.0.9.0.0.0.2.4.c.0.8.b.d.0.1.0.0.2
11544 .vitem &*${rfc2047:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11545 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11546 .cindex "RFC 2047" "expansion operator"
11547 .cindex "&%rfc2047%& expansion item"
11548 This operator encodes text according to the rules of
11549 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047). This is an
11550 encoding that is used in header lines to encode non-ASCII characters. It is
11551 assumed that the input string is in the encoding specified by the
11552 &%headers_charset%& option, which gets its default at build time. If the string
11553 contains only characters in the range 33&--126, and no instances of the
11556 ? = ( ) < > @ , ; : \ " . [ ] _
11558 it is not modified. Otherwise, the result is the RFC 2047 encoding of the
11559 string, using as many &"encoded words"& as necessary to encode all the
11563 .vitem &*${rfc2047d:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11564 .cindex "expansion" "RFC 2047"
11565 .cindex "RFC 2047" "decoding"
11566 .cindex "&%rfc2047d%& expansion item"
11567 This operator decodes strings that are encoded as per
11568 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047).
11570 bytes are replaced by question marks. Characters are converted into the
11571 character set defined by &%headers_charset%&. Overlong RFC 2047 &"words"& are
11572 not recognized unless &%check_rfc2047_length%& is set false.
11574 &*Note*&: If you use &%$header%&_&'xxx'&&*:*& (or &%$h%&_&'xxx'&&*:*&) to
11575 access a header line, RFC 2047 decoding is done automatically. You do not need
11576 to use this operator as well.
11580 .vitem &*${rxquote:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11581 .cindex "quoting" "in regular expressions"
11582 .cindex "regular expressions" "quoting"
11583 .cindex "&%rxquote%& expansion item"
11584 The &%rxquote%& operator inserts a backslash before any non-alphanumeric
11585 characters in its argument. This is useful when substituting the values of
11586 variables or headers inside regular expressions.
11589 .vitem &*${sha1:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11590 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11591 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-1 hashing"
11592 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11593 .cindex "&%sha1%& expansion item"
11594 The &%sha1%& operator computes the SHA-1 hash value of the string, and returns
11595 it as a 40-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11597 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11598 returns the SHA-1 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11601 .vitem &*${sha256:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11602 &*${sha2:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11603 &*${sha2_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11604 .cindex "SHA-256 hash"
11605 .cindex "SHA-2 hash"
11606 .cindex certificate fingerprint
11607 .cindex "expansion" "SHA-256 hashing"
11608 .cindex "&%sha256%& expansion item"
11609 .cindex "&%sha2%& expansion item"
11610 The &%sha256%& operator computes the SHA-256 hash value of the string
11612 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11614 If the string is a single variable of type certificate,
11615 returns the SHA-256 hash fingerprint of the certificate.
11617 The operator can also be spelled &%sha2%& and does the same as &%sha256%&
11618 (except for certificates, which are not supported).
11619 Finally, if an underbar
11620 and a number is appended it specifies the output length, selecting a
11621 member of the SHA-2 family of hash functions.
11622 Values of 256, 384 and 512 are accepted, with 256 being the default.
11625 .vitem &*${sha3:*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
11626 &*${sha3_<n>:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11627 .cindex "SHA3 hash"
11628 .cindex "expansion" "SHA3 hashing"
11629 .cindex "&%sha3%& expansion item"
11630 The &%sha3%& operator computes the SHA3-256 hash value of the string
11632 it as a 64-digit hexadecimal number, in which any letters are in upper case.
11634 If a number is appended, separated by an underbar, it specifies
11635 the output length. Values of 224, 256, 384 and 512 are accepted;
11636 with 256 being the default.
11638 The &%sha3%& expansion item is only supported if Exim has been
11639 compiled with GnuTLS 3.5.0 or later,
11640 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later.
11641 The macro "_CRYPTO_HASH_SHA3" will be defined if it is supported.
11644 .vitem &*${stat:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11645 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
11646 .cindex "file" "extracting characteristics"
11647 .cindex "&%stat%& expansion item"
11648 The string, after expansion, must be a file path. A call to the &[stat()]&
11649 function is made for this path. If &[stat()]& fails, an error occurs and the
11650 expansion fails. If it succeeds, the data from the stat replaces the item, as a
11651 series of <&'name'&>=<&'value'&> pairs, where the values are all numerical,
11652 except for the value of &"smode"&. The names are: &"mode"& (giving the mode as
11653 a 4-digit octal number), &"smode"& (giving the mode in symbolic format as a
11654 10-character string, as for the &'ls'& command), &"inode"&, &"device"&,
11655 &"links"&, &"uid"&, &"gid"&, &"size"&, &"atime"&, &"mtime"&, and &"ctime"&. You
11656 can extract individual fields using the &%extract%& expansion item.
11658 The use of the &%stat%& expansion in users' filter files can be locked out by
11659 the system administrator. &*Warning*&: The file size may be incorrect on 32-bit
11660 systems for files larger than 2GB.
11662 .vitem &*${str2b64:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11663 .cindex "&%str2b64%& expansion item"
11664 Now deprecated, a synonym for the &%base64%& expansion operator.
11668 .vitem &*${strlen:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11669 .cindex "expansion" "string length"
11670 .cindex "string" "length in expansion"
11671 .cindex "&%strlen%& expansion item"
11672 The item is replaced by the length of the expanded string, expressed as a
11673 decimal number. &*Note*&: Do not confuse &%strlen%& with &%length%&.
11674 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11677 .vitem &*${substr_*&<&'start'&>&*_*&<&'length'&>&*:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11678 .cindex "&%substr%& expansion item"
11679 .cindex "substring extraction"
11680 .cindex "expansion" "substring expansion"
11681 The &%substr%& operator is a simpler interface to the &%substr%& function that
11682 can be used when the two parameters are fixed numbers (as opposed to strings
11683 that change when expanded). The effect is the same as
11685 ${substr{<start>}{<length>}{<string>}}
11687 See the description of the general &%substr%& item above for details. The
11688 abbreviation &%s%& can be used when &%substr%& is used as an operator.
11689 All measurement is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware.
11691 .vitem &*${time_eval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11692 .cindex "&%time_eval%& expansion item"
11693 .cindex "time interval" "decoding"
11694 This item converts an Exim time interval such as &`2d4h5m`& into a number of
11697 .vitem &*${time_interval:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11698 .cindex "&%time_interval%& expansion item"
11699 .cindex "time interval" "formatting"
11700 The argument (after sub-expansion) must be a sequence of decimal digits that
11701 represents an interval of time as a number of seconds. It is converted into a
11702 number of larger units and output in Exim's normal time format, for example,
11705 .vitem &*${uc:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11706 .cindex "case forcing in strings"
11707 .cindex "string" "case forcing"
11708 .cindex "upper casing"
11709 .cindex "expansion" "case forcing"
11710 .cindex "&%uc%& expansion item"
11711 This forces the letters in the string into upper-case.
11712 Case is defined per the system C locale.
11714 .vitem &*${utf8clean:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11715 .cindex "correction of invalid utf-8 sequences in strings"
11716 .cindex "utf-8" "utf-8 sequences"
11717 .cindex "incorrect utf-8"
11718 .cindex "expansion" "utf-8 forcing"
11719 .cindex "&%utf8clean%& expansion item"
11720 This replaces any invalid utf-8 sequence in the string by the character &`?`&.
11721 In versions of Exim before 4.92, this did not correctly do so for a truncated
11722 final codepoint's encoding, and the character would be silently dropped.
11723 If you must handle detection of this scenario across both sets of Exim behavior,
11724 the complexity will depend upon the task.
11725 For instance, to detect if the first character is multibyte and a 1-byte
11726 extraction can be successfully used as a path component (as is common for
11727 dividing up delivery folders), you might use:
11729 condition = ${if inlist{${utf8clean:${length_1:$local_part}}}{:?}{yes}{no}}
11731 (which will false-positive if the first character of the local part is a
11732 literal question mark).
11734 .vitem "&*${utf8_domain_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11735 "&*${utf8_domain_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11736 "&*${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&" &&&
11737 "&*${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&"
11738 .cindex expansion UTF-8
11739 .cindex UTF-8 expansion
11741 .cindex internationalisation
11742 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11743 .cindex "&%utf8_domain_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11744 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_to_alabel%& expansion item"
11745 .cindex "&%utf8_localpart_from_alabel%& expansion item"
11746 These convert EAI mail name components between UTF-8 and a-label forms.
11747 For information on internationalisation support see &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
11750 .vitem &*${xtextd:*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11751 .cindex "text forcing in strings"
11752 .cindex "string" "xtext decoding"
11754 .cindex "&%xtextd%& expansion item"
11755 This performs xtext decoding of the string (per
11756 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461) section 4).
11767 .section "Expansion conditions" "SECTexpcond"
11768 .scindex IIDexpcond "expansion" "conditions"
11769 The following conditions are available for testing by the &%${if%& construct
11770 while expanding strings:
11773 .vitem &*!*&<&'condition'&>
11774 .cindex "expansion" "negating a condition"
11775 .cindex "negation" "in expansion condition"
11776 Preceding any condition with an exclamation mark negates the result of the
11779 .vitem <&'symbolic&~operator'&>&~&*{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11780 .cindex "numeric comparison"
11781 .cindex "expansion" "numeric comparison"
11782 There are a number of symbolic operators for doing numeric comparisons. They
11784 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
11786 .irow "== " "equal"
11787 .irow "> " "greater"
11788 .irow ">= " "greater or equal"
11790 .irow "<= " "less or equal"
11794 ${if >{$message_size}{10M} ...
11796 Note that the general negation operator provides for inequality testing. The
11797 two strings must take the form of optionally signed decimal integers,
11798 optionally followed by one of the letters &"K"&, &"M"& or &"G"& (in either upper or
11799 lower case), signifying multiplication by 1024, 1024*1024 or 1024*1024*1024, respectively.
11800 As a special case, the numerical value of an empty string is taken as
11803 In all cases, a relative comparator OP is testing if <&'string1'&> OP
11804 <&'string2'&>; the above example is checking if &$message_size$& is larger than
11805 10M, not if 10M is larger than &$message_size$&.
11808 .vitem &*acl&~{{*&<&'name'&>&*}{*&<&'arg1'&>&*}&&&
11809 {*&<&'arg2'&>&*}...}*&
11810 .cindex "expansion" "calling an acl"
11811 .cindex "&%acl%&" "expansion condition"
11812 The name and zero to nine argument strings are first expanded separately. The expanded
11813 arguments are assigned to the variables &$acl_arg1$& to &$acl_arg9$& in order.
11814 Any unused are made empty. The variable &$acl_narg$& is set to the number of
11815 arguments. The named ACL (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&) is called
11816 and may use the variables; if another acl expansion is used the values
11817 are restored after it returns. If the ACL sets
11818 a value using a "message =" modifier the variable $value becomes
11819 the result of the expansion, otherwise it is empty.
11820 If the ACL returns accept the condition is true; if deny, false.
11821 If the ACL returns defer the result is a forced-fail.
11823 .vitem &*bool&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11824 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11825 .cindex "&%bool%& expansion condition"
11826 This condition turns a string holding a true or false representation into
11827 a boolean state. It parses &"true"&, &"false"&, &"yes"& and &"no"&
11828 (case-insensitively); also integer numbers map to true if non-zero,
11830 An empty string is treated as false.
11831 Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored;
11832 thus a string consisting only of whitespace is false.
11833 All other string values will result in expansion failure.
11835 When combined with ACL variables, this expansion condition will let you
11836 make decisions in one place and act on those decisions in another place.
11839 ${if bool{$acl_m_privileged_sender} ...
11843 .vitem &*bool_lax&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
11844 .cindex "expansion" "boolean parsing"
11845 .cindex "&%bool_lax%& expansion condition"
11846 Like &%bool%&, this condition turns a string into a boolean state. But
11847 where &%bool%& accepts a strict set of strings, &%bool_lax%& uses the same
11848 loose definition that the Router &%condition%& option uses. The empty string
11849 and the values &"false"&, &"no"& and &"0"& map to false, all others map to
11850 true. Leading and trailing whitespace is ignored.
11852 Note that where &"bool{00}"& is false, &"bool_lax{00}"& is true.
11854 .vitem &*crypteq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11855 .cindex "expansion" "encrypted comparison"
11856 .cindex "encrypted strings, comparing"
11857 .cindex "&%crypteq%& expansion condition"
11858 This condition is included in the Exim binary if it is built to support any
11859 authentication mechanisms (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). Otherwise, it is
11860 necessary to define SUPPORT_CRYPTEQ in &_Local/Makefile_& to get &%crypteq%&
11861 included in the binary.
11863 The &%crypteq%& condition has two arguments. The first is encrypted and
11864 compared against the second, which is already encrypted. The second string may
11865 be in the LDAP form for storing encrypted strings, which starts with the
11866 encryption type in curly brackets, followed by the data. If the second string
11867 does not begin with &"{"& it is assumed to be encrypted with &[crypt()]& or
11868 &[crypt16()]& (see below), since such strings cannot begin with &"{"&.
11869 Typically this will be a field from a password file. An example of an encrypted
11870 string in LDAP form is:
11872 {md5}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==
11874 If such a string appears directly in an expansion, the curly brackets have to
11875 be quoted, because they are part of the expansion syntax. For example:
11877 ${if crypteq {test}{\{md5\}CY9rzUYh03PK3k6DJie09g==}{yes}{no}}
11879 The following encryption types (whose names are matched case-independently) are
11884 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in encrypted password"
11885 &%{md5}%& computes the MD5 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11886 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11887 length of the comparison string is 24, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded
11888 (as in the above example). If the length is 32, Exim assumes that it is a
11889 hexadecimal encoding of the MD5 digest. If the length not 24 or 32, the
11893 .cindex "SHA-1 hash"
11894 &%{sha1}%& computes the SHA-1 digest of the first string, and expresses this as
11895 printable characters to compare with the remainder of the second string. If the
11896 length of the comparison string is 28, Exim assumes that it is base64 encoded.
11897 If the length is 40, Exim assumes that it is a hexadecimal encoding of the
11898 SHA-1 digest. If the length is not 28 or 40, the comparison fails.
11901 .cindex "&[crypt()]&"
11902 &%{crypt}%& calls the &[crypt()]& function, which traditionally used to use
11903 only the first eight characters of the password. However, in modern operating
11904 systems this is no longer true, and in many cases the entire password is used,
11905 whatever its length.
11908 .cindex "&[crypt16()]&"
11909 &%{crypt16}%& calls the &[crypt16()]& function, which was originally created to
11910 use up to 16 characters of the password in some operating systems. Again, in
11911 modern operating systems, more characters may be used.
11913 Exim has its own version of &[crypt16()]&, which is just a double call to
11914 &[crypt()]&. For operating systems that have their own version, setting
11915 HAVE_CRYPT16 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim causes it to use the
11916 operating system version instead of its own. This option is set by default in
11917 the OS-dependent &_Makefile_& for those operating systems that are known to
11918 support &[crypt16()]&.
11920 Some years after Exim's &[crypt16()]& was implemented, a user discovered that
11921 it was not using the same algorithm as some operating systems' versions. It
11922 turns out that as well as &[crypt16()]& there is a function called
11923 &[bigcrypt()]& in some operating systems. This may or may not use the same
11924 algorithm, and both of them may be different to Exim's built-in &[crypt16()]&.
11926 However, since there is now a move away from the traditional &[crypt()]&
11927 functions towards using SHA1 and other algorithms, tidying up this area of
11928 Exim is seen as very low priority.
11930 If you do not put a encryption type (in curly brackets) in a &%crypteq%&
11931 comparison, the default is usually either &`{crypt}`& or &`{crypt16}`&, as
11932 determined by the setting of DEFAULT_CRYPT in &_Local/Makefile_&. The default
11933 default is &`{crypt}`&. Whatever the default, you can always use either
11934 function by specifying it explicitly in curly brackets.
11936 .vitem &*def:*&<&'variable&~name'&>
11937 .cindex "expansion" "checking for empty variable"
11938 .cindex "&%def%& expansion condition"
11939 The &%def%& condition must be followed by the name of one of the expansion
11940 variables defined in section &<<SECTexpvar>>&. The condition is true if the
11941 variable does not contain the empty string. For example:
11943 ${if def:sender_ident {from $sender_ident}}
11945 Note that the variable name is given without a leading &%$%& character. If the
11946 variable does not exist, the expansion fails.
11948 .vitem "&*def:header_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&&~&~or&~&&&
11949 &~&*def:h_*&<&'header&~name'&>&*:*&"
11950 .cindex "expansion" "checking header line existence"
11951 This condition is true if a message is being processed and the named header
11952 exists in the message. For example,
11954 ${if def:header_reply-to:{$h_reply-to:}{$h_from:}}
11956 &*Note*&: No &%$%& appears before &%header_%& or &%h_%& in the condition, and
11957 the header name must be terminated by a colon if white space does not follow.
11959 .vitem &*eq&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
11960 &*eqi&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
11961 .cindex "string" "comparison"
11962 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
11963 .cindex "&%eq%& expansion condition"
11964 .cindex "&%eqi%& expansion condition"
11965 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the two
11966 resulting strings are identical. For &%eq%& the comparison includes the case of
11967 letters, whereas for &%eqi%& the comparison is case-independent, where
11968 case is defined per the system C locale.
11970 .vitem &*exists&~{*&<&'file&~name'&>&*}*&
11971 .cindex "expansion" "file existence test"
11972 .cindex "file" "existence test"
11973 .cindex "&%exists%&, expansion condition"
11974 The substring is first expanded and then interpreted as an absolute path. The
11975 condition is true if the named file (or directory) exists. The existence test
11976 is done by calling the &[stat()]& function. The use of the &%exists%& test in
11977 users' filter files may be locked out by the system administrator.
11979 &*Note:*& Testing a path using this condition is not a sufficient way of
11981 Consider using a dsearch lookup.
11983 .vitem &*first_delivery*&
11984 .cindex "delivery" "first"
11985 .cindex "first delivery"
11986 .cindex "expansion" "first delivery test"
11987 .cindex "&%first_delivery%& expansion condition"
11988 .cindex retry condition
11989 This condition, which has no data, is true during a message's first delivery
11990 attempt. It is false during any subsequent delivery attempts.
11993 .vitem "&*forall{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
11994 "&*forany{*&<&'a list'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
11995 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
11996 .cindex "expansion" "&*forall*& condition"
11997 .cindex "expansion" "&*forany*& condition"
11999 These conditions iterate over a list.
12001 The first argument, after any leading change-of-separator
12002 (see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
12003 is expanded and the whole forms the list.
12005 By default, the list separator is a colon.
12007 The second argument is interpreted as a condition that is to
12008 be applied to each item in the list in turn. During the interpretation of the
12009 condition, the current list item is placed in a variable called &$item$&.
12011 For &*forany*&, interpretation stops if the condition is true for any item, and
12012 the result of the whole condition is true. If the condition is false for all
12013 items in the list, the overall condition is false.
12015 For &*forall*&, interpretation stops if the condition is false for any item,
12016 and the result of the whole condition is false. If the condition is true for
12017 all items in the list, the overall condition is true.
12019 Note that negation of &*forany*& means that the condition must be false for all
12020 items for the overall condition to succeed, and negation of &*forall*& means
12021 that the condition must be false for at least one item.
12025 ${if forany{$recipients_list}{match{$item}{^user3@}}{yes}{no}}
12027 The value of &$item$& is saved and restored while &%forany%& or &%forall%& is
12028 being processed, to enable these expansion items to be nested.
12030 To scan a named list, expand it with the &*listnamed*& operator.
12032 .vitem "&*forall_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
12033 "&*forany_json{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
12034 "&*forall_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&" &&&
12035 "&*forany_jsons{*&<&'a JSON array'&>&*}{*&<&'a condition'&>&*}*&"
12036 .cindex JSON "iterative conditions"
12037 .cindex JSON expansions
12038 .cindex expansion "&*forall_json*& condition"
12039 .cindex expansion "&*forany_json*& condition"
12040 .cindex expansion "&*forall_jsons*& condition"
12041 .cindex expansion "&*forany_jsons*& condition"
12042 As for the above, except that the first argument must, after expansion,
12044 The array separator is not changeable.
12045 For the &"jsons"& variants the elements are expected to be JSON strings
12046 and have their quotes removed before the evaluation of the condition.
12050 .vitem &*ge&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12051 &*gei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12052 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12053 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12054 .cindex "&%ge%& expansion condition"
12055 .cindex "&%gei%& expansion condition"
12056 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12057 string is lexically greater than or equal to the second string. For &%ge%& the
12058 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gei%& the comparison is
12060 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12062 .vitem &*gt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12063 &*gti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12064 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12065 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12066 .cindex "&%gt%& expansion condition"
12067 .cindex "&%gti%& expansion condition"
12068 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12069 string is lexically greater than the second string. For &%gt%& the comparison
12070 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%gti%& the comparison is
12072 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12075 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
12076 SRS decode. See SECT &<<SECTSRS>>& for details.
12079 .vitem &*inlist&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*& &&&
12080 &*inlisti&~{*&<&'subject'&>&*}{*&<&'list'&>&*}*&
12081 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12082 .cindex "list" "iterative conditions"
12083 The <&'subject'&> string is expanded.
12085 The <&'list'&> first has any change-of-list-separator
12086 +(see &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) retained verbatim,
12087 +then the remainder is expanded.
12089 The whole is treated as a list of simple strings;
12090 if the subject string is a member of that list, then the condition is true.
12091 For the case-independent &%inlisti%& condition, case is defined per the system C locale.
12093 These are simpler to use versions of the more powerful &*forany*& condition.
12094 Examples, and the &*forany*& equivalents:
12096 ${if inlist{needle}{foo:needle:bar}}
12097 ${if forany{foo:needle:bar}{eq{$item}{needle}}}
12098 ${if inlisti{Needle}{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}}
12099 ${if forany{fOo:NeeDLE:bAr}{eqi{$item}{Needle}}}
12102 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12103 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12104 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
12105 .cindex "de-tainting" "using an inlist expansion condition"
12106 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
12108 ${if inlist {$h_mycode:} {0 : 1 : 42} {$value}}
12110 can be used for de-tainting.
12111 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12114 .vitem &*isip&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
12115 &*isip4&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*& &&&
12116 &*isip6&~{*&<&'string'&>&*}*&
12117 .cindex "IP address" "testing string format"
12118 .cindex "string" "testing for IP address"
12119 .cindex "&%isip%& expansion condition"
12120 .cindex "&%isip4%& expansion condition"
12121 .cindex "&%isip6%& expansion condition"
12122 The substring is first expanded, and then tested to see if it has the form of
12123 an IP address. Both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses are valid for &%isip%&, whereas
12124 &%isip4%& and &%isip6%& test specifically for IPv4 or IPv6 addresses.
12126 For an IPv4 address, the test is for four dot-separated components, each of
12127 which consists of from one to three digits. For an IPv6 address, up to eight
12128 colon-separated components are permitted, each containing from one to four
12129 hexadecimal digits. There may be fewer than eight components if an empty
12130 component (adjacent colons) is present. Only one empty component is permitted.
12132 &*Note*&: The checks used to be just on the form of the address; actual numerical
12133 values were not considered. Thus, for example, 999.999.999.999 passed the IPv4
12135 This is no longer the case.
12137 The main use of these tests is to distinguish between IP addresses and
12138 host names, or between IPv4 and IPv6 addresses. For example, you could use
12140 ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}...
12142 to test which IP version an incoming SMTP connection is using.
12144 .vitem &*ldapauth&~{*&<&'ldap&~query'&>&*}*&
12145 .cindex "LDAP" "use for authentication"
12146 .cindex "expansion" "LDAP authentication test"
12147 .cindex "&%ldapauth%& expansion condition"
12148 This condition supports user authentication using LDAP. See section
12149 &<<SECTldap>>& for details of how to use LDAP in lookups and the syntax of
12150 queries. For this use, the query must contain a user name and password. The
12151 query itself is not used, and can be empty. The condition is true if the
12152 password is not empty, and the user name and password are accepted by the LDAP
12153 server. An empty password is rejected without calling LDAP because LDAP binds
12154 with an empty password are considered anonymous regardless of the username, and
12155 will succeed in most configurations. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details
12156 of SMTP authentication, and chapter &<<CHAPplaintext>>& for an example of how
12160 .vitem &*le&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12161 &*lei&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12162 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12163 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12164 .cindex "&%le%& expansion condition"
12165 .cindex "&%lei%& expansion condition"
12166 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12167 string is lexically less than or equal to the second string. For &%le%& the
12168 comparison includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lei%& the comparison is
12170 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12172 .vitem &*lt&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*& &&&
12173 &*lti&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12174 .cindex "string" "comparison"
12175 .cindex "expansion" "string comparison"
12176 .cindex "&%lt%& expansion condition"
12177 .cindex "&%lti%& expansion condition"
12178 The two substrings are first expanded. The condition is true if the first
12179 string is lexically less than the second string. For &%lt%& the comparison
12180 includes the case of letters, whereas for &%lti%& the comparison is
12182 Case and collation order are defined per the system C locale.
12185 .vitem &*match&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12186 .cindex "expansion" "regular expression comparison"
12187 .cindex "regular expressions" "match in expanded string"
12188 .cindex "&%match%& expansion condition"
12189 The two substrings are first expanded. The second is then treated as a regular
12190 expression and applied to the first. Because of the pre-expansion, if the
12191 regular expression contains dollar, or backslash characters, they must be
12192 escaped. Care must also be taken if the regular expression contains braces
12193 (curly brackets). A closing brace must be escaped so that it is not taken as a
12194 premature termination of <&'string2'&>. The easiest approach is to use the
12195 &`\N`& feature to disable expansion of the regular expression.
12198 ${if match {$local_part}{\N^\d{3}\N} ...
12200 If the whole expansion string is in double quotes, further escaping of
12201 backslashes is also required.
12203 The condition is true if the regular expression match succeeds.
12204 The regular expression is not required to begin with a circumflex
12205 metacharacter, but if there is no circumflex, the expression is not anchored,
12206 and it may match anywhere in the subject, not just at the start. If you want
12207 the pattern to match at the end of the subject, you must include the &`$`&
12208 metacharacter at an appropriate point.
12209 All character handling is done in bytes and is not UTF-8 aware,
12210 but we might change this in a future Exim release.
12212 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%if%& expansion"
12213 At the start of an &%if%& expansion the values of the numeric variable
12214 substitutions &$1$& etc. are remembered. Obeying a &%match%& condition that
12215 succeeds causes them to be reset to the substrings of that condition and they
12216 will have these values during the expansion of the success string. At the end
12217 of the &%if%& expansion, the previous values are restored. After testing a
12218 combination of conditions using &%or%&, the subsequent values of the numeric
12219 variables are those of the condition that succeeded.
12221 .vitem &*match_address&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12222 .cindex "&%match_address%& expansion condition"
12223 See &*match_local_part*&.
12225 .vitem &*match_domain&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12226 .cindex "&%match_domain%& expansion condition"
12227 See &*match_local_part*&.
12229 .vitem &*match_ip&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12230 .cindex "&%match_ip%& expansion condition"
12231 This condition matches an IP address to a list of IP address patterns. It must
12232 be followed by two argument strings. The first (after expansion) must be an IP
12233 address or an empty string. The second (not expanded) is a restricted host
12234 list that can match only an IP address, not a host name. For example:
12236 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{1.2.3.4:5.6.7.8}{...}{...}}
12238 The specific types of host list item that are permitted in the list are:
12241 An IP address, optionally with a CIDR mask.
12243 A single asterisk, which matches any IP address.
12245 An empty item, which matches only if the IP address is empty. This could be
12246 useful for testing for a locally submitted message or one from specific hosts
12247 in a single test such as
12248 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
12249 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. This comment applies to
12250 . ==== the use of xmlto plus fop. There's no problem when formatting with
12251 . ==== sdop, with or without the extra indent.
12253 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{:4.3.2.1:...}{...}{...}}
12255 where the first item in the list is the empty string.
12257 The item @[] matches any of the local host's interface addresses.
12259 Single-key lookups are assumed to be like &"net-"& style lookups in host lists
12260 (see section &<<SECThoslispatsikey>>&),
12261 even if &`net-`& is not specified. There is never any attempt to turn the IP
12262 address into a host name. The most common type of linear search for
12263 &*match_ip*& is likely to be &*iplsearch*&, in which the file can contain CIDR
12264 masks. For example:
12266 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{iplsearch;/some/file}...
12268 It is of course possible to use other kinds of lookup, and in such a case, you
12269 do need to specify the &`net-`& prefix if you want to specify a specific
12270 address mask, for example:
12272 ${if match_ip{$sender_host_address}{net24-dbm;/some/file}...
12274 However, unless you are combining a &%match_ip%& condition with others, it is
12275 just as easy to use the fact that a lookup is itself a condition, and write:
12277 ${lookup{${mask:$sender_host_address/24}}dbm{/a/file}...
12281 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12282 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12284 For the latter case, only the part after any leading
12285 change-of-separator specification is expanded.
12288 Consult section &<<SECThoslispatip>>& for further details of these patterns.
12290 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12291 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12292 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12294 .vitem &*match_local_part&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*}{*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12295 .cindex "domain list" "in expansion condition"
12296 .cindex "address list" "in expansion condition"
12297 .cindex "local part" "list, in expansion condition"
12298 .cindex "&%match_local_part%& expansion condition"
12299 This condition, together with &%match_address%& and &%match_domain%&, make it
12300 possible to test domain, address, and local part lists within expansions. Each
12301 condition requires two arguments: an item and a list to match. A trivial
12304 ${if match_domain{a.b.c}{x.y.z:a.b.c:p.q.r}{yes}{no}}
12306 In each case, the second argument may contain any of the allowable items for a
12307 list of the appropriate type. Also, because the second argument
12308 is a standard form of list, it is possible to refer to a named list.
12309 Thus, you can use conditions like this:
12311 ${if match_domain{$domain}{+local_domains}{...
12313 .cindex "&`+caseful`&"
12314 For address lists, the matching starts off caselessly, but the &`+caseful`&
12315 item can be used, as in all address lists, to cause subsequent items
12316 (including those of referenced named lists)
12317 to have their local parts matched casefully.
12318 Domains are always matched caselessly.
12320 The variable &$value$& will be set for a successful match and can be
12321 used in the success clause of an &%if%& expansion item using the condition.
12322 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
12323 .cindex "de-tainting" "using a match_local_part expansion condition"
12324 It will have the same taint status as the list; expansions such as
12326 ${if match_local_part {$local_part} {alice : bill : charlotte : dave} {$value}}
12328 can be used for de-tainting.
12329 Any previous &$value$& is restored after the if.
12331 Note that <&'string2'&> is not itself subject to string expansion, unless
12332 Exim was built with the EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option.
12334 For the latter case, only the part after any leading
12335 change-of-separator specification is expanded.
12338 &*Note*&: Host lists are &'not'& supported in this way. This is because
12339 hosts have two identities: a name and an IP address, and it is not clear
12340 how to specify cleanly how such a test would work. However, IP addresses can be
12341 matched using &%match_ip%&.
12343 .vitem &*pam&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*:...}*&
12344 .cindex "PAM authentication"
12345 .cindex "AUTH" "with PAM"
12346 .cindex "Solaris" "PAM support"
12347 .cindex "expansion" "PAM authentication test"
12348 .cindex "&%pam%& expansion condition"
12349 &'Pluggable Authentication Modules'&
12350 (&url(https://mirrors.edge.kernel.org/pub/linux/libs/pam/)) are a facility that is
12351 available in Solaris
12352 and in some GNU/Linux distributions.
12353 The Exim support, which is intended for use in conjunction with
12354 the SMTP AUTH command, is available only if Exim is compiled with
12358 in &_Local/Makefile_&. You probably need to add &%-lpam%& to EXTRALIBS, and
12359 in some releases of GNU/Linux &%-ldl%& is also needed.
12361 The argument string is first expanded, and the result must be a
12362 colon-separated list of strings. Leading and trailing white space is ignored.
12363 The PAM module is initialized with the service name &"exim"& and the user name
12364 taken from the first item in the colon-separated data string (<&'string1'&>).
12365 The remaining items in the data string are passed over in response to requests
12366 from the authentication function. In the simple case there will only be one
12367 request, for a password, so the data consists of just two strings.
12369 There can be problems if any of the strings are permitted to contain colon
12370 characters. In the usual way, these have to be doubled to avoid being taken as
12372 The &%listquote%& expansion item can be used for this.
12373 For example, the configuration
12374 of a LOGIN authenticator might contain this setting:
12376 server_condition = ${if pam{$auth1:${listquote{:}{$auth2}}}}
12378 In some operating systems, PAM authentication can be done only from a process
12379 running as root. Since Exim is running as the Exim user when receiving
12380 messages, this means that PAM cannot be used directly in those systems.
12381 . --- 2018-09-07: the pam_exim modified variant has gone, removed claims re using Exim via that
12384 .vitem &*pwcheck&~{*&<&'string1'&>&*:*&<&'string2'&>&*}*&
12385 .cindex "&'pwcheck'& daemon"
12387 .cindex "expansion" "&'pwcheck'& authentication test"
12388 .cindex "&%pwcheck%& expansion condition"
12389 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'pwcheck'& daemon.
12390 This is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked by a process
12391 that is not running as root. &*Note*&: The use of &'pwcheck'& is now
12392 deprecated. Its replacement is &'saslauthd'& (see below).
12394 The pwcheck support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12395 the location of the pwcheck daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12396 building Exim. For example:
12398 CYRUS_PWCHECK_SOCKET=/var/pwcheck/pwcheck
12400 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12401 the pwcheck daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12402 from the Cyrus SASL library. Ensure that &'exim'& is the only user that has
12403 access to the &_/var/pwcheck_& directory.
12405 The &%pwcheck%& condition takes one argument, which must be the user name and
12406 password, separated by a colon. For example, in a LOGIN authenticator
12407 configuration, you might have this:
12409 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth1:$auth2}}
12411 Again, for a PLAIN authenticator configuration, this would be:
12413 server_condition = ${if pwcheck{$auth2:$auth3}}
12415 .vitem &*queue_running*&
12416 .cindex "queue runner" "detecting when delivering from"
12417 .cindex "expansion" "queue runner test"
12418 .cindex "&%queue_running%& expansion condition"
12419 This condition, which has no data, is true during delivery attempts that are
12420 initiated by queue runner processes, and false otherwise.
12423 .vitem &*radius&~{*&<&'authentication&~string'&>&*}*&
12425 .cindex "expansion" "Radius authentication"
12426 .cindex "&%radius%& expansion condition"
12427 Radius authentication
12428 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2865,RFC 2865))
12429 is supported in a similar way to PAM. You must
12430 set RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE in &_Local/Makefile_& to specify the location of
12431 the Radius client configuration file in order to build Exim with Radius
12434 With just that one setting, Exim expects to be linked with the &%radiusclient%&
12435 library, using the original API. If you are using release 0.4.0 or later of
12436 this library, you need to set
12438 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADIUSCLIENTNEW
12440 in &_Local/Makefile_& when building Exim. You can also link Exim with the
12441 &%libradius%& library that comes with FreeBSD. To do this, set
12443 RADIUS_LIB_TYPE=RADLIB
12445 in &_Local/Makefile_&, in addition to setting RADIUS_CONFIGURE_FILE.
12446 You may also have to supply a suitable setting in EXTRALIBS so that the
12447 Radius library can be found when Exim is linked.
12449 The string specified by RADIUS_CONFIG_FILE is expanded and passed to the
12450 Radius client library, which calls the Radius server. The condition is true if
12451 the authentication is successful. For example:
12453 server_condition = ${if radius{<arguments>}}
12457 .vitem "&*saslauthd&~{{*&<&'user'&>&*}{*&<&'password'&>&*}&&&
12458 {*&<&'service'&>&*}{*&<&'realm'&>&*}}*&"
12459 .cindex "&'saslauthd'& daemon"
12461 .cindex "expansion" "&'saslauthd'& authentication test"
12462 .cindex "&%saslauthd%& expansion condition"
12463 This condition supports user authentication using the Cyrus &'saslauthd'&
12464 daemon. This replaces the older &'pwcheck'& daemon, which is now deprecated.
12465 Using this daemon is one way of making it possible for passwords to be checked
12466 by a process that is not running as root.
12468 The saslauthd support is not included in Exim by default. You need to specify
12469 the location of the saslauthd daemon's socket in &_Local/Makefile_& before
12470 building Exim. For example:
12472 CYRUS_SASLAUTHD_SOCKET=/var/state/saslauthd/mux
12474 You do not need to install the full Cyrus software suite in order to use
12475 the saslauthd daemon. You can compile and install just the daemon alone
12476 from the Cyrus SASL library.
12478 Up to four arguments can be supplied to the &%saslauthd%& condition, but only
12479 two are mandatory. For example:
12481 server_condition = ${if saslauthd{{$auth1}{$auth2}}}
12483 The service and the realm are optional (which is why the arguments are enclosed
12484 in their own set of braces). For details of the meaning of the service and
12485 realm, and how to run the daemon, consult the Cyrus documentation.
12490 .section "Combining expansion conditions" "SECID84"
12491 .cindex "expansion" "combining conditions"
12492 Several conditions can be tested at once by combining them using the &%and%&
12493 and &%or%& combination conditions. Note that &%and%& and &%or%& are complete
12494 conditions on their own, and precede their lists of sub-conditions. Each
12495 sub-condition must be enclosed in braces within the overall braces that contain
12496 the list. No repetition of &%if%& is used.
12500 .vitem &*or&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12501 .cindex "&""or""& expansion condition"
12502 .cindex "expansion" "&""or""& of conditions"
12503 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12504 any one of the sub-conditions is true.
12507 ${if or {{eq{$local_part}{spqr}}{eq{$domain}{testing.com}}}...
12509 When a true sub-condition is found, the following ones are parsed but not
12510 evaluated. If there are several &"match"& sub-conditions the values of the
12511 numeric variables afterwards are taken from the first one that succeeds.
12513 .vitem &*and&~{{*&<&'cond1'&>&*}{*&<&'cond2'&>&*}...}*&
12514 .cindex "&""and""& expansion condition"
12515 .cindex "expansion" "&""and""& of conditions"
12516 The sub-conditions are evaluated from left to right. The condition is true if
12517 all of the sub-conditions are true. If there are several &"match"&
12518 sub-conditions, the values of the numeric variables afterwards are taken from
12519 the last one. When a false sub-condition is found, the following ones are
12520 parsed but not evaluated.
12522 .ecindex IIDexpcond
12527 .section "Expansion variables" "SECTexpvar"
12528 .cindex "expansion" "variables, list of"
12529 This section contains an alphabetical list of all the expansion variables. Some
12530 of them are available only when Exim is compiled with specific options such as
12531 support for TLS or the content scanning extension.
12532 .cindex "tainted data"
12533 Variables marked as &'tainted'& are likely to carry data supplied by
12534 a potential attacker.
12535 Variables without such marking may also, depending on how their
12536 values are created.
12537 Such variables should not be further expanded,
12539 or used as command-line arguments for external commands.
12542 .vitem "&$0$&, &$1$&, etc"
12543 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)"
12544 When a &%match%& expansion condition succeeds, these variables contain the
12545 captured substrings identified by the regular expression during subsequent
12546 processing of the success string of the containing &%if%& expansion item.
12547 In the expansion condition case
12548 they do not retain their values afterwards; in fact, their previous
12549 values are restored at the end of processing an &%if%& item. The numerical
12550 variables may also be set externally by some other matching process which
12551 precedes the expansion of the string. For example, the commands available in
12552 Exim filter files include an &%if%& command with its own regular expression
12553 matching condition.
12554 If the subject string was tainted then any captured substring will also be.
12556 .vitem "&$acl_arg1$&, &$acl_arg2$&, etc"
12557 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12558 any arguments are copied to these variables,
12559 any unused variables being made empty.
12561 .vitem "&$acl_c...$&"
12562 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& modifier in an ACL. They
12563 can be given any name that starts with &$acl_c$& and is at least six characters
12564 long, but the sixth character must be either a digit or an underscore. For
12565 example: &$acl_c5$&, &$acl_c_mycount$&. The values of the &$acl_c...$&
12566 variables persist throughout the lifetime of an SMTP connection. They can be
12567 used to pass information between ACLs and between different invocations of the
12568 same ACL. When a message is received, the values of these variables are saved
12569 with the message, and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports
12570 during subsequent delivery.
12572 .vitem "&$acl_m...$&"
12573 These variables are like the &$acl_c...$& variables, except that their values
12574 are reset after a message has been received. Thus, if several messages are
12575 received in one SMTP connection, &$acl_m...$& values are not passed on from one
12576 message to the next, as &$acl_c...$& values are. The &$acl_m...$& variables are
12577 also reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting a TLS session. When a
12578 message is received, the values of these variables are saved with the message,
12579 and can be accessed by filters, routers, and transports during subsequent
12582 .vitem &$acl_narg$&
12583 Within an acl condition, expansion condition or expansion item
12584 this variable has the number of arguments.
12586 .vitem &$acl_verify_message$&
12587 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
12588 After an address verification has failed, this variable contains the failure
12589 message. It retains its value for use in subsequent modifiers of the verb.
12590 The message can be preserved by coding like this:
12592 warn !verify = sender
12593 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
12595 You can use &$acl_verify_message$& during the expansion of the &%message%& or
12596 &%log_message%& modifiers, to include information about the verification
12598 &*Note*&: The variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
12600 .vitem &$address_data$&
12601 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
12602 This variable is set by means of the &%address_data%& option in routers. The
12603 value then remains with the address while it is processed by subsequent routers
12604 and eventually a transport. If the transport is handling multiple addresses,
12605 the value from the first address is used. See chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&
12606 for more details. &*Note*&: The contents of &$address_data$& are visible in
12609 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify
12610 a recipient address, the final value is still in the variable for subsequent
12611 conditions and modifiers of the ACL statement. If routing the address caused it
12612 to be redirected to just one address, the child address is also routed as part
12613 of the verification, and in this case the final value of &$address_data$& is
12614 from the child's routing.
12616 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
12617 sender address, the final value is also preserved, but this time in
12618 &$sender_address_data$&, to distinguish it from data from a recipient
12621 In both cases (recipient and sender verification), the value does not persist
12622 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve
12623 these values for longer, you can save them in ACL variables.
12625 .vitem &$address_file$&
12626 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
12627 When, as a result of aliasing, forwarding, or filtering, a message is directed
12628 to a specific file, this variable holds the name of the file when the transport
12629 is running. At other times, the variable is empty. For example, using the
12630 default configuration, if user &%r2d2%& has a &_.forward_& file containing
12632 /home/r2d2/savemail
12634 then when the &(address_file)& transport is running, &$address_file$&
12635 contains the text string &`/home/r2d2/savemail`&.
12636 .cindex "Sieve filter" "value of &$address_file$&"
12637 For Sieve filters, the value may be &"inbox"& or a relative folder name. It is
12638 then up to the transport configuration to generate an appropriate absolute path
12639 to the relevant file.
12641 .vitem &$address_pipe$&
12642 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
12643 When, as a result of aliasing or forwarding, a message is directed to a pipe,
12644 this variable holds the pipe command when the transport is running.
12647 .vitem &$atrn_host$&
12648 .vindex ATRN "data for routing"
12649 When an ATRN command is accepted, this variable is filled in with the client
12650 IP and port, for use in a manualroute router.
12652 .vitem &$atrn_mode$&
12655 When in provider mode this variable will contain &"P"&.
12656 When in customer mode it will contain &"C"&.
12657 Otherwise, it will be empty.
12660 .vitem "&$auth1$& &-- &$auth4$&"
12661 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
12662 These variables are used in SMTP authenticators (see chapters
12663 &<<CHAPplaintext>>&&--&<<CHAPtlsauth>>&). Elsewhere, they are empty.
12665 .vitem &$authenticated_id$&
12666 .cindex "authentication" "id"
12667 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
12668 When a server successfully authenticates a client it may be configured to
12669 preserve some of the authentication information in the variable
12670 &$authenticated_id$& (see chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&). For example, a
12671 user/password authenticator configuration might preserve the user name for use
12672 in the routers. Note that this is not the same information that is saved in
12673 &$sender_host_authenticated$&.
12675 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection)
12676 the value of &$authenticated_id$& is normally the login name of the calling
12677 process. However, a trusted user can override this by means of the &%-oMai%&
12678 command line option.
12679 This second case also sets up information used by the
12680 &$authresults$& expansion item.
12682 .vitem &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12683 .cindex "authentication" "fail" "id"
12684 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
12685 When an authentication attempt fails, the variable &$authenticated_fail_id$&
12686 will contain the failed authentication id. If more than one authentication
12687 id is attempted, it will contain only the last one. The variable is
12688 available for processing in the ACL's, generally the quit or notquit ACL.
12689 A message to a local recipient could still be accepted without requiring
12690 authentication, which means this variable could also be visible in all of
12694 .tvar &$authenticated_sender$&
12695 .cindex "sender" "authenticated"
12696 .cindex "authentication" "sender"
12697 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
12698 When acting as a server, Exim takes note of the AUTH= parameter on an incoming
12699 SMTP MAIL command if it believes the sender is sufficiently trusted, as
12700 described in section &<<SECTauthparamail>>&. Unless the data is the string
12701 &"<>"&, it is set as the authenticated sender of the message, and the value is
12702 available during delivery in the &$authenticated_sender$& variable. If the
12703 sender is not trusted, Exim accepts the syntax of AUTH=, but ignores the data.
12705 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
12706 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP connection), the
12707 value of &$authenticated_sender$& is an address constructed from the login
12708 name of the calling process and &$qualify_domain$&, except that a trusted user
12709 can override this by means of the &%-oMas%& command line option.
12712 .vitem &$authentication_failed$&
12713 .cindex "authentication" "failure"
12714 .vindex "&$authentication_failed$&"
12715 This variable is set to &"1"& in an Exim server if a client issues an AUTH
12716 command that does not succeed. Otherwise it is set to &"0"&. This makes it
12717 possible to distinguish between &"did not try to authenticate"&
12718 (&$sender_host_authenticated$& is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to
12719 &"0"&) and &"tried to authenticate but failed"& (&$sender_host_authenticated$&
12720 is empty and &$authentication_failed$& is set to &"1"&).
12721 Failure includes cancellation of a authentication attempt,
12722 and any negative response to an AUTH command,
12723 (including, for example, an attempt to use an undefined mechanism).
12725 .vitem &$av_failed$&
12726 .cindex "content scanning" "AV scanner failure"
12727 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
12728 extension. It is set to &"0"& by default, but will be set to &"1"& if any
12729 problem occurs with the virus scanner (specified by &%av_scanner%&) during
12730 the ACL malware condition.
12732 .vitem &$body_linecount$&
12733 .cindex "message body" "line count"
12734 .cindex "body of message" "line count"
12735 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
12736 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12737 number of lines in the message's body. See also &$message_linecount$&.
12739 .vitem &$body_zerocount$&
12740 .cindex "message body" "binary zero count"
12741 .cindex "body of message" "binary zero count"
12742 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
12743 .vindex "&$body_zerocount$&"
12744 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
12745 number of binary zero bytes (ASCII NULs) in the message's body.
12747 .vitem &$bounce_recipient$&
12748 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
12749 This is set to the recipient address of a bounce message while Exim is creating
12750 it. It is useful if a customized bounce message text file is in use (see
12751 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12753 .vitem &$bounce_return_size_limit$&
12754 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
12755 This contains the value set in the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& option, rounded
12756 up to a multiple of 1000. It is useful when a customized error message text
12757 file is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&).
12759 .vitem &$caller_gid$&
12760 .cindex "gid (group id)" "caller"
12761 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
12762 The real group id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12763 not the same as the group id of the originator of a message (see
12764 &$originator_gid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12765 incarnation normally contains the Exim gid.
12767 .vitem &$caller_uid$&
12768 .cindex "uid (user id)" "caller"
12769 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
12770 The real user id under which the process that called Exim was running. This is
12771 not the same as the user id of the originator of a message (see
12772 &$originator_uid$&). If Exim re-execs itself, this variable in the new
12773 incarnation normally contains the Exim uid.
12775 .vitem &$callout_address$&
12776 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
12777 After a callout for verification, spamd or malware daemon service, the
12778 address that was connected to.
12780 .vitem &$compile_number$&
12781 .vindex "&$compile_number$&"
12782 The building process for Exim keeps a count of the number
12783 of times it has been compiled. This serves to distinguish different
12784 compilations of the same version of Exim.
12786 .vitem &$config_dir$&
12787 .vindex "&$config_dir$&"
12788 The directory name of the main configuration file. That is, the content of
12789 &$config_file$& with the last component stripped. The value does not
12790 contain the trailing slash. If &$config_file$& does not contain a slash,
12791 &$config_dir$& is ".".
12793 .vitem &$config_file$&
12794 .vindex "&$config_file$&"
12795 The name of the main configuration file Exim is using.
12797 .vitem &$connection_id$&
12798 .vindex "&$connection_id$&"
12799 .cindex connection "identifier logging"
12800 An identifier for the accepted connection, for use in custom logging.
12802 .vitem &$dkim_verify_status$&
12803 Results of DKIM verification.
12804 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12806 .vitem &$dkim_cur_signer$& &&&
12807 &$dkim_verify_reason$& &&&
12808 &$dkim_domain$& &&&
12809 &$dkim_identity$& &&&
12810 &$dkim_selector$& &&&
12812 &$dkim_canon_body$& &&&
12813 &$dkim_canon_headers$& &&&
12814 &$dkim_copiedheaders$& &&&
12815 &$dkim_bodylength$& &&&
12816 &$dkim_created$& &&&
12817 &$dkim_expires$& &&&
12818 &$dkim_headernames$& &&&
12819 &$dkim_key_testing$& &&&
12820 &$dkim_key_nosubdomains$& &&&
12821 &$dkim_key_srvtype$& &&&
12822 &$dkim_key_granularity$& &&&
12823 &$dkim_key_notes$& &&&
12824 &$dkim_key_length$&
12825 These variables are only available within the DKIM ACL.
12826 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12828 .vitem &$dkim_signers$&
12829 .vindex &$dkim_signers$&
12830 When a message has been received this variable contains
12831 a colon-separated list of signer domains and identities for the message.
12832 For details see section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
12834 .vitem &$dmarc_alignment_spf$& &&&
12835 &$dmarc_alignment_dkim$& &&&
12836 &$dmarc_domain_policy$& &&&
12837 &$dmarc_status$& &&&
12838 &$dmarc_status_text$& &&&
12839 &$dmarc_used_domains$&
12840 Results of DMARC verification.
12841 For details see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
12843 .vitem &$dnslist_domain$& &&&
12844 &$dnslist_matched$& &&&
12845 &$dnslist_text$& &&&
12847 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
12848 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
12849 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
12850 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
12851 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
12852 When a DNS (black) list lookup succeeds, these variables are set to contain
12853 the following data from the lookup: the list's domain name, the key that was
12854 looked up, the contents of any associated TXT record, and the value from the
12855 main A record. See section &<<SECID204>>& for more details.
12858 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this variable
12859 contains the domain. Uppercase letters in the domain are converted into lower
12860 case for &$domain$&.
12862 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
12863 &$domain$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting. &$domain$&
12864 is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering, because a
12865 message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just once.
12867 When more than one address is being delivered at once (for example, several
12868 RCPT commands in one SMTP delivery), &$domain$& is set only if they all
12869 have the same domain. Transports can be restricted to handling only one domain
12870 at a time if the value of &$domain$& is required at transport time &-- this is
12871 the default for local transports. For further details of the environment in
12872 which local transports are run, see chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
12874 .oindex "&%delay_warning_condition%&"
12875 At the end of a delivery, if all deferred addresses have the same domain, it is
12876 set in &$domain$& during the expansion of &%delay_warning_condition%&.
12878 The &$domain$& variable is also used in some other circumstances:
12881 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$domain$& contains the domain of
12882 the recipient address. The domain of the &'sender'& address is in
12883 &$sender_address_domain$& at both MAIL time and at RCPT time. &$domain$& is not
12884 normally set during the running of the MAIL ACL. However, if the sender address
12885 is verified with a callout during the MAIL ACL, the sender domain is placed in
12886 &$domain$& during the expansions of &%hosts%&, &%interface%&, and &%port%& in
12887 the &(smtp)& transport.
12890 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
12891 &$domain$& contains the domain portion of the address that is being rewritten;
12892 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example, to
12893 rewrite domains by file lookup.
12896 With one important exception, whenever a domain list is being scanned,
12897 &$domain$& contains the subject domain. &*Exception*&: When a domain list in
12898 a &%sender_domains%& condition in an ACL is being processed, the subject domain
12899 is in &$sender_address_domain$& and not in &$domain$&. It works this way so
12900 that, in a RCPT ACL, the sender domain list can be dependent on the
12901 recipient domain (which is what is in &$domain$& at this time).
12904 .cindex "ETRN" "value of &$domain$&"
12905 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
12906 When the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option is being expanded, &$domain$& contains
12907 the complete argument of the ETRN command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&).
12910 .cindex "tainted data"
12911 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
12912 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and may not
12913 be further expanded or used as a filename.
12914 When an untainted version is needed, one should be obtained from
12915 looking up the value in a local (therefore trusted) database.
12916 Often &$domain_data$& is usable in this role.
12919 .vitem &$domain_data$&
12920 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
12921 When the &%domains%& condition on a router
12924 against a list, the match value is copied to &$domain_data$&.
12925 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
12926 applied to the data read by a lookup.
12927 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
12929 If the router routes the
12930 address to a transport, the value is available in that transport. If the
12931 transport is handling multiple addresses, the value from the first address is
12934 &$domain_data$& set in an ACL is available during
12935 the rest of the ACL statement.
12937 .vitem &$exim_gid$&
12938 .vindex "&$exim_gid$&"
12939 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim group id.
12941 .vitem &$exim_path$&
12942 .vindex "&$exim_path$&"
12943 This variable contains the path to the Exim binary.
12945 .vitem &$exim_uid$&
12946 .vindex "&$exim_uid$&"
12947 This variable contains the numerical value of the Exim user id.
12949 .vitem &$exim_version$&
12950 .vindex "&$exim_version$&"
12951 This variable contains the version string of the Exim build.
12952 The first character is a major version number, currently 4.
12953 Then after a dot, the next group of digits is a minor version number.
12954 There may be other characters following the minor version.
12955 This value may be overridden by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
12957 .vitem &$header_$&<&'name'&>
12959 This is not strictly an expansion variable. It is expansion syntax for
12960 inserting the message header line with the given name. Note that the name must
12961 be terminated by colon or white space, because it may contain a wide variety of
12962 characters. Note also that braces must &'not'& be used.
12963 See the full description in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& above.
12965 .vitem &$headers_added$&
12966 .vindex "&$headers_added$&"
12967 Within an ACL this variable contains the headers added so far by
12968 the ACL modifier add_header (section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
12969 The headers are a newline-separated list.
12973 When the &%check_local_user%& option is set for a router, the user's home
12974 directory is placed in &$home$& when the check succeeds. In particular, this
12975 means it is set during the running of users' filter files. A router may also
12976 explicitly set a home directory for use by a transport; this can be overridden
12977 by a setting on the transport itself.
12979 When running a filter test via the &%-bf%& option, &$home$& is set to the value
12980 of the environment variable HOME, which is subject to the
12981 &%keep_environment%& and &%add_environment%& main config options.
12985 If a router assigns an address to a transport (any transport), and passes a
12986 list of hosts with the address, the value of &$host$& when the transport starts
12987 to run is the name of the first host on the list. Note that this applies both
12988 to local and remote transports.
12990 .cindex "transport" "filter"
12991 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
12992 For the &(smtp)& transport, if there is more than one host, the value of
12993 &$host$& changes as the transport works its way through the list. In
12994 particular, when the &(smtp)& transport is expanding its options for encryption
12995 using TLS, or for specifying a transport filter (see chapter
12996 &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the host to which it
12999 When used in the client part of an authenticator configuration (see chapter
13000 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&), &$host$& contains the name of the server to which the
13001 client is connected.
13004 .vitem &$host_address$&
13005 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
13006 This variable is set to the remote host's IP address whenever &$host$& is set
13007 for a remote connection. It is also set to the IP address that is being checked
13008 when the &%ignore_target_hosts%& option is being processed.
13010 .vitem &$host_data$&
13011 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
13012 If a &%hosts%& condition in an ACL is satisfied by means of a lookup, the
13013 result of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
13014 allows you, for example, to do things like this:
13016 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
13017 message = $host_data
13020 .vitem &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13021 .cindex "host name" "lookup, failure of"
13022 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13023 This variable normally contains &"0"&, as does &$host_lookup_failed$&. When a
13024 message comes from a remote host and there is an attempt to look up the host's
13025 name from its IP address, and the attempt is not successful, one of these
13026 variables is set to &"1"&.
13029 If the lookup receives a definite negative response (for example, a DNS lookup
13030 succeeded, but no records were found), &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13033 If there is any kind of problem during the lookup, such that Exim cannot
13034 tell whether or not the host name is defined (for example, a timeout for a DNS
13035 lookup), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&.
13038 Looking up a host's name from its IP address consists of more than just a
13039 single reverse lookup. Exim checks that a forward lookup of at least one of the
13040 names it receives from a reverse lookup yields the original IP address. If this
13041 is not the case, Exim does not accept the looked up name(s), and
13042 &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&. Thus, being able to find a name from an
13043 IP address (for example, the existence of a PTR record in the DNS) is not
13044 sufficient on its own for the success of a host name lookup. If the reverse
13045 lookup succeeds, but there is a lookup problem such as a timeout when checking
13046 the result, the name is not accepted, and &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to
13047 &"1"&. See also &$sender_host_name$&.
13049 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
13050 Performing these checks sets up information used by the
13051 &%authresults%& expansion item.
13054 .vitem &$host_lookup_failed$&
13055 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13056 See &$host_lookup_deferred$&.
13058 .vitem &$host_port$&
13059 .vindex "&$host_port$&"
13060 This variable is set to the remote host's TCP port whenever &$host$& is set
13061 for an outbound connection.
13063 .vitem &$initial_cwd$&
13064 .vindex "&$initial_cwd$&
13065 This variable contains the full path name of the initial working
13066 directory of the current Exim process. This may differ from the current
13067 working directory, as Exim changes this to "/" during early startup, and
13068 to &$spool_directory$& later.
13071 .vindex "&$inode$&"
13072 The only time this variable is set is while expanding the &%directory_file%&
13073 option in the &(appendfile)& transport. The variable contains the inode number
13074 of the temporary file which is about to be renamed. It can be used to construct
13075 a unique name for the file.
13077 .vitem &$interface_address$& &&&
13079 .vindex "&$interface_address$&"
13080 .vindex "&$interface_port$&"
13081 These are obsolete names for &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
13085 This variable is used during the expansion of &*forall*& and &*forany*&
13086 conditions (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&), and &*filter*&, &*map*&, and
13087 &*reduce*& items (see section &<<SECTexpcond>>&). In other circumstances, it is
13091 .vindex "&$ldap_dn$&"
13092 This variable, which is available only when Exim is compiled with LDAP support,
13093 contains the DN from the last entry in the most recently successful LDAP
13096 .vitem &$load_average$&
13097 .vindex "&$load_average$&"
13098 This variable contains the system load average, multiplied by 1000 so that it
13099 is an integer. For example, if the load average is 0.21, the value of the
13100 variable is 210. The value is recomputed every time the variable is referenced.
13102 .tvar &$local_part$&
13103 When an address is being routed, or delivered on its own, this
13104 variable contains the local part. When a number of addresses are being
13105 delivered together (for example, multiple RCPT commands in an SMTP
13106 session), &$local_part$& is not set.
13108 Global address rewriting happens when a message is received, so the value of
13109 &$local_part$& during routing and delivery is the value after rewriting.
13110 &$local_part$& is set during user filtering, but not during system filtering,
13111 because a message may have many recipients and the system filter is called just
13114 .cindex "tainted data"
13115 If the origin of the data is an incoming message,
13116 the result of expanding this variable is tainted and
13117 may not be further expanded or used as a filename.
13119 &*Warning*&: the content of this variable is usually provided by a potential
13121 Consider carefully the implications of using it unvalidated as a name
13123 This presents issues for users' &_.forward_& and filter files.
13124 For traditional full user accounts, use &%check_local_users%& and the
13125 &$local_part_data$& variable rather than this one.
13126 For virtual users, store a suitable pathname component in the database
13127 which is used for account name validation, and use that retrieved value
13128 rather than this variable.
13129 Often &$local_part_data$& is usable in this role.
13130 If needed, use a router &%address_data%& or &%set%& option for
13131 the retrieved data.
13133 When a message is being delivered to a file, pipe, or autoreply transport as a
13134 result of aliasing or forwarding, &$local_part$& is set to the local part of
13135 the parent address, not to the filename or command (see &$address_file$& and
13138 When an ACL is running for a RCPT command, &$local_part$& contains the
13139 local part of the recipient address.
13141 When a rewrite item is being processed (see chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&),
13142 &$local_part$& contains the local part of the address that is being rewritten;
13143 it can be used in the expansion of the replacement address, for example.
13145 In all cases, all quoting is removed from the local part. For example, for both
13148 "abc:xyz"@test.example
13149 abc\:xyz@test.example
13151 the value of &$local_part$& is
13155 If you use &$local_part$& to create another address, you should always wrap it
13156 inside a quoting operator. For example, in a &(redirect)& router you could
13159 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@new.domain.example
13161 &*Note*&: The value of &$local_part$& is normally lower cased. If you want
13162 to process local parts in a case-dependent manner in a router, you can set the
13163 &%caseful_local_part%& option (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&).
13165 .vitem &$local_part_data$&
13166 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
13167 When the &%local_parts%& condition on a router or ACL
13168 matches a local part list
13169 the match value is copied to &$local_part_data$&.
13170 This is an enhancement over previous versions of Exim, when it only
13171 applied to the data read by a lookup.
13172 For details on match values see section &<<SECTlistresults>>& et. al.
13174 The &%check_local_user%& router option also sets this variable.
13176 .vindex &$local_part_prefix$& &&&
13177 &$local_part_prefix_v$& &&&
13178 &$local_part_suffix$& &&&
13179 &$local_part_suffix_v$&
13180 .cindex affix variables
13181 If a local part prefix or suffix has been recognized, it is not included in the
13182 value of &$local_part$& during routing and subsequent delivery. The values of
13183 any prefix or suffix are in &$local_part_prefix$& and
13184 &$local_part_suffix$&, respectively.
13185 .cindex "tainted data"
13186 If the specification did not include a wildcard then
13187 the affix variable value is not tainted.
13189 If the affix specification included a wildcard then the portion of
13190 the affix matched by the wildcard is in
13191 &$local_part_prefix_v$& or &$local_part_suffix_v$& as appropriate,
13192 and both the whole and varying values are tainted.
13194 .vitem &$local_scan_data$&
13195 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
13196 This variable contains the text returned by the &[local_scan()]& function when
13197 a message is received. See chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>& for more details.
13199 .vitem &$local_user_gid$&
13200 .vindex "&$local_user_gid$&"
13201 See &$local_user_uid$&.
13203 .vitem &$local_user_uid$&
13204 .vindex "&$local_user_uid$&"
13205 This variable and &$local_user_gid$& are set to the uid and gid after the
13206 &%check_local_user%& router precondition succeeds. This means that their values
13207 are available for the remaining preconditions (&%senders%&, &%require_files%&,
13208 and &%condition%&), for the &%address_data%& expansion, and for any
13209 router-specific expansions. At all other times, the values in these variables
13210 are &`(uid_t)(-1)`& and &`(gid_t)(-1)`&, respectively.
13212 .vitem &$localhost_number$&
13213 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
13214 This contains the expanded value of the
13215 &%localhost_number%& option. The expansion happens after the main options have
13218 .vitem &$log_inodes$&
13219 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
13220 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's
13221 log files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is
13222 referenced. If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes,
13223 the value of is -1. See also the &%check_log_inodes%& option.
13225 .vitem &$log_space$&
13226 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
13227 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk
13228 partition where Exim's log files are being written. The value is recalculated
13229 whenever the variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the
13230 ability to find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems),
13231 the space value is -1. See also the &%check_log_space%& option.
13234 .vitem &$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&
13235 .vindex "&$lookup_dnssec_authenticated$&"
13236 This variable is set after a DNS lookup done by
13237 a dnsdb lookup expansion, dnslookup router or smtp transport.
13238 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13239 It will be empty if &(DNSSEC)& was not requested,
13240 &"no"& if the result was not labelled as authenticated data
13241 and &"yes"& if it was.
13242 Results that are labelled as authoritative answer that match
13243 the &%dns_trust_aa%& configuration variable count also
13244 as authenticated data.
13246 .vitem &$mailstore_basename$&
13247 .vindex "&$mailstore_basename$&"
13248 This variable is set only when doing deliveries in &"mailstore"& format in the
13249 &(appendfile)& transport. During the expansion of the &%mailstore_prefix%&,
13250 &%mailstore_suffix%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& options, it
13251 contains the basename of the files that are being written, that is, the name
13252 without the &".tmp"&, &".env"&, or &".msg"& suffix. At all other times, this
13255 .vitem &$malware_name$&
13256 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
13257 This variable is available when Exim is compiled with the
13258 content-scanning extension. It is set to the name of the virus that was found
13259 when the ACL &%malware%& condition is true (see section &<<SECTscanvirus>>&).
13261 .vitem &$max_received_linelength$&
13262 .vindex "&$max_received_linelength$&"
13263 .cindex "maximum" "line length"
13264 .cindex "line length" "maximum"
13265 This variable contains the number of bytes in the longest line that was
13266 received as part of the message, not counting the line termination
13268 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13270 .vitem &$message_age$&
13271 .cindex "message" "age of"
13272 .vindex "&$message_age$&"
13273 This variable is set at the start of a delivery attempt to contain the number
13274 of seconds since the message was received. It does not change during a single
13277 .tvar &$message_body$&
13278 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13279 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13280 .cindex "binary zero" "in message body"
13281 .oindex "&%message_body_visible%&"
13282 This variable contains the initial portion of a message's body while it is
13283 being delivered, and is intended mainly for use in filter files. The maximum
13284 number of characters of the body that are put into the variable is set by the
13285 &%message_body_visible%& configuration option; the default is 500.
13287 .oindex "&%message_body_newlines%&"
13288 By default, newlines are converted into spaces in &$message_body$&, to make it
13289 easier to search for phrases that might be split over a line break. However,
13290 this can be disabled by setting &%message_body_newlines%& to be true. Binary
13291 zeros are always converted into spaces.
13293 .tvar &$message_body_end$&
13294 .cindex "body of message" "expansion variable"
13295 .cindex "message body" "in expansion"
13296 This variable contains the final portion of a message's
13297 body while it is being delivered. The format and maximum size are as for
13300 .vitem &$message_body_size$&
13301 .cindex "body of message" "size"
13302 .cindex "message body" "size"
13303 .vindex "&$message_body_size$&"
13304 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the size of the body
13305 in bytes. The count starts from the character after the blank line that
13306 separates the body from the header. Newlines are included in the count. See
13307 also &$message_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13309 If the spool file is wireformat
13310 (see the &%spool_wireformat%& main option)
13311 the CRLF line-terminators are included in the count.
13313 .vitem &$message_exim_id$&
13314 .vindex "&$message_exim_id$&"
13315 When a message is being received or delivered, this variable contains the
13316 unique message id that is generated and used by Exim to identify the message.
13317 An id is not created for a message until after its header has been successfully
13318 received. &*Note*&: This is &'not'& the contents of the &'Message-ID:'& header
13319 line; it is the local id that Exim assigns to the message, for example:
13320 &`1BXTIK-0001yO-VA`&.
13322 .tvar &$message_headers$&
13323 This variable contains a concatenation of all the header lines when a message
13324 is being processed, except for lines added by routers or transports. The header
13325 lines are separated by newline characters. Their contents are decoded in the
13326 same way as a header line that is inserted by &%bheader%&.
13328 .tvar &$message_headers_raw$&
13329 This variable is like &$message_headers$& except that no processing of the
13330 contents of header lines is done.
13332 .vitem &$message_id$&
13333 This is an old name for &$message_exim_id$&. It is now deprecated.
13335 .vitem &$message_linecount$&
13336 .vindex "&$message_linecount$&"
13337 This variable contains the total number of lines in the header and body of the
13338 message. Compare &$body_linecount$&, which is the count for the body only.
13339 During the DATA and content-scanning ACLs, &$message_linecount$& contains the
13340 number of lines received. Before delivery happens (that is, before filters,
13341 routers, and transports run) the count is increased to include the
13342 &'Received:'& header line that Exim standardly adds, and also any other header
13343 lines that are added by ACLs. The blank line that separates the message header
13344 from the body is not counted.
13346 As with the special case of &$message_size$&, during the expansion of the
13347 appendfile transport's maildir_tag option in maildir format, the value of
13348 &$message_linecount$& is the precise size of the number of newlines in the
13349 file that has been written (minus one for the blank line between the
13350 header and the body).
13352 Here is an example of the use of this variable in a DATA ACL:
13355 ${if <{250}{${eval:$message_linecount - $body_linecount}}}
13356 message = Too many lines in message header
13358 In the MAIL and RCPT ACLs, the value is zero because at that stage the
13359 message has not yet been received.
13361 This variable is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
13363 .vitem &$message_size$&
13364 .cindex "size" "of message"
13365 .cindex "message" "size"
13366 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
13367 When a message is being processed, this variable contains its size in bytes. In
13368 most cases, the size includes those headers that were received with the
13369 message, but not those (such as &'Envelope-to:'&) that are added to individual
13370 deliveries as they are written. However, there is one special case: during the
13371 expansion of the &%maildir_tag%& option in the &(appendfile)& transport while
13372 doing a delivery in maildir format, the value of &$message_size$& is the
13373 precise size of the file that has been written. See also
13374 &$message_body_size$&, &$body_linecount$&, and &$body_zerocount$&.
13376 .cindex "RCPT" "value of &$message_size$&"
13377 While running a per message ACL (mail/rcpt/predata), &$message_size$&
13378 contains the size supplied on the MAIL command, or -1 if no size was given. The
13379 value may not, of course, be truthful.
13381 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
13382 &$mime_anomaly_text$& &&&
13383 &$mime_boundary$& &&&
13384 &$mime_charset$& &&&
13385 &$mime_content_description$& &&&
13386 &$mime_content_disposition$& &&&
13387 &$mime_content_id$& &&&
13388 &$mime_content_size$& &&&
13389 &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$& &&&
13390 &$mime_content_type$& &&&
13391 &$mime_decoded_filename$& &&&
13392 &$mime_filename$& &&&
13393 &$mime_is_coverletter$& &&&
13394 &$mime_is_multipart$& &&&
13395 &$mime_is_rfc822$& &&&
13396 &$mime_part_count$&
13397 A number of variables whose names start with &$mime$& are
13398 available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For
13399 details, see section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>&.
13401 .vitem "&$n0$& &-- &$n9$&"
13402 These variables are counters that can be incremented by means
13403 of the &%add%& command in filter files.
13405 .tvar &$original_domain$&
13406 .vindex "&$domain$&"
13407 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13408 same value as &$domain$&. However, if a &"child"& address (for example,
13409 generated by an alias, forward, or filter file) is being processed, this
13410 variable contains the domain of the original address (lower cased). This
13411 differs from &$parent_domain$& only when there is more than one level of
13412 aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being delivered in a
13413 single transport run, &$original_domain$& is not set.
13415 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13416 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13417 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13419 .tvar &$original_local_part$&
13420 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
13421 When a top-level address is being processed for delivery, this contains the
13422 same value as &$local_part$&, unless a prefix or suffix was removed from the
13423 local part, because &$original_local_part$& always contains the full local
13424 part. When a &"child"& address (for example, generated by an alias, forward, or
13425 filter file) is being processed, this variable contains the full local part of
13426 the original address.
13428 If the router that did the redirection processed the local part
13429 case-insensitively, the value in &$original_local_part$& is in lower case.
13430 This variable differs from &$parent_local_part$& only when there is more than
13431 one level of aliasing or forwarding. When more than one address is being
13432 delivered in a single transport run, &$original_local_part$& is not set.
13434 If a new address is created by means of a &%deliver%& command in a system
13435 filter, it is set up with an artificial &"parent"& address. This has the local
13436 part &'system-filter'& and the default qualify domain.
13438 .vitem &$originator_gid$&
13439 .cindex "gid (group id)" "of originating user"
13440 .cindex "sender" "gid"
13441 .vindex "&$caller_gid$&"
13442 .vindex "&$originator_gid$&"
13443 This variable contains the value of &$caller_gid$& that was set when the
13444 message was received. For messages received via the command line, this is the
13445 gid of the sending user. For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is
13446 normally the gid of the Exim user.
13448 .vitem &$originator_uid$&
13449 .cindex "uid (user id)" "of originating user"
13450 .cindex "sender" "uid"
13451 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
13452 .vindex "&$originator_uid$&"
13453 The value of &$caller_uid$& that was set when the message was received. For
13454 messages received via the command line, this is the uid of the sending user.
13455 For messages received by SMTP over TCP/IP, this is normally the uid of the Exim
13458 .tvar &$parent_domain$&
13459 This variable is similar to &$original_domain$& (see
13460 above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13462 .tvar &$parent_local_part$&
13463 This variable is similar to &$original_local_part$&
13464 (see above), except that it refers to the immediately preceding parent address.
13467 .cindex "pid (process id)" "of current process"
13469 This variable contains the current process id.
13471 .vitem &$pipe_addresses$&
13472 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
13473 .cindex "transport" "filter"
13474 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
13475 This is not an expansion variable, but is mentioned here because the string
13476 &`$pipe_addresses`& is handled specially in the command specification for the
13477 &(pipe)& transport (chapter &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&) and in transport filters
13478 (described under &%transport_filter%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
13479 It cannot be used in general expansion strings, and provokes an &"unknown
13480 variable"& error if encountered.
13481 &*Note*&: This value permits data supplied by a potential attacker to
13482 be used in the command for a &(pipe)& transport.
13483 Such configurations should be carefully assessed for security vulnerbilities.
13485 .vitem &$primary_hostname$&
13486 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
13487 This variable contains the value set by &%primary_hostname%& in the
13488 configuration file, or read by the &[uname()]& function. If &[uname()]& returns
13489 a single-component name, Exim calls &[gethostbyname()]& (or
13490 &[getipnodebyname()]& where available) in an attempt to acquire a fully
13491 qualified host name. See also &$smtp_active_hostname$&.
13494 .vitem &$proxy_external_address$& &&&
13495 &$proxy_external_port$& &&&
13496 &$proxy_local_address$& &&&
13497 &$proxy_local_port$& &&&
13499 These variables are only available when built with Proxy Protocol
13501 For details see chapter &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
13503 .vitem &$prdr_requested$&
13504 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
13505 This variable is set to &"yes"& if PRDR was requested by the client for the
13506 current message, otherwise &"no"&.
13508 .vitem &$prvscheck_address$& &&&
13509 &$prvscheck_keynum$& &&&
13510 &$prvscheck_result$&
13511 These variables are used in conjunction with the &%prvscheck%& expansion item,
13512 which is described in sections &<<SECTexpansionitems>>& and
13513 &<<SECTverifyPRVS>>&.
13515 .vitem &$qualify_domain$&
13516 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
13517 The value set for the &%qualify_domain%& option in the configuration file.
13519 .vitem &$qualify_recipient$&
13520 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
13521 The value set for the &%qualify_recipient%& option in the configuration file,
13522 or if not set, the value of &$qualify_domain$&.
13524 .vitem &$queue_name$&
13525 .vindex &$queue_name$&
13526 .cindex "named queues" variable
13527 .cindex queues named
13528 The name of the spool queue in use; empty for the default queue.
13530 .vitem &$queue_size$&
13531 .vindex "&$queue_size$&"
13532 .cindex "queue" "size of"
13533 .cindex "spool" "number of messages"
13534 This variable contains the number of messages queued.
13535 It is evaluated on demand, but no more often than once every minute.
13536 If there is no daemon notifier socket open, the value will be
13541 .cindex router variables
13542 Values can be placed in these variables by the &%set%& option of a router.
13543 They can be given any name that starts with &$r_$&.
13544 The values persist for the address being handled through subsequent routers
13545 and the eventual transport.
13547 .vitem &$rcpt_count$&
13548 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
13549 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13550 RCPT commands received for the current message. If this variable is used in a
13551 RCPT ACL, its value includes the current command.
13553 .vitem &$rcpt_defer_count$&
13554 .vindex "&$rcpt_defer_count$&"
13555 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "count of"
13556 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13557 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13558 temporary (4&'xx'&) response.
13560 .vitem &$rcpt_fail_count$&
13561 .vindex "&$rcpt_fail_count$&"
13562 When a message is being received by SMTP, this variable contains the number of
13563 RCPT commands in the current message that have previously been rejected with a
13564 permanent (5&'xx'&) response.
13566 .vitem &$received_count$&
13567 .vindex "&$received_count$&"
13568 This variable contains the number of &'Received:'& header lines in the message,
13569 including the one added by Exim (so its value is always greater than zero). It
13570 is available in the DATA ACL, the non-SMTP ACL, and while routing and
13573 .tvar &$received_for$&
13574 If there is only a single recipient address in an incoming message, this
13575 variable contains that address when the &'Received:'& header line is being
13576 built. The value is copied after recipient rewriting has happened, but before
13577 the &[local_scan()]& function is run.
13579 .vitem &$received_ip_address$& &&&
13581 .vindex "&$received_ip_address$&"
13582 .vindex "&$received_port$&"
13583 As soon as an Exim server starts processing an incoming TCP/IP connection, these
13584 variables are set to the address and port on the local IP interface.
13585 (The remote IP address and port are in
13586 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.) When testing with &%-bh%&,
13587 the port value is -1 unless it has been set using the &%-oMi%& command line
13590 As well as being useful in ACLs (including the &"connect"& ACL), these variable
13591 could be used, for example, to make the filename for a TLS certificate depend
13592 on which interface and/or port is being used for the incoming connection. The
13593 values of &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$& are saved with any
13594 messages that are received, thus making these variables available at delivery
13596 For outbound connections see &$sending_ip_address$&.
13598 .vitem &$received_protocol$&
13599 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
13600 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the name of the
13601 protocol by which it was received. Most of the names used by Exim are defined
13602 by RFCs 821, 2821, and 3848. They start with &"smtp"& (the client used HELO) or
13603 &"esmtp"& (the client used EHLO). This can be followed by &"s"& for secure
13604 (encrypted) and/or &"a"& for authenticated. Thus, for example, if the protocol
13605 is set to &"esmtpsa"&, the message was received over an encrypted SMTP
13606 connection and the client was successfully authenticated.
13608 Exim uses the protocol name &"smtps"& for the case when encryption is
13609 automatically set up on connection without the use of STARTTLS (see
13610 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&), and the client uses HELO to initiate the
13611 encrypted SMTP session. The name &"smtps"& is also used for the rare situation
13612 where the client initially uses EHLO, sets up an encrypted connection using
13613 STARTTLS, and then uses HELO afterwards.
13615 The &%-oMr%& option provides a way of specifying a custom protocol name for
13616 messages that are injected locally by trusted callers. This is commonly used to
13617 identify messages that are being re-injected after some kind of scanning.
13619 .vitem &$received_time$&
13620 .vindex "&$received_time$&"
13621 This variable contains the date and time when the current message was received,
13622 as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
13624 .vitem &$recipient_data$&
13625 .vindex "&$recipient_data$&"
13626 This variable is set after an indexing lookup success in an ACL &%recipients%&
13627 condition. It contains the data from the lookup, and the value remains set
13628 until the next &%recipients%& test. Thus, you can do things like this:
13630 &`require recipients = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13631 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$recipient_data`&
13633 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13634 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13635 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13636 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13638 .vitem &$recipient_verify_failure$&
13639 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
13640 In an ACL, when a recipient verification fails, this variable contains
13641 information about the failure. It is set to one of the following words:
13644 &"qualify"&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
13645 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
13648 &"route"&: Routing failed.
13651 &"mail"&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection occurred at
13652 or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial connection, HELO, or
13656 &"recipient"&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
13659 &"postmaster"&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
13662 The main use of this variable is expected to be to distinguish between
13663 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT.
13665 .tvar &$recipients$&
13666 .tvar &$recipients_list$&
13667 These variables both contain the envelope recipients for a message.
13669 The first uses a comma and a space separate the addresses in the replacement text.
13670 &*Note*&: an address can legitimately contain a comma;
13671 this variable is not intended for further processing.
13673 The second is a proper Exim list; colon-separated.
13675 However, the variables
13676 are not generally available, to prevent exposure of Bcc recipients in
13677 unprivileged users' filter files. You can use either of them only in these
13681 In a system filter file.
13683 In the ACLs associated with the DATA command and with non-SMTP messages, that
13684 is, the ACLs defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_data%&,
13685 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_not_smtp_start%&, &%acl_not_smtp%&, and
13686 &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&.
13688 From within a &[local_scan()]& function.
13692 .vitem &$recipients_count$&
13693 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
13694 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the number of
13695 envelope recipients that came with the message. Duplicates are not excluded
13696 from the count. While a message is being received over SMTP, the number
13697 increases for each accepted recipient. It can be referenced in an ACL.
13700 .vitem &$regex_match_string$&
13701 .vindex "&$regex_match_string$&"
13702 This variable is set to contain the matching regular expression after a
13703 &%regex%& ACL condition has matched (see section &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
13705 .vitem "&$regex1$&, &$regex2$&, etc"
13706 .cindex "regex submatch variables (&$1regex$& &$2regex$& etc)"
13707 When a &%regex%& or &%mime_regex%& ACL condition succeeds,
13708 these variables contain the
13709 captured substrings identified by the regular expression.
13710 If the subject string was tainted then so will any captured substring.
13713 .tvar &$reply_address$&
13714 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the contents of the
13715 &'Reply-To:'& header line if one exists and it is not empty, or otherwise the
13716 contents of the &'From:'& header line. Apart from the removal of leading
13717 white space, the value is not processed in any way. In particular, no RFC 2047
13718 decoding or character code translation takes place.
13720 .vitem &$return_path$&
13721 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
13722 When a message is being delivered, this variable contains the return path &--
13723 the sender field that will be sent as part of the envelope. It is not enclosed
13724 in <> characters. At the start of routing an address, &$return_path$& has the
13725 same value as &$sender_address$&, but if, for example, an incoming message to a
13726 mailing list has been expanded by a router which specifies a different address
13727 for bounce messages, &$return_path$& subsequently contains the new bounce
13728 address, whereas &$sender_address$& always contains the original sender address
13729 that was received with the message. In other words, &$sender_address$& contains
13730 the incoming envelope sender, and &$return_path$& contains the outgoing
13733 .vitem &$return_size_limit$&
13734 .vindex "&$return_size_limit$&"
13735 This is an obsolete name for &$bounce_return_size_limit$&.
13737 .vitem &$router_name$&
13738 .cindex "router" "name"
13739 .cindex "name" "of router"
13740 .vindex "&$router_name$&"
13741 During the running of a router, or a transport called,
13742 this variable contains the router name.
13745 .cindex "return code" "from &%run%& expansion"
13746 .vindex "&$runrc$&"
13747 This variable contains the return code from a command that is run by the
13748 &%${run...}%& expansion item. &*Warning*&: In a router or transport, you cannot
13749 assume the order in which option values are expanded, except for those
13750 preconditions whose order of testing is documented. Therefore, you cannot
13751 reliably expect to set &$runrc$& by the expansion of one option, and use it in
13754 .vitem &$self_hostname$&
13755 .oindex "&%self%&" "value of host name"
13756 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
13757 When an address is routed to a supposedly remote host that turns out to be the
13758 local host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& generic router option.
13759 One of its values causes the address to be passed to another router. When this
13760 happens, &$self_hostname$& is set to the name of the local host that the
13761 original router encountered. In other circumstances its contents are null.
13763 .tvar &$sender_address$&
13764 When a message is being processed, this variable contains the sender's address
13765 that was received in the message's envelope. The case of letters in the address
13766 is retained, in both the local part and the domain. For bounce messages, the
13767 value of this variable is the empty string. See also &$return_path$&.
13769 .vitem &$sender_address_data$&
13770 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
13771 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
13772 If &$address_data$& is set when the routers are called from an ACL to verify a
13773 sender address, the final value is preserved in &$sender_address_data$&, to
13774 distinguish it from data from a recipient address. The value does not persist
13775 after the end of the current ACL statement. If you want to preserve it for
13776 longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
13778 .tvar &$sender_address_domain$&
13779 The domain portion of &$sender_address$&.
13781 .tvar &$sender_address_local_part$&
13782 The local part portion of &$sender_address$&.
13784 .vitem &$sender_data$&
13785 .vindex "&$sender_data$&"
13786 This variable is set after a lookup success in an ACL &%senders%& condition or
13787 in a router &%senders%& option. It contains the data from the lookup, and the
13788 value remains set until the next &%senders%& test. Thus, you can do things like
13791 &`require senders = cdb*@;/some/file`&
13792 &`deny `&&'some further test involving'& &`$sender_data`&
13794 &*Warning*&: This variable is set only when a lookup is used as an indexing
13795 method in the address list, using the semicolon syntax as in the example above.
13796 The variable is not set for a lookup that is used as part of the string
13797 expansion that all such lists undergo before being interpreted.
13799 .vitem &$sender_fullhost$&
13800 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
13801 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the host
13802 name and IP address in a single string. It ends with the IP address in square
13803 brackets, followed by a colon and a port number if the logging of ports is
13804 enabled. The format of the rest of the string depends on whether the host
13805 issued a HELO or EHLO SMTP command, and whether the host name was verified by
13806 looking up its IP address. (Looking up the IP address can be forced by the
13807 &%host_lookup%& option, independent of verification.) A plain host name at the
13808 start of the string is a verified host name; if this is not present,
13809 verification either failed or was not requested. A host name in parentheses is
13810 the argument of a HELO or EHLO command. This is omitted if it is identical to
13811 the verified host name or to the host's IP address in square brackets.
13813 .vitem &$sender_helo_dnssec$&
13814 .vindex "&$sender_helo_dnssec$&"
13815 This boolean variable is true if a successful HELO verification was
13816 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13817 done using DNS information the resolver library stated was authenticated data.
13819 .tvar &$sender_helo_name$&
13820 When a message is received from a remote host that has issued a HELO or EHLO
13821 command, the argument of that command is placed in this variable. It is also
13822 set if HELO or EHLO is used when a message is received using SMTP locally via
13823 the &%-bs%& or &%-bS%& options.
13825 .vitem &$sender_host_address$&
13826 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
13827 When a message is received from a remote host using SMTP,
13828 this variable contains that
13829 host's IP address. For locally non-SMTP submitted messages, it is empty.
13831 .vitem &$sender_host_authenticated$&
13832 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
13833 This variable contains the name (not the public name) of the authenticator
13834 driver that successfully authenticated the client from which the message was
13835 received. It is empty if there was no successful authentication. See also
13836 &$authenticated_id$&.
13838 .vitem &$sender_host_dnssec$&
13839 .vindex "&$sender_host_dnssec$&"
13840 If an attempt to populate &$sender_host_name$& has been made
13841 (by reference, &%hosts_lookup%& or
13842 otherwise) then this boolean will have been set true if, and only if, the
13843 resolver library states that both
13844 the reverse and forward DNS were authenticated data. At all
13845 other times, this variable is false.
13847 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
13848 It is likely that you will need to coerce DNSSEC support on in the resolver
13849 library, by setting:
13854 In addition, on Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer the resolver library will
13855 default to stripping out a successful validation status.
13856 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
13857 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
13858 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
13859 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
13864 Exim does not perform DNSSEC validation itself, instead leaving that to a
13865 validating resolver (e.g. unbound, or bind with suitable configuration).
13867 If you have changed &%host_lookup_order%& so that &`bydns`& is not the first
13868 mechanism in the list, then this variable will be false.
13870 This requires that your system resolver library support EDNS0 (and that
13871 DNSSEC flags exist in the system headers). If the resolver silently drops
13872 all EDNS0 options, then this will have no effect. OpenBSD's asr resolver
13873 is known to currently ignore EDNS0, documented in CAVEATS of asr_run(3).
13876 .tvar &$sender_host_name$&
13877 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13878 host's name as obtained by looking up its IP address. For messages received by
13879 other means, this variable is empty.
13881 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
13882 If the host name has not previously been looked up, a reference to
13883 &$sender_host_name$& triggers a lookup (for messages from remote hosts).
13884 A looked up name is accepted only if it leads back to the original IP address
13885 via a forward lookup. If either the reverse or the forward lookup fails to find
13886 any data, or if the forward lookup does not yield the original IP address,
13887 &$sender_host_name$& remains empty, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&.
13889 .vindex "&$host_lookup_deferred$&"
13890 However, if either of the lookups cannot be completed (for example, there is a
13891 DNS timeout), &$host_lookup_deferred$& is set to &"1"&, and
13892 &$host_lookup_failed$& remains set to &"0"&.
13894 Once &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to &"1"&, Exim does not try to look up the
13895 host name again if there is a subsequent reference to &$sender_host_name$&
13896 in the same Exim process, but it does try again if &$host_lookup_deferred$&
13899 Exim does not automatically look up every calling host's name. If you want
13900 maximum efficiency, you should arrange your configuration so that it avoids
13901 these lookups altogether. The lookup happens only if one or more of the
13902 following are true:
13905 A string containing &$sender_host_name$& is expanded.
13907 The calling host matches the list in &%host_lookup%&. In the default
13908 configuration, this option is set to *, so it must be changed if lookups are
13909 to be avoided. (In the code, the default for &%host_lookup%& is unset.)
13911 Exim needs the host name in order to test an item in a host list. The items
13912 that require this are described in sections &<<SECThoslispatnam>>& and
13913 &<<SECThoslispatnamsk>>&.
13915 The calling host matches &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&.
13916 In this case, the host name is required to compare with the name quoted in any
13917 EHLO or HELO commands that the client issues.
13919 The remote host issues a EHLO or HELO command that quotes one of the
13920 domains in &%helo_lookup_domains%&. The default value of this option is
13921 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
13922 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
13924 helo_lookup_domains = @ : @[]
13926 which causes a lookup if a remote host (incorrectly) gives the server's name or
13927 IP address in an EHLO or HELO command.
13931 .vitem &$sender_host_port$&
13932 .vindex "&$sender_host_port$&"
13933 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the port
13934 number that was used on the remote host.
13936 .vitem &$sender_ident$&
13937 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
13938 When a message is received from a remote host, this variable contains the
13939 identification received in response to an RFC 1413 request. When a message has
13940 been received locally, this variable contains the login name of the user that
13943 .vitem &$sender_rate_$&&'xxx'&
13944 A number of variables whose names begin &$sender_rate_$& are set as part of the
13945 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. Details are given in section
13946 &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
13948 .vitem &$sender_rcvhost$&
13949 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
13950 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
13951 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
13952 This is provided specifically for use in &'Received:'& headers. It starts with
13953 either the verified host name (as obtained from a reverse DNS lookup) or, if
13954 there is no verified host name, the IP address in square brackets. After that
13955 there may be text in parentheses. When the first item is a verified host name,
13956 the first thing in the parentheses is the IP address in square brackets,
13957 followed by a colon and a port number if port logging is enabled. When the
13958 first item is an IP address, the port is recorded as &"port=&'xxxx'&"& inside
13961 There may also be items of the form &"helo=&'xxxx'&"& if HELO or EHLO
13962 was used and its argument was not identical to the real host name or IP
13963 address, and &"ident=&'xxxx'&"& if an RFC 1413 ident string is available. If
13964 all three items are present in the parentheses, a newline and tab are inserted
13965 into the string, to improve the formatting of the &'Received:'& header.
13967 .vitem &$sender_verify_failure$&
13968 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
13969 In an ACL, when a sender verification fails, this variable contains information
13970 about the failure. The details are the same as for
13971 &$recipient_verify_failure$&.
13973 .vitem &$sending_ip_address$&
13974 .vindex "&$sending_ip_address$&"
13975 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13976 been set up. It contains the IP address of the local interface that is being
13977 used. This is useful if a host that has more than one IP address wants to take
13978 on different personalities depending on which one is being used. For incoming
13979 connections, see &$received_ip_address$&.
13981 .vitem &$sending_port$&
13982 .vindex "&$sending_port$&"
13983 This variable is set whenever an outgoing SMTP connection to another host has
13984 been set up. It contains the local port that is being used. For incoming
13985 connections, see &$received_port$&.
13987 .vitem &$smtp_active_hostname$&
13988 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
13989 During an incoming SMTP session, this variable contains the value of the active
13990 host name, as specified by the &%smtp_active_hostname%& option. The value of
13991 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is saved with any message that is received, so its
13992 value can be consulted during routing and delivery.
13994 .tvar &$smtp_command$&
13995 During the processing of an incoming SMTP command, this variable contains the
13996 entire command. This makes it possible to distinguish between HELO and EHLO in
13997 the HELO ACL, and also to distinguish between commands such as these:
14002 For a MAIL command, extra parameters such as SIZE can be inspected. For a RCPT
14003 command, the address in &$smtp_command$& is the original address before any
14004 rewriting, whereas the values in &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are taken from
14005 the address after SMTP-time rewriting.
14007 .tvar &$smtp_command_argument$&
14008 .cindex "SMTP" "command, argument for"
14009 While an ACL is running to check an SMTP command, this variable contains the
14010 argument, that is, the text that follows the command name, with leading white
14011 space removed. Following the introduction of &$smtp_command$&, this variable is
14012 somewhat redundant, but is retained for backwards compatibility.
14014 .vitem &$smtp_command_history$&
14015 .cindex SMTP "command history"
14016 .vindex "&$smtp_command_history$&"
14017 A comma-separated list (with no whitespace) of the most-recent SMTP commands
14018 received, in time-order left to right. Only a limited number of commands
14021 .vitem &$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&
14022 .vindex "&$smtp_count_at_connection_start$&"
14023 This variable is set greater than zero only in processes spawned by the Exim
14024 daemon for handling incoming SMTP connections. The name is deliberately long,
14025 in order to emphasize what the contents are. When the daemon accepts a new
14026 connection, it increments this variable. A copy of the variable is passed to
14027 the child process that handles the connection, but its value is fixed, and
14028 never changes. It is only an approximation of how many incoming connections
14029 there actually are, because many other connections may come and go while a
14030 single connection is being processed. When a child process terminates, the
14031 daemon decrements its copy of the variable.
14033 .vitem &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
14034 .vindex "&$smtp_notquit_reason$&"
14035 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, this variable is set to a string
14036 that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP connection.
14038 .vitem "&$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$&"
14039 These variables are copies of the values of the &$n0$& &-- &$n9$& accumulators
14040 that were current at the end of the system filter file. This allows a system
14041 filter file to set values that can be tested in users' filter files. For
14042 example, a system filter could set a value indicating how likely it is that a
14043 message is junk mail.
14045 .vitem &$spam_score$& &&&
14046 &$spam_score_int$& &&&
14048 &$spam_report$& &&&
14050 A number of variables whose names start with &$spam$& are available when Exim
14051 is compiled with the content-scanning extension. For details, see section
14052 &<<SECTscanspamass>>&.
14054 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$& &&&
14055 &$spf_received$& &&&
14057 &$spf_result_guessed$& &&&
14058 &$spf_smtp_comment$&
14059 These variables are only available if Exim is built with SPF support.
14060 For details see section &<<SECSPF>>&.
14062 .vitem &$spool_directory$&
14063 .vindex "&$spool_directory$&"
14064 The name of Exim's spool directory.
14066 .vitem &$spool_inodes$&
14067 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
14068 The number of free inodes in the disk partition where Exim's spool files are
14069 being written. The value is recalculated whenever the variable is referenced.
14070 If the relevant file system does not have the concept of inodes, the value of
14071 is -1. See also the &%check_spool_inodes%& option.
14073 .vitem &$spool_space$&
14074 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
14075 The amount of free space (as a number of kilobytes) in the disk partition where
14076 Exim's spool files are being written. The value is recalculated whenever the
14077 variable is referenced. If the operating system does not have the ability to
14078 find the amount of free space (only true for experimental systems), the space
14079 value is -1. For example, to check in an ACL that there is at least 50
14080 megabytes free on the spool, you could write:
14082 condition = ${if > {$spool_space}{50000}}
14084 See also the &%check_spool_space%& option.
14087 .vitem &$thisaddress$&
14088 .vindex "&$thisaddress$&"
14089 This variable is set only during the processing of the &%foranyaddress%&
14090 command in a filter file. Its use is explained in the description of that
14091 command, which can be found in the separate document entitled &'Exim's
14092 interfaces to mail filtering'&.
14094 .vitem &$tls_in_bits$&
14095 .vindex "&$tls_in_bits$&"
14096 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
14097 on the inbound connection; the meaning of
14098 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
14099 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
14100 The value of this is automatically fed into the Cyrus SASL authenticator
14101 when acting as a server, to specify the "external SSF" (a SASL term).
14103 The deprecated &$tls_bits$& variable refers to the inbound side
14104 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14107 .vitem &$tls_out_bits$&
14108 .vindex "&$tls_out_bits$&"
14109 Contains an approximation of the TLS cipher's bit-strength
14110 on an outbound SMTP connection; the meaning of
14111 this depends upon the TLS implementation used.
14112 If TLS has not been negotiated, the value will be 0.
14114 .vitem &$tls_in_ourcert$&
14115 .vindex "&$tls_in_ourcert$&"
14116 .cindex certificate variables
14117 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
14118 inbound connection when the message was received.
14119 It is only useful as the argument of a
14120 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14121 or a &%def%& condition.
14123 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
14124 when a list of more than one
14125 file is used for &%tls_certificate%&, this variable is not reliable.
14126 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
14128 .vitem &$tls_in_peercert$&
14129 .vindex "&$tls_in_peercert$&"
14130 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
14131 inbound connection when the message was received.
14132 It is only useful as the argument of a
14133 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14134 or a &%def%& condition.
14135 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14136 which is not the leaf.
14138 .vitem &$tls_out_ourcert$&
14139 .vindex "&$tls_out_ourcert$&"
14140 This variable refers to the certificate presented to the peer of an
14141 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
14142 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14143 or a &%def%& condition.
14145 .vitem &$tls_out_peercert$&
14146 .vindex "&$tls_out_peercert$&"
14147 This variable refers to the certificate presented by the peer of an
14148 outbound connection. It is only useful as the argument of a
14149 &%certextract%& expansion item, &%md5%&, &%sha1%& or &%sha256%& operator,
14150 or a &%def%& condition.
14151 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14152 which is not the leaf.
14154 .vitem &$tls_in_certificate_verified$&
14155 .vindex "&$tls_in_certificate_verified$&"
14156 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when the
14157 message was received, and &"0"& otherwise.
14159 The deprecated &$tls_certificate_verified$& variable refers to the inbound side
14160 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14163 .vitem &$tls_out_certificate_verified$&
14164 .vindex "&$tls_out_certificate_verified$&"
14165 This variable is set to &"1"& if a TLS certificate was verified when an
14166 outbound SMTP connection was made,
14167 and &"0"& otherwise.
14169 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher$&
14170 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
14171 .vindex "&$tls_cipher$&"
14172 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14173 connection, this variable is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated, for
14174 example DES-CBC3-SHA. In other circumstances, in particular, for message
14175 received over unencrypted connections, the variable is empty. Testing
14176 &$tls_in_cipher$& for emptiness is one way of distinguishing between encrypted and
14177 non-encrypted connections during ACL processing.
14179 The deprecated &$tls_cipher$& variable is the same as &$tls_in_cipher$& during message reception,
14180 but in the context of an outward SMTP delivery taking place via the &(smtp)& transport
14181 becomes the same as &$tls_out_cipher$&.
14183 .vitem &$tls_in_cipher_std$&
14184 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher_std$&"
14185 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
14187 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher$&
14188 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher$&"
14190 cleared before any outgoing SMTP connection is made,
14191 and then set to the outgoing cipher suite if one is negotiated. See chapter
14192 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS support and chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for
14193 details of the &(smtp)& transport.
14195 .vitem &$tls_out_cipher_std$&
14196 .vindex "&$tls_out_cipher_std$&"
14197 As above, but returning the RFC standard name for the cipher suite.
14199 .vitem &$tls_out_dane$&
14200 .vindex &$tls_out_dane$&
14201 DANE active status. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
14203 .vitem &$tls_in_ocsp$&
14204 .vindex "&$tls_in_ocsp$&"
14205 When a message is received from a remote client connection
14206 the result of any OCSP request from the client is encoded in this variable:
14208 0 OCSP proof was not requested (default value)
14209 1 No response to request
14210 2 Response not verified
14211 3 Verification failed
14212 4 Verification succeeded
14215 .vitem &$tls_out_ocsp$&
14216 .vindex "&$tls_out_ocsp$&"
14217 When a message is sent to a remote host connection
14218 the result of any OCSP request made is encoded in this variable.
14219 See &$tls_in_ocsp$& for values.
14221 .vitem &$tls_in_peerdn$&
14222 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
14223 .vindex "&$tls_peerdn$&"
14224 .cindex certificate "extracting fields"
14225 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14226 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the client,
14227 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14228 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14229 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14230 which is not the leaf.
14232 The deprecated &$tls_peerdn$& variable refers to the inbound side
14233 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14236 .vitem &$tls_out_peerdn$&
14237 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
14238 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP
14239 connection, and Exim is configured to request a certificate from the server,
14240 the value of the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the
14241 &$tls_out_peerdn$& during subsequent processing.
14242 If certificate verification fails it may refer to a failing chain element
14243 which is not the leaf.
14246 .vitem &$tls_in_resumption$& &&&
14247 &$tls_out_resumption$&
14248 .vindex &$tls_in_resumption$&
14249 .vindex &$tls_out_resumption$&
14250 .cindex TLS resumption
14251 Observability for TLS session resumption. See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
14254 .tvar &$tls_in_sni$&
14255 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
14256 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14258 .cindex SNI "observability on server"
14259 When a TLS session is being established, if the client sends the Server
14260 Name Indication extension, the value will be placed in this variable.
14261 If the variable appears in &%tls_certificate%& then this option and
14262 some others, described in &<<SECTtlssni>>&,
14263 will be re-expanded early in the TLS session, to permit
14264 a different certificate to be presented (and optionally a different key to be
14265 used) to the client, based upon the value of the SNI extension.
14267 The deprecated &$tls_sni$& variable refers to the inbound side
14268 except when used in the context of an outbound SMTP delivery, when it refers to
14271 .vitem &$tls_out_sni$&
14272 .vindex "&$tls_out_sni$&"
14273 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
14275 .cindex SNI "observability in client"
14277 SMTP deliveries, this variable reflects the value of the &%tls_sni%& option on
14280 .vitem &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14281 .vindex &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$&
14282 Bitfield of TLSA record types found. See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
14284 .vitem &$tls_in_ver$&
14285 .vindex "&$tls_in_ver$&"
14286 When a message is received from a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14287 this variable is set to the protocol version, eg &'TLS1.2'&.
14289 .vitem &$tls_out_ver$&
14290 .vindex "&$tls_out_ver$&"
14291 When a message is being delivered to a remote host over an encrypted SMTP connection
14292 this variable is set to the protocol version.
14295 .vitem &$tod_bsdinbox$&
14296 .vindex "&$tod_bsdinbox$&"
14297 The time of day and the date, in the format required for BSD-style mailbox
14298 files, for example: Thu Oct 17 17:14:09 1995.
14300 .vitem &$tod_epoch$&
14301 .vindex "&$tod_epoch$&"
14302 The time and date as a number of seconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14304 .vitem &$tod_epoch_l$&
14305 .vindex "&$tod_epoch_l$&"
14306 The time and date as a number of microseconds since the start of the Unix epoch.
14308 .vitem &$tod_full$&
14309 .vindex "&$tod_full$&"
14310 A full version of the time and date, for example: Wed, 16 Oct 1995 09:51:40
14311 +0100. The timezone is always given as a numerical offset from UTC, with
14312 positive values used for timezones that are ahead (east) of UTC, and negative
14313 values for those that are behind (west).
14316 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
14317 The time and date in the format used for writing Exim's log files, for example:
14318 1995-10-12 15:32:29, but without a timezone.
14320 .vitem &$tod_logfile$&
14321 .vindex "&$tod_logfile$&"
14322 This variable contains the date in the format yyyymmdd. This is the format that
14323 is used for datestamping log files when &%log_file_path%& contains the &`%D`&
14326 .vitem &$tod_zone$&
14327 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
14328 This variable contains the numerical value of the local timezone, for example:
14331 .vitem &$tod_zulu$&
14332 .vindex "&$tod_zulu$&"
14333 This variable contains the UTC date and time in &"Zulu"& format, as specified
14334 by ISO 8601, for example: 20030221154023Z.
14336 .vitem &$transport_name$&
14337 .cindex "transport" "name"
14338 .cindex "name" "of transport"
14339 .vindex "&$transport_name$&"
14340 During the running of a transport, this variable contains its name.
14343 .vindex "&$value$&"
14344 This variable contains the result of an expansion lookup, extraction operation,
14345 or external command, as described above. It is also used during a
14346 &*reduce*& expansion.
14348 .vitem &$verify_mode$&
14349 .vindex "&$verify_mode$&"
14350 While a router or transport is being run in verify mode or for cutthrough delivery,
14351 contains "S" for sender-verification or "R" for recipient-verification.
14354 .vitem &$version_number$&
14355 .vindex "&$version_number$&"
14356 The version number of Exim. Same as &$exim_version$&, may be overridden
14357 by the &%exim_version%& main config option.
14359 .vitem &$warn_message_delay$&
14360 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
14361 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14362 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14364 .vitem &$warn_message_recipients$&
14365 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
14366 This variable is set only during the creation of a message warning about a
14367 delivery delay. Details of its use are explained in section &<<SECTcustwarn>>&.
14373 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14374 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14376 .chapter "Embedded Perl" "CHAPperl"
14377 .scindex IIDperl "Perl" "calling from Exim"
14378 Exim can be built to include an embedded Perl interpreter. When this is done,
14379 Perl subroutines can be called as part of the string expansion process. To make
14380 use of the Perl support, you need version 5.004 or later of Perl installed on
14381 your system. To include the embedded interpreter in the Exim binary, include
14386 in your &_Local/Makefile_& and then build Exim in the normal way.
14389 .section "Setting up so Perl can be used" "SECID85"
14390 .oindex "&%perl_startup%&"
14391 Access to Perl subroutines is via a global configuration option called
14392 &%perl_startup%& and an expansion string operator &%${perl ...}%&. If there is
14393 no &%perl_startup%& option in the Exim configuration file then no Perl
14394 interpreter is started and there is almost no overhead for Exim (since none of
14395 the Perl library will be paged in unless used). If there is a &%perl_startup%&
14396 option then the associated value is taken to be Perl code which is executed in
14397 a newly created Perl interpreter.
14399 The value of &%perl_startup%& is not expanded in the Exim sense, so you do not
14400 need backslashes before any characters to escape special meanings. The option
14401 should usually be something like
14403 perl_startup = do '/etc/exim.pl'
14405 where &_/etc/exim.pl_& is Perl code which defines any subroutines you want to
14406 use from Exim. Exim can be configured either to start up a Perl interpreter as
14407 soon as it is entered, or to wait until the first time it is needed. Starting
14408 the interpreter at the beginning ensures that it is done while Exim still has
14409 its setuid privilege, but can impose an unnecessary overhead if Perl is not in
14410 fact used in a particular run. Also, note that this does not mean that Exim is
14411 necessarily running as root when Perl is called at a later time. By default,
14412 the interpreter is started only when it is needed, but this can be changed in
14416 .oindex "&%perl_at_start%&"
14417 Setting &%perl_at_start%& (a boolean option) in the configuration requests
14418 a startup when Exim is entered.
14420 The command line option &%-ps%& also requests a startup when Exim is entered,
14421 overriding the setting of &%perl_at_start%&.
14424 There is also a command line option &%-pd%& (for delay) which suppresses the
14425 initial startup, even if &%perl_at_start%& is set.
14428 .oindex "&%perl_taintmode%&"
14429 .cindex "Perl" "taintmode"
14430 To provide more security executing Perl code via the embedded Perl
14431 interpreter, the &%perl_taintmode%& option can be set. This enables the
14432 taint mode of the Perl interpreter. You are encouraged to set this
14433 option to a true value. To avoid breaking existing installations, it
14436 &*Note*&: This is entirely separate from Exim's tainted-data tracking.
14439 .section "Calling Perl subroutines" "SECID86"
14440 When the configuration file includes a &%perl_startup%& option you can make use
14441 of the string expansion item to call the Perl subroutines that are defined
14442 by the &%perl_startup%& code. The operator is used in any of the following
14446 ${perl{foo}{argument}}
14447 ${perl{foo}{argument1}{argument2} ... }
14449 which calls the subroutine &%foo%& with the given arguments. A maximum of eight
14450 arguments may be passed. Passing more than this results in an expansion failure
14451 with an error message of the form
14453 Too many arguments passed to Perl subroutine "foo" (max is 8)
14455 The return value of the Perl subroutine is evaluated in a scalar context before
14456 it is passed back to Exim to be inserted into the expanded string. If the
14457 return value is &'undef'&, the expansion is forced to fail in the same way as
14458 an explicit &"fail"& on an &%if%& or &%lookup%& item. If the subroutine aborts
14459 by obeying Perl's &%die%& function, the expansion fails with the error message
14460 that was passed to &%die%&.
14463 .section "Calling Exim functions from Perl" "SECID87"
14464 Within any Perl code called from Exim, the function &'Exim::expand_string()'&
14465 is available to call back into Exim's string expansion function. For example,
14468 my $lp = Exim::expand_string('$local_part');
14470 makes the current Exim &$local_part$& available in the Perl variable &$lp$&.
14471 Note those are single quotes and not double quotes to protect against
14472 &$local_part$& being interpolated as a Perl variable.
14474 If the string expansion is forced to fail by a &"fail"& item, the result of
14475 &'Exim::expand_string()'& is &%undef%&. If there is a syntax error in the
14476 expansion string, the Perl call from the original expansion string fails with
14477 an appropriate error message, in the same way as if &%die%& were used.
14479 .cindex "debugging" "from embedded Perl"
14480 .cindex "log" "writing from embedded Perl"
14481 Two other Exim functions are available for use from within Perl code.
14482 &'Exim::debug_write()'& writes a string to the standard error stream if Exim's
14483 debugging is enabled. If you want a newline at the end, you must supply it.
14484 &'Exim::log_write()'& writes a string to Exim's main log, adding a leading
14485 timestamp. In this case, you should not supply a terminating newline.
14488 .section "Use of standard output and error by Perl" "SECID88"
14489 .cindex "Perl" "standard output and error"
14490 You should not write to the standard error or output streams from within your
14491 Perl code, as it is not defined how these are set up. In versions of Exim
14492 before 4.50, it is possible for the standard output or error to refer to the
14493 SMTP connection during message reception via the daemon. Writing to this stream
14494 is certain to cause chaos. From Exim 4.50 onwards, the standard output and
14495 error streams are connected to &_/dev/null_& in the daemon. The chaos is
14496 avoided, but the output is lost.
14498 .cindex "Perl" "use of &%warn%&"
14499 The Perl &%warn%& statement writes to the standard error stream by default.
14500 Calls to &%warn%& may be embedded in Perl modules that you use, but over which
14501 you have no control. When Exim starts up the Perl interpreter, it arranges for
14502 output from the &%warn%& statement to be written to the Exim main log. You can
14503 change this by including appropriate Perl magic somewhere in your Perl code.
14504 For example, to discard &%warn%& output completely, you need this:
14506 $SIG{__WARN__} = sub { };
14508 Whenever a &%warn%& is obeyed, the anonymous subroutine is called. In this
14509 example, the code for the subroutine is empty, so it does nothing, but you can
14510 include any Perl code that you like. The text of the &%warn%& message is passed
14511 as the first subroutine argument.
14515 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14516 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14518 .chapter "Starting the daemon and the use of network interfaces" &&&
14519 "CHAPinterfaces" &&&
14520 "Starting the daemon"
14521 .cindex "daemon" "starting"
14522 .cindex "interface" "listening"
14523 .cindex "network interface"
14524 .cindex "interface" "network"
14525 .cindex "IP address" "for listening"
14526 .cindex "daemon" "listening IP addresses"
14527 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening interfaces"
14528 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
14529 A host that is connected to a TCP/IP network may have one or more physical
14530 hardware network interfaces. Each of these interfaces may be configured as one
14531 or more &"logical"& interfaces, which are the entities that a program actually
14532 works with. Each of these logical interfaces is associated with an IP address.
14533 In addition, TCP/IP software supports &"loopback"& interfaces (127.0.0.1 in
14534 IPv4 and ::1 in IPv6), which do not use any physical hardware. Exim requires
14535 knowledge about the host's interfaces for use in three different circumstances:
14538 When a listening daemon is started, Exim needs to know which interfaces
14539 and ports to listen on.
14541 When Exim is routing an address, it needs to know which IP addresses
14542 are associated with local interfaces. This is required for the correct
14543 processing of MX lists by removing the local host and others with the
14544 same or higher priority values. Also, Exim needs to detect cases
14545 when an address is routed to an IP address that in fact belongs to the
14546 local host. Unless the &%self%& router option or the &%allow_localhost%&
14547 option of the smtp transport is set (as appropriate), this is treated
14548 as an error situation.
14550 When Exim connects to a remote host, it may need to know which interface to use
14551 for the outgoing connection.
14555 Exim's default behaviour is likely to be appropriate in the vast majority
14556 of cases. If your host has only one interface, and you want all its IP
14557 addresses to be treated in the same way, and you are using only the
14558 standard SMTP port, you should not need to take any special action. The
14559 rest of this chapter does not apply to you.
14561 In a more complicated situation you may want to listen only on certain
14562 interfaces, or on different ports, and for this reason there are a number of
14563 options that can be used to influence Exim's behaviour. The rest of this
14564 chapter describes how they operate.
14566 When a message is received over TCP/IP, the interface and port that were
14567 actually used are set in &$received_ip_address$& and &$received_port$&.
14571 .section "Starting a listening daemon" "SECID89"
14572 When a listening daemon is started (by means of the &%-bd%& command line
14573 option), the interfaces and ports on which it listens are controlled by the
14577 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& contains a list of default ports
14579 (For backward compatibility, this option can also be specified in the singular.)
14581 &%local_interfaces%& contains list of interface IP addresses on which to
14582 listen. Each item may optionally also specify a port.
14585 The default list separator in both cases is a colon, but this can be changed as
14586 described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&. When IPv6 addresses are involved,
14587 it is usually best to change the separator to avoid having to double all the
14588 colons. For example:
14590 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; \
14593 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
14595 There are two different formats for specifying a port along with an IP address
14596 in &%local_interfaces%&:
14599 The port is added onto the address with a dot separator. For example, to listen
14600 on port 1234 on two different IP addresses:
14602 local_interfaces = <; 192.168.23.65.1234 ; \
14603 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061.1234
14606 The IP address is enclosed in square brackets, and the port is added
14607 with a colon separator, for example:
14609 local_interfaces = <; [192.168.23.65]:1234 ; \
14610 [3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061]:1234
14614 When a port is not specified, the value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is used. The
14615 default setting contains just one port:
14617 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14619 If more than one port is listed, each interface that does not have its own port
14620 specified listens on all of them. Ports that are listed in
14621 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& can be identified either by name (defined in
14622 &_/etc/services_&) or by number. However, when ports are given with individual
14623 IP addresses in &%local_interfaces%&, only numbers (not names) can be used.
14627 .section "Special IP listening addresses" "SECID90"
14628 The addresses 0.0.0.0 and ::0 are treated specially. They are interpreted
14629 as &"all IPv4 interfaces"& and &"all IPv6 interfaces"&, respectively. In each
14630 case, Exim tells the TCP/IP stack to &"listen on all IPv&'x'& interfaces"&
14631 instead of setting up separate listening sockets for each interface. The
14632 default value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14634 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
14636 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is:
14638 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14640 Thus, by default, Exim listens on all available interfaces, on the SMTP port.
14644 .section "Overriding local_interfaces and daemon_smtp_ports" "SECID91"
14645 The &%-oX%& command line option can be used to override the values of
14646 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& and/or &%local_interfaces%& for a particular daemon
14647 instance. Another way of doing this would be to use macros and the &%-D%&
14648 option. However, &%-oX%& can be used by any admin user, whereas modification of
14649 the runtime configuration by &%-D%& is allowed only when the caller is root or
14652 The value of &%-oX%& is a list of items. The default colon separator can be
14653 changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) if required.
14654 If there are any items that do not
14655 contain dots or colons (that is, are not IP addresses), the value of
14656 &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is replaced by the list of those items. If there are any
14657 items that do contain dots or colons, the value of &%local_interfaces%& is
14658 replaced by those items. Thus, for example,
14662 overrides &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, but leaves &%local_interfaces%& unchanged,
14665 -oX 192.168.34.5.1125
14667 overrides &%local_interfaces%&, leaving &%daemon_smtp_ports%& unchanged.
14668 (However, since &%local_interfaces%& now contains no items without ports, the
14669 value of &%daemon_smtp_ports%& is no longer relevant in this example.)
14673 .section "Support for the submissions (aka SSMTP or SMTPS) protocol" "SECTsupobssmt"
14674 .cindex "submissions protocol"
14675 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
14676 .cindex "smtps protocol"
14677 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
14678 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
14679 Exim supports the use of TLS-on-connect, used by mail clients in the
14680 &"submissions"& protocol, historically also known as SMTPS or SSMTP.
14681 For some years, IETF Standards Track documents only blessed the
14682 STARTTLS-based Submission service (port 587) while common practice was to support
14683 the same feature set on port 465, but using TLS-on-connect.
14684 If your installation needs to provide service to mail clients
14685 (Mail User Agents, MUAs) then you should provide service on both the 587 and
14688 If the &%tls_on_connect_ports%& option is set to a list of port numbers or
14689 service names, connections to those ports must first establish TLS, before
14690 proceeding to the application layer use of the SMTP protocol.
14692 The common use of this option is expected to be
14694 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
14696 per &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314).
14697 There is also a command line option &%-tls-on-connect%&, which forces all ports
14698 to behave in this way when a daemon is started.
14700 &*Warning*&: Setting &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not of itself cause the
14701 daemon to listen on those ports. You must still specify them in
14702 &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%local_interfaces%&, or the &%-oX%& option. (This is
14703 because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& applies to &%inetd%& connections as well as to
14704 connections via the daemon.)
14709 .section "IPv6 address scopes" "SECID92"
14710 .cindex "IPv6" "address scopes"
14711 IPv6 addresses have &"scopes"&, and a host with multiple hardware interfaces
14712 can, in principle, have the same link-local IPv6 address on different
14713 interfaces. Thus, additional information is needed, over and above the IP
14714 address, to distinguish individual interfaces. A convention of using a
14715 percent sign followed by something (often the interface name) has been
14716 adopted in some cases, leading to addresses like this:
14718 fe80::202:b3ff:fe03:45c1%eth0
14720 To accommodate this usage, a percent sign followed by an arbitrary string is
14721 allowed at the end of an IPv6 address. By default, Exim calls &[getaddrinfo()]&
14722 to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use. This function recognizes the
14723 percent convention in operating systems that support it, and it processes the
14724 address appropriately. Unfortunately, some older libraries have problems with
14725 &[getaddrinfo()]&. If
14727 IPV6_USE_INET_PTON=yes
14729 is set in &_Local/Makefile_& (or an OS-dependent Makefile) when Exim is built,
14730 Exim uses &'inet_pton()'& to convert a textual IPv6 address for actual use,
14731 instead of &[getaddrinfo()]&. (Before version 4.14, it always used this
14732 function.) Of course, this means that the additional functionality of
14733 &[getaddrinfo()]& &-- recognizing scoped addresses &-- is lost.
14735 .section "Disabling IPv6" "SECID93"
14736 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
14737 Sometimes it happens that an Exim binary that was compiled with IPv6 support is
14738 run on a host whose kernel does not support IPv6. The binary will fall back to
14739 using IPv4, but it may waste resources looking up AAAA records, and trying to
14740 connect to IPv6 addresses, causing delays to mail delivery. If you set the
14741 .oindex "&%disable_ipv6%&"
14742 &%disable_ipv6%& option true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
14743 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
14744 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &(manualroute)& router,
14745 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
14746 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
14748 On the other hand, when IPv6 is in use, there may be times when you want to
14749 disable it for certain hosts or domains. You can use the &%dns_ipv4_lookup%&
14750 option to globally suppress the lookup of AAAA records for specified domains,
14751 and you can use the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic router option to ignore
14752 IPv6 addresses in an individual router.
14756 .section "Examples of starting a listening daemon" "SECID94"
14757 The default case in an IPv6 environment is
14759 daemon_smtp_ports = smtp
14760 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14762 This specifies listening on the smtp port on all IPv6 and IPv4 interfaces.
14763 Either one or two sockets may be used, depending on the characteristics of
14764 the TCP/IP stack. (This is complicated and messy; for more information,
14765 read the comments in the &_daemon.c_& source file.)
14767 To specify listening on ports 25 and 26 on all interfaces:
14769 daemon_smtp_ports = 25 : 26
14771 (leaving &%local_interfaces%& at the default setting) or, more explicitly:
14773 local_interfaces = <; ::0.25 ; ::0.26 \
14774 0.0.0.0.25 ; 0.0.0.0.26
14776 To listen on the default port on all IPv4 interfaces, and on port 26 on the
14777 IPv4 loopback address only:
14779 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0 : 127.0.0.1.26
14781 To specify listening on the default port on specific interfaces only:
14783 local_interfaces = 10.0.0.67 : 192.168.34.67
14785 &*Warning*&: Such a setting excludes listening on the loopback interfaces.
14789 .section "Recognizing the local host" "SECTreclocipadd"
14790 The &%local_interfaces%& option is also used when Exim needs to determine
14791 whether or not an IP address refers to the local host. That is, the IP
14792 addresses of all the interfaces on which a daemon is listening are always
14795 For this usage, port numbers in &%local_interfaces%& are ignored. If either of
14796 the items 0.0.0.0 or ::0 are encountered, Exim gets a complete list of
14797 available interfaces from the operating system, and extracts the relevant
14798 (that is, IPv4 or IPv6) addresses to use for checking.
14800 Some systems set up large numbers of virtual interfaces in order to provide
14801 many virtual web servers. In this situation, you may want to listen for
14802 email on only a few of the available interfaces, but nevertheless treat all
14803 interfaces as local when routing. You can do this by setting
14804 &%extra_local_interfaces%& to a list of IP addresses, possibly including the
14805 &"all"& wildcard values. These addresses are recognized as local, but are not
14806 used for listening. Consider this example:
14808 local_interfaces = <; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1 ; \
14810 3ffe:2101:12:1:a00:20ff:fe86:a061
14812 extra_local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
14814 The daemon listens on the loopback interfaces and just one IPv4 and one IPv6
14815 address, but all available interface addresses are treated as local when
14818 In some environments the local host name may be in an MX list, but with an IP
14819 address that is not assigned to any local interface. In other cases it may be
14820 desirable to treat other host names as if they referred to the local host. Both
14821 these cases can be handled by setting the &%hosts_treat_as_local%& option.
14822 This contains host names rather than IP addresses. When a host is referenced
14823 during routing, either via an MX record or directly, it is treated as the local
14824 host if its name matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, or if any of its IP
14825 addresses match &%local_interfaces%& or &%extra_local_interfaces%&.
14829 .section "Delivering to a remote host" "SECID95"
14830 Delivery to a remote host is handled by the smtp transport. By default, it
14831 allows the system's TCP/IP functions to choose which interface to use (if
14832 there is more than one) when connecting to a remote host. However, the
14833 &%interface%& option can be set to specify which interface is used. See the
14834 description of the smtp transport in chapter &<<CHAPsmtptrans>>& for more
14840 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14841 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
14843 .chapter "Main configuration" "CHAPmainconfig"
14844 .scindex IIDconfima "configuration file" "main section"
14845 .scindex IIDmaiconf "main configuration"
14846 The first part of the runtime configuration file contains three types of item:
14849 Macro definitions: These lines start with an upper case letter. See section
14850 &<<SECTmacrodefs>>& for details of macro processing.
14852 Named list definitions: These lines start with one of the words &"domainlist"&,
14853 &"hostlist"&, &"addresslist"&, or &"localpartlist"&. Their use is described in
14854 section &<<SECTnamedlists>>&.
14856 Main configuration settings: Each setting occupies one line of the file
14857 (with possible continuations). If any setting is preceded by the word
14858 &"hide"&, the &%-bP%& command line option displays its value to admin users
14859 only. See section &<<SECTcos>>& for a description of the syntax of these option
14863 This chapter specifies all the main configuration options, along with their
14864 types and default values. For ease of finding a particular option, they appear
14865 in alphabetical order in section &<<SECTalomo>>& below. However, because there
14866 are now so many options, they are first listed briefly in functional groups, as
14867 an aid to finding the name of the option you are looking for. Some options are
14868 listed in more than one group.
14870 .section "Miscellaneous" "SECID96"
14872 .row &%add_environment%& "environment variables"
14873 .row &%bi_command%& "to run for &%-bi%& command line option"
14874 .row &%debug_store%& "do extra internal checks"
14875 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
14876 .row &%keep_environment%& "environment variables"
14877 .row &%keep_malformed%& "for broken files &-- should not happen"
14878 .row &%localhost_number%& "for unique message ids in clusters"
14879 .row &%message_body_newlines%& "retain newlines in &$message_body$&"
14880 .row &%message_body_visible%& "how much to show in &$message_body$&"
14881 .row &%mua_wrapper%& "run in &""MUA wrapper""& mode"
14882 .row &%print_topbitchars%& "top-bit characters are printing"
14883 .row &%spool_wireformat%& "use wire-format spool data files when possible"
14884 .row &%timezone%& "force time zone"
14888 .section "Exim parameters" "SECID97"
14890 .row &%exim_group%& "override compiled-in value"
14891 .row &%exim_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14892 .row &%exim_user%& "override compiled-in value"
14893 .row &%primary_hostname%& "default from &[uname()]&"
14894 .row &%split_spool_directory%& "use multiple directories"
14895 .row &%spool_directory%& "override compiled-in value"
14900 .section "Privilege controls" "SECID98"
14902 .row &%admin_groups%& "groups that are Exim admin users"
14903 .row &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& "require admin for various checks"
14904 .row &%deliver_drop_privilege%& "drop root for delivery processes"
14905 .row &%local_from_check%& "insert &'Sender:'& if necessary"
14906 .row &%local_from_prefix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14907 .row &%local_from_suffix%& "for testing &'From:'& for local sender"
14908 .row &%local_sender_retain%& "keep &'Sender:'& from untrusted user"
14909 .row &%never_users%& "do not run deliveries as these"
14910 .row &%prod_requires_admin%& "forced delivery requires admin user"
14911 .row &%queue_list_requires_admin%& "queue listing requires admin user"
14912 .row &%trusted_groups%& "groups that are trusted"
14913 .row &%trusted_users%& "users that are trusted"
14918 .section "Logging" "SECID99"
14920 .row &%event_action%& "custom logging"
14921 .row &%hosts_connection_nolog%& "exemption from connect logging"
14922 .row &%log_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14923 .row &%log_selector%& "set/unset optional logging"
14924 .row &%log_timezone%& "add timezone to log lines"
14925 .row &%message_logs%& "create per-message logs"
14926 .row &%preserve_message_logs%& "after message completion"
14927 .row &%panic_coredump%& "request coredump on fatal errors"
14928 .row &%process_log_path%& "for SIGUSR1 and &'exiwhat'&"
14929 .row &%slow_lookup_log%& "control logging of slow DNS lookups"
14930 .row &%syslog_duplication%& "controls duplicate log lines on syslog"
14931 .row &%syslog_facility%& "set syslog &""facility""& field"
14932 .row &%syslog_pid%& "pid in syslog lines"
14933 .row &%syslog_processname%& "set syslog &""ident""& field"
14934 .row &%syslog_timestamp%& "timestamp syslog lines"
14935 .row &%write_rejectlog%& "control use of message log"
14940 .section "Frozen messages" "SECID100"
14942 .row &%auto_thaw%& "sets time for retrying frozen messages"
14943 .row &%freeze_tell%& "send message when freezing"
14944 .row &%move_frozen_messages%& "to another directory"
14945 .row &%timeout_frozen_after%& "keep frozen messages only so long"
14950 .section "Data lookups" "SECID101"
14952 .row &%ibase_servers%& "InterBase servers"
14953 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_dir%& "dir of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14954 .row &%ldap_ca_cert_file%& "file of CA certs to verify LDAP server's"
14955 .row &%ldap_cert_file%& "client cert file for LDAP"
14956 .row &%ldap_cert_key%& "client key file for LDAP"
14957 .row &%ldap_cipher_suite%& "TLS negotiation preference control"
14958 .row &%ldap_default_servers%& "used if no server in query"
14959 .row &%ldap_require_cert%& "action to take without LDAP server cert"
14960 .row &%ldap_start_tls%& "require TLS within LDAP"
14961 .row &%ldap_version%& "set protocol version"
14962 .row &%lookup_open_max%& "lookup files held open"
14963 .row &%mysql_servers%& "default MySQL servers"
14964 .row &%oracle_servers%& "Oracle servers"
14965 .row &%pgsql_servers%& "default PostgreSQL servers"
14966 .row &%sqlite_lock_timeout%& "as it says"
14971 .section "Message ids" "SECID102"
14973 .row &%message_id_header_domain%& "used to build &'Message-ID:'& header"
14974 .row &%message_id_header_text%& "ditto"
14979 .section "Embedded Perl Startup" "SECID103"
14981 .row &%perl_at_start%& "always start the interpreter"
14982 .row &%perl_startup%& "code to obey when starting Perl"
14983 .row &%perl_taintmode%& "enable taint mode in Perl"
14988 .section "Daemon" "SECID104"
14990 .row &%daemon_smtp_ports%& "default ports"
14991 .row &%daemon_startup_retries%& "number of times to retry"
14992 .row &%daemon_startup_sleep%& "time to sleep between tries"
14993 .row &%extra_local_interfaces%& "not necessarily listened on"
14994 .row &%local_interfaces%& "on which to listen, with optional ports"
14995 .row &%notifier_socket%& "override compiled-in value"
14996 .row &%pid_file_path%& "override compiled-in value"
14997 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
14998 .row &%smtp_backlog_monitor%& "level to log listen backlog"
15003 .section "Resource control" "SECID105"
15005 .row &%check_log_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
15006 .row &%check_log_space%& "before accepting a message"
15007 .row &%check_spool_inodes%& "before accepting a message"
15008 .row &%check_spool_space%& "before accepting a message"
15009 .row &%deliver_queue_load_max%& "no queue deliveries if load high"
15010 .row &%queue_only_load%& "queue incoming if load high"
15011 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
15012 .row &%queue_run_max%& "maximum simultaneous queue runners"
15013 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
15014 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
15015 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
15016 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
15017 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
15018 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
15019 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
15020 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
15022 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
15023 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
15024 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
15025 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "SMTP from reserved hosts if load high"
15026 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
15031 .section "Policy controls" "SECID106"
15033 .row &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
15034 .row &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
15035 .row &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL for start of non-SMTP message"
15036 .row &%acl_smtp_atrn%& "ACL for ATRN"
15037 .row &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
15038 .row &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for connection"
15039 .row &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL for DATA"
15040 .row &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for DATA, per-recipient"
15041 .row &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for DKIM verification"
15042 .row &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
15043 .row &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
15044 .row &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for EHLO or HELO"
15045 .row &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
15046 .row &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for AUTH on MAIL command"
15047 .row &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for MIME parts"
15048 .row &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
15049 .row &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL for start of data"
15050 .row &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
15051 .row &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
15052 .row &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
15053 .row &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
15054 .row &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& "ACL for WELLKNOWN"
15055 .row &%av_scanner%& "specify virus scanner"
15056 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
15058 .row &%dns_cname_loops%& "follow CNAMEs returned by resolver"
15059 .row &%dns_csa_search_limit%& "control CSA parent search depth"
15060 .row &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& "en/disable CSA IP reverse search"
15061 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
15062 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
15063 .row &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& "allow syntactic junk from these hosts"
15064 .row &%helo_allow_chars%& "allow illegal chars in HELO names"
15065 .row &%helo_lookup_domains%& "lookup hostname for these HELO names"
15066 .row &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& "HELO soft-checked for these hosts"
15067 .row &%helo_verify_hosts%& "HELO hard-checked for these hosts"
15068 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
15069 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
15070 .row &%hosts_proxy%& "use proxy protocol for these hosts"
15071 .row &%host_reject_connection%& "reject connection from these hosts"
15072 .row &%hosts_treat_as_local%& "useful in some cluster configurations"
15073 .row &%local_scan_timeout%& "timeout for &[local_scan()]&"
15074 .row &%message_size_limit%& "for all messages"
15075 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
15076 .row &%proxy_protocol_timeout%& "timeout for proxy protocol negotiation"
15077 .row &%spamd_address%& "set interface to SpamAssassin"
15078 .row &%strict_acl_vars%& "object to unset ACL variables"
15079 .row &%spf_smtp_comment_template%& "template for &$spf_smtp_comment$&"
15084 .section "Callout cache" "SECID107"
15086 .row &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative domain cache &&&
15088 .row &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive domain cache &&&
15090 .row &%callout_negative_expire%& "timeout for negative address cache item"
15091 .row &%callout_positive_expire%& "timeout for positive address cache item"
15092 .row &%callout_random_local_part%& "string to use for &""random""& testing"
15097 .section "TLS" "SECID108"
15099 .row &%gnutls_compat_mode%& "use GnuTLS compatibility mode"
15100 .row &%gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11%& "allow GnuTLS to autoload PKCS11 modules"
15101 .row &%hosts_require_alpn%& "mandatory ALPN"
15102 .row &%hosts_require_helo%& "mandatory HELO/EHLO"
15103 .row &%openssl_options%& "adjust OpenSSL compatibility options"
15104 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
15105 .row &%tls_alpn%& "acceptable protocol names"
15106 .row &%tls_certificate%& "location of server certificate"
15107 .row &%tls_crl%& "certificate revocation list"
15108 .row &%tls_dh_max_bits%& "clamp D-H bit count suggestion"
15109 .row &%tls_dhparam%& "DH parameters for server"
15110 .row &%tls_eccurve%& "EC curve selection for server"
15111 .row &%tls_ocsp_file%& "location of server certificate status proof"
15112 .row &%tls_on_connect_ports%& "specify SSMTP (SMTPS) ports"
15113 .row &%tls_privatekey%& "location of server private key"
15114 .row &%tls_remember_esmtp%& "don't reset after starting TLS"
15115 .row &%tls_require_ciphers%& "specify acceptable ciphers"
15116 .row &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& "try to verify client certificate"
15117 .row &%tls_verify_certificates%& "expected client certificates"
15118 .row &%tls_verify_hosts%& "insist on client certificate verify"
15123 .section "Local user handling" "SECID109"
15125 .row &%finduser_retries%& "useful in NIS environments"
15126 .row &%gecos_name%& "used when creating &'Sender:'&"
15127 .row &%gecos_pattern%& "ditto"
15128 .row &%max_username_length%& "for systems that truncate"
15129 .row &%unknown_login%& "used when no login name found"
15130 .row &%unknown_username%& "ditto"
15131 .row &%uucp_from_pattern%& "for recognizing &""From ""& lines"
15132 .row &%uucp_from_sender%& "ditto"
15137 .section "All incoming messages (SMTP and non-SMTP)" "SECID110"
15139 .row &%header_maxsize%& "total size of message header"
15140 .row &%header_line_maxsize%& "individual header line limit"
15141 .row &%message_size_limit%& "applies to all messages"
15142 .row &%percent_hack_domains%& "recognize %-hack for these domains"
15143 .row &%received_header_text%& "expanded to make &'Received:'&"
15144 .row &%received_headers_max%& "for mail loop detection"
15145 .row &%recipients_max%& "limit per message"
15146 .row &%recipients_max_reject%& "permanently reject excess recipients"
15152 .section "Non-SMTP incoming messages" "SECID111"
15154 .row &%receive_timeout%& "for non-SMTP messages"
15161 .section "Incoming SMTP messages" "SECID112"
15162 See also the &'Policy controls'& section above.
15165 .row &%dkim_verify_hashes%& "DKIM hash methods accepted for signatures"
15166 .row &%dkim_verify_keytypes%& "DKIM key types accepted for signatures"
15167 .row &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%& "DKIM key sizes accepted for signatures"
15168 .row &%dkim_verify_signers%& "DKIM domains for which DKIM ACL is run"
15169 .row &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& "DMARC sender for report messages"
15170 .row &%dmarc_history_file%& "DMARC results log"
15171 .row &%dmarc_tld_file%& "DMARC toplevel domains file"
15172 .row &%host_lookup%& "host name looked up for these hosts"
15173 .row &%host_lookup_order%& "order of DNS and local name lookups"
15174 .row &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified recipients"
15175 .row &%rfc1413_hosts%& "make ident calls to these hosts"
15176 .row &%rfc1413_query_timeout%& "zero disables ident calls"
15177 .row &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& "may send unqualified senders"
15178 .row &%smtp_accept_keepalive%& "some TCP/IP magic"
15179 .row &%smtp_accept_max%& "simultaneous incoming connections"
15180 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& "non-mail commands"
15181 .row &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%& "hosts to which the limit applies"
15182 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%& "messages per connection"
15183 .row &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& "connections from one host"
15184 .row &%smtp_accept_queue%& "queue mail if more connections"
15185 .row &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& "queue if more messages per &&&
15187 .row &%smtp_accept_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if more connections"
15188 .row &%smtp_active_hostname%& "host name to use in messages"
15189 .row &%smtp_banner%& "text for welcome banner"
15190 .row &%smtp_check_spool_space%& "from SIZE on MAIL command"
15191 .row &%smtp_connect_backlog%& "passed to TCP/IP stack"
15192 .row &%smtp_enforce_sync%& "of SMTP command/responses"
15193 .row &%smtp_etrn_command%& "what to run for ETRN"
15194 .row &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& "only one at once"
15195 .row &%smtp_load_reserve%& "only reserve hosts if this load"
15196 .row &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& "before dropping connection"
15197 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& "apply ratelimiting to these hosts"
15198 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& "ratelimit for MAIL commands"
15199 .row &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& "ratelimit for RCPT commands"
15200 .row &%smtp_receive_timeout%& "per command or data line"
15201 .row &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& "these are the reserve hosts"
15202 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
15207 .section "SMTP extensions" "SECID113"
15209 .row &%accept_8bitmime%& "advertise 8BITMIME"
15210 .row &%auth_advertise_hosts%& "advertise AUTH to these hosts"
15211 .row &%chunking_advertise_hosts%& "advertise CHUNKING to these hosts"
15212 .row &%dsn_advertise_hosts%& "advertise DSN extensions to these hosts"
15213 .row &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& "allow &""From ""& from these hosts"
15214 .row &%ignore_fromline_local%& "allow &""From ""& from local SMTP"
15215 .row &%limits_advertise_hosts%& "advertise LIMITS to these hosts"
15216 .row &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
15217 .row &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& "advertise pipelining to these hosts"
15218 .row &%prdr_enable%& "advertise PRDR to all hosts"
15219 .row &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& "advertise SMTPUTF8 to these hosts"
15220 .row &%tls_advertise_hosts%& "advertise TLS to these hosts"
15221 .row &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%& "advertise WELLKNOWN to these hosts"
15226 .section "Processing messages" "SECID114"
15228 .row &%allow_domain_literals%& "recognize domain literal syntax"
15229 .row &%allow_mx_to_ip%& "allow MX to point to IP address"
15230 .row &%allow_utf8_domains%& "in addresses"
15231 .row &%check_rfc2047_length%& "check length of RFC 2047 &""encoded &&&
15233 .row &%delivery_date_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15234 .row &%envelope_to_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15235 .row &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& "affects &%-t%& processing"
15236 .row &%headers_charset%& "default for translations"
15237 .row &%qualify_domain%& "default for senders"
15238 .row &%qualify_recipient%& "default for recipients"
15239 .row &%return_path_remove%& "from incoming messages"
15240 .row &%strip_excess_angle_brackets%& "in addresses"
15241 .row &%strip_trailing_dot%& "at end of addresses"
15242 .row &%untrusted_set_sender%& "untrusted can set envelope sender"
15247 .section "System filter" "SECID115"
15249 .row &%system_filter%& "locate system filter"
15250 .row &%system_filter_directory_transport%& "transport for delivery to a &&&
15252 .row &%system_filter_file_transport%& "transport for delivery to a file"
15253 .row &%system_filter_group%& "group for filter running"
15254 .row &%system_filter_pipe_transport%& "transport for delivery to a pipe"
15255 .row &%system_filter_reply_transport%& "transport for autoreply delivery"
15256 .row &%system_filter_user%& "user for filter running"
15261 .section "Routing and delivery" "SECID116"
15263 .row &%disable_ipv6%& "do no IPv6 processing"
15264 .row &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& "for broken domains"
15265 .row &%dns_check_names_pattern%& "pre-DNS syntax check"
15266 .row &%dns_dnssec_ok%& "parameter for resolver"
15267 .row &%dns_ipv4_lookup%& "only v4 lookup for these domains"
15268 .row &%dns_retrans%& "parameter for resolver"
15269 .row &%dns_retry%& "parameter for resolver"
15270 .row &%dns_trust_aa%& "DNS zones trusted as authentic"
15271 .row &%dns_use_edns0%& "parameter for resolver"
15272 .row &%hold_domains%& "hold delivery for these domains"
15273 .row &%local_interfaces%& "for routing checks"
15274 .row &%queue_domains%& "no immediate delivery for these"
15275 .row &%queue_fast_ramp%& "parallel delivery with 2-phase queue run"
15276 .row &%queue_only%& "no immediate delivery at all"
15277 .row &%queue_only_file%& "no immediate delivery if file exists"
15278 .row &%queue_only_load%& "no immediate delivery if load is high"
15279 .row &%queue_only_load_latch%& "don't re-evaluate load for each message"
15280 .row &%queue_only_override%& "allow command line to override"
15281 .row &%queue_run_in_order%& "order of arrival"
15282 .row &%queue_run_max%& "of simultaneous queue runners"
15283 .row &%queue_smtp_domains%& "no immediate SMTP delivery for these"
15284 .row &%remote_max_parallel%& "parallel SMTP delivery per message"
15285 .row &%remote_sort_domains%& "order of remote deliveries"
15286 .row &%retry_data_expire%& "timeout for retry data"
15287 .row &%retry_interval_max%& "safety net for retry rules"
15292 .section "Bounce and warning messages" "SECID117"
15294 .row &%bounce_message_file%& "content of bounce"
15295 .row &%bounce_message_text%& "content of bounce"
15296 .row &%bounce_return_body%& "include body if returning message"
15297 .row &%bounce_return_linesize_limit%& "limit on returned message line length"
15298 .row &%bounce_return_message%& "include original message in bounce"
15299 .row &%bounce_return_size_limit%& "limit on returned message"
15300 .row &%bounce_sender_authentication%& "send authenticated sender with bounce"
15301 .row &%dsn_from%& "set &'From:'& contents in bounces"
15302 .row &%errors_copy%& "copy bounce messages"
15303 .row &%errors_reply_to%& "&'Reply-to:'& in bounces"
15304 .row &%delay_warning%& "time schedule"
15305 .row &%delay_warning_condition%& "condition for warning messages"
15306 .row &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%& "discard undeliverable bounces"
15307 .row &%smtp_return_error_details%& "give detail on rejections"
15308 .row &%warn_message_file%& "content of warning message"
15313 .section "Alphabetical list of main options" "SECTalomo"
15314 Those options that undergo string expansion before use are marked with
15317 .option accept_8bitmime main boolean true
15319 .cindex "8-bit characters"
15320 .cindex "log" "selectors"
15321 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
15322 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" 8BITMIME
15323 This option causes Exim to send 8BITMIME in its response to an SMTP
15324 EHLO command, and to accept the BODY= parameter on MAIL commands.
15325 However, though Exim is 8-bit clean, it is not a protocol converter, and it
15326 takes no steps to do anything special with messages received by this route.
15328 Historically Exim kept this option off by default, but the maintainers
15329 feel that in today's Internet, this causes more problems than it solves.
15330 It now defaults to true.
15331 A more detailed analysis of the issues is provided by Dan Bernstein:
15333 &url(https://cr.yp.to/smtp/8bitmime.html)
15336 To log received 8BITMIME status use
15338 log_selector = +8bitmime
15341 .option acl_not_smtp main string&!! unset
15342 .cindex "&ACL;" "for non-SMTP messages"
15343 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15344 This option defines the ACL that is run when a non-SMTP message has been
15345 read and is on the point of being accepted. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for
15348 .option acl_not_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15349 This option defines the ACL that is run for individual MIME parts of non-SMTP
15350 messages. It operates in exactly the same way as &%acl_smtp_mime%& operates for
15353 .option acl_not_smtp_start main string&!! unset
15354 .cindex "&ACL;" "at start of non-SMTP message"
15355 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
15356 This option defines the ACL that is run before Exim starts reading a
15357 non-SMTP message. See section &<<SECnonSMTP>>& for further details.
15360 .option acl_smtp_atrn main string&!! unset
15361 .cindex ATRN "ACL for"
15362 .cindex ATRN advertisement
15363 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ATRN
15364 .cindex ODMR provider
15365 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ATRN command is
15367 If no value is set, or the result after expansion is an empty string,
15368 then the ATRN facility is not advertised.
15369 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs,
15370 and section &<<SECTODMRPRDVR>>& for description of ATRN.
15373 .option acl_smtp_auth main string&!! unset
15374 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting up for SMTP commands"
15375 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
15376 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP AUTH command is
15378 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs, and chapter
15379 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15381 .option acl_smtp_connect main string&!! unset
15382 .cindex "&ACL;" "on SMTP connection"
15383 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP connection is received.
15384 See section &<<SECconnectACL>>& for further details.
15386 .option acl_smtp_data main string&!! unset
15387 .cindex "DATA" "ACL for"
15388 This option defines the ACL that is run after an SMTP DATA command has been
15389 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the final
15390 acknowledgment is sent. See section &<<SECdataACLS>>& for further details.
15392 .option acl_smtp_data_prdr main string&!! accept
15393 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
15394 .cindex "DATA" "PRDR ACL for"
15395 .cindex "&ACL;" "PRDR-related"
15396 .cindex "&ACL;" "per-user data processing"
15397 This option defines the ACL that,
15398 if the PRDR feature has been negotiated,
15399 is run for each recipient after an SMTP DATA command has been
15400 processed and the message itself has been received, but before the
15401 acknowledgment is sent. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>& for further details.
15403 .option acl_smtp_dkim main string&!! unset
15404 .cindex DKIM "ACL for"
15405 This option defines the ACL that is run for each DKIM signature
15406 (by default, or as specified in the dkim_verify_signers option)
15407 of a received message.
15408 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>& for further details.
15410 .option acl_smtp_etrn main string&!! unset
15411 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
15412 .cindex "ETRN" advertisement
15413 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP ETRN command is
15415 If no value is set then the ETRN facility is not advertised.
15416 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs,
15417 and section &<<SECTETRN>>& for description of ETRN.
15419 .option acl_smtp_expn main string&!! unset
15420 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
15421 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EXPN command is
15422 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15424 .option acl_smtp_helo main string&!! unset
15425 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
15426 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
15427 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP EHLO or HELO
15428 command is received. See section &<<SECheloACL>>& for further details.
15431 .option acl_smtp_mail main string&!! unset
15432 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
15433 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP MAIL command is
15434 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15436 .option acl_smtp_mailauth main string&!! unset
15437 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
15438 This option defines the ACL that is run when there is an AUTH parameter on
15440 See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for general information on ACLs, and chapter
15441 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
15443 .option acl_smtp_mime main string&!! unset
15444 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
15445 This option is available when Exim is built with the content-scanning
15446 extension. It defines the ACL that is run for each MIME part in a message. See
15447 section &<<SECTscanmimepart>>& for details.
15449 .option acl_smtp_notquit main string&!! unset
15450 .cindex "not-QUIT, ACL for"
15451 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP session
15452 ends without a QUIT command being received.
15453 See section &<<SECTNOTQUITACL>>& for further details.
15455 .option acl_smtp_predata main string&!! unset
15456 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP DATA command is
15457 received, before the message itself is received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for
15460 .option acl_smtp_quit main string&!! unset
15461 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
15462 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP QUIT command is
15463 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15465 .option acl_smtp_rcpt main string&!! unset
15466 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
15467 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP RCPT command is
15468 received. See section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& for further details.
15470 .option acl_smtp_starttls main string&!! unset
15471 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
15472 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP STARTTLS command is
15473 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15475 .option acl_smtp_vrfy main string&!! unset
15476 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
15477 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP VRFY command is
15478 received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for further details.
15480 .option acl_smtp_wellknown main string&!! unset
15481 .cindex "WELLKNOWN, ACL for"
15482 This option defines the ACL that is run when an SMTP WELLKNOWN command is
15483 received. See section &<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>& for further details.
15485 .option add_environment main "string list" empty
15486 .cindex "environment" "set values"
15487 This option adds individual environment variables that the
15488 currently linked libraries and programs in child processes may use.
15489 Each list element should be of the form &"name=value"&.
15491 See &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the environment of &(pipe)& transports.
15493 .option admin_groups main "string list&!!" unset
15494 .cindex "admin user"
15495 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If the
15496 current group or any of the supplementary groups of an Exim caller is in this
15497 colon-separated list, the caller has admin privileges. If all your system
15498 programmers are in a specific group, for example, you can give them all Exim
15499 admin privileges by putting that group in &%admin_groups%&. However, this does
15500 not permit them to read Exim's spool files (whose group owner is the Exim gid).
15501 To permit this, you have to add individuals to the Exim group.
15503 .option allow_domain_literals main boolean false
15504 .cindex "domain literal"
15505 If this option is set, the
15506 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
15507 domain literal format is permitted in
15508 email addresses. The option is not set by default, because the domain literal
15509 format is not normally required these days, and few people know about it. It
15510 has, however, been exploited by mail abusers.
15512 Unfortunately, it seems that some DNS black list maintainers are using this
15513 format to report black listing to postmasters. If you want to accept messages
15514 addressed to your hosts by IP address, you need to set
15515 &%allow_domain_literals%& true, and also to add &`@[]`& to the list of local
15516 domains (defined in the named domain list &%local_domains%& in the default
15517 configuration). This &"magic string"& matches the domain literal form of all
15518 the local host's IP addresses.
15520 .option allow_mx_to_ip main boolean false
15521 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to IP address"
15522 It appears that more and more DNS zone administrators are breaking the rules
15523 and putting domain names that look like IP addresses on the right hand side of
15524 MX records. Exim follows the rules and rejects this, giving an error message
15525 that explains the misconfiguration. However, some other MTAs support this
15526 practice, so to avoid &"Why can't Exim do this?"& complaints,
15527 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& exists, in order to enable this heinous activity. It is not
15528 recommended, except when you have no other choice.
15530 .option allow_utf8_domains main boolean false
15531 .cindex "domain" "UTF-8 characters in"
15532 .cindex "UTF-8" "in domain name"
15533 Lots of discussion is going on about internationalized domain names. One
15534 camp is strongly in favour of just using UTF-8 characters, and it seems
15535 that at least two other MTAs permit this.
15536 This option allows Exim users to experiment if they wish.
15538 If it is set true, Exim's domain parsing function allows valid
15539 UTF-8 multicharacters to appear in domain name components, in addition to
15540 letters, digits, and hyphens.
15542 If Exim is built with internationalization support
15543 and the SMTPUTF8 ESMTP option is in use (see chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>&)
15544 this option can be left as default.
15546 if you want to look up such domain names in the DNS, you must also
15547 adjust the value of &%dns_check_names_pattern%& to match the extended form. A
15548 suitable setting is:
15550 dns_check_names_pattern = (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[a-z0-9\xc0-\xff]\
15551 (?>[-a-z0-9\x80-\xff]*[a-z0-9\x80-\xbf])?)+$
15553 Alternatively, you can just disable this feature by setting
15555 dns_check_names_pattern =
15557 That is, set the option to an empty string so that no check is done.
15560 .option auth_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15561 .cindex "authentication" "advertising"
15562 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising"
15563 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
15564 If any server authentication mechanisms are configured, Exim advertises them in
15565 response to an EHLO command only if the calling host matches this list.
15566 Otherwise, Exim does not advertise AUTH.
15567 Exim does not accept AUTH commands from clients to which it has not
15568 advertised the availability of AUTH. The advertising of individual
15569 authentication mechanisms can be controlled by the use of the
15570 &%server_advertise_condition%& generic authenticator option on the individual
15571 authenticators. See chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for further details.
15573 Certain mail clients (for example, Netscape) require the user to provide a name
15574 and password for authentication if AUTH is advertised, even though it may
15575 not be needed (the host may accept messages from hosts on its local LAN without
15576 authentication, for example). The &%auth_advertise_hosts%& option can be used
15577 to make these clients more friendly by excluding them from the set of hosts to
15578 which Exim advertises AUTH.
15580 .cindex "AUTH" "advertising when encrypted"
15581 If you want to advertise the availability of AUTH only when the connection
15582 is encrypted using TLS, you can make use of the fact that the value of this
15583 option is expanded, with a setting like this:
15585 auth_advertise_hosts = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{}{*}}
15587 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
15588 If &$tls_in_cipher$& is empty, the session is not encrypted, and the result of
15589 the expansion is empty, thus matching no hosts. Otherwise, the result of the
15590 expansion is *, which matches all hosts.
15593 .option auto_thaw main time 0s
15594 .cindex "thawing messages"
15595 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
15596 If this option is set to a time greater than zero, a queue runner will try a
15597 new delivery attempt on any frozen message, other than a bounce message, if
15598 this much time has passed since it was frozen. This may result in the message
15599 being re-frozen if nothing has changed since the last attempt. It is a way of
15600 saying &"keep on trying, even though there are big problems"&.
15602 &*Note*&: This is an old option, which predates &%timeout_frozen_after%& and
15603 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. It is retained for compatibility, but it is not
15604 thought to be very useful any more, and its use should probably be avoided.
15607 .option av_scanner main string "see below"
15608 This option is available if Exim is built with the content-scanning extension.
15609 It specifies which anti-virus scanner to use. The default value is:
15611 sophie:/var/run/sophie
15613 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
15614 before use. See section &<<SECTscanvirus>>& for further details.
15617 .option bi_command main string unset
15619 This option supplies the name of a command that is run when Exim is called with
15620 the &%-bi%& option (see chapter &<<CHAPcommandline>>&). The string value is
15621 just the command name, it is not a complete command line. If an argument is
15622 required, it must come from the &%-oA%& command line option.
15625 .option bounce_message_file main string&!! unset
15626 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
15627 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
15628 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
15629 for constructing bounce messages. Details of the file's contents are given in
15630 chapter &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
15631 .cindex bounce_message_file "tainted data"
15632 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
15633 absolute and untainted.
15634 See also &%warn_message_file%&.
15637 .option bounce_message_text main string unset
15638 When this option is set, its contents are included in the default bounce
15639 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
15640 delivery software."& It is not used if &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
15642 .option bounce_return_body main boolean true
15643 .cindex "bounce message" "including body"
15644 This option controls whether the body of an incoming message is included in a
15645 bounce message when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The default setting
15646 causes the entire message, both header and body, to be returned (subject to the
15647 value of &%bounce_return_size_limit%&). If this option is false, only the
15648 message header is included. In the case of a non-SMTP message containing an
15649 error that is detected during reception, only those header lines preceding the
15650 point at which the error was detected are returned.
15651 .cindex "bounce message" "including original"
15653 .option bounce_return_linesize_limit main integer 998
15654 .cindex "size" "of bounce lines, limit"
15655 .cindex "bounce message" "line length limit"
15656 .cindex "limit" "bounce message line length"
15657 This option sets a limit in bytes on the line length of messages
15658 that are returned to senders due to delivery problems,
15659 when &%bounce_return_message%& is true.
15660 The default value corresponds to RFC limits.
15661 If the message being returned has lines longer than this value it is
15662 treated as if the &%bounce_return_size_limit%& (below) restriction was exceeded.
15664 The option also applies to bounces returned when an error is detected
15665 during reception of a message.
15666 In this case lines from the original are truncated.
15668 The option does not apply to messages generated by an &(autoreply)& transport.
15671 .option bounce_return_message main boolean true
15672 If this option is set false, none of the original message is included in
15673 bounce messages generated by Exim. See also &%bounce_return_size_limit%& and
15674 &%bounce_return_body%&.
15677 .option bounce_return_size_limit main integer 100K
15678 .cindex "size" "of bounce, limit"
15679 .cindex "bounce message" "size limit"
15680 .cindex "limit" "bounce message size"
15681 This option sets a limit in bytes on the size of messages that are returned to
15682 senders as part of bounce messages when &%bounce_return_message%& is true. The
15683 limit should be less than the value of the global &%message_size_limit%& and of
15684 any &%message_size_limit%& settings on transports, to allow for the bounce text
15685 that Exim generates. If this option is set to zero there is no limit.
15687 When the body of any message that is to be included in a bounce message is
15688 greater than the limit, it is truncated, and a comment pointing this out is
15689 added at the top. The actual cutoff may be greater than the value given, owing
15690 to the use of buffering for transferring the message in chunks (typically 8K in
15691 size). The idea is to save bandwidth on those undeliverable 15-megabyte
15694 .option bounce_sender_authentication main string unset
15695 .cindex "bounce message" "sender authentication"
15696 .cindex "authentication" "bounce message"
15697 .cindex "AUTH" "on bounce message"
15698 This option provides an authenticated sender address that is sent with any
15699 bounce messages generated by Exim that are sent over an authenticated SMTP
15700 connection. A typical setting might be:
15702 bounce_sender_authentication = mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15704 which would cause bounce messages to be sent using the SMTP command:
15706 MAIL FROM:<> AUTH=mailer-daemon@my.domain.example
15708 The value of &%bounce_sender_authentication%& must always be a complete email
15711 .option callout_domain_negative_expire main time 3h
15712 .cindex "caching" "callout timeouts"
15713 .cindex "callout" "caching timeouts"
15714 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for a
15715 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15716 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15719 .option callout_domain_positive_expire main time 7d
15720 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for a
15721 domain. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15722 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15725 .option callout_negative_expire main time 2h
15726 This option specifies the expiry time for negative callout cache data for an
15727 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15728 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15731 .option callout_positive_expire main time 24h
15732 This option specifies the expiry time for positive callout cache data for an
15733 address. See section &<<SECTcallver>>& for details of callout verification, and
15734 section &<<SECTcallvercache>>& for details of the caching.
15737 .option callout_random_local_part main string&!! "see below"
15738 This option defines the &"random"& local part that can be used as part of
15739 callout verification. The default value is
15741 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
15743 See section &<<CALLaddparcall>>& for details of how this value is used.
15746 .options check_log_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15747 check_log_space main integer 10M
15748 See &%check_spool_space%& below.
15750 .oindex "&%check_rfc2047_length%&"
15751 .cindex "RFC 2047" "disabling length check"
15752 .option check_rfc2047_length main boolean true
15753 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047)
15754 defines a way of encoding non-ASCII characters in headers using a
15755 system of &"encoded words"&. The RFC specifies a maximum length for an encoded
15756 word; strings to be encoded that exceed this length are supposed to use
15757 multiple encoded words. By default, Exim does not recognize encoded words that
15758 exceed the maximum length. However, it seems that some software, in violation
15759 of the RFC, generates overlong encoded words. If &%check_rfc2047_length%& is
15760 set false, Exim recognizes encoded words of any length.
15763 .options check_spool_inodes main integer 100 &&&
15764 check_spool_space main integer 10M
15765 .cindex "checking disk space"
15766 .cindex "disk space, checking"
15767 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
15768 The four &%check_...%& options allow for checking of disk resources before a
15769 message is accepted.
15771 .vindex "&$log_inodes$&"
15772 .vindex "&$log_space$&"
15773 .vindex "&$spool_inodes$&"
15774 .vindex "&$spool_space$&"
15775 When any of these options are nonzero, they apply to all incoming messages. If you
15776 want to apply different checks to different kinds of message, you can do so by
15777 testing the variables &$log_inodes$&, &$log_space$&, &$spool_inodes$&, and
15778 &$spool_space$& in an ACL with appropriate additional conditions.
15781 &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_spool_inodes%& check the spool partition if
15782 either value is greater than zero, for example:
15784 check_spool_space = 100M
15785 check_spool_inodes = 100
15787 The spool partition is the one that contains the directory defined by
15788 SPOOL_DIRECTORY in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is used for holding messages in
15791 &%check_log_space%& and &%check_log_inodes%& check the partition in which log
15792 files are written if either is greater than zero. These should be set only if
15793 &%log_file_path%& and &%spool_directory%& refer to different partitions.
15795 If there is less space or fewer inodes than requested, Exim refuses to accept
15796 incoming mail. In the case of SMTP input this is done by giving a 452 temporary
15797 error response to the MAIL command. If ESMTP is in use and there was a
15798 SIZE parameter on the MAIL command, its value is added to the
15799 &%check_spool_space%& value, and the check is performed even if
15800 &%check_spool_space%& is zero, unless &%no_smtp_check_spool_space%& is set.
15802 The values for &%check_spool_space%& and &%check_log_space%& are held as a
15803 number of kilobytes (though specified in bytes).
15804 If a non-multiple of 1024 is specified, it is rounded up.
15806 For non-SMTP input and for batched SMTP input, the test is done at start-up; on
15807 failure a message is written to stderr and Exim exits with a non-zero code, as
15808 it obviously cannot send an error message of any kind.
15810 There is a slight performance penalty for these checks.
15811 Versions of Exim preceding 4.88 had these disabled by default;
15812 high-rate installations confident they will never run out of resources
15813 may wish to deliberately disable them.
15815 .option chunking_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
15816 .cindex CHUNKING advertisement
15817 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
15818 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" CHUNKING
15819 The CHUNKING extension
15820 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3030.html,RFC 3030))
15821 will be advertised in the EHLO message to these hosts.
15822 Hosts may use the BDAT command as an alternate to DATA.
15824 .option commandline_checks_require_admin main boolean &`false`&
15825 .cindex "restricting access to features"
15826 This option restricts various basic checking features to require an
15827 administrative user.
15828 This affects most of the &%-b*%& options, such as &%-be%&.
15830 .option debug_store main boolean &`false`&
15831 .cindex debugging "memory corruption"
15832 .cindex memory debugging
15833 This option, when true, enables extra checking in Exim's internal memory
15834 management. For use when a memory corruption issue is being investigated,
15835 it should normally be left as default.
15837 .option daemon_smtp_ports main string &`smtp`&
15838 .cindex "port" "for daemon"
15839 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting listening ports"
15840 This option specifies one or more default SMTP ports on which the Exim daemon
15841 listens. See chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& for details of how it is used. For
15842 backward compatibility, &%daemon_smtp_port%& (singular) is a synonym.
15844 .options daemon_startup_retries main integer 9 &&&
15845 daemon_startup_sleep main time 30s
15846 .cindex "daemon startup, retrying"
15847 These options control the retrying done by
15848 the daemon at startup when it cannot immediately bind a listening socket
15849 (typically because the socket is already in use): &%daemon_startup_retries%&
15850 defines the number of retries after the first failure, and
15851 &%daemon_startup_sleep%& defines the length of time to wait between retries.
15853 .option delay_warning main "time list" 24h
15854 .cindex "warning of delay"
15855 .cindex "delay warning, specifying"
15856 .cindex "queue" "delay warning"
15857 When a message is delayed, Exim sends a warning message to the sender at
15858 intervals specified by this option. The data is a colon-separated list of times
15859 after which to send warning messages. If the value of the option is an empty
15860 string or a zero time, no warnings are sent. Up to 10 times may be given. If a
15861 message has been in the queue for longer than the last time, the last interval
15862 between the times is used to compute subsequent warning times. For example,
15865 delay_warning = 4h:8h:24h
15867 the first message is sent after 4 hours, the second after 8 hours, and
15868 the third one after 24 hours. After that, messages are sent every 16 hours,
15869 because that is the interval between the last two times on the list. If you set
15870 just one time, it specifies the repeat interval. For example, with:
15874 messages are repeated every six hours. To stop warnings after a given time, set
15875 a very large time at the end of the list. For example:
15877 delay_warning = 2h:12h:99d
15879 Note that the option is only evaluated at the time a delivery attempt fails,
15880 which depends on retry and queue-runner configuration.
15881 Typically retries will be configured more frequently than warning messages.
15883 .option delay_warning_condition main string&!! "see below"
15884 .vindex "&$domain$&"
15885 The string is expanded at the time a warning message might be sent. If all the
15886 deferred addresses have the same domain, it is set in &$domain$& during the
15887 expansion. Otherwise &$domain$& is empty. If the result of the expansion is a
15888 forced failure, an empty string, or a string matching any of &"0"&, &"no"& or
15889 &"false"& (the comparison being done caselessly) then the warning message is
15890 not sent. The default is:
15892 delay_warning_condition = ${if or {\
15893 { !eq{$h_list-id:$h_list-post:$h_list-subscribe:}{} }\
15894 { match{$h_precedence:}{(?i)bulk|list|junk} }\
15895 { match{$h_auto-submitted:}{(?i)auto-generated|auto-replied} }\
15898 This suppresses the sending of warnings for messages that contain &'List-ID:'&,
15899 &'List-Post:'&, or &'List-Subscribe:'& headers, or have &"bulk"&, &"list"& or
15900 &"junk"& in a &'Precedence:'& header, or have &"auto-generated"& or
15901 &"auto-replied"& in an &'Auto-Submitted:'& header.
15903 .option deliver_drop_privilege main boolean false
15904 .cindex "unprivileged delivery"
15905 .cindex "delivery" "unprivileged"
15906 If this option is set true, Exim drops its root privilege at the start of a
15907 delivery process, and runs as the Exim user throughout. This severely restricts
15908 the kinds of local delivery that are possible, but is viable in certain types
15909 of configuration. There is a discussion about the use of root privilege in
15910 chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>&.
15912 .option deliver_queue_load_max main fixed-point unset
15913 .cindex "load average"
15914 .cindex "queue runner" "abandoning"
15915 When this option is set, a queue run is abandoned if the system load average
15916 becomes greater than the value of the option. The option has no effect on
15917 ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average.
15918 See also &%queue_only_load%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
15921 .option delivery_date_remove main boolean true
15922 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
15923 Exim's transports have an option for adding a &'Delivery-date:'& header to a
15924 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
15925 handled. &'Delivery-date:'& records the actual time of delivery. Such headers
15926 should not be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be
15927 removed at the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might
15928 occur when a delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
15930 .option disable_fsync main boolean false
15931 .cindex "&[fsync()]&, disabling"
15932 This option is available only if Exim was built with the compile-time option
15933 ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC. When this is not set, a reference to &%disable_fsync%& in
15934 a runtime configuration generates an &"unknown option"& error. You should not
15935 build Exim with ENABLE_DISABLE_FSYNC or set &%disable_fsync%& unless you
15936 really, really, really understand what you are doing. &'No pre-compiled
15937 distributions of Exim should ever make this option available.'&
15939 When &%disable_fsync%& is set true, Exim no longer calls &[fsync()]& to force
15940 updated files' data to be written to disc before continuing. Unexpected events
15941 such as crashes and power outages may cause data to be lost or scrambled.
15942 Here be Dragons. &*Beware.*&
15945 .option disable_ipv6 main boolean false
15946 .cindex "IPv6" "disabling"
15947 If this option is set true, even if the Exim binary has IPv6 support, no IPv6
15948 activities take place. AAAA records are never looked up, and any IPv6 addresses
15949 that are listed in &%local_interfaces%&, data for the &%manualroute%& router,
15950 etc. are ignored. If IP literals are enabled, the &(ipliteral)& router declines
15951 to handle IPv6 literal addresses.
15954 .option dkim_verify_hashes main "string list" "sha256 : sha512"
15955 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
15956 This option gives a list of hash types which are acceptable in signatures,
15957 and an order of processing.
15958 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15960 Acceptable values include:
15967 Note that the acceptance of sha1 violates
15968 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301).
15970 .option dkim_verify_keytypes main "string list" "ed25519 : rsa"
15971 This option gives a list of key types which are acceptable in signatures,
15972 and an order of processing.
15973 Signatures with algorithms not in the list will be ignored.
15976 .option dkim_verify_min_keysizes main "string list" "rsa=1024 ed25519=250"
15977 This option gives a list of key sizes which are acceptable in signatures.
15978 The list is keyed by the algorithm type for the key; the values are in bits.
15979 Signatures with keys smaller than given by this option will fail verification.
15981 The default enforces the
15982 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301)
15983 minimum key size for RSA signatures.
15985 .option dkim_verify_minimal main boolean false
15986 If set to true, verification of signatures will terminate after the
15989 .option dkim_verify_signers main "domain list&!!" $dkim_signers
15990 .cindex DKIM "controlling calls to the ACL"
15991 This option gives a list of DKIM domains for which the DKIM ACL is run.
15992 It is expanded after the message is received; by default it runs
15993 the ACL once for each signature in the message.
15994 See section &<<SECDKIMVFY>>&.
15997 .options dmarc_forensic_sender main string&!! unset &&&
15998 dmarc_history_file&!! main string unset &&&
15999 dmarc_tld_file main&!! string unset
16000 .cindex DMARC "main section options"
16001 These options control DMARC processing.
16002 See section &<<SECDMARC>>& for details.
16005 .option dns_again_means_nonexist main "domain list&!!" unset
16006 .cindex "DNS" "&""try again""& response; overriding"
16007 DNS lookups give a &"try again"& response for the DNS errors
16008 &"non-authoritative host not found"& and &"SERVERFAIL"&. This can cause Exim to
16009 keep trying to deliver a message, or to give repeated temporary errors to
16010 incoming mail. Sometimes the effect is caused by a badly set up name server and
16011 may persist for a long time. If a domain which exhibits this problem matches
16012 anything in &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, it is treated as if it did not exist.
16013 This option should be used with care. You can make it apply to reverse lookups
16014 by a setting such as this:
16016 dns_again_means_nonexist = *.in-addr.arpa
16018 This option applies to all DNS lookups that Exim does,
16019 except for TLSA lookups (where knowing about such failures
16020 is security-relevant).
16021 It also applies when the
16022 &[gethostbyname()]& or &[getipnodebyname()]& functions give temporary errors,
16023 since these are most likely to be caused by DNS lookup problems. The
16024 &(dnslookup)& router has some options of its own for controlling what happens
16025 when lookups for MX or SRV records give temporary errors. These more specific
16026 options are applied after this global option.
16028 .option dns_check_names_pattern main string "see below"
16029 .cindex "DNS" "pre-check of name syntax"
16030 When this option is set to a non-empty string, it causes Exim to check domain
16031 names for characters that are not allowed in host names before handing them to
16032 the DNS resolver, because some resolvers give temporary errors for names that
16033 contain unusual characters. If a domain name contains any unwanted characters,
16034 a &"not found"& result is forced, and the resolver is not called. The check is
16035 done by matching the domain name against a regular expression, which is the
16036 value of this option. The default pattern is
16038 dns_check_names_pattern = \
16039 (?i)^(?>(?(1)\.|())[^\W_](?>[a-z0-9/-]*[^\W_])?)+$
16041 which permits only letters, digits, slashes, and hyphens in components, but
16042 they must start and end with a letter or digit. Slashes are not, in fact,
16043 permitted in host names, but they are found in certain NS records (which can be
16044 accessed in Exim by using a &%dnsdb%& lookup). If you set
16045 &%allow_utf8_domains%&, you must modify this pattern, or set the option to an
16048 .option dns_csa_search_limit main integer 5
16049 This option controls the depth of parental searching for CSA SRV records in the
16050 DNS, as described in more detail in section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
16052 .option dns_csa_use_reverse main boolean true
16053 This option controls whether or not an IP address, given as a CSA domain, is
16054 reversed and looked up in the reverse DNS, as described in more detail in
16055 section &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
16057 .option dns_cname_loops main integer 1
16058 .cindex DNS "CNAME following"
16059 This option controls the following of CNAME chains, needed if the resolver does
16060 not do it internally.
16061 As of 2018 most should, and the default can be left.
16062 If you have an ancient one, a value of 10 is likely needed.
16064 The default value of one CNAME-follow is needed
16065 thanks to the observed return for an MX request,
16066 given no MX presence but a CNAME to an A, of the CNAME.
16069 .option dns_dnssec_ok main integer -1
16070 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16071 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16072 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
16073 DNS resolver library to either use or not use DNSSEC, overriding the system
16074 default. A value of 0 coerces DNSSEC off, a value of 1 coerces DNSSEC on.
16076 If the resolver library does not support DNSSEC then this option has no effect.
16078 On Linux with glibc 2.31 or newer this is insufficient, the resolver library
16079 will default to stripping out a successful validation status.
16080 This will break a previously working Exim installation.
16081 Provided that you do trust the resolver (ie, is on localhost) you can tell
16082 glibc to pass through any successful validation with a new option in
16083 &_/etc/resolv.conf_&:
16089 .option dns_ipv4_lookup main "domain list&!!" unset
16090 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS lookup for AAAA records"
16091 .cindex "DNS" "IPv6 lookup for AAAA records"
16092 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
16093 When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support and &%disable_ipv6%& is not set, it
16094 looks for IPv6 address records (AAAA records) as well as IPv4 address records
16095 (A records) when trying to find IP addresses for hosts, unless the host's
16096 domain matches this list.
16098 This is a fudge to help with name servers that give big delays or otherwise do
16099 not work for the AAAA record type. In due course, when the world's name
16100 servers have all been upgraded, there should be no need for this option.
16101 Note that all lookups, including those done for verification, are affected;
16102 this will result in verify failure for IPv6 connections or ones using names
16103 only valid for IPv6 addresses.
16106 .option dns_retrans main time 0s
16107 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16108 .cindex timeout "dns lookup"
16109 .cindex "DNS" timeout
16110 The options &%dns_retrans%& and &%dns_retry%& can be used to set the
16111 retransmission and retry parameters for DNS lookups. Values of zero (the
16112 defaults) leave the system default settings unchanged. The first value is the
16113 time between retries, and the second is the number of retries. It isn't
16114 totally clear exactly how these settings affect the total time a DNS lookup may
16115 take. I haven't found any documentation about timeouts on DNS lookups; these
16116 parameter values are available in the external resolver interface structure,
16117 but nowhere does it seem to describe how they are used or what you might want
16119 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& option.
16122 .option dns_retry main integer 0
16123 See &%dns_retrans%& above.
16126 .option dns_trust_aa main "domain list&!!" unset
16127 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16128 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16129 If this option is set then lookup results marked with the AA bit
16130 (Authoritative Answer) are trusted the same way as if they were
16131 DNSSEC-verified. The authority section's name of the answer must
16132 match with this expanded domain list.
16134 Use this option only if you talk directly to a resolver that is
16135 authoritative for some zones and does not set the AD (Authentic Data)
16136 bit in the answer. Some DNS servers may have an configuration option to
16137 mark the answers from their own zones as verified (they set the AD bit).
16138 Others do not have this option. It is considered as poor practice using
16139 a resolver that is an authoritative server for some zones.
16141 Use this option only if you really have to (e.g. if you want
16142 to use DANE for remote delivery to a server that is listed in the DNS
16143 zones that your resolver is authoritative for).
16145 If the DNS answer packet has the AA bit set and contains resource record
16146 in the answer section, the name of the first NS record appearing in the
16147 authority section is compared against the list. If the answer packet is
16148 authoritative but the answer section is empty, the name of the first SOA
16149 record in the authoritative section is used instead.
16151 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16152 .option dns_use_edns0 main integer -1
16153 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
16154 .cindex "DNS" "EDNS0"
16155 .cindex "DNS" "OpenBSD
16156 If this option is set to a non-negative number then Exim will initialise the
16157 DNS resolver library to either use or not use EDNS0 extensions, overriding
16158 the system default. A value of 0 coerces EDNS0 off, a value of 1 coerces EDNS0
16161 If the resolver library does not support EDNS0 then this option has no effect.
16163 OpenBSD's asr resolver routines are known to ignore the EDNS0 option; this
16164 means that DNSSEC will not work with Exim on that platform either, unless Exim
16165 is linked against an alternative DNS client library.
16168 .option drop_cr main boolean false
16169 This is an obsolete option that is now a no-op. It used to affect the way Exim
16170 handled CR and LF characters in incoming messages. What happens now is
16171 described in section &<<SECTlineendings>>&.
16173 .option dsn_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16174 .cindex "bounce messages" "success"
16175 .cindex "DSN" "success"
16176 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
16177 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" DSN
16178 DSN extensions (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461))
16179 will be advertised in the EHLO message to,
16180 and accepted from, these hosts.
16181 Hosts may use the NOTIFY and ORCPT options on RCPT TO commands,
16182 and RET and ENVID options on MAIL FROM commands.
16183 A NOTIFY=SUCCESS option requests success-DSN messages.
16184 A NOTIFY= option with no argument requests that no delay or failure DSNs
16186 &*Note*&: Supplying success-DSN messages has been criticised
16187 on privacy grounds; it can leak details of internal forwarding.
16189 .option dsn_from main "string&!!" "see below"
16190 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "in bounces"
16191 .cindex "bounce messages" "&'From:'& line, specifying"
16192 This option can be used to vary the contents of &'From:'& header lines in
16193 bounces and other automatically generated messages (&"Delivery Status
16194 Notifications"& &-- hence the name of the option). The default setting is:
16196 dsn_from = Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@$qualify_domain>
16198 The value is expanded every time it is needed. If the expansion fails, a
16199 panic is logged, and the default value is used.
16201 .option envelope_to_remove main boolean true
16202 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
16203 Exim's transports have an option for adding an &'Envelope-to:'& header to a
16204 message when it is delivered, in exactly the same way as &'Return-path:'& is
16205 handled. &'Envelope-to:'& records the original recipient address from the
16206 message's envelope that caused the delivery to happen. Such headers should not
16207 be present in incoming messages, and this option causes them to be removed at
16208 the time the message is received, to avoid any problems that might occur when a
16209 delivered message is subsequently sent on to some other recipient.
16212 .option errors_copy main "string list&!!" unset
16213 .cindex "bounce message" "copy to other address"
16214 .cindex "copy of bounce message"
16215 Setting this option causes Exim to send bcc copies of bounce messages that it
16216 generates to other addresses. &*Note*&: This does not apply to bounce messages
16217 coming from elsewhere. The value of the option is a colon-separated list of
16218 items. Each item consists of a pattern, terminated by white space, followed by
16219 a comma-separated list of email addresses. If a pattern contains spaces, it
16220 must be enclosed in double quotes.
16222 Each pattern is processed in the same way as a single item in an address list
16223 (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). When a pattern matches the recipient of
16224 the bounce message, the message is copied to the addresses on the list. The
16225 items are scanned in order, and once a matching one is found, no further items
16226 are examined. For example:
16228 errors_copy = spqr@mydomain postmaster@mydomain.example :\
16229 rqps@mydomain hostmaster@mydomain.example,\
16230 postmaster@mydomain.example
16232 .vindex "&$domain$&"
16233 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
16234 The address list is expanded before use. The expansion variables &$local_part$&
16235 and &$domain$& are set from the original recipient of the error message, and if
16236 there was any wildcard matching in the pattern, the expansion
16237 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%errors_copy%&"
16238 variables &$0$&, &$1$&, etc. are set in the normal way.
16241 .option errors_reply_to main string unset
16242 .cindex "bounce message" "&'Reply-to:'& in"
16243 By default, Exim's bounce and delivery warning messages contain the header line
16245 &`From: Mail Delivery System <Mailer-Daemon@`&&'qualify-domain'&&`>`&
16247 .oindex &%quota_warn_message%&
16248 where &'qualify-domain'& is the value of the &%qualify_domain%& option.
16249 A warning message that is generated by the &%quota_warn_message%& option in an
16250 &(appendfile)& transport may contain its own &'From:'& header line that
16251 overrides the default.
16253 Experience shows that people reply to bounce messages. If the
16254 &%errors_reply_to%& option is set, a &'Reply-To:'& header is added to bounce
16255 and warning messages. For example:
16257 errors_reply_to = postmaster@my.domain.example
16259 The value of the option is not expanded. It must specify a valid
16260 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
16261 address. However, if a warning message that is generated by the
16262 &%quota_warn_message%& option in an &(appendfile)& transport contain its
16263 own &'Reply-To:'& header line, the value of the &%errors_reply_to%& option is
16267 .option event_action main string&!! unset
16269 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
16270 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
16273 .option exim_group main string "compile-time configured"
16274 .cindex "gid (group id)" "Exim's own"
16275 .cindex "Exim group"
16276 This option changes the gid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16277 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. The value of this
16278 option is used only when &%exim_user%& is also set. Unless it consists entirely
16279 of digits, the string is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&, and failure causes a
16280 configuration error. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of
16284 .option exim_path main string "see below"
16285 .cindex "Exim binary, path name"
16286 This option specifies the path name of the Exim binary, which is used when Exim
16287 needs to re-exec itself. The default is set up to point to the file &'exim'& in
16288 the directory configured at compile time by the BIN_DIRECTORY setting. It
16289 is necessary to change &%exim_path%& if, exceptionally, Exim is run from some
16291 &*Warning*&: Do not use a macro to define the value of this option, because
16292 you will break those Exim utilities that scan the configuration file to find
16293 where the binary is. (They then use the &%-bP%& option to extract option
16294 settings such as the value of &%spool_directory%&.)
16297 .option exim_user main string "compile-time configured"
16298 .cindex "uid (user id)" "Exim's own"
16299 .cindex "Exim user"
16300 This option changes the uid under which Exim runs when it gives up root
16301 privilege. The default value is compiled into the binary. Ownership of the run
16302 time configuration file and the use of the &%-C%& and &%-D%& command line
16303 options is checked against the values in the binary, not what is set here.
16305 Unless it consists entirely of digits, the string is looked up using
16306 &[getpwnam()]&, and failure causes a configuration error. If &%exim_group%& is
16307 not also supplied, the gid is taken from the result of &[getpwnam()]& if it is
16308 used. See chapter &<<CHAPsecurity>>& for a discussion of security issues.
16311 .option exim_version main string "current version"
16312 .cindex "Exim version"
16313 .cindex customizing "version number"
16314 .cindex "version number of Exim" override
16315 This option overrides the &$version_number$&/&$exim_version$& that Exim reports in
16316 various places. Use with care; this may fool stupid security scanners.
16319 .option extra_local_interfaces main "string list" unset
16320 This option defines network interfaces that are to be considered local when
16321 routing, but which are not used for listening by the daemon. See section
16322 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>& for details.
16325 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
16326 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
16328 . .option "extract_addresses_remove_ &~&~arguments"
16329 . but apparently this results in searchability problems; bug 1197
16331 .option extract_addresses_remove_arguments main boolean true
16333 .cindex "command line" "addresses with &%-t%&"
16334 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&%-t%& option"
16335 According to some Sendmail documentation (Sun, IRIX, HP-UX), if any addresses
16336 are present on the command line when the &%-t%& option is used to build an
16337 envelope from a message's &'To:'&, &'Cc:'& and &'Bcc:'& headers, the command
16338 line addresses are removed from the recipients list. This is also how Smail
16339 behaves. However, other Sendmail documentation (the O'Reilly book) states that
16340 command line addresses are added to those obtained from the header lines. When
16341 &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%& is true (the default), Exim subtracts
16342 argument headers. If it is set false, Exim adds rather than removes argument
16346 .option finduser_retries main integer 0
16347 .cindex "NIS, retrying user lookups"
16348 On systems running NIS or other schemes in which user and group information is
16349 distributed from a remote system, there can be times when &[getpwnam()]& and
16350 related functions fail, even when given valid data, because things time out.
16351 Unfortunately these failures cannot be distinguished from genuine &"not found"&
16352 errors. If &%finduser_retries%& is set greater than zero, Exim will try that
16353 many extra times to find a user or a group, waiting for one second between
16356 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&" "multiple reading of"
16357 You should not set this option greater than zero if your user information is in
16358 a traditional &_/etc/passwd_& file, because it will cause Exim needlessly to
16359 search the file multiple times for non-existent users, and also cause delay.
16363 .option freeze_tell main "string list, comma separated" unset
16364 .cindex "freezing messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16365 .cindex "frozen messages" "sending a message when freezing"
16366 On encountering certain errors, or when configured to do so in a system filter,
16367 ACL, or special router, Exim freezes a message. This means that no further
16368 delivery attempts take place until an administrator thaws the message, or the
16369 &%auto_thaw%&, &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&, or &%timeout_frozen_after%&
16370 feature cause it to be processed. If &%freeze_tell%& is set, Exim generates a
16371 warning message whenever it freezes something, unless the message it is
16372 freezing is a locally-generated bounce message. (Without this exception there
16373 is the possibility of looping.) The warning message is sent to the addresses
16374 supplied as the comma-separated value of this option. If several of the
16375 message's addresses cause freezing, only a single message is sent. If the
16376 freezing was automatic, the reason(s) for freezing can be found in the message
16377 log. If you configure freezing in a filter or ACL, you must arrange for any
16378 logging that you require.
16381 .options gecos_name main string&!! unset &&&
16382 gecos_pattern main string unset
16384 .cindex "&""gecos""& field, parsing"
16385 Some operating systems, notably HP-UX, use the &"gecos"& field in the system
16386 password file to hold other information in addition to users' real names. Exim
16387 looks up this field for use when it is creating &'Sender:'& or &'From:'&
16388 headers. If either &%gecos_pattern%& or &%gecos_name%& are unset, the contents
16389 of the field are used unchanged, except that, if an ampersand is encountered,
16390 it is replaced by the user's login name with the first character forced to
16391 upper case, since this is a convention that is observed on many systems.
16393 When these options are set, &%gecos_pattern%& is treated as a regular
16394 expression that is to be applied to the field (again with && replaced by the
16395 login name), and if it matches, &%gecos_name%& is expanded and used as the
16398 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &%gecos_name%&"
16399 Numeric variables such as &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. can be used in the expansion to
16400 pick up sub-fields that were matched by the pattern. In HP-UX, where the user's
16401 name terminates at the first comma, the following can be used:
16403 gecos_pattern = ([^,]*)
16408 .option gnutls_compat_mode main boolean unset
16409 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
16410 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
16411 implementations of TLS.
16414 .option gnutls_allow_auto_pkcs11 main boolean unset
16415 This option will let GnuTLS (2.12.0 or later) autoload PKCS11 modules with
16416 the p11-kit configuration files in &_/etc/pkcs11/modules/_&.
16419 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Smart-cards-and-HSMs)
16424 .option headers_charset main string "see below"
16425 This option sets a default character set for translating from encoded MIME
16426 &"words"& in header lines, when referenced by an &$h_xxx$& expansion item. The
16427 default is the value of HEADERS_CHARSET in &_Local/Makefile_&. The
16428 ultimate default is ISO-8859-1. For more details see the description of header
16429 insertions in section &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
16433 .option header_maxsize main integer "see below"
16434 .cindex "header section" "maximum size of"
16435 .cindex "limit" "size of message header section"
16436 This option controls the overall maximum size of a message's header
16437 section. The default is the value of HEADER_MAXSIZE in
16438 &_Local/Makefile_&; the default for that is 1M. Messages with larger header
16439 sections are rejected.
16442 .option header_line_maxsize main integer 0
16443 .cindex "header lines" "maximum size of"
16444 .cindex "limit" "size of one header line"
16445 This option limits the length of any individual header line in a message, after
16446 all the continuations have been joined together. Messages with individual
16447 header lines that are longer than the limit are rejected. The default value of
16448 zero means &"no limit"&.
16453 .option helo_accept_junk_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16454 .cindex "HELO" "accepting junk data"
16455 .cindex "EHLO" "accepting junk data"
16456 Exim checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands for incoming SMTP
16457 mail, and gives an error response for invalid data. Unfortunately, there are
16458 some SMTP clients that send syntactic junk. They can be accommodated by setting
16459 this option. Note that this is a syntax check only. See &%helo_verify_hosts%&
16460 if you want to do semantic checking.
16461 See also &%helo_allow_chars%& for a way of extending the permitted character
16465 .option helo_allow_chars main string unset
16466 .cindex "HELO" "underscores in"
16467 .cindex "EHLO" "underscores in"
16468 .cindex "underscore in EHLO/HELO"
16469 This option can be set to a string of rogue characters that are permitted in
16470 non-ip-literal EHLO and HELO names in addition to the standard letters, digits,
16471 hyphens, and dots. For example if you really must allow underscores,
16474 helo_allow_chars = _
16476 This option does not apply to names that look like ip-literals.
16477 Note that the value is one string, not a list.
16480 .option helo_lookup_domains main "domain list&!!" &`@:@[]`&
16481 .cindex "HELO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16482 .cindex "EHLO" "forcing reverse lookup"
16483 If the domain given by a client in a HELO or EHLO command matches this
16484 list, a reverse lookup is done in order to establish the host's true name. The
16485 default forces a lookup if the client host gives the server's name or any of
16486 its IP addresses (in brackets), something that broken clients have been seen to
16490 .option helo_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16491 .cindex "HELO verifying" "optional"
16492 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, optional"
16493 By default, Exim just checks the syntax of HELO and EHLO commands (see
16494 &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& and &%helo_allow_chars%&). However, some sites like
16495 to do more extensive checking of the data supplied by these commands. The ACL
16496 condition &`verify = helo`& is provided to make this possible.
16497 Formerly, it was necessary also to set this option (&%helo_try_verify_hosts%&)
16498 to force the check to occur. From release 4.53 onwards, this is no longer
16499 necessary. If the check has not been done before &`verify = helo`& is
16500 encountered, it is done at that time. Consequently, this option is obsolete.
16501 Its specification is retained here for backwards compatibility.
16503 When an EHLO or HELO command is received, if the calling host matches
16504 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, Exim checks that the host name given in the HELO or
16505 EHLO command either:
16508 is an IP literal matching the calling address of the host, or
16510 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
16511 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
16512 matches the host name that Exim obtains by doing a reverse lookup of the
16513 calling host address, or
16515 when looked up in DNS yields the calling host address.
16518 However, the EHLO or HELO command is not rejected if any of the checks
16519 fail. Processing continues, but the result of the check is remembered, and can
16520 be detected later in an ACL by the &`verify = helo`& condition.
16522 If DNS was used for successful verification, the variable
16523 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
16524 &$helo_verify_dnssec$& records the DNSSEC status of the lookups.
16526 .option helo_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
16527 .cindex "HELO verifying" "mandatory"
16528 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying, mandatory"
16529 Like &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&, this option is obsolete, and retained only for
16530 backwards compatibility. For hosts that match this option, Exim checks the host
16531 name given in the HELO or EHLO in the same way as for
16532 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&. If the check fails, the HELO or EHLO command is
16533 rejected with a 550 error, and entries are written to the main and reject logs.
16534 If a MAIL command is received before EHLO or HELO, it is rejected with a 503
16537 .option hold_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
16538 .cindex "domain" "delaying delivery"
16539 .cindex "delivery" "delaying certain domains"
16540 This option allows mail for particular domains to be held in the queue
16541 manually. The option is overridden if a message delivery is forced with the
16542 &%-M%&, &%-qf%&, &%-Rf%& or &%-Sf%& options, and also while testing or
16543 verifying addresses using &%-bt%& or &%-bv%&. Otherwise, if a domain matches an
16544 item in &%hold_domains%&, no routing or delivery for that address is done, and
16545 it is deferred every time the message is looked at.
16547 This option is intended as a temporary operational measure for delaying the
16548 delivery of mail while some problem is being sorted out, or some new
16549 configuration tested. If you just want to delay the processing of some
16550 domains until a queue run occurs, you should use &%queue_domains%& or
16551 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, not &%hold_domains%&.
16553 A setting of &%hold_domains%& does not override Exim's code for removing
16554 messages from the queue if they have been there longer than the longest retry
16555 time in any retry rule. If you want to hold messages for longer than the normal
16556 retry times, insert a dummy retry rule with a long retry time.
16559 .option host_lookup main "host list&!!" unset
16560 .cindex "host name" "lookup, forcing"
16561 Exim does not look up the name of a calling host from its IP address unless it
16562 is required to compare against some host list, or the host matches
16563 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& or &%helo_verify_hosts%&, or the host matches this
16564 option (which normally contains IP addresses rather than host names). The
16565 default configuration file contains
16569 which causes a lookup to happen for all hosts. If the expense of these lookups
16570 is felt to be too great, the setting can be changed or removed.
16572 After a successful reverse lookup, Exim does a forward lookup on the name it
16573 has obtained, to verify that it yields the IP address that it started with. If
16574 this check fails, Exim behaves as if the name lookup failed.
16576 .vindex "&$host_lookup_failed$&"
16577 .vindex "&$sender_host_name$&"
16578 After any kind of failure, the host name (in &$sender_host_name$&) remains
16579 unset, and &$host_lookup_failed$& is set to the string &"1"&. See also
16580 &%dns_again_means_nonexist%&, &%helo_lookup_domains%&, and
16581 &`verify = reverse_host_lookup`& in ACLs.
16584 .option host_lookup_order main "string list" &`bydns:byaddr`&
16585 This option specifies the order of different lookup methods when Exim is trying
16586 to find a host name from an IP address. The default is to do a DNS lookup
16587 first, and then to try a local lookup (using &[gethostbyaddr()]& or equivalent)
16588 if that fails. You can change the order of these lookups, or omit one entirely,
16591 &*Warning*&: The &"byaddr"& method does not always yield aliases when there are
16592 multiple PTR records in the DNS and the IP address is not listed in
16593 &_/etc/hosts_&. Different operating systems give different results in this
16594 case. That is why the default tries a DNS lookup first.
16598 .option host_reject_connection main "host list&!!" unset
16599 .cindex "host" "rejecting connections from"
16600 If this option is set, incoming SMTP calls from the hosts listed are rejected
16601 as soon as the connection is made.
16602 This option is obsolete, and retained only for backward compatibility, because
16603 nowadays the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& can also reject incoming
16604 connections immediately.
16606 If the connection is on a TLS-on-connect port then the TCP connection is
16607 just dropped. Otherwise, an SMTP error is sent first.
16609 The ability to give an immediate rejection (either by this option or using an
16610 ACL) is provided for use in unusual cases. Many hosts will just try again,
16611 sometimes without much delay. Normally, it is better to use an ACL to reject
16612 incoming messages at a later stage, such as after RCPT commands. See
16613 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&.
16616 .option hosts_connection_nolog main "host list&!!" unset
16617 .cindex "host" "not logging connections from"
16618 This option defines a list of hosts for which connection logging does not
16619 happen, even though the &%smtp_connection%& log selector is set. For example,
16620 you might want not to log SMTP connections from local processes, or from
16621 127.0.0.1, or from your local LAN. This option is consulted in the main loop of
16622 the daemon; you should therefore strive to restrict its value to a short inline
16623 list of IP addresses and networks. To disable logging SMTP connections from
16624 local processes, you must create a host list with an empty item. For example:
16626 hosts_connection_nolog = :
16628 The hosts affected by this option also do not log "no MAIL in SMTP connection"
16629 lines, as may commonly be produced by a monitoring system.
16632 .option hosts_require_alpn main "host list&!!" unset
16633 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in server"
16635 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
16636 If the TLS library supports ALPN
16637 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any client
16638 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
16639 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
16641 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
16642 managed by this option, and should be done separately.
16645 .option hosts_require_helo main "host list&!!" *
16646 .cindex "HELO/EHLO" requiring
16647 Exim will require an accepted HELO or EHLO command from a host matching
16648 this list, before accepting a MAIL command.
16651 .option hosts_proxy main "host list&!!" unset
16652 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
16653 This option enables use of Proxy Protocol proxies for incoming
16654 connections. For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
16657 .option hosts_treat_as_local main "domain list&!!" unset
16658 .cindex "local host" "domains treated as"
16659 .cindex "host" "treated as local"
16660 If this option is set, any host names that match the domain list are treated as
16661 if they were the local host when Exim is scanning host lists obtained from MX
16663 or other sources. Note that the value of this option is a domain list, not a
16664 host list, because it is always used to check host names, not IP addresses.
16666 This option also applies when Exim is matching the special items
16667 &`@mx_any`&, &`@mx_primary`&, and &`@mx_secondary`& in a domain list (see
16668 section &<<SECTdomainlist>>&), and when checking the &%hosts%& option in the
16669 &(smtp)& transport for the local host (see the &%allow_localhost%& option in
16670 that transport). See also &%local_interfaces%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&, and
16671 chapter &<<CHAPinterfaces>>&, which contains a discussion about local network
16672 interfaces and recognizing the local host.
16675 .option ibase_servers main "string list" unset
16676 .cindex "InterBase" "server list"
16677 This option provides a list of InterBase servers and associated connection data,
16678 to be used in conjunction with &(ibase)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
16679 The option is available only if Exim has been built with InterBase support.
16683 .option ignore_bounce_errors_after main time 10w
16684 .cindex "bounce message" "discarding"
16685 .cindex "discarding bounce message"
16686 This option affects the processing of bounce messages that cannot be delivered,
16687 that is, those that suffer a permanent delivery failure. (Bounce messages that
16688 suffer temporary delivery failures are of course retried in the usual way.)
16690 After a permanent delivery failure, bounce messages are frozen,
16691 because there is no sender to whom they can be returned. When a frozen bounce
16692 message has been in the queue for more than the given time, it is unfrozen at
16693 the next queue run, and a further delivery is attempted. If delivery fails
16694 again, the bounce message is discarded. This makes it possible to keep failed
16695 bounce messages around for a shorter time than the normal maximum retry time
16696 for frozen messages. For example,
16698 ignore_bounce_errors_after = 12h
16700 retries failed bounce message deliveries after 12 hours, discarding any further
16701 failures. If the value of this option is set to a zero time period, bounce
16702 failures are discarded immediately. Setting a very long time (as in the default
16703 value) has the effect of disabling this option. For ways of automatically
16704 dealing with other kinds of frozen message, see &%auto_thaw%& and
16705 &%timeout_frozen_after%&.
16708 .options ignore_fromline_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
16709 ignore_fromline_local main boolean false
16710 .cindex "&""From""& line"
16711 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
16712 Some broken SMTP clients insist on sending a UUCP-like &"From&~"& line before
16713 the headers of a message. By default this is treated as the start of the
16714 message's body, which means that any following headers are not recognized as
16715 such. Exim can be made to ignore it by setting &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& to
16716 match those hosts that insist on sending it. If the sender is actually a local
16717 process rather than a remote host, and is using &%-bs%& to inject the messages,
16718 &%ignore_fromline_local%& must be set to achieve this effect.
16722 .option keep_environment main "string list" unset
16723 .cindex "environment" "values from"
16724 This option contains a string list of environment variables to keep.
16725 You have to trust these variables or you have to be sure that
16726 these variables do not impose any security risk. Keep in mind that
16727 during the startup phase Exim is running with an effective UID 0 in most
16728 installations. As the default value is an empty list, the default
16729 environment for using libraries, running embedded Perl code, or running
16730 external binaries is empty, and does not not even contain PATH or HOME.
16732 Actually the list is interpreted as a list of patterns
16733 (&<<SECTlistexpand>>&), except that it is not expanded first.
16735 WARNING: Macro substitution is still done first, so having a macro
16736 FOO and having FOO_HOME in your &%keep_environment%& option may have
16737 unexpected results. You may work around this using a regular expression
16738 that does not match the macro name: ^[F]OO_HOME$.
16740 Current versions of Exim issue a warning during startup if you do not mention
16741 &%keep_environment%& in your runtime configuration file and if your
16742 current environment is not empty. Future versions may not issue that warning
16745 See the &%add_environment%& main config option for a way to set
16746 environment variables to a fixed value. The environment for &(pipe)&
16747 transports is handled separately, see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for
16751 .option keep_malformed main time 4d
16752 This option specifies the length of time to keep messages whose spool files
16753 have been corrupted in some way. This should, of course, never happen. At the
16754 next attempt to deliver such a message, it gets removed. The incident is
16758 .option ldap_ca_cert_dir main string unset
16759 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate directory"
16760 .cindex certificate "directory for LDAP"
16761 This option indicates which directory contains CA certificates for verifying
16762 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16763 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16764 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16765 and constrained to be a directory.
16768 .option ldap_ca_cert_file main string unset
16769 .cindex "LDAP", "TLS CA certificate file"
16770 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16771 This option indicates which file contains CA certificates for verifying
16772 a TLS certificate presented by an LDAP server.
16773 While Exim does not provide a default value, your SSL library may.
16774 Analogous to &%tls_verify_certificates%& but as a client-side option for LDAP
16775 and constrained to be a file.
16778 .option ldap_cert_file main string unset
16779 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client certificate file"
16780 .cindex certificate "file for LDAP"
16781 This option indicates which file contains an TLS client certificate which
16782 Exim should present to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16783 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_key%&.
16786 .option ldap_cert_key main string unset
16787 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS client key file"
16788 .cindex certificate "key for LDAP"
16789 This option indicates which file contains the secret/private key to use
16790 to prove identity to the LDAP server during TLS negotiation.
16791 Should be used together with &%ldap_cert_file%&, which contains the
16792 identity to be proven.
16795 .option ldap_cipher_suite main string unset
16796 .cindex "LDAP" "TLS cipher suite"
16797 This controls the TLS cipher-suite negotiation during TLS negotiation with
16798 the LDAP server. See &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& for more details of the format of
16799 cipher-suite options with OpenSSL (as used by LDAP client libraries).
16802 .option ldap_default_servers main "string list" unset
16803 .cindex "LDAP" "default servers"
16804 This option provides a list of LDAP servers which are tried in turn when an
16805 LDAP query does not contain a server. See section &<<SECTforldaque>>& for
16806 details of LDAP queries. This option is available only when Exim has been built
16810 .option ldap_require_cert main string unset.
16811 .cindex "LDAP" "policy for LDAP server TLS cert presentation"
16812 This should be one of the values "hard", "demand", "allow", "try" or "never".
16813 A value other than one of these is interpreted as "never".
16814 See the entry "TLS_REQCERT" in your system man page for ldap.conf(5).
16815 Although Exim does not set a default, the LDAP library probably defaults
16819 .option ldap_start_tls main boolean false
16820 .cindex "LDAP" "whether or not to negotiate TLS"
16821 If set, Exim will attempt to negotiate TLS with the LDAP server when
16822 connecting on a regular LDAP port. This is the LDAP equivalent of SMTP's
16823 "STARTTLS". This is distinct from using "ldaps", which is the LDAP form
16825 In the event of failure to negotiate TLS, the action taken is controlled
16826 by &%ldap_require_cert%&.
16827 This option is ignored for &`ldapi`& connections.
16830 .option ldap_version main integer unset
16831 .cindex "LDAP" "protocol version, forcing"
16832 This option can be used to force Exim to set a specific protocol version for
16833 LDAP. If it option is unset, it is shown by the &%-bP%& command line option as
16834 -1. When this is the case, the default is 3 if LDAP_VERSION3 is defined in
16835 the LDAP headers; otherwise it is 2. This option is available only when Exim
16836 has been built with LDAP support.
16840 .option limits_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
16841 .cindex LIMITS "suppressing advertising"
16842 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
16843 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
16844 LIMITS extension (&url(https://www.ietf.org/rfc/rfc9422.html,RFC 9422))
16846 If permitted, Exim as a server will advertise in the EHLO response
16847 the limit for RCPT commands set by the &%recipients_max%& option (if it is set)
16848 and the limit for MAIL commands set by the &%smtp_accept_max_per_connection%&
16851 .option local_from_check main boolean true
16852 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "disabling addition of"
16853 .cindex "&'From:'& header line" "disabling checking of"
16854 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16855 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line, and
16856 checks that the &'From:'& header line matches the login of the calling user and
16857 the domain specified by &%qualify_domain%&.
16859 &*Note*&: An unqualified address (no domain) in the &'From:'& header in a
16860 locally submitted message is automatically qualified by Exim, unless the
16861 &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
16863 You can use &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& to permit affixes
16864 on the local part. If the &'From:'& header line does not match, Exim adds a
16865 &'Sender:'& header with an address constructed from the calling user's login
16866 and the default qualify domain.
16868 If &%local_from_check%& is set false, the &'From:'& header check is disabled,
16869 and no &'Sender:'& header is ever added. If, in addition, you want to retain
16870 &'Sender:'& header lines supplied by untrusted users, you must also set
16871 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true.
16873 .cindex "envelope from"
16874 .cindex "envelope sender"
16875 These options affect only the header lines in the message. The envelope sender
16876 is still forced to be the login id at the qualify domain unless
16877 &%untrusted_set_sender%& permits the user to supply an envelope sender.
16879 For messages received over TCP/IP, an ACL can specify &"submission mode"& to
16880 request similar header line checking. See section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&, which
16881 has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16886 .options local_from_prefix main string unset &&&
16887 local_from_suffix main string unset
16888 When Exim checks the &'From:'& header line of locally submitted messages for
16889 matching the login id (see &%local_from_check%& above), it can be configured to
16890 ignore certain prefixes and suffixes in the local part of the address. This is
16891 done by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and/or &%local_from_suffix%& to
16892 appropriate lists, in the same form as the &%local_part_prefix%& and
16893 &%local_part_suffix%& router options (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). For
16896 local_from_prefix = *-
16898 is set, a &'From:'& line containing
16900 From: anything-user@your.domain.example
16902 will not cause a &'Sender:'& header to be added if &'user@your.domain.example'&
16903 matches the actual sender address that is constructed from the login name and
16907 .option local_interfaces main "string list" "see below"
16908 This option controls which network interfaces are used by the daemon for
16909 listening; they are also used to identify the local host when routing. Chapter
16910 &<<CHAPinterfaces>>& contains a full description of this option and the related
16911 options &%daemon_smtp_ports%&, &%extra_local_interfaces%&,
16912 &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, and &%tls_on_connect_ports%&. The default value for
16913 &%local_interfaces%& is
16915 local_interfaces = 0.0.0.0
16917 when Exim is built without IPv6 support; otherwise it is
16919 local_interfaces = <; ::0 ; 0.0.0.0
16922 .option local_scan_timeout main time 5m
16923 .cindex "timeout" "for &[local_scan()]& function"
16924 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "timeout"
16925 This timeout applies to the &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter
16926 &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&). Zero means &"no timeout"&. If the timeout is exceeded,
16927 the incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP
16928 message. For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a
16929 non-zero code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
16933 .option local_sender_retain main boolean false
16934 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line" "retaining from local submission"
16935 When a message is submitted locally (that is, not over a TCP/IP connection) by
16936 an untrusted user, Exim removes any existing &'Sender:'& header line. If you
16937 do not want this to happen, you must set &%local_sender_retain%&, and you must
16938 also set &%local_from_check%& to be false (Exim will complain if you do not).
16939 See also the ACL modifier &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&. Section
16940 &<<SECTthesenhea>>& has more details about &'Sender:'& processing.
16945 .option localhost_number main string&!! unset
16946 .cindex "host" "locally unique number for"
16947 .cindex "message ids" "with multiple hosts"
16948 .cindex multiple "systems sharing a spool"
16949 .cindex "multiple hosts" "sharing a spool"
16950 .cindex "shared spool directory"
16951 .cindex "spool directory" sharing
16952 .vindex "&$localhost_number$&"
16953 Exim's message ids are normally unique only within the local host. If
16954 uniqueness among a set of hosts is required
16955 (eg. because they share a spool directory),
16956 each host must set a different
16957 value for the &%localhost_number%& option. The string is expanded immediately
16958 after reading the configuration file (so that a number can be computed from the
16959 host name, for example) and the result of the expansion must be a number in the
16960 range 0&--16 (or 0&--10 on operating systems with case-insensitive file
16961 systems). This is available in subsequent string expansions via the variable
16962 &$localhost_number$&. When &%localhost_number%& is set, the final four
16963 characters of the message id, instead of just being a fractional part of the
16964 time, are computed from the time and the local host number as described in
16965 section &<<SECTmessiden>>&.
16969 .option log_file_path main "string list&!!" "set at compile time"
16970 .cindex "log" "file path for"
16971 This option sets the path which is used to determine the names of Exim's log
16972 files, or indicates that logging is to be to syslog, or both. It is expanded
16973 when Exim is entered, so it can, for example, contain a reference to the host
16974 name. If no specific path is set for the log files at compile or runtime,
16975 or if the option is unset at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&)
16976 they are written in a sub-directory called &_log_& in Exim's spool directory.
16977 A path must start with a slash.
16978 To send to syslog, use the word &"syslog"&.
16979 Chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& contains further details about Exim's logging, and
16980 section &<<SECTwhelogwri>>& describes how the contents of &%log_file_path%& are
16981 used. If this string is fixed at your installation (contains no expansion
16982 variables) it is recommended that you do not set this option in the
16983 configuration file, but instead supply the path using LOG_FILE_PATH in
16984 &_Local/Makefile_& so that it is available to Exim for logging errors detected
16985 early on &-- in particular, failure to read the configuration file.
16988 .option log_selector main string unset
16989 .cindex "log" "selectors"
16990 This option can be used to reduce or increase the number of things that Exim
16991 writes to its log files. Its argument is made up of names preceded by plus or
16992 minus characters. For example:
16994 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
16996 A list of possible names and what they control is given in the chapter on
16997 logging, in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&.
17000 .option log_timezone main boolean false
17001 .cindex "log" "timezone for entries"
17002 .vindex "&$tod_log$&"
17003 .vindex "&$tod_zone$&"
17004 By default, the timestamps on log lines are in local time without the
17005 timezone. This means that if your timezone changes twice a year, the timestamps
17006 in log lines are ambiguous for an hour when the clocks go back. One way of
17007 avoiding this problem is to set the timezone to UTC. An alternative is to set
17008 &%log_timezone%& true. This turns on the addition of the timezone offset to
17009 timestamps in log lines. Turning on this option can add quite a lot to the size
17010 of log files because each line is extended by 6 characters. Note that the
17011 &$tod_log$& variable contains the log timestamp without the zone, but there is
17012 another variable called &$tod_zone$& that contains just the timezone offset.
17015 .option lookup_open_max main integer 25
17016 .cindex "too many open files"
17017 .cindex "open files, too many"
17018 .cindex "file" "too many open"
17019 .cindex "lookup" "maximum open files"
17020 .cindex "limit" "open files for lookups"
17021 This option limits the number of simultaneously open files for single-key
17022 lookups that use regular files (that is, &(lsearch)&, &(dbm)&, and &(cdb)&).
17023 Exim normally keeps these files open during routing, because often the same
17024 file is required several times. If the limit is reached, Exim closes the least
17025 recently used file. Note that if you are using the &'ndbm'& library, it
17026 actually opens two files for each logical DBM database, though it still counts
17027 as one for the purposes of &%lookup_open_max%&. If you are getting &"too many
17028 open files"& errors with NDBM, you need to reduce the value of
17029 &%lookup_open_max%&.
17032 .option max_username_length main integer 0
17033 .cindex "length of login name"
17034 .cindex "user name" "maximum length"
17035 .cindex "limit" "user name length"
17036 Some operating systems are broken in that they truncate long arguments to
17037 &[getpwnam()]& to eight characters, instead of returning &"no such user"&. If
17038 this option is set greater than zero, any attempt to call &[getpwnam()]& with
17039 an argument that is longer behaves as if &[getpwnam()]& failed.
17042 .option message_body_newlines main bool false
17043 .cindex "message body" "newlines in variables"
17044 .cindex "newline" "in message body variables"
17045 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
17046 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
17047 By default, newlines in the message body are replaced by spaces when setting
17048 the &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables. If this
17049 option is set true, this no longer happens.
17052 .option message_body_visible main integer 500
17053 .cindex "body of message" "visible size"
17054 .cindex "message body" "visible size"
17055 .vindex "&$message_body$&"
17056 .vindex "&$message_body_end$&"
17057 This option specifies how much of a message's body is to be included in the
17058 &$message_body$& and &$message_body_end$& expansion variables.
17061 .option message_id_header_domain main string&!! unset
17062 .cindex "&'Message-ID:'& header line"
17063 If this option is set, the string is expanded and used as the right hand side
17064 (domain) of the &'Message-ID:'& header that Exim creates if a
17065 locally-originated incoming message does not have one. &"Locally-originated"&
17066 means &"not received over TCP/IP."&
17067 Otherwise, the primary host name is used.
17068 Only letters, digits, dot and hyphen are accepted; any other characters are
17069 replaced by hyphens. If the expansion is forced to fail, or if the result is an
17070 empty string, the option is ignored.
17073 .option message_id_header_text main string&!! unset
17074 If this variable is set, the string is expanded and used to augment the text of
17075 the &'Message-id:'& header that Exim creates if a locally-originated incoming
17076 message does not have one. The text of this header is required by
17077 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
17078 to take the form of an address. By default, Exim uses its internal message id as
17079 the local part, and the primary host name as the domain. If this option is set,
17080 it is expanded, and provided the expansion is not forced to fail, and does not
17081 yield an empty string, the result is inserted into the header immediately
17082 before the @, separated from the internal message id by a dot. Any characters
17083 that are illegal in an address are automatically converted into hyphens. This
17084 means that variables such as &$tod_log$& can be used, because the spaces and
17085 colons will become hyphens.
17088 .option message_logs main boolean true
17089 .cindex "message logs" "disabling"
17090 .cindex "log" "message log; disabling"
17091 If this option is turned off, per-message log files are not created in the
17092 &_msglog_& spool sub-directory. This reduces the amount of disk I/O required by
17093 Exim, by reducing the number of files involved in handling a message from a
17094 minimum of four (header spool file, body spool file, delivery journal, and
17095 per-message log) to three. The other major I/O activity is Exim's main log,
17096 which is not affected by this option.
17099 .option message_size_limit main string&!! 50M
17100 .cindex "message" "size limit"
17101 .cindex "limit" "message size"
17102 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
17103 This option limits the maximum size of message that Exim will process. The
17104 value is expanded for each incoming connection so, for example, it can be made
17105 to depend on the IP address of the remote host for messages arriving via
17106 TCP/IP. After expansion, the value must be a sequence of decimal digits,
17107 optionally followed by K or M.
17109 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
17110 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
17111 If nonzero the value will be advertised as a parameter to the ESMTP SIZE
17112 service extension keyword.
17114 &*Note*&: This limit cannot be made to depend on a message's sender or any
17115 other properties of an individual message, because it has to be advertised in
17116 the server's response to EHLO. String expansion failure causes a temporary
17117 error. A value of zero means no limit, but its use is not recommended. See also
17118 &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17120 Incoming SMTP messages are failed with a 552 error if the limit is
17121 exceeded; locally-generated messages either get a stderr message or a delivery
17122 failure message to the sender, depending on the &%-oe%& setting. Rejection of
17123 an oversized message is logged in both the main and the reject logs. See also
17124 the generic transport option &%message_size_limit%&, which limits the size of
17125 message that an individual transport can process.
17127 If you use a virus-scanner and set this option to to a value larger than the
17128 maximum size that your virus-scanner is configured to support, you may get
17129 failures triggered by large mails. The right size to configure for the
17130 virus-scanner depends upon what data is passed and the options in use but it's
17131 probably safest to just set it to a little larger than this value. E.g., with a
17132 default Exim message size of 50M and a default ClamAV StreamMaxLength of 10M,
17133 some problems may result.
17135 A value of 0 will disable size limit checking; Exim will still advertise the
17136 SIZE extension in an EHLO response, but without a limit, so as to permit
17137 SMTP clients to still indicate the message size along with the MAIL verb.
17140 .option move_frozen_messages main boolean false
17141 .cindex "frozen messages" "moving"
17142 This option, which is available only if Exim has been built with the setting
17144 SUPPORT_MOVE_FROZEN_MESSAGES=yes
17146 in &_Local/Makefile_&, causes frozen messages and their message logs to be
17147 moved from the &_input_& and &_msglog_& directories on the spool to &_Finput_&
17148 and &_Fmsglog_&, respectively. There is currently no support in Exim or the
17149 standard utilities for handling such moved messages, and they do not show up in
17150 lists generated by &%-bp%& or by the Exim monitor.
17153 .option mua_wrapper main boolean false
17154 Setting this option true causes Exim to run in a very restrictive mode in which
17155 it passes messages synchronously to a smart host. Chapter &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&
17156 contains a full description of this facility.
17160 .option mysql_servers main "string list" unset
17161 .cindex "MySQL" "server list"
17162 This option provides a list of MySQL servers and associated connection data, to
17163 be used in conjunction with &(mysql)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&). The
17164 option is available only if Exim has been built with MySQL support.
17167 .option never_users main "string list&!!" unset
17168 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. Local
17169 message deliveries are normally run in processes that are setuid to the
17170 recipient, and remote deliveries are normally run under Exim's own uid and gid.
17171 It is usually desirable to prevent any deliveries from running as root, as a
17174 When Exim is built, an option called FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a
17175 list of users that must not be used for local deliveries. This list is fixed in
17176 the binary and cannot be overridden by the configuration file. By default, it
17177 contains just the single user name &"root"&. The &%never_users%& runtime option
17178 can be used to add more users to the fixed list.
17180 If a message is to be delivered as one of the users on the fixed list or the
17181 &%never_users%& list, an error occurs, and delivery is deferred. A common
17184 never_users = root:daemon:bin
17186 Including root is redundant if it is also on the fixed list, but it does no
17187 harm. This option overrides the &%pipe_as_creator%& option of the &(pipe)&
17191 .option notifier_socket main string "$spool_directory/exim_daemon_notify"
17192 This option gives the name for a unix-domain socket on which the daemon
17193 listens for work and information-requests.
17194 Only installations running multiple daemons sharing a spool directory
17195 should need to modify the default.
17197 The option is expanded before use.
17198 If the platform supports Linux-style abstract socket names, the result
17199 is used with a nul byte prefixed.
17201 it should be a full path name and use a directory accessible
17204 If this option is set as empty,
17205 or the command line &%-oY%& option is used, or
17206 the command line uses a &%-oX%& option and does not use &%-oP%&,
17207 then a notifier socket is not created.
17210 .option openssl_options main "string list" "+no_sslv2 +no_sslv3 +single_dh_use +no_ticket +no_renegotiation"
17211 .cindex "OpenSSL "compatibility options"
17212 This option allows an administrator to adjust the SSL options applied
17213 by OpenSSL to connections. It is given as a space-separated list of items,
17214 each one to be +added or -subtracted from the current value.
17216 This option is only available if Exim is built against OpenSSL. The values
17217 available for this option vary according to the age of your OpenSSL install.
17218 The &"all"& value controls a subset of flags which are available, typically
17219 the bug workaround options. The &'SSL_CTX_set_options'& man page will
17220 list the values known on your system and Exim should support all the
17221 &"bug workaround"& options and many of the &"modifying"& options. The Exim
17222 names lose the leading &"SSL_OP_"& and are lower-cased.
17224 Note that adjusting the options can have severe impact upon the security of
17225 SSL as used by Exim. It is possible to disable safety checks and shoot
17226 yourself in the foot in various unpleasant ways. This option should not be
17227 adjusted lightly. An unrecognised item will be detected at startup, by
17228 invoking Exim with the &%-bV%& flag.
17230 The option affects Exim operating both as a server and as a client.
17232 Historical note: prior to release 4.80, Exim defaulted this value to
17233 "+dont_insert_empty_fragments", which may still be needed for compatibility
17234 with some clients, but which lowers security by increasing exposure to
17235 some now infamous attacks.
17239 # Make both old MS and old Eudora happy:
17240 openssl_options = -all +microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer \
17241 +dont_insert_empty_fragments
17243 # Disable older protocol versions:
17244 openssl_options = +no_sslv2 +no_sslv3
17247 Possible options may include:
17251 &`allow_unsafe_legacy_renegotiation`&
17253 &`cipher_server_preference`&
17255 &`dont_insert_empty_fragments`&
17259 &`legacy_server_connect`&
17261 &`microsoft_big_sslv3_buffer`&
17263 &`microsoft_sess_id_bug`&
17265 &`msie_sslv2_rsa_padding`&
17267 &`netscape_challenge_bug`&
17269 &`netscape_reuse_cipher_change_bug`&
17273 &`no_session_resumption_on_renegotiation`&
17287 &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`&
17291 &`single_ecdh_use`&
17293 &`ssleay_080_client_dh_bug`&
17295 &`sslref2_reuse_cert_type_bug`&
17297 &`tls_block_padding_bug`&
17301 &`tls_rollback_bug`&
17304 As an aside, the &`safari_ecdhe_ecdsa_bug`& item is a misnomer and affects
17305 all clients connecting using the MacOS SecureTransport TLS facility prior
17306 to MacOS 10.8.4, including email clients. If you see old MacOS clients failing
17307 to negotiate TLS then this option value might help, provided that your OpenSSL
17308 release is new enough to contain this work-around. This may be a situation
17309 where you have to upgrade OpenSSL to get buggy clients working.
17312 .option oracle_servers main "string list" unset
17313 .cindex "Oracle" "server list"
17314 This option provides a list of Oracle servers and associated connection data,
17315 to be used in conjunction with &(oracle)& lookups (see section &<<SECID72>>&).
17316 The option is available only if Exim has been built with Oracle support.
17319 .option panic_coredump main boolean false
17320 This option is rarely needed but can help for some debugging investigations.
17321 If set, when an internal error is detected by Exim which is sufficient
17322 to terminate the process
17323 (all such are logged in the paniclog)
17324 then a coredump is requested.
17326 Note that most systems require additional administrative configuration
17327 to permit write a core file for a setuid program, which is Exim's
17328 common installed configuration.
17330 .option percent_hack_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17331 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
17332 .cindex "source routing" "in email address"
17333 .cindex "address" "source-routed"
17334 The &"percent hack"& is the convention whereby a local part containing a
17335 percent sign is re-interpreted as a new email address, with the percent
17336 replaced by @. This is sometimes called &"source routing"&, though that term is
17338 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
17339 addresses that begin with an @ character. If this
17340 option is set, Exim implements the percent facility for those domains listed,
17341 but no others. This happens before an incoming SMTP address is tested against
17344 &*Warning*&: The &"percent hack"& has often been abused by people who are
17345 trying to get round relaying restrictions. For this reason, it is best avoided
17346 if at all possible. Unfortunately, a number of less security-conscious MTAs
17347 implement it unconditionally. If you are running Exim on a gateway host, and
17348 routing mail through to internal MTAs without processing the local parts, it is
17349 a good idea to reject recipient addresses with percent characters in their
17350 local parts. Exim's default configuration does this.
17353 .options perl_at_start main boolean false &&&
17354 perl_startup main string unset
17356 These options are available only when Exim is built with an embedded Perl
17357 interpreter. See chapter &<<CHAPperl>>& for details of their use.
17359 .option perl_taintmode main boolean false
17361 This option enables the taint mode of the embedded Perl interpreter.
17364 .option pgsql_servers main "string list" unset
17365 .cindex "PostgreSQL lookup type" "server list"
17366 This option provides a list of PostgreSQL servers and associated connection
17367 data, to be used in conjunction with &(pgsql)& lookups (see section
17368 &<<SECID72>>&). The option is available only if Exim has been built with
17369 PostgreSQL support.
17372 .option pid_file_path main string&!! "set at compile time"
17373 .cindex "daemon" "pid file path"
17374 .cindex "pid file, path for"
17375 This option sets the name of the file to which the Exim daemon writes its
17376 process id. The string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, references
17379 pid_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim.pid
17381 If no path is set, the pid is written to the file &_exim-daemon.pid_& in Exim's
17383 The value set by the option can be overridden by the &%-oP%& command line
17384 option. A pid file is not written if a &"non-standard"& daemon is run by means
17385 of the &%-oX%& option, unless a path is explicitly supplied by &%-oP%&.
17388 .option pipelining_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17389 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
17390 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
17391 This option can be used to suppress the advertisement of the SMTP
17392 PIPELINING extension to specific hosts. See also the &*no_pipelining*&
17393 control in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. When PIPELINING is not advertised and
17394 &%smtp_enforce_sync%& is true, an Exim server enforces strict synchronization
17395 for each SMTP command and response. When PIPELINING is advertised, Exim assumes
17396 that clients will use it; &"out of order"& commands that are &"expected"& do
17397 not count as protocol errors (see &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%&).
17399 .option pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17400 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
17401 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
17402 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPECONNECT
17403 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
17404 this option controls which hosts the facility is advertised to
17405 and from which pipeline early-connection (before MAIL) SMTP
17406 commands are acceptable.
17407 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
17409 See also the &%hosts_pipe_connect%& smtp transport option.
17411 The SMTP service extension keyword advertised is &"PIPECONNECT"&;
17412 it permits the client to pipeline
17413 TCP connection and hello command (cleatext phase),
17414 or TLS-establishment and hello command (encrypted phase),
17415 on later connections to the same host.
17418 .option prdr_enable main boolean false
17419 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling on server"
17420 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
17421 This option can be used to enable the Per-Recipient Data Response extension
17422 to SMTP, defined by Eric Hall.
17423 If the option is set, PRDR is advertised by Exim when operating as a server.
17424 If the client requests PRDR, and more than one recipient, for a message
17425 an additional ACL is called for each recipient after the message content
17426 is received. See section &<<SECTPRDRACL>>&.
17428 .option preserve_message_logs main boolean false
17429 .cindex "message logs" "preserving"
17430 If this option is set, message log files are not deleted when messages are
17431 completed. Instead, they are moved to a sub-directory of the spool directory
17432 called &_msglog.OLD_&, where they remain available for statistical or debugging
17433 purposes. This is a dangerous option to set on systems with any appreciable
17434 volume of mail. Use with care!
17437 .option primary_hostname main string "see below"
17438 .cindex "name" "of local host"
17439 .cindex "host" "name of local"
17440 .cindex "local host" "name of"
17441 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
17442 This specifies the name of the current host. It is used in the default EHLO or
17443 HELO command for outgoing SMTP messages (changeable via the &%helo_data%&
17444 option in the &(smtp)& transport), and as the default for &%qualify_domain%&.
17445 The value is also used by default in some SMTP response messages from an Exim
17446 server. This can be changed dynamically by setting &%smtp_active_hostname%&.
17448 If &%primary_hostname%& is not set, Exim calls &[uname()]& to find the host
17449 name. If this fails, Exim panics and dies. If the name returned by &[uname()]&
17450 contains only one component, Exim passes it to &[gethostbyname()]& (or
17451 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) in order to obtain the fully qualified
17452 version. The variable &$primary_hostname$& contains the host name, whether set
17453 explicitly by this option, or defaulted.
17456 .option print_topbitchars main boolean false
17457 .cindex "printing characters"
17458 .cindex "8-bit characters"
17459 By default, Exim considers only those characters whose codes lie in the range
17460 32&--126 to be printing characters. In a number of circumstances (for example,
17461 when writing log entries) non-printing characters are converted into escape
17462 sequences, primarily to avoid messing up the layout. If &%print_topbitchars%&
17463 is set, code values of 128 and above are also considered to be printing
17466 This option also affects the header syntax checks performed by the
17467 &(autoreply)& transport, and whether Exim uses
17468 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047) encoding of
17469 the user's full name when constructing From: and Sender: addresses (as
17470 described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&). Setting this option can cause
17471 Exim to generate eight bit message headers that do not conform to the
17475 .option process_log_path main string unset
17476 .cindex "process log path"
17477 .cindex "log" "process log"
17478 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
17479 This option sets the name of the file to which an Exim process writes its
17480 &"process log"& when sent a USR1 signal. This is used by the &'exiwhat'&
17481 utility script. If this option is unset, the file called &_exim-process.info_&
17482 in Exim's spool directory is used. The ability to specify the name explicitly
17483 can be useful in environments where two different Exims are running, using
17484 different spool directories.
17487 .option prod_requires_admin main boolean true
17488 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17492 The &%-M%&, &%-R%&, and &%-q%& command-line options require the caller to be an
17493 admin user unless &%prod_requires_admin%& is set false. See also
17494 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17497 .option proxy_protocol_timeout main time 3s
17498 .cindex proxy "proxy protocol"
17499 This option sets the timeout for proxy protocol negotiation.
17500 For details see section &<<SECTproxyInbound>>&.
17503 .option qualify_domain main string "see below"
17504 .cindex "domain" "for qualifying addresses"
17505 .cindex "address" "qualification"
17506 This option specifies the domain name that is added to any envelope sender
17507 addresses that do not have a domain qualification. It also applies to
17508 recipient addresses if &%qualify_recipient%& is not set. Unqualified addresses
17509 are accepted by default only for locally-generated messages. Qualification is
17510 also applied to addresses in header lines such as &'From:'& and &'To:'& for
17511 locally-generated messages, unless the &%-bnq%& command line option is used.
17513 Messages from external sources must always contain fully qualified addresses,
17514 unless the sending host matches &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or
17515 &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& (as appropriate), in which case incoming
17516 addresses are qualified with &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%& as
17517 necessary. Internally, Exim always works with fully qualified envelope
17518 addresses. If &%qualify_domain%& is not set, it defaults to the
17519 &%primary_hostname%& value.
17522 .option qualify_recipient main string "see below"
17523 This option allows you to specify a different domain for qualifying recipient
17524 addresses to the one that is used for senders. See &%qualify_domain%& above.
17528 .option queue_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17529 .cindex "domain" "specifying non-immediate delivery"
17530 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17531 .cindex "message" "queueing certain domains"
17532 This option lists domains for which immediate delivery is not required.
17533 A delivery process is started whenever a message is received, but only those
17534 domains that do not match are processed. All other deliveries wait until the
17535 next queue run. See also &%hold_domains%& and &%queue_smtp_domains%&.
17538 .option queue_fast_ramp main boolean true
17539 .cindex "queue runner" "two phase"
17540 .cindex "queue" "double scanning"
17541 If set to true, two-phase queue runs, initiated using &%-qq%& on the
17542 command line, may start parallel delivery processes during their first
17543 phase. This will be done when a threshold number of messages have been
17544 routed for a single host.
17547 .option queue_list_requires_admin main boolean true
17548 .cindex "restricting access to features"
17550 The &%-bp%& command-line option, which lists the messages that are on the
17551 queue, requires the caller to be an admin user unless
17552 &%queue_list_requires_admin%& is set false.
17553 See also &%prod_requires_admin%& and &%commandline_checks_require_admin%&.
17556 .option queue_only main boolean false
17557 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17558 .cindex "message" "queueing unconditionally"
17559 If &%queue_only%& is set, a delivery process is not automatically started
17560 whenever a message is received. Instead, the message waits in the queue for the
17561 next queue run. Even if &%queue_only%& is false, incoming messages may not get
17562 delivered immediately when certain conditions (such as heavy load) occur.
17564 The &%-odq%& command line has the same effect as &%queue_only%&. The &%-odb%&
17565 and &%-odi%& command line options override &%queue_only%& unless
17566 &%queue_only_override%& is set false. See also &%queue_only_file%&,
17567 &%queue_only_load%&, and &%smtp_accept_queue%&.
17570 .option queue_only_file main "string list" unset
17571 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17572 .cindex "message" "queueing by file existence"
17573 This option can be set to a colon-separated list of absolute path names, each
17574 one optionally preceded by &"smtp"&. When Exim is receiving a message,
17575 it tests for the existence of each listed path using a call to &[stat()]&. For
17576 each path that exists, the corresponding queueing option is set.
17577 For paths with no prefix, &%queue_only%& is set; for paths prefixed by
17578 &"smtp"&, &%queue_smtp_domains%& is set to match all domains. So, for example,
17580 queue_only_file = smtp/some/file
17582 causes Exim to behave as if &%queue_smtp_domains%& were set to &"*"& whenever
17583 &_/some/file_& exists.
17586 .option queue_only_load main fixed-point unset
17587 .cindex "load average"
17588 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17589 .cindex "message" "queueing by load"
17590 If the system load average is higher than this value, incoming messages from
17591 all sources are queued, and no automatic deliveries are started. If this
17592 happens during local or remote SMTP input, all subsequent messages received on
17593 the same SMTP connection are queued by default, whatever happens to the load in
17594 the meantime, but this can be changed by setting &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17597 Deliveries will subsequently be performed by queue runner processes. This
17598 option has no effect on ancient operating systems on which Exim cannot
17599 determine the load average. See also &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and
17600 &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17603 .option queue_only_load_latch main boolean true
17604 .cindex "load average" "re-evaluating per message"
17605 When this option is true (the default), once one message has been queued
17606 because the load average is higher than the value set by &%queue_only_load%&,
17607 all subsequent messages received on the same SMTP connection are also queued.
17608 This is a deliberate choice; even though the load average may fall below the
17609 threshold, it doesn't seem right to deliver later messages on the same
17610 connection when not delivering earlier ones. However, there are special
17611 circumstances such as very long-lived connections from scanning appliances
17612 where this is not the best strategy. In such cases, &%queue_only_load_latch%&
17613 should be set false. This causes the value of the load average to be
17614 re-evaluated for each message.
17617 .option queue_only_override main boolean true
17618 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17619 When this option is true, the &%-od%&&'x'& command line options override the
17620 setting of &%queue_only%& or &%queue_only_file%& in the configuration file. If
17621 &%queue_only_override%& is set false, the &%-od%&&'x'& options cannot be used
17622 to override; they are accepted, but ignored.
17625 .option queue_run_in_order main boolean false
17626 .cindex "queue runner" "processing messages in order"
17627 If this option is set, queue runs happen in order of message arrival instead of
17628 in an arbitrary order. For this to happen, a complete list of the entire queue
17629 must be set up before the deliveries start. When the queue is all held in a
17630 single directory (the default), a single list is created for both the ordered
17631 and the non-ordered cases. However, if &%split_spool_directory%& is set, a
17632 single list is not created when &%queue_run_in_order%& is false. In this case,
17633 the sub-directories are processed one at a time (in a random order), and this
17634 avoids setting up one huge list for the whole queue. Thus, setting
17635 &%queue_run_in_order%& with &%split_spool_directory%& may degrade performance
17636 when the queue is large, because of the extra work in setting up the single,
17637 large list. In most situations, &%queue_run_in_order%& should not be set.
17641 .option queue_run_max main integer&!! 5
17642 .cindex "queue runner" "maximum number of"
17643 This controls the maximum number of queue runner processes that an Exim daemon
17644 can run simultaneously. This does not mean that it starts them all at once,
17645 but rather that if the maximum number are still running when the time comes to
17646 start another one, it refrains from starting another one. This can happen with
17647 very large queues and/or very sluggish deliveries. This option does not,
17648 however, interlock with other processes, so additional queue runners can be
17649 started by other means, or by killing and restarting the daemon.
17651 Setting this option to zero does not suppress queue runs; rather, it disables
17652 the limit, allowing any number of simultaneous queue runner processes to be
17653 run. If you do not want queue runs to occur, omit the &%-q%&&'xx'& setting on
17654 the daemon's command line.
17656 .cindex queues named
17657 .cindex "named queues" "resource limit"
17658 To set limits for different named queues use
17659 an expansion depending on the &$queue_name$& variable.
17661 .option queue_smtp_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17662 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
17663 .cindex "message" "queueing remote deliveries"
17664 .cindex "first pass routing"
17665 When this option is set, a delivery process is started whenever a message is
17666 received, routing is performed, and local deliveries take place.
17667 However, if any SMTP deliveries are required for domains that match
17668 &%queue_smtp_domains%&, they are not immediately delivered, but instead the
17669 message waits in the queue for the next queue run. Since routing of the message
17670 has taken place, Exim knows to which remote hosts it must be delivered, and so
17671 when the queue run happens, multiple messages for the same host are delivered
17672 over a single SMTP connection. The &%-odqs%& command line option causes all
17673 SMTP deliveries to be queued in this way, and is equivalent to setting
17674 &%queue_smtp_domains%& to &"*"&. See also &%hold_domains%& and
17678 .option receive_timeout main time 0s
17679 .cindex "timeout" "for non-SMTP input"
17680 This option sets the timeout for accepting a non-SMTP message, that is, the
17681 maximum time that Exim waits when reading a message on the standard input. If
17682 the value is zero, it will wait forever. This setting is overridden by the
17683 &%-or%& command line option. The timeout for incoming SMTP messages is
17684 controlled by &%smtp_receive_timeout%&.
17686 .option received_header_text main string&!! "see below"
17687 .cindex "customizing" "&'Received:'& header"
17688 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "customizing"
17689 This string defines the contents of the &'Received:'& message header that is
17690 added to each message, except for the timestamp, which is automatically added
17691 on at the end (preceded by a semicolon). The string is expanded each time it is
17692 used. If the expansion yields an empty string, no &'Received:'& header line is
17693 added to the message. Otherwise, the string should start with the text
17694 &"Received:"& and conform to the
17695 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
17696 specification for &'Received:'& header lines.
17697 The default setting is:
17700 received_header_text = Received: \
17701 ${if def:sender_rcvhost {from $sender_rcvhost\n\t}\
17702 {${if def:sender_ident \
17703 {from ${quote_local_part:$sender_ident} }}\
17704 ${if def:sender_helo_name {(helo=$sender_helo_name)\n\t}}}}\
17705 by $primary_hostname \
17706 ${if def:received_protocol {with $received_protocol }}\
17707 ${if def:tls_in_ver { ($tls_in_ver)}}\
17708 ${if def:tls_in_cipher_std { tls $tls_in_cipher_std\n\t}}\
17709 (Exim $version_number)\n\t\
17710 ${if def:sender_address \
17711 {(envelope-from <$sender_address>)\n\t}}\
17712 id $message_exim_id\
17713 ${if def:received_for {\n\tfor $received_for}}
17716 The references to the TLS version and cipher are
17717 omitted when Exim is built without TLS
17718 support. The use of conditional expansions ensures that this works for both
17719 locally generated messages and messages received from remote hosts, giving
17720 header lines such as the following:
17722 Received: from scrooge.carol.example ([192.168.12.25] ident=root)
17723 by marley.carol.example with esmtp (Exim 4.00)
17724 (envelope-from <bob@carol.example>)
17725 id 16IOWa-00019l-00
17726 for chas@dickens.example; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:44 +0000
17727 Received: by scrooge.carol.example with local (Exim 4.00)
17728 id 16IOWW-000083-00; Tue, 25 Dec 2001 14:43:41 +0000
17730 Until the body of the message has been received, the timestamp is the time when
17731 the message started to be received. Once the body has arrived, and all policy
17732 checks have taken place, the timestamp is updated to the time at which the
17733 message was accepted.
17736 .option received_headers_max main integer 30
17737 .cindex "loop" "prevention"
17738 .cindex "mail loop prevention"
17739 .cindex "&'Received:'& header line" "counting"
17740 When a message is to be delivered, the number of &'Received:'& headers is
17741 counted, and if it is greater than this parameter, a mail loop is assumed to
17742 have occurred, the delivery is abandoned, and an error message is generated.
17743 This applies to both local and remote deliveries.
17746 .option recipient_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17747 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17748 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17749 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17750 recipient addresses in message envelopes. The addresses are made fully
17751 qualified by the addition of the &%qualify_recipient%& value. This option also
17752 affects message header lines. Exim does not reject unqualified recipient
17753 addresses in headers, but it qualifies them only if the message came from a
17754 host that matches &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
17755 or if the message was submitted locally (not using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%&
17756 option was not set.
17759 .option recipients_max main integer&!! 50000
17760 .cindex "limit" "number of recipients"
17761 .cindex "recipient" "maximum number"
17762 If the value resulting from expanding this option
17763 is set greater than zero, it specifies the maximum number of
17764 original recipients for any message. Additional recipients that are generated
17765 by aliasing or forwarding do not count. SMTP messages get a 452 response for
17766 all recipients over the limit; earlier recipients are delivered as normal.
17767 Non-SMTP messages with too many recipients are failed, and no deliveries are
17770 For SMTP message the expansion is done after the connection is
17771 accepted (but before any SMTP conversation) and may depend on
17772 the IP addresses and port numbers of the connection.
17773 &*Note*&: If an expansion is used for the option,
17774 care should be taken that a resonable value results for
17777 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of incoming"
17778 &*Note*&: The RFCs specify that an SMTP server should accept at least 100
17779 RCPT commands in a single message.
17782 .option recipients_max_reject main boolean false
17783 If this option is set true, Exim rejects SMTP messages containing too many
17784 recipients by giving 552 errors to the surplus RCPT commands, and a 554
17785 error to the eventual DATA command. Otherwise (the default) it gives a 452
17786 error to the surplus RCPT commands and accepts the message on behalf of the
17787 initial set of recipients. The remote server should then re-send the message
17788 for the remaining recipients at a later time.
17791 .option remote_max_parallel main integer 4
17792 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for remote"
17793 This option controls parallel delivery of one message to a number of remote
17794 hosts. If the value is less than 2, parallel delivery is disabled, and Exim
17795 does all the remote deliveries for a message one by one. Otherwise, if a single
17796 message has to be delivered to more than one remote host, or if several copies
17797 have to be sent to the same remote host, up to &%remote_max_parallel%&
17798 deliveries are done simultaneously. If more than &%remote_max_parallel%&
17799 deliveries are required, the maximum number of processes are started, and as
17800 each one finishes, another is begun. The order of starting processes is the
17801 same as if sequential delivery were being done, and can be controlled by the
17802 &%remote_sort_domains%& option. If parallel delivery takes place while running
17803 with debugging turned on, the debugging output from each delivery process is
17804 tagged with its process id.
17806 This option controls only the maximum number of parallel deliveries for one
17807 message in one Exim delivery process. Because Exim has no central queue
17808 manager, there is no way of controlling the total number of simultaneous
17809 deliveries if the configuration allows a delivery attempt as soon as a message
17812 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option,
17813 and the &%serialize_hosts%& smtp transport option.
17815 .cindex "number of deliveries"
17816 .cindex "delivery" "maximum number of"
17817 If you want to control the total number of deliveries on the system, you
17818 need to set the &%queue_only%& option. This ensures that all incoming messages
17819 are added to the queue without starting a delivery process. Then set up an Exim
17820 daemon to start queue runner processes at appropriate intervals (probably
17821 fairly often, for example, every minute), and limit the total number of queue
17822 runners by setting the &%queue_run_max%& parameter. Because each queue runner
17823 delivers only one message at a time, the maximum number of deliveries that can
17824 then take place at once is &%queue_run_max%& multiplied by
17825 &%remote_max_parallel%&.
17827 If it is purely remote deliveries you want to control, use
17828 &%queue_smtp_domains%& instead of &%queue_only%&. This has the added benefit of
17829 doing the SMTP routing before queueing, so that several messages for the same
17830 host will eventually get delivered down the same connection.
17833 .option remote_sort_domains main "domain list&!!" unset
17834 .cindex "sorting remote deliveries"
17835 .cindex "delivery" "sorting remote"
17836 When there are a number of remote deliveries for a message, they are sorted by
17837 domain into the order given by this list. For example,
17839 remote_sort_domains = *.cam.ac.uk:*.uk
17841 would attempt to deliver to all addresses in the &'cam.ac.uk'& domain first,
17842 then to those in the &%uk%& domain, then to any others.
17845 .option retry_data_expire main time 7d
17846 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
17847 This option sets a &"use before"& time on retry information in Exim's hints
17848 database. Any older retry data is ignored. This means that, for example, once a
17849 host has not been tried for 7 days, Exim behaves as if it has no knowledge of
17853 .option retry_interval_max main time 24h
17854 .cindex "retry" "limit on interval"
17855 .cindex "limit" "on retry interval"
17856 Chapter &<<CHAPretry>>& describes Exim's mechanisms for controlling the
17857 intervals between delivery attempts for messages that cannot be delivered
17858 straight away. This option sets an overall limit to the length of time between
17859 retries. It cannot be set greater than 24 hours; any attempt to do so forces
17863 .option return_path_remove main boolean true
17864 .cindex "&'Return-path:'& header line" "removing"
17865 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821), section 4.4,
17866 states that an SMTP server must insert a
17867 &'Return-path:'& header line into a message when it makes a &"final delivery"&.
17868 The &'Return-path:'& header preserves the sender address as received in the
17869 MAIL command. This description implies that this header should not be present
17870 in an incoming message. If &%return_path_remove%& is true, any existing
17871 &'Return-path:'& headers are removed from messages at the time they are
17872 received. Exim's transports have options for adding &'Return-path:'& headers at
17873 the time of delivery. They are normally used only for final local deliveries.
17876 .option return_size_limit main integer 100K
17877 This option is an obsolete synonym for &%bounce_return_size_limit%&.
17880 .option rfc1413_hosts main "host list&!!" @[]
17882 .cindex "host" "for RFC 1413 calls"
17883 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1413,RFC 1413)
17884 identification calls are made to any client host which matches
17885 an item in the list.
17886 The default value specifies just this host, being any local interface
17889 .option rfc1413_query_timeout main time 0s
17890 .cindex "RFC 1413" "query timeout"
17891 .cindex "timeout" "for RFC 1413 call"
17892 This sets the timeout on
17893 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1413,RFC 1413)
17894 identification calls. If it is set to zero,
17895 no RFC 1413 calls are ever made.
17898 .option sender_unqualified_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
17899 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
17900 .cindex "host" "unqualified addresses from"
17901 This option lists those hosts from which Exim is prepared to accept unqualified
17902 sender addresses. The addresses are made fully qualified by the addition of
17903 &%qualify_domain%&. This option also affects message header lines. Exim does
17904 not reject unqualified addresses in headers that contain sender addresses, but
17905 it qualifies them only if the message came from a host that matches
17906 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%&, or if the message was submitted locally (not
17907 using TCP/IP), and the &%-bnq%& option was not set.
17910 .option slow_lookup_log main integer 0
17911 .cindex "logging" "slow lookups"
17912 .cindex "dns" "logging slow lookups"
17913 This option controls logging of slow lookups.
17914 If the value is nonzero it is taken as a number of milliseconds
17915 and lookups taking longer than this are logged.
17916 Currently this applies only to DNS lookups.
17920 .option smtp_accept_keepalive main boolean true
17921 .cindex "keepalive" "on incoming connection"
17922 This option controls the setting of the SO_KEEPALIVE option on incoming
17923 TCP/IP socket connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle
17924 connections periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The
17925 other end of the connection should send an acknowledgment if the connection is
17926 still okay or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing
17927 this is that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of
17928 connection that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without
17929 tidying up the TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several
17930 hours to detect unreachable hosts.
17934 .option smtp_accept_max main integer 20
17935 .cindex "limit" "incoming SMTP connections"
17936 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
17938 This option specifies the maximum number of simultaneous incoming SMTP calls
17939 that Exim will accept. It applies only to the listening daemon; there is no
17940 control (in Exim) when incoming SMTP is being handled by &'inetd'&. If the
17941 value is set to zero, no limit is applied. However, it is required to be
17942 non-zero if either &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& or &%smtp_accept_queue%& is
17943 set. See also &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%&.
17945 A new SMTP connection is immediately rejected if the &%smtp_accept_max%& limit
17946 has been reached. If not, Exim first checks &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%&. If
17947 that limit has not been reached for the client host, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&
17948 and &%smtp_load_reserve%& are then checked before accepting the connection.
17951 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail main integer 10
17952 .cindex "limit" "non-mail SMTP commands"
17953 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting non-mail commands"
17954 Exim counts the number of &"non-mail"& commands in an SMTP session, and drops
17955 the connection if there are too many. This option defines &"too many"&. The
17956 check catches some denial-of-service attacks, repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
17957 client looping sending EHLO, for example. The check is applied only if the
17958 client host matches &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&.
17960 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
17961 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
17962 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
17963 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
17964 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
17965 counted. The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately
17966 following STARTTLS is not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than
17967 MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
17970 .option smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts main "host list&!!" *
17971 You can control which hosts are subject to the &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
17972 check by setting this option. The default value makes it apply to all hosts. By
17973 changing the value, you can exclude any badly-behaved hosts that you have to
17977 . Allow this long option name to split; give it unsplit as a fifth argument
17978 . for the automatic .oindex that is generated by .option.
17979 . We insert " &~&~" which is both pretty nasty visually and results in
17980 . non-searchable text. HowItWorks.txt mentions an option for inserting
17981 . zero-width-space, which would be nicer visually and results in (at least)
17982 . html that Firefox will split on when it's forced to reflow (rather than
17983 . inserting a horizontal scrollbar). However, the text is still not
17984 . searchable. NM changed this occurrence for bug 1197 to no longer allow
17985 . the option name to split.
17987 .option smtp_accept_max_per_connection main integer&!! 1000
17988 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting incoming message count"
17989 .cindex "limit" "messages per SMTP connection"
17990 The value of this option limits the number of MAIL commands that Exim is
17991 prepared to accept over a single SMTP connection, whether or not each command
17992 results in the transfer of a message. After the limit is reached, a 421
17993 response is given to subsequent MAIL commands. This limit is a safety
17994 precaution against a client that goes mad (incidents of this type have been
17996 The option is expanded after the HELO or EHLO is received
17997 and may depend on values available at that time.
17998 An empty or zero value after expansion removes the limit.
18001 .option smtp_accept_max_per_host main string&!! unset
18002 .cindex "limit" "SMTP connections from one host"
18003 .cindex "host" "limiting SMTP connections from"
18004 This option restricts the number of simultaneous IP connections from a single
18005 host (strictly, from a single IP address) to the Exim daemon. The option is
18006 expanded, to enable different limits to be applied to different hosts by
18007 reference to &$sender_host_address$&. Once the limit is reached, additional
18008 connection attempts from the same host are rejected with error code 421. This
18009 is entirely independent of &%smtp_accept_reserve%&. The option's default value
18010 of zero imposes no limit. If this option is set greater than zero, it is
18011 required that &%smtp_accept_max%& be non-zero.
18013 &*Warning*&: When setting this option you should not use any expansion
18014 constructions that take an appreciable amount of time. The expansion and test
18015 happen in the main daemon loop, in order to reject additional connections
18016 without forking additional processes (otherwise a denial-of-service attack
18017 could cause a vast number or processes to be created). While the daemon is
18018 doing this processing, it cannot accept any other incoming connections.
18022 .option smtp_accept_queue main integer 0
18023 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming connection count"
18024 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
18025 .cindex "message" "queueing by SMTP connection count"
18026 If the number of simultaneous incoming SMTP connections being handled via the
18027 listening daemon exceeds this value, messages received by SMTP are just placed
18028 in the queue; no delivery processes are started automatically. The count is
18029 fixed at the start of an SMTP connection. It cannot be updated in the
18030 subprocess that receives messages, and so the queueing or not queueing applies
18031 to all messages received in the same connection.
18033 A value of zero implies no limit, and clearly any non-zero value is useful only
18034 if it is less than the &%smtp_accept_max%& value (unless that is zero). See
18035 also &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_load%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&, and the
18036 various &%-od%&&'x'& command line options.
18039 . See the comment on smtp_accept_max_per_connection
18041 .option smtp_accept_queue_per_connection main integer 10
18042 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
18043 .cindex "message" "queueing by message count"
18044 This option limits the number of delivery processes that Exim starts
18045 automatically when receiving messages via SMTP, whether via the daemon or by
18046 the use of &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&. If the value of the option is greater than zero,
18047 and the number of messages received in a single SMTP session exceeds this
18048 number, subsequent messages are placed in the queue, but no delivery processes
18049 are started. This helps to limit the number of Exim processes when a server
18050 restarts after downtime and there is a lot of mail waiting for it on other
18051 systems. On large systems, the default should probably be increased, and on
18052 dial-in client systems it should probably be set to zero (that is, disabled).
18055 .option smtp_accept_reserve main integer 0
18056 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming call count"
18057 .cindex "host" "reserved"
18058 When &%smtp_accept_max%& is set greater than zero, this option specifies a
18059 number of SMTP connections that are reserved for connections from the hosts
18060 that are specified in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&. The value set in
18061 &%smtp_accept_max%& includes this reserve pool. The specified hosts are not
18062 restricted to this number of connections; the option specifies a minimum number
18063 of connection slots for them, not a maximum. It is a guarantee that this group
18064 of hosts can always get at least &%smtp_accept_reserve%& connections. However,
18065 the limit specified by &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& is still applied to each
18068 For example, if &%smtp_accept_max%& is set to 50 and &%smtp_accept_reserve%& is
18069 set to 5, once there are 45 active connections (from any hosts), new
18070 connections are accepted only from hosts listed in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&,
18071 provided the other criteria for acceptance are met.
18074 .option smtp_active_hostname main string&!! unset
18075 .cindex "host" "name in SMTP responses"
18076 .cindex "SMTP" "host name in responses"
18077 .vindex "&$primary_hostname$&"
18078 This option is provided for multi-homed servers that want to masquerade as
18079 several different hosts. At the start of an incoming SMTP connection, its value
18080 is expanded and used instead of the value of &$primary_hostname$& in SMTP
18081 responses. For example, it is used as domain name in the response to an
18082 incoming HELO or EHLO command.
18084 .vindex "&$smtp_active_hostname$&"
18085 The active hostname is placed in the &$smtp_active_hostname$& variable, which
18086 is saved with any messages that are received. It is therefore available for use
18087 in routers and transports when the message is later delivered.
18089 If this option is unset, or if its expansion is forced to fail, or if the
18090 expansion results in an empty string, the value of &$primary_hostname$& is
18091 used. Other expansion failures cause a message to be written to the main and
18092 panic logs, and the SMTP command receives a temporary error. Typically, the
18093 value of &%smtp_active_hostname%& depends on the incoming interface address.
18096 smtp_active_hostname = ${if eq{$received_ip_address}{10.0.0.1}\
18097 {cox.mydomain}{box.mydomain}}
18100 Although &$smtp_active_hostname$& is primarily concerned with incoming
18101 messages, it is also used as the default for HELO commands in callout
18102 verification if there is no remote transport from which to obtain a
18103 &%helo_data%& value.
18105 .option smtp_backlog_monitor main integer 0
18106 .cindex "connection backlog" monitoring
18107 If this option is set to greater than zero, and the backlog of available
18108 TCP connections on a socket listening for SMTP is larger than it, a line
18109 is logged giving the value and the socket address and port.
18110 The value is retrived jsut before an accept call.
18111 This facility is only available on Linux.
18113 .option smtp_banner main string&!! "see below"
18114 .cindex "SMTP" "welcome banner"
18115 .cindex "banner for SMTP"
18116 .cindex "welcome banner for SMTP"
18117 .cindex "customizing" "SMTP banner"
18118 If a connect ACL does not supply a message,
18119 this string (which is expanded every time it is used) is output as the initial
18120 positive response to an SMTP connection. The default setting is:
18122 smtp_banner = $smtp_active_hostname ESMTP Exim \
18123 $version_number $tod_full
18125 Failure to expand the string causes a panic error;
18126 a forced fail just closes the connection.
18127 If you want to create a
18128 multiline response to the initial SMTP connection, use &"\n"& in the string at
18129 appropriate points, but not at the end. Note that the 220 code is not included
18130 in this string. Exim adds it automatically (several times in the case of a
18131 multiline response).
18134 .option smtp_check_spool_space main boolean true
18135 .cindex "checking disk space"
18136 .cindex "disk space, checking"
18137 .cindex "spool directory" "checking space"
18138 When this option is set, if an incoming SMTP session encounters the SIZE
18139 option on a MAIL command, it checks that there is enough space in the
18140 spool directory's partition to accept a message of that size, while still
18141 leaving free the amount specified by &%check_spool_space%& (even if that value
18142 is zero). If there isn't enough space, a temporary error code is returned.
18145 .option smtp_connect_backlog main integer 20
18146 .cindex "connection backlog" "set maximum"
18147 .cindex "SMTP" "connection backlog"
18148 .cindex "backlog of connections"
18149 This option specifies a maximum number of waiting SMTP connections. Exim passes
18150 this value to the TCP/IP system when it sets up its listener. Once this number
18151 of connections are waiting for the daemon's attention, subsequent connection
18152 attempts are refused at the TCP/IP level. At least, that is what the manuals
18153 say; in some circumstances such connection attempts have been observed to time
18154 out instead. For large systems it is probably a good idea to increase the
18155 value (to 50, say). It also gives some protection against denial-of-service
18156 attacks by SYN flooding.
18159 .option smtp_enforce_sync main boolean true
18160 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
18161 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
18162 The SMTP protocol specification requires the client to wait for a response from
18163 the server at certain points in the dialogue. Without PIPELINING these
18164 synchronization points are after every command; with PIPELINING they are
18165 fewer, but they still exist.
18167 Some spamming sites send out a complete set of SMTP commands without waiting
18168 for any response. Exim protects against this by rejecting a message if the
18169 client has sent further input when it should not have. The error response &"554
18170 SMTP synchronization error"& is sent, and the connection is dropped. Testing
18171 for this error cannot be perfect because of transmission delays (unexpected
18172 input may be on its way but not yet received when Exim checks). However, it
18173 does detect many instances.
18175 The check can be globally disabled by setting &%smtp_enforce_sync%& false.
18176 If you want to disable the check selectively (for example, only for certain
18177 hosts), you can do so by an appropriate use of a &%control%& modifier in an ACL
18178 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&). See also &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
18182 .option smtp_etrn_command main string&!! unset
18183 .cindex ETRN "command to be run"
18184 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
18185 .vindex "&$domain$&"
18186 If this option is set, the given command is run whenever an SMTP ETRN
18187 command is received from a host that is permitted to issue such commands (see
18188 chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&). The string is split up into separate arguments which
18189 are independently expanded. The expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the
18190 argument of the ETRN command, and no syntax checking is done on it. For
18193 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
18194 $sender_host_address
18196 If the option is not set, the argument for the ETRN command must
18197 be a &'#'& followed by an address string.
18198 In this case an &'exim -R <string>'& command is used;
18199 if the ETRN ACL has set up a named-queue then &'-MCG <queue>'& is appended.
18201 A new process is created to run the command, but Exim does not wait for it to
18202 complete. Consequently, its status cannot be checked. If the command cannot be
18203 run, a line is written to the panic log, but the ETRN caller still receives
18204 a 250 success response. Exim is normally running under its own uid when
18205 receiving SMTP, so it is not possible for it to change the uid before running
18209 .option smtp_etrn_serialize main boolean true
18210 .cindex ETRN serializing
18211 When this option is set, it prevents the simultaneous execution of more than
18212 one identical command as a result of ETRN in an SMTP connection. See
18213 section &<<SECTETRN>>& for details.
18216 .option smtp_load_reserve main fixed-point unset
18217 .cindex "load average"
18218 If the system load average ever gets higher than this, incoming SMTP calls are
18219 accepted only from those hosts that match an entry in &%smtp_reserve_hosts%&.
18220 If &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& is not set, no incoming SMTP calls are accepted when
18221 the load is over the limit. The option has no effect on ancient operating
18222 systems on which Exim cannot determine the load average. See also
18223 &%deliver_queue_load_max%& and &%queue_only_load%&.
18227 .option smtp_max_synprot_errors main integer 3
18228 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting syntax and protocol errors"
18229 .cindex "limit" "SMTP syntax and protocol errors"
18230 Exim rejects SMTP commands that contain syntax or protocol errors. In
18231 particular, a syntactically invalid email address, as in this command:
18233 RCPT TO:<abc xyz@a.b.c>
18235 causes immediate rejection of the command, before any other tests are done.
18236 (The ACL cannot be run if there is no valid address to set up for it.) An
18237 example of a protocol error is receiving RCPT before MAIL. If there are
18238 too many syntax or protocol errors in one SMTP session, the connection is
18239 dropped. The limit is set by this option.
18241 .cindex "PIPELINING" "expected errors"
18242 When the PIPELINING extension to SMTP is in use, some protocol errors are
18243 &"expected"&, for instance, a RCPT command after a rejected MAIL command.
18244 Exim assumes that PIPELINING will be used if it advertises it (see
18245 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&), and in this situation, &"expected"& errors do
18246 not count towards the limit.
18250 .option smtp_max_unknown_commands main integer 3
18251 .cindex "SMTP" "limiting unknown commands"
18252 .cindex "limit" "unknown SMTP commands"
18253 If there are too many unrecognized commands in an incoming SMTP session, an
18254 Exim server drops the connection. This is a defence against some kinds of abuse
18257 into making connections to SMTP ports; in these circumstances, a number of
18258 non-SMTP command lines are sent first.
18262 .options smtp_ratelimit_hosts main "host list&!!" unset &&&
18263 smtp_ratelimit_mail main string unset &&&
18264 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt main string unset
18265 .cindex "SMTP" "rate limiting"
18266 .cindex "limit" "rate of message arrival"
18267 .cindex "RCPT" "rate limiting"
18268 Some sites find it helpful to be able to limit the rate at which certain hosts
18269 can send them messages, and the rate at which an individual message can specify
18272 Exim has two rate-limiting facilities. This section describes the older
18273 facility, which can limit rates within a single connection. The newer
18274 &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can limit rates across all connections. See section
18275 &<<SECTratelimiting>>& for details of the newer facility.
18277 When a host matches &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%&, the values of
18278 &%smtp_ratelimit_mail%& and &%smtp_ratelimit_rcpt%& are used to control the
18279 rate of acceptance of MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session,
18280 respectively. Each option, if set, must contain a set of four comma-separated
18284 A threshold, before which there is no rate limiting.
18286 An initial time delay. Unlike other times in Exim, numbers with decimal
18287 fractional parts are allowed here.
18289 A factor by which to increase the delay each time.
18291 A maximum value for the delay. This should normally be less than 5 minutes,
18292 because after that time, the client is liable to timeout the SMTP command.
18295 For example, these settings have been used successfully at the site which
18296 first suggested this feature, for controlling mail from their customers:
18298 smtp_ratelimit_mail = 2,0.5s,1.05,4m
18299 smtp_ratelimit_rcpt = 4,0.25s,1.015,4m
18301 The first setting specifies delays that are applied to MAIL commands after
18302 two have been received over a single connection. The initial delay is 0.5
18303 seconds, increasing by a factor of 1.05 each time. The second setting applies
18304 delays to RCPT commands when more than four occur in a single message.
18308 .option smtp_receive_timeout main time&!! 5m
18309 .cindex "timeout" "for SMTP input"
18310 .cindex "SMTP" "input timeout"
18311 This sets a timeout value for SMTP reception. It applies to all forms of SMTP
18312 input, including batch SMTP. If a line of input (either an SMTP command or a
18313 data line) is not received within this time, the SMTP connection is dropped and
18314 the message is abandoned.
18315 A line is written to the log containing one of the following messages:
18317 SMTP command timeout on connection from...
18318 SMTP data timeout on connection from...
18320 The former means that Exim was expecting to read an SMTP command; the latter
18321 means that it was in the DATA phase, reading the contents of a message.
18323 If the first character of the option is a &"$"& the option is
18324 expanded before use and may depend on
18325 &$sender_host_name$&, &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&.
18329 The value set by this option can be overridden by the
18330 &%-os%& command-line option. A setting of zero time disables the timeout, but
18331 this should never be used for SMTP over TCP/IP. (It can be useful in some cases
18332 of local input using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.) For non-SMTP input, the reception
18333 timeout is controlled by &%receive_timeout%& and &%-or%&.
18336 .option smtp_reserve_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18337 This option defines hosts for which SMTP connections are reserved; see
18338 &%smtp_accept_reserve%& and &%smtp_load_reserve%& above.
18341 .option smtp_return_error_details main boolean false
18342 .cindex "SMTP" "details policy failures"
18343 .cindex "policy control" "rejection, returning details"
18344 In the default state, Exim uses bland messages such as
18345 &"Administrative prohibition"& when it rejects SMTP commands for policy
18346 reasons. Many sysadmins like this because it gives away little information
18347 to spammers. However, some other sysadmins who are applying strict checking
18348 policies want to give out much fuller information about failures. Setting
18349 &%smtp_return_error_details%& true causes Exim to be more forthcoming. For
18350 example, instead of &"Administrative prohibition"&, it might give:
18352 550-Rejected after DATA: '>' missing at end of address:
18353 550 failing address in "From" header is: <user@dom.ain
18357 .option smtputf8_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18358 .cindex "SMTPUTF8" "ESMTP extension, advertising"
18359 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
18360 When Exim is built with support for internationalised mail names,
18361 the availability thereof is advertised in
18362 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18363 chapter &<<CHAPi18n>>& for details of Exim's support for internationalisation.
18366 .option spamd_address main string "127.0.0.1 783"
18367 This option is available when Exim is compiled with the content-scanning
18368 extension. It specifies how Exim connects to SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon.
18369 See section &<<SECTscanspamass>>& for more details.
18373 .option spf_guess main string "v=spf1 a/24 mx/24 ptr ?all"
18374 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support.
18375 See section &<<SECSPF>>& for more details.
18377 .option spf_smtp_comment_template main string&!! "Please%_see%_http://www.open-spf.org/Why"
18378 This option is available when Exim is compiled with SPF support. It
18379 allows the customisation of the SMTP comment that the SPF library
18380 generates. You are strongly encouraged to link to your own explanative
18381 site. The template must not contain spaces. If you need spaces in the
18382 output, use the proper placeholder. If libspf2 can not parse the
18383 template, it uses a built-in default broken link. The following placeholders
18384 (along with Exim variables (but see below)) are allowed in the template:
18388 &*%{L}*&: Envelope sender's local part.
18390 &*%{S}*&: Envelope sender.
18392 &*%{O}*&: Envelope sender's domain.
18394 &*%{D}*&: Current(?) domain.
18396 &*%{I}*&: SMTP client Ip.
18398 &*%{C}*&: SMTP client pretty IP.
18400 &*%{T}*&: Epoch time (UTC).
18402 &*%{P}*&: SMTP client domain name.
18404 &*%{V}*&: IP version.
18406 &*%{H}*&: EHLO/HELO domain.
18408 &*%{R}*&: Receiving domain.
18410 The capitalized placeholders do proper URL encoding, if you use them
18411 lowercased, no encoding takes place. This list was compiled from the
18414 A note on using Exim variables: As
18415 currently the SPF library is initialized before the SMTP EHLO phase,
18416 the variables useful for expansion are quite limited.
18419 .option split_spool_directory main boolean false
18420 .cindex "multiple spool directories"
18421 .cindex "spool directory" "split"
18422 .cindex "directories, multiple"
18423 If this option is set, it causes Exim to split its input directory into 62
18424 subdirectories, each with a single alphanumeric character as its name. The
18425 sixth character of the message id is used to allocate messages to
18426 subdirectories; this is the least significant base-62 digit of the time of
18427 arrival of the message.
18429 Splitting up the spool in this way may provide better performance on systems
18430 where there are long mail queues, by reducing the number of files in any one
18431 directory. The msglog directory is also split up in a similar way to the input
18432 directory; however, if &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, all old msglog files
18433 are still placed in the single directory &_msglog.OLD_&.
18435 It is not necessary to take any special action for existing messages when
18436 changing &%split_spool_directory%&. Exim notices messages that are in the
18437 &"wrong"& place, and continues to process them. If the option is turned off
18438 after a period of being on, the subdirectories will eventually empty and be
18439 automatically deleted.
18441 When &%split_spool_directory%& is set, the behaviour of queue runner processes
18442 changes. Instead of creating a list of all messages in the queue, and then
18443 trying to deliver each one, in turn, it constructs a list of those in one
18444 sub-directory and tries to deliver them, before moving on to the next
18445 sub-directory. The sub-directories are processed in a random order. This
18446 spreads out the scanning of the input directories, and uses less memory. It is
18447 particularly beneficial when there are lots of messages in the queue. However,
18448 if &%queue_run_in_order%& is set, none of this new processing happens. The
18449 entire queue has to be scanned and sorted before any deliveries can start.
18452 .option spool_directory main string&!! "set at compile time"
18453 .cindex "spool directory" "path to"
18454 This defines the directory in which Exim keeps its spool, that is, the messages
18455 it is waiting to deliver. The default value is taken from the compile-time
18456 configuration setting, if there is one. If not, this option must be set. The
18457 string is expanded, so it can contain, for example, a reference to
18458 &$primary_hostname$&.
18460 If the spool directory name is fixed on your installation, it is recommended
18461 that you set it at build time rather than from this option, particularly if the
18462 log files are being written to the spool directory (see &%log_file_path%&).
18463 Otherwise log files cannot be used for errors that are detected early on, such
18464 as failures in the configuration file.
18466 By using this option to override the compiled-in path, it is possible to run
18467 tests of Exim without using the standard spool.
18469 .option spool_wireformat main boolean false
18470 .cindex "spool directory" "file formats"
18471 If this option is set, Exim may for some messages use an alternative format
18472 for data-files in the spool which matches the wire format.
18473 Doing this permits more efficient message reception and transmission.
18474 Currently it is only done for messages received using the ESMTP CHUNKING
18477 The following variables will not have useful values:
18479 $max_received_linelength
18484 Users of the local_scan() API (see &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&),
18485 and any external programs which are passed a reference to a message data file
18486 (except via the &"regex"&, &"malware"& or &"spam"&) ACL conditions)
18487 will need to be aware of the different formats potentially available.
18489 Using any of the ACL conditions noted will negate the reception benefit
18490 (as a Unix-mbox-format file is constructed for them).
18491 The transmission benefit is maintained.
18493 .option sqlite_lock_timeout main time 5s
18494 .cindex "sqlite lookup type" "lock timeout"
18495 This option controls the timeout that the &(sqlite)& lookup uses when trying to
18496 access an SQLite database. See section &<<SECTsqlite>>& for more details.
18498 .option strict_acl_vars main boolean false
18499 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables, handling unset"
18500 This option controls what happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL
18501 variable is referenced. If it is false (the default), an empty string
18502 is substituted; if it is true, an error is generated. See section
18503 &<<SECTaclvariables>>& for details of ACL variables.
18505 .option strip_excess_angle_brackets main boolean false
18506 .cindex "angle brackets, excess"
18507 If this option is set, redundant pairs of angle brackets round &"route-addr"&
18508 items in addresses are stripped. For example, &'<<xxx@a.b.c.d>>'& is
18509 treated as &'<xxx@a.b.c.d>'&. If this is in the envelope and the message is
18510 passed on to another MTA, the excess angle brackets are not passed on. If this
18511 option is not set, multiple pairs of angle brackets cause a syntax error.
18514 .option strip_trailing_dot main boolean false
18515 .cindex "trailing dot on domain"
18516 .cindex "dot" "trailing on domain"
18517 If this option is set, a trailing dot at the end of a domain in an address is
18518 ignored. If this is in the envelope and the message is passed on to another
18519 MTA, the dot is not passed on. If this option is not set, a dot at the end of a
18520 domain causes a syntax error.
18521 However, addresses in header lines are checked only when an ACL requests header
18525 .option syslog_duplication main boolean true
18526 .cindex "syslog" "duplicate log lines; suppressing"
18527 When Exim is logging to syslog, it writes the log lines for its three
18528 separate logs at different syslog priorities so that they can in principle
18529 be separated on the logging hosts. Some installations do not require this
18530 separation, and in those cases, the duplication of certain log lines is a
18531 nuisance. If &%syslog_duplication%& is set false, only one copy of any
18532 particular log line is written to syslog. For lines that normally go to
18533 both the main log and the reject log, the reject log version (possibly
18534 containing message header lines) is written, at LOG_NOTICE priority.
18535 Lines that normally go to both the main and the panic log are written at
18536 the LOG_ALERT priority.
18539 .option syslog_facility main string unset
18540 .cindex "syslog" "facility; setting"
18541 This option sets the syslog &"facility"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18542 syslog. The value must be one of the strings &"mail"&, &"user"&, &"news"&,
18543 &"uucp"&, &"daemon"&, or &"local&'x'&"& where &'x'& is a digit between 0 and 7.
18544 If this option is unset, &"mail"& is used. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18545 details of Exim's logging.
18548 .option syslog_pid main boolean true
18549 .cindex "syslog" "pid"
18550 If &%syslog_pid%& is set false, the PID on Exim's log lines are
18551 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. (Syslog normally prefixes
18552 the log lines with the PID of the logging process automatically.) You need
18553 to enable the &`+pid`& log selector item, if you want Exim to write it's PID
18554 into the logs.) See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18558 .option syslog_processname main string &`exim`&
18559 .cindex "syslog" "process name; setting"
18560 This option sets the syslog &"ident"& name, used when Exim is logging to
18561 syslog. The value must be no longer than 32 characters. See chapter
18562 &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of Exim's logging.
18566 .option syslog_timestamp main boolean true
18567 .cindex "syslog" "timestamps"
18568 .cindex timestamps syslog
18569 If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on Exim's log lines are
18570 omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for
18571 details of Exim's logging.
18574 .option system_filter main string&!! unset
18575 .cindex "filter" "system filter"
18576 .cindex "system filter" "specifying"
18577 .cindex "Sieve filter" "not available for system filter"
18578 This option specifies an Exim filter file that is applied to all messages at
18579 the start of each delivery attempt, before any routing is done. System filters
18580 must be Exim filters; they cannot be Sieve filters. If the system filter
18581 generates any deliveries to files or pipes, or any new mail messages, the
18582 appropriate &%system_filter_..._transport%& option(s) must be set, to define
18583 which transports are to be used. Details of this facility are given in chapter
18584 &<<CHAPsystemfilter>>&.
18585 A forced expansion failure results in no filter operation.
18588 .option system_filter_directory_transport main string&!! unset
18589 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
18590 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the
18591 &%save%& command in a system message filter specifies a path ending in &"/"&,
18592 implying delivery of each message into a separate file in some directory.
18593 During the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18596 .option system_filter_file_transport main string&!! unset
18597 .cindex "file" "transport for system filter"
18598 This sets the name of the transport driver that is to be used when the &%save%&
18599 command in a system message filter specifies a path not ending in &"/"&. During
18600 the delivery, the variable &$address_file$& contains the path name.
18602 .option system_filter_group main string unset
18603 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
18604 This option is used only when &%system_filter_user%& is also set. It sets the
18605 gid under which the system filter is run, overriding any gid that is associated
18606 with the user. The value may be numerical or symbolic.
18608 .option system_filter_pipe_transport main string&!! unset
18609 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "for system filter"
18610 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
18611 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%pipe%& command
18612 is used in a system filter. During the delivery, the variable &$address_pipe$&
18613 contains the pipe command.
18616 .option system_filter_reply_transport main string&!! unset
18617 .cindex "&(autoreply)& transport" "for system filter"
18618 This specifies the transport driver that is to be used when a &%mail%& command
18619 is used in a system filter.
18622 .option system_filter_user main string unset
18623 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
18624 If this option is set to root, the system filter is run in the main Exim
18625 delivery process, as root. Otherwise, the system filter runs in a separate
18626 process, as the given user, defaulting to the Exim run-time user.
18627 Unless the string consists entirely of digits, it
18628 is looked up in the password data. Failure to find the named user causes a
18629 configuration error. The gid is either taken from the password data, or
18630 specified by &%system_filter_group%&. When the uid is specified numerically,
18631 &%system_filter_group%& is required to be set.
18633 If the system filter generates any pipe, file, or reply deliveries, the uid
18634 under which the filter is run is used when transporting them, unless a
18635 transport option overrides.
18638 .option tcp_nodelay main boolean true
18639 .cindex "daemon" "TCP_NODELAY on sockets"
18640 .cindex "Nagle algorithm"
18641 .cindex "TCP_NODELAY on listening sockets"
18642 If this option is set false, it stops the Exim daemon setting the
18643 TCP_NODELAY option on its listening sockets. Setting TCP_NODELAY
18644 turns off the &"Nagle algorithm"&, which is a way of improving network
18645 performance in interactive (character-by-character) situations. Turning it off
18646 should improve Exim's performance a bit, so that is what happens by default.
18647 However, it appears that some broken clients cannot cope, and time out. Hence
18648 this option. It affects only those sockets that are set up for listening by the
18649 daemon. Sockets created by the smtp transport for delivering mail always set
18653 .option timeout_frozen_after main time 0s
18654 .cindex "frozen messages" "timing out"
18655 .cindex "timeout" "frozen messages"
18656 If &%timeout_frozen_after%& is set to a time greater than zero, a frozen
18657 message of any kind that has been in the queue for longer than the given time
18658 is automatically cancelled at the next queue run. If the frozen message is a
18659 bounce message, it is just discarded; otherwise, a bounce is sent to the
18660 sender, in a similar manner to cancellation by the &%-Mg%& command line option.
18661 If you want to timeout frozen bounce messages earlier than other kinds of
18662 frozen message, see &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&.
18664 &*Note:*& the default value of zero means no timeouts; with this setting,
18665 frozen messages remain in the queue forever (except for any frozen bounce
18666 messages that are released by &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&).
18669 .option timezone main string unset
18670 .cindex "timezone, setting"
18671 .cindex "environment" "values from"
18672 The value of &%timezone%& is used to set the environment variable TZ while
18673 running Exim (if it is different on entry). This ensures that all timestamps
18674 created by Exim are in the required timezone. If you want all your timestamps
18675 to be in UTC (aka GMT) you should set
18679 The default value is taken from TIMEZONE_DEFAULT in &_Local/Makefile_&,
18680 or, if that is not set, from the value of the TZ environment variable when Exim
18681 is built. If &%timezone%& is set to the empty string, either at build or run
18682 time, any existing TZ variable is removed from the environment when Exim
18683 runs. This is appropriate behaviour for obtaining wall-clock time on some, but
18684 unfortunately not all, operating systems.
18687 .option tls_advertise_hosts main "host list&!!" *
18688 .cindex "TLS" "advertising"
18689 .cindex "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
18690 .cindex "SMTP" "encrypted connection"
18691 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
18692 When Exim is built with support for TLS encrypted connections, the availability
18693 of the STARTTLS command to set up an encrypted session is advertised in
18694 response to EHLO only to those client hosts that match this option. See
18695 chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of Exim's support for TLS.
18696 Note that the default value requires that a certificate be supplied
18697 using the &%tls_certificate%& option. If TLS support for incoming connections
18698 is not required the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option should be set empty.
18701 .option tls_alpn main "string list&!!" "smtp : esmtp"
18702 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
18704 .cindex ALPN "set acceptable names for server"
18705 If this option is set,
18706 the TLS library supports ALPN,
18707 and the client offers either more than one
18708 ALPN name or a name which does not match the list,
18709 the TLS connection is declined.
18712 .option tls_certificate main "string list&!!" unset
18713 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate; location of"
18714 .cindex "certificate" "server, location of"
18715 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18716 files which contain the server's certificates (in PEM format).
18717 Commonly only one file is needed.
18718 The server's private key is also
18719 assumed to be in this file if &%tls_privatekey%& is unset. See chapter
18720 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18722 &*Note*&: The certificates defined by this option are used only when Exim is
18723 receiving incoming messages as a server. If you want to supply certificates for
18724 use when sending messages as a client, you must set the &%tls_certificate%&
18725 option in the relevant &(smtp)& transport.
18727 &*Note*&: If you use filenames based on IP addresses, change the list
18728 separator in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&) to avoid confusion under IPv6.
18730 &*Note*&: Under versions of OpenSSL preceding 1.1.1,
18731 when a list of more than one
18732 file is used, the &$tls_in_ourcert$& variable is unreliable.
18733 The macro "_TLS_BAD_MULTICERT_IN_OURCERT" will be defined for those versions.
18735 .cindex SNI "selecting server certificate based on"
18736 If the option contains &$tls_out_sni$& and Exim is built against OpenSSL, then
18737 if the OpenSSL build supports TLS extensions and the TLS client sends the
18738 Server Name Indication extension, then this option and others documented in
18739 &<<SECTtlssni>>& will be re-expanded.
18741 If this option is unset or empty a self-signed certificate will be
18743 Under Linux this is generated at daemon startup; on other platforms it will be
18744 generated fresh for every connection.
18746 .option tls_crl main string&!! unset
18747 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate revocation list"
18748 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for server"
18749 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
18750 be the name of a file that contains CRLs in PEM format.
18752 Under OpenSSL the option can specify a directory with CRL files.
18754 &*Note:*& Under OpenSSL the option must, if given, supply a CRL
18755 for each signing element of the certificate chain (i.e. all but the leaf).
18756 For the file variant this can be multiple PEM blocks in the one file.
18758 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18761 .option tls_dh_max_bits main integer 2236
18762 .cindex "TLS" "D-H bit count"
18763 The number of bits used for Diffie-Hellman key-exchange may be suggested by
18764 the chosen TLS library. That value might prove to be too high for
18765 interoperability. This option provides a maximum clamp on the value
18766 suggested, trading off security for interoperability.
18768 The value must be at least 1024.
18770 The value 2236 was chosen because, at time of adding the option, it was the
18771 hard-coded maximum value supported by the NSS cryptographic library, as used
18772 by Thunderbird, while GnuTLS was suggesting 2432 bits as normal.
18774 If you prefer more security and are willing to break some clients, raise this
18777 Note that the value passed to GnuTLS for *generating* a new prime may be a
18778 little less than this figure, because GnuTLS is inexact and may produce a
18779 larger prime than requested.
18782 .option tls_dhparam main string&!! unset
18783 .cindex "TLS" "D-H parameters for server"
18784 The value of this option is expanded and indicates the source of DH parameters
18785 to be used by Exim.
18787 &*Note: The Exim Maintainers strongly recommend using a filename with site-generated
18788 local DH parameters*&, which has been supported across all versions of Exim. The
18789 other specific constants available are a fallback so that even when
18790 "unconfigured", Exim can offer Perfect Forward Secrecy in older ciphersuites in TLS.
18792 If &%tls_dhparam%& is a filename starting with a &`/`&,
18793 then it names a file from which DH
18794 parameters should be loaded. If the file exists, it should hold a PEM-encoded
18795 PKCS#3 representation of the DH prime. If the file does not exist, for
18796 OpenSSL it is an error. For GnuTLS, Exim will attempt to create the file and
18797 fill it with a generated DH prime. For OpenSSL, if the DH bit-count from
18798 loading the file is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then it will be ignored,
18799 and treated as though the &%tls_dhparam%& were set to "none".
18801 If this option expands to the string "none", then no DH parameters will be
18804 If this option expands to the string "historic" and Exim is using GnuTLS, then
18805 Exim will attempt to load a file from inside the spool directory. If the file
18806 does not exist, Exim will attempt to create it.
18807 See section &<<SECTgnutlsparam>>& for further details.
18809 If Exim is using OpenSSL and this option is empty or unset, then Exim will load
18810 a default DH prime; the default is Exim-specific but lacks verifiable provenance.
18812 In older versions of Exim the default was the 2048 bit prime described in section
18813 2.2 of &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5114,RFC 5114),
18814 "2048-bit MODP Group with 224-bit Prime Order Subgroup", which
18815 in IKE is assigned number 23.
18817 Otherwise, the option must expand to the name used by Exim for any of a number
18818 of DH primes specified in
18819 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2409,RFC 2409),
18820 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3526,RFC 3526),
18821 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5114,RFC 5114),
18822 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7919,RFC 7919), or from other
18823 sources. As names, Exim uses a standard specified name, else "ike" followed by
18824 the number used by IKE, or "default" which corresponds to
18825 &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18827 The available standard primes are:
18828 &`ffdhe2048`&, &`ffdhe3072`&, &`ffdhe4096`&, &`ffdhe6144`&, &`ffdhe8192`&,
18829 &`ike1`&, &`ike2`&, &`ike5`&,
18830 &`ike14`&, &`ike15`&, &`ike16`&, &`ike17`&, &`ike18`&,
18831 &`ike22`&, &`ike23`& and &`ike24`&.
18833 The available additional primes are:
18834 &`exim.dev.20160529.1`&, &`exim.dev.20160529.2`& and &`exim.dev.20160529.3`&.
18836 Some of these will be too small to be accepted by clients.
18837 Some may be too large to be accepted by clients.
18838 The open cryptographic community has suspicions about the integrity of some
18839 of the later IKE values, which led into
18840 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7919,RFC 7919)
18841 providing new fixed constants (the "ffdhe" identifiers).
18843 At this point, all of the "ike" values should be considered obsolete;
18844 they are still in Exim to avoid breaking unusual configurations, but are
18845 candidates for removal the next time we have backwards-incompatible changes.
18846 Two of them in particular (&`ike1`& and &`ike22`&) are called out by
18847 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8247,RFC 8247)
18848 as MUST NOT use for IPSEC, and two more (&`ike23`& and &`ike24`&) as
18850 Because of this, Exim regards them as deprecated; if either of the first pair
18851 are used, warnings will be logged in the paniclog, and if any are used then
18852 warnings will be logged in the mainlog.
18853 All four will be removed in a future Exim release.
18855 The TLS protocol does not negotiate an acceptable size for this; clients tend
18856 to hard-drop connections if what is offered by the server is unacceptable,
18857 whether too large or too small, and there's no provision for the client to
18858 tell the server what these constraints are. Thus, as a server operator, you
18859 need to make an educated guess as to what is most likely to work for your
18862 Some known size constraints suggest that a bit-size in the range 2048 to 2236
18863 is most likely to maximise interoperability. The upper bound comes from
18864 applications using the Mozilla Network Security Services (NSS) library, which
18865 used to set its &`DH_MAX_P_BITS`& upper-bound to 2236. This affects many
18866 mail user agents (MUAs). The lower bound comes from Debian installs of Exim4
18867 prior to the 4.80 release, as Debian used to patch Exim to raise the minimum
18868 acceptable bound from 1024 to 2048.
18871 .option tls_eccurve main string list&!! &`auto`&
18872 .cindex TLS "EC cryptography"
18873 This option selects EC curves for use by Exim when used with OpenSSL.
18874 It has no effect when Exim is used with GnuTLS
18875 (the equivalent can be done using a priority string for the
18876 &%tls_require_ciphers%& option).
18878 After expansion it must contain
18879 one or (only for OpenSSL versiona 1.1.1 onwards) more
18880 EC curve names, such as &`prime256v1`&, &`secp384r1`&, or &`P-521`&.
18881 Consult your OpenSSL manual for valid curve names.
18883 For OpenSSL versions before (and not including) 1.0.2, the string
18884 &`auto`& selects &`prime256v1`&. For more recent OpenSSL versions
18885 &`auto`& tells the library to choose.
18887 If the option expands to an empty string, the effect is undefined.
18890 .option tls_ocsp_file main string&!! unset
18891 .cindex TLS "certificate status"
18892 .cindex TLS "OCSP proof file"
18894 must if set expand to the absolute path to a file which contains a current
18895 status proof for the server's certificate, as obtained from the
18896 Certificate Authority.
18898 Usable for GnuTLS 3.4.4 or 3.3.17 or OpenSSL 1.1.0 (or later).
18899 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP" will be defined for those versions.
18901 For OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later, and
18902 for GnuTLS 3.5.6 or later the expanded value of this option can be a list
18903 of files, to match a list given for the &%tls_certificate%& option.
18904 The ordering of the two lists must match.
18905 The macro "_HAVE_TLS_OCSP_LIST" will be defined for those versions.
18907 The file(s) should be in DER format,
18908 except for GnuTLS 3.6.3 or later
18910 when an optional filetype prefix can be used.
18911 The prefix must be one of "DER" or "PEM", followed by
18912 a single space. If one is used it sets the format for subsequent
18913 files in the list; the initial format is DER.
18914 If multiple proofs are wanted, for multiple chain elements
18915 (this only works under TLS1.3)
18916 they must be coded as a combined OCSP response.
18918 Although GnuTLS will accept PEM files with multiple separate
18919 PEM blobs (ie. separate OCSP responses), it sends them in the
18920 TLS Certificate record interleaved with the certificates of the chain;
18921 although a GnuTLS client is happy with that, an OpenSSL client is not.
18923 .option tls_on_connect_ports main "string list" unset
18926 This option specifies a list of incoming SSMTP (aka SMTPS) ports that should
18927 operate the SSMTP (SMTPS) protocol, where a TLS session is immediately
18928 set up without waiting for the client to issue a STARTTLS command. For
18929 further details, see section &<<SECTsupobssmt>>&.
18933 .option tls_privatekey main "string list&!!" unset
18934 .cindex "TLS" "server private key; location of"
18935 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be a list of absolute paths to
18936 files which contains the server's private keys.
18937 If this option is unset, or if
18938 the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the private
18939 key is assumed to be in the same file as the server's certificates. See chapter
18940 &<<CHAPTLS>>& for further details.
18942 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
18945 .option tls_remember_esmtp main boolean false
18946 .cindex "TLS" "esmtp state; remembering"
18947 .cindex "TLS" "broken clients"
18948 If this option is set true, Exim violates the RFCs by remembering that it is in
18949 &"esmtp"& state after successfully negotiating a TLS session. This provides
18950 support for broken clients that fail to send a new EHLO after starting a
18954 .option tls_require_ciphers main string&!! unset
18955 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
18956 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
18957 This option controls which ciphers can be used for incoming TLS connections.
18958 The &(smtp)& transport has an option of the same name for controlling outgoing
18959 connections. This option is expanded for each connection, so can be varied for
18960 different clients if required. The value of this option must be a list of
18961 permitted cipher suites. The OpenSSL and GnuTLS libraries handle cipher control
18962 in somewhat different ways. If GnuTLS is being used, the client controls the
18963 preference order of the available ciphers. Details are given in sections
18964 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
18967 .option tls_resumption_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18968 .cindex TLS resumption
18969 This option controls which connections to offer the TLS resumption feature.
18970 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
18973 .option tls_try_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
18974 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18975 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18976 See &%tls_verify_hosts%& below.
18979 .option tls_verify_certificates main string&!! system
18980 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
18981 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
18982 The value of this option is expanded, and must then be either the
18984 or the absolute path to
18985 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for clients that
18986 match &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&.
18988 The "system" value for the option will use a
18989 system default location compiled into the SSL library.
18990 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20,
18991 and will be taken as empty; an explicit location
18994 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
18995 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
18997 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
18999 either by file or directory
19000 are added to those given by the system default location.
19002 These certificates should be for the certificate authorities trusted, rather
19003 than the public cert of individual clients. With both OpenSSL and GnuTLS, if
19004 the value is a file then the certificates are sent by Exim as a server to
19005 connecting clients, defining the list of accepted certificate authorities.
19006 Thus the values defined should be considered public data. To avoid this,
19007 use the explicit directory version. (If your peer is Exim up to 4.85,
19008 using GnuTLS, you may need to send the CAs (thus using the file
19009 variant). Otherwise the peer doesn't send its certificate.)
19011 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for discussion of when this option might be re-expanded.
19013 A forced expansion failure or setting to an empty string is equivalent to
19017 .option tls_verify_hosts main "host list&!!" unset
19018 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
19019 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
19020 This option, along with &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, controls the checking of
19021 certificates from clients. The expected certificates are defined by
19022 &%tls_verify_certificates%&, which must be set. A configuration error occurs if
19023 either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is set and
19024 &%tls_verify_certificates%& is not set.
19026 Any client that matches &%tls_verify_hosts%& is constrained by
19027 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. When the client initiates a TLS session, it must
19028 present one of the listed certificates. If it does not, the connection is
19030 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
19031 the host to use TLS. It can still send SMTP commands through unencrypted
19032 connections. Forcing a client to use TLS has to be done separately using an
19033 ACL to reject inappropriate commands when the connection is not encrypted.
19035 A weaker form of checking is provided by &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. If a client
19036 matches this option (but not &%tls_verify_hosts%&), Exim requests a
19037 certificate and checks it against &%tls_verify_certificates%&, but does not
19038 abort the connection if there is no certificate or if it does not match. This
19039 state can be detected in an ACL, which makes it possible to implement policies
19040 such as &"accept for relay only if a verified certificate has been received,
19041 but accept for local delivery if encrypted, even without a verified
19044 Client hosts that match neither of these lists are not asked to present
19048 .option trusted_groups main "string list&!!" unset
19049 .cindex "trusted groups"
19050 .cindex "groups" "trusted"
19051 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
19052 option is set, any process that is running in one of the listed groups, or
19053 which has one of them as a supplementary group, is trusted. The groups can be
19054 specified numerically or by name. See section &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for
19055 details of what trusted callers are permitted to do. If neither
19056 &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the Exim user
19059 .option trusted_users main "string list&!!" unset
19060 .cindex "trusted users"
19061 .cindex "user" "trusted"
19062 This option is expanded just once, at the start of Exim's processing. If this
19063 option is set, any process that is running as one of the listed users is
19064 trusted. The users can be specified numerically or by name. See section
19065 &<<SECTtrustedadmin>>& for details of what trusted callers are permitted to do.
19066 If neither &%trusted_groups%& nor &%trusted_users%& is set, only root and the
19067 Exim user are trusted.
19069 .option unknown_login main string&!! unset
19070 .cindex "uid (user id)" "unknown caller"
19071 .vindex "&$caller_uid$&"
19072 This is a specialized feature for use in unusual configurations. By default, if
19073 the uid of the caller of Exim cannot be looked up using &[getpwuid()]&, Exim
19074 gives up. The &%unknown_login%& option can be used to set a login name to be
19075 used in this circumstance. It is expanded, so values like &%user$caller_uid%&
19076 can be set. When &%unknown_login%& is used, the value of &%unknown_username%&
19077 is used for the user's real name (gecos field), unless this has been set by the
19080 .option unknown_username main string unset
19081 See &%unknown_login%&.
19083 .option untrusted_set_sender main "address list&!!" unset
19084 .cindex "trusted users"
19085 .cindex "sender" "setting by untrusted user"
19086 .cindex "untrusted user setting sender"
19087 .cindex "user" "untrusted setting sender"
19088 .cindex "envelope from"
19089 .cindex "envelope sender"
19090 When an untrusted user submits a message to Exim using the standard input, Exim
19091 normally creates an envelope sender address from the user's login and the
19092 default qualification domain. Data from the &%-f%& option (for setting envelope
19093 senders on non-SMTP messages) or the SMTP MAIL command (if &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&
19094 is used) is ignored.
19096 However, untrusted users are permitted to set an empty envelope sender address,
19097 to declare that a message should never generate any bounces. For example:
19099 exim -f '<>' user@domain.example
19101 .vindex "&$sender_ident$&"
19102 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option allows you to permit untrusted users to set
19103 other envelope sender addresses in a controlled way. When it is set, untrusted
19104 users are allowed to set envelope sender addresses that match any of the
19105 patterns in the list. Like all address lists, the string is expanded. The
19106 identity of the user is in &$sender_ident$&, so you can, for example, restrict
19107 users to setting senders that start with their login ids
19108 followed by a hyphen
19109 by a setting like this:
19111 untrusted_set_sender = ^$sender_ident-
19113 If you want to allow untrusted users to set envelope sender addresses without
19114 restriction, you can use
19116 untrusted_set_sender = *
19118 The &%untrusted_set_sender%& option applies to all forms of local input, but
19119 only to the setting of the envelope sender. It does not permit untrusted users
19120 to use the other options which trusted user can use to override message
19121 parameters. Furthermore, it does not stop Exim from removing an existing
19122 &'Sender:'& header in the message, or from adding a &'Sender:'& header if
19123 necessary. See &%local_sender_retain%& and &%local_from_check%& for ways of
19124 overriding these actions. The handling of the &'Sender:'& header is also
19125 described in section &<<SECTthesenhea>>&.
19127 The log line for a message's arrival shows the envelope sender following
19128 &"<="&. For local messages, the user's login always follows, after &"U="&. In
19129 &%-bp%& displays, and in the Exim monitor, if an untrusted user sets an
19130 envelope sender address, the user's login is shown in parentheses after the
19134 .option uucp_from_pattern main string "see below"
19135 .cindex "&""From""& line"
19136 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
19137 Some applications that pass messages to an MTA via a command line interface use
19138 an initial line starting with &"From&~"& to pass the envelope sender. In
19139 particular, this is used by UUCP software. Exim recognizes such a line by means
19140 of a regular expression that is set in &%uucp_from_pattern%&. When the pattern
19141 matches, the sender address is constructed by expanding the contents of
19142 &%uucp_from_sender%&, provided that the caller of Exim is a trusted user. The
19143 default pattern recognizes lines in the following two forms:
19145 From ph10 Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
19146 From ph10 Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
19148 The pattern can be seen by running
19150 exim -bP uucp_from_pattern
19152 It checks only up to the hours and minutes, and allows for a 2-digit or 4-digit
19153 year in the second case. The first word after &"From&~"& is matched in the
19154 regular expression by a parenthesized subpattern. The default value for
19155 &%uucp_from_sender%& is &"$1"&, which therefore just uses this first word
19156 (&"ph10"& in the example above) as the message's sender. See also
19157 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%&.
19160 .option uucp_from_sender main string&!! &`$1`&
19161 See &%uucp_from_pattern%& above.
19164 .option warn_message_file main string&!! unset
19165 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
19166 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
19167 This option defines a template file containing paragraphs of text to be used
19168 for constructing the warning message which is sent by Exim when a message has
19169 been in the queue for a specified amount of time, as specified by
19170 &%delay_warning%&. Details of the file's contents are given in chapter
19171 &<<CHAPemsgcust>>&.
19172 .cindex warn_message_file "tainted data"
19173 The option is expanded to give the file path, which must be
19174 absolute and untainted.
19175 See also &%bounce_message_file%&.
19178 .option wellknown_advertise_hosts main boolean unset
19179 .cindex WELLKNOWN advertisement
19180 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" WELLKNOWN
19181 This option enables the advertising of the SMTP WELLKNOWN extension.
19182 See also the &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& ACL (&<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>&).
19184 .option write_rejectlog main boolean true
19185 .cindex "reject log" "disabling"
19186 If this option is set false, Exim no longer writes anything to the reject log.
19187 See chapter &<<CHAPlog>>& for details of what Exim writes to its logs.
19188 .ecindex IIDconfima
19189 .ecindex IIDmaiconf
19194 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19195 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
19197 .chapter "Generic options for routers" "CHAProutergeneric"
19198 .scindex IIDgenoprou1 "options" "generic; for routers"
19199 .scindex IIDgenoprou2 "generic options" "router"
19200 This chapter describes the generic options that apply to all routers.
19201 Those that are preconditions are marked with ‡ in the &"use"& field.
19203 For a general description of how a router operates, see sections
19204 &<<SECTrunindrou>>& and &<<SECTrouprecon>>&. The latter specifies the order in
19205 which the preconditions are tested. The order of expansion of the options that
19206 provide data for a transport is: &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&,
19207 &%headers_remove%&, &%transport%&.
19209 The name of a router is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
19210 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
19214 .option address_data routers string&!! unset
19215 .cindex "router" "data attached to address"
19216 The string is expanded just before the router is run, that is, after all the
19217 precondition tests have succeeded. If the expansion is forced to fail, the
19218 router declines, the value of &%address_data%& remains unchanged, and the
19219 &%more%& option controls what happens next. Other expansion failures cause
19220 delivery of the address to be deferred.
19222 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19223 When the expansion succeeds, the value is retained with the address, and can be
19224 accessed using the variable &$address_data$& in the current router, subsequent
19225 routers, and the eventual transport.
19227 &*Warning*&: If the current or any subsequent router is a &(redirect)& router
19228 that runs a user's filter file, the contents of &$address_data$& are accessible
19229 in the filter. This is not normally a problem, because such data is usually
19230 either not confidential or it &"belongs"& to the current user, but if you do
19231 put confidential data into &$address_data$& you need to remember this point.
19233 Even if the router declines or passes, the value of &$address_data$& remains
19234 with the address, though it can be changed by another &%address_data%& setting
19235 on a subsequent router. If a router generates child addresses, the value of
19236 &$address_data$& propagates to them. This also applies to the special kind of
19237 &"child"& that is generated by a router with the &%unseen%& option.
19239 The idea of &%address_data%& is that you can use it to look up a lot of data
19240 for the address once, and then pick out parts of the data later. For example,
19241 you could use a single LDAP lookup to return a string of the form
19243 uid=1234 gid=5678 mailbox=/mail/xyz forward=/home/xyz/.forward
19245 In the transport you could pick out the mailbox by a setting such as
19247 file = ${extract{mailbox}{$address_data}}
19249 This makes the configuration file less messy, and also reduces the number of
19250 lookups (though Exim does cache lookups).
19252 See also the &%set%& option below.
19254 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
19255 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19256 The &%address_data%& facility is also useful as a means of passing information
19257 from one router to another, and from a router to a transport. In addition, if
19258 &$address_data$& is set by a router when verifying a recipient address from an
19259 ACL, it remains available for use in the rest of the ACL statement. After
19260 verifying a sender, the value is transferred to &$sender_address_data$&.
19264 .option address_test routers&!? boolean true
19266 .cindex "router" "skipping when address testing"
19267 If this option is set false, the router is skipped when routing is being tested
19268 by means of the &%-bt%& command line option. This can be a convenience when
19269 your first router sends messages to an external scanner, because it saves you
19270 having to set the &"already scanned"& indicator when testing real address
19275 .option cannot_route_message routers string&!! unset
19276 .cindex "router" "customizing &""cannot route""& message"
19277 .cindex "customizing" "&""cannot route""& message"
19278 This option specifies a text message that is used when an address cannot be
19279 routed because Exim has run out of routers. The default message is
19280 &"Unrouteable address"&. This option is useful only on routers that have
19281 &%more%& set false, or on the very last router in a configuration, because the
19282 value that is used is taken from the last router that is considered. This
19283 includes a router that is skipped because its preconditions are not met, as
19284 well as a router that declines. For example, using the default configuration,
19287 cannot_route_message = Remote domain not found in DNS
19289 on the first router, which is a &(dnslookup)& router with &%more%& set false,
19292 cannot_route_message = Unknown local user
19294 on the final router that checks for local users. If string expansion fails for
19295 this option, the default message is used. Unless the expansion failure was
19296 explicitly forced, a message about the failure is written to the main and panic
19297 logs, in addition to the normal message about the routing failure.
19300 .option caseful_local_part routers boolean false
19301 .cindex "case of local parts"
19302 .cindex "router" "case of local parts"
19303 By default, routers handle the local parts of addresses in a case-insensitive
19304 manner, though the actual case is preserved for transmission with the message.
19305 If you want the case of letters to be significant in a router, you must set
19306 this option true. For individual router options that contain address or local
19307 part lists (for example, &%local_parts%&), case-sensitive matching can be
19308 turned on by &"+caseful"& as a list item. See section &<<SECTcasletadd>>& for
19311 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19312 .vindex "&$original_local_part$&"
19313 .vindex "&$parent_local_part$&"
19314 The value of the &$local_part$& variable is forced to lower case while a
19315 router is running unless &%caseful_local_part%& is set. When a router assigns
19316 an address to a transport, the value of &$local_part$& when the transport runs
19317 is the same as it was in the router. Similarly, when a router generates child
19318 addresses by aliasing or forwarding, the values of &$original_local_part$&
19319 and &$parent_local_part$& are those that were used by the redirecting router.
19321 This option applies to the processing of an address by a router. When a
19322 recipient address is being processed in an ACL, there is a separate &%control%&
19323 modifier that can be used to specify case-sensitive processing within the ACL
19324 (see section &<<SECTcontrols>>&).
19328 .option check_local_user routers&!? boolean false
19329 .cindex "local user, checking in router"
19330 .cindex "router" "checking for local user"
19331 .cindex "&_/etc/passwd_&"
19333 When this option is true, Exim checks that the local part of the recipient
19334 address (with affixes removed if relevant) is the name of an account on the
19335 local system. The check is done by calling the &[getpwnam()]& function rather
19336 than trying to read &_/etc/passwd_& directly. This means that other methods of
19337 holding password data (such as NIS) are supported. If the local part is a local
19339 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
19340 .cindex "de-tainting" "using router check_local_user option"
19341 &$local_part_data$& is set to an untainted version of the local part and
19342 &$home$& is set from the password data. The latter can be tested in other
19343 preconditions that are evaluated after this one (the order of evaluation is
19344 given in section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). However, the value of &$home$& can be
19345 overridden by &%router_home_directory%&. If the local part is not a local user,
19346 the router is skipped.
19348 If you want to check that the local part is either the name of a local user
19349 or matches something else, you cannot combine &%check_local_user%& with a
19350 setting of &%local_parts%&, because that specifies the logical &'and'& of the
19351 two conditions. However, you can use a &(passwd)& lookup in a &%local_parts%&
19352 setting to achieve this. For example:
19354 local_parts = passwd;$local_part : lsearch;/etc/other/users
19356 Note, however, that the side effects of &%check_local_user%& (such as setting
19357 up a home directory) do not occur when a &(passwd)& lookup is used in a
19358 &%local_parts%& (or any other) precondition.
19362 .option condition routers&!? string&!! unset
19363 .cindex "router" "customized precondition"
19364 This option specifies a general precondition test that has to succeed for the
19365 router to be called. The &%condition%& option is the last precondition to be
19366 evaluated (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). The string is expanded, and if the
19367 result is a forced failure, or an empty string, or one of the strings &"0"& or
19368 &"no"& or &"false"& (checked without regard to the case of the letters), the
19369 router is skipped, and the address is offered to the next one.
19371 If the result is any other value, the router is run (as this is the last
19372 precondition to be evaluated, all the other preconditions must be true).
19374 This option is unusual in that multiple &%condition%& options may be present.
19375 All &%condition%& options must succeed.
19377 The &%condition%& option provides a means of applying custom conditions to the
19378 running of routers. Note that in the case of a simple conditional expansion,
19379 the default expansion values are exactly what is wanted. For example:
19381 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19383 Because of the default behaviour of the string expansion, this is equivalent to
19385 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}{true}{}}
19388 A multiple condition example, which succeeds:
19390 condition = ${if >{$message_age}{600}}
19391 condition = ${if !eq{${lc:$local_part}}{postmaster}}
19395 If the expansion fails (other than forced failure) delivery is deferred. Some
19396 of the other precondition options are common special cases that could in fact
19397 be specified using &%condition%&.
19399 Historical note: We have &%condition%& on ACLs and on Routers. Routers
19400 are far older, and use one set of semantics. ACLs are newer and when
19401 they were created, the ACL &%condition%& process was given far stricter
19402 parse semantics. The &%bool{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19403 ACLs. The &%bool_lax{}%& expansion condition uses the same rules as
19404 Routers. More pointedly, the &%bool_lax{}%& was written to match the existing
19405 Router rules processing behavior.
19407 This is best illustrated in an example:
19409 # If used in an ACL condition will fail with a syntax error, but
19410 # in a router condition any extra characters are treated as a string
19412 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:GOOGLE.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19415 $ exim -be '${if eq {${lc:WHOIS.com}} {google.com}} {yes} {no}}'
19418 In each example above, the &%if%& statement actually ends after
19419 &"{google.com}}"&. Since no true or false braces were defined, the
19420 default &%if%& behavior is to return a boolean true or a null answer
19421 (which evaluates to false). The rest of the line is then treated as a
19422 string. So the first example resulted in the boolean answer &"true"&
19423 with the string &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it. The second example
19424 resulted in the null output (indicating false) with the string
19425 &" {yes} {no}}"& appended to it.
19427 In fact you can put excess forward braces in too. In the router
19428 &%condition%&, Exim's parser only looks for &"{"& symbols when they
19429 mean something, like after a &"$"& or when required as part of a
19430 conditional. But otherwise &"{"& and &"}"& are treated as ordinary
19433 Thus, in a Router, the above expansion strings will both always evaluate
19434 true, as the result of expansion is a non-empty string which doesn't
19435 match an explicit false value. This can be tricky to debug. By
19436 contrast, in an ACL either of those strings will always result in an
19437 expansion error because the result doesn't look sufficiently boolean.
19440 .option debug_print routers string&!! unset
19441 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
19442 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
19443 option) or in address-testing mode (see the &%-bt%& command line option),
19444 the string is expanded and included in the debugging output.
19445 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
19446 output, and Exim carries on processing.
19447 This option is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
19448 so on when debugging router configurations. For example, if a &%condition%&
19449 option appears not to be working, &%debug_print%& can be used to output the
19450 variables it references. The output happens after checks for &%domains%&,
19451 &%local_parts%&, and &%check_local_user%& but before any other preconditions
19452 are tested. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with one.
19453 The variable &$router_name$& contains the name of the router.
19457 .option disable_logging routers boolean false
19458 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any routing errors
19459 or for any deliveries caused by this router. You should not set this option
19460 unless you really, really know what you are doing. See also the generic
19461 transport option of the same name.
19463 .option dnssec_request_domains routers "domain list&!!" *
19464 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19465 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19466 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19467 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19468 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
19469 the DNSSEC request bit set.
19470 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19472 .option dnssec_require_domains routers "domain list&!!" unset
19473 .cindex "MX record" "security"
19474 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
19475 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
19476 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
19477 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
19478 the DNSSEC request bit set. Any returns not having the Authenticated Data bit
19479 (AD bit) set will be ignored and logged as a host-lookup failure.
19480 This applies to all of the SRV, MX, AAAA, A lookup sequence.
19483 .option domains routers&!? "domain list&!!" unset
19484 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific domains"
19485 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
19486 If this option is set,
19487 the argument is first expanded to give a list.
19488 The router is skipped unless the current domain matches the list.
19489 The data returned by the list check
19490 is placed in &$domain_data$& for use in string
19491 expansions of the driver's private options and in the transport.
19492 If the result of expansion is empty or a forced-fail,
19493 the router is skipped.
19495 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for
19496 a list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.
19498 A complex example, using a file like:
19504 and checking both domain and local_part
19506 domains = ${domain:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19507 local_parts = ${local_part:${lookup {$local_part@$domain} lseach,ret=key {/path/to/accountsfile}}}
19512 .option driver routers string unset
19513 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available routers is
19517 .option dsn_lasthop routers boolean false
19518 .cindex "DSN" "success"
19519 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
19520 If this option is set true, and extended DSN
19521 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461)) processing is in effect,
19522 Exim will not pass on DSN requests to downstream DSN-aware hosts but will
19523 instead send a success DSN as if the next hop does not support DSN.
19524 Not effective on redirect routers.
19528 .option errors_to routers string&!! unset
19529 .cindex "envelope from"
19530 .cindex "envelope sender"
19531 .cindex "router" "changing address for errors"
19532 If a router successfully handles an address, it may assign the address to a
19533 transport for delivery or it may generate child addresses. In both cases, if
19534 there is a delivery problem during later processing, the resulting bounce
19535 message is sent to the address that results from expanding this string,
19536 provided that the address verifies successfully. The &%errors_to%& option is
19537 expanded before &%headers_add%&, &%headers_remove%&, and &%transport%&.
19539 The &%errors_to%& setting associated with an address can be overridden if it
19540 subsequently passes through other routers that have their own &%errors_to%&
19541 settings, or if the message is delivered by a transport with a &%return_path%&
19544 If &%errors_to%& is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the result of
19545 the expansion fails to verify, the errors address associated with the incoming
19546 address is used. At top level, this is the envelope sender. A non-forced
19547 expansion failure causes delivery to be deferred.
19549 If an address for which &%errors_to%& has been set ends up being delivered over
19550 SMTP, the envelope sender for that delivery is the &%errors_to%& value, so that
19551 any bounces that are generated by other MTAs on the delivery route are also
19552 sent there. You can set &%errors_to%& to the empty string by either of these
19558 An expansion item that yields an empty string has the same effect. If you do
19559 this, a locally detected delivery error for addresses processed by this router
19560 no longer gives rise to a bounce message; the error is discarded. If the
19561 address is delivered to a remote host, the return path is set to &`<>`&, unless
19562 overridden by the &%return_path%& option on the transport.
19564 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
19565 If for some reason you want to discard local errors, but use a non-empty
19566 MAIL command for remote delivery, you can preserve the original return
19567 path in &$address_data$& in the router, and reinstate it in the transport by
19568 setting &%return_path%&.
19570 The most common use of &%errors_to%& is to direct mailing list bounces to the
19571 manager of the list, as described in section &<<SECTmailinglists>>&, or to
19572 implement VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) (see section &<<SECTverp>>&).
19576 .option expn routers&!? boolean true
19577 .cindex "address" "testing"
19578 .cindex "testing" "addresses"
19579 .cindex "EXPN" "router skipping"
19580 .cindex "router" "skipping for EXPN"
19581 If this option is turned off, the router is skipped when testing an address
19582 as a result of processing an SMTP EXPN command. You might, for example,
19583 want to turn it off on a router for users' &_.forward_& files, while leaving it
19584 on for the system alias file.
19585 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19588 The use of the SMTP EXPN command is controlled by an ACL (see chapter
19589 &<<CHAPACL>>&). When Exim is running an EXPN command, it is similar to testing
19590 an address with &%-bt%&. Compare VRFY, whose counterpart is &%-bv%&.
19594 .option fail_verify routers boolean false
19595 .cindex "router" "forcing verification failure"
19596 Setting this option has the effect of setting both &%fail_verify_sender%& and
19597 &%fail_verify_recipient%& to the same value.
19601 .option fail_verify_recipient routers boolean false
19602 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19603 verifying a recipient, verification fails.
19607 .option fail_verify_sender routers boolean false
19608 If this option is true and an address is accepted by this router when
19609 verifying a sender, verification fails.
19613 .option fallback_hosts routers "string list" unset
19614 .cindex "router" "fallback hosts"
19615 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on router"
19616 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
19617 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses. The list separator can be
19618 changed (see section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&), and a port can be specified with
19619 each name or address. In fact, the format of each item is exactly the same as
19620 defined for the list of hosts in a &(manualroute)& router (see section
19621 &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&).
19623 If a router queues an address for a remote transport, this host list is
19624 associated with the address, and used instead of the transport's fallback host
19625 list. If &%hosts_randomize%& is set on the transport, the order of the list is
19626 randomized for each use. See the &%fallback_hosts%& option of the &(smtp)&
19627 transport for further details.
19630 .option group routers string&!! "see below"
19631 .cindex "gid (group id)" "local delivery"
19632 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19633 .cindex "transport" "local"
19634 .cindex "router" "setting group"
19635 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
19636 specify a group, the group given here is used when running the delivery
19638 The group may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
19639 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
19640 The default is unset, unless &%check_local_user%& is set, when the default
19641 is taken from the password information. See also &%initgroups%& and &%user%&
19642 and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19646 .option headers_add routers list&!! unset
19647 .cindex "header lines" "adding"
19648 .cindex "router" "adding header lines"
19649 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19650 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19651 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19652 Each item is separately expanded, at routing time. However, this
19653 option has no effect when an address is just being verified. The way in which
19654 the text is used to add header lines at transport time is described in section
19655 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. New header lines are not actually added until the
19656 message is in the process of being transported. This means that references to
19657 header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration do not
19658 &"see"& the added header lines.
19660 The &%headers_add%& option is expanded after &%errors_to%&, but before
19661 &%headers_remove%& and &%transport%&. If an item is empty, or if
19662 an item expansion is forced to fail, the item has no effect. Other expansion
19663 failures are treated as configuration errors.
19665 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
19666 for a router; all listed headers are added.
19668 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_add%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19669 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19671 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
19672 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
19673 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19674 additions are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent routers.
19675 For a &%redirect%& router, if a generated address is the same as the incoming
19676 address, this can lead to duplicate addresses with different header
19677 modifications. Exim does not do duplicate deliveries (except, in certain
19678 circumstances, to pipes -- see section &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined
19679 which of the duplicates is discarded, so this ambiguous situation should be
19680 avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the &%redirect%& router may be of help.
19684 .option headers_remove routers list&!! unset
19685 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
19686 .cindex "router" "removing header lines"
19687 This option specifies a list of text headers,
19688 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
19689 that is associated with any addresses that are accepted by the router.
19690 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
19691 Each list item is separately expanded, at transport time.
19692 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
19694 the text is used to remove header lines at transport time is described in
19695 section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header lines are not actually removed until
19696 the message is in the process of being transported. This means that references
19697 to header lines in string expansions in the transport's configuration still
19698 &"see"& the original header lines.
19700 The &%headers_remove%& option is handled after &%errors_to%& and
19701 &%headers_add%&, but before &%transport%&. If an item expansion is forced to fail,
19702 the item has no effect. Other expansion failures are treated as configuration
19705 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
19706 for a router; all listed headers are removed.
19708 &*Warning 1*&: The &%headers_remove%& option cannot be used for a &(redirect)&
19709 router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
19711 &*Warning 2*&: If the &%unseen%& option is set on the router, all header
19712 removal requests are deleted when the address is passed on to subsequent
19713 routers, and this can lead to problems with duplicates -- see the similar
19714 warning for &%headers_add%& above.
19716 &*Warning 3*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
19717 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
19718 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19722 .option ignore_target_hosts routers "host list&!!" unset
19723 .cindex "IP address" "discarding"
19724 .cindex "router" "discarding IP addresses"
19725 Although this option is a host list, it should normally contain IP address
19726 entries rather than names. If any host that is looked up by the router has an
19727 IP address that matches an item in this list, Exim behaves as if that IP
19728 address did not exist. This option allows you to cope with rogue DNS entries
19731 remote.domain.example. A 127.0.0.1
19735 ignore_target_hosts = 127.0.0.1
19737 on the relevant router. If all the hosts found by a &(dnslookup)& router are
19738 discarded in this way, the router declines. In a conventional configuration, an
19739 attempt to mail to such a domain would normally provoke the &"unrouteable
19740 domain"& error, and an attempt to verify an address in the domain would fail.
19741 Similarly, if &%ignore_target_hosts%& is set on an &(ipliteral)& router, the
19742 router declines if presented with one of the listed addresses.
19744 You can use this option to disable the use of IPv4 or IPv6 for mail delivery by
19745 means of the first or the second of the following settings, respectively:
19747 ignore_target_hosts = 0.0.0.0/0
19748 ignore_target_hosts = <; 0::0/0
19750 The pattern in the first line matches all IPv4 addresses, whereas the pattern
19751 in the second line matches all IPv6 addresses.
19753 This option may also be useful for ignoring link-local and site-local IPv6
19754 addresses. Because, like all host lists, the value of &%ignore_target_hosts%&
19755 is expanded before use as a list, it is possible to make it dependent on the
19756 domain that is being routed.
19758 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
19759 During its expansion, &$host_address$& is set to the IP address that is being
19762 .option initgroups routers boolean false
19763 .cindex "additional groups"
19764 .cindex "groups" "additional"
19765 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
19766 .cindex "transport" "local"
19767 If the router queues an address for a transport, and this option is true, and
19768 the uid supplied by the router is not overridden by the transport, the
19769 &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport to ensure that
19770 any additional groups associated with the uid are set up. See also &%group%&
19771 and &%user%& and the discussion in chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
19775 .option local_part_prefix routers&!? "string list" unset
19776 .cindex affix "router precondition"
19777 .cindex "router" "prefix for local part"
19778 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, used in router"
19779 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the local part starts with
19780 one of the given strings, or &%local_part_prefix_optional%& is true. See
19781 section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions are
19784 The list is scanned from left to right, and the first prefix that matches is
19785 used. A limited form of wildcard is available; if the prefix begins with an
19786 asterisk, it matches the longest possible sequence of arbitrary characters at
19787 the start of the local part. An asterisk should therefore always be followed by
19788 some character that does not occur in normal local parts.
19789 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
19790 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
19791 Wildcarding can be used to set up multiple user mailboxes, as described in
19792 section &<<SECTmulbox>>&.
19794 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
19795 .vindex "&$local_part_prefix$&"
19796 During the testing of the &%local_parts%& option, and while the router is
19797 running, the prefix is removed from the local part, and is available in the
19798 expansion variable &$local_part_prefix$&. When a message is being delivered, if
19799 the router accepts the address, this remains true during subsequent delivery by
19800 a transport. In particular, the local part that is transmitted in the RCPT
19801 command for LMTP, SMTP, and BSMTP deliveries has the prefix removed by default.
19802 This behaviour can be overridden by setting &%rcpt_include_affixes%& true on
19803 the relevant transport.
19805 .vindex &$local_part_prefix_v$&
19806 If wildcarding (above) was used then the part of the prefix matching the
19807 wildcard is available in &$local_part_prefix_v$&.
19809 When an address is being verified, &%local_part_prefix%& affects only the
19810 behaviour of the router. If the callout feature of verification is in use, this
19811 means that the full address, including the prefix, will be used during the
19814 The prefix facility is commonly used to handle local parts of the form
19815 &%owner-something%&. Another common use is to support local parts of the form
19816 &%real-username%& to bypass a user's &_.forward_& file &-- helpful when trying
19817 to tell a user their forwarding is broken &-- by placing a router like this one
19818 immediately before the router that handles &_.forward_& files:
19822 local_part_prefix = real-
19824 transport = local_delivery
19826 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
19827 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
19829 condition = ${if match_ip {$sender_host_address} \
19830 {<; ; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1}}
19833 If both &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& are set for a router,
19834 both conditions must be met if not optional. Care must be taken if wildcards
19835 are used in both a prefix and a suffix on the same router. Different
19836 separator characters must be used to avoid ambiguity.
19839 .option local_part_prefix_optional routers boolean false
19840 See &%local_part_prefix%& above.
19844 .option local_part_suffix routers&!? "string list" unset
19845 .cindex "router" "suffix for local part"
19846 .cindex "suffix for local part" "used in router"
19847 This option operates in the same way as &%local_part_prefix%&, except that the
19848 local part must end (rather than start) with the given string, the
19849 &%local_part_suffix_optional%& option determines whether the suffix is
19850 mandatory, and the wildcard * character, if present, must be the last
19851 character of the suffix. This option facility is commonly used to handle local
19852 parts of the form &%something-request%& and multiple user mailboxes of the form
19856 .option local_part_suffix_optional routers boolean false
19857 See &%local_part_suffix%& above.
19861 .option local_parts routers&!? "local part list&!!" unset
19862 .cindex "router" "restricting to specific local parts"
19863 .cindex "local part" "checking in router"
19864 If this option is set, the argument is first expanded to give a list.
19865 The router is run only if the local part of the address matches the list.
19866 If the result of expansion is empty or a forced-fail,
19867 the router is skipped.
19869 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
19871 section &<<SECTlocparlis>>& for a discussion of local part lists. Because the
19872 string is expanded, it is possible to make it depend on the domain, for
19875 local_parts = dbm;/usr/local/specials/$domain_data
19877 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
19878 The data returned by the list check
19879 for the local part is placed in the variable &$local_part_data$& for use in
19880 expansions of the router's private options or in the transport.
19881 You might use this option, for
19882 example, if you have a large number of local virtual domains, and you want to
19883 send all postmaster mail to the same place without having to set up an alias in
19884 each virtual domain:
19888 local_parts = postmaster
19889 data = postmaster@real.domain.example
19893 .option log_as_local routers boolean "see below"
19894 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
19895 .cindex "delivery" "log line format"
19896 Exim has two logging styles for delivery, the idea being to make local
19897 deliveries stand out more visibly from remote ones. In the &"local"& style, the
19898 recipient address is given just as the local part, without a domain. The use of
19899 this style is controlled by this option. It defaults to true for the &(accept)&
19900 router, and false for all the others. This option applies only when a
19901 router assigns an address to a transport. It has no effect on routers that
19902 redirect addresses.
19906 .option more routers boolean&!! true
19907 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
19908 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
19909 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
19910 fail, the default value for the option (true) is used. Other failures cause
19911 delivery to be deferred.
19913 If this option is set false, and the router declines to handle the address, no
19914 further routers are tried, routing fails, and the address is bounced.
19916 However, if the router explicitly passes an address to the following router by
19917 means of the setting
19921 or otherwise, the setting of &%more%& is ignored. Also, the setting of &%more%&
19922 does not affect the behaviour if one of the precondition tests fails. In that
19923 case, the address is always passed to the next router.
19925 Note that &%address_data%& is not considered to be a precondition. If its
19926 expansion is forced to fail, the router declines, and the value of &%more%&
19927 controls what happens next.
19930 .option pass_on_timeout routers boolean false
19931 .cindex "timeout" "of router"
19932 .cindex "router" "timeout"
19933 If a router times out during a host lookup, it normally causes deferral of the
19934 address. If &%pass_on_timeout%& is set, the address is passed on to the next
19935 router, overriding &%no_more%&. This may be helpful for systems that are
19936 intermittently connected to the Internet, or those that want to pass to a smart
19937 host any messages that cannot immediately be delivered.
19939 There are occasional other temporary errors that can occur while doing DNS
19940 lookups. They are treated in the same way as a timeout, and this option
19941 applies to all of them.
19945 .option pass_router routers string unset
19946 .cindex "router" "go to after &""pass""&"
19947 Routers that recognize the generic &%self%& option (&(dnslookup)&,
19948 &(ipliteral)&, and &(manualroute)&) are able to return &"pass"&, forcing
19949 routing to continue, and overriding a false setting of &%more%&. When one of
19950 these routers returns &"pass"&, the address is normally handed on to the next
19951 router in sequence. This can be changed by setting &%pass_router%& to the name
19952 of another router. However (unlike &%redirect_router%&) the named router must
19953 be below the current router, to avoid loops. Note that this option applies only
19954 to the special case of &"pass"&. It does not apply when a router returns
19955 &"decline"& because it cannot handle an address.
19959 .option redirect_router routers string unset
19960 .cindex "router" "start at after redirection"
19961 Sometimes an administrator knows that it is pointless to reprocess addresses
19962 generated from alias or forward files with the same router again. For
19963 example, if an alias file translates real names into login ids there is no
19964 point searching the alias file a second time, especially if it is a large file.
19966 The &%redirect_router%& option can be set to the name of any router instance.
19967 It causes the routing of any generated addresses to start at the named router
19968 instead of at the first router. This option has no effect if the router in
19969 which it is set does not generate new addresses.
19973 .option require_files routers&!? "string list&!!" unset
19974 .cindex "file" "requiring for router"
19975 .cindex "router" "requiring file existence"
19976 This option provides a general mechanism for predicating the running of a
19977 router on the existence or non-existence of certain files or directories.
19978 Before running a router, as one of its precondition tests, Exim works its way
19979 through the &%require_files%& list, expanding each item separately.
19981 Because the list is split before expansion, any colons in expansion items must
19982 be doubled, or the facility for using a different list separator must be used
19983 (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
19984 If any expansion is forced to fail, the item is ignored. Other expansion
19985 failures cause routing of the address to be deferred.
19987 If any expanded string is empty, it is ignored. Otherwise, except as described
19988 below, each string must be a fully qualified file path, optionally preceded by
19989 &"!"&. The paths are passed to the &[stat()]& function to test for the
19990 existence of the files or directories. The router is skipped if any paths not
19991 preceded by &"!"& do not exist, or if any paths preceded by &"!"& do exist.
19994 If &[stat()]& cannot determine whether a file exists or not, delivery of
19995 the message is deferred. This can happen when NFS-mounted filesystems are
19998 This option is checked after the &%domains%&, &%local_parts%&, and &%senders%&
19999 options, so you cannot use it to check for the existence of a file in which to
20000 look up a domain, local part, or sender. (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a
20001 full list of the order in which preconditions are evaluated.) However, as
20002 these options are all expanded, you can use the &%exists%& expansion condition
20003 to make such tests. The &%require_files%& option is intended for checking files
20004 that the router may be going to use internally, or which are needed by a
20005 transport (e.g., &_.procmailrc_&).
20007 During delivery, the &[stat()]& function is run as root, but there is a
20008 facility for some checking of the accessibility of a file by another user.
20009 This is not a proper permissions check, but just a &"rough"& check that
20010 operates as follows:
20012 If an item in a &%require_files%& list does not contain any forward slash
20013 characters, it is taken to be the user (and optional group, separated by a
20014 comma) to be checked for subsequent files in the list. If no group is specified
20015 but the user is specified symbolically, the gid associated with the uid is
20018 require_files = mail:/some/file
20019 require_files = $local_part_data:$home/.procmailrc
20021 If a user or group name in a &%require_files%& list does not exist, the
20022 &%require_files%& condition fails.
20024 Exim performs the check by scanning along the components of the file path, and
20025 checking the access for the given uid and gid. It checks for &"x"& access on
20026 directories, and &"r"& access on the final file. Note that this means that file
20027 access control lists, if the operating system has them, are ignored.
20029 &*Warning 1*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an
20030 incoming SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. This
20031 may affect the result of a &%require_files%& check. In particular, &[stat()]&
20032 may yield the error EACCES (&"Permission denied"&). This means that the Exim
20033 user is not permitted to read one of the directories on the file's path.
20035 &*Warning 2*&: Even when Exim is running as root while delivering a message,
20036 &[stat()]& can yield EACCES for a file in an NFS directory that is mounted
20037 without root access. In this case, if a check for access by a particular user
20038 is requested, Exim creates a subprocess that runs as that user, and tries the
20039 check again in that process.
20041 The default action for handling an unresolved EACCES is to consider it to
20042 be caused by a configuration error, and routing is deferred because the
20043 existence or non-existence of the file cannot be determined. However, in some
20044 circumstances it may be desirable to treat this condition as if the file did
20045 not exist. If the filename (or the exclamation mark that precedes the filename
20046 for non-existence) is preceded by a plus sign, the EACCES error is treated
20047 as if the file did not exist. For example:
20049 require_files = +/some/file
20051 If the router is not an essential part of verification (for example, it
20052 handles users' &_.forward_& files), another solution is to set the &%verify%&
20053 option false so that the router is skipped when verifying.
20057 .option retry_use_local_part routers boolean "see below"
20058 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
20059 .cindex "local part" "in retry keys"
20060 When a delivery suffers a temporary routing failure, a retry record is created
20061 in Exim's hints database. For addresses whose routing depends only on the
20062 domain, the key for the retry record should not involve the local part, but for
20063 other addresses, both the domain and the local part should be included.
20064 Usually, remote routing is of the former kind, and local routing is of the
20067 This option controls whether the local part is used to form the key for retry
20068 hints for addresses that suffer temporary errors while being handled by this
20069 router. The default value is true for any router that has any of
20070 &%check_local_user%&,
20073 &%local_part_prefix%&,
20074 &%local_part_suffix%&,
20077 set, and false otherwise. Note that this option does not apply to hints keys
20078 for transport delays; they are controlled by a generic transport option of the
20081 Failing to set this option when it is needed
20082 (because a remote router handles only some of the local-parts for a domain)
20083 can result in incorrect error messages being generated.
20085 The setting of &%retry_use_local_part%& applies only to the router on which it
20086 appears. If the router generates child addresses, they are routed
20087 independently; this setting does not become attached to them.
20091 .option router_home_directory routers string&!! unset
20092 .cindex "router" "home directory for"
20093 .cindex "home directory" "for router"
20095 This option sets a home directory for use while the router is running. (Compare
20096 &%transport_home_directory%&, which sets a home directory for later
20097 transporting.) In particular, if used on a &(redirect)& router, this option
20098 sets a value for &$home$& while a filter is running. The value is expanded;
20099 forced expansion failure causes the option to be ignored &-- other failures
20100 cause the router to defer.
20102 Expansion of &%router_home_directory%& happens immediately after the
20103 &%check_local_user%& test (if configured), before any further expansions take
20105 (See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20107 While the router is running, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the value of
20108 &$home$& that came from &%check_local_user%&.
20110 When a router accepts an address and assigns it to a local transport (including
20111 the cases when a &(redirect)& router generates a pipe, file, or autoreply
20112 delivery), the home directory setting for the transport is taken from the first
20113 of these values that is set:
20116 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
20118 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
20120 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
20122 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
20125 In other words, &%router_home_directory%& overrides the password data for the
20126 router, but not for the transport.
20130 .option self routers string freeze
20131 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
20132 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
20133 This option applies to those routers that use a recipient address to find a
20134 list of remote hosts. Currently, these are the &(dnslookup)&, &(ipliteral)&,
20135 and &(manualroute)& routers.
20136 Certain configurations of the &(queryprogram)& router can also specify a list
20138 Usually such routers are configured to send the message to a remote host via an
20139 &(smtp)& transport. The &%self%& option specifies what happens when the first
20140 host on the list turns out to be the local host.
20141 The way in which Exim checks for the local host is described in section
20142 &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
20144 Normally this situation indicates either an error in Exim's configuration (for
20145 example, the router should be configured not to process this domain), or an
20146 error in the DNS (for example, the MX should not point to this host). For this
20147 reason, the default action is to log the incident, defer the address, and
20148 freeze the message. The following alternatives are provided for use in special
20153 Delivery of the message is tried again later, but the message is not frozen.
20155 .vitem "&%reroute%&: <&'domain'&>"
20156 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to
20157 be reprocessed by the routers. No rewriting of headers takes place. This
20158 behaviour is essentially a redirection.
20160 .vitem "&%reroute: rewrite:%& <&'domain'&>"
20161 The domain is changed to the given domain, and the address is passed back to be
20162 reprocessed by the routers. Any headers that contain the original domain are
20167 .vindex "&$self_hostname$&"
20168 The router passes the address to the next router, or to the router named in the
20169 &%pass_router%& option if it is set. This overrides &%no_more%&. During
20170 subsequent routing and delivery, the variable &$self_hostname$& contains the
20171 name of the local host that the router encountered. This can be used to
20172 distinguish between different cases for hosts with multiple names. The
20178 ensures that only those addresses that routed to the local host are passed on.
20179 Without &%no_more%&, addresses that were declined for other reasons would also
20180 be passed to the next router.
20183 Delivery fails and an error report is generated.
20186 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
20187 The anomaly is ignored and the address is queued for the transport. This
20188 setting should be used with extreme caution. For an &(smtp)& transport, it
20189 makes sense only in cases where the program that is listening on the SMTP port
20190 is not this version of Exim. That is, it must be some other MTA, or Exim with a
20191 different configuration file that handles the domain in another way.
20196 .option senders routers&!? "address list&!!" unset
20197 .cindex "router" "checking senders"
20198 If this option is set, the router is skipped unless the message's sender
20199 address matches something on the list.
20200 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20203 There are issues concerning verification when the running of routers is
20204 dependent on the sender. When Exim is verifying the address in an &%errors_to%&
20205 setting, it sets the sender to the null string. When using the &%-bt%& option
20206 to check a configuration file, it is necessary also to use the &%-f%& option to
20207 set an appropriate sender. For incoming mail, the sender is unset when
20208 verifying the sender, but is available when verifying any recipients. If the
20209 SMTP VRFY command is enabled, it must be used after MAIL if the sender address
20213 .option set routers "string list" unset
20214 .cindex router variables
20215 This option may be used multiple times on a router;
20216 because of this the list aspect is mostly irrelevant.
20217 The list separator is a semicolon but can be changed in the
20220 Each list-element given must be of the form &"name = value"&
20221 and the names used must start with the string &"r_"&.
20222 Values containing a list-separator should have them doubled.
20223 When a router runs, the strings are evaluated in order,
20224 to create variables which are added to the set associated with
20226 This is done immediately after all the preconditions, before the
20227 evaluation of the &%address_data%& option.
20228 The variable is set with the expansion of the value.
20229 The variables can be used by the router options
20230 (not including any preconditions)
20231 and by the transport.
20232 Later definitions of a given named variable will override former ones.
20233 Variable use is via the usual &$r_...$& syntax.
20235 This is similar to the &%address_data%& option, except that
20236 many independent variables can be used, with choice of naming.
20239 .option translate_ip_address routers string&!! unset
20240 .cindex "IP address" "translating"
20241 .cindex "packet radio"
20242 .cindex "router" "IP address translation"
20243 There exist some rare networking situations (for example, packet radio) where
20244 it is helpful to be able to translate IP addresses generated by normal routing
20245 mechanisms into other IP addresses, thus performing a kind of manual IP
20246 routing. This should be done only if the normal IP routing of the TCP/IP stack
20247 is inadequate or broken. Because this is an extremely uncommon requirement, the
20248 code to support this option is not included in the Exim binary unless
20249 SUPPORT_TRANSLATE_IP_ADDRESS=yes is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
20251 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
20252 The &%translate_ip_address%& string is expanded for every IP address generated
20253 by the router, with the generated address set in &$host_address$&. If the
20254 expansion is forced to fail, no action is taken.
20255 For any other expansion error, delivery of the message is deferred.
20256 If the result of the expansion is an IP address, that replaces the original
20257 address; otherwise the result is assumed to be a host name &-- this is looked
20258 up using &[gethostbyname()]& (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available) to
20259 produce one or more replacement IP addresses. For example, to subvert all IP
20260 addresses in some specific networks, this could be added to a router:
20262 translate_ip_address = \
20263 ${lookup{${mask:$host_address/26}}lsearch{/some/file}\
20266 The file would contain lines like
20268 10.2.3.128/26 some.host
20269 10.8.4.34/26 10.44.8.15
20271 You should not make use of this facility unless you really understand what you
20276 .option transport routers string&!! unset
20277 This option specifies the transport to be used when a router accepts an address
20278 and sets it up for delivery. A transport is never needed if a router is used
20279 only for verification. The value of the option is expanded at routing time,
20280 after the expansion of &%errors_to%&, &%headers_add%&, and &%headers_remove%&,
20281 and result must be the name of one of the configured transports. If it is not,
20282 delivery is deferred.
20284 The &%transport%& option is not used by the &(redirect)& router, but it does
20285 have some private options that set up transports for pipe and file deliveries
20286 (see chapter &<<CHAPredirect>>&).
20290 .option transport_current_directory routers string&!! unset
20291 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
20292 This option associates a current directory with any address that is routed
20293 to a local transport. This can happen either because a transport is
20294 explicitly configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a
20295 file or a pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), this
20296 option string is expanded and is set as the current directory, unless
20297 overridden by a setting on the transport.
20298 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20299 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20300 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for details of the local delivery
20306 .option transport_home_directory routers string&!! "see below"
20307 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
20308 This option associates a home directory with any address that is routed to a
20309 local transport. This can happen either because a transport is explicitly
20310 configured for the router, or because it generates a delivery to a file or a
20311 pipe. During the delivery process (that is, at transport time), the option
20312 string is expanded and is set as the home directory, unless overridden by a
20313 setting of &%home_directory%& on the transport.
20314 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
20315 logged, and delivery is deferred.
20317 If the transport does not specify a home directory, and
20318 &%transport_home_directory%& is not set for the router, the home directory for
20319 the transport is taken from the password data if &%check_local_user%& is set for
20320 the router. Otherwise it is taken from &%router_home_directory%& if that option
20321 is set; if not, no home directory is set for the transport.
20323 See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for further details of the local delivery
20329 .option unseen routers boolean&!! false
20330 .cindex "router" "carrying on after success"
20331 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value,
20332 that is, one of the strings &"yes"&, &"no"&, &"true"&, or &"false"&. Any other
20333 result causes an error, and delivery is deferred. If the expansion is forced to
20334 fail, the default value for the option (false) is used. Other failures cause
20335 delivery to be deferred.
20337 When this option is set true, routing does not cease if the router accepts the
20338 address. Instead, a copy of the incoming address is passed to the next router,
20339 overriding a false setting of &%more%&. There is little point in setting
20340 &%more%& false if &%unseen%& is always true, but it may be useful in cases when
20341 the value of &%unseen%& contains expansion items (and therefore, presumably, is
20342 sometimes true and sometimes false).
20344 .cindex "copy of message (&%unseen%& option)"
20345 Setting the &%unseen%& option has a similar effect to the &%unseen%& command
20346 qualifier in filter files. It can be used to cause copies of messages to be
20347 delivered to some other destination, while also carrying out a normal delivery.
20348 In effect, the current address is made into a &"parent"& that has two children
20349 &-- one that is delivered as specified by this router, and a clone that goes on
20350 to be routed further. For this reason, &%unseen%& may not be combined with the
20351 &%one_time%& option in a &(redirect)& router.
20353 &*Warning*&: Header lines added to the address (or specified for removal) by
20354 this router or by previous routers affect the &"unseen"& copy of the message
20355 only. The clone that continues to be processed by further routers starts with
20356 no added headers and none specified for removal. For a &%redirect%& router, if
20357 a generated address is the same as the incoming address, this can lead to
20358 duplicate addresses with different header modifications. Exim does not do
20359 duplicate deliveries (except, in certain circumstances, to pipes -- see section
20360 &<<SECTdupaddr>>&), but it is undefined which of the duplicates is discarded,
20361 so this ambiguous situation should be avoided. The &%repeat_use%& option of the
20362 &%redirect%& router may be of help.
20364 Unlike the handling of header modifications, any data that was set by the
20365 &%address_data%& option in the current or previous routers &'is'& passed on to
20366 subsequent routers.
20369 .option user routers string&!! "see below"
20370 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
20371 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
20372 .cindex "transport" "local"
20373 .cindex "router" "user for filter processing"
20374 .cindex "filter" "user for processing"
20375 When a router queues an address for a transport, and the transport does not
20376 specify a user, the user given here is used when running the delivery process.
20377 The user may be specified numerically or by name. If expansion fails, the
20378 error is logged and delivery is deferred.
20379 This user is also used by the &(redirect)& router when running a filter file.
20380 The default is unset, except when &%check_local_user%& is set. In this case,
20381 the default is taken from the password information. If the user is specified as
20382 a name, and &%group%& is not set, the group associated with the user is used.
20383 See also &%initgroups%& and &%group%& and the discussion in chapter
20384 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&.
20388 .option verify routers&!? boolean true
20389 Setting this option has the effect of setting &%verify_sender%& and
20390 &%verify_recipient%& to the same value.
20393 .option verify_only routers&!? boolean false
20394 .cindex "EXPN" "with &%verify_only%&"
20396 .cindex "router" "used only when verifying"
20397 If this option is set, the router is used only when verifying an address,
20398 delivering in cutthrough mode or
20399 testing with the &%-bv%& option, not when actually doing a delivery, testing
20400 with the &%-bt%& option, or running the SMTP EXPN command. It can be further
20401 restricted to verifying only senders or recipients by means of
20402 &%verify_sender%& and &%verify_recipient%&.
20404 &*Warning*&: When the router is being run to verify addresses for an incoming
20405 SMTP message, Exim is not running as root, but under its own uid. If the router
20406 accesses any files, you need to make sure that they are accessible to the Exim
20410 .option verify_recipient routers&!? boolean true
20411 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying recipient
20413 delivering in cutthrough mode
20414 or testing recipient verification using &%-bv%&.
20415 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20417 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20420 .option verify_sender routers&!? boolean true
20421 If this option is false, the router is skipped when verifying sender addresses
20422 or testing sender verification using &%-bvs%&.
20423 See section &<<SECTrouprecon>>& for a list of the order in which preconditions
20425 See also the &$verify_mode$& variable.
20426 .ecindex IIDgenoprou1
20427 .ecindex IIDgenoprou2
20434 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20435 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20437 .chapter "The accept router" "CHID4"
20438 .cindex "&(accept)& router"
20439 .cindex "routers" "&(accept)&"
20440 The &(accept)& router has no private options of its own. Unless it is being
20441 used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to
20442 be defined by the generic &%transport%& option. If the preconditions that are
20443 specified by generic options are met, the router accepts the address and queues
20444 it for the given transport. The most common use of this router is for setting
20445 up deliveries to local mailboxes. For example:
20449 domains = mydomain.example
20451 transport = local_delivery
20453 The &%domains%& condition in this example checks the domain of the address, and
20454 &%check_local_user%& checks that the local part is the login of a local user.
20455 When both preconditions are met, the &(accept)& router runs, and queues the
20456 address for the &(local_delivery)& transport.
20463 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20464 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20466 .chapter "The dnslookup router" "CHAPdnslookup"
20467 .scindex IIDdnsrou1 "&(dnslookup)& router"
20468 .scindex IIDdnsrou2 "routers" "&(dnslookup)&"
20469 The &(dnslookup)& router looks up the hosts that handle mail for the
20470 recipient's domain in the DNS. A transport must always be set for this router,
20471 unless &%verify_only%& is set.
20473 If SRV support is configured (see &%check_srv%& below), Exim first searches for
20474 SRV records. If none are found, or if SRV support is not configured,
20475 MX records are looked up. If no MX records exist, address records are sought.
20476 However, &%mx_domains%& can be set to disable the direct use of address
20479 MX records of equal priority are sorted by Exim into a random order. Exim then
20480 looks for address records for the host names obtained from MX or SRV records.
20481 When a host has more than one IP address, they are sorted into a random order,
20482 except that IPv6 addresses are sorted before IPv4 addresses. If all the
20483 IP addresses found are discarded by a setting of the &%ignore_target_hosts%&
20484 generic option, the router declines.
20486 Unless they have the highest priority (lowest MX value), MX records that point
20487 to the local host, or to any host name that matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&,
20488 are discarded, together with any other MX records of equal or lower priority.
20490 .cindex "MX record" "pointing to local host"
20491 .cindex "local host" "MX pointing to"
20492 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(dnslookup)& router"
20493 If the host pointed to by the highest priority MX record, or looked up as an
20494 address record, is the local host, or matches &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, what
20495 happens is controlled by the generic &%self%& option.
20498 .section "Problems with DNS lookups" "SECTprowitdnsloo"
20499 There have been problems with DNS servers when SRV records are looked up.
20500 Some misbehaving servers return a DNS error or timeout when a non-existent
20501 SRV record is sought. Similar problems have in the past been reported for
20502 MX records. The global &%dns_again_means_nonexist%& option can help with this
20503 problem, but it is heavy-handed because it is a global option.
20505 For this reason, there are two options, &%srv_fail_domains%& and
20506 &%mx_fail_domains%&, that control what happens when a DNS lookup in a
20507 &(dnslookup)& router results in a DNS failure or a &"try again"& response. If
20508 an attempt to look up an SRV or MX record causes one of these results, and the
20509 domain matches the relevant list, Exim behaves as if the DNS had responded &"no
20510 such record"&. In the case of an SRV lookup, this means that the router
20511 proceeds to look for MX records; in the case of an MX lookup, it proceeds to
20512 look for A or AAAA records, unless the domain matches &%mx_domains%&, in which
20513 case routing fails.
20516 .section "Declining addresses by dnslookup" "SECTdnslookupdecline"
20517 .cindex "&(dnslookup)& router" "declines"
20518 There are a few cases where a &(dnslookup)& router will decline to accept
20519 an address; if such a router is expected to handle "all remaining non-local
20520 domains", then it is important to set &%no_more%&.
20522 The router will defer rather than decline if the domain
20523 is found in the &%fail_defer_domains%& router option.
20525 Reasons for a &(dnslookup)& router to decline currently include:
20527 The domain does not exist in DNS
20529 The domain exists but the MX record's host part is just "."; this is a common
20530 convention (borrowed from SRV) used to indicate that there is no such service
20531 for this domain and to not fall back to trying A/AAAA records.
20533 Ditto, but for SRV records, when &%check_srv%& is set on this router.
20535 MX record points to a non-existent host.
20537 MX record points to an IP address and the main section option
20538 &%allow_mx_to_ip%& is not set.
20540 MX records exist and point to valid hosts, but all hosts resolve only to
20541 addresses blocked by the &%ignore_target_hosts%& generic option on this router.
20543 The domain is not syntactically valid (see also &%allow_utf8_domains%& and
20544 &%dns_check_names_pattern%& for handling one variant of this)
20546 &%check_secondary_mx%& is set on this router but the local host can
20547 not be found in the MX records (see below)
20553 .section "Private options for dnslookup" "SECID118"
20554 .cindex "options" "&(dnslookup)& router"
20555 The private options for the &(dnslookup)& router are as follows:
20557 .option check_secondary_mx dnslookup boolean false
20558 .cindex "MX record" "checking for secondary"
20559 If this option is set, the router declines unless the local host is found in
20560 (and removed from) the list of hosts obtained by MX lookup. This can be used to
20561 process domains for which the local host is a secondary mail exchanger
20562 differently to other domains. The way in which Exim decides whether a host is
20563 the local host is described in section &<<SECTreclocipadd>>&.
20566 .option check_srv dnslookup string&!! unset
20567 .cindex "SRV record" "enabling use of"
20568 The &(dnslookup)& router supports the use of SRV records
20569 (see &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2782,RFC 2782))
20570 in addition to MX and address records. The support is disabled by default. To
20571 enable SRV support, set the &%check_srv%& option to the name of the service
20572 required. For example,
20576 looks for SRV records that refer to the normal smtp service. The option is
20577 expanded, so the service name can vary from message to message or address
20578 to address. This might be helpful if SRV records are being used for a
20579 submission service. If the expansion is forced to fail, the &%check_srv%&
20580 option is ignored, and the router proceeds to look for MX records in the
20583 When the expansion succeeds, the router searches first for SRV records for
20584 the given service (it assumes TCP protocol). A single SRV record with a
20585 host name that consists of just a single dot indicates &"no such service for
20586 this domain"&; if this is encountered, the router declines. If other kinds of
20587 SRV record are found, they are used to construct a host list for delivery
20588 according to the rules of RFC 2782. MX records are not sought in this case.
20590 When no SRV records are found, MX records (and address records) are sought in
20591 the traditional way. In other words, SRV records take precedence over MX
20592 records, just as MX records take precedence over address records. Note that
20593 this behaviour is not sanctioned by RFC 2782, though a previous draft RFC
20594 defined it. It is apparently believed that MX records are sufficient for email
20595 and that SRV records should not be used for this purpose. However, SRV records
20596 have an additional &"weight"& feature which some people might find useful when
20597 trying to split an SMTP load between hosts of different power.
20599 See section &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& above for a discussion of Exim's behaviour
20600 when there is a DNS lookup error.
20605 .option fail_defer_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20606 .cindex "MX record" "not found"
20607 DNS lookups for domains matching &%fail_defer_domains%&
20608 which find no matching record will cause the router to defer
20609 rather than the default behaviour of decline.
20610 This maybe be useful for queueing messages for a newly created
20611 domain while the DNS configuration is not ready.
20612 However, it will result in any message with mistyped domains
20616 .option ipv4_only "string&!!" unset
20617 .cindex IPv6 disabling
20618 .cindex DNS "IPv6 disabling"
20619 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20620 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20621 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20622 only A records are used.
20624 .option ipv4_prefer "string&!!" unset
20625 .cindex IPv4 preference
20626 .cindex DNS "IPv4 preference"
20627 The string is expanded, and if the result is anything but a forced failure,
20628 or an empty string, or one of the strings “0” or “no” or “false”
20629 (checked without regard to the case of the letters),
20630 A records are sorted before AAAA records (inverting the default).
20632 .option mx_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20633 .cindex "MX record" "required to exist"
20634 .cindex "SRV record" "required to exist"
20635 A domain that matches &%mx_domains%& is required to have either an MX or an SRV
20636 record in order to be recognized. (The name of this option could be improved.)
20637 For example, if all the mail hosts in &'fict.example'& are known to have MX
20638 records, except for those in &'discworld.fict.example'&, you could use this
20641 mx_domains = ! *.discworld.fict.example : *.fict.example
20643 This specifies that messages addressed to a domain that matches the list but
20644 has no MX record should be bounced immediately instead of being routed using
20645 the address record.
20648 .option mx_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20649 If the DNS lookup for MX records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20650 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no MX records were found. See section
20651 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20656 .option qualify_single dnslookup boolean true
20657 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20658 .cindex "DNS" "qualifying single-component names"
20659 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DEFNAMES is set for DNS
20660 lookups. Typically, but not standardly, this causes the resolver to qualify
20661 single-component names with the default domain. For example, on a machine
20662 called &'dictionary.ref.example'&, the domain &'thesaurus'& would be changed to
20663 &'thesaurus.ref.example'& inside the resolver. For details of what your
20664 resolver actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and
20669 .option rewrite_headers dnslookup boolean true
20670 .cindex "rewriting" "header lines"
20671 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting"
20672 If the domain name in the address that is being processed is not fully
20673 qualified, it may be expanded to its full form by a DNS lookup. For example, if
20674 an address is specified as &'dormouse@teaparty'&, the domain might be
20675 expanded to &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. Domain expansion can also
20676 occur as a result of setting the &%widen_domains%& option. If
20677 &%rewrite_headers%& is true, all occurrences of the abbreviated domain name in
20678 any &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-to:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&
20679 header lines of the message are rewritten with the full domain name.
20681 This option should be turned off only when it is known that no message is
20682 ever going to be sent outside an environment where the abbreviation makes
20685 When an MX record is looked up in the DNS and matches a wildcard record, name
20686 servers normally return a record containing the name that has been looked up,
20687 making it impossible to detect whether a wildcard was present or not. However,
20688 some name servers have recently been seen to return the wildcard entry. If the
20689 name returned by a DNS lookup begins with an asterisk, it is not used for
20693 .option same_domain_copy_routing dnslookup boolean false
20694 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
20695 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(dnslookup)& router
20696 to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the router
20697 options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
20698 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
20699 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
20700 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
20702 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
20703 domain, and you are using a &(dnslookup)& router which is independent of the
20704 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
20705 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when &(dnslookup)&
20706 routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted addresses in the
20707 message that have the same domain are automatically given the same routing
20708 without processing them independently,
20709 provided the following conditions are met:
20712 No router that processed the address specified &%headers_add%& or
20713 &%headers_remove%&.
20715 The router did not change the address in any way, for example, by &"widening"&
20722 .option search_parents dnslookup boolean false
20723 .cindex "DNS" "resolver options"
20724 When this option is true, the resolver option RES_DNSRCH is set for DNS
20725 lookups. This is different from the &%qualify_single%& option in that it
20726 applies to domains containing dots. Typically, but not standardly, it causes
20727 the resolver to search for the name in the current domain and in parent
20728 domains. For example, on a machine in the &'fict.example'& domain, if looking
20729 up &'teaparty.wonderland'& failed, the resolver would try
20730 &'teaparty.wonderland.fict.example'&. For details of what your resolver
20731 actually does, consult your man pages for &'resolver'& and &'resolv.conf'&.
20733 Setting this option true can cause problems in domains that have a wildcard MX
20734 record, because any domain that does not have its own MX record matches the
20739 .option srv_fail_domains dnslookup "domain list&!!" unset
20740 If the DNS lookup for SRV records for one of the domains in this list causes a
20741 DNS lookup error, Exim behaves as if no SRV records were found. See section
20742 &<<SECTprowitdnsloo>>& for more discussion.
20747 .option widen_domains dnslookup "string list" unset
20748 .cindex "domain" "partial; widening"
20749 If a DNS lookup fails and this option is set, each of its strings in turn is
20750 added onto the end of the domain, and the lookup is tried again. For example,
20753 widen_domains = fict.example:ref.example
20755 is set and a lookup of &'klingon.dictionary'& fails,
20756 &'klingon.dictionary.fict.example'& is looked up, and if this fails,
20757 &'klingon.dictionary.ref.example'& is tried. Note that the &%qualify_single%&
20758 and &%search_parents%& options can cause some widening to be undertaken inside
20759 the DNS resolver. &%widen_domains%& is not applied to sender addresses
20760 when verifying, unless &%rewrite_headers%& is false (not the default).
20763 .section "Effect of qualify_single and search_parents" "SECID119"
20764 When a domain from an envelope recipient is changed by the resolver as a result
20765 of the &%qualify_single%& or &%search_parents%& options, Exim rewrites the
20766 corresponding address in the message's header lines unless &%rewrite_headers%&
20767 is set false. Exim then re-routes the address, using the full domain.
20769 These two options affect only the DNS lookup that takes place inside the router
20770 for the domain of the address that is being routed. They do not affect lookups
20771 such as that implied by
20775 that may happen while processing a router precondition before the router is
20776 entered. No widening ever takes place for these lookups.
20777 .ecindex IIDdnsrou1
20778 .ecindex IIDdnsrou2
20788 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20789 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20791 .chapter "The ipliteral router" "CHID5"
20792 .cindex "&(ipliteral)& router"
20793 .cindex "domain literal" "routing"
20794 .cindex "routers" "&(ipliteral)&"
20795 This router has no private options. Unless it is being used purely for
20796 verification (see &%verify_only%&) a transport is required to be defined by the
20797 generic &%transport%& option. The router accepts the address if its domain part
20798 takes the form of an
20799 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
20800 domain literal. For example, the &(ipliteral)&
20801 router handles the address
20805 by setting up delivery to the host with that IP address. IPv4 domain literals
20806 consist of an IPv4 address enclosed in square brackets. IPv6 domain literals
20807 are similar, but the address is preceded by &`ipv6:`&. For example:
20809 postmaster@[ipv6:fe80::a00:20ff:fe86:a061.5678]
20811 Exim allows &`ipv4:`& before IPv4 addresses, for consistency, and on the
20812 grounds that sooner or later somebody will try it.
20814 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(ipliteral)& router"
20815 If the IP address matches something in &%ignore_target_hosts%&, the router
20816 declines. If an IP literal turns out to refer to the local host, the generic
20817 &%self%& option determines what happens.
20819 The RFCs require support for domain literals; however, their use is
20820 controversial in today's Internet. If you want to use this router, you must
20821 also set the main configuration option &%allow_domain_literals%&. Otherwise,
20822 Exim will not recognize the domain literal syntax in addresses.
20826 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20827 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20829 .chapter "The iplookup router" "CHID6"
20830 .cindex "&(iplookup)& router"
20831 .cindex "routers" "&(iplookup)&"
20832 The &(iplookup)& router was written to fulfil a specific requirement in
20833 Cambridge University (which in fact no longer exists). For this reason, it is
20834 not included in the binary of Exim by default. If you want to include it, you
20837 ROUTER_IPLOOKUP=yes
20839 in your &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file.
20841 The &(iplookup)& router routes an address by sending it over a TCP or UDP
20842 connection to one or more specific hosts. The host can then return the same or
20843 a different address &-- in effect rewriting the recipient address in the
20844 message's envelope. The new address is then passed on to subsequent routers. If
20845 this process fails, the address can be passed on to other routers, or delivery
20846 can be deferred. Since &(iplookup)& is just a rewriting router, a transport
20847 must not be specified for it.
20849 .cindex "options" "&(iplookup)& router"
20850 .option hosts iplookup string unset
20851 This option must be supplied. Its value is a colon-separated list of host
20852 names. The hosts are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
20853 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
20854 and are tried in order until one responds to the query. If none respond, what
20855 happens is controlled by &%optional%&.
20858 .option optional iplookup boolean false
20859 If &%optional%& is true, if no response is obtained from any host, the address
20860 is passed to the next router, overriding &%no_more%&. If &%optional%& is false,
20861 delivery to the address is deferred.
20864 .option port iplookup integer 0
20865 .cindex "port" "&(iplookup)& router"
20866 This option must be supplied. It specifies the port number for the TCP or UDP
20870 .option protocol iplookup string udp
20871 This option can be set to &"udp"& or &"tcp"& to specify which of the two
20872 protocols is to be used.
20875 .option query iplookup string&!! "see below"
20876 This defines the content of the query that is sent to the remote hosts. The
20879 $local_part@$domain $local_part@$domain
20881 The repetition serves as a way of checking that a response is to the correct
20882 query in the default case (see &%response_pattern%& below).
20885 .option reroute iplookup string&!! unset
20886 If this option is not set, the rerouted address is precisely the byte string
20887 returned by the remote host, up to the first white space, if any. If set, the
20888 string is expanded to form the rerouted address. It can include parts matched
20889 in the response by &%response_pattern%& by means of numeric variables such as
20890 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. The variable &$0$& refers to the entire input string,
20891 whether or not a pattern is in use. In all cases, the rerouted address must end
20892 up in the form &'local_part@domain'&.
20895 .option response_pattern iplookup string unset
20896 This option can be set to a regular expression that is applied to the string
20897 returned from the remote host. If the pattern does not match the response, the
20898 router declines. If &%response_pattern%& is not set, no checking of the
20899 response is done, unless the query was defaulted, in which case there is a
20900 check that the text returned after the first white space is the original
20901 address. This checks that the answer that has been received is in response to
20902 the correct question. For example, if the response is just a new domain, the
20903 following could be used:
20905 response_pattern = ^([^@]+)$
20906 reroute = $local_part@$1
20909 .option timeout iplookup time 5s
20910 This specifies the amount of time to wait for a response from the remote
20911 machine. The same timeout is used for the &[connect()]& function for a TCP
20912 call. It does not apply to UDP.
20917 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20918 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
20920 .chapter "The manualroute router" "CHID7"
20921 .scindex IIDmanrou1 "&(manualroute)& router"
20922 .scindex IIDmanrou2 "routers" "&(manualroute)&"
20923 .cindex "domain" "manually routing"
20924 The &(manualroute)& router is so-called because it provides a way of manually
20925 routing an address according to its domain. It is mainly used when you want to
20926 route addresses to remote hosts according to your own rules, bypassing the
20927 normal DNS routing that looks up MX records. However, &(manualroute)& can also
20928 route to local transports, a facility that may be useful if you want to save
20929 messages for dial-in hosts in local files.
20931 The &(manualroute)& router compares a list of domain patterns with the domain
20932 it is trying to route. If there is no match, the router declines. Each pattern
20933 has associated with it a list of hosts and some other optional data, which may
20934 include a transport. The combination of a pattern and its data is called a
20935 &"routing rule"&. For patterns that do not have an associated transport, the
20936 generic &%transport%& option must specify a transport, unless the router is
20937 being used purely for verification (see &%verify_only%&).
20940 In the case of verification, matching the domain pattern is sufficient for the
20941 router to accept the address. When actually routing an address for delivery,
20942 an address that matches a domain pattern is queued for the associated
20943 transport. If the transport is not a local one, a host list must be associated
20944 with the pattern; IP addresses are looked up for the hosts, and these are
20945 passed to the transport along with the mail address. For local transports, a
20946 host list is optional. If it is present, it is passed in &$host$& as a single
20949 The list of routing rules can be provided as an inline string in
20950 &%route_list%&, or the data can be obtained by looking up the domain in a file
20951 or database by setting &%route_data%&. Only one of these settings may appear in
20952 any one instance of &(manualroute)&. The format of routing rules is described
20953 below, following the list of private options.
20956 .section "Private options for manualroute" "SECTprioptman"
20958 .cindex "options" "&(manualroute)& router"
20959 The private options for the &(manualroute)& router are as follows:
20961 .option host_all_ignored manualroute string defer
20962 See &%host_find_failed%&.
20964 .option host_find_failed manualroute string freeze
20965 This option controls what happens when &(manualroute)& tries to find an IP
20966 address for a host, and the host does not exist. The option can be set to one
20967 of the following values:
20976 The default (&"freeze"&) assumes that this state is a serious configuration
20977 error. The difference between &"pass"& and &"decline"& is that the former
20978 forces the address to be passed to the next router (or the router defined by
20981 overriding &%no_more%&, whereas the latter passes the address to the next
20982 router only if &%more%& is true.
20984 The value &"ignore"& causes Exim to completely ignore a host whose IP address
20985 cannot be found. If all the hosts in the list are ignored, the behaviour is
20986 controlled by the &%host_all_ignored%& option. This takes the same values
20987 as &%host_find_failed%&, except that it cannot be set to &"ignore"&.
20989 The &%host_find_failed%& option applies only to a definite &"does not exist"&
20990 state; if a host lookup gets a temporary error, delivery is deferred unless the
20991 generic &%pass_on_timeout%& option is set.
20994 .option hosts_randomize manualroute boolean false
20995 .cindex "randomized host list"
20996 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
20997 If this option is set, the order of the items in a host list in a routing rule
20998 is randomized each time the list is used, unless an option in the routing rule
20999 overrides (see below). Randomizing the order of a host list can be used to do
21000 crude load sharing. However, if more than one mail address is routed by the
21001 same router to the same host list, the host lists are considered to be the same
21002 (even though they may be randomized into different orders) for the purpose of
21003 deciding whether to batch the deliveries into a single SMTP transaction.
21005 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split
21006 into groups whose order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to
21007 set up MX-like behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an
21008 item that is just &`+`& in the host list. For example:
21010 route_list = * host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
21012 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
21013 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
21014 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored. If a
21015 randomized host list is passed to an &(smtp)& transport that also has
21016 &%hosts_randomize set%&, the list is not re-randomized.
21019 .option route_data manualroute string&!! unset
21020 If this option is set, it must expand to yield the data part of a routing rule.
21021 Typically, the expansion string includes a lookup based on the domain. For
21024 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/etc/routes}}
21026 If the expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string, the
21027 router declines. Other kinds of expansion failure cause delivery to be
21031 .option route_list manualroute "string list" unset
21032 This string is a list of routing rules, in the form defined below. Note that,
21033 unlike most string lists, the items are separated by semicolons. This is so
21034 that they may contain colon-separated host lists.
21037 .option same_domain_copy_routing manualroute boolean false
21038 .cindex "address" "copying routing"
21039 Addresses with the same domain are normally routed by the &(manualroute)&
21040 router to the same list of hosts. However, this cannot be presumed, because the
21041 router options and preconditions may refer to the local part of the address. By
21042 default, therefore, Exim routes each address in a message independently. DNS
21043 servers run caches, so repeated DNS lookups are not normally expensive, and in
21044 any case, personal messages rarely have more than a few recipients.
21046 If you are running mailing lists with large numbers of subscribers at the same
21047 domain, and you are using a &(manualroute)& router which is independent of the
21048 local part, you can set &%same_domain_copy_routing%& to bypass repeated DNS
21049 lookups for identical domains in one message. In this case, when
21050 &(manualroute)& routes an address to a remote transport, any other unrouted
21051 addresses in the message that have the same domain are automatically given the
21052 same routing without processing them independently. However, this is only done
21053 if &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& are unset.
21058 .section "Routing rules in route_list" "SECID120"
21059 The value of &%route_list%& is a string consisting of a sequence of routing
21060 rules, separated by semicolons. If a semicolon is needed in a rule, it can be
21061 entered as two semicolons. Alternatively, the list separator can be changed as
21062 described (for colon-separated lists) in section &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&.
21063 Empty rules are ignored. The format of each rule is
21065 <&'domain pattern'&> <&'list of hosts'&> <&'options'&>
21067 The following example contains two rules, each with a simple domain pattern and
21071 dict.ref.example mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example ; \
21072 thes.ref.example mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
21074 The three parts of a rule are separated by white space. The pattern and the
21075 list of hosts can be enclosed in quotes if necessary, and if they are, the
21076 usual quoting rules apply. Each rule in a &%route_list%& must start with a
21077 single domain pattern, which is the only mandatory item in the rule. The
21078 pattern is in the same format as one item in a domain list (see section
21079 &<<SECTdomainlist>>&),
21080 except that it may not be the name of an interpolated file.
21081 That is, it may be wildcarded, or a regular expression, or a file or database
21082 lookup (with semicolons doubled, because of the use of semicolon as a separator
21083 in a &%route_list%&).
21085 The rules in &%route_list%& are searched in order until one of the patterns
21086 matches the domain that is being routed. The list of hosts and then options are
21087 then used as described below. If there is no match, the router declines. When
21088 &%route_list%& is set, &%route_data%& must not be set.
21092 .section "Routing rules in route_data" "SECID121"
21093 The use of &%route_list%& is convenient when there are only a small number of
21094 routing rules. For larger numbers, it is easier to use a file or database to
21095 hold the routing information, and use the &%route_data%& option instead.
21096 The value of &%route_data%& is a list of hosts, followed by (optional) options.
21097 Most commonly, &%route_data%& is set as a string that contains an
21098 expansion lookup. For example, suppose we place two routing rules in a file
21101 dict.ref.example: mail-1.ref.example:mail-2.ref.example
21102 thes.ref.example: mail-3.ref.example:mail-4.ref.example
21104 This data can be accessed by setting
21106 route_data = ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/the/file/name}}
21108 Failure of the lookup results in an empty string, causing the router to
21109 decline. However, you do not have to use a lookup in &%route_data%&. The only
21110 requirement is that the result of expanding the string is a list of hosts,
21111 possibly followed by options, separated by white space. The list of hosts must
21112 be enclosed in quotes if it contains white space.
21117 .section "Format of the list of hosts" "SECID122"
21118 A list of hosts, whether obtained via &%route_data%& or &%route_list%&, is
21119 always separately expanded before use. If the expansion fails, the router
21120 declines. The result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list of names
21121 and/or IP addresses, optionally also including ports.
21122 If the list is written with spaces, it must be protected with quotes.
21123 The format of each item
21124 in the list is described in the next section. The list separator can be changed
21125 as described in section &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&.
21127 If the list of hosts was obtained from a &%route_list%& item, the following
21128 variables are set during its expansion:
21131 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(manualroute)& router"
21132 If the domain was matched against a regular expression, the numeric variables
21133 &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set. For example:
21135 route_list = ^domain(\d+) host-$1.text.example
21138 &$0$& is always set to the entire domain.
21140 &$1$& is also set when partial matching is done in a file lookup.
21143 .vindex "&$value$&"
21144 If the pattern that matched the domain was a lookup item, the data that was
21145 looked up is available in the expansion variable &$value$&. For example:
21147 route_list = lsearch;;/some/file.routes $value
21151 Note the doubling of the semicolon in the pattern that is necessary because
21152 semicolon is the default route list separator.
21156 .section "Format of one host item" "SECTformatonehostitem"
21157 Each item in the list of hosts can be either a host name or an IP address,
21158 optionally with an attached port number, or it can be a single "+"
21159 (see &%hosts_randomize%&).
21160 When no port is given, an IP address
21161 is not enclosed in brackets. When a port is specified, it overrides the port
21162 specification on the transport. The port is separated from the name or address
21163 by a colon. This leads to some complications:
21166 Because colon is the default separator for the list of hosts, either
21167 the colon that specifies a port must be doubled, or the list separator must
21168 be changed. The following two examples have the same effect:
21170 route_list = * "host1.tld::1225 : host2.tld::1226"
21171 route_list = * "<+ host1.tld:1225 + host2.tld:1226"
21174 When IPv6 addresses are involved, it gets worse, because they contain
21175 colons of their own. To make this case easier, it is permitted to
21176 enclose an IP address (either v4 or v6) in square brackets if a port
21177 number follows. For example:
21179 route_list = * "</ [10.1.1.1]:1225 / [::1]:1226"
21183 .section "How the list of hosts is used" "SECThostshowused"
21184 When an address is routed to an &(smtp)& transport by &(manualroute)&, each of
21185 the hosts is tried, in the order specified, when carrying out the SMTP
21186 delivery. However, the order can be changed by setting the &%hosts_randomize%&
21187 option, either on the router (see section &<<SECTprioptman>>& above), or on the
21190 Hosts may be listed by name or by IP address. An unadorned name in the list of
21191 hosts is interpreted as a host name. A name that is followed by &`/MX`& is
21192 interpreted as an indirection to a sublist of hosts obtained by looking up MX
21193 records in the DNS. For example:
21195 route_list = * x.y.z:p.q.r/MX:e.f.g
21197 If this feature is used with a port specifier, the port must come last. For
21200 route_list = * dom1.tld/mx::1225
21202 If the &%hosts_randomize%& option is set, the order of the items in the list is
21203 randomized before any lookups are done. Exim then scans the list; for any name
21204 that is not followed by &`/MX`& it looks up an IP address. If this turns out to
21205 be an interface on the local host and the item is not the first in the list,
21206 Exim discards it and any subsequent items. If it is the first item, what
21207 happens is controlled by the
21208 .oindex "&%self%&" "in &(manualroute)& router"
21209 &%self%& option of the router.
21211 A name on the list that is followed by &`/MX`& is replaced with the list of
21212 hosts obtained by looking up MX records for the name. This is always a DNS
21213 lookup; the &%bydns%& and &%byname%& options (see section &<<SECThowoptused>>&
21214 below) are not relevant here. The order of these hosts is determined by the
21215 preference values in the MX records, according to the usual rules. Because
21216 randomizing happens before the MX lookup, it does not affect the order that is
21217 defined by MX preferences.
21219 If the local host is present in the sublist obtained from MX records, but is
21220 not the most preferred host in that list, it and any equally or less
21221 preferred hosts are removed before the sublist is inserted into the main list.
21223 If the local host is the most preferred host in the MX list, what happens
21224 depends on where in the original list of hosts the &`/MX`& item appears. If it
21225 is not the first item (that is, there are previous hosts in the main list),
21226 Exim discards this name and any subsequent items in the main list.
21228 If the MX item is first in the list of hosts, and the local host is the
21229 most preferred host, what happens is controlled by the &%self%& option of the
21232 DNS failures when lookup up the MX records are treated in the same way as DNS
21233 failures when looking up IP addresses: &%pass_on_timeout%& and
21234 &%host_find_failed%& are used when relevant.
21236 The generic &%ignore_target_hosts%& option applies to all hosts in the list,
21237 whether obtained from an MX lookup or not.
21241 .section "How the options are used" "SECThowoptused"
21242 The options are a sequence of words, space-separated.
21243 One of the words can be the name of a transport; this overrides the
21244 &%transport%& option on the router for this particular routing rule only. The
21245 other words (if present) control randomization of the list of hosts on a
21246 per-rule basis, and how the IP addresses of the hosts are to be found when
21247 routing to a remote transport. These options are as follows:
21250 &%randomize%&: randomize the order of the hosts in this list, overriding the
21251 setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
21253 &%no_randomize%&: do not randomize the order of the hosts in this list,
21254 overriding the setting of &%hosts_randomize%& for this routing rule only.
21256 &%byname%&: use &[getipnodebyname()]& (&[gethostbyname()]& on older systems) to
21257 find IP addresses. This function may ultimately cause a DNS lookup, but it may
21258 also look in &_/etc/hosts_& or other sources of information.
21260 &%bydns%&: look up address records for the hosts directly in the DNS; fail if
21261 no address records are found. If there is a temporary DNS error (such as a
21262 timeout), delivery is deferred.
21264 &%ipv4_only%&: in direct DNS lookups, look up only A records.
21266 &%ipv4_prefer%&: in direct DNS lookups, sort A records before AAAA records.
21271 route_list = domain1 host1:host2:host3 randomize bydns;\
21272 domain2 host4:host5
21274 If neither &%byname%& nor &%bydns%& is given, Exim behaves as follows: First, a
21275 DNS lookup is done. If this yields anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that
21276 result is used. Otherwise, Exim goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]&
21277 or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the result of the lookup is the result of that
21280 &*Warning*&: It has been discovered that on some systems, if a DNS lookup
21281 called via &[getipnodebyname()]& times out, HOST_NOT_FOUND is returned
21282 instead of TRY_AGAIN. That is why the default action is to try a DNS
21283 lookup first. Only if that gives a definite &"no such host"& is the local
21286 &*Compatibility*&: From Exim 4.85 until fixed for 4.90, there was an
21287 inadvertent constraint that a transport name as an option had to be the last
21292 If no IP address for a host can be found, what happens is controlled by the
21293 &%host_find_failed%& option.
21296 When an address is routed to a local transport, IP addresses are not looked up.
21297 The host list is passed to the transport in the &$host$& variable.
21301 .section "Manualroute examples" "SECID123"
21302 In some of the examples that follow, the presence of the &%remote_smtp%&
21303 transport, as defined in the default configuration file, is assumed:
21306 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
21307 The &(manualroute)& router can be used to forward all external mail to a
21308 &'smart host'&. If you have set up, in the main part of the configuration, a
21309 named domain list that contains your local domains, for example:
21311 domainlist local_domains = my.domain.example
21313 You can arrange for all other domains to be routed to a smart host by making
21314 your first router something like this:
21317 driver = manualroute
21318 domains = !+local_domains
21319 transport = remote_smtp
21320 route_list = * smarthost.ref.example
21322 This causes all non-local addresses to be sent to the single host
21323 &'smarthost.ref.example'&. If a colon-separated list of smart hosts is given,
21324 they are tried in order
21325 (but you can use &%hosts_randomize%& to vary the order each time).
21326 Another way of configuring the same thing is this:
21329 driver = manualroute
21330 transport = remote_smtp
21331 route_list = !+local_domains smarthost.ref.example
21333 There is no difference in behaviour between these two routers as they stand.
21334 However, they behave differently if &%no_more%& is added to them. In the first
21335 example, the router is skipped if the domain does not match the &%domains%&
21336 precondition; the following router is always tried. If the router runs, it
21337 always matches the domain and so can never decline. Therefore, &%no_more%&
21338 would have no effect. In the second case, the router is never skipped; it
21339 always runs. However, if it doesn't match the domain, it declines. In this case
21340 &%no_more%& would prevent subsequent routers from running.
21343 .cindex "mail hub example"
21344 A &'mail hub'& is a host which receives mail for a number of domains via MX
21345 records in the DNS and delivers it via its own private routing mechanism. Often
21346 the final destinations are behind a firewall, with the mail hub being the one
21347 machine that can connect to machines both inside and outside the firewall. The
21348 &(manualroute)& router is usually used on a mail hub to route incoming messages
21349 to the correct hosts. For a small number of domains, the routing can be inline,
21350 using the &%route_list%& option, but for a larger number a file or database
21351 lookup is easier to manage.
21353 If the domain names are in fact the names of the machines to which the mail is
21354 to be sent by the mail hub, the configuration can be quite simple. For
21358 driver = manualroute
21359 transport = remote_smtp
21360 route_list = *.rhodes.tvs.example $domain
21362 This configuration routes domains that match &`*.rhodes.tvs.example`& to hosts
21363 whose names are the same as the mail domains. A similar approach can be taken
21364 if the host name can be obtained from the domain name by a string manipulation
21365 that the expansion facilities can handle. Otherwise, a lookup based on the
21366 domain can be used to find the host:
21369 driver = manualroute
21370 transport = remote_smtp
21371 route_data = ${lookup {$domain} cdb {/internal/host/routes}}
21373 The result of the lookup must be the name or IP address of the host (or
21374 hosts) to which the address is to be routed. If the lookup fails, the route
21375 data is empty, causing the router to decline. The address then passes to the
21379 .cindex "batched SMTP output example"
21380 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing; example"
21381 You can use &(manualroute)& to deliver messages to pipes or files in batched
21382 SMTP format for onward transportation by some other means. This is one way of
21383 storing mail for a dial-up host when it is not connected. The route list entry
21384 can be as simple as a single domain name in a configuration like this:
21387 driver = manualroute
21388 transport = batchsmtp_appendfile
21389 route_list = saved.domain.example
21391 though often a pattern is used to pick up more than one domain. If there are
21392 several domains or groups of domains with different transport requirements,
21393 different transports can be listed in the routing information:
21396 driver = manualroute
21398 *.saved.domain1.example $domain batch_appendfile; \
21399 *.saved.domain2.example \
21400 ${lookup{$domain}dbm{/domain2/hosts}{$value}fail} \
21403 .vindex "&$domain$&"
21405 The first of these just passes the domain in the &$host$& variable, which
21406 doesn't achieve much (since it is also in &$domain$&), but the second does a
21407 file lookup to find a value to pass, causing the router to decline to handle
21408 the address if the lookup fails.
21411 .cindex "UUCP" "example of router for"
21412 Routing mail directly to UUCP software is a specific case of the use of
21413 &(manualroute)& in a gateway to another mail environment. This is an example of
21414 one way it can be done:
21420 command = /usr/local/bin/uux -r - \
21421 ${substr_-5:$host}!rmail ${local_part}
21422 return_fail_output = true
21427 driver = manualroute
21429 ${lookup{$domain}lsearch{/usr/local/exim/uucphosts}}
21431 The file &_/usr/local/exim/uucphosts_& contains entries like
21433 darksite.ethereal.example: darksite.UUCP
21435 It can be set up more simply without adding and removing &".UUCP"& but this way
21436 makes clear the distinction between the domain name
21437 &'darksite.ethereal.example'& and the UUCP host name &'darksite'&.
21439 .ecindex IIDmanrou1
21440 .ecindex IIDmanrou2
21449 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21450 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21452 .chapter "The queryprogram router" "CHAPdriverlast"
21453 .scindex IIDquerou1 "&(queryprogram)& router"
21454 .scindex IIDquerou2 "routers" "&(queryprogram)&"
21455 .cindex "routing" "by external program"
21456 The &(queryprogram)& router routes an address by running an external command
21457 and acting on its output. This is an expensive way to route, and is intended
21458 mainly for use in lightly-loaded systems, or for performing experiments.
21459 However, if it is possible to use the precondition options (&%domains%&,
21460 &%local_parts%&, etc) to skip this router for most addresses, it could sensibly
21461 be used in special cases, even on a busy host. There are the following private
21463 .cindex "options" "&(queryprogram)& router"
21465 .option command queryprogram string&!! unset
21466 This option must be set. It specifies the command that is to be run. The
21467 command is split up into a command name and arguments, and then each is
21468 expanded separately (exactly as for a &(pipe)& transport, described in chapter
21469 &<<CHAPpipetransport>>&).
21472 .option command_group queryprogram string unset
21473 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in &(queryprogram)& router"
21474 This option specifies a gid to be set when running the command while routing an
21475 address for deliver. It must be set if &%command_user%& specifies a numerical
21476 uid. If it begins with a digit, it is interpreted as the numerical value of the
21477 gid. Otherwise it is looked up using &[getgrnam()]&.
21480 .option command_user queryprogram string unset
21481 .cindex "uid (user id)" "for &(queryprogram)&"
21482 This option must be set. It specifies the uid which is set when running the
21483 command while routing an address for delivery. If the value begins with a digit,
21484 it is interpreted as the numerical value of the uid. Otherwise, it is looked up
21485 using &[getpwnam()]& to obtain a value for the uid and, if &%command_group%& is
21486 not set, a value for the gid also.
21488 &*Warning:*& Changing uid and gid is possible only when Exim is running as
21489 root, which it does during a normal delivery in a conventional configuration.
21490 However, when an address is being verified during message reception, Exim is
21491 usually running as the Exim user, not as root. If the &(queryprogram)& router
21492 is called from a non-root process, Exim cannot change uid or gid before running
21493 the command. In this circumstance the command runs under the current uid and
21497 .option current_directory queryprogram string /
21498 This option specifies an absolute path which is made the current directory
21499 before running the command.
21502 .option timeout queryprogram time 1h
21503 If the command does not complete within the timeout period, its process group
21504 is killed and the message is frozen. A value of zero time specifies no
21508 The standard output of the command is connected to a pipe, which is read when
21509 the command terminates. It should consist of a single line of output,
21510 containing up to five fields, separated by white space. The maximum length of
21511 the line is 1023 characters. Longer lines are silently truncated. The first
21512 field is one of the following words (case-insensitive):
21515 &'Accept'&: routing succeeded; the remaining fields specify what to do (see
21518 &'Decline'&: the router declines; pass the address to the next router, unless
21519 &%no_more%& is set.
21521 &'Fail'&: routing failed; do not pass the address to any more routers. Any
21522 subsequent text on the line is an error message. If the router is run as part
21523 of address verification during an incoming SMTP message, the message is
21524 included in the SMTP response.
21526 &'Defer'&: routing could not be completed at this time; try again later. Any
21527 subsequent text on the line is an error message which is logged. It is not
21528 included in any SMTP response.
21530 &'Freeze'&: the same as &'defer'&, except that the message is frozen.
21532 &'Pass'&: pass the address to the next router (or the router specified by
21533 &%pass_router%&), overriding &%no_more%&.
21535 &'Redirect'&: the message is redirected. The remainder of the line is a list of
21536 new addresses, which are routed independently, starting with the first router,
21537 or the router specified by &%redirect_router%&, if set.
21540 When the first word is &'accept'&, the remainder of the line consists of a
21541 number of keyed data values, as follows (split into two lines here, to fit on
21544 ACCEPT TRANSPORT=<transport> HOSTS=<list of hosts>
21545 LOOKUP=byname|bydns DATA=<text>
21547 The data items can be given in any order, and all are optional. If no transport
21548 is included, the transport specified by the generic &%transport%& option is
21549 used. The list of hosts and the lookup type are needed only if the transport is
21550 an &(smtp)& transport that does not itself supply a list of hosts.
21552 The format of the list of hosts is the same as for the &(manualroute)& router.
21553 As well as host names and IP addresses with optional port numbers, as described
21554 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&, it may contain names followed by
21555 &`/MX`& to specify sublists of hosts that are obtained by looking up MX records
21556 (see section &<<SECThostshowused>>&).
21558 If the lookup type is not specified, Exim behaves as follows when trying to
21559 find an IP address for each host: First, a DNS lookup is done. If this yields
21560 anything other than HOST_NOT_FOUND, that result is used. Otherwise, Exim
21561 goes on to try a call to &[getipnodebyname()]& or &[gethostbyname()]&, and the
21562 result of the lookup is the result of that call.
21564 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
21565 If the DATA field is set, its value is placed in the &$address_data$&
21566 variable. For example, this return line
21568 accept hosts=x1.y.example:x2.y.example data="rule1"
21570 routes the address to the default transport, passing a list of two hosts. When
21571 the transport runs, the string &"rule1"& is in &$address_data$&.
21572 .ecindex IIDquerou1
21573 .ecindex IIDquerou2
21578 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21579 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
21581 .chapter "The redirect router" "CHAPredirect"
21582 .scindex IIDredrou1 "&(redirect)& router"
21583 .scindex IIDredrou2 "routers" "&(redirect)&"
21584 .cindex "alias file" "in a &(redirect)& router"
21585 .cindex "address redirection" "&(redirect)& router"
21586 The &(redirect)& router handles several kinds of address redirection. Its most
21587 common uses are for resolving local part aliases from a central alias file
21588 (usually called &_/etc/aliases_&) and for handling users' personal &_.forward_&
21589 files, but it has many other potential uses. The incoming address can be
21590 redirected in several different ways:
21593 It can be replaced by one or more new addresses which are themselves routed
21596 It can be routed to be delivered to a given file or directory.
21598 It can be routed to be delivered to a specified pipe command.
21600 It can cause an automatic reply to be generated.
21602 It can be forced to fail, optionally with a custom error message.
21604 It can be temporarily deferred, optionally with a custom message.
21606 It can be discarded.
21609 The generic &%transport%& option must not be set for &(redirect)& routers.
21610 However, there are some private options which define transports for delivery to
21611 files and pipes, and for generating autoreplies. See the &%file_transport%&,
21612 &%pipe_transport%& and &%reply_transport%& descriptions below.
21614 If success DSNs have been requested
21615 .cindex "DSN" "success"
21616 .cindex "Delivery Status Notification" "success"
21617 redirection triggers one and the DSN options are not passed any further.
21621 .section "Redirection data" "SECID124"
21622 The router operates by interpreting a text string which it obtains either by
21623 expanding the contents of the &%data%& option, or by reading the entire
21624 contents of a file whose name is given in the &%file%& option. These two
21625 options are mutually exclusive. The first is commonly used for handling system
21626 aliases, in a configuration like this:
21630 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/aliases}}
21632 If the lookup fails, the expanded string in this example is empty. When the
21633 expansion of &%data%& results in an empty string, the router declines. A forced
21634 expansion failure also causes the router to decline; other expansion failures
21635 cause delivery to be deferred.
21637 A configuration using &%file%& is commonly used for handling users'
21638 &_.forward_& files, like this:
21643 file = $home/.forward
21646 If the file does not exist, or causes no action to be taken (for example, it is
21647 empty or consists only of comments), the router declines. &*Warning*&: This
21648 is not the case when the file contains syntactically valid items that happen to
21649 yield empty addresses, for example, items containing only
21650 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21653 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21654 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21655 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21657 &*Warning*&: It is unwise to use &$local_part$& or &$domain$&
21658 directly for redirection,
21659 as they are provided by a potential attacker.
21660 In the examples above, &$local_part$& is used for looking up data held locally
21661 on the system, and not used directly (the second example derives &$home$& via
21662 the passsword file or database, using &$local_part$&).
21666 .section "Forward files and address verification" "SECID125"
21667 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
21668 It is usual to set &%no_verify%& on &(redirect)& routers which handle users'
21669 &_.forward_& files, as in the example above. There are two reasons for this:
21672 When Exim is receiving an incoming SMTP message from a remote host, it is
21673 running under the Exim uid, not as root. Exim is unable to change uid to read
21674 the file as the user, and it may not be able to read it as the Exim user. So in
21675 practice the router may not be able to operate.
21677 However, even when the router can operate, the existence of a &_.forward_& file
21678 is unimportant when verifying an address. What should be checked is whether the
21679 local part is a valid user name or not. Cutting out the redirection processing
21680 saves some resources.
21688 .section "Interpreting redirection data" "SECID126"
21689 .cindex "Sieve filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21690 .cindex "filter" "specifying in redirection data"
21691 The contents of the data string, whether obtained from &%data%& or &%file%&,
21692 can be interpreted in two different ways:
21695 If the &%allow_filter%& option is set true, and the data begins with the text
21696 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"&, it is interpreted as a list of
21697 &'filtering'& instructions in the form of an Exim or Sieve filter file,
21698 respectively. Details of the syntax and semantics of filter files are described
21699 in a separate document entitled &'Exim's interfaces to mail filtering'&; this
21700 document is intended for use by end users.
21702 Otherwise, the data must be a comma-separated list of redirection items, as
21703 described in the next section.
21706 When a message is redirected to a file (a &"mail folder"&), the filename given
21707 in a non-filter redirection list must always be an absolute path. A filter may
21708 generate a relative path &-- how this is handled depends on the transport's
21709 configuration. See section &<<SECTfildiropt>>& for a discussion of this issue
21710 for the &(appendfile)& transport.
21714 .section "Items in a non-filter redirection list" "SECTitenonfilred"
21715 .cindex "address redirection" "non-filter list items"
21716 When the redirection data is not an Exim or Sieve filter, for example, if it
21717 comes from a conventional alias or forward file, it consists of a list of
21718 addresses, filenames, pipe commands, or certain special items (see section
21719 &<<SECTspecitredli>>& below). The special items can be individually enabled or
21720 disabled by means of options whose names begin with &%allow_%& or &%forbid_%&,
21721 depending on their default values. The items in the list are separated by
21722 commas or newlines.
21723 If a comma is required in an item, the entire item must be enclosed in double
21726 Lines starting with a # character are comments, and are ignored, and # may
21727 also appear following a comma, in which case everything between the # and the
21728 next newline character is ignored.
21730 If an item is entirely enclosed in double quotes, these are removed. Otherwise
21731 double quotes are retained because some forms of mail address require their use
21732 (but never to enclose the entire address). In the following description,
21733 &"item"& refers to what remains after any surrounding double quotes have been
21736 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
21737 &*Warning*&: If you use an Exim expansion to construct a redirection address,
21738 and the expansion contains a reference to &$local_part$&, you should make use
21739 of the &%quote_local_part%& expansion operator, in case the local part contains
21740 special characters. For example, to redirect all mail for the domain
21741 &'obsolete.example'&, retaining the existing local part, you could use this
21744 data = ${quote_local_part:$local_part}@newdomain.example
21748 .section "Redirecting to a local mailbox" "SECTredlocmai"
21749 .cindex "routing" "loops in"
21750 .cindex "loop" "while routing, avoidance of"
21751 .cindex "address redirection" "to local mailbox"
21752 A redirection item may safely be the same as the address currently under
21753 consideration. This does not cause a routing loop, because a router is
21754 automatically skipped if any ancestor of the address that is being processed
21755 is the same as the current address and was processed by the current router.
21756 Such an address is therefore passed to the following routers, so it is handled
21757 as if there were no redirection. When making this loop-avoidance test, the
21758 complete local part, including any prefix or suffix, is used.
21760 .cindex "address redirection" "local part without domain"
21761 Specifying the same local part without a domain is a common usage in personal
21762 filter files when the user wants to have messages delivered to the local
21763 mailbox and also forwarded elsewhere. For example, the user whose login is
21764 &'cleo'& might have a &_.forward_& file containing this:
21766 cleo, cleopatra@egypt.example
21768 .cindex "backslash in alias file"
21769 .cindex "alias file" "backslash in"
21770 For compatibility with other MTAs, such unqualified local parts may be
21771 preceded by &"\"&, but this is not a requirement for loop prevention. However,
21772 it does make a difference if more than one domain is being handled
21775 If an item begins with &"\"& and the rest of the item parses as a valid
21776 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21777 address that does not include a domain, the item is qualified using the
21778 domain of the incoming address. In the absence of a leading &"\"&, unqualified
21779 addresses are qualified using the value in &%qualify_recipient%&, but you can
21780 force the incoming domain to be used by setting &%qualify_preserve_domain%&.
21782 Care must be taken if there are alias names for local users.
21783 Consider an MTA handling a single local domain where the system alias file
21788 Now suppose that Sam (whose login id is &'spqr'&) wants to save copies of
21789 messages in the local mailbox, and also forward copies elsewhere. He creates
21792 Sam.Reman, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21794 With these settings, an incoming message addressed to &'Sam.Reman'& fails. The
21795 &(redirect)& router for system aliases does not process &'Sam.Reman'& the
21796 second time round, because it has previously routed it,
21797 and the following routers presumably cannot handle the alias. The forward file
21798 should really contain
21800 spqr, spqr@reme.elsewhere.example
21802 but because this is such a common error, the &%check_ancestor%& option (see
21803 below) exists to provide a way to get round it. This is normally set on a
21804 &(redirect)& router that is handling users' &_.forward_& files.
21808 .section "Special items in redirection lists" "SECTspecitredli"
21809 In addition to addresses, the following types of item may appear in redirection
21810 lists (that is, in non-filter redirection data):
21813 .cindex "pipe" "in redirection list"
21814 .cindex "address redirection" "to pipe"
21815 An item is treated as a pipe command if it begins with &"|"& and does not parse
21817 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21818 address that includes a domain. A transport for running the
21819 command must be specified by the &%pipe_transport%& option.
21820 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21821 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21823 Single or double quotes can be used for enclosing the individual arguments of
21824 the pipe command; no interpretation of escapes is done for single quotes. If
21825 the command contains a comma character, it is necessary to put the whole item
21826 in double quotes, for example:
21828 "|/some/command ready,steady,go"
21830 since items in redirection lists are terminated by commas. Do not, however,
21831 quote just the command. An item such as
21833 |"/some/command ready,steady,go"
21835 is interpreted as a pipe with a rather strange command name, and no arguments.
21837 Note that the above example assumes that the text comes from a lookup source
21838 of some sort, so that the quotes are part of the data. If composing a
21839 redirect router with a &%data%& option directly specifying this command, the
21840 quotes will be used by the configuration parser to define the extent of one
21841 string, but will not be passed down into the redirect router itself. There
21842 are two main approaches to get around this: escape quotes to be part of the
21843 data itself, or avoid using this mechanism and instead create a custom
21844 transport with the &%command%& option set and reference that transport from
21845 an &%accept%& router.
21848 .cindex "file" "in redirection list"
21849 .cindex "address redirection" "to file"
21850 An item is interpreted as a path name if it begins with &"/"& and does not
21852 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
21853 address that includes a domain. For example,
21855 /home/world/minbari
21857 is treated as a filename, but
21859 /s=molari/o=babylon/@x400gate.way
21861 is treated as an address. For a filename, a transport must be specified using
21862 the &%file_transport%& option. However, if the generated path name ends with a
21863 forward slash character, it is interpreted as a directory name rather than a
21864 filename, and &%directory_transport%& is used instead.
21866 Normally, either the router or the transport specifies a user and a group under
21867 which to run the delivery. The default is to use the Exim user and group.
21869 .cindex "&_/dev/null_&"
21870 However, if a redirection item is the path &_/dev/null_&, delivery to it is
21871 bypassed at a high level, and the log entry shows &"**bypassed**"&
21872 instead of a transport name. In this case the user and group are not used.
21875 .cindex "included address list"
21876 .cindex "address redirection" "included external list"
21877 If an item is of the form
21879 :include:<path name>
21881 a list of further items is taken from the given file and included at that
21882 point. &*Note*&: Such a file can not be a filter file; it is just an
21883 out-of-line addition to the list. The items in the included list are separated
21884 by commas or newlines and are not subject to expansion. If this is the first
21885 item in an alias list in an &(lsearch)& file, a colon must be used to terminate
21886 the alias name. This example is incorrect:
21888 list1 :include:/opt/lists/list1
21890 It must be given as
21892 list1: :include:/opt/lists/list1
21894 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
21895 .cindex redirect "tainted data"
21896 Tainted data may not be used for a filename.
21898 .cindex "address redirection" "to black hole"
21899 .cindex "delivery" "discard"
21900 .cindex "delivery" "blackhole"
21901 .cindex "black hole"
21902 .cindex "abandoning mail"
21903 Sometimes you want to throw away mail to a particular local part. Making the
21904 &%data%& option expand to an empty string does not work, because that causes
21905 the router to decline. Instead, the alias item
21909 can be used. It does what its name implies. No delivery is
21910 done, and no error message is generated. This has the same effect as specifying
21911 &_/dev/null_& as a destination, but it can be independently disabled.
21913 &*Warning*&: If &':blackhole:'& appears anywhere in a redirection list, no
21914 delivery is done for the original local part, even if other redirection items
21915 are present. If you are generating a multi-item list (for example, by reading a
21916 database) and need the ability to provide a no-op item, you must use
21920 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
21921 .cindex "delivery" "forcing deferral"
21922 .cindex "failing delivery" "forcing"
21923 .cindex "deferred delivery, forcing"
21924 .cindex "customizing" "failure message"
21925 An attempt to deliver a particular address can be deferred or forced to fail by
21926 redirection items of the form
21931 respectively. When a redirection list contains such an item, it applies
21932 to the entire redirection; any other items in the list are ignored. Any
21933 text following &':fail:'& or &':defer:'& is placed in the error text
21934 associated with the failure. For example, an alias file might contain:
21936 X.Employee: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
21938 In the case of an address that is being verified from an ACL or as the subject
21940 .cindex "VRFY" "error text, display of"
21941 VRFY command, the text is included in the SMTP error response by
21943 .cindex "EXPN" "error text, display of"
21944 The text is not included in the response to an EXPN command. In non-SMTP cases
21945 the text is included in the error message that Exim generates.
21947 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
21948 By default for verify, Exim sends a 451 SMTP code for a &':defer:'&, and 550 for
21949 &':fail:'&. However, if the message starts with three digits followed by a
21950 space, optionally followed by an extended code of the form &'n.n.n'&, also
21951 followed by a space, and the very first digit is the same as the default error
21952 code, the code from the message is used instead. If the very first digit is
21953 incorrect, a panic error is logged, and the default code is used. You can
21954 suppress the use of the supplied code in a redirect router by setting the
21955 &%forbid_smtp_code%& option true. In this case, any SMTP code is quietly
21958 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
21959 In an ACL, an explicitly provided message overrides the default, but the
21960 default message is available in the variable &$acl_verify_message$& and can
21961 therefore be included in a custom message if this is desired.
21963 Normally the error text is the rest of the redirection list &-- a comma does
21964 not terminate it &-- but a newline does act as a terminator. Newlines are not
21965 normally present in alias expansions. In &(lsearch)& lookups they are removed
21966 as part of the continuation process, but they may exist in other kinds of
21967 lookup and in &':include:'& files.
21969 During routing for message delivery (as opposed to verification), a redirection
21970 containing &':fail:'& causes an immediate failure of the incoming address,
21971 whereas &':defer:'& causes the message to remain in the queue so that a
21972 subsequent delivery attempt can happen at a later time. If an address is
21973 deferred for too long, it will ultimately fail, because the normal retry
21977 .cindex "alias file" "exception to default"
21978 Sometimes it is useful to use a single-key search type with a default (see
21979 chapter &<<CHAPfdlookup>>&) to look up aliases. However, there may be a need
21980 for exceptions to the default. These can be handled by aliasing them to
21981 &':unknown:'&. This differs from &':fail:'& in that it causes the &(redirect)&
21982 router to decline, whereas &':fail:'& forces routing to fail. A lookup which
21983 results in an empty redirection list has the same effect.
21987 .section "Duplicate addresses" "SECTdupaddr"
21988 .cindex "duplicate addresses"
21989 .cindex "address duplicate, discarding"
21990 .cindex "pipe" "duplicated"
21991 Exim removes duplicate addresses from the list to which it is delivering, so as
21992 to deliver just one copy to each address. This does not apply to deliveries
21993 routed to pipes by different immediate parent addresses, but an indirect
21994 aliasing scheme of the type
21996 pipe: |/some/command $local_part
22000 does not work with a message that is addressed to both local parts, because
22001 when the second is aliased to the intermediate local part &"pipe"& it gets
22002 discarded as being the same as a previously handled address. However, a scheme
22005 localpart1: |/some/command $local_part
22006 localpart2: |/some/command $local_part
22008 does result in two different pipe deliveries, because the immediate parents of
22009 the pipes are distinct.
22013 .section "Repeated redirection expansion" "SECID128"
22014 .cindex "repeated redirection expansion"
22015 .cindex "address redirection" "repeated for each delivery attempt"
22016 When a message cannot be delivered to all of its recipients immediately,
22017 leading to two or more delivery attempts, redirection expansion is carried out
22018 afresh each time for those addresses whose children were not all previously
22019 delivered. If redirection is being used as a mailing list, this can lead to new
22020 members of the list receiving copies of old messages. The &%one_time%& option
22021 can be used to avoid this.
22024 .section "Errors in redirection lists" "SECID129"
22025 .cindex "address redirection" "errors"
22026 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, a malformed address that causes a parsing
22027 error is skipped, and an entry is written to the main log. This may be useful
22028 for mailing lists that are automatically managed. Otherwise, if an error is
22029 detected while generating the list of new addresses, the original address is
22030 deferred. See also &%syntax_errors_to%&.
22034 .section "Private options for the redirect router" "SECID130"
22036 .cindex "options" "&(redirect)& router"
22037 The private options for the &(redirect)& router are as follows:
22040 .option allow_defer redirect boolean false
22041 Setting this option allows the use of &':defer:'& in non-filter redirection
22042 data, or the &%defer%& command in an Exim filter file.
22045 .option allow_fail redirect boolean false
22046 .cindex "failing delivery" "from filter"
22047 If this option is true, the &':fail:'& item can be used in a redirection list,
22048 and the &%fail%& command may be used in an Exim filter file.
22051 .option allow_filter redirect boolean false
22052 .cindex "filter" "enabling use of"
22053 .cindex "Sieve filter" "enabling use of"
22054 Setting this option allows Exim to interpret redirection data that starts with
22055 &"#Exim filter"& or &"#Sieve filter"& as a set of filtering instructions. There
22056 are some features of Exim filter files that some administrators may wish to
22057 lock out; see the &%forbid_filter_%&&'xxx'& options below.
22059 It is also possible to lock out Exim filters or Sieve filters while allowing
22060 the other type; see &%forbid_exim_filter%& and &%forbid_sieve_filter%&.
22063 The filter is run using the uid and gid set by the generic &%user%& and
22064 &%group%& options. These take their defaults from the password data if
22065 &%check_local_user%& is set, so in the normal case of users' personal filter
22066 files, the filter is run as the relevant user. When &%allow_filter%& is set
22067 true, Exim insists that either &%check_local_user%& or &%user%& is set.
22071 .option allow_freeze redirect boolean false
22072 .cindex "freezing messages" "allowing in filter"
22073 Setting this option allows the use of the &%freeze%& command in an Exim filter.
22074 This command is more normally encountered in system filters, and is disabled by
22075 default for redirection filters because it isn't something you usually want to
22076 let ordinary users do.
22080 .option check_ancestor redirect boolean false
22081 This option is concerned with handling generated addresses that are the same
22082 as some address in the list of redirection ancestors of the current address.
22083 Although it is turned off by default in the code, it is set in the default
22084 configuration file for handling users' &_.forward_& files. It is recommended
22085 for this use of the &(redirect)& router.
22087 When &%check_ancestor%& is set, if a generated address (including the domain)
22088 is the same as any ancestor of the current address, it is replaced by a copy of
22089 the current address. This helps in the case where local part A is aliased to B,
22090 and B has a &_.forward_& file pointing back to A. For example, within a single
22091 domain, the local part &"Joe.Bloggs"& is aliased to &"jb"& and
22092 &_&~jb/.forward_& contains:
22094 \Joe.Bloggs, <other item(s)>
22096 Without the &%check_ancestor%& setting, either local part (&"jb"& or
22097 &"joe.bloggs"&) gets processed once by each router and so ends up as it was
22098 originally. If &"jb"& is the real mailbox name, mail to &"jb"& gets delivered
22099 (having been turned into &"joe.bloggs"& by the &_.forward_& file and back to
22100 &"jb"& by the alias), but mail to &"joe.bloggs"& fails. Setting
22101 &%check_ancestor%& on the &(redirect)& router that handles the &_.forward_&
22102 file prevents it from turning &"jb"& back into &"joe.bloggs"& when that was the
22103 original address. See also the &%repeat_use%& option below.
22106 .option check_group redirect boolean "see below"
22107 When the &%file%& option is used, the group owner of the file is checked only
22108 when this option is set. The permitted groups are those listed in the
22109 &%owngroups%& option, together with the user's default group if
22110 &%check_local_user%& is set. If the file has the wrong group, routing is
22111 deferred. The default setting for this option is true if &%check_local_user%&
22112 is set and the &%modemask%& option permits the group write bit, or if the
22113 &%owngroups%& option is set. Otherwise it is false, and no group check occurs.
22117 .option check_owner redirect boolean "see below"
22118 When the &%file%& option is used, the owner of the file is checked only when
22119 this option is set. If &%check_local_user%& is set, the local user is
22120 permitted; otherwise the owner must be one of those listed in the &%owners%&
22121 option. The default value for this option is true if &%check_local_user%& or
22122 &%owners%& is set. Otherwise the default is false, and no owner check occurs.
22125 .option data redirect string&!! unset
22126 This option is mutually exclusive with &%file%&. One or other of them must be
22127 set, but not both. The contents of &%data%& are expanded, and then used as the
22128 list of forwarding items, or as a set of filtering instructions. If the
22129 expansion is forced to fail, or the result is an empty string or a string that
22130 has no effect (consists entirely of comments), the router declines.
22132 When filtering instructions are used, the string must begin with &"#Exim
22133 filter"&, and all comments in the string, including this initial one, must be
22134 terminated with newline characters. For example:
22136 data = #Exim filter\n\
22137 if $h_to: contains Exim then save $home/mail/exim endif
22139 If you are reading the data from a database where newlines cannot be included,
22140 you can use the &${sg}$& expansion item to turn the escape string of your
22141 choice into a newline.
22144 .option directory_transport redirect string&!! unset
22145 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a directory when a path name
22146 ending with a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
22147 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
22148 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport.
22151 .option file redirect string&!! unset
22152 This option specifies the name of a file that contains the redirection data. It
22153 is mutually exclusive with the &%data%& option. The string is expanded before
22154 use; if the expansion is forced to fail, the router declines. Other expansion
22155 failures cause delivery to be deferred. The result of a successful expansion
22156 must be an absolute path. The entire file is read and used as the redirection
22157 data. If the data is an empty string or a string that has no effect (consists
22158 entirely of comments), the router declines.
22160 .cindex "NFS" "checking for file existence"
22161 If the attempt to open the file fails with a &"does not exist"& error, Exim
22162 runs a check on the containing directory,
22163 unless &%ignore_enotdir%& is true (see below).
22164 If the directory does not appear to exist, delivery is deferred. This can
22165 happen when users' &_.forward_& files are in NFS-mounted directories, and there
22166 is a mount problem. If the containing directory does exist, but the file does
22167 not, the router declines.
22170 .option file_transport redirect string&!! unset
22171 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
22172 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a file when a path name not
22173 ending in a slash is specified as a new &"address"&. The transport used is
22174 specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a
22175 configured transport. This should normally be an &(appendfile)& transport. When
22176 it is running, the filename is in &$address_file$&.
22179 .option filter_prepend_home redirect boolean true
22180 When this option is true, if a &(save)& command in an Exim filter specifies a
22181 relative path, and &$home$& is defined, it is automatically prepended to the
22182 relative path. If this option is set false, this action does not happen. The
22183 relative path is then passed to the transport unmodified.
22186 .option forbid_blackhole redirect boolean false
22187 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22188 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22189 If this option is true, the &':blackhole:'& item may not appear in a
22193 .option forbid_exim_filter redirect boolean false
22194 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22195 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22196 If this option is set true, only Sieve filters are permitted when
22197 &%allow_filter%& is true.
22202 .option forbid_file redirect boolean false
22203 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22204 .cindex "delivery" "to file; forbidding"
22205 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22206 .cindex "Sieve filter" "forbidding delivery to a file"
22207 .cindex "Sieve filter" "&""keep""& facility; disabling"
22208 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address that
22209 specifies delivery to a local file or directory, either from a filter or from a
22210 conventional forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is
22211 set. It applies to Sieve filters as well as to Exim filters, but if true, it
22212 locks out the Sieve's &"keep"& facility.
22215 .option forbid_filter_dlfunc redirect boolean false
22216 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22217 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22218 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
22219 make use of the &%dlfunc%& expansion facility to run dynamically loaded
22222 .option forbid_filter_existstest redirect boolean false
22223 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22224 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22225 .cindex "expansion" "statting a file"
22226 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filters are not allowed to
22227 make use of the &%exists%& condition or the &%stat%& expansion item.
22229 .option forbid_filter_logwrite redirect boolean false
22230 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22231 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22232 If this option is true, use of the logging facility in Exim filters is not
22233 permitted. Logging is in any case available only if the filter is being run
22234 under some unprivileged uid (which is normally the case for ordinary users'
22235 &_.forward_& files).
22238 .option forbid_filter_lookup redirect boolean false
22239 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22240 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22241 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22242 to make use of &%lookup%& items.
22245 .option forbid_filter_perl redirect boolean false
22246 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22247 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22248 This option has an effect only if Exim is built with embedded Perl support. If
22249 it is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed to make use
22250 of the embedded Perl support.
22253 .option forbid_filter_readfile redirect boolean false
22254 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22255 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22256 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22257 to make use of &%readfile%& items.
22260 .option forbid_filter_readsocket redirect boolean false
22261 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22262 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22263 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22264 to make use of &%readsocket%& items.
22267 .option forbid_filter_reply redirect boolean false
22268 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22269 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22270 If this option is true, this router may not generate an automatic reply
22271 message. Automatic replies can be generated only from Exim or Sieve filter
22272 files, not from traditional forward files. This option is forced to be true if
22273 &%one_time%& is set.
22276 .option forbid_filter_run redirect boolean false
22277 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22278 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22279 If this option is true, string expansions in Exim filter files are not allowed
22280 to make use of &%run%& items.
22283 .option forbid_include redirect boolean false
22284 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22285 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22286 If this option is true, items of the form
22288 :include:<path name>
22290 are not permitted in non-filter redirection lists.
22293 .option forbid_pipe redirect boolean false
22294 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22295 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22296 .cindex "delivery" "to pipe; forbidding"
22297 If this option is true, this router may not generate a new address which
22298 specifies delivery to a pipe, either from an Exim filter or from a conventional
22299 forward file. This option is forced to be true if &%one_time%& is set.
22302 .option forbid_sieve_filter redirect boolean false
22303 .cindex "restricting access to features"
22304 .cindex "filter" "locking out certain features"
22305 If this option is set true, only Exim filters are permitted when
22306 &%allow_filter%& is true.
22309 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
22310 .option forbid_smtp_code redirect boolean false
22311 If this option is set true, any SMTP error codes that are present at the start
22312 of messages specified for &`:defer:`& or &`:fail:`& are quietly ignored, and
22313 the default codes (451 and 550, respectively) are always used.
22318 .option hide_child_in_errmsg redirect boolean false
22319 .cindex "bounce message" "redirection details; suppressing"
22320 If this option is true, it prevents Exim from quoting a child address if it
22321 generates a bounce or delay message for it. Instead it says &"an address
22322 generated from <&'the top level address'&>"&. Of course, this applies only to
22323 bounces generated locally. If a message is forwarded to another host, &'its'&
22324 bounce may well quote the generated address.
22327 .option ignore_eacces redirect boolean false
22329 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22330 EACCES error (permission denied), the &(redirect)& router behaves as if the
22331 file did not exist.
22334 .option ignore_enotdir redirect boolean false
22336 If this option is set and an attempt to open a redirection file yields the
22337 ENOTDIR error (something on the path is not a directory), the &(redirect)&
22338 router behaves as if the file did not exist.
22340 Setting &%ignore_enotdir%& has another effect as well: When a &(redirect)&
22341 router that has the &%file%& option set discovers that the file does not exist
22342 (the ENOENT error), it tries to &[stat()]& the parent directory, as a check
22343 against unmounted NFS directories. If the parent can not be statted, delivery
22344 is deferred. However, it seems wrong to do this check when &%ignore_enotdir%&
22345 is set, because that option tells Exim to ignore &"something on the path is not
22346 a directory"& (the ENOTDIR error). This is a confusing area, because it seems
22347 that some operating systems give ENOENT where others give ENOTDIR.
22351 .option include_directory redirect string unset
22352 If this option is set, the path names of any &':include:'& items in a
22353 redirection list must start with this directory.
22356 .option modemask redirect "octal integer" 022
22357 This specifies mode bits which must not be set for a file specified by the
22358 &%file%& option. If any of the forbidden bits are set, delivery is deferred.
22361 .option one_time redirect boolean false
22362 .cindex "one-time aliasing/forwarding expansion"
22363 .cindex "alias file" "one-time expansion"
22364 .cindex "forward file" "one-time expansion"
22365 .cindex "mailing lists" "one-time expansion"
22366 .cindex "address redirection" "one-time expansion"
22367 Sometimes the fact that Exim re-evaluates aliases and reprocesses redirection
22368 files each time it tries to deliver a message causes a problem when one or more
22369 of the generated addresses fails be delivered at the first attempt. The problem
22370 is not one of duplicate delivery &-- Exim is clever enough to handle that &--
22371 but of what happens when the redirection list changes during the time that the
22372 message is on Exim's queue. This is particularly true in the case of mailing
22373 lists, where new subscribers might receive copies of messages that were posted
22374 before they subscribed.
22376 If &%one_time%& is set and any addresses generated by the router fail to
22377 deliver at the first attempt, the failing addresses are added to the message as
22378 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
22379 &"delivered"&. Thus, redirection does not happen again at the next delivery
22382 &*Warning 1*&: Any header line addition or removal that is specified by this
22383 router would be lost if delivery did not succeed at the first attempt. For this
22384 reason, the &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& generic options are not
22385 permitted when &%one_time%& is set.
22387 &*Warning 2*&: To ensure that the router generates only addresses (as opposed
22388 to pipe or file deliveries or auto-replies) &%forbid_file%&, &%forbid_pipe%&,
22389 and &%forbid_filter_reply%& are forced to be true when &%one_time%& is set.
22391 &*Warning 3*&: The &%unseen%& generic router option may not be set with
22394 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
22395 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
22396 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if
22397 &%all_parents%& log selector is set. It is expected that &%one_time%& will
22398 typically be used for mailing lists, where there is normally just one level of
22402 .option owners redirect "string list" unset
22403 .cindex "ownership" "alias file"
22404 .cindex "ownership" "forward file"
22405 .cindex "alias file" "ownership"
22406 .cindex "forward file" "ownership"
22407 This specifies a list of permitted owners for the file specified by &%file%&.
22408 This list is in addition to the local user when &%check_local_user%& is set.
22409 See &%check_owner%& above.
22412 .option owngroups redirect "string list" unset
22413 This specifies a list of permitted groups for the file specified by &%file%&.
22414 The list is in addition to the local user's primary group when
22415 &%check_local_user%& is set. See &%check_group%& above.
22418 .option pipe_transport redirect string&!! unset
22419 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
22420 A &(redirect)& router sets up a direct delivery to a pipe when a string
22421 starting with a vertical bar character is specified as a new &"address"&. The
22422 transport used is specified by this option, which, after expansion, must be the
22423 name of a configured transport. This should normally be a &(pipe)& transport.
22424 When the transport is run, the pipe command is in &$address_pipe$&.
22427 .option qualify_domain redirect string&!! unset
22428 .vindex "&$qualify_recipient$&"
22429 If this option is set, and an unqualified address (one without a domain) is
22430 generated, and that address would normally be qualified by the global setting
22431 in &%qualify_recipient%&, it is instead qualified with the domain specified by
22432 expanding this string. If the expansion fails, the router declines. If you want
22433 to revert to the default, you can have the expansion generate
22434 &$qualify_recipient$&.
22436 This option applies to all unqualified addresses generated by Exim filters,
22437 but for traditional &_.forward_& files, it applies only to addresses that are
22438 not preceded by a backslash. Sieve filters cannot generate unqualified
22441 .option qualify_preserve_domain redirect boolean false
22442 .cindex "domain" "in redirection; preserving"
22443 .cindex "preserving domain in redirection"
22444 .cindex "address redirection" "domain; preserving"
22445 If this option is set, the router's local &%qualify_domain%& option must not be
22446 set (a configuration error occurs if it is). If an unqualified address (one
22447 without a domain) is generated, it is qualified with the domain of the parent
22448 address (the immediately preceding ancestor) instead of the global
22449 &%qualify_recipient%& value. In the case of a traditional &_.forward_& file,
22450 this applies whether or not the address is preceded by a backslash.
22453 .option repeat_use redirect boolean true
22454 If this option is set false, the router is skipped for a child address that has
22455 any ancestor that was routed by this router. This test happens before any of
22456 the other preconditions are tested. Exim's default anti-looping rules skip
22457 only when the ancestor is the same as the current address. See also
22458 &%check_ancestor%& above and the generic &%redirect_router%& option.
22461 .option reply_transport redirect string&!! unset
22462 A &(redirect)& router sets up an automatic reply when a &%mail%& or
22463 &%vacation%& command is used in a filter file. The transport used is specified
22464 by this option, which, after expansion, must be the name of a configured
22465 transport. This should normally be an &(autoreply)& transport. Other transports
22466 are unlikely to do anything sensible or useful.
22469 .option rewrite redirect boolean true
22470 .cindex "address redirection" "disabling rewriting"
22471 If this option is set false, addresses generated by the router are not
22472 subject to address rewriting. Otherwise, they are treated like new addresses
22473 and are rewritten according to the global rewriting rules.
22476 .option sieve_inbox redirect string&!! inbox
22478 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22479 name of the mailbox used for "keep" operations (explicit or implicit).
22482 .option sieve_subaddress redirect string&!! unset
22483 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the
22484 :subaddress part of an address.
22486 .option sieve_useraddress redirect string&!! unset
22487 The value of this option is passed to a Sieve filter to specify the :user part
22488 of an address. However, if it is unset, the entire original local part
22489 (including any prefix or suffix) is used for :user.
22492 .option sieve_vacation_directory redirect string&!! unset
22493 .cindex "Sieve filter" "vacation directory"
22494 To enable the &"vacation"& extension for Sieve filters, you must set
22495 &%sieve_vacation_directory%& to the directory where vacation databases are held
22496 (do not put anything else in that directory), and ensure that the
22497 &%reply_transport%& option refers to an &(autoreply)& transport. Each user
22498 needs their own directory; Exim will create it if necessary.
22502 .option skip_syntax_errors redirect boolean false
22503 .cindex "forward file" "broken"
22504 .cindex "address redirection" "broken files"
22505 .cindex "alias file" "broken"
22506 .cindex "broken alias or forward files"
22507 .cindex "ignoring faulty addresses"
22508 .cindex "skipping faulty addresses"
22509 .cindex "error" "skipping bad syntax"
22510 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set, syntactically malformed addresses in
22511 non-filter redirection data are skipped, and each failing address is logged. If
22512 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set, a message is sent to the address it defines,
22513 giving details of the failures. If &%syntax_errors_text%& is set, its contents
22514 are expanded and placed at the head of the error message generated by
22515 &%syntax_errors_to%&. Usually it is appropriate to set &%syntax_errors_to%& to
22516 be the same address as the generic &%errors_to%& option. The
22517 &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is often used when handling mailing lists.
22519 If all the addresses in a redirection list are skipped because of syntax
22520 errors, the router declines to handle the original address, and it is passed to
22521 the following routers.
22523 If &%skip_syntax_errors%& is set when an Exim filter is interpreted, any syntax
22524 error in the filter causes filtering to be abandoned without any action being
22525 taken. The incident is logged, and the router declines to handle the address,
22526 so it is passed to the following routers.
22528 .cindex "Sieve filter" "syntax errors in"
22529 Syntax errors in a Sieve filter file cause the &"keep"& action to occur. This
22530 action is specified by
22531 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3028.html,RFC 3028).
22532 The values of &%skip_syntax_errors%&,
22533 &%syntax_errors_to%&, and &%syntax_errors_text%& are not used.
22535 &%skip_syntax_errors%& can be used to specify that errors in users' forward
22536 lists or filter files should not prevent delivery. The &%syntax_errors_to%&
22537 option, used with an address that does not get redirected, can be used to
22538 notify users of these errors, by means of a router like this:
22544 file = $home/.forward
22545 file_transport = address_file
22546 pipe_transport = address_pipe
22547 reply_transport = address_reply
22550 syntax_errors_to = real-$local_part@$domain
22551 syntax_errors_text = \
22552 This is an automatically generated message. An error has\n\
22553 been found in your .forward file. Details of the error are\n\
22554 reported below. While this error persists, you will receive\n\
22555 a copy of this message for every message that is addressed\n\
22556 to you. If your .forward file is a filter file, or if it is\n\
22557 a non-filter file containing no valid forwarding addresses,\n\
22558 a copy of each incoming message will be put in your normal\n\
22559 mailbox. If a non-filter file contains at least one valid\n\
22560 forwarding address, forwarding to the valid addresses will\n\
22561 happen, and those will be the only deliveries that occur.
22563 You also need a router to ensure that local addresses that are prefixed by
22564 &`real-`& are recognized, but not forwarded or filtered. For example, you could
22565 put this immediately before the &(userforward)& router:
22570 local_part_prefix = real-
22571 transport = local_delivery
22573 For security, it would probably be a good idea to restrict the use of this
22574 router to locally-generated messages, using a condition such as this:
22576 condition = ${if match_ip {$sender_host_address} \
22577 {<; ; 127.0.0.1 ; ::1}}
22581 .option syntax_errors_text redirect string&!! unset
22582 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22585 .option syntax_errors_to redirect string unset
22586 See &%skip_syntax_errors%& above.
22587 .ecindex IIDredrou1
22588 .ecindex IIDredrou2
22595 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22596 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22598 .chapter "Environment for running local transports" "CHAPenvironment" &&&
22599 "Environment for local transports"
22600 .scindex IIDenvlotra1 "local transports" "environment for"
22601 .scindex IIDenvlotra2 "environment" "local transports"
22602 .scindex IIDenvlotra3 "transport" "local; environment for"
22603 Local transports handle deliveries to files and pipes. (The &(autoreply)&
22604 transport can be thought of as similar to a pipe.) Exim always runs transports
22605 in subprocesses, under specified uids and gids. Typical deliveries to local
22606 mailboxes run under the uid and gid of the local user.
22608 Exim also sets a specific current directory while running the transport; for
22609 some transports a home directory setting is also relevant. The &(pipe)&
22610 transport is the only one that sets up environment variables; see section
22611 &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for details.
22613 The values used for the uid, gid, and the directories may come from several
22614 different places. In many cases, the router that handles the address associates
22615 settings with that address as a result of its &%check_local_user%&, &%group%&,
22616 or &%user%& options. However, values may also be given in the transport's own
22617 configuration, and these override anything that comes from the router.
22621 .section "Concurrent deliveries" "SECID131"
22622 .cindex "concurrent deliveries"
22623 .cindex "simultaneous deliveries"
22624 If two different messages for the same local recipient arrive more or less
22625 simultaneously, the two delivery processes are likely to run concurrently. When
22626 the &(appendfile)& transport is used to write to a file, Exim applies locking
22627 rules to stop concurrent processes from writing to the same file at the same
22630 However, when you use a &(pipe)& transport, it is up to you to arrange any
22631 locking that is needed. Here is a silly example:
22635 command = /bin/sh -c 'cat >>/some/file'
22637 This is supposed to write the message at the end of the file. However, if two
22638 messages arrive at the same time, the file will be scrambled. You can use the
22639 &%exim_lock%& utility program (see section &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>&) to lock a
22640 file using the same algorithm that Exim itself uses.
22645 .section "Uids and gids" "SECTenvuidgid"
22646 .cindex "local transports" "uid and gid"
22647 .cindex "transport" "local; uid and gid"
22648 All transports have the options &%group%& and &%user%&. If &%group%& is set, it
22649 overrides any group that the router set in the address, even if &%user%& is not
22650 set for the transport. This makes it possible, for example, to run local mail
22651 delivery under the uid of the recipient (set by the router), but in a special
22652 group (set by the transport). For example:
22655 # User/group are set by check_local_user in this router
22659 transport = group_delivery
22662 # This transport overrides the group
22664 driver = appendfile
22665 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
22668 If &%user%& is set for a transport, its value overrides what is set in the
22669 address by the router. If &%user%& is non-numeric and &%group%& is not set, the
22670 gid associated with the user is used. If &%user%& is numeric, &%group%& must be
22673 .oindex "&%initgroups%&"
22674 When the uid is taken from the transport's configuration, the &[initgroups()]&
22675 function is called for the groups associated with that uid if the
22676 &%initgroups%& option is set for the transport. When the uid is not specified
22677 by the transport, but is associated with the address by a router, the option
22678 for calling &[initgroups()]& is taken from the router configuration.
22680 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "uid for"
22681 The &(pipe)& transport contains the special option &%pipe_as_creator%&. If this
22682 is set and &%user%& is not set, the uid of the process that called Exim to
22683 receive the message is used, and if &%group%& is not set, the corresponding
22684 original gid is also used.
22686 This is the detailed preference order for obtaining a gid; the first of the
22687 following that is set is used:
22690 A &%group%& setting of the transport;
22692 A &%group%& setting of the router;
22694 A gid associated with a user setting of the router, either as a result of
22695 &%check_local_user%& or an explicit non-numeric &%user%& setting;
22697 The group associated with a non-numeric &%user%& setting of the transport;
22699 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's gid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set and
22700 the uid is the creator's uid;
22702 The Exim gid if the Exim uid is being used as a default.
22705 If, for example, the user is specified numerically on the router and there are
22706 no group settings, no gid is available. In this situation, an error occurs.
22707 This is different for the uid, for which there always is an ultimate default.
22708 The first of the following that is set is used:
22711 A &%user%& setting of the transport;
22713 In a &(pipe)& transport, the creator's uid if &%deliver_as_creator%& is set;
22715 A &%user%& setting of the router;
22717 A &%check_local_user%& setting of the router;
22722 Of course, an error will still occur if the uid that is chosen is on the
22723 &%never_users%& list.
22729 .section "Current and home directories" "SECID132"
22730 .cindex "current directory for local transport"
22731 .cindex "home directory" "for local transport"
22732 .cindex "transport" "local; home directory for"
22733 .cindex "transport" "local; current directory for"
22734 Routers may set current and home directories for local transports by means of
22735 the &%transport_current_directory%& and &%transport_home_directory%& options.
22736 However, if the transport's &%current_directory%& or &%home_directory%& options
22737 are set, they override the router's values. In detail, the home directory
22738 for a local transport is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22741 The &%home_directory%& option on the transport;
22743 The &%transport_home_directory%& option on the router;
22745 The password data if &%check_local_user%& is set on the router;
22747 The &%router_home_directory%& option on the router.
22750 The current directory is taken from the first of these values that is set:
22753 The &%current_directory%& option on the transport;
22755 The &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router.
22759 If neither the router nor the transport sets a current directory, Exim uses the
22760 value of the home directory, if it is set. Otherwise it sets the current
22761 directory to &_/_& before running a local transport.
22765 .section "Expansion variables derived from the address" "SECID133"
22766 .vindex "&$domain$&"
22767 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
22768 .vindex "&$original_domain$&"
22769 Normally a local delivery is handling a single address, and in that case the
22770 variables such as &$domain$& and &$local_part$& are set during local
22771 deliveries. However, in some circumstances more than one address may be handled
22772 at once (for example, while writing batch SMTP for onward transmission by some
22773 other means). In this case, the variables associated with the local part are
22774 never set, &$domain$& is set only if all the addresses have the same domain,
22775 and &$original_domain$& is never set.
22776 .ecindex IIDenvlotra1
22777 .ecindex IIDenvlotra2
22778 .ecindex IIDenvlotra3
22786 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22787 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
22789 .chapter "Generic options for transports" "CHAPtransportgeneric"
22790 .scindex IIDgenoptra1 "generic options" "transport"
22791 .scindex IIDgenoptra2 "options" "generic; for transports"
22792 .scindex IIDgenoptra3 "transport" "generic options for"
22793 The name of a transport is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
22794 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
22797 The following generic options apply to all transports:
22800 .option body_only transports boolean false
22801 .cindex "transport" "body only"
22802 .cindex "message" "transporting body only"
22803 .cindex "body of message" "transporting"
22804 If this option is set, the message's headers are not transported. It is
22805 mutually exclusive with &%headers_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)&
22806 or &(pipe)& transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and
22807 &%message_suffix%& should be checked, because this option does not
22808 automatically suppress them.
22811 .option current_directory transports string&!! unset
22812 .cindex "transport" "current directory for"
22813 This specifies the current directory that is to be set while running the
22814 transport, overriding any value that may have been set by the router.
22815 If the expansion fails for any reason, including forced failure, an error is
22816 logged, and delivery is deferred.
22819 .option disable_logging transports boolean false
22820 If this option is set true, nothing is logged for any
22821 deliveries by the transport or for any
22822 transport errors. You should not set this option unless you really, really know
22823 what you are doing.
22826 .option debug_print transports string&!! unset
22827 .cindex "testing" "variables in drivers"
22828 If this option is set and debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%& command line
22829 option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging output when the
22831 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
22832 output, and Exim carries on processing.
22833 This facility is provided to help with checking out the values of variables and
22834 so on when debugging driver configurations. For example, if a &%headers_add%&
22835 option is not working properly, &%debug_print%& could be used to output the
22836 variables it references. A newline is added to the text if it does not end with
22838 The variables &$transport_name$& and &$router_name$& contain the name of the
22839 transport and the router that called it.
22841 .option delivery_date_add transports boolean false
22842 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
22843 If this option is true, a &'Delivery-date:'& header is added to the message.
22844 This gives the actual time the delivery was made. As this is not a standard
22845 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%delivery_date_remove%&) which
22846 requests its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can
22847 safely be resent to other recipients.
22850 .option driver transports string unset
22851 This specifies which of the available transport drivers is to be used.
22852 There is no default, and this option must be set for every transport.
22855 .option envelope_to_add transports boolean false
22856 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
22857 If this option is true, an &'Envelope-to:'& header is added to the message.
22858 This gives the original address(es) in the incoming envelope that caused this
22859 delivery to happen. More than one address may be present if the transport is
22860 configured to handle several addresses at once, or if more than one original
22861 address was redirected to the same final address. As this is not a standard
22862 header, Exim has a configuration option (&%envelope_to_remove%&) which requests
22863 its removal from incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be
22864 resent to other recipients.
22866 &*Note:*& If used on a transport handling multiple recipients
22867 (the smtp transport unless &%max_rcpt%& is 1, the appendfile, pipe or lmtp
22868 transport if &%batch_max%& is greater than 1)
22869 then information about Bcc recipients will be leaked.
22870 Doing so is generally not advised.
22873 .option event_action transports string&!! unset
22875 This option declares a string to be expanded for Exim's events mechanism.
22876 For details see chapter &<<CHAPevents>>&.
22879 .option group transports string&!! "Exim group"
22880 .cindex "transport" "group; specifying"
22881 This option specifies a gid for running the transport process, overriding any
22882 value that the router supplies, and also overriding any value associated with
22883 &%user%& (see below).
22886 .option headers_add transports list&!! unset
22887 .cindex "header lines" "adding in transport"
22888 .cindex "transport" "header lines; adding"
22889 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22890 newline-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22891 which are (separately) expanded and added to the header
22892 portion of a message as it is transported, as described in section
22893 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Additional header lines can also be specified by
22894 routers. If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22895 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22896 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22898 Unlike most options, &%headers_add%& can be specified multiple times
22899 for a transport; all listed headers are added.
22902 .option headers_only transports boolean false
22903 .cindex "transport" "header lines only"
22904 .cindex "message" "transporting headers only"
22905 .cindex "header lines" "transporting"
22906 If this option is set, the message's body is not transported. It is mutually
22907 exclusive with &%body_only%&. If it is used with the &(appendfile)& or &(pipe)&
22908 transports, the settings of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& should be
22909 checked, since this option does not automatically suppress them.
22912 .option headers_remove transports list&!! unset
22913 .cindex "header lines" "removing"
22914 .cindex "transport" "header lines; removing"
22915 This option specifies a list of text headers,
22916 colon-separated (by default, changeable in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&),
22917 to be removed from the message.
22918 However, the option has no effect when an address is just being verified.
22919 Each list item is separately expanded.
22920 If the result of the expansion is an empty string, or if the expansion
22921 is forced to fail, no action is taken. Other expansion failures are treated as
22922 errors and cause the delivery to be deferred.
22923 If an item ends in *, it will match any header with the given prefix.
22925 Matching headers are omitted from the message as it is transported, as described
22926 in section &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&. Header removal can also be specified by
22929 Unlike most options, &%headers_remove%& can be specified multiple times
22930 for a transport; all listed headers are removed.
22932 &*Warning*&: Because of the separate expansion of the list items,
22933 items that contain a list separator must have it doubled.
22934 To avoid this, change the list separator (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
22938 .option headers_rewrite transports string unset
22939 .cindex "transport" "header lines; rewriting"
22940 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
22941 This option allows addresses in header lines to be rewritten at transport time,
22942 that is, as the message is being copied to its destination. The contents of the
22943 option are a colon-separated list of rewriting rules. Each rule is in exactly
22944 the same form as one of the general rewriting rules that are applied when a
22945 message is received. These are described in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. For
22948 headers_rewrite = a@b c@d f : \
22951 changes &'a@b'& into &'c@d'& in &'From:'& header lines, and &'x@y'& into
22952 &'w@z'& in all address-bearing header lines. The rules are applied to the
22953 header lines just before they are written out at transport time, so they affect
22954 only those copies of the message that pass through the transport. However, only
22955 the message's original header lines, and any that were added by a system
22956 filter, are rewritten. If a router or transport adds header lines, they are not
22957 affected by this option. These rewriting rules are &'not'& applied to the
22958 envelope. You can change the return path using &%return_path%&, but you cannot
22959 change envelope recipients at this time.
22962 .option home_directory transports string&!! unset
22963 .cindex "transport" "home directory for"
22965 This option specifies a home directory setting for a local transport,
22966 overriding any value that may be set by the router. The home directory is
22967 placed in &$home$& while expanding the transport's private options. It is also
22968 used as the current directory if no current directory is set by the
22969 &%current_directory%& option on the transport or the
22970 &%transport_current_directory%& option on the router. If the expansion fails
22971 for any reason, including forced failure, an error is logged, and delivery is
22975 .option initgroups transports boolean false
22976 .cindex "additional groups"
22977 .cindex "groups" "additional"
22978 .cindex "transport" "group; additional"
22979 If this option is true and the uid for the delivery process is provided by the
22980 transport, the &[initgroups()]& function is called when running the transport
22981 to ensure that any additional groups associated with the uid are set up.
22984 .option max_parallel transports integer&!! unset
22985 .cindex limit "transport parallelism"
22986 .cindex transport "parallel processes"
22987 .cindex transport "concurrency limit"
22988 .cindex "delivery" "parallelism for transport"
22989 If this option is set and expands to an integer greater than zero
22990 it limits the number of concurrent runs of the transport.
22991 The control does not apply to shadow transports.
22993 .cindex "hints database" "transport concurrency control"
22994 Exim implements this control by means of a hints database in which a record is
22995 incremented whenever a transport process is being created. The record
22996 is decremented and possibly removed when the process terminates.
22997 Obviously there is scope for
22998 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
22999 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
23001 If you use this option, you should also arrange to delete the
23002 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
23003 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
23004 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
23005 are used for ETRN and smtp transport serialization.
23008 .option message_size_limit transports string&!! 0
23009 .cindex "limit" "message size per transport"
23010 .cindex "size" "of message, limit"
23011 .cindex "transport" "message size; limiting"
23012 This option controls the size of messages passed through the transport. It is
23013 expanded before use; the result of the expansion must be a sequence of decimal
23014 digits, optionally followed by K or M. If the expansion fails for any reason,
23015 including forced failure, or if the result is not of the required form,
23016 delivery is deferred. If the value is greater than zero and the size of a
23017 message exceeds this limit, the address is failed. If there is any chance that
23018 the resulting bounce message could be routed to the same transport, you should
23019 ensure that &%return_size_limit%& is less than the transport's
23020 &%message_size_limit%&, as otherwise the bounce message will fail to get
23025 .option rcpt_include_affixes transports boolean false
23026 .cindex "prefix" "for local part, including in envelope"
23027 .cindex "suffix for local part" "including in envelope"
23028 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
23029 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
23030 When this option is false (the default), and an address that has had any
23031 affixes (prefixes or suffixes) removed from the local part is delivered by any
23032 form of SMTP or LMTP, the affixes are not included. For example, if a router
23035 local_part_prefix = *-
23037 routes the address &'abc-xyz@some.domain'& to an SMTP transport, the envelope
23040 RCPT TO:<xyz@some.domain>
23042 This is also the case when an ACL-time callout is being used to verify a
23043 recipient address. However, if &%rcpt_include_affixes%& is set true, the
23044 whole local part is included in the RCPT command. This option applies to BSMTP
23045 deliveries by the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports as well as to the
23046 &(lmtp)& and &(smtp)& transports.
23049 .option retry_use_local_part transports boolean "see below"
23050 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
23051 When a delivery suffers a temporary failure, a retry record is created
23052 in Exim's hints database. For remote deliveries, the key for the retry record
23053 is based on the name and/or IP address of the failing remote host. For local
23054 deliveries, the key is normally the entire address, including both the local
23055 part and the domain. This is suitable for most common cases of local delivery
23056 temporary failure &-- for example, exceeding a mailbox quota should delay only
23057 deliveries to that mailbox, not to the whole domain.
23059 However, in some special cases you may want to treat a temporary local delivery
23060 as a failure associated with the domain, and not with a particular local part.
23061 (For example, if you are storing all mail for some domain in files.) You can do
23062 this by setting &%retry_use_local_part%& false.
23064 For all the local transports, its default value is true. For remote transports,
23065 the default value is false for tidiness, but changing the value has no effect
23066 on a remote transport in the current implementation.
23069 .option return_path transports string&!! unset
23070 .cindex "envelope sender"
23071 .cindex "envelope from"
23072 .cindex "transport" "return path; changing"
23073 .cindex "return path" "changing in transport"
23074 If this option is set, the string is expanded at transport time and replaces
23075 the existing return path (envelope sender) value in the copy of the message
23076 that is being delivered. An empty return path is permitted. This feature is
23077 designed for remote deliveries, where the value of this option is used in the
23078 SMTP MAIL command. If you set &%return_path%& for a local transport, the
23079 only effect is to change the address that is placed in the &'Return-path:'&
23080 header line, if one is added to the message (see the next option).
23082 &*Note:*& A changed return path is not logged unless you add
23083 &%return_path_on_delivery%& to the log selector.
23085 .vindex "&$return_path$&"
23086 The expansion can refer to the existing value via &$return_path$&. This is
23087 either the message's envelope sender, or an address set by the
23088 &%errors_to%& option on a router. If the expansion is forced to fail, no
23089 replacement occurs; if it fails for another reason, delivery is deferred. This
23090 option can be used to support VERP (Variable Envelope Return Paths) &-- see
23091 section &<<SECTverp>>&.
23093 &*Note*&: If a delivery error is detected locally, including the case when a
23094 remote server rejects a message at SMTP time, the bounce message is not sent to
23095 the value of this option. It is sent to the previously set errors address.
23096 This defaults to the incoming sender address, but can be changed by setting
23097 &%errors_to%& in a router.
23101 .option return_path_add transports boolean false
23102 .chindex Return-path:
23103 If this option is true, a &'Return-path:'& header is added to the message.
23104 Although the return path is normally available in the prefix line of BSD
23105 mailboxes, this is commonly not displayed by MUAs, and so the user does not
23106 have easy access to it.
23108 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821)
23109 states that the &'Return-path:'& header is added to a message &"when
23110 the delivery SMTP server makes the final delivery"&. This implies that this
23111 header should not be present in incoming messages. Exim has a configuration
23112 option, &%return_path_remove%&, which requests removal of this header from
23113 incoming messages, so that delivered messages can safely be resent to other
23117 .option shadow_condition transports string&!! unset
23118 See &%shadow_transport%& below.
23121 .option shadow_transport transports string unset
23122 .cindex "shadow transport"
23123 .cindex "transport" "shadow"
23124 A local transport may set the &%shadow_transport%& option to the name of
23125 another local transport. Shadow remote transports are not supported.
23127 Whenever a delivery to the main transport succeeds, and either
23128 &%shadow_condition%& is unset, or its expansion does not result in the empty
23129 string or one of the strings &"0"& or &"no"& or &"false"&, the message is also
23130 passed to the shadow transport, with the same delivery address or addresses. If
23131 expansion fails, no action is taken except that non-forced expansion failures
23132 cause a log line to be written.
23134 The result of the shadow transport is discarded and does not affect the
23135 subsequent processing of the message. Only a single level of shadowing is
23136 provided; the &%shadow_transport%& option is ignored on any transport when it
23137 is running as a shadow. Options concerned with output from pipes are also
23138 ignored. The log line for the successful delivery has an item added on the end,
23141 ST=<shadow transport name>
23143 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
23144 parentheses afterwards. Shadow transports can be used for a number of different
23145 purposes, including keeping more detailed log information than Exim normally
23146 provides, and implementing automatic acknowledgment policies based on message
23147 headers that some sites insist on.
23150 .option transport_filter transports string&!! unset
23151 .cindex "transport" "filter"
23152 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
23153 This option sets up a filtering (in the Unix shell sense) process for messages
23154 at transport time. It should not be confused with mail filtering as set up by
23155 individual users or via a system filter.
23156 If unset, or expanding to an empty string, no filtering is done.
23158 When the message is about to be written out, the command specified by
23159 &%transport_filter%& is started up in a separate, parallel process, and
23160 the entire message, including the header lines, is passed to it on its standard
23161 input (this in fact is done from a third process, to avoid deadlock).
23162 The command must be specified as an absolute path.
23164 The process run by the command must use its standard input as the message
23165 data to be transformed, and write the results on its standard output.
23167 The lines of the message that are written to the transport filter are
23168 terminated by newline (&"\n"&). The message is passed to the filter before any
23169 SMTP-specific processing, such as turning &"\n"& into &"\r\n"& and escaping
23170 lines beginning with a dot, and also before any processing implied by the
23171 settings of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& in the &(appendfile)& or
23172 &(pipe)& transports.
23174 The standard error for the filter process is set to the same destination as its
23175 standard output; this is read and written to the message's ultimate
23176 destination. The process that writes the message to the filter, the
23177 filter itself, and the original process that reads the result and delivers it
23178 are all run in parallel, like a shell pipeline.
23180 The filter can perform any transformations it likes, but of course should take
23182 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
23183 syntax. Exim does not check the result, except to
23184 test for a final newline when SMTP is in use. All messages transmitted over
23185 SMTP must end with a newline, so Exim supplies one if it is missing.
23187 .cindex "content scanning" "per user"
23188 A transport filter can be used to provide content-scanning on a per-user basis
23189 at delivery time if the only required effect of the scan is to modify the
23190 message. For example, a content scan could insert a new header line containing
23191 a spam score. This could be interpreted by a filter in the user's MUA. It is
23192 not possible to discard a message at this stage.
23194 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
23195 A problem might arise if the filter increases the size of a message that is
23196 being sent down an SMTP connection. If the receiving SMTP server has indicated
23197 support for the SIZE parameter, Exim will have sent the size of the message
23198 at the start of the SMTP session. If what is actually sent is substantially
23199 more, the server might reject the message. This can be worked round by setting
23200 the &%size_addition%& option on the &(smtp)& transport, either to allow for
23201 additions to the message, or to disable the use of SIZE altogether.
23203 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23204 The value of the &%transport_filter%& option is the command string for starting
23205 the filter, which is run directly from Exim, not under a shell. The string is
23206 parsed by Exim in the same way as a command string for the &(pipe)& transport:
23207 Exim breaks it up into arguments and then expands each argument separately (see
23208 section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&). Any kind of expansion failure causes delivery
23209 to be deferred. The special argument &$pipe_addresses$& is replaced by a number
23210 of arguments, one for each address that applies to this delivery. (This isn't
23211 an ideal name for this feature here, but as it was already implemented for the
23212 &(pipe)& transport, it seemed sensible not to change it.)
23215 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
23216 The expansion variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available when the
23217 transport is a remote one. They contain the name and IP address of the host to
23218 which the message is being sent. For example:
23219 . used to have $sender_address in this cmdline, but it's tainted
23221 transport_filter = /some/directory/transport-filter.pl \
23222 $host $host_address $pipe_addresses
23225 Two problems arise if you want to use more complicated expansion items to
23226 generate transport filter commands, both of which due to the fact that the
23227 command is split up &'before'& expansion.
23229 If an expansion item contains white space, you must quote it, so that it is all
23230 part of the same command item. If the entire option setting is one such
23231 expansion item, you have to take care what kind of quoting you use. For
23234 transport_filter = '/bin/cmd${if eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}}'
23236 This runs the command &(/bin/cmd1)& if the host name is &'a.b.c'&, and
23237 &(/bin/cmd2)& otherwise.
23239 Option strings in general have any fully-surrounding double quote wrapping
23240 removed early in parsing (see &<<SECTstrings>>&).
23241 Then, for this option, quotes protect against whitespace being
23242 regarded as a separator while splitting into the command argument vector.
23243 Either double or single quotes can be used here;
23244 the former interprets backlash-quoted charachters
23245 and the latter does not.
23247 If double quotes had been used in this example, they would have been
23248 stripped by Exim when it read the option's value. When the value is used, if
23249 the single quotes were missing, the line would be split into two items,
23250 &`/bin/cmd${if`& and &`eq{$host}{a.b.c}{1}{2}`&, and an error would occur when
23251 Exim tried to expand the first one.
23253 Except for the special case of &$pipe_addresses$& that is mentioned above, an
23254 expansion cannot generate multiple arguments, or a command name followed by
23255 arguments. Consider this example:
23257 transport_filter = ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
23258 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
23260 The result of the lookup is interpreted as the name of the command, even
23261 if it contains white space. The simplest way round this is to use a shell:
23263 transport_filter = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$host}lsearch{/a/file}\
23264 {$value}{/bin/cat}}
23268 The filter process is run under the same uid and gid as the normal delivery.
23269 For remote deliveries this is the Exim uid/gid by default. The command should
23270 normally yield a zero return code. Transport filters are not supposed to fail.
23271 A non-zero code is taken to mean that the transport filter encountered some
23272 serious problem. Delivery of the message is deferred; the message remains on
23273 the queue and is tried again later. It is not possible to cause a message to be
23274 bounced from a transport filter.
23276 If a transport filter is set on an autoreply transport, the original message is
23277 passed through the filter as it is being copied into the newly generated
23278 message, which happens if the &%return_message%& option is set.
23281 .option transport_filter_timeout transports time 5m
23282 .cindex "transport" "filter, timeout"
23283 When Exim is reading the output of a transport filter, it applies a timeout
23284 that can be set by this option. Exceeding the timeout is normally treated as a
23285 temporary delivery failure. However, if a transport filter is used with a
23286 &(pipe)& transport, a timeout in the transport filter is treated in the same
23287 way as a timeout in the pipe command itself. By default, a timeout is a hard
23288 error, but if the &(pipe)& transport's &%timeout_defer%& option is set true, it
23289 becomes a temporary error.
23292 .option user transports string&!! "Exim user"
23293 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
23294 .cindex "transport" "user, specifying"
23295 This option specifies the user under whose uid the delivery process is to be
23296 run, overriding any uid that may have been set by the router. If the user is
23297 given as a name, the uid is looked up from the password data, and the
23298 associated group is taken as the value of the gid to be used if the &%group%&
23301 For deliveries that use local transports, a user and group are normally
23302 specified explicitly or implicitly (for example, as a result of
23303 &%check_local_user%&) by the router or transport.
23305 .cindex "hints database" "access by remote transport"
23306 For remote transports, you should leave this option unset unless you really are
23307 sure you know what you are doing. When a remote transport is running, it needs
23308 to be able to access Exim's hints databases, because each host may have its own
23310 .ecindex IIDgenoptra1
23311 .ecindex IIDgenoptra2
23312 .ecindex IIDgenoptra3
23319 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23320 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23322 .chapter "Address batching in local transports" "CHAPbatching" &&&
23324 .cindex "transport" "local; address batching in"
23325 The only remote transport (&(smtp)&) is normally configured to handle more than
23326 one address at a time, so that when several addresses are routed to the same
23327 remote host, just one copy of the message is sent. Local transports, however,
23328 normally handle one address at a time. That is, a separate instance of the
23329 transport is run for each address that is routed to the transport. A separate
23330 copy of the message is delivered each time.
23332 .cindex "batched local delivery"
23333 .oindex "&%batch_max%&"
23334 .oindex "&%batch_id%&"
23335 In special cases, it may be desirable to handle several addresses at once in a
23336 local transport, for example:
23339 In an &(appendfile)& transport, when storing messages in files for later
23340 delivery by some other means, a single copy of the message with multiple
23341 recipients saves space.
23343 In an &(lmtp)& transport, when delivering over &"local SMTP"& to some process,
23344 a single copy saves time, and is the normal way LMTP is expected to work.
23346 In a &(pipe)& transport, when passing the message
23347 to a scanner program or
23348 to some other delivery mechanism such as UUCP, multiple recipients may be
23352 These three local transports all have the same options for controlling multiple
23353 (&"batched"&) deliveries, namely &%batch_max%& and &%batch_id%&. To save
23354 repeating the information for each transport, these options are described here.
23356 The &%batch_max%& option specifies the maximum number of addresses that can be
23357 delivered together in a single run of the transport. Its default value is one
23358 (no batching). When more than one address is routed to a transport that has a
23359 &%batch_max%& value greater than one, the addresses are delivered in a batch
23360 (that is, in a single run of the transport with multiple recipients), subject
23361 to certain conditions:
23364 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23365 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$local_part$&, no
23366 batching is possible.
23368 .vindex "&$domain$&"
23369 If any of the transport's options contain a reference to &$domain$&, only
23370 addresses with the same domain are batched.
23372 .cindex "customizing" "batching condition"
23373 If &%batch_id%& is set, it is expanded for each address, and only those
23374 addresses with the same expanded value are batched. This allows you to specify
23375 customized batching conditions. Failure of the expansion for any reason,
23376 including forced failure, disables batching, but it does not stop the delivery
23379 Batched addresses must also have the same errors address (where to send
23380 delivery errors), the same header additions and removals, the same user and
23381 group for the transport, and if a host list is present, the first host must
23385 In the case of the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports, batching applies
23386 both when the file or pipe command is specified in the transport, and when it
23387 is specified by a &(redirect)& router, but all the batched addresses must of
23388 course be routed to the same file or pipe command. These two transports have an
23389 option called &%use_bsmtp%&, which causes them to deliver the message in
23390 &"batched SMTP"& format, with the envelope represented as SMTP commands. The
23391 &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& options are forced to the values
23394 escape_string = ".."
23396 when batched SMTP is in use. A full description of the batch SMTP mechanism is
23397 given in section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&. The &(lmtp)& transport does not have a
23398 &%use_bsmtp%& option, because it always delivers using the SMTP protocol.
23400 .cindex "&'Envelope-to:'& header line"
23401 If the generic &%envelope_to_add%& option is set for a batching transport, the
23402 &'Envelope-to:'& header that is added to the message contains all the addresses
23403 that are being processed together. If you are using a batching &(appendfile)&
23404 transport without &%use_bsmtp%&, the only way to preserve the recipient
23405 addresses is to set the &%envelope_to_add%& option.
23407 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "with multiple addresses"
23408 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
23409 If you are using a &(pipe)& transport without BSMTP, and setting the
23410 transport's &%command%& option, you can include &$pipe_addresses$& as part of
23411 the command. This is not a true variable; it is a bit of magic that causes each
23412 of the recipient addresses to be inserted into the command as a separate
23413 argument. This provides a way of accessing all the addresses that are being
23414 delivered in the batch. &*Note:*& This is not possible for pipe commands that
23415 are specified by a &(redirect)& router.
23420 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23421 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
23423 .chapter "The appendfile transport" "CHAPappendfile"
23424 .scindex IIDapptra1 "&(appendfile)& transport"
23425 .scindex IIDapptra2 "transports" "&(appendfile)&"
23426 .cindex "directory creation"
23427 .cindex "creating directories"
23428 The &(appendfile)& transport delivers a message by appending it to an existing
23429 file, or by creating an entirely new file in a specified directory. Single
23430 files to which messages are appended can be in the traditional Unix mailbox
23431 format, or optionally in the MBX format supported by the Pine MUA and
23432 University of Washington IMAP daemon, &'inter alia'&. When each message is
23433 being delivered as a separate file, &"maildir"& format can optionally be used
23434 to give added protection against failures that happen part-way through the
23435 delivery. A third form of separate-file delivery known as &"mailstore"& is also
23436 supported. For all file formats, Exim attempts to create as many levels of
23437 directory as necessary, provided that &%create_directory%& is set.
23439 The code for the optional formats is not included in the Exim binary by
23440 default. It is necessary to set SUPPORT_MBX, SUPPORT_MAILDIR and/or
23441 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE in &_Local/Makefile_& to have the appropriate code
23444 .cindex "quota" "system"
23445 Exim recognizes system quota errors, and generates an appropriate message. Exim
23446 also supports its own quota control within the transport, for use when the
23447 system facility is unavailable or cannot be used for some reason.
23449 If there is an error while appending to a file (for example, quota exceeded or
23450 partition filled), Exim attempts to reset the file's length and last
23451 modification time back to what they were before. If there is an error while
23452 creating an entirely new file, the new file is removed.
23454 Before appending to a file, a number of security checks are made, and the
23455 file is locked. A detailed description is given below, after the list of
23458 The &(appendfile)& transport is most commonly used for local deliveries to
23459 users' mailboxes. However, it can also be used as a pseudo-remote transport for
23460 putting messages into files for remote delivery by some means other than Exim.
23461 &"Batch SMTP"& format is often used in this case (see the &%use_bsmtp%&
23466 .section "The file and directory options" "SECTfildiropt"
23467 The &%file%& option specifies a single file, to which the message is appended;
23468 the &%directory%& option specifies a directory, in which a new file containing
23469 the message is created. Only one of these two options can be set, and for
23470 normal deliveries to mailboxes, one of them &'must'& be set.
23472 .vindex "&$address_file$&"
23473 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
23474 However, &(appendfile)& is also used for delivering messages to files or
23475 directories whose names (or parts of names) are obtained from alias,
23476 forwarding, or filtering operations (for example, a &%save%& command in a
23477 user's Exim filter). When such a transport is running, &$local_part$& contains
23478 the local part that was aliased or forwarded, and &$address_file$& contains the
23479 name (or partial name) of the file or directory generated by the redirection
23480 operation. There are two cases:
23483 If neither &%file%& nor &%directory%& is set, the redirection operation
23484 must specify an absolute path (one that begins with &`/`&). This is the most
23485 common case when users with local accounts use filtering to sort mail into
23486 different folders. See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the
23487 default configuration. If the path ends with a slash, it is assumed to be the
23488 name of a directory. A delivery to a directory can also be forced by setting
23489 &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%&.
23491 If &%file%& or &%directory%& is set for a delivery from a redirection, it is
23492 used to determine the file or directory name for the delivery. Normally, the
23493 contents of &$address_file$& are used in some way in the string expansion.
23495 If the &%create_file%& option is set to a path which
23496 matches (see the option definition below for details)
23497 a file or directory name
23498 for the delivery, that name becomes de-tainted.
23500 .cindex "tainted data" "in filenames"
23501 .cindex appendfile "tainted data"
23502 Tainted data may not be used for a file or directory name.
23503 This means that, for instance, &$local_part$& cannot be used directly
23504 as a component of a path. It can however be used as the key for a lookup
23505 which returns a path (or component).
23508 .cindex "Sieve filter" "configuring &(appendfile)&"
23509 .cindex "Sieve filter" "relative mailbox path handling"
23510 As an example of the second case, consider an environment where users do not
23511 have home directories. They may be permitted to use Exim filter commands of the
23516 or Sieve filter commands of the form:
23518 require "fileinto";
23519 fileinto "folder23";
23521 In this situation, the expansion of &%file%& or &%directory%& in the transport
23522 must transform the relative path into an appropriate absolute filename. In the
23523 case of Sieve filters, the name &'inbox'& must be handled. It is the
23528 is used as a result of a &"keep"& action in the filter. This example shows one
23529 way of handling this requirement:
23531 file = ${if eq{$address_file}{inbox} \
23532 {/var/mail/$local_part_data} \
23533 {${if eq{${substr_0_1:$address_file}}{/} \
23535 {$home/mail/$address_file} \
23539 With this setting of &%file%&, &'inbox'& refers to the standard mailbox
23540 location, absolute paths are used without change, and other folders are in the
23541 &_mail_& directory within the home directory.
23544 An alternative for the &"keep"& aspect is to use the &%sieve_inbox%& option
23545 on the redirect router that calls the Sieve filter,
23546 to explicitly set the filename used.
23549 &*Note 1*&: While processing an Exim filter, a relative path such as
23550 &_folder23_& is turned into an absolute path if a home directory is known to
23551 the router. In particular, this is the case if &%check_local_user%& is set. If
23552 you want to prevent this happening at routing time, you can set
23553 &%router_home_directory%& empty. This forces the router to pass the relative
23554 path to the transport.
23556 &*Note 2*&: An absolute path in &$address_file$& is not treated specially;
23557 the &%file%& or &%directory%& option is still used if it is set.
23560 &*Note 3*&: Permitting a user to enable writes to an absolute path
23561 may be a security issue.
23566 .section "Private options for appendfile" "SECID134"
23567 .cindex "options" "&(appendfile)& transport"
23571 .option allow_fifo appendfile boolean false
23572 .cindex "fifo (named pipe)"
23573 .cindex "named pipe (fifo)"
23574 .cindex "pipe" "named (fifo)"
23575 Setting this option permits delivery to named pipes (FIFOs) as well as to
23576 regular files. If no process is reading the named pipe at delivery time, the
23577 delivery is deferred.
23580 .option allow_symlink appendfile boolean false
23581 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
23582 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
23583 By default, &(appendfile)& will not deliver if the path name for the file is
23584 that of a symbolic link. Setting this option relaxes that constraint, but there
23585 are security issues involved in the use of symbolic links. Be sure you know
23586 what you are doing if you set this. Details of exactly what this option affects
23587 are included in the discussion which follows this list of options.
23590 .option batch_id appendfile string&!! unset
23591 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23592 However, batching is automatically disabled for &(appendfile)& deliveries that
23593 happen as a result of forwarding or aliasing or other redirection directly to a
23597 .option batch_max appendfile integer 1
23598 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
23601 .option check_group appendfile boolean false
23602 When this option is set, the group owner of the file defined by the &%file%&
23603 option is checked to see that it is the same as the group under which the
23604 delivery process is running. The default setting is false because the default
23605 file mode is 0600, which means that the group is irrelevant.
23608 .option check_owner appendfile boolean true
23609 When this option is set, the owner of the file defined by the &%file%& option
23610 is checked to ensure that it is the same as the user under which the delivery
23611 process is running.
23614 .option check_string appendfile string "see below"
23615 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23616 As &(appendfile)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for
23617 matching &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are
23618 replaced by the contents of &%escape_string%&. The value of &%check_string%& is
23619 a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of any letters it
23620 contains is significant.
23622 If &%use_bsmtp%& is set the values of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%&
23623 are forced to &"."& and &".."& respectively, and any settings in the
23624 configuration are ignored. Otherwise, they default to &"From&~"& and
23625 &">From&~"& when the &%file%& option is set, and unset when any of the
23626 &%directory%&, &%maildir%&, or &%mailstore%& options are set.
23628 The default settings, along with &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, are
23629 suitable for traditional &"BSD"& mailboxes, where a line beginning with
23630 &"From&~"& indicates the start of a new message. All four options need changing
23631 if another format is used. For example, to deliver to mailboxes in MMDF format:
23632 .cindex "MMDF format mailbox"
23633 .cindex "mailbox" "MMDF format"
23635 check_string = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23636 escape_string = "\1\1\1\1 \n"
23637 message_prefix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23638 message_suffix = "\1\1\1\1\n"
23640 .option create_directory appendfile boolean true
23641 .cindex "directory creation"
23642 When this option is true, Exim attempts to create any missing superior
23643 directories for the file that it is about to write. A created directory's mode
23644 is given by the &%directory_mode%& option.
23646 The group ownership of a newly created directory is highly dependent on the
23647 operating system (and possibly the file system) that is being used. For
23648 example, in Solaris, if the parent directory has the setgid bit set, its group
23649 is propagated to the child; if not, the currently set group is used. However,
23650 in FreeBSD, the parent's group is always used.
23654 .option create_file appendfile string anywhere
23655 This option constrains the location of files and directories that are created
23656 by this transport. It applies to files defined by the &%file%& option and
23657 directories defined by the &%directory%& option. In the case of maildir
23658 delivery, it applies to the top level directory, not the maildir directories
23661 The option must be set to one of the words &"anywhere"&, &"inhome"&, or
23662 &"belowhome"&, or to an absolute path.
23664 In the second and third cases, a home directory must have been
23665 set for the transport, and the file or directory being created must
23667 The "belowhome" checking additionally checks for attempts to use "../"
23668 to evade the testing.
23669 This option is not useful when an explicit filename is
23670 given for normal mailbox deliveries. It is intended for the case when filenames
23671 are generated from users' &_.forward_& files. These are usually handled
23672 by an &(appendfile)& transport called &%address_file%&. See also
23673 &%file_must_exist%&.
23675 In the fourth case,
23676 the value given for this option must be an absolute path for an
23677 existing directory.
23678 The value is used for checking instead of a home directory;
23679 checking is done in "belowhome" mode.
23681 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
23682 .cindex "de-tainting" "using appendfile create_file option"
23683 If "belowhome" checking is used, the file or directory path
23684 becomes de-tainted.
23687 .option directory appendfile string&!! unset
23688 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%file%& option, but one of &%file%&
23689 or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result of a
23690 redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&).
23692 When &%directory%& is set, the string is expanded, and the message is delivered
23693 into a new file or files in or below the given directory, instead of being
23694 appended to a single mailbox file. A number of different formats are provided
23695 (see &%maildir_format%& and &%mailstore_format%&), and see section
23696 &<<SECTopdir>>& for further details of this form of delivery.
23698 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23702 .option directory_file appendfile string&!! "see below"
23704 .vindex "&$inode$&"
23705 When &%directory%& is set, but neither &%maildir_format%& nor
23706 &%mailstore_format%& is set, &(appendfile)& delivers each message into a file
23707 whose name is obtained by expanding this string. The default value is:
23709 q${base62:$tod_epoch}-$inode
23711 This generates a unique name from the current time, in base 62 form, and the
23712 inode of the file. The variable &$inode$& is available only when expanding this
23716 .option directory_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0700
23717 If &(appendfile)& creates any directories as a result of the
23718 &%create_directory%& option, their mode is specified by this option.
23721 .option escape_string appendfile string "see description"
23722 See &%check_string%& above.
23725 .option file appendfile string&!! unset
23726 This option is mutually exclusive with the &%directory%& option, but one of
23727 &%file%& or &%directory%& must be set, unless the delivery is the direct result
23728 of a redirection (see section &<<SECTfildiropt>>&). The &%file%& option
23729 specifies a single file, to which the message is appended. One or more of
23730 &%use_fcntl_lock%&, &%use_flock_lock%&, or &%use_lockfile%& must be set with
23733 The result of expansion must not be tainted, unless the &%create_file%& option
23736 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
23737 .cindex "locking files"
23738 .cindex "lock files"
23739 If you are using more than one host to deliver over NFS into the same
23740 mailboxes, you should always use lock files.
23742 The string value is expanded for each delivery, and must yield an absolute
23743 path. The most common settings of this option are variations on one of these
23746 file = /var/spool/mail/$local_part_data
23747 file = /home/$local_part_data/inbox
23750 .cindex "&""sticky""& bit"
23751 In the first example, all deliveries are done into the same directory. If Exim
23752 is configured to use lock files (see &%use_lockfile%& below) it must be able to
23753 create a file in the directory, so the &"sticky"& bit must be turned on for
23754 deliveries to be possible, or alternatively the &%group%& option can be used to
23755 run the delivery under a group id which has write access to the directory.
23759 .option file_format appendfile string unset
23760 .cindex "file" "mailbox; checking existing format"
23761 This option requests the transport to check the format of an existing file
23762 before adding to it. The check consists of matching a specific string at the
23763 start of the file. The value of the option consists of an even number of
23764 colon-separated strings. The first of each pair is the test string, and the
23765 second is the name of a transport. If the transport associated with a matched
23766 string is not the current transport, control is passed over to the other
23767 transport. For example, suppose the standard &(local_delivery)& transport has
23770 file_format = "From : local_delivery :\
23771 \1\1\1\1\n : local_mmdf_delivery"
23773 Mailboxes that begin with &"From"& are still handled by this transport, but if
23774 a mailbox begins with four binary ones followed by a newline, control is passed
23775 to a transport called &%local_mmdf_delivery%&, which presumably is configured
23776 to do the delivery in MMDF format. If a mailbox does not exist or is empty, it
23777 is assumed to match the current transport. If the start of a mailbox doesn't
23778 match any string, or if the transport named for a given string is not defined,
23779 delivery is deferred.
23782 .option file_must_exist appendfile boolean false
23783 If this option is true, the file specified by the &%file%& option must exist.
23784 A temporary error occurs if it does not, causing delivery to be deferred.
23785 If this option is false, the file is created if it does not exist.
23788 .option lock_fcntl_timeout appendfile time 0s
23789 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23790 .cindex "mailbox" "locking, blocking and non-blocking"
23791 .cindex "locking files"
23792 By default, the &(appendfile)& transport uses non-blocking calls to &[fcntl()]&
23793 when locking an open mailbox file. If the call fails, the delivery process
23794 sleeps for &%lock_interval%& and tries again, up to &%lock_retries%& times.
23795 Non-blocking calls are used so that the file is not kept open during the wait
23796 for the lock; the reason for this is to make it as safe as possible for
23797 deliveries over NFS in the case when processes might be accessing an NFS
23798 mailbox without using a lock file. This should not be done, but
23799 misunderstandings and hence misconfigurations are not unknown.
23801 On a busy system, however, the performance of a non-blocking lock approach is
23802 not as good as using a blocking lock with a timeout. In this case, the waiting
23803 is done inside the system call, and Exim's delivery process acquires the lock
23804 and can proceed as soon as the previous lock holder releases it.
23806 If &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set to a non-zero time, blocking locks, with that
23807 timeout, are used. There may still be some retrying: the maximum number of
23810 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / lock_fcntl_timeout
23812 rounded up to the next whole number. In other words, the total time during
23813 which &(appendfile)& is trying to get a lock is roughly the same, unless
23814 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& is set very large.
23816 You should consider setting this option if you are getting a lot of delayed
23817 local deliveries because of errors of the form
23819 failed to lock mailbox /some/file (fcntl)
23822 .option lock_flock_timeout appendfile time 0s
23823 This timeout applies to file locking when using &[flock()]& (see
23824 &%use_flock%&); the timeout operates in a similar manner to
23825 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%&.
23828 .option lock_interval appendfile time 3s
23829 This specifies the time to wait between attempts to lock the file. See below
23830 for details of locking.
23833 .option lock_retries appendfile integer 10
23834 This specifies the maximum number of attempts to lock the file. A value of zero
23835 is treated as 1. See below for details of locking.
23838 .option lockfile_mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
23839 This specifies the mode of the created lock file, when a lock file is being
23840 used (see &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_mbx_lock%&).
23843 .option lockfile_timeout appendfile time 30m
23844 .cindex "timeout" "mailbox locking"
23845 When a lock file is being used (see &%use_lockfile%&), if a lock file already
23846 exists and is older than this value, it is assumed to have been left behind by
23847 accident, and Exim attempts to remove it.
23850 .option mailbox_filecount appendfile string&!! unset
23851 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23852 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23853 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23854 number of files in the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally
23855 followed by K or M. This provides a way of obtaining this information from an
23856 external source that maintains the data.
23859 .option mailbox_size appendfile string&!! unset
23860 .cindex "mailbox" "specifying size of"
23861 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
23862 If this option is set, it is expanded, and the result is taken as the current
23863 size the mailbox. It must be a decimal number, optionally followed by K or M.
23864 This provides a way of obtaining this information from an external source that
23865 maintains the data. This is likely to be helpful for maildir deliveries where
23866 it is computationally expensive to compute the size of a mailbox.
23870 .option maildir_format appendfile boolean false
23871 .cindex "maildir format" "specifying"
23872 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into a new
23873 file, in the &"maildir"& format that is used by other mail software. When the
23874 transport is activated directly from a &(redirect)& router (for example, the
23875 &(address_file)& transport in the default configuration), setting
23876 &%maildir_format%& causes the path received from the router to be treated as a
23877 directory, whether or not it ends with &`/`&. This option is available only if
23878 SUPPORT_MAILDIR is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section
23879 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23882 .option maildir_quota_directory_regex appendfile string "See below"
23883 .cindex "maildir format" "quota; directories included in"
23884 .cindex "quota" "maildir; directories included in"
23885 This option is relevant only when &%maildir_use_size_file%& is set. It defines
23886 a regular expression for specifying directories, relative to the quota
23887 directory (see &%quota_directory%&), that should be included in the quota
23888 calculation. The default value is:
23890 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\..*)$
23892 This includes the &_cur_& and &_new_& directories, and any maildir++ folders
23893 (directories whose names begin with a dot). If you want to exclude the
23895 folder from the count (as some sites do), you need to change this setting to
23897 maildir_quota_directory_regex = ^(?:cur|new|\.(?!Trash).*)$
23899 This uses a negative lookahead in the regular expression to exclude the
23900 directory whose name is &_.Trash_&. When a directory is excluded from quota
23901 calculations, quota processing is bypassed for any messages that are delivered
23902 directly into that directory.
23905 .option maildir_retries appendfile integer 10
23906 This option specifies the number of times to retry when writing a file in
23907 &"maildir"& format. See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23910 .option maildir_tag appendfile string&!! unset
23911 This option applies only to deliveries in maildir format, and is described in
23912 section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below.
23915 .option maildir_use_size_file appendfile&!! boolean false
23916 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
23917 The result of string expansion for this option must be a valid boolean value.
23918 If it is true, it enables support for &_maildirsize_& files. Exim
23919 creates a &_maildirsize_& file in a maildir if one does not exist, taking the
23920 quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If &%quota%& is unset, the
23921 value is zero. See &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& above and section
23922 &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& below for further details.
23924 .option maildirfolder_create_regex appendfile string unset
23925 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirfolder_& file"
23926 .cindex "&_maildirfolder_&, creating"
23927 The value of this option is a regular expression. If it is unset, it has no
23928 effect. Otherwise, before a maildir delivery takes place, the pattern is
23929 matched against the name of the maildir directory, that is, the directory
23930 containing the &_new_& and &_tmp_& subdirectories that will be used for the
23931 delivery. If there is a match, Exim checks for the existence of a file called
23932 &_maildirfolder_& in the directory, and creates it if it does not exist.
23933 See section &<<SECTmaildirdelivery>>& for more details.
23936 .option mailstore_format appendfile boolean false
23937 .cindex "mailstore format" "specifying"
23938 If this option is set with the &%directory%& option, the delivery is into two
23939 new files in &"mailstore"& format. The option is available only if
23940 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE is present in &_Local/Makefile_&. See section &<<SECTopdir>>&
23941 below for further details.
23944 .option mailstore_prefix appendfile string&!! unset
23945 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23946 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23949 .option mailstore_suffix appendfile string&!! unset
23950 This option applies only to deliveries in mailstore format, and is described in
23951 section &<<SECTopdir>>& below.
23954 .option mbx_format appendfile boolean false
23955 .cindex "locking files"
23956 .cindex "file" "locking"
23957 .cindex "file" "MBX format"
23958 .cindex "MBX format, specifying"
23959 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
23960 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. If &%mbx_format%& is set with the &%file%& option,
23961 the message is appended to the mailbox file in MBX format instead of
23962 traditional Unix format. This format is supported by Pine4 and its associated
23963 IMAP and POP daemons, by means of the &'c-client'& library that they all use.
23965 &*Note*&: The &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are not
23966 automatically changed by the use of &%mbx_format%&. They should normally be set
23967 empty when using MBX format, so this option almost always appears in this
23974 If none of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration,
23975 &%use_mbx_lock%& is assumed and the other locking options default to false. It
23976 is possible to specify the other kinds of locking with &%mbx_format%&, but
23977 &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_mbx_lock%& are mutually exclusive. MBX locking
23978 interworks with &'c-client'&, providing for shared access to the mailbox. It
23979 should not be used if any program that does not use this form of locking is
23980 going to access the mailbox, nor should it be used if the mailbox file is NFS
23981 mounted, because it works only when the mailbox is accessed from a single host.
23983 If you set &%use_fcntl_lock%& with an MBX-format mailbox, you cannot use
23984 the standard version of &'c-client'&, because as long as it has a mailbox open
23985 (this means for the whole of a Pine or IMAP session), Exim will not be able to
23986 append messages to it.
23989 .option message_prefix appendfile string&!! "see below"
23990 .cindex "&""From""& line"
23991 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
23992 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
23993 in which case it is:
23995 message_prefix = "From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}\
23996 {MAILER-DAEMON}} $tod_bsdinbox\n"
23998 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
23999 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
24001 .option message_suffix appendfile string&!! "see below"
24002 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
24003 The default is unset unless &%file%& is specified and &%use_bsmtp%& is not set,
24004 in which case it is a single newline character. The suffix can be suppressed by
24009 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
24010 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
24012 .option mode appendfile "octal integer" 0600
24013 If the output file is created, it is given this mode. If it already exists and
24014 has wider permissions, they are reduced to this mode. If it has narrower
24015 permissions, an error occurs unless &%mode_fail_narrower%& is false. However,
24016 if the delivery is the result of a &%save%& command in a filter file specifying
24017 a particular mode, the mode of the output file is always forced to take that
24018 value, and this option is ignored.
24021 .option mode_fail_narrower appendfile boolean true
24022 This option applies in the case when an existing mailbox file has a narrower
24023 mode than that specified by the &%mode%& option. If &%mode_fail_narrower%& is
24024 true, the delivery is deferred (&"mailbox has the wrong mode"&); otherwise Exim
24025 continues with the delivery attempt, using the existing mode of the file.
24028 .option notify_comsat appendfile boolean false
24029 If this option is true, the &'comsat'& daemon is notified after every
24030 successful delivery to a user mailbox. This is the daemon that notifies logged
24031 on users about incoming mail.
24034 .option quota appendfile string&!! unset
24035 .cindex "quota" "imposed by Exim"
24036 This option imposes a limit on the size of the file to which Exim is appending,
24037 or to the total space used in the directory tree when the &%directory%& option
24038 is set. In the latter case, computation of the space used is expensive, because
24039 all the files in the directory (and any sub-directories) have to be
24040 individually inspected and their sizes summed. (See &%quota_size_regex%& and
24041 &%maildir_use_size_file%& for ways to avoid this in environments where users
24042 have no shell access to their mailboxes).
24044 As there is no interlock against two simultaneous deliveries into a
24045 multi-file mailbox, it is possible for the quota to be overrun in this case.
24046 For single-file mailboxes, of course, an interlock is a necessity.
24048 A file's size is taken as its &'used'& value. Because of blocking effects, this
24049 may be a lot less than the actual amount of disk space allocated to the file.
24050 If the sizes of a number of files are being added up, the rounding effect can
24051 become quite noticeable, especially on systems that have large block sizes.
24052 Nevertheless, it seems best to stick to the &'used'& figure, because this is
24053 the obvious value which users understand most easily.
24055 The value of the option is expanded, and must then be a numerical value
24056 (decimal point allowed), optionally followed by one of the letters K, M, or G,
24057 for kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, optionally followed by a slash
24058 and further option modifiers. If Exim is running on a system with
24059 large file support (Linux and FreeBSD have this), mailboxes larger than 2G can
24062 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
24063 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
24065 &*Note*&: A value of zero is interpreted as &"no quota"&.
24067 The expansion happens while Exim is running as root, before it changes uid for
24068 the delivery. This means that files that are inaccessible to the end user can
24069 be used to hold quota values that are looked up in the expansion. When delivery
24070 fails because this quota is exceeded, the handling of the error is as for
24071 system quota failures.
24073 By default, Exim's quota checking mimics system quotas, and restricts the
24074 mailbox to the specified maximum size, though the value is not accurate to the
24075 last byte, owing to separator lines and additional headers that may get added
24076 during message delivery. When a mailbox is nearly full, large messages may get
24077 refused even though small ones are accepted, because the size of the current
24078 message is added to the quota when the check is made. This behaviour can be
24079 changed by setting &%quota_is_inclusive%& false. When this is done, the check
24080 for exceeding the quota does not include the current message. Thus, deliveries
24081 continue until the quota has been exceeded; thereafter, no further messages are
24082 delivered. See also &%quota_warn_threshold%&.
24085 .option quota_directory appendfile string&!! unset
24086 This option defines the directory to check for quota purposes when delivering
24087 into individual files. The default is the delivery directory, or, if a file
24088 called &_maildirfolder_& exists in a maildir directory, the parent of the
24089 delivery directory.
24092 .option quota_filecount appendfile string&!! 0
24093 This option applies when the &%directory%& option is set. It limits the total
24094 number of files in the directory (compare the inode limit in system quotas). It
24095 can only be used if &%quota%& is also set. The value is expanded; an expansion
24096 failure causes delivery to be deferred. A value of zero is interpreted as
24099 The option modifier &%no_check%& can be used to force delivery even if the over
24100 quota condition is met. The quota gets updated as usual.
24102 .option quota_is_inclusive appendfile boolean true
24103 See &%quota%& above.
24106 .option quota_size_regex appendfile string unset
24107 This option applies when one of the delivery modes that writes a separate file
24108 for each message is being used. When Exim wants to find the size of one of
24109 these files in order to test the quota, it first checks &%quota_size_regex%&.
24110 If this is set to a regular expression that matches the filename, and it
24111 captures one string, that string is interpreted as a representation of the
24112 file's size. The value of &%quota_size_regex%& is not expanded.
24114 This feature is useful only when users have no shell access to their mailboxes
24115 &-- otherwise they could defeat the quota simply by renaming the files. This
24116 facility can be used with maildir deliveries, by setting &%maildir_tag%& to add
24117 the file length to the filename. For example:
24119 maildir_tag = ,S=$message_size
24120 quota_size_regex = ,S=(\d+)
24122 An alternative to &$message_size$& is &$message_linecount$&, which contains the
24123 number of lines in the message.
24125 The regular expression should not assume that the length is at the end of the
24126 filename (even though &%maildir_tag%& puts it there) because maildir MUAs
24127 sometimes add other information onto the ends of message filenames.
24129 Section &<<SECID136>>& contains further information.
24131 This option should not be used when other message-handling software
24132 may duplicate messages by making hardlinks to the files. When that is done Exim
24133 will count the message size once for each filename, in contrast with the actual
24134 disk usage. When the option is not set, calculating total usage requires
24135 a system-call per file to get the size; the number of links is then available also
24136 as is used to adjust the effective size.
24139 .option quota_warn_message appendfile string&!! "see below"
24140 See below for the use of this option. If it is not set when
24141 &%quota_warn_threshold%& is set, it defaults to
24143 quota_warn_message = "\
24144 To: $local_part@$domain\n\
24145 Subject: Your mailbox\n\n\
24146 This message is automatically created \
24147 by mail delivery software.\n\n\
24148 The size of your mailbox has exceeded \
24149 a warning threshold that is\n\
24150 set by the system administrator.\n"
24154 .option quota_warn_threshold appendfile string&!! 0
24155 .cindex "quota" "warning threshold"
24156 .cindex "mailbox" "size warning"
24157 .cindex "size" "of mailbox"
24158 This option is expanded in the same way as &%quota%& (see above). If the
24159 resulting value is greater than zero, and delivery of the message causes the
24160 size of the file or total space in the directory tree to cross the given
24161 threshold, a warning message is sent. If &%quota%& is also set, the threshold
24162 may be specified as a percentage of it by following the value with a percent
24166 quota_warn_threshold = 75%
24168 If &%quota%& is not set, a setting of &%quota_warn_threshold%& that ends with a
24169 percent sign is ignored.
24171 The warning message itself is specified by the &%quota_warn_message%& option,
24172 and it must start with a &'To:'& header line containing the recipient(s) of the
24173 warning message. These do not necessarily have to include the recipient(s) of
24174 the original message. A &'Subject:'& line should also normally be supplied. You
24175 can include any other header lines that you want. If you do not include a
24176 &'From:'& line, the default is:
24178 From: Mail Delivery System <mailer-daemon@$qualify_domain_sender>
24180 .oindex &%errors_reply_to%&
24181 If you supply a &'Reply-To:'& line, it overrides the global &%errors_reply_to%&
24184 The &%quota%& option does not have to be set in order to use this option; they
24185 are independent of one another except when the threshold is specified as a
24189 .option use_bsmtp appendfile boolean false
24190 .cindex "envelope from"
24191 .cindex "envelope sender"
24192 If this option is set true, &(appendfile)& writes messages in &"batch SMTP"&
24193 format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP commands. If
24194 you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages, you can do
24195 so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&
24196 for details of batch SMTP.
24199 .option use_crlf appendfile boolean false
24200 .cindex "carriage return"
24202 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
24203 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
24204 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the file is then an exact image
24205 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
24207 &*Note:*& The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options
24208 (which are used to supply the traditional &"From&~"& and blank line separators
24209 in Berkeley-style mailboxes) are written verbatim, so must contain their own
24210 carriage return characters if these are needed. In cases where these options
24211 have non-empty defaults, the values end with a single linefeed, so they must be
24212 changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
24215 .option use_fcntl_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
24216 This option controls the use of the &[fcntl()]& function to lock a file for
24217 exclusive use when a message is being appended. It is set by default unless
24218 &%use_flock_lock%& is set. Otherwise, it should be turned off only if you know
24219 that all your MUAs use lock file locking. When both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
24220 &%use_flock_lock%& are unset, &%use_lockfile%& must be set.
24223 .option use_flock_lock appendfile boolean false
24224 This option is provided to support the use of &[flock()]& for file locking, for
24225 the few situations where it is needed. Most modern operating systems support
24226 &[fcntl()]& and &[lockf()]& locking, and these two functions interwork with
24227 each other. Exim uses &[fcntl()]& locking by default.
24229 This option is required only if you are using an operating system where
24230 &[flock()]& is used by programs that access mailboxes (typically MUAs), and
24231 where &[flock()]& does not correctly interwork with &[fcntl()]&. You can use
24232 both &[fcntl()]& and &[flock()]& locking simultaneously if you want.
24234 .cindex "Solaris" "&[flock()]& support"
24235 Not all operating systems provide &[flock()]&. Some versions of Solaris do not
24236 have it (and some, I think, provide a not quite right version built on top of
24237 &[lockf()]&). If the OS does not have &[flock()]&, Exim will be built without
24238 the ability to use it, and any attempt to do so will cause a configuration
24241 &*Warning*&: &[flock()]& locks do not work on NFS files (unless &[flock()]&
24242 is just being mapped onto &[fcntl()]& by the OS).
24245 .option use_lockfile appendfile boolean "see below"
24246 If this option is turned off, Exim does not attempt to create a lock file when
24247 appending to a mailbox file. In this situation, the only locking is by
24248 &[fcntl()]&. You should only turn &%use_lockfile%& off if you are absolutely
24249 sure that every MUA that is ever going to look at your users' mailboxes uses
24250 &[fcntl()]& rather than a lock file, and even then only when you are not
24251 delivering over NFS from more than one host.
24253 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
24254 In order to append to an NFS file safely from more than one host, it is
24255 necessary to take out a lock &'before'& opening the file, and the lock file
24256 achieves this. Otherwise, even with &[fcntl()]& locking, there is a risk of
24259 The &%use_lockfile%& option is set by default unless &%use_mbx_lock%& is set.
24260 It is not possible to turn both &%use_lockfile%& and &%use_fcntl_lock%& off,
24261 except when &%mbx_format%& is set.
24264 .option use_mbx_lock appendfile boolean "see below"
24265 This option is available only if Exim has been compiled with SUPPORT_MBX
24266 set in &_Local/Makefile_&. Setting the option specifies that special MBX
24267 locking rules be used. It is set by default if &%mbx_format%& is set and none
24268 of the locking options are mentioned in the configuration. The locking rules
24269 are the same as are used by the &'c-client'& library that underlies Pine and
24270 the IMAP4 and POP daemons that come with it (see the discussion below). The
24271 rules allow for shared access to the mailbox. However, this kind of locking
24272 does not work when the mailbox is NFS mounted.
24274 You can set &%use_mbx_lock%& with either (or both) of &%use_fcntl_lock%& and
24275 &%use_flock_lock%& to control what kind of locking is used in implementing the
24276 MBX locking rules. The default is to use &[fcntl()]& if &%use_mbx_lock%& is set
24277 without &%use_fcntl_lock%& or &%use_flock_lock%&.
24282 .section "Operational details for appending" "SECTopappend"
24283 .cindex "appending to a file"
24284 .cindex "file" "appending"
24285 Before appending to a file, the following preparations are made:
24288 If the name of the file is &_/dev/null_&, no action is taken, and a success
24292 .cindex "directory creation"
24293 If any directories on the file's path are missing, Exim creates them if the
24294 &%create_directory%& option is set. A created directory's mode is given by the
24295 &%directory_mode%& option.
24298 If &%file_format%& is set, the format of an existing file is checked. If this
24299 indicates that a different transport should be used, control is passed to that
24303 .cindex "file" "locking"
24304 .cindex "locking files"
24305 .cindex "NFS" "lock file"
24306 If &%use_lockfile%& is set, a lock file is built in a way that will work
24307 reliably over NFS, as follows:
24310 Create a &"hitching post"& file whose name is that of the lock file with the
24311 current time, primary host name, and process id added, by opening for writing
24312 as a new file. If this fails with an access error, delivery is deferred.
24314 Close the hitching post file, and hard link it to the lock filename.
24316 If the call to &[link()]& succeeds, creation of the lock file has succeeded.
24317 Unlink the hitching post name.
24319 Otherwise, use &[stat()]& to get information about the hitching post file, and
24320 then unlink hitching post name. If the number of links is exactly two, creation
24321 of the lock file succeeded but something (for example, an NFS server crash and
24322 restart) caused this fact not to be communicated to the &[link()]& call.
24324 If creation of the lock file failed, wait for &%lock_interval%& and try again,
24325 up to &%lock_retries%& times. However, since any program that writes to a
24326 mailbox should complete its task very quickly, it is reasonable to time out old
24327 lock files that are normally the result of user agent and system crashes. If an
24328 existing lock file is older than &%lockfile_timeout%& Exim attempts to unlink
24329 it before trying again.
24333 A call is made to &[lstat()]& to discover whether the main file exists, and if
24334 so, what its characteristics are. If &[lstat()]& fails for any reason other
24335 than non-existence, delivery is deferred.
24338 .cindex "symbolic link" "to mailbox"
24339 .cindex "mailbox" "symbolic link"
24340 If the file does exist and is a symbolic link, delivery is deferred, unless the
24341 &%allow_symlink%& option is set, in which case the ownership of the link is
24342 checked, and then &[stat()]& is called to find out about the real file, which
24343 is then subjected to the checks below. The check on the top-level link
24344 ownership prevents one user creating a link for another's mailbox in a sticky
24345 directory, though allowing symbolic links in this case is definitely not a good
24346 idea. If there is a chain of symbolic links, the intermediate ones are not
24350 If the file already exists but is not a regular file, or if the file's owner
24351 and group (if the group is being checked &-- see &%check_group%& above) are
24352 different from the user and group under which the delivery is running,
24353 delivery is deferred.
24356 If the file's permissions are more generous than specified, they are reduced.
24357 If they are insufficient, delivery is deferred, unless &%mode_fail_narrower%&
24358 is set false, in which case the delivery is tried using the existing
24362 The file's inode number is saved, and the file is then opened for appending.
24363 If this fails because the file has vanished, &(appendfile)& behaves as if it
24364 hadn't existed (see below). For any other failures, delivery is deferred.
24367 If the file is opened successfully, check that the inode number hasn't
24368 changed, that it is still a regular file, and that the owner and permissions
24369 have not changed. If anything is wrong, defer delivery and freeze the message.
24372 If the file did not exist originally, defer delivery if the &%file_must_exist%&
24373 option is set. Otherwise, check that the file is being created in a permitted
24374 directory if the &%create_file%& option is set (deferring on failure), and then
24375 open for writing as a new file, with the O_EXCL and O_CREAT options,
24376 except when dealing with a symbolic link (the &%allow_symlink%& option must be
24377 set). In this case, which can happen if the link points to a non-existent file,
24378 the file is opened for writing using O_CREAT but not O_EXCL, because
24379 that prevents link following.
24382 .cindex "loop" "while file testing"
24383 If opening fails because the file exists, obey the tests given above for
24384 existing files. However, to avoid looping in a situation where the file is
24385 being continuously created and destroyed, the exists/not-exists loop is broken
24386 after 10 repetitions, and the message is then frozen.
24389 If opening fails with any other error, defer delivery.
24392 .cindex "file" "locking"
24393 .cindex "locking files"
24394 Once the file is open, unless both &%use_fcntl_lock%& and &%use_flock_lock%&
24395 are false, it is locked using &[fcntl()]& or &[flock()]& or both. If
24396 &%use_mbx_lock%& is false, an exclusive lock is requested in each case.
24397 However, if &%use_mbx_lock%& is true, Exim takes out a shared lock on the open
24398 file, and an exclusive lock on the file whose name is
24400 /tmp/.<device-number>.<inode-number>
24402 using the device and inode numbers of the open mailbox file, in accordance with
24403 the MBX locking rules. This file is created with a mode that is specified by
24404 the &%lockfile_mode%& option.
24406 If Exim fails to lock the file, there are two possible courses of action,
24407 depending on the value of the locking timeout. This is obtained from
24408 &%lock_fcntl_timeout%& or &%lock_flock_timeout%&, as appropriate.
24410 If the timeout value is zero, the file is closed, Exim waits for
24411 &%lock_interval%&, and then goes back and re-opens the file as above and tries
24412 to lock it again. This happens up to &%lock_retries%& times, after which the
24413 delivery is deferred.
24415 If the timeout has a value greater than zero, blocking calls to &[fcntl()]& or
24416 &[flock()]& are used (with the given timeout), so there has already been some
24417 waiting involved by the time locking fails. Nevertheless, Exim does not give up
24418 immediately. It retries up to
24420 (lock_retries * lock_interval) / <timeout>
24422 times (rounded up).
24425 At the end of delivery, Exim closes the file (which releases the &[fcntl()]&
24426 and/or &[flock()]& locks) and then deletes the lock file if one was created.
24429 .section "Operational details for delivery to a new file" "SECTopdir"
24430 .cindex "delivery" "to single file"
24431 .cindex "&""From""& line"
24432 When the &%directory%& option is set instead of &%file%&, each message is
24433 delivered into a newly-created file or set of files. When &(appendfile)& is
24434 activated directly from a &(redirect)& router, neither &%file%& nor
24435 &%directory%& is normally set, because the path for delivery is supplied by the
24436 router. (See for example, the &(address_file)& transport in the default
24437 configuration.) In this case, delivery is to a new file if either the path name
24438 ends in &`/`&, or the &%maildir_format%& or &%mailstore_format%& option is set.
24440 No locking is required while writing the message to a new file, so the various
24441 locking options of the transport are ignored. The &"From"& line that by default
24442 separates messages in a single file is not normally needed, nor is the escaping
24443 of message lines that start with &"From"&, and there is no need to ensure a
24444 newline at the end of each message. Consequently, the default values for
24445 &%check_string%&, &%message_prefix%&, and &%message_suffix%& are all unset when
24446 any of &%directory%&, &%maildir_format%&, or &%mailstore_format%& is set.
24448 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting, it adds up the sizes of all
24449 the files in the delivery directory by default. However, you can specify a
24450 different directory by setting &%quota_directory%&. Also, for maildir
24451 deliveries (see below) the &_maildirfolder_& convention is honoured.
24454 .cindex "maildir format"
24455 .cindex "mailstore format"
24456 There are three different ways in which delivery to individual files can be
24457 done, controlled by the settings of the &%maildir_format%& and
24458 &%mailstore_format%& options. Note that code to support maildir or mailstore
24459 formats is not included in the binary unless SUPPORT_MAILDIR or
24460 SUPPORT_MAILSTORE, respectively, is set in &_Local/Makefile_&.
24462 .cindex "directory creation"
24463 In all three cases an attempt is made to create the directory and any necessary
24464 sub-directories if they do not exist, provided that the &%create_directory%&
24465 option is set (the default). The location of a created directory can be
24466 constrained by setting &%create_file%&. A created directory's mode is given by
24467 the &%directory_mode%& option. If creation fails, or if the
24468 &%create_directory%& option is not set when creation is required, delivery is
24473 .section "Maildir delivery" "SECTmaildirdelivery"
24474 .cindex "maildir format" "description of"
24475 If the &%maildir_format%& option is true, Exim delivers each message by writing
24476 it to a file whose name is &_tmp/<stime>.H<mtime>P<pid>.<host>_& in the
24477 directory that is defined by the &%directory%& option (the &"delivery
24478 directory"&). If the delivery is successful, the file is renamed into the
24479 &_new_& subdirectory.
24481 In the filename, <&'stime'&> is the current time of day in seconds, and
24482 <&'mtime'&> is the microsecond fraction of the time. After a maildir delivery,
24483 Exim checks that the time-of-day clock has moved on by at least one microsecond
24484 before terminating the delivery process. This guarantees uniqueness for the
24485 filename. However, as a precaution, Exim calls &[stat()]& for the file before
24486 opening it. If any response other than ENOENT (does not exist) is given,
24487 Exim waits 2 seconds and tries again, up to &%maildir_retries%& times.
24489 Before Exim carries out a maildir delivery, it ensures that subdirectories
24490 called &_new_&, &_cur_&, and &_tmp_& exist in the delivery directory. If they
24491 do not exist, Exim tries to create them and any superior directories in their
24492 path, subject to the &%create_directory%& and &%create_file%& options. If the
24493 &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& option is set, and the regular expression it
24494 contains matches the delivery directory, Exim also ensures that a file called
24495 &_maildirfolder_& exists in the delivery directory. If a missing directory or
24496 &_maildirfolder_& file cannot be created, delivery is deferred.
24498 These features make it possible to use Exim to create all the necessary files
24499 and directories in a maildir mailbox, including subdirectories for maildir++
24500 folders. Consider this example:
24502 maildir_format = true
24503 directory = /var/mail/$local_part_data\
24504 ${if eq{$local_part_suffix}{}{}\
24505 {/.${substr_1:$local_part_suffix}}}
24506 maildirfolder_create_regex = /\.[^/]+$
24508 If &$local_part_suffix$& is empty (there was no suffix for the local part),
24509 delivery is into a toplevel maildir with a name like &_/var/mail/pimbo_& (for
24510 the user called &'pimbo'&). The pattern in &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& does
24511 not match this name, so Exim will not look for or create the file
24512 &_/var/mail/pimbo/maildirfolder_&, though it will create
24513 &_/var/mail/pimbo/{cur,new,tmp}_& if necessary.
24515 However, if &$local_part_suffix$& contains &`-eximusers`& (for example),
24516 delivery is into the maildir++ folder &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers_&, which
24517 does match &%maildirfolder_create_regex%&. In this case, Exim will create
24518 &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/maildirfolder_& as well as the three maildir
24519 directories &_/var/mail/pimbo/.eximusers/{cur,new,tmp}_&.
24521 &*Warning:*& Take care when setting &%maildirfolder_create_regex%& that it does
24522 not inadvertently match the toplevel maildir directory, because a
24523 &_maildirfolder_& file at top level would completely break quota calculations.
24525 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24526 .cindex "maildir++"
24527 If Exim is required to check a &%quota%& setting before a maildir delivery, and
24528 &%quota_directory%& is not set, it looks for a file called &_maildirfolder_& in
24529 the maildir directory (alongside &_new_&, &_cur_&, &_tmp_&). If this exists,
24530 Exim assumes the directory is a maildir++ folder directory, which is one level
24531 down from the user's top level mailbox directory. This causes it to start at
24532 the parent directory instead of the current directory when calculating the
24533 amount of space used.
24535 One problem with delivering into a multi-file mailbox is that it is
24536 computationally expensive to compute the size of the mailbox for quota
24537 checking. Various approaches have been taken to reduce the amount of work
24538 needed. The next two sections describe two of them. A third alternative is to
24539 use some external process for maintaining the size data, and use the expansion
24540 of the &%mailbox_size%& option as a way of importing it into Exim.
24545 .section "Using tags to record message sizes" "SECID135"
24546 If &%maildir_tag%& is set, the string is expanded for each delivery.
24547 When the maildir file is renamed into the &_new_& sub-directory, the
24548 tag is added to its name. However, if adding the tag takes the length of the
24549 name to the point where the test &[stat()]& call fails with ENAMETOOLONG,
24550 the tag is dropped and the maildir file is created with no tag.
24553 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
24554 Tags can be used to encode the size of files in their names; see
24555 &%quota_size_regex%& above for an example. The expansion of &%maildir_tag%&
24556 happens after the message has been written. The value of the &$message_size$&
24557 variable is set to the number of bytes actually written. If the expansion is
24558 forced to fail, the tag is ignored, but a non-forced failure causes delivery to
24559 be deferred. The expanded tag may contain any printing characters except &"/"&.
24560 Non-printing characters in the string are ignored; if the resulting string is
24561 empty, it is ignored. If it starts with an alphanumeric character, a leading
24562 colon is inserted; this default has not proven to be the path that popular
24563 maildir implementations have chosen (but changing it in Exim would break
24564 backwards compatibility).
24566 For one common implementation, you might set:
24568 maildir_tag = ,S=${message_size}
24570 but you should check the documentation of the other software to be sure.
24572 It is advisable to also set &%quota_size_regex%& when setting &%maildir_tag%&
24573 as this allows Exim to extract the size from your tag, instead of having to
24574 &[stat()]& each message file.
24577 .section "Using a maildirsize file" "SECID136"
24578 .cindex "quota" "in maildir delivery"
24579 .cindex "maildir format" "&_maildirsize_& file"
24580 If &%maildir_use_size_file%& is true, Exim implements the maildir++ rules for
24581 storing quota and message size information in a file called &_maildirsize_&
24582 within the toplevel maildir directory. If this file does not exist, Exim
24583 creates it, setting the quota from the &%quota%& option of the transport. If
24584 the maildir directory itself does not exist, it is created before any attempt
24585 to write a &_maildirsize_& file.
24587 The &_maildirsize_& file is used to hold information about the sizes of
24588 messages in the maildir, thus speeding up quota calculations. The quota value
24589 in the file is just a cache; if the quota is changed in the transport, the new
24590 value overrides the cached value when the next message is delivered. The cache
24591 is maintained for the benefit of other programs that access the maildir and
24592 need to know the quota.
24594 If the &%quota%& option in the transport is unset or zero, the &_maildirsize_&
24595 file is maintained (with a zero quota setting), but no quota is imposed.
24597 A regular expression is available for controlling which directories in the
24598 maildir participate in quota calculations when a &_maildirsizefile_& is in use.
24599 See the description of the &%maildir_quota_directory_regex%& option above for
24603 .section "Mailstore delivery" "SECID137"
24604 .cindex "mailstore format" "description of"
24605 If the &%mailstore_format%& option is true, each message is written as two
24606 files in the given directory. A unique base name is constructed from the
24607 message id and the current delivery process, and the files that are written use
24608 this base name plus the suffixes &_.env_& and &_.msg_&. The &_.env_& file
24609 contains the message's envelope, and the &_.msg_& file contains the message
24610 itself. The base name is placed in the variable &$mailstore_basename$&.
24612 During delivery, the envelope is first written to a file with the suffix
24613 &_.tmp_&. The &_.msg_& file is then written, and when it is complete, the
24614 &_.tmp_& file is renamed as the &_.env_& file. Programs that access messages in
24615 mailstore format should wait for the presence of both a &_.msg_& and a &_.env_&
24616 file before accessing either of them. An alternative approach is to wait for
24617 the absence of a &_.tmp_& file.
24619 The envelope file starts with any text defined by the &%mailstore_prefix%&
24620 option, expanded and terminated by a newline if there isn't one. Then follows
24621 the sender address on one line, then all the recipient addresses, one per line.
24622 There can be more than one recipient only if the &%batch_max%& option is set
24623 greater than one. Finally, &%mailstore_suffix%& is expanded and the result
24624 appended to the file, followed by a newline if it does not end with one.
24626 If expansion of &%mailstore_prefix%& or &%mailstore_suffix%& ends with a forced
24627 failure, it is ignored. Other expansion errors are treated as serious
24628 configuration errors, and delivery is deferred. The variable
24629 &$mailstore_basename$& is available for use during these expansions.
24632 .section "Non-special new file delivery" "SECID138"
24633 If neither &%maildir_format%& nor &%mailstore_format%& is set, a single new
24634 file is created directly in the named directory. For example, when delivering
24635 messages into files in batched SMTP format for later delivery to some host (see
24636 section &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>&), a setting such as
24638 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
24640 might be used. A message is written to a file with a temporary name, which is
24641 then renamed when the delivery is complete. The final name is obtained by
24642 expanding the contents of the &%directory_file%& option.
24643 .ecindex IIDapptra1
24644 .ecindex IIDapptra2
24651 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24652 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24654 .chapter "The autoreply transport" "CHID8"
24655 .scindex IIDauttra1 "transports" "&(autoreply)&"
24656 .scindex IIDauttra2 "&(autoreply)& transport"
24657 The &(autoreply)& transport is not a true transport in that it does not cause
24658 the message to be transmitted. Instead, it generates a new mail message as an
24659 automatic reply to the incoming message. &'References:'& and
24660 &'Auto-Submitted:'& header lines are included. These are constructed according
24661 to the rules in RFCs
24662 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,2822) and
24663 &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc3834,3834), respectively.
24665 If the router that passes the message to this transport does not have the
24666 &%unseen%& option set, the original message (for the current recipient) is not
24667 delivered anywhere. However, when the &%unseen%& option is set on the router
24668 that passes the message to this transport, routing of the address continues, so
24669 another router can set up a normal message delivery.
24672 The &(autoreply)& transport is usually run as the result of mail filtering, a
24673 &"vacation"& message being the standard example. However, it can also be run
24674 directly from a router like any other transport. To reduce the possibility of
24675 message cascades, messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport always have
24676 empty envelope sender addresses, like bounce messages.
24678 The parameters of the message to be sent can be specified in the configuration
24679 by options described below. However, these are used only when the address
24680 passed to the transport does not contain its own reply information. When the
24681 transport is run as a consequence of a
24683 or &%vacation%& command in a filter file, the parameters of the message are
24684 supplied by the filter, and passed with the address. The transport's options
24685 that define the message are then ignored (so they are not usually set in this
24686 case). The message is specified entirely by the filter or by the transport; it
24687 is never built from a mixture of options. However, the &%file_optional%&,
24688 &%mode%&, and &%return_message%& options apply in all cases.
24690 &(Autoreply)& is implemented as a local transport. When used as a result of a
24691 command in a user's filter file, &(autoreply)& normally runs under the uid and
24692 gid of the user, and with appropriate current and home directories (see chapter
24693 &<<CHAPenvironment>>&).
24695 There is a subtle difference between routing a message to a &(pipe)& transport
24696 that generates some text to be returned to the sender, and routing it to an
24697 &(autoreply)& transport. This difference is noticeable only if more than one
24698 address from the same message is so handled. In the case of a pipe, the
24699 separate outputs from the different addresses are gathered up and returned to
24700 the sender in a single message, whereas if &(autoreply)& is used, a separate
24701 message is generated for each address that is passed to it.
24703 Non-printing characters are not permitted in the header lines generated for the
24704 message that &(autoreply)& creates, with the exception of newlines that are
24705 immediately followed by white space. If any non-printing characters are found,
24706 the transport defers.
24707 Whether characters with the top bit set count as printing characters or not is
24708 controlled by the &%print_topbitchars%& global option.
24710 If any of the generic options for manipulating headers (for example,
24711 &%headers_add%&) are set on an &(autoreply)& transport, they apply to the copy
24712 of the original message that is included in the generated message when
24713 &%return_message%& is set. They do not apply to the generated message itself.
24715 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
24716 If the &(autoreply)& transport receives return code 2 from Exim when it submits
24717 the message, indicating that there were no recipients, it does not treat this
24718 as an error. This means that autoreplies sent to &$sender_address$& when this
24719 is empty (because the incoming message is a bounce message) do not cause
24720 problems. They are just discarded.
24724 .section "Private options for autoreply" "SECID139"
24725 .cindex "options" "&(autoreply)& transport"
24727 .option bcc autoreply string&!! unset
24728 This specifies the addresses that are to receive &"blind carbon copies"& of the
24729 message when the message is specified by the transport.
24732 .option cc autoreply string&!! unset
24733 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'Cc:'& header
24734 when the message is specified by the transport.
24737 .option file autoreply string&!! unset
24738 The contents of the file are sent as the body of the message when the message
24739 is specified by the transport. If both &%file%& and &%text%& are set, the text
24740 string comes first.
24743 .option file_expand autoreply boolean false
24744 If this is set, the contents of the file named by the &%file%& option are
24745 subjected to string expansion as they are added to the message.
24748 .option file_optional autoreply boolean false
24749 If this option is true, no error is generated if the file named by the &%file%&
24750 option or passed with the address does not exist or cannot be read.
24753 .option from autoreply string&!! unset
24754 This specifies the contents of the &'From:'& header when the message is
24755 specified by the transport.
24758 .option headers autoreply string&!! unset
24759 This specifies additional
24760 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
24761 headers that are to be added to the message
24762 when the message is specified by the transport. Several can be given by using
24763 &"\n"& to separate them. There is no check on the format.
24766 .option log autoreply string&!! unset
24767 This option names a file in which a record of every message sent is logged when
24768 the message is specified by the transport.
24771 .option mode autoreply "octal integer" 0600
24772 If either the log file or the &"once"& file has to be created, this mode is
24776 .option never_mail autoreply "address list&!!" unset
24777 If any run of the transport creates a message with a recipient that matches any
24778 item in the list, that recipient is quietly discarded. If all recipients are
24779 discarded, no message is created. This applies both when the recipients are
24780 generated by a filter and when they are specified in the transport.
24784 .option once autoreply string&!! unset
24785 This option names a file or DBM database in which a record of each &'To:'&
24786 recipient is kept when the message is specified by the transport. &*Note*&:
24787 This does not apply to &'Cc:'& or &'Bcc:'& recipients.
24789 If &%once%& is unset, or is set to an empty string, the message is always sent.
24790 By default, if &%once%& is set to a non-empty filename, the message
24791 is not sent if a potential recipient is already listed in the database.
24792 However, if the &%once_repeat%& option specifies a time greater than zero, the
24793 message is sent if that much time has elapsed since a message was last sent to
24794 this recipient. A setting of zero time for &%once_repeat%& (the default)
24795 prevents a message from being sent a second time &-- in this case, zero means
24798 If &%once_file_size%& is zero, a DBM database is used to remember recipients,
24799 and it is allowed to grow as large as necessary. If &%once_file_size%& is set
24800 greater than zero, it changes the way Exim implements the &%once%& option.
24801 Instead of using a DBM file to record every recipient it sends to, it uses a
24802 regular file, whose size will never get larger than the given value.
24804 In the file, Exim keeps a linear list of recipient addresses and the times at
24805 which they were sent messages. If the file is full when a new address needs to
24806 be added, the oldest address is dropped. If &%once_repeat%& is not set, this
24807 means that a given recipient may receive multiple messages, but at
24808 unpredictable intervals that depend on the rate of turnover of addresses in the
24809 file. If &%once_repeat%& is set, it specifies a maximum time between repeats.
24812 .option once_file_size autoreply integer 0
24813 See &%once%& above.
24816 .option once_repeat autoreply time&!! 0s
24817 See &%once%& above.
24818 After expansion, the value of this option must be a valid time value.
24821 .option reply_to autoreply string&!! unset
24822 This specifies the contents of the &'Reply-To:'& header when the message is
24823 specified by the transport.
24826 .option return_message autoreply boolean false
24827 If this is set, a copy of the original message is returned with the new
24828 message, subject to the maximum size set in the &%return_size_limit%& global
24829 configuration option.
24832 .option subject autoreply string&!! unset
24833 This specifies the contents of the &'Subject:'& header when the message is
24834 specified by the transport. It is tempting to quote the original subject in
24835 automatic responses. For example:
24837 subject = Re: $h_subject:
24839 There is a danger in doing this, however. It may allow a third party to
24840 subscribe your users to an opt-in mailing list, provided that the list accepts
24841 bounce messages as subscription confirmations. Well-managed lists require a
24842 non-bounce message to confirm a subscription, so the danger is relatively
24847 .option text autoreply string&!! unset
24848 This specifies a single string to be used as the body of the message when the
24849 message is specified by the transport. If both &%text%& and &%file%& are set,
24850 the text comes first.
24853 .option to autoreply string&!! unset
24854 This specifies recipients of the message and the contents of the &'To:'& header
24855 when the message is specified by the transport.
24856 .ecindex IIDauttra1
24857 .ecindex IIDauttra2
24862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24863 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24865 .chapter "The lmtp transport" "CHAPLMTP"
24866 .cindex "transports" "&(lmtp)&"
24867 .cindex "&(lmtp)& transport"
24868 .cindex "LMTP" "over a pipe"
24869 .cindex "LMTP" "over a unix-domain socket"
24870 The &(lmtp)& transport runs the LMTP protocol
24871 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2033,RFC 2033)) over a pipe to a
24873 or by interacting with a Unix domain socket.
24874 This transport is something of a cross between the &(pipe)& and &(smtp)&
24875 transports. Exim also has support for using LMTP over TCP/IP; this is
24876 implemented as an option for the &(smtp)& transport. Because LMTP is expected
24877 to be of minority interest, the default build-time configure in &_src/EDITME_&
24878 has it commented out. You need to ensure that
24882 .cindex "options" "&(lmtp)& transport"
24883 is present in your &_Local/Makefile_& in order to have the &(lmtp)& transport
24884 included in the Exim binary. The private options of the &(lmtp)& transport are
24887 .option batch_id lmtp string&!! unset
24888 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24891 .option batch_max lmtp integer 1
24892 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
24893 Most LMTP servers can handle several addresses at once, so it is normally a
24894 good idea to increase this value. See the description of local delivery
24895 batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
24898 .option command lmtp string&!! unset
24899 This option must be set if &%socket%& is not set. The string is a command which
24900 is run in a separate process. It is split up into a command name and list of
24901 arguments, each of which is separately expanded (so expansion cannot change the
24902 number of arguments). The command is run directly, not via a shell. The message
24903 is passed to the new process using the standard input and output to operate the
24906 .option ignore_quota lmtp boolean false
24907 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
24908 If this option is set true, the string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT
24909 commands, provided that the LMTP server has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA
24910 in its response to the LHLO command.
24912 .option socket lmtp string&!! unset
24913 This option must be set if &%command%& is not set. The result of expansion must
24914 be the name of a Unix domain socket. The transport connects to the socket and
24915 delivers the message to it using the LMTP protocol.
24918 .option timeout lmtp time 5m
24919 The transport is aborted if the created process or Unix domain socket does not
24920 respond to LMTP commands or message input within this timeout. Delivery
24921 is deferred, and will be tried again later. Here is an example of a typical
24926 command = /some/local/lmtp/delivery/program
24930 This delivers up to 20 addresses at a time, in a mixture of domains if
24931 necessary, running as the user &'exim'&.
24935 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24936 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
24938 .chapter "The pipe transport" "CHAPpipetransport"
24939 .scindex IIDpiptra1 "transports" "&(pipe)&"
24940 .scindex IIDpiptra2 "&(pipe)& transport"
24941 The &(pipe)& transport is used to deliver messages via a pipe to a command
24942 running in another process. One example is the use of &(pipe)& as a
24943 pseudo-remote transport for passing messages to some other delivery mechanism
24944 (such as UUCP). Another is the use by individual users to automatically process
24945 their incoming messages. The &(pipe)& transport can be used in one of the
24949 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
24950 A router routes one address to a transport in the normal way, and the
24951 transport is configured as a &(pipe)& transport. In this case, &$local_part$&
24952 contains the local part of the address (as usual), and the command that is run
24953 is specified by the &%command%& option on the transport.
24955 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
24956 If the &%batch_max%& option is set greater than 1 (the default is 1), the
24957 transport can handle more than one address in a single run. In this case, when
24958 more than one address is routed to the transport, &$local_part$& is not set
24959 (because it is not unique). However, the pseudo-variable &$pipe_addresses$&
24960 (described in section &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& below) contains all the addresses
24961 that are routed to the transport.
24963 .vindex "&$address_pipe$&"
24964 A router redirects an address directly to a pipe command (for example, from an
24965 alias or forward file). In this case, &$address_pipe$& contains the text of the
24966 pipe command, and the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored unless
24967 &%force_command%& is set. If only one address is being transported
24968 (&%batch_max%& is not greater than one, or only one address was redirected to
24969 this pipe command), &$local_part$& contains the local part that was redirected.
24973 The &(pipe)& transport is a non-interactive delivery method. Exim can also
24974 deliver messages over pipes using the LMTP interactive protocol. This is
24975 implemented by the &(lmtp)& transport.
24977 In the case when &(pipe)& is run as a consequence of an entry in a local user's
24978 &_.forward_& file, the command runs under the uid and gid of that user. In
24979 other cases, the uid and gid have to be specified explicitly, either on the
24980 transport or on the router that handles the address. Current and &"home"&
24981 directories are also controllable. See chapter &<<CHAPenvironment>>& for
24982 details of the local delivery environment and chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&
24983 for a discussion of local delivery batching.
24985 .cindex "tainted data" "in pipe command"
24986 .cindex pipe "tainted data"
24987 Tainted data may not be used for the command name.
24990 .section "Concurrent delivery" "SECID140"
24991 If two messages arrive at almost the same time, and both are routed to a pipe
24992 delivery, the two pipe transports may be run concurrently. You must ensure that
24993 any pipe commands you set up are robust against this happening. If the commands
24994 write to a file, the &%exim_lock%& utility might be of use.
24995 Alternatively the &%max_parallel%& option could be used with a value
24996 of "1" to enforce serialization.
25001 .section "Returned status and data" "SECID141"
25002 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "returned data"
25003 If the command exits with a non-zero return code, the delivery is deemed to
25004 have failed, unless either the &%ignore_status%& option is set (in which case
25005 the return code is treated as zero), or the return code is one of those listed
25006 in the &%temp_errors%& option, which are interpreted as meaning &"try again
25007 later"&. In this case, delivery is deferred. Details of a permanent failure are
25008 logged, but are not included in the bounce message, which merely contains
25009 &"local delivery failed"&.
25011 If the command exits on a signal and the &%freeze_signal%& option is set then
25012 the message will be frozen in the queue. If that option is not set, a bounce
25013 will be sent as normal.
25015 If the return code is greater than 128 and the command being run is a shell
25016 script, it normally means that the script was terminated by a signal whose
25017 value is the return code minus 128. The &%freeze_signal%& option does not
25018 apply in this case.
25020 If Exim is unable to run the command (that is, if &[execve()]& fails), the
25021 return code is set to 127. This is the value that a shell returns if it is
25022 asked to run a non-existent command. The wording for the log line suggests that
25023 a non-existent command may be the problem.
25025 The &%return_output%& option can affect the result of a pipe delivery. If it is
25026 set and the command produces any output on its standard output or standard
25027 error streams, the command is considered to have failed, even if it gave a zero
25028 return code or if &%ignore_status%& is set. The output from the command is
25029 included as part of the bounce message. The &%return_fail_output%& option is
25030 similar, except that output is returned only when the command exits with a
25031 failure return code, that is, a value other than zero or a code that matches
25036 .section "How the command is run" "SECThowcommandrun"
25037 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "path for command"
25038 The command line is (by default) broken down into a command name and arguments
25039 by the &(pipe)& transport itself. The &%allow_commands%& and
25040 &%restrict_to_path%& options can be used to restrict the commands that may be
25043 .cindex "quoting" "in pipe command"
25044 Unquoted arguments are delimited by white space. If an argument appears in
25045 double quotes, backslash is interpreted as an escape character in the usual
25046 way. If an argument appears in single quotes, no escaping is done.
25048 String expansion is applied to the command line except when it comes from a
25049 traditional &_.forward_& file (commands from a filter file are expanded). The
25050 expansion is applied to each argument in turn rather than to the whole line.
25051 For this reason, any string expansion item that contains white space must be
25052 quoted so as to be contained within a single argument. A setting such as
25054 command = /some/path ${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}
25056 will not work, because the expansion item gets split between several
25057 arguments. You have to write
25059 command = /some/path "${if eq{$local_part}{postmaster}{xx}{yy}}"
25061 to ensure that it is all in one argument. The expansion is done in this way,
25062 argument by argument, so that the number of arguments cannot be changed as a
25063 result of expansion, and quotes or backslashes in inserted variables do not
25064 interact with external quoting. However, this leads to problems if you want to
25065 generate multiple arguments (or the command name plus arguments) from a single
25066 expansion. In this situation, the simplest solution is to use a shell. For
25069 command = /bin/sh -c ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/some/file}}
25072 .cindex "transport" "filter"
25073 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
25074 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
25075 Special handling takes place when an argument consists of precisely the text
25076 &`$pipe_addresses`& (no quotes).
25077 This is not a general expansion variable; the only
25078 place this string is recognized is when it appears as an argument for a pipe or
25079 transport filter command. It causes each address that is being handled to be
25080 inserted in the argument list at that point &'as a separate argument'&. This
25081 avoids any problems with spaces or shell metacharacters, and is of use when a
25082 &(pipe)& transport is handling groups of addresses in a batch.
25084 If &%force_command%& is enabled on the transport, special handling takes place
25085 for an argument that consists of precisely the text &`$address_pipe`&. It
25086 is handled similarly to &$pipe_addresses$& above. It is expanded and each
25087 argument is inserted in the argument list at that point
25088 &'as a separate argument'&. The &`$address_pipe`& item does not need to be
25089 the only item in the argument; in fact, if it were then &%force_command%&
25090 should behave as a no-op. Rather, it should be used to adjust the command
25091 run while preserving the argument vector separation.
25093 After splitting up into arguments and expansion, the resulting command is run
25094 in a subprocess directly from the transport, &'not'& under a shell. The
25095 message that is being delivered is supplied on the standard input, and the
25096 standard output and standard error are both connected to a single pipe that is
25097 read by Exim. The &%max_output%& option controls how much output the command
25098 may produce, and the &%return_output%& and &%return_fail_output%& options
25099 control what is done with it.
25101 Not running the command under a shell (by default) lessens the security risks
25102 in cases when a command from a user's filter file is built out of data that was
25103 taken from an incoming message. If a shell is required, it can of course be
25104 explicitly specified as the command to be run. However, there are circumstances
25105 where existing commands (for example, in &_.forward_& files) expect to be run
25106 under a shell and cannot easily be modified. To allow for these cases, there is
25107 an option called &%use_shell%&, which changes the way the &(pipe)& transport
25108 works. Instead of breaking up the command line as just described, it expands it
25109 as a single string and passes the result to &_/bin/sh_&. The
25110 &%restrict_to_path%& option and the &$pipe_addresses$& facility cannot be used
25111 with &%use_shell%&, and the whole mechanism is inherently less secure.
25115 .section "Environment variables" "SECTpipeenv"
25116 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
25117 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
25118 The environment variables listed below are set up when the command is invoked.
25119 This list is a compromise for maximum compatibility with other MTAs. Note that
25120 the &%environment%& option can be used to add additional variables to this
25121 environment. The environment for the &(pipe)& transport is not subject
25122 to the &%add_environment%& and &%keep_environment%& main config options.
25123 &*Note*&: Using enviroment variables loses track of tainted data.
25124 Writers of &(pipe)& transport commands should be wary of data supplied
25125 by potential attackers.
25127 &`DOMAIN `& the domain of the address
25128 &`HOME `& the home directory, if set
25129 &`HOST `& the host name when called from a router (see below)
25130 &`LOCAL_PART `& see below
25131 &`LOCAL_PART_PREFIX `& see below
25132 &`LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX `& see below
25133 &`LOGNAME `& see below
25134 &`MESSAGE_ID `& Exim's local ID for the message
25135 &`PATH `& as specified by the &%path%& option below
25136 &`QUALIFY_DOMAIN `& the sender qualification domain
25137 &`RECIPIENT `& the complete recipient address
25138 &`SENDER `& the sender of the message (empty if a bounce)
25139 &`SHELL `& &`/bin/sh`&
25140 &`TZ `& the value of the &%timezone%& option, if set
25141 &`USER `& see below
25143 When a &(pipe)& transport is called directly from (for example) an &(accept)&
25144 router, LOCAL_PART is set to the local part of the address. When it is
25145 called as a result of a forward or alias expansion, LOCAL_PART is set to
25146 the local part of the address that was expanded. In both cases, any affixes are
25147 removed from the local part, and made available in LOCAL_PART_PREFIX and
25148 LOCAL_PART_SUFFIX, respectively. LOGNAME and USER are set to the
25149 same value as LOCAL_PART for compatibility with other MTAs.
25152 HOST is set only when a &(pipe)& transport is called from a router that
25153 associates hosts with an address, typically when using &(pipe)& as a
25154 pseudo-remote transport. HOST is set to the first host name specified by
25158 If the transport's generic &%home_directory%& option is set, its value is used
25159 for the HOME environment variable. Otherwise, a home directory may be set
25160 by the router's &%transport_home_directory%& option, which defaults to the
25161 user's home directory if &%check_local_user%& is set.
25164 .section "Private options for pipe" "SECID142"
25165 .cindex "options" "&(pipe)& transport"
25169 .option allow_commands pipe "string list&!!" unset
25170 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "permitted commands"
25171 The string is expanded, and is then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
25172 permitted commands. If &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only commands
25173 permitted are those in the &%allow_commands%& list. They need not be absolute
25174 paths; the &%path%& option is still used for relative paths. If
25175 &%restrict_to_path%& is set with &%allow_commands%&, the command must either be
25176 in the &%allow_commands%& list, or a name without any slashes that is found on
25177 the path. In other words, if neither &%allow_commands%& nor
25178 &%restrict_to_path%& is set, there is no restriction on the command, but
25179 otherwise only commands that are permitted by one or the other are allowed. For
25182 allow_commands = /usr/bin/vacation
25184 and &%restrict_to_path%& is not set, the only permitted command is
25185 &_/usr/bin/vacation_&. The &%allow_commands%& option may not be set if
25186 &%use_shell%& is set.
25189 .option batch_id pipe string&!! unset
25190 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
25193 .option batch_max pipe integer 1
25194 This limits the number of addresses that can be handled in a single delivery.
25195 See the description of local delivery batching in chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>&.
25198 .option check_string pipe string unset
25199 As &(pipe)& writes the message, the start of each line is tested for matching
25200 &%check_string%&, and if it does, the initial matching characters are replaced
25201 by the contents of &%escape_string%&, provided both are set. The value of
25202 &%check_string%& is a literal string, not a regular expression, and the case of
25203 any letters it contains is significant. When &%use_bsmtp%& is set, the contents
25204 of &%check_string%& and &%escape_string%& are forced to values that implement
25205 the SMTP escaping protocol. Any settings made in the configuration file are
25209 .option command pipe string&!! unset
25210 This option need not be set when &(pipe)& is being used to deliver to pipes
25211 obtained directly from address redirections. In other cases, the option must be
25212 set, to provide a command to be run. It need not yield an absolute path (see
25213 the &%path%& option below). The command is split up into separate arguments by
25214 Exim, and each argument is separately expanded, as described in section
25215 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>& above.
25217 .cindex "tainted data"
25218 No part of the resulting command may be tainted.
25221 .option environment pipe "string list&!!" unset
25222 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "environment for command"
25223 .cindex "environment" "&(pipe)& transport"
25224 This option is used to add additional variables to the environment in which the
25225 command runs (see section &<<SECTpipeenv>>& for the default list). Its value is
25226 a string which is expanded, and then interpreted as a colon-separated list of
25227 environment settings of the form <&'name'&>=<&'value'&>.
25230 .option escape_string pipe string unset
25231 See &%check_string%& above.
25234 .option freeze_exec_fail pipe boolean false
25235 .cindex "exec failure"
25236 .cindex "failure of exec"
25237 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "failure of exec"
25238 Failure to exec the command in a pipe transport is by default treated like
25239 any other failure while running the command. However, if &%freeze_exec_fail%&
25240 is set, failure to exec is treated specially, and causes the message to be
25241 frozen, whatever the setting of &%ignore_status%&.
25244 .option freeze_signal pipe boolean false
25245 .cindex "signal exit"
25246 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "signal exit"
25247 Normally if the process run by a command in a pipe transport exits on a signal,
25248 a bounce message is sent. If &%freeze_signal%& is set, the message will be
25249 frozen in Exim's queue instead.
25252 .option force_command pipe boolean false
25253 .cindex "force command"
25254 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport", "force command"
25255 Normally when a router redirects an address directly to a pipe command
25256 the &%command%& option on the transport is ignored. If &%force_command%&
25257 is set, the &%command%& option will used. This is especially
25258 useful for forcing a wrapper or additional argument to be added to the
25259 command. For example:
25261 command = /usr/bin/remote_exec myhost -- $address_pipe
25265 Note that &$address_pipe$& is handled specially in &%command%& when
25266 &%force_command%& is set, expanding out to the original argument vector as
25267 separate items, similarly to a Unix shell &`"$@"`& construct.
25270 .option ignore_status pipe boolean false
25271 If this option is true, the status returned by the subprocess that is set up to
25272 run the command is ignored, and Exim behaves as if zero had been returned.
25273 Otherwise, a non-zero status or termination by signal causes an error return
25274 from the transport unless the status value is one of those listed in
25275 &%temp_errors%&; these cause the delivery to be deferred and tried again later.
25277 &*Note*&: This option does not apply to timeouts, which do not return a status.
25278 See the &%timeout_defer%& option for how timeouts are handled.
25281 .option log_defer_output pipe boolean false
25282 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "logging output"
25283 If this option is set, and the status returned by the command is
25284 one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, delivery was deferred),
25285 and any output was produced on stdout or stderr, the first line of it is
25286 written to the main log.
25289 .option log_fail_output pipe boolean false
25290 If this option is set, and the command returns any output on stdout or
25291 stderr, and also ends with a return code that is neither zero nor one of
25292 the return codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that is, the delivery
25293 failed), the first line of output is written to the main log. This
25294 option and &%log_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may
25298 .option log_output pipe boolean false
25299 If this option is set and the command returns any output on stdout or
25300 stderr, the first line of output is written to the main log, whatever
25301 the return code. This option and &%log_fail_output%& are mutually
25302 exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25305 .option max_output pipe integer 20K
25306 This specifies the maximum amount of output that the command may produce on its
25307 standard output and standard error file combined. If the limit is exceeded, the
25308 process running the command is killed. This is intended as a safety measure to
25309 catch runaway processes. The limit is applied independently of the settings of
25310 the options that control what is done with such output (for example,
25311 &%return_output%&). Because of buffering effects, the amount of output may
25312 exceed the limit by a small amount before Exim notices.
25315 .option message_prefix pipe string&!! "see below"
25316 The string specified here is expanded and output at the start of every message.
25317 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is
25320 From ${if def:return_path{$return_path}{MAILER-DAEMON}}\
25324 .cindex "&%tmail%&"
25325 .cindex "&""From""& line"
25326 This is required by the commonly used &_/usr/bin/vacation_& program.
25327 However, it must &'not'& be present if delivery is to the Cyrus IMAP server,
25328 or to the &%tmail%& local delivery agent. The prefix can be suppressed by
25333 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25334 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_prefix%&.
25337 .option message_suffix pipe string&!! "see below"
25338 The string specified here is expanded and output at the end of every message.
25339 The default is unset if &%use_bsmtp%& is set. Otherwise it is a single newline.
25340 The suffix can be suppressed by setting
25344 &*Note:*& If you set &%use_crlf%& true, you must change any occurrences of
25345 &`\n`& to &`\r\n`& in &%message_suffix%&.
25348 .option path pipe string&!! "/bin:/usr/bin"
25349 This option is expanded and
25350 specifies the string that is set up in the PATH environment
25351 variable of the subprocess.
25352 If the &%command%& option does not yield an absolute path name, the command is
25353 sought in the PATH directories, in the usual way. &*Warning*&: This does not
25354 apply to a command specified as a transport filter.
25357 .option permit_coredump pipe boolean false
25358 Normally Exim inhibits core-dumps during delivery. If you have a need to get
25359 a core-dump of a pipe command, enable this command. This enables core-dumps
25360 during delivery and affects both the Exim binary and the pipe command run.
25361 It is recommended that this option remain off unless and until you have a need
25362 for it and that this only be enabled when needed, as the risk of excessive
25363 resource consumption can be quite high. Note also that Exim is typically
25364 installed as a setuid binary and most operating systems will inhibit coredumps
25365 of these by default, so further OS-specific action may be required.
25368 .option pipe_as_creator pipe boolean false
25369 .cindex "uid (user id)" "local delivery"
25370 If the generic &%user%& option is not set and this option is true, the delivery
25371 process is run under the uid that was in force when Exim was originally called
25372 to accept the message. If the group id is not otherwise set (via the generic
25373 &%group%& option), the gid that was in force when Exim was originally called to
25374 accept the message is used.
25377 .option restrict_to_path pipe boolean false
25378 When this option is set, any command name not listed in &%allow_commands%& must
25379 contain no slashes. The command is searched for only in the directories listed
25380 in the &%path%& option. This option is intended for use in the case when a pipe
25381 command has been generated from a user's &_.forward_& file. This is usually
25382 handled by a &(pipe)& transport called &%address_pipe%&.
25385 .option return_fail_output pipe boolean false
25386 If this option is true, and the command produced any output and ended with a
25387 return code other than zero or one of the codes listed in &%temp_errors%& (that
25388 is, the delivery failed), the output is returned in the bounce message.
25389 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is itself a bounce
25390 message), output from the command is discarded. This option and
25391 &%return_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one of them may be set.
25395 .option return_output pipe boolean false
25396 If this option is true, and the command produced any output, the delivery is
25397 deemed to have failed whatever the return code from the command, and the output
25398 is returned in the bounce message. Otherwise, the output is just discarded.
25399 However, if the message has a null sender (that is, it is a bounce message),
25400 output from the command is always discarded, whatever the setting of this
25401 option. This option and &%return_fail_output%& are mutually exclusive. Only one
25402 of them may be set.
25406 .option temp_errors pipe "string list" "see below"
25407 .cindex "&(pipe)& transport" "temporary failure"
25408 This option contains either a colon-separated list of numbers, or a single
25409 asterisk. If &%ignore_status%& is false
25410 and &%return_output%& is not set,
25411 and the command exits with a non-zero return code, the failure is treated as
25412 temporary and the delivery is deferred if the return code matches one of the
25413 numbers, or if the setting is a single asterisk. Otherwise, non-zero return
25414 codes are treated as permanent errors. The default setting contains the codes
25415 defined by EX_TEMPFAIL and EX_CANTCREAT in &_sysexits.h_&. If Exim is
25416 compiled on a system that does not define these macros, it assumes values of 75
25417 and 73, respectively.
25420 .option timeout pipe time 1h
25421 If the command fails to complete within this time, it is killed. This normally
25422 causes the delivery to fail (but see &%timeout_defer%&). A zero time interval
25423 specifies no timeout. In order to ensure that any subprocesses created by the
25424 command are also killed, Exim makes the initial process a process group leader,
25425 and kills the whole process group on a timeout. However, this can be defeated
25426 if one of the processes starts a new process group.
25428 .option timeout_defer pipe boolean false
25429 A timeout in a &(pipe)& transport, either in the command that the transport
25430 runs, or in a transport filter that is associated with it, is by default
25431 treated as a hard error, and the delivery fails. However, if &%timeout_defer%&
25432 is set true, both kinds of timeout become temporary errors, causing the
25433 delivery to be deferred.
25435 .option umask pipe "octal integer" 022
25436 This specifies the umask setting for the subprocess that runs the command.
25439 .option use_bsmtp pipe boolean false
25440 .cindex "envelope sender"
25441 If this option is set true, the &(pipe)& transport writes messages in &"batch
25442 SMTP"& format, with the envelope sender and recipient(s) included as SMTP
25443 commands. If you want to include a leading HELO command with such messages,
25444 you can do so by setting the &%message_prefix%& option. See section
25445 &<<SECTbatchSMTP>>& for details of batch SMTP.
25447 .option use_classresources pipe boolean false
25448 .cindex "class resources (BSD)"
25449 This option is available only when Exim is running on FreeBSD, NetBSD, or
25450 BSD/OS. If it is set true, the &[setclassresources()]& function is used to set
25451 resource limits when a &(pipe)& transport is run to perform a delivery. The
25452 limits for the uid under which the pipe is to run are obtained from the login
25456 .option use_crlf pipe boolean false
25457 .cindex "carriage return"
25459 This option causes lines to be terminated with the two-character CRLF sequence
25460 (carriage return, linefeed) instead of just a linefeed character. In the case
25461 of batched SMTP, the byte sequence written to the pipe is then an exact image
25462 of what would be sent down a real SMTP connection.
25464 The contents of the &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& options are
25465 written verbatim, so must contain their own carriage return characters if these
25466 are needed. When &%use_bsmtp%& is not set, the default values for both
25467 &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%& end with a single linefeed, so their
25468 values must be changed to end with &`\r\n`& if &%use_crlf%& is set.
25471 .option use_shell pipe boolean false
25472 .vindex "&$pipe_addresses$&"
25473 If this option is set, it causes the command to be passed to &_/bin/sh_&
25474 instead of being run directly from the transport, as described in section
25475 &<<SECThowcommandrun>>&. This is less secure, but is needed in some situations
25476 where the command is expected to be run under a shell and cannot easily be
25477 modified. The &%allow_commands%& and &%restrict_to_path%& options, and the
25478 &`$pipe_addresses`& facility are incompatible with &%use_shell%&. The
25479 command is expanded as a single string, and handed to &_/bin/sh_& as data for
25484 .section "Using an external local delivery agent" "SECID143"
25485 .cindex "local delivery" "using an external agent"
25486 .cindex "&'procmail'&"
25487 .cindex "external local delivery"
25488 .cindex "delivery" "&'procmail'&"
25489 .cindex "delivery" "by external agent"
25490 The &(pipe)& transport can be used to pass all messages that require local
25491 delivery to a separate local delivery agent such as &%procmail%&. When doing
25492 this, care must be taken to ensure that the pipe is run under an appropriate
25493 uid and gid. In some configurations one wants this to be a uid that is trusted
25494 by the delivery agent to supply the correct sender of the message. It may be
25495 necessary to recompile or reconfigure the delivery agent so that it trusts an
25496 appropriate user. The following is an example transport and router
25497 configuration for &%procmail%&:
25502 command = /usr/local/bin/procmail -d $local_part_data
25506 check_string = "From "
25507 escape_string = ">From "
25509 user = $local_part_data
25516 transport = procmail_pipe
25518 In this example, the pipe is run as the local user, but with the group set to
25519 &'mail'&. An alternative is to run the pipe as a specific user such as &'mail'&
25520 or &'exim'&, but in this case you must arrange for &%procmail%& to trust that
25521 user to supply a correct sender address. If you do not specify either a
25522 &%group%& or a &%user%& option, the pipe command is run as the local user. The
25523 home directory is the user's home directory by default.
25525 &*Note*&: The command that the pipe transport runs does &'not'& begin with
25529 as shown in some &%procmail%& documentation, because Exim does not by default
25530 use a shell to run pipe commands.
25533 The next example shows a transport and a router for a system where local
25534 deliveries are handled by the Cyrus IMAP server.
25535 . Used to have R: local_part_suffix = .* + T: -m $local_part_suffix_v
25536 . but that suffix is tainted so cannot be used in a command arg
25537 . Really, you'd want to use a lookup for acceptable suffixes to do real detainting
25540 local_delivery_cyrus:
25542 command = /usr/cyrus/bin/deliver \
25543 -- $local_part_data
25555 transport = local_delivery_cyrus
25557 Note the unsetting of &%message_prefix%& and &%message_suffix%&, and the use of
25558 &%return_output%& to cause any text written by Cyrus to be returned to the
25560 .ecindex IIDpiptra1
25561 .ecindex IIDpiptra2
25564 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25565 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
25567 .chapter "The smtp transport" "CHAPsmtptrans"
25568 .scindex IIDsmttra1 "transports" "&(smtp)&"
25569 .scindex IIDsmttra2 "&(smtp)& transport"
25570 The &(smtp)& transport delivers messages over TCP/IP connections using the SMTP
25571 or LMTP protocol. The list of hosts to try can either be taken from the address
25572 that is being processed (having been set up by the router), or specified
25573 explicitly for the transport. Timeout and retry processing (see chapter
25574 &<<CHAPretry>>&) is applied to each IP address independently.
25577 .section "Multiple messages on a single connection" "SECID144"
25578 The sending of multiple messages over a single TCP/IP connection can arise in
25582 If a message contains more than &%max_rcpt%& (see below) addresses that are
25583 routed to the same host, more than one copy of the message has to be sent to
25584 that host. In this situation, multiple copies may be sent in a single run of
25585 the &(smtp)& transport over a single TCP/IP connection. (What Exim actually
25586 does when it has too many addresses to send in one message also depends on the
25587 value of the global &%remote_max_parallel%& option. Details are given in
25588 section &<<SECToutSMTPTCP>>&.)
25590 .cindex "hints database" "remembering routing"
25591 When a message has been successfully delivered over a TCP/IP connection, Exim
25592 looks in its hints database to see if there are any other messages awaiting a
25593 connection to the same host. If there are, a new delivery process is started
25594 for one of them, and the current TCP/IP connection is passed on to it. The new
25595 process may in turn send multiple copies and possibly create yet another
25600 For each copy sent over the same TCP/IP connection, a sequence counter is
25601 incremented, and if it ever gets to the value of &%connection_max_messages%&,
25602 no further messages are sent over that connection.
25606 .section "Use of the $host and $host_address variables" "SECID145"
25608 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
25609 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$host$& and
25610 &$host_address$& are the name and IP address of the first host on the host list
25611 passed by the router. However, when the transport is about to connect to a
25612 specific host, and while it is connected to that host, &$host$& and
25613 &$host_address$& are set to the values for that host. These are the values
25614 that are in force when the &%helo_data%&, &%hosts_try_auth%&, &%interface%&,
25615 &%serialize_hosts%&, and the various TLS options are expanded.
25618 .section "Use of $tls_cipher and $tls_peerdn" "usecippeer"
25619 .vindex &$tls_bits$&
25620 .vindex &$tls_cipher$&
25621 .vindex &$tls_peerdn$&
25622 .vindex &$tls_sni$&
25623 At the start of a run of the &(smtp)& transport, the values of &$tls_bits$&,
25624 &$tls_cipher$&, &$tls_peerdn$& and &$tls_sni$&
25625 are the values that were set when the message was received.
25626 These are the values that are used for options that are expanded before any
25627 SMTP connections are made. Just before each connection is made, these four
25628 variables are emptied. If TLS is subsequently started, they are set to the
25629 appropriate values for the outgoing connection, and these are the values that
25630 are in force when any authenticators are run and when the
25631 &%authenticated_sender%& option is expanded.
25633 These variables are deprecated in favour of &$tls_in_cipher$& et. al.
25634 and will be removed in a future release.
25637 .section "Private options for smtp" "SECID146"
25638 .cindex "options" "&(smtp)& transport"
25639 The private options of the &(smtp)& transport are as follows:
25642 .option address_retry_include_sender smtp boolean true
25643 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retrying after"
25644 When an address is delayed because of a 4&'xx'& response to a RCPT command, it
25645 is the combination of sender and recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue
25646 runs until the retry time is reached. You can delay the recipient without
25647 reference to the sender (which is what earlier versions of Exim did), by
25648 setting &%address_retry_include_sender%& false. However, this can lead to
25649 problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT commands.
25651 .option allow_localhost smtp boolean false
25652 .cindex "local host" "sending to"
25653 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25654 When a host specified in &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& (see below) turns out
25655 to be the local host, or is listed in &%hosts_treat_as_local%&, delivery is
25656 deferred by default. However, if &%allow_localhost%& is set, Exim goes on to do
25657 the delivery anyway. This should be used only in special cases when the
25658 configuration ensures that no looping will result (for example, a differently
25659 configured Exim is listening on the port to which the message is sent).
25662 .option authenticated_sender smtp string&!! unset
25664 When Exim has authenticated as a client, or if &%authenticated_sender_force%&
25665 is true, this option sets a value for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands,
25666 overriding any existing authenticated sender value. If the string expansion is
25667 forced to fail, the option is ignored. Other expansion failures cause delivery
25668 to be deferred. If the result of expansion is an empty string, that is also
25671 The expansion happens after the outgoing connection has been made and TLS
25672 started, if required. This means that the &$host$&, &$host_address$&,
25673 &$tls_out_cipher$&, and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables are set according to the
25674 particular connection.
25676 If the SMTP session is not authenticated, the expansion of
25677 &%authenticated_sender%& still happens (and can cause the delivery to be
25678 deferred if it fails), but no AUTH= item is added to MAIL commands
25679 unless &%authenticated_sender_force%& is true.
25681 This option allows you to use the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode to
25682 deliver mail to Cyrus IMAP and provide the proper local part as the
25683 &"authenticated sender"&, via a setting such as:
25685 authenticated_sender = $local_part
25687 This removes the need for IMAP subfolders to be assigned special ACLs to
25688 allow direct delivery to those subfolders.
25690 Because of expected uses such as that just described for Cyrus (when no
25691 domain is involved), there is no checking on the syntax of the provided
25695 .option authenticated_sender_force smtp boolean false
25696 If this option is set true, the &%authenticated_sender%& option's value
25697 is used for the AUTH= item on outgoing MAIL commands, even if Exim has not
25698 authenticated as a client.
25701 .option command_timeout smtp time 5m
25702 .cindex timeout "smtp transport command"
25703 This sets a timeout for receiving a response to an SMTP command that has been
25704 sent out. It is also used when waiting for the initial banner line from the
25705 remote host. Its value must not be zero.
25708 .option connect_timeout smtp time 5m
25709 .cindex timeout "smtp transport connect"
25710 This sets a timeout for the &[connect()]& function, which sets up a TCP/IP call
25711 to a remote host. A setting of zero allows the system timeout (typically
25712 several minutes) to act. To have any effect, the value of this option must be
25713 less than the system timeout. However, it has been observed that on some
25714 systems there is no system timeout, which is why the default value for this
25715 option is 5 minutes, a value recommended by
25716 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1123,RFC 1123).
25719 .option connection_max_messages smtp integer 500
25720 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
25721 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
25722 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
25723 This controls the maximum number of separate message deliveries that are sent
25724 over a single TCP/IP connection. If the value is zero, there is no limit.
25725 For testing purposes, this value can be overridden by the &%-oB%& command line
25728 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
25729 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a MAILMAX value,
25730 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
25731 that value also constrains the result of this option.
25734 .option dane_require_tls_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
25735 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers for DANE"
25736 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
25737 .cindex DANE "TLS ciphers"
25738 This option may be used to override &%tls_require_ciphers%& for connections
25739 where DANE has been determined to be in effect.
25740 If not set, then &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used.
25741 Normal SMTP delivery is not able to make strong demands of TLS cipher
25742 configuration, because delivery will fall back to plaintext. Once DANE has
25743 been determined to be in effect, there is no plaintext fallback and making the
25744 TLS cipherlist configuration stronger will increase security, rather than
25745 counter-intuitively decreasing it.
25746 If the option expands to be empty or is forced to fail, then it will
25747 be treated as unset and &%tls_require_ciphers%& will be used instead.
25750 .option data_timeout smtp time 5m
25751 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data blocks"
25752 This sets a timeout for the transmission of each block in the data portion of
25753 the message. As a result, the overall timeout for a message depends on the size
25754 of the message. Its value must not be zero. See also &%final_timeout%&.
25757 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
25758 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25759 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
25760 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25761 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
25762 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25763 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
25764 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25765 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
25766 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25767 .option dkim_selector smtp string&!! unset
25768 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25769 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
25770 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25771 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "per RFC"
25772 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25773 .option dkim_timestamps smtp string&!! unset
25774 DKIM signing option. For details see section &<<SECDKIMSIGN>>&.
25777 .option delay_after_cutoff smtp boolean true
25778 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
25779 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
25780 This option controls what happens when all remote IP addresses for a given
25781 domain have been inaccessible for so long that they have passed their retry
25784 In the default state, if the next retry time has not been reached for any of
25785 them, the address is bounced without trying any deliveries. In other words,
25786 Exim delays retrying an IP address after the final cutoff time until a new
25787 retry time is reached, and can therefore bounce an address without ever trying
25788 a delivery, when machines have been down for a long time. Some people are
25789 unhappy at this prospect, so...
25791 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
25792 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those
25793 IP addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
25794 none, of if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other words, it does not
25795 delay when a new message arrives, but immediately tries those expired IP
25796 addresses that haven't been tried since the message arrived. If there is a
25797 continuous stream of messages for the dead hosts, unsetting
25798 &%delay_after_cutoff%& means that there will be many more attempts to deliver
25802 .option dns_qualify_single smtp boolean true
25803 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used,
25804 and the &%gethostbyname%& option is false,
25805 the RES_DEFNAMES resolver option is set. See the &%qualify_single%& option
25806 in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more details.
25809 .option dns_search_parents smtp boolean false
25810 If the &%hosts%& or &%fallback_hosts%& option is being used, and the
25811 &%gethostbyname%& option is false, the RES_DNSRCH resolver option is set.
25812 See the &%search_parents%& option in chapter &<<CHAPdnslookup>>& for more
25816 .option dnssec_request_domains smtp "domain list&!!" *
25817 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25818 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25819 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25820 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25821 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_request_domains%& will be done with
25822 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only useful if the
25823 transport overrides or sets the host names. See the &%dnssec_request_domains%&
25828 .option dnssec_require_domains smtp "domain list&!!" unset
25829 .cindex "MX record" "security"
25830 .cindex "DNSSEC" "MX lookup"
25831 .cindex "security" "MX lookup"
25832 .cindex "DNS" "DNSSEC"
25833 DNS lookups for domains matching &%dnssec_require_domains%& will be done with
25834 the DNSSEC request bit set. Setting this transport option is only
25835 useful if the transport overrides or sets the host names. See the
25836 &%dnssec_require_domains%& router option.
25840 .option dscp smtp string&!! unset
25841 .cindex "DCSP" "outbound"
25842 This option causes the DSCP value associated with a socket to be set to one
25843 of a number of fixed strings or to numeric value.
25844 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
25845 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
25846 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
25848 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
25849 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
25850 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
25851 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
25852 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
25855 .option fallback_hosts smtp "string list" unset
25856 .cindex "fallback" "hosts specified on transport"
25857 String expansion is not applied to this option. The argument must be a
25858 colon-separated list of host names or IP addresses, optionally also including
25859 port numbers, though the separator can be changed, as described in section
25860 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25861 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25862 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&.
25864 Fallback hosts can also be specified on routers, which associate them with the
25865 addresses they process. As for the &%hosts%& option without &%hosts_override%&,
25866 &%fallback_hosts%& specified on the transport is used only if the address does
25867 not have its own associated fallback host list. Unlike &%hosts%&, a setting of
25868 &%fallback_hosts%& on an address is not overridden by &%hosts_override%&.
25869 However, &%hosts_randomize%& does apply to fallback host lists.
25871 If Exim is unable to deliver to any of the hosts for a particular address, and
25872 the errors are not permanent rejections, the address is put on a separate
25873 transport queue with its host list replaced by the fallback hosts, unless the
25874 address was routed via MX records and the current host was in the original MX
25875 list. In that situation, the fallback host list is not used.
25877 Once normal deliveries are complete, the fallback queue is delivered by
25878 re-running the same transports with the new host lists. If several failing
25879 addresses have the same fallback hosts (and &%max_rcpt%& permits it), a single
25880 copy of the message is sent.
25882 The resolution of the host names on the fallback list is controlled by the
25883 &%gethostbyname%& option, as for the &%hosts%& option. Fallback hosts apply
25884 both to cases when the host list comes with the address and when it is taken
25885 from &%hosts%&. This option provides a &"use a smart host only if delivery
25889 .option final_timeout smtp time 10m
25890 .cindex timeout "for transmitted SMTP data accept"
25891 This is the timeout that applies while waiting for the response to the final
25892 line containing just &"."& that terminates a message. Its value must not be
25895 .option gethostbyname smtp boolean false
25896 If this option is true when the &%hosts%& and/or &%fallback_hosts%& options are
25897 being used, names are looked up using &[gethostbyname()]&
25898 (or &[getipnodebyname()]& when available)
25899 instead of using the DNS. Of course, that function may in fact use the DNS, but
25900 it may also consult other sources of information such as &_/etc/hosts_&.
25902 .option gnutls_compat_mode smtp boolean unset
25903 This option controls whether GnuTLS is used in compatibility mode in an Exim
25904 server. This reduces security slightly, but improves interworking with older
25905 implementations of TLS.
25907 .option helo_data smtp string&!! "see below"
25908 .cindex "HELO" "argument, setting"
25909 .cindex "EHLO" "argument, setting"
25910 .cindex "LHLO argument setting"
25911 The value of this option is expanded after a connection to a another host has
25912 been set up. The result is used as the argument for the EHLO, HELO, or LHLO
25913 command that starts the outgoing SMTP or LMTP session. The default value of the
25918 During the expansion, the variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to
25919 the identity of the remote host, and the variables &$sending_ip_address$& and
25920 &$sending_port$& are set to the local IP address and port number that are being
25921 used. These variables can be used to generate different values for different
25922 servers or different local IP addresses. For example, if you want the string
25923 that is used for &%helo_data%& to be obtained by a DNS lookup of the outgoing
25924 interface address, you could use this:
25926 helo_data = ${lookup dnsdb{ptr=$sending_ip_address} \
25927 {${listextract{1}{<\n $value}}} \
25928 {$primary_hostname}}
25930 The use of &%helo_data%& applies both to sending messages and when doing
25933 .option host_name_extract smtp "string list&!!" "see below"
25934 .cindex "load balancer" "hosts behind"
25935 .cindex TLS resumption
25936 Some mail-accepting sites
25937 (notably Microsoft)
25938 operate many servers behind a network load-balancer. When this is done,
25939 with separated TLS session caches, TLS session resuption becomes problematic.
25940 It will only succeed when the same server happens to be selected by the
25941 load-balancer, matching the session stored in the client's cache.
25943 Exim can pull out a server name, if there is one, from the response to the
25944 client's SMTP EHLO command.
25945 For normal STARTTLS use, the default value of this option:
25947 ${if and { {match {$host} {.outlook.com\$}} \
25948 {match {$item} {\N^250-([\w.]+)\s\N}} \
25951 suffices for one known case.
25953 During the expansion of this option the &$item$& variable will have the
25954 server's EHLO response.
25956 For TLS-on-connect connections we do not have an EHLO
25957 response to use. Because of this the default value of this option is
25958 set to a static string for those cases, meaning that resumption will
25959 always be attempted if permitted by the &%tls_resumption_hosts%& option.
25961 The result of the option expansion is included in the key used to store and
25962 retrieve the TLS session, for session resumption.
25964 Operators of high-load sites may wish to evaluate their logs for indications
25965 of other destination sites operating load-balancers, and develop a suitable
25966 expression for this option.
25967 The smtp:ehlo event and the &$tls_out_resumption$& variable
25968 will be useful for such work.
25970 .option hosts smtp "string list&!!" unset
25971 Hosts are associated with an address by a router such as &(dnslookup)&, which
25972 finds the hosts by looking up the address domain in the DNS, or by
25973 &(manualroute)&, which has lists of hosts in its configuration. However,
25974 email addresses can be passed to the &(smtp)& transport by any router, and not
25975 all of them can provide an associated list of hosts.
25977 The &%hosts%& option specifies a list of hosts to be used if the address being
25978 processed does not have any hosts associated with it. The hosts specified by
25979 &%hosts%& are also used, whether or not the address has its own hosts, if
25980 &%hosts_override%& is set.
25982 The string is first expanded, before being interpreted as a colon-separated
25983 list of host names or IP addresses, possibly including port numbers. The
25984 separator may be changed to something other than colon, as described in section
25985 &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&. Each individual item in the list is the same as an
25986 item in a &%route_list%& setting for the &(manualroute)& router, as described
25987 in section &<<SECTformatonehostitem>>&. However, note that the &`/MX`& facility
25988 of the &(manualroute)& router is not available here.
25990 If the expansion fails, delivery is deferred. Unless the failure was caused by
25991 the inability to complete a lookup, the error is logged to the panic log as
25992 well as the main log. Host names are looked up either by searching directly for
25993 address records in the DNS or by calling &[gethostbyname()]& (or
25994 &[getipnodebyname()]& when available), depending on the setting of the
25995 &%gethostbyname%& option. When Exim is compiled with IPv6 support, if a host
25996 that is looked up in the DNS has both IPv4 and IPv6 addresses, both types of
25999 During delivery, the hosts are tried in order, subject to their retry status,
26000 unless &%hosts_randomize%& is set.
26003 .option hosts_avoid_esmtp smtp "host list&!!" unset
26004 .cindex "ESMTP, avoiding use of"
26005 .cindex "HELO" "forcing use of"
26006 .cindex "EHLO" "avoiding use of"
26007 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
26008 This option is for use with broken hosts that announce ESMTP facilities (for
26009 example, PIPELINING) and then fail to implement them properly. When a host
26010 matches &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%&, Exim sends HELO rather than EHLO at the
26011 start of the SMTP session. This means that it cannot use any of the ESMTP
26012 facilities such as AUTH, PIPELINING, SIZE, and STARTTLS.
26015 .option hosts_avoid_pipelining smtp "host list&!!" unset
26016 .cindex "PIPELINING" "avoiding the use of"
26017 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
26018 Exim will not use the ESMTP PIPELINING extension when delivering to any host
26019 that matches this list, even if the server host advertises PIPELINING support.
26021 .option hosts_pipe_connect smtp "host list&!!" unset
26022 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
26023 .cindex "pipelining" PIPECONNECT
26024 If Exim is built with the SUPPORT_PIPE_CONNECT build option
26025 this option controls which to hosts the facility watched for
26026 and recorded, and used for subsequent connections.
26028 The retry hints database is used for the record,
26029 and records are subject to the &%retry_data_expire%& option.
26030 When used, the pipelining saves on roundtrip times.
26031 It also turns SMTP into a client-first protocol
26032 so combines well with TCP Fast Open.
26034 See also the &%pipelining_connect_advertise_hosts%& main option.
26037 When the facility is used, if the transport &%interface%& option is unset
26038 the &%helo_data%& option
26039 will be expanded before the &$sending_ip_address$& variable
26041 A check is made for the use of that variable, without the
26042 presence of a &"def:"& test on it, but suitably complex coding
26043 can avoid the check and produce unexpected results.
26044 You have been warned.
26047 .option hosts_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26048 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
26049 Exim will not try to start a TLS session when delivering to any host that
26050 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26052 .option hosts_verify_avoid_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26053 .cindex "TLS" "avoiding for certain hosts"
26054 Exim will not try to start a TLS session for a verify callout,
26055 or when delivering in cutthrough mode,
26056 to any host that matches this list.
26059 .option hosts_max_try smtp integer 5
26060 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
26061 .cindex "limit" "number of hosts tried"
26062 .cindex "limit" "number of MX tried"
26063 .cindex "MX record" "maximum tried"
26064 This option limits the number of IP addresses that are tried for any one
26065 delivery in cases where there are temporary delivery errors. Section
26066 &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes in detail how the value of this option is used.
26069 .option hosts_max_try_hardlimit smtp integer 50
26070 This is an additional check on the maximum number of IP addresses that Exim
26071 tries for any one delivery. Section &<<SECTvalhosmax>>& describes its use and
26076 .option hosts_nopass_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26077 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
26078 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
26079 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26080 For any host that matches this list, a connection on which a TLS session has
26081 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
26082 message on the same connection. See section &<<SECTmulmessam>>& for an
26083 explanation of when this might be needed.
26085 .option hosts_noproxy_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26086 .cindex "TLS" "passing connection"
26087 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
26088 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
26089 For any host that matches this list, a TLS session which has
26090 been started will not be passed to a new delivery process for sending another
26091 message on the same session.
26093 The traditional implementation closes down TLS and re-starts it in the new
26094 process, on the same open TCP connection, for each successive message
26095 sent. If permitted by this option a pipe to to the new process is set up
26096 instead, and the original process maintains the TLS connection and proxies
26097 the SMTP connection from and to the new process and any subsequents.
26098 The new process has no access to TLS information, so cannot include it in
26103 .option hosts_override smtp boolean false
26104 If this option is set and the &%hosts%& option is also set, any hosts that are
26105 attached to the address are ignored, and instead the hosts specified by the
26106 &%hosts%& option are always used. This option does not apply to
26107 &%fallback_hosts%&.
26110 .option hosts_randomize smtp boolean false
26111 .cindex "randomized host list"
26112 .cindex "host" "list of; randomized"
26113 .cindex "fallback" "randomized hosts"
26114 If this option is set, and either the list of hosts is taken from the
26115 &%hosts%& or the &%fallback_hosts%& option, or the hosts supplied by the router
26116 were not obtained from MX records (this includes fallback hosts from the
26117 router), and were not randomized by the router, the order of trying the hosts
26118 is randomized each time the transport runs. Randomizing the order of a host
26119 list can be used to do crude load sharing.
26121 When &%hosts_randomize%& is true, a host list may be split into groups whose
26122 order is separately randomized. This makes it possible to set up MX-like
26123 behaviour. The boundaries between groups are indicated by an item that is just
26124 &`+`& in the host list. For example:
26126 hosts = host1:host2:host3:+:host4:host5
26128 The order of the first three hosts and the order of the last two hosts is
26129 randomized for each use, but the first three always end up before the last two.
26130 If &%hosts_randomize%& is not set, a &`+`& item in the list is ignored.
26132 .option hosts_require_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
26133 .cindex "authentication" "required by client"
26134 This option provides a list of servers for which authentication must succeed
26135 before Exim will try to transfer a message. If authentication fails for
26136 servers which are not in this list, Exim tries to send unauthenticated. If
26137 authentication fails for one of these servers, delivery is deferred. This
26138 temporary error is detectable in the retry rules, so it can be turned into a
26139 hard failure if required. See also &%hosts_try_auth%&, and chapter
26140 &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
26143 .option hosts_request_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" "see below"
26144 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
26145 Exim will request a Certificate Status on a
26146 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
26147 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
26149 The default is &"**"& if DANE is not in use for the connection,
26150 or if DANE-TA us used.
26151 It is empty if DANE-EE is used.
26153 .option hosts_require_alpn smtp "host list&!!" unset
26154 .cindex ALPN "require negotiation in client"
26156 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
26157 If the TLS library supports ALPN
26158 then a successful negotiation of ALPN will be required for any host
26159 matching the list, for TLS to be used.
26160 See also the &%tls_alpn%& option.
26162 &*Note*&: prevention of fallback to in-clear connection is not
26163 managed by this option; see &%hosts_require_tls%&.
26165 .option hosts_require_dane smtp "host list&!!" unset
26166 .cindex DANE "transport options"
26167 .cindex DANE "requiring for certain servers"
26168 If built with DANE support, Exim will require that a DNSSEC-validated
26169 TLSA record is present for any host matching the list,
26170 and that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made.
26171 There will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
26172 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
26173 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
26175 .option hosts_require_ocsp smtp "host list&!!" unset
26176 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
26177 Exim will request, and check for a valid Certificate Status being given, on a
26178 TLS session for any host that matches this list.
26179 &%tls_verify_certificates%& should also be set for the transport.
26181 .option hosts_require_tls smtp "host list&!!" unset
26182 .cindex "TLS" "requiring for certain servers"
26183 Exim will insist on using a TLS session when delivering to any host that
26184 matches this list. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26185 &*Note*&: This option affects outgoing mail only. To insist on TLS for
26186 incoming messages, use an appropriate ACL.
26188 .option hosts_try_auth smtp "host list&!!" unset
26189 .cindex "authentication" "optional in client"
26190 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
26191 authentication support, Exim will attempt to authenticate as a client when it
26192 connects. If authentication fails
26193 and &%hosts_require_auth%& permits,
26194 Exim will try to transfer the message unauthenticated.
26195 See also chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>& for details of authentication.
26197 .option hosts_try_chunking smtp "host list&!!" *
26198 .cindex CHUNKING "enabling, in client"
26199 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
26200 .cindex "RFC 3030" "CHUNKING"
26201 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
26202 CHUNKING support, Exim will attempt to use BDAT commands rather than DATA.
26203 Unless DKIM signing is being done,
26204 BDAT will not be used in conjunction with a transport filter.
26206 .option hosts_try_dane smtp "host list&!!" *
26207 .cindex DANE "transport options"
26208 .cindex DANE "attempting for certain servers"
26209 If built with DANE support, Exim will look up a
26210 TLSA record for any host matching the list,
26211 If one is found and that lookup was DNSSEC-validated,
26212 then Exim requires that a DANE-verified TLS connection is made for that host;
26213 there will be no fallback to in-clear communication.
26214 See the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router and transport options.
26215 See section &<<SECDANE>>&.
26217 .option hosts_try_fastopen smtp "host list&!!" *
26218 .cindex "fast open, TCP" "enabling, in client"
26219 .cindex "TCP Fast Open" "enabling, in client"
26220 .cindex "RFC 7413" "TCP Fast Open"
26221 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided
26222 the facility is supported by this system, Exim will attempt to
26223 perform a TCP Fast Open (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7413,RFC 7413).
26224 No data is sent on the SYN segment but, if the remote server also
26225 supports the facility, it can send its SMTP banner immediately after
26226 the SYN,ACK segment. This can save up to one round-trip time.
26228 The facility is only active for previously-contacted servers,
26229 as the initiator must present a cookie in the SYN segment.
26231 On (at least some) current Linux distributions the facility must be enabled
26232 in the kernel by the sysadmin before the support is usable.
26233 There is no option for control of the server side; if the system supports
26234 it it is always enabled. Note that lengthy operations in the connect ACL,
26235 such as DNSBL lookups, will still delay the emission of the SMTP banner.
26237 .option hosts_try_prdr smtp "host list&!!" *
26238 .cindex "PRDR" "enabling, optional in client"
26239 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PRDR
26240 This option provides a list of servers to which, provided they announce
26241 PRDR support, Exim will attempt to negotiate PRDR
26242 for multi-recipient messages.
26243 The option can usually be left as default.
26245 .option interface smtp "string list&!!" unset
26246 .cindex "bind IP address"
26247 .cindex "IP address" "binding"
26249 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26250 This option specifies which interface to bind to when making an outgoing SMTP
26251 call. The value is an IP address, not an interface name such as
26252 &`eth0`&. Do not confuse this with the interface address that was used when a
26253 message was received, which is in &$received_ip_address$&, formerly known as
26254 &$interface_address$&. The name was changed to minimize confusion with the
26255 outgoing interface address. There is no variable that contains an outgoing
26256 interface address because, unless it is set by this option, its value is
26259 During the expansion of the &%interface%& option the variables &$host$& and
26260 &$host_address$& refer to the host to which a connection is about to be made
26261 during the expansion of the string. Forced expansion failure, or an empty
26262 string result causes the option to be ignored. Otherwise, after expansion, the
26263 string must be a list of IP addresses, colon-separated by default, but the
26264 separator can be changed in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
26267 interface = <; 192.168.123.123 ; 3ffe:ffff:836f::fe86:a061
26269 The first interface of the correct type (IPv4 or IPv6) is used for the outgoing
26270 connection. If none of them are the correct type, the option is ignored. If
26271 &%interface%& is not set, or is ignored, the system's IP functions choose which
26272 interface to use if the host has more than one.
26275 .option keepalive smtp boolean true
26276 .cindex "keepalive" "on outgoing connection"
26277 This option controls the setting of SO_KEEPALIVE on outgoing TCP/IP socket
26278 connections. When set, it causes the kernel to probe idle connections
26279 periodically, by sending packets with &"old"& sequence numbers. The other end
26280 of the connection should send a acknowledgment if the connection is still okay
26281 or a reset if the connection has been aborted. The reason for doing this is
26282 that it has the beneficial effect of freeing up certain types of connection
26283 that can get stuck when the remote host is disconnected without tidying up the
26284 TCP/IP call properly. The keepalive mechanism takes several hours to detect
26288 .option lmtp_ignore_quota smtp boolean false
26289 .cindex "LMTP" "ignoring quota errors"
26290 If this option is set true when the &%protocol%& option is set to &"lmtp"&, the
26291 string &`IGNOREQUOTA`& is added to RCPT commands, provided that the LMTP server
26292 has advertised support for IGNOREQUOTA in its response to the LHLO command.
26294 .option max_rcpt smtp integer&!! 100
26295 .cindex "RCPT" "maximum number of outgoing"
26298 limits the number of RCPT commands that are sent in a single
26299 SMTP message transaction.
26300 A value setting of zero disables the limit.
26302 If a constant is given,
26303 each set of addresses is treated independently, and
26304 so can cause parallel connections to the same host if &%remote_max_parallel%&
26307 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26308 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTMAX value,
26309 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26310 that value also constrains the result of this option
26311 and no parallel connections will be caused on meeting the RCPTMAX limit.
26314 .option message_linelength_limit smtp integer 998
26315 .cindex "line length" limit
26316 This option sets the maximum line length, in bytes, that the transport
26317 will send. Any messages with lines exceeding the given value
26318 (before a transport filter, if any)
26319 will fail and a failure-DSN ("bounce") message will if possible be returned
26321 The default value is that defined by the SMTP standards.
26323 It is generally wise to also check in the data ACL so that messages
26324 received via SMTP can be refused without producing a bounce.
26327 .option multi_domain smtp boolean&!! true
26328 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26329 When this option is set, the &(smtp)& transport can handle a number of
26330 addresses containing a mixture of different domains provided they all resolve
26331 to the same list of hosts. Turning the option off restricts the transport to
26332 handling only one domain at a time. This is useful if you want to use
26333 &$domain$& in an expansion for the transport, because it is set only when there
26334 is a single domain involved in a remote delivery.
26336 It is expanded per-address and can depend on any of
26337 &$address_data$&, &$domain_data$&, &$local_part_data$&,
26338 &$host$&, &$host_address$& and &$host_port$&.
26340 If the connection is DANE-enabled then this option is ignored;
26341 only messages having the domain used for the DANE TLSA lookup are
26342 sent on the connection.
26344 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" LIMITS
26345 If the peer advertises a LIMITS extension with a RCPTDOMAINMAX value,
26346 and either TLSS is in use or was not advertised,
26347 this option is regarded as being false.
26350 .option port smtp string&!! "see below"
26351 .cindex "port" "sending TCP/IP"
26352 .cindex "TCP/IP" "setting outgoing port"
26353 This option specifies the TCP/IP port on the server to which Exim connects.
26354 &*Note:*& Do not confuse this with the port that was used when a message was
26355 received, which is in &$received_port$&, formerly known as &$interface_port$&.
26356 The name was changed to minimize confusion with the outgoing port. There is no
26357 variable that contains an outgoing port.
26359 If the value of this option begins with a digit it is taken as a port number;
26360 otherwise it is looked up using &[getservbyname()]&. The default value is
26362 but if &%protocol%& is set to &"lmtp"& the default is &"lmtp"&
26363 and if &%protocol%& is set to &"smtps"& the default is &"smtps"&.
26364 If the expansion fails, or if a port number cannot be found, delivery
26367 Note that at least one Linux distribution has been seen failing
26368 to put &"smtps"& in its &"/etc/services"& file, resulting is such deferrals.
26372 .option protocol smtp string smtp
26373 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
26374 .cindex "ssmtp protocol" "outbound"
26375 .cindex "TLS" "SSL-on-connect outbound"
26377 If this option is set to &"lmtp"& instead of &"smtp"&, the default value for
26378 the &%port%& option changes to &"lmtp"&, and the transport operates the LMTP
26380 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2033,RFC 2033)) instead of SMTP.
26381 This protocol is sometimes used for local
26382 deliveries into closed message stores. Exim also has support for running LMTP
26383 over a pipe to a local process &-- see chapter &<<CHAPLMTP>>&.
26385 &*Note*&: When using LMTP it should be considered whether the default values
26386 for some other features, such as DANE, are appropriate.
26388 If this option is set to &"smtps"&, the default value for the &%port%& option
26389 changes to &"smtps"&, and the transport initiates TLS immediately after
26390 connecting, as an outbound SSL-on-connect, instead of using STARTTLS to upgrade.
26391 The Internet standards bodies used to strongly discourage use of this mode,
26392 but as of &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314) it is preferred
26393 over STARTTLS for message submission
26394 (as distinct from MTA-MTA communication).
26397 .option retry_include_ip_address smtp boolean&!! true
26398 Exim normally includes both the host name and the IP address in the key it
26399 constructs for indexing retry data after a temporary delivery failure. This
26400 means that when one of several IP addresses for a host is failing, it gets
26401 tried periodically (controlled by the retry rules), but use of the other IP
26402 addresses is not affected.
26404 However, in some dialup environments hosts are assigned a different IP address
26405 each time they connect. In this situation the use of the IP address as part of
26406 the retry key leads to undesirable behaviour. Setting this option false causes
26407 Exim to use only the host name.
26408 Since it is expanded it can be made to depend on the host or domain.
26411 .option serialize_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26412 .cindex "serializing connections"
26413 .cindex "host" "serializing connections"
26414 Because Exim operates in a distributed manner, if several messages for the same
26415 host arrive at around the same time, more than one simultaneous connection to
26416 the remote host can occur. This is not usually a problem except when there is a
26417 slow link between the hosts. In that situation it may be helpful to restrict
26418 Exim to one connection at a time. This can be done by setting
26419 &%serialize_hosts%& to match the relevant hosts.
26421 .cindex "hints database" "serializing deliveries to a host"
26422 Exim implements serialization by means of a hints database in which a record is
26423 written whenever a process connects to one of the restricted hosts. The record
26424 is deleted when the connection is completed. Obviously there is scope for
26425 records to get left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To
26426 guard against this, Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
26428 If you set up this kind of serialization, you should also arrange to delete the
26429 relevant hints database whenever your system reboots. The names of the files
26430 start with &_misc_& and they are kept in the &_spool/db_& directory. There
26431 may be one or two files, depending on the type of DBM in use. The same files
26432 are used for ETRN serialization.
26434 See also the &%max_parallel%& generic transport option.
26437 .option size_addition smtp integer 1024
26438 .cindex "SIZE" "ESMTP extension"
26439 .cindex "message" "size issue for transport filter"
26440 .cindex "size" "of message"
26441 .cindex "transport" "filter"
26442 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
26443 If a remote SMTP server indicates that it supports the SIZE option of the
26444 MAIL command, Exim uses this to pass over the message size at the start of
26445 an SMTP transaction. It adds the value of &%size_addition%& to the value it
26446 sends, to allow for headers and other text that may be added during delivery by
26447 configuration options or in a transport filter. It may be necessary to increase
26448 this if a lot of text is added to messages.
26450 Alternatively, if the value of &%size_addition%& is set negative, it disables
26451 the use of the SIZE option altogether.
26454 .option socks_proxy smtp string&!! unset
26455 .cindex proxy SOCKS
26456 This option enables use of SOCKS proxies for connections made by the
26457 transport. For details see section &<<SECTproxySOCKS>>&.
26460 .option tls_alpn smtp string&!! unset
26461 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
26463 .cindex ALPN "set name in client"
26464 If this option is set
26465 and the TLS library supports ALPN,
26466 the value given is used.
26468 As of writing no value has been standardised for email use.
26469 The authors suggest using &"smtp"&.
26473 .option tls_certificate smtp string&!! unset
26474 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate, location of"
26475 .cindex "certificate" "client, location of"
26477 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26478 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26479 client's certificate, for possible use when sending a message over an encrypted
26480 connection. The values of &$host$& and &$host_address$& are set to the name and
26481 address of the server during the expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for
26484 &*Note*&: This option must be set if you want Exim to be able to use a TLS
26485 certificate when sending messages as a client. The global option of the same
26486 name specifies the certificate for Exim as a server; it is not automatically
26487 assumed that the same certificate should be used when Exim is operating as a
26491 .option tls_crl smtp string&!! unset
26492 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate revocation list"
26493 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list for client"
26494 This option specifies a certificate revocation list. The expanded value must
26495 be the name of a file that contains a CRL in PEM format.
26498 .option tls_dh_min_bits smtp integer 1024
26499 .cindex "TLS" "Diffie-Hellman minimum acceptable size"
26500 When establishing a TLS session, if a ciphersuite which uses Diffie-Hellman
26501 key agreement is negotiated, the server will provide a large prime number
26502 for use. This option establishes the minimum acceptable size of that number.
26503 If the parameter offered by the server is too small, then the TLS handshake
26506 Only supported when using GnuTLS.
26509 .option tls_privatekey smtp string&!! unset
26510 .cindex "TLS" "client private key, location of"
26512 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26513 The value of this option must be the absolute path to a file which contains the
26514 client's private key. This is used when sending a message over an encrypted
26515 connection using a client certificate. The values of &$host$& and
26516 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26517 expansion. If this option is unset, or the expansion is forced to fail, or the
26518 result is an empty string, the private key is assumed to be in the same file as
26519 the certificate. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26522 .option tls_require_ciphers smtp string&!! unset
26523 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers"
26524 .cindex "cipher" "requiring specific"
26526 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26527 The value of this option must be a list of permitted cipher suites, for use
26528 when setting up an outgoing encrypted connection. (There is a global option of
26529 the same name for controlling incoming connections.) The values of &$host$& and
26530 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26531 expansion. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS; note that this option
26532 is used in different ways by OpenSSL and GnuTLS (see sections
26533 &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&). For GnuTLS, the order of the
26534 ciphers is a preference order.
26537 .option tls_resumption_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26538 .cindex TLS resumption
26539 This option controls which connections to use the TLS resumption feature.
26540 See &<<SECTresumption>>& for details.
26544 .option tls_sni smtp string&!! unset
26545 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
26547 .cindex SNI "setting in client"
26548 .vindex "&$tls_sni$&"
26549 If this option is set
26550 and the connection is not DANE-validated
26551 then it sets the $tls_out_sni variable and causes any
26552 TLS session to pass this value as the Server Name Indication extension to
26553 the remote side, which can be used by the remote side to select an appropriate
26554 certificate and private key for the session.
26556 See &<<SECTtlssni>>& for more information.
26558 Note that for OpenSSL, this feature requires a build of OpenSSL that supports
26564 .option tls_tempfail_tryclear smtp boolean true
26565 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "to STARTTLS"
26566 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and there is a problem in
26567 setting up a TLS session, this option determines whether or not Exim should try
26568 to deliver the message unencrypted. If it is set false, delivery to the
26569 current host is deferred; if there are other hosts, they are tried. If this
26570 option is set true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'&
26571 response to STARTTLS. Also, if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent
26572 TLS negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
26573 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
26577 .option tls_try_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" *
26578 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26579 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26580 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26581 certificate verification will be tried but need not succeed.
26582 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26583 Note that unless the host is in this list
26584 TLS connections will be denied to hosts using self-signed certificates
26585 when &%tls_verify_certificates%& is matched.
26586 The &$tls_out_certificate_verified$& variable is set when
26587 certificate verification succeeds.
26590 .option tls_verify_cert_hostnames smtp "host list&!!" *
26591 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate hostname verification"
26592 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26593 This option give a list of hosts for which,
26594 while verifying the server certificate,
26595 checks will be included on the host name
26596 (note that this will generally be the result of a DNS MX lookup)
26597 versus the Subject-Alternate-Name (or, if none, Subject-Name) fields.
26598 Wildcard names are permitted,
26599 limited to being the initial component of a 3-or-more component FQDN.
26601 There is no equivalent checking on client certificates.
26604 .option tls_verify_certificates smtp string&!! system
26605 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26606 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26608 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
26609 The value of this option must be either the
26611 or the absolute path to
26612 a file or directory containing permitted certificates for servers,
26613 for use when setting up an encrypted connection.
26615 The "system" value for the option will use a location compiled into the SSL library.
26616 This is not available for GnuTLS versions preceding 3.0.20; a value of "system"
26617 is taken as empty and an explicit location
26620 The use of a directory for the option value is not available for GnuTLS versions
26621 preceding 3.3.6 and a single file must be used.
26623 With OpenSSL the certificates specified
26625 either by file or directory
26626 are added to those given by the system default location.
26628 The values of &$host$& and
26629 &$host_address$& are set to the name and address of the server during the
26630 expansion of this option. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for details of TLS.
26632 For back-compatibility,
26633 if neither tls_verify_hosts nor tls_try_verify_hosts are set
26634 (a single-colon empty list counts as being set)
26635 and certificate verification fails the TLS connection is closed.
26638 .option tls_verify_hosts smtp "host list&!!" unset
26639 .cindex "TLS" "server certificate verification"
26640 .cindex "certificate" "verification of server"
26641 This option gives a list of hosts for which, on encrypted connections,
26642 certificate verification must succeed.
26643 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option must also be set.
26644 If both this option and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& are unset
26645 operation is as if this option selected all hosts.
26646 &*Warning*&: Including a host in &%tls_verify_hosts%& does not require
26647 that connections use TLS.
26648 Fallback to in-clear communication will be done unless restricted by
26649 the &%hosts_require_tls%& option.
26651 .option utf8_downconvert smtp integer&!! -1
26652 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
26653 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
26654 If built with internationalization support,
26655 this option controls conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
26657 If, after expansion, the value is 1, 0, or -1 then this value overrides
26658 any value previously set for the message. Otherwise, any previously
26659 set value is used. To permit use of a previous value,
26660 set this option to an empty string.
26661 For details on the values see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
26666 .section "How the limits for the number of hosts to try are used" &&&
26668 .cindex "host" "maximum number to try"
26669 .cindex "limit" "hosts; maximum number tried"
26670 There are two options that are concerned with the number of hosts that are
26671 tried when an SMTP delivery takes place. They are &%hosts_max_try%& and
26672 &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%&.
26675 The &%hosts_max_try%& option limits the number of hosts that are tried
26676 for a single delivery. However, despite the term &"host"& in its name, the
26677 option actually applies to each IP address independently. In other words, a
26678 multihomed host is treated as several independent hosts, just as it is for
26681 Many of the larger ISPs have multiple MX records which often point to
26682 multihomed hosts. As a result, a list of a dozen or more IP addresses may be
26683 created as a result of routing one of these domains.
26685 Trying every single IP address on such a long list does not seem sensible; if
26686 several at the top of the list fail, it is reasonable to assume there is some
26687 problem that is likely to affect all of them. Roughly speaking, the value of
26688 &%hosts_max_try%& is the maximum number that are tried before deferring the
26689 delivery. However, the logic cannot be quite that simple.
26691 Firstly, IP addresses that are skipped because their retry times have not
26692 arrived do not count, and in addition, addresses that are past their retry
26693 limits are also not counted, even when they are tried. This means that when
26694 some IP addresses are past their retry limits, more than the value of
26695 &%hosts_max_retry%& may be tried. The reason for this behaviour is to ensure
26696 that all IP addresses are considered before timing out an email address (but
26697 see below for an exception).
26699 Secondly, when the &%hosts_max_try%& limit is reached, Exim looks down the host
26700 list to see if there is a subsequent host with a different (higher valued) MX.
26701 If there is, that host is considered next, and the current IP address is used
26702 but not counted. This behaviour helps in the case of a domain with a retry rule
26703 that hardly ever delays any hosts, as is now explained:
26705 Consider the case of a long list of hosts with one MX value, and a few with a
26706 higher MX value. If &%hosts_max_try%& is small (the default is 5) only a few
26707 hosts at the top of the list are tried at first. With the default retry rule,
26708 which specifies increasing retry times, the higher MX hosts are eventually
26709 tried when those at the top of the list are skipped because they have not
26710 reached their retry times.
26712 However, it is common practice to put a fixed short retry time on domains for
26713 large ISPs, on the grounds that their servers are rarely down for very long.
26714 Unfortunately, these are exactly the domains that tend to resolve to long lists
26715 of hosts. The short retry time means that the lowest MX hosts are tried every
26716 time. The attempts may be in a different order because of random sorting, but
26717 without the special MX check, the higher MX hosts would never be tried until
26718 all the lower MX hosts had timed out (which might be several days), because
26719 there are always some lower MX hosts that have reached their retry times. With
26720 the special check, Exim considers at least one IP address from each MX value at
26721 every delivery attempt, even if the &%hosts_max_try%& limit has already been
26724 The above logic means that &%hosts_max_try%& is not a hard limit, and in
26725 particular, Exim normally eventually tries all the IP addresses before timing
26726 out an email address. When &%hosts_max_try%& was implemented, this seemed a
26727 reasonable thing to do. Recently, however, some lunatic DNS configurations have
26728 been set up with hundreds of IP addresses for some domains. It can
26729 take a very long time indeed for an address to time out in these cases.
26731 The &%hosts_max_try_hardlimit%& option was added to help with this problem.
26732 Exim never tries more than this number of IP addresses; if it hits this limit
26733 and they are all timed out, the email address is bounced, even though not all
26734 possible IP addresses have been tried.
26735 .ecindex IIDsmttra1
26736 .ecindex IIDsmttra2
26742 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26743 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
26745 .chapter "Address rewriting" "CHAPrewrite"
26746 .scindex IIDaddrew "rewriting" "addresses"
26747 There are some circumstances in which Exim automatically rewrites domains in
26748 addresses. The two most common are when an address is given without a domain
26749 (referred to as an &"unqualified address"&) or when an address contains an
26750 abbreviated domain that is expanded by DNS lookup.
26752 Unqualified envelope addresses are accepted only for locally submitted
26753 messages, or for messages that are received from hosts matching
26754 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
26755 appropriate. Unqualified addresses in header lines are qualified if they are in
26756 locally submitted messages, or messages from hosts that are permitted to send
26757 unqualified envelope addresses. Otherwise, unqualified addresses in header
26758 lines are neither qualified nor rewritten.
26760 One situation in which Exim does &'not'& automatically rewrite a domain is
26761 when it is the name of a CNAME record in the DNS. The older RFCs suggest that
26762 such a domain should be rewritten using the &"canonical"& name, and some MTAs
26763 do this. The new RFCs do not contain this suggestion.
26766 .section "Explicitly configured address rewriting" "SECID147"
26767 This chapter describes the rewriting rules that can be used in the
26768 main rewrite section of the configuration file, and also in the generic
26769 &%headers_rewrite%& option that can be set on any transport.
26771 Some people believe that configured address rewriting is a Mortal Sin.
26772 Others believe that life is not possible without it. Exim provides the
26773 facility; you do not have to use it.
26775 The main rewriting rules that appear in the &"rewrite"& section of the
26776 configuration file are applied to addresses in incoming messages, both envelope
26777 addresses and addresses in header lines. Each rule specifies the types of
26778 address to which it applies.
26780 Whether or not addresses in header lines are rewritten depends on the origin of
26781 the headers and the type of rewriting. Global rewriting, that is, rewriting
26782 rules from the rewrite section of the configuration file, is applied only to
26783 those headers that were received with the message. Header lines that are added
26784 by ACLs or by a system filter or by individual routers or transports (which
26785 are specific to individual recipient addresses) are not rewritten by the global
26788 Rewriting at transport time, by means of the &%headers_rewrite%& option,
26789 applies all headers except those added by routers and transports. That is, as
26790 well as the headers that were received with the message, it also applies to
26791 headers that were added by an ACL or a system filter.
26794 In general, rewriting addresses from your own system or domain has some
26795 legitimacy. Rewriting other addresses should be done only with great care and
26796 in special circumstances. The author of Exim believes that rewriting should be
26797 used sparingly, and mainly for &"regularizing"& addresses in your own domains.
26798 Although it can sometimes be used as a routing tool, this is very strongly
26801 There are two commonly encountered circumstances where rewriting is used, as
26802 illustrated by these examples:
26805 The company whose domain is &'hitch.fict.example'& has a number of hosts that
26806 exchange mail with each other behind a firewall, but there is only a single
26807 gateway to the outer world. The gateway rewrites &'*.hitch.fict.example'& as
26808 &'hitch.fict.example'& when sending mail off-site.
26810 A host rewrites the local parts of its own users so that, for example,
26811 &'fp42@hitch.fict.example'& becomes &'Ford.Prefect@hitch.fict.example'&.
26816 .section "When does rewriting happen?" "SECID148"
26817 .cindex "rewriting" "timing of"
26818 .cindex "&ACL;" "rewriting addresses in"
26819 Configured address rewriting can take place at several different stages of a
26820 message's processing.
26822 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
26823 At the start of an ACL for MAIL, the sender address may have been rewritten
26824 by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule (see section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&), but no
26825 ordinary rewrite rules have yet been applied. If, however, the sender address
26826 is verified in the ACL, it is rewritten before verification, and remains
26827 rewritten thereafter. The subsequent value of &$sender_address$& is the
26828 rewritten address. This also applies if sender verification happens in a
26829 RCPT ACL. Otherwise, when the sender address is not verified, it is
26830 rewritten as soon as a message's header lines have been received.
26832 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26833 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26834 Similarly, at the start of an ACL for RCPT, the current recipient's address
26835 may have been rewritten by a special SMTP-time rewrite rule, but no ordinary
26836 rewrite rules have yet been applied to it. However, the behaviour is different
26837 from the sender address when a recipient is verified. The address is rewritten
26838 for the verification, but the rewriting is not remembered at this stage. The
26839 value of &$local_part$& and &$domain$& after verification are always the same
26840 as they were before (that is, they contain the unrewritten &-- except for
26841 SMTP-time rewriting &-- address).
26843 As soon as a message's header lines have been received, all the envelope
26844 recipient addresses are permanently rewritten, and rewriting is also applied to
26845 the addresses in the header lines (if configured). This happens before adding
26846 any header lines that were specified in MAIL or RCPT ACLs, and
26847 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "address rewriting; timing of"
26848 before the DATA ACL and &[local_scan()]& functions are run.
26850 When an address is being routed, either for delivery or for verification,
26851 rewriting is applied immediately to child addresses that are generated by
26852 redirection, unless &%no_rewrite%& is set on the router.
26854 .cindex "envelope from"
26855 .cindex "envelope sender" "rewriting at transport time"
26856 .cindex "rewriting" "at transport time"
26857 .cindex "header lines" "rewriting at transport time"
26858 At transport time, additional rewriting of addresses in header lines can be
26859 specified by setting the generic &%headers_rewrite%& option on a transport.
26860 This option contains rules that are identical in form to those in the rewrite
26861 section of the configuration file. They are applied to the original message
26862 header lines and any that were added by ACLs or a system filter. They are not
26863 applied to header lines that are added by routers or the transport.
26865 The outgoing envelope sender can be rewritten by means of the &%return_path%&
26866 transport option. However, it is not possible to rewrite envelope recipients at
26872 .section "Testing the rewriting rules that apply on input" "SECID149"
26873 .cindex "rewriting" "testing"
26874 .cindex "testing" "rewriting"
26875 Exim's input rewriting configuration appears in a part of the runtime
26876 configuration file headed by &"begin rewrite"&. It can be tested by the
26877 &%-brw%& command line option. This takes an address (which can be a full
26878 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
26879 address) as its argument. The output is a list of how the address would be
26880 transformed by the rewriting rules for each of the different places it might
26881 appear in an incoming message, that is, for each different header and for the
26882 envelope sender and recipient fields. For example,
26884 exim -brw ph10@exim.workshop.example
26886 might produce the output
26888 sender: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26889 from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26890 to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26891 cc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26892 bcc: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26893 reply-to: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26894 env-from: Philip.Hazel@exim.workshop.example
26895 env-to: ph10@exim.workshop.example
26897 which shows that rewriting has been set up for that address when used in any of
26898 the source fields, but not when it appears as a recipient address. At the
26899 present time, there is no equivalent way of testing rewriting rules that are
26900 set for a particular transport.
26903 .section "Rewriting rules" "SECID150"
26904 .cindex "rewriting" "rules"
26905 The rewrite section of the configuration file consists of lines of rewriting
26908 <&'source pattern'&> <&'replacement'&> <&'flags'&>
26910 Rewriting rules that are specified for the &%headers_rewrite%& generic
26911 transport option are given as a colon-separated list. Each item in the list
26912 takes the same form as a line in the main rewriting configuration (except that
26913 any colons must be doubled, of course).
26915 The formats of source patterns and replacement strings are described below.
26916 Each is terminated by white space, unless enclosed in double quotes, in which
26917 case normal quoting conventions apply inside the quotes. The flags are single
26918 characters which may appear in any order. Spaces and tabs between them are
26921 For each address that could potentially be rewritten, the rules are scanned in
26922 order, and replacements for the address from earlier rules can themselves be
26923 replaced by later rules (but see the &"q"& and &"R"& flags).
26925 The order in which addresses are rewritten is undefined, may change between
26926 releases, and must not be relied on, with one exception: when a message is
26927 received, the envelope sender is always rewritten first, before any header
26928 lines are rewritten. For example, the replacement string for a rewrite of an
26929 address in &'To:'& must not assume that the message's address in &'From:'& has
26930 (or has not) already been rewritten. However, a rewrite of &'From:'& may assume
26931 that the envelope sender has already been rewritten.
26933 .vindex "&$domain$&"
26934 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
26935 The variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& can be used in the replacement
26936 string to refer to the address that is being rewritten. Note that lookup-driven
26937 rewriting can be done by a rule of the form
26941 where the lookup key uses &$1$& and &$2$& or &$local_part$& and &$domain$& to
26942 refer to the address that is being rewritten.
26945 .section "Rewriting patterns" "SECID151"
26946 .cindex "rewriting" "patterns"
26947 .cindex "address list" "in a rewriting pattern"
26948 The source pattern in a rewriting rule is any item which may appear in an
26949 address list (see section &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a
26950 single-item address list, which means that it is expanded before being tested
26951 against the address. As always, if you use a regular expression as a pattern,
26952 you must take care to escape dollar and backslash characters, or use the &`\N`&
26953 facility to suppress string expansion within the regular expression.
26955 Domains in patterns should be given in lower case. Local parts in patterns are
26956 case-sensitive. If you want to do case-insensitive matching of local parts, you
26957 can use a regular expression that starts with &`^(?i)`&.
26959 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in rewriting rules"
26960 After matching, the numerical variables &$1$&, &$2$&, etc. may be set,
26961 depending on the type of match which occurred. These can be used in the
26962 replacement string to insert portions of the incoming address. &$0$& always
26963 refers to the complete incoming address. When a regular expression is used, the
26964 numerical variables are set from its capturing subexpressions. For other types
26965 of pattern they are set as follows:
26968 If a local part or domain starts with an asterisk, the numerical variables
26969 refer to the character strings matched by asterisks, with &$1$& associated with
26970 the first asterisk, and &$2$& with the second, if present. For example, if the
26973 *queen@*.fict.example
26975 is matched against the address &'hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example'& then
26977 $0 = hearts-queen@wonderland.fict.example
26981 Note that if the local part does not start with an asterisk, but the domain
26982 does, it is &$1$& that contains the wild part of the domain.
26985 If the domain part of the pattern is a partial lookup, the wild and fixed parts
26986 of the domain are placed in the next available numerical variables. Suppose,
26987 for example, that the address &'foo@bar.baz.example'& is processed by a
26988 rewriting rule of the form
26990 &`*@partial-dbm;/some/dbm/file`& <&'replacement string'&>
26992 and the key in the file that matches the domain is &`*.baz.example`&. Then
26998 If the address &'foo@baz.example'& is looked up, this matches the same
26999 wildcard file entry, and in this case &$2$& is set to the empty string, but
27000 &$3$& is still set to &'baz.example'&. If a non-wild key is matched in a
27001 partial lookup, &$2$& is again set to the empty string and &$3$& is set to the
27002 whole domain. For non-partial domain lookups, no numerical variables are set.
27006 .section "Rewriting replacements" "SECID152"
27007 .cindex "rewriting" "replacements"
27008 If the replacement string for a rule is a single asterisk, addresses that
27009 match the pattern and the flags are &'not'& rewritten, and no subsequent
27010 rewriting rules are scanned. For example,
27012 hatta@lookingglass.fict.example * f
27014 specifies that &'hatta@lookingglass.fict.example'& is never to be rewritten in
27017 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27018 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
27019 If the replacement string is not a single asterisk, it is expanded, and must
27020 yield a fully qualified address. Within the expansion, the variables
27021 &$local_part$& and &$domain$& refer to the address that is being rewritten.
27022 Any letters they contain retain their original case &-- they are not lower
27023 cased. The numerical variables are set up according to the type of pattern that
27024 matched the address, as described above. If the expansion is forced to fail by
27025 the presence of &"fail"& in a conditional or lookup item, rewriting by the
27026 current rule is abandoned, but subsequent rules may take effect. Any other
27027 expansion failure causes the entire rewriting operation to be abandoned, and an
27028 entry written to the panic log.
27032 .subsection "Rewriting flags" "SSECID153"
27033 There are three different kinds of flag that may appear on rewriting rules:
27036 Flags that specify which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite: E, F, T, b,
27039 A flag that specifies rewriting at SMTP time: S.
27041 Flags that control the rewriting process: Q, q, R, w.
27044 For rules that are part of the &%headers_rewrite%& generic transport option,
27045 E, F, T, and S are not permitted.
27049 .subsection "Flags specifying which headers and envelope addresses to rewrite" &&&
27051 .cindex rewriting flags
27052 If none of the following flag letters, nor the &"S"& flag (see section
27053 &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&) are present, a main rewriting rule applies to all headers
27054 and to both the sender and recipient fields of the envelope, whereas a
27055 transport-time rewriting rule just applies to all headers. Otherwise, the
27056 rewriting rule is skipped unless the relevant addresses are being processed.
27058 &`E`& rewrite all envelope fields
27059 &`F`& rewrite the envelope From field
27060 &`T`& rewrite the envelope To field
27061 &`b`& rewrite the &'Bcc:'& header
27062 &`c`& rewrite the &'Cc:'& header
27063 &`f`& rewrite the &'From:'& header
27064 &`h`& rewrite all headers
27065 &`r`& rewrite the &'Reply-To:'& header
27066 &`s`& rewrite the &'Sender:'& header
27067 &`t`& rewrite the &'To:'& header
27069 "All headers" means all of the headers listed above that can be selected
27070 individually, plus their &'Resent-'& versions. It does not include
27071 other headers such as &'Subject:'& etc.
27073 You should be particularly careful about rewriting &'Sender:'& headers, and
27074 restrict this to special known cases in your own domains.
27077 .subsection "The SMTP-time rewriting flag" SSECTrewriteS
27078 .cindex SMTP "rewriting malformed addresses"
27079 .cindex RCPT "rewriting argument of"
27080 .cindex MAIL "rewriting argument of"
27081 The rewrite flag &"S"& specifies a rewrite of incoming envelope addresses at
27082 SMTP time, as soon as an address is received in a MAIL or RCPT command, and
27083 before any other processing; even before syntax checking. The pattern is
27084 required to be a regular expression, and it is matched against the whole of the
27085 data for the command, including any surrounding angle brackets.
27087 .vindex "&$domain$&"
27088 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
27089 This form of rewrite rule allows for the handling of addresses that are not
27090 compliant with RFCs
27091 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,2821) and
27092 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,2822)
27093 (for example, &"bang paths"& in batched SMTP
27094 input). Because the input is not required to be a syntactically valid address,
27095 the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$& are not available during the
27096 expansion of the replacement string. The result of rewriting replaces the
27097 original address in the MAIL or RCPT command.
27100 .subsection "Flags controlling the rewriting process" SSECID155
27101 There are four flags which control the way the rewriting process works. These
27102 take effect only when a rule is invoked, that is, when the address is of the
27103 correct type (matches the flags) and matches the pattern:
27106 If the &"Q"& flag is set on a rule, the rewritten address is permitted to be an
27107 unqualified local part. It is qualified with &%qualify_recipient%&. In the
27108 absence of &"Q"& the rewritten address must always include a domain.
27110 If the &"q"& flag is set on a rule, no further rewriting rules are considered,
27111 even if no rewriting actually takes place because of a &"fail"& in the
27112 expansion. The &"q"& flag is not effective if the address is of the wrong type
27113 (does not match the flags) or does not match the pattern.
27115 The &"R"& flag causes a successful rewriting rule to be re-applied to the new
27116 address, up to ten times. It can be combined with the &"q"& flag, to stop
27117 rewriting once it fails to match (after at least one successful rewrite).
27119 .cindex "rewriting" "whole addresses"
27120 When an address in a header is rewritten, the rewriting normally applies only
27121 to the working part of the address, with any comments and
27122 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
27123 &"phrase"& left unchanged. For example, rewriting might change
27125 From: Ford Prefect <fp42@restaurant.hitch.fict.example>
27129 From: Ford Prefect <prefectf@hitch.fict.example>
27132 Sometimes there is a need to replace the whole address item, and this can be
27133 done by adding the flag letter &"w"& to a rule. If this is set on a rule that
27134 causes an address in a header line to be rewritten, the entire address is
27135 replaced, not just the working part. The replacement must be a complete
27136 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
27137 address, including the angle brackets if necessary. If text outside angle
27138 brackets contains a character whose value is greater than 126 or less than 32
27139 (except for tab), the text is encoded according to
27140 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047). The character set
27141 is taken from &%headers_charset%&, which gets its default at build time.
27143 When the &"w"& flag is set on a rule that causes an envelope address to be
27144 rewritten, all but the working part of the replacement address is discarded.
27148 .section "Rewriting examples" "SECID156"
27149 Here is an example of the two common rewriting paradigms:
27151 *@*.hitch.fict.example $1@hitch.fict.example
27152 *@hitch.fict.example ${lookup{$1}dbm{/etc/realnames}\
27153 {$value}fail}@hitch.fict.example bctfrF
27155 Note the use of &"fail"& in the lookup expansion in the second rule, forcing
27156 the string expansion to fail if the lookup does not succeed. In this context it
27157 has the effect of leaving the original address unchanged, but Exim goes on to
27158 consider subsequent rewriting rules, if any, because the &"q"& flag is not
27159 present in that rule. An alternative to &"fail"& would be to supply &$1$&
27160 explicitly, which would cause the rewritten address to be the same as before,
27161 at the cost of a small bit of processing. Not supplying either of these is an
27162 error, since the rewritten address would then contain no local part.
27164 The first example above replaces the domain with a superior, more general
27165 domain. This may not be desirable for certain local parts. If the rule
27167 root@*.hitch.fict.example *
27169 were inserted before the first rule, rewriting would be suppressed for the
27170 local part &'root'& at any domain ending in &'hitch.fict.example'&.
27172 Rewriting can be made conditional on a number of tests, by making use of
27173 &${if$& in the expansion item. For example, to apply a rewriting rule only to
27174 messages that originate outside the local host:
27176 *@*.hitch.fict.example "${if !eq {$sender_host_address}{}\
27177 {$1@hitch.fict.example}fail}"
27179 The replacement string is quoted in this example because it contains white
27182 .cindex "rewriting" "bang paths"
27183 .cindex "bang paths" "rewriting"
27184 Exim does not handle addresses in the form of &"bang paths"&. If it sees such
27185 an address it treats it as an unqualified local part which it qualifies with
27186 the local qualification domain (if the source of the message is local or if the
27187 remote host is permitted to send unqualified addresses). Rewriting can
27188 sometimes be used to handle simple bang paths with a fixed number of
27189 components. For example, the rule
27191 \N^([^!]+)!(.*)@your.domain.example$\N $2@$1
27193 rewrites a two-component bang path &'host.name!user'& as the domain address
27194 &'user@host.name'&. However, there is a security implication in using this as
27195 a global rewriting rule for envelope addresses. It can provide a backdoor
27196 method for using your system as a relay, because the incoming addresses appear
27197 to be local. If the bang path addresses are received via SMTP, it is safer to
27198 use the &"S"& flag to rewrite them as they are received, so that relay checking
27199 can be done on the rewritten addresses.
27206 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27207 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27209 .chapter "Retry configuration" "CHAPretry"
27210 .scindex IIDretconf1 "retry" "configuration, description of"
27211 .scindex IIDregconf2 "configuration file" "retry section"
27212 The &"retry"& section of the runtime configuration file contains a list of
27213 retry rules that control how often Exim tries to deliver messages that cannot
27214 be delivered at the first attempt. If there are no retry rules (the section is
27215 empty or not present), there are no retries. In this situation, temporary
27216 errors are treated as permanent. The default configuration contains a single,
27217 general-purpose retry rule (see section &<<SECID57>>&). The &%-brt%& command
27218 line option can be used to test which retry rule will be used for a given
27219 address, domain and error.
27221 The most common cause of retries is temporary failure to deliver to a remote
27222 host because the host is down, or inaccessible because of a network problem.
27223 Exim's retry processing in this case is applied on a per-host (strictly, per IP
27224 address) basis, not on a per-message basis. Thus, if one message has recently
27225 been delayed, delivery of a new message to the same host is not immediately
27226 tried, but waits for the host's retry time to arrive. If the &%retry_defer%&
27227 log selector is set, the message
27228 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
27229 &"retry time not reached"& is written to the main log whenever a delivery is
27230 skipped for this reason. Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& contains more details of
27231 the handling of errors during remote deliveries.
27233 Retry processing applies to routing as well as to delivering, except as covered
27234 in the next paragraph. The retry rules do not distinguish between these
27235 actions. It is not possible, for example, to specify different behaviour for
27236 failures to route the domain &'snark.fict.example'& and failures to deliver to
27237 the host &'snark.fict.example'&. I didn't think anyone would ever need this
27238 added complication, so did not implement it. However, although they share the
27239 same retry rule, the actual retry times for routing and transporting a given
27240 domain are maintained independently.
27242 When a delivery is not part of a queue run (typically an immediate delivery on
27243 receipt of a message), the routers are always run, and local deliveries are
27244 always attempted, even if retry times are set for them. This makes for better
27245 behaviour if one particular message is causing problems (for example, causing
27246 quota overflow, or provoking an error in a filter file). If such a delivery
27247 suffers a temporary failure, the retry data is updated as normal, and
27248 subsequent delivery attempts from queue runs occur only when the retry time for
27249 the local address is reached.
27251 .section "Changing retry rules" "SECID157"
27252 If you change the retry rules in your configuration, you should consider
27253 whether or not to delete the retry data that is stored in Exim's spool area in
27254 files with names like &_db/retry_&. Deleting any of Exim's hints files is
27255 always safe; that is why they are called &"hints"&.
27257 The hints retry data contains suggested retry times based on the previous
27258 rules. In the case of a long-running problem with a remote host, it might
27259 record the fact that the host has timed out. If your new rules increase the
27260 timeout time for such a host, you should definitely remove the old retry data
27261 and let Exim recreate it, based on the new rules. Otherwise Exim might bounce
27262 messages that it should now be retaining.
27266 .section "Format of retry rules" "SECID158"
27267 .cindex "retry" "rules"
27268 Each retry rule occupies one line and consists of three or four parts,
27269 separated by white space: a pattern, an error name, an optional list of sender
27270 addresses, and a list of retry parameters. The pattern and sender lists must be
27271 enclosed in double quotes if they contain white space. The rules are searched
27272 in order until one is found where the pattern, error name, and sender list (if
27273 present) match the failing host or address, the error that occurred, and the
27274 message's sender, respectively.
27277 The pattern is any single item that may appear in an address list (see section
27278 &<<SECTaddresslist>>&). It is in fact processed as a one-item address list,
27279 which means that it is expanded before being tested against the address that
27280 has been delayed. A negated address list item is permitted. Address
27281 list processing treats a plain domain name as if it were preceded by &"*@"&,
27282 which makes it possible for many retry rules to start with just a domain. For
27285 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27287 provides a rule for any address in the &'lookingglass.fict.example'& domain,
27290 alice@lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27292 applies only to temporary failures involving the local part &%alice%&.
27293 In practice, almost all rules start with a domain name pattern without a local
27296 .cindex "regular expressions" "in retry rules"
27297 &*Warning*&: If you use a regular expression in a retry rule pattern, it
27298 must match a complete address, not just a domain, because that is how regular
27299 expressions work in address lists.
27301 &`^\Nxyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Wrong%&
27302 &`^\N[^@]+@xyz\d+\.abc\.example$\N * G,1h,10m,2`& &%Right%&
27306 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for address errors" "SECID159"
27307 When Exim is looking for a retry rule after a routing attempt has failed (for
27308 example, after a DNS timeout), each line in the retry configuration is tested
27309 against the complete address only if &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the
27310 router. Otherwise, only the domain is used, except when matching against a
27311 regular expression, when the local part of the address is replaced with &"*"&.
27312 A domain on its own can match a domain pattern, or a pattern that starts with
27313 &"*@"&. By default, &%retry_use_local_part%& is true for routers where
27314 &%check_local_user%& is true, and false for other routers.
27316 Similarly, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a local delivery has
27317 failed (for example, after a mailbox full error), each line in the retry
27318 configuration is tested against the complete address only if
27319 &%retry_use_local_part%& is set for the transport (it defaults true for all
27322 .cindex "4&'xx'& responses" "retry rules for"
27323 However, when Exim is looking for a retry rule after a remote delivery attempt
27324 suffers an address error (a 4&'xx'& SMTP response for a recipient address), the
27325 whole address is always used as the key when searching the retry rules. The
27326 rule that is found is used to create a retry time for the combination of the
27327 failing address and the message's sender. It is the combination of sender and
27328 recipient that is delayed in subsequent queue runs until its retry time is
27329 reached. You can delay the recipient without regard to the sender by setting
27330 &%address_retry_include_sender%& false in the &(smtp)& transport but this can
27331 lead to problems with servers that regularly issue 4&'xx'& responses to RCPT
27336 .section "Choosing which retry rule to use for host and message errors" &&&
27338 For a temporary error that is not related to an individual address (for
27339 example, a connection timeout), each line in the retry configuration is checked
27340 twice. First, the name of the remote host is used as a domain name (preceded by
27341 &"*@"& when matching a regular expression). If this does not match the line,
27342 the domain from the email address is tried in a similar fashion. For example,
27343 suppose the MX records for &'a.b.c.example'& are
27345 a.b.c.example MX 5 x.y.z.example
27349 and the retry rules are
27351 p.q.r.example * F,24h,30m;
27352 a.b.c.example * F,4d,45m;
27354 and a delivery to the host &'x.y.z.example'& suffers a connection failure. The
27355 first rule matches neither the host nor the domain, so Exim looks at the second
27356 rule. This does not match the host, but it does match the domain, so it is used
27357 to calculate the retry time for the host &'x.y.z.example'&. Meanwhile, Exim
27358 tries to deliver to &'p.q.r.example'&. If this also suffers a host error, the
27359 first retry rule is used, because it matches the host.
27361 In other words, temporary failures to deliver to host &'p.q.r.example'& use the
27362 first rule to determine retry times, but for all the other hosts for the domain
27363 &'a.b.c.example'&, the second rule is used. The second rule is also used if
27364 routing to &'a.b.c.example'& suffers a temporary failure.
27366 &*Note*&: The host name is used when matching the patterns, not its IP address.
27367 However, if a message is routed directly to an IP address without the use of a
27368 host name, for example, if a &(manualroute)& router contains a setting such as:
27370 route_list = *.a.example 192.168.34.23
27372 then the &"host name"& that is used when searching for a retry rule is the
27373 textual form of the IP address.
27375 .section "Retry rules for specific errors" "SECID161"
27376 .cindex "retry" "specific errors; specifying"
27377 The second field in a retry rule is the name of a particular error, or an
27378 asterisk, which matches any error. The errors that can be tested for are:
27381 .vitem &%auth_failed%&
27382 Authentication failed when trying to send to a host in the
27383 &%hosts_require_auth%& list in an &(smtp)& transport.
27385 .vitem &%data_4xx%&
27386 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing DATA command, either immediately
27387 after the command, or after sending the message's data.
27389 .vitem &%mail_4xx%&
27390 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing MAIL command.
27392 .vitem &%rcpt_4xx%&
27393 A 4&'xx'& error was received for an outgoing RCPT command.
27396 For the three 4&'xx'& errors, either the first or both of the x's can be given
27397 as specific digits, for example: &`mail_45x`& or &`rcpt_436`&. For example, to
27398 recognize 452 errors given to RCPT commands for addresses in a certain domain,
27399 and have retries every ten minutes with a one-hour timeout, you could set up a
27400 retry rule of this form:
27402 the.domain.name rcpt_452 F,1h,10m
27404 These errors apply to both outgoing SMTP (the &(smtp)& transport) and outgoing
27405 LMTP (either the &(lmtp)& transport, or the &(smtp)& transport in LMTP mode).
27408 .vitem &%lost_connection%&
27409 A server unexpectedly closed the SMTP connection. There may, of course,
27410 legitimate reasons for this (host died, network died), but if it repeats a lot
27411 for the same host, it indicates something odd.
27414 A DNS lookup for a host failed.
27415 Note that a &%dnslookup%& router will need to have matched
27416 its &%fail_defer_domains%& option for this retry type to be usable.
27417 Also note that a &%manualroute%& router will probably need
27418 its &%host_find_failed%& option set to &%defer%&.
27420 .vitem &%refused_MX%&
27421 A connection to a host obtained from an MX record was refused.
27423 .vitem &%refused_A%&
27424 A connection to a host not obtained from an MX record was refused.
27427 A connection was refused.
27429 .vitem &%timeout_connect_MX%&
27430 A connection attempt to a host obtained from an MX record timed out.
27432 .vitem &%timeout_connect_A%&
27433 A connection attempt to a host not obtained from an MX record timed out.
27435 .vitem &%timeout_connect%&
27436 A connection attempt timed out.
27438 .vitem &%timeout_MX%&
27439 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host
27440 obtained from an MX record.
27442 .vitem &%timeout_A%&
27443 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session with a host not
27444 obtained from an MX record.
27447 There was a timeout while connecting or during an SMTP session.
27449 .vitem &%tls_required%&
27450 The server was required to use TLS (it matched &%hosts_require_tls%& in the
27451 &(smtp)& transport), but either did not offer TLS, or it responded with 4&'xx'&
27452 to STARTTLS, or there was a problem setting up the TLS connection.
27455 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27458 .vitem &%quota_%&<&'time'&>
27459 .cindex "quota" "error testing in retry rule"
27460 .cindex "retry" "quota error testing"
27461 A mailbox quota was exceeded in a local delivery by the &(appendfile)&
27462 transport, and the mailbox has not been accessed for <&'time'&>. For example,
27463 &'quota_4d'& applies to a quota error when the mailbox has not been accessed
27467 .cindex "mailbox" "time of last read"
27468 The idea of &%quota_%&<&'time'&> is to make it possible to have shorter
27469 timeouts when the mailbox is full and is not being read by its owner. Ideally,
27470 it should be based on the last time that the user accessed the mailbox.
27471 However, it is not always possible to determine this. Exim uses the following
27475 If the mailbox is a single file, the time of last access (the &"atime"&) is
27476 used. As no new messages are being delivered (because the mailbox is over
27477 quota), Exim does not access the file, so this is the time of last user access.
27479 .cindex "maildir format" "time of last read"
27480 For a maildir delivery, the time of last modification of the &_new_&
27481 subdirectory is used. As the mailbox is over quota, no new files are created in
27482 the &_new_& subdirectory, because no new messages are being delivered. Any
27483 change to the &_new_& subdirectory is therefore assumed to be the result of an
27484 MUA moving a new message to the &_cur_& directory when it is first read. The
27485 time that is used is therefore the last time that the user read a new message.
27487 For other kinds of multi-file mailbox, the time of last access cannot be
27488 obtained, so a retry rule that uses this type of error field is never matched.
27491 The quota errors apply both to system-enforced quotas and to Exim's own quota
27492 mechanism in the &(appendfile)& transport. The &'quota'& error also applies
27493 when a local delivery is deferred because a partition is full (the ENOSPC
27498 .section "Retry rules for specified senders" "SECID162"
27499 .cindex "retry" "rules; sender-specific"
27500 You can specify retry rules that apply only when the failing message has a
27501 specific sender. In particular, this can be used to define retry rules that
27502 apply only to bounce messages. The third item in a retry rule can be of this
27505 &`senders=`&<&'address list'&>
27507 The retry timings themselves are then the fourth item. For example:
27509 * rcpt_4xx senders=: F,1h,30m
27511 matches recipient 4&'xx'& errors for bounce messages sent to any address at any
27512 host. If the address list contains white space, it must be enclosed in quotes.
27515 a.domain rcpt_452 senders="xb.dom : yc.dom" G,8h,10m,1.5
27517 &*Warning*&: This facility can be unhelpful if it is used for host errors
27518 (which do not depend on the recipient). The reason is that the sender is used
27519 only to match the retry rule. Once the rule has been found for a host error,
27520 its contents are used to set a retry time for the host, and this will apply to
27521 all messages, not just those with specific senders.
27523 When testing retry rules using &%-brt%&, you can supply a sender using the
27524 &%-f%& command line option, like this:
27526 exim -f "" -brt user@dom.ain
27528 If you do not set &%-f%& with &%-brt%&, a retry rule that contains a senders
27529 list is never matched.
27535 .section "Retry parameters" "SECID163"
27536 .cindex "retry" "parameters in rules"
27537 The third (or fourth, if a senders list is present) field in a retry rule is a
27538 sequence of retry parameter sets, separated by semicolons. Each set consists of
27540 <&'letter'&>,<&'cutoff time'&>,<&'arguments'&>
27542 The letter identifies the algorithm for computing a new retry time; the cutoff
27543 time is the time beyond which this algorithm no longer applies, and the
27544 arguments vary the algorithm's action. The cutoff time is measured from the
27545 time that the first failure for the domain (combined with the local part if
27546 relevant) was detected, not from the time the message was received.
27548 .cindex "retry" "algorithms"
27549 .cindex "retry" "fixed intervals"
27550 .cindex "retry" "increasing intervals"
27551 .cindex "retry" "random intervals"
27552 The available algorithms are:
27555 &'F'&: retry at fixed intervals. There is a single time parameter specifying
27558 &'G'&: retry at geometrically increasing intervals. The first argument
27559 specifies a starting value for the interval, and the second a multiplier, which
27560 is used to increase the size of the interval at each retry.
27562 &'H'&: retry at randomized intervals. The arguments are as for &'G'&. For each
27563 retry, the previous interval is multiplied by the factor in order to get a
27564 maximum for the next interval. The minimum interval is the first argument of
27565 the parameter, and an actual interval is chosen randomly between them. Such a
27566 rule has been found to be helpful in cluster configurations when all the
27567 members of the cluster restart at once, and may therefore synchronize their
27568 queue processing times.
27571 When computing the next retry time, the algorithm definitions are scanned in
27572 order until one whose cutoff time has not yet passed is reached. This is then
27573 used to compute a new retry time that is later than the current time. In the
27574 case of fixed interval retries, this simply means adding the interval to the
27575 current time. For geometrically increasing intervals, retry intervals are
27576 computed from the rule's parameters until one that is greater than the previous
27577 interval is found. The main configuration variable
27578 .cindex "limit" "retry interval"
27579 .cindex "retry" "interval, maximum"
27580 .oindex "&%retry_interval_max%&"
27581 &%retry_interval_max%& limits the maximum interval between retries. It
27582 cannot be set greater than &`24h`&, which is its default value.
27584 A single remote domain may have a number of hosts associated with it, and each
27585 host may have more than one IP address. Retry algorithms are selected on the
27586 basis of the domain name, but are applied to each IP address independently. If,
27587 for example, a host has two IP addresses and one is unusable, Exim will
27588 generate retry times for it and will not try to use it until its next retry
27589 time comes. Thus the good IP address is likely to be tried first most of the
27592 .cindex "hints database" "use for retrying"
27593 Retry times are hints rather than promises. Exim does not make any attempt to
27594 run deliveries exactly at the computed times. Instead, a queue runner process
27595 starts delivery processes for delayed messages periodically, and these attempt
27596 new deliveries only for those addresses that have passed their next retry time.
27597 If a new message arrives for a deferred address, an immediate delivery attempt
27598 occurs only if the address has passed its retry time. In the absence of new
27599 messages, the minimum time between retries is the interval between queue runner
27600 processes. There is not much point in setting retry times of five minutes if
27601 your queue runners happen only once an hour, unless there are a significant
27602 number of incoming messages (which might be the case on a system that is
27603 sending everything to a smart host, for example).
27605 The data in the retry hints database can be inspected by using the
27606 &'exim_dumpdb'& or &'exim_fixdb'& utility programs (see chapter
27607 &<<CHAPutils>>&). The latter utility can also be used to change the data. The
27608 &'exinext'& utility script can be used to find out what the next retry times
27609 are for the hosts associated with a particular mail domain, and also for local
27610 deliveries that have been deferred.
27613 .section "Retry rule examples" "SECID164"
27614 Here are some example retry rules:
27616 alice@wonderland.fict.example quota_5d F,7d,3h
27617 wonderland.fict.example quota_5d
27618 wonderland.fict.example * F,1h,15m; G,2d,1h,2;
27619 lookingglass.fict.example * F,24h,30m;
27620 * refused_A F,2h,20m;
27621 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,5d,8h
27623 The first rule sets up special handling for mail to
27624 &'alice@wonderland.fict.example'& when there is an over-quota error and the
27625 mailbox has not been read for at least 5 days. Retries continue every three
27626 hours for 7 days. The second rule handles over-quota errors for all other local
27627 parts at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; the absence of a local part has the same
27628 effect as supplying &"*@"&. As no retry algorithms are supplied, messages that
27629 fail are bounced immediately if the mailbox has not been read for at least 5
27632 The third rule handles all other errors at &'wonderland.fict.example'&; retries
27633 happen every 15 minutes for an hour, then with geometrically increasing
27634 intervals until two days have passed since a delivery first failed. After the
27635 first hour there is a delay of one hour, then two hours, then four hours, and
27636 so on (this is a rather extreme example).
27638 The fourth rule controls retries for the domain &'lookingglass.fict.example'&.
27639 They happen every 30 minutes for 24 hours only. The remaining two rules handle
27640 all other domains, with special action for connection refusal from hosts that
27641 were not obtained from an MX record.
27643 The final rule in a retry configuration should always have asterisks in the
27644 first two fields so as to provide a general catch-all for any addresses that do
27645 not have their own special handling. This example tries every 15 minutes for 2
27646 hours, then with intervals starting at one hour and increasing by a factor of
27647 1.5 up to 16 hours, then every 8 hours up to 5 days.
27651 .section "Timeout of retry data" "SECID165"
27652 .cindex "timeout" "of retry data"
27653 .oindex "&%retry_data_expire%&"
27654 .cindex "hints database" "data expiry"
27655 .cindex "retry" "timeout of data"
27656 Exim timestamps the data that it writes to its retry hints database. When it
27657 consults the data during a delivery it ignores any that is older than the value
27658 set in &%retry_data_expire%& (default 7 days). If, for example, a host hasn't
27659 been tried for 7 days, Exim will try to deliver to it immediately a message
27660 arrives, and if that fails, it will calculate a retry time as if it were
27661 failing for the first time.
27663 This improves the behaviour for messages routed to rarely-used hosts such as MX
27664 backups. If such a host was down at one time, and happens to be down again when
27665 Exim tries a month later, using the old retry data would imply that it had been
27666 down all the time, which is not a justified assumption.
27668 If a host really is permanently dead, this behaviour causes a burst of retries
27669 every now and again, but only if messages routed to it are rare. If there is a
27670 message at least once every 7 days the retry data never expires.
27675 .section "Long-term failures" "SECID166"
27676 .cindex "delivery failure, long-term"
27677 .cindex "retry" "after long-term failure"
27678 Special processing happens when an email address has been failing for so long
27679 that the cutoff time for the last algorithm is reached. For example, using the
27680 default retry rule:
27682 * * F,2h,15m; G,16h,1h,1.5; F,4d,6h
27684 the cutoff time is four days. Reaching the retry cutoff is independent of how
27685 long any specific message has been failing; it is the length of continuous
27686 failure for the recipient address that counts.
27688 When the cutoff time is reached for a local delivery, or for all the IP
27689 addresses associated with a remote delivery, a subsequent delivery failure
27690 causes Exim to give up on the address, and a bounce message is generated.
27691 In order to cater for new messages that use the failing address, a next retry
27692 time is still computed from the final algorithm, and is used as follows:
27694 For local deliveries, one delivery attempt is always made for any subsequent
27695 messages. If this delivery fails, the address fails immediately. The
27696 post-cutoff retry time is not used.
27698 .cindex "final cutoff" "retries, controlling"
27699 .cindex retry "final cutoff"
27700 If the delivery is remote, there are two possibilities, controlled by the
27701 .oindex "&%delay_after_cutoff%&"
27702 &%delay_after_cutoff%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. The option is true by
27703 default. Until the post-cutoff retry time for one of the IP addresses,
27704 as set by the &%retry_data_expire%& option, is
27705 reached, the failing email address is bounced immediately, without a delivery
27706 attempt taking place. After that time, one new delivery attempt is made to
27707 those IP addresses that are past their retry times, and if that still fails,
27708 the address is bounced and new retry times are computed.
27710 In other words, when all the hosts for a given email address have been failing
27711 for a long time, Exim bounces rather then defers until one of the hosts' retry
27712 times is reached. Then it tries once, and bounces if that attempt fails. This
27713 behaviour ensures that few resources are wasted in repeatedly trying to deliver
27714 to a broken destination, but if the host does recover, Exim will eventually
27717 If &%delay_after_cutoff%& is set false, Exim behaves differently. If all IP
27718 addresses are past their final cutoff time, Exim tries to deliver to those IP
27719 addresses that have not been tried since the message arrived. If there are
27720 no suitable IP addresses, or if they all fail, the address is bounced. In other
27721 words, it does not delay when a new message arrives, but tries the expired
27722 addresses immediately, unless they have been tried since the message arrived.
27723 If there is a continuous stream of messages for the failing domains, setting
27724 &%delay_after_cutoff%& false means that there will be many more attempts to
27725 deliver to permanently failing IP addresses than when &%delay_after_cutoff%& is
27728 .section "Deliveries that work intermittently" "SECID167"
27729 .cindex "retry" "intermittently working deliveries"
27730 Some additional logic is needed to cope with cases where a host is
27731 intermittently available, or when a message has some attribute that prevents
27732 its delivery when others to the same address get through. In this situation,
27733 because some messages are successfully delivered, the &"retry clock"& for the
27734 host or address keeps getting reset by the successful deliveries, and so
27735 failing messages remain in the queue for ever because the cutoff time is never
27738 Two exceptional actions are applied to prevent this happening. The first
27739 applies to errors that are related to a message rather than a remote host.
27740 Section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>& has a discussion of the different kinds of error;
27741 examples of message-related errors are 4&'xx'& responses to MAIL or DATA
27742 commands, and quota failures. For this type of error, if a message's arrival
27743 time is earlier than the &"first failed"& time for the error, the earlier time
27744 is used when scanning the retry rules to decide when to try next and when to
27745 time out the address.
27747 The exceptional second action applies in all cases. If a message has been on
27748 the queue for longer than the cutoff time of any applicable retry rule for a
27749 given address, a delivery is attempted for that address, even if it is not yet
27750 time, and if this delivery fails, the address is timed out. A new retry time is
27751 not computed in this case, so that other messages for the same address are
27752 considered immediately.
27753 .ecindex IIDretconf1
27754 .ecindex IIDregconf2
27761 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27762 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
27764 .chapter "SMTP authentication" "CHAPSMTPAUTH"
27765 .scindex IIDauthconf1 "SMTP" "authentication configuration"
27766 .scindex IIDauthconf2 "authentication"
27767 The &"authenticators"& section of Exim's runtime configuration is concerned
27768 with SMTP authentication. This facility is an extension to the SMTP protocol,
27770 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2554,RFC 2554),
27771 which allows a client SMTP host to authenticate itself
27772 to a server. This is a common way for a server to recognize clients that are
27773 permitted to use it as a relay. SMTP authentication is not of relevance to the
27774 transfer of mail between servers that have no managerial connection with each
27777 The name of an authenticator is limited to be &drivernamemax; ASCII characters long;
27778 prior to Exim 4.95 names would be silently truncated at this length, but now
27781 .cindex "AUTH" "description of"
27782 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" AUTH
27783 Very briefly, the way SMTP authentication works is as follows:
27786 The server advertises a number of authentication &'mechanisms'& in response to
27787 the client's EHLO command.
27789 The client issues an AUTH command, naming a specific mechanism. The command
27790 may, optionally, contain some authentication data.
27792 The server may issue one or more &'challenges'&, to which the client must send
27793 appropriate responses. In simple authentication mechanisms, the challenges are
27794 just prompts for user names and passwords. The server does not have to issue
27795 any challenges &-- in some mechanisms the relevant data may all be transmitted
27796 with the AUTH command.
27798 The server either accepts or denies authentication.
27800 If authentication succeeds, the client may optionally make use of the AUTH
27801 option on the MAIL command to pass an authenticated sender in subsequent
27802 mail transactions. Authentication lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
27805 If authentication fails, the client may give up, or it may try a different
27806 authentication mechanism, or it may try transferring mail over the
27807 unauthenticated connection.
27810 If you are setting up a client, and want to know which authentication
27811 mechanisms the server supports, you can use Telnet to connect to port 25 (the
27812 SMTP port) on the server, and issue an EHLO command. The response to this
27813 includes the list of supported mechanisms. For example:
27815 &`$ `&&*&`telnet server.example 25`&*&
27816 &`Trying 192.168.34.25...`&
27817 &`Connected to server.example.`&
27818 &`Escape character is '^]'.`&
27819 &`220 server.example ESMTP Exim 4.20 ...`&
27820 &*&`ehlo client.example`&*&
27821 &`250-server.example Hello client.example [10.8.4.5]`&
27822 &`250-SIZE 52428800`&
27827 The second-last line of this example output shows that the server supports
27828 authentication using the PLAIN mechanism. In Exim, the different authentication
27829 mechanisms are configured by specifying &'authenticator'& drivers. Like the
27830 routers and transports, which authenticators are included in the binary is
27831 controlled by build-time definitions. The following are currently available,
27832 included by setting
27835 AUTH_CYRUS_SASL=yes
27839 AUTH_HEIMDAL_GSSAPI=yes
27844 in &_Local/Makefile_&, respectively. The first of these supports the CRAM-MD5
27845 authentication mechanism
27846 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2195,RFC 2195)),
27847 and the second provides an interface to the Cyrus SASL authentication library.
27848 The third is an interface to Dovecot's authentication system, delegating the
27849 work via a socket interface.
27850 The fourth provides for negotiation of authentication done via non-SMTP means,
27851 as defined by &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4422,RFC 4422) Appendix A.
27852 The fifth provides an interface to the GNU SASL authentication library, which
27853 provides mechanisms but typically not data sources.
27854 The sixth provides direct access to Heimdal GSSAPI, geared for Kerberos, but
27855 supporting setting a server keytab.
27856 The seventh can be configured to support
27857 the PLAIN authentication mechanism
27858 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2595,RFC 2595))
27859 or the LOGIN mechanism, which is
27860 not formally documented, but used by several MUAs.
27861 The eighth authenticator
27862 supports Microsoft's &'Secure Password Authentication'& mechanism.
27863 The last is an Exim authenticator but not an SMTP one;
27864 instead it can use information from a TLS negotiation.
27866 The authenticators are configured using the same syntax as other drivers (see
27867 section &<<SECTfordricon>>&). If no authenticators are required, no
27868 authentication section need be present in the configuration file. Each
27869 authenticator can in principle have both server and client functions. When Exim
27870 is receiving SMTP mail, it is acting as a server; when it is sending out
27871 messages over SMTP, it is acting as a client. Authenticator configuration
27872 options are provided for use in both these circumstances.
27874 To make it clear which options apply to which situation, the prefixes
27875 &%server_%& and &%client_%& are used on option names that are specific to
27876 either the server or the client function, respectively. Server and client
27877 functions are disabled if none of their options are set. If an authenticator is
27878 to be used for both server and client functions, a single definition, using
27879 both sets of options, is required. For example:
27883 public_name = CRAM-MD5
27884 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret1}fail}
27886 client_secret = secret2
27888 The &%server_%& option is used when Exim is acting as a server, and the
27889 &%client_%& options when it is acting as a client.
27891 Descriptions of the individual authenticators are given in subsequent chapters.
27892 The remainder of this chapter covers the generic options for the
27893 authenticators, followed by general discussion of the way authentication works
27896 &*Beware:*& the meaning of &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, ... varies on a per-driver and
27897 per-mechanism basis. Please read carefully to determine which variables hold
27898 account labels such as usercodes and which hold passwords or other
27899 authenticating data.
27901 Note that some mechanisms support two different identifiers for accounts: the
27902 &'authentication id'& and the &'authorization id'&. The contractions &'authn'&
27903 and &'authz'& are commonly encountered. The American spelling is standard here.
27904 Conceptually, authentication data such as passwords are tied to the identifier
27905 used to authenticate; servers may have rules to permit one user to act as a
27906 second user, so that after login the session is treated as though that second
27907 user had logged in. That second user is the &'authorization id'&. A robust
27908 configuration might confirm that the &'authz'& field is empty or matches the
27909 &'authn'& field. Often this is just ignored. The &'authn'& can be considered
27910 as verified data, the &'authz'& as an unverified request which the server might
27913 A &'realm'& is a text string, typically a domain name, presented by a server
27914 to a client to help it select an account and credentials to use. In some
27915 mechanisms, the client and server provably agree on the realm, but clients
27916 typically can not treat the realm as secure data to be blindly trusted.
27920 .section "Generic options for authenticators" "SECID168"
27921 .cindex "authentication" "generic options"
27922 .cindex "options" "generic; for authenticators"
27924 .option client_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27925 When Exim is authenticating as a client, it skips any authenticator whose
27926 &%client_condition%& expansion yields &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&. This can be
27927 used, for example, to skip plain text authenticators when the connection is not
27928 encrypted by a setting such as:
27930 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
27934 .option client_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27935 When client authentication succeeds, this condition is expanded; the
27936 result is used in the log lines for outbound messages.
27937 Typically it will be the user name used for authentication.
27940 .option driver authenticators string unset
27941 This option must always be set. It specifies which of the available
27942 authenticators is to be used.
27945 .option public_name authenticators string unset
27946 This option specifies the name of the authentication mechanism that the driver
27947 implements, and by which it is known to the outside world. These names should
27948 contain only upper case letters, digits, underscores, and hyphens
27949 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2222,RFC 2222)),
27950 but Exim in fact matches them caselessly. If &%public_name%& is not set, it
27951 defaults to the driver's instance name.
27954 .option server_advertise_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27955 When a server is about to advertise an authentication mechanism, the condition
27956 is expanded. If it yields the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the
27957 mechanism is not advertised.
27958 If the expansion fails, the mechanism is not advertised. If the failure was not
27959 forced, and was not caused by a lookup defer, the incident is logged.
27960 See section &<<SECTauthexiser>>& below for further discussion.
27963 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
27964 This option must be set for a &%plaintext%& server authenticator, where it
27965 is used directly to control authentication. See section &<<SECTplainserver>>&
27968 For the &(gsasl)& authenticator, this option is required for various
27969 mechanisms; see chapter &<<CHAPgsasl>>& for details.
27971 For the other authenticators, &%server_condition%& can be used as an additional
27972 authentication or authorization mechanism that is applied after the other
27973 authenticator conditions succeed. If it is set, it is expanded when the
27974 authenticator would otherwise return a success code. If the expansion is forced
27975 to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary
27976 error code to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty
27977 string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
27978 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds. For any
27979 other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded string as
27983 .option server_debug_print authenticators string&!! unset
27984 If this option is set and authentication debugging is enabled (see the &%-d%&
27985 command line option), the string is expanded and included in the debugging
27986 output when the authenticator is run as a server. This can help with checking
27987 out the values of variables.
27988 If expansion of the string fails, the error message is written to the debugging
27989 output, and Exim carries on processing.
27992 .option server_set_id authenticators string&!! unset
27993 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
27994 .vindex "&$authenticated_fail_id$&"
27995 When an Exim server successfully authenticates a client, this string is
27996 expanded using data from the authentication, and preserved for any incoming
27997 messages in the variable &$authenticated_id$&. It is also included in the log
27998 lines for incoming messages. For example, a user/password authenticator
27999 configuration might preserve the user name that was used to authenticate, and
28000 refer to it subsequently during delivery of the message.
28001 On a failing authentication the expansion result is instead saved in
28002 the &$authenticated_fail_id$& variable.
28003 If expansion fails, the option is ignored.
28006 .option server_mail_auth_condition authenticators string&!! unset
28007 This option allows a server to discard authenticated sender addresses supplied
28008 as part of MAIL commands in SMTP connections that are authenticated by the
28009 driver on which &%server_mail_auth_condition%& is set. The option is not used
28010 as part of the authentication process; instead its (unexpanded) value is
28011 remembered for later use.
28012 How it is used is described in the following section.
28018 .section "The AUTH parameter on MAIL commands" "SECTauthparamail"
28019 .cindex "authentication" "sender; authenticated"
28020 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
28021 When a client supplied an AUTH= item on a MAIL command, Exim applies
28022 the following checks before accepting it as the authenticated sender of the
28026 If the connection is not using extended SMTP (that is, HELO was used rather
28027 than EHLO), the use of AUTH= is a syntax error.
28029 If the value of the AUTH= parameter is &"<>"&, it is ignored.
28031 .vindex "&$authenticated_sender$&"
28032 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is defined, the ACL it specifies is run. While it is
28033 running, the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is set to the value obtained
28034 from the AUTH= parameter. If the ACL does not yield &"accept"&, the value of
28035 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. The &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& ACL may not
28036 return &"drop"& or &"discard"&. If it defers, a temporary error code (451) is
28037 given for the MAIL command.
28039 If &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& is not defined, the value of the AUTH= parameter
28040 is accepted and placed in &$authenticated_sender$& only if the client has
28043 If the AUTH= value was accepted by either of the two previous rules, and
28044 the client has authenticated, and the authenticator has a setting for the
28045 &%server_mail_auth_condition%&, the condition is checked at this point. The
28046 valued that was saved from the authenticator is expanded. If the expansion
28047 fails, or yields an empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, the value of
28048 &$authenticated_sender$& is deleted. If the expansion yields any other value,
28049 the value of &$authenticated_sender$& is retained and passed on with the
28054 When &$authenticated_sender$& is set for a message, it is passed on to other
28055 hosts to which Exim authenticates as a client. Do not confuse this value with
28056 &$authenticated_id$&, which is a string obtained from the authentication
28057 process, and which is not usually a complete email address.
28059 .vindex "&$sender_address$&"
28060 Whenever an AUTH= value is ignored, the incident is logged. The ACL for
28061 MAIL, if defined, is run after AUTH= is accepted or ignored. It can
28062 therefore make use of &$authenticated_sender$&. The converse is not true: the
28063 value of &$sender_address$& is not yet set up when the &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&
28068 .section "Authentication on an Exim server" "SECTauthexiser"
28069 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim server"
28070 When Exim receives an EHLO command, it advertises the public names of those
28071 authenticators that are configured as servers, subject to the following
28075 The client host must match &%auth_advertise_hosts%& (default *).
28077 If the &%server_advertise_condition%& option is set, its expansion must not
28078 yield the empty string, &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&.
28081 The order in which the authenticators are defined controls the order in which
28082 the mechanisms are advertised.
28084 Some mail clients (for example, some versions of Netscape) require the user to
28085 provide a name and password for authentication whenever AUTH is advertised,
28086 even though authentication may not in fact be needed (for example, Exim may be
28087 set up to allow unconditional relaying from the client by an IP address check).
28088 You can make such clients more friendly by not advertising AUTH to them.
28089 For example, if clients on the 10.9.8.0/24 network are permitted (by the ACL
28090 that runs for RCPT) to relay without authentication, you should set
28092 auth_advertise_hosts = ! 10.9.8.0/24
28094 so that no authentication mechanisms are advertised to them.
28096 The &%server_advertise_condition%& controls the advertisement of individual
28097 authentication mechanisms. For example, it can be used to restrict the
28098 advertisement of a particular mechanism to encrypted connections, by a setting
28101 server_advertise_condition = ${if eq{$tls_in_cipher}{}{no}{yes}}
28103 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
28104 If the session is encrypted, &$tls_in_cipher$& is not empty, and so the expansion
28105 yields &"yes"&, which allows the advertisement to happen.
28107 When an Exim server receives an AUTH command from a client, it rejects it
28108 immediately if AUTH was not advertised in response to an earlier EHLO
28109 command. This is the case if
28112 The client host does not match &%auth_advertise_hosts%&; or
28114 No authenticators are configured with server options; or
28116 Expansion of &%server_advertise_condition%& blocked the advertising of all the
28117 server authenticators.
28121 Otherwise, Exim runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_auth%& in order
28122 to decide whether to accept the command. If &%acl_smtp_auth%& is not set,
28123 AUTH is accepted from any client host.
28125 If AUTH is not rejected by the ACL, Exim searches its configuration for a
28126 server authentication mechanism that was advertised in response to EHLO and
28127 that matches the one named in the AUTH command. If it finds one, it runs
28128 the appropriate authentication protocol, and authentication either succeeds or
28129 fails. If there is no matching advertised mechanism, the AUTH command is
28130 rejected with a 504 error.
28132 .vindex "&$received_protocol$&"
28133 .vindex "&$sender_host_authenticated$&"
28134 When a message is received from an authenticated host, the value of
28135 &$received_protocol$& is set to &"esmtpa"& or &"esmtpsa"& instead of &"esmtp"&
28136 or &"esmtps"&, and &$sender_host_authenticated$& contains the name (not the
28137 public name) of the authenticator driver that successfully authenticated the
28138 client from which the message was received. This variable is empty if there was
28139 no successful authentication.
28141 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
28142 Successful authentication sets up information used by the
28143 &%authresults%& expansion item.
28145 .cindex authentication "failure event, server"
28146 If an authenticator is run and does not succeed,
28147 an event of type "auth:fail" is raised.
28148 While the event is being processed the variables
28149 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
28150 and &$authenticated_fail_id$& (as set by the authenticator &%server_set_id%& option)
28152 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged
28153 instead of the default log line.
28154 See &<<CHAPevents>>& for details on events.
28157 .subsection "Testing server authentication" "SECID169"
28158 .cindex "authentication" "testing a server"
28159 .cindex "AUTH" "testing a server"
28160 .cindex "base64 encoding" "creating authentication test data"
28161 Exim's &%-bh%& option can be useful for testing server authentication
28162 configurations. The data for the AUTH command has to be sent using base64
28163 encoding. A quick way to produce such data for testing is the following Perl
28167 printf ("%s", encode_base64(eval "\"$ARGV[0]\""));
28169 .cindex "binary zero" "in authentication data"
28170 This interprets its argument as a Perl string, and then encodes it. The
28171 interpretation as a Perl string allows binary zeros, which are required for
28172 some kinds of authentication, to be included in the data. For example, a
28173 command line to run this script on such data might be
28175 encode '\0user\0password'
28177 Note the use of single quotes to prevent the shell interpreting the
28178 backslashes, so that they can be interpreted by Perl to specify characters
28179 whose code value is zero.
28181 &*Warning 1*&: If either of the user or password strings starts with an octal
28182 digit, you must use three zeros instead of one after the leading backslash. If
28183 you do not, the octal digit that starts your string will be incorrectly
28184 interpreted as part of the code for the first character.
28186 &*Warning 2*&: If there are characters in the strings that Perl interprets
28187 specially, you must use a Perl escape to prevent them being misinterpreted. For
28188 example, a command such as
28190 encode '\0user@domain.com\0pas$$word'
28192 gives an incorrect answer because of the unescaped &"@"& and &"$"& characters.
28194 If you have the &%mimencode%& command installed, another way to produce
28195 base64-encoded strings is to run the command
28197 echo -e -n `\0user\0password' | mimencode
28199 The &%-e%& option of &%echo%& enables the interpretation of backslash escapes
28200 in the argument, and the &%-n%& option specifies no newline at the end of its
28201 output. However, not all versions of &%echo%& recognize these options, so you
28202 should check your version before relying on this suggestion.
28206 .section "Authentication by an Exim client" "SECID170"
28207 .cindex "authentication" "on an Exim client"
28208 The &(smtp)& transport has two options called &%hosts_require_auth%& and
28209 &%hosts_try_auth%&. When the &(smtp)& transport connects to a server that
28210 announces support for authentication, and the host matches an entry in either
28211 of these options, Exim (as a client) tries to authenticate as follows:
28214 For each authenticator that is configured as a client, in the order in which
28215 they are defined in the configuration, it searches the authentication
28216 mechanisms announced by the server for one whose name matches the public name
28217 of the authenticator.
28220 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28221 When it finds one that matches, it runs the authenticator's client code. The
28222 variables &$host$& and &$host_address$& are available for any string expansions
28223 that the client might do. They are set to the server's name and IP address. If
28224 any expansion is forced to fail, the authentication attempt is abandoned, and
28225 Exim moves on to the next authenticator. Otherwise an expansion failure causes
28226 delivery to be deferred.
28228 If the result of the authentication attempt is a temporary error or a timeout,
28229 Exim abandons trying to send the message to the host for the moment. It will
28230 try again later. If there are any backup hosts available, they are tried in the
28234 .cindex authentication "failure event, client"
28235 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code),
28236 an event of type "auth:fail" is raised.
28237 While the event is being processed the variable
28238 &$sender_host_authenticated$& (with the authenticator name)
28240 If the event is serviced and a string is returned then the string will be logged.
28241 See &<<CHAPevents>>& for details on events.
28244 If the response to authentication is a permanent error (5&'xx'& code), Exim
28245 carries on searching the list of authenticators and tries another one if
28246 possible. If all authentication attempts give permanent errors, or if there are
28247 no attempts because no mechanisms match (or option expansions force failure),
28248 what happens depends on whether the host matches &%hosts_require_auth%& or
28249 &%hosts_try_auth%&. In the first case, a temporary error is generated, and
28250 delivery is deferred. The error can be detected in the retry rules, and thereby
28251 turned into a permanent error if you wish. In the second case, Exim tries to
28252 deliver the message unauthenticated.
28255 Note that the hostlist test for whether to do authentication can be
28256 confused if name-IP lookups change between the time the peer is decided
28257 upon and the time that the transport runs. For example, with a manualroute
28258 router given a host name, and with DNS "round-robin" used by that name: if
28259 the local resolver cache times out between the router and the transport
28260 running, the transport may get an IP for the name for its authentication
28261 check which does not match the connection peer IP.
28262 No authentication will then be done, despite the names being identical.
28264 For such cases use a separate transport which always authenticates.
28266 .cindex "AUTH" "on MAIL command"
28267 When Exim has authenticated itself to a remote server, it adds the AUTH
28268 parameter to the MAIL commands it sends, if it has an authenticated sender for
28269 the message. If the message came from a remote host, the authenticated sender
28270 is the one that was receiving on an incoming MAIL command, provided that the
28271 incoming connection was authenticated and the &%server_mail_auth%& condition
28272 allowed the authenticated sender to be retained. If a local process calls Exim
28273 to send a message, the sender address that is built from the login name and
28274 &%qualify_domain%& is treated as authenticated. However, if the
28275 &%authenticated_sender%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it overrides
28276 the authenticated sender that was received with the message.
28277 .ecindex IIDauthconf1
28278 .ecindex IIDauthconf2
28285 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28286 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28288 .chapter "The plaintext authenticator" "CHAPplaintext"
28289 .scindex IIDplaiauth1 "&(plaintext)& authenticator"
28290 .scindex IIDplaiauth2 "authenticators" "&(plaintext)&"
28291 The &(plaintext)& authenticator can be configured to support the PLAIN and
28292 LOGIN authentication mechanisms, both of which transfer authentication data as
28293 plain (unencrypted) text (though base64 encoded). The use of plain text is a
28294 security risk; you are strongly advised to insist on the use of SMTP encryption
28295 (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&) if you use the PLAIN or LOGIN mechanisms. If you do
28296 use unencrypted plain text, you should not use the same passwords for SMTP
28297 connections as you do for login accounts.
28299 .section "Avoiding cleartext use" "SECTplain_TLS"
28300 The following generic option settings will disable &(plaintext)& authenticators when
28301 TLS is not being used:
28303 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher }
28304 client_condition = ${if def:tls_out_cipher}
28307 &*Note*&: a plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not vulnerable to casual snooping,
28308 but is still vulnerable to a Man In The Middle attack unless certificates
28309 (including their names) have been properly verified.
28311 .section "Plaintext server options" "SECID171"
28312 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (server)"
28313 When configured as a server, &(plaintext)& uses the following options:
28315 .option server_condition authenticators string&!! unset
28316 This is actually a global authentication option, but it must be set in order to
28317 configure the &(plaintext)& driver as a server. Its use is described below.
28319 .option server_prompts plaintext "string list&!!" unset
28320 The contents of this option, after expansion, must be a colon-separated list of
28321 prompt strings. If expansion fails, a temporary authentication rejection is
28324 .section "Using plaintext in a server" "SECTplainserver"
28325 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28326 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28327 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
28328 "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28329 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
28330 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28332 When running as a server, &(plaintext)& performs the authentication test by
28333 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
28334 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
28335 values when decoded. If any data is supplied with the command, it is treated as
28336 a list of strings, separated by NULs (binary zeros), the first three of which
28337 are placed in the expansion variables &$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, and &$auth3$&
28338 (neither LOGIN nor PLAIN uses more than three strings).
28340 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the values are also placed in
28341 the expansion variables &$1$&, &$2$&, and &$3$&. However, the use of these
28342 variables for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
28343 string expansions that also use them for other things.
28345 If there are more strings in &%server_prompts%& than the number of strings
28346 supplied with the AUTH command, the remaining prompts are used to obtain more
28347 data. Each response from the client may be a list of NUL-separated strings.
28349 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28350 Once a sufficient number of data strings have been received,
28351 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
28352 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
28353 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
28354 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
28355 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
28356 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
28357 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
28358 string as the error text.
28360 &*Warning*&: If you use a lookup in the expansion to find the user's
28361 password, be sure to make the authentication fail if the user is unknown.
28362 There are good and bad examples at the end of the next section.
28366 .subsection "The PLAIN authentication mechanism" "SECID172"
28367 .cindex "PLAIN authentication mechanism"
28368 .cindex authentication PLAIN
28369 .cindex "binary zero" "in &(plaintext)& authenticator"
28370 The PLAIN authentication mechanism
28371 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2595,RFC 2595))
28372 specifies that three strings be
28373 sent as one item of data (that is, one combined string containing two NUL
28374 separators). The data is sent either as part of the AUTH command, or
28375 subsequently in response to an empty prompt from the server.
28377 The second and third strings are a user name and a corresponding password.
28378 Using a single fixed user name and password as an example, this could be
28379 configured as follows:
28383 public_name = PLAIN
28385 server_condition = \
28386 ${if and {{eq{$auth2}{username}}{eq{$auth3}{mysecret}}}}
28387 server_set_id = $auth2
28389 Note that the default result strings from &%if%& (&"true"& or an empty string)
28390 are exactly what we want here, so they need not be specified. Obviously, if the
28391 password contains expansion-significant characters such as dollar, backslash,
28392 or closing brace, they have to be escaped.
28394 The &%server_prompts%& setting specifies a single, empty prompt (empty items at
28395 the end of a string list are ignored). If all the data comes as part of the
28396 AUTH command, as is commonly the case, the prompt is not used. This
28397 authenticator is advertised in the response to EHLO as
28401 and a client host can authenticate itself by sending the command
28403 AUTH PLAIN AHVzZXJuYW1lAG15c2VjcmV0
28405 As this contains three strings (more than the number of prompts), no further
28406 data is required from the client. Alternatively, the client may just send
28410 to initiate authentication, in which case the server replies with an empty
28411 prompt. The client must respond with the combined data string.
28413 The data string is base64 encoded, as required by the RFC. This example,
28414 when decoded, is <&'NUL'&>&`username`&<&'NUL'&>&`mysecret`&, where <&'NUL'&>
28415 represents a zero byte. This is split up into three strings, the first of which
28416 is empty. The &%server_condition%& option in the authenticator checks that the
28417 second two are &`username`& and &`mysecret`& respectively.
28419 Having just one fixed user name and password, as in this example, is not very
28420 realistic, though for a small organization with only a handful of
28421 authenticating clients it could make sense.
28423 A more sophisticated instance of this authenticator could use the user name in
28424 &$auth2$& to look up a password in a file or database, and maybe do an encrypted
28425 comparison (see &%crypteq%& in chapter &<<CHAPexpand>>&). Here is a example of
28426 this approach, where the passwords are looked up in a DBM file. &*Warning*&:
28427 This is an incorrect example:
28429 server_condition = \
28430 ${if eq{$auth3}{${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}}}}
28432 The expansion uses the user name (&$auth2$&) as the key to look up a password,
28433 which it then compares to the supplied password (&$auth3$&). Why is this example
28434 incorrect? It works fine for existing users, but consider what happens if a
28435 non-existent user name is given. The lookup fails, but as no success/failure
28436 strings are given for the lookup, it yields an empty string. Thus, to defeat
28437 the authentication, all a client has to do is to supply a non-existent user
28438 name and an empty password. The correct way of writing this test is:
28440 server_condition = ${lookup{$auth2}dbm{/etc/authpwd}\
28441 {${if eq{$value}{$auth3}}} {false}}
28443 In this case, if the lookup succeeds, the result is checked; if the lookup
28444 fails, &"false"& is returned and authentication fails. If &%crypteq%& is being
28445 used instead of &%eq%&, the first example is in fact safe, because &%crypteq%&
28446 always fails if its second argument is empty. However, the second way of
28447 writing the test makes the logic clearer.
28450 .subsection "The LOGIN authentication mechanism" "SECID173"
28451 .cindex "LOGIN authentication mechanism"
28452 .cindex authentication LOGIN
28453 The LOGIN authentication mechanism is not documented in any RFC, but is in use
28454 in a number of programs. No data is sent with the AUTH command. Instead, a
28455 user name and password are supplied separately, in response to prompts. The
28456 plaintext authenticator can be configured to support this as in this example:
28460 public_name = LOGIN
28461 server_prompts = User Name : Password
28462 server_condition = \
28463 ${if and {{eq{$auth1}{username}}{eq{$auth2}{mysecret}}}}
28464 server_set_id = $auth1
28466 Because of the way plaintext operates, this authenticator accepts data supplied
28467 with the AUTH command (in contravention of the specification of LOGIN), but
28468 if the client does not supply it (as is the case for LOGIN clients), the prompt
28469 strings are used to obtain two data items.
28471 Some clients are very particular about the precise text of the prompts. For
28472 example, Outlook Express is reported to recognize only &"Username:"& and
28473 &"Password:"&. Here is an example of a LOGIN authenticator that uses those
28474 strings. It uses the &%ldapauth%& expansion condition to check the user
28475 name and password by binding to an LDAP server:
28479 public_name = LOGIN
28480 server_prompts = Username:: : Password::
28481 server_condition = ${if and{{ \
28484 user="uid=${quote_ldap_dn:$auth1},ou=people,o=example.org" \
28485 pass=${quote:$auth2} \
28486 ldap://ldap.example.org/} }} }
28487 server_set_id = uid=$auth1,ou=people,o=example.org
28489 We have to check that the username is not empty before using it, because LDAP
28490 does not permit empty DN components. We must also use the &%quote_ldap_dn%&
28491 operator to correctly quote the DN for authentication. However, the basic
28492 &%quote%& operator, rather than any of the LDAP quoting operators, is the
28493 correct one to use for the password, because quoting is needed only to make
28494 the password conform to the Exim syntax. At the LDAP level, the password is an
28495 uninterpreted string.
28498 .subsection "Support for different kinds of authentication" "SECID174"
28499 A number of string expansion features are provided for the purpose of
28500 interfacing to different ways of user authentication. These include checking
28501 traditionally encrypted passwords from &_/etc/passwd_& (or equivalent), PAM,
28502 Radius, &%ldapauth%&, &'pwcheck'&, and &'saslauthd'&. For details see section
28508 .section "Using plaintext in a client" "SECID175"
28509 .cindex "options" "&(plaintext)& authenticator (client)"
28510 The &(plaintext)& authenticator has two client options:
28512 .option client_ignore_invalid_base64 plaintext boolean false
28513 If the client receives a server prompt that is not a valid base64 string,
28514 authentication is abandoned by default. However, if this option is set true,
28515 the error in the challenge is ignored and the client sends the response as
28518 .option client_send plaintext string&!! unset
28519 The string is a colon-separated list of authentication data strings. Each
28520 string is independently expanded before being sent to the server. The first
28521 string is sent with the AUTH command; any more strings are sent in response
28522 to prompts from the server. Before each string is expanded, the value of the
28523 most recent prompt is placed in the next &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable, starting
28524 with &$auth1$& for the first prompt. Up to three prompts are stored in this
28525 way. Thus, the prompt that is received in response to sending the first string
28526 (with the AUTH command) can be used in the expansion of the second string, and
28527 so on. If an invalid base64 string is received when
28528 &%client_ignore_invalid_base64%& is set, an empty string is put in the
28529 &$auth$&<&'n'&> variable.
28531 &*Note*&: You cannot use expansion to create multiple strings, because
28532 splitting takes priority and happens first.
28534 Because the PLAIN authentication mechanism requires NUL (binary zero) bytes in
28535 the data, further processing is applied to each string before it is sent. If
28536 there are any single circumflex characters in the string, they are converted to
28537 NULs. Should an actual circumflex be required as data, it must be doubled in
28540 This is an example of a client configuration that implements the PLAIN
28541 authentication mechanism with a fixed user name and password:
28545 public_name = PLAIN
28546 client_send = ^username^mysecret
28548 The lack of colons means that the entire text is sent with the AUTH
28549 command, with the circumflex characters converted to NULs.
28550 Note that due to the ambiguity of parsing three consectutive circumflex characters
28551 there is no way to provide a password having a leading circumflex.
28555 that uses the LOGIN mechanism is:
28559 public_name = LOGIN
28560 client_send = : username : mysecret
28562 The initial colon means that the first string is empty, so no data is sent with
28563 the AUTH command itself. The remaining strings are sent in response to
28565 .ecindex IIDplaiauth1
28566 .ecindex IIDplaiauth2
28571 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28572 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28574 .chapter "The cram_md5 authenticator" "CHID9"
28575 .scindex IIDcramauth1 "&(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28576 .scindex IIDcramauth2 "authenticators" "&(cram_md5)&"
28577 .cindex "CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism"
28578 .cindex authentication CRAM-MD5
28579 The CRAM-MD5 authentication mechanism is described in
28580 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2195,RFC 2195). The server
28581 sends a challenge string to the client, and the response consists of a user
28582 name and the CRAM-MD5 digest of the challenge string combined with a secret
28583 string (password) which is known to both server and client. Thus, the secret
28584 is not sent over the network as plain text, which makes this authenticator more
28585 secure than &(plaintext)&. However, the downside is that the secret has to be
28586 available in plain text at either end.
28589 .section "Using cram_md5 as a server" "SECID176"
28590 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (server)"
28591 This authenticator has one server option, which must be set to configure the
28592 authenticator as a server:
28594 .option server_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28595 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(cram_md5)& authenticator"
28596 When the server receives the client's response, the user name is placed in
28597 the expansion variable &$auth1$&, and &%server_secret%& is expanded to
28598 obtain the password for that user. The server then computes the CRAM-MD5 digest
28599 that the client should have sent, and checks that it received the correct
28600 string. If the expansion of &%server_secret%& is forced to fail, authentication
28601 fails. If the expansion fails for some other reason, a temporary error code is
28602 returned to the client.
28604 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed
28605 in &$1$&. However, the use of this variables for this purpose is now
28606 deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use
28607 numeric variables for other things.
28609 For example, the following authenticator checks that the user name given by the
28610 client is &"ph10"&, and if so, uses &"secret"& as the password. For any other
28611 user name, authentication fails.
28615 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28616 server_secret = ${if eq{$auth1}{ph10}{secret}fail}
28617 server_set_id = $auth1
28619 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
28620 If authentication succeeds, the setting of &%server_set_id%& preserves the user
28621 name in &$authenticated_id$&. A more typical configuration might look up the
28622 secret string in a file, using the user name as the key. For example:
28626 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28627 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/authpwd}\
28629 server_set_id = $auth1
28631 Note that this expansion explicitly forces failure if the lookup fails
28632 because &$auth1$& contains an unknown user name.
28634 As another example, if you wish to re-use a Cyrus SASL sasldb2 file without
28635 using the relevant libraries, you need to know the realm to specify in the
28636 lookup and then ask for the &"userPassword"& attribute for that user in that
28641 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28642 server_secret = ${lookup{$auth1:mail.example.org:userPassword}\
28643 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
28644 server_set_id = $auth1
28647 .section "Using cram_md5 as a client" "SECID177"
28648 .cindex "options" "&(cram_md5)& authenticator (client)"
28649 When used as a client, the &(cram_md5)& authenticator has two options:
28653 .option client_name cram_md5 string&!! "the primary host name"
28654 This string is expanded, and the result used as the user name data when
28655 computing the response to the server's challenge.
28658 .option client_secret cram_md5 string&!! unset
28659 This option must be set for the authenticator to work as a client. Its value is
28660 expanded and the result used as the secret string when computing the response.
28664 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
28665 Different user names and secrets can be used for different servers by referring
28666 to &$host$& or &$host_address$& in the options. Forced failure of either
28667 expansion string is treated as an indication that this authenticator is not
28668 prepared to handle this case. Exim moves on to the next configured client
28669 authenticator. Any other expansion failure causes Exim to give up trying to
28670 send the message to the current server.
28672 A simple example configuration of a &(cram_md5)& authenticator, using fixed
28677 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28679 client_secret = secret
28681 .ecindex IIDcramauth1
28682 .ecindex IIDcramauth2
28686 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28687 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28689 .chapter "The cyrus_sasl authenticator" "CHID10"
28690 .scindex IIDcyrauth1 "&(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator"
28691 .scindex IIDcyrauth2 "authenticators" "&(cyrus_sasl)&"
28692 .cindex "Cyrus" "SASL library"
28694 The code for this authenticator was provided by Matthew Byng-Maddick while
28695 at A L Digital Ltd.
28697 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides server support for the Cyrus SASL
28698 library implementation of the
28699 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2222,RFC 2222)
28700 (&"Simple Authentication and Security
28701 Layer"&). This library supports a number of authentication mechanisms,
28702 including PLAIN and LOGIN, but also several others that Exim does not support
28703 directly. In particular, there is support for Kerberos authentication.
28705 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator provides a gatewaying mechanism directly to
28706 the Cyrus interface, so if your Cyrus library can do, for example, CRAM-MD5,
28707 then so can the &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator. By default it uses the public
28708 name of the driver to determine which mechanism to support.
28710 Where access to some kind of secret file is required, for example, in GSSAPI
28711 or CRAM-MD5, it is worth noting that the authenticator runs as the Exim
28712 user, and that the Cyrus SASL library has no way of escalating privileges
28713 by default. You may also find you need to set environment variables,
28714 depending on the driver you are using.
28716 The application name provided by Exim is &"exim"&, so various SASL options may
28717 be set in &_exim.conf_& in your SASL directory. If you are using GSSAPI for
28718 Kerberos, note that because of limitations in the GSSAPI interface,
28719 changing the server keytab might need to be communicated down to the Kerberos
28720 layer independently. The mechanism for doing so is dependent upon the Kerberos
28723 For example, for older releases of Heimdal, the environment variable KRB5_KTNAME
28724 may be set to point to an alternative keytab file. Exim will pass this
28725 variable through from its own inherited environment when started as root or the
28726 Exim user. The keytab file needs to be readable by the Exim user.
28727 With newer releases of Heimdal, a setuid Exim may cause Heimdal to discard the
28728 environment variable. In practice, for those releases, the Cyrus authenticator
28729 is not a suitable interface for GSSAPI (Kerberos) support. Instead, consider
28730 the &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator, described in chapter &<<CHAPheimdalgss>>&
28733 .section "Using cyrus_sasl as a server" "SECID178"
28734 The &(cyrus_sasl)& authenticator has four private options. It puts the username
28735 (on a successful authentication) into &$auth1$&. For compatibility with
28736 previous releases of Exim, the username is also placed in &$1$&. However, the
28737 use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to
28738 confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables for other
28742 .option server_hostname cyrus_sasl string&!! "see below"
28743 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28744 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&. It is up to the underlying
28745 SASL plug-in what it does with this data.
28748 .option server_mech cyrus_sasl string "see below"
28749 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28750 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28751 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28755 driver = cyrus_sasl
28756 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28757 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28758 server_set_id = $auth1
28761 .option server_realm cyrus_sasl string&!! unset
28762 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
28765 .option server_service cyrus_sasl string &`smtp`&
28766 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
28769 For straightforward cases, you do not need to set any of the authenticator's
28770 private options. All you need to do is to specify an appropriate mechanism as
28771 the public name. Thus, if you have a SASL library that supports CRAM-MD5 and
28772 PLAIN, you could have two authenticators as follows:
28775 driver = cyrus_sasl
28776 public_name = CRAM-MD5
28777 server_set_id = $auth1
28780 driver = cyrus_sasl
28781 public_name = PLAIN
28782 server_set_id = $auth2
28784 Cyrus SASL does implement the LOGIN authentication method, even though it is
28785 not a standard method. It is disabled by default in the source distribution,
28786 but it is present in many binary distributions.
28787 .ecindex IIDcyrauth1
28788 .ecindex IIDcyrauth2
28793 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28794 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28795 .chapter "The dovecot authenticator" "CHAPdovecot"
28796 .scindex IIDdcotauth1 "&(dovecot)& authenticator"
28797 .scindex IIDdcotauth2 "authenticators" "&(dovecot)&"
28798 This authenticator is an interface to the authentication facility of the
28799 Dovecot 2 POP/IMAP server, which can support a number of authentication methods.
28800 Note that Dovecot must be configured to use auth-client not auth-userdb.
28801 If you are using Dovecot to authenticate POP/IMAP clients, it might be helpful
28802 to use the same mechanisms for SMTP authentication. This is a server
28803 authenticator only. There is only one non-generic option:
28805 .option server_socket dovecot string unset
28807 This option must specify the UNIX socket that is the interface to Dovecot
28808 authentication. The &%public_name%& option must specify an authentication
28809 mechanism that Dovecot is configured to support. You can have several
28810 authenticators for different mechanisms. For example:
28814 public_name = PLAIN
28815 server_advertise_condition = ${if def:tls_in_cipher}
28816 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28817 server_set_id = $auth1
28822 server_socket = /var/run/dovecot/auth-client
28823 server_set_id = $auth1
28826 &*Note*&: plaintext authentication methods such as PLAIN and LOGIN
28827 should not be advertised on cleartext SMTP connections.
28828 See the discussion in section &<<SECTplain_TLS>>&.
28830 If the SMTP connection is encrypted, or if &$sender_host_address$& is equal to
28831 &$received_ip_address$& (that is, the connection is local), the &"secured"&
28832 option is passed in the Dovecot authentication command. If, for a TLS
28833 connection, a client certificate has been verified, the &"valid-client-cert"&
28834 option is passed. When authentication succeeds, the identity of the user
28835 who authenticated is placed in &$auth1$&.
28837 The Dovecot configuration to match the above will look
28840 conf.d/10-master.conf :-
28845 unix_listener auth-client {
28852 conf.d/10-auth.conf :-
28854 auth_mechanisms = plain login ntlm
28857 .ecindex IIDdcotauth1
28858 .ecindex IIDdcotauth2
28861 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28862 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
28863 .chapter "The gsasl authenticator" "CHAPgsasl"
28864 .scindex IIDgsaslauth1 "&(gsasl)& authenticator"
28865 .scindex IIDgsaslauth2 "authenticators" "&(gsasl)&"
28866 .cindex "authentication" "GNU SASL"
28867 .cindex "authentication" "SASL"
28868 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
28869 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
28870 .cindex "authentication" "PLAIN"
28871 .cindex "authentication" "LOGIN"
28872 .cindex "authentication" "DIGEST-MD5"
28873 .cindex "authentication" "CRAM-MD5"
28874 .cindex "authentication" "SCRAM family"
28875 The &(gsasl)& authenticator provides integration for the GNU SASL
28876 library and the mechanisms it provides. This is new as of the 4.80 release
28877 and there are a few areas where the library does not let Exim smoothly
28878 scale to handle future authentication mechanisms, so no guarantee can be
28879 made that any particular new authentication mechanism will be supported
28880 without code changes in Exim.
28882 The library is expected to add support in an upcoming
28883 realease for the SCRAM-SHA-256 method.
28884 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_SHA_256 will be defined
28887 To see the list of mechanisms supported by the library run Exim with "auth" debug
28888 enabled and look for a line containing "GNU SASL supports".
28889 Note however that some may not have been tested from Exim.
28892 .option client_authz gsasl string&!! unset
28893 This option can be used to supply an &'authorization id'&
28894 which is different to the &'authentication_id'& provided
28895 by &%client_username%& option.
28896 If unset or (after expansion) empty it is not used,
28897 which is the common case.
28899 .option client_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28900 See &%server_channelbinding%& below.
28902 .option client_password gsasl string&!! unset
28903 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28904 the password to be used, in clear.
28906 .option client_username gsasl string&!! unset
28907 This option is exapanded before use, and should result in
28908 the account name to be used.
28911 .option client_spassword gsasl string&!! unset
28912 This option is only supported for library versions 1.9.1 and greater.
28913 The macro _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY will be defined when this is so.
28915 If a SCRAM mechanism is being used and this option is set
28916 and correctly sized
28917 it is used in preference to &%client_password%&.
28918 The value after expansion should be
28919 a 40 (for SHA-1) or 64 (for SHA-256) character string
28920 with the PBKDF2-prepared password, hex-encoded.
28922 Note that this value will depend on the salt and iteration-count
28923 supplied by the server.
28924 The option is expanded before use.
28925 During the expansion &$auth1$& is set with the client username,
28926 &$auth2$& with the iteration count, and
28927 &$auth3$& with the salt.
28929 The intent of this option
28930 is to support clients that can cache thes salted password
28931 to save on recalculation costs.
28932 The cache lookup should return an unusable value
28933 (eg. an empty string)
28934 if the salt or iteration count has changed
28936 If the authentication succeeds then the above variables are set,
28937 .vindex "&$auth4$&"
28938 plus the calculated salted password value value in &$auth4$&,
28939 during the expansion of the &%client_set_id%& option.
28940 A side-effect of this expansion can be used to prime the cache.
28943 .option server_channelbinding gsasl boolean false
28944 Some authentication mechanisms are able to use external context at both ends
28945 of the session to bind the authentication to that context, and fail the
28946 authentication process if that context differs. Specifically, some TLS
28947 ciphersuites can provide identifying information about the cryptographic
28950 This should have meant that certificate identity and verification becomes a
28951 non-issue, as a man-in-the-middle attack will cause the correct client and
28952 server to see different identifiers and authentication will fail.
28955 only usable by mechanisms which support "channel binding"; at time of
28956 writing, that's the SCRAM family.
28957 When using this feature the "-PLUS" variants of the method names need to be used.
28959 This defaults off to ensure smooth upgrade across Exim releases, in case
28960 this option causes some clients to start failing. Some future release
28961 of Exim might have switched the default to be true.
28963 . However, Channel Binding in TLS has proven to be vulnerable in current versions.
28964 . Do not plan to rely upon this feature for security, ever, without consulting
28965 . with a subject matter expert (a cryptographic engineer).
28967 This option was deprecated in previous releases due to doubts over
28968 the "Triple Handshake" vulnerability.
28969 Exim takes suitable precausions (requiring Extended Master Secret if TLS
28970 Session Resumption was used) for safety.
28973 .option server_hostname gsasl string&!! "see below"
28974 This option selects the hostname that is used when communicating with the
28975 library. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
28976 Some mechanisms will use this data.
28979 .option server_mech gsasl string "see below"
28980 This option selects the authentication mechanism this driver should use. The
28981 default is the value of the generic &%public_name%& option. This option allows
28982 you to use a different underlying mechanism from the advertised name. For
28987 public_name = X-ANYTHING
28988 server_mech = CRAM-MD5
28989 server_set_id = $auth1
28993 .option server_password gsasl string&!! unset
28994 Various mechanisms need access to the cleartext password on the server, so
28995 that proof-of-possession can be demonstrated on the wire, without sending
28996 the password itself.
28998 The data available for lookup varies per mechanism.
28999 In all cases, &$auth1$& is set to the &'authentication id'&.
29000 The &$auth2$& variable will always be the &'authorization id'& (&'authz'&)
29001 if available, else the empty string.
29002 The &$auth3$& variable will always be the &'realm'& if available,
29003 else the empty string.
29005 A forced failure will cause authentication to defer.
29007 If using this option, it may make sense to set the &%server_condition%&
29008 option to be simply "true".
29011 .option server_realm gsasl string&!! unset
29012 This specifies the SASL realm that the server claims to be in.
29013 Some mechanisms will use this data.
29016 .option server_scram_iter gsasl string&!! 4096
29017 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
29018 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
29019 when this option is expanded.
29021 The result of expansion should be a decimal number,
29022 and represents both a lower-bound on the security, and
29023 a compute cost factor imposed on the client
29024 (if it does not cache results, or the server changes
29025 either the iteration count or the salt).
29026 A minimum value of 4096 is required by the standards
29027 for all current SCRAM mechanism variants.
29029 .option server_scram_salt gsasl string&!! unset
29030 This option provides data for the SCRAM family of mechanisms.
29031 The &$auth1$&, &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& variables are available
29032 when this option is expanded.
29033 The value should be a base64-encoded string,
29034 of random data typically 4-to-16 bytes long.
29035 If unset or empty after expansion the library will provides a value for the
29036 protocol conversation.
29039 .option server_key gsasl string&!! unset
29040 .option server_skey gsasl string&!! unset
29041 These options can be used for the SCRAM family of mechanisms
29042 to provide stored information related to a password,
29043 the storage of which is preferable to plaintext.
29045 &%server_key%& is the value defined in the SCRAM standards as ServerKey;
29046 &%server_skey%& is StoredKey.
29048 They are only available for version 1.9.0 (or later) of the gsasl library.
29049 When this is so, the macros
29050 _OPT_AUTHENTICATOR_GSASL_SERVER_KEY
29051 and _HAVE_AUTH_GSASL_SCRAM_S_KEY
29054 The &$authN$& variables are available when these options are expanded.
29056 If set, the results of expansion should for each
29057 should be a 28 (for SHA-1) or 44 (for SHA-256) character string
29058 of base64-coded data, and will be used in preference to the
29059 &%server_password%& option.
29060 If unset or not of the right length, &%server_password%& will be used.
29062 The libgsasl library release includes a utility &'gsasl'& which can be used
29063 to generate these values.
29066 .option server_service gsasl string &`smtp`&
29067 This is the SASL service that the server claims to implement.
29068 Some mechanisms will use this data.
29071 .section "&(gsasl)& auth variables" "SECTgsaslauthvar"
29072 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
29073 These may be set when evaluating specific options, as detailed above.
29074 They will also be set when evaluating &%server_condition%&.
29076 Unless otherwise stated below, the &(gsasl)& integration will use the following
29077 meanings for these variables:
29080 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
29081 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&
29083 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
29084 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&
29086 .vindex "&$auth3$&"
29087 &$auth3$&: the &'realm'&
29090 On a per-mechanism basis:
29093 .cindex "authentication" "EXTERNAL"
29094 EXTERNAL: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'authorization id'&;
29095 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
29097 .cindex "authentication" "ANONYMOUS"
29098 ANONYMOUS: only &$auth1$& is set, to the possibly empty &'anonymous token'&;
29099 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
29101 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
29102 GSSAPI: &$auth1$& will be set to the &'GSSAPI Display Name'&;
29103 &$auth2$& will be set to the &'authorization id'&,
29104 the &%server_condition%& option must be present.
29107 An &'anonymous token'& is something passed along as an unauthenticated
29108 identifier; this is analogous to FTP anonymous authentication passing an
29109 email address, or software-identifier@, as the "password".
29112 An example showing the password having the realm specified in the callback
29113 and demonstrating a Cyrus SASL to GSASL migration approach is:
29115 gsasl_cyrusless_crammd5:
29117 public_name = CRAM-MD5
29118 server_realm = imap.example.org
29119 server_password = ${lookup{$auth1:$auth3:userPassword}\
29120 dbmjz{/etc/sasldb2}{$value}fail}
29121 server_set_id = ${quote:$auth1}
29122 server_condition = yes
29126 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29127 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29129 .chapter "The heimdal_gssapi authenticator" "CHAPheimdalgss"
29130 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth1 "&(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator"
29131 .scindex IIDheimdalgssauth2 "authenticators" "&(heimdal_gssapi)&"
29132 .cindex "authentication" "GSSAPI"
29133 .cindex "authentication" "Kerberos"
29134 The &(heimdal_gssapi)& authenticator provides server integration for the
29135 Heimdal GSSAPI/Kerberos library, permitting Exim to set a keytab pathname
29138 .option server_hostname heimdal_gssapi string&!! "see below"
29139 This option selects the hostname that is used, with &%server_service%&,
29140 for constructing the GSS server name, as a &'GSS_C_NT_HOSTBASED_SERVICE'&
29141 identifier. The default value is &`$primary_hostname`&.
29143 .option server_keytab heimdal_gssapi string&!! unset
29144 If set, then Heimdal will not use the system default keytab (typically
29145 &_/etc/krb5.keytab_&) but instead the pathname given in this option.
29146 The value should be a pathname, with no &"file:"& prefix.
29148 .option server_service heimdal_gssapi string&!! "smtp"
29149 This option specifies the service identifier used, in conjunction with
29150 &%server_hostname%&, for building the identifier for finding credentials
29154 .section "&(heimdal_gssapi)& auth variables" "SECTheimdalgssauthvar"
29155 Beware that these variables will typically include a realm, thus will appear
29156 to be roughly like an email address already. The &'authzid'& in &$auth2$& is
29157 not verified, so a malicious client can set it to anything.
29159 The &$auth1$& field should be safely trustable as a value from the Key
29160 Distribution Center. Note that these are not quite email addresses.
29161 Each identifier is for a role, and so the left-hand-side may include a
29162 role suffix. For instance, &"joe/admin@EXAMPLE.ORG"&.
29164 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
29166 .vindex "&$auth1$&"
29167 &$auth1$&: the &'authentication id'&, set to the GSS Display Name.
29169 .vindex "&$auth2$&"
29170 &$auth2$&: the &'authorization id'&, sent within SASL encapsulation after
29171 authentication. If that was empty, this will also be set to the
29176 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29177 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29179 .chapter "The spa authenticator" "CHAPspa"
29180 .scindex IIDspaauth1 "&(spa)& authenticator"
29181 .scindex IIDspaauth2 "authenticators" "&(spa)&"
29182 .cindex "authentication" "Microsoft Secure Password"
29183 .cindex "authentication" "NTLM"
29184 .cindex "Microsoft Secure Password Authentication"
29185 .cindex "NTLM authentication"
29186 The &(spa)& authenticator provides client support for Microsoft's &'Secure
29187 Password Authentication'& mechanism,
29188 which is also sometimes known as NTLM (NT LanMan). The code for client side of
29189 this authenticator was contributed by Marc Prud'hommeaux, and much of it is
29190 taken from the &url(https://www.samba.org/,Samba project). The code for the
29191 server side was subsequently contributed by Tom Kistner. The mechanism works as
29195 After the AUTH command has been accepted, the client sends an SPA
29196 authentication request based on the user name and optional domain.
29198 The server sends back a challenge.
29200 The client builds a challenge response which makes use of the user's password
29201 and sends it to the server, which then accepts or rejects it.
29204 Encryption is used to protect the password in transit.
29208 .section "Using spa as a server" "SECID179"
29209 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (server)"
29210 The &(spa)& authenticator has just one server option:
29212 .option server_password spa string&!! unset
29213 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &(spa)& authenticator"
29214 This option is expanded, and the result must be the cleartext password for the
29215 authenticating user, whose name is at this point in &$auth1$&. For
29216 compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the user name is also placed in
29217 &$1$&. However, the use of this variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as
29218 it can lead to confusion in string expansions that also use numeric variables
29219 for other things. For example:
29224 server_password = \
29225 ${lookup{$auth1}lsearch{/etc/exim/spa_clearpass}{$value}fail}
29227 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29228 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29234 .section "Using spa as a client" "SECID180"
29235 .cindex "options" "&(spa)& authenticator (client)"
29236 The &(spa)& authenticator has the following client options:
29240 .option client_domain spa string&!! unset
29241 This option specifies an optional domain for the authentication.
29244 .option client_password spa string&!! unset
29245 This option specifies the user's password, and must be set.
29248 .option client_username spa string&!! unset
29249 This option specifies the user name, and must be set. Here is an example of a
29250 configuration of this authenticator for use with the mail servers at
29256 client_username = msn/msn_username
29257 client_password = msn_plaintext_password
29258 client_domain = DOMAIN_OR_UNSET
29260 .ecindex IIDspaauth1
29261 .ecindex IIDspaauth2
29267 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29268 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29270 .chapter "The external authenticator" "CHAPexternauth"
29271 .scindex IIDexternauth1 "&(external)& authenticator"
29272 .scindex IIDexternauth2 "authenticators" "&(external)&"
29273 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
29274 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
29275 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
29276 The &(external)& authenticator provides support for
29277 authentication based on non-SMTP information.
29278 The specification is in
29279 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc4422,RFC 4422) Appendix A.
29280 It is only a transport and negotiation mechanism;
29281 the process of authentication is entirely controlled
29282 by the server configuration.
29284 The client presents an identity in-clear.
29285 It is probably wise for a server to only advertise,
29286 and for clients to only attempt,
29287 this authentication method on a secure (eg. under TLS) connection.
29289 One possible use, compatible with the
29290 &url(https://k9mail.github.io/,K-9 Mail Android client)
29291 is for using X509 client certificates.
29293 It thus overlaps in function with the TLS authenticator
29294 (see &<<CHAPtlsauth>>&)
29295 but is a full SMTP SASL authenticator
29296 rather than being implicit for TLS-connection carried
29297 client certificates only.
29299 The examples and discussion in this chapter assume that
29300 client-certificate authentication is being done.
29302 The client must present a certificate,
29303 for which it must have been requested via the
29304 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
29305 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29306 For authentication to be effective the certificate should be
29307 verifiable against a trust-anchor certificate known to the server.
29309 .section "External options" "SECTexternsoptions"
29310 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (server)"
29311 The &(external)& authenticator has two server options:
29313 .option server_param2 external string&!! unset
29314 .option server_param3 external string&!! unset
29315 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29316 These options are expanded before the &%server_condition%& option
29317 and the result are placed in &$auth2$& and &$auth3$& resectively.
29318 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29319 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29321 They can be used to clarify the coding of a complex &%server_condition%&.
29323 .section "Using external in a server" "SECTexternserver"
29324 .cindex "AUTH" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29325 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" &&&
29326 "in &(external)& authenticator"
29327 .vindex "&$auth1$&, &$auth2$&, etc"
29328 .cindex "base64 encoding" "in &(external)& authenticator"
29330 When running as a server, &(external)& performs the authentication test by
29331 expanding a string. The data sent by the client with the AUTH command, or in
29332 response to subsequent prompts, is base64 encoded, and so may contain any byte
29333 values when decoded. The decoded value is treated as
29334 an identity for authentication and
29335 placed in the expansion variable &$auth1$&.
29337 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, the value is also placed in
29338 the expansion variable &$1$&. However, the use of this
29339 variable for this purpose is now deprecated, as it can lead to confusion in
29340 string expansions that also use them for other things.
29342 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
29343 Once an identity has been received,
29344 &%server_condition%& is expanded. If the expansion is forced to fail,
29345 authentication fails. Any other expansion failure causes a temporary error code
29346 to be returned. If the result of a successful expansion is an empty string,
29347 &"0"&, &"no"&, or &"false"&, authentication fails. If the result of the
29348 expansion is &"1"&, &"yes"&, or &"true"&, authentication succeeds and the
29349 generic &%server_set_id%& option is expanded and saved in &$authenticated_id$&.
29350 For any other result, a temporary error code is returned, with the expanded
29351 string as the error text.
29355 ext_ccert_san_mail:
29357 public_name = EXTERNAL
29359 server_advertise_condition = $tls_in_certificate_verified
29360 server_param2 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29361 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29362 server_condition = ${if forany {$auth2} \
29363 {eq {$item}{$auth1}}}
29364 server_set_id = $auth1
29366 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29367 of your configured trust-anchors
29368 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29369 and which has a mail-SAN matching the claimed identity sent by the client.
29371 &*Note*&: up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN.
29372 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29373 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29377 .section "Using external in a client" "SECTexternclient"
29378 .cindex "options" "&(external)& authenticator (client)"
29379 The &(external)& authenticator has one client option:
29381 .option client_send external string&!! unset
29382 This option is expanded and sent with the AUTH command as the
29383 identity being asserted.
29389 public_name = EXTERNAL
29391 client_condition = ${if !eq{$tls_out_cipher}{}}
29392 client_send = myaccount@smarthost.example.net
29396 .ecindex IIDexternauth1
29397 .ecindex IIDexternauth2
29403 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29404 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29406 .chapter "The tls authenticator" "CHAPtlsauth"
29407 .scindex IIDtlsauth1 "&(tls)& authenticator"
29408 .scindex IIDtlsauth2 "authenticators" "&(tls)&"
29409 .cindex "authentication" "Client Certificate"
29410 .cindex "authentication" "X509"
29411 .cindex "Certificate-based authentication"
29412 The &(tls)& authenticator provides server support for
29413 authentication based on client certificates.
29415 It is not an SMTP authentication mechanism and is not
29416 advertised by the server as part of the SMTP EHLO response.
29417 It is an Exim authenticator in the sense that it affects
29418 the protocol element of the log line, can be tested for
29419 by the &%authenticated%& ACL condition, and can set
29420 the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
29422 The client must present a verifiable certificate,
29423 for which it must have been requested via the
29424 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& main options
29425 (see &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
29427 If an authenticator of this type is configured it is
29428 run immediately after a TLS connection being negotiated
29429 (due to either STARTTLS or TLS-on-connect)
29430 and can authenticate the connection.
29431 If it does, SMTP authentication is not subsequently offered.
29433 A maximum of one authenticator of this type may be present.
29436 .cindex "options" "&(tls)& authenticator (server)"
29437 The &(tls)& authenticator has three server options:
29439 .option server_param1 tls string&!! unset
29440 .cindex "variables (&$auth1$& &$auth2$& etc)" "in &(tls)& authenticator"
29441 This option is expanded after the TLS negotiation and
29442 the result is placed in &$auth1$&.
29443 If the expansion is forced to fail, authentication fails. Any other expansion
29444 failure causes a temporary error code to be returned.
29446 .option server_param2 tls string&!! unset
29447 .option server_param3 tls string&!! unset
29448 As above, for &$auth2$& and &$auth3$&.
29450 &%server_param1%& may also be spelled &%server_param%&.
29457 server_param1 = ${certextract {subj_altname,mail,>:} \
29458 {$tls_in_peercert}}
29459 server_condition = ${if and { {eq{$tls_in_certificate_verified}{1}} \
29462 {${lookup ldap{ldap:///\
29463 mailname=${quote_ldap_dn:${lc:$item}},\
29464 ou=users,LDAP_DC?mailid} {$value}{0} \
29466 server_set_id = ${if = {1}{${listcount:$auth1}} {$auth1}{}}
29468 This accepts a client certificate that is verifiable against any
29469 of your configured trust-anchors
29470 (which usually means the full set of public CAs)
29471 and which has a SAN with a good account name.
29473 Note that, up to TLS1.2, the client cert is on the wire in-clear, including the SAN,
29474 The account name is therefore guessable by an opponent.
29475 TLS 1.3 protects both server and client certificates, and is not vulnerable
29477 Likewise, a traditional plaintext SMTP AUTH done inside TLS is not.
29479 . An alternative might use
29481 . server_param1 = ${sha256:$tls_in_peercert}
29483 . to require one of a set of specific certs that define a given account
29484 . (the verification is still required, but mostly irrelevant).
29485 . This would help for per-device use.
29487 . However, for the future we really need support for checking a
29488 . user cert in LDAP - which probably wants a base-64 DER.
29490 .ecindex IIDtlsauth1
29491 .ecindex IIDtlsauth2
29494 Note that because authentication is traditionally an SMTP operation,
29495 the &%authenticated%& ACL condition cannot be used in
29496 a connect- or helo-ACL.
29500 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29501 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
29503 .chapter "Encrypted SMTP connections using TLS/SSL" "CHAPTLS" &&&
29504 "Encrypted SMTP connections"
29505 .scindex IIDencsmtp1 "encryption" "on SMTP connection"
29506 .scindex IIDencsmtp2 "SMTP" "encryption"
29507 .cindex "TLS" "on SMTP connection"
29510 Support for TLS (Transport Layer Security), formerly known as SSL (Secure
29511 Sockets Layer), is implemented by making use of the OpenSSL library or the
29512 GnuTLS library (Exim requires GnuTLS release 1.0 or later). There is no
29513 cryptographic code in the Exim distribution itself for implementing TLS. In
29514 order to use this feature you must install OpenSSL or GnuTLS, and then build a
29515 version of Exim that includes TLS support (see section &<<SECTinctlsssl>>&).
29516 You also need to understand the basic concepts of encryption at a managerial
29517 level, and in particular, the way that public keys, private keys, and
29518 certificates are used.
29520 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3207,RFC 3207)
29521 defines how SMTP connections can make use of encryption. Once a
29522 connection is established, the client issues a STARTTLS command. If the
29523 server accepts this, the client and the server negotiate an encryption
29524 mechanism. If the negotiation succeeds, the data that subsequently passes
29525 between them is encrypted.
29527 Exim's ACLs can detect whether the current SMTP session is encrypted or not,
29528 and if so, what cipher suite is in use, whether the client supplied a
29529 certificate, and whether or not that certificate was verified. This makes it
29530 possible for an Exim server to deny or accept certain commands based on the
29533 &*Warning*&: Certain types of firewall and certain anti-virus products can
29534 disrupt TLS connections. You need to turn off SMTP scanning for these products
29535 in order to get TLS to work.
29539 .section "Support for the &""submissions""& (aka &""ssmtp""& and &""smtps""&) protocol" &&&
29541 .cindex "submissions protocol"
29542 .cindex "ssmtp protocol"
29543 .cindex "smtps protocol"
29544 .cindex "SMTP" "submissions protocol"
29545 .cindex "SMTP" "ssmtp protocol"
29546 .cindex "SMTP" "smtps protocol"
29547 The history of port numbers for TLS in SMTP is a little messy and has been
29549 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314),
29550 the common practice of using the historically
29551 allocated port 465 for "email submission but with TLS immediately upon connect
29552 instead of using STARTTLS" is officially blessed by the IETF, and recommended
29553 by them in preference to STARTTLS.
29555 The name originally assigned to the port was &"ssmtp"& or &"smtps"&, but as
29556 clarity emerged over the dual roles of SMTP, for MX delivery and Email
29557 Submission, nomenclature has shifted. The modern name is now &"submissions"&.
29559 This approach was, for a while, officially abandoned when encrypted SMTP was
29560 standardized, but many clients kept using it, even as the TCP port number was
29561 reassigned for other use.
29562 Thus you may encounter guidance claiming that you shouldn't enable use of
29564 In practice, a number of mail-clients have only ever supported submissions,
29565 not submission with STARTTLS upgrade.
29566 Ideally, offer both submission (587) and submissions (465) service.
29568 Exim supports TLS-on-connect by means of the &%tls_on_connect_ports%&
29569 global option. Its value must be a list of port numbers;
29570 the most common use is expected to be:
29572 tls_on_connect_ports = 465
29574 The port numbers specified by this option apply to all SMTP connections, both
29575 via the daemon and via &'inetd'&. You still need to specify all the ports that
29576 the daemon uses (by setting &%daemon_smtp_ports%& or &%local_interfaces%& or
29577 the &%-oX%& command line option) because &%tls_on_connect_ports%& does not add
29578 an extra port &-- rather, it specifies different behaviour on a port that is
29581 There is also a &%-tls-on-connect%& command line option. This overrides
29582 &%tls_on_connect_ports%&; it forces the TLS-only behaviour for all ports.
29589 .section "OpenSSL vs GnuTLS" "SECTopenvsgnu"
29590 .cindex "TLS" "OpenSSL &'vs'& GnuTLS"
29591 TLS is supported in Exim using either the OpenSSL or GnuTLS library.
29592 To build Exim to use OpenSSL you need to set
29598 To build Exim to use GnuTLS, you need to set
29604 You must also set TLS_LIBS and TLS_INCLUDE appropriately, so that the
29605 include files and libraries for GnuTLS can be found.
29607 There are some differences in usage when using GnuTLS instead of OpenSSL:
29610 The &%tls_verify_certificates%& option
29611 cannot be the path of a directory
29612 for GnuTLS versions before 3.3.6
29613 (for later versions, or OpenSSL, it can be either).
29615 The default value for &%tls_dhparam%& differs for historical reasons.
29617 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
29618 .vindex "&$tls_out_peerdn$&"
29619 Distinguished Name (DN) strings reported by the OpenSSL library use a slash for
29620 separating fields; GnuTLS uses commas, in accordance with
29621 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2253,RFC 2253). This
29622 affects the value of the &$tls_in_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_peerdn$& variables.
29624 OpenSSL identifies cipher suites using hyphens as separators, for example:
29625 DES-CBC3-SHA. GnuTLS historically used underscores, for example:
29626 RSA_ARCFOUR_SHA. What is more, OpenSSL complains if underscores are present
29627 in a cipher list. To make life simpler, Exim changes underscores to hyphens
29628 for OpenSSL and passes the string unchanged to GnuTLS (expecting the library
29629 to handle its own older variants) when processing lists of cipher suites in the
29630 &%tls_require_ciphers%& options (the global option and the &(smtp)& transport
29633 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& options operate differently, as described in the
29634 sections &<<SECTreqciphssl>>& and &<<SECTreqciphgnu>>&.
29636 The &%tls_dh_min_bits%& SMTP transport option is only honoured by GnuTLS.
29637 When using OpenSSL, this option is ignored.
29638 (If an API is found to let OpenSSL be configured in this way,
29639 let the Exim Maintainers know and we'll likely use it).
29641 With GnuTLS, if an explicit list is used for the &%tls_privatekey%& main option,
29642 it must be ordered to match the &%tls_certificate%& list.
29644 Some other recently added features may only be available in one or the other.
29645 This should be documented with the feature. If the documentation does not
29646 explicitly state that the feature is infeasible in the other TLS
29647 implementation, then patches are welcome.
29649 The output from "exim -bV" will show which (if any) support was included
29651 Also, the macro "_HAVE_OPENSSL" or "_HAVE_GNUTLS" will be defined.
29655 .section "GnuTLS parameter computation" "SECTgnutlsparam"
29656 This section only applies if &%tls_dhparam%& is set to &`historic`& or to
29657 an explicit path; if the latter, then the text about generation still applies,
29658 but not the chosen filename.
29659 By default, as of Exim 4.80 a hard-coded D-H prime is used.
29660 See the documentation of &%tls_dhparam%& for more information.
29662 GnuTLS uses D-H parameters that may take a substantial amount of time
29663 to compute. It is unreasonable to re-compute them for every TLS session.
29664 Therefore, Exim keeps this data in a file in its spool directory, called
29665 &_gnutls-params-NNNN_& for some value of NNNN, corresponding to the number
29667 The file is owned by the Exim user and is readable only by
29668 its owner. Every Exim process that start up GnuTLS reads the D-H
29669 parameters from this file. If the file does not exist, the first Exim process
29670 that needs it computes the data and writes it to a temporary file which is
29671 renamed once it is complete. It does not matter if several Exim processes do
29672 this simultaneously (apart from wasting a few resources). Once a file is in
29673 place, new Exim processes immediately start using it.
29675 For maximum security, the parameters that are stored in this file should be
29676 recalculated periodically, the frequency depending on your paranoia level.
29677 If you are avoiding using the fixed D-H primes published in RFCs, then you
29678 are concerned about some advanced attacks and will wish to do this; if you do
29679 not regenerate then you might as well stick to the standard primes.
29681 Arranging this is easy in principle; just delete the file when you want new
29682 values to be computed. However, there may be a problem. The calculation of new
29683 parameters needs random numbers, and these are obtained from &_/dev/random_&.
29684 If the system is not very active, &_/dev/random_& may delay returning data
29685 until enough randomness (entropy) is available. This may cause Exim to hang for
29686 a substantial amount of time, causing timeouts on incoming connections.
29688 The solution is to generate the parameters externally to Exim. They are stored
29689 in &_gnutls-params-N_& in PEM format, which means that they can be
29690 generated externally using the &(certtool)& command that is part of GnuTLS.
29692 To replace the parameters with new ones, instead of deleting the file
29693 and letting Exim re-create it, you can generate new parameters using
29694 &(certtool)& and, when this has been done, replace Exim's cache file by
29695 renaming. The relevant commands are something like this:
29698 [ look for file; assume gnutls-params-2236 is the most recent ]
29701 # chown exim:exim new-params
29702 # chmod 0600 new-params
29703 # certtool --generate-dh-params --bits 2236 >>new-params
29704 # openssl dhparam -noout -text -in new-params | head
29705 [ check the first line, make sure it's not more than 2236;
29706 if it is, then go back to the start ("rm") and repeat
29707 until the size generated is at most the size requested ]
29708 # chmod 0400 new-params
29709 # mv new-params gnutls-params-2236
29711 If Exim never has to generate the parameters itself, the possibility of
29712 stalling is removed.
29714 The filename changed in Exim 4.80, to gain the -bits suffix. The value which
29715 Exim will choose depends upon the version of GnuTLS in use. For older GnuTLS,
29716 the value remains hard-coded in Exim as 1024. As of GnuTLS 2.12.x, there is
29717 a way for Exim to ask for the "normal" number of bits for D-H public-key usage,
29718 and Exim does so. This attempt to remove Exim from TLS policy decisions
29719 failed, as GnuTLS 2.12 returns a value higher than the current hard-coded limit
29720 of the NSS library. Thus Exim gains the &%tls_dh_max_bits%& global option,
29721 which applies to all D-H usage, client or server. If the value returned by
29722 GnuTLS is greater than &%tls_dh_max_bits%& then the value will be clamped down
29723 to &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. The default value has been set at the current NSS
29724 limit, which is still much higher than Exim historically used.
29726 The filename and bits used will change as the GnuTLS maintainers change the
29727 value for their parameter &`GNUTLS_SEC_PARAM_NORMAL`&, as clamped by
29728 &%tls_dh_max_bits%&. At the time of writing (mid 2012), GnuTLS 2.12 recommends
29729 2432 bits, while NSS is limited to 2236 bits.
29731 In fact, the requested value will be *lower* than &%tls_dh_max_bits%&, to
29732 increase the chance of the generated prime actually being within acceptable
29733 bounds, as GnuTLS has been observed to overshoot. Note the check step in the
29734 procedure above. There is no sane procedure available to Exim to double-check
29735 the size of the generated prime, so it might still be too large.
29738 .section "Requiring specific ciphers in OpenSSL" "SECTreqciphssl"
29739 .cindex "TLS" "requiring specific ciphers (OpenSSL)"
29740 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "OpenSSL"
29741 There is a function in the OpenSSL library that can be passed a list of cipher
29742 suites before the cipher negotiation takes place. This specifies which ciphers
29743 are acceptable for TLS versions prior to 1.3.
29744 The list is colon separated and may contain names like
29745 DES-CBC3-SHA. Exim passes the expanded value of &%tls_require_ciphers%&
29746 directly to this function call.
29747 Many systems will install the OpenSSL manual-pages, so you may have
29748 &'ciphers(1)'& available to you.
29749 The following quotation from the OpenSSL
29750 documentation specifies what forms of item are allowed in the cipher string:
29753 It can consist of a single cipher suite such as RC4-SHA.
29755 It can represent a list of cipher suites containing a certain algorithm,
29756 or cipher suites of a certain type. For example SHA1 represents all
29757 ciphers suites using the digest algorithm SHA1 and SSLv3 represents all
29760 Lists of cipher suites can be combined in a single cipher string using
29761 the + character. This is used as a logical and operation. For example
29762 SHA1+DES represents all cipher suites containing the SHA1 and the DES
29766 Each cipher string can be optionally preceded by one of the characters &`!`&,
29769 If &`!`& is used, the ciphers are permanently deleted from the list. The
29770 ciphers deleted can never reappear in the list even if they are explicitly
29773 If &`-`& is used, the ciphers are deleted from the list, but some or all
29774 of the ciphers can be added again by later options.
29776 If &`+`& is used, the ciphers are moved to the end of the list. This
29777 option does not add any new ciphers; it just moves matching existing ones.
29780 If none of these characters is present, the string is interpreted as
29781 a list of ciphers to be appended to the current preference list. If the list
29782 includes any ciphers already present they will be ignored: that is, they will
29783 not be moved to the end of the list.
29786 The OpenSSL &'ciphers(1)'& command may be used to test the results of a given
29789 # note single-quotes to get ! past any shell history expansion
29790 $ openssl ciphers 'HIGH:!MD5:!SHA1'
29793 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29794 there's probably no identity verification anyway, but ups the ante on the
29795 submission ports where the administrator might have some influence on the
29796 choice of clients used:
29798 # OpenSSL variant; see man ciphers(1)
29799 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29804 This example will prefer ECDSA-authenticated ciphers over RSA ones:
29806 tls_require_ciphers = ECDSA:RSA:!COMPLEMENTOFDEFAULT
29809 For TLS version 1.3 the control available is less fine-grained
29810 and Exim does not provide access to it at present.
29811 The value of the &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is ignored when
29812 TLS version 1.3 is negotiated.
29814 As of writing the library default cipher suite list for TLSv1.3 is
29816 TLS_AES_256_GCM_SHA384:TLS_CHACHA20_POLY1305_SHA256:TLS_AES_128_GCM_SHA256
29820 .section "Requiring specific ciphers or other parameters in GnuTLS" &&&
29822 .cindex "GnuTLS" "specifying parameters for"
29823 .cindex "TLS" "specifying ciphers (GnuTLS)"
29824 .cindex "TLS" "specifying key exchange methods (GnuTLS)"
29825 .cindex "TLS" "specifying MAC algorithms (GnuTLS)"
29826 .cindex "TLS" "specifying protocols (GnuTLS)"
29827 .cindex "TLS" "specifying priority string (GnuTLS)"
29828 .oindex "&%tls_require_ciphers%&" "GnuTLS"
29829 The GnuTLS library allows the caller to provide a "priority string", documented
29830 as part of the &[gnutls_priority_init]& function. This is very similar to the
29831 ciphersuite specification in OpenSSL.
29833 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is treated as the GnuTLS priority string
29834 and controls both protocols and ciphers.
29836 The &%tls_require_ciphers%& option is available both as an global option,
29837 controlling how Exim behaves as a server, and also as an option of the
29838 &(smtp)& transport, controlling how Exim behaves as a client. In both cases
29839 the value is string expanded. The resulting string is not an Exim list and
29840 the string is given to the GnuTLS library, so that Exim does not need to be
29841 aware of future feature enhancements of GnuTLS.
29843 Documentation of the strings accepted may be found in the GnuTLS manual, under
29844 "Priority strings". This is online as
29845 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/html_node/Priority-Strings.html),
29846 but beware that this relates to GnuTLS 3, which may be newer than the version
29847 installed on your system. If you are using GnuTLS 3,
29848 then the example code
29849 &url(https://www.gnutls.org/manual/gnutls.html#Listing-the-ciphersuites-in-a-priority-string)
29850 on that site can be used to test a given string.
29854 # Disable older versions of protocols
29855 tls_require_ciphers = NORMAL:%LATEST_RECORD_VERSION:-VERS-SSL3.0
29858 Prior to Exim 4.80, an older API of GnuTLS was used, and Exim supported three
29859 additional options, "&%gnutls_require_kx%&", "&%gnutls_require_mac%&" and
29860 "&%gnutls_require_protocols%&". &%tls_require_ciphers%& was an Exim list.
29862 This example will let the library defaults be permitted on the MX port, where
29863 there's probably no identity verification anyway, and lowers security further
29864 by increasing compatibility; but this ups the ante on the submission ports
29865 where the administrator might have some influence on the choice of clients
29869 tls_require_ciphers = ${if =={$received_port}{25}\
29875 .section "Configuring an Exim server to use TLS" "SECID182"
29876 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim server"
29877 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
29878 When Exim has been built with TLS support, it advertises the availability of
29879 the STARTTLS command to client hosts that match &%tls_advertise_hosts%&,
29880 but not to any others. The default value of this option is *, which means
29881 that STARTTLS is always advertised. Set it to blank to never advertise;
29882 this is reasonable for systems that want to use TLS only as a client.
29884 If STARTTLS is to be used you
29885 need to set some other options in order to make TLS available.
29887 If a client issues a STARTTLS command and there is some configuration
29888 problem in the server, the command is rejected with a 454 error. If the client
29889 persists in trying to issue SMTP commands, all except QUIT are rejected
29892 554 Security failure
29894 If a STARTTLS command is issued within an existing TLS session, it is
29895 rejected with a 554 error code.
29897 To enable TLS operations on a server, the &%tls_advertise_hosts%& option
29898 must be set to match some hosts. The default is * which matches all hosts.
29900 If this is all you do, TLS encryption will be enabled but not authentication -
29901 meaning that the peer has no assurance it is actually you he is talking to.
29902 You gain protection from a passive sniffer listening on the wire but not
29903 from someone able to intercept the communication.
29905 Further protection requires some further configuration at the server end.
29907 To make TLS work you need to set, in the server,
29909 tls_certificate = /some/file/name
29910 tls_privatekey = /some/file/name
29912 These options are, in fact, expanded strings, so you can make them depend on
29913 the identity of the client that is connected if you wish. The first file
29914 contains the server's X509 certificate, and the second contains the private key
29915 that goes with it. These files need to be
29916 PEM format and readable by the Exim user, and must
29917 always be given as full path names.
29918 The key must not be password-protected.
29919 They can be the same file if both the
29920 certificate and the key are contained within it. If &%tls_privatekey%& is not
29921 set, or if its expansion is forced to fail or results in an empty string, this
29922 is assumed to be the case. The certificate file may also contain intermediate
29923 certificates that need to be sent to the client to enable it to authenticate
29924 the server's certificate.
29926 For dual-stack (eg. RSA and ECDSA) configurations, these options can be
29927 colon-separated lists of file paths. Ciphers using given authentication
29928 algorithms require the presence of a suitable certificate to supply the
29929 public-key. The server selects among the certificates to present to the
29930 client depending on the selected cipher, hence the priority ordering for
29931 ciphers will affect which certificate is used.
29933 If you do not understand about certificates and keys, please try to find a
29934 source of this background information, which is not Exim-specific. (There are a
29935 few comments below in section &<<SECTcerandall>>&.)
29937 &*Note*&: These options do not apply when Exim is operating as a client &--
29938 they apply only in the case of a server. If you need to use a certificate in an
29939 Exim client, you must set the options of the same names in an &(smtp)&
29942 With just these options, an Exim server will be able to use TLS. It does not
29943 require the client to have a certificate (but see below for how to insist on
29944 this). There is one other option that may be needed in other situations. If
29946 tls_dhparam = /some/file/name
29948 is set, the SSL library is initialized for the use of Diffie-Hellman ciphers
29949 with the parameters contained in the file.
29950 Set this to &`none`& to disable use of DH entirely, by making no prime
29955 This may also be set to a string identifying a standard prime to be used for
29956 DH; if it is set to &`default`& or, for OpenSSL, is unset, then the prime
29957 used is &`ike23`&. There are a few standard primes available, see the
29958 documentation for &%tls_dhparam%& for the complete list.
29964 for a way of generating file data.
29966 The strings supplied for these three options are expanded every time a client
29967 host connects. It is therefore possible to use different certificates and keys
29968 for different hosts, if you so wish, by making use of the client's IP address
29969 in &$sender_host_address$& to control the expansion. If a string expansion is
29970 forced to fail, Exim behaves as if the option is not set.
29972 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
29973 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
29974 .vindex "&$tls_in_cipher$&"
29975 The variable &$tls_in_cipher$& is set to the cipher suite that was negotiated for
29976 an incoming TLS connection. It is included in the &'Received:'& header of an
29977 incoming message (by default &-- you can, of course, change this), and it is
29978 also included in the log line that records a message's arrival, keyed by
29979 &"X="&, unless the &%tls_cipher%& log selector is turned off. The &%encrypted%&
29980 condition can be used to test for specific cipher suites in ACLs.
29982 Once TLS has been established, the ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands
29983 can check the name of the cipher suite and vary their actions accordingly. The
29984 cipher suite names vary, depending on which TLS library is being used. For
29985 example, OpenSSL uses the name DES-CBC3-SHA for the cipher suite which in other
29986 contexts is known as TLS_RSA_WITH_3DES_EDE_CBC_SHA. Check the OpenSSL or GnuTLS
29987 documentation for more details.
29989 For outgoing SMTP deliveries, &$tls_out_cipher$& is used and logged
29990 (again depending on the &%tls_cipher%& log selector).
29993 .subsection "Requesting and verifying client certificates"
29994 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
29995 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
29996 If you want an Exim server to request a certificate when negotiating a TLS
29997 session with a client, you must set either &%tls_verify_hosts%& or
29998 &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&. You can, of course, set either of them to * to
29999 apply to all TLS connections. For any host that matches one of these options,
30000 Exim requests a certificate as part of the setup of the TLS session. The
30001 contents of the certificate are verified by comparing it with a list of
30002 expected trust-anchors or certificates.
30003 These may be the system default set (depending on library version),
30004 an explicit file or,
30005 depending on library version, a directory, identified by
30006 &%tls_verify_certificates%&.
30008 A file can contain multiple certificates, concatenated end to end. If a
30011 each certificate must be in a separate file, with a name (or a symbolic link)
30012 of the form <&'hash'&>.0, where <&'hash'&> is a hash value constructed from the
30013 certificate. You can compute the relevant hash by running the command
30015 openssl x509 -hash -noout -in /cert/file
30017 where &_/cert/file_& contains a single certificate.
30019 There is no checking of names of the client against the certificate
30020 Subject Name or Subject Alternate Names.
30022 The difference between &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& is
30023 what happens if the client does not supply a certificate, or if the certificate
30024 does not match any of the certificates in the collection named by
30025 &%tls_verify_certificates%&. If the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&, the
30026 attempt to set up a TLS session is aborted, and the incoming connection is
30027 dropped. If the client matches &%tls_try_verify_hosts%&, the (encrypted) SMTP
30028 session continues. ACLs that run for subsequent SMTP commands can detect the
30029 fact that no certificate was verified, and vary their actions accordingly. For
30030 example, you can insist on a certificate before accepting a message for
30031 relaying, but not when the message is destined for local delivery.
30033 .vindex "&$tls_in_peerdn$&"
30034 When a client supplies a certificate (whether it verifies or not), the value of
30035 the Distinguished Name of the certificate is made available in the variable
30036 &$tls_in_peerdn$& during subsequent processing of the message.
30038 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
30039 Because it is often a long text string, it is not included in the log line or
30040 &'Received:'& header by default. You can arrange for it to be logged, keyed by
30041 &"DN="&, by setting the &%tls_peerdn%& log selector, and you can use
30042 &%received_header_text%& to change the &'Received:'& header. When no
30043 certificate is supplied, &$tls_in_peerdn$& is empty.
30046 .subsection "Caching of static server configuration items" "SSECTserverTLScache"
30047 .cindex certificate caching
30048 .cindex privatekey caching
30049 .cindex crl caching
30050 .cindex ocsp caching
30051 .cindex ciphers caching
30052 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
30053 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
30054 .cindex tls_certificate caching
30055 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
30056 .cindex tls_crl caching
30057 .cindex tls_ocsp_file caching
30058 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
30059 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
30060 .cindex caching certificate
30061 .cindex caching privatekey
30062 .cindex caching crl
30063 .cindex caching ocsp
30064 .cindex caching ciphers
30065 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
30066 If any of the main configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&,
30067 &%tls_crl%& and &%tls_ocsp_file%& have values with no
30068 expandable elements,
30069 then the associated information is loaded at daemon startup.
30070 It is made available
30071 to child processes forked for handling received SMTP connections.
30073 This caching is currently only supported under Linux and FreeBSD.
30075 If caching is not possible, for example if an item has to be dependent
30076 on the peer host so contains a &$sender_host_name$& expansion, the load
30077 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
30079 The cache is invalidated and reloaded after any changes to the directories
30080 containing files specified by these options.
30082 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
30083 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
30084 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
30085 The latter case is not automatically invalidated;
30086 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
30087 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
30088 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
30089 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
30091 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
30092 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
30094 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
30095 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
30101 .section "Configuring an Exim client to use TLS" "SECTclientTLS"
30102 .cindex "cipher" "logging"
30103 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
30104 .cindex "log" "distinguished name"
30105 .cindex "TLS" "configuring an Exim client"
30106 The &%tls_cipher%& and &%tls_peerdn%& log selectors apply to outgoing SMTP
30107 deliveries as well as to incoming, the latter one causing logging of the
30108 server certificate's DN. The remaining client configuration for TLS is all
30109 within the &(smtp)& transport.
30111 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" STARTTLS
30112 It is not necessary to set any options to have TLS work in the &(smtp)&
30113 transport. If Exim is built with TLS support, and TLS is advertised by a
30114 server, the &(smtp)& transport always tries to start a TLS session. However,
30115 this can be prevented by setting &%hosts_avoid_tls%& (an option of the
30116 transport) to a list of server hosts for which TLS should not be used.
30118 If you do not want Exim to attempt to send messages unencrypted when an attempt
30119 to set up an encrypted connection fails in any way, you can set
30120 &%hosts_require_tls%& to a list of hosts for which encryption is mandatory. For
30121 those hosts, delivery is always deferred if an encrypted connection cannot be
30122 set up. If there are any other hosts for the address, they are tried in the
30125 When the server host is not in &%hosts_require_tls%&, Exim may try to deliver
30126 the message unencrypted. It always does this if the response to STARTTLS is
30127 a 5&'xx'& code. For a temporary error code, or for a failure to negotiate a TLS
30128 session after a success response code, what happens is controlled by the
30129 &%tls_tempfail_tryclear%& option of the &(smtp)& transport. If it is false,
30130 delivery to this host is deferred, and other hosts (if available) are tried. If
30131 it is true, Exim attempts to deliver unencrypted after a 4&'xx'& response to
30132 STARTTLS, and if STARTTLS is accepted, but the subsequent TLS
30133 negotiation fails, Exim closes the current connection (because it is in an
30134 unknown state), opens a new one to the same host, and then tries the delivery
30137 The &%tls_certificate%& and &%tls_privatekey%& options of the &(smtp)&
30138 transport provide the client with a certificate, which is passed to the server
30140 This is an optional thing for TLS connections, although either end
30142 If the server is Exim, it will request a certificate only if
30143 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& matches the client.
30145 &*Note*&: Do not use a certificate which has the OCSP-must-staple extension,
30146 for client use (they are usable for server use).
30147 As the TLS protocol has no means for the client to staple before TLS 1.3 it will result
30148 in failed connections.
30150 If the &%tls_verify_certificates%& option is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it
30151 specifies a collection of expected server certificates.
30153 the system default set (depending on library version),
30155 or (depending on library version) a directory.
30156 The client verifies the server's certificate
30157 against this collection, taking into account any revoked certificates that are
30158 in the list defined by &%tls_crl%&.
30159 Failure to verify fails the TLS connection unless either of the
30160 &%tls_verify_hosts%& or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options are set.
30162 The &%tls_verify_hosts%& and &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& options restrict
30163 certificate verification to the listed servers. Verification either must
30164 or need not succeed respectively.
30166 The &%tls_verify_cert_hostnames%& option lists hosts for which additional
30167 name checks are made on the server certificate.
30168 The match against this list is, as per other Exim usage, the
30169 IP for the host. That is most closely associated with the
30170 name on the DNS A (or AAAA) record for the host.
30171 However, the name that needs to be in the certificate
30172 is the one at the head of any CNAME chain leading to the A record.
30173 The option defaults to always checking.
30175 The &(smtp)& transport has two OCSP-related options:
30176 &%hosts_require_ocsp%&; a host-list for which a Certificate Status
30177 is requested and required for the connection to proceed. The default
30179 &%hosts_request_ocsp%&; a host-list for which (additionally)
30180 a Certificate Status is requested (but not necessarily verified). The default
30181 value is "*" meaning that requests are made unless configured
30184 The host(s) should also be in &%hosts_require_tls%&, and
30185 &%tls_verify_certificates%& configured for the transport,
30186 for OCSP to be relevant.
30189 &%tls_require_ciphers%& is set on the &(smtp)& transport, it must contain a
30190 list of permitted cipher suites. If either of these checks fails, delivery to
30191 the current host is abandoned, and the &(smtp)& transport tries to deliver to
30192 alternative hosts, if any.
30195 These options must be set in the &(smtp)& transport for Exim to use TLS when it
30196 is operating as a client. Exim does not assume that a server certificate (set
30197 by the global options of the same name) should also be used when operating as a
30201 .vindex "&$host_address$&"
30202 All the TLS options in the &(smtp)& transport are expanded before use, with
30203 &$host$& and &$host_address$& containing the name and address of the server to
30204 which the client is connected. Forced failure of an expansion causes Exim to
30205 behave as if the relevant option were unset.
30207 .vindex &$tls_out_bits$&
30208 .vindex &$tls_out_cipher$&
30209 .vindex &$tls_out_peerdn$&
30210 .vindex &$tls_out_sni$&
30211 Before an SMTP connection is established, the
30212 &$tls_out_bits$&, &$tls_out_cipher$&, &$tls_out_peerdn$& and &$tls_out_sni$&
30213 variables are emptied. (Until the first connection, they contain the values
30214 that were set when the message was received.) If STARTTLS is subsequently
30215 successfully obeyed, these variables are set to the relevant values for the
30216 outgoing connection.
30220 .subsection "Caching of static client configuration items" SECTclientTLScache
30221 .cindex certificate caching
30222 .cindex privatekey caching
30223 .cindex crl caching
30224 .cindex ciphers caching
30225 .cindex "CA bundle" caching
30226 .cindex "certificate authorities" caching
30227 .cindex tls_certificate caching
30228 .cindex tls_privatekey caching
30229 .cindex tls_crl caching
30230 .cindex tls_require_ciphers caching
30231 .cindex tls_verify_certificate caching
30232 .cindex caching certificate
30233 .cindex caching privatekey
30234 .cindex caching crl
30235 .cindex caching ciphers
30236 .cindex caching "certificate authorities
30237 If any of the transport configuration options &%tls_certificate%&, &%tls_privatekey%&
30238 and &%tls_crl%& have values with no
30239 expandable elements,
30240 then the associated information is loaded per smtp transport
30241 at daemon startup, at the start of a queue run, or on a
30242 command-line specified message delivery.
30243 It is made available
30244 to child processes forked for handling making SMTP connections.
30246 This caching is currently only supported under Linux.
30248 If caching is not possible, the load
30249 of the associated information is done at the startup of the TLS connection.
30251 The cache is invalidated in the daemon
30252 and reloaded after any changes to the directories
30253 containing files specified by these options.
30255 The information specified by the main option &%tls_verify_certificates%&
30256 is similarly cached so long as it specifies files explicitly
30257 or (under GnuTLS) is the string &"system,cache"&.
30258 The latter case is not automatically invaludated;
30259 it is the operator's responsibility to arrange for a daemon restart
30260 any time the system certificate authority bundle is updated.
30261 A HUP signal is sufficient for this.
30262 The value &"system"& results in no caching under GnuTLS.
30264 The macro _HAVE_TLS_CA_CACHE will be defined if the suffix for "system"
30265 is acceptable in configurations for the Exim executable.
30267 Caching of the system Certificate Authorities bundle can
30268 save significant time and processing on every TLS connection
30274 .section "Use of TLS Server Name Indication" "SECTtlssni"
30275 .cindex "TLS" "Server Name Indication"
30278 .vindex "&$tls_in_sni$&"
30279 .oindex "&%tls_in_sni%&"
30280 With TLS1.0 or above, there is an extension mechanism by which extra
30281 information can be included at various points in the protocol. One of these
30282 extensions, documented in
30283 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6066,RFC 6066)
30284 (and before that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4366,RFC 4366)) is
30285 &"Server Name Indication"&, commonly &"SNI"&. This extension is sent by the
30286 client in the initial handshake, so that the server can examine the servername
30287 within and possibly choose to use different certificates and keys (and more)
30290 This is analogous to HTTP's &"Host:"& header, and is the main mechanism by
30291 which HTTPS-enabled web-sites can be virtual-hosted, many sites to one IP
30294 With SMTP to MX, there are the same problems here as in choosing the identity
30295 against which to validate a certificate: you can't rely on insecure DNS to
30296 provide the identity which you then cryptographically verify. So this will
30297 be of limited use in that environment.
30299 With SMTP to Submission, there is a well-defined hostname which clients are
30300 connecting to and can validate certificates against. Thus clients &*can*&
30301 choose to include this information in the TLS negotiation. If this becomes
30302 wide-spread, then hosters can choose to present different certificates to
30303 different clients. Or even negotiate different cipher suites.
30305 The &%tls_sni%& option on an SMTP transport is an expanded string; the result,
30306 if not empty, will be sent on a TLS session as part of the handshake. There's
30307 nothing more to it. Choosing a sensible value not derived insecurely is the
30308 only point of caution. The &$tls_out_sni$& variable will be set to this string
30309 for the lifetime of the client connection (including during authentication).
30311 If DANE validated the connection attempt then the value of the &%tls_sni%& option
30312 is forced to the name of the destination host, after any MX- or CNAME-following.
30314 Except during SMTP client sessions, if &$tls_in_sni$& is set then it is a string
30315 received from a client.
30316 It can be logged with the &%log_selector%& item &`+tls_sni`&.
30318 If the string &`tls_in_sni`& appears in the main section's &%tls_certificate%&
30319 option (prior to expansion) then the following options will be re-expanded
30320 during TLS session handshake, to permit alternative values to be chosen:
30323 &%tls_certificate%&
30329 &%tls_verify_certificates%&
30334 Great care should be taken to deal with matters of case, various injection
30335 attacks in the string (&`../`& or SQL), and ensuring that a valid filename
30336 can always be referenced; it is important to remember that &$tls_in_sni$& is
30337 arbitrary unverified data provided prior to authentication.
30338 Further, the initial certificate is loaded before SNI has arrived, so
30339 an expansion for &%tls_certificate%& must have a default which is used
30340 when &$tls_in_sni$& is empty.
30342 The Exim developers are proceeding cautiously and so far no other TLS options
30345 When Exim is built against OpenSSL, OpenSSL must have been built with support
30346 for TLS Extensions. This holds true for OpenSSL 1.0.0+ and 0.9.8+ with
30347 enable-tlsext in EXTRACONFIGURE. If you invoke &(openssl s_client -h)& and
30348 see &`-servername`& in the output, then OpenSSL has support.
30350 When Exim is built against GnuTLS, SNI support is available as of GnuTLS
30351 0.5.10. (Its presence predates the current API which Exim uses, so if Exim
30352 built, then you have SNI support).
30356 .cindex ALPN "general information"
30357 .cindex TLS "Application Layer Protocol Names"
30358 There is a TLS feature related to SNI
30359 called Application Layer Protocol Name (ALPN).
30360 This is intended to declare, or select, what protocol layer will be using a TLS
30362 The client for the connection proposes a set of protocol names, and
30363 the server responds with a selected one.
30364 It is not, as of 2021, commonly used for SMTP connections.
30365 However, to guard against misdirected or malicious use of web clients
30366 (which often do use ALPN) against MTA ports, Exim by default check that
30367 there is no incompatible ALPN specified by a client for a TLS connection.
30368 If there is, the connection is rejected.
30370 As a client Exim does not supply ALPN by default.
30371 The behaviour of both client and server can be configured using the options
30372 &%tls_alpn%& and &%hosts_require_alpn%&.
30373 There are no variables providing observability.
30374 Some feature-specific logging may appear on denied connections, but this
30375 depends on the behaviour of the peer
30376 (not all peers can send a feature-specific TLS Alert).
30378 This feature is available when Exim is built with
30379 OpenSSL 1.1.0 or later or GnuTLS 3.2.0 or later;
30380 the macro _HAVE_TLS_ALPN will be defined when this is so.
30384 .section "Multiple messages on the same encrypted TCP/IP connection" &&&
30386 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries with TLS"
30387 .cindex "TLS" "multiple message deliveries"
30388 Exim sends multiple messages down the same TCP/IP connection by starting up
30389 an entirely new delivery process for each message, passing the socket from
30390 one process to the next. This implementation does not fit well with the use
30391 of TLS, because there is quite a lot of state information associated with a TLS
30392 connection, not just a socket identification. Passing all the state information
30393 to a new process is not feasible. Consequently, for sending using TLS Exim
30394 starts an additional proxy process for handling the encryption, piping the
30395 unencrypted data stream from and to the delivery processes.
30397 An older mode of operation can be enabled on a per-host basis by the
30398 &%hosts_noproxy_tls%& option on the &(smtp)& transport. If the host matches
30399 this list the proxy process described above is not used; instead Exim
30400 shuts down an existing TLS session being run by the delivery process
30401 before passing the socket to a new process. The new process may then
30402 try to start a new TLS session, and if successful, may try to re-authenticate
30403 if AUTH is in use, before sending the next message.
30405 The RFC is not clear as to whether or not an SMTP session continues in clear
30406 after TLS has been shut down, or whether TLS may be restarted again later, as
30407 just described. However, if the server is Exim, this shutdown and
30408 reinitialization works. It is not known which (if any) other servers operate
30409 successfully if the client closes a TLS session and continues with unencrypted
30410 SMTP, but there are certainly some that do not work. For such servers, Exim
30411 should not pass the socket to another process, because the failure of the
30412 subsequent attempt to use it would cause Exim to record a temporary host error,
30413 and delay other deliveries to that host.
30415 To test for this case, Exim sends an EHLO command to the server after
30416 closing down the TLS session. If this fails in any way, the connection is
30417 closed instead of being passed to a new delivery process, but no retry
30418 information is recorded.
30420 There is also a manual override; you can set &%hosts_nopass_tls%& on the
30421 &(smtp)& transport to match those hosts for which Exim should not pass
30422 connections to new processes if TLS has been used.
30427 .section "Certificates and all that" "SECTcerandall"
30428 .cindex "certificate" "references to discussion"
30429 In order to understand fully how TLS works, you need to know about
30430 certificates, certificate signing, and certificate authorities.
30431 This is a large topic and an introductory guide is unsuitable for the Exim
30432 reference manual, so instead we provide pointers to existing documentation.
30434 The Apache web-server was for a long time the canonical guide, so their
30435 documentation is a good place to start; their SSL module's Introduction
30436 document is currently at
30438 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_intro.html)
30440 and their FAQ is at
30442 &url(https://httpd.apache.org/docs/current/ssl/ssl_faq.html)
30445 Eric Rescorla's book, &'SSL and TLS'&, published by Addison-Wesley (ISBN
30446 0-201-61598-3) in 2001, contains both introductory and more in-depth
30448 More recently Ivan Ristić's book &'Bulletproof SSL and TLS'&,
30449 published by Feisty Duck (ISBN 978-1907117046) in 2013 is good.
30450 Ivan is the author of the popular TLS testing tools at
30451 &url(https://www.ssllabs.com/).
30454 .subsection "Certificate chains" SECID186
30455 A file named by &%tls_certificate%& may contain more than one
30456 certificate. This is useful in the case where the certificate that is being
30457 sent is validated by an intermediate certificate which the other end does
30458 not have. Multiple certificates must be in the correct order in the file.
30459 First the host's certificate itself, then the first intermediate
30460 certificate to validate the issuer of the host certificate, then the next
30461 intermediate certificate to validate the issuer of the first intermediate
30462 certificate, and so on, until finally (optionally) the root certificate.
30463 The root certificate must already be trusted by the recipient for
30464 validation to succeed, of course, but if it's not preinstalled, sending the
30465 root certificate along with the rest makes it available for the user to
30466 install if the receiving end is a client MUA that can interact with a user.
30468 Note that certificates using MD5 are unlikely to work on today's Internet;
30469 even if your libraries allow loading them for use in Exim when acting as a
30470 server, increasingly clients will not accept such certificates. The error
30471 diagnostics in such a case can be frustratingly vague.
30475 .subsection "Self-signed certificates" SECID187
30476 .cindex "certificate" "self-signed"
30477 You can create a self-signed certificate using the &'req'& command provided
30478 with OpenSSL, like this:
30479 . ==== Do not shorten the duration here without reading and considering
30480 . ==== the text below. Please leave it at 9999 days.
30482 openssl req -x509 -newkey rsa:1024 -keyout file1 -out file2 \
30485 &_file1_& and &_file2_& can be the same file; the key and the certificate are
30486 delimited and so can be identified independently. The &%-days%& option
30487 specifies a period for which the certificate is valid. The &%-nodes%& option is
30488 important: if you do not set it, the key is encrypted with a passphrase
30489 that you are prompted for, and any use that is made of the key causes more
30490 prompting for the passphrase. This is not helpful if you are going to use
30491 this certificate and key in an MTA, where prompting is not possible.
30493 . ==== I expect to still be working 26 years from now. The less technical
30494 . ==== debt I create, in terms of storing up trouble for my later years, the
30495 . ==== happier I will be then. We really have reached the point where we
30496 . ==== should start, at the very least, provoking thought and making folks
30497 . ==== pause before proceeding, instead of leaving all the fixes until two
30498 . ==== years before 2^31 seconds after the 1970 Unix epoch.
30500 NB: we are now past the point where 9999 days takes us past the 32-bit Unix
30501 epoch. If your system uses unsigned time_t (most do) and is 32-bit, then
30502 the above command might produce a date in the past. Think carefully about
30503 the lifetime of the systems you're deploying, and either reduce the duration
30504 of the certificate or reconsider your platform deployment. (At time of
30505 writing, reducing the duration is the most likely choice, but the inexorable
30506 progression of time takes us steadily towards an era where this will not
30507 be a sensible resolution).
30509 A self-signed certificate made in this way is sufficient for testing, and
30510 may be adequate for all your requirements if you are mainly interested in
30511 encrypting transfers, and not in secure identification.
30513 However, many clients require that the certificate presented by the server be a
30514 user (also called &"leaf"& or &"site"&) certificate, and not a self-signed
30515 certificate. In this situation, the self-signed certificate described above
30516 must be installed on the client host as a trusted root &'certification
30517 authority'& (CA), and the certificate used by Exim must be a user certificate
30518 signed with that self-signed certificate.
30520 For information on creating self-signed CA certificates and using them to sign
30521 user certificates, see the &'General implementation overview'& chapter of the
30522 Open-source PKI book, available online at
30523 &url(https://sourceforge.net/projects/ospkibook/).
30526 .subsection "Revoked certificates"
30527 .cindex "TLS" "revoked certificates"
30528 .cindex "revocation list"
30529 .cindex "certificate" "revocation list"
30530 .cindex "OCSP" "stapling"
30531 There are three ways for a certificate to be made unusable
30535 Certificate issuing authorities issue Certificate Revocation Lists (CRLs) when
30536 certificates are revoked. If you have such a list, you can pass it to an Exim
30537 server using the global option called &%tls_crl%& and to an Exim client using
30538 an identically named option for the &(smtp)& transport. In each case, the value
30539 of the option is expanded and must then be the name of a file that contains a
30541 The downside is that clients have to periodically re-download a potentially huge
30542 file from every certificate authority they know of.
30545 The way with most moving parts at query time is Online Certificate
30546 Status Protocol (OCSP), where the client verifies the certificate
30547 against an OCSP server run by the CA. This lets the CA track all
30548 usage of the certs. It requires running software with access to the
30549 private key of the CA, to sign the responses to the OCSP queries. OCSP
30550 is based on HTTP and can be proxied accordingly.
30552 The only widespread OCSP server implementation (known to this writer)
30553 comes as part of OpenSSL and aborts on an invalid request, such as
30554 connecting to the port and then disconnecting. This requires
30555 re-entering the passphrase each time some random client does this.
30558 The third way is OCSP Stapling; in this, the server using a certificate
30559 issued by the CA periodically requests an OCSP proof of validity from
30560 the OCSP server, then serves it up inline as part of the TLS
30561 negotiation. This approach adds no extra round trips, does not let the
30562 CA track users, scales well with number of certs issued by the CA and is
30563 resilient to temporary OCSP server failures, as long as the server
30564 starts retrying to fetch an OCSP proof some time before its current
30565 proof expires. The downside is that it requires server support.
30567 Unless Exim is built with the support disabled,
30568 or with GnuTLS earlier than version 3.3.16 / 3.4.8
30569 support for OCSP stapling is included.
30571 There is a global option called &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30572 The file specified therein is expected to be in DER format, and contain
30573 an OCSP proof. Exim will serve it as part of the TLS handshake. This
30574 option will be re-expanded for SNI, if the &%tls_certificate%& option
30575 contains &`tls_in_sni`&, as per other TLS options.
30577 Exim does not at this time implement any support for fetching a new OCSP
30578 proof. The burden is on the administrator to handle this, outside of
30579 Exim. The file specified should be replaced atomically, so that the
30580 contents are always valid. Exim will expand the &%tls_ocsp_file%& option
30581 on each connection, so a new file will be handled transparently on the
30584 When built with OpenSSL Exim will check for a valid next update timestamp
30585 in the OCSP proof; if not present, or if the proof has expired, it will be
30588 For the client to be able to verify the stapled OCSP the server must
30589 also supply, in its stapled information, any intermediate
30590 certificates for the chain leading to the OCSP proof from the signer
30591 of the server certificate. There may be zero or one such. These
30592 intermediate certificates should be added to the server OCSP stapling
30593 file named by &%tls_ocsp_file%&.
30595 Note that the proof only covers the terminal server certificate,
30596 not any of the chain from CA to it.
30598 There is no current way to staple a proof for a client certificate.
30601 A helper script "ocsp_fetch.pl" for fetching a proof from a CA
30602 OCSP server is supplied. The server URL may be included in the
30603 server certificate, if the CA is helpful.
30605 One failure mode seen was the OCSP Signer cert expiring before the end
30606 of validity of the OCSP proof. The checking done by Exim/OpenSSL
30607 noted this as invalid overall, but the re-fetch script did not.
30612 .ecindex IIDencsmtp1
30613 .ecindex IIDencsmtp2
30616 .section "TLS Resumption" "SECTresumption"
30617 .cindex TLS resumption
30618 TLS Session Resumption for TLS 1.2 and TLS 1.3 connections can be used (defined
30619 in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5077,RFC 5077) for 1.2).
30620 The support for this requires GnuTLS 3.6.3 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 (or later).
30622 Session resumption (this is the "stateless" variant) involves the server sending
30623 a "session ticket" to the client on one connection, which can be stored by the
30624 client and used for a later session. The ticket contains sufficient state for
30625 the server to reconstruct the TLS session, avoiding some expensive crypto
30626 calculation and (on TLS1.2) one full packet roundtrip time.
30629 Operational cost/benefit:
30631 The extra data being transmitted costs a minor amount, and the client has
30632 extra costs in storing and retrieving the data.
30634 In the Exim/Gnutls implementation the extra cost on an initial connection
30635 which is TLS1.2 over a loopback path is about 6ms on 2017-laptop class hardware.
30636 The saved cost on a subsequent connection is about 4ms; three or more
30637 connections become a net win. On longer network paths, two or more
30638 connections will have an average lower startup time thanks to the one
30639 saved packet roundtrip. TLS1.3 will save the crypto cpu costs but not any
30642 .cindex "hints database" tls
30643 Since a new hints DB is used on the TLS client,
30644 the hints DB maintenance should be updated to additionally handle "tls".
30649 The session ticket is encrypted, but is obviously an additional security
30650 vulnarability surface. An attacker able to decrypt it would have access
30651 all connections using the resumed session.
30652 The session ticket encryption key is not committed to storage by the server
30653 and is rotated regularly (OpenSSL: 1hr, and one previous key is used for
30654 overlap; GnuTLS 6hr but does not specify any overlap).
30655 Tickets have limited lifetime (2hr, and new ones issued after 1hr under
30656 OpenSSL. GnuTLS 2hr, appears to not do overlap).
30658 There is a question-mark over the security of the Diffie-Helman parameters
30659 used for session negotiation.
30664 The &%log_selector%& "tls_resumption" appends an asterisk to the tls_cipher "X="
30667 The variables &$tls_in_resumption$& and &$tls_out_resumption$&
30668 have bits 0-4 indicating respectively
30669 support built, client requested ticket, client offered session,
30670 server issued ticket, resume used. A suitable decode list is provided
30671 in the builtin macro _RESUME_DECODE for in &%listextract%& expansions.
30676 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& main option specifies a hostlist for which
30677 exim, operating as a server, will offer resumption to clients.
30678 Current best practice is to not offer the feature to MUA connection.
30679 Commonly this can be done like this:
30681 tls_resumption_hosts = ${if inlist {$received_port}{587:465} {:}{*}}
30683 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30684 is offered and/or accepted.
30686 The &%tls_resumption_hosts%& smtp transport option performs the
30687 equivalent function for operation as a client.
30688 If the peer host matches the list after expansion then resumption
30689 is attempted (if a stored session is available) or the information
30690 stored (if supplied by the peer).
30696 In a resumed session:
30698 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_cipher$& will have values different
30699 to the original (under GnuTLS).
30701 The variables &$tls_{in,out}_ocsp$& will be "not requested" or "no response",
30702 and the &%hosts_require_ocsp%& smtp trasnport option will fail.
30703 . XXX need to do something with that hosts_require_ocsp
30709 .section DANE "SECDANE"
30711 DNS-based Authentication of Named Entities, as applied to SMTP over TLS, provides assurance to a client that
30712 it is actually talking to the server it wants to rather than some attacker operating a Man In The Middle (MITM)
30713 operation. The latter can terminate the TLS connection you make, and make another one to the server (so both
30714 you and the server still think you have an encrypted connection) and, if one of the "well known" set of
30715 Certificate Authorities has been suborned - something which *has* been seen already (2014), a verifiable
30716 certificate (if you're using normal root CAs, eg. the Mozilla set, as your trust anchors).
30718 What DANE does is replace the CAs with the DNS as the trust anchor. The assurance is limited to a) the possibility
30719 that the DNS has been suborned, b) mistakes made by the admins of the target server. The attack surface presented
30720 by (a) is thought to be smaller than that of the set of root CAs.
30722 It also allows the server to declare (implicitly) that connections to it should use TLS. An MITM could simply
30723 fail to pass on a server's STARTTLS.
30725 DANE scales better than having to maintain (and communicate via side-channel) copies of server certificates
30726 for every possible target server. It also scales (slightly) better than having to maintain on an SMTP
30727 client a copy of the standard CAs bundle. It also means not having to pay a CA for certificates.
30729 DANE requires a server operator to do three things:
30731 Run DNSSEC. This provides assurance to clients
30732 that DNS lookups they do for the server have not been tampered with. The domain MX record applying
30733 to this server, its A record, its TLSA record and any associated CNAME records must all be covered by
30736 Add TLSA DNS records. These say what the server certificate for a TLS connection should be.
30738 Offer a server certificate, or certificate chain, in TLS connections which is anchored by one of the TLSA records.
30741 There are no changes to Exim specific to server-side operation of DANE.
30742 Support for client-side operation of DANE can be included at compile time by defining SUPPORT_DANE=yes
30743 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
30744 If it has been included, the macro "_HAVE_DANE" will be defined.
30746 .subsection "DNS records"
30747 A TLSA record consist of 4 fields, the "Certificate Usage", the
30748 "Selector", the "Matching type", and the "Certificate Association Data".
30749 For a detailed description of the TLSA record see
30750 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/rfc7671#page-5,RFC 7671).
30752 The TLSA record for the server may have "Certificate Usage" (1st) field of DANE-TA(2) or DANE-EE(3).
30753 These are the "Trust Anchor" and "End Entity" variants.
30754 The latter specifies the End Entity directly, i.e. the certificate involved is that of the server
30755 (and if only DANE-EE is used then it should be the sole one transmitted during the TLS handshake);
30756 this is appropriate for a single system, using a self-signed certificate.
30757 DANE-TA usage is effectively declaring a specific CA to be used; this might be a private CA or a public,
30759 A private CA at simplest is just a self-signed certificate (with certain
30760 attributes) which is used to sign server certificates, but running one securely
30761 does require careful arrangement.
30762 With DANE-TA, as implemented in Exim and commonly in other MTAs,
30763 the server TLS handshake must transmit the entire certificate chain from CA to server-certificate.
30764 DANE-TA is commonly used for several services and/or servers, each having a TLSA query-domain CNAME record,
30765 all of which point to a single TLSA record.
30766 DANE-TA and DANE-EE can both be used together.
30768 Our recommendation is to use DANE with a certificate from a public CA,
30769 because this enables a variety of strategies for remote clients to verify
30771 You can then publish information both via DANE and another technology,
30772 "MTA-STS", described below.
30774 When you use DANE-TA to publish trust anchor information, you ask entities
30775 outside your administrative control to trust the Certificate Authority for
30776 connections to you.
30777 If using a private CA then you should expect others to still apply the
30778 technical criteria they'd use for a public CA to your certificates.
30779 In particular, you should probably try to follow current best practices for CA
30780 operation around hash algorithms and key sizes.
30781 Do not expect other organizations to lower their security expectations just
30782 because a particular profile might be reasonable for your own internal use.
30784 When this text was last updated, this in practice means to avoid use of SHA-1
30785 and MD5; if using RSA to use key sizes of at least 2048 bits (and no larger
30786 than 4096, for interoperability); to use keyUsage fields correctly; to use
30787 random serial numbers.
30788 The list of requirements is subject to change as best practices evolve.
30789 If you're not already using a private CA, or it doesn't meet these
30790 requirements, then we encourage you to avoid all these issues and use a public
30791 CA such as &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt) instead.
30793 The TLSA record should have a "Selector" (2nd) field of SPKI(1) and
30794 a "Matching Type" (3rd) field of SHA2-512(2).
30796 For the "Certificate Authority Data" (4th) field, commands like
30799 openssl x509 -pubkey -noout <certificate.pem \
30800 | openssl rsa -outform der -pubin 2>/dev/null \
30805 are workable to create a hash of the certificate's public key.
30807 An example TLSA record for DANE-EE(3), SPKI(1), and SHA-512 (2) looks like
30810 _25._tcp.mail.example.com. TLSA 3 1 2 8BA8A336E...
30813 At the time of writing, &url(https://www.huque.com/bin/gen_tlsa)
30814 is useful for quickly generating TLSA records.
30817 For use with the DANE-TA model, server certificates must have a correct name (SubjectName or SubjectAltName).
30819 The Certificate issued by the CA published in the DANE-TA model should be
30820 issued using a strong hash algorithm.
30821 Exim, and importantly various other MTAs sending to you, will not
30822 re-enable hash algorithms which have been disabled by default in TLS
30824 This means no MD5 and no SHA-1. SHA2-256 is the minimum for reliable
30825 interoperability (and probably the maximum too, in 2018).
30827 .subsection "Interaction with OCSP"
30828 The use of OCSP-stapling should be considered, allowing for fast revocation of certificates (which would otherwise
30829 be limited by the DNS TTL on the TLSA records). However, this is likely to only be usable with DANE-TA. NOTE: the
30830 default of requesting OCSP for all hosts is modified iff DANE is in use, to:
30833 hosts_request_ocsp = ${if or { {= {0}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} \
30834 {= {4}{$tls_out_tlsa_usage}} } \
30838 The (new) variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& is a bitfield with numbered bits set for TLSA record usage codes.
30839 The zero above means DANE was not in use, the four means that only DANE-TA usage TLSA records were
30840 found. If the definition of &%hosts_request_ocsp%& includes the
30841 string "tls_out_tlsa_usage", they are re-expanded in time to
30842 control the OCSP request.
30844 This modification of hosts_request_ocsp is only done if it has the default value of "*". Admins who change it, and
30845 those who use &%hosts_require_ocsp%&, should consider the interaction with DANE in their OCSP settings.
30848 .subsection "Client configuration"
30849 For client-side DANE there are three new smtp transport options, &%hosts_try_dane%&, &%hosts_require_dane%&
30850 and &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%&.
30851 The &"require"& variant will result in failure if the target host is not
30852 DNSSEC-secured. To get DNSSEC-secured hostname resolution, use
30853 the &%dnssec_request_domains%& router or transport option.
30855 DANE will only be usable if the target host has DNSSEC-secured MX, A and TLSA records.
30857 A TLSA lookup will be done if either of the above options match and the host-lookup succeeded using DNSSEC.
30858 If a TLSA lookup is done and succeeds, a DANE-verified TLS connection
30859 will be required for the host. If it does not, the host will not
30860 be used; there is no fallback to non-DANE or non-TLS.
30862 If DANE is requested and usable, then the TLS cipher list configuration
30863 prefers to use the option &%dane_require_tls_ciphers%& and falls
30864 back to &%tls_require_ciphers%& only if that is unset.
30865 This lets you configure "decent crypto" for DANE and "better than nothing
30866 crypto" as the default. Note though that while GnuTLS lets the string control
30867 which versions of TLS/SSL will be negotiated, OpenSSL does not and you're
30868 limited to ciphersuite constraints.
30870 If DANE is requested and useable (see above) the following transport options are ignored:
30874 tls_try_verify_hosts
30875 tls_verify_certificates
30877 tls_verify_cert_hostnames
30881 If DANE is not usable, whether requested or not, and CA-anchored
30882 verification evaluation is wanted, the above variables should be set appropriately.
30884 The router and transport option &%dnssec_request_domains%& must not be
30885 set to &"never"&, and &%dnssec_require_domains%& is ignored.
30887 .subsection Observability
30888 If verification was successful using DANE then the "CV" item in the delivery log line will show as "CV=dane".
30890 There is a new variable &$tls_out_dane$& which will have "yes" if
30891 verification succeeded using DANE and "no" otherwise (only useful
30892 in combination with events; see &<<CHAPevents>>&),
30893 and a new variable &$tls_out_tlsa_usage$& (detailed above).
30895 .cindex DANE reporting
30896 An event (see &<<CHAPevents>>&) of type "dane:fail" will be raised on failures
30897 to achieve DANE-verified connection, if one was either requested and offered, or
30898 required. This is intended to support TLS-reporting as defined in
30899 &url(https://tools.ietf.org/html/draft-ietf-uta-smtp-tlsrpt-17).
30900 The &$event_data$& will be one of the Result Types defined in
30901 Section 4.3 of that document.
30903 .subsection General
30904 Under GnuTLS, DANE is only supported from version 3.0.0 onwards.
30906 DANE is specified in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6698,RFC 6698).
30907 It decouples certificate authority trust
30908 selection from a "race to the bottom" of "you must trust everything for mail
30910 It does retain the need to trust the assurances provided by the DNSSEC tree.
30912 There is an alternative technology called MTA-STS
30913 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8461,RFC 8461)), which
30914 instead publishes MX trust anchor information on an HTTPS website.
30915 The discovery of the address for that website does not (per standard)
30916 require DNSSEC, and could be regarded as being less secure than DANE
30919 Exim has no support for MTA-STS as a client, but Exim mail server operators
30920 can choose to publish information describing their TLS configuration using
30921 MTA-STS to let those clients who do use that protocol derive trust
30924 The MTA-STS design requires a certificate from a public Certificate Authority
30925 which is recognized by clients sending to you.
30926 That selection of which CAs are trusted by others is outside your control.
30928 The most interoperable course of action is probably to use
30929 &url(https://letsencrypt.org/,Let's Encrypt), with automated certificate
30930 renewal; to publish the anchor information in DNSSEC-secured DNS via TLSA
30931 records for DANE clients (such as Exim and Postfix) and to publish anchor
30932 information for MTA-STS as well. This is what is done for the &'exim.org'&
30933 domain itself (with caveats around occasionally broken MTA-STS because of
30934 incompatible specification changes prior to reaching RFC status).
30938 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30939 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
30941 .chapter "Access control lists" "CHAPACL"
30942 .scindex IIDacl "&ACL;" "description"
30943 .cindex "control of incoming mail"
30944 .cindex "message" "controlling incoming"
30945 .cindex "policy control" "access control lists"
30946 Access Control Lists (ACLs) are defined in a separate section of the runtime
30947 configuration file, headed by &"begin acl"&. Each ACL definition starts with a
30948 name, terminated by a colon. Here is a complete ACL section that contains just
30949 one very small ACL:
30953 accept hosts = one.host.only
30955 You can have as many lists as you like in the ACL section, and the order in
30956 which they appear does not matter. The lists are self-terminating.
30958 The majority of ACLs are used to control Exim's behaviour when it receives
30959 certain SMTP commands. This applies both to incoming TCP/IP connections, and
30960 when a local process submits a message using SMTP by specifying the &%-bs%&
30961 option. The most common use is for controlling which recipients are accepted
30962 in incoming messages. In addition, you can define an ACL that is used to check
30963 local non-SMTP messages. The default configuration file contains an example of
30964 a realistic ACL for checking RCPT commands. This is discussed in chapter
30965 &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
30968 .section "Testing ACLs" "SECID188"
30969 The &%-bh%& command line option provides a way of testing your ACL
30970 configuration locally by running a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
30973 .section "Specifying when ACLs are used" "SECID189"
30974 .cindex "&ACL;" "options for specifying"
30975 In order to cause an ACL to be used, you have to name it in one of the relevant
30976 options in the main part of the configuration. These options are:
30977 .cindex "ATRN" "ACL for"
30978 .cindex "AUTH" "ACL for"
30979 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
30980 .cindex "DKIM" "ACL for"
30981 .cindex "ETRN" "ACL for"
30982 .cindex "EXPN" "ACL for"
30983 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
30984 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
30985 .cindex "MAIL" "ACL for"
30986 .cindex "QUIT" "ACL for"
30987 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
30988 .cindex "RCPT" "ACL for"
30989 .cindex "STARTTLS, ACL for"
30990 .cindex "VRFY" "ACL for"
30991 .cindex "WELLKNOWN" "ACL for"
30992 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
30993 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
30994 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "ACL for"
30997 .irow &%acl_not_smtp%& "ACL for non-SMTP messages"
30998 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& "ACL for non-SMTP MIME parts"
30999 .irow &%acl_not_smtp_start%& "ACL at start of non-SMTP message"
31000 .irow &%acl_smtp_atrn%& "ACL for ATRN"
31001 .irow &%acl_smtp_auth%& "ACL for AUTH"
31002 .irow &%acl_smtp_connect%& "ACL for start of SMTP connection"
31003 .irow &%acl_smtp_data%& "ACL after DATA is complete"
31004 .irow &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& "ACL for each recipient, after DATA is complete"
31005 .irow &%acl_smtp_dkim%& "ACL for each DKIM signer"
31006 .irow &%acl_smtp_etrn%& "ACL for ETRN"
31007 .irow &%acl_smtp_expn%& "ACL for EXPN"
31008 .irow &%acl_smtp_helo%& "ACL for HELO or EHLO"
31009 .irow &%acl_smtp_mail%& "ACL for MAIL"
31010 .irow &%acl_smtp_mailauth%& "ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL"
31011 .irow &%acl_smtp_mime%& "ACL for content-scanning MIME parts"
31012 .irow &%acl_smtp_notquit%& "ACL for non-QUIT terminations"
31013 .irow &%acl_smtp_predata%& "ACL at start of DATA command"
31014 .irow &%acl_smtp_quit%& "ACL for QUIT"
31015 .irow &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& "ACL for RCPT"
31016 .irow &%acl_smtp_starttls%& "ACL for STARTTLS"
31017 .irow &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& "ACL for VRFY"
31018 .irow &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& "ACL for WELLKNOWN"
31021 For example, if you set
31023 acl_smtp_rcpt = small_acl
31025 the little ACL defined above is used whenever Exim receives a RCPT command
31026 in an SMTP dialogue. The majority of policy tests on incoming messages can be
31027 done when RCPT commands arrive. A rejection of RCPT should cause the
31028 sending MTA to give up on the recipient address contained in the RCPT
31029 command, whereas rejection at other times may cause the client MTA to keep on
31030 trying to deliver the message. It is therefore recommended that you do as much
31031 testing as possible at RCPT time.
31034 .subsection "The non-SMTP ACLs" SECnonSMTP
31035 .cindex "non-SMTP messages" "ACLs for"
31036 The non-SMTP ACLs apply to all non-interactive incoming messages, that is, they
31037 apply to batched SMTP as well as to non-SMTP messages. (Batched SMTP is not
31038 really SMTP.) Many of the ACL conditions (for example, host tests, and tests on
31039 the state of the SMTP connection such as encryption and authentication) are not
31040 relevant and are forbidden in these ACLs. However, the sender and recipients
31041 are known, so the &%senders%& and &%sender_domains%& conditions and the
31042 &$sender_address$& and &$recipients$& variables can be used. Variables such as
31043 &$authenticated_sender$& are also available. You can specify added header lines
31044 in any of these ACLs.
31046 The &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACL is run right at the start of receiving a
31047 non-SMTP message, before any of the message has been read. (This is the
31048 analogue of the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL for SMTP input.) In the case of
31049 batched SMTP input, it runs after the DATA command has been reached. The
31050 result of this ACL is ignored; it cannot be used to reject a message. If you
31051 really need to, you could set a value in an ACL variable here and reject based
31052 on that in the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL. However, this ACL can be used to set
31053 controls, and in particular, it can be used to set
31055 control = suppress_local_fixups
31057 This cannot be used in the other non-SMTP ACLs because by the time they are
31058 run, it is too late.
31060 The &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31061 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31063 The &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL is run just before the &[local_scan()]& function. Any
31064 kind of rejection is treated as permanent, because there is no way of sending a
31065 temporary error for these kinds of message.
31068 .subsection "The SMTP connect ACL" SECconnectACL
31069 .cindex "SMTP" "connection, ACL for"
31070 .oindex &%smtp_banner%&
31071 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_connect%& happens at the start of an SMTP
31072 session, after the test specified by &%host_reject_connection%& (which is now
31073 an anomaly) and any TCP Wrappers testing (if configured). If the connection is
31074 accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%& modifier, the contents of
31075 the message override the banner message that is otherwise specified by the
31076 &%smtp_banner%& option.
31078 For tls-on-connect connections, the ACL is run before the TLS connection
31079 is accepted; if the ACL does not accept then the TCP connection is dropped without
31080 any TLS startup attempt and without any SMTP response being transmitted.
31083 .subsection "The EHLO/HELO ACL" SECheloACL
31084 .cindex "EHLO" "ACL for"
31085 .cindex "HELO" "ACL for"
31086 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_helo%& happens when the client issues an
31087 EHLO or HELO command, after the tests specified by &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%&,
31088 &%helo_allow_chars%&, &%helo_verify_hosts%&, and &%helo_try_verify_hosts%&.
31089 Note that a client may issue more than one EHLO or HELO command in an SMTP
31090 session, and indeed is required to issue a new EHLO or HELO after successfully
31091 setting up encryption following a STARTTLS command.
31093 Note also that a deny neither forces the client to go away nor means that
31094 mail will be refused on the connection. Consider checking for
31095 &$sender_helo_name$& being defined in a MAIL or RCPT ACL to do that.
31097 If the command is accepted by an &%accept%& verb that has a &%message%&
31098 modifier, the message may not contain more than one line (it will be truncated
31099 at the first newline and a panic logged if it does). Such a message cannot
31100 affect the EHLO options that are listed on the second and subsequent lines of
31104 .subsection "The DATA ACLs" SECdataACLS
31105 .cindex "DATA" "ACLs for"
31106 Two ACLs are associated with the DATA command, because it is two-stage
31107 command, with two responses being sent to the client.
31108 When the DATA command is received, the ACL defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&
31109 is obeyed. This gives you control after all the RCPT commands, but before
31110 the message itself is received. It offers the opportunity to give a negative
31111 response to the DATA command before the data is transmitted. Header lines
31112 added by MAIL or RCPT ACLs are not visible at this time, but any that
31113 are defined here are visible when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run.
31115 You cannot test the contents of the message, for example, to verify addresses
31116 in the headers, at RCPT time or when the DATA command is received. Such
31117 tests have to appear in the ACL that is run after the message itself has been
31118 received, before the final response to the DATA command is sent. This is
31119 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%&, which is the second ACL that is
31120 associated with the DATA command.
31122 .cindex CHUNKING "BDAT command"
31123 .cindex BDAT "SMTP command"
31124 .cindex "RFC 3030" CHUNKING
31125 If CHUNKING was advertised and a BDAT command sequence is received,
31126 the &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL is not run.
31127 . XXX why not? It should be possible, for the first BDAT.
31128 The &%acl_smtp_data%& is run after the last BDAT command and all of
31129 the data specified is received.
31131 For both of these ACLs, it is not possible to reject individual recipients. An
31132 error response rejects the entire message. Unfortunately, it is known that some
31133 MTAs do not treat hard (5&'xx'&) responses to the DATA command (either
31134 before or after the data) correctly &-- they keep the message on their queues
31135 and try again later, but that is their problem, though it does waste some of
31138 The &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is run after
31139 the &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
31140 the &%acl_smtp_dkim%&
31141 and the &%acl_smtp_mime%& ACLs.
31143 .subsection "The SMTP DKIM ACL" SECTDKIMACL
31144 The &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled with DKIM support
31145 enabled (which is the default).
31147 If, for a specific message, an ACL control
31148 &*dkim_disable_verify*&
31149 has been set, this &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL is not called.
31151 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_dkim%& happens after a message has been
31152 received, and is executed for each DKIM signature found in a message. If not
31153 otherwise specified, the default action is to accept.
31155 This ACL is evaluated before &%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&.
31157 For details on the operation of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
31160 .subsection "The SMTP MIME ACL" SECID194
31161 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& option is available only when Exim is compiled with the
31162 content-scanning extension. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
31164 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
31167 .subsection "The SMTP PRDR ACL" SECTPRDRACL
31168 .cindex "PRDR" "ACL for"
31169 .oindex "&%prdr_enable%&"
31170 The &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
31171 with PRDR support enabled (which is the default).
31172 It becomes active only when the PRDR feature is negotiated between
31173 client and server for a message, and more than one recipient
31176 The ACL test specified by &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%& happens after a message
31177 has been received, and is executed once for each recipient of the message
31178 with &$local_part$& and &$domain$& valid.
31179 The test may accept, defer or deny for individual recipients.
31180 The &%acl_smtp_data%& will still be called after this ACL and
31181 can reject the message overall, even if this ACL has accepted it
31182 for some or all recipients.
31184 PRDR may be used to support per-user content filtering. Without it
31185 one must defer any recipient after the first that has a different
31186 content-filter configuration. With PRDR, the RCPT-time check
31187 .cindex "PRDR" "variable for"
31188 for this can be disabled when the variable &$prdr_requested$&
31190 Any required difference in behaviour of the main DATA-time
31191 ACL should however depend on the PRDR-time ACL having run, as Exim
31192 will avoid doing so in some situations (e.g. single-recipient mails).
31194 See also the &%prdr_enable%& global option
31195 and the &%hosts_try_prdr%& smtp transport option.
31197 This ACL is evaluated after &%acl_smtp_dkim%& but before &%acl_smtp_data%&.
31198 If the ACL is not defined, processing completes as if
31199 the feature was not requested by the client.
31201 .subsection "The SMTP WELLKNOWN ACL" SECTWELLKNOWNACL
31202 .cindex "WELLKNOWN" "ACL for"
31203 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_wellknown%&"
31204 The &%acl_smtp_wellknown%& ACL is available only when Exim is compiled
31205 with WELLKNOWN support enabled.
31207 The ACL determines the response to an SMTP WELLKNOWN command, using the normal
31208 accept/defer/deny verbs for the response code,
31209 and a new &"control=wellknown"& modifier.
31210 This modifier takes a single option, separated by a '/'
31211 character, which must be the name of a file containing the response
31212 cleartext. The modifier is expanded before use in the usual way before
31213 it is used. The configuration is responsible for picking a suitable file
31214 to return and, most importantly, not returning any unexpected file.
31215 The argument for the SMTP verb will be available in the &$smtp_command_argument$&
31216 variable and can be used for building the file path.
31217 If the file path given in the modifier is empty or inacessible, the control will
31223 accept control = wellknown/\
31224 ${lookup {${xtextd:$smtp_command_argument}} \
31225 dsearch,key=path,filter=file,ret=full \
31226 {$spooldir/wellknown.d}}
31228 File content will be encoded in &"xtext"& form, and line-wrapping
31229 for line-length limitation will be done before transmission.
31230 A response summary line will be prepended, with the (pre-encoding) file size.
31232 The above example uses the expansion operator ${xtextd:<coded-string>}
31233 which is needed to decode the xtext-encoded key from the SMTP verb.
31235 Under the util directory there is a "mailtest" utility which can be used
31236 to test/retrieve WELLKNOWN items. Syntax is
31238 mailtest -h host.example.com -w security.txt
31241 WELLKNOWN is a ESMTP extension providing access to extended
31242 information about the server. It is modelled on the webserver
31243 facilities documented in
31244 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8615,RFC 8615)
31245 and can be used for a security.txt file
31246 and could be used for ACME handshaking
31247 (&url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8555,RFC 8555)).
31249 Exim will advertise WELLKNOWN support in the EHLO response
31250 .oindex &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%&
31251 (conditional on a new option &%wellknown_advertise_hosts%&)
31252 and service WELLKNOWN smtp verbs having a single parameter
31253 giving a key for an item of "site-wide metadata".
31254 The verb and key are separated by whitespace,
31255 and the key is xtext-encoded
31256 (per &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3461,RFC 3461) section 4).
31259 .subsection "The QUIT ACL" SECTQUITACL
31260 .cindex "QUIT, ACL for"
31261 The ACL for the SMTP QUIT command is anomalous, in that the outcome of the ACL
31262 does not affect the response code to QUIT, which is always 221. Thus, the ACL
31263 does not in fact control any access.
31264 For this reason, it may only accept
31265 or warn as its final result.
31267 This ACL can be used for tasks such as custom logging at the end of an SMTP
31268 session. For example, you can use ACL variables in other ACLs to count
31269 messages, recipients, etc., and log the totals at QUIT time using one or
31270 more &%logwrite%& modifiers on a &%warn%& verb.
31272 &*Warning*&: Only the &$acl_c$&&'x'& variables can be used for this, because
31273 the &$acl_m$&&'x'& variables are reset at the end of each incoming message.
31275 You do not need to have a final &%accept%&, but if you do, you can use a
31276 &%message%& modifier to specify custom text that is sent as part of the 221
31279 This ACL is run only for a &"normal"& QUIT. For certain kinds of disastrous
31280 failure (for example, failure to open a log file, or when Exim is bombing out
31281 because it has detected an unrecoverable error), all SMTP commands from the
31282 client are given temporary error responses until QUIT is received or the
31283 connection is closed. In these special cases, the QUIT ACL does not run.
31286 .subsection "The not-QUIT ACL" SECTNOTQUITACL
31287 .vindex &$acl_smtp_notquit$&
31288 The not-QUIT ACL, specified by &%acl_smtp_notquit%&, is run in most cases when
31289 an SMTP session ends without sending QUIT. However, when Exim itself is in bad
31290 trouble, such as being unable to write to its log files, this ACL is not run,
31291 because it might try to do things (such as write to log files) that make the
31292 situation even worse.
31294 Like the QUIT ACL, this ACL is provided to make it possible to do customized
31295 logging or to gather statistics, and its outcome is ignored. The &%delay%&
31296 modifier is forbidden in this ACL, and the only permitted verbs are &%accept%&
31299 .vindex &$smtp_notquit_reason$&
31300 When the not-QUIT ACL is running, the variable &$smtp_notquit_reason$& is set
31301 to a string that indicates the reason for the termination of the SMTP
31302 connection. The possible values are:
31304 .irow &`acl-drop`& "Another ACL issued a &%drop%& command"
31305 .irow &`bad-commands`& "Too many unknown or non-mail commands"
31306 .irow &`command-timeout`& "Timeout while reading SMTP commands"
31307 .irow &`connection-lost`& "The SMTP connection has been lost"
31308 .irow &`data-timeout`& "Timeout while reading message data"
31309 .irow &`local-scan-error`& "The &[local_scan()]& function crashed"
31310 .irow &`local-scan-timeout`& "The &[local_scan()]& function timed out"
31311 .irow &`signal-exit`& "SIGTERM or SIGINT"
31312 .irow &`synchronization-error`& "SMTP synchronization error"
31313 .irow &`tls-failed`& "TLS failed to start"
31315 In most cases when an SMTP connection is closed without having received QUIT,
31316 Exim sends an SMTP response message before actually closing the connection.
31317 With the exception of the &`acl-drop`& case, the default message can be
31318 overridden by the &%message%& modifier in the not-QUIT ACL. In the case of a
31319 &%drop%& verb in another ACL, it is the message from the other ACL that is
31323 .section "Finding an ACL to use" "SECID195"
31324 .cindex "&ACL;" "finding which to use"
31325 The value of an &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& option is expanded before use, so
31326 you can use different ACLs in different circumstances. For example,
31328 acl_smtp_rcpt = ${if ={25}{$interface_port} \
31329 {acl_check_rcpt} {acl_check_rcpt_submit} }
31331 In the default configuration file there are some example settings for
31333 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4409,RFC 4409)
31334 message &"submission"& service on port 587 and an
31335 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8314,RFC 8314)
31336 &"submissions"& service on port 465. You can use a string
31337 expansion like this to choose an ACL for MUAs on these ports which is
31338 more appropriate for this purpose than the default ACL on port 25.
31340 The expanded string does not have to be the name of an ACL in the
31341 configuration file; there are other possibilities. Having expanded the
31342 string, Exim searches for an ACL as follows:
31345 If the string begins with a slash, Exim uses it as a filename, and reads its
31346 contents as an ACL. The lines are processed in the same way as lines in the
31347 Exim configuration file. In particular, continuation lines are supported, blank
31348 lines are ignored, as are lines whose first non-whitespace character is &"#"&.
31349 If the file does not exist or cannot be read, an error occurs (typically
31350 causing a temporary failure of whatever caused the ACL to be run). For example:
31352 acl_smtp_data = /etc/acls/\
31353 ${lookup{$sender_host_address}lsearch\
31354 {/etc/acllist}{$value}{default}}
31356 This looks up an ACL file to use on the basis of the host's IP address, falling
31357 back to a default if the lookup fails. If an ACL is successfully read from a
31358 file, it is retained in memory for the duration of the Exim process, so that it
31359 can be re-used without having to re-read the file.
31361 If the string does not start with a slash, and does not contain any spaces,
31362 Exim searches the ACL section of the configuration for an ACL whose name
31363 matches the string.
31365 If no named ACL is found, or if the string contains spaces, Exim parses
31366 the string as an inline ACL. This can save typing in cases where you just
31367 want to have something like
31369 acl_smtp_vrfy = accept
31371 in order to allow free use of the VRFY command. Such a string may contain
31372 newlines; it is processed in the same way as an ACL that is read from a file.
31378 .section "ACL return codes" "SECID196"
31379 .cindex "&ACL;" "return codes"
31380 Except for the QUIT ACL, which does not affect the SMTP return code (see
31381 section &<<SECTQUITACL>>& above), the result of running an ACL is either
31382 &"accept"& or &"deny"&, or, if some test cannot be completed (for example, if a
31383 database is down), &"defer"&. These results cause 2&'xx'&, 5&'xx'&, and 4&'xx'&
31384 return codes, respectively, to be used in the SMTP dialogue. A fourth return,
31385 &"error"&, occurs when there is an error such as invalid syntax in the ACL.
31386 This also causes a 4&'xx'& return code.
31388 For the non-SMTP ACL, &"defer"& and &"error"& are treated in the same way as
31389 &"deny"&, because there is no mechanism for passing temporary errors to the
31390 submitters of non-SMTP messages.
31393 ACLs that are relevant to message reception may also return &"discard"&. This
31394 has the effect of &"accept"&, but causes either the entire message or an
31395 individual recipient address to be discarded. In other words, it is a
31396 blackholing facility. Use it with care.
31398 If the ACL for MAIL returns &"discard"&, all recipients are discarded, and no
31399 ACL is run for subsequent RCPT commands. The effect of &"discard"& in a
31400 RCPT ACL is to discard just the one recipient address. If there are no
31401 recipients left when the message's data is received, the DATA ACL is not
31402 run. A &"discard"& return from the DATA or the non-SMTP ACL discards all the
31403 remaining recipients. The &"discard"& return is not permitted for the
31404 &%acl_smtp_predata%& ACL.
31406 If the ACL for VRFY returns &"accept"&, a recipient verify (without callout)
31407 is done on the address and the result determines the SMTP response.
31410 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "when all recipients discarded"
31411 The &[local_scan()]& function is always run, even if there are no remaining
31412 recipients; it may create new recipients.
31416 .section "Unset ACL options" "SECID197"
31417 .cindex "&ACL;" "unset options"
31418 The default actions when any of the &%acl_%&&'xxx'& options are unset are not
31419 all the same. &*Note*&: These defaults apply only when the relevant ACL is
31420 not defined at all. For any defined ACL, the default action when control
31421 reaches the end of the ACL statements is &"deny"&.
31423 For &%acl_smtp_quit%& and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& there is no default because
31424 these two are ACLs that are used only for their side effects. They cannot be
31425 used to accept or reject anything.
31427 For &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_smtp_auth%&, &%acl_smtp_connect%&,
31428 &%acl_smtp_data%&, &%acl_smtp_helo%&, &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_mailauth%&,
31429 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, and &%acl_smtp_starttls%&, the action
31430 when the ACL is not defined is &"accept"&.
31433 For the others (&%acl_smtp_atrn%&,
31435 &%acl_smtp_etrn%&, &%acl_smtp_expn%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&,
31436 &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& and &%acl_smtp_wellknown%&),
31437 the action when the ACL
31438 is not defined is &"deny"&. This means that &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& must be
31439 defined in order to receive any messages over an SMTP connection.
31440 For an example, see the ACL in the default configuration file.
31444 .section "Data for message ACLs" "SECID198"
31445 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for message ACL"
31447 .vindex &$local_part$&
31448 .vindex &$sender_address$&
31449 .vindex &$sender_host_address$&
31450 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31451 When a MAIL or RCPT ACL, or either of the DATA ACLs, is running, the variables
31452 that contain information about the host and the message's sender (for example,
31453 &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_address$&) are set, and can be used in ACL
31454 statements. In the case of RCPT (but not MAIL or DATA), &$domain$& and
31455 &$local_part$& are set from the argument address. The entire SMTP command
31456 is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31458 When an ACL for the AUTH parameter of MAIL is running, the variables that
31459 contain information about the host are set, but &$sender_address$& is not yet
31460 set. Section &<<SECTauthparamail>>& contains a discussion of this parameter and
31463 .vindex "&$message_size$&"
31464 The &$message_size$& variable is set to the value of the SIZE parameter on
31465 the MAIL command at MAIL, RCPT and pre-data time, or to -1 if
31466 that parameter is not given. The value is updated to the true message size by
31467 the time the final DATA ACL is run (after the message data has been
31470 .vindex "&$rcpt_count$&"
31471 .vindex "&$recipients_count$&"
31472 The &$rcpt_count$& variable increases by one for each RCPT command received.
31473 The &$recipients_count$& variable increases by one each time a RCPT command is
31474 accepted, so while an ACL for RCPT is being processed, it contains the number
31475 of previously accepted recipients. At DATA time (for both the DATA ACLs),
31476 &$rcpt_count$& contains the total number of RCPT commands, and
31477 &$recipients_count$& contains the total number of accepted recipients.
31483 .section "Data for non-message ACLs" "SECTdatfornon"
31484 .cindex "&ACL;" "data for non-message ACL"
31485 .vindex &$smtp_command_argument$&
31486 .vindex &$smtp_command$&
31487 When an ACL is being run for ATRN, AUTH, EHLO, ETRN, EXPN, HELO, STARTTLS, or VRFY,
31488 the remainder of the SMTP command line is placed in &$smtp_command_argument$&,
31489 and the entire SMTP command is available in &$smtp_command$&.
31490 These variables can be tested using a &%condition%& condition. For example,
31491 here is an ACL for use with AUTH, which insists that either the session is
31492 encrypted, or the CRAM-MD5 authentication method is used. In other words, it
31493 does not permit authentication methods that use cleartext passwords on
31494 unencrypted connections.
31497 accept encrypted = *
31498 accept condition = ${if eq{${uc:$smtp_command_argument}}\
31500 deny message = TLS encryption or CRAM-MD5 required
31502 (Another way of applying this restriction is to arrange for the authenticators
31503 that use cleartext passwords not to be advertised when the connection is not
31504 encrypted. You can use the generic &%server_advertise_condition%& authenticator
31505 option to do this.)
31509 .section "Format of an ACL" "SECID199"
31510 .cindex "&ACL;" "format of"
31511 .cindex "&ACL;" "verbs, definition of"
31512 An individual ACL definition consists of a number of statements.
31513 Each statement starts
31514 with a verb, optionally followed by a number of conditions and &"modifiers"&.
31515 Modifiers can change the way the verb operates, define error and log messages,
31516 set variables, insert delays, and vary the processing of accepted messages.
31518 If all the conditions are met, the verb is obeyed. The same condition may be
31519 used (with different arguments) more than once in the same statement. This
31520 provides a means of specifying an &"and"& conjunction between conditions. For
31523 deny dnslists = list1.example
31524 dnslists = list2.example
31526 If there are no conditions, the verb is always obeyed. Exim stops evaluating
31527 the conditions and modifiers when it reaches a condition that fails. What
31528 happens then depends on the verb (and in one case, on a special modifier). Not
31529 all the conditions make sense at every testing point. For example, you cannot
31530 test a sender address in the ACL that is run for a VRFY command.
31532 The definition of an ACL ends where another starts,
31533 or a different configuration section starts.
31536 .section "ACL verbs" "SECID200"
31537 The ACL verbs are as follows:
31540 .cindex "&%accept%& ACL verb"
31541 &%accept%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"accept"&. If any
31542 of the conditions are not met, what happens depends on whether &%endpass%&
31543 appears among the conditions (for syntax see below). If the failing condition
31544 is before &%endpass%&, control is passed to the next ACL statement; if it is
31545 after &%endpass%&, the ACL returns &"deny"&. Consider this statement, used to
31546 check a RCPT command:
31548 accept domains = +local_domains
31552 If the recipient domain does not match the &%domains%& condition, control
31553 passes to the next statement. If it does match, the recipient is verified, and
31554 the command is accepted if verification succeeds. However, if verification
31555 fails, the ACL yields &"deny"&, because the failing condition is after
31558 The &%endpass%& feature has turned out to be confusing to many people, so its
31559 use is not recommended nowadays. It is always possible to rewrite an ACL so
31560 that &%endpass%& is not needed, and it is no longer used in the default
31563 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier" "with &%accept%&"
31564 If a &%message%& modifier appears on an &%accept%& statement, its action
31565 depends on whether or not &%endpass%& is present. In the absence of &%endpass%&
31566 (when an &%accept%& verb either accepts or passes control to the next
31567 statement), &%message%& can be used to vary the message that is sent when an
31568 SMTP command is accepted. For example, in a RCPT ACL you could have:
31570 &`accept `&<&'some conditions'&>
31571 &` message = OK, I will allow you through today`&
31573 You can specify an SMTP response code, optionally followed by an &"extended
31574 response code"& at the start of the message, but the first digit must be the
31575 same as would be sent by default, which is 2 for an &%accept%& verb.
31577 If &%endpass%& is present in an &%accept%& statement, &%message%& specifies
31578 an error message that is used when access is denied. This behaviour is retained
31579 for backward compatibility, but current &"best practice"& is to avoid the use
31584 .cindex "&%defer%& ACL verb"
31585 &%defer%&: If all the conditions are true, the ACL returns &"defer"& which, in
31586 an SMTP session, causes a 4&'xx'& response to be given. For a non-SMTP ACL,
31587 &%defer%& is the same as &%deny%&, because there is no way of sending a
31588 temporary error. For a RCPT command, &%defer%& is much the same as using a
31589 &(redirect)& router and &`:defer:`& while verifying, but the &%defer%& verb can
31590 be used in any ACL, and even for a recipient it might be a simpler approach.
31594 .cindex "&%deny%& ACL verb"
31595 &%deny%&: If all the conditions are met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. If any of
31596 the conditions are not met, control is passed to the next ACL statement. For
31599 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
31601 rejects commands from hosts that are on a DNS black list.
31605 .cindex "&%discard%& ACL verb"
31606 &%discard%&: This verb behaves like &%accept%&, except that it returns
31607 &"discard"& from the ACL instead of &"accept"&. It is permitted only on ACLs
31608 that are concerned with receiving messages. When all the conditions are true,
31609 the sending entity receives a &"success"& response. However, &%discard%& causes
31610 recipients to be discarded. If it is used in an ACL for RCPT, just the one
31611 recipient is discarded; if used for MAIL, DATA or in the non-SMTP ACL, all the
31612 message's recipients are discarded. Recipients that are discarded before DATA
31613 do not appear in the log line when the &%received_recipients%& log selector is set.
31615 If the &%log_message%& modifier is set when &%discard%& operates,
31616 its contents are added to the line that is automatically written to the log.
31617 The &%message%& modifier operates exactly as it does for &%accept%&.
31621 .cindex "&%drop%& ACL verb"
31622 &%drop%&: This verb behaves like &%deny%&, except that an SMTP connection is
31623 forcibly closed after the 5&'xx'& error message has been sent. For example:
31625 drop condition = ${if > {$rcpt_count}{20}}
31626 message = I don't take more than 20 RCPTs
31628 There is no difference between &%deny%& and &%drop%& for the connect-time ACL.
31629 The connection is always dropped after sending a 550 response.
31632 .cindex "&%require%& ACL verb"
31633 &%require%&: If all the conditions are met, control is passed to the next ACL
31634 statement. If any of the conditions are not met, the ACL returns &"deny"&. For
31635 example, when checking a RCPT command,
31637 require message = Sender did not verify
31640 passes control to subsequent statements only if the message's sender can be
31641 verified. Otherwise, it rejects the command. Note the positioning of the
31642 &%message%& modifier, before the &%verify%& condition. The reason for this is
31643 discussed in section &<<SECTcondmodproc>>&.
31646 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
31647 &%warn%&: If all the conditions are true, a line specified by the
31648 &%log_message%& modifier is written to Exim's main log. Control always passes
31649 to the next ACL statement. If any condition is false, the log line is not
31650 written. If an identical log line is requested several times in the same
31651 message, only one copy is actually written to the log. If you want to force
31652 duplicates to be written, use the &%logwrite%& modifier instead.
31654 If &%log_message%& is not present, a &%warn%& verb just checks its conditions
31655 and obeys any &"immediate"& modifiers (such as &%control%&, &%set%&,
31656 &%logwrite%&, &%add_header%&, and &%remove_header%&) that appear before the
31657 first failing condition. There is more about adding header lines in section
31658 &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31660 If any condition on a &%warn%& statement cannot be completed (that is, there is
31661 some sort of defer), the log line specified by &%log_message%& is not written.
31662 This does not include the case of a forced failure from a lookup, which
31663 is considered to be a successful completion. After a defer, no further
31664 conditions or modifiers in the &%warn%& statement are processed. The incident
31665 is logged, and the ACL continues to be processed, from the next statement
31669 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31670 When one of the &%warn%& conditions is an address verification that fails, the
31671 text of the verification failure message is in &$acl_verify_message$&. If you
31672 want this logged, you must set it up explicitly. For example:
31674 warn !verify = sender
31675 log_message = sender verify failed: $acl_verify_message
31679 At the end of each ACL there is an implicit unconditional &%deny%&.
31681 As you can see from the examples above, the conditions and modifiers are
31682 written one to a line, with the first one on the same line as the verb, and
31683 subsequent ones on following lines. If you have a very long condition, you can
31684 continue it onto several physical lines by the usual backslash continuation
31685 mechanism. It is conventional to align the conditions vertically.
31689 .section "ACL variables" "SECTaclvariables"
31690 .cindex "&ACL;" "variables"
31691 There are some special variables that can be set during ACL processing. They
31692 can be used to pass information between different ACLs, different invocations
31693 of the same ACL in the same SMTP connection, and between ACLs and the routers,
31694 transports, and filters that are used to deliver a message. The names of these
31695 variables must begin with &$acl_c$& or &$acl_m$&, followed either by a digit or
31696 an underscore, but the remainder of the name can be any sequence of
31697 alphanumeric characters and underscores that you choose. There is no limit on
31698 the number of ACL variables. The two sets act as follows:
31700 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_c$& persist
31701 throughout an SMTP connection. They are never reset. Thus, a value that is set
31702 while receiving one message is still available when receiving the next message
31703 on the same SMTP connection.
31705 The values of those variables whose names begin with &$acl_m$& persist only
31706 while a message is being received. They are reset afterwards. They are also
31707 reset by MAIL, RSET, EHLO, HELO, and after starting up a TLS session.
31710 When a message is accepted, the current values of all the ACL variables are
31711 preserved with the message and are subsequently made available at delivery
31712 time. The ACL variables are set by a modifier called &%set%&. For example:
31714 accept hosts = whatever
31715 set acl_m4 = some value
31716 accept authenticated = *
31717 set acl_c_auth = yes
31719 &*Note*&: A leading dollar sign is not used when naming a variable that is to
31720 be set. If you want to set a variable without taking any action, you can use a
31721 &%warn%& verb without any other modifiers or conditions.
31723 .oindex &%strict_acl_vars%&
31724 What happens if a syntactically valid but undefined ACL variable is
31725 referenced depends on the setting of the &%strict_acl_vars%& option. If it is
31726 false (the default), an empty string is substituted; if it is true, an
31727 error is generated.
31729 Versions of Exim before 4.64 have a limited set of numbered variables, but
31730 their names are compatible, so there is no problem with upgrading.
31733 .section "Condition and modifier processing" "SECTcondmodproc"
31734 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; processing"
31735 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; processing"
31736 An exclamation mark preceding a condition negates its result. For example:
31738 deny domains = *.dom.example
31739 !verify = recipient
31741 causes the ACL to return &"deny"& if the recipient domain ends in
31742 &'dom.example'& and the recipient address cannot be verified. Sometimes
31743 negation can be used on the right-hand side of a condition. For example, these
31744 two statements are equivalent:
31746 deny hosts = !192.168.3.4
31747 deny !hosts = 192.168.3.4
31749 However, for many conditions (&%verify%& being a good example), only left-hand
31750 side negation of the whole condition is possible.
31752 The arguments of conditions and modifiers are expanded. A forced failure
31753 of an expansion causes a condition to be ignored, that is, it behaves as if the
31754 condition is true. Consider these two statements:
31756 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31757 {/some/file}{$value}fail}
31758 accept senders = ${lookup{$host_name}lsearch\
31759 {/some/file}{$value}{}}
31761 Each attempts to look up a list of acceptable senders. If the lookup succeeds,
31762 the returned list is searched, but if the lookup fails the behaviour is
31763 different in the two cases. The &%fail%& in the first statement causes the
31764 condition to be ignored, leaving no further conditions. The &%accept%& verb
31765 therefore succeeds. The second statement, however, generates an empty list when
31766 the lookup fails. No sender can match an empty list, so the condition fails,
31767 and therefore the &%accept%& also fails.
31769 ACL modifiers appear mixed in with conditions in ACL statements. Some of them
31770 specify actions that are taken as the conditions for a statement are checked;
31771 others specify text for messages that are used when access is denied or a
31772 warning is generated. The &%control%& modifier affects the way an incoming
31773 message is handled.
31775 The positioning of the modifiers in an ACL statement is important, because the
31776 processing of a verb ceases as soon as its outcome is known. Only those
31777 modifiers that have already been encountered will take effect. For example,
31778 consider this use of the &%message%& modifier:
31780 require message = Can't verify sender
31782 message = Can't verify recipient
31784 message = This message cannot be used
31786 If sender verification fails, Exim knows that the result of the statement is
31787 &"deny"&, so it goes no further. The first &%message%& modifier has been seen,
31788 so its text is used as the error message. If sender verification succeeds, but
31789 recipient verification fails, the second message is used. If recipient
31790 verification succeeds, the third message becomes &"current"&, but is never used
31791 because there are no more conditions to cause failure.
31793 For the &%deny%& verb, on the other hand, it is always the last &%message%&
31794 modifier that is used, because all the conditions must be true for rejection to
31795 happen. Specifying more than one &%message%& modifier does not make sense, and
31796 the message can even be specified after all the conditions. For example:
31799 !senders = *@my.domain.example
31800 message = Invalid sender from client host
31802 The &"deny"& result does not happen until the end of the statement is reached,
31803 by which time Exim has set up the message.
31807 .section "ACL modifiers" "SECTACLmodi"
31808 .cindex "&ACL;" "modifiers; list of"
31809 The ACL modifiers are as follows:
31812 .vitem &*add_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31813 This modifier specifies one or more header lines that are to be added to an
31814 incoming message, assuming, of course, that the message is ultimately
31815 accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&.
31817 .vitem &*continue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31818 .cindex "&%continue%& ACL modifier"
31819 .cindex "database" "updating in ACL"
31820 This modifier does nothing of itself, and processing of the ACL always
31821 continues with the next condition or modifier. The value of &%continue%& is in
31822 the side effects of expanding its argument. Typically this could be used to
31823 update a database. It is really just a syntactic tidiness, to avoid having to
31824 write rather ugly lines like this:
31826 &`condition = ${if eq{0}{`&<&'some expansion'&>&`}{true}{true}}`&
31828 Instead, all you need is
31830 &`continue = `&<&'some expansion'&>
31833 .vitem &*control*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31834 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
31835 This modifier affects the subsequent processing of the SMTP connection or of an
31836 incoming message that is accepted. The effect of the first type of control
31837 lasts for the duration of the connection, whereas the effect of the second type
31838 lasts only until the current message has been received. The message-specific
31839 controls always apply to the whole message, not to individual recipients,
31840 even if the &%control%& modifier appears in a RCPT ACL.
31842 As there are now quite a few controls that can be applied, they are described
31843 separately in section &<<SECTcontrols>>&. The &%control%& modifier can be used
31844 in several different ways. For example:
31846 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
31847 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left. That comment applies only
31848 . ==== when xmlto and fop are used; formatting with sdop gets it right either
31852 It can be at the end of an &%accept%& statement:
31854 accept ...some conditions
31857 In this case, the control is applied when this statement yields &"accept"&, in
31858 other words, when the conditions are all true.
31861 It can be in the middle of an &%accept%& statement:
31863 accept ...some conditions...
31865 ...some more conditions...
31867 If the first set of conditions are true, the control is applied, even if the
31868 statement does not accept because one of the second set of conditions is false.
31869 In this case, some subsequent statement must yield &"accept"& for the control
31873 It can be used with &%warn%& to apply the control, leaving the
31874 decision about accepting or denying to a subsequent verb. For
31877 warn ...some conditions...
31881 This example of &%warn%& does not contain &%message%&, &%log_message%&, or
31882 &%logwrite%&, so it does not add anything to the message and does not write a
31886 If you want to apply a control unconditionally, you can use it with a
31887 &%require%& verb. For example:
31889 require control = no_multiline_responses
31893 .vitem &*delay*&&~=&~<&'time'&>
31894 .cindex "&%delay%& ACL modifier"
31896 This modifier may appear in any ACL except notquit. It causes Exim to wait for
31897 the time interval before proceeding. However, when testing Exim using the
31898 &%-bh%& option, the delay is not actually imposed (an appropriate message is
31899 output instead). The time is given in the usual Exim notation, and the delay
31900 happens as soon as the modifier is processed. In an SMTP session, pending
31901 output is flushed before the delay is imposed.
31903 Like &%control%&, &%delay%& can be used with &%accept%& or &%deny%&, for
31906 deny ...some conditions...
31909 The delay happens if all the conditions are true, before the statement returns
31910 &"deny"&. Compare this with:
31913 ...some conditions...
31915 which waits for 30s before processing the conditions. The &%delay%& modifier
31916 can also be used with &%warn%& and together with &%control%&:
31918 warn ...some conditions...
31924 If &%delay%& is encountered when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use,
31925 responses to several commands are no longer buffered and sent in one packet (as
31926 they would normally be) because all output is flushed before imposing the
31927 delay. This optimization is disabled so that a number of small delays do not
31928 appear to the client as one large aggregated delay that might provoke an
31929 unwanted timeout. You can, however, disable output flushing for &%delay%& by
31930 using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_delay_flush%&.
31934 .cindex "&%endpass%& ACL modifier"
31935 This modifier, which has no argument, is recognized only in &%accept%& and
31936 &%discard%& statements. It marks the boundary between the conditions whose
31937 failure causes control to pass to the next statement, and the conditions whose
31938 failure causes the ACL to return &"deny"&. This concept has proved to be
31939 confusing to some people, so the use of &%endpass%& is no longer recommended as
31940 &"best practice"&. See the description of &%accept%& above for more details.
31943 .vitem &*log_message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
31944 .cindex "&%log_message%& ACL modifier"
31945 This modifier sets up a message that is used as part of the log message if the
31946 ACL denies access or a &%warn%& statement's conditions are true. For example:
31948 require log_message = wrong cipher suite $tls_in_cipher
31949 encrypted = DES-CBC3-SHA
31951 &%log_message%& is also used when recipients are discarded by &%discard%&. For
31954 &`discard `&<&'some conditions'&>
31955 &` log_message = Discarded $local_part@$domain because...`&
31957 When access is denied, &%log_message%& adds to any underlying error message
31958 that may exist because of a condition failure. For example, while verifying a
31959 recipient address, a &':fail:'& redirection might have already set up a
31962 The message may be defined before the conditions to which it applies, because
31963 the string expansion does not happen until Exim decides that access is to be
31964 denied. This means that any variables that are set by the condition are
31965 available for inclusion in the message. For example, the &$dnslist_$&<&'xxx'&>
31966 variables are set after a DNS black list lookup succeeds. If the expansion of
31967 &%log_message%& fails, or if the result is an empty string, the modifier is
31970 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
31971 If you want to use a &%warn%& statement to log the result of an address
31972 verification, you can use &$acl_verify_message$& to include the verification
31975 If &%log_message%& is used with a &%warn%& statement, &"Warning:"& is added to
31976 the start of the logged message. If the same warning log message is requested
31977 more than once while receiving a single email message, only one copy is
31978 actually logged. If you want to log multiple copies, use &%logwrite%& instead
31979 of &%log_message%&. In the absence of &%log_message%& and &%logwrite%&, nothing
31980 is logged for a successful &%warn%& statement.
31982 If &%log_message%& is not present and there is no underlying error message (for
31983 example, from the failure of address verification), but &%message%& is present,
31984 the &%message%& text is used for logging rejections. However, if any text for
31985 logging contains newlines, only the first line is logged. In the absence of
31986 both &%log_message%& and &%message%&, a default built-in message is used for
31987 logging rejections.
31990 .vitem "&*log_reject_target*&&~=&~<&'log name list'&>"
31991 .cindex "&%log_reject_target%& ACL modifier"
31992 .cindex "logging in ACL" "specifying which log"
31993 This modifier makes it possible to specify which logs are used for messages
31994 about ACL rejections. Its argument is a colon-separated list of words that can
31995 be &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"&. The default is &`main:reject`&. The list
31996 may be empty, in which case a rejection is not logged at all. For example, this
31997 ACL fragment writes no logging information when access is denied:
31999 &`deny `&<&'some conditions'&>
32000 &` log_reject_target =`&
32002 This modifier can be used in SMTP and non-SMTP ACLs. It applies to both
32003 permanent and temporary rejections. Its effect lasts for the rest of the
32007 .vitem &*logwrite*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
32008 .cindex "&%logwrite%& ACL modifier"
32009 .cindex "logging in ACL" "immediate"
32010 This modifier writes a message to a log file as soon as it is encountered when
32011 processing an ACL. (Compare &%log_message%&, which, except in the case of
32012 &%warn%& and &%discard%&, is used only if the ACL statement denies
32013 access.) The &%logwrite%& modifier can be used to log special incidents in
32016 &`accept `&<&'some special conditions'&>
32017 &` control = freeze`&
32018 &` logwrite = froze message because ...`&
32020 By default, the message is written to the main log. However, it may begin
32021 with a colon, followed by a comma-separated list of log names, and then
32022 another colon, to specify exactly which logs are to be written. For
32025 logwrite = :main,reject: text for main and reject logs
32026 logwrite = :panic: text for panic log only
32030 .vitem &*message*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
32031 .cindex "&%message%& ACL modifier"
32032 This modifier sets up a text string that is expanded and used as a response
32033 message when an ACL statement terminates the ACL with an &"accept"&, &"deny"&,
32034 or &"defer"& response. (In the case of the &%accept%& and &%discard%& verbs,
32035 there is some complication if &%endpass%& is involved; see the description of
32036 &%accept%& for details.)
32038 The expansion of the message happens at the time Exim decides that the ACL is
32039 to end, not at the time it processes &%message%&. If the expansion fails, or
32040 generates an empty string, the modifier is ignored. Here is an example where
32041 &%message%& must be specified first, because the ACL ends with a rejection if
32042 the &%hosts%& condition fails:
32044 require message = Host not recognized
32047 (Once a condition has failed, no further conditions or modifiers are
32050 .cindex "SMTP" "error codes"
32051 .oindex "&%smtp_banner%&
32052 For ACLs that are triggered by SMTP commands, the message is returned as part
32053 of the SMTP response. The use of &%message%& with &%accept%& (or &%discard%&)
32054 is meaningful only for SMTP, as no message is returned when a non-SMTP message
32055 is accepted. In the case of the connect ACL, accepting with a message modifier
32056 overrides the value of &%smtp_banner%&. For the EHLO/HELO ACL, a customized
32057 accept message may not contain more than one line (otherwise it will be
32058 truncated at the first newline and a panic logged), and it cannot affect the
32061 When SMTP is involved, the message may begin with an overriding response code,
32062 consisting of three digits optionally followed by an &"extended response code"&
32063 of the form &'n.n.n'&, each code being followed by a space. For example:
32065 deny message = 599 1.2.3 Host not welcome
32066 hosts = 192.168.34.0/24
32068 The first digit of the supplied response code must be the same as would be sent
32069 by default. A panic occurs if it is not. Exim uses a 550 code when it denies
32070 access, but for the predata ACL, note that the default success code is 354, not
32073 Notwithstanding the previous paragraph, for the QUIT ACL, unlike the others,
32074 the message modifier cannot override the 221 response code.
32076 The text in a &%message%& modifier is literal; any quotes are taken as
32077 literals, but because the string is expanded, backslash escapes are processed
32079 If the message contains newlines, this gives rise to a multi-line SMTP
32081 A long message line will also be split into multi-line SMTP responses,
32082 on word boundaries if possible.
32084 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
32085 While the text is being expanded, the &$acl_verify_message$& variable
32086 contains any message previously set.
32087 Afterwards, &$acl_verify_message$& is cleared.
32089 If &%message%& is used on a statement that verifies an address, the message
32090 specified overrides any message that is generated by the verification process.
32091 However, the original message is available in the variable
32092 &$acl_verify_message$&, so you can incorporate it into your message if you
32093 wish. In particular, if you want the text from &%:fail:%& items in &(redirect)&
32094 routers to be passed back as part of the SMTP response, you should either not
32095 use a &%message%& modifier, or make use of &$acl_verify_message$&.
32097 For compatibility with previous releases of Exim, a &%message%& modifier that
32098 is used with a &%warn%& verb behaves in a similar way to the &%add_header%&
32099 modifier, but this usage is now deprecated. However, &%message%& acts only when
32100 all the conditions are true, wherever it appears in an ACL command, whereas
32101 &%add_header%& acts as soon as it is encountered. If &%message%& is used with
32102 &%warn%& in an ACL that is not concerned with receiving a message, it has no
32106 .vitem &*queue*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
32107 .cindex "&%queue%& ACL modifier"
32108 .cindex "named queues" "selecting in ACL"
32109 This modifier specifies the use of a named queue for spool files
32111 It can only be used before the message is received (i.e. not in
32113 This could be used, for example, for known high-volume burst sources
32114 of traffic, or for quarantine of messages.
32115 Separate queue-runner processes will be needed for named queues.
32116 If the text after expansion is empty, the default queue is used.
32119 .vitem &*remove_header*&&~=&~<&'text'&>
32120 This modifier specifies one or more header names in a colon-separated list
32121 that are to be removed from an incoming message, assuming, of course, that
32122 the message is ultimately accepted. For details, see section &<<SECTremoveheadacl>>&.
32125 .vitem &*set*&&~<&'acl_name'&>&~=&~<&'value'&>
32126 .cindex "&%set%& ACL modifier"
32127 This modifier puts a value into one of the ACL variables (see section
32128 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&).
32131 .vitem &*udpsend*&&~=&~<&'parameters'&>
32132 .cindex "UDP communications"
32133 This modifier sends a UDP packet, for purposes such as statistics
32134 collection or behaviour monitoring. The parameters are expanded, and
32135 the result of the expansion must be a colon-separated list consisting
32136 of a destination server, port number, and the packet contents. The
32137 server can be specified as a host name or IPv4 or IPv6 address. The
32138 separator can be changed with the usual angle bracket syntax. For
32139 example, you might want to collect information on which hosts connect
32142 udpsend = <; 2001:dB8::dead:beef ; 1234 ;\
32143 $tod_zulu $sender_host_address
32150 .section "Use of the control modifier" "SECTcontrols"
32151 .cindex "&%control%& ACL modifier"
32152 The &%control%& modifier supports the following settings:
32155 .vitem &*control&~=&~allow_auth_unadvertised*&
32156 This modifier allows a client host to use the SMTP AUTH command even when it
32157 has not been advertised in response to EHLO. Furthermore, because there are
32158 apparently some really broken clients that do this, Exim will accept AUTH after
32159 HELO (rather than EHLO) when this control is set. It should be used only if you
32160 really need it, and you should limit its use to those broken clients that do
32161 not work without it. For example:
32163 warn hosts = 192.168.34.25
32164 control = allow_auth_unadvertised
32166 Normally, when an Exim server receives an AUTH command, it checks the name of
32167 the authentication mechanism that is given in the command to ensure that it
32168 matches an advertised mechanism. When this control is set, the check that a
32169 mechanism has been advertised is bypassed. Any configured mechanism can be used
32170 by the client. This control is permitted only in the connection and HELO ACLs.
32173 .vitem &*control&~=&~caseful_local_part*& &&&
32174 &*control&~=&~caselower_local_part*&
32175 .cindex "&ACL;" "case of local part in"
32176 .cindex "case of local parts"
32177 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
32178 These two controls are permitted only in the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&
32179 (that is, during RCPT processing). By default, the contents of &$local_part$&
32180 are lower cased before ACL processing. If &"caseful_local_part"& is specified,
32181 any uppercase letters in the original local part are restored in &$local_part$&
32182 for the rest of the ACL, or until a control that sets &"caselower_local_part"&
32185 These controls affect only the current recipient. Moreover, they apply only to
32186 local part handling that takes place directly in the ACL (for example, as a key
32187 in lookups). If a test to verify the recipient is obeyed, the case-related
32188 handling of the local part during the verification is controlled by the router
32189 configuration (see the &%caseful_local_part%& generic router option).
32191 This facility could be used, for example, to add a spam score to local parts
32192 containing upper case letters. For example, using &$acl_m4$& to accumulate the
32195 warn control = caseful_local_part
32196 set acl_m4 = ${eval:\
32198 ${if match{$local_part}{[A-Z]}{1}{0}}\
32200 control = caselower_local_part
32202 Notice that we put back the lower cased version afterwards, assuming that
32203 is what is wanted for subsequent tests.
32206 .vitem &*control&~=&~cutthrough_delivery/*&<&'options'&>
32207 .cindex "&ACL;" "cutthrough routing"
32208 .cindex "cutthrough" "requesting"
32209 This option requests delivery be attempted while the item is being received.
32211 The option is usable in the RCPT ACL.
32212 If enabled for a message received via smtp and routed to an smtp transport,
32213 and only one transport, interface, destination host and port combination
32214 is used for all recipients of the message,
32215 then the delivery connection is made while the receiving connection is open
32216 and data is copied from one to the other.
32218 An attempt to set this option for any recipient but the first
32219 for a mail will be quietly ignored.
32220 If a recipient-verify callout
32222 connection is subsequently
32223 requested in the same ACL it is held open and used for
32224 any subsequent recipients and the data,
32225 otherwise one is made after the initial RCPT ACL completes.
32227 Note that routers are used in verify mode,
32228 and cannot depend on content of received headers.
32229 Note also that headers cannot be
32230 modified by any of the post-data ACLs (DATA, MIME and DKIM).
32231 Headers may be modified by routers (subject to the above) and transports.
32232 The &'Received-By:'& header is generated as soon as the body reception starts,
32233 rather than the traditional time after the full message is received;
32234 this will affect the timestamp.
32236 All the usual ACLs are called; if one results in the message being
32237 rejected, all effort spent in delivery (including the costs on
32238 the ultimate destination) will be wasted.
32239 Note that in the case of data-time ACLs this includes the entire
32242 Cutthrough delivery is not supported via transport-filters or when DKIM signing
32243 of outgoing messages is done, because it sends data to the ultimate destination
32244 before the entire message has been received from the source.
32245 It is not supported for messages received with the SMTP PRDR
32249 Should the ultimate destination system positively accept or reject the mail,
32250 a corresponding indication is given to the source system and nothing is queued.
32251 If the item is successfully delivered in cutthrough mode
32252 the delivery log lines are tagged with ">>" rather than "=>" and appear
32253 before the acceptance "<=" line.
32255 If there is a temporary error the item is queued for later delivery in the
32257 This behaviour can be adjusted by appending the option &*defer=*&<&'value'&>
32258 to the control; the default value is &"spool"& and the alternate value
32259 &"pass"& copies an SMTP defer response from the target back to the initiator
32260 and does not queue the message.
32261 Note that this is independent of any recipient verify conditions in the ACL.
32263 Delivery in this mode avoids the generation of a bounce mail to a
32265 sender when the destination system is doing content-scan based rejection.
32268 .vitem &*control&~=&~debug/*&<&'options'&>
32269 .cindex "&ACL;" "enabling debug logging"
32270 .cindex "debugging" "enabling from an ACL"
32271 This control turns on debug logging, almost as though Exim had been invoked
32272 with &`-d`&, with the output going to a new logfile in the usual logs directory,
32273 by default called &'debuglog'&.
32275 Logging set up by the control will be maintained across spool residency.
32277 Options are a slash-separated list.
32278 If an option takes an argument, the option name and argument are separated by
32279 an equals character.
32280 Several options are supported:
32282 tag=<&'suffix'&> The filename can be adjusted with thise option.
32283 The argument, which may access any variables already defined,
32284 is appended to the default name.
32286 opts=<&'debug&~options'&> The argument specififes what is to be logged,
32287 using the same values as the &`-d`& command-line option.
32289 stop Logging started with this control may be
32290 stopped by using this option.
32292 kill Logging started with this control may be
32293 stopped by using this option.
32294 Additionally the debug file will be removed,
32295 providing one means for speculative debug tracing.
32297 pretrigger=<&'size'&> This option specifies a memory buffuer to be used
32298 for pre-trigger debug capture.
32299 Debug lines are recorded in the buffer until
32300 and if) a trigger occurs; at which time they are
32301 dumped to the debug file. Newer lines displace the
32302 oldest if the buffer is full. After a trigger,
32303 immediate writes to file are done as normal.
32305 trigger=<&'reason'&> This option selects cause for the pretrigger buffer
32306 see above) to be copied to file. A reason of &*now*&
32307 take effect immediately; one of &*paniclog*& triggers
32308 on a write to the panic log.
32311 Some examples (which depend on variables that don't exist in all
32315 control = debug/tag=.$sender_host_address
32316 control = debug/opts=+expand+acl
32317 control = debug/tag=.$message_exim_id/opts=+expand
32318 control = debug/kill
32319 control = debug/opts=+all/pretrigger=1024/trigger=paniclog
32320 control = debug/trigger=now
32324 .vitem &*control&~=&~dkim_disable_verify*&
32325 .cindex "disable DKIM verify"
32326 .cindex "DKIM" "disable verify"
32327 This control turns off DKIM verification processing entirely. For details on
32328 the operation and configuration of DKIM, see section &<<SECDKIM>>&.
32331 .vitem &*control&~=&~dmarc_disable_verify*& &&&
32332 &*control&~=&~dmarc_enable_forensic*&
32333 .cindex "disable DMARC verify"
32334 .cindex DMARC "disable verify"
32335 .cindex DMARC controls
32336 .cindex DMARC "forensic mails"
32337 These control affect DMARC processing. For details on
32338 the operation and configuration of DMARC, see section &<<SECDMARC>>&.
32340 The &"disable"& turns off DMARC verification processing entirely.
32343 .vitem &*control&~=&~dscp/*&<&'value'&>
32344 .cindex "&ACL;" "setting DSCP value"
32345 .cindex "DSCP" "inbound"
32346 This option causes the DSCP value associated with the socket for the inbound
32347 connection to be adjusted to a given value, given as one of a number of fixed
32348 strings or to numeric value.
32349 The &%-bI:dscp%& option may be used to ask Exim which names it knows of.
32350 Common values include &`throughput`&, &`mincost`&, and on newer systems
32351 &`ef`&, &`af41`&, etc. Numeric values may be in the range 0 to 0x3F.
32353 The outbound packets from Exim will be marked with this value in the header
32354 (for IPv4, the TOS field; for IPv6, the TCLASS field); there is no guarantee
32355 that these values will have any effect, not be stripped by networking
32356 equipment, or do much of anything without cooperation with your Network
32357 Engineer and those of all network operators between the source and destination.
32360 .vitem &*control&~=&~enforce_sync*& &&&
32361 &*control&~=&~no_enforce_sync*&
32362 .cindex "SMTP" "synchronization checking"
32363 .cindex "synchronization checking in SMTP"
32364 These controls make it possible to be selective about when SMTP synchronization
32365 is enforced. The global option &%smtp_enforce_sync%& specifies the initial
32366 state of the switch (it is true by default). See the description of this option
32367 in chapter &<<CHAPmainconfig>>& for details of SMTP synchronization checking.
32369 The effect of these two controls lasts for the remainder of the SMTP
32370 connection. They can appear in any ACL except the one for the non-SMTP
32371 messages. The most straightforward place to put them is in the ACL defined by
32372 &%acl_smtp_connect%&, which is run at the start of an incoming SMTP connection,
32373 before the first synchronization check. The expected use is to turn off the
32374 synchronization checks for badly-behaved hosts that you nevertheless need to
32378 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakedefer/*&<&'message'&>
32379 .cindex "fake defer"
32380 .cindex "defer, fake"
32382 This control works in exactly the same way as &%fakereject%& (described below)
32383 except that it causes an SMTP 450 response after the message data instead of a
32384 550 response. You must take care when using &%fakedefer%& because it causes the
32385 messages to be duplicated when the sender retries. Therefore, you should not
32386 use &%fakedefer%& if the message is to be delivered normally.
32388 .vitem &*control&~=&~fakereject/*&<&'message'&>
32389 .cindex "fake rejection"
32390 .cindex "rejection, fake"
32392 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and DATA ACLs, in other
32393 words, only when an SMTP message is being received. If Exim accepts the
32394 message, instead the final 250 response, a 550 rejection message is sent.
32395 However, Exim proceeds to deliver the message as normal. The control applies
32396 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32397 the same SMTP connection.
32399 The text for the 550 response is taken from the &%control%& modifier. If no
32400 message is supplied, the following is used:
32402 550-Your message has been rejected but is being
32403 550-kept for evaluation.
32404 550-If it was a legitimate message, it may still be
32405 550 delivered to the target recipient(s).
32407 This facility should be used with extreme caution.
32409 .vitem &*control&~=&~freeze*&
32410 .cindex "frozen messages" "forcing in ACL"
32411 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32412 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32413 it is placed on Exim's queue and frozen. The control applies only to the
32414 current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in the same
32417 This modifier can optionally be followed by &`/no_tell`&. If the global option
32418 &%freeze_tell%& is set, it is ignored for the current message (that is, nobody
32419 is told about the freezing), provided all the &*control=freeze*& modifiers that
32420 are obeyed for the current message have the &`/no_tell`& option.
32422 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_delay_flush*&
32423 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for delay"
32424 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before implementing a delay in an ACL, to
32425 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
32426 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%delay%& modifier,
32427 disables such output flushing.
32429 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_callout_flush*&
32430 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
32431 Exim normally flushes SMTP output before performing a callout in an ACL, to
32432 avoid unexpected timeouts in clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in
32433 use. This control, as long as it is encountered before the &%verify%& condition
32434 that causes the callout, disables such output flushing.
32436 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_mbox_unspool*&
32437 This control is available when Exim is compiled with the content scanning
32438 extension. Content scanning may require a copy of the current message, or parts
32439 of it, to be written in &"mbox format"& to a spool file, for passing to a virus
32440 or spam scanner. Normally, such copies are deleted when they are no longer
32441 needed. If this control is set, the copies are not deleted. The control applies
32442 only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that may be received in
32443 the same SMTP connection. It is provided for debugging purposes and is unlikely
32444 to be useful in production.
32446 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_multiline_responses*&
32447 .cindex "multiline responses, suppressing"
32448 This control is permitted for any ACL except the one for non-SMTP messages.
32449 It seems that there are broken clients in use that cannot handle multiline
32450 SMTP responses, despite the fact that
32451 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc821,RFC 821)
32452 defined them over 20 years ago.
32454 If this control is set, multiline SMTP responses from ACL rejections are
32455 suppressed. One way of doing this would have been to put out these responses as
32456 one long line. However,
32457 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821)
32458 specifies a maximum of 512 bytes per response
32459 (&"use multiline responses for more"& it says &-- ha!), and some of the
32460 responses might get close to that. So this facility, which is after all only a
32461 sop to broken clients, is implemented by doing two very easy things:
32464 Extra information that is normally output as part of a rejection caused by
32465 sender verification failure is omitted. Only the final line (typically &"sender
32466 verification failed"&) is sent.
32468 If a &%message%& modifier supplies a multiline response, only the first
32472 The setting of the switch can, of course, be made conditional on the
32473 calling host. Its effect lasts until the end of the SMTP connection.
32475 .vitem &*control&~=&~no_pipelining*&
32476 .cindex "PIPELINING" "suppressing advertising"
32477 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" PIPELINING
32478 This control turns off the advertising of the PIPELINING extension to SMTP in
32479 the current session. To be useful, it must be obeyed before Exim sends its
32480 response to an EHLO command. Therefore, it should normally appear in an ACL
32481 controlled by &%acl_smtp_connect%& or &%acl_smtp_helo%&. See also
32482 &%pipelining_advertise_hosts%&.
32484 .vitem &*control&~=&~queue/*&<&'options'&>* &&&
32485 &*control&~=&~queue_only*&
32486 .oindex "&%queue%&"
32487 .oindex "&%queue_only%&"
32488 .cindex "queueing incoming messages"
32489 .cindex queueing "forcing in ACL"
32490 .cindex "first pass routing"
32491 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, DATA, and non-SMTP ACLs, in
32492 other words, only when a message is being received. If the message is accepted,
32493 it is placed on Exim's queue and left there for delivery by a subsequent queue
32495 If used with no options set,
32496 no immediate delivery process is started. In other words, it has the
32497 effect as the &%queue_only%& global option or &'-odq'& command-line option.
32499 If the &'first_pass_route'& option is given then
32500 the behaviour is like the command-line &'-oqds'& option;
32501 a delivery process is started which stops short of making
32502 any SMTP delivery. The benefit is that the hints database will be updated for
32503 the message being waiting for a specific host, and a later queue run will be
32504 able to send all such messages on a single connection.
32506 The control only applies to the current message, not to any subsequent ones that
32507 may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32509 .vitem &*control&~=&~submission/*&<&'options'&>
32510 .cindex "message" "submission"
32511 .cindex "submission mode"
32512 This control is permitted only for the MAIL, RCPT, and start of data ACLs (the
32513 latter is the one defined by &%acl_smtp_predata%&). Setting it tells Exim that
32514 the current message is a submission from a local MUA. In this case, Exim
32515 operates in &"submission mode"&, and applies certain fixups to the message if
32516 necessary. For example, it adds a &'Date:'& header line if one is not present.
32517 This control is not permitted in the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL, because that is too
32518 late (the message has already been created).
32520 Chapter &<<CHAPmsgproc>>& describes the processing that Exim applies to
32521 messages. Section &<<SECTsubmodnon>>& covers the processing that happens in
32522 submission mode; the available options for this control are described there.
32523 The control applies only to the current message, not to any subsequent ones
32524 that may be received in the same SMTP connection.
32526 .vitem &*control&~=&~suppress_local_fixups*&
32527 .cindex "submission fixups, suppressing"
32528 This control applies to locally submitted (non TCP/IP) messages, and is the
32529 complement of &`control = submission`&. It disables the fixups that are
32530 normally applied to locally-submitted messages. Specifically:
32533 Any &'Sender:'& header line is left alone (in this respect, it is a
32534 dynamic version of &%local_sender_retain%&).
32536 No &'Message-ID:'&, &'From:'&, or &'Date:'& header lines are added.
32538 There is no check that &'From:'& corresponds to the actual sender.
32541 This control may be useful when a remotely-originated message is accepted,
32542 passed to some scanning program, and then re-submitted for delivery. It can be
32543 used only in the &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
32544 and &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs, because it has to be set before the message's
32547 &*Note:*& This control applies only to the current message, not to any others
32548 that are being submitted at the same time using &%-bs%& or &%-bS%&.
32550 .vitem &*control&~=&~utf8_downconvert*&
32551 This control enables conversion of UTF-8 in message envelope addresses
32553 For details see section &<<SECTi18nMTA>>&.
32555 .vitem &*control&~=&~wellknown*&
32556 This control sets up a response data file for a WELLKNOWN SMTP command.
32557 It may only be used in an ACL servicing that command.
32558 For details see section &<<SECTWELLKNOWNACL>>&.
32562 .section "Summary of message fixup control" "SECTsummesfix"
32563 All four possibilities for message fixups can be specified:
32566 Locally submitted, fixups applied: the default.
32568 Locally submitted, no fixups applied: use
32569 &`control = suppress_local_fixups`&.
32571 Remotely submitted, no fixups applied: the default.
32573 Remotely submitted, fixups applied: use &`control = submission`&.
32578 .section "Adding header lines in ACLs" "SECTaddheadacl"
32579 .cindex "header lines" "adding in an ACL"
32580 .cindex "header lines" "position of added lines"
32581 .cindex "&%add_header%& ACL modifier"
32582 The &%add_header%& modifier can be used to add one or more extra header lines
32583 to an incoming message, as in this example:
32585 warn dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
32586 dialup.mail-abuse.org
32587 add_header = X-blacklisted-at: $dnslist_domain
32589 The &%add_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32590 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32591 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32592 &%add_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%add_header%& with
32593 any ACL verb, including &%deny%& (though this is potentially useful only in a
32596 Headers will not be added to the message if the modifier is used in
32597 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32599 Leading and trailing newlines are removed from
32600 the data for the &%add_header%& modifier; if it then
32601 contains one or more newlines that
32602 are not followed by a space or a tab, it is assumed to contain multiple header
32603 lines. Each one is checked for valid syntax; &`X-ACL-Warn:`& is added to the
32604 front of any line that is not a valid header line.
32606 Added header lines are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32607 They are added to the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32608 However, if an identical header line is requested more than once, only one copy
32609 is actually added to the message. Further header lines may be accumulated
32610 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which they are added to the message, again
32611 with duplicates suppressed. Thus, it is possible to add two identical header
32612 lines to an SMTP message, but only if one is added before DATA and one after.
32613 In the case of non-SMTP messages, new headers are accumulated during the
32614 non-SMTP ACLs, and are added to the message after all the ACLs have run. If a
32615 message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP ACL, all added header lines
32616 are included in the entry that is written to the reject log.
32618 .cindex "header lines" "added; visibility of"
32619 Header lines are not visible in string expansions
32621 until they are added to the
32622 message. It follows that header lines defined in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata
32623 ACLs are not visible until the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs are run. Similarly,
32624 header lines that are added by the DATA or MIME ACLs are not visible in those
32625 ACLs. Because of this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of
32626 passing data between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do
32627 this, you can use ACL variables, as described in section
32628 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32630 The list of headers yet to be added is given by the &%$headers_added%& variable.
32632 The &%add_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32633 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32635 &`accept add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32636 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32638 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32639 &` add_header = ADDED: some text`&
32641 In the first case, the header line is always added, whether or not the
32642 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is added only if the
32643 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%add_header%& may occur in the same
32644 ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails are
32647 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb"
32648 For compatibility with previous versions of Exim, a &%message%& modifier for a
32649 &%warn%& verb acts in the same way as &%add_header%&, except that it takes
32650 effect only if all the conditions are true, even if it appears before some of
32651 them. Furthermore, only the last occurrence of &%message%& is honoured. This
32652 usage of &%message%& is now deprecated. If both &%add_header%& and &%message%&
32653 are present on a &%warn%& verb, both are processed according to their
32656 By default, new header lines are added to a message at the end of the existing
32657 header lines. However, you can specify that any particular header line should
32658 be added right at the start (before all the &'Received:'& lines), immediately
32659 after the first block of &'Received:'& lines, or immediately before any line
32660 that is not a &'Received:'& or &'Resent-something:'& header.
32662 This is done by specifying &":at_start:"&, &":after_received:"&, or
32663 &":at_start_rfc:"& (or, for completeness, &":at_end:"&) before the text of the
32664 header line, respectively. (Header text cannot start with a colon, as there has
32665 to be a header name first.) For example:
32667 warn add_header = \
32668 :after_received:X-My-Header: something or other...
32670 If more than one header line is supplied in a single &%add_header%& modifier,
32671 each one is treated independently and can therefore be placed differently. If
32672 you add more than one line at the start, or after the Received: block, they end
32673 up in reverse order.
32675 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32676 added in an ACL. It does NOT work for header lines that are added in a
32677 system filter or in a router or transport.
32681 .section "Removing header lines in ACLs" "SECTremoveheadacl"
32682 .cindex "header lines" "removing in an ACL"
32683 .cindex "header lines" "position of removed lines"
32684 .cindex "&%remove_header%& ACL modifier"
32685 The &%remove_header%& modifier can be used to remove one or more header lines
32686 from an incoming message, as in this example:
32688 warn message = Remove internal headers
32689 remove_header = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32691 The &%remove_header%& modifier is permitted in the MAIL, RCPT, PREDATA, DATA,
32692 MIME, DKIM, and non-SMTP ACLs (in other words, those that are concerned with
32693 receiving a message). The message must ultimately be accepted for
32694 &%remove_header%& to have any significant effect. You can use &%remove_header%&
32695 with any ACL verb, including &%deny%&, though this is really not useful for
32696 any verb that doesn't result in a delivered message.
32698 Headers will not be removed from the message if the modifier is used in
32699 DATA, MIME or DKIM ACLs for a message delivered by cutthrough routing.
32701 More than one header can be removed at the same time by using a colon separated
32702 list of header specifiers.
32703 If a specifier does not start with a circumflex (^)
32704 then it is treated as a header name.
32705 The header name matching is case insensitive.
32706 If it does, then it is treated as a (front-anchored)
32707 regular expression applied to the whole header.
32709 &*Note*&: The colon terminating a header name will need to be doubled
32710 if used in an RE, and there can legitimately be whitepace before it.
32714 remove_header = \N^(?i)Authentication-Results\s*::\s*example.org;\N
32717 List expansion is not performed, so you cannot use hostlists to
32718 create a list of headers, however both connection and message variable expansion
32719 are performed (&%$acl_c_*%& and &%$acl_m_*%&), illustrated in this example:
32721 warn hosts = +internal_hosts
32722 set acl_c_ihdrs = x-route-mail1 : x-route-mail2
32723 warn message = Remove internal headers
32724 remove_header = $acl_c_ihdrs
32726 Header specifiers for removal are accumulated during the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs.
32727 Matching header lines are removed from the message before processing the DATA and MIME ACLs.
32728 If multiple header lines match, all are removed.
32729 There is no harm in attempting to remove the same header twice nor in removing
32730 a non-existent header. Further header specifiers for removal may be accumulated
32731 during the DATA and MIME ACLs, after which matching headers are removed
32732 if present. In the case of non-SMTP messages, remove specifiers are
32733 accumulated during the non-SMTP ACLs, and are acted on after
32734 all the ACLs have run. If a message is rejected after DATA or by the non-SMTP
32735 ACL, there really is no effect because there is no logging of what headers
32736 would have been removed.
32738 .cindex "header lines" "removed; visibility of"
32739 Header lines are not visible in string expansions until the DATA phase when it
32740 is received. Any header lines removed in the MAIL, RCPT, and predata ACLs are
32741 not visible in the DATA ACL and MIME ACLs. Similarly, header lines that are
32742 removed by the DATA or MIME ACLs are still visible in those ACLs. Because of
32743 this restriction, you cannot use header lines as a way of controlling data
32744 passed between (for example) the MAIL and RCPT ACLs. If you want to do this,
32745 you should instead use ACL variables, as described in section
32746 &<<SECTaclvariables>>&.
32748 The &%remove_header%& modifier acts immediately as it is encountered during the
32749 processing of an ACL. Notice the difference between these two cases:
32751 &`accept remove_header = X-Internal`&
32752 &` `&<&'some condition'&>
32754 &`accept `&<&'some condition'&>
32755 &` remove_header = X-Internal`&
32757 In the first case, the header line is always removed, whether or not the
32758 condition is true. In the second case, the header line is removed only if the
32759 condition is true. Multiple occurrences of &%remove_header%& may occur in the
32760 same ACL statement. All those that are encountered before a condition fails
32763 &*Warning*&: This facility currently applies only to header lines that are
32764 present during ACL processing. It does NOT remove header lines that are added
32765 in a system filter or in a router or transport.
32770 .section "ACL conditions" "SECTaclconditions"
32771 .cindex "&ACL;" "conditions; list of"
32772 Some of the conditions listed in this section are available only when Exim is
32773 compiled with the content-scanning extension. They are included here briefly
32774 for completeness. More detailed descriptions can be found in the discussion on
32775 content scanning in chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32777 Not all conditions are relevant in all circumstances. For example, testing
32778 senders and recipients does not make sense in an ACL that is being run as the
32779 result of the arrival of an ETRN command, and checks on message headers can be
32780 done only in the ACLs specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& and &%acl_not_smtp%&. You
32781 can use the same condition (with different parameters) more than once in the
32782 same ACL statement. This provides a way of specifying an &"and"& conjunction.
32783 The conditions are as follows:
32787 .vitem &*acl&~=&~*&<&'name&~of&~acl&~or&~ACL&~string&~or&~file&~name&~'&>
32788 .cindex "&ACL;" "nested"
32789 .cindex "&ACL;" "indirect"
32790 .cindex "&ACL;" "arguments"
32791 .cindex "&%acl%& ACL condition"
32792 The possible values of the argument are the same as for the
32793 &%acl_smtp_%&&'xxx'& options. The named or inline ACL is run. If it returns
32794 &"accept"& the condition is true; if it returns &"deny"& the condition is
32795 false. If it returns &"defer"&, the current ACL returns &"defer"& unless the
32796 condition is on a &%warn%& verb. In that case, a &"defer"& return makes the
32797 condition false. This means that further processing of the &%warn%& verb
32798 ceases, but processing of the ACL continues.
32800 If the argument is a named ACL, up to nine space-separated optional values
32801 can be appended; they appear within the called ACL in $acl_arg1 to $acl_arg9,
32802 and $acl_narg is set to the count of values.
32803 Previous values of these variables are restored after the call returns.
32804 The name and values are expanded separately.
32805 Note that spaces in complex expansions which are used as arguments
32806 will act as argument separators.
32808 If the nested &%acl%& returns &"drop"& and the outer condition denies access,
32809 the connection is dropped. If it returns &"discard"&, the verb must be
32810 &%accept%& or &%discard%&, and the action is taken immediately &-- no further
32811 conditions are tested.
32813 ACLs may be nested up to 20 deep; the limit exists purely to catch runaway
32814 loops. This condition allows you to use different ACLs in different
32815 circumstances. For example, different ACLs can be used to handle RCPT commands
32816 for different local users or different local domains.
32819 .vitem &*atrn_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32820 .cindex ATRN "checking for queued messages"
32821 This condition is only usable in the ATRN ACL.
32822 It returns true if there are any messages queued for any of the domains given
32824 The list supplied must not be tainted
32825 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
32826 and should contain only domains relevant for the authenticated user
32827 (to avoid leaking information about other users).
32830 .vitem &*authenticated&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32831 .cindex "&%authenticated%& ACL condition"
32832 .cindex "authentication" "ACL checking"
32833 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for authentication"
32834 If the SMTP connection is not authenticated, the condition is false. Otherwise,
32835 the name of the authenticator is tested against the list. To test for
32836 authentication by any authenticator, you can set
32841 .vitem &*condition&~=&~*&<&'string'&>
32842 .cindex "&%condition%& ACL condition"
32843 .cindex "customizing" "ACL condition"
32844 .cindex "&ACL;" "customized test"
32845 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing, customized"
32846 This feature allows you to make up custom conditions. If the result of
32847 expanding the string is an empty string, the number zero, or one of the strings
32848 &"no"& or &"false"&, the condition is false. If the result is any non-zero
32849 number, or one of the strings &"yes"& or &"true"&, the condition is true. For
32850 any other value, some error is assumed to have occurred, and the ACL returns
32851 &"defer"&. However, if the expansion is forced to fail, the condition is
32852 ignored. The effect is to treat it as true, whether it is positive or
32855 .vitem &*decode&~=&~*&<&'location'&>
32856 .cindex "&%decode%& ACL condition"
32857 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32858 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32859 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be decoded into a file.
32860 If all goes well, the condition is true. It is false only if there are
32861 problems such as a syntax error or a memory shortage. For more details, see
32862 chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32864 .vitem &*dnslists&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~domain&~names&~and&~other&~data'&>
32865 .cindex "&%dnslists%& ACL condition"
32866 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
32867 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
32868 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
32869 This condition checks for entries in DNS black lists. These are also known as
32870 &"RBL lists"&, after the original Realtime Blackhole List, but note that the
32871 use of the lists at &'mail-abuse.org'& now carries a charge. There are too many
32872 different variants of this condition to describe briefly here. See sections
32873 &<<SECTmorednslists>>&&--&<<SECTmorednslistslast>>& for details.
32875 .vitem &*domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
32876 .cindex "&%domains%& ACL condition"
32877 .cindex "domain" "ACL checking"
32878 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient domain"
32879 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
32880 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the domain
32881 of the recipient address is in the domain list. If percent-hack processing is
32882 enabled, it is done before this test is done. If the check succeeds with a
32883 lookup, the result of the lookup is placed in &$domain_data$& until the next
32886 &*Note carefully*& (because many people seem to fall foul of this): you cannot
32887 use &%domains%& in a DATA ACL.
32890 .vitem &*encrypted&~=&~*&<&'string&~list'&>
32891 .cindex "&%encrypted%& ACL condition"
32892 .cindex "encryption" "checking in an ACL"
32893 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing for encryption"
32894 If the SMTP connection is not encrypted, the condition is false. Otherwise, the
32895 name of the cipher suite in use is tested against the list. To test for
32896 encryption without testing for any specific cipher suite(s), set
32902 .vitem &*hosts&~=&~*&<&'host&~list'&>
32903 .cindex "&%hosts%& ACL condition"
32904 .cindex "host" "ACL checking"
32905 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing the client host"
32906 This condition tests that the calling host matches the host list. If you have
32907 name lookups or wildcarded host names and IP addresses in the same host list,
32908 you should normally put the IP addresses first. For example, you could have:
32910 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7 : dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32912 The lookup in this example uses the host name for its key. This is implied by
32913 the lookup type &"dbm"&. (For a host address lookup you would use &"net-dbm"&
32914 and it wouldn't matter which way round you had these two items.)
32916 The reason for the problem with host names lies in the left-to-right way that
32917 Exim processes lists. It can test IP addresses without doing any DNS lookups,
32918 but when it reaches an item that requires a host name, it fails if it cannot
32919 find a host name to compare with the pattern. If the above list is given in the
32920 opposite order, the &%accept%& statement fails for a host whose name cannot be
32921 found, even if its IP address is 10.9.8.7.
32923 If you really do want to do the name check first, and still recognize the IP
32924 address even if the name lookup fails, you can rewrite the ACL like this:
32926 accept hosts = dbm;/etc/friendly/hosts
32927 accept hosts = 10.9.8.7
32929 The default action on failing to find the host name is to assume that the host
32930 is not in the list, so the first &%accept%& statement fails. The second
32931 statement can then check the IP address.
32933 .vindex "&$host_data$&"
32934 If a &%hosts%& condition is satisfied by means of a lookup, the result
32935 of the lookup is made available in the &$host_data$& variable. This
32936 allows you, for example, to set up a statement like this:
32938 deny hosts = net-lsearch;/some/file
32939 message = $host_data
32941 which gives a custom error message for each denied host.
32943 .vitem &*local_parts&~=&~*&<&'local&~part&~list'&>
32944 .cindex "&%local_parts%& ACL condition"
32945 .cindex "local part" "ACL checking"
32946 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a local part"
32947 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
32948 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks that the local
32949 part of the recipient address is in the list. If percent-hack processing is
32950 enabled, it is done before this test. If the check succeeds with a lookup, the
32951 result of the lookup is placed in &$local_part_data$&, which remains set until
32952 the next &%local_parts%& test.
32954 .vitem &*malware&~=&~*&<&'option'&>
32955 .cindex "&%malware%& ACL condition"
32956 .cindex "&ACL;" "virus scanning"
32957 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for viruses"
32958 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32959 content-scanning extension
32960 and only after a DATA command.
32961 It causes the incoming message to be scanned for
32962 viruses. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32964 .vitem &*mime_regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32965 .cindex "&%mime_regex%& ACL condition"
32966 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32967 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32968 content-scanning extension, and it is allowed only in the ACL defined by
32969 &%acl_smtp_mime%&. It causes the current MIME part to be scanned for a match
32970 with any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter
32973 .vitem &*ratelimit&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32974 .cindex "rate limiting"
32975 This condition can be used to limit the rate at which a user or host submits
32976 messages. Details are given in section &<<SECTratelimiting>>&.
32978 .vitem &*recipients&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
32979 .cindex "&%recipients%& ACL condition"
32980 .cindex "recipient" "ACL checking"
32981 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a recipient"
32982 This condition is relevant only in a RCPT ACL. It checks the entire
32983 recipient address against a list of recipients.
32985 .vitem &*regex&~=&~*&<&'list&~of&~regular&~expressions'&>
32986 .cindex "&%regex%& ACL condition"
32987 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing by regex matching"
32988 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
32989 content-scanning extension, and is available only in the DATA, MIME, and
32990 non-SMTP ACLs. It causes the incoming message to be scanned for a match with
32991 any of the regular expressions. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
32993 .vitem &*seen&~=&~*&<&'parameters'&>
32994 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
32995 This condition can be used to test if a situation has been previously met,
32996 for example for greylisting.
32997 Details are given in section &<<SECTseen>>&.
32999 .vitem &*sender_domains&~=&~*&<&'domain&~list'&>
33000 .cindex "&%sender_domains%& ACL condition"
33001 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
33002 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender domain"
33003 .vindex "&$domain$&"
33004 .vindex "&$sender_address_domain$&"
33005 This condition tests the domain of the sender of the message against the given
33006 domain list. &*Note*&: The domain of the sender address is in
33007 &$sender_address_domain$&. It is &'not'& put in &$domain$& during the testing
33008 of this condition. This is an exception to the general rule for testing domain
33009 lists. It is done this way so that, if this condition is used in an ACL for a
33010 RCPT command, the recipient's domain (which is in &$domain$&) can be used to
33011 influence the sender checking.
33013 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
33014 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
33016 .vitem &*senders&~=&~*&<&'address&~list'&>
33017 .cindex "&%senders%& ACL condition"
33018 .cindex "sender" "ACL checking"
33019 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a sender"
33020 This condition tests the sender of the message against the given list. To test
33021 for a bounce message, which has an empty sender, set
33025 &*Warning*&: It is a bad idea to use this condition on its own as a control on
33026 relaying, because sender addresses are easily, and commonly, forged.
33028 .vitem &*spam&~=&~*&<&'username'&>
33029 .cindex "&%spam%& ACL condition"
33030 .cindex "&ACL;" "scanning for spam"
33031 This condition is available only when Exim is compiled with the
33032 content-scanning extension. It causes the incoming message to be scanned by
33033 SpamAssassin. For details, see chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&.
33035 .vitem &*verify&~=&~certificate*&
33036 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33037 .cindex "TLS" "client certificate verification"
33038 .cindex "certificate" "verification of client"
33039 .cindex "&ACL;" "certificate verification"
33040 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a TLS certificate"
33041 This condition is true in an SMTP session if the session is encrypted, and a
33042 certificate was received from the client, and the certificate was verified. The
33043 server requests a certificate only if the client matches &%tls_verify_hosts%&
33044 or &%tls_try_verify_hosts%& (see chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>&).
33046 .vitem &*verify&~=&~csa*&
33047 .cindex "CSA verification"
33048 This condition checks whether the sending host (the client) is authorized to
33049 send email. Details of how this works are given in section
33050 &<<SECTverifyCSA>>&.
33052 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_names_ascii*&
33053 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33054 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header names only ASCII"
33055 .cindex "header lines" "verifying header names only ASCII"
33056 .cindex "verifying" "header names only ASCII"
33057 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
33059 This usually means an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
33060 It checks all header names (not the content) to make sure
33061 there are no non-ASCII characters, also excluding control characters. The
33062 allowable characters are decimal ASCII values 33 through 126.
33064 Exim itself will handle headers with non-ASCII characters, but it can cause
33065 problems for downstream applications, so this option will allow their
33066 detection and rejection in the DATA ACL's.
33068 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_sender/*&<&'options'&>
33069 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33070 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender in the header"
33071 .cindex "header lines" "verifying the sender in"
33072 .cindex "sender" "verifying in header"
33073 .cindex "verifying" "sender in header"
33074 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
33075 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
33076 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks that there is a verifiable address in at least one
33077 of the &'Sender:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, or &'From:'& header lines. Such an address
33078 is loosely thought of as a &"sender"& address (hence the name of the test).
33079 However, an address that appears in one of these headers need not be an address
33080 that accepts bounce messages; only sender addresses in envelopes are required
33081 to accept bounces. Therefore, if you use the callout option on this check, you
33082 might want to arrange for a non-empty address in the MAIL command.
33084 Details of address verification and the options are given later, starting at
33085 section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& (callouts are described in section
33086 &<<SECTcallver>>&). You can combine this condition with the &%senders%&
33087 condition to restrict it to bounce messages only:
33090 !verify = header_sender
33091 message = A valid sender header is required for bounces
33094 .vitem &*verify&~=&~header_syntax*&
33095 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33096 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying header syntax"
33097 .cindex "header lines" "verifying syntax"
33098 .cindex "verifying" "header syntax"
33099 This condition is relevant only in an ACL that is run after a message has been
33100 received, that is, in an ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_data%& or
33101 &%acl_not_smtp%&. It checks the syntax of all header lines that can contain
33102 lists of addresses (&'Sender:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&,
33103 and &'Bcc:'&), returning true if there are no problems.
33104 Unqualified addresses (local parts without domains) are
33105 permitted only in locally generated messages and from hosts that match
33106 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& or &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&, as
33109 Note that this condition is a syntax check only. However, a common spamming
33110 ploy used to be to send syntactically invalid headers such as
33114 and this condition can be used to reject such messages, though they are not as
33115 common as they used to be.
33117 .vitem &*verify&~=&~helo*&
33118 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33119 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying HELO/EHLO"
33120 .cindex "HELO" "verifying"
33121 .cindex "EHLO" "verifying"
33122 .cindex "verifying" "EHLO"
33123 .cindex "verifying" "HELO"
33124 This condition is true if a HELO or EHLO command has been received from the
33125 client host, and its contents have been verified. If there has been no previous
33126 attempt to verify the HELO/EHLO contents, it is carried out when this
33127 condition is encountered. See the description of the &%helo_verify_hosts%& and
33128 &%helo_try_verify_hosts%& options for details of how to request verification
33129 independently of this condition, and for detail of the verification.
33131 For SMTP input that does not come over TCP/IP (the &%-bs%& command line
33132 option), this condition is always true.
33135 .vitem &*verify&~=&~not_blind/*&<&'options'&>
33136 .cindex "verifying" "not blind"
33137 .cindex "bcc recipients, verifying none"
33138 This condition checks that there are no blind (bcc) recipients in the message.
33139 Every envelope recipient must appear either in a &'To:'& header line or in a
33140 &'Cc:'& header line for this condition to be true. Local parts are checked
33141 case-sensitively; domains are checked case-insensitively. If &'Resent-To:'& or
33142 &'Resent-Cc:'& header lines exist, they are also checked. This condition can be
33143 used only in a DATA or non-SMTP ACL.
33145 There is one possible option, &`case_insensitive`&. If this is present then
33146 local parts are checked case-insensitively.
33148 There are, of course, many legitimate messages that make use of blind (bcc)
33149 recipients. This check should not be used on its own for blocking messages.
33152 .vitem &*verify&~=&~recipient/*&<&'options'&>
33153 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33154 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying recipient"
33155 .cindex "recipient" "verifying"
33156 .cindex "verifying" "recipient"
33157 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
33158 This condition is relevant only after a RCPT command. It verifies the current
33159 recipient. Details of address verification are given later, starting at section
33160 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. After a recipient has been verified, the value
33161 of &$address_data$& is the last value that was set while routing the address.
33162 This applies even if the verification fails. When an address that is being
33163 verified is redirected to a single address, verification continues with the new
33164 address, and in that case, the subsequent value of &$address_data$& is the
33165 value for the child address.
33167 .vitem &*verify&~=&~reverse_host_lookup/*&<&'options'&>
33168 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33169 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying host reverse lookup"
33170 .cindex "host" "verifying reverse lookup"
33171 This condition ensures that a verified host name has been looked up from the IP
33172 address of the client host. (This may have happened already if the host name
33173 was needed for checking a host list, or if the host matched &%host_lookup%&.)
33174 Verification ensures that the host name obtained from a reverse DNS lookup, or
33175 one of its aliases, does, when it is itself looked up in the DNS, yield the
33176 original IP address.
33178 There is one possible option, &`defer_ok`&. If this is present and a
33179 DNS operation returns a temporary error, the verify condition succeeds.
33181 If this condition is used for a locally generated message (that is, when there
33182 is no client host involved), it always succeeds.
33184 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender/*&<&'options'&>
33185 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33186 .cindex "&ACL;" "verifying sender"
33187 .cindex "sender" "verifying"
33188 .cindex "verifying" "sender"
33189 This condition is relevant only after a MAIL or RCPT command, or after a
33190 message has been received (the &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs). If
33191 the message's sender is empty (that is, this is a bounce message), the
33192 condition is true. Otherwise, the sender address is verified.
33194 .vindex "&$address_data$&"
33195 .vindex "&$sender_address_data$&"
33196 If there is data in the &$address_data$& variable at the end of routing, its
33197 value is placed in &$sender_address_data$& at the end of verification. This
33198 value can be used in subsequent conditions and modifiers in the same ACL
33199 statement. It does not persist after the end of the current statement. If you
33200 want to preserve the value for longer, you can save it in an ACL variable.
33202 Details of verification are given later, starting at section
33203 &<<SECTaddressverification>>&. Exim caches the result of sender verification,
33204 to avoid doing it more than once per message.
33206 .vitem &*verify&~=&~sender=*&<&'address'&>&*/*&<&'options'&>
33207 .cindex "&%verify%& ACL condition"
33208 This is a variation of the previous option, in which a modified address is
33209 verified as a sender.
33211 Note that '/' is legal in local-parts; if the address may have such
33212 (eg. is generated from the received message)
33213 they must be protected from the options parsing by doubling:
33215 verify = sender=${listquote{/}{${address:$h_sender:}}}
33221 .section "Using DNS lists" "SECTmorednslists"
33222 .cindex "DNS list" "in ACL"
33223 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
33224 .cindex "&ACL;" "testing a DNS list"
33225 In its simplest form, the &%dnslists%& condition tests whether the calling host
33226 is on at least one of a number of DNS lists by looking up the inverted IP
33227 address in one or more DNS domains. (Note that DNS list domains are not mail
33228 domains, so the &`+`& syntax for named lists doesn't work - it is used for
33229 special options instead.) For example, if the calling host's IP
33230 address is 192.168.62.43, and the ACL statement is
33232 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org : \
33233 dialups.mail-abuse.org
33235 the following records are looked up:
33237 43.62.168.192.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33238 43.62.168.192.dialups.mail-abuse.org
33240 As soon as Exim finds an existing DNS record, processing of the list stops.
33241 Thus, multiple entries on the list provide an &"or"& conjunction. If you want
33242 to test that a host is on more than one list (an &"and"& conjunction), you can
33243 use two separate conditions:
33245 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33246 dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
33248 If a DNS lookup times out or otherwise fails to give a decisive answer, Exim
33249 behaves as if the host does not match the list item, that is, as if the DNS
33250 record does not exist. If there are further items in the DNS list, they are
33253 This is usually the required action when &%dnslists%& is used with &%deny%&
33254 (which is the most common usage), because it prevents a DNS failure from
33255 blocking mail. However, you can change this behaviour by putting one of the
33256 following special items in the list:
33257 .itable none 0 0 2 25* left 75* left
33258 .irow "+include_unknown" "behave as if the item is on the list"
33259 .irow "+exclude_unknown" "behave as if the item is not on the list (default)"
33260 .irow "+defer_unknown " "give a temporary error"
33262 .cindex "&`+include_unknown`&"
33263 .cindex "&`+exclude_unknown`&"
33264 .cindex "&`+defer_unknown`&"
33265 Each of these applies to any subsequent items on the list. For example:
33267 deny dnslists = +defer_unknown : foo.bar.example
33269 Testing the list of domains stops as soon as a match is found. If you want to
33270 warn for one list and block for another, you can use two different statements:
33272 deny dnslists = blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33273 warn dnslists = dialups.mail-abuse.org
33274 message = X-Warn: sending host is on dialups list
33276 .cindex caching "of dns lookup"
33278 DNS list lookups are cached by Exim for the duration of the SMTP session
33279 (but limited by the DNS return TTL value),
33280 so a lookup based on the IP address is done at most once for any incoming
33281 connection (assuming long-enough TTL).
33282 Exim does not share information between multiple incoming
33283 connections (but your local name server cache should be active).
33285 There are a number of DNS lists to choose from, some commercial, some free,
33286 or free for small deployments. An overview can be found at
33287 &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Comparison_of_DNS_blacklists).
33291 .subsection "Specifying the IP address for a DNS list lookup" SECID201
33292 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by explicit IP address"
33293 By default, the IP address that is used in a DNS list lookup is the IP address
33294 of the calling host. However, you can specify another IP address by listing it
33295 after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example:
33297 deny dnslists = black.list.tld/192.168.1.2
33299 This feature is not very helpful with explicit IP addresses; it is intended for
33300 use with IP addresses that are looked up, for example, the IP addresses of the
33301 MX hosts or nameservers of an email sender address. For an example, see section
33302 &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>& below.
33307 .subsection "DNS lists keyed on domain names" SECID202
33308 .cindex "DNS list" "keyed by domain name"
33309 There are some lists that are keyed on domain names rather than inverted IP
33310 addresses (see, e.g., the &'domain based zones'& link at
33311 &url(http://www.rfc-ignorant.org/)). No reversing of components is used
33312 with these lists. You can change the name that is looked up in a DNS list by
33313 listing it after the domain name, introduced by a slash. For example,
33315 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
33316 message = Sender's domain is listed at $dnslist_domain
33318 This particular example is useful only in ACLs that are obeyed after the
33319 RCPT or DATA commands, when a sender address is available. If (for
33320 example) the message's sender is &'user@tld.example'& the name that is looked
33321 up by this example is
33323 tld.example.dsn.rfc-ignorant.org
33325 A single &%dnslists%& condition can contain entries for both names and IP
33326 addresses. For example:
33328 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33329 dsn.rfc-ignorant.org/$sender_address_domain
33331 The first item checks the sending host's IP address; the second checks a domain
33332 name. The whole condition is true if either of the DNS lookups succeeds.
33337 .subsection "Multiple explicit keys for a DNS list" SECTmulkeyfor
33338 .cindex "DNS list" "multiple keys for"
33339 The syntax described above for looking up explicitly-defined values (either
33340 names or IP addresses) in a DNS blacklist is a simplification. After the domain
33341 name for the DNS list, what follows the slash can in fact be a list of items.
33342 As with all lists in Exim, the default separator is a colon. However, because
33343 this is a sublist within the list of DNS blacklist domains, it is necessary
33344 either to double the separators like this:
33346 dnslists = black.list.tld/name.1::name.2
33348 or to change the separator character, like this:
33350 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;name.1;name.2
33352 If an item in the list is an IP address, it is inverted before the DNS
33353 blacklist domain is appended. If it is not an IP address, no inversion
33354 occurs. Consider this condition:
33356 dnslists = black.list.tld/<;192.168.1.2;a.domain
33358 The DNS lookups that occur are:
33360 2.1.168.192.black.list.tld
33361 a.domain.black.list.tld
33363 Once a DNS record has been found (that matches a specific IP return
33364 address, if specified &-- see section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>&), no further lookups
33365 are done. If there is a temporary DNS error, the rest of the sublist of domains
33366 or IP addresses is tried. A temporary error for the whole dnslists item occurs
33367 only if no other DNS lookup in this sublist succeeds. In other words, a
33368 successful lookup for any of the items in the sublist overrides a temporary
33369 error for a previous item.
33371 The ability to supply a list of items after the slash is in some sense just a
33372 syntactic convenience. These two examples have the same effect:
33374 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain : black.list.tld/b.domain
33375 dnslists = black.list.tld/a.domain::b.domain
33377 However, when the data for the list is obtained from a lookup, the second form
33378 is usually much more convenient. Consider this example:
33380 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|${lookup dnsdb {>|a=<|\
33381 ${lookup dnsdb {>|mxh=\
33382 $sender_address_domain} }} }
33383 message = The mail servers for the domain \
33384 $sender_address_domain \
33385 are listed at $dnslist_domain ($dnslist_value); \
33388 Note the use of &`>|`& in the dnsdb lookup to specify the separator for
33389 multiple DNS records. The inner dnsdb lookup produces a list of MX hosts
33390 and the outer dnsdb lookup finds the IP addresses for these hosts. The result
33391 of expanding the condition might be something like this:
33393 dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org/<|192.168.2.3|192.168.5.6|...
33395 Thus, this example checks whether or not the IP addresses of the sender
33396 domain's mail servers are on the Spamhaus black list.
33398 The key that was used for a successful DNS list lookup is put into the variable
33399 &$dnslist_matched$& (see section &<<SECID204>>&).
33404 .subsection "Data returned by DNS lists" SECID203
33405 .cindex "DNS list" "data returned from"
33406 DNS lists are constructed using address records in the DNS. The original RBL
33407 just used the address 127.0.0.1 on the right hand side of each record, but the
33408 RBL+ list and some other lists use a number of values with different meanings.
33409 The values used on the RBL+ list are:
33410 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
33411 .irow 127.1.0.1 "RBL"
33412 .irow 127.1.0.2 "DUL"
33413 .irow 127.1.0.3 "DUL and RBL"
33414 .irow 127.1.0.4 "RSS"
33415 .irow 127.1.0.5 "RSS and RBL"
33416 .irow 127.1.0.6 "RSS and DUL"
33417 .irow 127.1.0.7 "RSS and DUL and RBL"
33419 Section &<<SECTaddmatcon>>& below describes how you can distinguish between
33420 different values. Some DNS lists may return more than one address record;
33421 see section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>& for details of how they are checked.
33423 Values returned by a properly running DBSBL should be in the 127.0.0.0/8
33424 range. If a DNSBL operator loses control of the domain, lookups on it
33425 may start returning other addresses. Because of this, Exim now ignores
33426 returned values outside the 127/8 region.
33429 .subsection "Variables set from DNS lists" SECID204
33430 .cindex "expansion" "variables, set from DNS list"
33431 .cindex "DNS list" "variables set from"
33432 .vindex "&$dnslist_domain$&"
33433 .vindex "&$dnslist_matched$&"
33434 .vindex "&$dnslist_text$&"
33435 .vindex "&$dnslist_value$&"
33436 When an entry is found in a DNS list, the variable &$dnslist_domain$& contains
33437 the name of the overall domain that matched (for example,
33438 &`spamhaus.example`&), &$dnslist_matched$& contains the key within that domain
33439 (for example, &`192.168.5.3`&), and &$dnslist_value$& contains the data from
33440 the DNS record. When the key is an IP address, it is not reversed in
33441 &$dnslist_matched$& (though it is, of course, in the actual lookup). In simple
33442 cases, for example:
33444 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example
33446 the key is also available in another variable (in this case,
33447 &$sender_host_address$&). In more complicated cases, however, this is not true.
33448 For example, using a data lookup (as described in section &<<SECTmulkeyfor>>&)
33449 might generate a dnslists lookup like this:
33451 deny dnslists = spamhaus.example/<|192.168.1.2|192.168.6.7|...
33453 If this condition succeeds, the value in &$dnslist_matched$& might be
33454 &`192.168.6.7`& (for example).
33456 If more than one address record is returned by the DNS lookup, all the IP
33457 addresses are included in &$dnslist_value$&, separated by commas and spaces.
33458 The variable &$dnslist_text$& contains the contents of any associated TXT
33459 record. For lists such as RBL+ the TXT record for a merged entry is often not
33460 very meaningful. See section &<<SECTmordetinf>>& for a way of obtaining more
33463 You can use the DNS list variables in &%message%& or &%log_message%& modifiers
33464 &-- even if these appear before the condition in the ACL, they are not
33465 expanded until after it has failed. For example:
33467 deny hosts = !+local_networks
33468 message = $sender_host_address is listed \
33470 dnslists = rbl-plus.mail-abuse.example
33475 .subsection "Additional matching conditions for DNS lists" SECTaddmatcon
33476 .cindex "DNS list" "matching specific returned data"
33477 You can add an equals sign and an IP address after a &%dnslists%& domain name
33478 in order to restrict its action to DNS records with a matching right hand side.
33481 deny dnslists = rblplus.mail-abuse.org=127.0.0.2
33483 rejects only those hosts that yield 127.0.0.2. Without this additional data,
33484 any address record is considered to be a match. For the moment, we assume
33485 that the DNS lookup returns just one record. Section &<<SECThanmuldnsrec>>&
33486 describes how multiple records are handled.
33488 More than one IP address may be given for checking, using a comma as a
33489 separator. These are alternatives &-- if any one of them matches, the
33490 &%dnslists%& condition is true. For example:
33492 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33494 If you want to specify a constraining address list and also specify names or IP
33495 addresses to be looked up, the constraining address list must be specified
33496 first. For example:
33498 deny dnslists = dsn.rfc-ignorant.org\
33499 =127.0.0.2/$sender_address_domain
33502 If the character &`&&`& is used instead of &`=`&, the comparison for each
33503 listed IP address is done by a bitwise &"and"& instead of by an equality test.
33504 In other words, the listed addresses are used as bit masks. The comparison is
33505 true if all the bits in the mask are present in the address that is being
33506 tested. For example:
33508 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.3
33510 matches if the address is &'x.x.x.'&3, &'x.x.x.'&7, &'x.x.x.'&11, etc. If you
33511 want to test whether one bit or another bit is present (as opposed to both
33512 being present), you must use multiple values. For example:
33514 dnslists = a.b.c&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33516 matches if the final component of the address is an odd number or two times
33521 .subsection "Negated DNS matching conditions" SECID205
33522 You can supply a negative list of IP addresses as part of a &%dnslists%&
33525 deny dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33527 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33528 IP address yielded by the list is either 127.0.0.2 or 127.0.0.3"&,
33530 deny dnslists = a.b.c!=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33532 means &"deny if the host is in the black list at the domain &'a.b.c'& and the
33533 IP address yielded by the list is not 127.0.0.2 and not 127.0.0.3"&. In other
33534 words, the result of the test is inverted if an exclamation mark appears before
33535 the &`=`& (or the &`&&`&) sign.
33537 &*Note*&: This kind of negation is not the same as negation in a domain,
33538 host, or address list (which is why the syntax is different).
33540 If you are using just one list, the negation syntax does not gain you much. The
33541 previous example is precisely equivalent to
33543 deny dnslists = a.b.c
33544 !dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.2,127.0.0.3
33546 However, if you are using multiple lists, the negation syntax is clearer.
33547 Consider this example:
33549 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33551 dnsbl.njabl.org!=127.0.0.3 : \
33554 Using only positive lists, this would have to be:
33556 deny dnslists = sbl.spamhaus.org : \
33558 deny dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org
33559 !dnslists = dnsbl.njabl.org=127.0.0.3
33560 deny dnslists = relays.ordb.org
33562 which is less clear, and harder to maintain.
33564 Negation can also be used with a bitwise-and restriction.
33565 The dnslists condition with only be trus if a result is returned
33566 by the lookup which, anded with the restriction, is all zeroes.
33569 deny dnslists = zen.spamhaus.org!&0.255.255.0
33575 .subsection "Handling multiple DNS records from a DNS list" SECThanmuldnsrec
33576 A DNS lookup for a &%dnslists%& condition may return more than one DNS record,
33577 thereby providing more than one IP address. When an item in a &%dnslists%& list
33578 is followed by &`=`& or &`&&`& and a list of IP addresses, in order to restrict
33579 the match to specific results from the DNS lookup, there are two ways in which
33580 the checking can be handled. For example, consider the condition:
33582 dnslists = a.b.c=127.0.0.1
33584 What happens if the DNS lookup for the incoming IP address yields both
33585 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2 by means of two separate DNS records? Is the
33586 condition true because at least one given value was found, or is it false
33587 because at least one of the found values was not listed? And how does this
33588 affect negated conditions? Both possibilities are provided for with the help of
33589 additional separators &`==`& and &`=&&`&.
33592 If &`=`& or &`&&`& is used, the condition is true if any one of the looked up
33593 IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. For the example above, the
33594 condition is true because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33596 If &`==`& or &`=&&`& is used, the condition is true only if every one of the
33597 looked up IP addresses matches one of the listed addresses. If the condition is
33600 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1
33602 and the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33603 false because 127.0.0.2 is not listed. You would need to have:
33605 dnslists = a.b.c==127.0.0.1,127.0.0.2
33607 for the condition to be true.
33610 When &`!`& is used to negate IP address matching, it inverts the result, giving
33611 the precise opposite of the behaviour above. Thus:
33613 If &`!=`& or &`!&&`& is used, the condition is true if none of the looked up IP
33614 addresses matches one of the listed addresses. Consider:
33616 dnslists = a.b.c!&0.0.0.1
33618 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33619 false because 127.0.0.1 matches.
33621 If &`!==`& or &`!=&&`& is used, the condition is true if there is at least one
33622 looked up IP address that does not match. Consider:
33624 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1
33626 If the DNS lookup yields both 127.0.0.1 and 127.0.0.2, the condition is
33627 true, because 127.0.0.2 does not match. You would need to have:
33629 dnslists = a.b.c!=&0.0.0.1,0.0.0.2
33631 for the condition to be false.
33633 When the DNS lookup yields only a single IP address, there is no difference
33634 between &`=`& and &`==`& and between &`&&`& and &`=&&`&.
33639 .subsection "Detailed information from merged DNS lists" SECTmordetinf
33640 .cindex "DNS list" "information from merged"
33641 When the facility for restricting the matching IP values in a DNS list is used,
33642 the text from the TXT record that is set in &$dnslist_text$& may not reflect
33643 the true reason for rejection. This happens when lists are merged and the IP
33644 address in the A record is used to distinguish them; unfortunately there is
33645 only one TXT record. One way round this is not to use merged lists, but that
33646 can be inefficient because it requires multiple DNS lookups where one would do
33647 in the vast majority of cases when the host of interest is not on any of the
33650 A less inefficient way of solving this problem is available. If
33651 two domain names, comma-separated, are given, the second is used first to
33652 do an initial check, making use of any IP value restrictions that are set.
33653 If there is a match, the first domain is used, without any IP value
33654 restrictions, to get the TXT record. As a byproduct of this, there is also
33655 a check that the IP being tested is indeed on the first list. The first
33656 domain is the one that is put in &$dnslist_domain$&. For example:
33659 sbl.spamhaus.org,sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org=127.0.0.2 : \
33660 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33662 rejected because $sender_host_address is blacklisted \
33663 at $dnslist_domain\n$dnslist_text
33665 For the first blacklist item, this starts by doing a lookup in
33666 &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'& and testing for a 127.0.0.2 return. If there is a
33667 match, it then looks in &'sbl.spamhaus.org'&, without checking the return
33668 value, and as long as something is found, it looks for the corresponding TXT
33669 record. If there is no match in &'sbl-xbl.spamhaus.org'&, nothing more is done.
33670 The second blacklist item is processed similarly.
33672 If you are interested in more than one merged list, the same list must be
33673 given several times, but because the results of the DNS lookups are cached,
33674 the DNS calls themselves are not repeated. For example:
33677 http.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.2 : \
33678 socks.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.3 : \
33679 misc.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.4 : \
33680 dul.dnsbl.sorbs.net,dnsbl.sorbs.net=127.0.0.10
33682 In this case there is one lookup in &'dnsbl.sorbs.net'&, and if none of the IP
33683 values matches (or if no record is found), this is the only lookup that is
33684 done. Only if there is a match is one of the more specific lists consulted.
33688 .subsection "DNS lists and IPv6" SECTmorednslistslast
33689 .cindex "IPv6" "DNS black lists"
33690 .cindex "DNS list" "IPv6 usage"
33691 If Exim is asked to do a dnslist lookup for an IPv6 address, it inverts it
33692 nibble by nibble. For example, if the calling host's IP address is
33693 3ffe:ffff:836f:0a00:000a:0800:200a:c031, Exim might look up
33695 1.3.0.c.a.0.0.2.0.0.8.0.a.0.0.0.0.0.a.0.f.6.3.8.
33696 f.f.f.f.e.f.f.3.blackholes.mail-abuse.org
33698 (split over two lines here to fit on the page). Unfortunately, some of the DNS
33699 lists contain wildcard records, intended for IPv4, that interact badly with
33700 IPv6. For example, the DNS entry
33702 *.3.some.list.example. A 127.0.0.1
33704 is probably intended to put the entire 3.0.0.0/8 IPv4 network on the list.
33705 Unfortunately, it also matches the entire 3::/4 IPv6 network.
33707 You can exclude IPv6 addresses from DNS lookups by making use of a suitable
33708 &%condition%& condition, as in this example:
33710 deny condition = ${if isip4{$sender_host_address}}
33711 dnslists = some.list.example
33714 If an explicit key is being used for a DNS lookup and it may be an IPv6
33715 address you should specify alternate list separators for both the outer
33716 (DNS list name) list and inner (lookup keys) list:
33718 dnslists = <; dnsbl.example.com/<|$acl_m_addrslist
33722 .section "Previously seen user and hosts" "SECTseen"
33723 .cindex "&%seen%& ACL condition"
33724 .cindex greylisting
33725 The &%seen%& ACL condition can be used to test whether a
33726 situation has been previously met.
33727 It uses a hints database to record a timestamp against a key.
33728 The syntax of the condition is:
33730 &`seen =`& <&'optional flag'&><&'time interval'&> &`/`& <&'options'&>
33735 defer seen = -5m / key=${sender_host_address}_$local_part@$domain
33737 in a RCPT ACL will implement simple greylisting.
33739 The parameters for the condition are
33740 a possible minus sign,
33742 then, slash-separated, a list of options.
33743 The interval is taken as an offset before the current time,
33744 and used for the test.
33745 If the interval is preceded by a minus sign then the condition returns
33746 whether a record is found which is before the test time.
33747 Otherwise, the condition returns whether one is found which is since the
33750 Options are read in order with later ones overriding earlier ones.
33752 The default key is &$sender_host_address$&.
33753 An explicit key can be set using a &%key=value%& option.
33755 If a &%readonly%& option is given then
33756 no record create or update is done.
33757 If a &%write%& option is given then
33758 a record create or update is always done.
33759 An update is done if the test is for &"since"&.
33760 If none of those hold and there was no existing record,
33761 a record is created.
33763 Creates and updates are marked with the current time.
33765 Finally, a &"before"& test which succeeds, and for which the record
33766 is old enough, will be refreshed with a timestamp of the test time.
33767 This can prevent tidying of the database from removing the entry.
33768 The interval for this is, by default, 10 days.
33769 An explicit interval can be set using a
33770 &%refresh=value%& option.
33772 Note that &"seen"& should be added to the list of hints databases
33773 for maintenance if this ACL condition is used.
33776 .section "Rate limiting incoming messages" "SECTratelimiting"
33777 .cindex "rate limiting" "client sending"
33778 .cindex "limiting client sending rates"
33779 .oindex "&%smtp_ratelimit_*%&"
33780 The &%ratelimit%& ACL condition can be used to measure and control the rate at
33781 which clients can send email. This is more powerful than the
33782 &%smtp_ratelimit_*%& options, because those options control the rate of
33783 commands in a single SMTP session only, whereas the &%ratelimit%& condition
33784 works across all connections (concurrent and sequential) from the same client
33785 host. The syntax of the &%ratelimit%& condition is:
33787 &`ratelimit =`& <&'m'&> &`/`& <&'p'&> &`/`& <&'options'&> &`/`& <&'key'&>
33789 If the average client sending rate is less than &'m'& messages per time
33790 period &'p'& then the condition is false; otherwise it is true.
33792 As a side-effect, the &%ratelimit%& condition sets the expansion variable
33793 &$sender_rate$& to the client's computed rate, &$sender_rate_limit$& to the
33794 configured value of &'m'&, and &$sender_rate_period$& to the configured value
33797 The parameter &'p'& is the smoothing time constant, in the form of an Exim
33798 time interval, for example, &`8h`& for eight hours. A larger time constant
33799 means that it takes Exim longer to forget a client's past behaviour. The
33800 parameter &'m'& is the maximum number of messages that a client is permitted to
33801 send in each time interval. It also specifies the number of messages permitted
33802 in a fast burst. By increasing both &'m'& and &'p'& but keeping &'m/p'&
33803 constant, you can allow a client to send more messages in a burst without
33804 changing its long-term sending rate limit. Conversely, if &'m'& and &'p'& are
33805 both small, messages must be sent at an even rate.
33807 There is a script in &_util/ratelimit.pl_& which extracts sending rates from
33808 log files, to assist with choosing appropriate settings for &'m'& and &'p'&
33809 when deploying the &%ratelimit%& ACL condition. The script prints usage
33810 instructions when it is run with no arguments.
33812 The key is used to look up the data for calculating the client's average
33813 sending rate. This data is stored in Exim's spool directory, alongside the
33814 retry and other hints databases. The default key is &$sender_host_address$&,
33815 which means Exim computes the sending rate of each client host IP address.
33816 By changing the key you can change how Exim identifies clients for the purpose
33817 of ratelimiting. For example, to limit the sending rate of each authenticated
33818 user, independent of the computer they are sending from, set the key to
33819 &$authenticated_id$&. You must ensure that the lookup key is meaningful; for
33820 example, &$authenticated_id$& is only meaningful if the client has
33821 authenticated (which you can check with the &%authenticated%& ACL condition).
33823 The lookup key does not have to identify clients: If you want to limit the
33824 rate at which a recipient receives messages, you can use the key
33825 &`$local_part@$domain`& with the &%per_rcpt%& option (see below) in a RCPT
33828 Each &%ratelimit%& condition can have up to four options. A &%per_*%& option
33829 specifies what Exim measures the rate of, for example, messages or recipients
33830 or bytes. You can adjust the measurement using the &%unique=%& and/or
33831 &%count=%& options. You can also control when Exim updates the recorded rate
33832 using a &%strict%&, &%leaky%&, or &%readonly%& option. The options are
33833 separated by a slash, like the other parameters. They may appear in any order.
33835 Internally, Exim appends the smoothing constant &'p'& onto the lookup key with
33836 any options that alter the meaning of the stored data. The limit &'m'& is not
33837 stored, so you can alter the configured maximum rate and Exim will still
33838 remember clients' past behaviour. If you change the &%per_*%& mode or add or
33839 remove the &%unique=%& option, the lookup key changes so Exim will forget past
33840 behaviour. The lookup key is not affected by changes to the update mode and
33841 the &%count=%& option.
33844 .subsection "Ratelimit options for what is being measured" ratoptmea
33845 .cindex "rate limiting" "per_* options"
33848 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33849 This option limits the client's connection rate. It is not
33850 normally used in the &%acl_not_smtp%&, &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&, or
33851 &%acl_not_smtp_start%& ACLs.
33854 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33855 This option limits the client's rate of sending messages. This is
33856 the default if none of the &%per_*%& options is specified. It can be used in
33857 &%acl_smtp_mail%&, &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&, &%acl_smtp_mime%&,
33858 &%acl_smtp_data%&, or &%acl_not_smtp%&.
33861 .cindex "rate limiting" per_conn
33862 This option limits the sender's email bandwidth. It can be used in
33863 the same ACLs as the &%per_mail%& option, though it is best to use this option
33864 in the &%acl_smtp_mime%&, &%acl_smtp_data%& or &%acl_not_smtp%& ACLs; if it is
33865 used in an earlier ACL, Exim relies on the SIZE parameter given by the client
33866 in its MAIL command, which may be inaccurate or completely missing. You can
33867 follow the limit &'m'& in the configuration with K, M, or G to specify limits
33868 in kilobytes, megabytes, or gigabytes, respectively.
33871 .cindex "rate limiting" per_rcpt
33872 This option causes Exim to limit the rate at which recipients are
33873 accepted. It can be used in the &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&, &%acl_smtp_predata%&,
33874 &%acl_smtp_mime%&, or &%acl_smtp_data%& ACLs. In
33875 &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& the rate is updated one recipient at a time; in the other
33876 ACLs the rate is updated with the total (accepted) recipient count in one go. Note that
33877 in either case the rate limiting engine will see a message with many
33878 recipients as a large high-speed burst.
33881 .cindex "rate limiting" per_addr
33882 This option is like the &%per_rcpt%& option, except it counts the
33883 number of different recipients that the client has sent messages to in the
33884 last time period. That is, if the client repeatedly sends messages to the same
33885 recipient, its measured rate is not increased. This option can only be used in
33889 .cindex "rate limiting" per_cmd
33890 This option causes Exim to recompute the rate every time the
33891 condition is processed. This can be used to limit the rate of any SMTP
33892 command. If it is used in multiple ACLs it can limit the aggregate rate of
33893 multiple different commands.
33896 .cindex "rate limiting" count
33897 This option can be used to alter how much Exim adds to the client's
33899 A value is required, after an equals sign.
33900 For example, the &%per_byte%& option is equivalent to
33901 &`per_mail/count=$message_size`&.
33902 If there is no &%count=%& option, Exim
33903 increases the measured rate by one (except for the &%per_rcpt%& option in ACLs
33904 other than &%acl_smtp_rcpt%&).
33905 The count does not have to be an integer.
33908 .cindex "rate limiting" unique
33909 This option is described in section &<<ratoptuniq>>& below.
33913 .subsection "Ratelimit update modes" ratoptupd
33914 .cindex "rate limiting" "reading data without updating"
33915 You can specify one of three options with the &%ratelimit%& condition to
33916 control when its database is updated. This section describes the &%readonly%&
33917 mode, and the next section describes the &%strict%& and &%leaky%& modes.
33919 If the &%ratelimit%& condition is used in &%readonly%& mode, Exim looks up a
33920 previously-computed rate to check against the limit.
33922 For example, you can test the client's sending rate and deny it access (when
33923 it is too fast) in the connect ACL. If the client passes this check then it
33924 can go on to send a message, in which case its recorded rate will be updated
33925 in the MAIL ACL. Subsequent connections from the same client will check this
33929 deny ratelimit = 100 / 5m / readonly
33930 log_message = RATE CHECK: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33931 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33934 warn ratelimit = 100 / 5m / strict
33935 log_message = RATE UPDATE: $sender_rate/$sender_rate_period \
33936 (max $sender_rate_limit)
33939 If Exim encounters multiple &%ratelimit%& conditions with the same key when
33940 processing a message then it may increase the client's measured rate more than
33941 it should. For example, this will happen if you check the &%per_rcpt%& option
33942 in both &%acl_smtp_rcpt%& and &%acl_smtp_data%&. However it's OK to check the
33943 same &%ratelimit%& condition multiple times in the same ACL. You can avoid any
33944 multiple update problems by using the &%readonly%& option on later ratelimit
33947 The &%per_*%& options described above do not make sense in some ACLs. If you
33948 use a &%per_*%& option in an ACL where it is not normally permitted then the
33949 update mode defaults to &%readonly%& and you cannot specify the &%strict%& or
33950 &%leaky%& modes. In other ACLs the default update mode is &%leaky%& (see the
33951 next section) so you must specify the &%readonly%& option explicitly.
33954 .subsection "Ratelimit options for handling fast clients" ratoptfast
33955 .cindex "rate limiting" "strict and leaky modes"
33956 If a client's average rate is greater than the maximum, the rate limiting
33957 engine can react in two possible ways, depending on the presence of the
33958 &%strict%& or &%leaky%& update modes. This is independent of the other
33959 counter-measures (such as rejecting the message) that may be specified by the
33962 The &%leaky%& (default) option means that the client's recorded rate is not
33963 updated if it is above the limit. The effect of this is that Exim measures the
33964 client's average rate of successfully sent email,
33965 up to the given limit.
33966 This is appropriate if the countermeasure when the condition is true
33967 consists of refusing the message, and
33968 is generally the better choice if you have clients that retry automatically.
33969 If the action when true is anything more complex then this option is
33970 likely not what is wanted.
33972 The &%strict%& option means that the client's recorded rate is always
33973 updated. The effect of this is that Exim measures the client's average rate
33974 of attempts to send email, which can be much higher than the maximum it is
33975 actually allowed. If the client is over the limit it may be subjected to
33976 counter-measures by the ACL. It must slow down and allow sufficient time to
33977 pass that its computed rate falls below the maximum before it can send email
33978 again. The time (the number of smoothing periods) it must wait and not
33979 attempt to send mail can be calculated with this formula:
33981 ln(peakrate/maxrate)
33985 .subsection "Limiting the rate of different events" ratoptuniq
33986 .cindex "rate limiting" "counting unique events"
33987 The &%ratelimit%& &%unique=%& option controls a mechanism for counting the
33988 rate of different events. For example, the &%per_addr%& option uses this
33989 mechanism to count the number of different recipients that the client has
33990 sent messages to in the last time period; it is equivalent to
33991 &`per_rcpt/unique=$local_part@$domain`&. You could use this feature to
33992 measure the rate that a client uses different sender addresses with the
33993 options &`per_mail/unique=$sender_address`&.
33995 For each &%ratelimit%& key Exim stores the set of &%unique=%& values that it
33996 has seen for that key. The whole set is thrown away when it is older than the
33997 rate smoothing period &'p'&, so each different event is counted at most once
33998 per period. In the &%leaky%& update mode, an event that causes the client to
33999 go over the limit is not added to the set, in the same way that the client's
34000 recorded rate is not updated in the same situation.
34002 When you combine the &%unique=%& and &%readonly%& options, the specific
34003 &%unique=%& value is ignored, and Exim just retrieves the client's stored
34006 The &%unique=%& mechanism needs more space in the ratelimit database than the
34007 other &%ratelimit%& options in order to store the event set. The number of
34008 unique values is potentially as large as the rate limit, so the extra space
34009 required increases with larger limits.
34011 The uniqueification is not perfect: there is a small probability that Exim
34012 will think a new event has happened before. If the sender's rate is less than
34013 the limit, Exim should be more than 99.9% correct. However in &%strict%& mode
34014 the measured rate can go above the limit, in which case Exim may under-count
34015 events by a significant margin. Fortunately, if the rate is high enough (2.7
34016 times the limit) that the false positive rate goes above 9%, then Exim will
34017 throw away the over-full event set before the measured rate falls below the
34018 limit. Therefore the only harm should be that exceptionally high sending rates
34019 are logged incorrectly; any countermeasures you configure will be as effective
34023 .subsection "Using rate limiting" useratlim
34024 Exim's other ACL facilities are used to define what counter-measures are taken
34025 when the rate limit is exceeded. This might be anything from logging a warning
34026 (for example, while measuring existing sending rates in order to define
34027 policy), through time delays to slow down fast senders, up to rejecting the
34028 message. For example:
34030 # Log all senders' rates
34031 warn ratelimit = 0 / 1h / strict
34032 log_message = Sender rate $sender_rate / $sender_rate_period
34034 # Slow down fast senders; note the need to truncate $sender_rate
34035 # at the decimal point.
34036 warn ratelimit = 100 / 1h / per_rcpt / strict
34037 delay = ${eval: ${sg{$sender_rate}{[.].*}{}} - \
34038 $sender_rate_limit }s
34040 # Keep authenticated users under control
34041 deny authenticated = *
34042 ratelimit = 100 / 1d / strict / $authenticated_id
34044 # System-wide rate limit
34045 defer ratelimit = 10 / 1s / $primary_hostname
34046 message = Sorry, too busy. Try again later.
34048 # Restrict incoming rate from each host, with a default
34049 # set using a macro and special cases looked up in a table.
34050 defer ratelimit = ${lookup {$sender_host_address} \
34051 cdb {DB/ratelimits.cdb} \
34052 {$value} {RATELIMIT} }
34053 message = Sender rate exceeds $sender_rate_limit \
34054 messages per $sender_rate_period
34056 &*Warning*&: If you have a busy server with a lot of &%ratelimit%& tests,
34057 especially with the &%per_rcpt%& option, you may suffer from a performance
34058 bottleneck caused by locking on the ratelimit hints database. Apart from
34059 making your ACLs less complicated, you can reduce the problem by using a
34060 RAM disk for Exim's hints directory (usually &_/var/spool/exim/db/_&). However
34061 this means that Exim will lose its hints data after a reboot (including retry
34062 hints, the callout cache, and ratelimit data).
34066 .section "Address verification" "SECTaddressverification"
34067 .cindex "verifying address" "options for"
34068 .cindex "policy control" "address verification"
34069 Several of the &%verify%& conditions described in section
34070 &<<SECTaclconditions>>& cause addresses to be verified. Section
34071 &<<SECTsenaddver>>& discusses the reporting of sender verification failures.
34072 The verification conditions can be followed by options that modify the
34073 verification process. The options are separated from the keyword and from each
34074 other by slashes, and some of them contain parameters. For example:
34076 verify = sender/callout
34077 verify = recipient/defer_ok/callout=10s,defer_ok
34079 The first stage of address verification, which always happens, is to run the
34080 address through the routers, in &"verify mode"&. Routers can detect the
34081 difference between verification and routing for delivery, and their actions can
34082 be varied by a number of generic options such as &%verify%& and &%verify_only%&
34083 (see chapter &<<CHAProutergeneric>>&). If routing fails, verification fails.
34084 The available options are as follows:
34087 If the &%callout%& option is specified, successful routing to one or more
34088 remote hosts is followed by a &"callout"& to those hosts as an additional
34089 check. Callouts and their sub-options are discussed in the next section.
34091 If there is a defer error while doing verification routing, the ACL
34092 normally returns &"defer"&. However, if you include &%defer_ok%& in the
34093 options, the condition is forced to be true instead. Note that this is a main
34094 verification option as well as a suboption for callouts.
34096 The &%no_details%& option is covered in section &<<SECTsenaddver>>&, which
34097 discusses the reporting of sender address verification failures.
34099 The &%success_on_redirect%& option causes verification always to succeed
34100 immediately after a successful redirection. By default, if a redirection
34101 generates just one address, that address is also verified. See further
34102 discussion in section &<<SECTredirwhilveri>>&.
34104 If the &%quota%& option is specified for recipient verify,
34105 successful routing to an appendfile transport is followed by a call into
34106 the transport to evaluate the quota status for the recipient.
34107 No actual delivery is done, but verification will succeed if the quota
34108 is sufficient for the message (if the sender gave a message size) or
34109 not already exceeded (otherwise).
34112 .cindex "verifying address" "differentiating failures"
34113 .vindex "&$recipient_verify_failure$&"
34114 .vindex "&$sender_verify_failure$&"
34115 .vindex "&$acl_verify_message$&"
34116 After an address verification failure, &$acl_verify_message$& contains the
34117 error message that is associated with the failure. It can be preserved by
34120 warn !verify = sender
34121 set acl_m0 = $acl_verify_message
34123 If you are writing your own custom rejection message or log message when
34124 denying access, you can use this variable to include information about the
34125 verification failure.
34126 This variable is cleared at the end of processing the ACL verb.
34128 In addition, &$sender_verify_failure$& or &$recipient_verify_failure$& (as
34129 appropriate) contains one of the following words:
34132 &%qualify%&: The address was unqualified (no domain), and the message
34133 was neither local nor came from an exempted host.
34135 &%route%&: Routing failed.
34137 &%mail%&: Routing succeeded, and a callout was attempted; rejection
34138 occurred at or before the MAIL command (that is, on initial
34139 connection, HELO, or MAIL).
34141 &%recipient%&: The RCPT command in a callout was rejected.
34143 &%postmaster%&: The postmaster check in a callout was rejected.
34145 &%quota%&: The quota check for a local recipient did non pass.
34148 The main use of these variables is expected to be to distinguish between
34149 rejections of MAIL and rejections of RCPT in callouts.
34151 The above variables may also be set after a &*successful*&
34152 address verification to:
34155 &%random%&: A random local-part callout succeeded
34161 .section "Callout verification" "SECTcallver"
34162 .cindex "verifying address" "by callout"
34163 .cindex "callout" "verification"
34164 .cindex "SMTP" "callout verification"
34165 For non-local addresses, routing verifies the domain, but is unable to do any
34166 checking of the local part. There are situations where some means of verifying
34167 the local part is desirable. One way this can be done is to make an SMTP
34168 &'callback'& to a delivery host for the sender address or a &'callforward'& to
34169 a subsequent host for a recipient address, to see if the host accepts the
34170 address. We use the term &'callout'& to cover both cases. Note that for a
34171 sender address, the callback is not to the client host that is trying to
34172 deliver the message, but to one of the hosts that accepts incoming mail for the
34175 Exim does not do callouts by default. If you want them to happen, you must
34176 request them by setting appropriate options on the &%verify%& condition, as
34177 described below. This facility should be used with care, because it can add a
34178 lot of resource usage to the cost of verifying an address. However, Exim does
34179 cache the results of callouts, which helps to reduce the cost. Details of
34180 caching are in section &<<SECTcallvercache>>&.
34182 Recipient callouts are usually used only between hosts that are controlled by
34183 the same administration. For example, a corporate gateway host could use
34184 callouts to check for valid recipients on an internal mailserver. A successful
34185 callout does not guarantee that a real delivery to the address would succeed;
34186 on the other hand, a failing callout does guarantee that a delivery would fail.
34188 If the &%callout%& option is present on a condition that verifies an address, a
34189 second stage of verification occurs if the address is successfully routed to
34190 one or more remote hosts. The usual case is routing by a &(dnslookup)& or a
34191 &(manualroute)& router, where the router specifies the hosts. However, if a
34192 router that does not set up hosts routes to an &(smtp)& transport with a
34193 &%hosts%& setting, the transport's hosts are used. If an &(smtp)& transport has
34194 &%hosts_override%& set, its hosts are always used, whether or not the router
34195 supplies a host list.
34196 Callouts are only supported on &(smtp)& transports.
34198 The port that is used is taken from the transport, if it is specified and is a
34199 remote transport. (For routers that do verification only, no transport need be
34200 specified.) Otherwise, the default SMTP port is used. If a remote transport
34201 specifies an outgoing interface, this is used; otherwise the interface is not
34202 specified. Likewise, the text that is used for the HELO command is taken from
34203 the transport's &%helo_data%& option; if there is no transport, the value of
34204 &$smtp_active_hostname$& is used.
34206 For a sender callout check, Exim makes SMTP connections to the remote hosts, to
34207 test whether a bounce message could be delivered to the sender address. The
34208 following SMTP commands are sent:
34210 &`HELO `&<&'local host name'&>
34212 &`RCPT TO:`&<&'the address to be tested'&>
34215 LHLO is used instead of HELO if the transport's &%protocol%& option is
34218 The callout may use EHLO, AUTH and/or STARTTLS given appropriate option
34221 A recipient callout check is similar. By default, it also uses an empty address
34222 for the sender. This default is chosen because most hosts do not make use of
34223 the sender address when verifying a recipient. Using the same address means
34224 that a single cache entry can be used for each recipient. Some sites, however,
34225 do make use of the sender address when verifying. These are catered for by the
34226 &%use_sender%& and &%use_postmaster%& options, described in the next section.
34228 If the response to the RCPT command is a 2&'xx'& code, the verification
34229 succeeds. If it is 5&'xx'&, the verification fails. For any other condition,
34230 Exim tries the next host, if any. If there is a problem with all the remote
34231 hosts, the ACL yields &"defer"&, unless the &%defer_ok%& parameter of the
34232 &%callout%& option is given, in which case the condition is forced to succeed.
34234 .cindex "SMTP" "output flushing, disabling for callout"
34235 A callout may take a little time. For this reason, Exim normally flushes SMTP
34236 output before performing a callout in an ACL, to avoid unexpected timeouts in
34237 clients when the SMTP PIPELINING extension is in use. The flushing can be
34238 disabled by using a &%control%& modifier to set &%no_callout_flush%&.
34240 .cindex "tainted data" "de-tainting"
34241 .cindex "de-tainting" "using recipient verify"
34242 A recipient callout which gets a 2&'xx'& code
34243 will assign untainted values to the
34244 &$domain_data$& and &$local_part_data$& variables,
34245 corresponding to the domain and local parts of the recipient address.
34250 .subsection "Additional parameters for callouts" CALLaddparcall
34251 .cindex "callout" "additional parameters for"
34252 The &%callout%& option can be followed by an equals sign and a number of
34253 optional parameters, separated by commas. For example:
34255 verify = recipient/callout=10s,defer_ok
34257 The old syntax, which had &%callout_defer_ok%& and &%check_postmaster%& as
34258 separate verify options, is retained for backwards compatibility, but is now
34259 deprecated. The additional parameters for &%callout%& are as follows:
34263 .vitem <&'a&~time&~interval'&>
34264 .cindex "callout" "timeout, specifying"
34265 This specifies the timeout that applies for the callout attempt to each host.
34268 verify = sender/callout=5s
34270 The default is 30 seconds. The timeout is used for each response from the
34271 remote host. It is also used for the initial connection, unless overridden by
34272 the &%connect%& parameter.
34275 .vitem &*connect&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34276 .cindex "callout" "connection timeout, specifying"
34277 This parameter makes it possible to set a different (usually smaller) timeout
34278 for making the SMTP connection. For example:
34280 verify = sender/callout=5s,connect=1s
34282 If not specified, this timeout defaults to the general timeout value.
34284 .vitem &*defer_ok*&
34285 .cindex "callout" "defer, action on"
34286 When this parameter is present, failure to contact any host, or any other kind
34287 of temporary error, is treated as success by the ACL. However, the cache is not
34288 updated in this circumstance.
34290 .vitem &*fullpostmaster*&
34291 .cindex "callout" "full postmaster check"
34292 This operates like the &%postmaster%& option (see below), but if the check for
34293 &'postmaster@domain'& fails, it tries just &'postmaster'&, without a domain, in
34294 accordance with the specification in
34295 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821).
34296 The RFC states that the unqualified address &'postmaster'& should be accepted.
34299 .vitem &*mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
34300 .cindex "callout" "sender when verifying header"
34301 When verifying addresses in header lines using the &%header_sender%&
34302 verification option, Exim behaves by default as if the addresses are envelope
34303 sender addresses from a message. Callout verification therefore tests to see
34304 whether a bounce message could be delivered, by using an empty address in the
34305 MAIL command. However, it is arguable that these addresses might never be used
34306 as envelope senders, and could therefore justifiably reject bounce messages
34307 (empty senders). The &%mailfrom%& callout parameter allows you to specify what
34308 address to use in the MAIL command. For example:
34310 require verify = header_sender/callout=mailfrom=abcd@x.y.z
34312 This parameter is available only for the &%header_sender%& verification option.
34315 .vitem &*maxwait&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34316 .cindex "callout" "overall timeout, specifying"
34317 This parameter sets an overall timeout for performing a callout verification.
34320 verify = sender/callout=5s,maxwait=30s
34322 This timeout defaults to four times the callout timeout for individual SMTP
34323 commands. The overall timeout applies when there is more than one host that can
34324 be tried. The timeout is checked before trying the next host. This prevents
34325 very long delays if there are a large number of hosts and all are timing out
34326 (for example, when network connections are timing out).
34329 .vitem &*no_cache*&
34330 .cindex "callout" "cache, suppressing"
34331 .cindex "caching callout, suppressing"
34332 When this parameter is given, the callout cache is neither read nor updated.
34334 .vitem &*postmaster*&
34335 .cindex "callout" "postmaster; checking"
34336 When this parameter is set, a successful callout check is followed by a similar
34337 check for the local part &'postmaster'& at the same domain. If this address is
34338 rejected, the callout fails (but see &%fullpostmaster%& above). The result of
34339 the postmaster check is recorded in a cache record; if it is a failure, this is
34340 used to fail subsequent callouts for the domain without a connection being
34341 made, until the cache record expires.
34343 .vitem &*postmaster_mailfrom&~=&~*&<&'email&~address'&>
34344 The postmaster check uses an empty sender in the MAIL command by default.
34345 You can use this parameter to do a postmaster check using a different address.
34348 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=abc@x.y.z
34350 If both &%postmaster%& and &%postmaster_mailfrom%& are present, the rightmost
34351 one overrides. The &%postmaster%& parameter is equivalent to this example:
34353 require verify = sender/callout=postmaster_mailfrom=
34355 &*Warning*&: The caching arrangements for postmaster checking do not take
34356 account of the sender address. It is assumed that either the empty address or
34357 a fixed non-empty address will be used. All that Exim remembers is that the
34358 postmaster check for the domain succeeded or failed.
34362 .cindex "callout" "&""random""& check"
34363 When this parameter is set, before doing the normal callout check, Exim does a
34364 check for a &"random"& local part at the same domain. The local part is not
34365 really random &-- it is defined by the expansion of the option
34366 &%callout_random_local_part%&, which defaults to
34368 $primary_hostname-$tod_epoch-testing
34370 The idea here is to try to determine whether the remote host accepts all local
34371 parts without checking. If it does, there is no point in doing callouts for
34372 specific local parts. If the &"random"& check succeeds, the result is saved in
34373 a cache record, and used to force the current and subsequent callout checks to
34374 succeed without a connection being made, until the cache record expires.
34376 .vitem &*use_postmaster*&
34377 .cindex "callout" "sender for recipient check"
34378 This parameter applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34380 deny !verify = recipient/callout=use_postmaster
34382 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
34383 It causes a non-empty postmaster address to be used in the MAIL command when
34384 performing the callout for the recipient, and also for a &"random"& check if
34385 that is configured. The local part of the address is &`postmaster`& and the
34386 domain is the contents of &$qualify_domain$&.
34388 .vitem &*use_sender*&
34389 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34391 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender
34393 It causes the message's actual sender address to be used in the MAIL
34394 command when performing the callout, instead of an empty address. There is no
34395 need to use this option unless you know that the called hosts make use of the
34396 sender when checking recipients. If used indiscriminately, it reduces the
34397 usefulness of callout caching.
34400 This option applies to recipient callouts only. For example:
34402 require verify = recipient/callout=use_sender,hold
34404 It causes the connection to be held open and used for any further recipients
34405 and for eventual delivery (should that be done quickly).
34406 Doing this saves on TCP and SMTP startup costs, and TLS costs also
34407 when that is used for the connections.
34408 The advantage is only gained if there are no callout cache hits
34409 (which could be enforced by the no_cache option),
34410 if the use_sender option is used,
34411 if neither the random nor the use_postmaster option is used,
34412 and if no other callouts intervene.
34415 If you use any of the parameters that set a non-empty sender for the MAIL
34416 command (&%mailfrom%&, &%postmaster_mailfrom%&, &%use_postmaster%&, or
34417 &%use_sender%&), you should think about possible loops. Recipient checking is
34418 usually done between two hosts that are under the same management, and the host
34419 that receives the callouts is not normally configured to do callouts itself.
34420 Therefore, it is normally safe to use &%use_postmaster%& or &%use_sender%& in
34421 these circumstances.
34423 However, if you use a non-empty sender address for a callout to an arbitrary
34424 host, there is the likelihood that the remote host will itself initiate a
34425 callout check back to your host. As it is checking what appears to be a message
34426 sender, it is likely to use an empty address in MAIL, thus avoiding a
34427 callout loop. However, to be on the safe side it would be best to set up your
34428 own ACLs so that they do not do sender verification checks when the recipient
34429 is the address you use for header sender or postmaster callout checking.
34431 Another issue to think about when using non-empty senders for callouts is
34432 caching. When you set &%mailfrom%& or &%use_sender%&, the cache record is keyed
34433 by the sender/recipient combination; thus, for any given recipient, many more
34434 actual callouts are performed than when an empty sender or postmaster is used.
34439 .subsection "Callout caching" SECTcallvercache
34440 .cindex "hints database" "callout cache"
34441 .cindex "callout" "cache, description of"
34442 .cindex "caching" "callout"
34443 Exim caches the results of callouts in order to reduce the amount of resources
34444 used, unless you specify the &%no_cache%& parameter with the &%callout%&
34445 option. A hints database called &"callout"& is used for the cache. Two
34446 different record types are used: one records the result of a callout check for
34447 a specific address, and the other records information that applies to the
34448 entire domain (for example, that it accepts the local part &'postmaster'&).
34450 When an original callout fails, a detailed SMTP error message is given about
34451 the failure. However, for subsequent failures that use the cache data, this message
34454 The expiry times for negative and positive address cache records are
34455 independent, and can be set by the global options &%callout_negative_expire%&
34456 (default 2h) and &%callout_positive_expire%& (default 24h), respectively.
34458 If a host gives a negative response to an SMTP connection, or rejects any
34459 commands up to and including
34463 (but not including the MAIL command with a non-empty address),
34464 any callout attempt is bound to fail. Exim remembers such failures in a
34465 domain cache record, which it uses to fail callouts for the domain without
34466 making new connections, until the domain record times out. There are two
34467 separate expiry times for domain cache records:
34468 &%callout_domain_negative_expire%& (default 3h) and
34469 &%callout_domain_positive_expire%& (default 7d).
34471 Domain records expire when the negative expiry time is reached if callouts
34472 cannot be made for the domain, or if the postmaster check failed.
34473 Otherwise, they expire when the positive expiry time is reached. This
34474 ensures that, for example, a host that stops accepting &"random"& local parts
34475 will eventually be noticed.
34477 The callout caching mechanism is based on the domain of the address that is
34478 being tested. If the domain routes to several hosts, it is assumed that their
34479 behaviour will be the same.
34483 .section "Quota caching" "SECTquotacache"
34484 .cindex "hints database" "quota cache"
34485 .cindex "quota" "cache, description of"
34486 .cindex "caching" "quota"
34487 Exim caches the results of quota verification
34488 in order to reduce the amount of resources used.
34489 The &"callout"& hints database is used.
34491 The default cache periods are five minutes for a positive (good) result
34492 and one hour for a negative result.
34493 To change the periods the &%quota%& option can be followed by an equals sign
34494 and a number of optional paramemters, separated by commas.
34497 verify = recipient/quota=cachepos=1h,cacheneg=1d
34499 Possible parameters are:
34501 .vitem &*cachepos&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34502 .cindex "quota cache" "positive entry expiry, specifying"
34503 Set the lifetime for a positive cache entry.
34504 A value of zero seconds is legitimate.
34506 .vitem &*cacheneg&~=&~*&<&'time&~interval'&>
34507 .cindex "quota cache" "negative entry expiry, specifying"
34508 As above, for a negative entry.
34510 .vitem &*no_cache*&
34511 Set both positive and negative lifetimes to zero.
34513 .section "Sender address verification reporting" "SECTsenaddver"
34514 .cindex "verifying" "suppressing error details"
34515 See section &<<SECTaddressverification>>& for a general discussion of
34516 verification. When sender verification fails in an ACL, the details of the
34517 failure are given as additional output lines before the 550 response to the
34518 relevant SMTP command (RCPT or DATA). For example, if sender callout is in use,
34521 MAIL FROM:<xyz@abc.example>
34523 RCPT TO:<pqr@def.example>
34524 550-Verification failed for <xyz@abc.example>
34525 550-Called: 192.168.34.43
34526 550-Sent: RCPT TO:<xyz@abc.example>
34527 550-Response: 550 Unknown local part xyz in <xyz@abc.example>
34528 550 Sender verification failed
34530 If more than one RCPT command fails in the same way, the details are given
34531 only for the first of them. However, some administrators do not want to send
34532 out this much information. You can suppress the details by adding
34533 &`/no_details`& to the ACL statement that requests sender verification. For
34536 verify = sender/no_details
34539 .section "Redirection while verifying" "SECTredirwhilveri"
34540 .cindex "verifying" "redirection while"
34541 .cindex "address redirection" "while verifying"
34542 A dilemma arises when a local address is redirected by aliasing or forwarding
34543 during verification: should the generated addresses themselves be verified,
34544 or should the successful expansion of the original address be enough to verify
34545 it? By default, Exim takes the following pragmatic approach:
34548 When an incoming address is redirected to just one child address, verification
34549 continues with the child address, and if that fails to verify, the original
34550 verification also fails.
34552 When an incoming address is redirected to more than one child address,
34553 verification does not continue. A success result is returned.
34556 This seems the most reasonable behaviour for the common use of aliasing as a
34557 way of redirecting different local parts to the same mailbox. It means, for
34558 example, that a pair of alias entries of the form
34561 aw123: :fail: Gone away, no forwarding address
34563 work as expected, with both local parts causing verification failure. When a
34564 redirection generates more than one address, the behaviour is more like a
34565 mailing list, where the existence of the alias itself is sufficient for
34566 verification to succeed.
34568 It is possible, however, to change the default behaviour so that all successful
34569 redirections count as successful verifications, however many new addresses are
34570 generated. This is specified by the &%success_on_redirect%& verification
34571 option. For example:
34573 require verify = recipient/success_on_redirect/callout=10s
34575 In this example, verification succeeds if a router generates a new address, and
34576 the callout does not occur, because no address was routed to a remote host.
34578 When verification is being tested via the &%-bv%& option, the treatment of
34579 redirections is as just described, unless the &%-v%& or any debugging option is
34580 also specified. In that case, full verification is done for every generated
34581 address and a report is output for each of them.
34585 .section "Client SMTP authorization (CSA)" "SECTverifyCSA"
34586 .cindex "CSA" "verifying"
34587 Client SMTP Authorization is a system that allows a site to advertise
34588 which machines are and are not permitted to send email. This is done by placing
34589 special SRV records in the DNS; these are looked up using the client's HELO
34590 domain. At the time of writing, CSA is still an Internet Draft. Client SMTP
34591 Authorization checks in Exim are performed by the ACL condition:
34595 This fails if the client is not authorized. If there is a DNS problem, or if no
34596 valid CSA SRV record is found, or if the client is authorized, the condition
34597 succeeds. These three cases can be distinguished using the expansion variable
34598 &$csa_status$&, which can take one of the values &"fail"&, &"defer"&,
34599 &"unknown"&, or &"ok"&. The condition does not itself defer because that would
34600 be likely to cause problems for legitimate email.
34602 The error messages produced by the CSA code include slightly more
34603 detail. If &$csa_status$& is &"defer"&, this may be because of problems
34604 looking up the CSA SRV record, or problems looking up the CSA target
34605 address record. There are four reasons for &$csa_status$& being &"fail"&:
34608 The client's host name is explicitly not authorized.
34610 The client's IP address does not match any of the CSA target IP addresses.
34612 The client's host name is authorized but it has no valid target IP addresses
34613 (for example, the target's addresses are IPv6 and the client is using IPv4).
34615 The client's host name has no CSA SRV record but a parent domain has asserted
34616 that all subdomains must be explicitly authorized.
34619 The &%csa%& verification condition can take an argument which is the domain to
34620 use for the DNS query. The default is:
34622 verify = csa/$sender_helo_name
34624 This implementation includes an extension to CSA. If the query domain
34625 is an address literal such as [192.0.2.95], or if it is a bare IP
34626 address, Exim searches for CSA SRV records in the reverse DNS as if
34627 the HELO domain was (for example) &'95.2.0.192.in-addr.arpa'&. Therefore it is
34630 verify = csa/$sender_host_address
34632 In fact, this is the check that Exim performs if the client does not say HELO.
34633 This extension can be turned off by setting the main configuration option
34634 &%dns_csa_use_reverse%& to be false.
34636 If a CSA SRV record is not found for the domain itself, a search
34637 is performed through its parent domains for a record which might be
34638 making assertions about subdomains. The maximum depth of this search is limited
34639 using the main configuration option &%dns_csa_search_limit%&, which is 5 by
34640 default. Exim does not look for CSA SRV records in a top level domain, so the
34641 default settings handle HELO domains as long as seven
34642 (&'hostname.five.four.three.two.one.com'&). This encompasses the vast majority
34643 of legitimate HELO domains.
34645 The &'dnsdb'& lookup also has support for CSA. Although &'dnsdb'& also supports
34646 direct SRV lookups, this is not sufficient because of the extra parent domain
34647 search behaviour of CSA, and (as with PTR lookups) &'dnsdb'& also turns IP
34648 addresses into lookups in the reverse DNS space. The result of a successful
34651 ${lookup dnsdb {csa=$sender_helo_name}}
34653 has two space-separated fields: an authorization code and a target host name.
34654 The authorization code can be &"Y"& for yes, &"N"& for no, &"X"& for explicit
34655 authorization required but absent, or &"?"& for unknown.
34660 .section "Bounce address tag validation" "SECTverifyPRVS"
34661 .cindex "BATV, verifying"
34662 Bounce address tag validation (BATV) is a scheme whereby the envelope senders
34663 of outgoing messages have a cryptographic, timestamped &"tag"& added to them.
34664 Genuine incoming bounce messages should therefore always be addressed to
34665 recipients that have a valid tag. This scheme is a way of detecting unwanted
34666 bounce messages caused by sender address forgeries (often called &"collateral
34667 spam"&), because the recipients of such messages do not include valid tags.
34669 There are two expansion items to help with the implementation of the BATV
34670 &"prvs"& (private signature) scheme in an Exim configuration. This scheme signs
34671 the original envelope sender address by using a simple key to add a hash of the
34672 address and some time-based randomizing information. The &%prvs%& expansion
34673 item creates a signed address, and the &%prvscheck%& expansion item checks one.
34674 The syntax of these expansion items is described in section
34675 &<<SECTexpansionitems>>&.
34676 The validity period on signed addresses is seven days.
34678 As an example, suppose the secret per-address keys are stored in an MySQL
34679 database. A query to look up the key for an address could be defined as a macro
34682 PRVSCHECK_SQL = ${lookup mysql{SELECT secret FROM batv_prvs \
34683 WHERE sender='${quote_mysql:$prvscheck_address}'\
34686 Suppose also that the senders who make use of BATV are defined by an address
34687 list called &%batv_senders%&. Then, in the ACL for RCPT commands, you could
34690 # Bounces: drop unsigned addresses for BATV senders
34692 recipients = +batv_senders
34693 message = This address does not send an unsigned reverse path
34695 # Bounces: In case of prvs-signed address, check signature.
34697 condition = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}\
34698 {PRVSCHECK_SQL}{1}}
34699 !condition = $prvscheck_result
34700 message = Invalid reverse path signature.
34702 The first statement rejects recipients for bounce messages that are addressed
34703 to plain BATV sender addresses, because it is known that BATV senders do not
34704 send out messages with plain sender addresses. The second statement rejects
34705 recipients that are prvs-signed, but with invalid signatures (either because
34706 the key is wrong, or the signature has timed out).
34708 A non-prvs-signed address is not rejected by the second statement, because the
34709 &%prvscheck%& expansion yields an empty string if its first argument is not a
34710 prvs-signed address, thus causing the &%condition%& condition to be false. If
34711 the first argument is a syntactically valid prvs-signed address, the yield is
34712 the third string (in this case &"1"&), whether or not the cryptographic and
34713 timeout checks succeed. The &$prvscheck_result$& variable contains the result
34714 of the checks (empty for failure, &"1"& for success).
34716 There is one more issue you must consider when implementing prvs-signing:
34717 you have to ensure that the routers accept prvs-signed addresses and
34718 deliver them correctly. The easiest way to handle this is to use a &(redirect)&
34719 router to remove the signature with a configuration along these lines:
34723 data = ${prvscheck {$local_part@$domain}{PRVSCHECK_SQL}}
34725 This works because, if the third argument of &%prvscheck%& is empty, the result
34726 of the expansion of a prvs-signed address is the decoded value of the original
34727 address. This router should probably be the first of your routers that handles
34730 To create BATV-signed addresses in the first place, a transport of this form
34733 external_smtp_batv:
34735 return_path = ${prvs {$return_path} \
34736 {${lookup mysql{SELECT \
34737 secret FROM batv_prvs WHERE \
34738 sender='${quote_mysql:$sender_address}'} \
34741 If no key can be found for the existing return path, no signing takes place.
34745 .section "Using an ACL to control relaying" "SECTrelaycontrol"
34746 .cindex "&ACL;" "relay control"
34747 .cindex "relaying" "control by ACL"
34748 .cindex "policy control" "relay control"
34749 An MTA is said to &'relay'& a message if it receives it from some host and
34750 delivers it directly to another host as a result of a remote address contained
34751 within it. Redirecting a local address via an alias or forward file and then
34752 passing the message on to another host is not relaying,
34753 .cindex "&""percent hack""&"
34754 but a redirection as a result of the &"percent hack"& is.
34756 Two kinds of relaying exist, which are termed &"incoming"& and &"outgoing"&.
34757 A host which is acting as a gateway or an MX backup is concerned with incoming
34758 relaying from arbitrary hosts to a specific set of domains. On the other hand,
34759 a host which is acting as a smart host for a number of clients is concerned
34760 with outgoing relaying from those clients to the Internet at large. Often the
34761 same host is fulfilling both functions,
34763 . as illustrated in the diagram below,
34765 but in principle these two kinds of relaying are entirely independent. What is
34766 not wanted is the transmission of mail from arbitrary remote hosts through your
34767 system to arbitrary domains.
34770 You can implement relay control by means of suitable statements in the ACL that
34771 runs for each RCPT command. For convenience, it is often easiest to use
34772 Exim's named list facility to define the domains and hosts involved. For
34773 example, suppose you want to do the following:
34776 Deliver a number of domains to mailboxes on the local host (or process them
34777 locally in some other way). Let's say these are &'my.dom1.example'& and
34778 &'my.dom2.example'&.
34780 Relay mail for a number of other domains for which you are the secondary MX.
34781 These might be &'friend1.example'& and &'friend2.example'&.
34783 Relay mail from the hosts on your local LAN, to whatever domains are involved.
34784 Suppose your LAN is 192.168.45.0/24.
34788 In the main part of the configuration, you put the following definitions:
34790 domainlist local_domains = my.dom1.example : my.dom2.example
34791 domainlist relay_to_domains = friend1.example : friend2.example
34792 hostlist relay_from_hosts = 192.168.45.0/24
34794 Now you can use these definitions in the ACL that is run for every RCPT
34798 accept domains = +local_domains : +relay_to_domains
34799 accept hosts = +relay_from_hosts
34801 The first statement accepts any RCPT command that contains an address in
34802 the local or relay domains. For any other domain, control passes to the second
34803 statement, which accepts the command only if it comes from one of the relay
34804 hosts. In practice, you will probably want to make your ACL more sophisticated
34805 than this, for example, by including sender and recipient verification. The
34806 default configuration includes a more comprehensive example, which is described
34807 in chapter &<<CHAPdefconfil>>&.
34811 .section "Checking a relay configuration" "SECTcheralcon"
34812 .cindex "relaying" "checking control of"
34813 You can check the relay characteristics of your configuration in the same way
34814 that you can test any ACL behaviour for an incoming SMTP connection, by using
34815 the &%-bh%& option to run a fake SMTP session with which you interact.
34820 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34821 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
34823 .chapter "Content scanning at ACL time" "CHAPexiscan"
34824 .scindex IIDcosca "content scanning" "at ACL time"
34825 The extension of Exim to include content scanning at ACL time, formerly known
34826 as &"exiscan"&, was originally implemented as a patch by Tom Kistner. The code
34827 was integrated into the main source for Exim release 4.50, and Tom continues to
34828 maintain it. Most of the wording of this chapter is taken from Tom's
34831 It is also possible to scan the content of messages at other times. The
34832 &[local_scan()]& function (see chapter &<<CHAPlocalscan>>&) allows for content
34833 scanning after all the ACLs have run. A transport filter can be used to scan
34834 messages at delivery time (see the &%transport_filter%& option, described in
34835 chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&).
34837 If you want to include the ACL-time content-scanning features when you compile
34838 Exim, you need to arrange for WITH_CONTENT_SCAN to be defined in your
34839 &_Local/Makefile_&. When you do that, the Exim binary is built with:
34842 Two additional ACLs (&%acl_smtp_mime%& and &%acl_not_smtp_mime%&) that are run
34843 for all MIME parts for SMTP and non-SMTP messages, respectively.
34845 Additional ACL conditions and modifiers: &%decode%&, &%malware%&,
34846 &%mime_regex%&, &%regex%&, and &%spam%&. These can be used in the ACL that is
34847 run at the end of message reception (the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL).
34849 An additional control feature (&"no_mbox_unspool"&) that saves spooled copies
34850 of messages, or parts of messages, for debugging purposes.
34852 Additional expansion variables that are set in the new ACL and by the new
34855 Two new main configuration options: &%av_scanner%& and &%spamd_address%&.
34858 Content-scanning is continually evolving, and new features are still being
34859 added. While such features are still unstable and liable to incompatible
34860 changes, they are made available in Exim by setting options whose names begin
34861 EXPERIMENTAL_ in &_Local/Makefile_&. Such features are not documented in
34862 this manual. You can find out about them by reading the file called
34863 &_doc/experimental.txt_&.
34865 All the content-scanning facilities work on a MBOX copy of the message that is
34866 temporarily created in a file called:
34868 <&'spool_directory'&>&`/scan/`&<&'message_id'&>/<&'message_id'&>&`.eml`&
34870 The &_.eml_& extension is a friendly hint to virus scanners that they can
34871 expect an MBOX-like structure inside that file. The file is created when the
34872 first content scanning facility is called. Subsequent calls to content
34873 scanning conditions open the same file again. The directory is recursively
34874 removed when the &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL has finished running, unless
34876 control = no_mbox_unspool
34878 has been encountered. When the MIME ACL decodes files, they are put into the
34879 same directory by default.
34883 .section "Scanning for viruses" "SECTscanvirus"
34884 .cindex "virus scanning"
34885 .cindex "content scanning" "for viruses"
34886 .cindex "content scanning" "the &%malware%& condition"
34887 The &%malware%& ACL condition lets you connect virus scanner software to Exim.
34888 It supports a &"generic"& interface to scanners called via the shell, and
34889 specialized interfaces for &"daemon"& type virus scanners, which are resident
34890 in memory and thus are much faster.
34892 Since message data needs to have arrived,
34893 the condition may be only called in ACL defined by
34895 &%acl_smtp_data_prdr%&,
34896 &%acl_smtp_mime%& or
34899 A timeout of 2 minutes is applied to a scanner call (by default);
34900 if it expires then a defer action is taken.
34902 .oindex "&%av_scanner%&"
34903 You can set the &%av_scanner%& option in the main part of the configuration
34904 to specify which scanner to use, together with any additional options that
34905 are needed. The basic syntax is as follows:
34907 &`av_scanner = <`&&'scanner-type'&&`>:<`&&'option1'&&`>:<`&&'option2'&&`>:[...]`&
34909 If you do not set &%av_scanner%&, it defaults to
34911 av_scanner = sophie:/var/run/sophie
34913 If the value of &%av_scanner%& starts with a dollar character, it is expanded
34915 The usual list-parsing of the content (see &<<SECTlistconstruct>>&) applies.
34916 The following scanner types are supported in this release,
34917 though individual ones can be included or not at build time:
34921 .cindex "virus scanners" "avast"
34922 This is the scanner daemon of Avast. It has been tested with Avast Core
34923 Security (currently at version 2.2.0).
34924 You can get a trial version at &url(https://www.avast.com) or for Linux
34925 at &url(https://www.avast.com/linux-server-antivirus).
34926 This scanner type takes one option,
34927 which can be either a full path to a UNIX socket,
34928 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
34929 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
34930 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
34931 A list of options may follow. These options are interpreted on the
34932 Exim's side of the malware scanner, or are given on separate lines to
34933 the daemon as options before the main scan command.
34935 .cindex &`pass_unscanned`& "avast"
34936 If &`pass_unscanned`&
34937 is set, any files the Avast scanner can't scan (e.g.
34938 decompression bombs, or invalid archives) are considered clean. Use with
34943 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34944 av_scanner = avast:/var/run/avast/scan.sock:pass_unscanned:FLAGS -fullfiles:SENSITIVITY -pup
34945 av_scanner = avast:192.168.2.22 5036
34947 If you omit the argument, the default path
34948 &_/var/run/avast/scan.sock_&
34950 If you use a remote host,
34951 you need to make Exim's spool directory available to it,
34952 as the scanner is passed a file path, not file contents.
34953 For information about available commands and their options you may use
34955 $ socat UNIX:/var/run/avast/scan.sock STDIO:
34961 If the scanner returns a temporary failure (e.g. license issues, or
34962 permission problems), the message is deferred and a paniclog entry is
34963 written. The usual &`defer_ok`& option is available.
34965 .vitem &%aveserver%&
34966 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
34967 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 5. You can get a trial version
34968 at &url(https://www.kaspersky.com/). This scanner type takes one option,
34969 which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket. The default is shown in this
34972 av_scanner = aveserver:/var/run/aveserver
34977 .cindex "virus scanners" "clamd"
34978 This daemon-type scanner is GPL and free. You can get it at
34979 &url(https://www.clamav.net/). Some older versions of clamd do not seem to
34980 unpack MIME containers, so it used to be recommended to unpack MIME attachments
34981 in the MIME ACL. This is no longer believed to be necessary.
34983 The options are a list of server specifiers, which may be
34984 a UNIX socket specification,
34985 a TCP socket specification,
34986 or a (global) option.
34988 A socket specification consists of a space-separated list.
34989 For a Unix socket the first element is a full path for the socket,
34990 for a TCP socket the first element is the IP address
34991 and the second a port number,
34992 Any further elements are per-server (non-global) options.
34993 These per-server options are supported:
34995 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
34998 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
34999 a failed connect is made. The default is to not retry.
35001 If a Unix socket file is specified, only one server is supported.
35005 av_scanner = clamd:/opt/clamd/socket
35006 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234
35007 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234:local
35008 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 retry=10s
35009 av_scanner = clamd:192.0.2.3 1234 : 192.0.2.4 1234
35011 If the value of av_scanner points to a UNIX socket file or contains the
35013 option, then the ClamAV interface will pass a filename containing the data
35014 to be scanned, which should normally result in less I/O happening and be
35015 more efficient. Normally in the TCP case, the data is streamed to ClamAV as
35016 Exim does not assume that there is a common filesystem with the remote host.
35018 The final example shows that multiple TCP targets can be specified. Exim will
35019 randomly use one for each incoming email (i.e. it load balances them). Note
35020 that only TCP targets may be used if specifying a list of scanners; a UNIX
35021 socket cannot be mixed in with TCP targets. If one of the servers becomes
35022 unavailable, Exim will try the remaining one(s) until it finds one that works.
35023 When a clamd server becomes unreachable, Exim will log a message. Exim does
35024 not keep track of scanner state between multiple messages, and the scanner
35025 selection is random, so the message will get logged in the mainlog for each
35026 email that the down scanner gets chosen first (message wrapped to be readable):
35028 2013-10-09 14:30:39 1VTumd-0000Y8-BQ malware acl condition:
35029 clamd: connection to localhost, port 3310 failed
35030 (Connection refused)
35033 If the option is unset, the default is &_/tmp/clamd_&. Thanks to David Saez for
35034 contributing the code for this scanner.
35037 .cindex "virus scanners" "command line interface"
35038 This is the keyword for the generic command line scanner interface. It can be
35039 used to attach virus scanners that are invoked from the shell. This scanner
35040 type takes 3 mandatory options:
35043 The full path and name of the scanner binary, with all command line options,
35044 and a placeholder (&`%s`&) for the directory to scan.
35047 A regular expression to match against the STDOUT and STDERR output of the
35048 virus scanner. If the expression matches, a virus was found. You must make
35049 absolutely sure that this expression matches on &"virus found"&. This is called
35050 the &"trigger"& expression.
35053 Another regular expression, containing exactly one pair of parentheses, to
35054 match the name of the virus found in the scanners output. This is called the
35055 &"name"& expression.
35058 For example, Sophos Sweep reports a virus on a line like this:
35060 Virus 'W32/Magistr-B' found in file ./those.bat
35062 For the trigger expression, we can match the phrase &"found in file"&. For the
35063 name expression, we want to extract the W32/Magistr-B string, so we can match
35064 for the single quotes left and right of it. Altogether, this makes the
35065 configuration setting:
35067 av_scanner = cmdline:\
35068 /path/to/sweep -ss -all -rec -archive %s:\
35069 found in file:'(.+)'
35072 .cindex "virus scanners" "DrWeb"
35073 The DrWeb daemon scanner (&url(https://www.sald.ru/)) interface
35075 either a full path to a UNIX socket,
35076 or host and port specifiers separated by white space.
35077 The host may be a name or an IP address; the port is either a
35078 single number or a pair of numbers with a dash between.
35081 av_scanner = drweb:/var/run/drwebd.sock
35082 av_scanner = drweb:192.168.2.20 31337
35084 If you omit the argument, the default path &_/usr/local/drweb/run/drwebd.sock_&
35085 is used. Thanks to Alex Miller for contributing the code for this scanner.
35088 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-protd"
35089 The f-protd scanner is accessed via HTTP over TCP.
35090 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number
35094 av_scanner = f-protd:localhost 10200-10204
35096 If you omit the argument, the default values shown above are used.
35098 .vitem &%f-prot6d%&
35099 .cindex "virus scanners" "f-prot6d"
35100 The f-prot6d scanner is accessed using the FPSCAND protocol over TCP.
35101 One argument is taken, being a space-separated hostname and port number.
35104 av_scanner = f-prot6d:localhost 10200
35106 If you omit the argument, the default values show above are used.
35109 .cindex "virus scanners" "F-Secure"
35110 The F-Secure daemon scanner (&url(https://www.f-secure.com/)) takes one
35111 argument which is the path to a UNIX socket. For example:
35113 av_scanner = fsecure:/path/to/.fsav
35115 If no argument is given, the default is &_/var/run/.fsav_&. Thanks to Johan
35116 Thelmen for contributing the code for this scanner.
35118 .vitem &%kavdaemon%&
35119 .cindex "virus scanners" "Kaspersky"
35120 This is the scanner daemon of Kaspersky Version 4. This version of the
35121 Kaspersky scanner is outdated. Please upgrade (see &%aveserver%& above). This
35122 scanner type takes one option, which is the path to the daemon's UNIX socket.
35125 av_scanner = kavdaemon:/opt/AVP/AvpCtl
35127 The default path is &_/var/run/AvpCtl_&.
35130 .cindex "virus scanners" "mksd"
35131 This was a daemon type scanner that is aimed mainly at Polish users,
35132 though some documentation was available in English.
35133 The history can be shown at &url(https://en.wikipedia.org/wiki/Mks_vir)
35134 and this appears to be a candidate for removal from Exim, unless
35135 we are informed of other virus scanners which use the same protocol
35137 The only option for this scanner type is
35138 the maximum number of processes used simultaneously to scan the attachments,
35139 provided that mksd has
35140 been run with at least the same number of child processes. For example:
35142 av_scanner = mksd:2
35144 You can safely omit this option (the default value is 1).
35147 .cindex "virus scanners" "simple socket-connected"
35148 This is a general-purpose way of talking to simple scanner daemons
35149 running on the local machine.
35150 There are four options:
35151 an address (which may be an IP address and port, or the path of a Unix socket),
35152 a commandline to send (may include a single %s which will be replaced with
35153 the path to the mail file to be scanned),
35154 an RE to trigger on from the returned data,
35155 and an RE to extract malware_name from the returned data.
35158 av_scanner = sock:127.0.0.1 6001:%s:(SPAM|VIRUS):(.*)$
35160 Note that surrounding whitespace is stripped from each option, meaning
35161 there is no way to specify a trailing newline.
35162 The socket specifier and both regular-expressions are required.
35163 Default for the commandline is &_%s\n_& (note this does have a trailing newline);
35164 specify an empty element to get this.
35167 .cindex "virus scanners" "Sophos and Sophie"
35168 Sophie is a daemon that uses Sophos' &%libsavi%& library to scan for viruses.
35169 You can get Sophie at &url(http://sophie.sourceforge.net/). The only option
35170 for this scanner type is the path to the UNIX socket that Sophie uses for
35171 client communication. For example:
35173 av_scanner = sophie:/tmp/sophie
35175 The default path is &_/var/run/sophie_&, so if you are using this, you can omit
35179 When &%av_scanner%& is correctly set, you can use the &%malware%& condition in
35180 the DATA ACL. &*Note*&: You cannot use the &%malware%& condition in the MIME
35183 The &%av_scanner%& option is expanded each time &%malware%& is called. This
35184 makes it possible to use different scanners. See further below for an example.
35185 The &%malware%& condition caches its results, so when you use it multiple times
35186 for the same message, the actual scanning process is only carried out once.
35187 However, using expandable items in &%av_scanner%& disables this caching, in
35188 which case each use of the &%malware%& condition causes a new scan of the
35191 The &%malware%& condition takes a right-hand argument that is expanded before
35192 use and taken as a list, slash-separated by default.
35193 The first element can then be one of
35196 &"true"&, &"*"&, or &"1"&, in which case the message is scanned for viruses.
35197 The condition succeeds if a virus was found, and fail otherwise. This is the
35200 &"false"& or &"0"& or an empty string, in which case no scanning is done and
35201 the condition fails immediately.
35203 A regular expression, in which case the message is scanned for viruses. The
35204 condition succeeds if a virus is found and its name matches the regular
35205 expression. This allows you to take special actions on certain types of virus.
35206 Note that &"/"& characters in the RE must be doubled due to the list-processing,
35207 unless the separator is changed (in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&).
35210 You can append a &`defer_ok`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to accept
35211 messages even if there is a problem with the virus scanner.
35212 Otherwise, such a problem causes the ACL to defer.
35214 You can append a &`tmo=<val>`& element to the &%malware%& argument list to
35215 specify a non-default timeout. The default is two minutes.
35218 malware = * / defer_ok / tmo=10s
35220 A timeout causes the ACL to defer.
35222 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
35223 When a connection is made to the scanner the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
35224 is set to record the actual address used.
35226 .vindex "&$malware_name$&"
35227 When a virus is found, the condition sets up an expansion variable called
35228 &$malware_name$& that contains the name of the virus. You can use it in a
35229 &%message%& modifier that specifies the error returned to the sender, and/or in
35232 Beware the interaction of Exim's &%message_size_limit%& with any size limits
35233 imposed by your anti-virus scanner.
35235 Here is a very simple scanning example:
35238 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35240 The next example accepts messages when there is a problem with the scanner:
35242 deny malware = */defer_ok
35243 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35245 The next example shows how to use an ACL variable to scan with both sophie and
35246 aveserver. It assumes you have set:
35248 av_scanner = $acl_m0
35250 in the main Exim configuration.
35252 deny set acl_m0 = sophie
35254 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35256 deny set acl_m0 = aveserver
35258 message = This message contains malware ($malware_name)
35262 .section "Scanning with SpamAssassin and Rspamd" "SECTscanspamass"
35263 .cindex "content scanning" "for spam"
35264 .cindex "spam scanning"
35265 .cindex "SpamAssassin"
35267 The &%spam%& ACL condition calls SpamAssassin's &%spamd%& daemon to get a spam
35268 score and a report for the message.
35269 Support is also provided for Rspamd.
35271 For more information about installation and configuration of SpamAssassin or
35272 Rspamd refer to their respective websites at
35273 &url(https://spamassassin.apache.org/) and &url(https://www.rspamd.com/)
35275 SpamAssassin can be installed with CPAN by running:
35277 perl -MCPAN -e 'install Mail::SpamAssassin'
35279 SpamAssassin has its own set of configuration files. Please review its
35280 documentation to see how you can tweak it. The default installation should work
35283 .oindex "&%spamd_address%&"
35284 By default, SpamAssassin listens on 127.0.0.1, TCP port 783 and if you
35285 intend to use an instance running on the local host you do not need to set
35286 &%spamd_address%&. If you intend to use another host or port for SpamAssassin,
35287 you must set the &%spamd_address%& option in the global part of the Exim
35288 configuration as follows (example):
35290 spamd_address = 192.168.99.45 783
35292 The SpamAssassin protocol relies on a TCP half-close from the client.
35293 If your SpamAssassin client side is running a Linux system with an
35294 iptables firewall, consider setting
35295 &%net.netfilter.nf_conntrack_tcp_timeout_close_wait%& to at least the
35296 timeout, Exim uses when waiting for a response from the SpamAssassin
35297 server (currently defaulting to 120s). With a lower value the Linux
35298 connection tracking may consider your half-closed connection as dead too
35302 To use Rspamd (which by default listens on all local addresses
35304 you should add &%variant=rspamd%& after the address/port pair, for example:
35306 spamd_address = 127.0.0.1 11333 variant=rspamd
35309 As of version 2.60, &%SpamAssassin%& also supports communication over UNIX
35310 sockets. If you want to us these, supply &%spamd_address%& with an absolute
35311 filename instead of an address/port pair:
35313 spamd_address = /var/run/spamd_socket
35315 You can have multiple &%spamd%& servers to improve scalability. These can
35316 reside on other hardware reachable over the network. To specify multiple
35317 &%spamd%& servers, put multiple address/port pairs in the &%spamd_address%&
35318 option, separated with colons (the separator can be changed in the usual way &<<SECTlistsepchange>>&):
35320 spamd_address = 192.168.2.10 783 : \
35321 192.168.2.11 783 : \
35324 Up to 32 &%spamd%& servers are supported.
35325 When a server fails to respond to the connection attempt, all other
35326 servers are tried until one succeeds. If no server responds, the &%spam%&
35329 Unix and TCP socket specifications may be mixed in any order.
35330 Each element of the list is a list itself, space-separated by default
35331 and changeable in the usual way (&<<SECTlistsepchange>>&);
35332 take care to not double the separator.
35334 For TCP socket specifications a host name or IP (v4 or v6, but
35335 subject to list-separator quoting rules) address can be used,
35336 and the port can be one or a dash-separated pair.
35337 In the latter case, the range is tried in strict order.
35339 Elements after the first for Unix sockets, or second for TCP socket,
35341 The supported options are:
35343 pri=<priority> Selection priority
35344 weight=<value> Selection bias
35345 time=<start>-<end> Use only between these times of day
35346 retry=<timespec> Retry on connect fail
35347 tmo=<timespec> Connection time limit
35348 variant=rspamd Use Rspamd rather than SpamAssassin protocol
35351 The &`pri`& option specifies a priority for the server within the list,
35352 higher values being tried first.
35353 The default priority is 1.
35355 The &`weight`& option specifies a selection bias.
35356 Within a priority set
35357 servers are queried in a random fashion, weighted by this value.
35358 The default value for selection bias is 1.
35360 Time specifications for the &`time`& option are <hour>.<minute>.<second>
35361 in the local time zone; each element being one or more digits.
35362 Either the seconds or both minutes and seconds, plus the leading &`.`&
35363 characters, may be omitted and will be taken as zero.
35365 Timeout specifications for the &`retry`& and &`tmo`& options
35366 are the usual Exim time interval standard, e.g. &`20s`& or &`1m`&.
35368 The &`tmo`& option specifies an overall timeout for communication.
35369 The default value is two minutes.
35371 The &`retry`& option specifies a time after which a single retry for
35372 a failed connect is made.
35373 The default is to not retry.
35375 The &%spamd_address%& variable is expanded before use if it starts with
35376 a dollar sign. In this case, the expansion may return a string that is
35377 used as the list so that multiple spamd servers can be the result of an
35380 .vindex "&$callout_address$&"
35381 When a connection is made to the server the expansion variable &$callout_address$&
35382 is set to record the actual address used.
35384 .section "Calling SpamAssassin from an Exim ACL" "SECID206"
35385 Here is a simple example of the use of the &%spam%& condition in a DATA ACL:
35388 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35390 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition specifies a name. This is
35391 relevant if you have set up multiple SpamAssassin profiles. If you do not want
35392 to scan using a specific profile, but rather use the SpamAssassin system-wide
35393 default profile, you can scan for an unknown name, or simply use &"nobody"&.
35394 Rspamd does not use this setting. However, you must put something on the
35397 The name allows you to use per-domain or per-user antispam profiles in
35398 principle, but this is not straightforward in practice, because a message may
35399 have multiple recipients, not necessarily all in the same domain. Because the
35400 &%spam%& condition has to be called from a DATA-time ACL in order to be able to
35401 read the contents of the message, the variables &$local_part$& and &$domain$&
35403 Careful enforcement of single-recipient messages
35404 (e.g. by responding with defer in the recipient ACL for all recipients
35406 or the use of PRDR,
35407 .cindex "PRDR" "use for per-user SpamAssassin profiles"
35408 are needed to use this feature.
35410 The right-hand side of the &%spam%& condition is expanded before being used, so
35411 you can put lookups or conditions there. When the right-hand side evaluates to
35412 &"0"& or &"false"&, no scanning is done and the condition fails immediately.
35415 Scanning with SpamAssassin uses a lot of resources. If you scan every message,
35416 large ones may cause significant performance degradation. As most spam messages
35417 are quite small, it is recommended that you do not scan the big ones. For
35420 deny condition = ${if < {$message_size}{10K}}
35422 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35425 The &%spam%& condition returns true if the threshold specified in the user's
35426 SpamAssassin profile has been matched or exceeded. If you want to use the
35427 &%spam%& condition for its side effects (see the variables below), you can make
35428 it always return &"true"& by appending &`:true`& to the username.
35430 .cindex "spam scanning" "returned variables"
35431 When the &%spam%& condition is run, it sets up a number of expansion
35433 Except for &$spam_report$&,
35434 these variables are saved with the received message so are
35435 available for use at delivery time.
35438 .vitem &$spam_score$&
35439 The spam score of the message, for example, &"3.4"& or &"30.5"&. This is useful
35440 for inclusion in log or reject messages.
35442 .vitem &$spam_score_int$&
35443 The spam score of the message, multiplied by ten, as an integer value. For
35444 example &"34"& or &"305"&. It may appear to disagree with &$spam_score$&
35445 because &$spam_score$& is rounded and &$spam_score_int$& is truncated.
35446 The integer value is useful for numeric comparisons in conditions.
35448 .vitem &$spam_bar$&
35449 A string consisting of a number of &"+"& or &"-"& characters, representing the
35450 integer part of the spam score value. A spam score of 4.4 would have a
35451 &$spam_bar$& value of &"++++"&. This is useful for inclusion in warning
35452 headers, since MUAs can match on such strings. The maximum length of the
35453 spam bar is 50 characters.
35455 .vitem &$spam_report$&
35456 A multiline text table, containing the full SpamAssassin report for the
35457 message. Useful for inclusion in headers or reject messages.
35458 This variable is only usable in a DATA-time ACL.
35459 Beware that SpamAssassin may return non-ASCII characters, especially
35460 when running in country-specific locales, which are not legal
35461 unencoded in headers.
35463 .vitem &$spam_action$&
35464 For SpamAssassin either 'reject' or 'no action' depending on the
35465 spam score versus threshold.
35466 For Rspamd, the recommended action.
35470 The &%spam%& condition caches its results unless expansion in
35471 spamd_address was used. If you call it again with the same user name, it
35472 does not scan again, but rather returns the same values as before.
35474 The &%spam%& condition returns DEFER if there is any error while running
35475 the message through SpamAssassin or if the expansion of spamd_address
35476 failed. If you want to treat DEFER as FAIL (to pass on to the next ACL
35477 statement block), append &`/defer_ok`& to the right-hand side of the
35478 spam condition, like this:
35480 deny spam = joe/defer_ok
35481 message = This message was classified as SPAM
35483 This causes messages to be accepted even if there is a problem with &%spamd%&.
35485 Here is a longer, commented example of the use of the &%spam%&
35488 # put headers in all messages (no matter if spam or not)
35489 warn spam = nobody:true
35490 add_header = X-Spam-Score: $spam_score ($spam_bar)
35491 add_header = X-Spam-Report: $spam_report
35493 # add second subject line with *SPAM* marker when message
35494 # is over threshold
35496 add_header = Subject: *SPAM* $h_Subject:
35498 # reject spam at high scores (> 12)
35499 deny spam = nobody:true
35500 condition = ${if >{$spam_score_int}{120}{1}{0}}
35501 message = This message scored $spam_score spam points.
35506 .section "Scanning MIME parts" "SECTscanmimepart"
35507 .cindex "content scanning" "MIME parts"
35508 .cindex "MIME content scanning"
35509 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_mime%&"
35510 .oindex "&%acl_not_smtp_mime%&"
35511 The &%acl_smtp_mime%& global option specifies an ACL that is called once for
35512 each MIME part of an SMTP message, including multipart types, in the sequence
35513 of their position in the message. Similarly, the &%acl_not_smtp_mime%& option
35514 specifies an ACL that is used for the MIME parts of non-SMTP messages. These
35515 options may both refer to the same ACL if you want the same processing in both
35518 These ACLs are called (possibly many times) just before the &%acl_smtp_data%&
35519 ACL in the case of an SMTP message, or just before the &%acl_not_smtp%& ACL in
35520 the case of a non-SMTP message. However, a MIME ACL is called only if the
35521 message contains a &'Content-Type:'& header line. When a call to a MIME
35522 ACL does not yield &"accept"&, ACL processing is aborted and the appropriate
35523 result code is sent to the client. In the case of an SMTP message, the
35524 &%acl_smtp_data%& ACL is not called when this happens.
35526 You cannot use the &%malware%& or &%spam%& conditions in a MIME ACL; these can
35527 only be used in the DATA or non-SMTP ACLs. However, you can use the &%regex%&
35528 condition to match against the raw MIME part. You can also use the
35529 &%mime_regex%& condition to match against the decoded MIME part (see section
35530 &<<SECTscanregex>>&).
35532 At the start of a MIME ACL, a number of variables are set from the header
35533 information for the relevant MIME part. These are described below. The contents
35534 of the MIME part are not by default decoded into a disk file except for MIME
35535 parts whose content-type is &"message/rfc822"&. If you want to decode a MIME
35536 part into a disk file, you can use the &%decode%& condition. The general
35539 &`decode = [/`&<&'path'&>&`/]`&<&'filename'&>
35541 The right hand side is expanded before use. After expansion,
35545 &"0"& or &"false"&, in which case no decoding is done.
35547 The string &"default"&. In that case, the file is put in the temporary
35548 &"default"& directory <&'spool_directory'&>&_/scan/_&<&'message_id'&>&_/_& with
35549 a sequential filename consisting of the message id and a sequence number. The
35550 full path and name is available in &$mime_decoded_filename$& after decoding.
35552 A full path name starting with a slash. If the full name is an existing
35553 directory, it is used as a replacement for the default directory. The filename
35554 is then sequentially assigned. If the path does not exist, it is used as
35555 the full path and filename.
35557 If the string does not start with a slash, it is used as the
35558 filename, and the default path is then used.
35560 The &%decode%& condition normally succeeds. It is only false for syntax
35561 errors or unusual circumstances such as memory shortages.
35562 The variable &$mime_filename$& will have the suggested name for the file.
35563 Note however that this might contain anything, and is very difficult
35564 to safely use as all or even part of the filename.
35565 If you place files outside of the default path, they are not
35566 automatically unlinked.
35568 For RFC822 attachments (these are messages attached to messages, with a
35569 content-type of &"message/rfc822"&), the ACL is called again in the same manner
35570 as for the primary message, only that the &$mime_is_rfc822$& expansion
35571 variable is set (see below). Attached messages are always decoded to disk
35572 before being checked, and the files are unlinked once the check is done.
35574 The MIME ACL supports the &%regex%& and &%mime_regex%& conditions. These can be
35575 used to match regular expressions against raw and decoded MIME parts,
35576 respectively. They are described in section &<<SECTscanregex>>&.
35578 .cindex "MIME content scanning" "returned variables"
35579 The following list describes all expansion variables that are
35580 available in the MIME ACL:
35583 .vitem &$mime_anomaly_level$& &&&
35584 &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35585 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_level$&
35586 .vindex &$mime_anomaly_text$&
35587 If there are problems decoding, these variables contain information on
35588 the detected issue.
35590 .vitem &$mime_boundary$&
35591 .vindex &$mime_boundary$&
35592 If the current part is a multipart (see &$mime_is_multipart$& below), it should
35593 have a boundary string, which is stored in this variable. If the current part
35594 has no boundary parameter in the &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable
35595 contains the empty string.
35597 .vitem &$mime_charset$&
35598 .vindex &$mime_charset$&
35599 This variable contains the character set identifier, if one was found in the
35600 &'Content-Type:'& header. Examples for charset identifiers are:
35606 Please note that this value is not normalized, so you should do matches
35607 case-insensitively.
35609 .vitem &$mime_content_description$&
35610 .vindex &$mime_content_description$&
35611 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Description:'&
35612 header. It can contain a human-readable description of the parts content. Some
35613 implementations repeat the filename for attachments here, but they are usually
35614 only used for display purposes.
35616 .vitem &$mime_content_disposition$&
35617 .vindex &$mime_content_disposition$&
35618 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-Disposition:'&
35619 header. You can expect strings like &"attachment"& or &"inline"& here.
35621 .vitem &$mime_content_id$&
35622 .vindex &$mime_content_id$&
35623 This variable contains the normalized content of the &'Content-ID:'& header.
35624 This is a unique ID that can be used to reference a part from another part.
35626 .vitem &$mime_content_size$&
35627 .vindex &$mime_content_size$&
35628 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35629 successfully run. It contains the size of the decoded part in kilobytes. The
35630 size is always rounded up to full kilobytes, so only a completely empty part
35631 has a &$mime_content_size$& of zero.
35633 .vitem &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35634 .vindex &$mime_content_transfer_encoding$&
35635 This variable contains the normalized content of the
35636 &'Content-transfer-encoding:'& header. This is a symbolic name for an encoding
35637 type. Typical values are &"base64"& and &"quoted-printable"&.
35639 .vitem &$mime_content_type$&
35640 .vindex &$mime_content_type$&
35641 If the MIME part has a &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains its
35642 value, lowercased, and without any options (like &"name"& or &"charset"&). Here
35643 are some examples of popular MIME types, as they may appear in this variable:
35647 application/octet-stream
35651 If the MIME part has no &'Content-Type:'& header, this variable contains the
35654 .vitem &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35655 .vindex &$mime_decoded_filename$&
35656 This variable is set only after the &%decode%& modifier (see above) has been
35657 successfully run. It contains the full path and filename of the file
35658 containing the decoded data.
35663 .vitem &$mime_filename$&
35664 .vindex &$mime_filename$&
35665 This is perhaps the most important of the MIME variables. It contains a
35666 proposed filename for an attachment, if one was found in either the
35667 &'Content-Type:'& or &'Content-Disposition:'& headers. The filename will be
35668 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047) or
35669 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2231,RFC 2231)
35670 decoded, but no additional sanity checks are done.
35672 found, this variable contains the empty string.
35674 .vitem &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35675 .vindex &$mime_is_coverletter$&
35676 This variable attempts to differentiate the &"cover letter"& of an e-mail from
35677 attached data. It can be used to clamp down on flashy or unnecessarily encoded
35678 content in the cover letter, while not restricting attachments at all.
35680 The variable contains 1 (true) for a MIME part believed to be part of the
35681 cover letter, and 0 (false) for an attachment. At present, the algorithm is as
35685 The outermost MIME part of a message is always a cover letter.
35688 If a multipart/alternative or multipart/related MIME part is a cover letter,
35689 so are all MIME subparts within that multipart.
35692 If any other multipart is a cover letter, the first subpart is a cover letter,
35693 and the rest are attachments.
35696 All parts contained within an attachment multipart are attachments.
35699 As an example, the following will ban &"HTML mail"& (including that sent with
35700 alternative plain text), while allowing HTML files to be attached. HTML
35701 coverletter mail attached to non-HTML coverletter mail will also be allowed:
35703 deny !condition = $mime_is_rfc822
35704 condition = $mime_is_coverletter
35705 condition = ${if eq{$mime_content_type}{text/html}{1}{0}}
35706 message = HTML mail is not accepted here
35709 .vitem &$mime_is_multipart$&
35710 .vindex &$mime_is_multipart$&
35711 This variable has the value 1 (true) when the current part has the main type
35712 &"multipart"&, for example, &"multipart/alternative"& or &"multipart/mixed"&.
35713 Since multipart entities only serve as containers for other parts, you may not
35714 want to carry out specific actions on them.
35716 .vitem &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35717 .vindex &$mime_is_rfc822$&
35718 This variable has the value 1 (true) if the current part is not a part of the
35719 checked message itself, but part of an attached message. Attached message
35720 decoding is fully recursive.
35722 .vitem &$mime_part_count$&
35723 .vindex &$mime_part_count$&
35724 This variable is a counter that is raised for each processed MIME part. It
35725 starts at zero for the very first part (which is usually a multipart). The
35726 counter is per-message, so it is reset when processing RFC822 attachments (see
35727 &$mime_is_rfc822$&). The counter stays set after &%acl_smtp_mime%& is
35728 complete, so you can use it in the DATA ACL to determine the number of MIME
35729 parts of a message. For non-MIME messages, this variable contains the value -1.
35734 .section "Scanning with regular expressions" "SECTscanregex"
35735 .cindex "content scanning" "with regular expressions"
35736 .cindex "regular expressions" "content scanning with"
35737 You can specify your own custom regular expression matches on the full body of
35738 the message, or on individual MIME parts.
35740 The &%regex%& condition takes one or more regular expressions as arguments and
35741 matches them against the full message (when called in the DATA ACL) or a raw
35742 MIME part (when called in the MIME ACL). The &%regex%& condition matches
35743 linewise, with a maximum line length of 32K characters. That means you cannot
35744 have multiline matches with the &%regex%& condition.
35746 The &%mime_regex%& condition can be called only in the MIME ACL. It matches up
35747 to 32K of decoded content (the whole content at once, not linewise). If the
35748 part has not been decoded with the &%decode%& modifier earlier in the ACL, it
35749 is decoded automatically when &%mime_regex%& is executed (using default path
35750 and filename values). If the decoded data is larger than 32K, only the first
35751 32K characters are checked.
35753 The regular expressions are passed as a colon-separated list. To include a
35754 literal colon, you must double it. Since the whole right-hand side string is
35755 expanded before being used, you must also escape dollar signs and backslashes
35756 with more backslashes, or use the &`\N`& facility to disable expansion.
35757 Here is a simple example that contains two regular expressions:
35759 deny regex = [Mm]ortgage : URGENT BUSINESS PROPOSAL
35760 message = contains blacklisted regex ($regex_match_string)
35762 The conditions returns true if any one of the regular expressions matches. The
35763 &$regex_match_string$& expansion variable is then set up and contains the
35764 matching regular expression.
35765 The expansion variables &$regex1$& &$regex2$& etc
35766 are set to any substrings captured by the regular expression.
35768 &*Warning*&: With large messages, these conditions can be fairly
35776 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35777 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
35779 .chapter "Adding a local scan function to Exim" "CHAPlocalscan" &&&
35780 "Local scan function"
35781 .scindex IIDlosca "&[local_scan()]& function" "description of"
35782 .cindex "customizing" "input scan using C function"
35783 .cindex "policy control" "by local scan function"
35784 In these days of email worms, viruses, and ever-increasing spam, some sites
35785 want to apply a lot of checking to messages before accepting them.
35787 The content scanning extension (chapter &<<CHAPexiscan>>&) has facilities for
35788 passing messages to external virus and spam scanning software. You can also do
35789 a certain amount in Exim itself through string expansions and the &%condition%&
35790 condition in the ACL that runs after the SMTP DATA command or the ACL for
35791 non-SMTP messages (see chapter &<<CHAPACL>>&), but this has its limitations.
35793 To allow for further customization to a site's own requirements, there is the
35794 possibility of linking Exim with a private message scanning function, written
35795 in C. If you want to run code that is written in something other than C, you
35796 can of course use a little C stub to call it.
35798 The local scan function is run once for every incoming message, at the point
35799 when Exim is just about to accept the message.
35800 It can therefore be used to control non-SMTP messages from local processes as
35801 well as messages arriving via SMTP.
35803 Exim applies a timeout to calls of the local scan function, and there is an
35804 option called &%local_scan_timeout%& for setting it. The default is 5 minutes.
35805 Zero means &"no timeout"&.
35806 Exim also sets up signal handlers for SIGSEGV, SIGILL, SIGFPE, and SIGBUS
35807 before calling the local scan function, so that the most common types of crash
35808 are caught. If the timeout is exceeded or one of those signals is caught, the
35809 incoming message is rejected with a temporary error if it is an SMTP message.
35810 For a non-SMTP message, the message is dropped and Exim ends with a non-zero
35811 code. The incident is logged on the main and reject logs.
35815 .section "Building Exim to use a local scan function" "SECID207"
35816 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "building Exim to use"
35817 To make use of the local scan function feature, you must tell Exim where your
35818 function is before building Exim, by setting
35819 both HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN and
35820 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE in your
35821 &_Local/Makefile_&. A recommended place to put it is in the &_Local_&
35822 directory, so you might set
35824 HAVE_LOCAL_SCAN=yes
35825 LOCAL_SCAN_SOURCE=Local/local_scan.c
35827 for example. The function must be called &[local_scan()]&;
35828 the source file(s) for it should first #define LOCAL_SCAN
35829 and then #include "local_scan.h".
35831 Exim after it has received a message, when the success return code is about to
35832 be sent. This is after all the ACLs have been run. The return code from your
35833 function controls whether the message is actually accepted or not. There is a
35834 commented template function (that just accepts the message) in the file
35835 _src/local_scan.c_.
35837 If you want to make use of Exim's runtime configuration file to set options
35838 for your &[local_scan()]& function, you must also set
35840 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35842 in &_Local/Makefile_& (see section &<<SECTconoptloc>>& below).
35847 .section "API for local_scan()" "SECTapiforloc"
35848 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "API description"
35849 .cindex &%dlfunc%& "API description"
35850 You must include this line near the start of your code:
35853 #include "local_scan.h"
35855 This header file defines a number of variables and other values, and the
35856 prototype for the function itself. Exim is coded to use unsigned char values
35857 almost exclusively, and one of the things this header defines is a shorthand
35858 for &`unsigned char`& called &`uschar`&.
35859 It also makes available the following macro definitions, to simplify casting character
35860 strings and pointers to character strings:
35862 #define CS (char *)
35863 #define CCS (const char *)
35864 #define CSS (char **)
35865 #define US (unsigned char *)
35866 #define CUS (const unsigned char *)
35867 #define USS (unsigned char **)
35869 The function prototype for &[local_scan()]& is:
35871 extern int local_scan(int fd, uschar **return_text);
35873 The arguments are as follows:
35876 &%fd%& is a file descriptor for the file that contains the body of the message
35877 (the -D file). The file is open for reading and writing, but updating it is not
35878 recommended. &*Warning*&: You must &'not'& close this file descriptor.
35880 The descriptor is positioned at character 26 of the file, which is the first
35881 character of the body itself, because the first 26 characters (19 characters
35882 before Exim 4.97) are the message id followed by &`-D`& and a newline.
35883 If you rewind the file, you should use the
35884 macro SPOOL_DATA_START_OFFSET to reset to the start of the data, just in
35885 case this changes in some future version.
35887 &%return_text%& is an address which you can use to return a pointer to a text
35888 string at the end of the function. The value it points to on entry is NULL.
35891 The function must return an &%int%& value which is one of the following macros:
35894 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&
35895 .vindex "&$local_scan_data$&"
35896 The message is accepted. If you pass back a string of text, it is saved with
35897 the message, and made available in the variable &$local_scan_data$&. No
35898 newlines are permitted (if there are any, they are turned into spaces) and the
35899 maximum length of text is 1000 characters.
35901 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_FREEZE`&
35902 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35903 queued without immediate delivery, and is frozen.
35905 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT_QUEUE`&
35906 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT, except that the accepted message is
35907 queued without immediate delivery.
35909 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT`&
35910 The message is rejected; the returned text is used as an error message which is
35911 passed back to the sender and which is also logged. Newlines are permitted &--
35912 they cause a multiline response for SMTP rejections, but are converted to
35913 &`\n`& in log lines. If no message is given, &"Administrative prohibition"& is
35916 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT`&
35917 The message is temporarily rejected; the returned text is used as an error
35918 message as for LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT. If no message is given, &"Temporary local
35921 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35922 This behaves as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, except that the header of the rejected
35923 message is not written to the reject log. It has the effect of unsetting the
35924 &%rejected_header%& log selector for just this rejection. If
35925 &%rejected_header%& is already unset (see the discussion of the
35926 &%log_selection%& option in section &<<SECTlogselector>>&), this code is the
35927 same as LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35929 .vitem &`LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT_NOLOGHDR`&
35930 This code is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT in the same way that
35931 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT_NOLOGHDR is a variation of LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT.
35934 If the message is not being received by interactive SMTP, rejections are
35935 reported by writing to &%stderr%& or by sending an email, as configured by the
35936 &%-oe%& command line options.
35940 .section "Configuration options for local_scan()" "SECTconoptloc"
35941 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "configuration options"
35942 It is possible to have option settings in the main configuration file
35943 that set values in static variables in the &[local_scan()]& module. If you
35944 want to do this, you must have the line
35946 LOCAL_SCAN_HAS_OPTIONS=yes
35948 in your &_Local/Makefile_& when you build Exim. (This line is in
35949 &_OS/Makefile-Default_&, commented out). Then, in the &[local_scan()]& source
35950 file, you must define static variables to hold the option values, and a table
35953 The table must be a vector called &%local_scan_options%&, of type
35954 &`optionlist`&. Each entry is a triplet, consisting of a name, an option type,
35955 and a pointer to the variable that holds the value. The entries must appear in
35956 alphabetical order. Following &%local_scan_options%& you must also define a
35957 variable called &%local_scan_options_count%& that contains the number of
35958 entries in the table. Here is a short example, showing two kinds of option:
35960 static int my_integer_option = 42;
35961 static uschar *my_string_option = US"a default string";
35963 optionlist local_scan_options[] = {
35964 { "my_integer", opt_int, &my_integer_option },
35965 { "my_string", opt_stringptr, &my_string_option }
35968 int local_scan_options_count =
35969 sizeof(local_scan_options)/sizeof(optionlist);
35971 The values of the variables can now be changed from Exim's runtime
35972 configuration file by including a local scan section as in this example:
35976 my_string = some string of text...
35978 The available types of option data are as follows:
35981 .vitem &*opt_bool*&
35982 This specifies a boolean (true/false) option. The address should point to a
35983 variable of type &`BOOL`&, which will be set to TRUE or FALSE, which are macros
35984 that are defined as &"1"& and &"0"&, respectively. If you want to detect
35985 whether such a variable has been set at all, you can initialize it to
35986 TRUE_UNSET. (BOOL variables are integers underneath, so can hold more than two
35989 .vitem &*opt_fixed*&
35990 This specifies a fixed point number, such as is used for load averages.
35991 The address should point to a variable of type &`int`&. The value is stored
35992 multiplied by 1000, so, for example, 1.4142 is truncated and stored as 1414.
35995 This specifies an integer; the address should point to a variable of type
35996 &`int`&. The value may be specified in any of the integer formats accepted by
35999 .vitem &*opt_mkint*&
36000 This is the same as &%opt_int%&, except that when such a value is output in a
36001 &%-bP%& listing, if it is an exact number of kilobytes or megabytes, it is
36002 printed with the suffix K or M.
36004 .vitem &*opt_octint*&
36005 This also specifies an integer, but the value is always interpreted as an
36006 octal integer, whether or not it starts with the digit zero, and it is
36007 always output in octal.
36009 .vitem &*opt_stringptr*&
36010 This specifies a string value; the address must be a pointer to a
36011 variable that points to a string (for example, of type &`uschar *`&).
36013 .vitem &*opt_time*&
36014 This specifies a time interval value. The address must point to a variable of
36015 type &`int`&. The value that is placed there is a number of seconds.
36018 If the &%-bP%& command line option is followed by &`local_scan`&, Exim prints
36019 out the values of all the &[local_scan()]& options.
36023 .section "Available Exim variables" "SECID208"
36024 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim variables"
36025 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of C variables. These
36026 are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to release.
36027 Note, however, that you can obtain the value of any Exim expansion variable,
36028 including &$recipients$&, by calling &'expand_string()'&. The exported
36029 C variables are as follows:
36032 .vitem &*int&~body_linecount*&
36033 This variable contains the number of lines in the message's body.
36034 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
36036 .vitem &*int&~body_zerocount*&
36037 This variable contains the number of binary zero bytes in the message's body.
36038 It is not valid if the &%spool_wireformat%& option is used.
36040 .vitem &*unsigned&~int&~debug_selector*&
36041 This variable is set to zero when no debugging is taking place. Otherwise, it
36042 is a bitmap of debugging selectors. Two bits are identified for use in
36043 &[local_scan()]&; they are defined as macros:
36046 The &`D_v`& bit is set when &%-v%& was present on the command line. This is a
36047 testing option that is not privileged &-- any caller may set it. All the
36048 other selector bits can be set only by admin users.
36051 The &`D_local_scan`& bit is provided for use by &[local_scan()]&; it is set
36052 by the &`+local_scan`& debug selector. It is not included in the default set
36056 Thus, to write to the debugging output only when &`+local_scan`& has been
36057 selected, you should use code like this:
36059 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
36060 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
36062 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string_message*&
36063 After a failing call to &'expand_string()'& (returned value NULL), the
36064 variable &%expand_string_message%& contains the error message, zero-terminated.
36066 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_list*&
36067 A pointer to a chain of header lines. The &%header_line%& structure is
36070 .vitem &*header_line&~*header_last*&
36071 A pointer to the last of the header lines.
36073 .vitem &*const&~uschar&~*headers_charset*&
36074 The value of the &%headers_charset%& configuration option.
36076 .vitem &*BOOL&~host_checking*&
36077 This variable is TRUE during a host checking session that is initiated by the
36078 &%-bh%& command line option.
36080 .vitem &*uschar&~*interface_address*&
36081 The IP address of the interface that received the message, as a string. This
36082 is NULL for locally submitted messages.
36084 .vitem &*int&~interface_port*&
36085 The port on which this message was received. When testing with the &%-bh%&
36086 command line option, the value of this variable is -1 unless a port has been
36087 specified via the &%-oMi%& option.
36089 .vitem &*uschar&~*message_id*&
36090 This variable contains Exim's message id for the incoming message (the value of
36091 &$message_exim_id$&) as a zero-terminated string.
36093 .vitem &*uschar&~*received_protocol*&
36094 The name of the protocol by which the message was received.
36096 .vitem &*int&~recipients_count*&
36097 The number of accepted recipients.
36099 .vitem &*recipient_item&~*recipients_list*&
36100 .cindex "recipient" "adding in local scan"
36101 .cindex "recipient" "removing in local scan"
36102 The list of accepted recipients, held in a vector of length
36103 &%recipients_count%&. The &%recipient_item%& structure is discussed below. You
36104 can add additional recipients by calling &'receive_add_recipient()'& (see
36105 below). You can delete recipients by removing them from the vector and
36106 adjusting the value in &%recipients_count%&. In particular, by setting
36107 &%recipients_count%& to zero you remove all recipients. If you then return the
36108 value &`LOCAL_SCAN_ACCEPT`&, the message is accepted, but immediately
36109 blackholed. To replace the recipients, you can set &%recipients_count%& to zero
36110 and then call &'receive_add_recipient()'& as often as needed.
36112 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_address*&
36113 The envelope sender address. For bounce messages this is the empty string.
36115 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_address*&
36116 The IP address of the sending host, as a string. This is NULL for
36117 locally-submitted messages.
36119 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_authenticated*&
36120 The name of the authentication mechanism that was used, or NULL if the message
36121 was not received over an authenticated SMTP connection.
36123 .vitem &*uschar&~*sender_host_name*&
36124 The name of the sending host, if known.
36126 .vitem &*int&~sender_host_port*&
36127 The port on the sending host.
36129 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_input*&
36130 This variable is TRUE for all SMTP input, including BSMTP.
36132 .vitem &*BOOL&~smtp_batched_input*&
36133 This variable is TRUE for BSMTP input.
36135 .vitem &*int&~store_pool*&
36136 The contents of this variable control which pool of memory is used for new
36137 requests. See section &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& for details.
36141 .section "Structure of header lines" "SECID209"
36142 The &%header_line%& structure contains the members listed below.
36143 You can add additional header lines by calling the &'header_add()'& function
36144 (see below). You can cause header lines to be ignored (deleted) by setting
36149 .vitem &*struct&~header_line&~*next*&
36150 A pointer to the next header line, or NULL for the last line.
36152 .vitem &*int&~type*&
36153 A code identifying certain headers that Exim recognizes. The codes are printing
36154 characters, and are documented in chapter &<<CHAPspool>>& of this manual.
36155 Notice in particular that any header line whose type is * is not transmitted
36156 with the message. This flagging is used for header lines that have been
36157 rewritten, or are to be removed (for example, &'Envelope-sender:'& header
36158 lines.) Effectively, * means &"deleted"&.
36160 .vitem &*int&~slen*&
36161 The number of characters in the header line, including the terminating and any
36164 .vitem &*uschar&~*text*&
36165 A pointer to the text of the header. It always ends with a newline, followed by
36166 a zero byte. Internal newlines are preserved.
36171 .section "Structure of recipient items" "SECID210"
36172 The &%recipient_item%& structure contains these members:
36175 .vitem &*uschar&~*address*&
36176 This is a pointer to the recipient address as it was received.
36178 .vitem &*int&~pno*&
36179 This is used in later Exim processing when top level addresses are created by
36180 the &%one_time%& option. It is not relevant at the time &[local_scan()]& is run
36181 and must always contain -1 at this stage.
36183 .vitem &*uschar&~*errors_to*&
36184 If this value is not NULL, bounce messages caused by failing to deliver to the
36185 recipient are sent to the address it contains. In other words, it overrides the
36186 envelope sender for this one recipient. (Compare the &%errors_to%& generic
36187 router option.) If a &[local_scan()]& function sets an &%errors_to%& field to
36188 an unqualified address, Exim qualifies it using the domain from
36189 &%qualify_recipient%&. When &[local_scan()]& is called, the &%errors_to%& field
36190 is NULL for all recipients.
36195 .section "Available Exim functions" "SECID211"
36196 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "available Exim functions"
36197 The header &_local_scan.h_& gives you access to a number of Exim functions.
36198 These are the only ones that are guaranteed to be maintained from release to
36202 .vitem "&*pid_t&~child_open(uschar&~**argv,&~uschar&~**envp,&~int&~newumask,&&&
36203 &~int&~*infdptr,&~int&~*outfdptr, &~&~BOOL&~make_leader)*&"
36205 This function creates a child process that runs the command specified by
36206 &%argv%&. The environment for the process is specified by &%envp%&, which can
36207 be NULL if no environment variables are to be passed. A new umask is supplied
36208 for the process in &%newumask%&.
36210 Pipes to the standard input and output of the new process are set up
36211 and returned to the caller via the &%infdptr%& and &%outfdptr%& arguments. The
36212 standard error is cloned to the standard output. If there are any file
36213 descriptors &"in the way"& in the new process, they are closed. If the final
36214 argument is TRUE, the new process is made into a process group leader.
36216 The function returns the pid of the new process, or -1 if things go wrong.
36218 .vitem &*int&~child_close(pid_t&~pid,&~int&~timeout)*&
36219 This function waits for a child process to terminate, or for a timeout (in
36220 seconds) to expire. A timeout value of zero means wait as long as it takes. The
36221 return value is as follows:
36226 The process terminated by a normal exit and the value is the process
36232 The process was terminated by a signal and the value is the negation of the
36238 The process timed out.
36242 The was some other error in wait(); &%errno%& is still set.
36245 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim(int&~*fd)*&
36246 This function provide you with a means of submitting a new message to
36247 Exim. (Of course, you can also call &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& yourself if you
36248 want, but this packages it all up for you.) The function creates a pipe,
36249 forks a subprocess that is running
36251 exim -t -oem -oi -f <>
36253 and returns to you (via the &`int *`& argument) a file descriptor for the pipe
36254 that is connected to the standard input. The yield of the function is the PID
36255 of the subprocess. You can then write a message to the file descriptor, with
36256 recipients in &'To:'&, &'Cc:'&, and/or &'Bcc:'& header lines.
36258 When you have finished, call &'child_close()'& to wait for the process to
36259 finish and to collect its ending status. A timeout value of zero is usually
36260 fine in this circumstance. Unless you have made a mistake with the recipient
36261 addresses, you should get a return code of zero.
36264 .vitem &*pid_t&~child_open_exim2(int&~*fd,&~uschar&~*sender,&~uschar&~&&&
36265 *sender_authentication)*&
36266 This function is a more sophisticated version of &'child_open()'&. The command
36269 &`exim -t -oem -oi -f `&&'sender'&&` -oMas `&&'sender_authentication'&
36271 The third argument may be NULL, in which case the &%-oMas%& option is omitted.
36274 .vitem &*void&~debug_printf(char&~*,&~...)*&
36275 This is Exim's debugging function, with arguments as for &'printf()'&. The
36276 output is written to the standard error stream. If no debugging is selected,
36277 calls to &'debug_printf()'& have no effect. Normally, you should make calls
36278 conditional on the &`local_scan`& debug selector by coding like this:
36280 if ((debug_selector & D_local_scan) != 0)
36281 debug_printf("xxx", ...);
36284 .vitem &*uschar&~*expand_string(uschar&~*string)*&
36285 This is an interface to Exim's string expansion code. The return value is the
36286 expanded string, or NULL if there was an expansion failure.
36287 The C variable &%expand_string_message%& contains an error message after an
36288 expansion failure. If expansion does not change the string, the return value is
36289 the pointer to the input string. Otherwise, the return value points to a new
36290 block of memory that was obtained by a call to &'store_get()'&. See section
36291 &<<SECTmemhanloc>>& below for a discussion of memory handling.
36293 .vitem &*void&~header_add(int&~type,&~char&~*format,&~...)*&
36294 This function allows you to an add additional header line at the end of the
36295 existing ones. The first argument is the type, and should normally be a space
36296 character. The second argument is a format string and any number of
36297 substitution arguments as for &[sprintf()]&. You may include internal newlines
36298 if you want, and you must ensure that the string ends with a newline.
36300 .vitem "&*void&~header_add_at_position(BOOL&~after,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
36301 BOOL&~topnot,&~int&~type,&~char&~*format, &~&~...)*&"
36302 This function adds a new header line at a specified point in the header
36303 chain. The header itself is specified as for &'header_add()'&.
36305 If &%name%& is NULL, the new header is added at the end of the chain if
36306 &%after%& is true, or at the start if &%after%& is false. If &%name%& is not
36307 NULL, the header lines are searched for the first non-deleted header that
36308 matches the name. If one is found, the new header is added before it if
36309 &%after%& is false. If &%after%& is true, the new header is added after the
36310 found header and any adjacent subsequent ones with the same name (even if
36311 marked &"deleted"&). If no matching non-deleted header is found, the &%topnot%&
36312 option controls where the header is added. If it is true, addition is at the
36313 top; otherwise at the bottom. Thus, to add a header after all the &'Received:'&
36314 headers, or at the top if there are no &'Received:'& headers, you could use
36316 header_add_at_position(TRUE, US"Received", TRUE,
36317 ' ', "X-xxx: ...");
36319 Normally, there is always at least one non-deleted &'Received:'& header, but
36320 there may not be if &%received_header_text%& expands to an empty string.
36323 .vitem &*void&~header_remove(int&~occurrence,&~uschar&~*name)*&
36324 This function removes header lines. If &%occurrence%& is zero or negative, all
36325 occurrences of the header are removed. If occurrence is greater than zero, that
36326 particular instance of the header is removed. If no header(s) can be found that
36327 match the specification, the function does nothing.
36330 .vitem "&*BOOL&~header_testname(header_line&~*hdr,&~uschar&~*name,&~&&&
36331 int&~length,&~BOOL&~notdel)*&"
36332 This function tests whether the given header has the given name. It is not just
36333 a string comparison, because white space is permitted between the name and the
36334 colon. If the &%notdel%& argument is true, a false return is forced for all
36335 &"deleted"& headers; otherwise they are not treated specially. For example:
36337 if (header_testname(h, US"X-Spam", 6, TRUE)) ...
36339 .vitem &*uschar&~*lss_b64encode(uschar&~*cleartext,&~int&~length)*&
36340 .cindex "base64 encoding" "functions for &[local_scan()]& use"
36341 This function base64-encodes a string, which is passed by address and length.
36342 The text may contain bytes of any value, including zero. The result is passed
36343 back in dynamic memory that is obtained by calling &'store_get()'&. It is
36346 .vitem &*int&~lss_b64decode(uschar&~*codetext,&~uschar&~**cleartext)*&
36347 This function decodes a base64-encoded string. Its arguments are a
36348 zero-terminated base64-encoded string and the address of a variable that is set
36349 to point to the result, which is in dynamic memory. The length of the decoded
36350 string is the yield of the function. If the input is invalid base64 data, the
36351 yield is -1. A zero byte is added to the end of the output string to make it
36352 easy to interpret as a C string (assuming it contains no zeros of its own). The
36353 added zero byte is not included in the returned count.
36355 .vitem &*int&~lss_match_domain(uschar&~*domain,&~uschar&~*list)*&
36356 This function checks for a match in a domain list. Domains are always
36357 matched caselessly. The return value is one of the following:
36358 .itable none 0 0 2 15* left 85* left
36359 .irow &`OK`& "match succeeded"
36360 .irow &`FAIL`& "match failed"
36361 .irow &`DEFER`& "match deferred"
36363 DEFER is usually caused by some kind of lookup defer, such as the
36364 inability to contact a database.
36366 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_local_part(uschar&~*localpart,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
36368 This function checks for a match in a local part list. The third argument
36369 controls case-sensitivity. The return values are as for
36370 &'lss_match_domain()'&.
36372 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_address(uschar&~*address,&~uschar&~*list,&~&&&
36374 This function checks for a match in an address list. The third argument
36375 controls the case-sensitivity of the local part match. The domain is always
36376 matched caselessly. The return values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&.
36378 .vitem "&*int&~lss_match_host(uschar&~*host_name,&~uschar&~*host_address,&~&&&
36380 This function checks for a match in a host list. The most common usage is
36383 lss_match_host(sender_host_name, sender_host_address, ...)
36385 .vindex "&$sender_host_address$&"
36386 An empty address field matches an empty item in the host list. If the host name
36387 is NULL, the name corresponding to &$sender_host_address$& is automatically
36388 looked up if a host name is required to match an item in the list. The return
36389 values are as for &'lss_match_domain()'&, but in addition, &'lss_match_host()'&
36390 returns ERROR in the case when it had to look up a host name, but the lookup
36393 .vitem "&*void&~log_write(unsigned&~int&~selector,&~int&~which,&~char&~&&&
36395 This function writes to Exim's log files. The first argument should be zero (it
36396 is concerned with &%log_selector%&). The second argument can be &`LOG_MAIN`& or
36397 &`LOG_REJECT`& or &`LOG_PANIC`& or the inclusive &"or"& of any combination of
36398 them. It specifies to which log or logs the message is written. The remaining
36399 arguments are a format and relevant insertion arguments. The string should not
36400 contain any newlines, not even at the end.
36403 .vitem &*void&~receive_add_recipient(uschar&~*address,&~int&~pno)*&
36404 This function adds an additional recipient to the message. The first argument
36405 is the recipient address. If it is unqualified (has no domain), it is qualified
36406 with the &%qualify_recipient%& domain. The second argument must always be -1.
36408 This function does not allow you to specify a private &%errors_to%& address (as
36409 described with the structure of &%recipient_item%& above), because it pre-dates
36410 the addition of that field to the structure. However, it is easy to add such a
36411 value afterwards. For example:
36413 receive_add_recipient(US"monitor@mydom.example", -1);
36414 recipients_list[recipients_count-1].errors_to =
36415 US"postmaster@mydom.example";
36418 .vitem &*BOOL&~receive_remove_recipient(uschar&~*recipient)*&
36419 This is a convenience function to remove a named recipient from the list of
36420 recipients. It returns true if a recipient was removed, and false if no
36421 matching recipient could be found. The argument must be a complete email
36428 .vitem "&*uschar&~rfc2047_decode(uschar&~*string,&~BOOL&~lencheck,&&&
36429 &~uschar&~*target,&~int&~zeroval,&~int&~*lenptr, &~&~uschar&~**error)*&"
36430 This function decodes strings that are encoded according to
36431 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047). Typically
36432 these are the contents of header lines. First, each &"encoded word"& is decoded
36433 from the Q or B encoding into a byte-string. Then, if provided with the name of
36434 a charset encoding, and if the &[iconv()]& function is available, an attempt is
36435 made to translate the result to the named character set. If this fails, the
36436 binary string is returned with an error message.
36438 The first argument is the string to be decoded. If &%lencheck%& is TRUE, the
36439 maximum MIME word length is enforced. The third argument is the target
36440 encoding, or NULL if no translation is wanted.
36442 .cindex "binary zero" "in RFC 2047 decoding"
36443 .cindex "RFC 2047" "binary zero in"
36444 If a binary zero is encountered in the decoded string, it is replaced by the
36445 contents of the &%zeroval%& argument. For use with Exim headers, the value must
36446 not be 0 because header lines are handled as zero-terminated strings.
36448 The function returns the result of processing the string, zero-terminated; if
36449 &%lenptr%& is not NULL, the length of the result is set in the variable to
36450 which it points. When &%zeroval%& is 0, &%lenptr%& should not be NULL.
36452 If an error is encountered, the function returns NULL and uses the &%error%&
36453 argument to return an error message. The variable pointed to by &%error%& is
36454 set to NULL if there is no error; it may be set non-NULL even when the function
36455 returns a non-NULL value if decoding was successful, but there was a problem
36459 .vitem &*int&~smtp_fflush(void)*&
36460 This function is used in conjunction with &'smtp_printf()'&, as described
36463 .vitem &*void&~smtp_printf(char&~*,BOOL,&~...)*&
36464 The arguments of this function are almost like &[printf()]&; it writes to the SMTP
36465 output stream. You should use this function only when there is an SMTP output
36466 stream, that is, when the incoming message is being received via interactive
36467 SMTP. This is the case when &%smtp_input%& is TRUE and &%smtp_batched_input%&
36468 is FALSE. If you want to test for an incoming message from another host (as
36469 opposed to a local process that used the &%-bs%& command line option), you can
36470 test the value of &%sender_host_address%&, which is non-NULL when a remote host
36473 If an SMTP TLS connection is established, &'smtp_printf()'& uses the TLS
36474 output function, so it can be used for all forms of SMTP connection.
36476 The second argument is used to request that the data be buffered
36477 (when TRUE) or flushed (along with any previously buffered, when FALSE).
36478 This is advisory only, but likely to save on system-calls and packets
36479 sent when a sequence of calls to the function are made.
36481 The argument was added in Exim version 4.90 - changing the API/ABI.
36482 Nobody noticed until 4.93 was imminent, at which point the
36483 ABI version number was incremented.
36485 Strings that are written by &'smtp_printf()'& from within &[local_scan()]&
36486 must start with an appropriate response code: 550 if you are going to return
36487 LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT, 451 if you are going to return
36488 LOCAL_SCAN_TEMPREJECT, and 250 otherwise. Because you are writing the
36489 initial lines of a multi-line response, the code must be followed by a hyphen
36490 to indicate that the line is not the final response line. You must also ensure
36491 that the lines you write terminate with CRLF. For example:
36493 smtp_printf("550-this is some extra info\r\n");
36494 return LOCAL_SCAN_REJECT;
36496 Note that you can also create multi-line responses by including newlines in
36497 the data returned via the &%return_text%& argument. The added value of using
36498 &'smtp_printf()'& is that, for instance, you could introduce delays between
36499 multiple output lines.
36501 The &'smtp_printf()'& function does not return any error indication, because it
36503 guarantee a flush of
36504 pending output, and therefore does not test
36505 the state of the stream. (In the main code of Exim, flushing and error
36506 detection is done when Exim is ready for the next SMTP input command.) If
36507 you want to flush the output and check for an error (for example, the
36508 dropping of a TCP/IP connection), you can call &'smtp_fflush()'&, which has no
36509 arguments. It flushes the output stream, and returns a non-zero value if there
36512 .vitem &*void&~*store_get(int,BOOL)*&
36513 This function accesses Exim's internal store (memory) manager. It gets a new
36514 chunk of memory whose size is given by the first argument.
36515 The second argument should be given as TRUE if the memory will be used for
36516 data possibly coming from an attacker (eg. the message content),
36517 FALSE if it is locally-sourced.
36518 Exim bombs out if it ever
36519 runs out of memory. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36521 .vitem &*void&~*store_get_perm(int,BOOL)*&
36522 This function is like &'store_get()'&, but it always gets memory from the
36523 permanent pool. See the next section for a discussion of memory handling.
36525 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copy(uschar&~*string)*&
36528 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_copyn(uschar&~*string,&~int&~length)*&
36531 .vitem &*uschar&~*string_sprintf(char&~*format,&~...)*&
36532 These three functions create strings using Exim's dynamic memory facilities.
36533 The first makes a copy of an entire string. The second copies up to a maximum
36534 number of characters, indicated by the second argument. The third uses a format
36535 and insertion arguments to create a new string. In each case, the result is a
36536 pointer to a new string in the current memory pool. See the next section for
36542 .section "More about Exim's memory handling" "SECTmemhanloc"
36543 .cindex "&[local_scan()]& function" "memory handling"
36544 No function is provided for freeing memory, because that is never needed.
36545 The dynamic memory that Exim uses when receiving a message is automatically
36546 recycled if another message is received by the same process (this applies only
36547 to incoming SMTP connections &-- other input methods can supply only one
36548 message at a time). After receiving the last message, a reception process
36551 Because it is recycled, the normal dynamic memory cannot be used for holding
36552 data that must be preserved over a number of incoming messages on the same SMTP
36553 connection. However, Exim in fact uses two pools of dynamic memory; the second
36554 one is not recycled, and can be used for this purpose.
36556 If you want to allocate memory that remains available for subsequent messages
36557 in the same SMTP connection, you should set
36559 store_pool = POOL_PERM
36561 before calling the function that does the allocation. There is no need to
36562 restore the value if you do not need to; however, if you do want to revert to
36563 the normal pool, you can either restore the previous value of &%store_pool%& or
36564 set it explicitly to POOL_MAIN.
36566 The pool setting applies to all functions that get dynamic memory, including
36567 &'expand_string()'&, &'store_get()'&, and the &'string_xxx()'& functions.
36568 There is also a convenience function called &'store_get_perm()'& that gets a
36569 block of memory from the permanent pool while preserving the value of
36576 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36577 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36579 .chapter "System-wide message filtering" "CHAPsystemfilter"
36580 .scindex IIDsysfil1 "filter" "system filter"
36581 .scindex IIDsysfil2 "filtering all mail"
36582 .scindex IIDsysfil3 "system filter"
36583 The previous chapters (on ACLs and the local scan function) describe checks
36584 that can be applied to messages before they are accepted by a host. There is
36585 also a mechanism for checking messages once they have been received, but before
36586 they are delivered. This is called the &'system filter'&.
36588 The system filter operates in a similar manner to users' filter files, but it
36589 is run just once per message (however many recipients the message has).
36590 It should not normally be used as a substitute for routing, because &%deliver%&
36591 commands in a system router provide new envelope recipient addresses.
36592 The system filter must be an Exim filter. It cannot be a Sieve filter.
36594 The system filter is run at the start of a delivery attempt, before any routing
36595 is done. If a message fails to be completely delivered at the first attempt,
36596 the system filter is run again at the start of every retry.
36597 If you want your filter to do something only once per message, you can make use
36598 .cindex retry condition
36599 of the &%first_delivery%& condition in an &%if%& command in the filter to
36600 prevent it happening on retries.
36602 .vindex "&$domain$&"
36603 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
36604 &*Warning*&: Because the system filter runs just once, variables that are
36605 specific to individual recipient addresses, such as &$local_part$& and
36606 &$domain$&, are not set, and the &"personal"& condition is not meaningful. If
36607 you want to run a centrally-specified filter for each recipient address
36608 independently, you can do so by setting up a suitable &(redirect)& router, as
36609 described in section &<<SECTperaddfil>>& below.
36612 .section "Specifying a system filter" "SECID212"
36613 .cindex "uid (user id)" "system filter"
36614 .cindex "gid (group id)" "system filter"
36615 The name of the file that contains the system filter must be specified by
36616 setting &%system_filter%&. If you want the filter to run under a uid and gid
36617 other than root, you must also set &%system_filter_user%& and
36618 &%system_filter_group%& as appropriate. For example:
36620 system_filter = /etc/mail/exim.filter
36621 system_filter_user = exim
36623 If a system filter generates any deliveries directly to files or pipes (via the
36624 &%save%& or &%pipe%& commands), transports to handle these deliveries must be
36625 specified by setting &%system_filter_file_transport%& and
36626 &%system_filter_pipe_transport%&, respectively. Similarly,
36627 &%system_filter_reply_transport%& must be set to handle any messages generated
36628 by the &%reply%& command.
36631 .section "Testing a system filter" "SECID213"
36632 You can run simple tests of a system filter in the same way as for a user
36633 filter, but you should use &%-bF%& rather than &%-bf%&, so that features that
36634 are permitted only in system filters are recognized.
36636 If you want to test the combined effect of a system filter and a user filter,
36637 you can use both &%-bF%& and &%-bf%& on the same command line.
36641 .section "Contents of a system filter" "SECID214"
36642 The language used to specify system filters is the same as for users' filter
36643 files. It is described in the separate end-user document &'Exim's interface to
36644 mail filtering'&. However, there are some additional features that are
36645 available only in system filters; these are described in subsequent sections.
36646 If they are encountered in a user's filter file or when testing with &%-bf%&,
36649 .cindex "frozen messages" "manual thaw; testing in filter"
36650 There are two special conditions which, though available in users' filter
36651 files, are designed for use in system filters. The condition &%first_delivery%&
36652 is true only for the first attempt at delivering a message, and
36653 &%manually_thawed%& is true only if the message has been frozen, and
36654 subsequently thawed by an admin user. An explicit forced delivery counts as a
36655 manual thaw, but thawing as a result of the &%auto_thaw%& setting does not.
36657 &*Warning*&: If a system filter uses the &%first_delivery%& condition to
36658 specify an &"unseen"& (non-significant) delivery, and that delivery does not
36659 succeed, it will not be tried again.
36660 If you want Exim to retry an unseen delivery until it succeeds, you should
36661 arrange to set it up every time the filter runs.
36663 When a system filter finishes running, the values of the variables &$n0$& &--
36664 &$n9$& are copied into &$sn0$& &-- &$sn9$& and are thereby made available to
36665 users' filter files. Thus a system filter can, for example, set up &"scores"&
36666 to which users' filter files can refer.
36670 .section "Additional variable for system filters" "SECID215"
36671 .vindex "&$recipients$&"
36672 The expansion variable &$recipients$&, containing a list of all the recipients
36673 of the message (separated by commas and white space), is available in system
36674 filters. It is not available in users' filters for privacy reasons.
36678 .section "Defer, freeze, and fail commands for system filters" "SECID216"
36679 .cindex "freezing messages"
36680 .cindex "message" "freezing"
36681 .cindex "message" "forced failure"
36682 .cindex "&%fail%&" "in system filter"
36683 .cindex "&%freeze%& in system filter"
36684 .cindex "&%defer%& in system filter"
36685 There are three extra commands (&%defer%&, &%freeze%& and &%fail%&) which are
36686 always available in system filters, but are not normally enabled in users'
36687 filters. (See the &%allow_defer%&, &%allow_freeze%& and &%allow_fail%& options
36688 for the &(redirect)& router.) These commands can optionally be followed by the
36689 word &%text%& and a string containing an error message, for example:
36691 fail text "this message looks like spam to me"
36693 The keyword &%text%& is optional if the next character is a double quote.
36695 The &%defer%& command defers delivery of the original recipients of the
36696 message. The &%fail%& command causes all the original recipients to be failed,
36697 and a bounce message to be created. The &%freeze%& command suspends all
36698 delivery attempts for the original recipients. In all cases, any new deliveries
36699 that are specified by the filter are attempted as normal after the filter has
36702 The &%freeze%& command is ignored if the message has been manually unfrozen and
36703 not manually frozen since. This means that automatic freezing by a system
36704 filter can be used as a way of checking out suspicious messages. If a message
36705 is found to be all right, manually unfreezing it allows it to be delivered.
36707 .cindex "log" "&%fail%& command log line"
36708 .cindex "&%fail%&" "log line; reducing"
36709 The text given with a fail command is used as part of the bounce message as
36710 well as being written to the log. If the message is quite long, this can fill
36711 up a lot of log space when such failures are common. To reduce the size of the
36712 log message, Exim interprets the text in a special way if it starts with the
36713 two characters &`<<`& and contains &`>>`& later. The text between these two
36714 strings is written to the log, and the rest of the text is used in the bounce
36715 message. For example:
36717 fail "<<filter test 1>>Your message is rejected \
36718 because it contains attachments that we are \
36719 not prepared to receive."
36722 .cindex "loop" "caused by &%fail%&"
36723 Take great care with the &%fail%& command when basing the decision to fail on
36724 the contents of the message, because the bounce message will of course include
36725 the contents of the original message and will therefore trigger the &%fail%&
36726 command again (causing a mail loop) unless steps are taken to prevent this.
36727 Testing the &%error_message%& condition is one way to prevent this. You could
36730 if $message_body contains "this is spam" and not error_message
36731 then fail text "spam is not wanted here" endif
36733 though of course that might let through unwanted bounce messages. The
36734 alternative is clever checking of the body and/or headers to detect bounces
36735 generated by the filter.
36737 The interpretation of a system filter file ceases after a
36739 &%freeze%&, or &%fail%& command is obeyed. However, any deliveries that were
36740 set up earlier in the filter file are honoured, so you can use a sequence such
36746 to send a specified message when the system filter is freezing (or deferring or
36747 failing) a message. The normal deliveries for the message do not, of course,
36752 .section "Adding and removing headers in a system filter" "SECTaddremheasys"
36753 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in system filter"
36754 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in system filter"
36755 .cindex "filter" "header lines; adding/removing"
36756 Two filter commands that are available only in system filters are:
36758 headers add <string>
36759 headers remove <string>
36761 The argument for the &%headers add%& is a string that is expanded and then
36762 added to the end of the message's headers. It is the responsibility of the
36763 filter maintainer to make sure it conforms to
36764 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822) syntax. Leading white
36765 space is ignored, and if the string is otherwise empty, or if the expansion is
36766 forced to fail, the command has no effect.
36768 You can use &"\n"& within the string, followed by white space, to specify
36769 continued header lines. More than one header may be added in one command by
36770 including &"\n"& within the string without any following white space. For
36773 headers add "X-header-1: ....\n \
36774 continuation of X-header-1 ...\n\
36777 Note that the header line continuation white space after the first newline must
36778 be placed before the backslash that continues the input string, because white
36779 space after input continuations is ignored.
36781 The argument for &%headers remove%& is a colon-separated list of header names.
36782 This command applies only to those headers that are stored with the message;
36783 those that are added at delivery time (such as &'Envelope-To:'& and
36784 &'Return-Path:'&) cannot be removed by this means. If there is more than one
36785 header with the same name, they are all removed.
36787 The &%headers%& command in a system filter makes an immediate change to the set
36788 of header lines that was received with the message (with possible additions
36789 from ACL processing). Subsequent commands in the system filter operate on the
36790 modified set, which also forms the basis for subsequent message delivery.
36791 Unless further modified during routing or transporting, this set of headers is
36792 used for all recipients of the message.
36794 During routing and transporting, the variables that refer to the contents of
36795 header lines refer only to those lines that are in this set. Thus, header lines
36796 that are added by a system filter are visible to users' filter files and to all
36797 routers and transports. This contrasts with the manipulation of header lines by
36798 routers and transports, which is not immediate, but which instead is saved up
36799 until the message is actually being written (see section
36800 &<<SECTheadersaddrem>>&).
36802 If the message is not delivered at the first attempt, header lines that were
36803 added by the system filter are stored with the message, and so are still
36804 present at the next delivery attempt. Header lines that were removed are still
36805 present, but marked &"deleted"& so that they are not transported with the
36806 message. For this reason, it is usual to make the &%headers%& command
36807 conditional on &%first_delivery%& so that the set of header lines is not
36808 modified more than once.
36810 Because header modification in a system filter acts immediately, you have to
36811 use an indirect approach if you want to modify the contents of a header line.
36814 headers add "Old-Subject: $h_subject:"
36815 headers remove "Subject"
36816 headers add "Subject: new subject (was: $h_old-subject:)"
36817 headers remove "Old-Subject"
36822 .section "Setting an errors address in a system filter" "SECID217"
36823 .cindex "envelope from"
36824 .cindex "envelope sender"
36825 In a system filter, if a &%deliver%& command is followed by
36827 errors_to <some address>
36829 in order to change the envelope sender (and hence the error reporting) for that
36830 delivery, any address may be specified. (In a user filter, only the current
36831 user's address can be set.) For example, if some mail is being monitored, you
36834 unseen deliver monitor@spying.example errors_to root@local.example
36836 to take a copy which would not be sent back to the normal error reporting
36837 address if its delivery failed.
36841 .section "Per-address filtering" "SECTperaddfil"
36842 .vindex "&$domain_data$&"
36843 .vindex "&$local_part_data$&"
36844 In contrast to the system filter, which is run just once per message for each
36845 delivery attempt, it is also possible to set up a system-wide filtering
36846 operation that runs once for each recipient address. In this case, variables
36847 such as &$local_part_data$& and &$domain_data$& can be used,
36848 and indeed, the choice of filter file could be made dependent on them.
36849 This is an example of a router which implements such a filter:
36854 domains = +local_domains
36855 file = /central/filters/$local_part_data
36860 The filter is run in a separate process under its own uid. Therefore, either
36861 &%check_local_user%& must be set (as above), in which case the filter is run as
36862 the local user, or the &%user%& option must be used to specify which user to
36863 use. If both are set, &%user%& overrides.
36865 Care should be taken to ensure that none of the commands in the filter file
36866 specify a significant delivery if the message is to go on to be delivered to
36867 its intended recipient. The router will not then claim to have dealt with the
36868 address, so it will be passed on to subsequent routers to be delivered in the
36870 .ecindex IIDsysfil1
36871 .ecindex IIDsysfil2
36872 .ecindex IIDsysfil3
36879 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36880 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
36882 .chapter "Message processing" "CHAPmsgproc"
36883 .scindex IIDmesproc "message" "general processing"
36884 Exim performs various transformations on the sender and recipient addresses of
36885 all messages that it handles, and also on the messages' header lines. Some of
36886 these are optional and configurable, while others always take place. All of
36887 this processing, except rewriting as a result of routing, and the addition or
36888 removal of header lines while delivering, happens when a message is received,
36889 before it is placed on Exim's queue.
36891 Some of the automatic processing takes place by default only for
36892 &"locally-originated"& messages. This adjective is used to describe messages
36893 that are not received over TCP/IP, but instead are passed to an Exim process on
36894 its standard input. This includes the interactive &"local SMTP"& case that is
36895 set up by the &%-bs%& command line option.
36897 &*Note*&: Messages received over TCP/IP on the loopback interface (127.0.0.1
36898 or ::1) are not considered to be locally-originated. Exim does not treat the
36899 loopback interface specially in any way.
36901 If you want the loopback interface to be treated specially, you must ensure
36902 that there are appropriate entries in your ACLs.
36907 .section "Submission mode for non-local messages" "SECTsubmodnon"
36908 .cindex "message" "submission"
36909 .cindex "submission mode"
36910 Processing that happens automatically for locally-originated messages (unless
36911 &%suppress_local_fixups%& is set) can also be requested for messages that are
36912 received over TCP/IP. The term &"submission mode"& is used to describe this
36913 state. Submission mode is set by the modifier
36915 control = submission
36917 in a MAIL, RCPT, or pre-data ACL for an incoming message (see sections
36918 &<<SECTACLmodi>>& and &<<SECTcontrols>>&). This makes Exim treat the message as
36919 a local submission, and is normally used when the source of the message is
36920 known to be an MUA running on a client host (as opposed to an MTA). For
36921 example, to set submission mode for messages originating on the IPv4 loopback
36922 interface, you could include the following in the MAIL ACL:
36924 warn hosts = 127.0.0.1
36925 control = submission
36927 .cindex "&%sender_retain%& submission option"
36928 There are some options that can be used when setting submission mode. A slash
36929 is used to separate options. For example:
36931 control = submission/sender_retain
36933 Specifying &%sender_retain%& has the effect of setting &%local_sender_retain%&
36934 true and &%local_from_check%& false for the current incoming message. The first
36935 of these allows an existing &'Sender:'& header in the message to remain, and
36936 the second suppresses the check to ensure that &'From:'& matches the
36937 authenticated sender. With this setting, Exim still fixes up messages by adding
36938 &'Date:'& and &'Message-ID:'& header lines if they are missing, but makes no
36939 attempt to check sender authenticity in header lines.
36941 When &%sender_retain%& is not set, a submission mode setting may specify a
36942 domain to be used when generating a &'From:'& or &'Sender:'& header line. For
36945 control = submission/domain=some.domain
36947 The domain may be empty. How this value is used is described in sections
36948 &<<SECTthefrohea>>& and &<<SECTthesenhea>>&. There is also a &%name%& option
36949 that allows you to specify the user's full name for inclusion in a created
36950 &'Sender:'& or &'From:'& header line. For example:
36952 accept authenticated = *
36953 control = submission/domain=wonderland.example/\
36954 name=${lookup {$authenticated_id} \
36955 lsearch {/etc/exim/namelist}}
36957 Because the name may contain any characters, including slashes, the &%name%&
36958 option must be given last. The remainder of the string is used as the name. For
36959 the example above, if &_/etc/exim/namelist_& contains:
36961 bigegg: Humpty Dumpty
36963 then when the sender has authenticated as &'bigegg'&, the generated &'Sender:'&
36966 Sender: Humpty Dumpty <bigegg@wonderland.example>
36968 .cindex "return path" "in submission mode"
36969 By default, submission mode forces the return path to the same address as is
36970 used to create the &'Sender:'& header. However, if &%sender_retain%& is
36971 specified, the return path is also left unchanged.
36973 &*Note*&: The changes caused by submission mode take effect after the predata
36974 ACL. This means that any sender checks performed before the fix-ups use the
36975 untrusted sender address specified by the user, not the trusted sender address
36976 specified by submission mode. Although this might be slightly unexpected, it
36977 does mean that you can configure ACL checks to spot that a user is trying to
36978 spoof another's address.
36980 .section "Line endings" "SECTlineendings"
36981 .cindex "line endings"
36982 .cindex "carriage return"
36984 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2821,RFC 2821)
36985 specifies that CRLF (two characters: carriage-return, followed by
36986 linefeed) is the line ending for messages transmitted over the Internet using
36987 SMTP over TCP/IP. However, within individual operating systems, different
36988 conventions are used. For example, Unix-like systems use just LF, but others
36989 use CRLF or just CR.
36991 Exim was designed for Unix-like systems, and internally, it stores messages
36992 using the system's convention of a single LF as a line terminator. When
36993 receiving a message, all line endings are translated to this standard format.
36994 Originally, it was thought that programs that passed messages directly to an
36995 MTA within an operating system would use that system's convention. Experience
36996 has shown that this is not the case; for example, there are Unix applications
36997 that use CRLF in this circumstance. For this reason, and for compatibility with
36998 other MTAs, the way Exim handles line endings for all messages is now as
37002 CR is treated as a line ending; if it is immediately followed by LF, the LF
37005 The sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate an incoming SMTP message,
37006 nor a local message in the state where a line containing only a dot is a
37009 If a bare CR is encountered within a header line, an extra space is added after
37010 the line terminator so as not to end the header line. The reasoning behind this
37011 is that bare CRs in header lines are most likely either to be mistakes, or
37012 people trying to play silly games.
37014 If the first header line received in a message ends with CRLF, a subsequent
37015 bare LF in a header line is treated in the same way as a bare CR in a header
37016 line and a bare LF in a body line is replaced with a space.
37018 If the first header line received in a message does not end with CRLF, a subsequent
37019 LF not preceded by CR is treated as a line ending.
37026 .section "Unqualified addresses" "SECID218"
37027 .cindex "unqualified addresses"
37028 .cindex "address" "qualification"
37029 By default, Exim expects every envelope address it receives from an external
37030 host to be fully qualified. Unqualified addresses cause negative responses to
37031 SMTP commands. However, because SMTP is used as a means of transporting
37032 messages from MUAs running on personal workstations, there is sometimes a
37033 requirement to accept unqualified addresses from specific hosts or IP networks.
37035 Exim has two options that separately control which hosts may send unqualified
37036 sender or recipient addresses in SMTP commands, namely
37037 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&. In both
37038 cases, if an unqualified address is accepted, it is qualified by adding the
37039 value of &%qualify_domain%& or &%qualify_recipient%&, as appropriate.
37041 .oindex "&%qualify_domain%&"
37042 .oindex "&%qualify_recipient%&"
37043 Unqualified addresses in header lines are automatically qualified for messages
37044 that are locally originated, unless the &%-bnq%& option is given on the command
37045 line. For messages received over SMTP, unqualified addresses in header lines
37046 are qualified only if unqualified addresses are permitted in SMTP commands. In
37047 other words, such qualification is also controlled by
37048 &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& and &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%&,
37053 .section "The UUCP From line" "SECID219"
37054 .cindex "&""From""& line"
37055 .cindex "UUCP" "&""From""& line"
37056 .cindex "sender" "address"
37057 .oindex "&%uucp_from_pattern%&"
37058 .oindex "&%uucp_from_sender%&"
37059 .cindex "envelope from"
37060 .cindex "envelope sender"
37061 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
37062 Messages that have come from UUCP (and some other applications) often begin
37063 with a line containing the envelope sender and a timestamp, following the word
37064 &"From"&. Examples of two common formats are:
37066 From a.oakley@berlin.mus Fri Jan 5 12:35 GMT 1996
37067 From f.butler@berlin.mus Fri, 7 Jan 97 14:00:00 GMT
37069 This line precedes the
37070 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37071 header lines. For compatibility with Sendmail,
37072 Exim recognizes such lines at the start of messages that are submitted to it
37073 via the command line (that is, on the standard input). It does not recognize
37074 such lines in incoming SMTP messages, unless the sending host matches
37075 &%ignore_fromline_hosts%& or the &%-bs%& option was used for a local message
37076 and &%ignore_fromline_local%& is set. The recognition is controlled by a
37077 regular expression that is defined by the &%uucp_from_pattern%& option, whose
37078 default value matches the two common cases shown above and puts the address
37079 that follows &"From"& into &$1$&.
37081 .cindex "numerical variables (&$1$& &$2$& etc)" "in &""From ""& line handling"
37082 When the caller of Exim for a non-SMTP message that contains a &"From"& line is
37083 a trusted user, the message's sender address is constructed by expanding the
37084 contents of &%uucp_sender_address%&, whose default value is &"$1"&. This is
37086 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37087 address. If there is no domain, the local part is
37088 qualified with &%qualify_domain%& unless it is the empty string. However, if
37089 the command line &%-f%& option is used, it overrides the &"From"& line.
37091 If the caller of Exim is not trusted, the &"From"& line is recognized, but the
37092 sender address is not changed. This is also the case for incoming SMTP messages
37093 that are permitted to contain &"From"& lines.
37095 Only one &"From"& line is recognized. If there is more than one, the second is
37096 treated as a data line that starts the body of the message, as it is not valid
37097 as a header line. This also happens if a &"From"& line is present in an
37098 incoming SMTP message from a source that is not permitted to send them.
37102 .section "Header lines"
37103 .subsection "Resent- header lines" SECID220
37105 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37106 makes provision for sets of header lines starting with the string
37107 &`Resent-`& to be added to a message when it is resent by the original
37108 recipient to somebody else. These headers are &'Resent-Date:'&,
37109 &'Resent-From:'&, &'Resent-Sender:'&, &'Resent-To:'&, &'Resent-Cc:'&,
37110 &'Resent-Bcc:'& and &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The RFC says:
37113 &'Resent fields are strictly informational. They MUST NOT be used in the normal
37114 processing of replies or other such automatic actions on messages.'&
37117 This leaves things a bit vague as far as other processing actions such as
37118 address rewriting are concerned. Exim treats &%Resent-%& header lines as
37122 A &'Resent-From:'& line that just contains the login id of the submitting user
37123 is automatically rewritten in the same way as &'From:'& (see below).
37125 If there's a rewriting rule for a particular header line, it is also applied to
37126 &%Resent-%& header lines of the same type. For example, a rule that rewrites
37127 &'From:'& also rewrites &'Resent-From:'&.
37129 For local messages, if &'Sender:'& is removed on input, &'Resent-Sender:'& is
37132 For a locally-submitted message,
37133 if there are any &%Resent-%& header lines but no &'Resent-Date:'&,
37134 &'Resent-From:'&, or &'Resent-Message-Id:'&, they are added as necessary. It is
37135 the contents of &'Resent-Message-Id:'& (rather than &'Message-Id:'&) which are
37136 included in log lines in this case.
37138 The logic for adding &'Sender:'& is duplicated for &'Resent-Sender:'& when any
37139 &%Resent-%& header lines are present.
37145 .subsection Auto-Submitted: SECID221
37146 Whenever Exim generates an autoreply, a bounce, or a delay warning message, it
37147 includes the header line:
37149 Auto-Submitted: auto-replied
37152 .subsection Bcc: SECID222
37153 .cindex "&'Bcc:'& header line"
37154 If Exim is called with the &%-t%& option, to take recipient addresses from a
37155 message's header, it removes any &'Bcc:'& header line that may exist (after
37156 extracting its addresses). If &%-t%& is not present on the command line, any
37157 existing &'Bcc:'& is not removed.
37160 .subsection Date: SECID223
37162 If a locally-generated or submission-mode message has no &'Date:'& header line,
37163 Exim adds one, using the current date and time, unless the
37164 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control has been specified.
37166 .subsection Delivery-date: SECID224
37167 .cindex "&'Delivery-date:'& header line"
37168 .oindex "&%delivery_date_remove%&"
37169 &'Delivery-date:'& header lines are not part of the standard
37170 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37172 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See
37173 the generic &%delivery_date_add%& transport option.) They should not be present
37174 in messages in transit. If the &%delivery_date_remove%& configuration option is
37175 set (the default), Exim removes &'Delivery-date:'& header lines from incoming
37179 .subsection Envelope-to: SECID225
37180 .chindex Envelope-to:
37181 .oindex "&%envelope_to_remove%&"
37182 &'Envelope-to:'& header lines are not part of the standard
37183 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822) header set.
37184 Exim can be configured to add them to the final delivery of messages. (See the
37185 generic &%envelope_to_add%& transport option.) They should not be present in
37186 messages in transit. If the &%envelope_to_remove%& configuration option is set
37187 (the default), Exim removes &'Envelope-to:'& header lines from incoming
37191 .subsection From: SECTthefrohea
37193 .cindex "Sendmail compatibility" "&""From""& line"
37194 .cindex "message" "submission"
37195 .cindex "submission mode"
37196 If a submission-mode message does not contain a &'From:'& header line, Exim
37197 adds one if either of the following conditions is true:
37200 The envelope sender address is not empty (that is, this is not a bounce
37201 message). The added header line copies the envelope sender address.
37203 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
37204 The SMTP session is authenticated and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty.
37206 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
37207 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
37208 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
37210 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local
37211 part is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
37213 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
37214 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
37218 A non-empty envelope sender takes precedence.
37220 If a locally-generated incoming message does not contain a &'From:'& header
37221 line, and the &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds one
37222 containing the sender's address. The calling user's login name and full name
37223 are used to construct the address, as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
37224 They are obtained from the password data by calling &[getpwuid()]& (but see the
37225 &%unknown_login%& configuration option). The address is qualified with
37226 &%qualify_domain%&.
37228 For compatibility with Sendmail, if an incoming, non-SMTP message has a
37229 &'From:'& header line containing just the unqualified login name of the calling
37230 user, this is replaced by an address containing the user's login name and full
37231 name as described in section &<<SECTconstr>>&.
37234 .subsection Message-ID: SECID226
37235 .chindex Message-ID:
37236 .cindex "message" "submission"
37237 .oindex "&%message_id_header_text%&"
37238 If a locally-generated or submission-mode incoming message does not contain a
37239 &'Message-ID:'& or &'Resent-Message-ID:'& header line, and the
37240 &%suppress_local_fixups%& control is not set, Exim adds a suitable header line
37241 to the message. If there are any &'Resent-:'& headers in the message, it
37242 creates &'Resent-Message-ID:'&. The id is constructed from Exim's internal
37243 message id, preceded by the letter E to ensure it starts with a letter, and
37244 followed by @ and the primary host name. Additional information can be included
37245 in this header line by setting the &%message_id_header_text%& and/or
37246 &%message_id_header_domain%& options.
37249 .subsection Received: SECID227
37251 A &'Received:'& header line is added at the start of every message. The
37252 contents are defined by the &%received_header_text%& configuration option, and
37253 Exim automatically adds a semicolon and a timestamp to the configured string.
37255 The &'Received:'& header is generated as soon as the message's header lines
37256 have been received. At this stage, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header
37257 line is the time that the message started to be received. This is the value
37258 that is seen by the DATA ACL and by the &[local_scan()]& function.
37260 Once a message is accepted, the timestamp in the &'Received:'& header line is
37261 changed to the time of acceptance, which is (apart from a small delay while the
37262 -H spool file is written) the earliest time at which delivery could start.
37265 .subsection References: SECID228
37266 .chindex References:
37267 Messages created by the &(autoreply)& transport include a &'References:'&
37268 header line. This is constructed according to the rules that are described in
37270 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37271 (which states that replies should contain such a header line),
37272 and section 3.14 of &url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc3834,RFC 3834)
37273 (which states that automatic
37274 responses are not different in this respect). However, because some mail
37275 processing software does not cope well with very long header lines, no more
37276 than 12 message IDs are copied from the &'References:'& header line in the
37277 incoming message. If there are more than 12, the first one and then the final
37278 11 are copied, before adding the message ID of the incoming message.
37282 .subsection Return-path: SECID229
37283 .chindex Return-path:
37284 .oindex "&%return_path_remove%&"
37285 &'Return-path:'& header lines are defined as something an MTA may insert when
37286 it does the final delivery of messages. (See the generic &%return_path_add%&
37287 transport option.) Therefore, they should not be present in messages in
37288 transit. If the &%return_path_remove%& configuration option is set (the
37289 default), Exim removes &'Return-path:'& header lines from incoming messages.
37293 .subsection Sender: SECTthesenhea
37294 .cindex "&'Sender:'& header line"
37295 .cindex "message" "submission"
37297 For a locally-originated message from an untrusted user, Exim may remove an
37298 existing &'Sender:'& header line, and it may add a new one. You can modify
37299 these actions by setting the &%local_sender_retain%& option true, the
37300 &%local_from_check%& option false, or by using the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
37303 When a local message is received from an untrusted user and
37304 &%local_from_check%& is true (the default), and the &%suppress_local_fixups%&
37305 control has not been set, a check is made to see if the address given in the
37306 &'From:'& header line is the correct (local) sender of the message. The address
37307 that is expected has the login name as the local part and the value of
37308 &%qualify_domain%& as the domain. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part can
37309 be permitted by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%&
37310 appropriately. If &'From:'& does not contain the correct sender, a &'Sender:'&
37311 line is added to the message.
37313 If you set &%local_from_check%& false, this checking does not occur. However,
37314 the removal of an existing &'Sender:'& line still happens, unless you also set
37315 &%local_sender_retain%& to be true. It is not possible to set both of these
37316 options true at the same time.
37318 .cindex "submission mode"
37319 By default, no processing of &'Sender:'& header lines is done for messages
37320 received over TCP/IP or for messages submitted by trusted users. However, when
37321 a message is received over TCP/IP in submission mode, and &%sender_retain%& is
37322 not specified on the submission control, the following processing takes place:
37324 .vindex "&$authenticated_id$&"
37325 First, any existing &'Sender:'& lines are removed. Then, if the SMTP session is
37326 authenticated, and &$authenticated_id$& is not empty, a sender address is
37327 created as follows:
37330 .vindex "&$qualify_domain$&"
37331 If no domain is specified by the submission control, the local part is
37332 &$authenticated_id$& and the domain is &$qualify_domain$&.
37334 If a non-empty domain is specified by the submission control, the local part
37335 is &$authenticated_id$&, and the domain is the specified domain.
37337 If an empty domain is specified by the submission control,
37338 &$authenticated_id$& is assumed to be the complete address.
37341 This address is compared with the address in the &'From:'& header line. If they
37342 are different, a &'Sender:'& header line containing the created address is
37343 added. Prefixes and suffixes for the local part in &'From:'& can be permitted
37344 by setting &%local_from_prefix%& and &%local_from_suffix%& appropriately.
37346 .cindex "return path" "created from &'Sender:'&"
37347 &*Note*&: Whenever a &'Sender:'& header line is created, the return path for
37348 the message (the envelope sender address) is changed to be the same address,
37349 except in the case of submission mode when &%sender_retain%& is specified.
37353 .section "Adding and removing header lines in routers and transports" &&&
37354 "SECTheadersaddrem"
37355 .cindex "header lines" "adding; in router or transport"
37356 .cindex "header lines" "removing; in router or transport"
37357 When a message is delivered, the addition and removal of header lines can be
37358 specified in a system filter, or on any of the routers and transports that
37359 process the message. Section &<<SECTaddremheasys>>& contains details about
37360 modifying headers in a system filter. Header lines can also be added in an ACL
37361 as a message is received (see section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>&).
37363 In contrast to what happens in a system filter, header modifications that are
37364 specified on routers and transports apply only to the particular recipient
37365 addresses that are being processed by those routers and transports. These
37366 changes do not actually take place until a copy of the message is being
37367 transported. Therefore, they do not affect the basic set of header lines, and
37368 they do not affect the values of the variables that refer to header lines.
37370 &*Note*&: In particular, this means that any expansions in the configuration of
37371 the transport cannot refer to the modified header lines, because such
37372 expansions all occur before the message is actually transported.
37374 For both routers and transports, the argument of a &%headers_add%&
37375 option must be in the form of one or more
37376 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37377 header lines, separated by newlines (coded as &"\n"&). For example:
37379 headers_add = X-added-header: added by $primary_hostname\n\
37380 X-added-second: another added header line
37382 Exim does not check the syntax of these added header lines.
37384 Multiple &%headers_add%& options for a single router or transport can be
37385 specified; the values will append to a single list of header lines.
37386 Each header-line is separately expanded.
37388 The argument of a &%headers_remove%& option must consist of a colon-separated
37389 list of header names. This is confusing, because header names themselves are
37390 often terminated by colons. In this case, the colons are the list separators,
37391 not part of the names. For example:
37393 headers_remove = return-receipt-to:acknowledge-to
37396 Multiple &%headers_remove%& options for a single router or transport can be
37397 specified; the arguments will append to a single header-names list.
37398 Each item is separately expanded.
37399 Note that colons in complex expansions which are used to
37400 form all or part of a &%headers_remove%& list
37401 will act as list separators.
37403 When &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%& is specified on a router,
37404 items are expanded at routing time,
37405 and then associated with all addresses that are
37406 accepted by that router, and also with any new addresses that it generates. If
37407 an address passes through several routers as a result of aliasing or
37408 forwarding, the changes are cumulative.
37410 .oindex "&%unseen%&"
37411 However, this does not apply to multiple routers that result from the use of
37412 the &%unseen%& option. Any header modifications that were specified by the
37413 &"unseen"& router or its predecessors apply only to the &"unseen"& delivery.
37415 Addresses that end up with different &%headers_add%& or &%headers_remove%&
37416 settings cannot be delivered together in a batch, so a transport is always
37417 dealing with a set of addresses that have the same header-processing
37420 The transport starts by writing the original set of header lines that arrived
37421 with the message, possibly modified by the system filter. As it writes out
37422 these lines, it consults the list of header names that were attached to the
37423 recipient address(es) by &%headers_remove%& options in routers, and it also
37424 consults the transport's own &%headers_remove%& option. Header lines whose
37425 names are on either of these lists are not written out. If there are multiple
37426 instances of any listed header, they are all skipped.
37428 After the remaining original header lines have been written, new header
37429 lines that were specified by routers' &%headers_add%& options are written, in
37430 the order in which they were attached to the address. These are followed by any
37431 header lines specified by the transport's &%headers_add%& option.
37433 This way of handling header line modifications in routers and transports has
37434 the following consequences:
37437 The original set of header lines, possibly modified by the system filter,
37438 remains &"visible"&, in the sense that the &$header_$&&'xxx'& variables refer
37439 to it, at all times.
37441 Header lines that are added by a router's
37442 &%headers_add%& option are not accessible by means of the &$header_$&&'xxx'&
37443 expansion syntax in subsequent routers or the transport.
37445 Conversely, header lines that are specified for removal by &%headers_remove%&
37446 in a router remain visible to subsequent routers and the transport.
37448 Headers added to an address by &%headers_add%& in a router cannot be removed by
37449 a later router or by a transport.
37451 An added header can refer to the contents of an original header that is to be
37452 removed, even it has the same name as the added header. For example:
37454 headers_remove = subject
37455 headers_add = Subject: new subject (was: $h_subject:)
37459 &*Warning*&: The &%headers_add%& and &%headers_remove%& options cannot be used
37460 for a &(redirect)& router that has the &%one_time%& option set.
37466 .section "Constructed addresses" "SECTconstr"
37467 .cindex "address" "constructed"
37468 .cindex "constructed address"
37469 When Exim constructs a sender address for a locally-generated message, it uses
37472 <&'user name'&>&~&~<&'login'&&`@`&&'qualify_domain'&>
37476 Zaphod Beeblebrox <zaphod@end.univ.example>
37478 The user name is obtained from the &%-F%& command line option if set, or
37479 otherwise by looking up the calling user by &[getpwuid()]& and extracting the
37480 &"gecos"& field from the password entry. If the &"gecos"& field contains an
37481 ampersand character, this is replaced by the login name with the first letter
37482 upper cased, as is conventional in a number of operating systems. See the
37483 &%gecos_name%& option for a way to tailor the handling of the &"gecos"& field.
37484 The &%unknown_username%& option can be used to specify user names in cases when
37485 there is no password file entry.
37488 In all cases, the user name is made to conform to
37489 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37491 parts of it if necessary. In addition, if it contains any non-printing
37492 characters, it is encoded as described in
37493 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2047,RFC 2047), which defines a way of
37494 including non-ASCII characters in header lines. The value of the
37495 &%headers_charset%& option specifies the name of the encoding that is used (the
37496 characters are assumed to be in this encoding). The setting of
37497 &%print_topbitchars%& controls whether characters with the top bit set (that
37498 is, with codes greater than 127) count as printing characters or not.
37502 .section "Case of local parts" "SECID230"
37503 .cindex "case of local parts"
37504 .cindex "local part" "case of"
37505 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37506 states that the case of letters in the local parts of addresses cannot
37507 be assumed to be non-significant. Exim preserves the case of local parts of
37508 addresses, but by default it uses a lower-cased form when it is routing,
37509 because on most Unix systems, usernames are in lower case and case-insensitive
37510 routing is required. However, any particular router can be made to use the
37511 original case for local parts by setting the &%caseful_local_part%& generic
37514 .cindex "mixed-case login names"
37515 If you must have mixed-case user names on your system, the best way to proceed,
37516 assuming you want case-independent handling of incoming email, is to set up
37517 your first router to convert incoming local parts in your domains to the
37518 correct case by means of a file lookup. For example:
37522 domains = +local_domains
37523 data = ${lookup{$local_part}cdb\
37524 {/etc/usercased.cdb}{$value}fail}\
37527 For this router, the local part is forced to lower case by the default action
37528 (&%caseful_local_part%& is not set). The lower-cased local part is used to look
37529 up a new local part in the correct case. If you then set &%caseful_local_part%&
37530 on any subsequent routers which process your domains, they will operate on
37531 local parts with the correct case in a case-sensitive manner.
37535 .section "Dots in local parts" "SECID231"
37536 .cindex "dot" "in local part"
37537 .cindex "local part" "dots in"
37538 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2822,RFC 2822)
37539 forbids empty components in local parts. That is, an unquoted local
37540 part may not begin or end with a dot, nor have two consecutive dots in the
37541 middle. However, it seems that many MTAs do not enforce this, so Exim permits
37542 empty components for compatibility.
37546 .section "Rewriting addresses" "SECID232"
37547 .cindex "rewriting" "addresses"
37548 Rewriting of sender and recipient addresses, and addresses in headers, can
37549 happen automatically, or as the result of configuration options, as described
37550 in chapter &<<CHAPrewrite>>&. The headers that may be affected by this are
37551 &'Bcc:'&, &'Cc:'&, &'From:'&, &'Reply-To:'&, &'Sender:'&, and &'To:'&.
37553 Automatic rewriting includes qualification, as mentioned above. The other case
37554 in which it can happen is when an incomplete non-local domain is given. The
37555 routing process may cause this to be expanded into the full domain name. For
37556 example, a header such as
37560 might get rewritten as
37562 To: hare@teaparty.wonderland.fict.example
37564 Rewriting as a result of routing is the one kind of message processing that
37565 does not happen at input time, as it cannot be done until the address has
37568 Strictly, one should not do &'any'& deliveries of a message until all its
37569 addresses have been routed, in case any of the headers get changed as a
37570 result of routing. However, doing this in practice would hold up many
37571 deliveries for unreasonable amounts of time, just because one address could not
37572 immediately be routed. Exim therefore does not delay other deliveries when
37573 routing of one or more addresses is deferred.
37574 .ecindex IIDmesproc
37578 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37579 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
37581 .chapter "SMTP processing" "CHAPSMTP"
37582 .scindex IIDsmtpproc1 "SMTP" "processing details"
37583 .scindex IIDsmtpproc2 "LMTP" "processing details"
37584 Exim supports a number of different ways of using the SMTP protocol, and its
37585 LMTP variant, which is an interactive protocol for transferring messages into a
37586 closed mail store application. This chapter contains details of how SMTP is
37587 processed. For incoming mail, the following are available:
37590 SMTP over TCP/IP (Exim daemon or &'inetd'&);
37592 SMTP over the standard input and output (the &%-bs%& option);
37594 Batched SMTP on the standard input (the &%-bS%& option).
37597 For mail delivery, the following are available:
37600 SMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport);
37602 LMTP over TCP/IP (the &(smtp)& transport with the &%protocol%& option set to
37605 LMTP over a pipe to a process running in the local host (the &(lmtp)&
37608 Batched SMTP to a file or pipe (the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports with
37609 the &%use_bsmtp%& option set).
37612 &'Batched SMTP'& is the name for a process in which batches of messages are
37613 stored in or read from files (or pipes), in a format in which SMTP commands are
37614 used to contain the envelope information.
37618 .section "Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP" "SECToutSMTPTCP"
37619 .cindex "SMTP" "outgoing over TCP/IP"
37620 .cindex "outgoing SMTP over TCP/IP"
37621 .cindex "LMTP" "over TCP/IP"
37622 .cindex "outgoing LMTP over TCP/IP"
37625 .cindex "SIZE" "option on MAIL command"
37626 Outgoing SMTP and LMTP over TCP/IP is implemented by the &(smtp)& transport.
37627 The &%protocol%& option selects which protocol is to be used, but the actual
37628 processing is the same in both cases.
37630 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SIZE
37631 If, in response to its EHLO command, Exim is told that the SIZE
37632 extension is supported, it adds SIZE=<&'n'&> to each subsequent MAIL
37633 command. The value of <&'n'&> is the message size plus the value of the
37634 &%size_addition%& option (default 1024) to allow for additions to the message
37635 such as per-transport header lines, or changes made in a
37636 .cindex "transport" "filter"
37637 .cindex "filter" "transport filter"
37638 transport filter. If &%size_addition%& is set negative, the use of SIZE is
37641 If the remote server advertises support for PIPELINING, Exim uses the
37642 pipelining extension to SMTP
37643 (&url(https://datatracker.ietf.org/doc/html/rfc2197,RFC 2197))
37644 to reduce the number of TCP/IP packets required for the transaction.
37646 If the remote server advertises support for the STARTTLS command, and Exim
37647 was built to support TLS encryption, it tries to start a TLS session unless the
37648 server matches &%hosts_avoid_tls%&. See chapter &<<CHAPTLS>>& for more details.
37649 Either a match in that or &%hosts_verify_avoid_tls%& apply when the transport
37650 is called for verification.
37652 If the remote server advertises support for the AUTH command, Exim scans
37653 the authenticators configuration for any suitable client settings, as described
37654 in chapter &<<CHAPSMTPAUTH>>&.
37656 .cindex "carriage return"
37658 Responses from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37659 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters, so in
37660 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37663 If a message contains a number of different addresses, all those with the same
37664 characteristics (for example, the same envelope sender) that resolve to the
37665 same set of hosts, in the same order, are sent in a single SMTP transaction,
37666 even if they are for different domains, unless there are more than the setting
37667 of the &%max_rcpt%&s option in the &(smtp)& transport allows, in which case
37668 they are split into groups containing no more than &%max_rcpt%&s addresses
37669 each. If &%remote_max_parallel%& is greater than one, such groups may be sent
37670 in parallel sessions. The order of hosts with identical MX values is not
37671 significant when checking whether addresses can be batched in this way.
37673 When the &(smtp)& transport suffers a temporary failure that is not
37674 message-related, Exim updates its transport-specific database, which contains
37675 records indexed by host name that remember which messages are waiting for each
37676 particular host. It also updates the retry database with new retry times.
37678 .cindex "hints database" "retry keys"
37679 Exim's retry hints are based on host name plus IP address, so if one address of
37680 a multi-homed host is broken, it will soon be skipped most of the time.
37681 See the next section for more detail about error handling.
37683 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
37684 .cindex "SMTP" "batching over TCP/IP"
37685 When a message is successfully delivered over a TCP/IP SMTP connection, Exim
37686 looks in the hints database for the transport to see if there are any queued
37687 messages waiting for the host to which it is connected.
37688 If it finds one, it arranges to attempt that message on the same connection.
37690 The &%connection_max_messages%& option of the &(smtp)& transport can be used to
37691 limit the number of messages sent down a single TCP/IP connection.
37693 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
37694 The second and subsequent messages delivered down an existing connection are
37695 identified in the main log by the addition of an asterisk after the closing
37696 square bracket of the IP address.
37701 .subsection "Errors in outgoing SMTP" SECToutSMTPerr
37702 .cindex "error" "in outgoing SMTP"
37703 .cindex "SMTP" "errors in outgoing"
37704 .cindex "host" "error"
37705 Three different kinds of error are recognized for outgoing SMTP: host errors,
37706 message errors, and recipient errors.
37709 .vitem "&*Host errors*&"
37710 A host error is not associated with a particular message or with a
37711 particular recipient of a message. The host errors are:
37714 Connection refused or timed out,
37716 Any error response code on connection,
37718 Any error response code to EHLO or HELO,
37720 Loss of connection at any time, except after &"."&,
37722 I/O errors at any time,
37724 Timeouts during the session, other than in response to MAIL, RCPT or
37725 the &"."& at the end of the data.
37728 For a host error, a permanent error response on connection, or in response to
37729 EHLO, causes all addresses routed to the host to be failed. Any other host
37730 error causes all addresses to be deferred, and retry data to be created for the
37731 host. It is not tried again, for any message, until its retry time arrives. If
37732 the current set of addresses are not all delivered in this run (to some
37733 alternative host), the message is added to the list of those waiting for this
37734 host, so if it is still undelivered when a subsequent successful delivery is
37735 made to the host, it will be sent down the same SMTP connection.
37737 .vitem "&*Message errors*&"
37738 .cindex "message" "error"
37739 A message error is associated with a particular message when sent to a
37740 particular host, but not with a particular recipient of the message. The
37741 message errors are:
37744 Any error response code to MAIL, DATA, or the &"."& that terminates
37747 Timeout after MAIL,
37749 Timeout or loss of connection after the &"."& that terminates the data. A
37750 timeout after the DATA command itself is treated as a host error, as is loss of
37751 connection at any other time.
37754 For a message error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes all addresses
37755 to be failed, and a delivery error report to be returned to the sender. A
37756 temporary error response (4&'xx'&), or one of the timeouts, causes all
37757 addresses to be deferred. Retry data is not created for the host, but instead,
37758 a retry record for the combination of host plus message id is created. The
37759 message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. This ensures
37760 that the failing message will not be sent to this host again until the retry
37761 time arrives. However, other messages that are routed to the host are not
37762 affected, so if it is some property of the message that is causing the error,
37763 it will not stop the delivery of other mail.
37765 If the remote host specified support for the SIZE parameter in its response
37766 to EHLO, Exim adds SIZE=&'nnn'& to the MAIL command, so an
37767 over-large message will cause a message error because the error arrives as a
37770 .vitem "&*Recipient errors*&"
37771 .cindex "recipient" "error"
37772 A recipient error is associated with a particular recipient of a message. The
37773 recipient errors are:
37776 Any error response to RCPT,
37778 Timeout after RCPT.
37781 For a recipient error, a permanent error response (5&'xx'&) causes the
37782 recipient address to be failed, and a bounce message to be returned to the
37783 sender. A temporary error response (4&'xx'&) or a timeout causes the failing
37784 address to be deferred, and routing retry data to be created for it. This is
37785 used to delay processing of the address in subsequent queue runs, until its
37786 routing retry time arrives. This applies to all messages, but because it
37787 operates only in queue runs, one attempt will be made to deliver a new message
37788 to the failing address before the delay starts to operate. This ensures that,
37789 if the failure is really related to the message rather than the recipient
37790 (&"message too big for this recipient"& is a possible example), other messages
37791 have a chance of getting delivered. If a delivery to the address does succeed,
37792 the retry information gets cleared, so all stuck messages get tried again, and
37793 the retry clock is reset.
37795 The message is not added to the list of those waiting for this host. Use of the
37796 host for other messages is unaffected, and except in the case of a timeout,
37797 other recipients are processed independently, and may be successfully delivered
37798 in the current SMTP session. After a timeout it is of course impossible to
37799 proceed with the session, so all addresses get deferred. However, those other
37800 than the one that failed do not suffer any subsequent retry delays. Therefore,
37801 if one recipient is causing trouble, the others have a chance of getting
37802 through when a subsequent delivery attempt occurs before the failing
37803 recipient's retry time.
37806 In all cases, if there are other hosts (or IP addresses) available for the
37807 current set of addresses (for example, from multiple MX records), they are
37808 tried in this run for any undelivered addresses, subject of course to their
37809 own retry data. In other words, recipient error retry data does not take effect
37810 until the next delivery attempt.
37812 Some hosts have been observed to give temporary error responses to every
37813 MAIL command at certain times (&"insufficient space"& has been seen). It
37814 would be nice if such circumstances could be recognized, and defer data for the
37815 host itself created, but this is not possible within the current Exim design.
37816 What actually happens is that retry data for every (host, message) combination
37819 The reason that timeouts after MAIL and RCPT are treated specially is that
37820 these can sometimes arise as a result of the remote host's verification
37821 procedures. Exim makes this assumption, and treats them as if a temporary error
37822 response had been received. A timeout after &"."& is treated specially because
37823 it is known that some broken implementations fail to recognize the end of the
37824 message if the last character of the last line is a binary zero. Thus, it is
37825 helpful to treat this case as a message error.
37827 Timeouts at other times are treated as host errors, assuming a problem with the
37828 host, or the connection to it. If a timeout after MAIL, RCPT,
37829 or &"."& is really a connection problem, the assumption is that at the next try
37830 the timeout is likely to occur at some other point in the dialogue, causing it
37831 then to be treated as a host error.
37833 There is experimental evidence that some MTAs drop the connection after the
37834 terminating &"."& if they do not like the contents of the message for some
37835 reason, in contravention of the RFC, which indicates that a 5&'xx'& response
37836 should be given. That is why Exim treats this case as a message rather than a
37837 host error, in order not to delay other messages to the same host.
37842 .section "Incoming SMTP messages over TCP/IP" "SECID233"
37843 .cindex "SMTP" "incoming over TCP/IP"
37844 .cindex "incoming SMTP over TCP/IP"
37847 Incoming SMTP messages can be accepted in one of two ways: by running a
37848 listening daemon, or by using &'inetd'&. In the latter case, the entry in
37849 &_/etc/inetd.conf_& should be like this:
37851 smtp stream tcp nowait exim /opt/exim/bin/exim in.exim -bs
37853 Exim distinguishes between this case and the case of a locally running user
37854 agent using the &%-bs%& option by checking whether or not the standard input is
37855 a socket. When it is, either the port must be privileged (less than 1024), or
37856 the caller must be root or the Exim user. If any other user passes a socket
37857 with an unprivileged port number, Exim prints a message on the standard error
37858 stream and exits with an error code.
37860 By default, Exim does not make a log entry when a remote host connects or
37861 disconnects (either via the daemon or &'inetd'&), unless the disconnection is
37862 unexpected. It can be made to write such log entries by setting the
37863 &%smtp_connection%& log selector.
37865 .cindex "carriage return"
37867 Commands from the remote host are supposed to be terminated by CR followed by
37868 LF. However, there are known to be hosts that do not send CR characters. In
37869 order to be able to interwork with such hosts, Exim treats LF on its own as a
37871 Furthermore, because common code is used for receiving messages from all
37872 sources, a CR on its own is also interpreted as a line terminator. However, the
37873 sequence &"CR, dot, CR"& does not terminate incoming SMTP data.
37875 .cindex "EHLO" "invalid data"
37876 .cindex "HELO" "invalid data"
37877 One area that sometimes gives rise to problems concerns the EHLO or
37878 HELO commands. Some clients send syntactically invalid versions of these
37879 commands, which Exim rejects by default. (This is nothing to do with verifying
37880 the data that is sent, so &%helo_verify_hosts%& is not relevant.) You can tell
37881 Exim not to apply a syntax check by setting &%helo_accept_junk_hosts%& to
37882 match the broken hosts that send invalid commands.
37884 .cindex "SIZE option on MAIL command"
37885 .cindex "MAIL" "SIZE option"
37886 The amount of disk space available is checked whenever SIZE is received on
37887 a MAIL command, independently of whether &%message_size_limit%& or
37888 &%check_spool_space%& is configured, unless &%smtp_check_spool_space%& is set
37889 false. A temporary error is given if there is not enough space. If
37890 &%check_spool_space%& is set, the check is for that amount of space plus the
37891 value given with SIZE, that is, it checks that the addition of the incoming
37892 message will not reduce the space below the threshold.
37894 When a message is successfully received, Exim includes the local message id in
37895 its response to the final &"."& that terminates the data. If the remote host
37896 logs this text it can help with tracing what has happened to a message.
37898 The Exim daemon can limit the number of simultaneous incoming connections it is
37899 prepared to handle (see the &%smtp_accept_max%& option). It can also limit the
37900 number of simultaneous incoming connections from a single remote host (see the
37901 &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& option). Additional connection attempts are
37902 rejected using the SMTP temporary error code 421.
37904 The Exim daemon does not rely on the SIGCHLD signal to detect when a
37905 subprocess has finished, as this can get lost at busy times. Instead, it looks
37906 for completed subprocesses every time it wakes up. Provided there are other
37907 things happening (new incoming calls, starts of queue runs), completed
37908 processes will be noticed and tidied away. On very quiet systems you may
37909 sometimes see a &"defunct"& Exim process hanging about. This is not a problem;
37910 it will be noticed when the daemon next wakes up.
37912 When running as a daemon, Exim can reserve some SMTP slots for specific hosts,
37913 and can also be set up to reject SMTP calls from non-reserved hosts at times of
37914 high system load &-- for details see the &%smtp_accept_reserve%&,
37915 &%smtp_load_reserve%&, and &%smtp_reserve_hosts%& options. The load check
37916 applies in both the daemon and &'inetd'& cases.
37918 Exim normally starts a delivery process for each message received, though this
37919 can be varied by means of the &%-odq%& command line option and the
37920 &%queue_only%&, &%queue_only_file%&, and &%queue_only_load%& options. The
37921 number of simultaneously running delivery processes started in this way from
37922 SMTP input can be limited by the &%smtp_accept_queue%& and
37923 &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& options. When either limit is reached,
37924 subsequently received messages are just put on the input queue without starting
37925 a delivery process.
37927 The controls that involve counts of incoming SMTP calls (&%smtp_accept_max%&,
37928 &%smtp_accept_queue%&, &%smtp_accept_reserve%&) are not available when Exim is
37929 started up from the &'inetd'& daemon, because in that case each connection is
37930 handled by an entirely independent Exim process. Control by load average is,
37931 however, available with &'inetd'&.
37933 Exim can be configured to verify addresses in incoming SMTP commands as they
37934 are received. See chapter &<<CHAPACL>>& for details. It can also be configured
37935 to rewrite addresses at this time &-- before any syntax checking is done. See
37936 section &<<SSECTrewriteS>>&.
37938 Exim can also be configured to limit the rate at which a client host submits
37939 MAIL and RCPT commands in a single SMTP session. See the
37940 &%smtp_ratelimit_hosts%& option.
37944 .subsection "Unrecognized SMTP commands" SECID234
37945 .cindex "SMTP" "unrecognized commands"
37946 If Exim receives more than &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& unrecognized SMTP
37947 commands during a single SMTP connection, it drops the connection after sending
37948 the error response to the last command. The default value for
37949 &%smtp_max_unknown_commands%& is 3. This is a defence against some kinds of
37950 abuse that subvert web servers into making connections to SMTP ports; in these
37951 circumstances, a number of non-SMTP lines are sent first.
37954 .subsection "Syntax and protocol errors in SMTP commands" SECID235
37955 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors"
37956 .cindex "SMTP" "protocol errors"
37957 A syntax error is detected if an SMTP command is recognized, but there is
37958 something syntactically wrong with its data, for example, a malformed email
37959 address in a RCPT command. Protocol errors include invalid command
37960 sequencing such as RCPT before MAIL. If Exim receives more than
37961 &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& such commands during a single SMTP connection, it
37962 drops the connection after sending the error response to the last command. The
37963 default value for &%smtp_max_synprot_errors%& is 3. This is a defence against
37964 broken clients that loop sending bad commands (yes, it has been seen).
37968 .subsection "Use of non-mail SMTP commands" SECID236
37969 .cindex "SMTP" "non-mail commands"
37970 The &"non-mail"& SMTP commands are those other than MAIL, RCPT, and
37971 DATA. Exim counts such commands, and drops the connection if there are too
37972 many of them in a single SMTP session. This action catches some
37973 denial-of-service attempts and things like repeated failing AUTHs, or a mad
37974 client looping sending EHLO. The global option &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&
37975 defines what &"too many"& means. Its default value is 10.
37977 When a new message is expected, one occurrence of RSET is not counted. This
37978 allows a client to send one RSET between messages (this is not necessary,
37979 but some clients do it). Exim also allows one uncounted occurrence of HELO
37980 or EHLO, and one occurrence of STARTTLS between messages. After
37981 starting up a TLS session, another EHLO is expected, and so it too is not
37984 The first occurrence of AUTH in a connection, or immediately following
37985 STARTTLS is also not counted. Otherwise, all commands other than MAIL,
37986 RCPT, DATA, and QUIT are counted.
37988 You can control which hosts are subject to the limit set by
37989 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%& by setting
37990 &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail_hosts%&. The default value is &`*`&, which makes
37991 the limit apply to all hosts. This option means that you can exclude any
37992 specific badly-behaved hosts that you have to live with.
37997 .subsection "The VRFY and EXPN commands" SECID237
37998 When Exim receives a VRFY or EXPN command on a TCP/IP connection, it
37999 runs the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_vrfy%& or &%acl_smtp_expn%& (as
38000 appropriate) in order to decide whether the command should be accepted or not.
38002 .cindex "VRFY" "processing"
38003 When no ACL is defined for VRFY, or if it rejects without
38004 setting an explicit response code, the command is accepted
38005 (with a 252 SMTP response code)
38006 in order to support awkward clients that do a VRFY before every RCPT.
38007 When VRFY is accepted, it runs exactly the same code as when Exim is
38008 called with the &%-bv%& option, and returns 250/451/550
38009 SMTP response codes.
38011 .cindex "EXPN" "processing"
38012 If no ACL for EXPN is defined, the command is rejected.
38013 When EXPN is accepted, a single-level expansion of the address is done.
38014 EXPN is treated as an &"address test"& (similar to the &%-bt%& option) rather
38015 than a verification (the &%-bv%& option). If an unqualified local part is given
38016 as the argument to EXPN, it is qualified with &%qualify_domain%&. Rejections
38017 of VRFY and EXPN commands are logged on the main and reject logs, and
38018 VRFY verification failures are logged in the main log for consistency with
38023 .subsection "The ETRN command" SECTETRN
38024 .cindex "ETRN" "processing"
38025 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ETRN
38026 Most modern installations never need to use this.
38027 It is used for managing messages queued for an intermittently-connecting
38028 destination (eg. one using a dialup connection).
38030 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_etrn%&"
38031 The command is only available if permitted by an ACL
38032 specfied by the main-section &%acl_smtp_etrn%& option.
38034 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1985,RFC 1985)
38035 describes an ESMTP command called ETRN that is designed to
38036 overcome the security problems of the TURN command (which has fallen into
38037 disuse). When Exim receives an ETRN command on a TCP/IP connection, it runs
38038 the ACL specified by &%acl_smtp_etrn%& in order to decide whether the command
38039 should be accepted or not. If no ACL is defined, the command is rejected.
38041 The ETRN command is concerned with &"releasing"& messages that are awaiting
38042 delivery to certain hosts. As Exim does not organize its message queue by host,
38043 the only form of ETRN that is supported by default is the one where the
38044 text starts with the &"#"& prefix, in which case the remainder of the text is
38045 specific to the SMTP server. A valid ETRN command causes a run of Exim with
38046 the &%-R%& option to happen, with the remainder of the ETRN text as its
38047 argument. For example,
38055 which causes a delivery attempt on all messages with undelivered addresses
38056 containing the text &"brigadoon"&. When &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set (the
38057 default), Exim prevents the simultaneous execution of more than one queue run
38058 for the same argument string as a result of an ETRN command. This stops
38059 a misbehaving client from starting more than one queue runner at once.
38061 .cindex "hints database" "ETRN serialization"
38062 Exim implements the serialization by means of a hints database in which a
38063 record is written whenever a process is started by ETRN, and deleted when
38064 the process completes. However, Exim does not keep the SMTP session waiting for
38065 the ETRN process to complete. Once ETRN is accepted, the client is sent
38066 a &"success"& return code. Obviously there is scope for hints records to get
38067 left lying around if there is a system or program crash. To guard against this,
38068 Exim ignores any records that are more than six hours old.
38070 .oindex "&%smtp_etrn_command%&"
38071 For more control over what ETRN does, the &%smtp_etrn_command%& option can
38072 used. This specifies a command that is run whenever ETRN is received,
38073 whatever the form of its argument. For
38076 smtp_etrn_command = /etc/etrn_command $domain \
38077 $sender_host_address
38079 .vindex "&$domain$&"
38080 The string is split up into arguments which are independently expanded. The
38081 expansion variable &$domain$& is set to the argument of the ETRN command,
38082 and no syntax checking is done on the contents of this argument. Exim does not
38083 wait for the command to complete, so its status code is not checked. Exim runs
38084 under its own uid and gid when receiving incoming SMTP, so it is not possible
38085 for it to change them before running the command.
38089 .subsection "The ATRN command, and ODMR" SECTODMR
38090 .cindex ATRN processing
38091 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" ATRN
38092 .cindex ODMR provider
38093 A second method for handling
38094 On-Demand Message Reception (ODMR)
38095 for intermittently-connecting destinations is specified by
38096 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2645.html,RFC 2645).
38098 This describes an ESMTP command called ATRN which requests
38099 a swap in server/client roles of the communicating SMTP endpoints,
38100 and delivery of queued messages.
38101 Note that this supports customers having IP addresses that
38104 Exim supports both the &"provider"& and &"customer"& sides of ODMR,
38105 to use the terms of that specification.
38107 . need a sub-subsection here
38108 .subsection "ODMR provider connection" SECTODMRPRDVR
38110 In the &"provider"& use case Exim is
38111 initially an SMTP server, then transferring to an SMTP client
38112 role if an ATRN command is accepted.
38114 .oindex "&%acl_smtp_atrn%&"
38115 The command is only available if permitted by an ACL
38116 specfied by the main-section &%acl_smtp_atrn%& option.
38117 Per the standard, this should only be for a specific
38118 provider port number (386, named "odmr");
38119 Exim should be configured to listen on that port
38120 (in addition to other duties) via &%daemon_smtp_ports%&
38121 or equivalent commandline options, and restrict the
38122 advertising of the facility to the port:
38124 acl_smtp_atrn = ${if = {$received_port}{386} {check_atrn}{}}
38127 A recieved ATRN command will be rejected unless
38128 authentication has previously been done on the connection.
38130 Any arguments supplied with an ATRN command are (per standard)
38131 a comma-separated list of requested domains,
38132 and will be available in the &$smtp_command_argument$&
38135 The ACL configured may return &"deny"& for any policy reaons
38136 (for example, the authenticated user is not permitted the facility).
38137 Otherwise it should use the ACL &"atrn_domains"& condition,
38138 which returns true if there are queued messages for any of
38139 the given list of domains.
38140 If that condition fails the ACL should return &"defer"&
38141 with a "453 You have no mail" response;
38142 else it should return &"accept"&.
38144 For example (with default domain handling, and one possible de-taint method) :
38147 warn set acl_m0 = clientdom.net
38148 deny condition = ${if def:smtp_command_argument}
38149 set acl_m0 = ${map \
38150 {<, $smtp_command_argument} \
38151 {${if inlist{$item}{clientdom.net:cl2dom.net} {$value}}} \
38153 condition = ${if !def:acl_m0}
38154 defer !atrn_domains = <, $acl_m0
38155 message = 453 You have no mail
38159 Acceptance by the ACL will result in a queue-run for messages
38160 having addresses with the given domains.
38161 A suitable router and transport must be configured for the deliveries.
38163 To access a named queue
38164 .cindex queue named
38165 the ACL should use a "queue =" modifier before the "atrn_domains"
38167 If the ACL does not accept, re-set the queue to an empty value
38168 so as to not disrupt any later SMTP operations on the connection.
38170 Use of the &"atrn_domains"& condition additionally sets up
38171 the &$atrn_host$& variable, which can be used by a manualroute
38172 router. Being otherwise empty, this router will decline in
38173 other situations so can be safely placed in a general router chain.
38179 driver = manualroute
38180 route_data = <;$atrn_host
38181 transport = call_customer
38188 Although not discssed in the specification document,
38189 Exim supports use of ATRN within a STARTTLS-
38190 or TLS-on-connect- encrypted connection
38191 (which is wise if a plaintext authentication mechanism is used).
38192 In such cases the TLS connection will remain open across the
38193 role-swap, and be used for the sending of queued messages.
38195 Note that the RFC requires that the CRAM-MD5 authentication
38196 method be supported.
38197 Exim does not enforce this, but leaves it up to the configuration;
38198 see chapter &<<CHID9>>&.
38201 .subsection "ODMR customer connection" SECTODMRCUST
38202 .cindex ODMR customer
38203 Exim supports the &"customer"& side of ODMR,
38204 with a command-line option &"-atrn"& that requests a connection
38205 to a given host, issuance of an ATRN command then operation
38206 in SMTP server mode.
38207 The option must be followed by two arguments.
38209 The first is the name or IP of the provider to be contacted.
38211 The second, which may be empty, should be a comma-separated list
38212 of domains for which mail is to be requested.
38213 Interpretation of the list is up to the provider;
38214 an empty list is expected to result in some default being returned.
38216 The provider host is placed in &$domain$& for routing;
38217 router and transport must be configured suitably to make the connection.
38222 driver = manualroute
38223 condition = ${if eq {$atrn_mode}{C}}
38224 route_data = <;$domain
38225 transport = call_provider
38232 command_timeout = 10m
38235 Note that the specification requires a long timeout for the ATRN
38236 command, to allow for scanning of queued messages.
38238 Configuration should also include client-side authentication
38239 and processing for receiving messages.
38244 .section "Incoming local SMTP" "SECID238"
38245 .cindex "SMTP" "local incoming"
38246 Some user agents use SMTP to pass messages to their local MTA using the
38247 standard input and output, as opposed to passing the envelope on the command
38248 line and writing the message to the standard input. This is supported by the
38249 &%-bs%& option. This form of SMTP is handled in the same way as incoming
38250 messages over TCP/IP (including the use of ACLs), except that the envelope
38251 sender given in a MAIL command is ignored unless the caller is trusted. In
38252 an ACL you can detect this form of SMTP input by testing for an empty host
38253 identification. It is common to have this as the first line in the ACL that
38254 runs for RCPT commands:
38258 This accepts SMTP messages from local processes without doing any other tests.
38262 .section "Batched SMTP" "SECTgenbatchSMTP"
38263 .subsection "Outgoing batched SMTP" "SECTbatchSMTP"
38264 .cindex "SMTP" "batched outgoing"
38265 .cindex "batched SMTP output"
38266 Both the &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& transports can be used for handling
38267 batched SMTP. Each has an option called &%use_bsmtp%& which causes messages to
38268 be output in BSMTP format. No SMTP responses are possible for this form of
38269 delivery. All it is doing is using SMTP commands as a way of transmitting the
38270 envelope along with the message.
38272 The message is written to the file or pipe preceded by the SMTP commands
38273 MAIL and RCPT, and followed by a line containing a single dot. Lines in
38274 the message that start with a dot have an extra dot added. The SMTP command
38275 HELO is not normally used. If it is required, the &%message_prefix%& option
38276 can be used to specify it.
38278 Because &(appendfile)& and &(pipe)& are both local transports, they accept only
38279 one recipient address at a time by default. However, you can arrange for them
38280 to handle several addresses at once by setting the &%batch_max%& option. When
38281 this is done for BSMTP, messages may contain multiple RCPT commands. See
38282 chapter &<<CHAPbatching>>& for more details.
38285 When one or more addresses are routed to a BSMTP transport by a router that
38286 sets up a host list, the name of the first host on the list is available to the
38287 transport in the variable &$host$&. Here is an example of such a transport and
38292 driver = manualroute
38293 transport = smtp_appendfile
38294 route_list = domain.example batch.host.example
38298 driver = appendfile
38299 directory = /var/bsmtp/$host
38304 This causes messages addressed to &'domain.example'& to be written in BSMTP
38305 format to &_/var/bsmtp/batch.host.example_&, with only a single copy of each
38306 message (unless there are more than 1000 recipients).
38310 .subsection "Incoming batched SMTP" "SECTincomingbatchedSMTP"
38311 .cindex "SMTP" "batched incoming"
38312 .cindex "batched SMTP input"
38313 The &%-bS%& command line option causes Exim to accept one or more messages by
38314 reading SMTP on the standard input, but to generate no responses. If the caller
38315 is trusted, the senders in the MAIL commands are believed; otherwise the
38316 sender is always the caller of Exim. Unqualified senders and receivers are not
38317 rejected (there seems little point) but instead just get qualified. HELO
38318 and EHLO act as RSET; VRFY, EXPN, ETRN and HELP, act
38319 as NOOP; QUIT quits.
38321 Minimal policy checking is done for BSMTP input. Only the non-SMTP
38322 ACL is run in the same way as for non-SMTP local input.
38324 If an error is detected while reading a message, including a missing &"."& at
38325 the end, Exim gives up immediately. It writes details of the error to the
38326 standard output in a stylized way that the calling program should be able to
38327 make some use of automatically, for example:
38329 554 Unexpected end of file
38330 Transaction started in line 10
38331 Error detected in line 14
38333 It writes a more verbose version, for human consumption, to the standard error
38336 An error was detected while processing a file of BSMTP input.
38337 The error message was:
38339 501 '>' missing at end of address
38341 The SMTP transaction started in line 10.
38342 The error was detected in line 12.
38343 The SMTP command at fault was:
38345 rcpt to:<malformed@in.com.plete
38347 1 previous message was successfully processed.
38348 The rest of the batch was abandoned.
38350 The return code from Exim is zero only if there were no errors. It is 1 if some
38351 messages were accepted before an error was detected, and 2 if no messages were
38353 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc1
38354 .ecindex IIDsmtpproc2
38358 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38359 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38361 .chapter "Customizing bounce and warning messages" "CHAPemsgcust" &&&
38362 "Customizing messages"
38363 When a message fails to be delivered, or remains in the queue for more than a
38364 configured amount of time, Exim sends a message to the original sender, or
38365 to an alternative configured address. The text of these messages is built into
38366 the code of Exim, but it is possible to change it, either by adding a single
38367 string, or by replacing each of the paragraphs by text supplied in a file.
38369 The &'From:'& and &'To:'& header lines are automatically generated; you can
38370 cause a &'Reply-To:'& line to be added by setting the &%errors_reply_to%&
38371 option. Exim also adds the line
38373 Auto-Submitted: auto-generated
38375 to all warning and bounce messages,
38378 .section "Customizing bounce messages" "SECID239"
38379 .cindex "customizing" "bounce message"
38380 .cindex "bounce message" "customizing"
38381 If &%bounce_message_text%& is set, its contents are included in the default
38382 message immediately after &"This message was created automatically by mail
38383 delivery software."& The string is not expanded. It is not used if
38384 &%bounce_message_file%& is set.
38386 When &%bounce_message_file%& is set, it must point to a template file for
38387 constructing error messages. The file consists of a series of text items,
38388 separated by lines consisting of exactly four asterisks. If the file cannot be
38389 opened, default text is used and a message is written to the main and panic
38390 logs. If any text item in the file is empty, default text is used for that
38393 .vindex "&$bounce_recipient$&"
38394 .vindex "&$bounce_return_size_limit$&"
38395 Each item of text that is read from the file is expanded, and there are two
38396 expansion variables which can be of use here: &$bounce_recipient$& is set to
38397 the recipient of an error message while it is being created, and
38398 &$bounce_return_size_limit$& contains the value of the &%return_size_limit%&
38399 option, rounded to a whole number.
38401 The items must appear in the file in the following order:
38404 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
38405 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
38407 The second item forms the start of the error message. After it, Exim lists the
38408 failing addresses with their error messages.
38410 The third item is used to introduce any text from pipe transports that is to be
38411 returned to the sender. It is omitted if there is no such text.
38413 The fourth, fifth and sixth items will be ignored and may be empty.
38414 The fields exist for back-compatibility
38417 The default state (&%bounce_message_file%& unset) is equivalent to the
38418 following file, in which the sixth item is empty. The &'Subject:'& and some
38419 other lines have been split in order to fit them on the page:
38421 Subject: Mail delivery failed
38422 ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
38423 {: returning message to sender}}
38425 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
38427 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$bounce_recipient}
38428 {that you sent }{sent by
38432 }}could not be delivered to all of its recipients.
38433 This is a permanent error. The following address(es) failed:
38435 The following text was generated during the delivery attempt(s):
38437 ------ This is a copy of the message, including all the headers.
38440 ------ The body of the message is $message_size characters long;
38442 ------ $bounce_return_size_limit or so are included here.
38445 .section "Customizing warning messages" "SECTcustwarn"
38446 .cindex "customizing" "warning message"
38447 .cindex "warning of delay" "customizing the message"
38448 The option &%warn_message_file%& can be pointed at a template file for use when
38449 warnings about message delays are created. In this case there are only three
38453 The first item is included in the headers, and should include at least a
38454 &'Subject:'& header. Exim does not check the syntax of these headers.
38456 The second item forms the start of the warning message. After it, Exim lists
38457 the delayed addresses.
38459 The third item then ends the message.
38462 The default state is equivalent to the following file, except that some lines
38463 have been split here, in order to fit them on the page:
38465 Subject: Warning: message $message_exim_id delayed
38466 $warn_message_delay
38468 This message was created automatically by mail delivery software.
38470 A message ${if eq{$sender_address}{$warn_message_recipients}
38471 {that you sent }{sent by
38475 }}has not been delivered to all of its recipients after
38476 more than $warn_message_delay in the queue on $primary_hostname.
38478 The message identifier is: $message_exim_id
38479 The subject of the message is: $h_subject
38480 The date of the message is: $h_date
38482 The following address(es) have not yet been delivered:
38484 No action is required on your part. Delivery attempts will
38485 continue for some time, and this warning may be repeated at
38486 intervals if the message remains undelivered. Eventually the
38487 mail delivery software will give up, and when that happens,
38488 the message will be returned to you.
38490 .vindex "&$warn_message_delay$&"
38491 .vindex "&$warn_message_recipients$&"
38492 However, in the default state the subject and date lines are omitted if no
38493 appropriate headers exist. During the expansion of this file,
38494 &$warn_message_delay$& is set to the delay time in one of the forms &"<&'n'&>
38495 minutes"& or &"<&'n'&> hours"&, and &$warn_message_recipients$& contains a list
38496 of recipients for the warning message. There may be more than one if there are
38497 multiple addresses with different &%errors_to%& settings on the routers that
38503 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38504 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
38506 .chapter "Some common configuration settings" "CHAPcomconreq"
38507 This chapter discusses some configuration settings that seem to be fairly
38508 common. More examples and discussion can be found in the Exim book.
38512 .section "Sending mail to a smart host" "SECID240"
38513 .cindex "smart host" "example router"
38514 If you want to send all mail for non-local domains to a &"smart host"&, you
38515 should replace the default &(dnslookup)& router with a router which does the
38516 routing explicitly:
38518 send_to_smart_host:
38519 driver = manualroute
38520 route_list = !+local_domains smart.host.name
38521 transport = remote_smtp
38523 You can use the smart host's IP address instead of the name if you wish.
38524 If you are using Exim only to submit messages to a smart host, and not for
38525 receiving incoming messages, you can arrange for it to do the submission
38526 synchronously by setting the &%mua_wrapper%& option (see chapter
38527 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&).
38532 .section "Using Exim to handle mailing lists" "SECTmailinglists"
38533 .cindex "mailing lists"
38534 Exim can be used to run simple mailing lists, but for large and/or complicated
38535 requirements, the use of additional specialized mailing list software such as
38536 Majordomo or Mailman is recommended.
38538 The &(redirect)& router can be used to handle mailing lists where each list
38539 is maintained in a separate file, which can therefore be managed by an
38540 independent manager. The &%domains%& router option can be used to run these
38541 lists in a separate domain from normal mail. For example:
38545 domains = lists.example
38546 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38549 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38552 This router is skipped for domains other than &'lists.example'&. For addresses
38553 in that domain, it looks for a file that matches the local part. If there is no
38554 such file, the router declines, but because &%no_more%& is set, no subsequent
38555 routers are tried, and so the whole delivery fails.
38557 The &%forbid_pipe%& and &%forbid_file%& options prevent a local part from being
38558 expanded into a filename or a pipe delivery, which is usually inappropriate in
38561 .oindex "&%errors_to%&"
38562 The &%errors_to%& option specifies that any delivery errors caused by addresses
38563 taken from a mailing list are to be sent to the given address rather than the
38564 original sender of the message. However, before acting on this, Exim verifies
38565 the error address, and ignores it if verification fails.
38567 For example, using the configuration above, mail sent to
38568 &'dicts@lists.example'& is passed on to those addresses contained in
38569 &_/usr/lists/dicts_&, with error reports directed to
38570 &'dicts-request@lists.example'&, provided that this address can be verified.
38571 There could be a file called &_/usr/lists/dicts-request_& containing
38572 the address(es) of this particular list's manager(s), but other approaches,
38573 such as setting up an earlier router (possibly using the &%local_part_prefix%&
38574 or &%local_part_suffix%& options) to handle addresses of the form
38575 &%owner-%&&'xxx'& or &%xxx-%&&'request'&, are also possible.
38579 .section "Syntax errors in mailing lists" "SECID241"
38580 .cindex "mailing lists" "syntax errors in"
38581 If an entry in redirection data contains a syntax error, Exim normally defers
38582 delivery of the original address. That means that a syntax error in a mailing
38583 list holds up all deliveries to the list. This may not be appropriate when a
38584 list is being maintained automatically from data supplied by users, and the
38585 addresses are not rigorously checked.
38587 If the &%skip_syntax_errors%& option is set, the &(redirect)& router just skips
38588 entries that fail to parse, noting the incident in the log. If in addition
38589 &%syntax_errors_to%& is set to a verifiable address, a message is sent to it
38590 whenever a broken address is skipped. It is usually appropriate to set
38591 &%syntax_errors_to%& to the same address as &%errors_to%&.
38595 .section "Re-expansion of mailing lists" "SECID242"
38596 .cindex "mailing lists" "re-expansion of"
38597 Exim remembers every individual address to which a message has been delivered,
38598 in order to avoid duplication, but it normally stores only the original
38599 recipient addresses with a message. If all the deliveries to a mailing list
38600 cannot be done at the first attempt, the mailing list is re-expanded when the
38601 delivery is next tried. This means that alterations to the list are taken into
38602 account at each delivery attempt, so addresses that have been added to
38603 the list since the message arrived will therefore receive a copy of the
38604 message, even though it pre-dates their subscription.
38606 If this behaviour is felt to be undesirable, the &%one_time%& option can be set
38607 on the &(redirect)& router. If this is done, any addresses generated by the
38608 router that fail to deliver at the first attempt are added to the message as
38609 &"top level"& addresses, and the parent address that generated them is marked
38610 &"delivered"&. Thus, expansion of the mailing list does not happen again at the
38611 subsequent delivery attempts. The disadvantage of this is that if any of the
38612 failing addresses are incorrect, correcting them in the file has no effect on
38613 pre-existing messages.
38615 The original top-level address is remembered with each of the generated
38616 addresses, and is output in any log messages. However, any intermediate parent
38617 addresses are not recorded. This makes a difference to the log only if the
38618 &%all_parents%& selector is set, but for mailing lists there is normally only
38619 one level of expansion anyway.
38623 .section "Closed mailing lists" "SECID243"
38624 .cindex "mailing lists" "closed"
38625 The examples so far have assumed open mailing lists, to which anybody may
38626 send mail. It is also possible to set up closed lists, where mail is accepted
38627 from specified senders only. This is done by making use of the generic
38628 &%senders%& option to restrict the router that handles the list.
38630 The following example uses the same file as a list of recipients and as a list
38631 of permitted senders. It requires three routers:
38635 domains = lists.example
38636 local_part_suffix = -request
38637 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file {/usr/lists}}
38638 file = /usr/lists/${local_part_data}-request
38643 domains = lists.example
38644 local_parts = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,filter=file,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38645 senders = ${if exists {$local_part_data} {lsearch;$local_part_data}{*}}
38646 file = ${lookup {$local_part} dsearch,ret=full {/usr/lists}}
38649 errors_to = ${quote_local_part:$local_part-request}@lists.example
38654 domains = lists.example
38656 data = :fail: $local_part@lists.example is a closed mailing list
38658 All three routers have the same &%domains%& setting, so for any other domains,
38659 they are all skipped. The first router runs only if the local part ends in
38660 &%-request%&. It handles messages to the list manager(s) by means of an open
38663 The second router runs only if the &%senders%& precondition is satisfied. It
38664 checks for the existence of a list that corresponds to the local part, and then
38665 checks that the sender is on the list by means of a linear search. It is
38666 necessary to check for the existence of the file before trying to search it,
38667 because otherwise Exim thinks there is a configuration error. If the file does
38668 not exist, the expansion of &%senders%& is *, which matches all senders. This
38669 means that the router runs, but because there is no list, declines, and
38670 &%no_more%& ensures that no further routers are run. The address fails with an
38671 &"unrouteable address"& error.
38673 The third router runs only if the second router is skipped, which happens when
38674 a mailing list exists, but the sender is not on it. This router forcibly fails
38675 the address, giving a suitable error message.
38680 .section "Variable Envelope Return Paths (VERP)" "SECTverp"
38682 .cindex "Variable Envelope Return Paths"
38683 .cindex "envelope from"
38684 .cindex "envelope sender"
38685 Variable Envelope Return Paths &-- see &url(https://cr.yp.to/proto/verp.txt) &--
38686 are a way of helping mailing list administrators discover which subscription
38687 address is the cause of a particular delivery failure. The idea is to encode
38688 the original recipient address in the outgoing envelope sender address, so that
38689 if the message is forwarded by another host and then subsequently bounces, the
38690 original recipient can be extracted from the recipient address of the bounce.
38692 .oindex &%errors_to%&
38693 .oindex &%return_path%&
38694 Envelope sender addresses can be modified by Exim using two different
38695 facilities: the &%errors_to%& option on a router (as shown in previous mailing
38696 list examples), or the &%return_path%& option on a transport. The second of
38697 these is effective only if the message is successfully delivered to another
38698 host; it is not used for errors detected on the local host (see the description
38699 of &%return_path%& in chapter &<<CHAPtransportgeneric>>&). Here is an example
38700 of the use of &%return_path%& to implement VERP on an &(smtp)& transport:
38706 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38707 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38709 This has the effect of rewriting the return path (envelope sender) on outgoing
38710 SMTP messages, if the local part of the original return path ends in
38711 &"-request"&, and the domain is &'your.dom.example'&. The rewriting inserts the
38712 local part and domain of the recipient into the return path. Suppose, for
38713 example, that a message whose return path has been set to
38714 &'somelist-request@your.dom.example'& is sent to
38715 &'subscriber@other.dom.example'&. In the transport, the return path is
38718 somelist-request+subscriber=other.dom.example@your.dom.example
38720 .vindex "&$local_part$&"
38721 For this to work, you must tell Exim to send multiple copies of messages that
38722 have more than one recipient, so that each copy has just one recipient. This is
38723 achieved by setting &%max_rcpt%& to 1. Without this, a single copy of a message
38724 might be sent to several different recipients in the same domain, in which case
38725 &$local_part$& is not available in the transport, because it is not unique.
38727 Unless your host is doing nothing but mailing list deliveries, you should
38728 probably use a separate transport for the VERP deliveries, so as not to use
38729 extra resources in making one-per-recipient copies for other deliveries. This
38730 can easily be done by expanding the &%transport%& option in the router:
38734 domains = ! +local_domains
38736 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}\
38737 {verp_smtp}{remote_smtp}}
38740 If you want to change the return path using &%errors_to%& in a router instead
38741 of using &%return_path%& in the transport, you need to set &%errors_to%& on all
38742 routers that handle mailing list addresses. This will ensure that all delivery
38743 errors, including those detected on the local host, are sent to the VERP
38746 On a host that does no local deliveries and has no manual routing, only the
38747 &(dnslookup)& router needs to be changed. A special transport is not needed for
38748 SMTP deliveries. Every mailing list recipient has its own return path value,
38749 and so Exim must hand them to the transport one at a time. Here is an example
38750 of a &(dnslookup)& router that implements VERP:
38754 domains = ! +local_domains
38755 transport = remote_smtp
38757 ${if match {$return_path}{^(.+?)-request@your.dom.example\$}}
38758 {${quote_local_part:$1-request+$local_part=$domain}@your.dom.example}fail}
38761 Before you start sending out messages with VERPed return paths, you must also
38762 configure Exim to accept the bounce messages that come back to those paths.
38763 Typically this is done by setting a &%local_part_suffix%& option for a
38764 router, and using this to route the messages to wherever you want to handle
38767 The overhead incurred in using VERP depends very much on the size of the
38768 message, the number of recipient addresses that resolve to the same remote
38769 host, and the speed of the connection over which the message is being sent. If
38770 a lot of addresses resolve to the same host and the connection is slow, sending
38771 a separate copy of the message for each address may take substantially longer
38772 than sending a single copy with many recipients (for which VERP cannot be
38780 .section "Virtual domains" "SECTvirtualdomains"
38781 .cindex "virtual domains"
38782 .cindex "domain" "virtual"
38783 The phrase &'virtual domain'& is unfortunately used with two rather different
38787 A domain for which there are no real mailboxes; all valid local parts are
38788 aliases for other email addresses. Common examples are organizational
38789 top-level domains and &"vanity"& domains.
38791 One of a number of independent domains that are all handled by the same host,
38792 with mailboxes on that host, but where the mailbox owners do not necessarily
38793 have login accounts on that host.
38796 The first usage is probably more common, and does seem more &"virtual"& than
38797 the second. This kind of domain can be handled in Exim with a straightforward
38798 aliasing router. One approach is to create a separate alias file for each
38799 virtual domain. Exim can test for the existence of the alias file to determine
38800 whether the domain exists. The &(dsearch)& lookup type is useful here, leading
38801 to a router of this form:
38805 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/virtual
38806 data = ${lookup{$local_part}lsearch{/etc/mail/virtual/$domain_data}}
38809 The &%domains%& option specifies that the router is to be skipped, unless there
38810 is a file in the &_/etc/mail/virtual_& directory whose name is the same as the
38811 domain that is being processed.
38812 The &(dsearch)& lookup used results in an untainted version of &$domain$&
38813 being placed into the &$domain_data$& variable.
38815 When the router runs, it looks up the local
38816 part in the file to find a new address (or list of addresses). The &%no_more%&
38817 setting ensures that if the lookup fails (leading to &%data%& being an empty
38818 string), Exim gives up on the address without trying any subsequent routers.
38820 This one router can handle all the virtual domains because the alias filenames
38821 follow a fixed pattern. Permissions can be arranged so that appropriate people
38822 can edit the different alias files. A successful aliasing operation results in
38823 a new envelope recipient address, which is then routed from scratch.
38825 The other kind of &"virtual"& domain can also be handled in a straightforward
38826 way. One approach is to create a file for each domain containing a list of
38827 valid local parts, and use it in a router like this:
38831 domains = dsearch;/etc/mail/domains
38832 local_parts = lsearch;/etc/mail/domains/$domain
38833 transport = my_mailboxes
38835 The address is accepted if there is a file for the domain, and the local part
38836 can be found in the file. The &%domains%& option is used to check for the
38837 file's existence because &%domains%& is tested before the &%local_parts%&
38838 option (see section &<<SECTrouprecon>>&). You cannot use &%require_files%&,
38839 because that option is tested after &%local_parts%&. The transport is as
38843 driver = appendfile
38844 file = /var/mail/$domain_data/$local_part_data
38847 This uses a directory of mailboxes for each domain. The &%user%& setting is
38848 required, to specify which uid is to be used for writing to the mailboxes.
38850 The configuration shown here is just one example of how you might support this
38851 requirement. There are many other ways this kind of configuration can be set
38852 up, for example, by using a database instead of separate files to hold all the
38853 information about the domains.
38857 .section "Multiple user mailboxes" "SECTmulbox"
38858 .cindex "multiple mailboxes"
38859 .cindex "mailbox" "multiple"
38860 .cindex "local part" "prefix"
38861 .cindex "local part" "suffix"
38862 Heavy email users often want to operate with multiple mailboxes, into which
38863 incoming mail is automatically sorted. A popular way of handling this is to
38864 allow users to use multiple sender addresses, so that replies can easily be
38865 identified. Users are permitted to add prefixes or suffixes to their local
38866 parts for this purpose. The wildcard facility of the generic router options
38867 &%local_part_prefix%& and &%local_part_suffix%& can be used for this. For
38868 example, consider this router:
38873 file = $home/.forward
38874 local_part_suffix = -*
38875 local_part_suffix_optional
38878 .vindex "&$local_part_suffix$&"
38879 It runs a user's &_.forward_& file for all local parts of the form
38880 &'username-*'&. Within the filter file the user can distinguish different
38881 cases by testing the variable &$local_part_suffix$&. For example:
38883 if $local_part_suffix contains -special then
38884 save /home/$local_part_data/Mail/special
38887 If the filter file does not exist, or does not deal with such addresses, they
38888 fall through to subsequent routers, and, assuming no subsequent use of the
38889 &%local_part_suffix%& option is made, they presumably fail. Thus, users have
38890 control over which suffixes are valid.
38892 Alternatively, a suffix can be used to trigger the use of a different
38893 &_.forward_& file &-- which is the way a similar facility is implemented in
38899 local_part_suffix = -*
38900 local_part_suffix_optional
38901 file = ${lookup {.forward$local_part_suffix} dsearch,ret=full {$home} {$value}fail}
38904 If there is no suffix, &_.forward_& is used; if the suffix is &'-special'&, for
38905 example, &_.forward-special_& is used. Once again, if the appropriate file
38906 does not exist, or does not deal with the address, it is passed on to
38907 subsequent routers, which could, if required, look for an unqualified
38908 &_.forward_& file to use as a default.
38912 .section "Simplified vacation processing" "SECID244"
38913 .cindex "vacation processing"
38914 The traditional way of running the &'vacation'& program is for a user to set up
38915 a pipe command in a &_.forward_& file
38916 (see section &<<SECTspecitredli>>& for syntax details).
38917 This is prone to error by inexperienced users. There are two features of Exim
38918 that can be used to make this process simpler for users:
38921 A local part prefix such as &"vacation-"& can be specified on a router which
38922 can cause the message to be delivered directly to the &'vacation'& program, or
38923 alternatively can use Exim's &(autoreply)& transport. The contents of a user's
38924 &_.forward_& file are then much simpler. For example:
38926 spqr, vacation-spqr
38929 The &%require_files%& generic router option can be used to trigger a
38930 vacation delivery by checking for the existence of a certain file in the
38931 user's home directory. The &%unseen%& generic option should also be used, to
38932 ensure that the original delivery also proceeds. In this case, all the user has
38933 to do is to create a file called, say, &_.vacation_&, containing a vacation
38937 Another advantage of both these methods is that they both work even when the
38938 use of arbitrary pipes by users is locked out.
38942 .section "Taking copies of mail" "SECID245"
38943 .cindex "message" "copying every"
38944 Some installations have policies that require archive copies of all messages to
38945 be made. A single copy of each message can easily be taken by an appropriate
38946 command in a system filter, which could, for example, use a different file for
38947 each day's messages.
38949 There is also a shadow transport mechanism that can be used to take copies of
38950 messages that are successfully delivered by local transports, one copy per
38951 delivery. This could be used, &'inter alia'&, to implement automatic
38952 notification of delivery by sites that insist on doing such things.
38956 .section "Intermittently connected hosts" "SECID246"
38957 .cindex "intermittently connected hosts"
38958 It has become quite common (because it is cheaper) for hosts to connect to the
38959 Internet periodically rather than remain connected all the time. The normal
38960 arrangement is that mail for such hosts accumulates on a system that is
38961 permanently connected.
38963 Exim was designed for use on permanently connected hosts, and so it is not
38964 particularly well-suited to use in an intermittently connected environment.
38965 Nevertheless there are some features that can be used.
38968 .section "Exim on the upstream server host" "SECID247"
38969 It is tempting to arrange for incoming mail for the intermittently connected
38970 host to remain in Exim's queue until the client connects. However, this
38971 approach does not scale very well. Two different kinds of waiting message are
38972 being mixed up in the same queue &-- those that cannot be delivered because of
38973 some temporary problem, and those that are waiting for their destination host
38974 to connect. This makes it hard to manage the queue, as well as wasting
38975 resources, because each queue runner scans the entire queue.
38977 A better approach is to separate off those messages that are waiting for an
38978 intermittently connected host. This can be done by delivering these messages
38979 into local files in batch SMTP, &"mailstore"&, or other envelope-preserving
38980 format, from where they are transmitted by other software when their
38981 destination connects. This makes it easy to collect all the mail for one host
38982 in a single directory, and to apply local timeout rules on a per-message basis
38985 On a very small scale, leaving the mail on Exim's queue can be made to work. If
38986 you are doing this, you should configure Exim with a long retry period for the
38987 intermittent host. For example:
38989 cheshire.wonderland.fict.example * F,5d,24h
38991 This stops a lot of failed delivery attempts from occurring, but Exim remembers
38992 which messages it has queued up for that host. Once the intermittent host comes
38993 online, forcing delivery of one message (either by using the &%-M%& or &%-R%&
38994 options, or by using the ETRN SMTP command (see section &<<SECTETRN>>&)
38995 causes all the queued up messages to be delivered, often down a single SMTP
38996 connection. While the host remains connected, any new messages get delivered
38999 If the connecting hosts do not have fixed IP addresses, that is, if a host is
39000 issued with a different IP address each time it connects, Exim's retry
39001 mechanisms on the holding host get confused, because the IP address is normally
39002 used as part of the key string for holding retry information. This can be
39003 avoided by unsetting &%retry_include_ip_address%& on the &(smtp)& transport.
39004 Since this has disadvantages for permanently connected hosts, it is best to
39005 arrange a separate transport for the intermittently connected ones.
39009 .section "Exim on the intermittently connected client host" "SECID248"
39010 The value of &%smtp_accept_queue_per_connection%& should probably be
39011 increased, or even set to zero (that is, disabled) on the intermittently
39012 connected host, so that all incoming messages down a single connection get
39013 delivered immediately.
39015 .cindex "SMTP" "passed connection"
39016 .cindex "SMTP" "multiple deliveries"
39017 .cindex "multiple SMTP deliveries"
39018 .cindex "first pass routing"
39019 Mail waiting to be sent from an intermittently connected host will probably
39020 not have been routed, because without a connection DNS lookups are not
39021 possible. This means that if a normal queue run is done at connection time,
39022 each message is likely to be sent in a separate SMTP session. This can be
39023 avoided by starting the queue run with a command line option beginning with
39024 &%-qq%& instead of &%-q%&. In this case, the queue is scanned twice. In the
39025 first pass, routing is done but no deliveries take place. The second pass is a
39026 normal queue run; since all the messages have been previously routed, those
39027 destined for the same host are likely to get sent as multiple deliveries in a
39028 single SMTP connection.
39032 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39033 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39035 .chapter "Using Exim as a non-queueing client" "CHAPnonqueueing" &&&
39036 "Exim as a non-queueing client"
39037 .cindex "client, non-queueing"
39038 .cindex "smart host" "suppressing queueing"
39039 On a personal computer, it is a common requirement for all
39040 email to be sent to a &"smart host"&. There are plenty of MUAs that can be
39041 configured to operate that way, for all the popular operating systems.
39042 However, there are some MUAs for Unix-like systems that cannot be so
39043 configured: they submit messages using the command line interface of
39044 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. Furthermore, utility programs such as &'cron'& submit
39047 If the personal computer runs continuously, there is no problem, because it can
39048 run a conventional MTA that handles delivery to the smart host, and deal with
39049 any delays via its queueing mechanism. However, if the computer does not run
39050 continuously or runs different operating systems at different times, queueing
39051 email is not desirable.
39053 There is therefore a requirement for something that can provide the
39054 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_& interface but deliver messages to a smart host without
39055 any queueing or retrying facilities. Furthermore, the delivery to the smart
39056 host should be synchronous, so that if it fails, the sending MUA is immediately
39057 informed. In other words, we want something that extends an MUA that submits
39058 to a local MTA via the command line so that it behaves like one that submits
39059 to a remote smart host using TCP/SMTP.
39061 There are a number of applications (for example, there is one called &'ssmtp'&)
39062 that do this job. However, people have found them to be lacking in various
39063 ways. For instance, you might want to allow aliasing and forwarding to be done
39064 before sending a message to the smart host.
39066 Exim already had the necessary infrastructure for doing this job. Just a few
39067 tweaks were needed to make it behave as required, though it is somewhat of an
39068 overkill to use a fully-featured MTA for this purpose.
39070 .oindex "&%mua_wrapper%&"
39071 There is a Boolean global option called &%mua_wrapper%&, defaulting false.
39072 Setting &%mua_wrapper%& true causes Exim to run in a special mode where it
39073 assumes that it is being used to &"wrap"& a command-line MUA in the manner
39074 just described. As well as setting &%mua_wrapper%&, you also need to provide a
39075 compatible router and transport configuration. Typically there will be just one
39076 router and one transport, sending everything to a smart host.
39078 When run in MUA wrapping mode, the behaviour of Exim changes in the
39082 A daemon cannot be run, nor will Exim accept incoming messages from &'inetd'&.
39083 In other words, the only way to submit messages is via the command line.
39085 Each message is synchronously delivered as soon as it is received (&%-odi%& is
39086 assumed). All queueing options (&%queue_only%&, &%queue_smtp_domains%&,
39087 &%control%& in an ACL, etc.) are quietly ignored. The Exim reception process
39088 does not finish until the delivery attempt is complete. If the delivery is
39089 successful, a zero return code is given.
39091 Address redirection is permitted, but the final routing for all addresses must
39092 be to the same remote transport, and to the same list of hosts. Furthermore,
39093 the return address (envelope sender) must be the same for all recipients, as
39094 must any added or deleted header lines. In other words, it must be possible to
39095 deliver the message in a single SMTP transaction, however many recipients there
39098 If these conditions are not met, or if routing any address results in a
39099 failure or defer status, or if Exim is unable to deliver all the recipients
39100 successfully to one of the smart hosts, delivery of the entire message fails.
39102 Because no queueing is allowed, all failures are treated as permanent; there
39103 is no distinction between 4&'xx'& and 5&'xx'& SMTP response codes from the
39104 smart host. Furthermore, because only a single yes/no response can be given to
39105 the caller, it is not possible to deliver to some recipients and not others. If
39106 there is an error (temporary or permanent) for any recipient, all are failed.
39108 If more than one smart host is listed, Exim will try another host after a
39109 connection failure or a timeout, in the normal way. However, if this kind of
39110 failure happens for all the hosts, the delivery fails.
39112 When delivery fails, an error message is written to the standard error stream
39113 (as well as to Exim's log), and Exim exits to the caller with a return code
39114 value 1. The message is expunged from Exim's spool files. No bounce messages
39115 are ever generated.
39117 No retry data is maintained, and any retry rules are ignored.
39119 A number of Exim options are overridden: &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced
39120 true, &%max_rcpt%& in the &(smtp)& transport is forced to &"unlimited"&,
39121 &%remote_max_parallel%& is forced to one, and fallback hosts are ignored.
39124 The overall effect is that Exim makes a single synchronous attempt to deliver
39125 the message, failing if there is any kind of problem. Because no local
39126 deliveries are done and no daemon can be run, Exim does not need root
39127 privilege. It should be possible to run it setuid to &'exim'& instead of setuid
39128 to &'root'&. See section &<<SECTrunexiwitpri>>& for a general discussion about
39129 the advantages and disadvantages of running without root privilege.
39134 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39135 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
39137 .chapter "Log files" "CHAPlog"
39138 .scindex IIDloggen "log" "general description"
39139 .cindex "log" "types of"
39140 Exim writes three different logs, referred to as the main log, the reject log,
39145 The main log records the arrival of each message and each delivery in a single
39146 line in each case. The format is as compact as possible, in an attempt to keep
39147 down the size of log files. Two-character flag sequences make it easy to pick
39148 out these lines. A number of other events are recorded in the main log. Some of
39149 them are optional, in which case the &%log_selector%& option controls whether
39150 they are included or not. A Perl script called &'eximstats'&, which does simple
39151 analysis of main log files, is provided in the Exim distribution (see section
39152 &<<SECTmailstat>>&).
39154 .cindex "reject log"
39155 The reject log records information from messages that are rejected as a result
39156 of a configuration option (that is, for policy reasons).
39157 The first line of each rejection is a copy of the line that is also written to
39158 the main log. Then, if the message's header has been read at the time the log
39159 is written, its contents are written to this log. Only the original header
39160 lines are available; header lines added by ACLs are not logged. You can use the
39161 reject log to check that your policy controls are working correctly; on a busy
39162 host this may be easier than scanning the main log for rejection messages. You
39163 can suppress the writing of the reject log by setting &%write_rejectlog%&
39166 .cindex "panic log"
39167 .cindex "system log"
39168 When certain serious errors occur, Exim writes entries to its panic log. If the
39169 error is sufficiently disastrous, Exim bombs out afterwards. Panic log entries
39170 are usually written to the main log as well, but can get lost amid the mass of
39171 other entries. The panic log should be empty under normal circumstances. It is
39172 therefore a good idea to check it (or to have a &'cron'& script check it)
39173 regularly, in order to become aware of any problems. When Exim cannot open its
39174 panic log, it tries as a last resort to write to the system log (syslog). This
39175 is opened with LOG_PID+LOG_CONS and the facility code of LOG_MAIL. The
39176 message itself is written at priority LOG_CRIT.
39179 Every log line starts with a timestamp, in the format shown in the following
39180 example. Note that many of the examples shown in this chapter are line-wrapped.
39181 In the log file, this would be all on one line:
39183 2001-09-16 16:09:47 SMTP connection from [127.0.0.1] closed
39186 By default, the timestamps are in the local timezone. There are two
39187 ways of changing this:
39190 You can set the &%timezone%& option to a different time zone; in particular, if
39195 the timestamps will be in UTC (aka GMT).
39197 If you set &%log_timezone%& true, the time zone is added to the timestamp, for
39200 2003-04-25 11:17:07 +0100 Start queue run: pid=12762
39204 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
39205 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
39206 Exim does not include its process id in log lines by default, but you can
39207 request that it does so by specifying the &`pid`& log selector (see section
39208 &<<SECTlogselector>>&). When this is set, the process id is output, in square
39209 brackets, immediately after the time and date.
39214 .section "Where the logs are written" "SECTwhelogwri"
39215 .cindex "log" "destination"
39216 .cindex "log" "to file"
39217 .cindex "log" "to syslog"
39219 The logs may be written to local files, or to syslog, or both. However, it
39220 should be noted that many syslog implementations use UDP as a transport, and
39221 are therefore unreliable in the sense that messages are not guaranteed to
39222 arrive at the loghost, nor is the ordering of messages necessarily maintained.
39223 It has also been reported that on large log files (tens of megabytes) you may
39224 need to tweak syslog to prevent it syncing the file with each write &-- on
39225 Linux this has been seen to make syslog take 90% plus of CPU time.
39227 The destination for Exim's logs is configured by setting LOG_FILE_PATH in
39228 &_Local/Makefile_& or by setting &%log_file_path%& in the runtime
39229 configuration. This latter string is expanded, so it can contain, for example,
39230 references to the host name:
39232 log_file_path = /var/log/$primary_hostname/exim_%slog
39234 It is generally advisable, however, to set the string in &_Local/Makefile_&
39235 rather than at runtime, because then the setting is available right from the
39236 start of Exim's execution. Otherwise, if there's something it wants to log
39237 before it has read the configuration file (for example, an error in the
39238 configuration file) it will not use the path you want, and may not be able to
39241 The value of LOG_FILE_PATH or &%log_file_path%& is a colon-separated
39242 list, currently limited to at most two items. This is one option where the
39243 facility for changing a list separator may not be used. The list must always be
39244 colon-separated. If an item in the list is &"syslog"& then syslog is used;
39245 otherwise the item must either be an absolute path, containing &`%s`& at the
39246 point where &"main"&, &"reject"&, or &"panic"& is to be inserted, or be empty,
39247 implying the use of a default path.
39249 When Exim encounters an empty item in the list, it searches the list defined by
39250 LOG_FILE_PATH, and uses the first item it finds that is neither empty nor
39251 &"syslog"&. This means that an empty item in &%log_file_path%& can be used to
39252 mean &"use the path specified at build time"&. If no such item exists, log
39253 files are written in the &_log_& subdirectory of the spool directory. This is
39254 equivalent to the configuration file setting:
39256 log_file_path = $spool_directory/log/%slog
39258 If you do not specify anything at build time or runtime,
39259 or if you unset the option at runtime (i.e. &`log_file_path = `&),
39260 that is where the logs are written.
39262 A log file path may also contain &`%D`& or &`%M`& if datestamped log filenames
39263 are in use &-- see section &<<SECTdatlogfil>>& below.
39265 Here are some examples of possible Makefile settings:
39267 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog `& syslog only
39268 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=:syslog `& syslog and default path
39269 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=syslog : /usr/log/exim_%s `& syslog and specified path
39270 &`LOG_FILE_PATH=/usr/log/exim_%s `& specified path only
39272 If there are more than two paths in the list, the first is used and a panic
39277 .section "Logging to local files that are periodically &""cycled""&" "SECID285"
39278 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
39279 .cindex "cycling logs"
39280 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
39281 .cindex "log" "local files; writing to"
39282 Some operating systems provide centralized and standardized methods for cycling
39283 log files. For those that do not, a utility script called &'exicyclog'& is
39284 provided (see section &<<SECTcyclogfil>>&). This renames and compresses the
39285 main and reject logs each time it is called. The maximum number of old logs to
39286 keep can be set. It is suggested this script is run as a daily &'cron'& job.
39288 An Exim delivery process opens the main log when it first needs to write to it,
39289 and it keeps the file open in case subsequent entries are required &-- for
39290 example, if a number of different deliveries are being done for the same
39291 message. However, remote SMTP deliveries can take a long time, and this means
39292 that the file may be kept open long after it is renamed if &'exicyclog'& or
39293 something similar is being used to rename log files on a regular basis. To
39294 ensure that a switch of log files is noticed as soon as possible, Exim calls
39295 &[stat()]& on the main log's name before reusing an open file, and if the file
39296 does not exist, or its inode has changed, the old file is closed and Exim
39297 tries to open the main log from scratch. Thus, an old log file may remain open
39298 for quite some time, but no Exim processes should write to it once it has been
39303 .section "Datestamped log files" "SECTdatlogfil"
39304 .cindex "log" "datestamped files"
39305 Instead of cycling the main and reject log files by renaming them
39306 periodically, some sites like to use files whose names contain a datestamp,
39307 for example, &_mainlog-20031225_&. The datestamp is in the form &_yyyymmdd_& or
39308 &_yyyymm_&. Exim has support for this way of working. It is enabled by setting
39309 the &%log_file_path%& option to a path that includes &`%D`& or &`%M`& at the
39310 point where the datestamp is required. For example:
39312 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%slog-%D
39313 log_file_path = /var/log/exim-%s-%D.log
39314 log_file_path = /var/spool/exim/log/%D-%slog
39315 log_file_path = /var/log/exim/%s.%M
39317 As before, &`%s`& is replaced by &"main"& or &"reject"&; the following are
39318 examples of names generated by the above examples:
39320 /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog-20021225
39321 /var/log/exim-reject-20021225.log
39322 /var/spool/exim/log/20021225-mainlog
39323 /var/log/exim/main.200212
39325 When this form of log file is specified, Exim automatically switches to new
39326 files at midnight. It does not make any attempt to compress old logs; you
39327 will need to write your own script if you require this. You should not
39328 run &'exicyclog'& with this form of logging.
39330 The location of the panic log is also determined by &%log_file_path%&, but it
39331 is not datestamped, because rotation of the panic log does not make sense.
39332 When generating the name of the panic log, &`%D`& or &`%M`& are removed from
39333 the string. In addition, if it immediately follows a slash, a following
39334 non-alphanumeric character is removed; otherwise a preceding non-alphanumeric
39335 character is removed. Thus, the four examples above would give these panic
39338 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
39339 /var/log/exim-panic.log
39340 /var/spool/exim/log/paniclog
39341 /var/log/exim/panic
39345 .section "Logging to syslog" "SECID249"
39346 .cindex "log" "syslog; writing to"
39347 The use of syslog does not change what Exim logs or the format of its messages,
39348 except in one respect. If &%syslog_timestamp%& is set false, the timestamps on
39349 Exim's log lines are omitted when these lines are sent to syslog. Apart from
39350 that, the same strings are written to syslog as to log files. The syslog
39351 &"facility"& is set to LOG_MAIL, and the program name to &"exim"&
39352 by default, but you can change these by setting the &%syslog_facility%& and
39353 &%syslog_processname%& options, respectively. If Exim was compiled with
39354 SYSLOG_LOG_PID set in &_Local/Makefile_& (this is the default in
39355 &_src/EDITME_&), then, on systems that permit it (all except ULTRIX), the
39356 LOG_PID flag is set so that the &[syslog()]& call adds the pid as well as
39357 the time and host name to each line.
39358 The three log streams are mapped onto syslog priorities as follows:
39361 &'mainlog'& is mapped to LOG_INFO
39363 &'rejectlog'& is mapped to LOG_NOTICE
39365 &'paniclog'& is mapped to LOG_ALERT
39368 Many log lines are written to both &'mainlog'& and &'rejectlog'&, and some are
39369 written to both &'mainlog'& and &'paniclog'&, so there will be duplicates if
39370 these are routed by syslog to the same place. You can suppress this duplication
39371 by setting &%syslog_duplication%& false.
39373 Exim's log lines can sometimes be very long, and some of its &'rejectlog'&
39374 entries contain multiple lines when headers are included. To cope with both
39375 these cases, entries written to syslog are split into separate &[syslog()]&
39376 calls at each internal newline, and also after a maximum of
39377 870 data characters. (This allows for a total syslog line length of 1024, when
39378 additions such as timestamps are added.) If you are running a syslog
39379 replacement that can handle lines longer than the 1024 characters allowed by
39380 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc3164,RFC 3164), you should set
39382 SYSLOG_LONG_LINES=yes
39384 in &_Local/Makefile_& before building Exim. That stops Exim from splitting long
39385 lines, but it still splits at internal newlines in &'reject'& log entries.
39387 To make it easy to re-assemble split lines later, each component of a split
39388 entry starts with a string of the form [<&'n'&>/<&'m'&>] or [<&'n'&>\<&'m'&>]
39389 where <&'n'&> is the component number and <&'m'&> is the total number of
39390 components in the entry. The / delimiter is used when the line was split
39391 because it was too long; if it was split because of an internal newline, the \
39392 delimiter is used. For example, supposing the length limit to be 50 instead of
39393 870, the following would be the result of a typical rejection message to
39394 &'mainlog'& (LOG_INFO), each line in addition being preceded by the time, host
39395 name, and pid as added by syslog:
39397 [1/5] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected from
39398 [2/5] [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' header
39399 [3/5] when scanning for sender: missing or malformed lo
39400 [4/5] cal part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam.exa
39403 The same error might cause the following lines to be written to &"rejectlog"&
39406 [1/18] 2002-09-16 16:09:43 16RdAL-0006pc-00 rejected fro
39407 [2/18] m [127.0.0.1] (ph10): syntax error in 'From' head
39408 [3/18] er when scanning for sender: missing or malformed
39409 [4/18] local part in "<>" (envelope sender is <ph10@cam
39411 [6\18] Recipients: ph10@some.domain.cam.example
39412 [7\18] P Received: from [127.0.0.1] (ident=ph10)
39413 [8\18] by xxxxx.cam.example with smtp (Exim 4.00)
39414 [9\18] id 16RdAL-0006pc-00
39415 [10/18] for ph10@cam.example; Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:
39416 [11\18] 09:43 +0100
39418 [13\18] Subject: this is a test header
39419 [18\18] X-something: this is another header
39420 [15/18] I Message-Id: <E16RdAL-0006pc-00@xxxxx.cam.examp
39423 [18/18] Date: Mon, 16 Sep 2002 16:09:43 +0100
39425 Log lines that are neither too long nor contain newlines are written to syslog
39426 without modification.
39428 If only syslog is being used, the Exim monitor is unable to provide a log tail
39429 display, unless syslog is routing &'mainlog'& to a file on the local host and
39430 the environment variable EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set to tell the monitor
39435 .section "Log line flags" "SECID250"
39436 One line is written to the main log for each message received, and for each
39437 successful, unsuccessful, and delayed delivery. These lines can readily be
39438 picked out by the distinctive two-character flags that immediately follow the
39439 timestamp. The flags are:
39440 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
39441 .irow &%<=%& "message arrival"
39442 .irow &%(=%& "message fakereject"
39443 .irow &%=>%& "normal message delivery"
39444 .irow &%->%& "additional address in same delivery"
39445 .irow &%>>%& "cutthrough message delivery"
39446 .irow &%*>%& "delivery suppressed by &%-N%&"
39447 .irow &%**%& "delivery failed; address bounced"
39448 .irow &%==%& "delivery deferred; temporary problem"
39452 .section "Logging message reception" "SECID251"
39453 .cindex "log" "reception line"
39454 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
39455 message received is shown in the basic example below, which is split over
39456 several lines in order to fit it on the page:
39458 2002-10-31 08:57:53 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 <= kryten@dwarf.fict.example
39459 H=mailer.fict.example [192.168.123.123] U=exim
39460 P=smtp S=5678 id=<incoming message id>
39462 The address immediately following &"<="& is the envelope sender address. A
39463 bounce message is shown with the sender address &"<>"&, and if it is locally
39464 generated, this is followed by an item of the form
39468 which is a reference to the message that caused the bounce to be sent.
39472 For messages from other hosts, the H and U fields identify the remote host and
39473 record the RFC 1413 identity of the user that sent the message, if one was
39474 received. The number given in square brackets is the IP address of the sending
39475 host. If there is a single, unparenthesized host name in the H field, as
39476 above, it has been verified to correspond to the IP address (see the
39477 &%host_lookup%& option). If the name is in parentheses, it was the name quoted
39478 by the remote host in the SMTP HELO or EHLO command, and has not been
39479 verified. If verification yields a different name to that given for HELO or
39480 EHLO, the verified name appears first, followed by the HELO or EHLO
39481 name in parentheses.
39483 Misconfigured hosts (and mail forgers) sometimes put an IP address, with or
39484 without brackets, in the HELO or EHLO command, leading to entries in
39485 the log containing text like these examples:
39487 H=(10.21.32.43) [192.168.8.34]
39488 H=([10.21.32.43]) [192.168.8.34]
39490 This can be confusing. Only the final address in square brackets can be relied
39493 For locally generated messages (that is, messages not received over TCP/IP),
39494 the H field is omitted, and the U field contains the login name of the caller
39497 .cindex "authentication" "logging"
39498 .cindex "AUTH" "logging"
39499 For all messages, the P field specifies the protocol used to receive the
39500 message. This is the value that is stored in &$received_protocol$&. In the case
39501 of incoming SMTP messages, the value indicates whether or not any SMTP
39502 extensions (ESMTP), encryption, or authentication were used. If the SMTP
39503 session was encrypted, there is an additional X field that records the cipher
39504 suite that was used.
39506 .cindex log protocol
39507 The protocol is set to &"esmtpsa"& or &"esmtpa"& for messages received from
39508 hosts that have authenticated themselves using the SMTP AUTH command. The first
39509 value is used when the SMTP connection was encrypted (&"secure"&). In this case
39510 there is an additional item A= followed by the name of the authenticator that
39511 was used. If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's
39512 &%server_set_id%& option, this is logged too, separated by a colon from the
39513 authenticator name.
39515 .cindex "size" "of message"
39516 The id field records the existing message id, if present. The size of the
39517 received message is given by the S field. When the message is delivered,
39518 headers may be removed or added, so that the size of delivered copies of the
39519 message may not correspond with this value (and indeed may be different to each
39522 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
39523 data when a message is received. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
39527 .section "Logging deliveries" "SECID252"
39528 .cindex "log" "delivery line"
39529 The format of the single-line entry in the main log that is written for every
39530 delivery is shown in one of the examples below, for local and remote
39531 deliveries, respectively. Each example has been split into multiple lines in order
39532 to fit it on the page:
39534 2002-10-31 08:59:13 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 => marv
39535 <marv@hitch.fict.example> R=localuser T=local_delivery
39536 2002-10-31 09:00:10 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 =>
39537 monk@holistic.fict.example R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp
39538 H=holistic.fict.example [192.168.234.234]
39540 For ordinary local deliveries, the original address is given in angle brackets
39541 after the final delivery address, which might be a pipe or a file. If
39542 intermediate address(es) exist between the original and the final address, the
39543 last of these is given in parentheses after the final address. The R and T
39544 fields record the router and transport that were used to process the address.
39546 If SMTP AUTH was used for the delivery there is an additional item A=
39547 followed by the name of the authenticator that was used.
39548 If an authenticated identification was set up by the authenticator's &%client_set_id%&
39549 option, this is logged too, as a second colon-separated list item.
39550 Optionally (see the &%smtp_mailauth%& &%log_selector%&) there may be a third list item.
39552 If a shadow transport was run after a successful local delivery, the log line
39553 for the successful delivery has an item added on the end, of the form
39555 &`ST=<`&&'shadow transport name'&&`>`&
39557 If the shadow transport did not succeed, the error message is put in
39558 parentheses afterwards.
39560 .cindex "asterisk" "after IP address"
39561 When more than one address is included in a single delivery (for example, two
39562 SMTP RCPT commands in one transaction) the second and subsequent addresses are
39563 flagged with &`->`& instead of &`=>`&. When two or more messages are delivered
39564 down a single SMTP connection, an asterisk follows the
39565 remote IP address (and port if enabled)
39566 in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
39567 When two or more messages are delivered down a single TLS connection, the
39568 DNS and some TLS-related information logged for the first message delivered
39569 will not be present in the log lines for the second and subsequent messages.
39570 TLS cipher information is still available.
39572 .cindex "delivery" "cutthrough; logging"
39573 .cindex "cutthrough" "logging"
39574 When delivery is done in cutthrough mode it is flagged with &`>>`& and the log
39575 line precedes the reception line, since cutthrough waits for a possible
39576 rejection from the destination in case it can reject the sourced item.
39578 The generation of a reply message by a filter file gets logged as a
39579 &"delivery"& to the addressee, preceded by &">"&.
39581 The &%log_selector%& option can be used to request the logging of additional
39582 data when a message is delivered. See section &<<SECTlogselector>>& below.
39585 .section "Discarded deliveries" "SECID253"
39586 .cindex "discarded messages"
39587 .cindex "message" "discarded"
39588 .cindex "delivery" "discarded; logging"
39589 When a message is discarded as a result of the command &"seen finish"& being
39590 obeyed in a filter file which generates no deliveries, a log entry of the form
39592 2002-12-10 00:50:49 16auJc-0001UB-00 => discarded
39593 <low.club@bridge.example> R=userforward
39595 is written, to record why no deliveries are logged. When a message is discarded
39596 because it is aliased to &":blackhole:"& the log line is like this:
39598 1999-03-02 09:44:33 10HmaX-0005vi-00 => :blackhole:
39599 <hole@nowhere.example> R=blackhole_router
39603 .section "Deferred deliveries" "SECID254"
39604 When a delivery is deferred, a line of the following form is logged:
39606 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 == marvin@endrest.example
39607 R=dnslookup T=smtp defer (146): Connection refused
39609 In the case of remote deliveries, the error is the one that was given for the
39610 last IP address that was tried. Details of individual SMTP failures are also
39611 written to the log, so the above line would be preceded by something like
39613 2002-12-19 16:20:23 16aiQz-0002Q5-00 Failed to connect to
39614 mail1.endrest.example [192.168.239.239]: Connection refused
39616 When a deferred address is skipped because its retry time has not been reached,
39617 a message is written to the log, but this can be suppressed by setting an
39618 appropriate value in &%log_selector%&.
39622 .section "Delivery failures" "SECID255"
39623 .cindex "delivery" "failure; logging"
39624 If a delivery fails because an address cannot be routed, a line of the
39625 following form is logged:
39627 1995-12-19 16:20:23 0tRiQz-0002Q5-00 ** jim@trek99.example
39628 <jim@trek99.example>: unknown mail domain
39630 If a delivery fails at transport time, the router and transport are shown, and
39631 the response from the remote host is included, as in this example:
39633 2002-07-11 07:14:17 17SXDU-000189-00 ** ace400@pb.example
39634 R=dnslookup T=remote_smtp: SMTP error from remote mailer
39635 after pipelined RCPT TO:<ace400@pb.example>: host
39636 pbmail3.py.example [192.168.63.111]: 553 5.3.0
39637 <ace400@pb.example>...Addressee unknown
39639 The word &"pipelined"& indicates that the SMTP PIPELINING extension was being
39640 used. See &%hosts_avoid_esmtp%& in the &(smtp)& transport for a way of
39641 disabling PIPELINING. The log lines for all forms of delivery failure are
39642 flagged with &`**`&.
39646 .section "Fake deliveries" "SECID256"
39647 .cindex "delivery" "fake; logging"
39648 If a delivery does not actually take place because the &%-N%& option has been
39649 used to suppress it, a normal delivery line is written to the log, except that
39650 &"=>"& is replaced by &"*>"&.
39654 .section "Completion" "SECID257"
39657 2002-10-31 09:00:11 16ZCW1-0005MB-00 Completed
39659 is written to the main log when a message is about to be removed from the spool
39660 at the end of its processing.
39665 .section "Summary of Fields in Log Lines" "SECID258"
39666 .cindex "log" "summary of fields"
39667 A summary of the field identifiers that are used in log lines is shown in
39668 the following table:
39670 &`A `& authenticator name (and optional id and sender)
39671 &`C `& SMTP confirmation on delivery
39672 &`Ci `& connection identifier
39673 &` `& command list for &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39674 &`CV `& certificate verification status
39675 &`D `& duration of &"no mail in SMTP session"&
39676 &`DKIM`& domain verified in incoming message
39677 &`DN `& distinguished name from peer certificate
39678 &`DS `& DNSSEC secured lookups
39679 &`DT `& on &`=>`&, &'=='& and &'**'& lines: time taken for, or to attempt, a delivery
39680 &`F `& sender address (on delivery lines)
39681 &`H `& host name and IP address
39682 &`I `& local interface used
39683 &`id `& message id (from header) for incoming message
39684 &`K `& CHUNKING extension used
39685 &`L `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: PIPELINING extension used
39686 &`M8S `& 8BITMIME status for incoming message
39687 &`P `& on &`<=`& lines: protocol used
39688 &` `& on &`=>`& and &`**`& lines: return path
39689 &`PRDR`& PRDR extension used
39690 &`PRX `& on &`<=`& and &`=>`& lines: proxy address
39691 &`Q `& alternate queue name
39692 &`QT `& on &`=>`& lines: time spent on queue so far
39693 &` `& on &"Completed"& lines: time spent on queue
39694 &`R `& on &`<=`& lines: reference for local bounce
39695 &` `& on &`=>`& &`>>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: router name
39696 &`RT `& on &`<=`& lines: time taken for reception
39697 &`S `& size of message in bytes
39698 &`SNI `& server name indication from TLS client hello
39699 &`ST `& shadow transport name
39700 &`T `& on &`<=`& lines: message subject (topic)
39701 &`TFO `& connection took advantage of TCP Fast Open
39702 &` `& on &`=>`& &`**`& and &`==`& lines: transport name
39703 &`U `& local user or RFC 1413 identity
39704 &`X `& TLS cipher suite
39708 .section "Other log entries" "SECID259"
39709 Various other types of log entry are written from time to time. Most should be
39710 self-explanatory. Among the more common are:
39713 .cindex "retry" "time not reached"
39714 &'retry time not reached'&&~&~An address previously suffered a temporary error
39715 during routing or local delivery, and the time to retry has not yet arrived.
39716 This message is not written to an individual message log file unless it happens
39717 during the first delivery attempt.
39719 &'retry time not reached for any host'&&~&~An address previously suffered
39720 temporary errors during remote delivery, and the retry time has not yet arrived
39721 for any of the hosts to which it is routed.
39723 .cindex "spool directory" "file locked"
39724 &'spool file locked'&&~&~An attempt to deliver a message cannot proceed because
39725 some other Exim process is already working on the message. This can be quite
39726 common if queue running processes are started at frequent intervals. The
39727 &'exiwhat'& utility script can be used to find out what Exim processes are
39730 .cindex "error" "ignored"
39731 &'error ignored'&&~&~There are several circumstances that give rise to this
39734 Exim failed to deliver a bounce message whose age was greater than
39735 &%ignore_bounce_errors_after%&. The bounce was discarded.
39737 A filter file set up a delivery using the &"noerror"& option, and the delivery
39738 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39740 A delivery set up by a router configured with
39741 . ==== As this is a nested list, any displays it contains must be indented
39742 . ==== as otherwise they are too far to the left.
39746 failed. The delivery was discarded.
39749 .cindex DKIM "log line"
39750 &'DKIM: d='&&~&~Verbose results of a DKIM verification attempt, if enabled for
39751 logging and the message has a DKIM signature header.
39758 .section "Reducing or increasing what is logged" "SECTlogselector"
39759 .cindex "log" "selectors"
39760 By setting the &%log_selector%& global option, you can disable some of Exim's
39761 default logging to the main log, or you can request additional logging. The value of
39762 &%log_selector%& is made up of names preceded by plus or minus characters. For
39765 log_selector = +arguments -retry_defer
39767 The list of optional log items is in the following table, with the default
39768 selection marked by asterisks:
39769 .itable none 0 0 3 2.8in left 10pt center 3in left
39770 .irow &`8bitmime`& "received 8BITMIME status"
39771 .irow &`acl_warn_skipped`& * "skipped &%warn%& statement in ACL"
39772 .irow &`address_rewrite`& "address rewriting"
39773 .irow &`all_parents`& "all parents in => lines"
39774 .irow &`arguments`& "command line arguments"
39775 .irow &`connection_id`& "connection identifier"
39776 .irow &`connection_reject`& * "connection rejections"
39777 .irow &`delay_delivery`& * "immediate delivery delayed"
39778 .irow &`deliver_time`& "time taken to attempt delivery"
39779 .irow &`delivery_size`& "add &`S=`&&'nnn'& to => lines"
39780 .irow &`dkim`& * "DKIM verified domain on <= lines"
39781 .irow &`dkim_verbose`& "separate full DKIM verification result line, per signature; DKIM signing"
39782 .irow &`dnslist_defer`& * "defers of DNS list (aka RBL) lookups"
39783 .irow &`dnssec`& "DNSSEC secured lookups"
39784 .irow &`etrn`& * "ETRN commands"
39785 .irow &`host_lookup_failed`& * "as it says"
39786 .irow &`ident_timeout`& "timeout for ident connection"
39787 .irow &`incoming_interface`& "local interface & port on <= and => lines"
39788 .irow &`incoming_port`& "remote port on <= lines"
39789 .irow &`lost_incoming_connection`& * "as it says (includes timeouts)"
39790 .irow &`millisec`& "millisecond timestamps and RT,QT,DT,D times"
39791 .irow &`msg_id`& * "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value"
39792 .irow &`msg_id_created`& "on <= lines, Message-ID: header value when one had to be added"
39793 .irow &`outgoing_interface`& "local interface on => lines"
39794 .irow &`outgoing_port`& "add remote port to => lines"
39795 .irow &`queue_run`& * "start and end queue runs"
39796 .irow &`queue_time`& "time on queue for one recipient"
39797 .irow &`queue_time_exclusive`& "exclude recieve time from QT times"
39798 .irow &`queue_time_overall`& "time on queue for whole message"
39799 .irow &`pid`& "Exim process id"
39800 .irow &`pipelining`& "PIPELINING use, on <= and => lines"
39801 .irow &`proxy`& "proxy address on <= and => lines"
39802 .irow &`receive_time`& "time taken to receive message"
39803 .irow &`received_recipients`& "recipients on <= lines"
39804 .irow &`received_sender`& "sender on <= lines"
39805 .irow &`rejected_header`& * "header contents on reject log"
39806 .irow &`retry_defer`& * "&<quote>&retry time not reached&</quote>&"
39807 .irow &`return_path_on_delivery`& "put return path on => and ** lines"
39808 .irow &`sender_on_delivery`& "add sender to => lines"
39809 .irow &`sender_verify_fail`& * "sender verification failures"
39810 .irow &`size_reject`& * "rejection because too big"
39811 .irow &`skip_delivery`& * "delivery skipped in a queue run"
39812 .irow &`smtp_confirmation`& * "SMTP confirmation on => lines"
39813 .irow &`smtp_connection`& "incoming SMTP connections"
39814 .irow &`smtp_incomplete_transaction`& "incomplete SMTP transactions"
39815 .irow &`smtp_mailauth`& "AUTH argument to MAIL commands"
39816 .irow &`smtp_no_mail`& "session with no MAIL commands"
39817 .irow &`smtp_protocol_error`& "SMTP protocol errors"
39818 .irow &`smtp_syntax_error`& "SMTP syntax errors"
39819 .irow &`subject`& "contents of &'Subject:'& on <= lines"
39820 .irow &`tls_certificate_verified`& * "certificate verification status"
39821 .irow &`tls_cipher`& * "TLS cipher suite on <= and => lines"
39822 .irow &`tls_peerdn`& "TLS peer DN on <= and => lines"
39823 .irow &`tls_resumption`& "append * to cipher field"
39824 .irow &`tls_sni`& "TLS SNI on <= lines"
39825 .irow &`unknown_in_list`& "lookup failed in list match"
39826 .irow &`all`& "&*all of the above*&"
39828 See also the &%slow_lookup_log%& main configuration option,
39829 section &<<SECID99>>&
39831 More details on each of these items follows:
39835 .cindex "log" "8BITMIME"
39836 &%8bitmime%&: This causes Exim to log any 8BITMIME status of received messages,
39837 which may help in tracking down interoperability issues with ancient MTAs
39838 that are not 8bit clean. This is added to the &"<="& line, tagged with
39839 &`M8S=`& and a value of &`0`&, &`7`& or &`8`&, corresponding to "not given",
39840 &`7BIT`& and &`8BITMIME`& respectively.
39842 .cindex "&%warn%& ACL verb" "log when skipping"
39843 &%acl_warn_skipped%&: When an ACL &%warn%& statement is skipped because one of
39844 its conditions cannot be evaluated, a log line to this effect is written if
39845 this log selector is set.
39847 .cindex "log" "rewriting"
39848 .cindex "rewriting" "logging"
39849 &%address_rewrite%&: This applies both to global rewrites and per-transport
39850 rewrites, but not to rewrites in filters run as an unprivileged user (because
39851 such users cannot access the log).
39853 .cindex "log" "full parentage"
39854 &%all_parents%&: Normally only the original and final addresses are logged on
39855 delivery lines; with this selector, intermediate parents are given in
39856 parentheses between them.
39858 .cindex "log" "Exim arguments"
39859 .cindex "Exim arguments, logging"
39860 &%arguments%&: This causes Exim to write the arguments with which it was called
39861 to the main log, preceded by the current working directory. This is a debugging
39862 feature, added to make it easier to find out how certain MUAs call
39863 &_/usr/sbin/sendmail_&. The logging does not happen if Exim has given up root
39864 privilege because it was called with the &%-C%& or &%-D%& options. Arguments
39865 that are empty or that contain white space are quoted. Non-printing characters
39866 are shown as escape sequences. This facility cannot log unrecognized arguments,
39867 because the arguments are checked before the configuration file is read. The
39868 only way to log such cases is to interpose a script such as &_util/logargs.sh_&
39869 between the caller and Exim.
39871 .cindex log "connection identifier"
39872 .cindex connection "identifier logging"
39873 &%connection_id%&: An identifier for the accepted connection is added to
39874 connection start and end lines and to message accept lines.
39875 The identifier is tagged by Ci=.
39876 The value is PID-based, so will reset on reboot and will wrap.
39878 .cindex log "connection rejections"
39879 .cindex connection "rejection logging"
39880 &%connection_reject%&: A log entry is written whenever an incoming SMTP
39881 connection is rejected, for whatever reason.
39883 .cindex log "delayed delivery"
39884 .cindex "delayed delivery, logging"
39885 &%delay_delivery%&: A log entry is written whenever a delivery process is not
39886 started for an incoming message because the load is too high or too many
39887 messages were received on one connection. Logging does not occur if no delivery
39888 process is started because &%queue_only%& is set or &%-odq%& was used.
39890 .cindex "log" "delivery duration"
39891 &%deliver_time%&: For each delivery, the amount of real time it has taken to
39892 perform the actual delivery is logged as DT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`DT=1s`&.
39893 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
39894 precision, eg. &`DT=0.304s`&.
39896 .cindex "log" "message size on delivery"
39897 .cindex "size" "of message"
39898 &%delivery_size%&: For each delivery, the size of message delivered is added to
39899 the &"=>"& line, tagged with S=.
39901 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39902 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39903 &%dkim%&: For message acceptance log lines, when an DKIM signature in the header
39904 verifies successfully a tag of DKIM is added, with one of the verified domains.
39906 .cindex log "DKIM verification"
39907 .cindex DKIM "verification logging"
39908 &%dkim_verbose%&: A log entry is written for each attempted DKIM verification.
39909 Also, on message delivery lines signing information (domain and selector)
39910 is added, tagged with DKIM=.
39912 .cindex "log" "dnslist defer"
39913 .cindex "DNS list" "logging defer"
39914 .cindex "black list (DNS)"
39915 &%dnslist_defer%&: A log entry is written if an attempt to look up a host in a
39916 DNS black list suffers a temporary error.
39919 .cindex dnssec logging
39920 &%dnssec%&: For message acceptance and (attempted) delivery log lines, when
39921 dns lookups gave secure results a tag of DS is added.
39922 For acceptance this covers the reverse and forward lookups for host name verification.
39923 It does not cover helo-name verification.
39924 For delivery this covers the SRV, MX, A and/or AAAA lookups.
39926 .cindex "log" "ETRN commands"
39927 .cindex "ETRN" "logging"
39928 &%etrn%&: Every valid ETRN command that is received is logged, before the ACL
39929 is run to determine whether or not it is actually accepted. An invalid ETRN
39930 command, or one received within a message transaction is not logged by this
39931 selector (see &%smtp_syntax_error%& and &%smtp_protocol_error%&).
39933 .cindex "log" "host lookup failure"
39934 &%host_lookup_failed%&: When a lookup of a host's IP addresses fails to find
39935 any addresses, or when a lookup of an IP address fails to find a host name, a
39936 log line is written. This logging does not apply to direct DNS lookups when
39937 routing email addresses, but it does apply to &"byname"& lookups.
39939 .cindex "log" "ident timeout"
39940 .cindex "RFC 1413" "logging timeout"
39941 &%ident_timeout%&: A log line is written whenever an attempt to connect to a
39942 client's ident port times out.
39944 .cindex "log" "incoming interface"
39945 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39946 .cindex "log" "local interface"
39947 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
39948 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
39949 .cindex "interface" "logging"
39950 &%incoming_interface%&: The interface on which a message was received is added
39951 to the &"<="& line as an IP address in square brackets, tagged by I= and
39952 followed by a colon and the port number. The local interface and port are also
39953 added to other SMTP log lines, for example, &"SMTP connection from"&, to
39954 rejection lines, and (despite the name) to outgoing
39955 &"=>"&, &"->"&, &"=="& and &"**"& lines.
39956 The latter can be disabled by turning off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
39958 .cindex log "incoming proxy address"
39959 .cindex proxy "logging proxy address"
39960 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging proxy address"
39961 &%proxy%&: The internal (closest to the system running Exim) IP address
39962 of the proxy, tagged by PRX=, on the &"<="& line for a message accepted
39963 on a proxied connection
39964 or the &"=>"& line for a message delivered on a proxied connection.
39965 See &<<SECTproxyInbound>>& for more information.
39967 .cindex "log" "incoming remote port"
39968 .cindex "port" "logging remote"
39969 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging incoming remote port"
39970 .vindex "&$sender_fullhost$&"
39971 .vindex "&$sender_rcvhost$&"
39972 &%incoming_port%&: The remote port number from which a message was received is
39973 added to log entries and &'Received:'& header lines, following the IP address
39974 in square brackets, and separated from it by a colon. This is implemented by
39975 changing the value that is put in the &$sender_fullhost$& and
39976 &$sender_rcvhost$& variables. Recording the remote port number has become more
39977 important with the widening use of NAT
39978 (see &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2505,RFC 2505)).
39980 .cindex "log" "dropped connection"
39981 &%lost_incoming_connection%&: A log line is written when an incoming SMTP
39982 connection is unexpectedly dropped.
39984 .cindex "log" "millisecond timestamps"
39985 .cindex millisecond logging
39986 .cindex timestamps "millisecond, in logs"
39987 &%millisec%&: Timestamps have a period and three decimal places of finer granularity
39988 appended to the seconds value.
39990 .cindex "log" "message id"
39991 &%msg_id%&: The value of the Message-ID: header.
39993 &%msg_id_created%&: The value of the Message-ID: header, when one had to be created.
39994 This will be either because the message is a bounce, or was submitted locally
39995 (submission mode) without one.
39996 The field identifier will have an asterix appended: &"id*="&.
39998 .cindex "log" "outgoing interface"
39999 .cindex "log" "local interface"
40000 .cindex "log" "local address and port"
40001 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging local address and port"
40002 .cindex "interface" "logging"
40003 &%outgoing_interface%&: If &%incoming_interface%& is turned on, then the
40004 interface on which a message was sent is added to delivery lines as an I= tag
40005 followed by IP address in square brackets. You can disable this by turning
40006 off the &%outgoing_interface%& option.
40008 .cindex "log" "outgoing remote port"
40009 .cindex "port" "logging outgoing remote"
40010 .cindex "TCP/IP" "logging outgoing remote port"
40011 &%outgoing_port%&: The remote port number is added to delivery log lines (those
40012 containing => tags) following the IP address.
40013 The local port is also added if &%incoming_interface%& and
40014 &%outgoing_interface%& are both enabled.
40015 This option is not included in the default setting, because for most ordinary
40016 configurations, the remote port number is always 25 (the SMTP port), and the
40017 local port is a random ephemeral port.
40019 .cindex "log" "process ids in"
40020 .cindex "pid (process id)" "in log lines"
40021 &%pid%&: The current process id is added to every log line, in square brackets,
40022 immediately after the time and date.
40024 .cindex log pipelining
40025 .cindex pipelining "logging outgoing"
40026 &%pipelining%&: A field is added to delivery and accept
40027 log lines when the ESMTP PIPELINING extension was used.
40028 The field is a single "L".
40030 On accept lines, where PIPELINING was offered but not used by the client,
40031 the field has a minus appended.
40033 .cindex "pipelining" "early connection"
40034 If Exim is built without the DISABLE_PIPE_CONNECT build option
40035 accept "L" fields have a period appended if the feature was
40036 offered but not used, or an asterisk appended if used.
40037 Delivery "L" fields have an asterisk appended if used.
40040 .cindex "log" "queue run"
40041 .cindex "queue runner" "logging"
40042 &%queue_run%&: The start and end of every queue run are logged.
40044 .cindex "log" "queue time"
40045 &%queue_time%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on the
40046 local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on delivery (&`=>`&) lines, for example,
40048 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
40049 precision, eg. &`QT=1.578s`&.
40051 &%queue_time_overall%&: The amount of time the message has been in the queue on
40052 the local host is logged as QT=<&'time'&> on &"Completed"& lines, for
40053 example, &`QT=3m45s`&.
40055 .cindex "log" "receive duration"
40056 &%receive_time%&: For each message, the amount of real time it has taken to
40057 perform the reception is logged as RT=<&'time'&>, for example, &`RT=1s`&.
40058 If millisecond logging is enabled, short times will be shown with greater
40059 precision, eg. &`RT=0.204s`&.
40061 .cindex "log" "recipients"
40062 &%received_recipients%&: The recipients of a message are listed in the main log
40063 as soon as the message is received. The list appears at the end of the log line
40064 that is written when a message is received, preceded by the word &"for"&. The
40065 addresses are listed after they have been qualified, but before any rewriting
40067 Recipients that were discarded by an ACL for MAIL or RCPT do not appear
40070 .cindex "log" "sender reception"
40071 &%received_sender%&: The unrewritten original sender of a message is added to
40072 the end of the log line that records the message's arrival, after the word
40073 &"from"& (before the recipients if &%received_recipients%& is also set).
40075 .cindex "log" "header lines for rejection"
40076 &%rejected_header%&: If a message's header has been received at the time a
40077 rejection is written to the reject log, the complete header is added to the
40078 log. Header logging can be turned off individually for messages that are
40079 rejected by the &[local_scan()]& function (see section &<<SECTapiforloc>>&).
40081 .cindex "log" "retry defer"
40082 &%retry_defer%&: A log line is written if a delivery is deferred because a
40083 retry time has not yet been reached. However, this &"retry time not reached"&
40084 message is always omitted from individual message logs after the first delivery
40087 .cindex "log" "return path"
40088 &%return_path_on_delivery%&: The return path that is being transmitted with
40089 the message is included in delivery and bounce lines, using the tag P=.
40090 This is omitted if no delivery actually happens, for example, if routing fails,
40091 or if delivery is to &_/dev/null_& or to &`:blackhole:`&.
40093 .cindex "log" "sender on delivery"
40094 &%sender_on_delivery%&: The message's sender address is added to every delivery
40095 and bounce line, tagged by F= (for &"from"&).
40096 This is the original sender that was received with the message; it is not
40097 necessarily the same as the outgoing return path.
40099 .cindex "log" "sender verify failure"
40100 &%sender_verify_fail%&: If this selector is unset, the separate log line that
40101 gives details of a sender verification failure is not written. Log lines for
40102 the rejection of SMTP commands contain just &"sender verify failed"&, so some
40105 .cindex "log" "size rejection"
40106 &%size_reject%&: A log line is written whenever a message is rejected because
40109 .cindex "log" "frozen messages; skipped"
40110 .cindex "frozen messages" "logging skipping"
40111 &%skip_delivery%&: A log line is written whenever a message is skipped during a
40112 queue run because it another process is already delivering it or because
40114 .cindex "&""spool file is locked""&"
40115 .cindex "&""message is frozen""&"
40116 The message that is written is either &"spool file is locked"& or
40117 &"message is frozen"&.
40119 .cindex "log" "smtp confirmation"
40120 .cindex "SMTP" "logging confirmation"
40121 .cindex "LMTP" "logging confirmation"
40122 &%smtp_confirmation%&: The response to the final &"."& in the SMTP or LMTP dialogue for
40123 outgoing messages is added to delivery log lines in the form &`C=`&<&'text'&>.
40124 A number of MTAs (including Exim) return an identifying string in this
40127 .cindex "log" "SMTP connections"
40128 .cindex "SMTP" "logging connections"
40129 &%smtp_connection%&: A log line is written whenever an incoming SMTP connection is
40130 established or closed, unless the connection is from a host that matches
40131 &%hosts_connection_nolog%&. (In contrast, &%lost_incoming_connection%& applies
40132 only when the closure is unexpected.) This applies to connections from local
40133 processes that use &%-bs%& as well as to TCP/IP connections. If a connection is
40134 dropped in the middle of a message, a log line is always written, whether or
40135 not this selector is set, but otherwise nothing is written at the start and end
40136 of connections unless this selector is enabled.
40138 For TCP/IP connections to an Exim daemon, the current number of connections is
40139 included in the log message for each new connection, but note that the count is
40140 reset if the daemon is restarted.
40141 Also, because connections are closed (and the closure is logged) in
40142 subprocesses, the count may not include connections that have been closed but
40143 whose termination the daemon has not yet noticed. Thus, while it is possible to
40144 match up the opening and closing of connections in the log, the value of the
40145 logged counts may not be entirely accurate.
40147 .cindex "log" "SMTP transaction; incomplete"
40148 .cindex "SMTP" "logging incomplete transactions"
40149 &%smtp_incomplete_transaction%&: When a mail transaction is aborted by
40150 RSET, QUIT, loss of connection, or otherwise, the incident is logged,
40151 and the message sender plus any accepted recipients are included in the log
40152 line. This can provide evidence of dictionary attacks.
40154 .cindex "log" "non-MAIL SMTP sessions"
40155 .cindex "MAIL" "logging session without"
40156 &%smtp_no_mail%&: A line is written to the main log whenever an accepted SMTP
40157 connection terminates without having issued a MAIL command. This includes both
40158 the case when the connection is dropped, and the case when QUIT is used. It
40159 does not include cases where the connection is rejected right at the start (by
40160 an ACL, or because there are too many connections, or whatever). These cases
40161 already have their own log lines.
40163 The log line that is written contains the identity of the client in the usual
40164 way, followed by D= and a time, which records the duration of the connection.
40165 If the connection was authenticated, this fact is logged exactly as it is for
40166 an incoming message, with an A= item. If the connection was encrypted, CV=,
40167 DN=, and X= items may appear as they do for an incoming message, controlled by
40168 the same logging options.
40170 Finally, if any SMTP commands were issued during the connection, a C= item
40171 is added to the line, listing the commands that were used. For example,
40175 shows that the client issued QUIT straight after EHLO. If there were fewer
40176 than 20 commands, they are all listed. If there were more than 20 commands,
40177 the last 20 are listed, preceded by &"..."&. However, with the default
40178 setting of 10 for &%smtp_accept_max_nonmail%&, the connection will in any case
40179 have been aborted before 20 non-mail commands are processed.
40181 &%smtp_mailauth%&: A third subfield with the authenticated sender,
40182 colon-separated, is appended to the A= item for a message arrival or delivery
40183 log line, if an AUTH argument to the SMTP MAIL command (see &<<SECTauthparamail>>&)
40184 was accepted or used.
40186 .cindex "log" "SMTP protocol error"
40187 .cindex "SMTP" "logging protocol error"
40188 &%smtp_protocol_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP protocol error
40189 encountered. Exim does not have perfect detection of all protocol errors
40190 because of transmission delays and the use of pipelining. If PIPELINING has
40191 been advertised to a client, an Exim server assumes that the client will use
40192 it, and therefore it does not count &"expected"& errors (for example, RCPT
40193 received after rejecting MAIL) as protocol errors.
40195 .cindex "SMTP" "logging syntax errors"
40196 .cindex "SMTP" "syntax errors; logging"
40197 .cindex "SMTP" "unknown command; logging"
40198 .cindex "log" "unknown SMTP command"
40199 .cindex "log" "SMTP syntax error"
40200 &%smtp_syntax_error%&: A log line is written for every SMTP syntax error
40201 encountered. An unrecognized command is treated as a syntax error. For an
40202 external connection, the host identity is given; for an internal connection
40203 using &%-bs%& the sender identification (normally the calling user) is given.
40205 .cindex "log" "subject"
40206 .cindex "subject, logging"
40207 &%subject%&: The subject of the message is added to the arrival log line,
40208 preceded by &"T="& (T for &"topic"&, since S is already used for &"size"&).
40209 Any MIME &"words"& in the subject are decoded. The &%print_topbitchars%& option
40210 specifies whether characters with values greater than 127 should be logged
40211 unchanged, or whether they should be rendered as escape sequences.
40213 .cindex "log" "certificate verification"
40215 .cindex DANE logging
40216 &%tls_certificate_verified%&: An extra item is added to <= and => log lines
40217 when TLS is in use. The item is &`CV=yes`& if the peer's certificate was
40219 using a CA trust anchor,
40220 &`CV=dane`& if using a DNS trust anchor,
40221 and &`CV=no`& if not.
40223 .cindex "log" "TLS cipher"
40224 .cindex "TLS" "logging cipher"
40225 &%tls_cipher%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
40226 connection, the cipher suite used is added to the log line, preceded by X=.
40228 .cindex "log" "TLS peer DN"
40229 .cindex "TLS" "logging peer DN"
40230 &%tls_peerdn%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
40231 connection, and a certificate is supplied by the remote host, the peer DN is
40232 added to the log line, preceded by DN=.
40234 .cindex "log" "TLS resumption"
40235 .cindex "TLS" "logging session resumption"
40236 &%tls_resumption%&: When a message is sent or received over an encrypted
40237 connection and the TLS session resumed one used on a previous TCP connection,
40238 an asterisk is appended to the X= cipher field in the log line.
40240 .cindex "log" "TLS SNI"
40241 .cindex "TLS" "logging SNI"
40242 .cindex SNI logging
40243 &%tls_sni%&: When a message is received over an encrypted connection, and
40244 the remote host provided the Server Name Indication extension, the SNI is
40245 added to the log line, preceded by SNI=.
40247 .cindex "log" "DNS failure in list"
40248 &%unknown_in_list%&: This setting causes a log entry to be written when the
40249 result of a list match is failure because a DNS lookup failed, or because
40250 a bad IP address was in the list.
40254 .section "Message log" "SECID260"
40255 .cindex "message" "log file for"
40256 .cindex "log" "message log; description of"
40257 .cindex "&_msglog_& directory"
40258 .oindex "&%preserve_message_logs%&"
40259 In addition to the general log files, Exim writes a log file for each message
40260 that it handles. The names of these per-message logs are the message ids, and
40261 they are kept in the &_msglog_& sub-directory of the spool directory. Each
40262 message log contains copies of the log lines that apply to the message. This
40263 makes it easier to inspect the status of an individual message without having
40264 to search the main log. A message log is deleted when processing of the message
40265 is complete, unless &%preserve_message_logs%& is set, but this should be used
40266 only with great care because they can fill up your disk very quickly.
40268 On a heavily loaded system, it may be desirable to disable the use of
40269 per-message logs, in order to reduce disk I/O. This can be done by setting the
40270 &%message_logs%& option false.
40276 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40277 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
40279 .chapter "Exim utilities" "CHAPutils"
40280 .scindex IIDutils "utilities"
40281 A number of utility scripts and programs are supplied with Exim and are
40282 described in this chapter. There is also the Exim Monitor, which is covered in
40283 the next chapter. The utilities described here are:
40285 .itable none 0 0 3 7* left 15* left 40* left
40286 .irow &<<SECTfinoutwha>>& &'exiwhat'& &&&
40287 "list what Exim processes are doing"
40288 .irow &<<SECTgreptheque>>& &'exiqgrep'& "grep the queue"
40289 .irow &<<SECTsumtheque>>& &'exiqsumm'& "summarize the queue"
40290 .irow &<<SECTextspeinf>>& &'exigrep'& "search the main log"
40291 .irow &<<SECTexipick>>& &'exipick'& "select messages on &&&
40293 .irow &<<SECTcyclogfil>>& &'exicyclog'& "cycle (rotate) log files"
40294 .irow &<<SECTmailstat>>& &'eximstats'& &&&
40295 "extract statistics from the log"
40296 .irow &<<SECTcheckaccess>>& &'exim_checkaccess'& &&&
40297 "check address acceptance from given IP"
40298 .irow &<<SECTdbmbuild>>& &'exim_dbmbuild'& "build a DBM file"
40299 .irow &<<SECTfinindret>>& &'exinext'& "extract retry information"
40300 .irow &<<SECTdumpdb>>& &'exim_dumpdb'& "dump a hints database"
40301 .irow &<<SECTtidydb>>& &'exim_tidydb'& "clean up a hints database"
40302 .irow &<<SECTfixdb>>& &'exim_fixdb'& "patch a hints database"
40303 .irow &<<SECTmailboxmaint>>& &'exim_lock'& "lock a mailbox file"
40304 .irow &<<SECTexim_msgdate>>& &'exim_msgdate'& "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)"
40307 Another utility that might be of use to sites with many MTAs is Tom Kistner's
40308 &'exilog'&. It provides log visualizations across multiple Exim servers. See
40309 &url(https://duncanthrax.net/exilog/) for details.
40314 .section "Finding out what Exim processes are doing (exiwhat)" "SECTfinoutwha"
40315 .cindex "&'exiwhat'&"
40316 .cindex "process, querying"
40318 On operating systems that can restart a system call after receiving a signal
40319 (most modern OS), an Exim process responds to the SIGUSR1 signal by writing
40320 a line describing what it is doing to the file &_exim-process.info_& in the
40321 Exim spool directory. The &'exiwhat'& script sends the signal to all Exim
40322 processes it can find, having first emptied the file. It then waits for one
40323 second to allow the Exim processes to react before displaying the results. In
40324 order to run &'exiwhat'& successfully you have to have sufficient privilege to
40325 send the signal to the Exim processes, so it is normally run as root.
40327 &*Warning*&: This is not an efficient process. It is intended for occasional
40328 use by system administrators. It is not sensible, for example, to set up a
40329 script that sends SIGUSR1 signals to Exim processes at short intervals.
40332 Unfortunately, the &'ps'& command that &'exiwhat'& uses to find Exim processes
40333 varies in different operating systems. Not only are different options used,
40334 but the format of the output is different. For this reason, there are some
40335 system configuration options that configure exactly how &'exiwhat'& works. If
40336 it doesn't seem to be working for you, check the following compile-time
40338 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
40339 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_CMD`& "the command for running &'ps'&"
40340 .irow &`EXIWHAT_PS_ARG`& "the argument for &'ps'&"
40341 .irow &`EXIWHAT_EGREP_ARG`& "the argument for &'egrep'& to select from &'ps'& output"
40342 .irow &`EXIWHAT_KILL_ARG`& "the argument for the &'kill'& command"
40344 An example of typical output from &'exiwhat'& is
40346 164 daemon: -q1h, listening on port 25
40347 10483 running queue: waiting for 0tAycK-0002ij-00 (10492)
40348 10492 delivering 0tAycK-0002ij-00 to mail.ref.example
40349 [10.19.42.42] (editor@ref.example)
40350 10592 handling incoming call from [192.168.243.242]
40351 10628 accepting a local non-SMTP message
40353 The first number in the output line is the process number. The third line has
40354 been split here, in order to fit it on the page.
40358 .section "Selective queue listing (exiqgrep)" "SECTgreptheque"
40359 .cindex "&'exiqgrep'&"
40360 .cindex "queue" "grepping"
40361 This utility is a Perl script contributed by Matt Hubbard. It runs
40365 or (in case &*-a*& switch is specified)
40369 to obtain a queue listing, and then greps the output to select messages
40370 that match given criteria. The following selection options are available:
40373 .vitem &*-f*&&~<&'regex'&>
40374 Match the sender address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
40375 tested is enclosed in angle brackets, so you can test for bounce messages with
40379 .vitem &*-r*&&~<&'regex'&>
40380 Match a recipient address using a case-insensitive search. The field that is
40381 tested is not enclosed in angle brackets.
40383 .vitem &*-s*&&~<&'regex'&>
40384 Match against the size field.
40386 .vitem &*-y*&&~<&'seconds'&>
40387 Match messages that are younger than the given time.
40389 .vitem &*-o*&&~<&'seconds'&>
40390 Match messages that are older than the given time.
40393 Match only frozen messages.
40396 Match only non-frozen messages.
40398 .vitem &*-G*&&~<&'queuename'&>
40399 Match only messages in the given queue. Without this, the default queue is searched.
40402 The following options control the format of the output:
40406 Display only the count of matching messages.
40409 Long format &-- display the full message information as output by Exim. This is
40413 Display message ids only.
40416 Brief format &-- one line per message.
40419 Display messages in reverse order.
40422 Include delivered recipients in queue listing.
40425 The following options give alternates for configuration:
40428 .vitem &*-C*&&~<&'config&~file'&>
40429 is used to specify an alternate &_exim.conf_& which might
40430 contain alternate exim configuration the queue management might be using.
40432 .vitem &*-E*&&~<&'path'&>
40433 can be used to specify a path for the exim binary,
40434 overriding the built-in one.
40437 There is one more option, &%-h%&, which outputs a list of options.
40438 At least one selection option, or either the &*-c*& or &*-h*& option, must be given.
40442 .section "Summarizing the queue (exiqsumm)" "SECTsumtheque"
40443 .cindex "&'exiqsumm'&"
40444 .cindex "queue" "summary"
40445 The &'exiqsumm'& utility is a Perl script which reads the output of &`exim
40446 -bp`& and produces a summary of the messages in the queue. Thus, you use it by
40447 running a command such as
40449 exim -bp | exiqsumm
40451 The output consists of one line for each domain that has messages waiting for
40452 it, as in the following example:
40454 3 2322 74m 66m msn.com.example
40456 Each line lists the number of pending deliveries for a domain, their total
40457 volume, and the length of time that the oldest and the newest messages have
40458 been waiting. Note that the number of pending deliveries is greater than the
40459 number of messages when messages have more than one recipient.
40461 A summary line is output at the end. By default the output is sorted on the
40462 domain name, but &'exiqsumm'& has the options &%-a%& and &%-c%&, which cause
40463 the output to be sorted by oldest message and by count of messages,
40464 respectively. There are also three options that split the messages for each
40465 domain into two or more subcounts: &%-b%& separates bounce messages, &%-f%&
40466 separates frozen messages, and &%-s%& separates messages according to their
40469 The output of &'exim -bp'& contains the original addresses in the message, so
40470 this also applies to the output from &'exiqsumm'&. No domains from addresses
40471 generated by aliasing or forwarding are included (unless the &%one_time%&
40472 option of the &(redirect)& router has been used to convert them into &"top
40473 level"& addresses).
40478 .section "Extracting specific information from the log (exigrep)" &&&
40480 .cindex "&'exigrep'&"
40481 .cindex "log" "extracts; grepping for"
40482 The &'exigrep'& utility is a Perl script that searches one or more main log
40483 files for entries that match a given pattern. When it finds a match, it
40484 extracts all the log entries for the relevant message, not just those that
40485 match the pattern. Thus, &'exigrep'& can extract complete log entries for a
40486 given message, or all mail for a given user, or for a given host, for example.
40487 The input files can be in Exim log format or syslog format.
40488 If a matching log line is not associated with a specific message, it is
40489 included in &'exigrep'&'s output without any additional lines. The usage is:
40491 &`exigrep [-t<`&&'n'&&`>] [-I] [-l] [-M] [-v] <`&&'pattern'&&`> [<`&&'log file'&&`>] ...`&
40493 If no log filenames are given on the command line, the standard input is read.
40495 The &%-t%& argument specifies a number of seconds. It adds an additional
40496 condition for message selection. Messages that are complete are shown only if
40497 they spent more than <&'n'&> seconds in the queue.
40499 By default, &'exigrep'& does case-insensitive matching. The &%-I%& option
40500 makes it case-sensitive. This may give a performance improvement when searching
40501 large log files. Without &%-I%&, the Perl pattern matches use Perl's &`/i`&
40502 option; with &%-I%& they do not. In both cases it is possible to change the
40503 case sensitivity within the pattern by using &`(?i)`& or &`(?-i)`&.
40505 The &%-l%& option means &"literal"&, that is, treat all characters in the
40506 pattern as standing for themselves. Otherwise the pattern must be a Perl
40507 regular expression.
40509 The &%-v%& option inverts the matching condition. That is, a line is selected
40510 if it does &'not'& match the pattern.
40512 The &%-M%& options means &"related messages"&. &'exigrep'& will show messages
40513 that are generated as a result/response to a message that &'exigrep'& matched
40517 user_a sends a message to user_b, which generates a bounce back to user_b. If
40518 &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_a"&, only the first message will be
40519 displayed. But if &'exigrep'& is used to search for &"user_b"&, the first and
40520 the second (bounce) message will be displayed. Using &%-M%& with &'exigrep'&
40521 when searching for &"user_a"& will show both messages since the bounce is
40522 &"related"& to or a &"result"& of the first message that was found by the
40525 If the location of a &'zcat'& command is known from the definition of
40526 ZCAT_COMMAND in &_Local/Makefile_&, &'exigrep'& automatically passes any file
40527 whose name ends in COMPRESS_SUFFIX through &'zcat'& as it searches it.
40528 If the ZCAT_COMMAND is not executable, &'exigrep'& tries to use
40529 autodetection of some well known compression extensions.
40532 .section "Selecting messages by various criteria (exipick)" "SECTexipick"
40533 .cindex "&'exipick'&"
40534 John Jetmore's &'exipick'& utility is included in the Exim distribution. It
40535 lists messages from the queue according to a variety of criteria. For details
40536 of &'exipick'&'s facilities, run &'exipick'& with
40537 the &%--help%& option.
40540 .section "Cycling log files (exicyclog)" "SECTcyclogfil"
40541 .cindex "log" "cycling local files"
40542 .cindex "cycling logs"
40543 .cindex "&'exicyclog'&"
40544 The &'exicyclog'& script can be used to cycle (rotate) &'mainlog'& and
40545 &'rejectlog'& files. This is not necessary if only syslog is being used, or if
40546 you are using log files with datestamps in their names (see section
40547 &<<SECTdatlogfil>>&). Some operating systems have their own standard mechanisms
40548 for log cycling, and these can be used instead of &'exicyclog'& if preferred.
40549 There are two command line options for &'exicyclog'&:
40551 &%-k%& <&'count'&> specifies the number of log files to keep, overriding the
40552 default that is set when Exim is built. The default default is 10.
40554 &%-l%& <&'path'&> specifies the log file path, in the same format as Exim's
40555 &%log_file_path%& option (for example, &`/var/log/exim_%slog`&), again
40556 overriding the script's default, which is to find the setting from Exim's
40560 Each time &'exicyclog'& is run the filenames get &"shuffled down"& by one. If
40561 the main log filename is &_mainlog_& (the default) then when &'exicyclog'& is
40562 run &_mainlog_& becomes &_mainlog.01_&, the previous &_mainlog.01_& becomes
40563 &_mainlog.02_& and so on, up to the limit that is set in the script or by the
40564 &%-k%& option. Log files whose numbers exceed the limit are discarded. Reject
40565 logs are handled similarly.
40567 If the limit is greater than 99, the script uses 3-digit numbers such as
40568 &_mainlog.001_&, &_mainlog.002_&, etc. If you change from a number less than 99
40569 to one that is greater, or &'vice versa'&, you will have to fix the names of
40570 any existing log files.
40572 If no &_mainlog_& file exists, the script does nothing. Files that &"drop off"&
40573 the end are deleted. All files with numbers greater than 01 are compressed,
40574 using a compression command which is configured by the COMPRESS_COMMAND
40575 setting in &_Local/Makefile_&. It is usual to run &'exicyclog'& daily from a
40576 root &%crontab%& entry of the form
40578 1 0 * * * su exim -c /usr/exim/bin/exicyclog
40580 assuming you have used the name &"exim"& for the Exim user. You can run
40581 &'exicyclog'& as root if you wish, but there is no need.
40585 .section "Mail statistics (eximstats)" "SECTmailstat"
40586 .cindex "statistics"
40587 .cindex "&'eximstats'&"
40588 A Perl script called &'eximstats'& is provided for extracting statistical
40589 information from log files. The output is either plain text, or HTML.
40590 . --- 2018-09-07: LogReport's Lire appears to be dead; website is a Yahoo Japan
40591 . --- 404 error and everything else points to that.
40593 The &'eximstats'& script has been hacked about quite a bit over time. The
40594 latest version is the result of some extensive revision by Steve Campbell. A
40595 lot of information is given by default, but there are options for suppressing
40596 various parts of it. Following any options, the arguments to the script are a
40597 list of files, which should be main log files. For example:
40599 eximstats -nr /var/spool/exim/log/mainlog.01
40601 By default, &'eximstats'& extracts information about the number and volume of
40602 messages received from or delivered to various hosts. The information is sorted
40603 both by message count and by volume, and the top fifty hosts in each category
40604 are listed on the standard output. Similar information, based on email
40605 addresses or domains instead of hosts can be requested by means of various
40606 options. For messages delivered and received locally, similar statistics are
40607 also produced per user.
40609 The output also includes total counts and statistics about delivery errors, and
40610 histograms showing the number of messages received and deliveries made in each
40611 hour of the day. A delivery with more than one address in its envelope (for
40612 example, an SMTP transaction with more than one RCPT command) is counted
40613 as a single delivery by &'eximstats'&.
40615 Though normally more deliveries than receipts are reported (as messages may
40616 have multiple recipients), it is possible for &'eximstats'& to report more
40617 messages received than delivered, even though the queue is empty at the start
40618 and end of the period in question. If an incoming message contains no valid
40619 recipients, no deliveries are recorded for it. A bounce message is handled as
40620 an entirely separate message.
40622 &'eximstats'& always outputs a grand total summary giving the volume and number
40623 of messages received and deliveries made, and the number of hosts involved in
40624 each case. It also outputs the number of messages that were delayed (that is,
40625 not completely delivered at the first attempt), and the number that had at
40626 least one address that failed.
40628 The remainder of the output is in sections that can be independently disabled
40629 or modified by various options. It consists of a summary of deliveries by
40630 transport, histograms of messages received and delivered per time interval
40631 (default per hour), information about the time messages spent in the queue,
40632 a list of relayed messages, lists of the top fifty sending hosts, local
40633 senders, destination hosts, and destination local users by count and by volume,
40634 and a list of delivery errors that occurred.
40636 The relay information lists messages that were actually relayed, that is, they
40637 came from a remote host and were directly delivered to some other remote host,
40638 without being processed (for example, for aliasing or forwarding) locally.
40640 There are quite a few options for &'eximstats'& to control exactly what it
40641 outputs. These are documented in the Perl script itself, and can be extracted
40642 by running the command &(perldoc)& on the script. For example:
40644 perldoc /usr/exim/bin/eximstats
40647 .section "Checking access policy (exim_checkaccess)" "SECTcheckaccess"
40648 .cindex "&'exim_checkaccess'&"
40649 .cindex "policy control" "checking access"
40650 .cindex "checking access"
40651 The &%-bh%& command line argument allows you to run a fake SMTP session with
40652 debugging output, in order to check what Exim is doing when it is applying
40653 policy controls to incoming SMTP mail. However, not everybody is sufficiently
40654 familiar with the SMTP protocol to be able to make full use of &%-bh%&, and
40655 sometimes you just want to answer the question &"Does this address have
40656 access?"& without bothering with any further details.
40658 The &'exim_checkaccess'& utility is a &"packaged"& version of &%-bh%&. It takes
40659 two arguments, an IP address and an email address:
40661 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example
40663 The utility runs a call to Exim with the &%-bh%& option, to test whether the
40664 given email address would be accepted in a RCPT command in a TCP/IP
40665 connection from the host with the given IP address. The output of the utility
40666 is either the word &"accepted"&, or the SMTP error response, for example:
40669 550 Relay not permitted
40671 When running this test, the utility uses &`<>`& as the envelope sender address
40672 for the MAIL command, but you can change this by providing additional
40673 options. These are passed directly to the Exim command. For example, to specify
40674 that the test is to be run with the sender address &'himself@there.example'&
40677 exim_checkaccess 10.9.8.7 A.User@a.domain.example \
40678 -f himself@there.example
40680 Note that these additional Exim command line items must be given after the two
40681 mandatory arguments.
40683 Because the &%exim_checkaccess%& uses &%-bh%&, it does not perform callouts
40684 while running its checks. You can run checks that include callouts by using
40685 &%-bhc%&, but this is not yet available in a &"packaged"& form.
40689 .section "Making DBM files (exim_dbmbuild)" "SECTdbmbuild"
40690 .cindex "DBM" "building dbm files"
40691 .cindex "building DBM files"
40692 .cindex "&'exim_dbmbuild'&"
40693 .cindex "lower casing"
40694 .cindex "binary zero" "in lookup key"
40695 The &'exim_dbmbuild'& program reads an input file containing keys and data in
40696 the format used by the &(lsearch)& lookup (see section
40697 &<<SECTsinglekeylookups>>&). It writes a DBM file using the lower-cased alias
40698 names as keys and the remainder of the information as data. The lower-casing
40699 can be prevented by calling the program with the &%-nolc%& option.
40701 A terminating zero is included as part of the key string. This is expected by
40702 the &(dbm)& lookup type. However, if the option &%-nozero%& is given,
40703 &'exim_dbmbuild'& creates files without terminating zeroes in either the key
40704 strings or the data strings. The &(dbmnz)& lookup type can be used with such
40707 The program requires two arguments: the name of the input file (which can be a
40708 single hyphen to indicate the standard input), and the name of the output file.
40709 It creates the output under a temporary name, and then renames it if all went
40713 If the native DB interface is in use (USE_DB is set in a compile-time
40714 configuration file &-- this is common in free versions of Unix) the two
40715 filenames must be different, because in this mode the Berkeley DB functions
40716 create a single output file using exactly the name given. For example,
40718 exim_dbmbuild /etc/aliases /etc/aliases.db
40720 reads the system alias file and creates a DBM version of it in
40721 &_/etc/aliases.db_&.
40723 In systems that use the &'ndbm'& routines (mostly proprietary versions of
40724 Unix), two files are used, with the suffixes &_.dir_& and &_.pag_&. In this
40725 environment, the suffixes are added to the second argument of
40726 &'exim_dbmbuild'&, so it can be the same as the first. This is also the case
40727 when the Berkeley functions are used in compatibility mode (though this is not
40728 recommended), because in that case it adds a &_.db_& suffix to the filename.
40730 If a duplicate key is encountered, the program outputs a warning, and when it
40731 finishes, its return code is 1 rather than zero, unless the &%-noduperr%&
40732 option is used. By default, only the first of a set of duplicates is used &--
40733 this makes it compatible with &(lsearch)& lookups. There is an option
40734 &%-lastdup%& which causes it to use the data for the last duplicate instead.
40735 There is also an option &%-nowarn%&, which stops it listing duplicate keys to
40736 &%stderr%&. For other errors, where it doesn't actually make a new file, the
40742 .section "Finding individual retry times (exinext)" "SECTfinindret"
40743 .cindex "retry" "times"
40744 .cindex "&'exinext'&"
40745 A utility called &'exinext'& (mostly a Perl script) provides the ability to
40746 fish specific information out of the retry database. Given a mail domain (or a
40747 complete address), it looks up the hosts for that domain, and outputs any retry
40748 information for the hosts or for the domain. At present, the retry information
40749 is obtained by running &'exim_dumpdb'& (see below) and post-processing the
40750 output. For example:
40752 $ exinext piglet@milne.fict.example
40753 kanga.milne.example:192.168.8.1 error 146: Connection refused
40754 first failed: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40755 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 14:57:34
40756 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 15:02:34
40757 roo.milne.example:192.168.8.3 error 146: Connection refused
40758 first failed: 20-Jan-1996 13:12:08
40759 last tried: 21-Feb-1996 11:42:03
40760 next try at: 21-Feb-1996 19:42:03
40761 past final cutoff time
40763 You can also give &'exinext'& a local part, without a domain, and it
40764 will give any retry information for that local part in your default domain.
40765 A message id can be used to obtain retry information pertaining to a specific
40766 message. This exists only when an attempt to deliver a message to a remote host
40767 suffers a message-specific error (see section &<<SECToutSMTPerr>>&).
40768 &'exinext'& is not particularly efficient, but then it is not expected to be
40771 The &'exinext'& utility calls Exim to find out information such as the location
40772 of the spool directory. The utility has &%-C%& and &%-D%& options, which are
40773 passed on to the &'exim'& commands. The first specifies an alternate Exim
40774 configuration file, and the second sets macros for use within the configuration
40775 file. These features are mainly to help in testing, but might also be useful in
40776 environments where more than one configuration file is in use.
40780 .section "Hints database maintenance" "SECThindatmai"
40781 .cindex "hints database" "maintenance"
40782 .cindex "maintaining Exim's hints database"
40783 Three utility programs are provided for maintaining the DBM files that Exim
40784 uses to contain its delivery hint information. Each program requires two
40785 arguments. The first specifies the name of Exim's spool directory, and the
40786 second is the name of the database it is to operate on. These are as follows:
40789 &'retry'&: the database of retry information
40791 &'wait-'&<&'transport name'&>: databases of information about messages waiting
40794 &'callout'&: the callout cache
40796 &'ratelimit'&: the data for implementing the ratelimit ACL condition
40798 &'tls'&: TLS session resumption data
40800 &'misc'&: other hints data
40803 The &'misc'& database is used for
40806 Serializing delivery to a specific host (when &%serialize_hosts%& is set in an
40807 &(smtp)& transport)
40809 Limiting the concurrency of specific transports (when &%max_parallel%& is set
40812 Recording EHLO-time facilities advertised by hosts
40814 Serializing ETRN runs (when &%smtp_etrn_serialize%& is set)
40819 .subsection "exim_dumpdb" "SECTdumpdb"
40820 .cindex "&'exim_dumpdb'&"
40821 The entire contents of a database are written to the standard output by the
40822 &'exim_dumpdb'& program,
40823 taking as arguments the spool and database names.
40824 An option &'-z'& may be given to request times in UTC;
40825 otherwise times are in the local timezone.
40826 An option &'-k'& may be given to dump only the record keys.
40827 For example, to dump the retry database:
40829 exim_dumpdb /var/spool/exim retry
40831 For the retry database
40832 two lines of output are produced for each entry:
40834 T:mail.ref.example:192.168.242.242 146 77 Connection refused
40835 31-Oct-1995 12:00:12 02-Nov-1995 12:21:39 02-Nov-1995 20:21:39 *
40837 The first item on the first line is the key of the record. It starts with one
40838 of the letters R, or T, depending on whether it refers to a routing or
40839 transport retry. For a local delivery, the next part is the local address; for
40840 a remote delivery it is the name of the remote host, followed by its failing IP
40841 address (unless &%retry_include_ip_address%& is set false on the &(smtp)&
40842 transport). If the remote port is not the standard one (port 25), it is added
40843 to the IP address. Then there follows an error code, an additional error code,
40844 and a textual description of the error.
40846 The three times on the second line are the time of first failure, the time of
40847 the last delivery attempt, and the computed time for the next attempt. The line
40848 ends with an asterisk if the cutoff time for the last retry rule has been
40851 Each output line from &'exim_dumpdb'& for the &'wait-xxx'& databases
40852 consists of a host name followed by a list of ids for messages that are or were
40853 waiting to be delivered to that host. If there are a very large number for any
40854 one host, continuation records, with a sequence number added to the host name,
40855 may be seen. The data in these records is often out of date, because a message
40856 may be routed to several alternative hosts, and Exim makes no effort to keep
40861 .subsection "exim_tidydb" "SECTtidydb"
40862 .cindex "&'exim_tidydb'&"
40863 The &'exim_tidydb'& utility program is used to tidy up the contents of a hints
40864 database. If run with no options, it removes all records that are more than 30
40865 days old. The age is calculated from the date and time that the record was last
40866 updated. Note that, in the case of the retry database, it is &'not'& the time
40867 since the first delivery failure. Information about a host that has been down
40868 for more than 30 days will remain in the database, provided that the record is
40869 updated sufficiently often.
40871 The cutoff date can be altered by means of the &%-t%& option, which must be
40872 followed by a time. For example, to remove all records older than a week from
40873 the retry database:
40875 exim_tidydb -t 7d /var/spool/exim retry
40877 Both the &'wait-xxx'& and &'retry'& databases contain items that involve
40878 message ids. In the former these appear as data in records keyed by host &--
40879 they were messages that were waiting for that host &-- and in the latter they
40880 are the keys for retry information for messages that have suffered certain
40881 types of error. When &'exim_tidydb'& is run, a check is made to ensure that
40882 message ids in database records are those of messages that are still on the
40883 queue. Message ids for messages that no longer exist are removed from
40884 &'wait-xxx'& records, and if this leaves any records empty, they are deleted.
40885 For the &'retry'& database, records whose keys are non-existent message ids are
40886 removed. The &'exim_tidydb'& utility outputs comments on the standard output
40887 whenever it removes information from the database.
40889 Certain records are automatically removed by Exim when they are no longer
40890 needed, but others are not. For example, if all the MX hosts for a domain are
40891 down, a retry record is created for each one. If the primary MX host comes back
40892 first, its record is removed when Exim successfully delivers to it, but the
40893 records for the others remain because Exim has not tried to use those hosts.
40895 It is important, therefore, to run &'exim_tidydb'& periodically on all the
40896 hints databases. You should do this at a quiet time of day, because it requires
40897 a database to be locked (and therefore inaccessible to Exim) while it does its
40898 work. Removing records from a DBM file does not normally make the file smaller,
40899 but all the common DBM libraries are able to re-use the space that is released.
40900 After an initial phase of increasing in size, the databases normally reach a
40901 point at which they no longer get any bigger, as long as they are regularly
40904 &*Warning*&: If you never run &'exim_tidydb'&, the space used by the hints
40905 databases is likely to keep on increasing.
40910 .subsection "exim_fixdb" "SECTfixdb"
40911 .cindex "&'exim_fixdb'&"
40912 The &'exim_fixdb'& program is a utility for interactively modifying databases.
40913 Its main use is for testing Exim, but it might also be occasionally useful for
40914 getting round problems in a live system. Its interface
40915 is somewhat crude. On entry, it prompts for input with a right angle-bracket. A
40916 key of a database record can then be entered, and the data for that record is
40919 If &"d"& is typed at the next prompt, the entire record is deleted. For all
40920 except the &'retry'& database, that is the only operation that can be carried
40921 out. For the &'retry'& database, each field is output preceded by a number, and
40922 data for individual fields can be changed by typing the field number followed
40923 by new data, for example:
40927 resets the time of the next delivery attempt. Time values are given as a
40928 sequence of digit pairs for year, month, day, hour, and minute. Colons can be
40929 used as optional separators.
40931 Both displayed and input times are in the local timezone by default.
40932 If an option &'-z'& is used on the command line, displayed times
40938 .section "Mailbox maintenance (exim_lock)" "SECTmailboxmaint"
40939 .cindex "mailbox" "maintenance"
40940 .cindex "&'exim_lock'&"
40941 .cindex "locking mailboxes"
40942 The &'exim_lock'& utility locks a mailbox file using the same algorithm as
40943 Exim. For a discussion of locking issues, see section &<<SECTopappend>>&.
40944 &'Exim_lock'& can be used to prevent any modification of a mailbox by Exim or
40945 a user agent while investigating a problem. The utility requires the name of
40946 the file as its first argument. If the locking is successful, the second
40947 argument is run as a command (using C's &[system()]& function); if there is no
40948 second argument, the value of the SHELL environment variable is used; if this
40949 is unset or empty, &_/bin/sh_& is run. When the command finishes, the mailbox
40950 is unlocked and the utility ends. The following options are available:
40954 Use &[fcntl()]& locking on the open mailbox.
40957 Use &[flock()]& locking on the open mailbox, provided the operating system
40960 .vitem &%-interval%&
40961 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets the
40962 interval to sleep between retries (default 3).
40964 .vitem &%-lockfile%&
40965 Create a lock file before opening the mailbox.
40968 Lock the mailbox using MBX rules.
40971 Suppress verification output.
40973 .vitem &%-retries%&
40974 This must be followed by a number; it sets the number of times to try to get
40975 the lock (default 10).
40977 .vitem &%-restore_time%&
40978 This option causes &%exim_lock%& to restore the modified and read times to the
40979 locked file before exiting. This allows you to access a locked mailbox (for
40980 example, to take a backup copy) without disturbing the times that the user
40983 .vitem &%-timeout%&
40984 This must be followed by a number, which is a number of seconds; it sets a
40985 timeout to be used with a blocking &[fcntl()]& lock. If it is not set (the
40986 default), a non-blocking call is used.
40989 Generate verbose output.
40992 If none of &%-fcntl%&, &%-flock%&, &%-lockfile%& or &%-mbx%& are given, the
40993 default is to create a lock file and also to use &[fcntl()]& locking on the
40994 mailbox, which is the same as Exim's default. The use of &%-flock%& or
40995 &%-fcntl%& requires that the file be writeable; the use of &%-lockfile%&
40996 requires that the directory containing the file be writeable. Locking by lock
40997 file does not last forever; Exim assumes that a lock file is expired if it is
40998 more than 30 minutes old.
41000 The &%-mbx%& option can be used with either or both of &%-fcntl%& or
41001 &%-flock%&. It assumes &%-fcntl%& by default. MBX locking causes a shared lock
41002 to be taken out on the open mailbox, and an exclusive lock on the file
41003 &_/tmp/.n.m_& where &'n'& and &'m'& are the device number and inode
41004 number of the mailbox file. When the locking is released, if an exclusive lock
41005 can be obtained for the mailbox, the file in &_/tmp_& is deleted.
41007 The default output contains verification of the locking that takes place. The
41008 &%-v%& option causes some additional information to be given. The &%-q%& option
41009 suppresses all output except error messages.
41013 exim_lock /var/spool/mail/spqr
41015 runs an interactive shell while the file is locked, whereas
41017 &`exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr <<End`&
41018 <&'some commands'&>
41021 runs a specific non-interactive sequence of commands while the file is locked,
41022 suppressing all verification output. A single command can be run by a command
41025 exim_lock -q /var/spool/mail/spqr \
41026 "cp /var/spool/mail/spqr /some/where"
41028 Note that if a command is supplied, it must be entirely contained within the
41029 second argument &-- hence the quotes.
41032 .section "Message Ids for humans (exim_msgdate)" "SECTexim_msgdate"
41033 .cindex "exim_msgdate"
41034 The &'exim_msgdate'& utility is written by Andrew Aitchison and included in the Exim distribution.
41035 This Perl script converts an Exim Mesage ID back into a human readable form.
41036 For details of &'exim_msgdate'&'s options, run &'exim_msgdate'& with the &%--help%& option.
41038 Section &<<SECTmessiden>>& (Message identification) describes Exim Mesage IDs.
41040 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41041 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41043 .chapter "The Exim monitor" "CHAPeximon"
41044 .scindex IIDeximon "Exim monitor" "description"
41045 .cindex "X-windows"
41046 .cindex "&'eximon'&"
41047 .cindex "Local/eximon.conf"
41048 .cindex "&_exim_monitor/EDITME_&"
41049 The Exim monitor is an application which displays in an X window information
41050 about the state of Exim's queue and what Exim is doing. An admin user can
41051 perform certain operations on messages from this GUI interface; however all
41052 such facilities are also available from the command line, and indeed, the
41053 monitor itself makes use of the command line to perform any actions requested.
41057 .section "Running the monitor" "SECID264"
41058 The monitor is started by running the script called &'eximon'&. This is a shell
41059 script that sets up a number of environment variables, and then runs the
41060 binary called &_eximon.bin_&. The default appearance of the monitor window can
41061 be changed by editing the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file created by editing
41062 &_exim_monitor/EDITME_&. Comments in that file describe what the various
41063 parameters are for.
41065 The parameters that get built into the &'eximon'& script can be overridden for
41066 a particular invocation by setting up environment variables of the same names,
41067 preceded by &`EXIMON_`&. For example, a shell command such as
41069 EXIMON_LOG_DEPTH=400 eximon
41071 (in a Bourne-compatible shell) runs &'eximon'& with an overriding setting of
41072 the LOG_DEPTH parameter. If EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH is set in the environment, it
41073 overrides the Exim log file configuration. This makes it possible to have
41074 &'eximon'& tailing log data that is written to syslog, provided that MAIL.INFO
41075 syslog messages are routed to a file on the local host.
41077 X resources can be used to change the appearance of the window in the normal
41078 way. For example, a resource setting of the form
41080 Eximon*background: gray94
41082 changes the colour of the background to light grey rather than white. The
41083 stripcharts are drawn with both the data lines and the reference lines in
41084 black. This means that the reference lines are not visible when on top of the
41085 data. However, their colour can be changed by setting a resource called
41086 &"highlight"& (an odd name, but that's what the Athena stripchart widget uses).
41087 For example, if your X server is running Unix, you could set up lighter
41088 reference lines in the stripcharts by obeying
41091 Eximon*highlight: gray
41094 .cindex "admin user"
41095 In order to see the contents of messages in the queue, and to operate on them,
41096 &'eximon'& must either be run as root or by an admin user.
41098 The command-line parameters of &'eximon'& are passed to &_eximon.bin_& and may
41099 contain X11 resource parameters interpreted by the X11 library. In addition,
41100 if the first parameter starts with the string "gdb" then it is removed and the
41101 binary is invoked under gdb (the parameter is used as the gdb command-name, so
41102 versioned variants of gdb can be invoked).
41104 The monitor's window is divided into three parts. The first contains one or
41105 more stripcharts and two action buttons, the second contains a &"tail"& of the
41106 main log file, and the third is a display of the queue of messages awaiting
41107 delivery, with two more action buttons. The following sections describe these
41108 different parts of the display.
41113 .section "The stripcharts" "SECID265"
41114 .cindex "stripchart"
41115 The first stripchart is always a count of messages in the queue. Its name can
41116 be configured by setting QUEUE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
41117 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file. The remaining stripcharts are defined in the
41118 configuration script by regular expression matches on log file entries, making
41119 it possible to display, for example, counts of messages delivered to certain
41120 hosts or using certain transports. The supplied defaults display counts of
41121 received and delivered messages, and of local and SMTP deliveries. The default
41122 period between stripchart updates is one minute; this can be adjusted by a
41123 parameter in the &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
41125 The stripchart displays rescale themselves automatically as the value they are
41126 displaying changes. There are always 10 horizontal lines in each chart; the
41127 title string indicates the value of each division when it is greater than one.
41128 For example, &"x2"& means that each division represents a value of 2.
41130 It is also possible to have a stripchart which shows the percentage fullness of
41131 a particular disk partition, which is useful when local deliveries are confined
41132 to a single partition.
41134 .cindex "&%statvfs%& function"
41135 This relies on the availability of the &[statvfs()]& function or equivalent in
41136 the operating system. Most, but not all versions of Unix that support Exim have
41137 this. For this particular stripchart, the top of the chart always represents
41138 100%, and the scale is given as &"x10%"&. This chart is configured by setting
41139 SIZE_STRIPCHART and (optionally) SIZE_STRIPCHART_NAME in the
41140 &_Local/eximon.conf_& file.
41145 .section "Main action buttons" "SECID266"
41146 .cindex "size" "of monitor window"
41147 .cindex "Exim monitor" "window size"
41148 .cindex "window size"
41149 Below the stripcharts there is an action button for quitting the monitor. Next
41150 to this is another button marked &"Size"&. They are placed here so that
41151 shrinking the window to its default minimum size leaves just the queue count
41152 stripchart and these two buttons visible. Pressing the &"Size"& button causes
41153 the window to expand to its maximum size, unless it is already at the maximum,
41154 in which case it is reduced to its minimum.
41156 When expanding to the maximum, if the window cannot be fully seen where it
41157 currently is, it is moved back to where it was the last time it was at full
41158 size. When it is expanding from its minimum size, the old position is
41159 remembered, and next time it is reduced to the minimum it is moved back there.
41161 The idea is that you can keep a reduced window just showing one or two
41162 stripcharts at a convenient place on your screen, easily expand it to show
41163 the full window when required, and just as easily put it back to what it was.
41164 The idea is copied from what the &'twm'& window manager does for its
41165 &'f.fullzoom'& action. The minimum size of the window can be changed by setting
41166 the MIN_HEIGHT and MIN_WIDTH values in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
41168 Normally, the monitor starts up with the window at its full size, but it can be
41169 built so that it starts up with the window at its smallest size, by setting
41170 START_SMALL=yes in &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
41174 .section "The log display" "SECID267"
41175 .cindex "log" "tail of; in monitor"
41176 The second section of the window is an area in which a display of the tail of
41177 the main log is maintained.
41178 To save space on the screen, the timestamp on each log line is shortened by
41179 removing the date and, if &%log_timezone%& is set, the timezone.
41180 The log tail is not available when the only destination for logging data is
41181 syslog, unless the syslog lines are routed to a local file whose name is passed
41182 to &'eximon'& via the EXIMON_LOG_FILE_PATH environment variable.
41184 The log sub-window has a scroll bar at its lefthand side which can be used to
41185 move back to look at earlier text, and the up and down arrow keys also have a
41186 scrolling effect. The amount of log that is kept depends on the setting of
41187 LOG_BUFFER in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, which specifies the amount of memory
41188 to use. When this is full, the earlier 50% of data is discarded &-- this is
41189 much more efficient than throwing it away line by line. The sub-window also has
41190 a horizontal scroll bar for accessing the ends of long log lines. This is the
41191 only means of horizontal scrolling; the right and left arrow keys are not
41192 available. Text can be cut from this part of the window using the mouse in the
41193 normal way. The size of this subwindow is controlled by parameters in the
41194 configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&.
41196 Searches of the text in the log window can be carried out by means of the ^R
41197 and ^S keystrokes, which default to a reverse and a forward search,
41198 respectively. The search covers only the text that is displayed in the window.
41199 It cannot go further back up the log.
41201 The point from which the search starts is indicated by a caret marker. This is
41202 normally at the end of the text in the window, but can be positioned explicitly
41203 by pointing and clicking with the left mouse button, and is moved automatically
41204 by a successful search. If new text arrives in the window when it is scrolled
41205 back, the caret remains where it is, but if the window is not scrolled back,
41206 the caret is moved to the end of the new text.
41208 Pressing ^R or ^S pops up a window into which the search text can be typed.
41209 There are buttons for selecting forward or reverse searching, for carrying out
41210 the search, and for cancelling. If the &"Search"& button is pressed, the search
41211 happens and the window remains so that further searches can be done. If the
41212 &"Return"& key is pressed, a single search is done and the window is closed. If
41213 ^C is typed the search is cancelled.
41215 The searching facility is implemented using the facilities of the Athena text
41216 widget. By default this pops up a window containing both &"search"& and
41217 &"replace"& options. In order to suppress the unwanted &"replace"& portion for
41218 eximon, a modified version of the &%TextPop%& widget is distributed with Exim.
41219 However, the linkers in BSDI and HP-UX seem unable to handle an externally
41220 provided version of &%TextPop%& when the remaining parts of the text widget
41221 come from the standard libraries. The compile-time option EXIMON_TEXTPOP can be
41222 unset to cut out the modified &%TextPop%&, making it possible to build Eximon
41223 on these systems, at the expense of having unwanted items in the search popup
41228 .section "The queue display" "SECID268"
41229 .cindex "queue" "display in monitor"
41230 The bottom section of the monitor window contains a list of all messages that
41231 are in the queue, which includes those currently being received or delivered,
41232 as well as those awaiting delivery. The size of this subwindow is controlled by
41233 parameters in the configuration file &_Local/eximon.conf_&, and the frequency
41234 at which it is updated is controlled by another parameter in the same file &--
41235 the default is 5 minutes, since queue scans can be quite expensive. However,
41236 there is an &"Update"& action button just above the display which can be used
41237 to force an update of the queue display at any time.
41239 When a host is down for some time, a lot of pending mail can build up for it,
41240 and this can make it hard to deal with other messages in the queue. To help
41241 with this situation there is a button next to &"Update"& called &"Hide"&. If
41242 pressed, a dialogue box called &"Hide addresses ending with"& is put up. If you
41243 type anything in here and press &"Return"&, the text is added to a chain of
41244 such texts, and if every undelivered address in a message matches at least one
41245 of the texts, the message is not displayed.
41247 If there is an address that does not match any of the texts, all the addresses
41248 are displayed as normal. The matching happens on the ends of addresses so, for
41249 example, &'cam.ac.uk'& specifies all addresses in Cambridge, while
41250 &'xxx@foo.com.example'& specifies just one specific address. When any hiding
41251 has been set up, a button called &"Unhide"& is displayed. If pressed, it
41252 cancels all hiding. Also, to ensure that hidden messages do not get forgotten,
41253 a hide request is automatically cancelled after one hour.
41255 While the dialogue box is displayed, you can't press any buttons or do anything
41256 else to the monitor window. For this reason, if you want to cut text from the
41257 queue display to use in the dialogue box, you have to do the cutting before
41258 pressing the &"Hide"& button.
41260 The queue display contains, for each unhidden queued message, the length of
41261 time it has been in the queue, the size of the message, the message id, the
41262 message sender, and the first undelivered recipient, all on one line. If it is
41263 a bounce message, the sender is shown as &"<>"&. If there is more than one
41264 recipient to which the message has not yet been delivered, subsequent ones are
41265 listed on additional lines, up to a maximum configured number, following which
41266 an ellipsis is displayed. Recipients that have already received the message are
41269 .cindex "frozen messages" "display"
41270 If a message is frozen, an asterisk is displayed at the left-hand side.
41272 The queue display has a vertical scroll bar, and can also be scrolled by means
41273 of the arrow keys. Text can be cut from it using the mouse in the normal way.
41274 The text searching facilities, as described above for the log window, are also
41275 available, but the caret is always moved to the end of the text when the queue
41276 display is updated.
41280 .section "The queue menu" "SECID269"
41281 .cindex "queue" "menu in monitor"
41282 If the &%shift%& key is held down and the left button is clicked when the mouse
41283 pointer is over the text for any message, an action menu pops up, and the first
41284 line of the queue display for the message is highlighted. This does not affect
41287 If you want to use some other event for popping up the menu, you can set the
41288 MENU_EVENT parameter in &_Local/eximon.conf_& to change the default, or
41289 set EXIMON_MENU_EVENT in the environment before starting the monitor. The
41290 value set in this parameter is a standard X event description. For example, to
41291 run eximon using &%ctrl%& rather than &%shift%& you could use
41293 EXIMON_MENU_EVENT='Ctrl<Btn1Down>' eximon
41295 The title of the menu is the message id, and it contains entries which act as
41299 &'message log'&: The contents of the message log for the message are displayed
41300 in a new text window.
41302 &'headers'&: Information from the spool file that contains the envelope
41303 information and headers is displayed in a new text window. See chapter
41304 &<<CHAPspool>>& for a description of the format of spool files.
41306 &'body'&: The contents of the spool file containing the body of the message are
41307 displayed in a new text window. There is a default limit of 20,000 bytes to the
41308 amount of data displayed. This can be changed by setting the BODY_MAX
41309 option at compile time, or the EXIMON_BODY_MAX option at runtime.
41311 &'deliver message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-M%& option to request
41312 delivery of the message. This causes an automatic thaw if the message is
41313 frozen. The &%-v%& option is also set, and the output from Exim is displayed in
41314 a new text window. The delivery is run in a separate process, to avoid holding
41315 up the monitor while the delivery proceeds.
41317 &'freeze message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mf%& option to request
41318 that the message be frozen.
41320 .cindex "thawing messages"
41321 .cindex "unfreezing messages"
41322 .cindex "frozen messages" "thawing"
41323 &'thaw message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mt%& option to request
41324 that the message be thawed.
41326 .cindex "delivery" "forcing failure"
41327 &'give up on msg'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mg%& option to request
41328 that Exim gives up trying to deliver the message. A bounce message is generated
41329 for any remaining undelivered addresses.
41331 &'remove message'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mrm%& option to request
41332 that the message be deleted from the system without generating a bounce
41335 &'add recipient'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address can
41336 be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
41337 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
41338 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
41339 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mar%& option to request that an
41340 additional recipient be added to the message, unless the entry box is empty, in
41341 which case no action is taken.
41343 &'mark delivered'&: A dialog box is displayed into which a recipient address
41344 can be typed. If the address is not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter
41345 is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&, the address is qualified with that domain.
41346 Otherwise it must be entered as a fully qualified address. Pressing RETURN
41347 causes a call to Exim to be made using the &%-Mmd%& option to mark the given
41348 recipient address as already delivered, unless the entry box is empty, in which
41349 case no action is taken.
41351 &'mark all delivered'&: A call to Exim is made using the &%-Mmad%& option to
41352 mark all recipient addresses as already delivered.
41354 &'edit sender'&: A dialog box is displayed initialized with the current
41355 sender's address. Pressing RETURN causes a call to Exim to be made using the
41356 &%-Mes%& option to replace the sender address, unless the entry box is empty,
41357 in which case no action is taken. If you want to set an empty sender (as in
41358 bounce messages), you must specify it as &"<>"&. Otherwise, if the address is
41359 not qualified and the QUALIFY_DOMAIN parameter is set in &_Local/eximon.conf_&,
41360 the address is qualified with that domain.
41363 When a delivery is forced, a window showing the &%-v%& output is displayed. In
41364 other cases when a call to Exim is made, if there is any output from Exim (in
41365 particular, if the command fails) a window containing the command and the
41366 output is displayed. Otherwise, the results of the action are normally apparent
41367 from the log and queue displays. However, if you set ACTION_OUTPUT=yes in
41368 &_Local/eximon.conf_&, a window showing the Exim command is always opened, even
41369 if no output is generated.
41371 The queue display is automatically updated for actions such as freezing and
41372 thawing, unless ACTION_QUEUE_UPDATE=no has been set in
41373 &_Local/eximon.conf_&. In this case the &"Update"& button has to be used to
41374 force an update of the display after one of these actions.
41376 In any text window that is displayed as result of a menu action, the normal
41377 cut-and-paste facility is available, and searching can be carried out using ^R
41378 and ^S, as described above for the log tail window.
41385 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41386 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41388 .chapter "Security considerations" "CHAPsecurity"
41389 .scindex IIDsecurcon "security" "discussion of"
41390 This chapter discusses a number of issues concerned with security, some of
41391 which are also covered in other parts of this manual.
41393 For reasons that this author does not understand, some people have promoted
41394 Exim as a &"particularly secure"& mailer. Perhaps it is because of the
41395 existence of this chapter in the documentation. However, the intent of the
41396 chapter is simply to describe the way Exim works in relation to certain
41397 security concerns, not to make any specific claims about the effectiveness of
41398 its security as compared with other MTAs.
41400 What follows is a description of the way Exim is supposed to be. Best efforts
41401 have been made to try to ensure that the code agrees with the theory, but an
41402 absence of bugs can never be guaranteed. Any that are reported will get fixed
41403 as soon as possible.
41406 .section "Building a more &""hardened""& Exim" "SECID286"
41407 .cindex "security" "build-time features"
41408 There are a number of build-time options that can be set in &_Local/Makefile_&
41409 to create Exim binaries that are &"harder"& to attack, in particular by a rogue
41410 Exim administrator who does not have the root password, or by someone who has
41411 penetrated the Exim (but not the root) account. These options are as follows:
41414 ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX can be set to a string that is required to match the
41415 start of any filenames used with the &%-C%& option. When it is set, these
41416 filenames are also not allowed to contain the sequence &"/../"&. (However, if
41417 the value of the &%-C%& option is identical to the value of CONFIGURE_FILE in
41418 &_Local/Makefile_&, Exim ignores &%-C%& and proceeds as usual.) There is no
41419 default setting for &%ALT_CONFIG_PREFIX%&.
41421 If the permitted configuration files are confined to a directory to
41422 which only root has access, this guards against someone who has broken
41423 into the Exim account from running a privileged Exim with an arbitrary
41424 configuration file, and using it to break into other accounts.
41427 If a non-trusted configuration file (i.e. not the default configuration file
41428 or one which is trusted by virtue of being listed in the TRUSTED_CONFIG_LIST
41429 file) is specified with &%-C%&, or if macros are given with &%-D%& (but see
41430 the next item), then root privilege is retained only if the caller of Exim is
41431 root. This locks out the possibility of testing a configuration using &%-C%&
41432 right through message reception and delivery, even if the caller is root. The
41433 reception works, but by that time, Exim is running as the Exim user, so when
41434 it re-execs to regain privilege for the delivery, the use of &%-C%& causes
41435 privilege to be lost. However, root can test reception and delivery using two
41439 The WHITELIST_D_MACROS build option declares some macros to be safe to override
41440 with &%-D%& if the real uid is one of root, the Exim run-time user or the
41441 CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined. The potential impact of this option is limited by
41442 requiring the run-time value supplied to &%-D%& to match a regex that errs on
41443 the restrictive side. Requiring build-time selection of safe macros is onerous
41444 but this option is intended solely as a transition mechanism to permit
41445 previously-working configurations to continue to work after release 4.73.
41447 If DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined, the use of the &%-D%& command line option
41450 FIXED_NEVER_USERS can be set to a colon-separated list of users that are
41451 never to be used for any deliveries. This is like the &%never_users%& runtime
41452 option, but it cannot be overridden; the runtime option adds additional users
41453 to the list. The default setting is &"root"&; this prevents a non-root user who
41454 is permitted to modify the runtime file from using Exim as a way to get root.
41459 .section "Root privilege" "SECID270"
41461 .cindex "root privilege"
41462 The Exim binary is normally setuid to root, which means that it gains root
41463 privilege (runs as root) when it starts execution. In some special cases (for
41464 example, when the daemon is not in use and there are no local deliveries), it
41465 may be possible to run Exim setuid to some user other than root. This is
41466 discussed in the next section. However, in most installations, root privilege
41467 is required for two things:
41470 To set up a socket connected to the standard SMTP port (25) when initialising
41471 the listening daemon. If Exim is run from &'inetd'&, this privileged action is
41474 To be able to change uid and gid in order to read users' &_.forward_& files and
41475 perform local deliveries as the receiving user or as specified in the
41479 It is not necessary to be root to do any of the other things Exim does, such as
41480 receiving messages and delivering them externally over SMTP, and it is
41481 obviously more secure if Exim does not run as root except when necessary.
41482 For this reason, a user and group for Exim to use must be defined in
41483 &_Local/Makefile_&. These are known as &"the Exim user"& and &"the Exim
41484 group"&. Their values can be changed by the runtime configuration, though this
41485 is not recommended. Often a user called &'exim'& is used, but some sites use
41486 &'mail'& or another user name altogether.
41488 Exim uses &[setuid()]& whenever it gives up root privilege. This is a permanent
41489 abdication; the process cannot regain root afterwards. Prior to release 4.00,
41490 &[seteuid()]& was used in some circumstances, but this is no longer the case.
41492 After a new Exim process has interpreted its command line options, it changes
41493 uid and gid in the following cases:
41498 If the &%-C%& option is used to specify an alternate configuration file, or if
41499 the &%-D%& option is used to define macro values for the configuration, and the
41500 calling process is not running as root, the uid and gid are changed to those of
41501 the calling process.
41502 However, if DISABLE_D_OPTION is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, the &%-D%&
41503 option may not be used at all.
41504 If WHITELIST_D_MACROS is defined in &_Local/Makefile_&, then some macro values
41505 can be supplied if the calling process is running as root, the Exim run-time
41506 user or CONFIGURE_OWNER, if defined.
41511 If the expansion test option (&%-be%&) or one of the filter testing options
41512 (&%-bf%& or &%-bF%&) are used, the uid and gid are changed to those of the
41515 If the process is not a daemon process or a queue runner process or a delivery
41516 process or a process for testing address routing (started with &%-bt%&), the
41517 uid and gid are changed to the Exim user and group. This means that Exim always
41518 runs under its own uid and gid when receiving messages. This also applies when
41519 testing address verification
41522 (the &%-bv%& option) and testing incoming message policy controls (the &%-bh%&
41525 For a daemon, queue runner, delivery, or address testing process, the uid
41526 remains as root at this stage, but the gid is changed to the Exim group.
41529 The processes that initially retain root privilege behave as follows:
41532 A daemon process changes the gid to the Exim group and the uid to the Exim
41533 user after setting up one or more listening sockets. The &[initgroups()]&
41534 function is called, so that if the Exim user is in any additional groups, they
41535 will be used during message reception.
41537 A queue runner process retains root privilege throughout its execution. Its
41538 job is to fork a controlled sequence of delivery processes.
41541 A delivery process retains root privilege throughout most of its execution.,
41542 including while the recipient addresses in a message are being routed.
41545 However, if a user's filter file has to be processed,
41546 this is done in a subprocess that runs under the individual user's uid and
41547 gid. A system filter is run as root unless &%system_filter_user%& is set.
41550 Any actual deliveries (that is, the transports themselves) are run in
41551 subprocesses which always change to a non-root uid and gid.
41554 deliveries this is typically the uid and gid of the owner of the mailbox.
41556 For remote deliveries, the Exim uid and gid are used.
41559 Once all the delivery
41560 subprocesses have been run, a delivery process changes to the Exim uid and gid
41561 while doing post-delivery tidying up such as updating the retry database and
41562 generating bounce and warning messages.
41565 A process that is testing addresses (the &%-bt%& option) runs as root so that
41566 the routing is done in the same environment as a message delivery.
41572 .section "Running Exim without privilege" "SECTrunexiwitpri"
41573 .cindex "privilege, running without"
41574 .cindex "unprivileged running"
41575 .cindex "root privilege" "running without"
41576 Some installations like to run Exim in an unprivileged state for more of its
41577 operation, for added security. Support for this mode of operation is provided
41578 by the global option &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. When this is set, the uid and
41579 gid are changed to the Exim user and group at the start of a delivery process
41580 (and also queue runner and address testing processes). This means that address
41581 routing is no longer run as root, and the deliveries themselves cannot change
41585 .cindex "daemon" "restarting"
41586 Leaving the binary setuid to root, but setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%& means
41587 that the daemon can still be started in the usual way, and it can respond
41588 correctly to SIGHUP because the re-invocation regains root privilege.
41590 An alternative approach is to make Exim setuid to the Exim user and also setgid
41591 to the Exim group. If you do this, the daemon must be started from a root
41592 process. (Calling Exim from a root process makes it behave in the way it does
41593 when it is setuid root.) However, the daemon cannot restart itself after a
41594 SIGHUP signal because it cannot regain privilege.
41596 It is still useful to set &%deliver_drop_privilege%& in this case, because it
41597 stops Exim from trying to re-invoke itself to do a delivery after a message has
41598 been received. Such a re-invocation is a waste of resources because it has no
41601 If restarting the daemon is not an issue (for example, if &%mua_wrapper%& is
41602 set, or &'inetd'& is being used instead of a daemon), having the binary setuid
41603 to the Exim user seems a clean approach, but there is one complication:
41605 In this style of operation, Exim is running with the real uid and gid set to
41606 those of the calling process, and the effective uid/gid set to Exim's values.
41607 Ideally, any association with the calling process' uid/gid should be dropped,
41608 that is, the real uid/gid should be reset to the effective values so as to
41609 discard any privileges that the caller may have. While some operating systems
41610 have a function that permits this action for a non-root effective uid, quite a
41611 number of them do not. Because of this lack of standardization, Exim does not
41612 address this problem at this time.
41614 For this reason, the recommended approach for &"mostly unprivileged"& running
41615 is to keep the Exim binary setuid to root, and to set
41616 &%deliver_drop_privilege%&. This also has the advantage of allowing a daemon to
41617 be used in the most straightforward way.
41619 If you configure Exim not to run delivery processes as root, there are a
41620 number of restrictions on what you can do:
41623 You can deliver only as the Exim user/group. You should explicitly use the
41624 &%user%& and &%group%& options to override routers or local transports that
41625 normally deliver as the recipient. This makes sure that configurations that
41626 work in this mode function the same way in normal mode. Any implicit or
41627 explicit specification of another user causes an error.
41629 Use of &_.forward_& files is severely restricted, such that it is usually
41630 not worthwhile to include them in the configuration.
41632 Users who wish to use &_.forward_& would have to make their home directory and
41633 the file itself accessible to the Exim user. Pipe and append-to-file entries,
41634 and their equivalents in Exim filters, cannot be used. While they could be
41635 enabled in the Exim user's name, that would be insecure and not very useful.
41637 Unless the local user mailboxes are all owned by the Exim user (possible in
41638 some POP3 or IMAP-only environments):
41641 They must be owned by the Exim group and be writeable by that group. This
41642 implies you must set &%mode%& in the appendfile configuration, as well as the
41643 mode of the mailbox files themselves.
41645 You must set &%no_check_owner%&, since most or all of the files will not be
41646 owned by the Exim user.
41648 You must set &%file_must_exist%&, because Exim cannot set the owner correctly
41649 on a newly created mailbox when unprivileged. This also implies that new
41650 mailboxes need to be created manually.
41655 These restrictions severely restrict what can be done in local deliveries.
41656 However, there are no restrictions on remote deliveries. If you are running a
41657 gateway host that does no local deliveries, setting &%deliver_drop_privilege%&
41658 gives more security at essentially no cost.
41660 If you are using the &%mua_wrapper%& facility (see chapter
41661 &<<CHAPnonqueueing>>&), &%deliver_drop_privilege%& is forced to be true.
41666 .section "Delivering to local files" "SECID271"
41667 Full details of the checks applied by &(appendfile)& before it writes to a file
41668 are given in chapter &<<CHAPappendfile>>&.
41672 .section "Running local commands" "SECTsecconslocalcmds"
41673 .cindex "security" "local commands"
41674 .cindex "security" "command injection attacks"
41675 There are a number of ways in which an administrator can configure Exim to run
41676 commands based upon received, untrustworthy, data. Further, in some
41677 configurations a user who can control a &_.forward_& file can also arrange to
41678 run commands. Configuration to check includes, but is not limited to:
41681 Use of &%use_shell%& in the pipe transport: various forms of shell command
41682 injection may be possible with this option present. It is dangerous and should
41683 be used only with considerable caution. Consider constraints which whitelist
41684 allowed characters in a variable which is to be used in a pipe transport that
41685 has &%use_shell%& enabled.
41687 A number of options such as &%forbid_filter_run%&, &%forbid_filter_perl%&,
41688 &%forbid_filter_dlfunc%& and so forth which restrict facilities available to
41689 &_.forward_& files in a redirect router. If Exim is running on a central mail
41690 hub to which ordinary users do not have shell access, but home directories are
41691 NFS mounted (for instance) then administrators should review the list of these
41692 forbid options available, and should bear in mind that the options that may
41693 need forbidding can change as new features are added between releases.
41695 The &%${run...}%& expansion item does not use a shell by default, but
41696 administrators can configure use of &_/bin/sh_& as part of the command.
41697 Such invocations should be viewed with prejudicial suspicion.
41699 Administrators who use embedded Perl are advised to explore how Perl's
41700 taint checking might apply to their usage.
41702 Use of &%${expand...}%& is somewhat analogous to shell's eval builtin and
41703 administrators are well advised to view its use with suspicion, in case (for
41704 instance) it allows a local-part to contain embedded Exim directives.
41706 Use of &%${match_local_part...}%& and friends becomes more dangerous if
41707 Exim was built with EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS defined: the second string in
41708 each can reference arbitrary lists and files, rather than just being a list
41710 The EXPAND_LISTMATCH_RHS option was added and set false by default because of
41711 real-world security vulnerabilities caused by its use with untrustworthy data
41712 injected in, for SQL injection attacks.
41713 Consider the use of the &%inlisti%& expansion condition instead.
41719 .section "Trust in configuration data" "SECTsecconfdata"
41720 .cindex "security" "data sources"
41721 .cindex "security" "regular expressions"
41722 .cindex "regular expressions" "security"
41723 .cindex "PCRE2" "security"
41724 If configuration data for Exim can come from untrustworthy sources, there
41725 are some issues to be aware of:
41728 Use of &%${expand...}%& may provide a path for shell injection attacks.
41730 Letting untrusted data provide a regular expression is unwise.
41732 Using &%${match...}%& to apply a fixed regular expression against untrusted
41733 data may result in pathological behaviour within PCRE2. Be aware of what
41734 "backtracking" means and consider options for being more strict with a regular
41735 expression. Avenues to explore include limiting what can match (avoiding &`.`&
41736 when &`[a-z0-9]`& or other character class will do), use of atomic grouping and
41737 possessive quantifiers or just not using regular expressions against untrusted
41740 It can be important to correctly use &%${quote:...}%&,
41741 &%${quote_local_part:...}%& and &%${quote_%&<&'lookup-type'&>&%:...}%& expansion
41742 items to ensure that data is correctly constructed.
41744 Some lookups might return multiple results, even though normal usage is only
41745 expected to yield one result.
41751 .section "IPv4 source routing" "SECID272"
41752 .cindex "source routing" "in IP packets"
41753 .cindex "IP source routing"
41754 Many operating systems suppress IP source-routed packets in the kernel, but
41755 some cannot be made to do this, so Exim does its own check. It logs incoming
41756 IPv4 source-routed TCP calls, and then drops them. Things are all different in
41757 IPv6. No special checking is currently done.
41761 .section "The VRFY, EXPN, and ETRN commands in SMTP" "SECID273"
41762 Support for these SMTP commands is disabled by default. If required, they can
41763 be enabled by defining suitable ACLs.
41768 .section "Privileged users" "SECID274"
41769 .cindex "trusted users"
41770 .cindex "admin user"
41771 .cindex "privileged user"
41772 .cindex "user" "trusted"
41773 .cindex "user" "admin"
41774 Exim recognizes two sets of users with special privileges. Trusted users are
41775 able to submit new messages to Exim locally, but supply their own sender
41776 addresses and information about a sending host. For other users submitting
41777 local messages, Exim sets up the sender address from the uid, and doesn't
41778 permit a remote host to be specified.
41781 However, an untrusted user is permitted to use the &%-f%& command line option
41782 in the special form &%-f <>%& to indicate that a delivery failure for the
41783 message should not cause an error report. This affects the message's envelope,
41784 but it does not affect the &'Sender:'& header. Untrusted users may also be
41785 permitted to use specific forms of address with the &%-f%& option by setting
41786 the &%untrusted_set_sender%& option.
41788 Trusted users are used to run processes that receive mail messages from some
41789 other mail domain and pass them on to Exim for delivery either locally, or over
41790 the Internet. Exim trusts a caller that is running as root, as the Exim user,
41791 as any user listed in the &%trusted_users%& configuration option, or under any
41792 group listed in the &%trusted_groups%& option.
41794 Admin users are permitted to do things to the messages on Exim's queue. They
41795 can freeze or thaw messages, cause them to be returned to their senders, remove
41796 them entirely, or modify them in various ways. In addition, admin users can run
41797 the Exim monitor and see all the information it is capable of providing, which
41798 includes the contents of files on the spool.
41802 By default, the use of the &%-M%& and &%-q%& options to cause Exim to attempt
41803 delivery of messages on its queue is restricted to admin users. This
41804 restriction can be relaxed by setting the &%no_prod_requires_admin%& option.
41805 Similarly, the use of &%-bp%& (and its variants) to list the contents of the
41806 queue is also restricted to admin users. This restriction can be relaxed by
41807 setting &%no_queue_list_requires_admin%&.
41809 Exim recognizes an admin user if the calling process is running as root or as
41810 the Exim user or if any of the groups associated with the calling process is
41811 the Exim group. It is not necessary actually to be running under the Exim
41812 group. However, if admin users who are not root or the Exim user are to access
41813 the contents of files on the spool via the Exim monitor (which runs
41814 unprivileged), Exim must be built to allow group read access to its spool
41817 By default, regular users are trusted to perform basic testing and
41818 introspection commands, as themselves. This setting can be tightened by
41819 setting the &%commandline_checks_require_admin%& option.
41820 This affects most of the checking options,
41821 such as &%-be%& and anything else &%-b*%&.
41824 .section "Spool files" "SECID275"
41825 .cindex "spool directory" "files"
41826 Exim's spool directory and everything it contains is owned by the Exim user and
41827 set to the Exim group. The mode for spool files is defined in the
41828 &_Local/Makefile_& configuration file, and defaults to 0640. This means that
41829 any user who is a member of the Exim group can access these files.
41833 .section "Use of argv[0]" "SECID276"
41834 Exim examines the last component of &%argv[0]%&, and if it matches one of a set
41835 of specific strings, Exim assumes certain options. For example, calling Exim
41836 with the last component of &%argv[0]%& set to &"rsmtp"& is exactly equivalent
41837 to calling it with the option &%-bS%&. There are no security implications in
41842 .section "Use of %f formatting" "SECID277"
41843 The only use made of &"%f"& by Exim is in formatting load average values. These
41844 are actually stored in integer variables as 1000 times the load average.
41845 Consequently, their range is limited and so therefore is the length of the
41850 .section "Embedded Exim path" "SECID278"
41851 Exim uses its own path name, which is embedded in the code, only when it needs
41852 to re-exec in order to regain root privilege. Therefore, it is not root when it
41853 does so. If some bug allowed the path to get overwritten, it would lead to an
41854 arbitrary program's being run as exim, not as root.
41858 .section "Dynamic module directory" "SECTdynmoddir"
41859 Any dynamically loadable modules must be installed into the directory
41860 defined in &`LOOKUP_MODULE_DIR`& in &_Local/Makefile_& for Exim to permit
41864 .section "Use of sprintf()" "SECID279"
41865 .cindex "&[sprintf()]&"
41866 A large number of occurrences of &"sprintf"& in the code are actually calls to
41867 &'string_sprintf()'&, a function that returns the result in malloc'd store.
41868 The intermediate formatting is done into a large fixed buffer by a function
41869 that runs through the format string itself, and checks the length of each
41870 conversion before performing it, thus preventing buffer overruns.
41872 The remaining uses of &[sprintf()]& happen in controlled circumstances where
41873 the output buffer is known to be sufficiently long to contain the converted
41878 .section "Use of debug_printf() and log_write()" "SECID280"
41879 Arbitrary strings are passed to both these functions, but they do their
41880 formatting by calling the function &'string_vformat()'&, which runs through
41881 the format string itself, and checks the length of each conversion.
41885 .section "Use of strcat() and strcpy()" "SECID281"
41886 These are used only in cases where the output buffer is known to be large
41887 enough to hold the result.
41888 .ecindex IIDsecurcon
41893 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41894 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
41896 .chapter "Format of spool files" "CHAPspool"
41897 .scindex IIDforspo1 "format" "spool files"
41898 .scindex IIDforspo2 "spool directory" "format of files"
41899 .scindex IIDforspo3 "spool files" "format of"
41900 .cindex "spool files" "editing"
41901 A message on Exim's queue consists of two files, whose names are the message id
41902 followed by -D and -H, respectively. The data portion of the message is kept in
41903 the -D file on its own. The message's envelope, status, and headers are all
41904 kept in the -H file, whose format is described in this chapter. Each of these
41905 two files contains the final component of its own name as its first line. This
41906 is insurance against disk crashes where the directory is lost but the files
41907 themselves are recoverable.
41909 The file formats may be changed, or new formats added, at any release.
41910 Spool files are not intended as an interface to other programs
41911 and should not be used as such.
41913 Some people are tempted into editing -D files in order to modify messages. You
41914 need to be extremely careful if you do this; it is not recommended and you are
41915 on your own if you do it. Here are some of the pitfalls:
41918 You must ensure that Exim does not try to deliver the message while you are
41919 fiddling with it. The safest way is to take out a write lock on the -D file,
41920 which is what Exim itself does, using &[fcntl()]&. If you update the file in
41921 place, the lock will be retained. If you write a new file and rename it, the
41922 lock will be lost at the instant of rename.
41924 .vindex "&$body_linecount$&"
41925 If you change the number of lines in the file, the value of
41926 &$body_linecount$&, which is stored in the -H file, will be incorrect and can
41927 cause incomplete transmission of messages or undeliverable messages.
41929 If the message is in MIME format, you must take care not to break it.
41931 If the message is cryptographically signed, any change will invalidate the
41934 All in all, modifying -D files is fraught with danger.
41936 Files whose names end with -J may also be seen in the &_input_& directory (or
41937 its subdirectories when &%split_spool_directory%& is set). These are journal
41938 files, used to record addresses to which the message has been delivered during
41939 the course of a delivery attempt. If there are still undelivered recipients at
41940 the end, the -H file is updated, and the -J file is deleted. If, however, there
41941 is some kind of crash (for example, a power outage) before this happens, the -J
41942 file remains in existence. When Exim next processes the message, it notices the
41943 -J file and uses it to update the -H file before starting the next delivery
41946 Files whose names end with -K or .eml may also be seen in the spool.
41947 These are temporaries used for DKIM or malware processing, when that is used.
41948 They should be tidied up by normal operations; any old ones are probably
41949 relics of crashes and can be removed.
41951 .section "Format of the -H file" "SECID282"
41952 .cindex "uid (user id)" "in spool file"
41953 .cindex "gid (group id)" "in spool file"
41954 The second line of the -H file contains the login name for the uid of the
41955 process that called Exim to read the message, followed by the numerical uid and
41956 gid. For a locally generated message, this is normally the user who sent the
41957 message. For a message received over TCP/IP via the daemon, it is
41958 normally the Exim user.
41960 The third line of the file contains the address of the message's sender as
41961 transmitted in the envelope, contained in angle brackets. The sender address is
41962 empty for bounce messages. For incoming SMTP mail, the sender address is given
41963 in the MAIL command. For locally generated mail, the sender address is
41964 created by Exim from the login name of the current user and the configured
41965 &%qualify_domain%&. However, this can be overridden by the &%-f%& option or a
41966 leading &"From&~"& line if the caller is trusted, or if the supplied address is
41967 &"<>"& or an address that matches &%untrusted_set_senders%&.
41969 The fourth line contains two numbers. The first is the time that the message
41970 was received, in the conventional Unix form &-- the number of seconds since the
41971 start of the epoch. The second number is a count of the number of messages
41972 warning of delayed delivery that have been sent to the sender.
41974 There follow a number of lines starting with a hyphen.
41975 These contain variables, can appear in any
41976 order, and are omitted when not relevant.
41978 If there is a second hyphen after the first,
41979 the corresponding data is tainted.
41980 If there is a value in parentheses, the data is quoted for a lookup.
41982 The following word specifies a variable,
41983 and the remainder of the item depends on the variable.
41986 .vitem "&%-acl%&&~<&'number'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41987 This item is obsolete, and is not generated from Exim release 4.61 onwards;
41988 &%-aclc%& and &%-aclm%& are used instead. However, &%-acl%& is still
41989 recognized, to provide backward compatibility. In the old format, a line of
41990 this form is present for every ACL variable that is not empty. The number
41991 identifies the variable; the &%acl_c%&&*x*& variables are numbered 0&--9 and
41992 the &%acl_m%&&*x*& variables are numbered 10&--19. The length is the length of
41993 the data string for the variable. The string itself starts at the beginning of
41994 the next line, and is followed by a newline character. It may contain internal
41997 .vitem "&%-aclc%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
41998 A line of this form is present for every ACL connection variable that is
41999 defined. Note that there is a space between &%-aclc%& and the rest of the name.
42000 The length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
42001 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
42002 character. It may contain internal newlines.
42004 .vitem "&%-aclm%&&~<&'rest-of-name'&>&~<&'length'&>"
42005 A line of this form is present for every ACL message variable that is defined.
42006 Note that there is a space between &%-aclm%& and the rest of the name. The
42007 length is the length of the data string for the variable. The string itself
42008 starts at the beginning of the next line, and is followed by a newline
42009 character. It may contain internal newlines.
42011 .vitem "&%-active_hostname%&&~<&'hostname'&>"
42012 This is present if, when the message was received over SMTP, the value of
42013 &$smtp_active_hostname$& was different to the value of &$primary_hostname$&.
42015 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_recipient%&
42016 This is present if unqualified recipient addresses are permitted in header
42017 lines (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at
42018 transport time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote
42019 messages from hosts that match &%recipient_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
42021 .vitem &%-allow_unqualified_sender%&
42022 This is present if unqualified sender addresses are permitted in header lines
42023 (to stop such addresses from being qualified if rewriting occurs at transport
42024 time). Local messages that were input using &%-bnq%& and remote messages from
42025 hosts that match &%sender_unqualified_hosts%& set this flag.
42027 .vitem "&%-auth_id%&&~<&'text'&>"
42028 The id information for a message received on an authenticated SMTP connection
42029 &-- the value of the &$authenticated_id$& variable.
42031 .vitem "&%-auth_sender%&&~<&'address'&>"
42032 The address of an authenticated sender &-- the value of the
42033 &$authenticated_sender$& variable.
42035 .vitem "&%-body_linecount%&&~<&'number'&>"
42036 This records the number of lines in the body of the message, and is
42037 present unless &%-spool_file_wireformat%& is.
42039 .vitem "&%-body_zerocount%&&~<&'number'&>"
42040 This records the number of binary zero bytes in the body of the message, and is
42041 present if the number is greater than zero.
42043 .vitem &%-deliver_firsttime%&
42044 This is written when a new message is first added to the spool. When the spool
42045 file is updated after a deferral, it is omitted.
42047 .vitem "&%-frozen%&&~<&'time'&>"
42048 .cindex "frozen messages" "spool data"
42049 The message is frozen, and the freezing happened at <&'time'&>.
42051 .vitem "&%-helo_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
42052 This records the host name as specified by a remote host in a HELO or EHLO
42055 .vitem "&%-host_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
42056 This records the IP address of the host from which the message was received and
42057 the remote port number that was used. It is omitted for locally generated
42060 .vitem "&%-host_auth%&&~<&'text'&>"
42061 If the message was received on an authenticated SMTP connection, this records
42062 the name of the authenticator &-- the value of the
42063 &$sender_host_authenticated$& variable.
42065 .vitem &%-host_lookup_failed%&
42066 This is present if an attempt to look up the sending host's name from its IP
42067 address failed. It corresponds to the &$host_lookup_failed$& variable.
42069 .vitem "&%-host_name%&&~<&'text'&>"
42070 .cindex "reverse DNS lookup"
42071 .cindex "DNS" "reverse lookup"
42072 This records the name of the remote host from which the message was received,
42073 if the host name was looked up from the IP address when the message was being
42074 received. It is not present if no reverse lookup was done.
42076 .vitem "&%-ident%&&~<&'text'&>"
42077 For locally submitted messages, this records the login of the originating user,
42078 unless it was a trusted user and the &%-oMt%& option was used to specify an
42079 ident value. For messages received over TCP/IP, this records the ident string
42080 supplied by the remote host, if any.
42082 .vitem "&%-interface_address%&&~<&'address'&>.<&'port'&>"
42083 This records the IP address of the local interface and the port number through
42084 which a message was received from a remote host. It is omitted for locally
42085 generated messages.
42088 The message is from a local sender.
42090 .vitem &%-localerror%&
42091 The message is a locally-generated bounce message.
42093 .vitem "&%-local_scan%&&~<&'string'&>"
42094 This records the data string that was returned by the &[local_scan()]& function
42095 when the message was received &-- the value of the &$local_scan_data$&
42096 variable. It is omitted if no data was returned.
42098 .vitem &%-manual_thaw%&
42099 The message was frozen but has been thawed manually, that is, by an explicit
42100 Exim command rather than via the auto-thaw process.
42103 A testing delivery process was started using the &%-N%& option to suppress any
42104 actual deliveries, but delivery was deferred. At any further delivery attempts,
42107 .vitem &%-received_protocol%&
42108 This records the value of the &$received_protocol$& variable, which contains
42109 the name of the protocol by which the message was received.
42111 .vitem &%-sender_set_untrusted%&
42112 The envelope sender of this message was set by an untrusted local caller (used
42113 to ensure that the caller is displayed in queue listings).
42115 .vitem "&%-spam_score_int%&&~<&'number'&>"
42116 If a message was scanned by SpamAssassin, this is present. It records the value
42117 of &$spam_score_int$&.
42119 .vitem &%-spool_file_wireformat%&
42120 The -D file for this message is in wire-format (for ESMTP CHUNKING)
42121 rather than Unix-format.
42122 The line-ending is CRLF rather than newline.
42123 There is still, however, no leading-dot-stuffing.
42125 .vitem &%-tls_certificate_verified%&
42126 A TLS certificate was received from the client that sent this message, and the
42127 certificate was verified by the server.
42129 .vitem "&%-tls_cipher%&&~<&'cipher name'&>"
42130 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, this records the
42131 name of the cipher suite that was used.
42133 .vitem "&%-tls_peerdn%&&~<&'peer DN'&>"
42134 When the message was received over an encrypted connection, and a certificate
42135 was received from the client, this records the Distinguished Name from that
42139 Following the options there is a list of those addresses to which the message
42140 is not to be delivered. This set of addresses is initialized from the command
42141 line when the &%-t%& option is used and &%extract_addresses_remove_arguments%&
42142 is set; otherwise it starts out empty. Whenever a successful delivery is made,
42143 the address is added to this set. The addresses are kept internally as a
42144 balanced binary tree, and it is a representation of that tree which is written
42145 to the spool file. If an address is expanded via an alias or forward file, the
42146 original address is added to the tree when deliveries to all its child
42147 addresses are complete.
42149 If the tree is empty, there is a single line in the spool file containing just
42150 the text &"XX"&. Otherwise, each line consists of two letters, which are either
42151 Y or N, followed by an address. The address is the value for the node of the
42152 tree, and the letters indicate whether the node has a left branch and/or a
42153 right branch attached to it, respectively. If branches exist, they immediately
42154 follow. Here is an example of a three-node tree:
42156 YY darcy@austen.fict.example
42157 NN alice@wonderland.fict.example
42158 NN editor@thesaurus.ref.example
42160 After the non-recipients tree, there is a list of the message's recipients.
42161 This is a simple list, preceded by a count. It includes all the original
42162 recipients of the message, including those to whom the message has already been
42163 delivered. In the simplest case, the list contains one address per line. For
42167 editor@thesaurus.ref.example
42168 darcy@austen.fict.example
42170 alice@wonderland.fict.example
42172 However, when a child address has been added to the top-level addresses as a
42173 result of the use of the &%one_time%& option on a &(redirect)& router, each
42174 line is of the following form:
42176 <&'top-level address'&> <&'errors_to address'&> &&&
42177 <&'length'&>,<&'parent number'&>#<&'flag bits'&>
42179 The 01 flag bit indicates the presence of the three other fields that follow
42180 the top-level address. Other bits may be used in future to support additional
42181 fields. The <&'parent number'&> is the offset in the recipients list of the
42182 original parent of the &"one time"& address. The first two fields are the
42183 envelope sender that is associated with this address and its length. If the
42184 length is zero, there is no special envelope sender (there are then two space
42185 characters in the line). A non-empty field can arise from a &(redirect)& router
42186 that has an &%errors_to%& setting.
42189 A blank line separates the envelope and status information from the headers
42190 which follow. A header may occupy several lines of the file, and to save effort
42191 when reading it in, each header is preceded by a number and an identifying
42192 character. The number is the number of characters in the header, including any
42193 embedded newlines and the terminating newline. The character is one of the
42197 .row <&'blank'&> "header in which Exim has no special interest"
42198 .row &`B`& "&'Bcc:'& header"
42199 .row &`C`& "&'Cc:'& header"
42200 .row &`F`& "&'From:'& header"
42201 .row &`I`& "&'Message-id:'& header"
42202 .row &`P`& "&'Received:'& header &-- P for &""postmark""&"
42203 .row &`R`& "&'Reply-To:'& header"
42204 .row &`S`& "&'Sender:'& header"
42205 .row &`T`& "&'To:'& header"
42206 .row &`*`& "replaced or deleted header"
42209 Deleted or replaced (rewritten) headers remain in the spool file for debugging
42210 purposes. They are not transmitted when the message is delivered. Here is a
42211 typical set of headers:
42213 111P Received: by hobbit.fict.example with local (Exim 4.00)
42214 id 14y9EI-00026G-00; Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
42215 049 Message-Id: <E14y9EI-00026G-00@hobbit.fict.example>
42216 038* X-rewrote-sender: bb@hobbit.fict.example
42217 042* From: Bilbo Baggins <bb@hobbit.fict.example>
42218 049F From: Bilbo Baggins <B.Baggins@hobbit.fict.example>
42219 099* To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation,
42220 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
42221 104T To: alice@wonderland.fict.example, rdo@foundation.example,
42222 darcy@austen.fict.example, editor@thesaurus.ref.example
42223 038 Date: Fri, 11 May 2001 10:28:59 +0100
42225 The asterisked headers indicate that the envelope sender, &'From:'& header, and
42226 &'To:'& header have been rewritten, the last one because routing expanded the
42227 unqualified domain &'foundation'&.
42228 .ecindex IIDforspo1
42229 .ecindex IIDforspo2
42230 .ecindex IIDforspo3
42232 .section "Format of the -D file" "SECID282a"
42233 The data file is traditionally in Unix-standard format: lines are ended with
42234 an ASCII newline character.
42235 However, when the &%spool_wireformat%& main option is used some -D files
42236 can have an alternate format.
42237 This is flagged by a &%-spool_file_wireformat%& line in the corresponding -H file.
42238 The -D file lines (not including the first name-component line) are
42239 suitable for direct copying to the wire when transmitting using the
42240 ESMTP CHUNKING option, meaning lower processing overhead.
42241 Lines are terminated with an ASCII CRLF pair.
42242 There is no dot-stuffing (and no dot-termination).
42244 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42245 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
42247 .chapter "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC" "CHAPdkim" &&&
42248 "DKIM, SPF, SRS and DMARC Support"
42250 .section "DKIM (DomainKeys Identified Mail)" SECDKIM
42253 DKIM is a mechanism by which messages sent by some entity can be provably
42254 linked to a domain which that entity controls. It permits reputation to
42255 be tracked on a per-domain basis, rather than merely upon source IP address.
42256 DKIM is documented in &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376).
42258 As DKIM relies on the message being unchanged in transit, messages handled
42259 by a mailing-list (which traditionally adds to the message) will not match
42260 any original DKIM signature.
42262 DKIM support is compiled into Exim by default if TLS support is present.
42263 It can be disabled by setting DISABLE_DKIM=yes in &_Local/Makefile_&.
42265 Exim's DKIM implementation allows for
42267 Signing outgoing messages: This function is implemented in the SMTP transport.
42268 It can co-exist with all other Exim features
42269 (including transport filters) except cutthrough delivery.
42270 However, signing options may not depend on headers modified by
42271 routers, the transport or a transport filter.
42273 Verifying signatures in incoming messages: This is implemented by an additional
42274 ACL (acl_smtp_dkim), which can be called several times per message, with
42275 different signature contexts.
42278 In typical Exim style, the verification implementation does not include any
42279 default "policy". Instead it enables you to build your own policy using
42280 Exim's standard controls.
42282 Please note that verification of DKIM signatures in incoming mail is turned
42283 on by default for logging (in the <= line) purposes.
42285 Additional log detail can be enabled using the &%dkim_verbose%& log_selector.
42286 When set, for each signature in incoming email,
42287 exim will log a line displaying the most important signature details, and the
42288 signature status. Here is an example (with line-breaks added for clarity):
42290 2009-09-09 10:22:28 1MlIRf-0003LU-U3 DKIM:
42291 d=facebookmail.com s=q1-2009b
42292 c=relaxed/relaxed a=rsa-sha1
42293 i=@facebookmail.com t=1252484542 [verification succeeded]
42296 You might want to turn off DKIM verification processing entirely for internal
42297 or relay mail sources. To do that, set the &%dkim_disable_verify%& ACL
42298 control modifier. This should typically be done in the RCPT ACL, at points
42299 where you accept mail from relay sources (internal hosts or authenticated
42303 .subsection "Signing outgoing messages" SECDKIMSIGN
42304 .cindex DKIM signing
42306 For signing to be usable you must have published a DKIM record in DNS.
42307 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301)
42308 (which does not cover EC keys) says:
42310 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42312 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
42313 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
42316 Note also that the key content (the 'p=' field)
42317 in the DNS record is different between RSA and EC keys;
42318 for the former it is the base64 of the ASN.1 for the RSA public key
42319 (equivalent to the private-key .pem with the header/trailer stripped)
42320 but for EC keys it is the base64 of the pure key; no ASN.1 wrapping.
42322 Signing is enabled by setting private options on the SMTP transport.
42323 These options take (expandable) strings as arguments.
42325 .option dkim_domain smtp "string list&!!" unset
42326 The domain(s) you want to sign with.
42327 After expansion, this can be a list.
42328 Each element in turn,
42330 .vindex "&$dkim_domain$&"
42331 is put into the &%$dkim_domain%& expansion variable
42332 while expanding the remaining signing options.
42333 If it is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done,
42334 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
42336 .option dkim_selector smtp "string list&!!" unset
42337 This sets the key selector string.
42338 After expansion, which can use &$dkim_domain$&, this can be a list.
42339 Each element in turn is put in the expansion
42340 .vindex "&$dkim_selector$&"
42341 variable &%$dkim_selector%& which may be used in the &%dkim_private_key%&
42342 option along with &%$dkim_domain%&.
42343 If the option is empty after expansion, DKIM signing is not done for this domain,
42344 and no error will result even if &%dkim_strict%& is set.
42346 To do, for example, dual-signing with RSA and EC keys
42347 this could be be used:
42349 dkim_selector = ec_sel : rsa_sel
42350 dkim_private_key = KEYS_DIR/$dkim_selector
42353 .option dkim_private_key smtp string&!! unset
42354 This sets the private key to use.
42355 You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and
42356 &%$dkim_selector%& expansion variables to determine the private key to use.
42357 The result can either
42359 be a valid RSA private key in ASCII armor (.pem file), including line breaks
42361 with GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
42362 be a valid Ed25519 private key (same format as above)
42364 start with a slash, in which case it is treated as a file that contains
42367 be "0", "false" or the empty string, in which case the message will not
42368 be signed. This case will not result in an error, even if &%dkim_strict%&
42372 To generate keys under OpenSSL:
42374 openssl genrsa -out dkim_rsa.private 2048
42375 openssl rsa -in dkim_rsa.private -out /dev/stdout -pubout -outform PEM
42377 The result file from the first command should be retained,
42378 permissions set so that Exim can read it,
42379 and this option set to use it.
42380 Take the base-64 lines from the output of the second command, concatenated,
42381 for the DNS TXT record.
42382 See section 3.6 of &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376)
42383 for the record specification.
42387 certtool --generate-privkey --rsa --bits=2048 --password='' -8 --outfile=dkim_rsa.private
42388 certtool --load-privkey=dkim_rsa.private --pubkey-info
42391 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42393 Signers MUST use RSA keys of at least 1024 bits for all keys.
42394 Signers SHOULD use RSA keys of at least 2048 bits.
42397 EC keys for DKIM are defined by
42398 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8463,RFC 8463).
42399 They are considerably smaller than RSA keys for equivalent protection.
42400 As they are a recent development, users should consider dual-signing
42401 (by setting a list of selectors, and an expansion for this option)
42402 for some transition period.
42403 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
42406 OpenSSL 1.1.1 and GnuTLS 3.6.0 can create Ed25519 private keys:
42408 openssl genpkey -algorithm ed25519 -out dkim_ed25519.private
42409 certtool --generate-privkey --key-type=ed25519 --outfile=dkim_ed25519.private
42412 To produce the required public key value for a DNS record:
42414 openssl pkey -outform DER -pubout -in dkim_ed25519.private | tail -c +13 | base64
42415 certtool --load_privkey=dkim_ed25519.private --pubkey_info --outder | tail -c +13 | base64
42418 Exim also supports an alternate format
42419 of Ed25519 keys in DNS which was a candidate during development
42420 of the standard, but not adopted.
42421 A future release will probably drop that support.
42423 .option dkim_hash smtp string&!! sha256
42424 Can be set to any one of the supported hash methods, which are:
42426 &`sha1`& &-- should not be used, is old and insecure
42428 &`sha256`& &-- the default
42430 &`sha512`& &-- possibly more secure but less well supported
42433 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42435 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42438 .option dkim_identity smtp string&!! unset
42439 If set after expansion, the value is used to set an "i=" tag in
42440 the signing header. The DKIM standards restrict the permissible
42441 syntax of this optional tag to a mail address, with possibly-empty
42442 local part, an @, and a domain identical to or subdomain of the "d="
42443 tag value. Note that Exim does not check the value.
42445 .option dkim_canon smtp string&!! unset
42446 This option sets the canonicalization method used when signing a message.
42447 The DKIM RFC currently supports two methods: "simple" and "relaxed".
42448 The option defaults to "relaxed" when unset. Note: the current implementation
42449 only supports signing with the same canonicalization method for both headers and body.
42451 .option dkim_strict smtp string&!! unset
42452 This option defines how Exim behaves when signing a message that
42453 should be signed fails for some reason. When the expansion evaluates to
42454 either &"1"& or &"true"&, Exim will defer. Otherwise Exim will send the message
42455 unsigned. You can use the &%$dkim_domain%& and &%$dkim_selector%& expansion
42458 .option dkim_sign_headers smtp string&!! "see below"
42459 If set, this option must expand to a colon-separated
42460 list of header names.
42461 Headers with these names, or the absence of such a header, will be included
42462 in the message signature.
42463 When unspecified, the header names listed in
42464 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc4871,RFC 4871) will be used,
42465 whether or not each header is present in the message.
42466 The default list is available for the expansion in the macro
42467 &"_DKIM_SIGN_HEADERS"&
42468 and an oversigning variant is in &"_DKIM_OVERSIGN_HEADERS"&.
42470 If a name is repeated, multiple headers by that name (or the absence thereof)
42471 will be signed. The textually later headers in the headers part of the
42472 message are signed first, if there are multiples.
42474 A name can be prefixed with either an &"="& or a &"+"& character.
42475 If an &"="& prefix is used, all headers that are present with this name
42477 If a &"+"& prefix if used, all headers that are present with this name
42478 will be signed, and one signature added for a missing header with the
42479 name will be appended.
42481 .option dkim_timestamps smtp integer&!! unset
42482 This option controls the inclusion of timestamp information in the signature.
42483 If not set, no such information will be included.
42484 Otherwise, must be an unsigned number giving an offset in seconds from the
42485 current time for the expiry tag (e.g. 1209600 for two weeks); both creation
42486 (t=) and expiry (x=) tags will be included unless the offset is 0 (no expiry).
42488 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376)
42489 lists these tags as RECOMMENDED.
42492 .subsection "Verifying DKIM signatures in incoming mail" SECDKIMVFY
42493 .cindex DKIM verification
42495 Verification of DKIM signatures in SMTP incoming email is done for all
42496 messages for which an ACL control &%dkim_disable_verify%& has not been set.
42498 .cindex DKIM "selecting signature algorithms"
42499 Individual classes of DKIM signature algorithm can be ignored by changing
42500 the main options &%dkim_verify_hashes%& or &%dkim_verify_keytypes%&.
42501 The &%dkim_verify_minimal%& option can be set to cease verification
42502 processing for a message once the first passing signature is found.
42504 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
42505 Performing verification sets up information used by the
42506 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42508 For most purposes the default option settings suffice and the remainder
42509 of this section can be ignored.
42511 The results of verification are made available to the
42512 &%acl_smtp_dkim%& ACL, which (for complex needs) can examine and modify them.
42513 A missing ACL definition defaults to accept.
42514 By default, the ACL is called once for each
42515 syntactically(!) correct signature in the incoming message.
42516 If any ACL call does not accept, the message is not accepted.
42517 If a cutthrough delivery was in progress for the message, that is
42518 summarily dropped (having wasted the transmission effort).
42520 To evaluate the verification result in the ACL
42521 a large number of expansion variables
42522 containing the signature status and its details are set up during the
42523 runtime of the ACL.
42525 Calling the ACL only for existing signatures is not sufficient to build
42526 more advanced policies. For that reason, the main option
42527 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, and an expansion variable
42528 &%$dkim_signers%& exist.
42530 The main option &%dkim_verify_signers%& can be set to a colon-separated
42531 list of DKIM domains or identities for which the ACL &%acl_smtp_dkim%& is
42532 called. It is expanded when the message has been received. At this point,
42533 the expansion variable &%$dkim_signers%& already contains a colon-separated
42534 list of signer domains and identities for the message. When
42535 &%dkim_verify_signers%& is not specified in the main configuration,
42538 dkim_verify_signers = $dkim_signers
42540 This leads to the default behaviour of calling &%acl_smtp_dkim%& for each
42541 DKIM signature in the message. Current DKIM verifiers may want to explicitly
42542 call the ACL for known domains or identities. This would be achieved as follows:
42544 dkim_verify_signers = paypal.com:ebay.com:$dkim_signers
42546 This would result in &%acl_smtp_dkim%& always being called for "paypal.com"
42547 and "ebay.com", plus all domains and identities that have signatures in the message.
42548 You can also be more creative in constructing your policy. For example:
42550 dkim_verify_signers = $sender_address_domain:$dkim_signers
42553 If a domain or identity is listed several times in the (expanded) value of
42554 &%dkim_verify_signers%&, the ACL is only called once for that domain or identity.
42556 Note that if the option is set using untrustworthy data
42557 (such as the From: header)
42558 care should be taken to force lowercase for domains
42559 and for the domain part if identities.
42560 The default setting can be regarded as trustworthy in this respect.
42562 If multiple signatures match a domain (or identity), the ACL is called once
42563 for each matching signature.
42566 Inside the DKIM ACL, the following expansion variables are
42567 available (from most to least important):
42571 .vitem &%$dkim_cur_signer%&
42572 The signer that is being evaluated in this ACL run. This can be a domain or
42573 an identity. This is one of the list items from the expanded main option
42574 &%dkim_verify_signers%& (see above).
42576 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_status%&
42577 So long as a DKIM ACL is defined
42578 (it need do no more than accept, which is the default),
42579 after all the DKIM ACL runs have completed, the value becomes a
42580 colon-separated list of the values after each run.
42581 The value is maintained for the MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42583 Within the DKIM ACL,
42584 a string describing the general status of the signature. One of
42586 &%none%&: There is no signature in the message for the current domain or
42587 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42589 &%invalid%&: The signature could not be verified due to a processing error.
42590 More detail is available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
42592 &%fail%&: Verification of the signature failed. More detail is
42593 available in &%$dkim_verify_reason%&.
42595 &%pass%&: The signature passed verification. It is valid.
42598 This variable can be overwritten using an ACL 'set' modifier.
42599 This might, for instance, be done to enforce a policy restriction on
42600 hash-method or key-size:
42602 warn condition = ${if eq {$dkim_verify_status}{pass}}
42603 condition = ${if eq {${length_3:$dkim_algo}}{rsa}}
42604 condition = ${if or {{eq {$dkim_algo}{rsa-sha1}} \
42605 {< {$dkim_key_length}{1024}}}}
42606 logwrite = NOTE: forcing DKIM verify fail (was pass)
42607 set dkim_verify_status = fail
42608 set dkim_verify_reason = hash too weak or key too short
42611 .vitem &%$dkim_verify_reason%&
42612 A string giving a little bit more detail when &%$dkim_verify_status%& is either
42613 "fail" or "invalid". One of
42615 &%pubkey_unavailable%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public
42616 key for the domain could not be retrieved. This may be a temporary problem.
42618 &%pubkey_syntax%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="invalid"): The public key
42619 record for the domain is syntactically invalid.
42621 &%bodyhash_mismatch%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The calculated
42622 body hash does not match the one specified in the signature header. This
42623 means that the message body was modified in transit.
42625 &%signature_incorrect%& (when &%$dkim_verify_status%&="fail"): The signature
42626 could not be verified. This may mean that headers were modified,
42627 re-written or otherwise changed in a way which is incompatible with
42628 DKIM verification. It may of course also mean that the signature is forged.
42631 This variable can be overwritten, with any value, using an ACL 'set' modifier.
42633 .vitem &%$dkim_domain%&
42634 The signing domain. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated if there is
42635 an actual signature in the message for the current domain or identity (as
42636 reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42638 .vitem &%$dkim_identity%&
42639 The signing identity, if present. IMPORTANT: This variable is only populated
42640 if there is an actual signature in the message for the current domain or
42641 identity (as reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42643 .vitem &%$dkim_selector%&
42644 The key record selector string.
42646 .vitem &%$dkim_algo%&
42647 The algorithm used. One of 'rsa-sha1' or 'rsa-sha256'.
42648 If running under GnuTLS 3.6.0 or OpenSSL 1.1.1 or later,
42649 may also be 'ed25519-sha256'.
42650 The "_CRYPTO_SIGN_ED25519" macro will be defined if support is present
42653 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42655 rsa-sha1 MUST NOT be used for signing or verifying.
42657 DKIM signatures identified as having been signed with historic
42658 algorithms (currently, rsa-sha1) have permanently failed evaluation
42661 To enforce this you must either have a DKIM ACL which checks this variable
42662 and overwrites the &$dkim_verify_status$& variable as discussed above,
42663 or have set the main option &%dkim_verify_hashes%& to exclude
42664 processing of such signatures.
42666 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_body%&
42667 The body canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42669 .vitem &%$dkim_canon_headers%&
42670 The header canonicalization method. One of 'relaxed' or 'simple'.
42672 .vitem &%$dkim_copiedheaders%&
42673 A transcript of headers and their values which are included in the signature
42674 (copied from the 'z=' tag of the signature).
42675 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6376,RFC 6376)
42676 requires that verification fail if the From: header is
42677 not included in the signature. Exim does not enforce this; sites wishing
42678 strict enforcement should code the check explicitly.
42680 .vitem &%$dkim_bodylength%&
42681 The number of signed body bytes. If zero ("0"), the body is unsigned. If no
42682 limit was set by the signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes sure
42683 that this variable always expands to an integer value.
42684 &*Note:*& The presence of the signature tag specifying a signing body length
42685 is one possible route to spoofing of valid DKIM signatures.
42686 A paranoid implementation might wish to regard signature where this variable
42687 shows less than the "no limit" return as being invalid.
42689 .vitem &%$dkim_created%&
42690 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signature was created.
42691 When this was not specified by the signer, "0" is returned.
42693 .vitem &%$dkim_expires%&
42694 UNIX timestamp reflecting the date and time when the signer wants the
42695 signature to be treated as "expired". When this was not specified by the
42696 signer, "9999999999999" is returned. This makes it possible to do useful
42697 integer size comparisons against this value.
42698 Note that Exim does not check this value.
42700 .vitem &%$dkim_headernames%&
42701 A colon-separated list of names of headers included in the signature.
42703 .vitem &%$dkim_key_testing%&
42704 "1" if the key record has the "testing" flag set, "0" if not.
42706 .vitem &%$dkim_key_nosubdomains%&
42707 "1" if the key record forbids subdomaining, "0" otherwise.
42709 .vitem &%$dkim_key_srvtype%&
42710 Service type (tag s=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42713 .vitem &%$dkim_key_granularity%&
42714 Key granularity (tag g=) from the key record. Defaults to "*" if not specified
42717 .vitem &%$dkim_key_notes%&
42718 Notes from the key record (tag n=).
42720 .vitem &%$dkim_key_length%&
42721 Number of bits in the key.
42722 Valid only once the key is loaded, which is at the time the header signature
42723 is verified, which is after the body hash is.
42725 Note that &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc8301,RFC 8301) says:
42727 Verifiers MUST NOT consider signatures using RSA keys of
42728 less than 1024 bits as valid signatures.
42731 This is enforced by the default setting for the &%dkim_verify_min_keysizes%&
42736 In addition, two ACL conditions are provided:
42739 .vitem &%dkim_signers%&
42740 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of domains or identities
42741 for a match against the domain or identity that the ACL is currently verifying
42742 (reflected by &%$dkim_cur_signer%&).
42743 This condition is only usable in a DKIM ACL.
42744 This is typically used to restrict an ACL
42745 verb to a group of domains or identities. For example:
42748 # Warn when Mail purportedly from GMail has no gmail signature
42749 warn sender_domains = gmail.com
42750 dkim_signers = gmail.com
42752 log_message = GMail sender without gmail.com DKIM signature
42755 Note that the above does not check for a total lack of DKIM signing;
42756 for that check for empty &$h_DKIM-Signature:$& in the data ACL.
42758 .vitem &%dkim_status%&
42759 ACL condition that checks a colon-separated list of possible DKIM verification
42760 results against the actual result of verification,
42761 given by &$dkim_verify_status$& if that is non-empty or "none" if empty.
42762 This condition may be used in DKIM, MIME, PRDR and DATA ACLs.
42764 A basic verification might be:
42766 deny !dkim_status = pass:none:invalid
42769 A more complex use could be
42770 to restrict an ACL verb to a list of verification outcomes, for example:
42773 deny sender_domains = paypal.com:paypal.de
42774 dkim_signers = paypal.com:paypal.de
42775 dkim_status = none:invalid:fail
42776 message = Mail from Paypal with invalid/missing signature
42779 The possible status keywords are: 'none','invalid','fail' and 'pass'. Please
42780 see the documentation of the &%$dkim_verify_status%& expansion variable above
42781 for more information of what they mean.
42783 The condition is true if the status
42784 (or any of the list of status values)
42785 is any one of the supplied list.
42791 .section "SPF (Sender Policy Framework)" SECSPF
42792 .cindex SPF verification
42794 SPF is a mechanism whereby a domain may assert which IP addresses may transmit
42795 messages with its domain in the envelope from, documented by
42796 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc7208,RFC 7208).
42797 For more information on SPF see &url(http://www.open-spf.org), a static copy of
42798 the &url(http://openspf.org).
42799 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https, open-spf.org is told to be a
42800 . --- web-archive copy of the now dead openspf.org site
42801 . --- See https://www.mail-archive.com/mailop@mailop.org/msg08019.html for a
42804 Messages sent by a system not authorised will fail checking of such assertions.
42805 This includes retransmissions done by traditional forwarders.
42807 SPF verification support is built into Exim if SUPPORT_SPF=yes is set in
42808 &_Local/Makefile_&. The support uses the &_libspf2_& library
42809 &url(https://www.libspf2.org/).
42811 .cindex "dynamic modules"
42812 The support can be built as a dynamic-load module if desired;
42813 see the comments in that Makefile.
42816 There is no Exim involvement in the transmission of messages;
42817 publishing certain DNS records is all that is required.
42819 For verification, an ACL condition and an expansion lookup are provided.
42820 .cindex authentication "expansion item"
42821 Performing verification sets up information used by the
42822 &%authresults%& expansion item.
42825 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42826 .cindex ACL "spf condition"
42827 The ACL condition "spf" can be used at or after the MAIL ACL.
42828 It takes as an argument a list of strings giving the outcome of the SPF check,
42829 and will succeed for any matching outcome.
42833 The SPF check passed, the sending host is positively verified by SPF.
42836 The SPF check failed, the sending host is NOT allowed to send mail for the
42837 domain in the envelope-from address.
42839 .vitem &%softfail%&
42840 The SPF check failed, but the queried domain can't absolutely confirm that this
42844 The queried domain does not publish SPF records.
42847 The SPF check returned a "neutral" state. This means the queried domain has
42848 published a SPF record, but wants to allow outside servers to send mail under
42849 its domain as well. This should be treated like "none".
42851 .vitem &%permerror%&
42852 This indicates a syntax error in the SPF record of the queried domain.
42853 You may deny messages when this occurs.
42855 .vitem &%temperror%&
42856 This indicates a temporary error during all processing, including Exim's
42857 SPF processing. You may defer messages when this occurs.
42860 There was an error during processing of the SPF lookup
42863 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert
42864 its meaning, for example "!fail" will match all results but
42865 "fail". The string list is evaluated left-to-right, in a
42866 short-circuit fashion.
42871 message = $sender_host_address is not allowed to send mail from \
42872 ${if def:sender_address_domain \
42873 {$sender_address_domain}{$sender_helo_name}}. \
42874 Please see http://www.open-spf.org/Why;\
42875 identity=${if def:sender_address_domain \
42876 {$sender_address}{$sender_helo_name}};\
42877 ip=$sender_host_address
42880 Note: The above mentioned URL may not be as helpful as expected. You are
42881 encouraged to replace the link with a link to a site with more
42884 When the spf condition has run, it sets up several expansion
42887 .cindex SPF "verification variables"
42889 .vitem &$spf_header_comment$&
42890 .vindex &$spf_header_comment$&
42891 This contains a human-readable string describing the outcome
42892 of the SPF check. You can add it to a custom header or use
42893 it for logging purposes.
42895 .vitem &$spf_received$&
42896 .vindex &$spf_received$&
42897 This contains a complete Received-SPF: header (name and
42898 content) that can be added to the message. Please note that
42899 according to the SPF draft, this header must be added at the
42900 top of the header list, i.e. with
42902 add_header = :at_start:$spf_received
42904 See section &<<SECTaddheadacl>>& for further details.
42906 Note: in case of "Best-guess" (see below), the convention is
42907 to put this string in a header called X-SPF-Guess: instead.
42909 .vitem &$spf_result$&
42910 .vindex &$spf_result$&
42911 This contains the outcome of the SPF check in string form,
42912 currently one of pass, fail, softfail, none, neutral, permerror,
42913 temperror, or &"(invalid)"&.
42915 .vitem &$spf_result_guessed$&
42916 .vindex &$spf_result_guessed$&
42917 This boolean is true only if a best-guess operation was used
42918 and required in order to obtain a result.
42920 .vitem &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42921 .vindex &$spf_smtp_comment$&
42922 .vindex &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&
42923 This contains a string that can be used in a SMTP response
42924 to the calling party. Useful for "fail".
42925 The string is generated by the SPF library from the template configured in the main config
42926 option &%spf_smtp_comment_template%&.
42930 .cindex SPF "ACL condition"
42931 .cindex ACL "spf_guess condition"
42932 .cindex SPF "best guess"
42933 In addition to SPF, you can also perform checks for so-called
42934 "Best-guess". Strictly speaking, "Best-guess" is not standard
42935 SPF, but it is supported by the same framework that enables SPF
42937 Refer to &url(http://www.open-spf.org/FAQ/Best_guess_record)
42938 for a description of what it means.
42939 . --- 2019-10-28: still not https:
42941 To access this feature, simply use the spf_guess condition in place
42942 of the spf one. For example:
42945 deny spf_guess = fail
42946 message = $sender_host_address doesn't look trustworthy to me
42949 In case you decide to reject messages based on this check, you
42950 should note that although it uses the same framework, "Best-guess"
42951 is not SPF, and therefore you should not mention SPF at all in your
42954 When the spf_guess condition has run, it sets up the same expansion
42955 variables as when spf condition is run, described above.
42957 Additionally, since Best-guess is not standardized, you may redefine
42958 what "Best-guess" means to you by redefining the main configuration
42959 &%spf_guess%& option.
42960 For example, the following:
42963 spf_guess = v=spf1 a/16 mx/16 ptr ?all
42966 would relax host matching rules to a broader network range.
42969 .cindex SPF "lookup expansion"
42971 A lookup expansion is also available. It takes an email
42972 address as the key and an IP address
42977 ${lookup {username@domain} spf {ip.ip.ip.ip}}
42980 The lookup will return the same result strings as can appear in
42981 &$spf_result$& (pass,fail,softfail,neutral,none,err_perm,err_temp).
42987 .subsection "SRS (Sender Rewriting Scheme)" SECTSRS
42988 .cindex SRS "sender rewriting scheme"
42989 .cindex VERP "variable envelope return path"
42991 SRS can be used to modify sender addresses when forwarding so that
42992 SPF verification does not object to them.
42993 It can also be used to identify a received bounce message as
42994 likely (or not) having been trigged by a message from the
42995 local system, and for identifying dead addresses in mailing lists.
42996 It is one implementation of a VERP (Variable Envelope Return Path) method.
42998 SRS operates by encoding the original envelope sender in a new
42999 sender local part and using a domain run by the forwarding site
43000 as the new domain for the sender. Any DSN message should be returned
43001 to this new sender at the forwarding site, which can extract the
43002 original sender from the coded local part and forward the DSN to
43005 This is a way of avoiding the breakage that SPF does to forwarding.
43006 The constructed local-part will be longer than the original,
43007 leading to possible problems with very long addresses.
43008 The changing of the sender address also hinders the tracing of mail
43011 Exim can be built to include native SRS support. To do this
43012 SUPPORT_SRS=yes must be defined in &_Local/Makefile_&.
43013 If this has been done, the macros _HAVE_SRS and _HAVE_NATIVE_SRS
43015 The support is limited to SRS0-encoding; SRS1 is not supported.
43017 .cindex SRS excoding
43018 To encode an address use this expansion item:
43020 .vitem &*${srs_encode&~{*&<&'secret'&>&*}{*&<&'return&~path'&>&*}{*&<&'original&~domain'&>&*}}*&
43021 .cindex "&%srs_encode%& expansion item"
43022 .cindex SRS "expansion item"
43023 The first argument should be a secret known and used by all systems
43024 handling the recipient domain for the original message.
43025 There is no need to periodically change this key; a timestamp is also
43027 The second argument should be given as the envelope sender address before this
43028 encoding operation.
43029 If this value is empty the the expansion result will be empty.
43030 The third argument should be the recipient domain of the message when
43031 it arrived at this system.
43032 All arguments are expanded before use.
43034 The result of the expansion is the replacement envelope-from (return path)
43038 .cindex SRS decoding
43039 To decode an address use this expansion condition:
43041 .vitem &*inbound_srs&~{*&<&'local&~part'&>&*}{*&<&'secret'&>&*}*&
43042 The first argument should be the recipient local part as it was received.
43043 The second argument is the site secret.
43044 Both arguments are expanded before use.
43046 If the messages is not for an SRS-encoded recipient the condition will
43048 If it is, the condition will return true and the variable
43049 &$srs_recipient$& will be set to the decoded (original) value.
43051 If the second argument is empty then the condition returns true if
43052 the first argument is in valid SRS formet, else false.
43053 The variable &$srs_recipient$& is not set for this case.
43059 SRS_SECRET = <pick something unique for your site for this. Use on all MXs.>
43065 # if outbound, and forwarding has been done, use an alternate transport
43066 domains = ! +my_domains
43067 transport = ${if eq {$local_part@$domain} \
43068 {$original_local_part@$original_domain} \
43069 {remote_smtp} {remote_forwarded_smtp}}
43074 domains = +my_domains
43075 # detect inbound bounces which are SRS'd, and decode them
43076 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {SRS_SECRET}}
43077 data = $srs_recipient
43079 inbound_srs_failure:
43082 domains = +my_domains
43083 # detect inbound bounces which look SRS'd but are invalid
43084 condition = ${if inbound_srs {$local_part} {}}
43086 data = :fail: Invalid SRS recipient address
43088 #... further routers here get inbound_srs-redirected recipients
43089 # and any that were not SRS'd
43092 # transport; should look like the non-forward outbound
43093 # one, plus the max_rcpt and return_path options
43094 remote_forwarded_smtp:
43096 # single-recipient so that $original_domain is valid
43098 # modify the envelope from, for mails that we forward
43099 return_path = ${srs_encode {SRS_SECRET} {$return_path} {$original_domain}}
43106 .section DMARC SECDMARC
43107 .cindex DMARC verification
43109 DMARC combines feedback from SPF, DKIM, and header From: in order
43110 to attempt to provide better indicators of the authenticity of an
43111 email. This document does not explain the fundamentals; you
43112 should read and understand how it works by visiting the
43113 &url(http://www.dmarc.org/,DMARC website).
43115 If Exim is built with DMARC support,
43116 the libopendmarc library is used.
43118 For building Exim yourself, obtain the library from
43119 &url(http://sourceforge.net/projects/opendmarc/,sourceforge)
43120 to obtain a copy, or find it in your favorite package
43121 repository. You will need to attend to the local/Makefile feature
43122 SUPPORT_DMARC and the associated LDFLAGS addition.
43123 This description assumes
43124 that headers will be in /usr/local/include, and that the libraries
43125 are in /usr/local/lib.
43127 .subsection Configuration SSECDMARCCONFIG
43128 .cindex DMARC configuration
43130 There are three main-configuration options:
43131 .cindex DMARC "configuration options"
43133 The &%dmarc_tld_file%& option
43134 .oindex &%dmarc_tld_file%&
43135 defines the location of a text file of valid
43136 top level domains the opendmarc library uses
43137 during domain parsing. Maintained by Mozilla,
43138 the most current version can be downloaded
43139 from a link at &url(https://publicsuffix.org/list/public_suffix_list.dat).
43140 See also the util/renew-opendmarc-tlds.sh script.
43141 The default for the option is unset.
43143 It is expanded before use.
43144 If not set (or empty after expansion), DMARC processing is disabled.
43148 The &%dmarc_history_file%& option
43149 .oindex &%dmarc_history_file%&
43150 defines the location of a file to log results
43151 of dmarc verification on inbound emails. The
43152 contents are importable by the opendmarc tools
43153 which will manage the data, send out DMARC
43154 reports, and expire the data. Make sure the
43155 directory of this file is writable by the user
43157 The default for the option is unset.
43159 It is expanded before use.
43160 If not set (or empty after expansion), no history is written.
43163 The &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& option
43164 .oindex &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
43165 defines an alternate email address to use when sending a
43166 forensic report detailing alignment failures
43167 if a sender domain's dmarc record specifies it
43168 and you have configured Exim to send them.
43169 If set, this is expanded and used for the
43170 From: header line; the address is extracted
43171 from it and used for the envelope from.
43172 If not set (the default), the From: header is expanded from
43173 the dsn_from option, and <> is used for the
43176 .subsection Controls SSECDMARCCONTROLS
43177 .cindex DMARC controls
43179 By default, the DMARC processing will run for any remote,
43180 non-authenticated user. It makes sense to only verify DMARC
43181 status of messages coming from remote, untrusted sources. You can
43182 use standard conditions such as hosts, senders, etc, to decide that
43183 DMARC verification should *not* be performed for them and disable
43184 DMARC with an ACL control modifier:
43186 control = dmarc_disable_verify
43188 A DMARC record can also specify a "forensic address", which gives
43189 exim an email address to submit reports about failed alignment.
43190 Exim does not do this by default because in certain conditions it
43191 results in unintended information leakage (what lists a user might
43192 be subscribed to, etc). You must configure exim to submit forensic
43193 reports to the owner of the domain. If the DMARC record contains a
43194 forensic address and you specify the control statement below, then
43195 exim will send these forensic emails. It is also advised that you
43196 configure a &%dmarc_forensic_sender%& because the default sender address
43197 construction might be inadequate.
43199 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
43201 (AGAIN: You can choose not to send these forensic reports by simply
43202 not putting the dmarc_enable_forensic control line at any point in
43203 your exim config. If you don't tell exim to send them, it will not
43206 There are no options to either control. Both must appear before
43209 .subsection ACL SSECDMARCACL
43210 .cindex DMARC "ACL condition"
43212 DMARC checks can be run on incoming SMTP messages by using the
43213 &"dmarc_status"& ACL condition in the DATA ACL. You are required to
43214 call the &"spf"& condition first in the ACLs, then the &"dmarc_status"&
43215 condition. Putting this condition in the ACLs is required in order
43216 for a DMARC check to actually occur. All of the variables are set
43217 up before the DATA ACL, but there is no actual DMARC check that
43218 occurs until a &"dmarc_status"& condition is encountered in the ACLs.
43220 The &"dmarc_status"& condition takes a list of strings on its
43221 right-hand side. These strings describe recommended action based
43222 on the DMARC check. To understand what the policy recommendations
43223 mean, refer to the DMARC website above. Valid strings are:
43224 .itable none 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43225 .irow &'accept'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends accepting the email"
43226 .irow &'reject'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends rejecting the email"
43227 .irow &'quarantine'& "The DMARC check failed and the library recommends keeping it for further inspection"
43228 .irow &'none'& "The DMARC check passed and the library recommends no specific action, neutral"
43229 .irow &'norecord'& "No policy section in the DMARC record for this RFC5322.From field"
43230 .irow &'nofrom'& "Unable to determine the domain of the sender"
43231 .irow &'temperror'& "Library error or dns error"
43232 .irow &'off'& "The DMARC check was disabled for this email"
43234 You can prefix each string with an exclamation mark to invert its
43235 meaning, for example "!accept" will match all results but
43236 "accept". The string list is evaluated left-to-right in a
43237 short-circuit fashion. When a string matches the outcome of the
43238 DMARC check, the condition succeeds. If none of the listed
43239 strings matches the outcome of the DMARC check, the condition
43242 Of course, you can also use any other lookup method that Exim
43243 supports, including LDAP, Postgres, MySQL, etc, as long as the
43244 result is a list of colon-separated strings.
43246 Performing the check sets up information used by the
43247 &%authresults%& expansion item.
43249 Several expansion variables are set before the DATA ACL is
43250 processed, and you can use them in this ACL. The following
43251 expansion variables are available:
43254 .vitem &$dmarc_status$&
43255 .vindex &$dmarc_status$&
43256 .cindex DMARC result
43257 A one word status indicating what the DMARC library
43258 thinks of the email. It is a combination of the results of
43259 DMARC record lookup and the SPF/DKIM/DMARC processing results
43260 (if a DMARC record was found). The actual policy declared
43261 in the DMARC record is in a separate expansion variable.
43263 .vitem &$dmarc_status_text$&
43264 .vindex &$dmarc_status_text$&
43265 Slightly longer, human readable status.
43267 .vitem &$dmarc_used_domain$&
43268 .vindex &$dmarc_used_domain$&
43269 The domain which DMARC used to look up the DMARC policy record.
43271 .vitem &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
43272 .vindex &$dmarc_domain_policy$&
43273 The policy declared in the DMARC record. Valid values
43274 are "none", "reject" and "quarantine". It is blank when there
43275 is any error, including no DMARC record.
43278 .vitem &$dmarc_alignment_spf$&
43279 .vindex &$dmarc_alignment_spf$&
43280 The result of the SPF alignment portion of the test status;
43283 .vitem &$dmarc_alignment_dkim$&
43284 .vindex &$dmarc_alignment_dkim$&
43285 The result of the DKIM alignment portion of the test status;
43290 .subsection Logging SSECDMARCLOGGING
43291 .cindex DMARC logging
43293 By default, Exim's DMARC configuration is intended to be
43294 non-intrusive and conservative. To facilitate this, Exim will not
43295 create any type of logging files without explicit configuration by
43296 you, the admin. Nor will Exim send out any emails/reports about
43297 DMARC issues without explicit configuration by you, the admin (other
43298 than typical bounce messages that may come about due to ACL
43299 processing or failure delivery issues).
43301 In order to log statistics suitable to be imported by the opendmarc
43302 tools, you need to:
43304 Configure the global option &%dmarc_history_file%&
43306 Configure cron jobs to call the appropriate opendmarc history
43307 import scripts and truncating the dmarc_history_file
43310 In order to send forensic reports, you need to:
43312 Configure the global option &%dmarc_forensic_sender%&
43314 Configure, somewhere before the DATA ACL, the control option to
43315 enable sending DMARC forensic reports
43318 .subsection Example SSECDMARCEXAMPLE
43319 .cindex DMARC example
43324 warn domains = +local_domains
43325 hosts = +local_hosts
43326 control = dmarc_disable_verify
43328 warn !domains = +screwed_up_dmarc_records
43329 control = dmarc_enable_forensic
43331 warn condition = (lookup if destined to mailing list)
43332 set acl_m_mailing_list = 1
43335 warn dmarc_status = accept : none : off
43337 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: $dmarc_status $dmarc_used_domain
43339 warn dmarc_status = !accept
43341 log_message = DMARC DEBUG: '$dmarc_status' for $dmarc_used_domain
43343 warn dmarc_status = quarantine
43345 set $acl_m_quarantine = 1
43346 # Do something in a transport with this flag variable
43348 deny condition = ${if eq{$dmarc_domain_policy}{reject}}
43349 condition = ${if eq{$acl_m_mailing_list}{1}}
43350 message = Messages from $dmarc_used_domain break mailing lists
43352 deny dmarc_status = reject
43354 message = Message from $dmarc_used_domain failed sender's DMARC policy, REJECT
43356 warn add_header = :at_start:${authresults {$primary_hostname}}
43363 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43364 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43366 .chapter "Proxies" "CHAPproxies" &&&
43368 .cindex "proxy support"
43369 .cindex "proxy" "access via"
43371 A proxy is an intermediate system through which communication is passed.
43372 Proxies may provide a security, availability or load-distribution function.
43375 .section "Inbound proxies" SECTproxyInbound
43376 .cindex proxy inbound
43377 .cindex proxy "server side"
43378 .cindex proxy "Proxy protocol"
43379 .cindex "Proxy protocol" proxy
43381 Exim has support for receiving inbound SMTP connections via a proxy
43382 that uses &"Proxy Protocol"& to speak to it.
43383 To include this support, include &"SUPPORT_PROXY=yes"&
43386 It was built on the HAProxy specification, found at
43387 &url(https://www.haproxy.org/download/1.8/doc/proxy-protocol.txt).
43389 The purpose of this facility is so that an application load balancer,
43390 such as HAProxy, can sit in front of several Exim servers
43391 to distribute load.
43392 Exim uses the local protocol communication with the proxy to obtain
43393 the remote SMTP system IP address and port information.
43394 There is no logging if a host passes or
43395 fails Proxy Protocol negotiation, but it can easily be determined and
43396 recorded in an ACL (example is below).
43398 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%hosts_proxy%&
43399 main configuration option to a hostlist; connections from these
43400 hosts will use Proxy Protocol.
43401 Exim supports both version 1 and version 2 of the Proxy Protocol and
43402 automatically determines which version is in use.
43404 The Proxy Protocol header is the first data received on a TCP connection
43405 and is inserted before any TLS-on-connect handshake from the client; Exim
43406 negotiates TLS between Exim-as-server and the remote client, not between
43407 Exim and the proxy server. The Proxy Protocol header must be received
43408 within &%proxy_protocol_timeout%&, which defaults to 3s.
43410 The following expansion variables are usable
43411 (&"internal"& and &"external"& here refer to the interfaces
43413 .itable none 0 0 2 30* left 70* left
43414 .irow $proxy_external_address "IP of host being proxied or IP of remote interface of proxy"
43415 .irow $proxy_external_port "Port of host being proxied or Port on remote interface of proxy"
43416 .irow $proxy_local_address "IP of proxy server inbound or IP of local interface of proxy"
43417 .irow $proxy_local_port "Port of proxy server inbound or Port on local interface of proxy"
43418 .irow $proxy_session "boolean: SMTP connection via proxy"
43420 If &$proxy_session$& is set but &$proxy_external_address$& is empty
43421 there was a protocol error.
43422 The variables &$sender_host_address$& and &$sender_host_port$&
43423 will have values for the actual client system, not the proxy.
43425 Since the real connections are all coming from the proxy, and the
43426 per host connection tracking is done before Proxy Protocol is
43427 evaluated, &%smtp_accept_max_per_host%& must be set high enough to
43428 handle all of the parallel volume you expect per inbound proxy.
43429 With the option set so high, you lose the ability
43430 to protect your server from many connections from one IP.
43431 In order to prevent your server from overload, you
43432 need to add a per connection ratelimit to your connect ACL.
43433 A possible solution is:
43435 # Set max number of connections per host
43437 # Or do some kind of IP lookup in a flat file or database
43438 # LIMIT = ${lookup{$sender_host_address}iplsearch{/etc/exim/proxy_limits}}
43440 defer ratelimit = LIMIT / 5s / per_conn / strict
43441 message = Too many connections from this IP right now
43446 .section "Outbound proxies" SECTproxySOCKS
43447 .cindex proxy outbound
43448 .cindex proxy "client side"
43449 .cindex proxy SOCKS
43450 .cindex SOCKS proxy
43451 Exim has support for sending outbound SMTP via a proxy
43452 using a protocol called SOCKS5 (defined by
43453 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1928,RFC 1928)).
43454 The support can be optionally included by defining SUPPORT_SOCKS=yes in
43457 Use of a proxy is enabled by setting the &%socks_proxy%& option
43458 on an smtp transport.
43460 If unset (or empty after expansion) then proxying is not done.
43462 Otherwise, expansion should result in a list
43463 (colon-separated by default) of proxy specifiers.
43464 Each proxy specifier is a list
43465 (space-separated by default) where the initial element
43466 is an IP address and any subsequent elements are options.
43468 Each option is a string of form <name>=<value>.
43469 The list of options is in the following table:
43470 .itable none 0 0 2 10* left 90* left
43471 .irow &'auth'& "authentication method"
43472 .irow &'name'& "authentication username"
43473 .irow &'pass'& "authentication password"
43474 .irow &'port'& "tcp port"
43475 .irow &'tmo'& "connection timeout"
43476 .irow &'pri'& "priority"
43477 .irow &'weight'& "selection bias"
43480 More details on each of these options follows:
43483 .cindex authentication "to proxy"
43484 .cindex proxy authentication
43485 &%auth%&: Either &"none"& (default) or &"name"&.
43486 Using &"name"& selects username/password authentication per
43487 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc1929,RFC 1929)
43488 for access to the proxy.
43489 Default is &"none"&.
43491 &%name%&: sets the username for the &"name"& authentication method.
43494 &%pass%&: sets the password for the &"name"& authentication method.
43497 &%port%&: the TCP port number to use for the connection to the proxy.
43500 &%tmo%&: sets a connection timeout in seconds for this proxy.
43503 &%pri%&: specifies a priority for the proxy within the list,
43504 higher values being tried first.
43505 The default priority is 1.
43507 &%weight%&: specifies a selection bias.
43508 Within a priority set servers are queried in a random fashion,
43509 weighted by this value.
43510 The default value for selection bias is 1.
43513 Proxies from the list are tried according to their priority
43514 and weight settings until one responds. The timeout for the
43515 overall connection applies to the set of proxied attempts.
43517 .section Logging SECTproxyLog
43518 To log the (local) IP of a proxy in the incoming or delivery logline,
43519 add &"+proxy"& to the &%log_selector%& option.
43520 This will add a component tagged with &"PRX="& to the line.
43522 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43523 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43525 .chapter "Internationalisation" "CHAPi18n" &&&
43526 "Internationalisation""
43527 .cindex internationalisation "email address"
43530 .cindex utf8 "mail name handling"
43532 Exim has support for Internationalised mail names.
43533 To include this it must be built with SUPPORT_I18N and the libidn library.
43534 Standards supported are RFCs
43535 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2060.html,2060),
43536 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc5890.html,5890),
43537 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6530.html,6530) and
43538 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc6533.html,6533).
43540 If Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N_2008 (in addition to SUPPORT_I18N, not
43541 instead of it) then IDNA2008 is supported; this adds an extra library
43542 requirement, upon libidn2.
43544 .section "MTA operations" SECTi18nMTA
43545 .cindex SMTPUTF8 "ESMTP option"
43546 .cindex "ESMTP extensions" SMTPUTF8
43547 The main configuration option &%smtputf8_advertise_hosts%& specifies
43548 a host list. If this matches the sending host and
43549 accept_8bitmime is true (the default) then the ESMTP option
43550 SMTPUTF8 will be advertised.
43552 If the sender specifies the SMTPUTF8 option on a MAIL command
43553 international handling for the message is enabled and
43554 the expansion variable &$message_smtputf8$& will have value TRUE.
43556 The option &%allow_utf8_domains%& is set to true for this
43557 message. All DNS lookups are converted to a-label form
43558 whatever the setting of &%allow_utf8_domains%&
43559 when Exim is built with SUPPORT_I18N.
43561 Both localparts and domain are maintained as the original
43562 UTF-8 form internally; any comparison or regular-expression use will
43563 require appropriate care. Filenames created, eg. by
43564 the appendfile transport, will have UTF-8 names.
43566 HELO names sent by the smtp transport will have any UTF-8
43567 components expanded to a-label form,
43568 and any certificate name checks will be done using the a-label
43571 .cindex log protocol
43572 .cindex SMTPUTF8 logging
43573 .cindex i18n logging
43574 Log lines and Received-by: header lines will acquire a "utf8"
43575 prefix on the protocol element, eg. utf8esmtp.
43577 The following expansion operators can be used:
43579 ${utf8_domain_to_alabel:str}
43580 ${utf8_domain_from_alabel:str}
43581 ${utf8_localpart_to_alabel:str}
43582 ${utf8_localpart_from_alabel:str}
43585 .cindex utf8 "address downconversion"
43586 .cindex i18n "utf8 address downconversion"
43588 may use the following modifier:
43590 control = utf8_downconvert
43591 control = utf8_downconvert/<value>
43593 This sets a flag requiring that envelope addresses are converted to
43594 a-label form before smtp delivery.
43595 This is usually for use in a Message Submission Agent context,
43596 but could be used for any message.
43598 If a value is appended it may be:
43599 .itable none 0 0 2 5* right 95* left
43600 .irow &`1`& "mandatory downconversion"
43601 .irow &`0`& "no downconversion"
43602 .irow &`-1`& "if SMTPUTF8 not supported by destination host"
43604 If no value is given, 1 is used.
43606 If mua_wrapper is set, the utf8_downconvert control
43607 is initially set to -1.
43609 The smtp transport has an option &%utf8_downconvert%&.
43610 If set it must expand to one of the three values described above,
43611 or an empty string.
43612 If non-empty it overrides value previously set
43613 (due to mua_wrapper or by an ACL control).
43616 There is no explicit support for VRFY and EXPN.
43617 Configurations supporting these should inspect
43618 &$smtp_command_argument$& for an SMTPUTF8 argument.
43620 There is no support for LMTP on Unix sockets.
43621 Using the "lmtp" protocol option on an smtp transport,
43622 for LMTP over TCP, should work as expected.
43624 There is no support for DSN unitext handling,
43625 and no provision for converting logging from or to UTF-8.
43629 .section "MDA operations" SECTi18nMDA
43630 To aid in constructing names suitable for IMAP folders
43631 the following expansion operator can be used:
43633 ${imapfolder {<string>} {<sep>} {<specials>}}
43636 The string is converted from the charset specified by
43637 the "headers charset" command (in a filter file)
43638 or &%headers_charset%& main configuration option (otherwise),
43640 modified UTF-7 encoding specified by
43641 &url(https://www.rfc-editor.org/rfc/rfc2060.html,RFC 2060),
43642 with the following exception: All occurrences of <sep>
43643 (which has to be a single character)
43644 are replaced with periods ("."), and all periods and slashes that are not
43645 <sep> and are not in the <specials> string are BASE64 encoded.
43647 The third argument can be omitted, defaulting to an empty string.
43648 The second argument can be omitted, defaulting to "/".
43650 This is the encoding used by Courier for Maildir names on disk, and followed
43651 by many other IMAP servers.
43655 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}} `& yields &`Foo.Bar`&
43656 &`${imapfolder {Foo/Bar}{.}{/}} `& yields &`Foo&&AC8-Bar`&
43657 &`${imapfolder {Räksmörgås}} `& yields &`R&&AOQ-ksm&&APY-rg&&AOU-s`&
43660 Note that the source charset setting is vital, and also that characters
43661 must be representable in UTF-16.
43664 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43665 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43667 .chapter "Events" "CHAPevents" &&&
43671 The events mechanism in Exim can be used to intercept processing at a number
43672 of points. It was originally invented to give a way to do customised logging
43673 actions (for example, to a database) but can also be used to modify some
43674 processing actions.
43676 Most installations will never need to use Events.
43677 The support can be left out of a build by defining DISABLE_EVENT=yes
43678 in &_Local/Makefile_&.
43680 There are two major classes of events: main and transport.
43681 The main configuration option &%event_action%& controls reception events;
43682 a transport option &%event_action%& controls delivery events.
43684 Both options are a string which is expanded when the event fires.
43685 An example might look like:
43686 .cindex logging custom
43688 event_action = ${if eq {msg:delivery}{$event_name} \
43689 {${lookup pgsql {SELECT * FROM record_Delivery( \
43690 '${quote_pgsql:$sender_address_domain}',\
43691 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$sender_address_local_part}}', \
43692 '${quote_pgsql:$domain}', \
43693 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$local_part}}', \
43694 '${quote_pgsql:$host_address}', \
43695 '${quote_pgsql:${lc:$host}}', \
43696 '${quote_pgsql:$message_exim_id}')}} \
43700 Events have names which correspond to the point in process at which they fire.
43701 The name is placed in the variable &$event_name$& and the event action
43702 expansion must check this, as it will be called for every possible event type.
43705 The current list of events is:
43706 .itable all 0 0 4 25* left 10* center 15* center 50* left
43707 .row auth:fail after both "per driver per authentication attempt"
43708 .row dane:fail after transport "per connection"
43709 .row dns:fail after both "per lookup"
43710 .row msg:complete after main "per message"
43711 .row msg:defer after transport "per message per delivery try"
43712 .row msg:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43713 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer after transport "per recipient per host"
43714 .row msg:rcpt:defer after transport "per recipient"
43715 .row msg:host:defer after transport "per host per delivery try; host errors"
43716 .row msg:fail:delivery after transport "per recipient"
43717 .row msg:fail:internal after main "per recipient"
43718 .row tcp:connect before transport "per connection"
43719 .row tcp:close after transport "per connection"
43720 .row tls:cert before both "per certificate in verification chain"
43721 .row tls:fail:connect after main "per connection"
43722 .row smtp:connect after transport "per connection"
43723 .row smtp:ehlo after transport "per connection"
43724 .row smtp:fail:protocol after main "per connection"
43725 .row smtp:fail:syntax after main "per connection"
43728 New event types may be added in future.
43730 The event name is a colon-separated list, defining the type of
43731 event in a tree of possibilities. It may be used as a list
43732 or just matched on as a whole. There will be no spaces in the name.
43734 The second column in the table above describes whether the event fires
43735 before or after the action is associates with. Those which fire before
43736 can be used to affect that action (more on this below).
43738 The third column in the table above says what section of the configuration
43739 should define the event action.
43741 An additional variable, &$event_data$&, is filled with information varying
43742 with the event type:
43744 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43745 .row auth:fail "smtp response"
43746 .row dane:fail "failure reason"
43747 .row dns:fail "failure reason, key and lookup-type"
43748 .row msg:defer "error string"
43749 .row msg:delivery "smtp confirmation message"
43750 .row msg:fail:internal "failure reason"
43751 .row msg:fail:delivery "smtp error message"
43752 .row msg:host:defer "error string"
43753 .row msg:rcpt:host:defer "error string"
43754 .row msg:rcpt:defer "error string"
43755 .row tls:cert "verification chain depth"
43756 .row tls:fail:connect "error string"
43757 .row smtp:connect "smtp banner"
43758 .row smtp:ehlo "smtp ehlo response"
43759 .row smtp:fail:protocol "error string"
43760 .row smtp:fail:syntax "error string"
43764 The :defer events populate one extra variable: &$event_defer_errno$&.
43766 For complex operations an ACL expansion can be used in &%event_action%&,
43767 however due to the multiple contexts that Exim operates in during
43768 the course of its processing:
43770 variables set in transport events will not be visible outside that
43773 acl_m variables in a server context are lost on a new connection,
43774 and after smtp helo/ehlo/mail/starttls/rset commands
43776 Using an ACL expansion with the logwrite modifier can be
43777 a useful way of writing to the main log.
43779 The expansion of the event_action option should normally
43780 return an empty string. Should it return anything else the
43781 following will be forced:
43782 .itable all 0 0 2 20* left 80* left
43783 .row auth:fail "log information to write"
43784 .row tcp:connect "do not connect"
43785 .row tls:cert "refuse verification"
43786 .row smtp:connect "close connection"
43788 All other message types ignore the result string, and
43789 no other use is made of it.
43791 For a tcp:connect event, if the connection is being made to a proxy
43792 then the &$host_address$& and &$host_port$& variables
43793 will be that of the proxy and not the target system.
43795 For tls:cert events, if GnuTLS is in use this will trigger only per
43796 chain element received on the connection.
43797 For OpenSSL it will trigger for every chain element including those
43800 For dns:fail events from dnsdb lookups, a &"defer_never"& option does not
43801 affect the reporting of DNS_AGAIN.
43803 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43804 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43806 .chapter "Adding new drivers or lookup types" "CHID13" &&&
43807 "Adding drivers or lookups"
43808 .cindex "adding drivers"
43809 .cindex "new drivers, adding"
43810 .cindex "drivers" "adding new"
43811 The following actions have to be taken in order to add a new router, transport,
43812 authenticator, or lookup type to Exim:
43815 Choose a name for the driver or lookup type that does not conflict with any
43816 existing name; I will use &"newdriver"& in what follows.
43818 Add to &_src/EDITME_& the line:
43820 <&'type'&>&`_NEWDRIVER=yes`&
43822 where <&'type'&> is ROUTER, TRANSPORT, AUTH, or LOOKUP. If the
43823 code is not to be included in the binary by default, comment this line out. You
43824 should also add any relevant comments about the driver or lookup type.
43826 Add to &_src/config.h.defaults_& the line:
43828 #define <type>_NEWDRIVER
43831 Edit &_src/drtables.c_&, adding conditional code to pull in the private header
43832 and create a table entry as is done for all the other drivers and lookup types.
43834 Edit &_scripts/lookups-Makefile_& if this is a new lookup; there is a for-loop
43835 near the bottom, ranging the &`name_mod`& variable over a list of all lookups.
43836 Add your &`NEWDRIVER`& to that list.
43837 As long as the dynamic module would be named &_newdriver.so_&, you can use the
43838 simple form that most lookups have.
43840 Edit &_Makefile_& in the appropriate sub-directory (&_src/routers_&,
43841 &_src/transports_&, &_src/auths_&, or &_src/lookups_&); add a line for the new
43842 driver or lookup type and add it to the definition of OBJ.
43844 Edit &_OS/Makefile-Base_& adding a &_.o_& file for the predefined-macros, to the
43845 definition of OBJ_MACRO. Add a set of line to do the compile also.
43847 Create &_newdriver.h_& and &_newdriver.c_& in the appropriate sub-directory of
43850 Edit &_scripts/MakeLinks_& and add commands to link the &_.h_& and &_.c_& files
43851 as for other drivers and lookups.
43854 Then all you need to do is write the code! A good way to start is to make a
43855 proforma by copying an existing module of the same type, globally changing all
43856 occurrences of the name, and cutting out most of the code. Note that any
43857 options you create must be listed in alphabetical order, because the tables are
43858 searched using a binary chop procedure.
43860 There is a &_README_& file in each of the sub-directories of &_src_& describing
43861 the interface that is expected.
43866 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43867 . ////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43869 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43870 . These lines are processing instructions for the Simple DocBook Processor that
43871 . Philip Hazel has developed as a less cumbersome way of making PostScript and
43872 . PDFs than using xmlto and fop. They will be ignored by all other XML
43874 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43879 foot_right_recto="&chaptertitle;"
43880 foot_right_verso="&chaptertitle;"
43884 .makeindex "Options index" "option"
43885 .makeindex "Variables index" "variable"
43886 .makeindex "Concept index" "concept"
43889 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////
43890 . /////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////////